diff options
| -rw-r--r-- | .gitattributes | 3 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 12847-0.txt | 10329 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 12847-h/12847-h.htm | 13740 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | LICENSE.txt | 11 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | README.md | 2 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/12847-0.txt | 10704 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/12847-0.zip | bin | 0 -> 192533 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/12847-h.zip | bin | 0 -> 195951 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/12847-h/12847-h.htm | 14199 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/old/12847.txt | 10368 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | old/old/12847.zip | bin | 0 -> 191119 bytes |
11 files changed, 59356 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6833f05 --- /dev/null +++ b/.gitattributes @@ -0,0 +1,3 @@ +* text=auto +*.txt text +*.md text diff --git a/12847-0.txt b/12847-0.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..5cbdc07 --- /dev/null +++ b/12847-0.txt @@ -0,0 +1,10329 @@ +*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 12847 *** + +Havelok the Dane: A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln. + +By Charles W. Whistler, M.R.C.S. + + + + +CONTENTS + + PREFACE. + CHAPTER I. GRIM THE FISHER AND HIS SONS. + CHAPTER II. KING HODULF’S SECRET. + CHAPTER III. HAVELOK, SON OF GUNNAR. + CHAPTER IV. ACROSS THE SWAN’S PATH. + CHAPTER V. STORM AND SHIPWRECK. + CHAPTER VI. THE BEGINNING OF GRIMSBY TOWN. + CHAPTER VII. BROTHERHOOD. + CHAPTER VIII. BERTHUN THE COOK. + CHAPTER IX. CURAN THE PORTER. + CHAPTER X. KING ALSI OF LINDSEY. + CHAPTER XI. THE COMING OF THE PRINCESS. + CHAPTER XII. IN LINCOLN MARKETPLACE. + CHAPTER XIII. THE WITAN’S FEASTING. + CHAPTER XIV. THE CRAFT OF ALSI THE KING. + CHAPTER XV. THE FORTUNE OF CURAN THE PORTER. + CHAPTER XVI. A STRANGEST WEDDING. + CHAPTER XVII. HOW THE BRIDE WENT HOME. + CHAPTER XVIII. JARL SIGURD OF DENMARK. + CHAPTER XIX. THE LAST OF GRIFFIN OF WALES. + CHAPTER XX. THE OWNING OF THE HEIR. + CHAPTER XXI. THE TOKEN OF SACK AND ANCHOR. + CHAPTER XXII. KING ALSI’S WELCOME. + CHAPTER XXIII. BY TETFORD STREAM. + CHAPTER XXIV. PEACE, AND FAREWELL. + + + + +PREFACE. + + +If any excuse is needed for recasting the ancient legend of Grim the +fisher and his foster-son Havelok the Dane, it may be found in the +fascination of the story itself, which made it one of the most popular +legends in England from the time of the Norman conquest, at least, to +that of Elizabeth. From the eleventh to the thirteenth centuries it +seems to have been almost classic; and during that period two full +metrical versions—one in Norman-French and the other in English—were +written, besides many other short versions and abridgments, which still +exist. These are given exhaustively by Professor Skeat in his edition +of the English poem for the Early English Text Society, and it is +needless to do more than refer to them here as the sources from which +this story is gathered. + +These versions differ most materially from one another in names and +incidents, while yet preserving the main outlines of the whole history. +It is evident that there has been a far more ancient, orally-preserved +tradition, which has been the original of the freely-treated poems and +concise prose statements of the legend which we have. And it seems +possible, from among the many variations, and from under the disguise +of the mediaeval forms in which it has been hidden, to piece together +what this original may have been, at least with some probability. + +We have one clue to the age of the legend of Havelok in the statement +by the eleventh-century Norman poet that his tale comes from a British +source, which at least gives a very early date for the happenings +related; while another version tells us that the king of “Lindesie” was +a Briton. Welsh names occur, accordingly, in several places; and it is +more than likely that the old legend preserved a record of actual +events in the early days of the Anglo-Saxon settlement in England, when +there were yet marriages between conquerors and conquered, and the +origins of Angle and Jute and Saxon were not yet forgotten in the +pedigrees of the many petty kings. + +One of the most curious proofs of the actual British origin of the +legend is in the statement that the death of Havelok’s father occurred +as the result of a British invasion of Denmark for King Arthur, by a +force under a leader with the distinctly Norse name of Hodulf. The +claim for conquest of the north by Arthur is very old, and is repeated +by Geoffrey of Monmouth, and may well have originated in the +remembrance of some successful raid on the Danish coasts by the Norse +settlers in the Gower district of Pembrokeshire, in company with a +contingent of their Welsh neighbours. + +This episode does not occur in the English version; but here an attack +on Havelok on his return home to Denmark is made by men led by one +Griffin, and this otherwise unexplainable survival of a Welsh name +seems to connect the two accounts in some way that recalls the ancient +legend at the back of both. + +I have therefore treated the Welsh element in the story as deserving a +more prominent place, at least in subsidiary incidents, than it has in +the two old metrical versions. It has been possible to follow neither +of these exactly, as in names and details they are widely apart; but to +one who knows both, the sequence of events will, I think, be clear +enough. + +I have, for the same reason of the British origin of the legend, +preferred the simple and apposite derivation of the name of “Curan,” +taken by the hero during his servitude, from the Welsh _Cwran_, “a +wonder,” to the Norman explanation of the name as meaning a “scullion,” +which seems to be rather a guess, based on the menial position of the +prince, than a translation. + +For the long existence of a Welsh servile population in the lowlands of +Lincolnshire there is evidence enough in the story of Guthlac of +Crowland, and the type may still be found there. There need be little +excuse for claiming some remains of their old Christianity among them, +and the “hermit” who reads the dream for the princess may well have +been a half-forgotten Welsh priest. But the mediaeval poems have +Christianized the ancient legend, until it would seem to stand in +somewhat the same relationship to what it was as the German +“Niebelungen Lied” does to the “Volsunga Saga.” + +With regard to the dreams which recur so constantly, I have in the case +of the princess transferred the date of hers to the day previous to her +marriage, the change only involving a difference of a day, but seeming +to he needed, as explanatory of her sudden submission to her guardian. +And instead of crediting Havelok with the supernatural light bodily, it +has been transferred to the dream which seems to haunt those who have +to do with him. + +As to the names of the various characters, they are in the old versions +hardly twice alike. I have, therefore, taken those which seem to have +been modernized from their originals, or preserved by simple +transliteration, and have set them back in what seems to have been +their first form. Gunther, William, and Bertram, for instance, seem to +be modernized from Gunnar, Withelm, and perhaps Berthun; while Sykar, +Aunger, and Gryme are but alternative English spellings of the northern +Sigurd, Arngeir, and Grim. + +The device on Havelok’s banner in chapter xxi. is exactly copied from +the ancient seal of the Corporation of Grimsby,[1] which is of the date +of Edward the First. The existence of this is perhaps the best proof +that the story of Grim and Havelok is more than a romance. Certainly +the Norse “Heimskringla” record claims an older northern origin for the +town than that of the Danish invasion of Alfred’s time; and the +historic freedom of its ships from toll in the port of Elsinore has +always been held to date from the days of its founder. + +The strange and mysterious “blue stones” of Grimsby and Louth are yet +in evidence, and those of the former town are connected by legend with +Grim. Certainly they have some very ancient if long-forgotten +associations, and it is more than likely that they have been brought as +“palladia” with the earliest northern settlers. A similar stone exists +in the centre of the little East Anglian town of Harleston, with a +definite legend of settlement attached to it; and there may be others. +The Coronation Stone of Westminster and the stone in Kingston-on-Thames +are well-known proofs of the ancient sanctity that surrounded such +objects for original reasons that are now lost. + +The final battle at Tetford, with its details, are from the Norman +poem. The later English account is rounded off with the disgrace and +burning alive of the false guardian; but for many reasons the earlier +seems to be the more correct account. Certainly the mounds of some +great forgotten fight remain in the Tetford valley, and Havelok is said +to have come to “Carleflure,” which, being near Saltfleet, and on the +road to Tetford, may be Canton, where there is a strong camp of what is +apparently Danish type. + +Those who can read with any comfort the crabbed Norman-French and Early +English poetic versions will see at once where I have added incidents +that may bring the story into a connected whole, as nearly as possible +on the old Saga lines; and those readers to whom the old romance is new +will hardly wish that I should pull the story to pieces again, to no +purpose so far as they are concerned. And, at least, for a fairly free +treatment of the subject, I have the authority of those previous +authors whom I have mentioned. + +In the different versions, the founder of Grimsby is variously +described as a steward of the Danish king’s castle, a merchant, a +fisher, and in the English poem—probably because it was felt that none +other would have undertaken the drowning of the prince—as a thrall. +Another version gives no account of the sack episode, but says that +Grim finds both queen and prince wandering on the shore. Grim the +fisher is certainly a historic character in his own town, and it has +not been hard to combine the various callings of the worthy +foster-father of Havelok and the troubles of both mother and son. A +third local variant tells that Havelok was found at Grimsby by the +fisher adrift in an open boat; and I have given that boat also a place +in the story, in a different way. + +The names of the kings are too far lost to be set back in their place +in history, but Professor Skeet gives the probable date of Havelok and +Grim as at the end of the sixth century, with a possible identification +of the former with the “governor of Lincoln” baptized by Paulinus. I +have, therefore, assumed this period where required. But a legend of +this kind is a romance of all time, and needs no confinement to date +and place. Briton and Saxon, Norman and Englishman, and maybe Norseman +and Dane, have loved the old story, and with its tale of right and love +triumphant it still has its own power. + +Stockland, _1899_ + +Chas. W. Whistler + + + + +CHAPTER I. +GRIM THE FISHER AND HIS SONS. + + +This story is not about myself, though, because I tell of things that I +have seen, my name must needs come into it now and then. The man whose +deeds I would not have forgotten is my foster-brother, Havelok, of whom +I suppose every one in England has heard. Havelok the Dane men call him +here, and that is how he will always be known, as I think. + +He being so well known, it is likely that some will write down his +doings, and, not knowing them save by hearsay, will write them wrongly +and in different ways, whereof will come confusion, and at last none +will be believed. Wherefore, as he will not set them down himself, it +is best that I do so. Not that I would have anyone think that the +penmanship is mine. Well may I handle oar, and fairly well axe and +sword, as is fitting for a seaman, but the pen made of goose feather is +beyond my rough grip in its littleness, though I may make shift to use +a sail-needle, for it is stiff and straightforward in its ways, and no +scrawling goeth therewith. + +Therefore my friend Wislac, the English priest, will be the penman, +having skill thereto. I would have it known that I can well trust him +to write even as I speak, though he has full leave to set aside all +hard words and unseemly, such as a sailor is apt to use unawares; and +where my Danish way of speaking goeth not altogether with the English, +he may alter the wording as he will, so long as the sense is always the +same. Then, also, will he read over to me what he has written, and +therefore all may be sure that this is indeed my true story. + + +Now, as it is needful that one begins at the beginning, it happens that +the first thing to be told is how I came to be Havelok’s +foster-brother, and that seems like beginning with myself after all. +But all the story hangs on this, and so there is no help for it. + +If it is asked when this beginning might be, I would say, for an +Englishman who knows not the names of Danish kings, that it was before +the first days of the greatness of Ethelbert of Kent, the overlord of +all England, the Bretwalda, and therefore, as Father Wislac counts, +about the year of grace 580. But King Ethelbert does not come into the +story, nor does the overlord of all Denmark; for the kings of whom I +must speak were under-kings, though none the less kingly for all that. +One must ever be the mightiest of many; and, as in England, there were +at that time many kings in Denmark, some over wide lands and others +over but small realms, with that one who was strong enough to make the +rest pay tribute to him as overlord, and only keeping that place by the +power of the strong hand, not for any greater worth. + +Our king on the west coast of Denmark, where the story of Havelok the +Dane must needs begin, was Gunnar Kirkeban—so called because, being a +heathen altogether, as were we all in Denmark at that time, he had been +the bane of many churches in the western isles of Scotland, and in +Wales and Ireland, and made a boast thereof. However, that cruelty of +his was his own bane in the end, as will be seen. Otherwise he was a +well-loved king and a great warrior, tall, and stronger than any man in +Denmark, as was said. His wife, the queen, was a foreigner, but the +fairest of women. Her name was Eleyn, and from this it was thought that +she came from the far south. Certainly Gunnar had brought her back from +Gardariki,[2] whither he had gone on a trading journey one year. Gunnar +and she had two daughters and but one son, and that son was Havelok, at +this time seven years old. + +Next to the king came our own lord, Jarl Sigurd, older than Gunnar, and +his best counsellor, though in the matter of sparing harmless and +helpless church folk his advice was never listened to. His hall was +many miles from the king’s place, southward down the coast. + +Here, too, lived my father, Grim, with us in a good house which had +been his father’s before him. Well loved by Jarl Sigurd was Grim, who +had ever been his faithful follower, and was the best seaman in all the +town. He was also the most skilful fisher on our coasts, being by birth +a well-to-do freeman enough, and having boats of his own since he could +first sail one. At one time the jarl had made him steward of his house; +but the sea drew him ever, and he waxed restless away from it. +Therefore, after a time, he asked the jarl’s leave to take to the sea +again, and so prospered in the fishery that at last he bought a large +trading buss from the Frisian coast, and took to the calling of the +merchant. + +So for some years my father, stout warrior as he proved himself in many +a fight at his lord’s side, traded peacefully—that is, so long as men +would suffer him to do so; for it happened more than once that his ship +was boarded by Vikings, who in the end went away, finding that they had +made a mistake in thinking that they had found a prize in a harmless +trader, for Grim was wont to man his ship with warriors, saying that +what was worth trading was worth keeping. I mind me how once he came to +England with a second cargo, won on the high seas from a Viking’s +plunder, which the Viking brought alongside our ship, thinking to add +our goods thereto. Things went the other way, and we left him only an +empty ship, which maybe was more than he would have spared to us. That +was on my second voyage, when I was fifteen. + +Mostly my father traded to England, for there are few of the Saxon kin +who take ship for themselves, and the havens to which he went were +Tetney and Saltfleet, on the Lindsey shore of Humber, where he soon had +friends. + +So Grim prospered and waxed rich fast, and in the spring of the year +wherein the story begins was getting the ship ready for the first +cruise of the season, meaning to be afloat early; for then there was +less trouble with the wild Norse Viking folk, for one cruise at least. +Then happened that which set all things going otherwise than he had +planned, and makes my story worth telling. + +We—that is my father Grim, Leva my mother, my two brothers and myself, +and our two little sisters, Gunhild and Solva—sat quietly in our great +room, busy at one little thing or another, each in his way, before the +bright fire that burned on the hearth in the middle of the floor. There +was no trouble at all for us to think of more than that the wind had +held for several weeks in the southwest and northwest, and we wondered +when it would shift to its wonted springtide easting, so that we could +get the ship under way once more for the voyage she was prepared for. +Pleasant talk it was, and none could have thought that it was to be the +last of many such quiet evenings that had gone before. + +Yet it seemed that my father was uneasy, and we had been laughing at +him for his silence, until he said, looking into the fire, “I will tell +you what is on my mind, and then maybe you will laugh at me the more +for thinking aught of the matter. Were I in any but a peaceful land, I +should say that a great battle had been fought not so far from us, and +to the northward.” + +Then my mother looked up at him, knowing that he had seen many fights, +and was wise in the signs that men look for before them; but she asked +nothing, and so I said, “What makes you think this, father?” + +He answered me with another question. + +“How many kites will you see overhead at any time, sons?” + +I wondered at this, but it was easy to answer—to Raven, at least. + +“Always one, and sometimes another within sight of the first,” Raven +said. + +“And if there is food, what then?” + +“The first swoops down on it, and the next follows, and the one that +watches the second follows that, and so on until there are many kites +gathered.” + +“What if one comes late?” + +“He swings overhead and screams, and goes back to his place; then no +more come.” + +“Ay,” he said; “you will make a sailor yet, son Raven, for you watch +things. Now I will tell you what I saw today. There was the one kite +sailing over my head as I was at the ship garth, and presently it +screamed so that I looked up. Then it left its wide circles over the +town, and flew northward, straight as an arrow. Then from the southward +came another, following it, and after that another, and yet others, all +going north. And far off I could see where others flew, and they too +went north. And presently flapped over me the ravens in the wake of the +kites, and the great sea eagles came in screaming and went the same +way, and so for all the time that I was at the ship, and until I came +home.” + +“There is a sacrifice to the Asir somewhere,” I said, “for the birds of +Odin and Thor have always their share.” + +My father shook his head. + +“The birds cry to one another, as I think, and say when the feast is +but enough for those that have gathered. They have cried now that there +is room for all at some great feasting. Once have I seen the like +before, and that was when I was with the ship guard when the jarl +fought his great battle in the Orkneys; we knew that he had fought by +the same token.” + +But my mother said that I was surely right. There was no fear of battle +here, and indeed with Gunnar and Sigurd to guard the land we had had +peace for many a long year on our own coasts, if other lands had had to +fear them. My father laughed a little, saying that perhaps it was so, +and then my mother took the two little ones and went with them into the +sleeping room to put them to rest, while I and my two brothers went out +to the cattle garth to see that all was well for the night. + +Then, when our eyes were used to the moonlight, which was not very +bright, away to the northward we saw a red glow that was not that of +the sunset or of the northern lights, dying down now and then, and then +again flaring up as will a far-off fire; and even as we looked we heard +the croak of an unseen raven flying thitherward overhead. + +“Call father,” I said to Withelm, who was the youngest of us three. The +boy ran in, and presently my father came out and looked long at the +glow in the sky. + +“Even as I thought,” he said. “The king’s town is burning, and I must +go to tell the jarl. Strange that we have had no message. Surely the +king’s men must be hard pressed if this is a foe’s work.” + +So he went at once, leaving us full of wonder and excited, as boys will +be at anything that is new and has a touch of fear in it. But he had +hardly gone beyond the outbuildings when one came running and calling +him. The jarl had sent for him, for there was strange news from the +king. Then he and this messenger hastened off together. + +In half an hour the war horns were blowing fiercely, and all the quiet +town was awake, for my father’s forebodings were true, and the foe was +on us. In our house my mother was preparing the food that her husband +should carry with him, and I was putting a last polish on the arms that +should keep him, while the tramp of men who went to the gathering rang +down the street, one by one at first, and then in twos and threes. My +mother neither wept nor trembled, but worked with a set face that would +not show fear. + +Then came in my father, and I armed him, begging at the same time that +I might go also, for I could use _my_ weapons well enough; but he told +me that some must needs bide at home as a guard, and that I was as much +wanted there as at the king’s place, wherewith I had to be content. It +was by no means unlikely that we also might be attacked, if it was true +that the king’s men were outnumbered, as was said. + +Now when my father went to say farewell to us, nowhere could be found +my brother Withelm. + +“The boy has gone to watch the muster,” my father said. “I shall see +him there presently.” + +Then, because he saw that my mother was troubled more than her wont, he +added, “Have no fear for me. This will be no more than a raid of +Norsemen, and they will plunder and be away with the tide before we get +to the place.” + +So he laughed and went out, having done his best to cheer us all, and I +went with him to where the men were gathered in their arms in the wide +space in the midst of the houses. There I sought for little Withelm, +but could not find him among the women and children who looked on; and +before we had been there more than a few minutes the jarl gave the +word, and the march was begun. There were about fifteen miles to be +covered between our town and the king’s. + +I watched them out of sight, and then went home, having learned that I +was to be called out only in case of need. And as I drew near the +homestead I saw a light in the little ash grove that was behind the +garth.[3] In the midst of the trees, where this light seemed to be, was +our wooden image of Thor the Hammer Bearer, older than any of us could +tell; and in front of this was what we used as his altar—four +roughly-squared stones set together. These stones were blue-black in +colour, and whence they came I do not know, unless it was true that my +forefathers brought them here when first Odin led his folk to the +northern lands. Always they had been the altar for my people, and my +father held that we should have no luck away from them. + +So it was strange to see a light in that place, where none would +willingly go after dark, and half was I feared to go and see what it +might mean. But then it came into my mind that the enemy might be +creeping on the house through the grove, and that therefore I must +needs find out all about it. So I went softly to the nearest trees, and +crept from one to another, ever getting closer to the light; and I will +say that I feared more that I might see some strange thing that was +more than mortal than that I should see the leading foeman stealing +towards me. But presently it was plain that the light did not move as +if men carried it, but it flickered as a little fire; and at last I saw +that it burned on the altar stones, and that frightened me so that I +almost fled. + +Maybe I should have done so, but that I heard a voice that I knew; and +so, looking once more, I saw a figure standing before the fire, and +knew it. It was little Withelm, and why a ten-year-old boy should be +here I could not think. But I called him softly, and he started +somewhat, turning and trying to look through the darkness towards me, +though he did not seem afraid. There was a little fire of dry sticks +burning on the stones, and the gaunt old statue seemed to look more +terrible than ever in its red blaze. One might have thought that the +worn face writhed itself as the light played over it. + +“It is I, Withelm,” I said softly, for the fear of the place was on me. +“We have sought you everywhere, and father would have wished you +farewell. What are you doing here?” + +I came forward then, for it was plain that the child feared nothing, so +that I was put to shame. And as I came I asked once more what he was +doing in this place. + +“The jarl has surely forgotten the sacrifice to the Asir before the +warriors went to fight, and they will be angry,” he answered very +calmly. “It is right that one should remember, and I feared for father, +and therefore—” + +He pointed to the altar, and I saw that he had laid his own untasted +supper on the fire that he had lighted, and I had naught to say. The +thing was over-strange to me, who thought nothing of these things. It +was true that the host always sacrificed before sailing on the Viking +path, but tonight had been urgent haste. + +“Thor will not listen to any but a warrior,” I said. “Come home, +brother, for mother waits us.” + +“If not Thor, who is maybe busy at the battle they talk of, then do I +think that All Father will listen,” he said stoutly. “But this was all +that I had to make sacrifice withal, and it may not be enough.” + +“The jarl will make amends when he comes back,” I said, wishing to get +home and away from this place, and yet unwilling to chide the child. +“Now let us go, for mother will grow anxious.” + +With that he put his hand in mine, and we both saluted Thor, as was +fitting, and then went homeward. It seemed to me that the glare in the +north was fiercer now than when I had first seen it. + +Now, after my mother had put Withelm to bed, I told her how I had found +him; and thereat she wept a little, as I could see in the firelight. + +After a long silence she said, “Strange things and good come into the +mind of a child, and one may learn what his fate shall be in the days +to come. I am sure from this that Withelm will be a priest.” + +Now as one may buy the place of a godar, with the right to have a +temple of the Asir for a district and the authority that goes +therewith, if so be that one falls vacant or is to be given up by the +holder, this did not seem unlikely, seeing how rich we were fast +growing. And indeed my mother’s saying came to pass hereafter, though +not at all in the way of which we both thought. + +There was no alarm that night. The old warriors watched round the town +and along the northern tracks, but saw nothing, and in the morning the +black smoke hung over the place of the burning, drifting slowly +seaward. The wind had changed, and they said that it would doubtless +have taken the foe away with it, as my father had hoped. So I went down +to the ship with Raven, and worked at the few things that were still +left to be done to her as she lay in her long shed on the slips, ready +to take the water at any tide. She was only waiting for cargo and +stores to be put on board her with the shift of wind that had come at +last, and I thought that my father would see to these things as soon as +he came back. + +Now in the evening we had news from the Jarl, and strange enough it +was. My father came back two days afterwards and told us all, and so I +may as well make a short story of it. The ways of Gunnar Kirkeban had +been his end, for a certain Viking chief, a Norseman, had wintered in +Wales during the past winter, and there he had heard from the Welsh of +the wrongs that they had suffered at his hands. Also he had heard of +the great booty of Welsh gold that Gunnar had taken thence in the last +summer; and so, when these Welsh asked that he would bide with them and +help fight the next Danes who came, he had offered to do more than +that—he would lead them to Gunnar’s place if they would find men to man +three ships that he had taken, and would be content to share the booty +with them. + +The Welsh king was of the line of Arthur, and one who yet hoped to win +back the land of his fathers from the Saxons and English; and so he +listened to this Hodulf, thinking to gain a powerful ally in him for +attack on the eastern coast of England after this. So, favoured by the +wind that had kept us from the sea, Hodulf, with twenty ships in all, +had fallen on Gunnar unawares, and had had an easy victory, besetting +the town in such wise that only in the confusion while the wild Welsh +were burning and plundering on every side had the messenger to the jarl +been able to slip away. + +But when the jarl and our men reached the town there was naught to be +done but to make terms with Hodulf as best he might, that the whole +country might not be overrun. For Gunnar had been slain in his own +hall, with his two young daughters and with the queen also, as was +supposed. Havelok the prince was in his hands, and for his sake +therefore Sigurd had been the more ready to come to terms. + +Then Hodulf sent messengers to the overlord of all Denmark, saying that +he would hold this kingdom as for him, and backed up that promise with +a great present from Gunnar’s treasure, so that he was listened to. +Therefore our jarl was helpless; and there being no other king strong +enough to aid him if he rose, in the end he had to take Hodulf for lord +altogether, though it went sorely against the grain. + +I have heard it said by the Welsh folk that Hodulf held the kingdom for +their lord; and it is likely that he humoured them by saying that he +would do so, which was a safe promise to make, as even King Arthur +himself could never have reached him to make him pay scatt. + + + + +CHAPTER II. +KING HODULF’S SECRET. + + +My father came home heavy and anxious enough, for he did not know how +things would go under this new king, though he had promised peace to +all men who would own him. We in our place saw nothing of him or his +men for the next few weeks, but he was well spoken of by those who had +aught to do with him elsewhere. So my father went on trying to gather a +cargo for England; but it was a slow business, as the burnt and +plundered folk of the great town had naught for us, and others sold to +them. But he would never be idle, and every day when weather served we +went fishing, for he loved his old calling well, as a man will love +that which he can do best. Our two boats and their gear were always in +the best of order, and our kinsman, Arngeir, used and tended them when +we were away in the ship in summertime. + +Now, one evening, as we came up from the shore after beaching the boat +on the hard below the town, and half a mile from the nearest houses, +and being, as one may suppose, not altogether in holiday trim, so that +Grim and his boys with their loads of fish and nets looked as though a +fisher’s hovel were all the home that they might own, we saw a +horseman, followed at a little distance by two more, riding towards us. +The dusk was gathering, and at first we thought that this was Jarl +Sigurd, who would ask us maybe to send fish to his hall, and so we set +our loads down and waited for him. + +But it was not our lord, and I had never seen this man before. From his +arms, which were of a new pattern to me, he might be one of the host of +Hodulf, as I thought. + +“Ho, fisher!” he cried, when he was yet some way from us; “leave your +lads, and come hither. I have a word for you.” + +He reined up and waited, and now I was sure that he was a Norseman, for +his speech was rougher than ours. He was a tall, handsome man enough; +but I liked neither his voice nor face, nor did I care to hear Grim, my +father, summoned in such wise, not remembering that just now a stranger +could not tell that he was aught but a fisher thrall of the jarl’s. + +But my father did as he was asked, setting down the nets that he was +carrying, and only taking with him the long boathook on which he had +slung them as he went forward. I suppose he remembered the old saying, +that a man should not stir a step on land without his weapons, as one +never knows when there may be need of them; and so, having no other, he +took this. + +I heard the first questions that the man asked, for he spoke loudly. + +“Whose man are you?” + +“Sigurd’s,” answered my father shortly. + +“Whose are the boats?” + +“Mine, seeing that I built them.” + +“Why, then, there is somewhat that you can do for me,” the horseman +said. “Is your time your own, however?” + +“If the jarl needs me not.” + +“Tonight, then?” + +“I have naught to do after I have carried the nets home.” + +“That is well,” said the stranger; and after that he dropped his voice +so that I heard no more, but he and my father talked long together. + +We waited, and at last the talk ended, and my father came hack to us, +while the stranger rode away northward along the sands. Then I asked +who the man was, and what he wanted. + +“He is some chief of these Norsemen, and one who asks more questions of +a thrall, as he thinks me, than he would dare ask Sigurd the jarl, or +Grim the merchant either, for that matter.” + +Seeing that my father did not wish to say more at this time, we asked +nothing else, but went homeward in silence. It seemed as if he was ill +at ease, and he went more quickly than was his wont, so that presently +Raven and little Withelm lagged behind us with their burdens, for our +catch had been a good one. + +Then he stopped outside the garth when we reached home, and told me not +to go in yet. And when the others came up he said to them, “Do you two +take in the things and the fish, and tell mother that Radbard and I +have to go down to the ship. There is cargo to be seen to, and it is +likely that we shall he late, so bid her not wait up for us.” + +Then he told me to come, and we left the two boys at once and turned +away towards the haven. There was nothing strange in this, for cargo +often came at odd times, and we were wont to work late in stowing it. I +did wonder that we had not stayed to snatch a bit of supper, but it +crossed my mind that the Norseman had told my father of some goods that +had maybe been waiting for the whole day while we were at sea. And then +that did not seem likely, for he had taken us for thralls. So I was +puzzled, but held my peace until it should seem good to my father to +tell me what we were about. + +When we reached a place where there was no house very near and no man +about, he said to me at last, “What is on hand I do not rightly know, +but yon man was Hodulf, the new king, as I suppose we must call him. He +would not tell me his name, but I saw him when he and the jarl made +terms the other day. Now he has bidden me meet him on the road a mile +from the town as soon as it is dark, and alone. He has somewhat secret +for me to do.” + +“It is a risk to go alone and unarmed,” I answered; “let me go home and +get your weapons, for the errand does not seem honest.” + +“That is what I think also,” said my father, “and that is why I am +going to meet him. It is a bad sign when a king has a secret to share +with a thrall, and I have a mind to find out what it is. There may be +some plot against our jarl.” + +He was silent for a few minutes, as if thinking, and then he went on. + +“I cannot take arms, or he would suspect me, and would tell me nothing; +but if there is any plotting to be done whereof I must tell the jarl, +it will be as well that you should hear it.” + +Then he said that he thought it possible for me to creep very close to +the place where he was to meet Hodulf, so that I could hear all or most +of what went on, and that I might as well be armed in case of foul +play, for he did not suppose that the Norseman would think twice about +cutting down a thrall who did not please him. + +It was almost dark by this time, and therefore he must be going. I was +not to go home for arms, but to borrow from Arngeir as we passed his +house. And this I did, saying that I had an errand beyond the town and +feared prowling men of the Norse host. Which danger being a very +reasonable one, Arngeir offered to go with me; and I had some +difficulty in preventing him from doing so, for he was like an elder +brother to all of us. However, I said that I had no great distance to +go, and feigned to be ashamed of myself for my fears; and he laughed at +me, and let me go my way with sword and spear and seax[4] also, which +last my father would take under his fisher’s jerkin. + +I caught up my father quickly, and we went along the sands northwards +until we came to the place where we must separate. The road was but a +quarter of a mile inland from this spot, for it ran near the shore, and +it was not much more than that to the place where Hodulf would be +waiting. + +“Creep as near as you can,” my father said; “but come to help only if I +call. I do not think that I am likely to do so.” + +Then we went our ways, he making straight for the road, and I turning +to my left a little. It was dark, for there was no moon now, but save +that I was soundly scratched by the brambles of the fringe of brushwood +that grew all along the low hills of the coast, there was nothing to +prevent my going on quickly, for I knew the ground well enough, by +reason of yearly bird nesting. When I reached the roadway the meeting +place was yet to my left, and I could hear my father’s footsteps coming +steadily in the distance. So I skirted the road for a little way, and +then came to an open bit of heath and rising land, beyond which I +thought I should find Hodulf. Up this I ran quickly, dropping into the +heather at the top; and sure enough, in a hollow just off the road I +could dimly make out the figure of a mounted man waiting. + +Then my father came along the road past me, and I crawled among the +tall heather clumps until I was not more than twenty paces from the +hollow, which was a little below me. + +Hodulf’s horse winded me, as I think, and threw up its head snorting, +and I heard its bit rattle. But my father was close at hand, and that +was lucky. + +“Ho, fisher, is that you?” he called softly. + +“I am here,” was the answer, and at once my father came into the hollow +from the road. + +“Are any folk about?” Hodulf said. + +“I have met none. Now, what is all this business?” answered my father. + +“Business that will make a free man of you for the rest of your days, +and rich, moreover, master thrall,” said Hodulf. “That is, if you do as +I bid you.” + +“A thrall can do naught else than what he is bidden.” + +“Nay, but he can do that in a way that will earn great reward, now and +then; and your reward for obedience and silence thereafter in this +matter shall be aught that you like to ask.” + +“This sounds as if I were to peril my life,” my father said. “I know +naught else that can be worth so much as that might be.” + +“There is no peril,” said Hodulf scornfully; “your skin shall not be so +much as scratched—ay, and if this is well done it will know a master’s +dog whip no more.” + +I heard my father chuckle with a thrall’s cunning laugh at this, and +then he said eagerly, “Well, master, what is it?” + +“I will tell you. But first will you swear as on the holy ring that of +what you shall do for me no man shall know hereafter?” + +“What I do at your bidding none shall know, and that I swear,” answered +my father slowly, as if trying to repeat the king’s words. + +“See here, then,” said Hodulf, and I heard his armour clatter as he +dismounted. + +Then the footsteps of both men shuffled together for a little while, +and once I thought I heard a strange sound as of a muffled cry, at +which Hodulf muttered under his breath. I could see that they took +something large from the saddle bow, and set it on the ground, and then +they spoke again. + +“Have you a heavy anchor?” asked the king. + +“A great one.” + +“Well, then, tie it to this sack and sink it tonight where tide will +never shift it. Then you may come to me and claim what reward you +will.” + +“Freedom, and gold enough to buy a new boat—two new boats!” said my +father eagerly. + +Hodulf laughed at that, and got on his horse again. I saw his tall form +lift itself against the dim sky as he did so. + +“What is in the sack?” asked my father. + +“That is not your concern,” Hodulf answered sharply. “If you know not, +then you can tell no man, even in your sleep. Put off at once and sink +it.” + +“It is in my mind,” said my father, “that I had better not look in the +sack. Where shall I find you, lord, when the thing is in the sea? For +as yet I have not heard your name.” + +I think that Hodulf had forgotten that he would have to answer this +question, or else he thought that everyone knew him, for he did not +reply all at once. + +“You may ask the king for your reward,” he said, after a little +thought, “for this is his business. Now you know that it will be best +for you to be secret and sure. Not much worth will your chance of +escape from torture be if this becomes known. But you know also that +the reward is certain.” + +“The king!” cried my father, with a sort of gasp of surprise. + +I could almost think that I saw him staring with mouth agape as would a +silly thrall; for so well had he taken the thrall’s part that had I not +known who was speaking all the time, I had certainly had no doubt that +one was there. + +“Come to Hodulf, the king, and pray for freedom and your gold as a boon +of his goodness, saying naught else, or making what tale you will of a +hard master, or justice, so that you speak naught of what you have +done, and that—and maybe more—shall be granted.” + +“You yourself will speak for me?” + +“I am the king—and think not that the darkness will prevent my knowing +your face again,” Hodulf replied. + +There was a threat in the words, and with them he turned his horse and +rode away quickly northwards. I heard the hoofs of his men’s horses +rattle on the road as they joined him, before he had gone far. + +When the sounds died away altogether, and there was no fear of his +coming back suddenly on us, my father whistled and I joined him. He +almost started to find how near I was. + +“You have heard all, then?” he said. + +“Every word,” I answered, “and I like it not. Where is this sack he +spoke of?” + +It lay at his feet. A large sack it was, and full of somewhat heavy and +warm that seemed to move a little when I put my hand on it. Still less +did I like the business as I felt that. + +“More also!” quoth my father, as if thinking of the king’s last words. +“If that does not mean a halter for my neck, I am mistaken. What have +we here, son, do you think?” + +“Somewhat that should not be here, certainly,” I answered. “There would +not be so much talk about drowning a dog, as one might think this to +be.” + +“Unless it were his wife’s,” answered my father, with a laugh. + +Then he stooped, and I helped him to get the sack on his shoulders. It +was heavy, but not very—not so heavy as a young calf in a sack would +be; and he carried it easily, taking my spear to help him. + +“The thrall is even going to take this to the house of Grim the +merchant, whom the king will not know again, though he may see in the +dark,” said he; “then we shall know how we stand.” + +We met no one on our way back, for the town had gone to sleep, until +the watchman passed the time of night with us, thinking no doubt that +we had fish or goods in the burden. And when we came home a sleepy +thrall opened to us, for all were at rest save him. And he too went his +way to the shed where his place was when he had stirred the fire to a +blaze and lit a torch that we might see to eat the supper that was left +for us. + +Then we were alone, and while I set Arngeir’s weapons in a corner, my +father put down the sack, and stood looking at it. It seemed to sway a +little, and to toss as it settled down. And now that there was light it +was plain that the shape of what was inside it was strangely like that +of a child, doubled up with knees to chin, as it showed through the +sacking. + +“Hodulf or no Hodulf,” said my father, “I am going to see more of +this.” + +With that he took a knife from the table and cut the cord that fastened +the mouth, turning back the sack quickly. + +And lo! gagged and bound hand and foot in such wise that he could not +move, in the sack was a wondrously handsome boy of about the size of +Withelm; and for all his terrible journey across the king’s saddle, and +in spite of our rough handling, his eyes were bright and fearless as he +looked up at us. + +“Radbard,” said my father, “what if Hodulf had met with a thrall who +had done his bidding in truth?” + +I would not think thereof, for surely by this time there had been no +light in the eyes that seemed to me to be grateful to us. + +Now my father knelt down by the boy’s side, and began to take the +lashings from him, telling him at the same time to be silent when the +gag was gone. + +And hard work enough the poor child had to keep himself from screaming +when his limbs were loosed, so cramped was he, for he had been bound +almost into a ball. And even as we rubbed and chafed the cold hands and +feet he swooned with the pain of the blood running freely once more. + +“This is a business for mother,” said my father, on that; “get your +supper, and take it to bed with you, and say naught to the boys in the +morning. This is a thing that may not be talked of.” + +Now I should have liked to stay, but my father meant what he said, and +I could be of no more use; so I took my food, and went up to the loft +where we three slept, and knew no more of what trouble that night might +have for others. + + + + +CHAPTER III. +HAVELOK, SON OF GUNNAR. + + +Now after I had gone, Grim, my father, tried to bring the child round, +but he could not do so; and therefore, leaving him near the fire, he +went softly to call Leva, my mother, to help him; and all the while he +was wondering who the child might be, though indeed a fear that he knew +only too well was growing in his heart, for there would surely he only +one whom Hodulf could wish out of his way. + +As he opened the door that led to the sleeping room beyond the high +seat, the light shone on Leva, and showed her sitting up in bed with +wide eyes that seemed to gaze on somewhat that was terrible, and at +first he thought her awake. But she yet slept, and so he called her +gently, and she started and woke. + +“Husband, is that you?” she said. “I had a strange dream even now which +surely portends somewhat.” + +Now, as all men know, our folk in the north are most careful in the +matter of attending to dreams, specially those that come in troubled +times, holding that often warning or good counsel comes from them. I +cannot say that I have ever had any profit in that way myself, being no +dreamer at all; but it is certain that others have, as may be seen +hereafter. Wherefore my father asked Leva what this dream might be. + +“In my dream,” she answered, “it seemed that you came into the house +bearing a sack, which you gave into my charge, saying that therein lay +wealth and good fortune for us. And I would not believe this, for you +said presently that to gain this the sack and all that was therein was +to be thrown into the sea, which seemed foolishness. Whereon I cast it +into a corner in anger, and thereout came pitiful cries and wailings. +Then said I that it were ill to drown aught that had a voice as of a +child, and so you bade me leave it. Then I seemed to sleep here; but +presently in my dream I rose and looked on the sack again, and lo! +round about it shone a great light, so that all the place was bright, +and I was afraid. Then you came and opened the sack, and therein was a +wondrous child, from whose mouth came a flame, as it were the shaft of +a sunbeam, that stretched over all Denmark, and across the sea to +England, whereby I knew that this child was one who should hereafter be +king of both these lands. And on this I stared even as you woke me.” + +Now Grim was silent, for this was passing strange, and moreover it +fitted with his thought of who this child might be, since Hodulf. would +make away with him thus secretly. + +“What make you of the dream?” asked Leva, seeing that he pondered on +it. + +“It is in my mind that your dream will come true altogether, for +already it has begun to do so,” he answered. “Rise and come into the +hall, and I will show you somewhat.” + +On that Leva made haste and dressed and came out, and there, lying as +if in sleep before the fire, was the wondrous child of her dream, and +the sack was under his head as he lay; and she was wont to say to those +few who knew the story, that the kingliness of that child was plain to +be seen, as had been the flame of which she had dreamed, so that all +might know it, though the clothes that he wore were such as a churl +might be ashamed of. + +Then she cried out a little, but not loudly, and knelt by the child to +see him the better; and whether he had come to himself before and had +dropped asleep for very weariness, or out of his swoon had passed into +sleep, I cannot say, but at her touch he stirred a little. + +“What child is this? and how came he here?” she asked, wondering. + +“Already your dream has told you truly how he came,” Grim answered, +“but who he is I do not rightly know yet. Take him up and bathe him, +wife; and if he is the one I think him, there will be a mark whereby we +may know him.” + +“How should he be marked? And why look you to find any sign thus?” + +But Grim had turned down the rough shirt and bared the child’s neck and +right shoulder, whereon were bruises that made Leva well-nigh weep as +she saw them, for it was plain that he had been evilly treated for many +days before this. But there on the white skin was the mark of the +king’s line—the red four-armed cross with bent ends which Gunnar and +all his forebears had borne. + +Seeing that, Leva looked up wondering in her husband’s face, and he +answered the question that he saw written in her eyes. + +“He is as I thought—he is Havelok, the son of Gunnar, our king. Hodulf +gave him to me that I might drown him.” + +Then he told her all that had happened, and how from the first time +that he had lifted the sack and felt what was within it he had feared +that this was what was being done. Hodulf would have no rival growing +up beside him, and as he dared not slay him openly, he would have it +thought that he had been stolen away by his father’s friends, and then +folk would maybe wait quietly in hopes that he would come again when +time went on. + +Now Leva bathed Havelok in the great tub, and with the warmth and +comfort of the hot water he waked and was well content, so that +straightway, when he was dressed in Withelm’s holiday clothes, which +fitted him, though he was but seven years old at this time, and Withelm +was a well-grown boy enough for his ten winters, he asked for food, and +they gave him what was yet on the board; and we lived well in Denmark. + +“There is no doubt that he hath a kingly hunger,” quoth Grim as he +watched him. + +“Friend,” said Havelok, hearing this, though it was not meant for his +ears, “it is likely, seeing that this is the third day since I have had +food given me. And I thank you, good people, though I would have you +know that it is the custom to serve the king’s son kneeling.” + +“How should we know that you are the king’s son indeed?” asked Grim. + +“I am Havelok, son of Gunnar,” the boy said gravely. “Yon traitor, +Hodulf, has slain my father, and my two sisters, and driven out my +mother, whither I cannot tell, and now he would drown me.” + +Then the boy could hardly keep a brave front any longer, and he added, +“Yet I do not think that you will do to me as I heard him bid you.” + +Then came over Grim a great pity and sorrow that it should seem needful +thus to sue to him, and there grew a lump in his throat, so that for a +while he might not answer, and the boy thought him in doubt, so that in +his eyes there was a great fear. But Leva wept outright, and threw +herself on her knees beside him, putting her arms round him as he sat, +speaking words of comfort. + +Then Grim knelt also, and said, “Thralls of yours are we, Havelok, son +of Gunnar, and for you shall our lives be given before Hodulf shall +harm you. Nor shall he know that you live until the day comes when you +can go to him sword in hand and helm on head, with half the men of this +realm at your back, and speak to him of what he did and what he +planned, and the vengeance that shall be therefor.” + +So Grim took on himself to be Havelok’s foster-father, and, as he +ended, the boy said with glowing eyes, “I would that I were grown up. +How long shall this be before it comes to pass?” + +And then of a sudden he said, as a tired child will, “Friends, I am +sorely weary. Let me sleep.” + +So Leva took him in her arms and laid him in their own bed; and at once +he slept, so that she left him and came back to Grim by the fireside, +for there was much to be said. + +First of all it was clear that Havelok must be hidden, and it was not +to be supposed that Hodulf would be satisfied until he had seen the +thrall to whom he had trusted such a secret come back for his reward. +If he came not he would be sought; and then he would find out to whom +he had spoken, and there would be trouble enough. + +But it seemed easy to hide Havelok on board the ship, and sail with him +to England as soon as possible. A few days might well pass before a +thrall could get to Hodulf, so that he would suspect nothing just at +first. There were merchants in England who would care for the boy well, +and the two boats might be sunk, so that the king should not ask whose +they were. So when Grim came home again the fisher would be thought of +as drowned on his errand, and Hodulf would be content. + +But then, after a little talk of this, it was plain that all the town +could not be told to say that the fisher was drowned on such a night, +and Hodulf would leave naught undone to find the truth of the matter. +So the puzzle became greater, and the one thing that was clear was that +Grim was in sore danger, and Havelok also. + +Then suddenly outside the dogs barked, and a voice which they obeyed +quieted them. Grim sprang for his axe, which hung on the wall, and went +to the door, whereon someone was knocking gently. + +“Open, uncle; it is I, Arngeir.” + +“What does the boy want at this time?” said Grim, taking down the great +bar that kept the door, axe in hand, for one must be cautious in such +times as these. + +Arngeir came in—a tall young man of twenty, handsome, and like Grim in +ways, for he was his brother’s son. + +“Lucky am I in finding you astir,” he said. “I thought I should have +had to wake you all. Are you just home from sea, or just going out?” + +“Not long home,” answered Leva; “but what has brought you?” + +“I have a guest for you, if I may bring one here at this hour.” + +“A friend of yours never comes at the wrong time,” Grim said. “Why not +bring him in?” + +“If it were a friend of mine and a man he would do well enough at my +house for the night,” said Arngeir, smiling; “but the one for whom I +have come is a lady, and, I think, one in sore trouble.” + +“Who is she?” asked my mother, wondering much. + +“From the king’s town, certainly,” answered Arngeir, “but I do not know +her name. Truth to tell, I forgot to ask it, for she is sorely spent; +and so I made haste to come to you.” + +Then Leva would know how a lady came at this time to Arngeir’s house, +for he was alone, save for his four men, being an orphan without other +kin beside us, and his house was close to our shipyard and the sea. + +“She came not to me, but I found her,” he replied. “My horse is sick, +and I must get up an hour ago and see to it for the second time +tonight. Then as I came from the stable I saw someone go towards the +shipyard, and, as I thought, into the open warehouse. It was dark, and +I could not tell then if this was man or woman; but I knew that no one +had business there, and there are a few things that a thief might pick +up. So I took an axe and one of the dogs, and went to see what was on +hand, but at first there was naught to be found of anyone. If it had +not been for the dog, I think that I should have gone away, but he went +into the corner where the bales of wool are set, and there he whined +strangely, and when I looked, there was this lady on the bales, and she +was weeping and sore afraid. So I asked her what was amiss, and it was +not easy to get an answer at first. But at last she told me that she +had escaped from the burning of the king’s town, and would fain be +taken across the sea into some place of peace. So I cheered her by +saying that you would surely help her; and then I took her to my house +and came to you. Worn and rent are her garments, but one may see that +they have been rich, and I deem her some great lady.” + +“Go and bring her here, husband,” said my mother, on hearing that. + +But he was already going, and at once he and Arngeir went out and down +the street. There were many other ladies and their children who had +taken refuge here with the townsfolk after the burning, and the coming +of this one was but another count in the long tale of trouble that +began on the Welsh shore with the ways of Gunnar, the church’s bane. + +My father was long gone, and the day was breaking when he came back. My +mother slept in the great chair before the fire, for waiting had +wearied her, but she woke as she heard Grim’s footstep, and unbarred +the door to him, ready to welcome the guest that she looked for. But he +was alone, and on his face was the mark of some new trouble, and that a +great one. + +He came in and barred the door after him, and then sat down wearily and +ate for the first time since we had had our meal at sea; and while he +did so Leva asked him nothing, wondering what was wrong, but knowing +that she would hear in good time. And when he had eaten well he spoke. + +“The lady is Eleyn the queen. She has been wandering for these many +days from place to place, sometimes in the woods, and sometimes in +hiding in the cottages of the poor folk, always with a fear of staying +in one place, lest Hodulf should find her, for it is known that he is +seeking her. Then at last one told her of my ship, and she is here to +seek me.” + +Now one may know what the wonder and pity of my mother was, and she +would fain have gone to her. But Grim had left her at Arngeir’s house, +for folk were stirring in the town, and there were many who would know +the queen if they saw her. + +“It will soon be known that Arngeir has a guest,” my mother said, +“whereas none would have wondered had she been here.” + +“By this time tomorrow it will not matter if Hodulf knows,” answered +Grim, “for she will be safe.” + +“Where will you hide her then and what of Havelok?” + +“For those two there is no safety but across the sea, and they are the +most precious cargo that I shall ever have carried. Already Arngeir and +the men are at work on the ship, getting the rollers under her keel, +that she may take the water with the next tide. I shall sail with the +tide that comes with the darkness again, saying that I shall find cargo +elsewhere in other ports, as I have done once before.” + +“I had not looked to say farewell to you quite so soon,” my mother +said; “but this is right. Now I will have all things ready, that the +queen shall be in what comfort she may on the voyage. But it will be +well that none shall know, even of your seamen, who the passengers are, +else will word go to Hodulf in some way hereafter that Havelok has +escaped.” + +“I have thought of that,” answered Grim. “It will be best that none, +not even Radbard, shall know who this is whom we have in the house. A +chance word goes far sometimes.” + +“The boy will tell his name.” + +“There are many who are named after him, and that is no matter. Do you +speak to him, for it is plain that he has sense enough, and bid him say +naught but that he and his mother have escaped from the town, and, if +you will, that he escaped in the sack. I will speak to Radbard, and +there will be no trouble. Only Arngeir must know the truth, and that +not until we are on the high seas perhaps.” + +So there seemed to be no more fear, and in an hour the house was astir, +and there was work enough for all in preparing for the voyage. As for +me, I went down to the ship with my father, and worked there. + +Now, I will say that not for many a long year did I know who this +foster-brother of mine was. It was enough for me to be told that he was +the son of some great man or other with whom Hodulf had a private feud. +Nor did I ever speak of that night’s work to any, for my father bade me +not to do so. Presently I knew, of course, that the lady was Havelok’s +mother; but that told me nothing, for I never heard her name. + +We worked at the ship for three hours or so, stowing the bales of wool +and the other little cargo we had; and then my father sent me to the +fishing-boats for a pair of oars belonging to the ship’s boat that were +there, and, as it fell out, it was a good thing that I and not one of +the men went. When I came to the place where they were drawn up on the +beach, as we had left them last night, there was a stranger talking to +some of the fisher folk, who were working at their nets not far off; +and though another might have paid no heed to this, I, with the +remembrance of last night fresh in my mind, wondered if he was by any +chance there on an errand from Hodulf. I thought that, were I he, I +should surely send someone to know, at least, if the fisher went out +last night after I had spoken with him. So I loitered about until the +man went away, which he did slowly, passing close to me, and looking at +the boats carefully, as if he would remember them. Then I went and +asked the men to whom he had been speaking what he wanted. They said +that they wondered that he had not spoken to me, for he had been asking +about my father and of his ship, and if he took any passenger with him +this voyage. It would seem that he wanted to sail with us, from all he +said. + +Certainly he had begun by asking whose boats these were, and wondered +that a merchant should go fishing at all, when there was no need for +him to do so. Also he had asked if Grim had been out last night, and +they had of course told him that he had not, for neither boat had been +shifted from the berth she had been given when we came in at dusk. + +“Ah,” he had said, “well did I wot that your merchant would do no night +work,” and so made a jest of the matter, saying that in his country it +were below the state of a merchant to have aught to do with a thrall’s +work. He was certainly a Norseman, and they thought that I should find +him with my father. Now I thought otherwise, and also I saw that all +was known. This man was a spy of Hodulf’s, and would go straight back +to his master. My father must hear of this at once; and I hurried back +to the ship, and took him aside and told him. And as I did so his face +grew grey under the tan that sea and wind had given it, and I knew not +altogether why. + +“Tell Arngeir to come to me,” he said; “I am going to the jarl. Tell no +one, but go home and say to mother that I shall be with her in an hour. +Then come back and work here.” + +Then he and Arngeir went to Sigurd, and told him all from the +beginning. And when the jarl heard, he was glad for the safety of the +queen and of Havelok, but he said that there was no doubt that Denmark +was no place for Grim any longer. + +“That is my thought also,” said my father; “but now am I Havelok’s +foster-father, and for him I can make a home across the sea, where I +will train him up for the time that shall surely come, when he shall +return and take his father’s kingdom.” + +“That is well,” the jarl said, “but you have little time. What Hodulf +will do one cannot say, but he may come here with his men behind him to +force me to give you up, and the town will be searched for Havelok, and +both he and the queen will be lost.” + +“If that is so,” my father answered, “we have time enough. Two hours +for the spy to reach his master; one hour for Hodulf to hear him, and +to bethink himself; an hour for gathering his men; and four hours, at +the least, in which to get here. Eight hours, at the least, have we, +and the tide serves in six. I had thought of waiting till dark, but +that is of no use now. We may as well go, for there are true men here, +who will wait to welcome him who flies when he comes again.” + +“This is a sore wrench for you and yours, good friend and faithful,” +Sigurd said, “but it must be. Nevertheless I can make your loss as +little as it may be. You shall sell all that is yours to me at your own +price, that you may have the means to make a new home well, wherever +you may choose.” + +At first my father would not have that, saying that there would be much +trouble on his account presently. + +But Sigurd said that, first, the trouble was not of his making at all; +and next, that if Hodulf plundered the place, it was as well to send +away as much as possible beforehand; and lastly—and this was what +touched my father most—that he must think of his charge. + +“Why, old friend, you are giving up all for Havelok, as would I. And am +I to have no share in the training of him for the days to come?” + +Therewith he waited for no more words, but went to his great chest, and +took thereout chain after chain of linked gold rings, and put them in a +canvas bag, without weighing or counting them, and gave them to Grim. + +“Lord, here is enough to buy half the town!” my father said. + +“What of that? The town is Havelok’s by right, and maybe you can buy +him a village across seas with it. But give me a full quittance for my +purchase of your goods and cattle and house, that I may have right to +them.” + +That Grim did at once, before witnesses who were called in, none +wondering that he chose thus to secure his property while he was away, +because Hodulf might make demands on it. They did not know that any +money changed hands, and thought it formal only, and a wise thing to be +done. + +After that Grim and Arngeir took leave of the jarl, thanking him, and +they went to our house. + +There waited my mother anxiously enough, for she knew from my message +that there was somewhat new to be told, or my father had not left the +ship. Nor do I think that what was to be done was altogether a surprise +to her, for she had thought much, and knew the dangers that might crop +up. So, being very brave, she strove to make light of the trouble that +leaving her home cost her, and set about gathering the few things that +she could take. + +Now on the hearth sat Withelm, tending the fire, and he heard presently +that we were all to go to sea; and that pleased him well, for he had +ever longed to sail with his father. As for Havelok, he had waked once, +and had well eaten, and now was sleeping again. + +Then said Withelm, “When will the sacrifice to Aegir and Ran[5] for +luck on the swan’s path be?” + +“Scant time have we for that,” my father said, “for tide will not +wait.” + +“Then,” said the boy, “it were well to take the stone altar with us, +and make sacrifice on board. I have heard that Aegir is wrathful and +strong.” + +Then my father said to Leva, “The boy is right in one thing, and that +is, that if we are to make a new home beyond the sea, the blue stones +that have belonged to our family since time untold should go with us, +else will there be no luck in this flitting.” + +“What matter?” + +“West they came with us in the days of Odin, and west they shall go +with us once more,” my father said. + +And there was an end of question on the matter, for presently Arngeir +came up with the team of oxen and a sled, and my father hastily cried +to Thor as in time of sudden war, and then on the sled they loaded the +stones easily. I helped, and it is certain that they were no trouble to +uproot or lift, though they were bedded in the ground and heavy. +Wherefrom we all thought that the flitting was by the will of the +Norns, and likely to turn out well. + +But in no way could we lift Thor himself. It was as if he were rooted, +and maybe he was so. Therefore we left him, but sadly. + +One may suppose that, had any noticed that Grim was taking these sacred +things with him, there would have been a talk; but as we sailed light, +none thought them aught but needed ballast; and we brought other stones +to the ship with them and afterwards. + +Of course folk did wonder at this sudden sailing of ours, but my father +made no secret of his wish to get out of the way of Hodulf, who had +taken the ships of one or two other men elsewhere, so that all thought +he feared that his would be the next to be seized, and deemed him +prudent in going. As for our own crew, they were told that it was +certain that the ship would be taken unless we went on this tide, and +so they worked well. + +Very early in the morning, and unseen, Arngeir had brought Eleyn, the +queen, on board, and she was in the cabin under the raised after deck +all the while that the bustle of making ready was going on. Only my +father went in there at any time, unless he gave the key to one of us, +for there he kept his valuables and the arms. + +Presently, when all the men were forward and busy, I got Havelok on +board unnoticed. We had kept Withelm running to and fro from ship to +house with little burdens all the morning, mightily busy; and then, +when the chance came, Havelok in Withelm’s clothes, and with a bundle +on his head, came running to me. I waited by the after cabin, and I +opened the door quickly and let him in. Then he saw his mother; and how +those two met, who had thought each other lost beyond finding, I will +not try to say. + +I closed the door softly and left them, locking it again, and found +Withelm close to me, and Arngeir watching to see that all went well. + +Soon after that there came a Norseman, dressed as a merchant, who +talked with my father of goods, and lading, and whither he was bound, +and the like. When he went away, he thought that he had found out that +we were for the Texel, but I do not know that he was from Hodulf. There +had been time for him to send a spy in haste, however, if he wished to +watch us; but at any rate this man heard naught of our charges. + +Then, at the last moment, my mother and the children came on board, and +at once we hauled out of the harbour. I mind that an old woman ran +along the wharf when she found that all were going, and cried that Dame +Leva had not paid for certain fowls bought of her; and my father +laughed in lightness of heart, and threw her a silver penny, so that +she let us go with a blessing. And after that it did not matter what +the people thought of this going of ours, for in an hour we were far at +sea with a fair wind on the quarter, heading south at first, that the +Norseman might see us, but when the land was dim astern, and there was +no more fear, bearing away south and west for the Humber in far-off +England. + +Now that was the last I saw of Denmark for many a long year, and I knew +it must be so. But, as I have told, none but my father and mother, and +now Arngeir, knew all that we were carrying with us. + + + + +CHAPTER IV. +ACROSS THE SWAN’S PATH. + + +All that night, and during the morning of the next day, we sailed +steadily with a fresh northwest breeze that bade fair to strengthen +by-and-by. If it held, we should see the cliffs of Northumbria on our +bow tomorrow morning, and then would run down the coast to the Humber, +where my father meant to put in first. He thought to leave the queen +and Havelok with merchants whom he knew in Lindsey, and with them would +stay my mother and the little ones while he made a trading voyage +elsewhere. There would be time enough to find out the best place in +which to make a home when the autumn came, and after he had been to an +English port or two that he did not know yet. + +When half the morning was past, the sun shone out warmly, and all came +on deck from the after cabin, where the ladies and children were. Our +men knew by this time that we had passengers, flying like ourselves +from Hodulf, and therefore they were not at all surprised to see +Havelok and his mother with their mistress. None of them had ever seen +either of them before, as it happened, though I do not think that any +could have recognized the queen as she was then, wan and worn with the +terror of her long hiding. Very silent was she as she sat on deck +gazing ever at the long white wake of the ship that seemed to stretch +for a little way towards Denmark, only to fade away as a track over +which one may never go back. And silent, too, was my mother; but the +children, who had no care, were pleased with all things, and Raven and +I were full of the ways of old seamen. + +So everything went quietly until after we had our midday meal. We were +all amidships on the wide deck, except my father and Arngeir, who sat +side by side on the steersman’s bench on the high poop. There was no +spray coming on board, for we were running, and the ship was very +steady. Raven and I were forward with the men, busy with the many +little things yet to be done to the rigging and such like that had been +left in the haste at last, and there was no thought but that this +quiet, save for some shift of wind maybe, would last until we saw the +English shore. + +Now I do not know if my father had seen aught from the after deck, but +presently he came forward, and passed up the steps to the forecastle, +and there sat down on the weather rail, looking out to leeward for some +time quietly. I thought that maybe he had sighted some of the high land +on the Scots coast, for it was clear enough to see very far, and so I +went to see also. But there was nothing, and we talked of this and that +for ten minutes, when he said, “Look and see if you can catch sight of +aught on the skyline just aft of the fore stay as you sit.” + +I looked long, and presently caught sight of something white that +showed for a moment as we heaved up on a wave, and then was gone. + +“Somewhat I saw,” I said, “but it has gone. It might have been the top +of a sail.” + +Then I caught a glimpse of it again, and my father saw it also, and, as +we watched, it hove up slowly until it was plain to be seen. The vessel +it belonged to was sailing in such a way as to cross our course in the +end, though she was only a few points nearer the wind than we were. It +seemed that she was swifter than ourselves, too, from the way she kept +her place on our bow. Now a merchant must needs look on every sail with +more or less distrust, as there is always a chance of meeting with +ship-plundering Vikings, though the best of them will do naught but +take toll from a trader on the high seas. So before long all our men +were watching the stranger, and soon it was plain that she was a +longship, fresh from her winter quarters. We thought, therefore, that +she was not likely to trouble about us, having no need of stores as +yet, and we being plainly in ballast only. Nor did she alter her course +in any way, but mile after mile she sailed with us, always edging up +nearer as she went, until at last we could see the men on her bows and +the helmsman at his place. + +I thought that one could hardly see a more handsome ship than she was, +fresh with new paint, and with her dragon head shining golden in the +sun. But I had seen her before, and that in no pleasant way. She was +the ship of which I have already spoken—that which we beat off two +years ago, taking their cargo of plunder by way of amends for being +attacked. + +There was this difference, however, at that time, that then we had all +our men on board, and the Viking was short-handed after a fighting +raid, whereas now we had but fifteen men instead of five-and-twenty, +because in the hurry we had not had time to summon any who lived beyond +the town, and it was plain that the Viking had a full crew, maybe of +sixty men. + +“It is in my mind,” my father said to Arngeir, “that our old foe will +think twice before he attacks us again; but seeing whom we have to deal +with, it is as well to be ready. We might keep him off with arrows, if +he does not find out how few we are, should he make an attempt on us; +but if he boards, we must submit, and make the best bargain we can.” + +So he passed word that the men were to lie down on deck, leaving only a +few to be seen, that the Viking might think us as he had known us +before; and then the arms-chests were opened, and the bows and throwing +weapons were set to hand by us boys while the men armed themselves. + +Then my father spoke to them, saying, “I do not know if this Viking +will pass us by as too hard a nut to crack, seeing that he knows of us +already; but if he does not, it will be of no use our trying to fight +him, as you can see. I would not waste your lives for naught. But it +may be that a show of force will keep him off, so we will wait under +arms until we are sure what he will do.” + +Then the men broke out, saying that they had beaten this man before +with him as leader, and they were in no mind to give up without a +fight. + +“Well, then,” my father answered, “it is plain that you will back me, +and so I will call on you if there is need or chance. But we have the +women folk to think of now, and we must not risk aught.” + +Now the longship held on her course steadily, never shifting her helm +for so much as a point. In half an hour or so we must be alongside one +another, at this rate, and that Arngeir did not altogether like the +look of, for it would seem as if she meant to find out all about us at +least. There was some little sea running, and it might be thought +easier to board us on the lee side, therefore. We could not get away +from her in any way, for even now, while she was closer hauled than we, +she kept pace with us, and had she paid off to the same course as +ourselves, she would have left us astern in a very short time. + +Presently a man swarmed up her rigging in order to look down on our +decks, and as he went up, my father bade our men crawl over to +windward, so that he should see all one gunwale lined with men, and so +think that both were, and deem that we were setting a trap for them in +order to entice them alongside by pretending to be hardly manned. At +the same time, he sent the ladies and children into the cabin, so that +they might not be seen. + +That did not please Havelok at all, for he seemed to scent a fight in +the air, and wanted weapons, that he might stand beside the other men, +asking for an axe for choice. It was all that I could do to quiet him +by saying that if there was any need of him I would call him, but that +just now we thought the Vikings would go away if they saw many warriors +on deck. Which indeed was all that we hoped, but he thought that would +spoil sport, and so hastened into the shelter. + +After that there fell a silence on us, for at any moment now we might +be hailed by the other ship. And when we were but a bow shot apart the +hail came. The two vessels were then broadside on to each other, we a +little ahead, if anything. My father was steering now, fully armed, and +Arngeir was beside him with myself. I had the big shield wherewith one +guards the helmsman if arrows are flying. + +The Viking bade us strike sail, and let him come alongside, but my +father made no answer. Still we held on, and the Viking paid off a +little, as though he were not so sure if it were wise to fall on us, as +we showed no fear of him. + +Then my father spoke to Arngeir in a stern voice that I had heard only +when we met this same ship before. + +“This will not last long. If there is one chance for us, it is to run +him down and it may be done. Our ship will stand the blow, for these +longships are but eggshells beside her. Pass the word for the men to +shoot the steersman when I give the word. Then they must run forward, +lest the Vikings climb over the bows as we strike her.” + +Arngeir’s eyes flashed at that, and at once he went to the men, and +there was a click and rattle as the arrows went to string, and they +gathered themselves together in readiness to leap up when the word +came. There seemed every chance that we should be upon the longship +before they knew what we were about, for we had the weather gauge. + +Now the Viking hailed again, and again bore up for us a little, whereat +my father smiled grimly, for it helped his plan. And this time, as +there was no answer, his men sent an arrow or two on board, which did +no harm. + +“It is plain that we are to be taken,” my father said on that, “so we +will wait no longer. Stand by, men, and one lucky shot will do all. +Shoot!” + +The helm went up as he spoke, and the men leaped to their feet, raining +arrows round the two men who were at the helm, and down on the Viking +we swept with a great cheer. + +But in a moment there were four men on her after deck, and whether the +first helmsman was shot I cannot say; but I think not, for quickly as +we had borne down on her she was ready, rushing away from us, instead +of luffing helplessly, as we had expected. It would almost have seemed +that our move had been looked for. + +Ten more minutes passed while we exchanged arrow flights, and then the +longship had so gained on us that she struck sail and waited for us +with her long oars run out and ready. + +“That is all we can do,” said my father, with a sort of groan. “Put up +your weapons, men, for it is no good fighting now.” + +They did so, growling; and as we neared the longship, her oars took the +water, and she flew alongside of us, and a grappling hook flung deftly +from her bows caught our after gunwale, and at once she dropped astern, +and swung to its chain as to a tow line. We were not so much as bidden +to strike sail now, and the Vikings began to crowd forward in order to +board us by the stern, as the grappling chain was hove short by their +windlass. + +“Hold on,” my father cried to them “we give up. Where is your chief?” + +Now the men were making way for him when a strange thing happened. Out +of the after cabin ran Havelok when he heard that word, crying that it +was not the part of good warriors to give up while they could wield +sword—words that surely he had learned from Gunnar, his father. And +after him came his mother, silent, and terrified lest he should be +harmed. + +Havelok ran up the steps to my father, and the queen followed. I have +said that there was a little sea running, and this made the ships jerk +and strain at the chain that held them together fiercely, now that it +was so short. And even as the queen came to the top step, where there +was no rail, for the steps were not amidships, but alongside the +gunwale, one of these jerks came; and in a moment she was in the sea, +and in a moment also Arngeir was after her, for he was a fine swimmer. + +The Vikings cried out as they saw this, but the poor queen said no +word, nor did she ever rise again after the first time. It is likely +that she was drawn under the longship at once. + +So for a little while there was no talk of terms or fighting, but all +held their breath as they watched to see if the queen floated alongside +anywhere; but there was only Arngeir, who swam under the lee of the +Viking, and called to her men for guidance. They threw him a rope’s end +as he came to the stern, and he clung to it for a little while, hoping +to see the flash of a white hood that the queen wore, over the white +wave crests: but at last he gave up, and the Vikings hauled him on +board, praising him for his swimming, as he had on his mail. + +Then the chief turned to my father, and spoke to him across the few +fathoms of water that were between the ships. + +“We meet again, Grim, as time comes round; and now I have a mind to let +you go, though I have that old grudge against you, for I think that +your wife is loss enough.” + +“Not my wife, Arnvid, but a passenger—one whom I would not have lost +for all that you can take from me.” + +“Well, I am glad it is no worse. But it seems that you are in ballast. +How comes it that you have no cargo for me, for you owe me one?” + +Then my father told him shortly that he had fled from Hodulf; and all +those doings were news to the Viking, so that they talked in friendly +wise, while the men listened, and the ships crept on together down the +wind. + +But when all was told, save of the matter of Havelok, and who the lost +lady was, the Viking laughed shortly, and said, “Pleasant gossip, Grim, +but not business. What will you give us to go away in peace? I do not +forget that you all but ran us down just now, and that one or two of us +have arrows sticking in us which came from your ship. But that first +was a good bit of seamanship, and there is not much harm from the +last.” + +“Well,” said my father, “it seems to me that you owe me a ship, for it +is certain that I once had that one, and gave her back to you.” + +The Viking laughed. + +“True enough, and therefore I give you back your ship now, and we are +quits. But I am coming on board to see what property I can lift.” + +My father shrugged his shoulders, and turned away, and at once the +Vikings hauled on the chain until their dragon head was against our +quarter, when the chief and some twenty of his men came on board. The +way in which they took off the hatches without staying to question +where they should begin told a tale of many a like plundering. + +Then, I do not know how it was rightly, for I was aft with my father, +there began a quarrel between the Vikings and our men; and though both +Grim and the chief tried to stop it, five of our few were slain +outright, and three more badly hurt before it was ended. The rest of +our crew took refuge on the fore deck, and there bided after that. The +whole fray was over in a few minutes, and it seemed that the Vikings +half expected somewhat of the sort. + +Then they took all the linen and woollen goods, and our spare sails, +and all the arms and armour from the men and from the chests to their +own ship. Only they left my father and Arngeir their war gear, saying +that it were a shame to disarm two brave men. + +Then the chief said, “Little cargo have you, friend Grim, and therefore +I am the more sure that you have store of money with you. Even flight +from Hodulf would not prevent you from taking that wherewith to trade. +So I must have it; and it rests with you whether we tear your ship to +splinters in hunting for your hiding place or not.” + +“I suppose there is no help for it, but I will say that the most of +what I have is not mine,” said my father. + +“Why, what matter? When one gives gold into the hands of a seafarer, +one has to reckon with such chances as this. You must needs hand it +over.” + +So, as there was naught else to do, Grim brought out the jarl’s heavy +bag, and gave it to the chief, who whistled to himself as he hefted it. + +“Grim,” he said, “for half this I would have let you go without sending +a man on board. What is this foolishness? You must have known that.” + +“The gold is not mine,” my father answered; “it was my hope that you +would have been content with the cargo.” + +“Well, I have met with an honest man for once,” the Viking said; and he +called his men, and they cast off and left us. + +But we were in no happy plight when he had gone away to the eastward on +his old course. Half our men were gone, for the wounded were of no use, +and the loss of the queen weighed heavily on us. And before long it +began to blow hard from the north, and we had to shorten sail before +there was real need, lest it should be too much for us few presently, +as it certainly would have been by the time that darkness fell, for the +gale strengthened. + +Then, added to all this, there was trouble in the cabin under the after +deck, for since his mother was lost, Havelok had spoken no word. I had +brought him down to my mother from the deck, and had left him with her, +hoping that he did not know what had happened; but now he was in a high +fever, and sorely ill. Perhaps he would have been so in any case, after +the long days of Hodulf’s cruelty, but he had borne them well. A child +is apt, however, to give up, as it were, suddenly. + +So, burdened with trouble, we drove before the gale, and the only +pleasant thing was to see how the good ship behaved in it, while at +least we were on our course all the time. Therefore, one could not say +that there was any danger; and but for these other things, none would +have thought much of wind or sea, which were no worse than we had +weathered many a time before. We had sea room, and no lee shore to +fear, and the ship was stanch, and no sailor can ask for more than +that. + + + + +CHAPTER V. +STORM AND SHIPWRECK. + + +The gale held without much change through the night, and then with +morning shifted a few points to the westward, which was nothing to +complain of. The sea rose, and a few rain squalls came up and passed; +but they had no weight in them, and did not keep the waves down as a +steady fall will. And all day long it was the same, and the ship fled +ever before it. There was no thought now of reaching any port we might +wish, but least of all did we think of making the Lindsey shore, which +lies open to the north and east. When the gale broke, we must find +harbour where we could; and indeed; to my father at this time all ports +were alike, as refuge from Hodulf. When darkness came again one of the +wounded men died, and Havelok was yet ill in the after cabin, so that +my mother was most anxious for him. The plunging ship was no place for +a sick child. + +Now it was not possible for us to tell how far we had run since we had +parted from the Viking, and all we knew was that we had no shore to +fear with the wind as it was, and therefore nothing but patience was +needed. But in the night came a sudden lull in the gale that told of a +change at hand, and in half an hour it was blowing harder than ever +from the northeast, and setting us down to the English coast fast, for +we could do naught but run before such a wind. It thickened up also, +and was very dark even until full sunrise, so that one could hardly +tell when the sun was above the sea’s rim. + +I crept from the fore cabin about this time, after trying in vain to +sleep, and found the men sheltering under the break of the deck and +looking always to leeward. Two of them were at the steering oar with my +father, for Arngeir was worn out, and I had left him in the cabin, +sleeping heavily in spite of the noise of waves and straining planking. +Maybe he would have waked in a moment had that turmoil ceased. + +It was of no use trying to speak to the men without shouting in their +ears, and getting to windward to do that, moreover, and so I looked +round to see if there was any change coming. But all was grey overhead, +and a grey wall of rain and flying drift from the wave tops was all +round us, blotting out all things that were half a mile from us, if +there were anything to be blotted out. It always seems as if there must +be somewhat beyond a thickness of any sort at sea. But there was one +thing that I did notice, and that was that the sea was no longer grey, +as it had been yesterday, but was browner against the cold sky, while +the foam of the following wave crests was surely not so white as it had +been, and at this I wondered. + +Then I crawled aft and went to my father and asked him what he thought +of the wind and the chance of its dropping. He had had the lead going +for long now. + +“We are right off the Humber mouth, to judge by the colour of the +water,” he told me, “or else off the Wash, which is more to the south. +I cannot tell which rightly, for we have run far, and maybe faster than +I know. If only one could see—” + +There he stopped, and I knew enough to understand that we were in some +peril unless a shift of wind came very soon, since the shore was under +our lee now, if by good luck we were not carried straight into the +great river itself. So for an hour or more I watched, and all the time +it seemed that hope grew less, for the sea grew shorter, as if against +tide, and ever its colour was browner with the mud of the Trent and her +sisters. + +Presently, as I clung to the rail, there seemed to grow a new sound +over and amid all those to which I had become used—as it were a low +roaring that swelled up in the lulls, and sank and rose again. And I +knew what it was, and held up my hand to my father, listening, and he +heard also. It was the thunder of breakers on a sandy coast to leeward. + +He put his whistle to his lips and called shrilly, and the men saw him +if they could not hear, and sprang up, clawing aft through the water +that flooded the waist along the rail. + +“Breakers to leeward, men,” he cried “we must wear ship, and then shall +clear them. We shall be standing right into Humber after that, as I +think.” + +Arngeir heard the men trampling, if not the whistle, and he was with us +directly, and heard what was to be done. + +“It is a chance if the yard stands it,” he said, looking aloft. + +“Ay, but we cannot chance going about in this sea, and we are too short +of men to lower and hoist again. Listen!” + +Arngeir did so, and heard for the first time the growing anger of the +surf on the shore, and had no more doubt. We were then running with the +wind on the port quarter, and it was useless to haul closer to the wind +on that tack, whereas if we could wear safely we should be leaving the +shore at once by a little closer sailing. + +“Ran is spreading her nets,” said Arngeir, “but if all holds, she will +have no luck with her fishing.”[6] + +Then we manned the main sheet and the guys from the great yards, but we +were all too few for the task, which needed every man of the fifteen +that we had sailed with. There was the back stay to be set up afresh on +the weather quarter for the new tack also, and three men must see to +that. + +We watched my father’s hand for the word, and steadily sheeted home +until all seemed to be going well. But the next moment there was a +crash and a cry, and we were a mastless wreck, drifting helplessly. +Maybe some flaw of wind took us as the head of the great sail went +over, but its power was too much for the men at guys and back stay, and +they had the tackle torn through their hands. The mast snapped six feet +above the deck, smashing the gunwales as it fell forward and overboard, +but hurting none of us. + +Then a following sea or two broke over the stern, and I was washed from +the poop, for I had been at the sheet, down to the deck, and there +saved myself among the fallen rigging, half drowned. One of the men was +washed overboard at the same time, but a bight of the rigging that was +over the side caught him under the chin, and his mates hauled him on +board again by the head, as it were. He was wont to make a jest of it +afterward, saying that he was not likely to be hanged twice, but he had +a wry neck from that day forward. + +No more seas came over us, for the wreck over the bows brought us head +to wind, though we shipped a lot of water across the decks as she +rolled in the sea. Then we rode to the drag of the fallen sail for a +time, and it seemed quiet now that there was no noise of wind screaming +in rigging above us. But all the while the thunder of the breakers grew +nearer and plainer. + +I bided where I was, for the breath was knocked out of me for the +moment. I saw my father lash the helm, and then he and the rest got the +two axes that hung by the cabin door, and came forward with them. The +mast was pounding our side in a way that would start the planking +before long, and it must be cut adrift, and by that time I could join +him. + +When that was done, and it did not take long, we cleared the anchor and +cable and let go, for it was time. The sound of the surf was drowning +all else. But the anchor held, and the danger was over for the while, +and as one might think altogether; but the tide was running against the +gale, and what might happen when it turned was another matter. + +Now we got the sail on deck again, and unlaced it from the yard, +setting that in place with some sort of rigging, ready to be stepped as +a mast if the wind shifted to any point that might help us off shore. + +It may be thought how we watched that one cable that held us from the +waves and the place where they broke, for therein lay our only chance, +and we longed for the clear light that comes after rain, that we might +see the worst, at least, if we were to feel it. But the anchor held, +and presently we lost the feeling of a coming terror that had been over +us, the utmost peril being past. My father went to the after cabin now, +and though the poor children were bruised with the heavy rolling of the +ship as she came into the wind, they were all well save Havelok, and he +had fallen asleep in my mother’s arms at last. + +With the turn of the tide, which came about three hours after midday, +the clouds broke, and slowly the land grew out of the mists until we +could see it plainly, though it was hardly higher than the sea that +broke over it in whirling masses of spindrift. By-and-by we could see +far-off hills beyond wide-stretching marshlands that looked green and +rich across yellow sandhills that fringed the shore. And from them we +were not a mile, and at their feet were such breakers as no ship might +win through, though, if we might wait until they were at rest, the +level sand was good for beaching at the neap tides. For we were well +into Humber mouth, and to the northward of us, across the yellow water, +was the long point of Spurn, and the ancient port of Ravenspur, with +its Roman jetties falling into decay under the careless hand of the +Saxon, under its shelter. There was no port on this southern side of +the Humber, though farther south was Tetney Haven and again Saltfleet, +to which my father had been, but neither in nor out of them might a +vessel get in a northeast gale. + +I have said that this clearness came with the turn of the tide, and now +that began to flow strongly, setting in with the wind with more than +its wonted force, for the northwest shift of the gale had kept it from +falling, as it always will on this coast. That, of course, I learned +later, but it makes plain what happened next. Our anchor began to drag +with the weight of both tide and wind, and that was the uttermost of +our dread. + +Slowly it tore through its holding, and as it were step by step at +first, and once we thought it stopped when we had paid out all the +cable. But wind and sea were too strong, and presently again we saw the +shore marks shifting, and we knew that there was no hope. The ship must +touch the ground sooner or later, and then the end would come with one +last struggle in the surf, and on shore was no man whose hand might be +stretched to drag a spent man to the land, if he won through. It would +have seemed less lonely had one watched us, but I did not know then +that no pity for the wrecked need be looked for from the marshmen of +the Lindsey shore. There was not so much as a fisher’s boat of wicker +and skins in sight on the sandhills, where one might have looked to see +some drawn up. + +Now my father went to the cabin and told my mother that things were at +their worst, and she was very brave. + +“If you are to die at this time, husband,” she said, “it is good that I +shall die with you. Better it is, as I think, than a sickness that +comes to one and leaves the other. But after that you will go to the +place of Odin, to Valhalla; but I whither?” + +Then spoke little Withelm, ever thoughtful, and now not at all afraid. + +“If Freya wants not a sailor’s wife who is willing to fight the waves +with Grim, my father, it will be strange.” + +My mother was wont to say that this saying of the child’s did much to +cheer her at that time, but there is little place for a woman in the +old faiths. So she smiled at him, and that made him bold to speak of +what he had surely been thinking since the storm began. + +“I suppose that Aegir is wroth because we made no sacrifice to him +before we set sail. I think that I would cast the altar stones to him, +that he may know that we meant to do so.” + +This sounds a child’s thought only, and so it was; but it set my father +thinking, and in the end helped us out of trouble. + +“I have heard,” my father said, “that men in our case have thrown +overboard the high-seat pillars, and have followed them to shore +safely. We have none, but the stones are more sacred yet. Overboard +they shall go, and as the boat with them goes through the surf we may +learn somewhat.” + +With that he hastened on deck, and told the men what he would do; and +they thought it a good plan, as maybe they would have deemed anything +that seemed to call for help from the strong ones of the sea. So they +got the boat ready to launch over the quarter, and the four stones, +being uncovered since the Vikings took our cargo, were easily got on +deck, and they were placed in the bottom of the boat, and steadied +there with coils of fallen rigging, so that they could not shift. They +were just a fair load for the boat. Then my father cried for help to +the Asir, bidding Aegir take the altar as full sacrifice; and when we +had done so we waited for a chance as a long wave foamed past us, and +launched the boat fairly on its back, so that she seemed to fly from +our hands, and was far astern in a moment. + +Now we looked to see her make straight for the breakers, lift on the +first of them, and then capsize. That first line was not a quarter of a +mile from us now. + +But she never reached them. She plunged away at first, heading right +for the surf, and then went steadily westward, and up the shore line +outside it, until she was lost to sight among the wild waves, for she +was very low in the water. + +“Cheer up, men,” my father said, as he saw that; “we are not ashore +yet, nor will be so long as the tide takes that current along shore. We +shall stop dragging directly.” + +And so it was, for when the ship slowly came to the place where the +boat had changed her course, the anchor held once more for a while +until the gathering strength of the tide forced it to drag again. Now, +however, it was not toward the shore that we drifted, but up the +Humber, as the boat had gone; and as we went the sea became less heavy, +for we were getting into the lee of the Spurn headland. + +Soon the clouds began to break, flying wildly overhead with patches of +blue sky and passing sunshine in between them that gladdened us. The +wind worked round to the eastward at the same time, and we knew that +the end of the gale had come. But, blowing as it did right into the +mouth of the river, the sea became more angry, and it would be worse +yet when the tide set again outwards. Already we had shipped more water +than was good, and we might not stand much more. It seemed best, +therefore, to my father that we should try to run as far up the Humber +as we might while we had the chance, for the current that held us safe +might change as tide altered in force and depth. + +So we buoyed the cable, not being able to get the anchor in this sea, +and then stepped the yard in the mast’s place, and hoisted the peak of +the sail corner-wise as best we might; and that was enough to heel us +almost gunwale under as the cable was slipped and the ship headed about +up the river mouth. We shipped one or two more heavy seas as she paid +off before the wind, but we were on the watch for them, and no harm was +done. + +After that the worst was past, for every mile we flew over brought us +into safer waters; and now we began to wonder where the boat with its +strange cargo had gone, and we looked out for her along the shore as we +sailed, and at last saw her, though it was a wonder that we did so. + +The tide had set her into a little creek that opened out suddenly, and +there Arngeir saw her first, aground on a sandbank, with the lift of +each wave that crept into the haven she had found sending her higher on +it. And my father cried to us that we had best follow her; and he put +the helm over, while we sheeted home and stood by for the shock of +grounding. + +Then in a few minutes we were in a smother of foam across a little sand +bar, and after that in quiet water, and the sorely-tried ship was safe. +She took the ground gently enough in the little creek, not ten score +paces from where the boat was lying, and we were but an arrow flight +from the shore. As the tide rose the ship drifted inward toward it, so +that we had to wait only for the ebb that we might go dry shod to the +land. + +Before that time came there was rest for us all, and we needed it +sorely. It was a wonder that none of the children had been hurt in the +wild tossing of the ship, but children come safely through things that +would be hard on a man. Bruised they were and very hungry, but somehow +my mother had managed to steady them on the cabin floor, and they were +none the worse, only Havelok slept even yet with a sleep that was too +heavy to be broken by the worst of the tossing as he lay in my mother’s +lap. She could not tell if this heavy sleep was good or not. + +Then we saw to the wounded men, and thereafter slept in the sun or in +the fore cabin as each chose, leaving Arngeir only on watch. It was +possible that the shore folk would be down to the strand soon, seeking +for what the waves might have sent them, and the tide must be watched +also. + +Just before its turn he woke us, for it was needful that we should get +a line ashore to prevent the ship from going out with the ebb, and with +one I swam ashore. There was not so much as a stump to which to make +fast, and so one of the men followed me, and we went to the boat, set +the altar stones carefully ashore, then fetched the spare anchor, and +moored her with that in a place where the water seemed deep to the +bank. + +It was a bad place. For when the tide fell, which it did very fast, we +found that we had put her on a ledge. Presently therefore, and while we +were trying to bail out the water that was in her, the ship took the +ground aft, and we could not move her before the worst happened. +Swiftly the tide left her, and her long keel bent and twisted, and her +planks gaped with the strain of her own weight, all the greater for the +water yet in her that flowed to the hanging bows. The good ship might +sail no more. Her back was broken. + +That was the only time that I have ever seen my father weep. But as the +stout timbers cracked and groaned under the strain it seemed to him as +if the ship that he loved was calling piteously to him for help that he +could not give, and it was too much for him. The gale that was yet +raging overhead and the sea that was still terrible in the wide waters +of the river had been things that had not moved him, for that the ship +should break up in a last struggle with them was, as it were, a fitting +end for her. But that by his fault here in the hardly-won haven she +should meet her end was not to be borne, and he turned away from us and +wept. + +Then came my mother and set her hand on his shoulder and spoke softly +to him with wise words. + +“Husband, but a little while ago it would have been wonderful if there +were one of us left alive, or one plank of the ship on another. And now +we are all safe and unhurt, and the loss of the ship is the least of +ills that might have been.” + +“Nay, wife,” he said; “you cannot understand.” + +“Then it is woe for the—for the one who is with us. But how had it been +if you had seen Hodulf and his men round our house, and all the +children slain that one might not escape, while on the roof crowed the +red cock, and naught was left to us? We have lost less than if we had +stayed for that, and we have gained what we sought, even safety. See, +to the shore have come the ancient holy things of our house, and that +not by your guidance. Surely here shall be the place for us that is +best.” + +“Ay, wife; you are right in all these things, but it is not for them.” + +Then she laughed a little, forcing herself to do so, as it seemed. + +“Why, then, it is for the ship that I was ever jealous of, for she took +you away from me. Now I think that I should be glad that she can do so +no more. But I am not, for well I know what the trouble must be, and I +would have you think no more of it. The good ship has saved us all, and +so her work is done, and well done. Never, if she sailed many a long +sea mile with you, would anything be worth telling of her besides this. +And the burden of common things would surely be all unmeet for her +after what she has borne hither.” + +“It is well said, Leva, my wife,” my father answered. + +From that time he was cheerful, and told us how it was certain that we +had been brought here for good, seeing that the Norns[7] must have led +the stones to the haven, so that this must be the place that we sought. + + + + +CHAPTER VI. +THE BEGINNING OF GRIMSBY TOWN. + + +Easily we went ashore when the tide fell, across the spits of sand that +ran between the mud banks, and we climbed the low sandhill range that +hid the land from us, and saw the place where we should bide. And it +might have been worse; for all the level country between us and the +hills was fat, green meadow and marsh, on which were many cattle and +sheep feeding. Here and there were groves of great trees, hemmed in +with the quickset fences that are as good as stockades for defence +round the farmsteads of the English folk, and on other patches of +rising ground were the huts of thralls or herdsmen, and across the wide +meadows glittered and flashed streams and meres, above which the +wildfowl that the storm had driven inland wheeled in clouds. All the +lower hills seemed to be wooded thickly, and the alder copses that +would shelter boar and deer and maybe wolves stretched in some places +thence across the marsh. Pleasant and homely seemed all this after long +looking at the restless sea. + +Then said my father, “Now am I no longer Grim the merchant, and that +pride of mine is at an end. But here is a place where Grim the fisher +may do well enough, if I am any judge of shore and sea. Here have we +haven for the boats, and yonder swim the fish, and inland are the towns +that need them. Nor have we seen a sign of a fisher so far as we have +come.” + +Now we had been seen as soon as we stood on the sandhills; and before +long the herdsman and thralls began to gather to us, keeping aloof +somewhat at first, as if fearing my father’s arms. But when we spoke +with them we could learn nothing, for they were Welsh marshmen who knew +but little of the tongue of their English masters. Serfs they were now +in these old fastnesses of theirs to the English folk of the +Lindiswaras, who had won their land and called it after their own name, +Lindsey. + +But before long there rode from one of the farmsteads an Englishman of +some rank, who had been sent for, as it would seem, and he came with +half a dozen armed housecarls behind him to see what was going on. Him +we could understand well enough, for there is not so much difference +between our tongue and that of the English; and when he learned our +plight he was very kindly. His name was Witlaf Stalling, and he was the +great man of these parts, being lord over many a mile of the marsh and +upland, and dwelling at his own place, Stallingborough, some five miles +to the north and inland hence. + +Now it had been in this man’s power to seize us and all we had as his +own, seeing that we were cast on his shore; but he treated us as guests +rather, bidding us shelter in one of his near farmsteads as long as we +would, and telling my father to come and speak with him when we had +saved what we could from the wreck. He bade the thralls help at that +also, so that we had fallen in with a friend, and our troubles were +less for his kindness. + +We saved what cargo we had left during the next few days, while we +dwelt at the farm. Then at the height of the spring tides the ship +broke up, for a second gale came before the sea that the last had +raised was gone. And then I went with my father to speak with Witlaf +the thane at Stallingborough, that we might ask his leave to make our +home on the little haven, and there become fishers once more. + +That he granted readily, asking many questions about our troubles, for +he wondered that one who had owned so good a ship seemed so content to +become a mere fisher in a strange land, without thought of making his +way home. But all that my father told him was that he had had to fly +from the new king of our land, and that he had been a fisher before, so +that there was no hardship in the change. + +“Friend Grim,” said Witlaf when he had heard this, “you are a brave +man, as it seems to me, and well may you prosper here, as once before. +I will not stand in your way. Now, if you will hold it from me on +condition of service in any time of war, to be rendered by yourself and +your sons and any men you may hire, I will grant you what land you will +along the coast, so that none may question you in anything. Not that +the land is worth aught to any but a fisher who needs a place for boats +and nets; but if you prosper, others will come to the place, and you +shall be master.” + +One could hardly have sought so much as that, and heartily did we thank +the kindly thane, gladly taking the fore shore as he wished. But he +said that he thought the gain was on his side, seeing what men he had +won. + +“Now we must call the place by a name, for it has none,” he said, +laughing. “Grim’s Stead, maybe?” + +“Call the place a town at once,” answered my father, laughing also. +“Grimsby has a good sound to a homeless man.” + +So Grimsby the place has been from that day forward, and, as I suppose, +will be now to the end of time. But for a while there was only the one +house that we built of the timbers and planks of our ship by the side +of the haven—a good house enough for a fisher and his family, but not +what one would look for from the name. + +By the time that was built Havelok was himself again, though he had +been near to his death. Soon he waxed strong and rosy in the sea winds, +and out-went Withelm both in stature and strength. But it seemed that +of all that had happened he remembered naught, either of the storm, or +of his mother’s death, or of the time of Hodulf. My mother thought that +the sickness had taken away his memory, and that it might come back in +time. But from the day we came to the house on the shore he was content +to call Grim and Leva father and mother, and ourselves were his +brothers, even as he will hold us even now. Yet my father would never +take him with us to the fishing, as was right, seeing who he was and +what might lie before him. Nor did he ever ask to go, as we had asked +since we were able to climb into the boat as she lay on the shore; and +we who knew not who he was, and almost forgot how he came to us, ceased +to wonder at this after a while; and it seemed right that he should be +the home-stayer, as if there must needs be one in every household. + +Nevertheless he was always the foremost in all our sports, loving the +weapon play best of all, so that it was no softness that kept him from +the sea. I hold that the old saw that says, “What is bred in the bone +cometh out in the flesh,” is true, and never truer than in the ways of +Havelok. + +For it is not to be thought that because my father went back perforce +to the fisher’s calling he forgot that the son of Gunnar Kirkeban +should be brought up always in such wise that when the time came he +should be ready to go to the slayer of his father, sword in hand, and +knowing how to use it. Therefore both Havelok and we were trained +always in the craft of the warrior. + +Witlaf the thane was right when he said that men would draw to the +place if we prospered, and it was not so long before the name that had +been a jest at first was so no longer. Truly we had hard times at +first, for our one ship’s boat was all unfitted for the fishing; but +the Humber teemed with fish, and there were stake nets to be set that +need no boat. None seemed to care for taking the fish but ourselves, +for the English folk had no knowledge of the riches to be won from the +sea, and the eels of the river were the best that they ever saw. So +they were very ready to buy, and soon the name of Grim the fisher was +known far and wide in Lindsey, for my father made great baskets of the +willows of the marsh, and carried his burden of fish through the land, +alone at first, until we were able to help him, while Arngeir and we +minded the nets. + +Only two of our men stayed here with us, being fishers and old comrades +of my father. The rest he bade find their way home to Denmark to their +wives and children, from the Northumbrian coast, or else take service +with the king, Ethelwald, who ruled in East Anglia, beyond the Wash, +who, being a Dane by descent from the Jutes who took part with Angles +and Saxons in winning this new land, was glad to have Danish men for +his housecarls. Some went to him, and were well received there, as we +knew long afterwards. + +The man who had been washed overboard and hauled back at risk of his +neck was one of these. His name was Mord, and he would have stayed with +us; but my father thought it hard that he should not have some better +chance than we could give him here, for it was not easy to live at +first. Somewhat of the same kind he said to Arngeir, for he had heard +of this king when he had been in the king’s new haven in the Wash some +time ago. But Arngeir would by no means leave the uncle who had been as +a father to him. + +Now when we marked out the land that Witlaf gave us, there was a good +omen. My father set the four blue altar stones at each corner of the +land as the boundaries, saying that thus they would hallow all the +place, rather than make an altar again of them here where there was no +grove to shelter them, or, indeed, any other spot that was not open, +where a holy place might be. And when we measured the distances between +them a second time they were greater than at first, which betokens the +best of luck to him whose house is to be there. I suppose that they +will bide in these places now while Grimsby is a town, for, as every +one knows, it is unlucky to move a boundary stone. + +Soon my father found a man who had some skill in the shipwright’s +craft, and brought him to our place from Saltfleet. Then we built as +good a boat as one could wish, and, not long after that, another. But +my father was careful that none of the Lindsey folk whom he had known +should think that this fisher was the Grim whom they had once traded +with, lest word should go to Hodulf in any way. + +Now we soon hired men to help us, and the fishing throve apace. We +carried the fish even to the great city of Lincoln, where Alsi the +Lindsey king had his court, though it was thirty miles away. For we had +men in the villages on the road who took the great baskets on from one +to another, and always Grim and one of us were there on the market day, +and men said that never had the town and court seen such fish as Grim’s +before. Soon, therefore, he was rich, for a fisher; and that was heard +of by other fishers from far off, and they drew to Grimsby, so that the +town spread, and Witlaf the good thane said that it was a lucky day +which drove us to his shore, for he waxed rich with dues that they were +willing to pay. We built boats and let them out to these men, so that +one might truly say that all the fishery was Grim’s. + +Then a trading ship put in, hearing of the new haven, and that was a +great day for us. But her coming made my father anxious, since Hodulf +was likely to seek for news of Grim the merchant from any who had been +to England; and hearing at last of him, he would perhaps be down on us, +Vikingwise, with fire and sword. But after that traders came and went, +and we heard naught of him except we asked for news; for he left us in +peace, if he knew that his enemy lived yet. Men said that he was not +much loved in Denmark. + +So the town grew, and well did we prosper, so that there is naught to +be said of any more trouble, which is what my story seems to be made up +of so far. Yet we had come well through all at last; and that, I +suppose, is what makes the tale of any man worth hearing. + +Twelve years went all well thus, and in those years Havelok came to +manhood, though not yet to his full strength. What that would be in a +few more summers none could tell, for he was already almost a giant in +build and power, so that he could lift and carry at once the four great +fish baskets, which we bore one at a time when full of fish, easily, +and it was he who could get a stranded boat afloat when we could hardly +move her between us, though all three of us were strong as we grew up. + +Very handsome was Havelok also, and, like many very strong men, very +quiet. And all loved him, from the children who played along the +water’s edge to the oldest dame in the town; for he had a good word for +all, and there was not one in the place whom he had not helped at one +time or another. More than one there was who owed him life—either his +own, or that of a child saved from the water. + +Most of all Havelok loved my father; and once, when he was about +eighteen, he took it into his head that he was burdensome to him by +reason of his great growth. So nothing would satisfy him but that he +must go with us to the fishing, though it was against Grim’s will +somewhat. But he could make no hand at it, seeing that he could pull +any two of us round if he took an oar, and being as likely as not to +break that moreover. Nor could he bear the quiet of the long waiting at +the drift nets, when hour after hour of the night goes by in silence +before the herring shoal comes in a river of blue and silver and the +buoys sink with its weight; rather would he be at the weapon play with +the sons of Witlaf, our friend, who loved him. + +But though the fishing was not for him, after a while he would not be +idle, saying, when my father tried to persuade him to trouble not at +all about our work, that it was no shame for a man to work, but, +rather, that he should not do so. So one day he went to the old Welsh +basket maker who served us, and bade him make a great basket after his +own pattern, the like of which the old man had never so much as thought +of. + +“Indeed, master,” he said, when it was done, “you will never be able to +carry so great a load of fish as that will hold.” + +“Let us see,” quoth Havelok, laughing; and with that he put him gently +into it, and lifted him into the air, and on to his mighty shoulder, +carrying him easily, and setting him down in safety. + +The basket maker was cross at first, but none was able to be angry with +Havelok long, and he too began to smile. + +“It is ‘curan’ that you are, master,” he said; “not even Arthur himself +could have done that.” + +“Many times have I heard your folk call me that. I would learn what it +means,” said Havelok. + +But the old man could hardly find the English word for the name, which +means “a wonder,” and nothing more. Nevertheless the marsh folk were +wont to call their friend “Hablok Curan” in their talk, for a wonder he +was to all who knew him. + +So he came home with his great basket, and said, “Here sit I by the +fire, eating more than my share, and helping to win it not at all. Now +will I make amends, for I will go the fisher’s rounds through the +marshlands with my basket, and I think that I shall do well.” + +Now my father tried to prevent him doing this, because, as I know now, +it was not work for a king’s son. But Havelok would not be denied. + +“Fat and idle am I, and my muscles need hardening,” he said. “Let me +go, father, for I was restless at home.” + +So from that time he went out into the marshland far and wide, and the +people grew to know and love him well. Always he came back with his +fish sold, and gave money and full account to my father, and mostly the +account would end thus: + +“Four fish also there were more, but the burden was heavy, and so I +even gave them to a certain old dame.” + +And my mother would say, “It is likely that the burden was lighter for +her blessing.” + +And, truly, if the love of poor folk did help, Havelok’s burden weighed +naught, great though it was. + +Yet we thought little of the blessings of the Welsh folk of the marsh +in those days, for they blessed not in the names of the Asir, being +sons of the British Christians of long ago, and many, as I think, +Christians yet. Witlaf and all the English folk were Odin’s men, as we +were, having a temple at the place called Thor’s Way, among the hills. +But we had naught to do with the faith of the thralls, which was not +our business. Only Withelm was curious in the matter, and was wont to +ask them thereof at times, though at first they feared to tell him +anything, seeing how the Saxons and English had treated the Christian +folk at their first coming. But that was forgotten now, by the English +at least, and times were quiet for these poor folk. There was a wise +man, too, of their faith, who lived in the wild hills not far from the +city, and they were wont to go to him for advice if they needed it. +They said also that the king of Lindsey had once been a Christian, for +he was Welsh by birth on his mother’s side, and had been so brought up. +It is certain that his sister Orwenna, who married Ethelwald of East +Anglia, was one, but I have seen Alsi the king at the feasts of the +Asir at Thor’s Way when Yuletide was kept, so it is not so certain +about him. He had many Welsh nobles about him at the court, kinsmen of +his mother mostly, so that it did not seem strange, though there is not +much love lost between the English and the folk whom they conquered, as +one might suppose. + +Now, as I have said, none but Withelm thought twice about these things; +but in the end the love of the marsh folk was a thing that was needed, +and that Withelm had learned somewhat of their faith was the greatest +help that could be, as will be seen. + + + + +CHAPTER VII. +BROTHERHOOD. + + +True are the words of the Havamal, the song of the wisdom of Odin, +which say, “One may know and no other, but all men know if three know.” + +Therefore for all these years my father told none of us the secret of +Havelok’s birth; and when Arngeir married my sister Solva he made him +take oath that he would not tell what he knew to her, while she, being +but a child at the time of the flight, had forgotten how this +well-loved brother of hers came to us. But it happened once that Grim +was sick, and it seemed likely that he would die, so that this secret +weighed on him, and he did not rightly know what to do for the best, +Havelok at the time being but seventeen, and the time that he should +think of his own place not being yet come. At that time he told Arngeir +all that he foresaw, and set things in order, that we three should not +be backward when need was. + +He called us to him, Havelok not being present, and spoke to us. + +“Sons,” he said, “well have you all obeyed me all these years, and I +think that you will listen to me now, for I must speak to you of +Havelok, who came to us as you know. Out of his saving from his foes +came our flight here; and I will not find fault with any of the things +that happened, for they have turned out well, save that it seems that I +may never see the land of my birth again, and at times I weary for it. +For me Denmark seems to lie within the four square of the ancient +stones; but if you will do my bidding, you and Havelok shall see her +again, though how I cannot tell.” + +Then I could hardly speak for trouble, but Withelm said softly, “As we +have been wont to do, father, so it shall be.” + +“Well shall my word be kept, therefore,” Grim said, smiling on us. +“Listen, therefore. In the days to come, when time is ripe, Arngeir +shall tell you more of Havelok your foster-brother, and there will be +signs enough by which he shall know that it is time to speak. And then +Havelok will need all the help that you can give him; and as your lord +shall you serve him, with both hands, and with life itself if need be. +And I seem to see that each of you has his place beside him—Radbard as +his strong helper, and Raven as his watchful comrade, and Withelm as +his counsellor. For ‘Bare is back without brother behind it,’ son +Radbard and ‘Ere one goes out, give heed to the doorways,’ son Raven; +and ‘Wisdom is wanted by him who fares widely’ son Withelm. So say the +old proverbs, and they are true. No quarreller is Havelok; but if he +must fight, that will be no playground. Careful is he; but he has met +with no guile as yet, and he trusts all men. Slow to think, if sure, +are so mighty frames as his becomes, even when quick wit is needed.” + +He was silent for a while, and I thought that he had no more to say, +and I knew that he had spoken rightly of what each was best fitted for, +but he went on once more. + +“This is my will, therefore, that to you shall Havelok be as the eldest +brother from this time forward, that these places shall not have to +come suddenly to you hereafter. Then will you know that I have spoken +rightly, though maybe it seems hard to Radbard and Raven now, they +being so much older.” + +Then I said truly that already Havelok was first in our hearts. And +that was true, for he was as a king among us—a king who was served by +all with loving readiness, and yet one who served all. Maybe that is +just what makes a good king when all is said and done. + +Then my father bade us carry him out of the house and down to the shore +where there was a lonely place in the sandhills, covered with the +sweet, short grass that the sheep love; and, while Raven and I bore +him, Withelm went and brought Havelok. + +“This is well, father,” he said gladly. “I had not thought you strong +enough to come thus far.” + +“Maybe it is the last time that I come living out of the house,” Grim +said; “but there is one thing yet to be done, and it must be done here. +See, son Havelok, these are your brothers in all but blood, and they +must be that also in the old Danish way.” + +“Nothing more is needed, father,” Havelok said, wondering. “I have no +brothers but these of mine, and they could be no more so.” + +Thereat my father smiled, as well content, but he said that the ancient +way must he kept. + +“But I am sorely weak,” he added. “Fetch hither Arngeir.” + +It was because of this illness that none of us were at the fishing on +that day, and Arngeir was not long in coming. And while we waited for +that little while my father was silent, looking ever northward to the +land that he had given up for Havelok; and I think that foster-son of +his knew it, for he knelt beside him and set his strong arm round him, +saying nothing. So Arngeir came with Raven, who went for him, and my +father told him what he needed to be done; and Arngeir said that it was +well thought of, and went to work with his seax on the smooth turf. + +He cut a long strip where it seemed to be toughest, leaving the ends +yet fast, and carefully he raised it and stretched it until it would +make an arch some three spans high, and so propped it at either end +with more turf that it stayed in that position. + +Then my father said, “This is the old custom, that they who are of +different family should be brothers indeed. Out of one earth should +they be made afresh, as it were, that on the face of earth they shall +be one. Pass therefore under the arch, beginning with Havelok.” + +Then, while my father spoke strange and ancient runes, Havelok did as +he was bidden, kneeling down and creeping under the uplifted turf; and +as I came after him he gave me his hand and raised me, and so with each +of the other two. And then, unbidden, Arngeir followed, for he too +loved Havelok, and would fain be his brother indeed. + +After that my father took a sharp flint knife that he had brought with +him, and with it cut Havelok’s arm a little, and each of us set his +lips to that wound, and afterwards he to the like marks in our right +arms, and so the ancient rite was complete. + +Yet it had not been needed, as I know, for not even I ever thought of +him but as the dearest of brothers, though I minded how he came. + +Now after this my father grew stronger, maybe because this was off his +mind; but he might never go to sea again, nor even to Lincoln town, for +he was not strong enough. What his illness was I do not rightly know, +hut I do not think that any one here overlooked him, though it might be +that from across the sea Hodulf had power to work him harm. It was said +that he had Finnish wizards about his court; but if that was so, he +never harmed the one whom he had most to fear—even Havelok. But then I +suppose that even a Finn could not harm one for whom great things are +in store. + +So two years more passed over, and then came the time of which one +almost fears to think—the time of the great famine. Slowly it came on +the land; but we could see it coming, and the dread of it was fearsome, +but for the hope that never quite leaves a man until the end. For first +the wheat that was winter sown came not up but in scattered blades here +and there, and then ere the spring-sown grain had lain in the land for +three weeks it had rotted, and over the rich, ploughed lands seemed to +rise a sour smell in the springtime air, when one longs for the +sweetness of growing things. And then came drought in April, and all +day long the sun shone, or if it were not shining the clouds that hid +it were hard and grey and high and still over land and sea. + +Then before the marsh folk knew what they were doing, the merchants of +Lincoln had bought the stored corn, giving prices that should have told +men that it was precious to those who sold as to the buyers; and then +the grass failed in the drought, and the farmers were glad to sell the +cattle and sheep for what they could gain, rather than see them starve. + +Then my father bade us dry and store all the fish we might against the +time that he saw was coming, and hard we worked at that. And even as we +toiled, from day to day we caught less, for the fish were leaving the +shores, and we had to go farther and farther for them, until at last a +day came when the boats came home empty, and the women wept at the +shore as the men drew them up silently, looking away from those whom +they could feed no longer. + +That was the worst day, as I think, and it was in high summer. I mind +that I went to Stallingborough that day with the last of the fresh fish +of yesterday’s catch for Witlaf’s household, and it was hotter than +ever; and in all the orchards hung not one green apple, and even the +hardy blackberry briers had no leaves or sign of blossom, and in the +dikes the watercress was blackened and evil to see. + +But I will say that in Grimsby we felt not the worst, by reason of that +wisdom of my father, and always Witlaf and his house shared with us. +Hard it was here, but elsewhere harder. + +And then came the pestilence that goes with famine always. I have heard +that men have prayed to their gods for that, for it has seemed better +to them to die than live. + +With the first breath of the pestilence died Grim my father, and about +that I do not like to say much. He bade us remember the words he had +spoken of Havelok our brother, and he spoke long to Arngeir in private +of the same; and then he told us to lay him in mound in the ancient +way, but with his face toward Denmark, whence we came. And thereafter +he said no more, but lay still until there came up suddenly through the +thick air a thunderstorm from the north; and in that he passed, and +with his passing the rain came. + +Thereof Withelm said that surely Odin fetched him, and that at once he +had made prayer for us. But the Welsh folk said that not Odin but the +White Christ had taken the man who had been a father to them, and had +staved off the worst of the famine from them. + +Then pined and died my mother Leva, for she passed in her sleep on the +day before we made the mound over her husband, and so we laid them in +it together, and that was well for both, as I think, for so they would +have wished. + +So we made a great bale fire over my father’s mound, where it stood +over the highest sandhill; and no warrior was ever more wept, for +English and Welsh and Danes were at one in this. We set his weapons +with him, and laid him in the boat that was the best—and a Saxon gave +that—and in it oars and mast and sail, and so covered him therein. And +so he waits for the end of all things that are now, and the beginning +of those better ones that shall be. + +That thunderstorm was nothing to the land, for it skirted the shores +and died away to the south, and after it came the heat again; but at +least it brought a little hope. There were fish along the shore that +night, too, if not many; and though they were gone again in the +morning, there was a better store in every house, for men were mindful +of Grim’s teaching. + +Now, of all men, Havelok seemed to feel the trouble of the famine the +most, because he could not bear to see the children hungry in the +cottages of the fishers. It seemed to him that he had more than his +share of the stores, because so mighty a frame of his needed feeding +mightily, as he said. And so for two days after my father died and was +left in his last resting, Havelok went silent about the place. Here by +the shore the pestilence hardly came, and so that trouble was not added +to us, though the weak and old went, as had Grim and Leva, here and +there. + +Then, on the third day, Havelok called Arngeir and us, and spoke what +was in his mind. + +“Brothers, I may not bear this any longer, and I must go away. I can do +no more to help than can the weakest in the town; and even my strength +is an added trouble to those who have not enough without me. Day by day +grows the store in the house less; and it will waste more slowly if I +am elsewhere.” + +Then Arngeir said quickly, “This is foolishness, Havelok, my brother. +Whither will you go? For worse is the famine inland; and I think that +we may last out here. The fish will come back presently.” + +“I will go to Lincoln. All know that there is plenty there, for the +townsfolk were wise in time. There is the court, and at the court a +strong man is likely to be welcome, if only as one who shall keep the +starving poor from the doors, as porter.” + +He spoke bitterly, for Alsi, the king, had no good name for kindness, +and at that Withelm laughed sadly. + +“Few poor would Havelok turn away,” he said, under his breath; “rather +were he likely to take the king’s food from the very board, and share +it among them.” + +That made us laugh a little, for it was true enough; and one might seem +to see our mighty one sweeping the table, while none dared try to stay +him. + +But many times of late Havelok had gone dinnerless, that he might feed +some weak one in the village. Maybe some of us did likewise; but, if +so, we learned from him. + +“Well, then,” Havelok said, when we had had our wretched laugh, “Alsi, +the king, can better afford to feed me than can anyone else. Therefore, +I will go and see about it. And if not the king, then, doubtless, some +rich merchant will give me food for work, seeing that I can lift things +handily. But Radbard here is a great and hungry man also, and it will +be well that he come with me; or else, being young and helpless, I may +fall into bad hands.” + +So he spoke, jesting and making little of the matter. But I saw that he +was right, and that we who were strong to take what might come should +go away. It was likely that a day of our meals would make a week’s fare +for Arngeir’s three little ones, and they were to be thought for. + +Now for a little while Arngeir tried to keep us back; but it was plain +that he knew also that our going was well thought of, and only his care +for Havelok stood in the way. Indeed, he said that I and Raven might +go. + +“Raven knows as much about the fish as did our father,” Havelok said. +“He will go out in the morning, and look at sky and sea, and sniff at +the wind; and if I say it will be fine, he says that the herrings will +be in such a place; and so they are, while maybe it rains all day to +spite my weather wisdom. You cannot do without Raven; for it is ill to +miss any chance of the sea just now. Nor can Withelm go, for he knows +all in the place, and who is most in want. It will not do to be without +house steward. So we two will go. Never have I been to Lincoln yet, and +Radbard knows the place well.” + +I think that I have never said that Grim would never take Havelok to +the city, lest he should be known by some of the Danish folk who came +now and then to the court, some from over seas, and others from the +court of King Ethelwald, of whom I have spoken, the Norfolk king. But +that danger was surely over now, for Havelok would be forgotten in +Denmark; and Ethelwald was long dead, and his wife also, leaving his +daughter Goldberga to her uncle Alsi, as his ward. So Alsi held both +kingdoms until the princess was of age, when she would take her own. It +was said that she lived at Dover until that time, and so none of her +Danes were likely to be at court if we went there and found places. + +So Havelok’s plan was to be carried out, and he and I were to set forth +next morning. Arngeir was yet uneasy about it, nevertheless, as one +could see; but I did not at that time know why it should be so doubtful +a matter that two strong men should go forth and seek their fortune but +thirty miles away. So we laughed at him. + +“Well,” he said, “every one knows Radbard; but they will want to know +who his tall comrade may be. Old foes has Havelok, as Radbard knows, +and therefore it may be well to find a new name for him.” + +“No need to go far for that,” Withelm said. “The marsh folk call him +Curan.” + +“Curan, the wonder, is good,” Arngeir said, after a little thought, for +we all knew Welsh enough by this time. “Or if you like a Danish name +better, brother, call it ‘Kwaran,’ but silent about yourself you must +surely be.” + +We used to call him that at times—for it means “the quiet” in our old +tongue—seeing how gentle and courtly he was in all his ways. So the +name was well fitting in either way. + +“Silent and thoughtful should the son of a king be,” says the Havamal, +and so it was with Havelok, son of Gunnar. + +Now when I came to think, it was plain that we three stood in the mind +of our brother in the place which my father had boded for us, and I was +glad. Well I knew that Raven, the watchful, and Withelm, the wise and +thoughtful, would do their parts; and I thought that whether I could do +mine was to be seen very shortly. If I failed in help at need it should +not be my fault. It had been long growing in my mind who Havelok must +be, though I said nothing of what I thought, because my father had +bidden me be silent long ago, and I thought that I knew why. + +We were to start early in the morning, so that we should get to the +city betimes in the evening; and there was one thing that troubled the +good sisters more than it did us. They would have had us go in all our +finery, such as we were wont to wear on holidays and at feastings; but +none of that was left. It had gone in buying corn, while there was any +left to buy, along with every silver penny that we had. So we must go +in the plain fisher gear, that is made for use and not for show, frayed +and stained, and a trifle tarry, but good enough. It would not do to go +in our war gear into a peaceful city; and so we took but the seax that +every Englishman wears, and the short travelling spear that all +wayfarers use. Hardly was it likely that even the most hungry outlaw of +the wild woldland would care to fall on us; for by this time such as we +seemed had spent their all in food for themselves and their families, +and all the money in Lindsey seemed to have gone away to places where +there was yet somewhat to buy. + +Busy were those kind sisters of ours that night in making ready the +last meal that we should need to take from them. And all the while they +foretold pleasant things for us at the king’s court—how that we should +find high honour and the like. So they set us forth well and +cheerfully. + +With the dawn we started, and Havelok was thoughtful beyond his wont +after we had bidden farewell to the home folk, so that I thought that +he grieved for leaving them at the last. + +“Downhearted, are you, brother?” I said, when we had gone a couple of +miles in silence across the level. “I have been to Lincoln two or three +times in a month sometimes in the summer, and it is no great distance +after all. I think nothing of the journey, or of going so short a way +from home.” + +“Nor do I,” he answered. “First, I was thinking of the many times my +father, Grim, went this way, and now he can walk no more; and then I +was thinking of that empty cottage we passed just now, where there was +a pleasant little family enough three months ago, who are all gone. And +then—ay, I will tell you—I had a dream last night that stays in my +mind, so that I think that out of this journey of ours will come +somewhat.” + +“Food and shelter, to wit,” said I, “which is all we want for a month +or two. Let us hear it.” + +“If we get all that I had in that dream, we shall want no more all our +lives,” he said, with a smile; “but it seems a foolish dream, now that +I come to tell it.” + +“That is mostly the way with dreams. It is strange how wonderful they +seem until daylight comes. I have heard Witlaf’s gleeman say that the +best lays he ever made were in his sleep; but if he remembered aught of +them, they were naught.” + +“It is not like that altogether with my dream,” Havelok said, “for it +went thus. I thought that I was in Denmark—though how I knew it was +Denmark I cannot say—and on a hill I sat, and at my feet was stretched +out all the land, so that I could see all over it at once. Then I +longed for it, and I stretched out my arms to gather it in, and so long +were they that they could well fathom it, and so I drew it to myself. +With towns and castles it was gathered in, and the keys of the +strongholds fell rattling at my feet, while the weight of the great +land seemed to lie on my knees. Then said one, and the voice was the +voice of Grim, ‘This is not all the dream that I have made for you, but +it is enough for now.’ That is the dream, therefore, and what make you +of it?” + +“A most amazing hunger, brother, certainly, and promise of enough to +satisfy it withal. I think that the sisters have talked about our +advancement at court until you have dreamed thereof.” + +“Why,” he said, “that is surely at the bottom of the dream, and I am +foolish to think more of it.” + +Then we went on, and grew light hearted as the miles passed. But though +I had seemed to think little of the dream, it went strangely with my +thoughts of what might lie before Havelok in days to come. + +As we went inland from the sea, the track of the pestilence was more +dread, for we passed house after house that had none living in them, +and some held the deserted dead. I might say many things of what we +saw, but I do not like to think of them much. Many a battlefield have I +seen since that day, but I do not think them so terrible as the field +over which has gone the foe that is unseen ere he smites. One knows the +worst of the battle when it is over and the roll is called, but who +knows where famine and pestilence stay? And those have given life for +king or land willingly, but these were helpless. + +It was good to climb the welds and look back, for in the high lands +there was none of this. Below us the levels, with their bright waters, +were wrapped in a strange blue haze, that had come with the famine at +its worst, and, as men said, had brought or made the sickness. I had +heard of it; but it was not so plain when one was in it, or else our +shore was free, which is likely, seeing how little we suffered. + +After that we kept to the high land, not so much fearing the blue robe +of the pestilence as what things of its working we might see; and so it +was late in the afternoon that we came in sight of Lincoln town, on its +hill, with the wide meres and river at its feet. I have seen no city +that stands more wonderfully than this of ours, with the grey walls of +the Roman town to crown the gathering of red and brown roofs that +nestle on the slope and within them. And ever as we drew nearer Havelok +became more silent, as I thought because he had never seen so great a +town before, until we passed the gates of the stockade that keeps the +town that lies without the old walls, and then he said, looking round +him strangely, “Brother, you will laugh at me, no doubt, for an arrant +dreamer, but this is the place whereto in dreams I have been many a +time. Now we shall come to yon turn of the road among the houses, and +beyond that we shall surely see a stone-arched gate in a great wall, +and spearmen on guard thereat.” + +It was so, and the gate and guard were before us in a few more steps. +It was the gate of the old Roman town, inside which was the palace of +the king and one or two more great houses only. Our English kin hate a +walled town or a stone house, and they would not live within the strong +walls, whose wide span was, save for the king’s palace, which was built +partly of the house of the Roman governor, and these other halls, which +went for naught in so wide a meadow, empty and green, and crossed by +two paved roads, with grass growing between the stones. There were +brown marks, as of the buried stones of other foundations, on the grass +where the old streets had been. + +All the straggling English town was outside the walls, and only in time +of war would the people use them as a stronghold, as they used the +still more ancient camps on the hills. + +“Many times have you heard us tell of this place, Havelok,” I said. “It +is no wonder that you seem to know it.” + +“Nay,” he answered, “but this is the city of my dreams, and somewhat is +to happen here.” + + + + +CHAPTER VIII. +BERTHUN THE COOK. + + +For that night we went to the house of the old dame with whom my father +and I were wont to lodge when we came to the market, and she took us in +willingly, though she could make little cheer for us. Truly, as had +been said, the scarcity was not so great in Lincoln, but everything was +terribly dear, and that to some is almost as bad. + +“No money have I now, dame,” I said ruefully, “but I think that for old +sake’s sake you will not turn us away.” + +“Not I, faith,” she answered. “I mind the first day your father came +here, and never a penny had he, and since then there has been no want +in this house. Luck comes with Grim and his folk, as I think. But this +is a son whom I have not seen before, if he is indeed your brother.” + +“I am Grim’s son Curan,” said Havelok, “and I have not been to Lincoln +ere this. But I have heard of you many times.” + +That pleased our old hostess, and then she asked after Grim. Hard it +was to have to tell her that he was gone, and hard it was for her to +hear, for the little house had been open to us for ten years. + +“What will you do now, masters?” she asked, when she had told us of +many a kindness done to her and her husband, who was long dead now, by +my father. + +I told her that we were too many at home since the fishing had failed, +and had therefore come to find some work here, at the court if +possible. + +“Doubtless two strong men will not have to go far to find somewhat,” +she said; “but the court is full of idle folk, and maybe no place is +empty. Now I will have you bide with me while you are at a loose end, +for there are yet a few silver pennies in store, and I ween that they +came out of Grim’s pouch to me. Lonely am I, and it is no good hoarding +them when his sons are hungry.” + +We thanked her for that kind saying, but she made light of it, saying +that almost did she hope that we should find no work, that we might +bide and lighten her loneliness for a time. + +“But if an old woman’s advice is good for aught, you shall not go to +the court first of all. Sour is King Alsi, and he is likely to turn you +away offhand rather than grant the smallest boon. But there is Berthun +the cook, as we call him—steward is his court name though—and he orders +the household, and is good-natured, so that all like him. Every morning +he comes into the market, and there you can ask him if there is a place +for you, and he loves to look on a man such as Curan. But if it is +weapons you want—and I suppose that is in the minds of tall men always, +though it brings sorrow in the end—there is the captain of the guard +who lives over the gate, and he might be glad to see you enough.” + +We said that we would see the steward, for we wanted no long +employment. We would go back to Grimsby when the famine ended, if it +were only by the coming of the fish again. + +Then she gave us of the best she had—black bread and milk to wit; and +after that we slept soundly before the fire, as I had done many times +before in that humble house. Black bread and milk it was again in the +morning; but there was plenty, and goodwill to season it. Then the old +dame sent us forth cheerfully and early, that we might not miss Berthun +the steward, from whom she hoped great things for us. + +So we sat in the marketplace for an hour or more watching the gates of +the wall for his coming; and men stared at Havelok, so that we went to +the bridge and waited there. One could see all the market from thence. +There were a good many of the market folk coming in presently, and most +of them knew me, and more than one stopped and spoke. + +Now Havelok grew restless, and wandered here and there looking at +things, though not going far from me; and while I was thus alone on the +bridge, a man I knew by sight came and leaned on the rail by me, and +told me that he had just seen the most handsome man and the goodliest +to look on that was in the kingdom, as he thought. + +“Yonder he stands,” he said, “like a king who has fallen on bad times. +I mind that I thought that Alsi, our king, would look like that, before +I saw him, and sorely disappointed was I in him therefore. Now I wonder +who yon man may be?” + +I did not say that I knew, but I looked at Havelok, and for the first +time, perhaps because I had never seen him among strangers before, I +knew that he was wondrous to look on. Full head and shoulders was he +above all the folk, and the Lindseymen are no babes in stature. And at +the same moment it came to me that it were not well that men should +know him as the son of Grim the fisher. If my father, who was the +wisest of men, had been so careful for all these years, I must not be +less so; for if there were ever any fear of the spies of Hodulf, it +would be now when his foe might be strong enough in years to think of +giving trouble. Not that I ever thought much of the said Hodulf, seeing +how far off he was; but my father had brought me up to dread him for +this brother of mine. Certainly by this time Hodulf knew that Grim had +come to England in safety, for the name of the new town must have come +to his ears: and if Grim, then the boy he had given to him. + +The man who spoke to me went away soon, and Havelok strolled back to +me. + +“I would that the cook, or whoever he is, would come,” he said. “I grow +weary of this crowd that seems to have naught to do but stare at a +stranger.” + +“What shall we ask, when he does come? and supposing that there is a +place for but one of us?” I said. + +“Why, then, the one it fits best will take it, and the other must seek +some other chance. That is all.” + +“As you will, brother,” I answered, “but I would rather that we should +be together.” + +“And I also. But after all, both will be in Lincoln, and we must take +what comes. It is but for a little while, and we shall not like to +burden that good old dame by being too hard to please. We want somewhat +to do until we can go home, not for a day longer, and I care not what +it is.” + +“That is right,” I said; “and the sooner I see one of our folk coming +over this bridge with a full basket of fish, the better I shall like +it. But it may be a long day before that. Now, I have been thinking +that it were not well that you should say that you are the son of +Grim.” + +I did not quite know how he would take this, for he was proud of my +father as I. But that very pride made it easy. + +“Maybe not,” he said thoughtfully, “for it seems unworthy of his sons +that we have to ask for service from any man. But I do not think that +he could blame us, as things are. Nevertheless, folk shall not talk.” + +“Men know me,” said I, “but that cannot be helped.” + +He laughed gaily at that. + +“Why, here we speak as if one man in a hundred knew you. And after all +it may be that we shall get a place that none need be ashamed of. Look, +here comes a mighty fine lord from the gateway.” + +It was Berthun the steward, for whom we were waiting, and I knew him +well by sight. Often had he bought our fish, but I did not think that +he would remember me by name, if he had ever heard it. He was a portly +and well-favoured man, not old, and as he came down the street to the +marketplace at the hill foot he laughed and talked with one and another +of the townsfolk, whether high or low, in very pleasant wise. + +Presently he stopped at a stall, and priced some meat; and when he had +bought it he looked round and called for some men to carry it for him; +and at that the idlers made a rush for him, tripping over one another +in haste to be first, while he laughed at them. + +He chose two or three, and sent them up the hill to the palace with +their burdens, and then went to another booth and bought. + +“This is work at which I should make a good hand,” said Havelok, +laughing at the scrambling men who ran forward when the steward again +called for porters. “Well paid also the job must be, to judge of their +eagerness.” + +The three men who had been chosen took their burden and went away, and +the steward came near us, to a bakery that was close to the bridge end. + +“I have a mind to do porter for once,” Havelok said. “Then I can at +least earn somewhat to take back to the dame tonight.” + +“If you do so,” I answered, “I will wait here for you. But you will +have to fight for the place.” + +Now the steward bought all that he needed, and that was bread for the +whole palace for the day, and again he called for porters. Whereon +Havelok got up from the bridge rail and went towards him in no great +hurry, so that the idlers were in a crowd before him. + +“Ho! friends,” cried Havelok, “let the good cook see all of us and make +his choice. He can only take one at a time.” + +“One, forsooth,” said a man from the crowd; “why, there is a load for +four men there.” + +“Well, then, let him pick four little ones, and give these little ones +a chance of being seen.” + +Now I do not think that he would have troubled with the matter any +more; but whether the men knew that this was the last load that the +steward had to send home, or whether they quarrelled, I cannot say, but +in their eagerness to raise the two great baskets they fell to +struggling over them, and the steward tried to quiet the turmoil by a +free use of his staff, and there was a danger that the bread should be +scattered. + +“Here will be waste of what there is none too much of just now,” said +Havelok; and with that he went to the aid of the steward, picking up +and setting aside the men before him, and then brushing the struggling +rivals into a ruefully wondering heap from about the baskets, so that +he and the steward faced each other, while there fell a silence on the +little crowd that had gathered. Even the men who had been put aside +stayed their abuse as they saw what manner of man had come to the +rescue of the baskets, and Havelok and the cook began to laugh. + +“Fe, fi, fo, fum!” said Berthun; “here is surely a Cornish giant among +us! Now I thank you, good Blunderbore, or whatever your name is, for +brushing off these flies.” + +“The folk in this place are unmannerly,” said Havelok; “hut if you want +the bread carried up the hill I will do it for you.” + +Berthun looked him up and down in a puzzled sort of way once or twice +ere he answered, “Well, as that is your own proposal, pick your helpers +and do so; I would not have asked such a thing of you myself.” + +“There is not much help needed,” said Havelok. “I think this may be +managed if I get a fair hold.” + +Now we were used to seeing him carry such loads as would try the +strength of even Raven and myself, who could lift a load for three men; +but when he took the two great baskets of bread and swung them into +place on either arm, a smothered shout went round the crowd, and more +than once I heard the old Welsh name that the marsh folk had given him +spoken. + +“Let us be going,” said Havelok to the steward on that. “One would +think that none of these had ever hefted a fair load in his life, to +listen to them.” + +So he nodded to me across the heads of the crowd, and followed Berthun, +and the idlers followed him for a little. The guard turned these back +at the gate, and Havelok went through, and I could see him no more. + +Presently the crowd drifted back to their places, and I heard them +talking. Havelok and his strength was likely to be a nine days’ wonder +in Lincoln, and I was glad that I had asked him not to say whence he +was. + +“He is some thane’s son who is disguised,” said one. + +“Maybe he is under a vow,” said another; and then one chimed in with a +story of some prince of Arthur’s time, by name Gareth, who hid his +state at his mother’s command. + +“As for me,” said the baker, “I think that he is a fisher, as he +looks—at least, that is, as his clothes make him.” + +So even he had his doubts, and I will say that I understood well enough +now why my father never brought him here before. + +Havelok was long in coming back, as I thought, and I seemed to be +wasting time here, and so I bethought me of the other man to whom the +old dame had said we might go—namely, the captain of the gate. I should +see Havelok if I stood there. + +The captain was talking with some of his men as I came up, and of +course it was of Havelok that they spoke; and seeing that I wore the +same dress as he, they asked me if I knew who he was. + +“He is a fisher from the coast,” I answered. “I have heard him called +Curan.” + +“Welsh then,” the captain answered, somewhat disappointed, as it +seemed. “If he had been a Mercian, or even a Saxon, I would have had +him here, but a fisher has had no training in arms after all.” + +“Some of us have,” said I. + +The captain looked me up and down, and then walked round me, saying +nothing until we were face to face again. + +“That, I take it, is a hint that you might like to be a housecarl of +the king’s,” he said. “Are you a Lindseyman?” + +“I am the son of Grim of Grimsby,” I said. + +“Why, then, I suppose you would not think of it, seeing that my place +is not empty; but if you will dress in that way you must not wonder if +I took you for a likely man for a housecarl. We know Grim well by +repute. Come in and tell me about the famine, and this new town of +yours that one hears of.” + +Now I could not see Havelok as yet, and so I went into the stone-arched +Roman guardroom, and Eglaf the captain fetched out a pot of wine and +some meat, and made me very welcome while we talked. And presently I +thought that I might do worse than be a housecarl for a time, if Eglaf +would have me. I should be armed at least, and with comrades to help if +Havelok needed me; though all the while I thought myself foolish for +thinking that any harm could come to him who was so strong. +Nevertheless, what my father had laid on us all was to be heeded, and I +was to be his helper in arms. So presently I told Eglaf that the +housecarl’s life seemed an easy one, and that it would be pleasant to +go armed for a while, if he would have me for a short time, seeing that +the famine had left us naught to do. + +“Well, there is plenty to eat and drink,” he said, “and good lodging in +the great hall or here, as one’s post may be, and a silver penny every +day; but no fighting to be done, seeing that Alsi will sooner pay a foe +to go away than let us see to the matter. Doing naught is mighty hard +work at times.” + +Then he asked if I had arms, and I said that I would send for them at +once, and that settled the matter. If I chose to come with my own arms +I should be welcome. + +“I am glad to get you,” he said, “for there will be a crowd in the +place ere long, for the Witan is to meet, and the thanes will come with +their men, and there will be fine doings, so that we need another +strong arm or two that we may keep the peace,” + +He took a long pull at the wine pot, and then went on, “Moreover, the +princess’s Danes are sure to want to fight some of the English folk for +sport.” + +“What! is she here?” + +“Not yet. They say that she is coming when the Witan meets, because the +Witan wants to see her, not because Alsi does. But he dare not go +against them, and so it must be.” + +Now Goldberga, the princess, was, as I have said, Alsi’s ward, and was +at this time just eighteen, so that it would be time for her to take +the kingdom that was hers by right. It was common talk, however, that +Alsi by no means liked the thought of giving the wide lands of East +Anglia up to her, and that he would not do so if he could anywise help +it. Maybe the Witan thought so also, and would see fair play. Ethelwald +and his wife Orwenna had been well loved both here and in Norfolk, and +it was said that Goldberga their daughter grew wondrous fair and +queenly. + +I had learned one thing though, and that was that we should have +Ethelwald’s Danes here shortly, and that I did not like; but after all, +what did these few men of an old household know of the past days in +Denmark? There had been no going backwards and forwards between the two +countries since the king died ten years ago. Nevertheless I was glad +that I had found a friend in Eglaf, and that I was to be here. + +Then I got up to go, and the captain bade me come as soon as I could, +for he could talk to me as he could not to the men, maybe. So I bade +him farewell, and went slowly back, down the street, sitting down in +the old place. + +It was not long after that before Havelok came, and I saw Berthun the +steward come as far as the gate with him, and stand looking after him +as he walked away; then Eglaf came out, and both looked and talked for +a while, and therefore, as soon as I knew that Havelok saw me, I went +away and across the bridge to a place that was quiet, and waited for +him there. + +“Well, brother,” I said, “you have had a long job with the cook. What +is the end of it all?” + +“I do not know,” he answered slowly. “That is to be seen yet.” + +I looked at him, for his voice was strange, and I saw that he seemed to +have the same puzzled look in his eyes as he had last night when we +came first into the city. I asked if anything was amiss. + +“Nothing,” he said; “but this is a place of dreams. I think that I +shall wake presently in Grimsby.” + +We walked on, and past the straggling houses outside the stockade, and +so into the fields; and little by little he told me what was troubling +him. + +Berthun the steward had said nothing until the palace was reached, and +had led him to the great servants’ hall, and there had bidden him set +down his load and rest. Then he had asked if he would like to see the +place, and of course Havelok had said that he would, wondering at the +same time if this was all the pay that the porters got. So he was shown +the king’s hall, and the arms on the wall, and the high seat, and the +king’s own chamber, and many more things, and all the while they seemed +nothing strange to Havelok. + +“This Berthun watched me as a cat watches a mouse all the while,” he +said, “and at last he asked if I had ever seen a king’s house before. I +told him that I had a dream palace which had all these things, but was +not the same. And at that he smiled and asked my name. ‘Curan,’ I said, +of course; and at that he smiled yet more, in a way that seemed to say +that he did not believe me. ‘It is a good name for the purpose,’ he +said, ‘but I have to ask your pardon for calling you by the old giant’s +name just now.’ I said that as he did not know my name, and it was a +jest that fitted, it was no matter. Then he made a little bow, and +asked if I would take any food before I went from the place; so I told +him that it was just what I came for, and he laughed, and I had such a +meal as I have not seen for months. It is in my mind that I left a +famine in that house, so hungry was I. There is no pride about this +Berthun, for he served me himself, and I thanked him.” + +Then Havelok stopped and passed his hand over his face, and he laughed +a little, uneasy laugh. + +“And all the while I could not get it out of my head that he ought to +be kneeling before me.” + +“Well,” he went on after a little, “when I had done, this Berthun asked +me a question, saying that he was a discreet man, and that if he could +help me in any way he would do so. Had I a vow on me? Nothing more than +to earn my keep until the famine was over, I said. I had left poor folk +who would have the more for my absence, and he seemed to think that +this was a wondrous good deed. So I told him that if he could help me +in this I should be glad. Whereon he lowered his voice and asked if I +must follow the way of Gareth the prince. I had not heard of this +worthy, and so I said that what was good enough for a prince was +doubtless good enough for me, and that pleased him wonderfully. + +“‘Gladly will I take you into my service,’ he said, ‘if that will +content you.’ Which it certainly would; and so I am to be porter again +tomorrow. Then I said that I had a comrade to whom I must speak first. +He said that no doubt word must be sent home of my welfare, and he saw +me as far as the gate.” + +“Which of you went out of the hall first?” I asked. + +“Now I come to think of it, I did. I went to let him pass, as the +elder, though it was in my mind to walk out as if the place belonged to +me; and why, I do not know, for no such thought ever came to me in +Witlaf’s house, or even in a cottage; but he stood aside and made me go +first.” + +Now I longed for Withelm and his counsel, for one thing was plain to +me, and that was that with the once familiar things of the kingship +before him the lost memory of his childhood was waking in Havelok, and +I thought that the time my father boded was at hand. The steward had +seen that a court and its ways were no new thing to him, and had seen +too that he had been wont to take the first place somewhere; so he had +deemed that this princely-looking youth was under a vow of service, in +the old way. It is likely that the Welsh name would make him think that +he was from beyond the marches to the west, and that was just as well. + +Then Havelok said, “Let us go back to the widow’s house and sleep. My +head aches sorely, and it is full of things that are confused, so that +I do not know rightly who I am or where. Maybe it will pass with rest.” + +We turned hack, and then I told him what I meant to do; and that +pleased him, for we should see one another often. + +“We are in luck, brother, so far,” he said, “having lit on what we +needed so soon; but I would that these dreams would pass.” + +“It is the poor food of many days gone by,” I said. “Berthun will cure +that for you very shortly.” + +“It is likely enough,” he answered more gaily. + +“Little want is in that house, but honest Berthun does not know what a +trencherman he has hired. But I would that we had somewhat to take back +to our good old dame tonight.” + +But she was more than satisfied with our news; and when she saw that +Havelok was silent, she made some curious draught of herbs for him, +which he swallowed, protesting, and after that he slept peacefully. + +I went out to the marketplace and found a man whom I knew—one of those +who carried our fish at times; and him I sent, with promise of two +silver pennies presently, to Arngeir for my arms, telling him that all +was well. + + + + +CHAPTER IX. +CURAN THE PORTER. + + +There is no need for me to say how my arms came to me from Grimsby, and +how I went to Eglaf as I had promised. I will only say that the life +was pleasant enough, if idle, as a housecarl, and that I saw Havelok +every day at one time or another, which was all that I could wish. + +But as I had to wait a day or two while the messenger went and the arms +came from home, I saw Havelok meet the steward on the next day: and a +quaint meeting enough it was, for Berthun hardly knew how he should +behave to this man, whom he had made up his mind was a wandering +prince. + +There was the crowd who waited for the call for porters, as ever; hut +the steward would have none of them, until he saw his new man towering +over the rest, and then he half made a motion to unbonnet, which he +checked and turned into a beckoning wave of the hand, whereon the +idlers made their rush for him, and Havelok walked through and over +them, more or less, as they would not make way for him. But so +good-naturedly was this done, that even those whom he lifted from his +path and dropped on one side laughed when they saw who had cleared a +way for himself, and stood gaping to see what came next. + +“Ho—why, yes—Curan—that was the name certainly. I have been looking for +you, as we said,” stammered the steward. + +“Here am I, therefore,” answered Havelok, “and where is the load?” + +“Truth to tell, I have bought but this at present,” said the steward, +pointing to a small basket of green stuff on the stall at which he +stood. + +“Well, I suppose there is more to come,” Havelok said, taking it up; +“it will be a beginning.” + +“I will not ask you to carry more than that,” Berthun began. + +“Why, man, this is foolishness. If you have a porter, make him carry +all he can, else he will not earn his keep.” + +“As you will,” answered the steward, shrugging his shoulders as one who +cannot account for some folk’s whims, and going on to the next booth. + +Now, I suppose that the idlers looked to see Havelok walk away with +this light load gladly, as any one of them would have done, and that +then their turn would have come; but this was not what they expected. +Maybe they would have liked to see the strong man sweep up all the +palace marketing and carry it, as a show, but it might interfere with +their own gains. So there was a murmur or two among them, and this grew +when Havelok took the next burden in like manner. + +“Ho, master cook,” cried a ragged man at last, “this is not the custom, +and it is not fair that one man should do all the work, and all for one +wage.” + +Berthun took no notice of this; and so the cry was repeated, and that +by more than one. And at last he turned round and answered. + +“Go to, ye knaves,” he said with a red face and angrily; “if I find a +man who will save me the trouble of your wrangles every day, shall I +not do as I please?” + +Then there was a tumult of voices, and some of them seemed sad, as if a +last hope was gone, and that Havelok heard. + +“There is somewhat in this,” he said to the cook. “What pay have you +given to each man who carries for you?” + +“A yesterday’s loaf each,” answered Berthun, wondering plainly that +Havelok paid any heed to the noise. + +“Well, then, let us go on, and we will think of somewhat,” Havelok +said; and then he turned to the people, who were silent at once. + +“I am a newcomer, and a hungry one,” he said, smiling quietly, “and I +have a mind to earn my loaf well. Hinder me not for today, and +hereafter I will take my chance with the rest, if need is.” + +Thereat the folk began to laugh also, for it was plain that none had +any chance at all if he chose to put forth his strength; but an old man +said loudly, “Let the good youth alone now, and he shall talk with us +when he has done his errand and fed that great bulk of his. He has an +honest face, and will be fair to all.” + +That seemed to please the crowd; and after that they said no more, but +followed and watched the gathering up of Havelok’s mighty burden. And +presently there was more than he could manage; and he spoke to Berthun, +who checked himself in a half bow as he answered. + +Then Havelok looked over the faces before him, and beckoned to two men +who seemed weakly and could not press forward, and to them he gave the +lighter wares, and so left the market with his master, as one must call +the steward. + +“What told I you?” said the old man, as they came back from the great +gate. “Never saw I one with a face like that who harmed any man, either +in word or deed.” + +Now when Havelok had set down his load in the kitchen, he straightened +himself and said to Berthun, who was, as one may say, waiting his +pleasure. + +“This is today’s task; but it is in my mind that I would stay up here +and work.” + +“What would you do?” + +“There are men yonder who will miss the carrying if I am market porter +always. But here are things I can earn my keep at, and help the other +servants with at the same time. Water drawing there is, and carrying of +logs for the fire, and cleaving them also, and many other things that +will be but hardening my muscles, while they are over heavy to be +pleasant for other folk.” + +“Well,” answered Berthun, “that is all I could wish, and welcome to +some here will you be. Let it be so.” + +“Now, I do not think that you would make a gain by my work this +morning?” + +“Truly not, if any one is wronged by my doing so,” the puzzled steward +said. + +Then Havelok asked how many men would have been needed to carry up the +goods that he had brought, and Berthun said that he was wont to send +one at least from each stall, and more if the burden was heavy. + +“Then today four poor knaves must go dinnerless by reason of my +strength, and that does not please me altogether,” said Havelok +gravely. “Give these two their loaves; and then, I pray you, give me +the other four, and let me go back to the market.” + +And then he added, with a smile, “I think that I can order matters +there so that things will be more fair, and that you will have less +trouble with that unmannerly scramble.” + +“If you can do that, you are even as your name calls you. Take them and +welcome, Curan, and then come here and do what work you will,” Berthun +said in haste. + +“Tasks you must set me, or I shall grow idle. That is the failing of +over-big men,” Havelok said; and he took the loaves and left the palace +with the two market men at his heels. + +I saw him come back, and at once the crowd of idlers made for him, but +in a respectful way enough. I knew, however, how easily these folks +took to throwing mud and stones in their own quarrels, and I was a +little anxious, for to interfere with the ways of the market is a high +offence among them. + +But Havelok knew naught of that, and went his way with his loaves to +the bridge end, and there sat on the rail and looked at the men before +him. And _lo!_ back to my mind came old days in Denmark, and how I once +saw Gunnar the king sitting in open court to do justice, and then I +knew for certain that I was looking on his son. And when Havelok spoke +it was in the voice of Gunnar that I had long forgotten, but which came +back to me clear and plain, as if it were yesterday that I had heard +it. Never does a boy forget his first sight of the king. + +“Friends,” said Havelok, “if I do two men’s work I get two men’s pay, +or else I might want to know the reason why. But I am only one man, all +the same, and it seems right to me that none should be the loser. +Wherefore I have a mind to share my pay fairly.” + +There was a sort of shout at that and Havelok set his four loaves in a +row on the rail beside him. But then some of the rougher men went to +make a rush at them, and he took the foremost two and shook them, so +that others laughed and bade the rest beware. + +“So that is just where the trouble comes in,” said Havelok coolly; “the +strong get the first chance, as I did this morning, by reason of there +being none to see fair play.” + +“Bide in the market, master, and we will make you judge among us,” +cried a small man from the edge of the crowd. + +“Fair and softly,” Havelok answered. “I am not going to bide here +longer than I can help. Come hither, grandfer,” and he beckoned to the +old man who had bidden them wait his return, “tell me the names of the +men who have been longest without any work.” + +The old man pointed out three, and then Havelok stopped him. + +“One of these loaves is my own wage,” he said; “but you three shall +have the others, and that will be the easiest day’s work you ever did. +But think not that I am going to do the like every day, for Lincoln +hill is no easy climb, and the loaf is well earned at the top. +Moreover, it is not good to encourage the idle by working for them.” + +So the three men had their loaves, and Havelok began to eat his own +slowly, swinging his legs on the bridge rail while the men watched him. + +“Master,” said the small man from behind, pushing forward a little, now +that the crowd was looser, “make a law for the market, I pray you, that +all may have a chance.” + +“Who am I to make laws?” said my brother slowly, and, as he said this, +his hand went up to his brows as it had gone last night when the palace +had wearied him. + +“The strong make laws for the weak,” the old man said to him in a low +voice. “If the strong is honest, for the weak it is well. Things are +hard for the weak here; and therefore say somewhat, for it may be of +use.” + +“It can be none, unless the strong is at hand to see that the law is +kept.” + +“Sometimes the market will see that a rule is not broken, for itself. +There is no rule for this matter.” + +Again Havelok passed his hand over his eyes, and he was long in +answering. The loaf lay at his side now. Presently he looked straight +before him, and, as if he saw far beyond Lincoln Hill and away to the +north, he said, “This is my will, therefore, that from this time +forward it shall be the law that men shall have one among them who may +fairly and without favour so order this matter that all shall come to +Berthun the steward in turns that shall be kept, and so also with the +carrying for any other man. There shall be a company of porters, +therefore, which a man must join before he shall do this work, save +that every stranger who comes shall be suffered to take a burden once, +and then shall be told of this company, and the custom that is to be. +And I will that this old man shall see to this matter.” + +And then he stopped suddenly, and seemed to start as a great shout went +up from the men, a shout as of praise; and his eyes looked again on +them, and that wonderingly. + +“They will keep this law,” said the old man. “Well have you spoken.” + +“I have said a lot of foolishness, maybe,” answered Havelok. “For the +life of me I could not say it again.” + +“There is not one of us that could not do so,” said his adviser. “But +bide you here, master, in the town?” + +“I am in service at the palace.” + +Then the old man turned round to the others and said, “This is good +that we have heard, and it is nothing fresh, for all trades have their +companies, and why should not we? Is this stranger’s word to be kept?” + +Maybe there were one or two of the rougher men who held their peace, +for they had had more than their share of work, but from the rest came +a shout of “Ay!” as it were at the Witan. + +“Well, then,” said Havelok suddenly, getting down from his seat and +giving his loaf to the old man, “see you to it; and if any give trouble +hereafter, I shall hear from the cook, and, by Odin, I will even come +down and knock their heads together for them. So farewell.” + +He smiled round pleasantly, yet in that way which has a meaning at the +back of it; and at that every cap went off and the men did him +reverence as to a thane at least, and he nodded to them and came across +to me. + +“Come out into the fields, brother, for I shall weep if I bide here +longer.” + +So he said; and we went away quickly, while the men gathered round the +old leader who was to be, and talked earnestly. + +“This famine plays strange tricks with me,” he said when we were away +from every one. “Did you hear all that I said?” + +“I heard all, and you have spoken the best thing that could have been +said. Eight years have I been to this market, and a porters’ guild is +just what is needed. And it will come about now.” + +“It was more dreaming, and so I must be a wise man in my dream. Even as +in the palace yesterday it came on me, and I seemed to be at the gate +of a great hall, and it was someone else that was speaking, and yet +myself. It is in my mind that I told these knaves what my lordly will +was, forsooth; and the words came to me in our old Danish tongue, so +that it was hard not to use it. But it seems to me that long ago I did +these things, or saw them, I know not which, somewhere. Tell me, did +the king live in our town across the sea?” + +“No, but in another some way off. My father took me there once or +twice.” + +“Can you mind that he took me also?” + +I shook my head, and longed for Withelm. Surely I would send for him, +or for Arngeir, if this went on. Arngeir for choice, for I could tell +him what I thought; and that would only puzzle Withelm, who knew less +than I. + +“We will ask Arngeir some day,” I said; “he can remember.” + +“I suppose he did take me,” mused Havelok; “and I suppose that I want +more sleep or more food or somewhat. Now we will go and tell the old +dame of my luck, for she has lost her lodger.” + +Then he told me of his fortune with the steward. + +“Half afraid of me he seems, for he will have me do just what I will. +That will be no hard place therefore.” + +But I thought that if I knew anything of Havelok my brother, he would +be likely to make it hard by doing every one’s work for him, and that +Berthun saw this; or else that, as I had thought last night, the shrewd +courtier saw the prince behind the fisher’s garb. + +So we parted presently at the gate of the palace wall, and I went back +to the widow to wait for my arms, while he went to his master. And I +may as well tell the end of Havelok’s lawmaking. + +Berthun went down to the market next day, and came back with a wonder +to be told. And it was to Havelok that he went first to tell it, as he +was drawing bucket after bucket of water from the deep old Roman well +in the courtyard to fill the great tub which he considered a fair load +to carry at once. + +“There is something strange happening in the market,” he said, “and I +think that you have a hand in it. The decency of the place is +wonderful, and you said that you thought I might have less trouble with +the men than I was wont if you went down with the loaves. What did you? +For I went to the baker’s stalls and bought, and looked round for the +tail that is after me always; and I was alone, and all the market folk +were agape to see what was to be done. I thought that I had offended +the market by yesterday’s business, as they had called out on me, and I +thought that I should have to come and fetch your—that is, if it +pleased you. But first I called, as is my wont, for porters. Now all +that rabble sat in a row along a wall, and, by Baldur, when I looked, +they had cleaned themselves! Whereupon an old gaffer, who has carried +things once or twice for me when there has been no crowd and he has +been able to come forward, lifted up his voice and asked how many men I +wanted, so please me. + +“‘Two,’I said, wondering, and at that two got up and came to me, and I +sent them off. It was the same at the next booth, and the next, for he +told off men as I wanted them; and here am I back a full half-hour +earlier than ever before, and no mud splashes from the crowd either. It +is said that they have made a porters’ guild; and who has put that +sense into their heads unless your—that is, unless you have done so, I +cannot say.” + +Havelok laughed. + +“Well, I did tell them that they should take turns, or somewhat like +that; and I also told them that if you complained of them I would see +to it.” + +“Did you say that you would pay them, may I ask—that is, of course, if +they were orderly? For if so, I thank—” + +“I told them that if you complained I would knock their heads +together,” said Havelok. + +And that was the beginning of the Lincoln porters’ guild; and in after +days Havelok was wont to say that he would that all lawmaking was as +easy as that first trial of his. Certainly from that day forward there +was no man in all the market who would not have done aught for my +brother, and many a dispute was he called on to settle. It is not +always that a law, however good it may be, finds not a single one to +set himself against it. But then Havelok was a strong man. + +Now there is naught to tell of either Havelok or myself for a little +while, for we went on in our new places comfortably enough. One heard +much of Havelok, though, for word of him and his strength and +goodliness, and of his kindness moreover, went through the town, with +tales of what he had done. But I never heard that any dared to ask him +to make a show of himself by doing feats of strength. Only when he came +down to the guardroom sometimes with me would he take part in the +weapon play that he loved, and the housecarls, who were all tried and +good warriors, said that he was their master in the use of every +weapon, and it puzzled them to know where he had learned so well, for +he yet wore his fisher’s garb. They sent his arms with mine from +Grimsby, thinking that he also needed them; but he left them with the +widow. + +Havelok used to laugh if they asked him this, and tell them that it +came by nature, and in that saying there was more than a little truth. +So the housecarls, when they heard how Berthun was wont to treat him, +thought also that he was some great man in hiding, and that the steward +knew who he was. They did not know but that my close friendship with +him had sprung up since he came, and that was well, and Eglaf and he +and I were soon much together. The captain wanted him to leave the cook +and be one of his men, but we thought that he had better bide where he +was, rather than let Alsi the king have him always about him. For now +and then that strange feeling, as of the old days, came over him when +he was in the great hall, and he had to go away and brood over it for a +while until he would set himself some mighty task and forget it. + +But one day he came to me and said that he was sure he knew the ways of +a king too well for it all to be a dream, adding that Berthun saw that +also, and was curious about him. + +“Tell me, brother, whence came I? _Was_ I truly brought up in a court?” + +“I have never heard,” I answered. “All that I know for certain is that +you fled with us from Hodulf, the new king, and that for reasons which +my father never told me.” + +Then said Havelok, “There was naught worth telling, therefore. I +suppose I was the child of some steward like Berthun; but yet—” + +So he went away, and I wondered long if it were not time that Arngeir +should tell all that he knew. It was of no good for me to say that in +voice and ways and deed he had brought back to me the Gunnar whom I had +not seen for so many long years, for that was as likely as not to be a +fancy of mine, or if not a fancy, he might be only a sister’s son or +the like. But in all that he said there was no word of his mother, and +by that I knew that his remembrance must be but a shadow, if a growing +one. + +But there was no head in all the wide street that was not turned to +look after him; and now he went his way from me with two children, whom +he had caught up from somewhere, perched on either shoulder, and +another in his arms, and they crowed with delight as he made believe to +be some giant who was to eat them forthwith, and ran up the hill with +them. No such playmate had the Lincoln children before Havelok came. + + + + +CHAPTER X. +KING ALSI OF LINDSEY. + + +Three weeks after we came the Witan[8] began to gather, and that was a +fine sight as the great nobles of Lindsey, and of the North folk of +East Anglia, came day by day into the town with their followings, +taking up their quarters either in the better houses of the place or +else pitching bright-coloured tents and pavilions on the hillside +meadows beyond the stockades. Many brought their ladies with them, and +all day long was feasting and mirth at one place or another, as friend +met with friend. Never had I seen such a gay sight as the marketplace +was at midday, when the young thanes and their men met there and +matched their followers at all sorts of sports. The English nobles are +far more fond of gay dress and jewels than our Danish folk, though I +must say that when the few Danes of Ethelwald’s household came it would +seem that they had taken kindly to the fashion of their home. + +Our housecarls grumbled a bit for a while, for with all the newcomers +dressed span new for the gathering, we had had nothing fresh for it +from the king, as was the custom, and I for one was ashamed of myself, +for under my mail was naught but the fisher’s coat, which is good +enough for hard wear, but not for show. But one day we were fitted out +fresh by the king’s bounty in blue and scarlet jerkins and hose, and we +swaggered after that with the best, as one may suppose. + +Berthun had the ordering of that business, and he came and sat with +Eglaf in the gatehouse and talked of it. + +“Pity that you do not put your man Curan into decent gear,” the captain +said. “That old sailcloth rig does not do either him or you or the +court credit.” + +“That is what I would do,” said the steward, “but he will not take +aught but the food that he calls his hire. He is a strange man +altogether, and I think that he is not what he seems.” + +“So you have told me many times, and I think with you. He will be some +crack-brained Welsh princeling who has been crossed in love, and so has +taken some vow on him, as the King Arthur that they prate of taught +them to do. Well, if he is such, it is an easy matter to make him +clothe himself decently. It is only to tell him that the clothes are +from the king, and no man who has been well brought up may refuse such +a gift.” + +“But suppose that he thanks the king for the gift. Both he and the king +will be wroth with me.” + +“Not Curan, when he has once got the things on; and as for >Alsi, he +will take the thanks to himself, and chuckle to think that the mistake +has gained him credit for a good deed that he never did.” + +“Hush, comrade, hush!” said Berthun quickly; “naught but good of the +king!” + +“I said naught ill. But if Woden or Frey, or whoever looks after good +deeds, scores the mistake to Alsi as well, it will be the first on the +count of charity that—” + +But at this Berthun rose up in stately wise. + +“I may not listen to this. To think that here in the guardroom I should +hear such—” + +“Sit down, comrade,” said Eglaf, laughing, and pulling the steward into +his seat again. “Well you know that I would be cut to pieces for the +king tomorrow if need were, and so I earn free speech of him I guard. +If I may not say what I think of him to a man who knows as much of him +as I, who may?” + +“I have no doubt that the king would clothe Curan if I asked him,” said +Berthun stiffly, but noways loth to take his seat again. + +“But it is as much as your place is worth to do it. I know what you +would say.” + +Berthun laughed. + +“I will do it myself, and if Alsi does get the credit, what matter?” + +Wherefore it came to pass that as I was on guard at the gate leading to +the town next day I saw a most noble-looking man coming towards me, and +I looked a second time, for I thought him one of the noblest of all the +thanes who had yet come, and the second look told me that it was +Havelok in this new array. I will say that honest Berthun had done his +part well; and if the king was supposed to be the giver, he had nothing +to complain of. Eglaf had told me of the way in which the dressing of +Havelok was to be done. + +“Ho!” said I, “I thought you some newcomer.” + +“I hardly know myself,” he answered, “and I am not going to grumble at +the change, seeing that this is holiday time. Berthun came to me last +evening, and called me aside, and said that it was the king’s wont to +dress his folk anew at the time of the Witan, and then wanted to know +if my vow prevented me from wearing aught but fisher’s clothes. And +when I said that if new clothes went as wage for service about the +place I was glad to hear it, he was pleased, as if it had been likely +that I would refuse a good offer. So the tailor went to work on me, and +hence this finery. But you are as fine, and this is more than we +counted on when we left Grimsby. I suppose it is all in honour of the +lady of the North folk, Goldberga.” + +“Maybe, for I have heard that she is to come.” + +“To be fetched rather, if one is to believe all that one hears. They +say that Alsi has kept her almost as a captive in Dover, having given +her into the charge of some friend of his there, that she may be far +from her own kingdom and people. Now the Norfolk Witan has made him +bring her here. Berthun seems to think there will be trouble.” + +“Only because Alsi will not want to let the kingdom go from his hand to +her. But that will not matter. He is bound by the old promise to her +father.” + +Now we were talking to one another in broad Danish, there being none +near to hear us. We had always used it among ourselves at Grimsby, for +my father loved his old tongue. But at that moment there rode up to the +gate a splendid horseman, young and handsome, and with great gold +bracelets on his arms, one or two of which caught my eye at once, for +they were of the old Danish patterns, and just such as Jarl Sigurd used +to wear. But if I was quick to notice these tokens of the old land, he +had been yet quicker, for he reined up before I stayed him, as was my +duty if he would pass through this gate to the palace, so that I might +know his authority. + +“If I am not mistaken,” he said in our own tongue, “I heard you two +talking in the way I love best. Skoal, therefore, to the first Northman +I have met between here and London town, for it is good to hear a +friendly voice.” + +“Skoal to the jarl!” I answered, and I gave the salute of Sigurd’s +courtmen, which came into my mind on the moment with the familiar +greeting of long years ago. And “Skoal,” said Havelok. + +“Jarl! How know you that I am that?” + +“By the jarl’s bracelet that you wear, surely.” + +“So you are a real Dane—not an English-bred one like myself. That is +good. You and I will have many a talk together. Odin, how good it is to +meet a housecarl who speaks as man to man and does not cringe to me! +Who are you?” + +“Radbard Grimsson of Grimsby, housecarl just now to this King of +Lindsey.” + +“And your comrade?” + +I was about to tell this friendly countryman Havelok’s name without +thought, but stopped in time. Of all the things I had been brought up +to dread most for him, that an English Dane should find him out was the +worst, so I said, “He is called Curan, and he is a Lindsey marshman.” + +“Who can talk Danish though his name is Welsh. That is strange. Well, +you are right about me. I am Ragnar of Norwich, the earl, as the +English for jarl goes. Now I want to see Alsi the king straightway.” + +“That is a matter for the captain,” I said, and I called for him. + +Eglaf came out and made a deep reverence when he saw the earl, knowing +at once who he was, and as this was just what the earl had said that he +did not like, he looked quaintly at me across Eglaf’s broad bent back, +so that I had to grin perforce. + +All unknowing of which the captain heard the earl’s business, and then +told me to see him to the palace gates, and take his horse to the +stables when he had dismounted and was in the hands of Berthun. + +So I went, and Havelok turned away and went on some errand down the +steep street. + +This Ragnar was one of whom I had often heard, for he was the governor +of all the North folk for Alsi until the Lady Goldberga should take her +place. He was her cousin, being the son of Ethelwald’s sister, who was +of course a Dane. Danish, and from the old country, was his father +also, being one of the men who had come over to the court of East +Anglia when Ethelwald was made king. + +All the way to the door we talked of Denmark, but it was not far. There +Berthun came out and greeted the earl in court fashion, and I thought +that I was done with, because the grooms had run to take the great bay +horse as they heard the trampling. But, as it happened, I was wanted. + +Ragnar went in, saying to me that he would find me out again presently; +and I saw him walk across the great hall to the hearth, and stand there +while Berthun went to the king’s presence to tell him of the new +arrival. Then I stood for a minute to look at the horse, for the grooms +had had no orders to take him away; and mindful of Eglaf’s word to me, +I was going to tell them to do so, and to see it done, when Berthun +came hurriedly and called me. + +“Master Housecarl,” he said rather breathlessly, “by the king’s order +you are to come within the hall and guard the doorway.” + +I shouldered my spear and followed him, and as we were out of hearing +of the grooms I said that the captain had ordered me to take the horse +to the stables. + +“I will see to that,” he said. “Now you are to bide at the door while +the king speaks with Earl Ragnar, for there will be none else present. +Let no one pass in without the king’s leave.” + +We passed through the great door as he said that, and he closed it +after him. Ragnar was yet standing near the high seat, and turned as he +heard the sound, and smiled when he saw me. Berthun went quickly away +through a side entrance, and the hail was empty save for us two. The +midday meal was over an hour since, and the long tables had been +cleared away, so that the place seemed desolate to me, as I had only +seen it before when I sat with the other men at the cross tables for +meals. It was not so good a hall as was Jarl Sigurd’s in Denmark, for +it was not rich with carving and colour as was his, and the arms on the +wall were few, and the hangings might have been brighter and better in +a king’s place. + +“Our king does not seem to keep much state,” Ragnar said, looking round +as I was looking, and we both laughed. + +Then the door on the high place opened, and the king came in, soberly +dressed, and with a smile on his face which seemed to me to have been +made on purpose for this greeting, for he mostly looked sour enough. +Nor did it seem that his eyes had any pleasure in them. + +“Welcome, kinsman,” he said, seeming hearty enough, however; “I had +looked for you before this. What news from our good town of Norwich?” + +He held out his hand to Ragnar, who took it frankly, and his strong +grip twisted the king’s set smile into a grin of pain for a moment. + +“All was well there three weeks ago when I left there to go to London. +Now, I have ridden on to say that the Lady Goldberga is not far hence, +so that her coming may be prepared for.” + +Now, as the earl said this, the king’s smile went from his face, and +black enough he looked for a moment. The look passed quickly, and the +smile came back, but it seemed hard to keep it up. + +“Why, that is well,” he said; “so you fell in with her on the way.” + +“I have attended her from London,” answered the earl, looking +steadfastly at Alsi, “and it was as well that I did so, as it +happened.” + +“What has been amiss?” asked the king sharply, and trying to look +troubled. He let the smile go now altogether. + +“Your henchman, Griffin the Welshman, had no guard with her that was +fitting for our princess,” Ragnar said. “He had but twenty men, and +these not of the best. It is in my mind also that I should have been +told of this journey, for I am surely the right man to have guarded my +queen who is to be.” + +At that Alsi’s face went ashy pale, and I did not rightly know why at +the time, but it seemed more in anger than aught else. But he had to +make some answer. + +“We sent a messenger to you,” he said hastily; “I cannot tell why he +did not reach you.” + +“He must have come too late, and after I had heard of this from others; +so I had already gone to meet the princess. I am glad that I was sent +for, and it may pass. Well, it is lucky that I was in time, for we were +attacked on the road, and but for my men there would have been +trouble.” + +Then Alsi broke into wrath, which was real enough. + +“This passes all. Where and by whom were you attacked? and why should +any fall on the party?” + +“Five miles on the other side of Ancaster town, where the Ermin Street +runs among woods, we were fallen on, but who the men were I cannot say. +Why they should fall on us seems plain enough, seeing that the ransom +of a princess is likely to be a great sum.” + +“Was it a sharp fight?” + +“It was not,” answered Ragnar, “for it seemed to me that the men looked +only to find your Welsh thane Griffin and his men. When they saw my +Norfolk housecarls, they waited no longer, and we only rode down one or +two of them. But I have somewhat against this Griffin, for he helped me +not at all. Until this day he and his men had ridden fairly with us, +but by the time this attack came they were half a mile behind us.” + +“Do you mean to say that you think Griffin in league with +these—outlaws, as one may suppose them?” said Alsi, with wrath and more +else written in twitching mouth and crafty eyes. + +“I would not have said that,” Ragnar answered, looking in some surprise +at the king, “it had never come into my head. But I will say that as +the Ermin Street is straight as an arrow, and he was in full sight of +us, he might have spurred his horses to our help, whereas he never +quickened his pace till he saw that the outlaws, or whoever they were, +had gone. I put this as a complaint to you.” + +“These men seem to have scared you, at least,” sneered the king. + +Ragnar flushed deeply. + +“For the princess—yes. It is not fitting that a man who is in charge of +so precious a lady should hold back in danger, even of the least +seeming, as did Griffin. And I told him so.” + +Now I thought that Alsi would have been as angry with Griffin as was +the earl, and that he would add that he also would speak his mind to +him, hut instead of that he went off in another way. + +“It was a pity that a pleasant journey with a fair companion was thus +broken in upon. But it was doubtless pleasant that the lady should see +that her kinsman was not unwilling to draw sword for her. A pretty +little jest this, got up between Griffin and yourself, and such as a +young man may be forgiven for playing. I shall hear Goldberga complain +of honest Griffin presently, and now I shall know how to answer her. +Ay, I will promise him the like talking to that you gave him, and then +we three will laugh over it all together.” + +And with that the king broke into a cackle of laughter, catching hold +of the earl’s arm in his glee. And I never saw any man look so +altogether bewildered as did Ragnar. + +“Little jest was there in the matter, lord king, let me tell you,” he +said, trying to draw his arm away. + +“Nay, I am not angry with you, kinsman; indeed, I am not. We have been +young and eager that bright eyes should see our valour ourselves ere +now,” and he shook his finger at the earl gaily. “I only wonder that +you induced that fiery Welshman to take a rating in the hearing of the +princess quietly.” + +“What I had to say to him I said apart. I will not say that he did take +it quietly.” + +“Meaning—that you had a good laugh over it;” and Alsi shook the earl’s +arm as in glee. “There now, you have made a clean breast, and I am not +one to spoil sport. Go and meet Goldberga at the gates, and bring her +to me in state, and you shall be lodged here, if you will. Quite right +of you to tell me this, or Griffin would have been in trouble. But I +must not have the lady scared again, mind you.” + +He turned quickly away, then, with a sort of stifled laugh, as if he +wanted to get away to enjoy a good jest, and left Ragnar staring +speechless at him as he crossed the high place and went through the +private door. + +Then the earl turned to me, “By Loki, fellow countryman, there is +somewhat wrong here. What does he mean by feigning to think the whole +affair a jest? It won’t be much of a jest if Griffin and I slay one +another tomorrow, as we mean to do, because of what was not done, and +what was said about it.” + +“It has seemed to me, jarl,” I said plainly, “that all this is more +like a jest between the king and Griffin.” + +“Call it a jest, as that is loyal, at least. But I think that you are +right. If Goldberga had been carried off—Come, we shall be saying too +much in these walls.” + +I had only been told to wait while the king and earl spoke together, +and so I opened the door and followed him out. The horse was yet there +waiting for him, and it was plain that the king had not meant him to +stay. + +“Bid the grooms lead the horse after us, and we will go to your +captain. Then you shall take me to one of my friends, for you will know +where their houses are.” + +But at that moment a man from the palace ran after us, bringing an +order from the king that I was to go back to him. So Ragnar bade me +farewell. + +“Come to me tonight at the gatehouse,” he said. “I will speak to the +captain to let you off duty.” + +“Say nothing to him, jarl, for it is needless. I am only with him for a +time, and am my own master. I have no turn on watch tonight, and so am +free.” + +So I went back, and found the king in the hall again, and he was still +smiling. If he had looked me straight in the face, I suppose that he +might have seen that I was not a man to whom he was used, but he did +not. He seemed not to wish to do so. + +“So, good fellow,” he said, “you have heard a pleasant jest of our +young kinsman’s contriving, but I will that you say nothing of it. It +is a pity to take a good guardroom story from you, however, without +some recompense, and therefore—” + +With that he put a little bag into my hand, and it was heavy. I said +nothing, but bowed in the English way, and he went on, “You understand; +no word is to be said of what you have heard unless I bid you repeat +it. That I may have to do, lest it is said that Griffin the thane is +‘nidring’[9] by any of his enemies. You know all the story—how the earl +and he planned a sham attack on the princess’s party, that Ragnar might +show his valour, which, of course, he could not do if Griffin was +there. Therefore the thane held back. But maybe you heard all, and +understood it.” + +“I heard all, lord king, and I will say naught.” + +The king waved his hand in sign that I was dismissed, and I bowed and +went. There were five rings of gold in the bag, worth about the whole +year’s wage of a courtman, and I thought that for keeping a jest to +myself that was good pay indeed. There must be more behind that +business, as it had seemed to me already. + +Now, as I crossed the green within the old walls on my way to the gate, +it happened that Havelok came back from the town, and as he came I +heard him whistling softly to himself a strange wild call, as it were, +of a hunting horn, very sweet, and one that I had never heard before. + +“Ho, brother!” I said, for there was no one near us. “What is that call +you are whistling?” + +He started and looked up at me suddenly, and I saw that his trouble was +on him again. + +“In my dream,” he said slowly, “there is a man on a great horse, and he +wears such bracelets as Ragnar of Norwich, and he winds his horn with +that call, and I run to him; and then I myself am on the horse, and I +go to the stables, and after that there is nothing but the call that I +hear. Now it has gone again.” + +And his hand went up in the way that made me sad to see. + +“It will come back by-and-by. Trouble not about it.” + +“I would that we were back in Grimsby,” he said, with a great sigh. +“This is a place of shadows. Ghosts are these of days that I think can +never have been.” + +“Well,” said I, wanting to take him out of himself, “this is no ghost, +at all events. I would that one of our brothers would come from home +that I might send it to them in Grimsby. We do not need it.” + +So I showed him the gold, and he wondered at it, and laughed, saying +that the housecarls had the best place after all. And so he went on, +and I back to the gate. + +Surely he minded at last the days when Gunnar his father had ridden +home to the gate, as the Danish earl had ridden even now, and had +called his son to him with that call. It was all coming back, as one +thing or another brought it to his mind; and I wondered what should be +when he knew that the dream was the truth. For what should Havelok, +foster-son of the fisher, do against a king who for twelve long years +had held his throne? And who in all the old land would believe that he +was indeed the son of the lost king? Better, it seemed to me, that this +had not happened, and that he had been yet the happy, careless, +well-loved son of Grim, with no thought of aught higher than the good +of the folk he knew. + +When I got back to the gate, we were marched down the town, that we +might be ready to receive the princess; and as I went through the +market, I saw one of the porters whom I knew, and I beckoned to him, so +that he came alongside me in the ranks, and I asked him if he would go +to Grimsby for me for a silver penny. He would do it gladly; and so I +sent him with word to Arngeir that I needed one of them here to take a +gift that I had for them. I would meet whoever came at the widow’s +house, and I set a time when I would look for them. I thought it was +well that the king’s gold should not be wasted, even for a day’s use, +if I could help it. And I wearied to see one of the brothers, and hear +all that was going on. + + + + +CHAPTER XI. +THE COMING OF THE PRINCESS. + + +There is no need for me to tell aught of the entry of the Lady +Goldberga into the town, for anyone may know how the people cheered +her, and how the party were met by the Norfolk thanes and many others, +and so rode on up the hill to the palace. What the princess was like I +hardly noticed at that time, for she was closely hooded, and her +maidens were round her. And I had something else to think of; for +foremost, and richly dressed, with a gold chain round his neck, rode a +man whose strange way of carrying his head caught my eye at once, so +that I looked more than a second time at him. + +And at last I knew him. It was that man of ours whose neck had been +twisted by the way in which he had been hauled on board at the time of +the wreck, and had afterwards gone to Ethelwald’s court. One would say +that this Mord had prospered exceedingly, for he was plainly a man of +some consequence in the princess’s household. He did not know me, +though it happened that he looked right at me for a moment; but I did +not expect him to do so after twelve years, seeing that I was but a boy +when we parted. I thought that I would seek him presently. + +Then I saw Griffin, the Welsh thane, and I did not like the looks of +him at all. He was a black-haired man, clean shaven, so that the cruel +thinness of his lips was not hidden, and his black eyes were restless, +and never stayed anywhere, unless he looked at Ragnar for a moment, and +then that was a look of deadly hatred. He wore his armour well, and had +a steady seat on his horse; but, if all that I had heard of him was +true, his looks did not belie him. Men had much to say of him here, +for, being some far-off kin to Alsi’s Welsh mother, he was always about +the court, and was hated. He had gone to Dover to fetch the princess +before we came here, but it happened that I had once or twice seen him +at other times when I was in Lincoln, so that I knew him now. + +There was great feasting that night in the king’s hall, as one may +suppose, and I sat with the housecarls at the cross tables beyond the +fire, and I could see the Lady Goldberga at Alsi’s side. Tired she was +with her long journey, and she did not remain long at the table; but I +had never seen so wondrously beautiful a lady. Griffin sat next to her +on the king’s right hand, for Ragnar was at the king’s left, in the +seat of next honour; and I saw that the lady had no love for the Welsh +thane. But I also thought that I saw how he would give his all for a +kindly glance from her; and if, as Alsi had seemed to hint, Ragnar was +a favoured lover, I did not wonder that Griffin had been ready to do +him a bad turn. I had rather that the thane was my friend than my foe, +for he would be no open enemy. + +I left the feast when the first change of guard went out, for I saw +that the ale cup was passing faster than we Danes think fitting, being +less given to it than the English. And when the guard was set I waited +alone in the guardroom of the old gate, for Eglaf was yet at the hall, +and would be there all night maybe. And presently Earl Ragnar came in +and sat down with me. + +He was silent for a while, and I waited for him to speak, until he +looked up at me with a little laugh, and said, “I told you that I had +to fight Griffin tomorrow?” + +“You did, earl. Is that matter settled otherwise?” + +“Not at all,” he answered. “I believe now that he was acting under +orders, but I have said things to him which he cannot pass over. I +called him ‘nidring’ to his face, and that I still mean; for though I +thought of cowardice at the time, he is none the less so if he has +plotted against the princess. So naught but the sword will end the +feud.” + +He pondered for some moments, and then went on, “It is a bad business; +for if I slay Griffin, he is the king’s favourite; and if he slays me, +the Norfolk thanes will have somewhat to say. And all is bad for the +Lady Goldberga, who needs all the friends that she has, for in either +case there will be trouble between the two kingdoms that Alsi holds +just now.” + +“If Griffin is slain,” I said, “I think that the lady has one trouble +out of the way.” + +“Ay; and the king will make out, as you heard him do even now, that I +am looking that way myself. It is not so, for I will say to you at once +that to me there is but one lady in all the world, and she is in +Norfolk at this time. Now I am going to ask you something that is a +favour.” + +I thought that he would give me some message for this lady, in case he +fell; but he had more to ask than that. Nothing more or less than that +I should be his second in the fight, because I was a fellow countryman, +while to ask an East Anglian thane would he to make things harder yet +for Goldberga. + +“I am no thane, earl,” I said plainly. “This is an honour that is over +high for me.” + +“It seems that you own a town, for I asked Eglaf just now,” he +answered; “and that is enough surely to give you thane’s rank in a +matter like this. But that is neither here nor there; it is as Dane to +Dane that I ask you. If I could find another of us I would ask him +also, that you might not have to stand alone. I am asking you to break +the law that bids the keeping of the peace at the time of the meeting +of the Witan.” + +“That is no matter,” I said. “If I have to fly, it will be with you as +victor; and if it is but a matter of a fine, I have had that from the +king today which will surely pay it.” + +And I told him of the gift for silence, whereat he laughed heartily, +and then said that the secret was more worth than he thought. This +looked very bad, and like proof that the king was at the bottom of the +whole business. + +Now I had been thinking, and it seemed better that there should be two +witnesses of the fight on our side, and I thought that Havelok was the +man who would make the second. So I told Ragnar that I could find +another Dane who was at least as worthy as I, and he was well pleased. +Then he told me where the meeting was to be, and where we should meet +him just before daylight; and so he went back to the hall, where the +lights were yet burning redly, and the songs were wilder than ever. + +And I found Havelok, and told him of the fight that was to be, and +asked him to come with us. His arms were at the widow’s, and he could +get them without any noticing him. + +There is no need to say that he was ready as I to help Ragnar, and so +we spoke of time and place, and parted for the night. + +Very early came Havelok to the house, for I lodged at the widow’s when +I was not on night duty; and we armed ourselves, and then came Ragnar. +He greeted me first, and then looked at Havelok in amaze, as it seemed, +and then bowed a little, and asked me to make my friend known to him. + +“If you are the friend of whom Radbard has told me, I think that I am +fortunate in having come to him.” + +“I am his brother, lord earl,” answered Havelok, “and I am at your +service.” + +Ragnar looked from one of us to the other, and then smiled. + +“A brother Dane and a brother in arms, truly,” he said. “Well, that is +all that I need ask, except your name, as I am to be another brother of +the same sort.” + +Then Havelok looked at me, and I nodded. I knew what he meant; but it +was not right that the earl should not know who he was. + +“Men call me Curan here, lord earl, and that I must be to you +hereafter. But I am Havelok of Grimsby, son of Grim.” + +In a moment I saw that the earl knew more of that name than I had +deemed possible; and then I minded Mord, the wry-necked, who was the +chamberlain now. But Ragnar said nothing beyond that he would remember +the request, and that he was well seconded. And then we went out into +the grey morning, and without recrossing the bridge, away to the level +meadows on the south of the river, far from any roadway. + +“There is not an island in the stream,” said Ragnar, “or I should have +wanted the old northern holmgang battle. I doubt if we could even get +these Welshmen to peg out the lists.” + +“That we must see to,” I said. “We will have all things fair in some +way.” + +Half a mile from the town we came to what they call a carr—a woody rise +in the level marsh—and on the skirts of this two men waited us. They +were the seconds of Griffin, Welsh or half Welsh both of them by their +looks, and both were well armed. Their greeting was courteous enough, +and they led us by a little track into the heart of the thickets, and +there was a wide and level clearing, most fit for a fight, in which +waited Griffin himself. + +Now I had never taken any part in a fight before, and I did not rightly +know what I had to do to begin with. However, one of the other side +seemed to be well up in the matter, and at once he came to me and +Havelok and took us aside. + +“Here is a little trouble,” he said: “our men have said nothing of what +weapons they will use.” + +“I take it,” said Havelok at once, “that they meant to use those which +were most handy to them, therefore.” + +The Welshman stared, and answered rather stiffly, “This is not a matter +of chance medley, young sir, but an ordered affair. But doubtless this +is the first time you have been in this case, and do not know the +rules. Let me tell you, therefore, that your earl, being the challenged +man, has choice of weapons. + +“Why, then,” answered Havelok, “it seems to me that if we say as I have +already said, it is fair on our part. For it is certain that the earl +will want to use the axe, and your man is about half his weight, so +that would be uneven.” + +“As the challenged man, the earl is entitled to any advantage in +weapons.” + +“He needs none. Let us fight fairly or not at all. The earl takes the +axe.—What say you, Radbard? Griffin takes what he likes.” + +“You keep to the axe after all, and yet say that it gives an +advantage.” + +“Axe against axe it does, but if your man chooses to take a twenty-foot +spear and keep out of its way, we do not object. We give him his own +choice.” + +Then the other second said frankly, “This is generous, Cadwal. No more +need be said. But this young thane has not yet asked his earl whether +it will suit him.” + +“Faith, no,” said Havelok, laughing; “I was thinking what I should like +myself, and nothing at all of the earl.” + +So I went across to Ragnar, who was waiting patiently at one end of the +clearing, while Griffin was pacing with uneven steps backward and +forward at the other, and I told him what the question was. + +“I thought it would be a matter of swords,” he said, “but I am Dane +enough to like the axe best. Settle it as you will. Of course he knows +naught of axe play, so that you are right in not pressing it on him. He +is a light man, and active, and maybe will be glad not even to try +sword to sword; for look at the sort of bodkin he is wearing.” + +The earl and we had the northern long sword, of course; but when I +looked I saw that the Welsh had short, straight, and heavy weapons of +about half the length of ours, and so even sword to sword seemed hard +on the lighter man; wherein I was wrong, as I had yet to learn. + +I went back, therefore, and told the others. + +“The earl takes the axe, and the thane has his choice, as we have +said.” + +“We have to thank you,” said the other second, while Cadwal only +laughed a short laugh, and bade us choose the ground with them. + +There was no difficulty about that, for the light was clear and bright, +and though the sun was up, the trees bid any bright rays that might be +in the eyes of the fighters. However, we set them across the light, so +that all there was might be even; and then we agreed that if one was +forced back to the edge of the clearing he was to be held beaten, as if +we had been on an island. It was nearly as good, for the shore of trees +and brushwood was very plain and sharp. + +Now Ragnar unslung his round shield from his shoulders, and took his +axe from me, for I had carried it for him, and his face was quiet and +steady, as the face of one should be who has a deed to do that must be +seen through to the end. But Griffin and his men talked quickly in +their own tongue, and I had to tell them that we understood it well +enough. Then they looked at each other, and were silent suddenly. I +wondered what they, were about to say, for it seemed that my warning +came just in time for them. + +Griffin took a shield from the thane they called Cadwal, and it was +square—a shape that I had not seen before in use, though Witlaf had one +like it on the wall at Stallingborough. He said that it had been won +from a chief by his forefathers when the English first came into the +land, and that it was the old Roman shape. It seemed unhandy to me, but +I had no time to think of it for a moment, for now Cadwal had a last +question. + +“Is this fight to be to the death?” + +“No,” I answered; “else were the rule we made about the boundary of no +use.” + +Then Griffin cried in a sort of choked voice, “It shall be to the +death.” + +But I said nothing, and the other second, with Cadwal, shook his head. + +Ragnar made no sign, but Cadwal said to Havelok, “You were foremost in +the matter just now. What say you?” + +“Rules are rules, and what my comrade says is right. If the first blow +slays, we cannot help it, but there shall be no second wound. The man +who is first struck is defeated.” + +“I will not have it so,” said Griffin. + +“Well, then, thane, after you have wounded the earl you will have to +reckon with me, if you must slay someone.” + +Griffin looked at the towering form of my brother and made no answer, +and the other second told him that it was right. There was naught but +an angry word or two to be atoned for. So there was an end, and Ragnar +went on guard. Griffin made ready also, and at once it was plain that +here was no uneven match after all. + +Both of them wore ring mail of the best. We had set the two six paces +apart, and they must step forward to get within striking distance. At +once Griffin seemed to grow smaller, for he crouched down as a cat that +is going to spring, and raised his shield before him, so that from +where I stood behind Ragnar I could only see his black glittering eyes +and round helm above its edge. And his right arm was drawn back, so +that only the point of his heavy leaf-bladed sword was to be seen +glancing from the right edge steadily. And now his eyes were steady as +the sword point, which was no brighter than they. If once he got inside +the sweep of the great axe it would be bad for Ragnar. + +One step forward went the earl, shield up and axe balanced, but Griffin +never moved. Then Ragnar leapt forward and struck out, but I could see +that it was a feint, and he recovered at once. Griffin’s shield had +gone up in a moment above his head, and in a moment it was back in its +place, and over it his eyes glared as before, unwavering. And then, +like a wildcat, he sprang at Ragnar, making no sweeping blow with his +sword, but thrusting with straight arm, so that the whole weight of his +flying body was behind the point. Ragnar struck out, but the square +shield was overhead to stay the blow, and full on the round Danish +buckler the point of the short sword rang, for the earl was ready to +meet it. + +In a moment the Welshman was back in his crouching guard, leaving a +great ragged hole in the shield whence he had wrenched his weapon point +in a way that told of a wrist turn that had been long practised. Ragnar +had needed no leech, had his quick eye not saved him from that thrust. + +Then for a breathing space the two watched each other, while we held +our breath, motionless. And then Griffin slowly began to circle round +his foe, still crouching. + +Then, like a thunderbolt, Ragnar’s axe swept down on the thane, and +neither shield nor helm would have been of avail had that blow gone +home. Back leapt Griffin, and the axe shore the edge only of his +shield; and then, shield aloft and point foremost, he flew on the earl +before the axe had recovered from its swing, and I surely thought that +the end had come, for the earl’s shield was lowered, and his face was +unguarded. + +But that was what he looked for. Up and forward flew the round shield, +catching the thane’s straightened arm along its whole length, and then, +as sword and arm were dashed upwards, smiting him fairly in the face; +and, like a stone, the Welshman was hurled from it, and fell backward +in a heap on the grass three paces away. It seemed to me that he was +off his feet in his spring as the shield smote him. + +There he lay, and Havelok strode forward and stood between the two, +with his face to Griffin, for Ragnar had dropped his axe to rest when +his foe fell. + +“No blood drawn,” said my brother, “but no more fighting can there be. +The man’s arm is out.” + +And so it was, for the mighty heave that turned the thrust had ended +Griffin’s fighting for a long day. But he did not think so. + +The sweat was standing on his face in great beads from the pain, but he +got up and shifted his sword to his left hand. + +“It is to the death,” he cried; “I can fight as well with the left. +Stand aside.” + +“An it had been so, you were a dead man now,” said Havelok, “for the +earl held his hand where he might have slain. If he had chosen, you +might have felt his axe before you touched the ground.” + +Thereat, without warning other than a snarl of “Your own saying,” +Griffin leapt at my brother fiercely, only to meet a swing of his axe +that sent his sword flying from his hand. And that was deft of Havelok, +for there is nothing more hard to meet than a left-handed attack at any +time, and this seemed unlooked for. + +“Well, I did say somewhat of this sort,” said Havelok; “but it was +lucky that I had not forgotten it.” + +Then he took the thane by the waist and left arm and set him down +gently; and after that all the fury went from him, and he grew pale +with the pain of the arm that was hurt. But both I and the Welshmen had +shouted to Griffin to hold, all uselessly, so quick had been his onset +on his new foe. + +Cadwal held his peace, biting his lip, but the other Welshman began to +blame Griffin loudly for this. + +“Nay,” said Havelok, smiling; “it was my own fault maybe. The thane was +overhasty certainly, but one does not think with pain gnawing at one. +Let that pass. + +“Now, earl, I think that you may say what you have to say that will set +things right once more.” + +“Can none of us put the arm back first?” I said. “I will try, if none +else has done such a thing before, for it will not be the first time.” + +“Put it back, if you can,” said Cadwal. “If there is anything to be +said, it had better be in some sort of comfort.” + +So I put the arm back, for when once the trick is learned there is not, +as a rule, much trouble. But Griffin never thanked me. He left that to +his seconds, who did so well enough. + +Then Ragnar came forward and said gravely, “I was wrong when I called +you ‘nidring,’ and I take back the word and ask you to forget it. No +man who is that will face the Danish axe as you have faced it, and I +will say that the British sword is a thing to be feared.” + +But Griffin made no answer, and when Ragnar held out his hand he would +not see it. + +“Maybe I have not yet made amends,” Ragnar went on. “I will add, +therefore, as I know that my words will go no farther, that I am sure +that the thing concerning which we quarrelled yesterday was done by you +at the orders of another. It was not your own doing, and no thought of +cowardice is in my mind now.” + +But Griffin never answered; and now he turned his back on the earl, who +was plainly grieved, and said no more to him, but turned to us and the +two Welshmen. + +“I do not think that I can say more. If there is aught that is needed, +tell me. We have fought a fair fight, and I have taken back the words +that caused it.” + +Then said Cadwal, “No more is needed. I did not think that we had met +with so generous a foe. If Griffin will say naught, we say this for +him. He has no cause for enmity left. And I say also that he has to +thank this thane for his life as well as the earl.” + +“No thane am I,” said Havelok, “but only Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby. +And even that name is set aside for a while, so that I must ask you to +forget it. I have seen a good fight, if a short one, and one could not +smite a wounded man who forgot himself for a moment.” + +There was nothing more to be had from Griffin, for we waited a minute +or two in silence to see if he would speak, and then we saluted and +left the wood. + +The last thing that I saw seemed to be a matter of high words between +Griffin and his seconds; and, indeed, if they were telling him what +they thought, it is likely that he wished he had been more courteous. +It is easy enough for a man who wants a quarrel to have done with one +and then start another. + + + + +CHAPTER XII. +IN LINCOLN MARKETPLACE. + + +We went quietly back to the town, and there was only one thing that I +wished, and that was that Havelok had not had to tell his name twice. +Ragnar was full of thanks to us for our help, and said that he would +that we would come to Norfolk with him. + +“We have a man who knows you also,” he said, “but he has been with our +princess for a long time now. He is called Mord, and is her +chamberlain. He has often told me how he came by his wry-neck at the +time of your shipwreck.” + +So he said, and looked at Havelok. But this was a thing that he had not +seen, as he was so sick at the time. I said that I remembered Mord +well, and would seek him some time in the day. + +And as I said this I was thinking that I must find out from Mord +whether he knew and had told more than I could of who Havelok was and +whence he came to us. It seemed to me that the earl had heard some tale +or other, and unless it was from him I could not think from whence. + +Now the earl said, “This business has ended better than I could have +hoped, and I think that Alsi will not hear of it. Griffin can well +account for a slipped shoulder by any sort of fall that he likes to own +to, and Alsi would be hardly pleased to hear that he had run the risk +of setting all Norfolk against him for nothing after all.” + +“There is no doubt that he meant you to know that he does not consider +the quarrel done with,” I said. “You have an enemy there.” + +“Nothing new, that,” answered Ragnar, laughing. “He thinks that I stand +in his way with the princess. I suppose it is common talk that if he +wedded her Alsi would still hold the East Anglian kingdom, making him +ealdorman, if only I were out of the way. But were I to wed the lady, +then it is certain that she would take the crown at once. I do not mean +to do so, for then it is likely that three people would be unhappy for +the rest of their days. But that would be less wretched for her than to +wed Griffin.” + +“This is no pleasant strait for the poor lady,” said Havelok grimly. +“Do none ask what she herself can wish?” + +“That is the trouble,” said the earl, “for she is in Alsi’s hand, and +there is some old promise and oath sworn between him and Ethelwald her +father that holds him back. Else had she been wedded to Griffin before +now.” + +Then we came to the widow’s house, and Havelok left his arms there, and +we went on to the marketplace. As we crossed the bridge we saw that +there was something going forward, for there was a gathering in the +wide space, and a shouting and cheering now and then, and even Berthun +himself was there looking on and seeming to be highly entertained. + +“Here is a crowd that I will not face just now, in my arms,” said the +earl; “for this hole in my shield looks bad, not having been there when +I went out. Farewell for the time, therefore, and think of what I said +about your coming to Norwich with me.” + +He turned away therefore, and Havelok looked after him for a moment. +The shield hung at his back, plain to be seen. + +“It is a hole, for certain,” he said; “but there is no need to show it +in that wise.” + +So he strode after him. + +“By your leave, earl, I will arrange your cloak across the shield, and +then you can get it to your armourer without notice.” + +“That is well thought of,” answered Ragnar, as Havelok did as he had +said. “I do not forget that I think that I owe you my life, though I +have said nothing as yet.” + +“How is that?” + +“Griffin would have flown on me as he did on you, certainly; and it is +in my mind that you foresaw it, which I did not. I could not have +stayed him.” + +“Well I did,” answered my brother; “else had either I or you a hole in +us like the one that is well covered now. But I feared what came to +pass.” + +Ragnar held out his hand, and Havelok took it, and so they parted +without more words; but I knew that these two were friends from that +time forward, whatever happened. + +There were some sports of some sort on hand, when we came to see what +all the noise was; and Berthun, seeing us, called Havelok to him. + +“I have been looking for you,” he said, with that curious tone of his +that always seemed to be asking pardon for his boldness in speaking to +my brother; “for here are games at which they need some one to show the +way.” + +“This is a sport that I have not seen before,” answered Havelok, +looking over the heads of the crowd. “I should make a poor hand at it.” + +They had been tossing a great fir pole, which was now laid on one side, +with its top split from its falls, and they, thanes and freemen in +turn, were putting a great stone, so heavy that a matter of a few +inches beyond the longest cast yet made would be something to be proud +of. Good sport enough it was to see the brawny housecarls heave it from +the ground and swing it. But no one could lift it above his knee, so +that one may suppose that it flew no great distance at a cast. + +“Nay, but the thanes are trying,” Berthun said. “It is open to all to +do what they can. One of your porters is best man so far.” + +“Well, I will not try to outdo him.” + +“I would that you would lift the stone, Curan. That is a thing that I +should most like to see.” + +“Well then, master, as you bid me, I will try. But do not expect too +much.” + +The man who had the stone made his cast, which was nothing to speak of; +and then the stone lay unclaimed for a time, while all the onlookers +waited to see who came forward next. Then Havelok made his way through +the crowd, and a silence as of wonder fell on the people; for some knew +him, and had heard of his strength, and those who did not stared at him +as at a wonder. But the silence did not last long, for the porters who +were there set up a sort of shout of delight, and that one who had made +the longest cast so far began to tell him how best to heft the stone +and swing it. + +Then Havelok bent to raise the stone, and the noise hushed again. I saw +his mighty limbs harden and knot under the strain, and up to his knee +he heaved it, and to his middle, and yet higher, to his chest, while we +all held our breaths, and then with a mighty lift it was at his +shoulder, and he poised it, and swung as one who balances for a moment, +and then hurled it from him. Then was a shout that Alsi might have +heard in his hilltop palace, for full four paces beyond the strong +porter’s cast it flew, lighting with a mighty crash, and bedding itself +in the ground where it lit. And I saw the young thanes with wide eyes +looking at my brother, and from beside me Berthun the cook fairly +roared with delight. + +And then from across the space between the two lines of onlookers I saw +a man in a fisher’s dress that caught my eye. It was Withelm, and we +nodded to each other, well pleased. + +Now there seemed to be a strife as to who should get nearest to +Havelok, for men crowded to pat him and to look up at him, and that +pleased him not at all. One came and bade him take the silver pennies +that the thanes had set out for the prize, but he shook his head and +smiled. + +“I threw the thing because I was bidden, and not for any prize,” he +said. “I would have it given to the porter who fairly won it.” + +Then he elbowed his way to Berthun, and said, “let us go, master; we +have stayed here too long already.” + +“As it pleases you,” the steward said; and Havelok waved his hand to +me, and they went their way. + +He had not seen Withelm, and I was glad, for I wanted to speak to him +alone first. + +Now men began to ask who this was, and many voices answered, while the +porter went to claim the prize from the thane who held it. + +Two silver pennies the thane gave him, and said, “This seems to be a +friend of yours, and it was good to hear you try to help him without +acrimony. Not that he needed any hints from any one, however. Who is +he?” + +“Men call him Curan, that being the name he gives himself; but he came +as a stranger to the place, and none know from whence, unless Berthun +the cook may do so. Surely he is a friend of mine, for he shook me +once, and that shaking made an honest man of me. He himself taught me +what fair play is, at that same time.” + +So said the porter, and laughed, and the thane joined him. + +“Well, he has made a sort of name for himself as a wonder, certainly, +now. I think that this cast of his will be told of every time men lift +a stone here in Lincoln,” said the thane. + +They left the stone where he had set it, and any one may see it there +to this day, and there I suppose it will be for a wonder while +Havelok’s name is remembered. + +Then they began wrestling and the like, and I left the crowd and went +to Withelm, going afterwards to the widow’s. I was not yet wanted by +Eglaf for any housecarl duty. + +“I sent a man to Grimsby yesterday,” I said; “but you must have passed +him on the way somewhere, for he could not have started soon enough to +take you a message before you left.” + +“I met him on the road last night, for I myself thought it time to come +and see how you two fared. I bided at Cabourn for the night, and your +messenger came on with me.” + +Then he told me that all were well at Grimsby; for fish came now and +then and kept the famine from the town, though there were none to send +elsewhere; and it was well that we had left, though they all missed us +sorely. + +Then we began to talk of the doings here; and at last I spoke of +Havelok’s trouble, as one may well call it, telling him also of the +strange dream with which it all began. + +“All this is strange,” he said thoughtfully; “but if Havelok our +brother is indeed a king’s son, it is only what he is like in all his +ways. Wise was our father Grim, and I mind how he seemed always to be +careful of him in every way, and good reason must he have had not to +say what he knew. We will not ask aught until the time of which Arngeir +knows has come. Nor can we say aught to Havelok, though he is troubled, +for we know nothing. As for the dream, that is part of it all, and it +is a portent, as I think.” + +“Did I know the man who could read it, I would go to him and tell him +it.” + +“There is one man who can read dreams well,” Withelm answered, flushing +a little, “but I do not know if you would care to seek him. I stayed +with him last night, and he is on his way even now to Lincoln, driven +by the famine. I mean the old British priest David, who has his little +hut and chapel in the Cabourn woods. His people have no more to give +him.” + +I knew that Withelm thought much of this old man of late, and I was not +surprised to hear him speak of him now. All knew his wisdom, and the +marsh folk were wont to seek him when they were in any trouble or +difficulty. But I did not care to go to him, for he seemed to belong to +the thralls, as one might say. + +“Well, if he comes here, no doubt you will know where to find him if we +need him,” I said. “Bide with us for a few days at least, for here is +plenty, and there is much going on.” + +So we went into the town, and then to the palace, and found Havelok, +and after that I had to go to the gate on guard. And what these two did +I cannot say, but, at all events, there is nothing worth telling of. + +Now, however, I have to tell things that I did not see or hear myself, +and therefore I would have it understood that I heard all from those +who took some part or other in the matter, and so know all well. + +I have not said much of the meetings of the Witan, for I had naught +more to do with them than to guard the doors of the hall where they met +now and then; but since the princess and Ragnar came they seem to have +somewhat to do with the story, as will be seen. + +On this day one of the Norfolk thanes asked in full meeting what plans +the king had for his ward Goldberga, and her coming into her kingdom, +saying that she, being eighteen years of age, was old enough to take +her place. + +Now Alsi had thought of this beforehand, and was ready at once. + +“It is a matter of concern to us always,” he said, “and much have I +thought thereof. It is full time that she took her father’s place with +the consent of the Witan, which is needed.” + +He looked round us for reply to this, and at once the Norfolk thanes +said, “We will have Goldberga for our queen, as was the will of +Ethelwald.” + +“That,” said Alsi, “is as I thought. I needed only to hear it said +openly. Now, therefore, it remains but to speak of one other thing and +that is a weighty one. It was her father’s will and I swore to carry it +out, that she should be wedded to the most goodly and mightiest man in +the realm. It seems to me that on her marriage hangs all the wealth of +her kingdom; and ill it would be if, after she took the throne, she +took to herself one who made himself an evil adviser. I would say that +it were better to see her married first, for it does not follow that +you would choose to have the man whom I thought fitting to be over you, +as he certainly would be.” + +Now all this was so straightforward in all seeming that none of the +thanes could be aught but pleased. Moreover, it took away a fear that +they had had lest Griffin was to be the man. None could say that he +fulfilled the conditions of the will of Ethelwald. The spokesman said, +therefore, that it was well set before them, and that it was best to +wait, saying at the end, “For, after all, we might have to change our +minds concerning the princess, if with her we must take a man who will +prove a burden or tyrant to us all.” + +Then they asked the king to find a good husband for the princess as +soon as might be, so that he was not against her liking. + +“Well,” said Alsi, “it is a hard task for a man who has no wife to help +him; but we will trust to the good sense of my niece. Now, I had +thought of Ragnar of Norwich; but it is in my mind that the old laws of +near kin are somewhat against this.” + +I suppose that he had no intention of letting the earl marry the +princess; but this was policy, as it might please the thanes. However, +the matter of kinship did not please some, and that was all that he +needed, for there was excuse then for him if he forbade that match, +which was the last he wanted. + +Ragnar sat in his place and heard all this, and he wished himself back +at Norwich. + +So there the matter ended, and that was the last sitting of the Witan. +There was to be a great breaking-up feast that night before the thanes +scattered to their homes. + +Now while this was going on I ended my spell of duty, and bethought me +of Mord the chamberlain, and so went to Berthun and asked for him. He +said that if I had any special business with Mord I might see him; and +I said, truly enough, that my errand was special, having to do with +friends of his; so it was not long before they took me to him. He was +in a long room that was built on the side of the great hall, as it +were, and I could hear the murmur of the voices of those who spoke at +the Witan while I waited. + +Now Mord was not so much changed as I, and at first he did not know me +at all. + +“Well, master housecarl, what may your message be, and from whom is +it?” he said, without more than a glance at me. + +“Why, there are some old friends of yours who are anxious to know if +you have forgotten the feeling of a halter round your neck,” I said in +good Danish. + +Then, after one look, he knew me at once, and ran to me, and took my +hand, and almost kissed me in his pleasure, for since I could handle an +oar he had known me, and had taught me how to do that, moreover. + +Then he called for wine and food; and we sat down together and had a +long talk of the old days, and of how we had fared after he left, and +of all else that came uppermost. And sorely he grieved at my father’s +death, and at the trouble that was on us. The famine had not been so +sore in the south, and pestilence had not been at all. + +As for himself, he had been courtman, as we call the housecarls, at +first, and so had risen to be chamberlain to the king, and now to the +princess, and had been with her everywhere that Alsi had sent her since +her father died. + +“It was a good day for me, and wise was Grim when he bade me go to +Ethelwald to seek service,” he said; “yet I would that I had seen him +once more. I have never been to this place before, else I should have +sought him.” + +Now I was going to ask him about Havelok, but hardly knew how to begin. +He saved me the trouble however, by speaking first. + +“Who were the lady and the boy we had on board when we came to +England?” he said. “I never heard, and maybe it was as well that I did +not.” + +“My father never told me. But why do you think that it was well not to +know?” + +“Because I am sure that Grim had good reason for not telling. Before I +had been a year at Norwich there came a ship from Denmark into the +river, and soon men told me that her master was asking for news of one +Grim, a merchant, who was lost. So I saw him, not saying who I was or +that I had anything to do with Grim; and then I found that it was not +so much of the master that he wanted news as of the boy we had with us. +He did not ask of the lady at all, and I was sure that this was the man +who came and spoke to Grim just as we were sailing, if you remember. So +then it came to me that we knew nothing of the coming on board of these +two, only learning of their presence when we were far at sea. And now, +if Hodulf troubled himself so much about this boy, there must be +something that he was not meant to know about his flight, for he must +be of some note. Did I not know that the king’s son was in his hands at +that time, I should have thought that our passenger was he. However, I +told him of the shipwreck as of a thing that I had seen, saying that +Grim and his family and a few men only had been saved; and I told him +also that I had heard that he had lost some folk in an attack by +Vikings. With that he seemed well satisfied, and I heard no more of +him. I have wondered ever since who the boy was, and if he was yet +alive. I mind that he was like to die when he came ashore.” + +Then I laughed, and said that he would hear of him soon enough, for all +the town was talking of him; and he guessed whom I meant, for he had +heard of the cook’s mighty man. + +Now I said no more but this: + +“My father kept this matter secret all these years, and with reason, as +we have seen; and so, while he is here, we call this foster-brother of +mine Curan, until the time comes when his name may he known. Maybe it +will be best for you not to say much of your knowledge of him. What +does Earl Ragnar know of our wreck? For he told me that you knew me.” + +“I told him all about it at one time or another,” Mord answered. “He +always wanted to hear of Denmark.” + +So that was all that the chamberlain knew; but it was plain to me that +the earl had put two and two together when he heard Havelok’s name, and +had remembered that this was also the name of Gunnar’s son. Afterwards +I found that Mord had heard from Denmark that Hodulf was said to have +made away with Havelok, but he never remembered that at this time. +Ragnar knew this, and did remember it. + +Pleasant it was to talk of old days with an old friend thus, and the +time went quickly. Then Mord must go to his mistress and I to my place, +and so we parted for the time. But my last doubt of who Havelok my +brother might be was gone. I was sure that he was the son of Gunnar the +king. + + + + +CHAPTER XIII. +THE WITAN’S FEASTING. + + +Now I have to tell of a strange thing that happened in the night that +was just past, the first that the Lady Goldberga had spent here in +Lincoln for many a year, for on that happening hangs a great deal, and +it will make clear what I myself saw presently at the breaking-up feast +of the Witan. That puzzled me mightily at the time, as it did many at +the feast, but I see no reason why it should not be told at once. + +Now I have said that Goldberga left the hall early overnight, being +wearied with the journey, and having the remembrance of the attack on +her party so near to Lincoln to trouble her also. Not much cause to +love her uncle Alsi had she; though perhaps, also, not much to make her +hate him, except that he had kept her so far away from her own people +of late, in a sort of honourable captivity. Now it was plain to her +that had it not been for the presence of Ragnar and his men, her guard +would not have been able to drive off the attackers; and the strange +way in which Griffin had held back had been too plain for her not to +notice. Already she feared him, and it seemed that he might have +plotted her carrying off thus. That Alsi might have had a hand in the +matter did not come into her mind, as it did into the minds of others, +for she knew little of him, thinking him honest if not very pleasant in +his ways, else had not her father made him her guardian. + +I will say now that in the attack he did have a hand. Many a long year +afterward it all came out in some way. He dared not give his niece to +Griffin openly, but he wished to do so, as then he would have an +under-king in East Anglia of his own choosing. Sorely against the grain +with him was it that he should have to give up those fair lands to this +girl, who would hold the throne by her own right, and not at all under +him. So he and Griffin had plotted thus, and only Ragnar’s presence had +spoilt the plan, though Griffin had tried to save it by holding back. +But I must say also that up to this time none had had aught to say +against Alsi as a ruler, though he was over close, and not at all +hearty in his ways at home. But now, for the sake of the kingdom, he +had begun to plot; and this plan having come to naught, he must make +others, as will be seen. I do not think that this planning to keep +Ethelwald’s kingdom from his daughter was anything fresh to Alsi, but +the time for action had come now. + +He had made ready by keeping the fair princess far away, and there were +none who could speak of her goodness, or, indeed, had heard much of her +since she was a child. Therefore, as men were content enough with him, +none would trouble much if the princess came not to the throne, given +good reason why she should not do so. And the very best reason would be +that which Alsi had given at the Witan—if her husband was not fit to be +king. + +It is possible that Goldberga knew that her marriage would be talked of +at this Witan: but I do not think that she troubled herself much about +it, not by any means intending to be married against her will. I have +heard that so ran the will of Ethelwald, that she was to have choice to +some extent. However that may be, with so many thoughts to trouble her +she went to rest, and her sleep was not easy until the morning was +near, and then came quiet. + +But presently, in the grey of the dawn, she woke, and called her old +nurse, who was in the chamber with her; and when she came she told her +that she had had a strange vision or dream, so real that she did not +know which it was. And what it portended she could not say, for it was +wonderful altogether, and surely was good. + +“I thought that a voice wakened me, calling me to look on somewhat; and +so I rose as I was bidden, and saw before me the most mighty and +comeliest man that could be thought of. Kinglike he was, though he had +no crown and was meanly clad, without brooch or bracelet that a king +should wear. But the wonder was that from his mouth came a bright shaft +of flame, as it were of a sunbeam, that lighted all the place, and on +his shoulder shone a cross of burning light as of red-hot gold, and I +knew that it was the mark of a mighty king. + +“Then I heard the voice again, and I turned, and saw that it was an +angel who spoke to me, and his face was bright and kind. + +“‘Fear not, Goldberga,’ he said, ‘for this is your husband that shall +be. King’s son and heir is he, as that token of the fiery cross shows. +More, also, it will betoken—that he shall reign in England and in +Denmark, a great king and mighty. And this you shall see, and with him +shall you reign as queen and well-loved lady.’ + +“So the voice ceased, and the angel was gone, and when I looked up +there was naught but the growing dawn across yon window, and the voice +of the thrush that sings outside.” + +Now the old nurse pondered over the dream for a while without speaking, +for she could not see what it might mean at first. + +But at last she said, “It is a good dream surely, because of the angel +that spoke; but there seems only one way in which it can come to pass. +A prince must come for you from Denmark, for there he would reign by +his own right, and here he would do so by yours. Yet I have heard that +the Danish kings are most terrible heathen, worse than the Saxon kin, +of whom we know the worst now. Maybe that is why the angel told you to +have no fear. I mind Gunnar Kirkeban, and what he wrought on the +churches and Christian folk in Wales—in Gower on the Severn Sea, and on +the holy Dee—when I was young.” + +For both Goldberga and this old nurse of hers were Christian, as had +been Orwenna, Ethelwald’s wife, her mother. It had been a great day for +them when the King of Kent had brought over his fair wife, Bertha, from +France, for she, too, was Christian, and had restored the ancient +church in the very castle where Goldberga was kept. + +Now the princess went to sleep again, and woke refreshed; but all day +long the memory of the dream and of him whom she saw in it bided with +her, until it was time for her to go to the great hall for the feast of +the Witan. + +Now it happened that on this night I must be one of the two housecarls +who should stand, torch in hand, behind the king. It was a place that +none of the men cared for much, since they saw their comrades feasting +at the end of the room, while they must bide hungry till the end, and +mind that no sparks from the flaring pine fell on the guests, moreover. +Eglaf would have excused me this had I wished; but I would take my turn +with the rest, and maybe did not mind losing the best of the feast so +much as the others. There were some three hundred guests at that feast, +and it was a wondrous fair sight to me as I stood on the high place and +saw them gather. The long table behind which I was ran right across the +dais, rich with gold and silver and glass work: and below this, all +down the hall, ran long tables again, set lengthwise, that none might +have their backs to the king. And at the end of the hall, crosswise, +were the tables for the housecarls, and the men of the house, and of +the thanes who were guests. And as the housecarls came in they hung +their shields and weapons on the walls in order, so that they flashed +bright from above the hangings that Berthun and his men had set up +afresh and more gaily than I had seen yet in this place. + +There was a fire on the great hearth in the midst of the hall; but as +it was high summer, only a little one, and over it were no cauldrons, +as there would have been in the winter. Berthun was doing his cookery +elsewhere. But between the tables were spaces where his thralls and the +women could pass as they bore round the food and drink. And backwards +and forwards among them went Berthun until the very last, anxious and +important, seeing that all was right, and showing one guest after +another to their places. No light matter was that either, for to set a +thane in too low a place for his rank was likely to be a cause of +strife and complaint. Also he must know if there were old feuds still +remembered, lest he should set deadly enemies side by side. I did not +envy him, by any means. + +When it seemed that there were few more guests to come, and only half a +dozen seats were vacant on the high place, Berthun passed into the room +beyond the hall, and at once a hush fell on the noisy folk, who had +been talking to one another as though they had never met before. The +gleemen tuned their harps, and I and my comrade lit our torches from +those already burning on the wall, and stood ready, for the king was +coming. + +Out of the door backed Berthun with many bows, and loud sang the +gleemen, while all in the hall stood up at once; and then came Alsi, +leading the princess, first; and then Ragnar, with the wife of some +great noble; and after him that noble and another lady; but Griffin was +not there. Bright looked Goldberga in her blue dress, with wondrous +jewels on arm and neck, and maybe the brighter for the absence of the +Welsh thane, as I thought. + +So they sat as last night, save that the noble who had come next to +Ragnar was in Griffin’s place; and therefore I stood behind the king +and the princess, with the light of my torch falling between the two. + +Now they were set, and at once Berthun bore a great beaker of wine to +the king, and all down the hall ran his men with the pitchers of wine +and mead and ale, and with them the women of the household and the +wives of the courtmen, filling every drinking horn for the welcome cup. + +Then the gleemen hushed their song, and Alsi stood up with the +gold-rimmed horn of the king in his hand, and high he raised it, and +cried, “Waeshael!” + +And all the guests rose up, cup in hand, with a wonderful flashing of +the glorious English jewels, and cried with one voice, “Drinc hael, +Cyning!” + +Then all sat them down, and at once came Berthun’s men with the laden +spits and the cauldrons, and first they served the high table, kneeling +on the dais steps while each noble helped himself and the lady next him +with what he would. And then down the hall the feast began, and for a +time befell a silence—the silence of hungry folk who have before them a +good reason for not saying much for a little while. + +I looked for Havelok among Berthun’s men, but he was not there. Nor was +he at the lower cross tables with the other people of the palace. But +Withelm was there, for Eglaf had seen him with me not an hour ago, and +had bidden him come, as a stranger from far off. There were a few other +strangers there also, as one might suppose, for the king’s hall must be +open at these times. + +Now I looked on all this, and it pleased me; and then I began to hear +the talk of those at the high table, and that was pleasant also. First +I heard that Griffin had fallen off his horse, and had put his arm out. +Whereon one said that he only needed one hand to feed with, and +marvelled that so small a hurt kept him away from so pleasant a place +as was his. + +“It seems that he fell on his face,” answered a thane who had seen him. +“He is not as handsome as he was last night. That is what keeps him +away. Some passerby put his arm in straightway.” + +At that I almost laughed, but kept a face wooden as that of our old +statue of Thor, for Eglaf had warned me that I was but a torch, as it +were, unless by any chance I was spoken to. But Ragnar glanced my way +with a half smile. Presently they began to talk of the stone putting, +and of the mighty man who had come with Berthun, and I saw several +looking idly down the hall to see if they could spy him. One of the +thanes on the high seat, at the end, was he who had held the prizes at +these sports. + +Now it seemed that Alsi had not heard of this before; and when he had +been told all about it, he said that he did not know that he had any +man who was strong enough to make such a cast as they spoke of, though +Eglaf had picked up a big man somewhere lately, whom he had noticed at +the hall end once or twice. + +Then he ran his eyes over the tables, for now the women folk had sat +down among the men, and one could see everywhere. But he did not see +the man he meant, and so turned sharply on us two housecarls behind +him. + +“Here he is,” he said, laughing and looking at me. “Were you the mighty +stone putter they make such a talk of?” + +“I am not, lord,” I said, somewhat out of countenance, because every +one looked at me together. It had never seemed to me that I was so big +before; perhaps because I was used to Havelok, and to Raven, who was +nigh as tall as myself, and maybe a bit broader. + +“Why, then, who was he?” said the king. “We must ask Berthun, unless +anyone can see him in the hall.” + +Then the thane of the prizes said, “He is not here, lord; for little +trouble would there be in seeing him, if he were, seeing that he is a +full head and shoulders over even this housecarl of yours.” + +Now the princess had turned to look at me, and she saw that I was +abashed, and so she smiled at me pleasantly, as much as to say that she +was a little sorry for me, and turned away. Then thought I that if ever +the princess needed one to fight for her, even to death, I would do so +for the sake of that smile and the thought for a rough housecarl that +was behind it. + +Now came Berthun with more wine, before the matter of the stone was +forgotten in other talk, and the king said, “It seems that you have +found a new man, steward, for all are talking of him. I mean the man +who is said to have thrown a big stone certain miles, or somewhat like +it, from all accounts. Where is he?” + +“He is my new porter,” answered Berthun, with much pride; “but he is +not in the hail, for he does not like to hear much of himself, being +quiet in his ways, although so strong.” + +“Here is a marvel,” laughed Alsi, “and by-and-by we must see him. I +wonder that Eglaf let you have him.” + +Now Eglaf sat at the head of the nearest of the lower tables, and all +in hearing of the king were of course listening by this time. So he +said, “The man had his choice, and chose the heavier place, if you will +believe me, lord. It is terrible to see how Berthun loads him at times; +so that I may get him yet.” + +Then all laughed at the steward, whose face grew red; but he had to +laugh also, because the jest pleased the king. He went away quickly; +and one told Eglaf that he had better eat no more, else would he run +risk of somewhat deadly at the cook’s hands. But those two were old +friends, as has been seen, and they were ever seeking jests at each +other’s expense. + +Now the talk drifted away to other things, and I hoped that Havelok had +been forgotten, for no more than I would he like being stared at. The +feast went on, and twice I had to take new torches, but Berthun saw +that I had wine, if I could not eat as yet. Then had men finished +eating, and the tables were cleared, and the singing began, very +pleasant to hearken. Not only the gleemen sang, but the harp went +round, and all who could did so. Well do the Lindsey folk sing, after +their own manner, three men at a time, in a gladsome way, with +well-matched voices, and that for just long enough to be pleasant. + +So the harp went its way down the hall, and the great folk fell to talk +again; and at last one said, so that Alsi heard him, “Why, we have not +seen the strong man yet. Strange that he is not feasting with the +rest.” + +Whereat the king beckoned Berthun. + +“Bring your new wonder here,” he said. “Say that I have heard of his +deed, and would look on him.” + +Berthun bowed and went his way; and I wondered how my brother would +bear this, for the hall and its ordering was wont, as I have said, to +bring back his troubled thoughts of things half remembered. + +Presently he came in at the door at the lower end of the hall, and at +first none noticed him, for there was singing going on, and through +that door came and went many with things for the feast from the +kitchens. Then some one turned to see who towered over them thus, and +when he saw Havelok he went on looking, so that others looked also. +Then one of the three singers looked, and his voice stayed, for he was +a stranger, and had heard nothing of this newcomer, and then Havelok +followed Berthun up the hall in a kind of hush that fell, and he was +smiling a little, as if it amused him. He had on the things that the +steward had given him, and they were good enough—as good as, if more +sober than, my housecarl finery. But I suppose that not one in all the +gathering looked at what he wore; for as he passed up the long tables, +it seemed that there was no man worth looking at but he, and even +Ragnar seemed to be but a common man when one turned to him with eyes +that had seen Havelok. + +Now Alsi the king sat staring at him, still as a carven image, with his +hand halfway to his mouth, as he raised his horn from the table; and +Ragnar looked wide-eyed, for he knew him again, and I saw a little +smile curl the corners of his lips and pass; and then Havelok was at +the step of the high place, and there he gave the salute of the +courtmen of a Danish king, heeding Berthun, who tried to make him do +reverence, not at all. + +Now a spark from my torch drew my eyes from him, lest it should fall on +the princess’s robe; and when it went out, I saw that the fair hand +that rested on the arm of the great chair was shaking like a leaf. When +I looked, her face was white and troubled, and she half rose from her +seat and then sank back in it gently, and the thane who sat next her +spoke anxiously to her in a low voice, and the lady by his side rose up +and came to her. + +Then Alsi turned, and he too spoke, asking if aught was amiss. + +“The princess faints with the heat of the hall,” said the thane’s wife. +“She yet feels the long journey. May she not go hence?” + +Then Goldberga said bravely, “It is naught, and it will pass.” + +But they made her rise and leave the hall; and the guests stood up as +she went with her ladies round her, and many were the murmurs of pity +that I heard. + +“As though she had seen a ghost, so white is she,” one whispered. + +But none knew how much the lady was to be pitied. She had seen the man +of her vision; and, lo! for all that she knew, he was a thrall who +toiled in the palace kitchens. + +And after her, as she withdrew, looked Havelok with eyes in which there +was more than pity. I could see him well, but I did not know how he had +seen the fair princess tremble and grow white as she gazed on him. I +know that, as he saw her for this first time, it was with the wish that +he were in Ragnar’s place. But I thought that if Havelok were king, +here was the queen for him. + +Now Alsi bade the feast go on, and be spoke a few words only to +Havelok, letting him go at once, and I was glad. This sudden faintness +of the princess had put all out somewhat, and none cared to take up a +jest where it had stayed. Nevertheless, I saw the king’s eyes follow my +brother down the hall, and in them was a new and strange look that was +not pleasant at all. + +Then it seemed that one was staring at me, and as will happen, I must +look in a certain place; and there was Cadwal, the Welsh thane, halfway +down one of the long tables, glaring first at me, and then at Havelok, +as he went. It came into my mind that he would be wroth with Ragnar for +bringing a kitchen knave as his second, as it were, in derision of +Griffin. I thought that I would find a chance presently to tell him why +my fellow second chose to be serving thus, and so make things right +with him, for this seemed to be due to Ragnar, if not to all concerned. + +Not long after Goldberga had gone, the king withdrew also, and then the +hall grew noisy enough, and I could leave my place. But by that time +Cadwal had left also; and next day, when I sought him, both he and +Griffin were no longer in Lincoln, none knowing whither they had gone. +So I troubled no more about them. + +But had I known that these two had been among the Welshmen that Hodulf +led to Denmark when he slew Gunnar Kirkeban, and therefore knew all the +story of the loss of Havelok, and how Hodulf had sought for news of +him, I should have been in fear enough that we had not yet done with +them. Rightly, too, should I have feared that, as will be seen. + +Now while I looked about the hall for Cadwal, Mord the chamberlain saw +me, and made me sit down by him while I ate. Hungry enough was I by +that time, as may be supposed, for one cannot make a meal off the sight +of a feast; and as I ate, the noise of the hall grew apace as the cups +went round. Then some of the older thanes left, and soon Mord and I had +that table to ourselves. It was plain that he was full of something +that he would say to me, and when I was ready to listen he bent near me +and said, “So that was the boy who fled with us.” + +“Ay. He has grown since you saw him last.” + +“That is not all,” answered Mord. “Well I knew Gunnar, our king, and +tonight I thought he had come back to us from Valhalla, goodlier yet +and mightier than ever, as one who has feasted with the Asir might well +be. For if this boy of ours is not Gunnar’s son, then he is Gunnar +himself.” + +Now that was no new thought to me, as I have shown, and I was ready for +it, seeing that even I had seen the likeness to the king as I +remembered him. + +“Keep that thought to yourself for a while, Mord,” I said. “It is in my +mind that you are right, but the time has not yet come for me to know.” + +“That is wisdom, too,” he answered; “for if once he gathers a +following, there is a bad time in store for Hodulf. And it will be +better that we fall on him unawares, before he knows that Havelok, son +of Gunnar, lives.” + +“We fall on him?” + +“Ay, you and I, mail on chest and weapon in hand, with Havelok to lead +us. What? think you that I would hold back when Gunnar’s son is +calling?” + +“Steady, friend,” I said, laughing; “men will be looking at us.” + +So he was silent again; and now I thought that the time of which my +father spoke had surely come, for it was plain that Havelok was a man +whom men would gladly follow as he went to win back his kingdom. And I +went and fetched Withelm from where he sat, and so we three talked long +and pleasantly, until it was time for us to go forth from the hall. And +we thought that it was good for Arngeir to come here, for the secret +was coming to light of itself, as it were, and we would have him speak +with Mord. + + + + +CHAPTER XIV. +THE CRAFT OF ALSI THE KING. + + +Now Alsi the king went from the feast with a new and cruel thought in +his mind under the smiling face that he wore, and long he sat in his +own chamber, chin on hand and eyes far off, thinking; and at last he +called Berthun. + +“What is the name of this big knave of yours?” he asked, when the +steward stood before him. + +“He calls himself Curan, lord.” + +“Calls himself. Well, it is likely that he knows his own name best. Is +he Welsh, therefore?” + +“So I think, lord.” + +“You might have been certain by this time, surely. I like Welshmen +about the place, and I was giving you credit for finding me a good one. +Whence comes he?” + +Now it was on Berthun’s tongue to say that he thought that Curan came +from the marshland, yet clinging to his own thoughts of what he was. He +did not at all believe that he came from that refuge of thralls. But he +must seem certain unless he was to be laughed at again. + +So he said, “He comes from the marsh-country.” + +“Does he speak Welsh?” + +“I have heard him do so to the market people, if he happened to meet a +Briton there.” + +“Why, then, of course he is Welsh: and here have I found out in two +minutes what you have taken I do not know how long to think about. Go +to, Berthun; you grow slow of mind with good living.” + +The king chuckled, and Berthun bowed humbly; but now the steward was +determined to say no more than he was obliged in answer to more +questions. Also he began to hope that Alsi would ask nothing about the +clothes this man of his wore, else he would be well laughed at for +spending his money on a stranger. + +But Alsi seemed pleased with himself, or else with what he had heard, +and went on. + +“Has this Curan friends in the town?” + +“None, lord, so far as I know.” + +“Let me tell you that you may know a man’s friends by the company he +keeps. With whom does he talk?” + +“None come to seek him, lord, except one of the housecarls—the big man +to whom you spoke tonight. Seldom does he go into the town, and then +only the porters seem to know him, for he was among them, as a +stranger, when I met him first.” + +“A big man will always make an acquaintance with another,” Alsi said, +“and the porters are the lowest in the place. One may be sure that he +has left his friends in some starving village in the marsh, and has +none here. That will do, Berthun. Take care of him, for I may have use +for him. But next time you hire a man, use your wits to learn somewhat +of him, if it is too much trouble to ask.” + +So Berthun was dismissed, and went out in a bad temper with himself. +Yet he knew that he would have been laughed at for a fool if he had +said that he thought Curan more than he seemed. + +Now Alsi was alone, and he fell to thought again. By-and-by it was +plain to be understood what his thoughts had been, and they were bad. +And after he had slept on them they were no better, seeing what came of +them. But I think that he was pleased to find that Havelok was, as he +thought, a Welsh marshman, and well-nigh friendless, for so he would be +the more ready to do what he was bidden; though, indeed, there seemed +little doubt that the plan Alsi made for himself would find no +stumbling block in Curan, if it might meet with a check elsewhere. +That, however, was to be seen. + +Well pleased was Alsi the king with somewhat, men said in the morning. + +But there was one who rose heavy and sorely troubled, and that was the +Lady Goldberga, for all the fancies that had been brought to her by the +vision had come to nothing, or worse than nothing, as she looked on +Havelok and saw in the cook’s knave the very form of him of whom she +had dreamed, and whom she could not forget. Glad had she been to go to +her own chamber and away from the kindly ladies who could not know her +real trouble; but not even to her old nurse did she tell what that was. +Her one thought now was to seek someone who was skilful in the reading +of dreams, and so find some new hope from it all. But no one could tell +her of such a one here, unless it were to be a priest of Woden, and +that she would not hear of. + +Then, early in the morning, Alsi sent for her, saying that he would +speak with her alone for a while. So she went to him, where he sat in +the chamber beyond the high place; and he greeted her kindly, asking +after her rest, and saying that he hoped that the sudden faintness had +hurt her not. Then he led her to a seat, and bade her rest while he +talked of state affairs. + +“For it must be known to you, my niece, that the Witan thinks it time +that you should take your father’s kingdom.” + +Now Goldberga knew that, and had long made up her mind that when the +time came she would not shrink from the burden of the crown. + +It may well have been that Alsi thought that she would wish to wait for +a time yet, for he did not seem altogether pleased when she answered, +“If the Witan thinks right, I am ready.” + +“But,” he said, “there is one thing to come before that. The Witan must +know who your husband shall be. And that is reasonable, for he will +have a share in ruling the kingdom.” + +Then said Goldberga, “They need have no fear in that matter, for I will +wed none but a king or the heir of a king.” + +“Well,” said Alsi, dryly enough, “they are not so plentiful as are +blackberries, and there may be two words to that.” + +“I am not anxious to be wedded,” answered the princess, “and I can +wait. It is, as you say, a matter that is much to the country.” + +Then Alsi tried another plan, seeing that Goldberga was not at all put +out by this. So he forced a cunning smile that was meant to be +pleasant, and said, “I had thought that your mind ran somewhat on +Ragnar.” + +He looked to see the lady change colour, but she did not. + +“Ragnar is my cousin,” she said, “or a good brother to me, if you will. +Moreover, until the other day when he met me in London by some good +fortune, I had hardly seen him since my father died.” + +“What think you of Griffin?” + +“Nothing at all, for nidring he is,” answered Goldberga with curling +lip. + +Now that angered Alsi, for he had so much to do with that business; and +if Griffin was to be called thus by his fault, he was likely to lose a +friend. + +“I would have you remember,” he said, “that in all this choosing it +remains for me to give consent or withhold it.” + +“I shall only ask your consent to my wedding such a man as I have told +you of, uncle—a king or a king’s son.” + +“So,” said Alsi, “you would choose first, and ask me afterwards, +forsooth! That is not the way that things are to be between us. It is +for me to choose, and that according to the oath which I took when your +father made me guardian of you and his realm.” + +“Yet,” said Goldberga very gently, “I think that my father would not +have meant that I should be the only one not to be asked.” + +“I can only go by what I swore, and that I will carry out. I promised +to see you married to the most goodly and mightiest man in the land.” + +“That can be none but a king, as I think.” + +Now Alsi grew impatient, for he meant to settle one matter before he +went much farther. + +“I will say at once that I can have no king over the East Anglian +kingdom. It is not to be thought of that after all these years I should +have to take second place there. You will hold the kingdom from me, and +I shall be overlord there. I will send you some atheling who can keep +the land in order for you, but there shall be no king to bring that +land under the power of his own kingdom.” + +That was plain speaking, and it roused Goldberga. + +“Never have you been overlord of my kingdom,” she said. “Well have you +ruled it for me while I could not rule it myself, and for that I thank +you heartily. But it is not right that I should seem to hold it from +you.” + +“That is to be seen,” sneered Alsi, “for it lies with me to say what +marriage you make, and on that depends whether the Witan, in its +wisdom, sees fit to hail you as queen. Not until you are married will +you take the kingdom at all.” + +“Then,” said the princess, growing pale, “I will speak to the Witan +myself, and learn their will.” + +“The Witan has broken up,” answered Alsi, “and the good thanes are +miles on their way homewards by this time. You are too late.” + +“I will call them up again.” + +“Certainly—that is, if I let my men run hither and thither to fetch +them. But after all, in this matter I am master. Whom you wed lies with +me.” + +Goldberga saw that she was in the hands of the king, and maybe as much +a prisoner as at Dover. So her spirits fled, and she asked what the +king willed. + +Alsi knew now that nothing but his utmost plan would be of any avail to +save that kingdom for himself, and so he broke out into wrath, working +up his fury that he might not go back. + +“My will is that you obey me in this carrying out of the oath I took on +the holy ring, [10] and on the Gospels also to please your mother. You +shall marry the man whom I choose, so that he be according to the words +of that oath.” + +“So that he be king or son of a king, I will obey you,” answered +Goldberga. + +“Then you defy me. For that I have told you that I will not have. Now +shall we see who is master. You mind yon kitchen knave of last night? +There can be none in all England mightier or more goodly than he is to +look on, and him shall you wed. So will my oath be well kept. Then if +your precious Witan will have him, well and good, for his master shall +I be.” + +Thereat the princess said that it were better that she should die; but +now Alsi had set out all his plan to her, and he did not mean to flinch +from carrying it out. There was no doubt that the Norfolk people would +hold that she had disgraced herself by the marriage, and so would +refuse to have her as queen. And that was all he needed. + +But Goldberga had no more to say, for she was past speaking, and the +king was fain to call her ladies. And when they came he went away +quickly, and gave orders for the safe keeping of the princess, lest she +should try to fly, or to get any message to Ragnar or other of the +Norfolk thanes. + +Now he must go through with this marriage, for he had shown himself too +plainly, and never would the princess trust him again. I have heard +that he sent for Griffin at this time; but, as I found, he was gone; +and if the king thought that perhaps the princess would wed him now to +escape from the kitchen knave, he had no chance to bring him forward. I +suppose he could have made out that Griffin, or for that matter any one +else he chose, was such a one as his oath to Ethelwald demanded. + +Sore wept Goldberga when she was back in her own place, and at first it +was hard for her to believe that Alsi could mean what he had +threatened. But then she could not forget her dream, and in that she +had most certainly seen the very form of him who stood before her at +the high place last night; and that perhaps troubled her more than +aught, for it seemed to say that him she must wed. But no king’s son +could he be, so that there must be yet such another mighty man to be +found. + +And then in her heart she knew that there could not be two such men, +both alike in all points to him of the vision. And she knew also, +though maybe she would not own it, that if this Curan had been but a +thane of little estate, she could have had naught to say against the +matter. + +And so at last she found that in her trouble and doubt and wish for +peace she was thinking, “Would that he were not the kitchen knave!” + +Now, it chanced that the old nurse had gone out into the town, and was +away all this while, so that she knew nothing of this new trouble; and +presently she was coming back with her arms full of what she had +bought, and there met her Havelok and Withelm, who had been to the +widow’s, and were on their way to find me at the gate. + +“Mother,” said Havelok, “let me help you up with these things.” + +That frightened the old lady, for she had been looking at him, and had +made up her mind that he was some mighty noble, as did most strangers. + +“Nay, lord,” she said; “that is not fitting for you.” + +“Less fitting is it that a strong man should see you thus burdened and +not help. No lord am I, but only the cook’s man. So I am going to the +palace.” + +But this she would not believe at first, and still refused. However, +Lincoln Hill is very steep, and she was not sorry when Havelok laughed +and took the things from her so soon as she had to halt for breath. + +“Curan will carry you up also, if you will, mother,” said Withelm. + +The nurse tossed her head at him and made no answer, being on her +dignity at once. Moreover, she had heard of Curan by this time, though +she had not seen him before. So she said no more, and went on proudly +enough, with her mighty attendant after her; but all the while it was +in her mind that there was some jest, or maybe wager, between the two. + +Now Withelm stopped at the gate; but I was not there, for I had been +sent to the palace, where guards were to be at each door. The word was +that some plot had been found out against the princess, and that +therefore we had to be careful. One easily believed that with all the +talk about the attack made on her party that was flying about. So he +came on to the palace kitchens, for Berthun knew him well, having so +often bought fish from him in the market; and there he sat down to talk +with the steward, for there was nothing much going on at the time, and +I was on guard. + +Now, the old nurse went to her mistress; and Goldberga sat in the +shadow, and was weeping no longer, seeing that it would not help at +all. + +“There is a wonder down yonder,” said the old lady, not seeing that +there had been any trouble yet—“such a man as I never saw in all my +days; and he even carried my goods up all the hill for me, old and ugly +as I am. That is not what every young man would do nowadays. Maybe it +was different when I was young, or else my being young made the +difference. The youth with him called him Curan, which is the name of +the strong porter they prate of, but doubtless that was a jest. This is +the most kingly man that could be; and I ween that those two made a +wager that he dared not carry a bundle up to the palace, whereby I was +the gainer, for breath grows short up that pitch. And when I thanked +him he bowed in that wise that can only come of being rightly taught +when one is young. Now, I am going to ask Berthun who he is, for he +spoke to him when he saw him, and that humbly, as it seemed.” + +So talked the nurse, and to all Goldberga answered never a word, for +all the trouble came back again, and with it the thought that she +hated, that if only— + +Then, as the nurse was leaving her, she called her back. + +“Nurse,” she said, “I am in sore trouble about the dream. It bides with +me, and will not cease to puzzle me until I weary for some one to read +it plainly. I would that Queen Bertha’s good chaplain were here, for I +might have been helped by him.” + +Then the nurse came back, quick to hear the sad tone in the voice of +her whom she had tended and loved since she was a child. + +“Why, my pretty, have you been weeping?” she said. “There was naught in +a dream like that to fray you thus.” + +“Nay, but it has come to me that this place is altogether heathen; and +it may have come from the hand of Freya, the false fiend that they +worship as a goddess, so that I may be ready to wed a heathen. Is there +no Christian in all this place?” + +“There are Welsh folk yet left in the marsh,” said the nurse, +pondering; “and where there is a Briton there is a Christian, and +there, also, will be a hidden priest. But it would be as much as his +life is worth to come here, even could we find one.” + +Then Goldberga said, “Alsi is not altogether heathen. If I asked he +would surely grant this.” + +For she thought that she knew how to gain consent. + +“If one can be found, and that is not likely. Well, then, I will ask +Berthun, who is good-natured enough, and most likely will not trouble +about a Christian coming here; and if so, we need not even ask Alsi.” + +So she went, not thinking for a moment that there was a priest of the +faith to be heard of. Mostly she wanted to hear more of Havelok, but +she would honestly do her other errand. + +But on her way across the courtyard she met Mord, and he was a great +friend of hers. + +“Whither now, nurse? They will not let you go out of the palace. They +say that there is trouble on hand with those folk that fell on us, and +we have to bide in shelter for a day or two.” + +“Well, I have been down the town this hour, and all is quiet enough. +This Alsi is an over-timid man. But I was seeking Berthun with a +strange message from the princess, and one that is not over safe here.” + +“Let me give it then.” + +“Well, it is nothing more or less than to ask if he can find a +Christian priest. Our mistress has had a strange dream, and it is true +that it sorely troubles her. So she wants one to whom she may tell it, +that it may be read aright. But though I must ask, I do not hope to +find one.” + +“Why,” said Mord, “there is not one Christian in all Lindsey.” + +“I would not say that. When I was first here with Orwenna the queen, +before she married Ethelwald, there were some in the marsh; for one day +I heard my own tongue spoken there, hunting with my mistress; and so +she stayed and talked with these poor folk, though the Welsh they spoke +was bad enough. But they were Christians, as they told her in fear and +trembling. They have not so much need to fear now.” + +“Then I can help you,” said Mord gladly. “Say nothing to the cook, for +I have found old friends who come from far in the marsh, and they will +tell me at once if they have heard of any priest. Why, when I think, +they know Welsh, and one has called himself by a Welsh name, and you +have seen him—Curan the porter.” + +“Ay; then do you ask these friends, and tell them that the sooner they +can bring a priest the better shall they be rewarded. I would give much +to have Goldberga’s mind set at rest.” + +So Mord said that he would go at once; and glad he was to see Withelm +sitting with Berthun, + +“Well,” said the steward, “I have known Withelm of Grimsby for the last +ten years or so, and I do not suppose that it matters if you speak with +him.” + +“Why should it matter if I speak with any one I choose?” asked Mord, +somewhat angrily. + +“That you must ask the king; for his orders are that the people of the +princess have no dealings with outsiders for two days.” + +“Mighty careful of us is Alsi all of a sudden,” said Mord. “I suppose +he thinks that someone will stick a seax into some of us in all +friendly wise while we are talking.” + +But Berthun only laughed, and went to where the nurse was beckoning to +him. He told her his own thoughts of Havelok, being glad to have a +ready hearer. + +At once Withelm was able to tell Mord that the old priest who was his +friend was in Lincoln at this time by good chance, and that he would +surely come to the princess at need. But when they came to talk of when +and how, it did not seem all so easy; and Mord went to the nurse to +tell her all. + +Then they had to speak to Berthun about it, and he was kindly and +willing to help; but he said that none might come to speak with the +princess without leave from the king. No doubt he would grant it +easily, if asked by Goldberga herself. + +“I will go and tell her,” said the old lady. “Keep your man here till I +return.” + +Now she brought this good news to the princess, and one need not say +how she rejoiced. And now a thought had come to her, and she was eager +to send a message to Alsi. + +“Surely,” she thought, “he does but threaten me with the kitchen knave, +that he may make me change my will. And, therefore, if I say that I am +ready to obey him, he will be pleased; and then time is gained at the +least, and it is not possible that he will choose so badly for me after +all.” + +So when the nurse asked her what she would do about getting the priest +to her presence, she said, “Go and tell my uncle first that I am +willing to obey him in the matter of which we spoke this morning.” + +“So that was what has troubled you after all, and not the dream? I +thought it should not have made all these tear marks,” said the nurse +quickly. “Now, why did you not tell me? I dare give Alsi a talking to +if he needs it.” + +“Nay, nurse, but it was the dream. My uncle and I did but disagree on +somewhat, and maybe I was wrong. By-and-by I will tell you.” + +“Tell me now, and then I shall know better how to ask for what you +need.” + +But Goldberga could not bring herself to say what Alsi had threatened, +and now felt sure that she would hear no more of that. So she told the +nurse that she had vowed only to marry a king, and that Alsi had been +angry, saying that kings were not so easily found. Also, that he was +the man who had to find her a husband. + +“That is the best sense that this king ever spoke,” said the nurse. +“Many a long year might you wait if you had your way thus. You are wise +in sending that message. Well, after that I will ask him to let you see +the priest, saying, if he is cross-grained, that a talk with him will +make your mind even better fitted to obey. Many things like that I can +say. We shall have him here presently.” + +Now, all that seemed very good to both of them, and the nurse went her +way. And when she came to Alsi, she gave the message plainly. + +“That will save a great deal of trouble,” said the king. “Tell her that +I am glad to hear it. She says this of her own accord, and not at your +advice?” + +“She told me before I had heard a word of what the trouble was between +you. It was no word of mine.” + +“I am glad of it. But I will say that I am somewhat surprised.” + +And that was true, for this message seemed to Alsi to be nothing more +or less than that Goldberga would marry his man. When he thought for a +moment, however, he saw that it could not be thus; and also, it was +plain to him what the poor girl had in her mind. And now he chuckled to +think what a weapon he had against her. Nor would he be slow to use it. + +Then the nurse said that he need have no surprise, for Goldberga was +ever gentle and willing to be led, though sometimes the pride of her +race came uppermost for a time. And then she asked if a certain priest +of the faith might come and speak with her. + +Now, Alsi knew that only one could be meant—namely, the hermit who +bided at Cabourn. He had heard of him often, and would not suffer him +to be hurt, for his sister Orwenna had protected him. The heathen +English minded him not at all by this time, for he was the best leech +in the land, and so useful to them. So Alsi said pleasantly that he was +quite willing that the priest should come, deeming that he was at +Cabourn, and that it would be a day or two before he would be brought. + +So he called the housecarl from outside the door, and when he came he +said, “Pass the word that when one who calls himself David comes and +asks for the princess, he is to be admitted to her.” + +So that was made easy, and the nurse thanked him and withdrew; and when +he was alone, Alsi grinned evilly and rubbed his hands. + +“Now is East Anglia mine in truth,” he said; and with that he bade the +housecarl fetch Curan, the cook’s porter, to him. And then he sent one +to Ragnar with such a message that he rode out that night and away to +Norwich. + + + + +CHAPTER XV. +THE FORTUNE OF CURAN THE PORTER. + + +While the nurse told Withelm to fetch the priest when Alsi was in the +hall that evening, the housecarl came for Havelok; and much wondering, +he followed the man to the king, and presently stood before him and +saluted. + +“Where did you get that salute?” said Alsi sharply, seeing at once that +it was not English; and, indeed, it was that of Gunnar’s courtmen. + +“I cannot tell,” answered my brother. “It seems to be there when +needed.” + +“Well, it is not that used here. Get the housecarls to teach you better +manners.” + +Then Havelok bowed a little, in token that he would do so; and when +Alsi spoke to him next it was in Welsh. + +“You are a marshman, as I hear?” + +Now Havelok had learned fairly well from the poor folk who loved him, +but carelessly, so that when he answered Alsi frowned at his way of +speaking. + +“I am from the marsh,” he said simply. + +“We had better get back to English!” the king said; “you people forget +your own tongue. Now, are you married?” + +Thereat Havelok laughed lightly. + +“That I am not,” he answered. + +“Well, then, if I find you a fair wife, you would be willing, +doubtless?” + +“That I should not,” answered Havelok bluntly, and wondering what this +crafty-looking king was driving at. “What could I do with a wife? For I +have neither house nor goods, nor where to take her, nor withal to keep +her; else had I not been the cook’s knave.” + +“It would seem that you carry all your fortune on your back, +therefore,” said Alsi, looking at Havelok’s gay attire with somewhat of +a sneer. + +“That may well be, King Alsi, for even these clothes are not my own. +Berthun gave them me, and I think that they come from yourself.” + +Alsi grinned, for Eglaf’s saying of him was not so far wrong; but he +had more serious business on hand than to talk of these things with a +churl. + +“Now, if I bid you, it is your part to obey. I have a wife for you, and +her you shall wed.” + +“There are two words to that, King Alsi. Neither will I wed against my +will, nor will I wed one who is unwilling.” + +“As to that first,” said the king, for he began to be angered with +Havelok’s boldness, “if a man will not do my bidding, I have dungeons +where he can have time to think things over, and men who can keep him +there, be he never so mighty; and if a man will not see with my eyes +when I bid him, blinded shall he be.” + +This he said somewhat hurriedly, for a dark flush came on the face of +the man before him, and he thought that he must try some other plan +than force with him. + +“And as for that other point, I did not so much as hint that the bride +was likely to be unwilling. I will say that she is willing, rather.” + +Now that troubled Havelok, for it seemed that all was arranged already, +and the thought of the dungeon was not pleasant. There was no doubt +that if the king chose he could cast him into one until he was +forgotten; and the light and the breath of the wind from the sea were +very dear to Havelok. So he thought that he would at least gain time by +seeming to listen to the proposal; for, after all, it might come to +nothing, and maybe it was but a jest, though a strange one. + +“Well, lord king,” he said, “if the bride knows enough of me to be +willing, it is but fair that I should have the like chance of choice.” + +Now Alsi thought that it was impossible that this churl, as he deemed +him, would not be overjoyed to hear of the match he had made for him, +and he must needs know it soon. Yet there was that about Havelok that +puzzled him, for his ways were not those of a churl, and he spoke as a +freeman should speak. + +So much the more likely that the people would believe him when he said +that Goldberga wedded him of her own wish, he thought. It was as well +that he was not altogether a common-seeming man. + +“You have seen the damsel already,” he said therefore. “Now I will not +say that this match is altogether of my choosing; but I have an oath to +keep, and it seems that I can only keep it by making you her husband. +But, as I say, she is willing, and, I will add, well dowered.” + +Now it grew plain to my brother that there was something strange in all +this, so he said, “An oath is a thing that must not be hindered in the +fulfilling, if a man can further it. But what has a king’s oath to do +with me?” + +“I have sworn to find her the goodliest and mightiest man alive; and, +though I must needs say it to your face, there is none like yourself. +No flattery this to bend you to my will, but sober truth—at least, as I +see it.” + +At that Havelok grew impatient. + +“Well, if that be so, who is the bride?” he asked, not caring to give +the king his title, or forgetting to do so, for on him was coming the +feeling that he was this man’s equal here in the palace. And at last, +not seeming to notice this, Alsi answered plainly. + +“The Princess Goldberga.” + +Then Havelok stared at him in blank wonder for some moments; and Alsi +grew red under his gaze, and his eyes were shifty, and would not meet +the honest look that was on him. + +Then at last said Havelok slowly, and watching the king intently all +the while, “What this means I cannot tell. If you speak truth, it is +wonderful; and if not, it is unkingly.” + +“On my word as a king, truth it is,” said Alsi hastily, for there was +that in Havelok’s face that he did not like. + +One might think that the king was growing afraid of his own kitchen +knave. + +“If that is so, there is no more to be said,” answered Havelok. “Yet +you will forgive me if I say that I must have this from the lips of the +princess herself as well. It may be that her mind will change.” + +“That is but fair,” answered Alsi; “and you are a wise man. The mind of +a damsel is unsteady, whether she be princess or milkmaid; but have no +fear.” + +“No man fear I; but I do fear to hurt any lady, and I would not do +that.” + +Then Alsi thought that all was well, and he spoke smooth words to my +brother, so that Havelok doubted him more than ever. Therefore it came +into his mind that all he could do for the best was to seem to agree, +and wait for what the princess herself said. And if Alsi was working +some subtlety, then he would wring his neck for him, if need be; and +after that—well, the housecarls would cut him in pieces, and he would +slay some of them, and so go to Valhalla, and dreams would be at an +end. And he would have died to some purpose here, for he knew that +Goldberga would come to her kingdom, ay, and maybe Alsi’s as well, for +she was his sister’s daughter, and his next of kin, and well loved by +those who had been allowed to know aught of her. + +But I would not have any think that the promise of so wondrous a bride +was not pleasing to him. It was more, for he had seen her grow white +and troubled as she looked on him, and he had seen her bear well +whatever pain had caused that; and he had known that in the one sight +he had of Goldberga somewhat had taught him what it was to have one +face unforgotten in his mind. + +So he said to Alsi, “All this fortune that you hold out to me is most +unlooked for, seeing what I am in your hall; and I have not thanked you +yet, King Alsi. That, however, is hard to do, as you may understand.” + +“I understand well enough,” answered the king, in high good humour +again, now that all seemed to be going well. “And after all, it is the +lady whom you must thank.” + +“But when shall I see her to do so?” + +“Tomorrow, surely; ay, tomorrow early shall you speak with her,” +answered the king quickly. “Now go, and hold your peace. Let me warn +you that there are those about the court who would go any lengths to +remove you from the face of the earth if they knew of this. Tell no man +of the honour that has come to you as yet. Be the porter for a short +time longer, and then you will be the man whom all envy. It is likely +that I must make you a thane, by right of the choice of the princess.” + +“I know well when to speak and when to keep silence, lord king,” said +my brother, and with that he bowed and left the hall. + +Then Alsi put his lips to a silver whistle that he carried, and blew a +call that brought Eglaf hurriedly to him from the outer door. + +“The guards may go,” said the king; “but see that the porter Curan +leaves not the palace until I myself send him forth tomorrow.” + +The captain saluted and went his way. He had had six men within call of +the king all the time that he spoke with Havelok, and one may make what +one likes of that. At least the threat of the dungeon was no idle one. + +Now went Havelok from the hall very heavy and troubled, for beyond the +fair talk of the king lurked surely some plan that was not fair at all. +It was not to be thought that he could not prevent, if he chose, a +foolish marriage of the princess, even did she desire it ever so much. +And my brother could not believe that she had set her heart on one whom +she had but seen once, and then in the midst of faintness. That, +however, might be known easily when he was face to face with her. It +was a thing that could not be made a matter of pretence. + +Now when he came back to the great kitchen, which was nigh as big as +the hall, Withelm was yet there, for the priest was at the widow’s, and +there was no haste to bring him; and by that time I had come in also, +and was sitting with him at the far end, where none had need to come. +It was Berthun’s own end, as one might say, and he was lord in his own +place. Only a few thralls were about, and the cook himself had gone +into the town. + +“Here is our brother,” I said, “and there is somewhat wrong.” + +He came moodily up to us, and sat him down, saying nothing, and he +leaned his head on his hands for a while. + +“What is amiss, brother?” said Withelm. + +“Wait,” he answered. “I will think before I speak.” + +I could see that this was not the old puzzlement, but something new and +heavy, so we held our peace. Long was he before he moved or spoke, and +when he did so it was wearily. + +“Well knew I that somewhat was to happen to me in this town, even as I +told you, brother, when we first passed its gates. And now it seems to +be coming to pass. For this is what is on me, as it seems to me—either +that I must see the light of day no more, or must live to be a scorn +and sorrow to one for whom it were meet that a man should die.” + +“Surely the black dream is on you, my brother! Neither of these things +can be for you!” I cried. + +“Would that it were the dream, for that is not all of sorrow, and that +also is of things so long past that they are forgotten. I can bear +that, for your voice always drives it away. But now the hand of Alsi +the king is on me for some ill of his own—” + +“Stay,” said Withelm. “Let us go out and speak, if that name is to be +heard. It were safer.” + +“Less safe, brother,” answered Havelok. “At once we should be kept +apart. Listen, and I will tell you all, and then say your say.” + +Then he told us, word for word, all that had just passed between him +and the king. And as we listened, it grew on us that here was no wrong +to the princess, but rather the beginning of honour. I could see the +downfall that was in store for Alsi, and I thought also that I saw hope +for the winning back of the Danish kingdom, with an East Anglian host +to back us. And this also saw Withelm, and his eyes sparkled. But +Havelok knew not yet all that had grown so plain to us. + +He ended, and we said nothing for a moment. + +“Well?” he said, not looking up, but with eyes that sought the floor, +as if ashamed. + +“By Odin,” said I, speaking the thought that was uppermost, “here will +be a downfall for Alsi!” + +“Ay, you are right, brother. I will not wed her.” + +But that was by no means what I meant, as may be known; and now Withelm +held up a warning hand to me, and I knew that his advice was always +best. + +“If the maiden is unwilling, wed her not,” he said. “If she is willing, +even as the king said, that is another matter. We have no reason to +doubt his word as yet.” + +“You saw not his face as he spoke. And then, how should the princess +think of me?” + +“Who knows? Even Odin owned that the minds of maids were hard to +fathom. But one may find a reason or two. Maybe that oath has somewhat +to do with it. A good daughter will go far to carry out her father’s +will, and, in the plain sense thereof, she will certainly do it thus. +Then it is likely that she knows that you are no churl, but the son of +Grim, though we have fallen on hard times for a while. I have heard say +that it is the custom here that a man who has crossed the seas in his +own ship so many times is a thane by right of that hardihood. Thane’s +son, therefore, might we call you. Then there is the jealousy of every +other thane, if she chooses an East Anglian. Then she needs one who +shall be mighty to lead her forces. Even the greatest thane will be +content to follow a man who is a warrior of warriors. Ragnar can have +told her what you are in that way. Faith, brother, there are reasons +enough.” + +Havelok laughed a short laugh at all this, and he grew brighter. There +was sense in Withelm’s words, if they would not bear looking deeply +into. + +Then I said, adding to these words, “Moreover, Alsi could stop the +whole foolishness of his niece if he did not think it a fitting match +in some way.” + +“So he could,” answered Havelok. “But yet—I tell you that there was +naught but evil in his face. Why did he try to force me?” + +Then he went back to the thing that weighed mostly on his noble +heart—the thought that he was unworthy altogether. + +“I fear that the princess does but think of me because she must. It is +in my mind that Alsi may have threatened her also until she has +consented. How shall I know this?” + +“Most easily, as she speaks with you,” answered Withelm. “Tomorrow will +tell you that. And then, if you find things thus, what shall prevent +your flying?” + +“Brother Radbard and the other housecarls,” said Havelok grimly. + +“Not if you ask the princess to help you out of her own way by +pretending to be most willing. If Alsi thinks you a gladsome couple, +there is no difficulty. You walk out of the palace as a master there. +Then you fly to Ragnar. That is all.” + +Now that was such an easy way out of the whole coil that we planned it +out. And yet it seemed to me that it was a pity that Havelok knew not +more of what seemed to us so sure now. So, seeing that things were +fairly straightened by this last thought, I got up and said that I must +be going, making a sign to Withelm to come also; and, with a few more +words, we went out. I saw Havelok set himself to a mighty task of water +drawing as I looked back. + +“Now,” said I, “here is a strange affair with a vengeance. Neither head +nor tail can I make of it. But if all we think is right, this is the +marriage for the son of Gunnar.” + +“Son of Gunnar, or son of Grim,” said Withelm, “princess or not, happy +is the maiden who gains Havelok for a husband. Maybe her woman’s wit +has told her so. She will have many suitors whom she knows to be +seeking her throne only, and to him she gives it as a gift unsought.” + +“That is all beyond me,” I said; “but he would fill a throne well. But +his own modesty in the matter of his worthiness is likely to stand in +the way. Why should we not tell him all that we know? Then he will feel +that he is doing no wrong.” + +“Because we are not sure, and because it is not for us to choose the +time. I have sent for Arngeir this morning, as we said would be well +last night. If the princess is unwilling, there are many things that +may be said; and if not, there must be many days before the wedding; +and, ere the day, Havelok may feel that he is her equal in birth at +least, if we are not wrong. But since I have waited here, Mord has told +me the dream that has troubled the princess, that I may tell the +priest, so that he can think it over. She has dreamed that she is to +wed a man who shall be king both in Denmark and England, and she saw +the man, moreover. Strangely like Havelok’s dream is that. Now what +else made her turn faint but that this vision was like Havelok? And +does not that make it possible that she wishes to wed him? Therefore I +am going to tell the priest the story of Havelok, so far as I know it.” + +“Well thought of. Tell him this also, for now I may surely tell you +what you have not yet heard thereof.” + +So I told him how Grim and I had taken Havelok from Hodulf, and then he +was the more certain that we had saved the son of our king. + +Now we thought that we had got to the bottom of the whole matter of the +wedding. Of course the dream had all to do with the fainting, but +nothing to do with the supposed wish. But we did not know that. + +“Speak not of Gunnar by name, however,” I said; “he was a terror to +Christian folk. The priest is likely to hinder the marriage with all +his might else.” + +Withelm flushed as he had when he first spoke of the priest to me. + +“I think not, brother; for he knows Havelok well, and loves him.” + +“So,” said I shortly, “he hopes to make him a Christian, doubtless.” + +“I think that he will do so, if he has a Christian wife to help.” + +“That would not suit Havelok,” I said, laughing. + +“Nay, but such a mind as his it seems to suit well already, though he +has not heard much.” + +“Why, then,” said I, wondering, “if it suits our best and bravest, it +must be a wondrous faith. It seems strange, however; but I know naught +of it. What is good for him and you, my brother, is sure to be best.” + +“I feared that you would be angry.” + +“Nay, but with you and Havelok? How should that be? Why, if you two +said that we must turn Christian, I should hold it right; so would +Raven. I suppose that I go to the Ve[11] because you do.” + +Now I troubled no more about the matter, being nothing but a sea dog +who could use a weapon. And now I said that I was going to Eglaf to say +that I might have to leave him at any time for home, in case we had to +fly with Havelok. So Withelm went his way to the old priest with a +light heart, and I to the captain. + +“Well,” said Eglaf, “this is about what I expected when your brother +came. Good it has been to have you here; and I think that I shall see +you as a housecarl for good yet. When do you go?” + +“The first time that I do not turn up on guard I am gone, not till +then.” + +“Come and drink a farewell cup first.” + +“I shall be in a great hurry if I do not do that,” I answered, +laughing. + +But it was my thought that maybe when once my back was turned on the +town, I should not have time to think of going near King Alsi’s guard. + +Then I went to find Ragnar the earl, for we thought it well that he +should know what was on hand. But when I came to the house of the thane +with whom he was quartered, they told me that he had gone hastily with +all his men, for word had come of some rising in his land that must be +seen to at once. That was bad; and as one must find a reason for +everything, I thought that the going of Griffin had much to do with the +outbreak. There I was wrong, as I found later. But then, too, I knew +that the craft of Alsi was at work in this message. He had his own +reasons for wishing the earl out of the way. + + + + +CHAPTER XVI. +A STRANGEST WEDDING. + + +Long spoke Withelm and the priest David together, until it was time for +them to seek the palace; and when they came there, they spoke to Mord +also. Then David thought it was well to say naught to Havelok until +more was learned from Goldberga herself, for he would soon see how +things stood with her. Then he would see Withelm again, and they would +plan together for the best. So Withelm waited for the return of the +priest, whom Mord took to his mistress. Alsi and his men were supping +in the hall, but Goldberga was waiting in her own chamber. + +Now the princess thought that, after her message to the king, she would +hear no more of the kitchen knave, and so was happier. But all the +while she pondered over her dream the thought of Havelok must needs +come into it, and that was troublesome. Nevertheless, it was not to be +helped, seeing that there was no doubt at all that he and the man of +the vision were like to each other as ever were twins. Wherefore if the +thought of one must be pleasant so at last must be that of the other. +And then came the nurse with tales of what Berthun thought of this man +of his—how that he was surely a wandering prince, with a vow of service +on him, like Gareth of the Round Table in the days of Arthur. + +So presently it seemed to the princess that the churl was gone, as it +were, and in his place was a wandering atheling, at least, who was not +a terror at all. Then at length the slow time wore away until Mord came +with David the priest. + +No priestly garb had the old man on, for that had made his danger +certain; but though he was clad in a thrall’s rough dress, he was not +to be mistaken for aught but a most reverend man. + +“Peace be with you, my daughter,” he said; “it is good to look on the +child of Orwenna, the queen whom we loved.” + +Then the chamberlain left those two alone, and at once Goldberga told +the priest why she had asked him to run the risk of coming to her, for +there is no doubt that he was in peril, though not from Alsi himself. + +At first she asked him many things about her mother, and learned much +of her goodness to the poor folk, and of their love to her; and +presently, when she grew more sure of the kindness and seeming wisdom +of the priest, she told him all her dream, adding no thoughts of her +own, as she mistrusted them. + +Then said David, “There seems naught but good in this, and it is not +hard to unravel. I think that all shall come to pass even as it was +told you.” + +“I feared the heathen ways of the place, and thought that it might be +some snare of the old gods,” said Goldberga. + +But David told her that they could have no power on her, and asked her +if the king knew of the vision, that being one thing of which he was +not sure; and when he found that he did not, the whole affair seemed +more strange than before. + +But now the princess asked him, “Plain were the words that I heard, hut +what meant the light as of a sunbeam that came from the mouth of the +man of the vision?” + +“That surely means that in word and in heart and in all else the man +shall be kingly altogether, so that there shall be no mistaking the +same; and it may also mean that you shall know the man at once when you +see him.” + +At that Goldberga grew pale and red by turns, so that David, quick to +read the thoughts of those who came to him for help, asked if she had +seen anyone who she thought must be meant, not at all knowing that she +must needs say that this was Curan. + +Not at all willingly did she tell him this; but she did so, adding at +last that Alsi had threatened to wed her to this man. + +Now it was plain to David that all was pulling the same way, for surely +Alsi wrought, unknowing, for the fulfilling of the dream; and all +seemed to prove that Havelok was the son of the Danish king, and that +he would win back his kingdom. Then he found out that the princess had +no knowledge that the king had spoken to Havelok, but it did not seem +to be needful that he should tell her that he had done so. That would +be told by Alsi himself if he meant, as seemed certain, to carry out +his threat. So he thought awhile, and at last he saw what he might do +without saying anything to bend the choice of the princess in any way. + +“It will soon be plain in what way the dream shall be fulfilled,” he +said; “and this is certain, that you shall be wedded to none but the +right man, else had it not been sent. Have no fear, therefore, even as +it was bidden you.” + +Then the princess said that the only thing which troubled her was the +fear lest Alsi should yet force her to wed this one who was so like him +she had seen in her dream. + +“That,” said the priest, “is doubtless the most strange part of the +whole matter, yet I think that even thus there need be no fear. I will +tell you now that I know this one who is called Curan well, and I, and +all who know him, love him. Truly he is not a Christian, but he is no +hater of the faith, and that is much in these days. Nor is he a churl, +but rather one of the most noble of men. It is certain that, whatever +Alsi might wish, he would not wed you against your will. He has but to +know your thoughts in order to help you in any way. But I must also +tell you this, that he is a Dane, who fled from his land when he was a +child; and it is thought that he is the son of the Danish king, who was +slain at the time when Mord, your servant, fled also. He came to +England in the same ship as did Mord, who can tell you more of him. It +is certain that there is a secret about his birth, and the one who +knows that secret is not far off. If need is, we can learn it, for +there was a set time for its telling, and maybe this is it. Now, if it +is true that he is the son of the Danish king, it does seem as if your +dream might be bidding you to have no fear of what seems doubtful in +the matter, though I cannot tell, and do not like to say so for +certain. His name is not Curan, but Havelok.” + +Then Goldberga said, “I have heard of that flight and of the wreck from +Mord often. He was wont to tell me of the child, and of the lady who +was drowned, and he said that he thought him the king’s son.” + +After that she was greatly cheered, for the worst of the trouble seemed +to be over and gone. It was in her mind now that Alsi knew who Havelok +was, and that he tried her, for she was not one to think ill of any. + +So she let the priest go, with many thanks, saying, “Now I know that +whatever happens is the will of Heaven, and must be for the best. I am +ready for whatever shall befall.” + +Now I do not know what had seemed good to Alsi, for he had changed his +mind concerning David’s visit to Goldberga, and had suddenly given +orders that if he came he was to be put in ward at once. So Mord met +the old man as he left the chamber, and told him that he must fly; and +after that Withelm took him away in the dusk, for none hindered his +going, and went to the widow’s with him, hearing all that had been +said; and that which they thought was even as Goldberga had said, that +all must needs be for the best. In a day or two all would he plain, for +Arngeir would have come. So Withelm sent forth the old man to his own +place with a good store of food, going with him for some miles, and +promising him help for coming days until the dearth was ended. + +Now into the palace none might come after the feast was set; and all +this time I was on guard, for there were double posts round the place, +by reason of Alsi’s fear of the attackers of the princess, as was said. +So it happened that neither of us saw Havelok until next morning; and +now I have to tell how we saw him, and what happened with the first +sunlight, when men were thinking of breaking their fast. + +We of the housecarls took that first meal of the day in the great +hall—so many of us, that is, who were not on duty; and when we had nigh +finished, Alsi would come in and seat himself on the high place, where +Eglaf and half a dozen other thanes sat also at times when there was no +special state to be kept. + +I was early this morning, having just taken my spell of watching at the +gate, and being, therefore, free for the rest of the day, and I was +hungry with the sweet air of the July weather and the freshness that +comes with sunrise. So I was not altogether pleased to see that there +was seemingly some new affair of state on hand, while the breakfast was +not yet set out by reason of preparations that were going on where the +king’s chair was wont to stand. There was Berthun, looking puzzled and +by no means pleased, and his men were busy setting out benches on the +high place, of a sort that were not those that were wont to be there, +in three sides of a square, the open side facing the hall. One bench +made each side, and all three were carved from back rail to clawed feet +wondrously. Old they seemed also. Then, too, instead of the sweet +sedges that strewed the high place, men had spread a cloth of bright +hues underfoot there, and the sedges had been swept among the rushes of +the lower places. All this was so strange that I went forward, and when +I had a chance I asked the steward what was on hand. + +“If you know not, master housecarl, no more do I. ‘Justice to be done,’ +says the king, and so I suppose that you have some notable prisoner in +ward—maybe the leader of those villains who scared our fair princess.” + +“But we had taken no man, and I will say that we had wondered that we +had not been sent out to hunt those people, instead of biding to see if +they came to trouble us here.” + +“Why, then,” said Berthun, “some thane must be bringing a captive +shortly. But why Alsi orders these benches, it passes me to make out. +They are those that have been used for the weddings of his kin since +the days of Hengist. Last time was when Orwenna, his sister, wedded +Ethelwald of Norfolk. Maybe he thinks that they need airing.” + +He laughed and went on directing his men; but knowing what I knew, I +wondered what it all might mean, for there was one wedding that I could +not help thinking of. + +Presently the hall began to fill as men came in, and every one had +somewhat to say, and all marvelled at this that was going on. Then +Berthun came and beckoned to me, for I must fetch Eglaf the captain at +once, as the king had need of him, in haste. Then Eglaf hurried to the +hall; and after a word or two with Alsi, the horns were blown outside +the hall door to call every man of the guard to the place. And when +they came, we were all set round the wall as if guarding all that were +in it. But there were none but the folk of the palace to guard, and +they were wondering as were we; and when that was done, and the click +and rattle of arms as we moved to our places was ended, there was a +silence on all—the silence of men who wait for somewhat to happen. + +Now Berthun went to the door on the high place, as he was wont when all +was ready for the king’s presence, and the hush deepened, none knowing +what they expected to see. + +Forth came Berthun backward, as was the custom, and he turned aside to +let the king pass him. His face was red and angry, as I thought, but +amazed also. I was standing next to Eglaf, and he was at the foot of +the dais, at the end of his line of men, so that I could see all +plainly. + +Then came Alsi, leading the princess, and after Goldberga came her +nurse. No other ladies were with her; and now I noticed that there was +not one thane on the high place, which was strange, and the first time +that such a thing had been since I came here. I looked down the hall, +and none were present. Now I looked at Alsi; and on his pale face was a +smile that might have been as of one who will be glad, though he does +not feel so. But the eyes of the princess were bright with tears, and +hardly did she look from the floor. Hers was a face to make one sad to +see at that time, wondrously beautiful as it was. + +Alsi led her by the hand, and set her on the bench that was to his +left, and signed to the nurse to sit beside her, which the old lady +did, bridling and looking with scorn at the king as she took her place. +There she sought the hand of the princess, and held it tightly, as in +comforting wise. Very rich garments had the nurse, but Goldberga was +dressed in some plain robe of white that shone when the light caught +it. Mostly I do not see these things, but now I wished that she always +wore that same. + +As for Alsi, he had on his finest gear, even as at the great feast of +the Witan—crimson cloak, fur-lined, and dark-green hose, gold-gartered +across, and white and gold tunic. He had a little crown on also, and +that was the only thing kingly about him, to my mind. + +Now he cast one look at Goldberga, which made her shrink into herself, +as it were, and turned with a smile to us all. + +“Friends,” he said, “this is short notice for a wedding, but all men +know that ‘Happy is the wooing that is not long a-doing,’ so no more +need be said of that. All men know also that when good Ethelwald died +he made me swear to him that I would wed his daughter to the mightiest +and goodliest and fairest man that was in the land. I have ever been +mindful of that oath, and now it seems that the time for keeping it has +come. Whether the man whom my niece will wed is all that the oath +requires, you shall judge; and if he is such a one, I must not stand in +the way. I do not myself know that I have ever seen one who is so fully +set forth in words as is this bridegroom in those of the oath.” + +Now I heard one whisper near me, “Whom has Goldberga chosen?” + +And that was what Alsi would have liked to hear, for his speech seemed +to say that thus it was, and maybe that he did not altogether like the +choice. + +But now Alsi said to Berthun, “Bring in the bridegroom.” + +“Whom shall I bring, lord?” the steward asked in blank wonder, and Alsi +whispered his answer. + +At that Berthun’s hands flew up, and his mouth opened, and he did not +stir. + +“Go, fool,” said Alsi, and I thought that he would have stamped his +foot. + +Now I knew who was meant in a moment, and even as the steward took his +first step from off the dais to go down the hail to his own entrance, I +said to Eglaf, “Here is an end to my service with you. My time is up.” + +“Why, what is amiss?” + +“The bridegroom is my brother—that is all; and I must be free to serve +him as I may.” + +“Well, if that is so, you are in luck. But I do not think that either +of Grim’s sons can be the man. Big enough are you, certainly, but +goodly? Nay, but that red head of yours spoils you.” + +I daresay that he would have said more about Raven and Withelm, for a +talk was going round; but a hush came suddenly, and then a strange +murmur of stifled wonder, for Havelok came into the hall after Berthun, +and all eyes were turned to him. + +Now I saw my brother smile as he came, seeing someone whom he liked +first of all; and then he looked up the hall, and at once his face +became ashy pale, for he saw what was to be done. Yet he went on +firmly, looking neither to right nor left, until he came to the high +place. There he caught my eye, and I made a little sign to him to show +that I knew his trouble. + +They came to the step, and Berthun stood aside to let Havelok pass, and +then Alsi held out his hand to raise my brother to the high place. But +Havelok seemed not to see that, stepping up by himself as the king bade +him come. Then the women who were in the hall spoke to one another in a +murmur that seemed of praise; but whiter and more white grew the +princess, so that I feared that she would faint. But she did not; and +presently there seemed to come into her eyes some brave resolve, and +she was herself again, looking from Alsi to Havelok, and again at Alsi. + +Now, too, the king looked at him up and down, as one who measures his +man before a fight. And when he met Havelok’s eyes he grew red, and +turned away to the folk below him. + +“So, friends,” he cried, “what say you? Am I true to the words of my +oath in allowing this marriage?” + +There was not one there who did not know Havelok, whom they called +Curan; and though all thought these doings strange, there was a hum of +assent, for the oath said naught of the station in life of the +bridegroom. Good King Ethelwald had been too trustful. + +“That is well,” said Alsi, with a grave face. “All here will bear +witness that this was not done without counsel taken. Now, let the +bridegroom sit in his place here to my right.” + +He waved his hand, and Havelok sat down on the bench that faced +Goldberga; and now he looked long at her with a look that seemed to be +questioning. Alsi was going to his seat in the cross bench, where the +parents of the couple are wont to sit at a wedding while the vows are +made, but he seemed to bethink himself. It is my belief that he said +what he did in order to shame both Havelok and Goldberga. + +“Why, it is not seemly that the bridegroom should sit alone without one +to be by him. Where are your friends, Curan?” + +At that Alsi met with more than he bargained for. At once Berthun came +forward, and forth came I, and without a word we sat one on each side +of him. There were others who would have come also, for I saw even +Eglaf take a step towards the high place, had we not done so. + +Alsi’s face became black at that, for here was not the friendless churl +he was scoffing at. But he tried to smile, as if pleased. + +“Why, this is well,” he said. “Good it is to see a master helping his +man, and a soldier ready to back a comrade of a sort. Now we have +witnesses. Let us go on with the wedding.” + +Now the golden loving cup that was used at the feasts had been filled +and set at a little side table that stood there, and it was to be the +bride cup that should be drunk between the twain when all was settled. +So Alsi took this cup and held it, while he sat in the place of the +father of the bride. Now, I knew nothing of what should he done, but +Berthun did so, and well he took my brother’s part, having undertaken +for him thus. + +“It is the custom,” said Alsi, “that the bridegroom should state what +he sets forth of the dowry to the bride.” + +Whereat Berthun, without hesitation, spoke hastily to Havelok, and told +him to let him answer, meaning, as I have not the least doubt, to +promise all that he had saved in long years of service. But Havelok +smiled a little, and set his hand to his neck, and I remembered one +thing that he had—a ring which had always hung on a cord under his +jerkin since he came to Grimsby, and which my father had bidden him +keep ever. + +“This give I,” he said, setting it on the floor at his feet, “and with +it all that I am, and all that I shall hereafter be, and all that shall +be mine at any time.” + +Alsi looked at the ring as it flashed before him, and his face changed. +No such jewel had he in all his treasures, for it was of dwarf work in +gold, set with a deep crimson stone that was like the setting sun for +brightness. I do not know whence these stones came, unless it were from +the East. Eleyn the queen, his mother, was thence, and I know now that +the ring was hers. But I think that when Alsi saw this he half repented +of the match, though he had gone too far now to draw back. So he bowed, +and said that it was well, as he would have said had there been nothing +forthcoming. + +Then Berthun, in his turn, asked for the bridegroom that the dowry of +the bride should be stated for all to hear. + +“The wealth left my niece by her father,” said Alsi. “The matter of the +kingdom is for the Witan of the East Anglians to settle.” + +Then came from out the king’s chamber two men bearing bags of gold, and +that was set before the princess. It was a noble dowry, and honest was +the king in this matter at least. + +Now were the vows to be said and the bride cup to be drunk, and that +was the hardest part of all to Havelok. + +Slowly he rose as the king held it out to him, and he took it from his +hand and stood before Goldberga; and she, too, rose and faced him, and +for a moment they stood thus, surely the most handsome couple that had +ever been. + +Then Havelok said, looking in the clear eyes of the princess, “This +have I sworn, that I will wed no unwilling bride. It is but for you to +say one word, and the cup falls, and all is ended.” + +Alsi started at that, and I thought he was going to speak, but he held +his peace. Still as a rock was Havelok while he waited for the answer, +and the folk in the hall were as still as he. They began to see that +all was not right as the king would have it thought. + +Once the princess looked at Alsi, and that with pride in her face, and +then she looked long and steadfastly at Havelok, and one by one his +fingers loosened themselves on the golden stem of the cup, that she +might know him ready for her word. + +Then she put forth her hand and closed it round his strong fingers, +that he must hold it fast by her doing, and that was all that was +needed. It was more than words could have told. And she smiled as she +did it. + +And at that a light came on Havelok’s face, and he smiled gravely back +at her, and he said in a low voice that shook a little, “May the gods +so treat me as I treat you, my princess. Can it be that you will trust +me thus?” + +She answered in no words, but I saw her hand tighten over his, and her +eyes never left his face. + +Then Havelok raised his other hand, and took that of Goldberga, which +was on the cup, and faced to the people. + +“Thus do I pledge her who shall be henceforward my wife through good +and ill; and may Odin, Freya, and Niord be witnesses of my oath of +faith to her in all that the word may mean.” + +So he drank, and I stole a glance at the king. Never saw I a man so +amazed, for to him the Danish names of the Asir had come as some sort +of a shock, seeing that he had deemed this man, with the name of Curan, +a Briton. And he looked at Berthun with a look that seemed to say more +than was likely to be pleasant by-and-by. But the steward paid no heed +to him. + +Now Havelok had made his vow, and he gave the cup to the princess; and +she, too, turned a little toward the people, but still she looked on +Havelok. + +“Faith shall answer to faith,” she said in a clear voice. “Here do I +take this man for my husband, in the sight of God, and with you all as +witnesses, and I pray that the blessing of Him may be on us both.” + +So she drank also, and Havelok stopped and raised the wondrous ring +from where it had been unheeded on the floor, and took the band of +Goldberga, and set it on her finger, and kissed the hand ere he let it +go. + +But Goldberga lifted her face toward him, and he bent and kissed her +forehead, and so they were wedded. + +I have heard men scoff at the thought of love at first sight, but never +can any one of us do so who saw this wedding. + + + + +CHAPTER XVII. +HOW THE BRIDE WENT HOME. + + +Now the folk cheered, and loudest of all honest Eglaf and his warriors. +I wondered what should come next, for neither feast nor bride ale was +prepared, and Berthun was looking puzzled. Then I saw that the only +face in all the wide hall which was not bright was that of Alsi, and +his brow was black as a thunder cloud, while his fingers were white +with the force with which he clutched and twisted the end of his +jewelled belt. Plainly he was in a royal rage that none had scoffed at +this wedding, but that all had taken it as a matter that was right +altogether. + +But he had one more evil thing in his mind that must be seen through; +and he came forward, smoothing his face, as best he might, to the fixed +smile that I had seen when he spoke with Ragnar, and learned that his +first plot had miscarried. + +“Now, friends,” he said, “all this has been so hasty that we have +prepared no feast. Even now, it seems that the horses stand at the door +to take bride and bridegroom hence, and doubtless there waits somewhere +the feast that has been bespoken without my knowledge. Well, strange +are the ways of lovers, and we will pardon them. I have therefore only +to bid them farewell.” + +With that he turned to Havelok, and held out his hand, as in all good +fellowship, but Havelok would not see it. + +“Fare as it shall be meted to you by the Asir, King Alsi,” he said, +“for at least Loki loves craft.” + +Then he turned to me, and asked hurriedly where we should go if we must +leave thus. + +“To Grimsby,” I said. “That is home.” + +Alsi spoke to the princess now, and maybe it was as well that he did +not offer so much as his hand. Wise was he in his way. + +“Farewell, niece,” he said; “all this shall come shortly before the +Witan of Ethelwald’s folk.” + +“Farewell, uncle,” she answered calmly. “That is a matter which I will +see to myself. You have carried out your oath to the letter, so far, +and now it remains that you should leave the government of the realm to +me.” + +With that she put her hand on Havelok’s arm. + +“Come, husband; we have heard that the horses wait. Let us be gone.” + +And then in a quick whisper she added, as if nigh overdone, “Take me +hence quickly, for I may not bear more.” + +They wasted no more words; and through a lane of folk, who blessed +them, those two went to the great door down the long hall, and I +followed, and Berthun and the nurse came after me. One flung the door +open; and on the steps, all unaware of what had happened, lounged Mord, +waiting, and up and down on the green the grooms led the horses of the +princess—six in all. On two were packed her goods, and the third had a +pack saddle that waited for the bags that held her dowry. The other +three were for herself and Mord and the nurse. There was not one for +Havelok. + +“This is hasty, my princess,” Mord said. “Whither are we bound?” + +“For Grimsby, Mord,” I answered quickly. “Are there no more horses to +be had?” + +“Never a one, unless we steal from the king,” he answered. + +The people were crowding out now that they might see the start, and I +saw Berthun speak to a man among them who was a stranger to me. And +from him he turned directly with a glad face. + +“Go down to such a hostelry,” he said to me, “and there ask for what +horses you will. Maybe I shall have to follow you for my part in this +matter—that is, if I am not put in the dungeon.” + +“Faith,” I answered, “better had you come with us than run that risk. +Alsi is in a bad mood.” + +He shook his head; and then the people behind him made way, for the +king was coming. + +“Almost had you forgotten this,” he said; “and I think you will want +it.” + +The men with the money were there, and he waved his hand to them. +Havelok lifted the princess to her horse without heeding him, and the +men set the bags on the pack horses. + +“See the bridegroom down the street, you who were his witnesses,” the +king went on, with a curling lip; “and if you are a wise man, master +Berthun, you will not come back again.” + +Berthun bowed and went into the hail, past the king, and across to his +own door, without a word. After him the thronging people closed up, and +though I thought that a housecarl would have been sent to see what he +was about, this would have made an open talk, and Alsi forbore. + +“Let Havelok take your horse, Mord,” I whispered to him; “I will tell +you why directly.” + +He nodded, and I told Havelok to mount. Then I helped up the nurse, who +wept and muttered to herself; and so we started, Alsi standing on the +steps with words of feigned goodspeed as we did so. + +But the housecarls and the people shouted with wishes that were real, +no doubt thinking that we were bound for the far-off kingdom of the +prince who had won Goldberga by service as a kitchen knave in her +uncle’s hall for very love of her. + +Directly we were outside the gate that leads down the hill, I saw +Withelm, who was there waiting for me, and he knew at once what had +happened. + +He came to my side, and asked only, “Already?” + +“Already,” I answered; “but it is well. Go to the widow’s straightway, +and bring Havelok’s arms to him at the hostelry at the end of the +marketplace, where we have to find more horses.” + +He went at once, and silently we came down the street and to the +courtyard of the inn. Some few folk stared at us; but the princess was +hardly known here, and she had cast her long, white mantle hoodwise +over her head and face, so that one could not tell who she was. So +early in the day there were few people in the marketplace either. + +Berthun was in the courtyard of the inn, and I was glad to see him, for +I did not know what would happen to him. It was likely that Alsi would +seek for someone on whom to visit his anger at the way things had gone. +But the steward had been warned, and was not one to run any risk. + +“I did but go back for a few things that I did not care to leave,” he +said; and he showed me that he had brought his own horse from the +stables, and on it were large saddlebags. No poor man was Berthun after +years of service in the palace, where gifts from thane and lady are +always ready for the man who has had the care of them. Across the +saddle bow also were his mail shirt and arms, and his shield hung with +his helm from the peak. + +“You see that I must needs cast in my lot with yours, or rather +Curan’s,” he said, laughing; “but it is in my mind that in the end I +shall not be sorry to have done so. I think that I am tired of the +fireside, and want adventure for a while.” + +“Well,” I answered, “you are likely to have them, and that shortly, if +I am not mistaken; but we shall see. Now about these horses, for we had +better get out of Lincoln as soon as we may.” + +The man he had spoken with was a merchant, who came yearly, and was a +friend of his. He had more horses than he meant to keep, as he had here +each year; for every one knows that a horse can always be sold in +Lincoln, and they were good ones. Then my gold came in well, and I +bought three, one for each of us brothers. I daresay that I paid dearly +for them, but there was no time for haggling in the way that a horse +dealer loves. Out of the way of Alsi we must get, before he bethought +him of more crafty devices. And I thought, moreover, that we should be +riding towards East Anglia shortly, and it was not everywhere that a +steed fit to carry Havelok on a long journey was to be had. + +I had bidden him leave all this to me as we came down the hill, and +glad he was to do so. Now he had dismounted, and stood by the side of +the princess, speaking earnestly to her. It was plain that what he said +was pleasant to her also. But we left them apart, as one might suppose. + +Now came a warrior into the courtyard, and he bore more arms. It was +Withelm, who had borrowed the gear of the widow’s dead husband, that he +might be ready for whatever might happen: and it was good to see +Havelok’s eyes grow bright as he spied the well-known weapons that his +brother had in his arms. He said one word to Goldberga, and then came +to us. + +“Let me get into war gear at once,” he said, laughing in a way that +lightened my heart. “I shall not feel that I have shaken off service to +Alsi until I have done so.” + +And then he saw Berthun here for the first time. + +“Nay, but here is my master,” he added. “And I will say that I owe him +much for his kindness.” + +“Now the kindness shall be on your part, if any was on mine. Take me +into your service, I pray you, henceforward.” + +“Good friend of mine,” said Havelok, “naught have I to offer you. And +how should one serve me?” + +“With heart and hand and head, neither more nor less,” answered +Berthun. “I have seen you serve, and now will see you command. Let me +bide with you, my master, at least, giving you such service as I may.” + +“Such help as you may, rather. For now we all serve the princess,” +Havelok said. + +And with that Berthun was well content for the time. + +“Well, then,” said I, “see to Havelok’s arms, while we get the horses +ready, for I want Withelm here.” + +So Havelok and his new man went into the house with his arms, and then +I saw Goldberga beckoning to us. It was the first time that I had +spoken to her, and I think that I was frightened, if that is what they +call the feeling that makes one wish to be elsewhere. But there was +nothing to fear in the sweet face that she turned to us. + +“Brothers,” she said, “Havelok tells me that it was one of you who +brought David the priest to me. I do not rightly know yet which is +Withelm.” + +With that she smiled and blushed a little, and I stood, helm in hand, +stupidly enough. But my brother was more ready. + +“I am Withelm, my princess—” he began. + +“Nay; but ‘sister’ it shall be between me and my husband’s brothers. +Now, brother Withelm, there is one thing that is next my heart, and in +it I know you will help me.” + +There she wavered for a moment, and then went on bravely. + +“Christian am I, and I do not think that we are rightly wedded until +the priest has done his part. And to that Havelok agrees most +willingly, saying that I must ask you thereof, for he does not know +where the old man is now.” + +“Wedded in the little chapel that is in the thick of Cabourn woods +shall you be, for David has gone there already. We can ride and find +him before many hours are over, sweet lady of ours.” + +She thanked him in few words, and with much content. + +Then came forth from the house Havelok, in the arms that suited him so +well—golden, shining mail shirt of hard bronze scales, and steel, +horned helm, plain and strong, and girt with sword and seax, and with +axe and shield slung over shoulder, as noble a warrior surely as was in +all England, ay, or in the Northlands that gave him birth either; and +what wonder that the eyes of the princess glowed with a new pride as +she looked at her mighty husband? + +But Mord almost shouted when he saw him come thus, and to me he said, + +“It is Gunnar—Gunnar, I tell you—come back from Asgard to help my +princess.” + +“Wait till we get to Grimsby, and Arngeir will make all clear,” I said. +“Get into your arms, and we will start. All is ready now.” + +We did not wait for Mord, but mounted and rode out, and the princess +looked round at us as she rode first beside Havelok, and said, “Never +have I ridden so well attended, as I think.” + +And from beside me, with broad face from under his helm, Berthun +answered for us all, “Never with men so ready to die for you, at least, +my mistress.” + +And that was true. + +Half a mile out of the town we rode at a quick trot, and then thundered +Mord after us, and his hurry surely meant something. I reined up and +waited for him. + +“What is the hurry, Mord?” said I. + +“Maybe it is nothing, and maybe it is much,” he answered; “but Griffin +of Chester has gone up to the palace, for I saw him. He has his arm in +a sling, and his face looks as if it had been trodden on. Now Alsi will +tell him all this, and if we are not followed I am mistaken. He would +think nothing of wiping out our party to take the princess, and Alsi +will not mind if he does. How shall we give him the slip?” + +Withelm rode with his chin over his shoulder, and I beckoned him and +told him this. Not long was his quick wit in seeing a way out of what +might be a danger. + +“Let us ride on quickly down the Ermin Street, and he will think us +making for the south and Norwich. Then we will turn off to Cabourn, and +he will lose us. After that he may hear that some of us belong to +Grimsby, and will go there; but he will be too late to hurt us. Hard +men are our fishers, and they would fight for Havelok and the sons of +Grim.” + +So we did that, riding down the old Roman way to a wide, waste forest +land where none should see us turn off, and then across the forest +paths to Cabourn; and there we found the hermit, and there Havelok and +Goldberga were wedded again with all the rites of Holy Church, and the +bride was well content. + +Now while that was our way, I will say what we escaped by this plan of +my brother’s, though we did not hear all for a long time. Presently we +did hear what had happened at Grimsby towards this business, as will be +seen. + +To Lincoln comes Griffin, with Cadwal his thane, just as we had left +the town thus by another road, and straightway he betakes himself to +the palace. There he finds Alsi in an evil mood, and in the hall the +people are talking fast, and there is no Berthun to receive him. + +So, as he sits at the high table and breaks his fast beside the king, +he asks what all the wonderment may be. And Alsi tells him, speaking in +Welsh. + +“East Anglia is mine,” he says, “for I have rid myself of the girl.” + +Griffin sets his hand on his dagger. + +“Hast killed her?” he says sharply. + +“No; married her.” + +“To whom, then?” + +“To a man whom the Witan will not have as a king at any price.” + +“There you broke faith with me,” says Griffin, snarling. “I would have +taken her, and chanced that.” + +“My oath was in the way of that. You missed the chance on the road the +other day, which would have made things easy for us both. There was no +other for you.” + +Now Griffin curses Ragnar, and the Welsh tongue is good for that +business. + +“Who is the man, then?” he says, when he has done. + +“The biggest and best-looking countryman of yours that I have ever set +eyes on,” answers Alsi, looking askance at Griffin’s angry face. “There +is a sort of consolation for you.” + +“His name,” fairly shouts Griffin. + +“Curan, the kitchen knave,” says Alsi, chuckling. + +“O fool, and doubly fool!” cries Griffin; “now have you outdone +yourself. Was it not plain to you that the man could be no thrall? Even +Ragnar looks mean beside him, and I hate Ragnar, so that I know well +how goodly he is.” + +Now Alsi grows uneasy, knowing that this had become plainer and plainer +to him as the wedding went on. + +“Why, what do you know of this knave of mine?” he asks. “He was goodly +enough for the sake of my oath, and the Witan will have none of him. +That is all I care for.” + +“What do I know of him? Just this—that you have married the queen of +the East Angles to Havelok, son of Gunnar Kirkeban of Denmark, for whom +men wait over there even now. The Witan not have him? I tell you that +every man in the land will follow him and Goldberga if they so much as +lift their finger. Done are the days of your kingship, and that by your +own deed.” + +Alsi grows white at this and trembles, for he minds the wondrous ring +and the names of the Asir, but he asks for more certainty. + +Then Griffin tells him that he was with Hodulf, and knew all the secret +of the making away with the boy, and how that came to naught. Then he +says that Hodulf had heard from certain Vikings that they had fallen on +Grim’s ship, and that in the grappling of the vessel the boy and a lady +had been drowned. It is quite likely that they, or some of them, +thought so in truth, seeing how that happened. After that Hodulf had +made inquiry, and was told that there were none but the children of +Grim with him, and so was content. So my father’s wisdom was justified. + +“Now I learned his name the other day; and I have a ship waiting to +take me at once to Hodulf, that I may warn him. I have ridden back from +Grimsby even now to say that, given a chance, say on some lonely ride, +that might well have been contrived, I would take Goldberga with me +beyond the sea. I thought more of that than of Hodulf, to say the +truth.” + +Now Alsi breaks down altogether, and prays Griffin to help him out of +this. + +“Follow the party and take her. They are few and unarmed, and it will +be easy, for men think that there is a plot to carry her off, and this +will not surprise any. Go to the sheriff and tell him that it has +happened, and he will hang the men on sight when you have taken them. +Then get to sea with the girl, and to Hodulf, and both he and I will +reward you.” + +“Thanks,” says Griffin, with a sneer; “I have my own men. Yours might +have orders that I am the one to be hanged. It would be worth your +while now to make a friend of your kitchen knave. You are not to be +trusted.” + +So these two wrangle for a while bitterly, for Alsi is not overlord of +Griffin in any way. And the end is that the thane rides towards Grimsby +first of all, with twenty men at his heels, knowing more than we +thought. But he hears naught of us, and presently meets Arngeir on his +way thence to see us. Him he knows, for already he has had dealings +with him in the hiring of the ship. So he learns from him that +certainly no such party as he seeks is on the road, and therefore rides +off to the Ermin Street to stay us from going south. + +But now we had time for a long start; and so he follows the Roman road +when he reaches it all that day and part of next, and we hear no more +of him at that time. There are many parties travelling on that way, and +he follows one after another. + +Now Arngeir knew at once that somewhat had happened when he heard from +Griffin that the most notable man of those whom he sought was named +Curan, and therefore he turned back at once and waited for us. And when +we came in sight of the long roof of the house that Grim, our father, +had built, standing among the clustering cottages of our fishers, with +the masts of a trading ship or two showing above it in the haven, he +was there on the road to greet us, having watched anxiously for our +coming from the beacon tower that we had made. + +Maybe we were two miles out of Grimsby at this time, for one can see +far along the level marsh tracks from our tower; and Withelm and Mord +and I rode on to him as soon as we saw him, that we might tell him all +that had happened, and we rode slowly and talked for half a mile or so. + +Then Withelm waited and brought Havelok to us, staying himself with the +princess, that he might tell her the wondrous story of her husband; for +we thought that it would be easier for him than for our brother maybe. +Havelok was not one to speak freely of himself. + +And when Goldberga had heard all, she was silent for a long way, and +then wept a little, but at last told Withelm that all this had been +foretold to her in her dream. + +“Yet I am glad,” she said, “that I did not know this for certain, else +had my Havelok thought that I did but wed him for his birth. Tell him, +brother, that it was not so; say that I knew him as the husband Heaven +sent for me when first I saw him.” + +Now Havelok listened to Arngeir as he told him the well-kept secret, +and now and again asked a question. + +And when all was told he said, “Now have the dreams passed, and the +light is come. I mind all plainly from the first.” + +And he told all that had happened after Hodulf caught him, from the +murder of his sisters to the time when I helped my father to take him +from the sack. Only he never remembered the death of his mother or the +storm, or how we came to Grimsby. Maybe it is rather a wonder that +after all those hard things gone through he should recall anything, for +he was nearly dying when we came ashore, as I have told. + +“But I am Grim’s son,” he said, “for all this, and never shall I forget +it. By right of life saved, and by right of upbringing, am I his, and +by right of brotherhood to his sons. Gunnar, who was my father, would +have me say this, if I am like him, as Mord tells me I am.” + +Then he looked at us in brotherly wise, as if we would maybe not allow +that claim now; but there needed naught to be said between us when he +met our eyes. He was Grim’s son indeed to us, and we his younger +brothers for all the days that were to come. + +“One thing there is that makes me glad,” he said, “and that is because +I may now be held worthy of this sweet bride of mine so strangely +given, as indeed I fear that I am not. Men will say that she has done +no wrong in wedding me; and for all that Alsi may say, it will be +believed that she knew well whom she was wedding. There will be no +blame to her.” + +That seemed to be all his thought of the matter now, and it was like +him. Then he went back to his princess, and we spurred on to Grimsby, +and set all to work, that the greeting might be all that we could make +it. + +And so, when those two rode into our garth, and the gates were closed +after them, we reined our horses round them, and drew our swords, and +cried the ancient greeting with one mighty shout: + +“Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson—Skoal to Goldberga, Havelok’s wife! Skoal! +Yours we are, and for you we will die! Skoal!” + + + + +CHAPTER XVIII. +JARL SIGURD OF DENMARK. + + +Now one would like to tell of quiet days at Grimsby; but they were not +to be. Three days after Havelok’s homecoming we were on the “swan’s +path,” and heading for Denmark, with the soft south wind of high summer +speeding us on the way. And I will tell how that came about, for else +it may seem strange that Havelok did not see to the rights of his wife +first of all. + +That was his first thought, in truth, and we brothers planned many ways +of getting to work for her, for it was certain that Alsi would be on +his guard. And on the next day came a man from Lincoln to seek Berthun, +with news. That good friend had done what none of us had been able to +manage, for he had told the merchant, his friend, to bide in the hall +and hear what went on, and then to let him know all else that seemed +needful that we should hear. Now he had learned all from the words of +Griffin and Alsi, who took no care in their speech, thinking that none +in the hall knew the Welsh tongue that they used. + +It being the business of a merchant to know that of every place where +he trades, and he travelling widely, there was no difficulty to him, +and mightily he enjoyed the sport. Then he sent off straightway to us; +and now it was plain that we were in danger—not at once, maybe, but ere +long. Griffin would hear sooner or later that his quarry was in Grimsby +after all. So we went to our good old friend, Witlaf of +Stallingborough, and told him all. + +“Why,” he said, “I will have no Welsh outsiders harrying my friends. +Light up your beacon if he comes, and shut your gates in his face, and +I and the housecarls will take him in the rear, and he will not wait +here long. I have not had a fight for these twenty years or so, and it +does me good to think of one.” + +So we thought that there was little fear of the Welshman. + +When I came back from this errand, however, I chose to pass the mound +where my father slept, and on it, hand in hand, sat Havelok and +Goldberga—for it was a quiet place, and none came near it often. It was +good to see them thus in that place, and happy they seemed together. + +Goldberga called me when I came near, and I sat down beside them as she +bade me. + +“Here we have been talking of what we shall do now, for it seems that +to both of us are many things to hand,” she said. “Good it would be if +we could set them aside; but we were born to them, and we cannot let +them be. And, most of all, here in this place we may not forget the +duty that Grim would remind us of. Havelok must go to Denmark and win +back his kingdom from Hodulf first of all.” + +“We have thought that East Anglia was to be won first from Alsi,” I +said. + +“So says Havelok; but I do not think so. For, indeed, I am but the +wife, and the things of the husband come first of all. Now, this is +what I would say. Sail to Denmark before Hodulf knows what is coming, +and there will be less trouble.” + +“I am slow at seeing things,” said Havelok; “but the same might be said +of your kingdom.” + +“Alsi is ready, and Hodulf is not,” she answered, laughing; “any one +can see that. + +“Is it not so, brother?” + +So it was; and I thought that she was right. + +“Let us ask the brothers,” I said, “for here are many things to be +thought of; and, first of all, where to get men.” + +That was the greatest trouble to our minds, but none at all to hers. + +“Get them in Denmark,” she said, when we were all together in the great +room of the house that evening. “Let us go as merchant folk, and find +Sigurd, or his son if he is dead. If I am not much mistaken, all the +land will rise for the son of Gunnar so soon as it is known that he has +come again.” + +“Sigurd is yet alive,” Arngeir said; “and more than that, he is +waiting. For he promised Grim that he would be ready, and I heard the +promise. I think that this plan is good, and can well be managed. Here +is the ship that Griffin was to have taken today, and he is not here. +Gold enough I have, for Grim hoarded against this time.” + +Then he showed us the store that, through long years, my father had +brought together to take the place of that of Sigurd’s which had been +lost; and it was no small one. And so we planned at once; and in the +end we three brothers were to go with Havelok and Goldberga, leaving +Mord to get to Ragnar and tell him that Goldberga was following the +fortunes of her husband, and would return to see to her own if all went +well. Berthun would go with him, and Arngeir would bide at home, for we +needed one to whom messages might come; and while none would know us +now in Denmark, either Arngeir or Mord might be seen, and men would +tell Hodulf that the men of Grim had come home, and so perhaps spoil +all. Word might go to Denmark from Griffin even yet. + +We had little thought of any sorry ending to our plans, for the dreams +that had come so true so far cheered us. And so, with the evening tide +of the next day, we sailed in the same ship that had been hired for +Griffin. + +But first Havelok spent a long hour on my father’s mound alone, +thinking of all that he owed to him who rested there. And to him came +Goldberga softly, presently, lest he should be lonely in that place. +And there she spoke to him of her own faith, saying that already he +owed much to it. For he was making his vows to the Asir for success. + +“Shall you pray yet again to the Asir, my husband?” she asked. + +“Why should I? I have vowed my vows, and there is an end. If they heed +them, all is well; and if not, the Norns hinder.” + +“There is One whom the Norns hinder not at all,” she said gently, and +so told him how that her prayers would go up every day. + +Fain was she that he also prayed in that wise to her God, that naught +might be apart in their minds. + +Then he said, “I have heard this from David and Withelm also, and it is +good. Teach me to vow to your God, sweet wife, and I will do so; and +you shall teach me to pray as you pray.” + +So it came to pass that Havelok in the after days was more than ready +to help the Christian teachers when they came to him; for that was how +the vow that he made ran, that he would do so if he was king, and had +the power. + +Now there is nothing to tell of our voyage, for one could not wish for +a better passage, if the ship was slow. Indeed, she was so slow that a +smaller vessel that left Tetney haven on the next day reached the same +port that we were bound for on the night that we came to our old home. +And that we learned soon after she had come. + +Into Sigurd’s haven we sailed on the morning tide, and strange it +seemed to me to see the well-known place unchanged as we neared it. My +father’s house was there, and Arngeir’s, and the great hall of the jarl +towered over all, as I remembered it. Men were building a ship in the +long shed where ours had been built, and where the queen had hidden; +and the fishing boats lay on the hard as on the day when Havelok had +come to us. The little grove was yet behind our house, and it seemed +strange when I remembered that the old stones of its altar were far +beyond the seas. I wondered if Thor yet stood under his great ash tree; +and then I saw one change, for that tree was gone, and in its place +stood a watchtower, stone built, and broad and high, for haven beacon. + +On the high fore deck stood Havelok, and his arm was round Goldberga as +we ran in, but they were silent. The land held overmuch of coming +wonder for them to put into words, as I think. + +Presently the boats came off to us in the old way, and here and there I +seemed to know the faces of the men, but I was not sure. It was but the +remembrance of the old Danish cast of face, maybe. I could put no names +to any of them. And as we were warped alongside the wharf, there rode +down to see who we were Sigurd the jarl himself, seeming unchanged, +although twelve years had gone over him. He was younger than my father, +I think, and was at that age when a man changes too slowly for a boy to +notice aught but that the one he left as a man he thought old is so +yet. He was just the noble-looking warrior that I had always wondered +at and admired. + +We had arranged in this way: Havelok was to be the merchant, and we his +partners in the venture, trading with the goods in the ship as our own. +That the owner, who was also ship master, had agreed to willingly +enough, as we promised to make good any loss that might be from our +want of skill in bargaining. One may say that we bought the cargo, +which was not a great one, on our own risk, therefore, hiring the +vessel to wait our needs, in case we found it better to fly or to land +elsewhere presently. Then Havelok was to ask the jarl’s leave to trade +in the land, and so find a chance to speak with him in private. After +that the goods might be an excuse for going far and wide through the +villages to let men know who had come, without rousing Hodulf’s fears. + +And as we thought of all this on the voyage, Goldberga remembered that +it was likely that Sigurd would know again the ring that had been the +queen’s, and she said that it had better be shown him at once, that he +might begin to suspect who his guest was. For we knew that he was true +to the son of Gunnar, if none else might still be so. + +This seemed good to us all; and, indeed, everything seemed to be well +planned, though we knew that there are always some happenings that have +been overlooked. We thought we had provided against these by keeping +the ship as our own to wait for us, however, and it will be seen how it +all worked out in the end. + +Now Havelok went ashore as soon as the ship was moored; and the moment +that he touched land he made a sign on his breast, and I think that it +was not that of the hammer of Thor, for Goldberga watched him with +bright eyes, and she seemed content as she did so. He went at once to +where the jarl sat on his horse waiting him, and greetings passed. I +was so used to seeing men stare at my brother that I thought little of +the long look that Sigurd gave him; but presently it seemed that he was +mightily taken with this newcomer, for he came on board the ship, that +he might speak more with him and us. + +“Presently,” he said, “you must come and dine with me at my hall; for +the lady whom I saw as you came in will be weary, and a meal on shore +after a long voyage is ever pleasant. Now what is your errand here?” + +“Trading, jarl,” answered Havelok. + +“I thought you somewhat over warlike-looking for a merchant,” said +Sigurd; “what is your merchandise?” + +“Lincoln cloth, and bar iron, and such like; and with it all one thing +that is worth showing to you, jarl, for I will sell it to none but +yourself.” + +Now we went aft slowly, and presently Havelok and the jarl were alone +by the steering oar, by design on our part. + +“This seems to be somewhat special,” said Sigurd. “What is it?” + +Havelok took the ring from his pouch, and set it in the jarl’s hand +without a word; and long Sigurd looked at it. I saw the red on his +cheek deepen as he did so, but he said never a word for a long time. +And next he looked at Havelok, and the eyes of these two met. + +“This is beyond price,” said the jarl slowly. “Not my whole town would +buy this. It is such as a queen might wear and be proud of.” + +“Should I show it to Hodulf the king, therefore?” asked Havelok, with +his eyes on those of the jarl. + +“Let no man see it until I know if I can buy it,” answered Sigurd. +“Trust it to my keeping, if you will, for I would have it valued +maybe.” + +“It is my wife’s, and you must ask her that.” + +Then Havelok called Goldberga from her cabin under the after deck, and +the jarl greeted her in most courtly wise. + +“I will trust it with you, Jarl Sigurd,” she said, when he asked her if +he might keep the ring for a time. “Yet it is a great trust, as you +know, and it will be well to show the ring to none but men who are +true.” + +“It is to true men that I would show it,” he answered, with that look +that had passed between him and Havelok already; and I was sure that he +knew now pretty certainly who we were. Yet he could not say more at +this time, for the many men who waited for Havelok must be told +somewhat of his coming first. + +Now men were gathering on the wharf to see the newcomers, and so the +jarl spoke openly for all to hear. + +“Come up to my hall, all of you, and take a meal ashore with me; for +good is the first food on dry land after days at sea and the fare of +the ship.” + +So he went across the gangway, and to his horse, and rode away quickly, +calling back to us, “Hasten, for we wait for you. And I will find you +lodgings in the town for the time that you bide with us.” + +Now at first that seemed somewhat hazardous, for we had meant to stay +in the ship, lest we should have to fly for any reason suddenly. But it +seemed that we had no choice but to do as he bade us, and we could not +doubt him in any way. We should go armed, of course, as in a strange +place; and, after all, unless Hodulf heard of us, and wanted to see us, +he was not to be feared as yet. So I fell to wondering where our +lodgings would he, and if the old families still dwelt in the houses +that I had known, and then who had ours. Many such thoughts will crowd +into the mind of one who sees his old land again after many years, and +finds naught changed, to the eye at least. + +Men have told me that, as we came into the hall presently, they thought +us the most goodly company that had ever crossed its threshold; and +that is likely, for at our head were Havelok and Goldberga. Raven was a +mighty warrior to look on as he came next, grave and silent, with +far-seeing grey eyes that were full of watching, as it were, from his +long seafaring, and yet had the seaman’s ready smile in them. And +Withelm was the pattern of a well-made youth who has his strength yet +to gather, and already knows how to make the best use of that he has. +There were none but thought that he was the most handsome of the three +sons of Grim. And last came I, and I am big enough, at least, to stand +at Havelok’s back; and for the rest, one remembers what Eglaf said of +me. But I do not think that any noticed us with those twain to look at, +unless they scanned our arms, which were more after the English sort +than the Danish, so far as mail and helms are concerned, and therefore +might seem strange. + +The old hall was not changed at all; and handsome it seemed after +Alsi’s, though it was not so large. There were more and better weapons +on the walls, and carved work was everywhere, so that in the swirl and +heat-flicker of the torches the beams, and door posts, and bench ends, +and the pillars of the high seat seemed alive with knotted dragons that +began, and ended, and writhed everywhere, wondrous to look on. Our +English have not the long winter nights, and cruel frosts, and deep +snow that make time for such work as this for the men of the household. + +There fell a silence as we came in, and then Sigurd greeted us; and we +were set on the high seat, and feasted royally. On right and left of +our host sat Havelok and Goldberga, and the jarl’s wife next to +Havelok, and Biorn the Brown, the sheriff, next to our princess. This +was a newcomer here since my days, but well we liked him. + +There is nothing to tell of what happened at this feast, for Sigurd +asked no questions of us but the most common ones of sea, and wind, and +voyage, and never a word that would have been hard for Havelok to +answer in this company, where men of Hodulf’s might well be present. +Withelm noticed this, and said that no doubt it was done purposely, and +he thought much of it. + +When we had ended with song and tale, and it was near time for rest, +Sigurd bade Biorn, the sheriff, take us to his house for the night, +telling him that he must answer for our safety, and specially that of +the fair lady who had come from so far. And then he gave us a good +guard of his housecarls to take us down the street, as if he feared +some danger. + +“Why, jarl,” said Biorn, “our guests will have a bad night if they +think that in our quiet place they need twenty men to see them to bed +thus!” + +“Nay, but the town is strange to the lady,” answered Sigurd; “and who +knows what she may fear in a foreign land!” + +So Biorn laughed, and was content; and we bade farewell to the jarl, +and went out. And then I found that it was to my father’s house we were +to go, for it had been given to Biorn. + +Now, I was next to Goldberga as we came to the door, and there was a +step into the house which we always had to warn strangers of when it +was dark; and so, in the old way, without thinking for a moment, I said +to her, “One step into the house, sister.” + +“Ho, Master Radbard, if that is you, you have sharp eyes in the dark,” +said Biorn at once; “I was just about to say that myself.” + +“I have some feeling in my toes,” I answered; and that turned the +matter, for they laughed. + +And then, when we were inside, and the courtmen had gone clattering +down the street homewards, Biorn took the great door bar from its old +place and ran it into the sockets in the doorposts, as I had done so +many times; and the runes that my father had cut on it when he made the +house were still plain to be seen on it, with the notches I had made +with the first knife that I ever had. More I will not say, but +everywhere that my eyes fell were things that I knew, even to fishing +gear, for it seemed that Biorn was somewhat of a fisher, like Grim +himself. + +Then they put me and my brothers into our old loft, and Havelok and +Goldberga had the room that had been my father’s. As for Biorn, he +would be in the great room, before the fire. There was only this one +door to the house, and therefore he would guard that. His thralls were +in the sheds, as ours used to be, so that we and he were alone in the +house. + +Now, as soon as we three had gone into our old place of rest, Raven +went at once, as in the old days, to the little square window that was +in the high-pitched gable, and looked out over the town and sea. We +used to laugh at him for this, for he was never happy until he had +seen, as we said, if all was yet there. + +“There are yet lights in the jarl’s hall,” he said, “and there are one +or two moving about down in the haven. I think that there is a vessel +coming in.” + +“Come and lie down, brother,” I said. “We are not in Grimsby, and you +cannot go and take toll from her if there is.” + +He laughed, and came to his bed; but we talked of old days and of many +things more for a long while before we slept. And most of all, we +thought that Sigurd the jarl knew Havelok by the token of the ring and +by that likeness to Gunnar which Mord had seen, and that our errand was +almost told. + +So we slept without thought of any danger; but the first hour of the +night in that house was not so quiet to Goldberga, for presently she +woke Havelok, and she was trembling. + +“Husband,” she said, “it is in my mind that we are in danger in this +place; for I cannot sleep by reason of a dream that will come to me so +soon as my eyes are closed.” + +“You are overtired with the voyage,” Havelok told her gently; and then +he asked her what the dream was. + +“It seems that I see you attacked by a boar and many foxes, and hard +pressed, and then that a bear and good hounds help you. Yet we have to +flee to a great tree, and there is safety. Then come two lions, and +they obey you.” + +“I think that is a dream that comes of waves, and the foam that has +followed us, and the shrill wind in the rigging, and the humming of the +sail, sweet wife; and the tree is the tall mast maybe, and the lions +are the surges that you saw along this shore, where is no danger.” + +So she was content; and then all in the house slept. + + + + +CHAPTER XIX. +THE LAST OF GRIFFIN OF WALES. + + +Maybe it was about an hour before midnight when the first waking came +to any of us, and then it was Biorn himself who was roused by footsteps +that stayed at the doorway itself, after coming across the garth, and +then a voice that was strange to him which bade him open. At once he +caught up his axe and went to the door, and asked quietly who was +there. + +“Open at once,” said the man who was without; “we must speak with you.” + +“Go hence, I pray you, and wait for morning,” said the sheriff. “Here +are guests of the jarl’s, and they must not be disturbed.” + +“Open, or we will open for ourselves,” was the answer. “We have no time +to stay here talking.” + +“That is no honest speech,” quoth Biorn. “Go hence, or give me your +errand from without.” + +“Open, fool, or we will have the door down.” + +“There is an axe waiting for you if you do that. I rede you go hence in +peace, or it may be worse for you in the end.” + +I suppose it was in the mind of the sheriff that here were some friends +of his who had been overlong at the ale bench in the hall that evening; +but on this there was a little talk outside, and then the crash of a +great stone that was hurled against the door; and at that he started +back and got his mail shirt on him, for the door was strong enough to +stand many such blows yet. It seemed that there was more than a drunken +frolic on hand. Then came another stone against the door, and it shook; +and at the same moment Havelok came from his chamber to see what was +amiss, for the noise had waked him. He had thrown on the feasting gear +that he had been wearing; but he had neither mail nor helm, though he +had his axe in his hand. + +“What is the noise?” he said anxiously, seeing that Biorn was arming. + +The sheriff told him quickly, and again the door was battered. + +“It is a pity that a good door should be spoilt,” said Havelok, “for +down it is bound to come thus. Stand you there with the axe, and I will +even save them the trouble of breaking in.” + +“Nay,” said Biorn; “we know not how many are there, and it were better +that you should arm first. There is time.” + +“Why, they think that you are alone in the house, no doubt, and will +run when they find out their mistake. They are common thieves from the +forest, or outlaws. Stand you by to cut down the first man that dares +to enter, if there happen to be one bold enough.” + +He set his axe down, and went to the bar, and began to slide it back +into the deep socket that would let it free, and the men outside stayed +their blows as they heard it scraping. It was a very heavy bar of oak, +some seven feet long, and over a palm square. + +“Now!” cried Havelok, and caught the bar from its place. + +He did not take the trouble to set it down and get his axe; but as the +door opened a little he stood back balancing the great beam in his +hands, as a boy would handle a quarterstaff, ready for the rush of the +thieves that he expected, and so he was in the way of Biorn more or +less. + +Now there was silence outside, and one saw that the door was free, and +set his foot to it, and flung it open, for it went inwards. And then +Havelok knew that there was a stern fight before him, for the moonlight +showed the grim form of Griffin, the Welsh thane, fully armed and +ready. + +“Stand back, friend,” cried Biorn hastily, fearing for the unarmed man, +and caring nothing that beyond the foremost was a group of some half +dozen more warriors. + +But he spoke too late, for as Griffin stepped back a pace on seeing his +enemy himself in the doorway, Havelok had gone a pace forward, and now +was outside, where he had a clear swing of his unhandy weapon. + +Now Griffin gathered himself together, and spoke some few words to his +men in his own tongue; but my brother paid no heed to them, for he knew +what the way of the Briton was likely to be. And he was not wrong, for +without warning Griffin flew on him, sword point foremost, and left +handed, for he might not use the right for many a long day yet. + +Biorn shouted; but Havelok was ready, and the heavy bar caught and +shivered the light sword, and then swung and hurled the thane back +among his men with a rib broken. Havelok followed that up, falling on +the men even as their leader was among their feet. Two he felled with +downright strokes, and another shrank away in time to save himself from +the like fate. Then a fourth got in under his guard, and wounded +Havelok slightly in the left arm; and unless Biorn had been out and +beside him by that time it would have gone hard with him, for both +those who were left were on him, and another was hanging back for a +chance to come. + +There was shouting enough now, for the Briton does not fight in silence +as do the northern men, and we had waked. First of all Raven ran down +to the great room, half dazed with sleep, and blaming himself for all +this trouble, for he had seen that a ship was coming in, and he might +have thought it possible that it had brought Griffin and his men, whose +tongue had told him at once what had happened. + +Now he called to us to arm quickly, and sought for a weapon for +himself; and in that familiar place he went to the old corner where the +oars were wont to be set. There was one, for I have said that this +Biorn was a fisher, and the place that was handy for us had been so for +him. That was a homely weapon to Raven, and out into the moonlight he +came with it, and swept a Welshman away from Havelok’s side as he came. +But now more men were coming—townsfolk who had been roused by the +noise—and they knew nothing of the attackers, and so thought them +friends of ours, who joined us in falling on their sheriff; and there +was a wild confusion when Withelm and I came down armed. + +But what we saw first was a dim, white figure in the doorway of the +other room; and there stood Goldberga, wide eyed and trembling. + +“My dream, my dream!” she said. + +But of that we knew nothing; and we could but tell her to be of good +courage, for we would win through yet, and so went out to the fight. + +By this time Griffin was up again, and as I came from the door he was +once more ready to fall on Havelok from behind. So I thought it best to +stay him, and I shouted his name, and he turned and made for me. But +there was no skill in his coming, or he did not think me worth it, for +the axe had the better, and there was an end of Griffin. + +Withelm saw at once that Havelok had no weapon but the bar, and he ran +to him and held out his own axe. + +“Thanks, brother. Mine is inside the door. Get it for me,” said he; but +now he was laughing, and doing not much harm to anyone, and as I got +behind his back I saw why this was. + +There was only one of Griffin’s men left, and all the rest of the crowd +of half-armed men were townsfolk. Havelok and Raven were keeping these +back with sweeps of their long weapons, and behind them against the +wall was the sheriff, swearing and shouting vainly to bid his people +hold off and listen to him. And the noise was so great that they did +but think that he was calling them to rescue him from these who had +taken him prisoner. It seemed that the Welshman was keeping this up +also; but neither he nor any of the men cared to risk any nearness to +the sweep of bar and long oar in such hands. There were many broken +heads in that crowd; but it was growing greater every minute, and those +who were coming were well armed, having taken their time over it. They +say that there were sixty men there at one time. + +Now ran Withelm with the axe, and at that Havelok parted with the door +bar, and ended the last Welshman at the same time, for he hurled it at +him endwise, like a spear, and it took him full in the chest, and he +went down to rise no more. And at that the townsmen ran in, and we were +busy for a space, until once more they were in a howling circle round +us. But they had wounded Havelok again; and Biorn was at his wit’s end, +for he had had to take part in the fight this time. The men were mad +with battle, and forgot who he was, as it seemed. And now some raised a +cry for bows. + +That was the worst thing that we had to fear, and Raven called to us, +“Into the house, brothers, and keep them out of it till the jarl comes. +He will hear, or be sent for.” + +So we went back and got into the doorway, and we could not bar it at +first. But Withelm hewed off the blade of Raven’s oar, and I went out +and cleared the folk away for a space, and leapt back; and Havelok and +I got the door shut quickly against them as they came back on it, and +we barred it with the oar loom. That was but pine, however, and it +would not last long. + +Outside, the people were quiet for a little, wondering, no doubt, how +to rescue Biorn. He wanted to go out to them, but it did not seem safe +just yet. If they grew more reasonable it might be so. + +Then, as we rested thus, Goldberga came quickly, for she saw that her +husband was wounded, and she began to bind his hurts with a scarf she +had. She was very pale, but she was not weeping, and her hands did not +shake as she went to work. + +“This is my dream,” she said. “Was that the voice of Griffin that I +heard? It does not seem possible; but there is none other who speaks in +the old tongue of Britain here, surely.” + +“There is no more fear of him,” said Havelok, looking tenderly at her. +“Your dream has come true so far, if he was in it. How did it end?” + +“We fled to a tree,” she said, smiling faintly. + +Havelok smiled also, for this seemed dream stuff only to all of us—all +of us but Withelm, that is, for at once he said, “This door will be +down with a few blows. What of that tower of yours, Biorn? Might we not +get there and wait till the jarl comes?” + +At that Biorn almost shouted. + +“That is a good thought, and we can get there easily. Well it will be, +also, for the men are wild now, and there have been too many slain and +hurt for them to listen to reason.” + +“Bide you here,” said Withelm, “for it is we whom they seek. Then you +can talk to them.” + +But he would not do that, seeing that we had been put in his charge by +the jarl. + +“I go with you,” he said. “Now, if we climb out of the window that is +in the back of the house we can get to the tower before they know we +are gone.” + +We went into that chamber where Havelok had once been when he was taken +from the sack, and even as I unbarred the heavy shutter and took it +down, the door began to shake with a fresh attack on it. The trees of +the grove were two hundred yards from the house, maybe, and among them +loomed high and black the watchtower I had seen from the sea. A wide +path had been cut to it, and the moonlight shone straight down this to +the door of the building. + +Now Biorn went out first, and then he helped out Goldberga, and after +her we made Havelok go; and we called to these three to get to the +tower as Withelm came next, for every moment I looked to see our +enemies—if they are to be called so when I hardly suppose they knew +what they were fighting about—come round to fall on the back of the +house. + +Because of Goldberga they went; and Biorn opened the tower door, and +she passed into the blackness of its entry, but the two men stayed +outside for us. And we three were all out of the house when the first +of the crowd bethought themselves, and made for the back, and saw us. + +At once they raised a shout and a rush, and we did not think it worth +while to wait for them, as they would get between us and the tower, +which was open for us. So we ran, and they were, some twenty of them, +hard at our heels as we reached the door, and half fell inside, for the +winding stairway was close to the entry. I think that Biorn and Havelok +had made their plans as they saw what was coming, for Havelok followed +us and stood in the doorway, while Biorn was just outside with his axe +ready. + +“Hold hard, friends!” he called, as the men came up and halted before +him; “what is all this?” + +“Stand aside and let us get at them,” said the foremost, panting. + +“Nay,” said Biorn; “what harm have they done?” + +“Slain a dozen men and lamed twice as many more,” answered several +voices; “have them forth straightway.” + +“They were attacked, and defended themselves,” said the sheriff, “and +it is no fault of theirs that they had to do their best. Get you home, +and I will answer to the jarl for them. They are the jarl’s guests.” + +Then was a howl that was strange, and with it voices which seemed to +let some light on the matter. + +“They have slain the jarl’s guests.” + +And then came forward a big black-bearded man whom I had seen in the +crowd already, and he squared up to Biorn. + +“Lies are no good, master sheriff, for we know that the outlanders who +spoke the strange tongue must be the guests who came.” + +“I am no liar,” answered Biorn. “Is there not one man here who saw the +ship and her folk this afternoon?” + +Now this man seemed not to want that question answered, for he shouted +to the crowd not to waste time in wrangling, but to have out the +murderers; and he took a step towards Biorn, bidding him side no more +with the men, but let the folk deal with them. + +“You overdo your business as sheriff!” he said. + +It was Biorn who wasted no more time, for he saw that here was deeper +trouble than a common riot. He lifted his axe. + +“Come nearer at your peril,” he said. + +Then the black-bearded man sprang at him, and axe met sword for a parry +or two, flashing white in the moonlight. Then one weapon flashed red +suddenly, and it was Biorn’s, and back into the tower he sprang as his +foe fell, and Havelok flung the door to, and I barred it. + +“Up,” said Biorn; and in the dark we stumbled from stair to stair, +while the crowd howled and beat on the door below us. It was good to +get out into the moonlight on the roof, where we could rest. I was glad +that the tower was there instead of Thor, and also that it was strong. +It was no great height, but wide, and the men below looked comfortably +far off at all events. + +“Here is a fine affair,” quoth Biorn, sitting himself down with his +back against the high stone wall round the tower top. “It will take me +all my time to set this right.” + +“You have stood by us well, friend,” Havelok said, “and it is a pity +that you have had to share our trouble so far as this. Who was the man +who fell on you?” + +“That is the trouble,” answered Biorn, “for there will be more noise +over him than all the rest. He was Hodulf’s steward, the man who +gathers the scatt, and therefore is not liked. And all men know that +there was no love lost between him and me.” + +“Hodulf’s man,” said I; “how long has he been here, and is he a +Norseman?” + +For I knew him. He was the man who had spoken to me at the boat side +when we had to fly—one, therefore, who knew all of the secret of +Havelok. + +“Ay, one of the Norsemen who came here with the king at the first, and +is almost the last left of that crew. I suppose that you have heard the +story.” + +We had, in a way that the honest sheriff did not guess, and I only +nodded. But I thought that we had got rid of an enemy in him, and that +Griffin had fallen in with him on landing, and known him, and taken him +into his counsel about us. He would have gone down to see the vessel +and collect the king’s dues from her and from us at the same time. He +had not come into the town till late, as we heard afterwards. + +There was no time for asking more now, however, for the shouts of the +men round the door ceased, and someone gave orders, as if there was a +plan to be carried out. So I went and looked over on the side where the +door was to see what was on hand. + +It was about what one would have expected. They had got the trunk of a +tree, and were going to batter the door in. But now we were all armed, +for Raven had brought Havelok’s gear with him when he fetched his own. +He had thought also for Goldberga, and she was sitting in the corner of +the tower walls wrapped in a great cloak that she had used at sea, with +her eyes on her husband, unfearing, and as it seemed waiting for the +end that her dream foretold. + +I called the rest, and we looked down on the men. They saw us, and an +arrow or two flew at us, badly aimed in the moonlight. + +“Waste of good arrows,” said Havelok; “but we must keep them from the +door somehow.” + +“Would that the jarl would come,” growled Biorn, “for I do not see how +we are to do that.” + +“If they do break in,” said I, “any one can hold a stairway like this +against a crowd.” + +“I do not want to hurt more of these,” answered Havelok, looking round +him. And then his eyes lit up, and he laughed. “Why, we can keep them +back easily enough, after all.” + +He went to the tower corner, and shouted to the men below. Four or five +had the heavy log that they were to use as a ram, and they were just +about to charge the door with it, and no timber planking can stand that +sort of thing. + +“Ho, men,” he cried; “set that down, or some of you may get hurt.” + +They set up a roar of laughter at him as they heard, and then Havelok +laid hold of the great square block of stone that was on the very +corner of the wall, and tore it from its setting. + +“Odin!” said Biorn, as he saw that, “where do they breed such men as +this?” + +“Here,” answered Withelm, looking at the sheriff. + +Now Havelok hove up the stone over his head, and a sort of gasp went up +from the crowd below. One saw what was coming, and ran to drag back the +men with the beam, and stopped short before he reached them in terror, +crying to them to beware. But their heads were down, and they were +starting into a run. + +“Halt!” cried Havelok, but they did not stay. “Stand clear!” he shouted +in the sailor’s way. + +And then he swung the stone and let it go, while those who watched fled +back as if it was cast at them. Down is crashed on the attackers, +felling the man whom it struck, and dashing the timber from the grasp +of the others, so that one fell with it across his leg and lay howling, +while the rest gathered themselves up and got away from under the tower +as soon as they might. + +Now no man dared to come forward, and that angered Havelok. + +“Are you going to let these two bide there?” he said. “Pick the poor +knaves from under the stone and timber, and see to them.” + +But they hung back yet, and he called them “nidring.” + +Thereat two or three made a step forward, and one said, “Lord, let us +do as you bid us, and harm us not.” + +“You are safe,” he answered, and Biorn laughed and said that this was +the most wholesome word that he had heard tonight. + +“Lord, forsooth! Mighty little of that was there five minutes ago.” + +But it was not the terrible stone throwing only that wrung this from +them, as I think. They had seen Havelok in his arms, with the light of +battle on his face in the broad moonlight, and knew him for a king +among men. + +They took the hurt men from under the tower, and then crowded together, +watching us. And some man must needs loose an arrow at us, and it rang +on my mail, and that let loose the crowd again. Soon we had to shelter +under the battlement, but they were not able to lodge any arrows among +us, for that is a bit of skill that needs daylight. Then they dared to +get to the timber once more, and we saw them coming. + +Havelok took his helm, and set it on his sword point, and raised it +slowly above the wall, and that drew all the arrows in a moment. Then +he leapt up, and tore the stone from the other corner; and again, but +this time without warning, it fell on the men below, and that wrought +more harm than before. But it stayed them for a time, though not so +long, for now their blood was up, and the berserk spirit was waking in +them. Already the third stone was poised in the mighty hands, and would +have fallen, when there was a cry of, “The jarl! the jarl!” and along +the path into the clearing galloped Sigurd himself, with his courtmen +running behind him, and he called on the men to stay. + +They dropped the beam at the command, and were silent. And Sigurd +looked up at the tower, and saw who was there, and stayed with his face +raised, motionless for a space. I minded how Mord had stared and cried +out when first he saw Havelok, the son of Gunnar, in his war gear. + +“Biorn! where is Biorn?” cried Sigurd, looking back on the crowd as if +he thought he would be there. + +“Here am I, jarl,” came the answer, and the sheriff looked out from +beside Havelok. + +“What is all this?” + +“On my word, jarl, I cannot tell. Here have I been beset in my own +house, and but for your guests some of us would have come off badly. +There were outlanders who fell on us, and, as I think, stirred up the +folk to carry on the business, telling them that we had slain +ourselves, as one might say, for it was the cry that we had slain the +jarl’s guests.” + +“O fools, to take up the word of a chance stranger against that of your +own sheriff!” Sigurd cried, facing the people. + +“Nay, but the steward said so likewise,” cried some. + +“Hodulf’s steward?” said the jarl suddenly; “where is he?” + +“Yonder. Biorn slew him.” + +“He was leading this crowd,” said Biorn from above, “tried to force his +way into the tower past me, and would not be warned.” + +“What of the outlanders?” + +“All slain. Seven Welshmen they were.” + +Then I said plainly, remembering that the jarl would have known him, +“Their leader was Griffin, who came with Hodulf at the first. What +brought him here, think you, Sigurd the jarl?” + +But Sigurd looked round on the people, and scanned them for a long +time, and at last he said, in a hush that fell when he began to speak, +“Men who mind the old days, look at the man whom you have sought to +kill, and say if there is that about him which will tell you why +Hodulf’s men have set you on him thus.” + +Then the white faces turned with one accord to Havelok, as he stood +resting the great cornerstone on the battlement before him, and there +grew a whisper that became a word and that was almost a shout from the +many voices that answered. + +“Gunnar! Gunnar Kirkeban come again!” + +Then was silence, and the jarl spoke to Havelok. + +“Tell us your name, and whence you come.” + +“Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby men call me,” he said. + +And then men knew who he was indeed, for little by little the secret +had been pieced together, if not told from the king’s place, in the +years that had passed. And at that there rose and grew a murmur and a +cry. + +“Havelok, son of Gunnar! Havelok the king!” + +Then said Sigurd in a great voice, “Who is for Hodulf of us all? Let no +man go hence who is for him.” + +And I saw two or three men cut down then and there, and after that +there was a roar of voices that called for Havelok to lead them. + +“Come down, lord,” said Sigurd, unhelming and looking up. + +So we went from the tower, and round Havelok the men crowded, kissing +his hand and asking pardon for what they had wrought in error; and +Sigurd dismounted and knelt before him, holding forth his sword hilt in +token of homage, that his king might touch it. + +“Only Havelok son of Gunnar dares call himself son of Grim also, and in +that word all the tale is told. But I have known you from the first by +the token of the ring and by this likeness. Yet I waited for you to +speak, and for the time that should be best; and now that has come of +itself, and I am glad.” + +So said Sigurd, as we went from the tower to the hall, with the +townsmen at our heels in a wondering crowd. There were many among them +who would show the wounds that Havelok had given them with pride +hereafter, as tokens that they had known him well. + +Then we stayed on the steps of the hall door, and the jarl called out +man by man, and the war arrow was put in their hands with the names of +those men who waited for the coming of Havelok, that all through the +night the message that should bring him a mighty host on the morrow +should go far and wide. + +And the gathering word was, “Come, for the horn of the king is +sounding.” + +Then Sigurd said, “Speak to the people, my king, and all is done.” + +So Havelok smiled, and lifted his voice, and spoke. + +“Stand by me, friends, as steadfastly as you have fought against me, +and I shall be well content. And see, here is the queen for whom you +will fight also. There is not one of you but will play the man under +her eyes.” + +Not many words or crafty, but men saw his face, and heard that which +was in the voice, and they needed no word of reward to come, but +shouted as we had shouted when the bride came home to Grimsby, and I +thought that with the shout the throne of Hodulf was rocking. + + + + +CHAPTER XX. +THE OWNING OF THE HEIR. + + +Worn out we were with that long fight, and we all had some small +wounds—not much worth speaking of; and when these were seen to, we +slept. Only my brother Raven waked, and he sat through all the rest of +the short night on the high place, with his sword across his knees, +watching, for he blamed himself, overmuch as we all thought, for the +happenings of the attack. + +“Trouble not, brother, for we were in the keeping of Biorn, and he +could not have dreamt that foes could follow us over seas. It was not +for you to be on guard.” + +These were Withelm’s words, but for once Raven did not heed them. + +“Would Grim, our father, have slept with a lee shore under him, leaving +a stranger to keep watch? That is not how he taught me my duty; and I +have been careless, and I know it. I should have thought of Griffin +when I saw the ship come in.” + +So he had his way, and the last that I saw ere my eyes closed was his +stern form guarding us; and when I woke he was yet there, motionless, +with far-off eyes that noted the little movement that I made, and +glanced at me to see that all was well. + +In the grey of the morning the first of the chiefs to whom the arrow +had sped began to come in; but the jarl would not have Havelok waked, +for he was greatly troubled at the little wounds that had befallen this +long-waited guest. So the chiefs gathered very silently in the great +hall, and sat waiting while the light broadened and shone, gleam by +gleam, on their bright arms and anxious faces. It was not possible for +those who had not yet seen Havelok to be all so sure that it was indeed +he. They longed to see him, and to know him for the very son of Gunnar +for themselves. + +Presently there were maybe twenty chiefs in the hall—men who had fought +beside Kirkeban, and men who had been boys with Havelok, and some who +had known his grandfather—and the jarl thought that it was time that +they had the surety that they needed, for time went on, and there was +certainty that Hodulf must hear of all this morning. One could not +expect that no man would earn reward by warning him. + +So Sigurd went softly to the place where Havelok lay in the little +guest chamber that opened out of the inner room that was the jarl’s +own, and he slid the boards that closed it apart gently and looked in +to wake him. But instead of doing that, he came back to the hall and +beckoned the chiefs, and they rose and followed him silently. And when +they went Raven went also, without a word, that he might be near his +charge while these many strangers spoke with him. + +Now Sigurd stood at the spot where the little shifting of the sliding +board made it possible to see within the chamber, and one by one the +chiefs came and peered through the chink for a moment, and stood aside +for the next. And it was wondrous to see how each man went and looked +with doubt or wonder or just carelessly, and then turned away with a +great light of joy on his face and a new life in the whole turn and +sway of the body. + +It was dark in the chamber, save for the dim spaces under the eaves +that let in the sweet air from the sea to the sleepers. But from +somewhere aloft, where the timbering of the upper walls toward the east +had shrunk, so that there was a little hole that faced the newly-risen +sun, came the long shaft of a sunbeam that pierced the darkness like a +glorious spear, and lit on the mighty shoulder of Havelok that lay bare +of covering, and on the white hand of Goldberga that was across it. And +on the one they saw the crimson bent-armed cross that was the mark of +the line whence he and his father had sprung, and on the other glowed +and flashed the blood-red stone of the ring of Eleyn the queen. And +round that circle of sunshine was light enough for the chiefs to see +those two noble faces, and they were content. + +“Gunnar’s son,” said one old chief: “but were he only the son of Grim, +for those twain would I die.” + +So the warriors crept back to the hall silently as they had come; and +now they went out to their men and told them that all doubt had gone, +and along the road that led to Hodulf’s town the jarl sent mounted men +to watch for his coming. And always fresh men were pouring in, and +among them went the chiefs who had seen Havelok, and told them the +news. + +Now it was not long before there was a gathering of all the chiefs in +the hall of Sigurd, that they might break their fast, and then they saw +Havelok as he led in the princess to meet them. He stood on the high +place in his arms, and a shout of greeting went up; and when it was +over, Sigurd asked him to tell all that had happened to him; and he did +that in as few words as might be, for he was no great speaker, though +what he did say was always to the point, and left little to be asked. + +And when he had ended, there rose up a grey-headed old chief, and said, +“Give this warrior the horn of Gunnar, that we may hear him wind it. I +would not say that unless I were sure that he was the right man to have +it.” + +Now I stood beside Havelok, and while Sigurd went from the hall to some +treasure chamber to get this that had been asked for, I said to him, +“Mind you the day when we met Ragnar. and a call came into your dream? +Wind that call now; for, if I am not wrong, it will be welcome to those +who knew your father.” + +“I mind the day but not the call. I have never remembered it since,” he +said, and I was sorry. + +Sigurd brought the horn, and it was a wondrous one, golden and heavy. +It seemed to be a hunting horn, not very long, and little curved, but +from end to end it was wrought with strange figures of men and beasts +in rings that ran round it. + +“Have you seen this before?” asked Sigurd wistfully, and looking into +Havelok’s face as he gave it into his hand. + +One could feel that men waited his answer, and it came slowly. + +“Ay, friend, I am sure that I have, but I cannot yet say when or where. +I am sure that it is not the first time that I have had it in my hand.” + +And as he said this, Havelok’s face flushed a little, and his brow +wrinkled as if he tried to bring back the things of that which he had +thought his dream for so long. + +It would seem that in the years there had grown up a tale that this was +a magic horn, which none but the very son of Gunnar could wind, and to +the chiefs who saw Havelok now for the first time this was a test to +prove him. But all knew that the words he spoke of it were proof +enough, for a pretender would have said plainly that it had been +Gunnar’s, and that he knew it. I think that Sigurd was wise in what he +did next, for he set another horn in my brother’s hand, and asked him +the same question; and at this Havelok looked for a moment and shook +his head. + +“I have not seen that one before, nor one like it. I am sure that I +have seen this, or its fellow.” + +At that the faces that watched brightened, for there was no doubt in +the way that Havelok spoke; and then the old chief who had asked for +the horn said, “That—‘The horn of the king is sounding’—was the +gathering word of the night that has brought us here, and long have we +waited for it. Let Havelok wind his father’s horn, that we may hear it +once again.” + +Then Havelok set it to his lips, and at once the call that he had +remembered came back to him, and clear and sweet and full of longing +its strange notes rang under the arched roof, unfaltering until the +last; and then over him came the full remembrance of all that it had +been to him, and he turned away from the many eyes and sank on the high +seat, and set his head in his arms on the table, that men might not see +that he needs must weep; and Goldberga stepped a little before him, and +set her hand on his, for I think that she knew the loneliness that came +on him. + +Yet he was not alone in his sorrow, for down in the hall were men to +whom the lost call brought back the memory of a bright young king +riding to his home, and calling the son whom he loved with the call +that he had made for him alone; and they saw the fair child running +from the hall, and the mother following more slowly with smiles of +welcome; and they saw the grim courtmen, who looked on and were glad; +and they minded how they had lifted the boy to the war saddle; and +their eyes grew hot with tears also, and they had no need to be +ashamed. + +And as men stood motionless, with the last notes of the wild horn yet +ringing in their ears, there drifted a shadow across the days, and, lo! +beside Havelok, with his hand on his shoulder, stood the form of Gunnar +the king for a long moment, bright as any one of us who lived, in the +morning sunlight, and his face was full of joy and of hope and promise +for the time to come. And then he passed, but as he faded from us his +hand was on the hand of Goldberga that clasped her husband’s, as though +he would wed them afresh there on the high place of his friend’s hall. + +Now there went a sigh of wonder among the chiefs, and Havelok looked up +as if he followed the going of one whom he would not lose, and I know +that he saw Gunnar after he was unseen to us. + +“Surely,” he said, “surely that was my father who was here?” + +And Sigurd answered, “With your own call you called him, and he was +here.” + +But now the last lurking doubt was gone, and there was no more delay, +for the chiefs crowded with shouts of joy to the high place, and they +knelt to Havelok and hailed him as king then and there; and so they led +him to the great door of the hall, and the mightiest of them raised him +high on a wide shield before all the freemen who waited on the green +that is round the jarl’s house, and they cried, “Skoal to Havelok the +king!” + +And there was in answer the most stirring shout that a man may hear—the +shout of a host that hail the one for whom they are content to die. + +That was the first day of the reign of Havelok the king; and now there +were two kings in the land, and one was loved as few have been loved, +and the other was hated. And one was weak in men, as yet, while the +other was strong. + +Now Sigurd bade all those who were present gather in solemn Thing, that +they might make Havelok king indeed; and that was a gathering of all +the best in our quarter of the land, so that all would uphold what they +had done. And when they were gathered in the great hall in due order, +the doors were set wide open, and outside the freemen who followed the +chiefs sat in silence to see what they might and hear. + +Then swore Havelok to keep the ancient laws and customs, and to do +even-handed justice to all men, and to be bound by all else that a good +king should hold by. Sometimes these oaths are not kept as well as they +might be, but I was certain that here was one who would keep them. + +Thereafter Sigurd brought forth a crown that he had had made hastily by +his craftsmen from two gold arm rings, and they set it on Havelok’s +head, and hailed him as king indeed; and one by one the chiefs came and +swore all fealty to him, beginning with Sigurd, and ending with a boy +of some seventeen winters, who looked at the king he bent before as +though he was Thor himself. + +Then they would have had Havelok forth to the people at once; but he +bade them hearken for a moment, and said, taking Goldberga by the hand, +“Were it not for this my wife, I do not think that I had been here +today, and without her I am nothing. Now I am king by your word, and I +think that I might bid you take her as queen. But I had rather that she +was made queen by your word also, that whither I live or fall in the +strife that is to come, you may fight for her.” + +At that there was a murmur of praise, and all agreed that she should be +crowned at once. So Havelok set the crown on her head while the chiefs +in one voice swore to uphold her through good and ill, as though she +were Havelok himself. + +Then said Havelok, “Now have you taken her for queen for her own sake, +and I will tell you a thing that has not been heard here as yet. On +this throne sits the queen of two lands, and there shall come a day +when you and I shall set your lady on that other throne which is hers +by right. King’s daughter she is, for Ethelwald of the East Angles was +her father, and out of her right has she been kept by Alsi of Lindsey, +her evil kinsman.” + +At that men were glad, for great is the magic of kingly descent. And +thereupon that old warrior who had bidden Havelok sound the horn said, +“We have heard of Ethelwald the good king, and of this Alsi moreover, +and we know men who have seen both, and also Orwenna, the mother of our +own queen here. I followed your father across the seas in the old days, +and I seem to hear his voice again as you speak to us. And I saw +him—ay, I saw him yonder even now, and I am content. When the time +comes that for the sake of Goldberga you will gather a host and cross +the ‘swan’s path,’ I will not hold back, if you will have me.” + +There was spoken the mind of all that company, and they were not +backward to say so. For in the heart of the Dane is ever the love of +the sea, and of the clash of arms on a far-off strand that comes after +battle with wind and wave. + +Very bravely did Goldberga thank the chiefs for their love to her +husband and herself in a few words that were all that were needed to +bind the hearers to her, so well and truly were they chosen. And she +said that if the Anglian land was to be won it was for Havelok and not +for herself altogether, and she added, “Here we have spoken as if +already Hodulf was overthrown, and it is good that we are in such brave +heart. Yet this has been foretold to me, and I am sure that there will +be no mishap.” + +Then Sigurd said, “What gift do we give our queen, now that she has +come among us?” + +But Goldberga replied, “If it is the custom that one shall be given, I +will mind you of the promise hereafter, when Anglia is won, and you and +I are Havelok’s upholders on that throne. There is one thing that I +will ask then, that a wrong may be righted.” + +“Nay, but we will give you some gift now, and then you shall ask what +you will also.” + +“You have given me more than I dared hope,” she said, “even the brave +hearts and hands that have hailed us here. I can ask no more. Only +promise to give me one boon when I need it, and I am happy.” + +Then they said, “What you will, and when you will, Goldberga, the +queen. There is naught that you will ask amiss.” + +Now they showed Havelok to the warriors as crowned king, and I need not +tell how he was greeted. And after that we all went back into the hall +to speak of the way in which we were to meet Hodulf. + +Havelok would have a message sent to him, bidding him give up the land +in peace. + +“It may be that thus we shall save the sadness of fighting our own +people, though, indeed, they love the playground of Hodulf. He is an +outlander, and perhaps he may think well to make terms with us.” + +Some said that it was of no use, but then Havelok answered that even so +it was good to send a challenge to him. + +“For the sake of peace we will do this, though I would rather meet him +in open fight, for I have my father to avenge.” + +Now I rose up and said, “Let me go and speak with him, taking Withelm +as my counsellor. For I know all the story, and that will make him sure +that he has the right man to fight against. I will speak with him in +open hall, and more than he shall learn how he thought to slay +Havelok.” + +All thought that this was good, and I was to go at once. It was but a +few hours’ ride, as has been said, to his town, and the matter was as +well done with. + +So they gave me a guard of twenty of the jarl’s courtmen, and in half +an hour I was riding northward on my errand. And to say the truth I did +not know if it was certain that I should come back, for Hodulf was +hardly to be trusted. + +I did wait to break my fast, and that was all, for I had no mind to +spend the night on the road back from the talk that I should have had; +but though I wasted so little time, the people were already beginning +to prepare for rejoicing in their own way with games of all sorts and +with feasting in the open. I saw, as we rode down the street, the piles +of firewood that were to roast oxen whole, and near them were the butts +that held ale for all comers. There were men who set up the marks for +the archers, and others who staked out the rings for the wrestling and +sword play. And as we left the town we met two men who led a great +brown bear by a ring in his nose, for the baiting. I was sorry for the +poor beast, but the men called him “Hodulf,” already, and I thought +that a good sign in its way. + +Another good sign, and that one which could not be mistaken, was to see +the warriors coming in by twos and threes as the news reached them. +They were dotted along the roads from all quarters, and across the +heaths we saw the flash of the arms of more. + +And ever as they met us they hailed us with, “What cheer, comrades? Is +the news true? Is Havelok come to his own?” and the like, and they +would hurry on, rejoicing in the answer that they had. + +But I will say that presently, when we passed a stretch of wild moor +where we saw no man, the same was going on towards the town of Hodulf; +for if the news came to a village, some would be for the king that was, +and other and older men for the king that might be. Yet all asked that +question; and more than once, when they heard the reply, there would be +a halt and a talk, and then the men would turn and cast in their lot +with the son of Gunnar, hastening to him with more eager steps than had +taken them to Hodulf. + + + + +CHAPTER XXI. +THE TOKEN OF SACK AND ANCHOR. + + +It seemed only the other day that I had passed over the well-known +ways, and I showed Withelm the hollow where Grim had met with the king +and taken his precious burden from him. Then we passed along the wild +shore, and the linnets were singing and the whinchats were calling as +ever, and the old mounds of the heroes of the bygone were awesome to me +now as long ago, when I looked at them standing lonesome along the +shore with only the wash of the waves to disturb them. And so we came +to the town at high noon, and already there was the bustle of a +gathering host in the place, for the news had fled before us. + +They had built a new and greater hall in place of that which had been +burned; and there sat Hodulf with his chiefs, wondering and planning, +and maybe waiting for more certain news of what had happened. Not long +would they wait for that now. + +We rode to the door, and one came to meet us with words of welcome, +thinking that we were men who came to the levy that was gathering; but +his words stayed when I asked to be taken to the presence of Hodulf, as +I came with a message from Havelok Gunnarsson the king. + +The man, chamberlain or steward, or whatever he was, stared at me, and +said in a low voice, “It is true then?” + +“True as I am Radbard Grimsson, who helped Havelok to fly from hence.” + +“Unwelcome will you be, for Hodulf is in no good mood,” the man said. +“I hardly think it safe for you to trust yourself with him.” + +“Then,” said I, “open the door of the hall, and I will go in with my +men, and see what he says.” + +“Well, that will be bad for me, but I have a mind to see Havelok.” + +So I told Withelm to come at my side, and bade half the courtmen follow +us closely, and when they were inside to see that the door was not +barred after us on any pretence. The rest would bide with the horses +outside. + +Then we loosed the peace strings of our weapons, and in we went, +quietly and in order; and the chiefs turned to look at us, thinking us +more of themselves. Hodulf sat on his place on the dais, and there were +thirty-one others with him, sitting on the benches that were set along +the walls. Withelm counted them. + +Then the door was closed, and the man with whom I had spoken set his +back against it, but it was not barred; and I went forward to the steps +of the high place, and stood before Hodulf. + +“Well, what now?” he said, seeing that I was a stranger. + +“First of all, I ask for safe conduct from this hall as a messenger +from king to king.” + +“That you have, of course,” he answered. “What is your message?” + +It did not seem that he thought of Havelok at all, but rather that I +came from some king to whom he had sent. There were two living not so +far off. I thought that there was no good in beating about the bush, +for such an errand as mine had better he told boldly. So I spoke out +for all to hear. + +“This is the word of Havelok, son of Gunnar the king, to Hodulf of +Norway, who sits in his place. Home he has come to take his own, and +now he would tell you that the time has come that he is able to rule +the kingdom for himself.” + +“And what if he has?” said Hodulf, without the least change of face, as +if he had been expecting this, and nothing more or less. + +But if he was quiet, the chiefs had heard my words in a very different +way. Some had leaped up, and others bent forward, to hear the answer to +my words the better. I heard one or two laugh; but there were some on +whose faces seemed to be written doubt and anxiety. I think that some +would have spoken, for Hodulf held up his hand for silence, and looked +to me for answer. + +“It will be well for you to give up the throne to him, making such +terms as you may,” I said. + +“That is a fair offer,” said Hodulf, quite unmoved, to all seeming, but +looking at me in a way that told me how his anger was held back by main +force, as it were; “but how am I to know that this one who sends so +bold a message is the real Havelok? I am not a fool that I should give +up my throne to the first who asks it. Doubtless you bring some token +that you come from the very son of Gunnar.” + +“It is right that you should ask one, and also that you should have one +that there can be no mistaking,” I said. “This is it. By the token of +the sack and the anchor I bid you know that Havelok sends me to you.” + +At that the face of Hodulf became ashy grey beneath the tan of wind and +sea, and I saw that his hand clutched the hilt of his sword so that the +knuckles of his fingers grew white. He had never thought to hear of +that deed again, and he knew that he had to deal with the one whom he +had thought dead. Some of the young chiefs in the hall laughed at that +token, but he flashed a glance at them which stayed the laugh on their +lips. + +“I know not what you mean,” he said, altogether staggered. + +“It is right,” I said, “that if the token is not plain I should make it +so. It is but fair also to the chiefs who are here.” + +Then he stayed me. True it is that old sin makes new shame. + +“I will take it as enough,” he said hastily. “I mind some old saying of +the kind. Ay, that is it—a hidden king and a voyage across the sea. It +is enough.” + +“Not enough,” said a chief in the hall close to the high seat. “Let +this warrior say what he means plainly.” + +There were many who agreed to this, and I did not wait for Hodulf any +longer. I told them who I was, and then showed them why that token was +to be held enough for any man; and as I spoke, there were black looks +toward the high seat among the older men. As for Hodulf, he sat with a +forced smile, and seemed to listen indulgently, as to a well-made tale. + +And after that the matter was out of my hands, for the same chief who +had asked for the tale came and stood by my side, and he faced Hodulf +and spoke. + +“For twelve years have I served you as king, and now I know that I have +wasted the faith I gave you. What became of the sisters of Havelok? +Answer me that, Hodulf, or I will go and ask their brother concerning +whom you have lied to me.” + +“Go and ask him,” answered Hodulf, biting his lips; “go and hear more +lies. Who can know the son of Gunnar when he sees him?” + +“That is answered out of your own mouth,” said the chief. “Is Sigurd a +fool that he should hail the first man who asks him to do so?” + +And from beside me Withelm answered also, “Maybe it is a pity that +Griffin of Wales was slain last night in trying to kill Havelok. He +knew him, and I have heard that he came here to warn Hodulf that his +time was come.” + +Hodulf’s face grew whiter when he heard that; but it was what he +needed, as some sort of excuse to let loose his passion. + +White and shaking with wrath and fear, he rose up and he cried, +“Murdered is Griffin! Ho, warriors, let not these go forth!” + +Whereon the old chief lifted his voice also, “Ho, Gunnar’s men! Ho, men +who love the old line! To Grim’s son, ahoy!” + +And he drew his sword, snapping the thongs that had bound it to the +sheath, so manfully tugged he at them in his wrath, and there was a +rush of men to us, and another to Hodulf. + +Now I think that we might have slain him there, and after that have +been slain ourselves, for the odds were against us, even though I had +the courtmen; but that was Havelok’s deed to do, for the sake of father +and sisters to be avenged, and so we only cut our way out of the hall +to the door, which my men threw open at once. There were two of +Hodulf’s men hurt only, for the most of them had run to the high place, +and few were between us and our going. So we took five chiefs and their +followers back with us, and that was worth the errand. + +We thought that it would not be long now before Hodulf was on us; but +the days passed, and there was no news of him, and all the while we +grew stronger. I do not know if the same could be said of him, and it +is doubtful if time made much difference to his forces. Those who +followed him were the men who owed all to him, either as men raised to +some sort of power when he first came, or else strangers whom he had +brought in with him. Some of the younger chiefs of the old families +held by him also, for they had known no other, and then there were old +feuds with Gunnar that held back some from us; but these few took part +with neither side. + +So before a week was out we had a matter of six thousand men in and +about the town; and it seemed that, with so good a force, it was as +well to march on Hodulf as to wait for him. And that was good hearing +for us all, for there was not a man who did not long to be up and +doing, though to smite a blow for Havelok should be the last deed that +he might do. + +They made me captain of the courtmen who were Havelok’s own, maybe +because I had served with Alsi, and Withelm was captain of Goldberga’s +own guard. High honour was that for the sons of Grim, for there was not +one in either of these companies but was of high birth; but then we +were Havelok’s brothers, and all seemed well content to serve under us. +I wanted Raven to be in my place, but he said that he was no warrior on +shore. + +“Just now I am Havelok’s watchdog, to be at his heels always. +Presently, if he likes to give me a ship when we sail to England, that +will suit me.” + +So Havelok made him his standard bearer; and as that would keep him at +the king’s side in the thickest fight, he was well pleased. Goldberga +wrought the standard that he bore, with the help of Sigurd’s wife, and +on it was the figure of Grim, sword and shield in hand, but with his +helm at his feet, as showing that he had laid it by; and on either side +of him stood Havelok and his wife, each with a crown above their heads, +as though they waited for the coming time when they should be set there +firmly by the bearing forward of this banner. Havelok bore his axe, +holding out the ring to Goldberga with the other hand, while she had +her sceptre in the left, and stretched the right hand to her husband. +There were runes that told the names of these three, for that is +needful in such work, as it passes the skill of woman to make a good +likeness, nor do I think it would be lucky to do so if it could be +compassed. Wondrous was the banner with gold and bright colours, and it +was hung from a gilded spear, ashen hafted, and long, that it might be +seen afar in battle. + +Now on the day when Havelok set his men in order for the march on +Hodulf word came that he was coming at last. It is likely that he knew +we were on the point of marching, and would choose his own ground on +which to wait for us. So we went to certain battle, as it seemed, and +none were sorry for that. So in the bright sunshine of a cloudless +morning Havelok and Goldberga rode down the line of the men, who would +fight to the death for them, and those two were good to look on. Day +and night Sigurd’s weapon smiths had wrought to make a mail shirt that +should be worthy of a king, and I thought that they had wrought well. +They had set a crown round the helm that they made for him, and Sigurd +had given him a sword that had been his father’s at one time, golden +hilted, and with runes on its blue blade. But Havelok would not part +with the axe that Grim had given him, plain as it was, and that was his +chosen weapon. + +But for once I think that men looked more at her who rode at Havelok’s +side than at him, goodly and kingly as he was in the war gear. For +Goldberga had on a silver coat of chain mail, and a little gold circlet +was round the silver helm that she wore, while at her saddle bow was an +axe, on which were runes written in gold, and a sword light enough for +her hand was in a gem-studded baldric from her shoulder. There was a +chief who had given her these, and it was said that they had first of +all belonged to one who had fought as a shield maiden at the great +battle of Dunheidi, by the side of Hervoer, the sister of the mighty +hero Angantyr. His forefather had won them at that time, and now they +were worn by one who was surely like the Valkyries, for no fairer or +more wondrous to look on in war gear could they be than our English +queen. + +She would have gone even into the battle with Havelok, but that neither +he nor we would suffer. She was to bide here in the town until we came +back in triumph or defeat; and as men looked on her, they grew strong, +that no tears might be for those bright eyes. + +Now I left them before the march began, for I and the courtmen were to +go forward and see where the foe was posted, and so bring word again. +And we went some five miles before we saw the first sign of them. Then +on a rise in the wild heath waited a few horsemen, who watched us for a +little while, and then rode away from us and beyond it. We followed +them, and when we came to where they had been, we saw that they had +fallen back on a company of about the same strength as ours, save that +there were more horsemen. I was the only mounted man of my little +force, and that rather to save my strength than because I liked riding. +I should certainly fight on foot, as would Havelok himself, in the old +way. It is not good to trust to the four feet of a horse when one means +business. + +We bided where we were, waiting to see what these men did, and soon +beyond them grew the long cloud of dust starred with shifting sparks +that told us that the host of Hodulf was on foot and advancing. It +seemed to me that here we had a good place to meet it, for the land +went down in a long slope that was in our favour, and therefore I set a +man on my horse, and sent him back with all speed to Havelok to bid him +hasten. Our host was not so far behind me, and I could see both from +this hill. We had full time to take position here before Hodulf’s army +was in reach. + +Now it seemed that the foemen would see what they could also, and they +began to move toward us. It was plain that we should have a small fight +on our own account directly, for I did not mean to let them take our +place. We moved, therefore, toward them, and at that the half-dozen +horsemen made for us at a trot. Then I saw that their leader was Hodulf +himself. + +We were in a track that led across the hill, and here on the slope it +was worn deep with ages of traffic between the two towns, and on either +side the heather grew thick and high, so that the horsemen could not +get round us. So Hodulf rode forward to where we barred the way, and +told me to stand aside. + +“What next?” I asked. “I may as well bid you go back, for I came here +to stop you.” + +“Come over to me, and leave this half-crowned kinglet of yours. It +shall be worth your while.” + +“Hard up for men must you be, Hodulf,” said one of my courtmen, +laughing. + +At that he made a sign to his followers, for they came on us at the +gallop, with levelled spears. We closed up, and hewed the spear points +off, and then dealt with the horses and men who foundered among us, and +they struggled back, leaving three men and four horses in the roadway. +It was bravely done, too, for there were only eight of them, and they +did us no harm beyond a bruise or two. I wished that we had taken or +slain Hodulf, however, for that might have made things easier in the +end. + +Hodulf got back to his courtmen, and now they came on. At that moment +over the hill behind us rode Havelok and Raven, and saw at once what +was on hand. They had ridden on, but the host was hard after them. + +“Send a man to bid the host halt,” Havelok said to me, “for we can end +the matter here. Now shall I be hand to hand with Hodulf, even as I +would wish.” + +I sent a man back as he bade me, and he stayed the host half a mile +beyond the hill, where they were not seen. Hodulf’s army was yet two +miles away across the heath, and none had gone back to hasten it. + +Now Havelok went forward, holding up his hand in token of parley, and +his enemy rode from his men to meet him. + +“There is much between us, Hodulf,” Havelok said, “and we have been +together along this road before. Yet for the sake of the men who follow +us it may be that we can make peace.” + +“That is for me to say,” answered Hodulf, “for you have invaded my +land, and are the peace breaker.” + +“I might mind you of a blood feud between us two,” said Havelok, “but +that is not the business of the host. For the sake of the land I will +say this. Give up the throne that you have held for me, and you shall +go hence with what treasure you have gathered, taking your Norsemen +with you. There will be no shame in doing that, for I am able now to +hold the land for myself.” + +Hodulf laughed a short laugh. + +“Fine talk that for the son of Grim the thrall, who drowned Havelok for +me! ‘Nidring’ should I be if I gave up to you.” + +“If things must go in that way, we will settle the matter here and now. +Will you that we fight hand to hand while our men look on, or shall we +go back to them and charge? I like the first plan best myself, as I +would avenge my father and sisters, and also that insult of the way in +which we passed this road together twelve years ago.” + +So said Havelok, and his words fell like ice from his lips, and he was +very still as he spoke, though the red flush crept into his cheek and +his brows lowered. + +And Hodulf did not answer at once. He looked at the towering young +warrior before him, and maybe into his mind there crept the thought of +the children whom he had slain, whom this one would avenge. Well he +knew that the true Havelok was speaking with him, though he would not +own it, and branded my father with the name of thrall for the sake of +insult to his foster son. + +At last he said, “We will go back to the men, for you have advantage in +that bulk of yours.” + +“As you will,” answered Havelok. “Twelve years ago that was on your +side.” + +He reined round at once, and touched his horse with the spur without +another glance at his enemy. And then we shouted, and Raven spurred +forward with a great oath, for Hodulf plucked his sword from the +scabbard, and with a new treachery in his heart, rode after our brother +and was almost on him. The shout was just in time, for Havelok turned +in his saddle as the blow was falling. + +Quick as light, he took it on the shaft of the spear he carried, and +turned it, wheeling his horse short round at the same time. Lindsey +training was there in that horsemanship of his. Hodulf’s horse shot +past as the blow failed, and then Raven seemed to be the next man to be +dealt with. + +But Havelok called to him to stand aside, for this was his own fight; +and at that Hodulf had his horse in hand again, and was ready to meet +his foe fairly. + +And now Havelok had cast aside the spear, and taken the axe from the +saddle bow; and these two met, unshielded, for neither had time to +unsling the round buckler from his shoulder. + +It was no long fight, for now Hodulf’s men were coming up, and there +need be no more thought of aught but ending one who was ready to smite +a foul blow before us all shamelessly. Havelok spurred his horse, and +the two met and closed for one moment. Then down went the Norseman with +cleft helm, and the old wrongs were avenged, and there was but one king +in the land. + +Then Hodulf’s men were on Havelok, but not before Raven was at his +back, and over Hodulf there was a struggle in which Havelok was in +peril for a short time before we closed round him. Well fought the +courtmen of the fallen king, and well fought my men, and we bore them +back, fighting every foot of ground, until there were only five of them +left, and these five yielded in all honour, being outnumbered. Yet ours +was a smaller band by half ere there was an end. + +It had not lasted long, and still the host of Hodulf was so far off +that they knew not so much as that there was any fighting. Then we went +to the hilltop, and set the banner there, and our line came on and +halted along the crest. + +One hardly need say what wonder and rejoicing there was when it was +known how Hodulf had met his end, and Sigurd and other chiefs went to +where we had fought, and looked on him. And one took the helm, which +had round it the stolen crown, and gave it to Havelok. + +“Set it on the standard,” he said, “for we may need that it shall be +shown presently. As for Hodulf, bear him aside out of the path of the +host, that we may lay him in mound when all is ended.” + +One cried that he did not deserve honour of any kind, and there were +some who agreed to that openly. I will not say that I was not one of +them, for I had seen the foul play, and heard the insult to Grim, my +father. + +But Havelok answered gravely, “He has been a king, and I have not heard +that he was altogether a bad one. All else was between him and me, and +that is paid for by his death. Think only of the twelve years in which +you have owned him as lord, and then you will know that it is right +that he should be given the last honours. You had no feud as had I.” + +Then they did as he bade them, and that gladly, for the words were +king-like, and of good omen for the days to come. I saw Sigurd and the +older chiefs glance at each other, and it was plain that they were well +pleased. + +Now the host came on, and it was greater than ours; but when there was +no sign of its leader the march wavered, and at last halted altogether. +Whereon some chiefs rode to speak to us, and Havelok met them with his +leaders. He had to speak first, for they could not well ask where +Hodulf was. The helm was a token that told them much. + +“I met your king even now,” he said, “and I offered him peace and +honourable return to Norway with his property if he would give up the +throne that is mine by right. Maybe I was wrong in thinking that he +might do so, but he refused. There were certain matters between us two, +besides that of the crown, which needed settling; and therefore, after +that, I challenged him to fight on these points, that being needful +before they were done with. So we fought, and our feud was ended. +Hodulf is dead, and his courtmen would not live after him while there +was a chance of avenging his fall. That was before the host came up. +Now I offer peace and friendship to all, and I can blame none who have +held to the king who has fallen. It was not to be expected that all +would own me at once. Only those Norsemen who came with Hodulf or have +come hither since must leave the land, and they shall go in honour, +taking their goods with them. Their time is up; that is all.” + +It was a long speech for Havelok, but in it was all that could be said. +Long and closely did the chiefs look at him as he spoke, for none of +them had seen him before. His words were not idly to be set aside +either, and they spoke together in a low voice when he had ended. + +“This is a matter for the whole host to settle,” one said at last. “We +will speak to them, and give you an answer shortly.” + +“Take one of Hodulf’s courtmen with you, that he may tell all of the +fight,” Havelok said: “he need not come back.” + +I gave the man his arms again, for he might as well have them if he +stayed. + +“Thanks, lord,” he said. “Here is one who will tell the truth for +Havelok.” + +Then our host sat down, and we watched the foemen as the news came to +them. We could not hear, of course, for they were a quarter of a mile +away, but if any tumult rose we should be warned in time. They were +very still, however. There was a long talk, and then one chief came +back to us. + +“I am going to ask a strange thing,” he said, “but the men wish to see +Havelok face to face.” + +Now Sigurd said that this was too great a risk, and even Withelm agreed +with him. + +But Havelok answered, “The men are my own men, but they are not sure +that I am the right king. It is plain that I am like my father, and +therefore it is safe for me to go.” + +“That,” said the chief, “is what we told them, and what they wish to +see.” + +“Then,” said Havelok, “I will come. Bid your men sit down, and bid the +horsemen dismount, and I will ride to them with five others. Then can +be no fear on either side.” + +“That will do well,” said Sigurd; and the chief went back, and at once +the host sat down. + +Then Havelok rode to them, and with him went we three and Sigurd and +Biorn. + +There was a murmur of wonder as he came, and it grew louder as he +unhelmed and stayed before them. + +And then one shouted, “Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson!” and at once the +shout was taken up along the line. And that shout grew until the chiefs +joined in it, for it was the voice of the host, which cannot be +gainsaid; and without more delay, one by one the leaders pressed +forward and knelt on one knee to their king, and did homage to him. +Only the Norsemen held back; and presently, when we were talking to the +Danish chiefs in all friendly wise, they drew apart with their men, and +formed up into a close-ranked body that looked dangerous. + +“Surely they do not mean to fight!” said Withelm. + +Then one of them shouted that he must speak to the king, and that +seemed as if they owned him at least, so Havelok went to them. + +“You have heard my terms,” he said, “and I think that they are all that +you could ask. What is amiss?” + +“Your terms are good enough,” the speaker said, “and we know that our +time is come. But we must have surety that the people will not fall on +us, for we are flying, as it were. And we want the body of our king. We +would not have him buried any wise, as if he was a thrall.” + +“He shall be given to you, and as for the rest none shall harm you. +Moreover, for that saying about your king I will add this: that if +there are any of you who hold lands to which there is no Danish heir, +he shall take service with me if he will, and so keep them.” + +So there was no man in all the host who was not content; and that was +the second king-making of Havelok, as it were, for now there was no man +against him. The hosts were disbanded then and there, and we went that +day to Hodulf’s town, and took possession of all that had been in his +hands. Then was rejoicing over all the land, for a king of the old line +was on the throne once more, and his way was full of promise. + + + + +CHAPTER XXII. +KING ALSI’S WELCOME. + + +Now there was one thing that was in the minds of all of us, and that +was the winning of Goldberga’s kingdom for her; but that was a matter +which was not to be thought of yet for a long while. Two years were we +in Denmark, and well loved was Havelok by all, whether one speaks of +the other kings who owned him as Gunnar’s heir at once, or the people +over whom he and Goldberga reigned. But we sent messages to Arngeir and +to Ragnar to say that all was well, and we heard from them in time how +Alsi feared what was to come, and had rather make friends with the +Anglians than offend them. So he had not given out anything that was +against the princess, but had told all how she had wedded the heir of +Denmark, and that she had given up her land to himself, and followed +her husband across the sea. It was not hard for him to feign gladness +in her well-doing; and Berthun counselled Ragnar to let things be thus, +and yet prepare for her return. + +In my own heart was the wish to go back to England always, for there +was my home; and I found that it was the same with my brothers, for +there is that in the English land which makes all who touch it love it. +And there was the mound that held my father, and there were the folk +among whom we had been brought up in the town that we had made; and I +longed to see once more the green marshes and the grey wolds of +Lindsey, and the brown waves of the wide Humber rolling shorewards, +line after line. I tired of the heaths and forests and peat mosses of +this land of my birth. And if that was so to me, it was a yet deeper +longing in the hearts of the brothers who hardly remembered this place; +and after a while we spoke of it more often. + +I do not know if we said much to others, but at last the younger chiefs +began to wonder when the promised time when they should cross the +“swan’s path” for Goldberga should come. Maybe they tired of the long +peace, as a Dane will. But when that talk began, Withelm knew that +things were ripe, and he told Havelok. That was in the third spring of +Havelok’s kingship, when it grew near to the time when men fit out +their ships. + +“This is what I have looked for,” he said; “and now we will delay no +longer, for here am I king indeed, and there is none who will rise +against me. Wonderful it is that men have hailed me thus. And now I +will tell you, brother, that I long for England. If I might take my +friends with me, I do not think that I should care if I never came here +again. It is not my home; and here my Goldberga is not altogether +happy, well as the folk love her.” + +Thereafter he called a great Thing[12] of all the freemen in the land, +and set the matter plainly before them, asking if they minded the words +he spoke when they crowned the queen, and if they were still ready to +follow him to the winning of her crown beyond the sea. + +There was no doubt what the answer would be; and it was said at once +that the sooner the ships were got ready the better. + +“Then,” said Havelok, “who shall mind this land while I am away? It may +be long ere I come back.” + +Now there was a cry that I should be king while Havelok was away, +forsooth! and a poor hand I should have made at the business. But I +said that it was foolishness, and that, moreover, I would go with +Havelok. And when they said that this was modesty on my part, I +answered that I had seen several kings, and that there was but one who +was worth thinking of, and that was my brother; therefore, I would go +on serving him where I could see him. + +“This is what Grim, my father, said to me long ago,” I said—“I was to +mind the old saying, ‘Bare is back without brother behind it;’ and, +therefore, I must see Havelok safe through this.” + +“Why, brother,” says Havelok, laughing, “if that saying must be +remembered—and I at least know it is true—it would make for leaving you +behind me here to see all fair when my back was turned.” + +Then he saw that I was grieved, for I thought for the moment that he +would bid me to stay, and so I should have to do so; but he took my +part. + +“I cannot be without my brothers,” he said. “If I had any word in the +matter—which mainly concerns the folk to be ruled, as it seems to me +(for I do not know of any man who would not uphold me)—I should say +that Sigurd the jarl was the right man, for all know that he is a good +ruler, nor will it be any new thing to submit to him.” + +That pleased all, and the end of it was that Sigurd was chosen to hold +the land for Havelok. + +Then Sigurd sat on the steps of the high place at Havelok’s feet, and +the king said, “I have no need to tell any man here who this is, and +why I think him worthy of the highest honour, for all know him and his +worth as well as I. Mainly by him was the thought of my return kept in +the minds of men, so that when the time came all were ready to hail me, +as you have done. Therefore, as by him I am king, so I make him king +also for me. He shall rule all the land while I am away, and to him +shall all men account as to me. And because it is right that his +kingship should be certain, I give him all his jarldom as a kingdom +from henceforth, only subject to me and my heirs as overlord. King +therefore he is, and none can say that you are ruled by naught but a +jarl.” + +Then Havelok girt on the new king’s sword, and set his own crowned helm +on his head for a moment; and all the Thing hailed him gladly, for he +was the right man without doubt. + +Then Sigurd did homage for his new honour; and after that he rose up, +and grew red and uneasy, as if there was somewhat that he wished to +say, and was half afraid to do so. + +Thereat some friend in the hall said, “You take your kingship worse +than did Radbard himself, as it seems. What is amiss?” + +“Why, I wanted to go on the Viking path with Havelok, and now it seems +that I cannot.” + +Then one shouted, “I never heard of a land going wrong while its king +was away risking his life to get property for his men. There is no man +here who is going to rise against either you or Havelok. And it is only +to send a message to our great overlord to say what we are about, and +he will see that the land is in peace. Nor do I think that any king +would harry Havelok’s land, for he is well loved by all his peers.” + +Wherefore it seemed that Sigurd must go also, and we had to set Biorn +as head man while Sigurd was away; but that would only be for a month +or two. So all things were ordered well, and in a month we set sail +with twenty ships, and in them a matter of fifteen hundred men. + +At first we thought that we would make for Grimsby; but then it seemed +best to land elsewhere, and more to the south, for we would have +messages sent at once to Ragnar to call East Anglia to Havelok’s +banner, and Alsi would have less chance of cutting us off from him. So +we sailed to Saltfleet haven, which lies some twenty-five miles +southward from Grimsby. Raven piloted us in safely, and there were none +to hinder our landing. The town was empty, indeed, when the ships came +into the haven, for all had fled in haste, except a few thralls, for +fear of the Vikings. + +Yet when we sent these thralls to say that Goldberga had come for her +own, the people came back and made us welcome, for her story was in +every mouth; and after that we fared well in Saltfleet, and men began +to gather to us. + +We sent to Arngeir and to Ragnar at once, and next day the Grimsby folk +were with us, but long before any word could come to Norwich, Alsi had +set about gathering a host against us. + +But we had not come to fight him for Lindsey, and our errand was to bid +him give up her own rights to Goldberga. One must be ready with the +strong hand if one expects to find justice from such a man; and Havelok +had thought it possible that if we came here first we should bring him +to reason at once, whereas if we went to Norfolk there would be +fighting with all the host of the Lindsey kingdom before long; while if +he did fight here we might save Goldberga’s land from that trouble, and +maybe have fewer to deal with. + +So a message was to be sent to Alsi at once, bidding him know that +Goldberga had come to ask for her rights, and that he might give them +to her in all honour. Arngeir was to take this, for it did not seem +right that a Dane should do so, and he was one who would be listened +to. I was to go with him, with my courtmen as guard; and we rode to +Lincoln on the fourth day after our coming to Saltfleet. Good it was to +ride over the old land again, and I thought that it had never looked +more fair with the ripening harvest, for when last I had seen it there +was none. The track of the famine was yet on all the villages, for +fewer folk were in them than in the days before the pestilence and the +dearth, but these had enough and to spare. + +And when these poor folk heard from us that Curan and his princess had +come again for what was hers, they took rusty weapons and flint-tipped +arrows and stone hammers from the hiding places in the thatch of their +hovels, and went across the marshlands to where the little hill of +Saltfleet stands above its haven, that they might help the one whom +they had loved as a fisher lad to become a mighty king. + +So we came to Lincoln, and already there was a gathering of thanes and +their men in the town, and they knew on what errand we had come well +enough. But they were courteous, and we were given quarters in the town +at once, that we might see Alsi with the first light in the morning. + +I will not say that we had a quiet night there, for we did not trust +Alsi; but we had no need to fear. In the morning Eglaf came to bid us +to the palace to speak with the king. + +“This is about what I expected, when I heard of the mistake that our +king had made,” he said, “and so far you are in luck. It is not +everyone who is a fisher one day and captain of the courtmen next, as +one might say. I like the look of your men, and I am going to take some +of the credit of that to myself, for a man has to learn before he can +command.” + +“I will not deny your share in the matter,” I answered, laughing, “for +had it not been for my time with you I had been at sea altogether. Now, +shall we have to fight you?” + +He shrugged his broad shoulders. + +“Who knows what is in the mind of our king? I do not, and you know +enough of him by this time to be certain that one cannot guess. He may +be all smiles and rejoicing that his dear niece has come back safely, +or just the other way. He has been very careful how he has dealt with +the Norfolk thanes of late, and what that means I do not know.” + +Then he asked what had become of Griffin, and I told him. I do not +think that he was surprised, for some word of the matter had reached +here by the news that chapmen bring from all parts. + +Now there was no more time for talk, for we came to the hall; and we +went in, Arngeir leading, and the rest of us following two by two. The +hall was pretty full of thanes and their men, and it was just as I had +last seen it. Alsi sat alone on his high seat, and there was no man +with him on the dais. I thought that he looked thinner and anxious. + +Arngeir went up the hall at once, and stood before the king, and +greeted him in the English way, which seemed strange to me after the +two years of Danish customs; and then Alsi bade him tell his errand. + +“I have come from Goldberga of East Anglia, and from Havelok the Dane, +her husband, to say that she has returned to her land, and would ask +that you would give her the throne that you have held for her since the +day that her father made you her guardian. It has been said that she +might ask you to give account of your management of the realm to her; +but that she does not wish to do, being sure that all will be rightly +done in the matter, and she only asks to be set in the place that was +her father’s.” + +So said Arngeir, plainly, and I could see that the thanes thought the +words good. + +And Alsi answered, “Has this matter been put before the Witan of the +East Angles?” + +I suppose that he thought to hear Arngeir say that there had been no +time for so doing at present, but my brother was readier than I should +have been. + +“Doubtless it has,” he said, “for that was your own promise to +Goldberga on her marriage.” + +At that Alsi flushed, and his brows wrinkled. He had said nothing to +the Witan at all, but had waited in hopes that he should hear no more +of his niece, telling the tale that we had heard. + +“I have had no answer from them,” he said at last, for Arngeir was +looking at him in a way that he could not meet. “It was her saying that +she would do this for herself.” + +“Then they do not refuse,” said Arngeir quietly, “nor did I think that +they would do so. It only remains therefore, that you, King Alsi, +should do your part. Then can the queen speak to the Witan, even as she +said, concerning her husband.” + +Now it must have been clear to the king that nothing short of a plain +answer would be taken, and he sat and thought for a while. One could +see that he was planning what to say, as if things had not gone as he +expected. Maybe he hoped to put off the matter by talk of asking the +Witan, and so to gain time, for we had certainly taken him unawares. + +At last he said, “How am I to know that you are here with full power to +speak for Goldberga? For this is a weighty matter.” + +Arngeir held out his hand, and on it was the ring of Orwenna the queen, +which Alsi had last seen here on the high place. + +“There is the token, King Alsi, and it is one which you know well,” he +answered. + +“Ay, I know it,” answered the king with a grin that was not pleasant. + +And then he said, “I will speak with my thanes, and give you word to +carry back in an hour’s time, now that I know you to be a true +messenger.” + +“There should be no reason for waiting so long as that, nor do I think +that the matter of the throne of East Anglia is a question for Lindsey +thanes,” answered Arngeir at once. “All this is between you and the +princess.” + +Thereat one of the thanes rose up and said, “If a kingdom has been +handed over to our king, it is not to be taken again without our having +a good deal to say about it. I do not know, moreover, if we can have a +foreigner over any part of our land.” + +“Goldberga never gave up her right to the kingdom,” Arngeir answered, +“as anyone who was here at the wedding would tell you. And as for +Havelok, her husband, being a foreigner, it seems to me that a Jute who +has been brought up here in Lindsey since he was seven winters old is +less a foreigner than a Briton is to us.” + +None made any answer to that, and I could see that the king was growing +angry at being met thus at every turn. But he began to smile in that +way of his that I had learned to mistrust. + +“That is not altogether courteous to either Goldberga or myself,” he +said, as if he would think the words a jest, seeing that he was half +Welsh. “Give me time, I pray you, to think of this, as I have asked, +and you shall go back with your answer.” + +There was no help for it, and we had to leave the hall in order that +Alsi might say what he had to say to his thanes. And I said to Arngeir +that it seemed that we should have to fight the matter out. + +“Alsi risks losing both kingdoms if he does that,” he answered, “for we +shall take what we choose if we are the victors. The visions that have +been thus right so far say that we shall be so.” + +“I shall be glad if we do come out on the right side,” I said; “but I +have not so much faith in these dream tellings as some. Nor do I think +that it seems altogether fair to fight on a certainty.” + +“When it is a matter of punishing one who does not keep faith, I do not +think that it matters much,” he answered, laughing. “I should like +certainty that he would not get the best of the honest side in that +case.” + +We were outside on the wide green within the square of the Roman walls +at this time, and now from within the hall came the sound of shouts and +cheering which we heard plainly enough. But whether it meant that the +thanes cheered Alsi because he would fight, rather than that they +applauded his justice to his niece, was not to be known as yet. As for +me, I thought that it was hardly likely to be the latter. + +Then came three thanes from the hail with the message, and it was this, +“Alsi bids Havelok go back to his own land and bide content therewith.” + +“What word is there for Goldberga, then?” asked Arngeir. + +“None. She has thrown in her lot with the Dane, and it is he with whom +we will not deal.” + +Then said I, “How was it that she had to throw in her lot with Havelok? +He was Alsi’s own choice for her.” + +“That is not what we have heard,” the spokesman answered. “Now it is +best that you go hence, for you have the answer.” + +“This means fighting for Goldberga’s rights,” said Arngeir, “and I will +tell you that Havelok will not be backward in the matter.” + +“In that case we shall meet again on the battlefield ere long,” +answered the thane. “I will not say that Havelok is in the wrong, and +things might have been better settled. Farewell till then. The Norns +will show who is right.” + +So we went, and I thought, as did Arngeir, that there was some little +feeling among his men that Alsi was wrong. + +Now Alsi set to work to gather forces in earnest, and he went to work +in a way that was all his own: for, saying nothing about Goldberga, he +sent to all his thanes with word that the Vikings had come in force and +invaded the land, led by the son of Gunnar Kirkeban, whose ways were +worse than those of his father, for he spared none, whereas Kirkeban +harried but the Welsh Christian folk. He prayed them therefore to +hasten, that this scourge might be driven back to the sea whence he +came. And that brought men to him fast, for no Englishman can bear that +an invader shall set foot on his shore, be he who he may. Few knew who +the wife of Havelok was at that time, but I do not know that it would +have made so much difference if they had. None thought that into +England had come the fair princess who was so well loved. + +Sorely troubled was Goldberga when she heard this answer, but it was +all that the rest of us looked for. And the next question was how best +to meet the false king. + +In the end we did a thing that may seem to some to have been rash +altogether, but it was our wish to compel Alsi to fight before his +force was great enough to crush us. It might be long before Ragnar +could raise a host and join us, for there was always a chance that he +might have trouble in getting the Norfolk thanes to come to his +standard for a march on Lindsey. If we had gone to Norfolk at once +there would have been no fear of that kind, but the fighting might have +been more bitter and longer drawn out. + +We sent the fleet southward into the Wash, that it might wait for us at +the port of the Fossdyke, on what men call the Frieston shore; and then +we left Saltfleet and marched across country to the wolds, and +southward and westward along them, that we might draw Alsi from +Lincoln. And all the way men joined us for the sake of Curan, whom they +knew, and of Goldberga, of whom they had heard, so that in numbers at +least our host was a great one. Ragged it might be, as one may say, +with the wild marshmen, who had no sort of training and no chiefs to +keep them in hand; but I knew that no host Alsi could get together had +any such trained force in it as we had in the fifteen hundred Vikings, +for they had seen many fights, and the ways of the sea teach men to +hold together and to obey orders at once and without hesitating. + +So we went until we came to Tetford, above Horncastle town; and there +is a great camp on a hilltop, made by the British, no doubt, in the +days when they fought with Rome. There we stayed, for Alsi was upon us. +We saw the fires of his camp in the village and on the hillsides across +the valley, but a mile or two from us that night; and it seemed that +his host was greater than ours, as we thought it would be, but not so +much so as to cause dread of the battle that was to come. + +Now there were two men who came to us that night, and we thought that +they had brought some message from Alsi at first. But all that they +wanted was to join Havelok, and we were glad of them. They were those +two seconds of Griffin’s, Cadwal and the other, whose name was Idrys, +and with them was David the priest, who had fled to us. + +“We know that Havelok is one who is worth fighting for,” they said, +“for we have proved it already. We are not Alsi’s men, and our fathers +fought for his mother’s Welsh kin against the English long ago. Let us +fight for the rights of Goldberga, at least.” + +Havelok welcomed them in all friendliness, though he asked them if they +had no grudge against him for the slaying of Griffin. + +“As to that,” they said, “after the duel we think that he deserved all +that has befallen him. We were ashamed to be his seconds.” + +Now these two took in hand to lead the marshmen, and set to work with +them at once, for they were ready to follow them as known thanes of the +British. And that was something gained. + +We slept on our arms that night, and all night long David woke and +prayed for our success, and I think that his prayers were not lost. + + + + +CHAPTER XXIII. +BY TETFORD STREAM. + + +In the early morning Alsi set his men in order in the valley, and +seemed to wait for us to come down to him, for it was of no use to try +to take the strong camp which sheltered us. And so, after council held, +we did not keep him waiting, but left the hill and marched on him. We +had the camp to fall back on if things went the wrong way, and beyond +that the road to the sea and the ships was open, with a chance of +meeting Ragnar on the way, moreover. + +Very long and deep seemed the line as we neared it, and it was formed +on the banks of a stream that runs down the valley, so that we must +cross the water to attack. But the stream was shallow now with the +August heat, and it was not much sunk between its banks. + +When he saw that, Sigurd, who was a man of many fights, said that we +had better send the marshmen round to fall on the wings of the foe, +while we went straight for the centre of the line in the wedge +formation that the Viking loves. For so we should have no trouble in +crossing the stream, and should cut the force against us in two. + +So the two Welsh thanes led their wild levies out on either side of us +Danes, who were in the centre, and then we formed the wedge. Havelok +himself would have gone first of all at its point: but that we would +not suffer, for if he fell the battle was lost at its beginning. + +“Nay,” he said, “for we fight for Goldberga.” + +“And what would she say were we to set you foremost of us all?” asked +Withelm. “Little love were there to either of you in that. You are the +heart of the host, and one shields that although it gives strength to +all the hands which obey it.” + +So Withelm and Arngeir and I went foremost, and behind us came the +courtmen, and in the midst of their shield wall was Havelok, with Raven +and the banner at his side. After them, rank on rank and with +close-locked shields, was such a force as had not been seen in Lindsey +for many a long day. Alsi’s men grew very silent as they saw us come +on, until we reached, through a storm of arrows that could not stay us, +the bank of the stream, and then they raised a war song that roared and +thundered among the hills as though the tide was coming up the valley +in one great wave. But we saved our breath until the first of us were +on the banks of the stream, and then I shouted, and with a great shout +of “Ahoy!” in answer, we charged through the stream and up the far +bank, where Alsi’s spearmen waited for us. + +They crowded together as they saw how narrow our front was, and there +was a hedge of steel before us three brothers; but the spear is not the +weapon to use if one would check the onrush of the Northman’s wedge, +and shield and axe between them dashed and hewed a way to the men who +got to their swords too late, and then we were in the midst of Alsi’s +line, with the gap that we had made widening behind us with each step +that we took forward. + +Now it was sheer hewing at the mass who crowded on us; and I mind how +we seemed to fight in silence, although the battle cries were +unceasing, and waxed ever louder; for it was as when one walks by the +shore and thinks not at all of the noise of breakers that never ends. +Now and then there was one shout that was new, and it seemed to be the +only voice. Most of all, the noise grew on the wings where the savage +Welsh fell on their masters and ancient foes in wild tumult. + +We tried to cut our way to Alsi, for we could see him as he sat on his +horse—the only mounted man in all the hosts; but we could not reach +him. And presently the time came when we who were foremost must let +fresh men take our places. Sigurd stepped to my side, and Withelm fell +back, and another took the place of Arngeir, and then my turn came, and +we went slowly from the front to where the hollow centre of the wedge +gave us rest. Only a few arrows fell there now and then; but the time +for using bows was past, seeing that we were hand to hand with all the +Lindsey host. And then I saw that Sigurd had done what we had failed +in, for he had reached the shield wall that was round the king himself. +And for a moment I was savage that the chance came to him so soon after +I had left the fighting line; but then I minded that Eglaf, my friend, +would be there, and I was glad that I need not cross swords with him +after all. I had thought of that happening before the fight began, but +in the turmoil of hottest struggle I had forgotten it. + +Now Sigurd was before the thick mass of the housecarls, and hand to +hand with them; and then he was among them, and he leapt at the bridle +of Alsi’s horse and grasped it. I saw the king’s sword flash down on +his helm, and he reeled under the stroke, but without letting go of the +rein. Then the housecarls made a rush, and bore back our men, and the +horse reared suddenly. There was a wild shout, and the war saddle was +empty; and again our men surged forward, so that I could not see what +had happened. + +But now our Welshmen had been beaten back from the wings—not easily, +but for want of training—and they were forced back across the brook, +and there held our bank well, giving way no step further. The water +kept them in an even front, against their will, as it were; and Alsi’s +men charged them in vain, knee deep in the stream that ran red. But +that let loose the men who had been held back from us; and now we were +overborne by numbers, and we began to go back. That was the worst part +of the whole fight, and the hardest hour of all the battle, as may be +supposed, for the wedge grew closer, as it was forced together by sheer +weight. None ever broke into it. + +Presently our rear was on the water’s edge, and it seemed likely that +in crossing there might be a breaking of the line; and when he saw +that, Havelok called to me, and he went to the front with the courtmen +round him. It was good to hear the cheers of our men as they saw the +dancing banner above the fight, and beneath it, in the bright sun, the +gold-circled helm of their king. The Lindseymen drew back a foot’s pace +as they saw the giant who came on them, and I heard some call that this +was Curan of Grimsby, as if in wonder. Then we had to fight hard, and +Sigurd fell back past me, with a wound on his shoulder where Alsi’s +sword had glanced from the helm. No life had been left to Sigurd had a +better hand wielded the weapon; but he was not badly hurt. I could not +see Alsi anywhere, nor Eglaf. + +Steadily the numbers drove us back, though before Havelok was always a +space into which men hardly dared to come. The wedge was pushed away +from us, and we had to fall back with it, until we crossed the stream; +and there Sigurd swung the massed men into line, and then came the +first pause in the fight. The two hosts stood, with the narrow water +between them, and glared on each other, silent now. And then the bowmen +began to get to work from either side, until the arrows were all gone. + +Now Havelok called to the foe, and they were silent while he spoke to +them. + +“Is Alsi yet alive?” he said; “for if not, I have no war with his men. +If he is, let me speak with him.” + +None answered for a while, and the men looked at each other as if they +knew not if the man they were fighting for lived or not. + +Then one came forward and said, “Alsi lives, and we have not done with +you yet. Get you back to your home beyond the sea!” + +And then they charged us again; but the water was a better front for us +than it had been for them, and across it they could not win. We drove +them back once and twice; and again came a time when both sides were +wearied and must needs rest. + +So it went on until night fell. We never stirred from that water’s +edge, and the stream was choked with valiant English and hardy Danes; +and yet the attacks came with the shout of “Out! out!” and the answer +from us of “Havelok, ahoy!” + +At last one who seemed a great chief came and cried a truce, for night +was falling; and he said that if Havelok would claim no advantage +therefrom, the men of Lindsey would get back from the field, and leave +it free for us to take our fallen. + +“But I must have your word that with the end of that task you go back +to the place you now hold, that we may begin afresh, if it seems good +to us, in the morning.” + +Then said Havelok, “That is well spoken, and I cannot but agree. Who +are you, however, for I must know that this is said with authority?” + +“I am the Earl of Chester,” he answered. “Alsi has set the leading of +the host in my hands, for he is hurt somewhat.” + +“I did not think that Mercians would have troubled to fight to uphold +Alsi of Lindsey in his ways with his niece,” Havelok said. + +“What is that?” said the earl. “Hither came I for love of fighting, +maybe, in the first place; and next to drive out certain Vikings. I +know naught of the business of which you speak.” + +“Then,” said I, “go and ask Eglaf, the captain of the housecarls, for +he knows all about it. We are no raiding Danes, but those who fight for +Goldberga of East Anglia.” + +At that a hum of voices went down the English line, and this earl bit +his lip in doubt. + +“Well,” he said, “that is Alsi’s affair, and I will speak to him. We +have had a good fight, and I will not say that either of us has the +best of it. Shall it be as I have said?” + +“Ay,” answered Havelok; and the earl drew off his men for half a mile, +and in the gathering dusk we crossed the brook, and went on our errand +across the field. It was not hard to find our men, for they lay in a +great wedge as we had fought. There had been no straggling from that +array, and no break had been made in its lines. Alsi had lost more than +we, for his men had beaten against that steel wall in vain, and the +arms of the Northman are better than those of any other nation. + +We took the wounded back to the camp, and there Goldberga and the wives +of our English thanes tended them; and as we gathered up the slain the +Lindsey men were among us at the same work, and we spoke to them as if +naught was amiss between us, nor any fight to begin again in the +morning. And then we learned how few knew what we had come for. It was +with them as with the Earl of Chester. They had no knowledge of +Goldberga’s homecoming, and least of all thought that at the back of +the trouble were the wiles of Alsi. It was two years ago that Goldberga +had gone, and her wedding had seemed to end her story. Now the men +heard and wondered; and it is said that very many left Alsi that night +and went home, angry with him for his falsehood. + +Now when all was done we sought rest, and weary we were. I will say for +myself that I did not feel like fighting next morning at all, for I was +tired out, and the one or two wounds that I had were getting sorely +stiff. Raven was much in the same case, and grumbled, sailor-wise, at +the weight of the banner and aught else that came uppermost in his +mind. Yet I knew that he would be the first to go forward again when +the time came. + +The host slept on their arms along the bank of the stream through the +hot night, and the banner was pitched in their midst. Soon the moon +rose, and only the footsteps of the sentries along our front went up +and down, while across the water was the same silence; for both hosts +were wearied out, and each had learned that the other were true men, +and there was no mistrust on either side. When the light came once more +we should fight to prove who were the best men at arms, and with no +hatred between us. + +Presently the mists crept up from the stream and wreathed the sleepers +on either bank with white, swaying clouds, and I mind that the last +thought I had before I closed my eyes was that my armour would be +rusted by the clinging damp—as if it were not war-stained from helm to +deerskin shoe already with stains that needed more cleansing than any +rust. + +Then I waked suddenly, for someone went past me, and I sat up to see +who it might be. The moon was very bright and high now, but the figure +that I saw wading in the white mist was shadowy, and I could not tell +who it was. And then another and yet another figure came from the rear +of our line, and passed among the sleeping ranks, and joined the first +noiselessly; and after a little while many came, hurrying, and they +formed up on the bank of the stream into the mighty wedge. And I feared +greatly, for not one of the sleepers stirred as the warriors went among +us, and I had looked on the faces of those who passed me, and I knew +that they were the dead whom I had seen the men gather even now and lay +in their last rank beyond our line. + +Then I saw that on the far bank was gathered another host, and that was +of Alsi’s men, and among them I knew the forms of some who had fallen +in the first onset when I led the charge. + +I tried to put forth my hand to wake Withelm, but I could not stir, and +when I would have spoken, I could frame no word, so that alone in all +the host I saw the slain men fight their battle over again, step by +step. The wedge of the Northmen won to the far shore as we had won—as +they had won in life but a few hours ago—and into the line of foemen +they cut their way, and on the far side of the stream they stayed and +fought, as it had been in the battle. Yet though one could see that the +men shouted and cried, there was no sound at all, and among the wildest +turmoil walked the sentries of Alsi’s host unconcerned and unknowing. +And to me they seemed to be the ghosts, and the phantom strife that +which was real. + +Then I was ware of a stranger thing yet than all I had seen so far, for +on the field were more than those whom I knew. There stood watching on +either side of the battle two other ghostly hosts, taking no part in +the struggle, but watching it as we had watched from our place when we +fell back into the rear to rest, pointing and seeming to cheer strokes +that were good and deeds that were valiant. And I knew that these were +men who had fought and died on this same field in older days, for on +one side were the white-clad Britons, and on the other the stern, +dark-faced Romans, steel and bronze from head to foot. + +So the battle went onward to where we had won and had been pressed +back; and then, little by little, the hosts faded away, and with them +went the watchers, and surely across the field went the quick gallop of +no earthly steeds, the passing to Odin of the choosers of the slain, +the Valkyries. + +Then came across the brook to me one through the mist, and the sentries +paid no heed to him, and he came to my side and spoke to me. It was +Cadwal, the Welsh thane, and his breast was gashed so that I thought +that he could not have lived. + +“Ay, I am dead,” he said, “as men count death, and yet I would have +part in victory over Alsi, for the sake of Havelok and of Goldberga. +Stay up my body on the morrow, that I may seem to fight at least, that +I may bide in the ranks once more in the day of victory. Little victory +have the British seen since Hengist came. Say that you will do this.” + +Then he looked wistfully at me, and I gave him some token of assent; +and at that came back all the shadows of our men, and seemed to pray +the same. And then was a stir of feet near me, and a shadow across the +trampled grass, and instead of the dead the voice of Havelok spoke +softly to me, and with him was Goldberga, clad in her mail. And I +thought that they and I were slain also, and I cried to this one who +seemed to be one of Odin’s maidens that I too would fain be stayed up +with Cadwal and the rest, that I might have part in victory. + +Then Goldberga stooped to me, and laid her soft hand on my forehead, +and took off my helm, so that the air came to me, and thereat I woke +altogether. + +“Brother,” she said, “you are restless and sorely wounded, as it seems. +It is not good that you should lie in this mist.” + +At her voice the others woke, and for a while she talked with us in a +low tone, cheering us. And presently she asked of that strange request +that I had made to her. + +I told her, for it was a message that should not be kept back, thus +given; and when he heard it, Withelm sighed a little, and said, “Would +that we had all those who have fallen. Yet if it is as they have asked +our brother, our host will seem as strong as before we joined battle in +the morning. Leave this to me, brother, for it may be done.” + +Then he rose up and went softly to where Idrys, the friend of Cadwal, +lay, and spoke long with him. It was true that Cadwal was slain, though +I had not yet heard of it until he told me himself thus. + +Then I slept heavily, while the others talked for a while. It is a hard +place at a wedge tip when Englishmen are against one; and I am not much +use in a council. Presently they would wake me if my word was wanted. + +But it was not needed, for the sunlight woke me. There was a growing +stir in our lines and across the water also, and I looked round. The +mists were yet dense, for there was not enough breeze to stir the heavy +folds of the banner, and Raven slept still with his arm round its +staff. Havelok was not here now, and I thought that he had gone to the +camp with Goldberga, and would be back shortly. + +Then I saw that our rear rank was already formed up, as I thought, and +that is not quite the order of things, as a rule, and it seemed far off +from the stream. I thought that they should have asked me about this, +for there were some of my courtmen in that line. + +And then I saw that in the line was no movement, and no flash of arms, +as when one man speaks to another, turning a little. And before that +line stood the form of a chief who leant on his broad spear, motionless +and seeming watchful. I knew him at once, and it was Cadwal, and those +he commanded were the dead. That was even to me an awesome sight, for +in the mists they seemed ready and waiting for the word that would +never come to their ears, resting on the spears that they could use no +more. It had been done by the marshmen in the dark hours of the +morning, and from across the stream I saw Alsi’s men staring at the new +force that they thought had come to help us. There were men enough +moving along our bank with food to us to prevent them seeing that this +line stirred not at all. + +There was a scald who came with us from Denmark, and now with the full +rising of the sun he took his harp and went along the stream bank +singing the song of Dunheidi fight and so sweet was his voice, and so +strong, that even Alsi’s men gathered to hearken to him. His name was +Heidrek, and he has set all that he saw with Havelok into a saga; but +we, here, mostly remember the brave waking that he gave us that +morning. It was wonderful how the bright song cheered us. One saw that +the stiffened limbs shook themselves into litheness once more, and the +listless faces brightened, and into the hearts that were heavy came new +hope, and that was the song’s work. + +Now men began to jest with their foes across the stream, and those who +had Danish loaves threw them across in exchange for English, that they +might have somewhat to talk of. Ours were rye, and theirs of barley; +but it was not a fair change after ours had been so long a voyage. + +It was not long before our war horns sounded for the mustering, and men +ran to their arms. The Lindsey host drew back from the talk with our +men at the same time, and, without waiting for word from their leaders, +began to get in line along the stream, where they had been when we +halted last night. But we had no thought of falling on them until we +had had some parley with the king or the Earl of Chester. And now it +was plain that with the grim rearguard behind us we outnumbered the men +of Alsi who were left. + +Now came from the village in rear of the foe a little company, in the +midst of which was one horseman, and that was the king himself. His arm +was slung to his breast, and he sat his horse weakly, so that it was +true enough that he had been hurt. With him were the earl and Eglaf, +and the housecarls, and I sent one to fetch Havelok quickly, that there +might be no delay in the words that were to be said. + +Alsi rode to the water’s edge and looked out over our host, and his +white face became whiter, and his thin lips twitched as he saw that our +line was no weaker than it had seemed when first he saw it. He spoke to +the earl, and he too counted the odds before him, and he smiled a +little to himself. He had not much to say to Alsi. + +Then broke out a thunderous cheer from all our men, for with Havelok +and Sigurd at her horse’s rein, and with Withelm’s courtmen of her own +guard behind her, came Goldberga the queen to speak with the man who +had broken his trust. She had on her mail, as on the day when we ended +Hodulf; and she rode to the centre of our line, and there stayed, with +a flush on her cheek that the wild shouts of our men had called there. + +Then I heard the name of “Goldberga, Goldberga!” run down the English +line, and I saw Alsi shrink back into himself, as it were; and then +some Lincoln men close to him began to grow restless, and all at once +they lifted their helms and cheered also, and that cheer was taken up +by all the host, as it seemed, until the ring of hills seemed alive +with voices. And with that Alsi half turned his horse to fly. + +Yet his men did not mean to leave him. It was but the hailing of the +lady whom they knew, and her coming thus was more than the simple +warriors had wit or mind to fathom. But now Goldberga held up her hand, +and the cries ceased, and silence came. Then she lifted her voice, +clear as a silver bell, and said, “It seems strange to me that English +folk should be fighting against me and my husband’s men who have +brought me home. I would know the meaning of this, King Alsi, for it +would seem that your oath to my father is badly kept. Maybe I have +thought that the people would not have me in his place; but their voice +does not ring in those shouts, for which I thank them with all my +heart, as if they hated me. Now, therefore, I myself ask that my +guardian will give up to me that which is my own.” + +We held our peace, but a hum of talk went all through the English +ranks. The Earl of Chester sat down on the bank, and set his sword +across his knees, and began to tie the peace strings round the hilt, in +token that he was going to fight no more. Now and then he looked at +Goldberga, and smiled at her earnest face. But Alsi made no sign of +answer. + +Then the queen spoke again to him. + +“There must be some reason why you have thus set a host in arms against +me,” she said, “and what that may be I would know.” + +Then, as Alsi answered not at all, the earl spoke frankly. + +“We were told that we had to drive out the Vikings, and I must say that +they do not go easily. But it was not told us that they came here to +right a wrong, else had I not fought.” + +Many called out in the same words, and then sat down as the earl had +done. + +And at last Alsi spoke for himself. + +“We do not fight against you, my niece, but against the Danes. We +cannot have them in the country.” + +“They do not mean to bide here, but they will not go before my throne +is given to me. Never came a foreign host into a land in more friendly +wise than this of mine.” + +At that Alsi’s face seemed to clear, and his forced smile came to him. +He looked round on the thanes who were nearest him, and coughed, and +then answered, “Here has been some mistake, my niece, and it has cost +many good lives. If it is even as you say, get you to your land of +Anglia, and there shall be peace. I myself will send word to Ragnar +that he shall hail you as queen.” + +Then up spoke a new voice, and it was one that I knew well. + +“No need to do that, lord king,” said Berthun the cook. “Here have I +come posthaste, and riding day and night, to say that Ragnar is but a +day’s march from here, that he and all Norfolk may see that their queen +comes to her own.” + +Then Alsi’s face grew ashy pale, and without another word he swung his +horse round and went his way. I saw him reel in the saddle before he +had gone far, and Eglaf set his arm round him and stayed him up. After +him Goldberga looked wistfully, for she was forgiving, and had fain +that he had spoken one word of sorrow. But none else heeded him, for +now the thanes, led by the earl himself, came thronging across the +water, that they might ask forgiveness for even seeming to withstand +Goldberga. And on both sides the men set down their arms, and began to +pile mighty fires, that the peace made should not want its handfasting +feast. + +For the fair princess had won her own, and there was naught but +gladness. + + + + +CHAPTER XXIV. +PEACE, AND FAREWELL. + + +Now there was feasting enough, and somewhere they found at a thane’s +house a great tent, and they set that up, so that Havelok and Goldberga +might have their own court round them, as it were. Gladly did Berthun +rid himself of war gear and take to his old trade again. I suppose that +the little Tetford valley had never heard the like sounds of rejoicing +before. + +Near midnight a man came to me and said that a message had come to me +from the other side, and I rose from the board and went out, to find +Eglaf waiting for me in the moonlight. He was armed, and his face was +wan and tired. + +“Come apart, friend,” he said; “I have a message from the king.” + +“To me?” + +“No, to Havelok. But you must hear it first, and then tell him as you +will.” + +We walked away from the tent and across the hillside for some way, and +then he said without more words, “This is the message that Alsi sends +to Havelok, whose name was Curan. ‘Forgive the things that are past, +for many there are that need forgiving. I have no heir, and it is for +myself that I have schemed amiss. In Lincoln town lies a great +treasure, of which Eglaf and I alone know. Give it, I pray you, to your +Danes, that they may harm the land not at all, and so shall I ward off +some of the evil that might come through me even yet. I think that, +after me, you shall be king.’” + +“That is wise of Alsi; but is there no word for Goldberga?” + +“Ay, but not by my mouth. I fetched David the priest two hours ago, and +he bears those messages.” + +“Is there yet more to say?” I asked, for it seemed to me that there +was. + +“There is,” he answered. “Alsi is dead.” + +So there was an end of all his schemings, and I will say no more of +them. It was Eglaf’s thought that it was not so much his hurts that had +killed the king, but a broken heart because of this failure. For the +second time now I knew that it is true that “old sin makes new shame.” + +Now how we told Havelok this, and how Goldberga was somewhat comforted +by the words that David the priest brought her from her uncle, there is +no need to say. But when the news was known in all the host of Lindsey, +there was a great gathering of all in the wide meadow, and we sat in +the camp and wondered what end should be to the talk. Ragnar had come; +but his host was now no great one, for we had sent word to him of the +peace, and there was a great welcome for him and his men. + +The Lindsey thanes did not talk long, and presently some half dozen of +the best of them came to us, and said that with one accord the +gathering would ask that Havelok and Goldberga should reign over them. + +“We will answer for all in the land,” they said. “If there are other +thanes who should have had a word in the matter, they are not here +because, knowing more than we, they would not fight for Alsi in this +quarrel. If there is any other man to be thought of, he cannot go +against the word of the host.” + +“I have my kingdom in Denmark,” said Havelok, “and my wife has hers in +Anglia. How should we take this? See, here is Ragnar of Norwich; he is +worthy to be king, if any. Here, too, is the Earl of Chester, who led +you. It will be well to set these two names before the host.” + +“The host will have none but Havelok and Goldberga,” they said. + +So the long-ago visions came to pass, and in a few days more we were +feasting in the old hall at Lincoln. But before we left the valley of +the battle we laid in mound in all honour those who had fallen. Seven +great mounds we made, at which men wonder and will wonder while they +stand at Tetford. For well fought the Danes of Goldberga, and well +fought the Lindseymen on that day. Yet I think that those who would +fain have lived to see the victory had their share in it, as they stood +in their grim and silent ranks behind us. + +Then was a new crowning of those two, and messages to the overlord of +Lindsey, sent by the thanes, to say that all was settled on the old +lines of peaceful tribute to be paid; and then, when word and presents +came back from him, Goldberga rose up on the high place where she had +been so strangely wedded, and looked down at the joyous faces of her +nobles at the long tables. + +“When I was crowned in Denmark,” she said, “there was a promise made +me, that when this day came to me in Norfolk I might ask one boon of +all who upheld me. I do not know if I may ask it here and now, for the +promise was made by my husband’s people. Yet it is a matter that is +dear to my heart that I shall seek from you all, if I may.” + +Then all the hall rang with voices that bade her ask what she would; +and she bowed and flushed red, and hesitated a little. Then she took +heart and spoke. + +“It is but this,” she said. “Let the poor Christian folk bide in peace; +and if teachers come from the south or from the north presently who +will speak of that faith, bear with them, I pray you, for they work no +harm indeed.” + +Almost was she weeping as she said this, and her white hands were +clasped tightly before her. But she looked bravely at the thanes, and +waited for the answer, though I think that she feared what it would be. + +But an old thane rose up in his place, smiling, and he answered, “If +you had commanded us this, my queen, it would have been done. The +Christian folk, if there are any, shall have no hurt. I think that we +had forgotten the old days of trouble with them. Yet I hear that in +Kent the new faith, as it seems to us, is being taught, and that the +king looks on it with favour. It may be that here it will come also. +For your sake I will listen if a teacher comes to me.” + +The thanes thought little of this boon, and they all answered that it +was freely granted. But they said that it was no boon to give, and bade +her ask somewhat that was better. + +“Why then,” she said, “if I must ask more, think no more of me as queen +save as that I am the wife of the king. Havelok is your ruler in good +sooth.” + +That pleased them all well, and they laughed and wished that all had +wives who had no mind to rule. + +“Here is word that is going home to my wife,” said one to his +neighbour. “If the queen sets the fashion of obedience, it behoves all +good wives to follow her leading.” + +“Maybe I would let some other than yourself tell the lady that,” +answered the other thane with a great laugh, for he knew that household +and its ruler. + +So Goldberga had her will, and then began the long years of peace and +happiness to the kingdoms of which all men know. Wherefore I think that +my story is done. What I have told is halting maybe, and rough, but it +is true. And Goldberga, my sister, says that it is good. Which is all +the praise that I need. + + +So far went Radbard, my friend, and then he would tell no more. So it +is left to me, Wislac the priest, who have written for him, to finish. +He says that everyone knows the rest, and so they do just now. But in +the years to come, when this story is read, men will want to know more. +So it is fit that I should end the story, telling things that I myself +know to be true also. + +Sigurd’s host went back in the autumn, rich with the treasure of Alsi +the king; and from that time forward no Danish host ever sought our +shores. Wars enough have been in England here, but they have not harmed +us. No host has been suffered to cross the borders of Lindsey or East +Anglia, save in peace, and in the wars of Penda of Mercia Havelok has +taken no part. Yet he has had to fight to hold his own more than once, +but always with victory, for always the prayers of the few Christians +have been with him. + +They set Earl Ragnar to hold the southern kingdom for Havelok and his +wife; and presently, when he was left a widower, he wedded the youngest +daughter of Grim, Havelok’s foster father. Eglaf was captain of the +Lincoln courtmen or housecarls, whichever the right name may be among +those who speak of them. One name is Danish and the other English, but +they mean the same. As for my good friend Radbard, he was high sheriff +before long, and that he is yet. He wedded Ragnar’s sister the year +that Havelok was crowned in Norwich, which was the next year after the +crowning at Lincoln. + +Raven went back to the sea, and he will now be in Denmark or else on +the Viking path with Sigurd, for that is what he best loves. Arngeir +bides at Grimsby, high in honour with all, and the port and town grow +greater and more prosperous year by year. Wise was Grim when he chose +to stay in the place where he had chanced to come, if it were not more +than chance that brought him. I suppose that for all time the ships +that are from Grimsby will be free from all dues in the ports that are +Havelok’s in the Danish land. Witlaf, the good old thane, bides in his +place yet, and he rejoices ever that he had a hand in bringing Havelok +up. Nor does our king forget that. + +Indeed, I think that he forgets naught but ill done toward him. Never +is a man who has done one little thing for him overlooked, if he is met +by our king after many years, and that is a royal gift indeed. + +I would that all married folk were as are this royal couple of ours. +Never are they happy apart, and never has a word gone awry between +them. If one speaks of Havelok, one must needs think of Goldberga; and +if one says a word of the queen, one means the king also. Happy in +their people and in their wondrous fair children are they, and that is +all that can be wished for them. + +There was one thing wanting for long years, that I and Withelm ever +longed for for Havelok—a thing for which Goldberga prayed ever. I came +to them from Queen Bertha in Kent, when good old David died; and at +that time Havelok was not a Christian, but surely the most Christian +heathen that ever was. I knew that he must come into the faith at some +time; and I, at least, could not find it in my heart to blame him +altogether for holding to the Asir whom his fathers worshipped. It was +in sheer honesty and singleness of heart that he did so, and I had +never skill enough to show him the right. But Withelm, who has long +been a priest of the faith, and shall surely be our bishop ere long, +had more to do with his conversion than any other. + +Yet it did not come until the days when Paulinus came from York and +preached with the fire of the missionary to us all. And then we saw the +mighty warrior go down to the water in the white robe of the +catechumen, and come therefrom with his face shining with a new and +wondrous light. + +Then he founded a monastery at Grimsby, that there the men of the +marsh, who had been kind to him in the old days, might find teachers in +all that was good; and there it will surely be after many a long year, +until there is need for its work no more, if such a time ever comes. + +So the land grows Christian fast, and good will be its folk if they +follow the way of king and queen and their brothers. + +Now have I finished also, and this is farewell. Look you, husbands and +wives, that you may be said to be like Havelok and Goldberga; and see, +brothers, that you mind the words that Grim spoke to his sons, and +which they heeded so well— + +“Bare is back without brother behind it.” And that is a true word, +though it was a heathen who spoke it. + +THE END. + + + + + [1] I have to thank the Mayor of Grimsby for most kindly furnishing me + with an impression of this ancient seal. + + [2] Now Nishni-Novgorod, from time immemorial the great meetingplace + of north and south, east and west. + + [3] The _garth_ was the fenced and stockaded enclosure round a + northern homestead. + + [4] The _seax_ was the heavy, curved dagger carried by men of all + ranks. + + [5] The northern sea god and goddess. + + [6] Men drowned at sea were thought to go to the halls of Pan and + Aegir. Ran is represented as fishing for heroes in time of storm. + + [7] The Norns were the Fates of the northern mythology. + + [8] The “Witanagemot,” the representative assembly for the kingdom, + whence our Parliament sprang. + + [9] The greatest term of reproach for a coward. + + [10] The gold ring kept in the Temple of the Asir, on which all oaths + must be sworn. + + [11] The sanctuary of the Asir. Thorsway and Withern in Lincolnshire + both preserve the name in the last and first syllable respectively, + both meaning “Thor’s sanctuary.” + + [12] The northern equivalent of the Saxon “Folkmote,” or general + assembly of the people. + +*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 12847 *** diff --git a/12847-h/12847-h.htm b/12847-h/12847-h.htm new file mode 100644 index 0000000..8c21777 --- /dev/null +++ b/12847-h/12847-h.htm @@ -0,0 +1,13740 @@ +<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN" +"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd"> +<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en"> +<head> +<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=UTF-8" /> +<meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" /> +<title>The Project Gutenberg eBook of Havelok the Dane: A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln, by Charles Whistler</title> + +<style type="text/css"> + +body { margin-left: 20%; + margin-right: 20%; + text-align: justify; } + +h1, h2, h3, h4, h5 {text-align: center; font-style: normal; font-weight: +normal; line-height: 1.5; margin-top: .5em; margin-bottom: .5em;} + +h1 {font-size: 300%; + margin-top: 0.6em; + margin-bottom: 0.6em; + letter-spacing: 0.12em; + word-spacing: 0.2em; + text-indent: 0em;} +h2 {font-size: 150%; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 1em;} +h3 {font-size: 130%; margin-top: 1em;} +h4 {font-size: 120%;} +h5 {font-size: 110%;} + +.no-break {page-break-before: avoid;} /* for epubs */ + +div.chapter {page-break-before: always; margin-top: 4em;} + +hr {width: 80%; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em;} + +p {text-indent: 1em; + margin-top: 0.25em; + margin-bottom: 0.25em; } + +p.right {text-align: right; + margin-right: 10%; + margin-top: 1em; + margin-bottom: 1em; } + +p.footnote {font-size: 90%; + text-indent: 0%; + margin-left: 10%; + margin-right: 10%; + margin-top: 1em; + margin-bottom: 1em; } + +sup { vertical-align: top; font-size: 0.6em; } + +a:link {color:blue; text-decoration:none} +a:visited {color:blue; text-decoration:none} +a:hover {color:red} + +</style> +</head> +<body> +<div>*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 12847 ***</div> + +<h1>Havelok the Dane: A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln.</h1> + +<h2 class="no-break">By Charles W. Whistler, M.R.C.S.</h2> + +<hr /> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2>CONTENTS</h2> + +<table summary="" style=""> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap00">PREFACE.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap01">CHAPTER I. GRIM THE FISHER AND HIS SONS.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap02">CHAPTER II. KING HODULF’S SECRET.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap03">CHAPTER III. HAVELOK, SON OF GUNNAR.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap04">CHAPTER IV. ACROSS THE SWAN’S PATH.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap05">CHAPTER V. STORM AND SHIPWRECK.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap06">CHAPTER VI. THE BEGINNING OF GRIMSBY TOWN.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap07">CHAPTER VII. BROTHERHOOD.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap08">CHAPTER VIII. BERTHUN THE COOK.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap09">CHAPTER IX. CURAN THE PORTER.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap10">CHAPTER X. KING ALSI OF LINDSEY.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap11">CHAPTER XI. THE COMING OF THE PRINCESS.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap12">CHAPTER XII. IN LINCOLN MARKETPLACE.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap13">CHAPTER XIII. THE WITAN’S FEASTING.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap14">CHAPTER XIV. THE CRAFT OF ALSI THE KING.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap15">CHAPTER XV. THE FORTUNE OF CURAN THE PORTER.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap16">CHAPTER XVI. A STRANGEST WEDDING.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap17">CHAPTER XVII. HOW THE BRIDE WENT HOME.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap18">CHAPTER XVIII. JARL SIGURD OF DENMARK.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap19">CHAPTER XIX. THE LAST OF GRIFFIN OF WALES.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap20">CHAPTER XX. THE OWNING OF THE HEIR.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap21">CHAPTER XXI. THE TOKEN OF SACK AND ANCHOR.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap22">CHAPTER XXII. KING ALSI’S WELCOME.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap23">CHAPTER XXIII. BY TETFORD STREAM.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap24">CHAPTER XXIV. PEACE, AND FAREWELL.</a></td> +</tr> + +</table> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap00">PREFACE.</a></h2> + +<p> +If any excuse is needed for recasting the ancient legend of Grim the fisher and +his foster-son Havelok the Dane, it may be found in the fascination of the +story itself, which made it one of the most popular legends in England from the +time of the Norman conquest, at least, to that of Elizabeth. From the eleventh +to the thirteenth centuries it seems to have been almost classic; and during +that period two full metrical versions—one in Norman-French and the other in +English—were written, besides many other short versions and abridgments, which +still exist. These are given exhaustively by Professor Skeat in his edition of +the English poem for the Early English Text Society, and it is needless to do +more than refer to them here as the sources from which this story is gathered. +</p> + +<p> +These versions differ most materially from one another in names and incidents, +while yet preserving the main outlines of the whole history. It is evident that +there has been a far more ancient, orally-preserved tradition, which has been +the original of the freely-treated poems and concise prose statements of the +legend which we have. And it seems possible, from among the many variations, +and from under the disguise of the mediaeval forms in which it has been hidden, +to piece together what this original may have been, at least with some +probability. +</p> + +<p> +We have one clue to the age of the legend of Havelok in the statement by the +eleventh-century Norman poet that his tale comes from a British source, which +at least gives a very early date for the happenings related; while another +version tells us that the king of “Lindesie” was a Briton. Welsh names occur, +accordingly, in several places; and it is more than likely that the old legend +preserved a record of actual events in the early days of the Anglo-Saxon +settlement in England, when there were yet marriages between conquerors and +conquered, and the origins of Angle and Jute and Saxon were not yet forgotten +in the pedigrees of the many petty kings. +</p> + +<p> +One of the most curious proofs of the actual British origin of the legend is in +the statement that the death of Havelok’s father occurred as the result of a +British invasion of Denmark for King Arthur, by a force under a leader with the +distinctly Norse name of Hodulf. The claim for conquest of the north by Arthur +is very old, and is repeated by Geoffrey of Monmouth, and may well have +originated in the remembrance of some successful raid on the Danish coasts by +the Norse settlers in the Gower district of Pembrokeshire, in company with a +contingent of their Welsh neighbours. +</p> + +<p> +This episode does not occur in the English version; but here an attack on +Havelok on his return home to Denmark is made by men led by one Griffin, and +this otherwise unexplainable survival of a Welsh name seems to connect the two +accounts in some way that recalls the ancient legend at the back of both. +</p> + +<p> +I have therefore treated the Welsh element in the story as deserving a more +prominent place, at least in subsidiary incidents, than it has in the two old +metrical versions. It has been possible to follow neither of these exactly, as +in names and details they are widely apart; but to one who knows both, the +sequence of events will, I think, be clear enough. +</p> + +<p> +I have, for the same reason of the British origin of the legend, preferred the +simple and apposite derivation of the name of “Curan,” taken by the hero during +his servitude, from the Welsh <i>Cwran</i>, “a wonder,” to the Norman +explanation of the name as meaning a “scullion,” which seems to be rather a +guess, based on the menial position of the prince, than a translation. +</p> + +<p> +For the long existence of a Welsh servile population in the lowlands of +Lincolnshire there is evidence enough in the story of Guthlac of Crowland, and +the type may still be found there. There need be little excuse for claiming +some remains of their old Christianity among them, and the “hermit” who reads +the dream for the princess may well have been a half-forgotten Welsh priest. +But the mediaeval poems have Christianized the ancient legend, until it would +seem to stand in somewhat the same relationship to what it was as the German +“Niebelungen Lied” does to the “Volsunga Saga.” +</p> + +<p> +With regard to the dreams which recur so constantly, I have in the case of the +princess transferred the date of hers to the day previous to her marriage, the +change only involving a difference of a day, but seeming to he needed, as +explanatory of her sudden submission to her guardian. And instead of crediting +Havelok with the supernatural light bodily, it has been transferred to the +dream which seems to haunt those who have to do with him. +</p> + +<p> +As to the names of the various characters, they are in the old versions hardly +twice alike. I have, therefore, taken those which seem to have been modernized +from their originals, or preserved by simple transliteration, and have set them +back in what seems to have been their first form. Gunther, William, and +Bertram, for instance, seem to be modernized from Gunnar, Withelm, and perhaps +Berthun; while Sykar, Aunger, and Gryme are but alternative English spellings +of the northern Sigurd, Arngeir, and Grim. +</p> + +<p> +The device on Havelok’s banner in chapter xxi. is exactly copied from the +ancient seal of the Corporation of Grimsby,<a href="#fn1" +name="fnref1"><sup>[1]</sup></a> which is of the date of Edward the First. The +existence of this is perhaps the best proof that the story of Grim and Havelok +is more than a romance. Certainly the Norse “Heimskringla” record claims an +older northern origin for the town than that of the Danish invasion of Alfred’s +time; and the historic freedom of its ships from toll in the port of Elsinore +has always been held to date from the days of its founder. +</p> + +<p> +The strange and mysterious “blue stones” of Grimsby and Louth are yet in +evidence, and those of the former town are connected by legend with Grim. +Certainly they have some very ancient if long-forgotten associations, and it is +more than likely that they have been brought as “palladia” with the earliest +northern settlers. A similar stone exists in the centre of the little East +Anglian town of Harleston, with a definite legend of settlement attached to it; +and there may be others. The Coronation Stone of Westminster and the stone in +Kingston-on-Thames are well-known proofs of the ancient sanctity that +surrounded such objects for original reasons that are now lost. +</p> + +<p> +The final battle at Tetford, with its details, are from the Norman poem. The +later English account is rounded off with the disgrace and burning alive of the +false guardian; but for many reasons the earlier seems to be the more correct +account. Certainly the mounds of some great forgotten fight remain in the +Tetford valley, and Havelok is said to have come to “Carleflure,” which, being +near Saltfleet, and on the road to Tetford, may be Canton, where there is a +strong camp of what is apparently Danish type. +</p> + +<p> +Those who can read with any comfort the crabbed Norman-French and Early English +poetic versions will see at once where I have added incidents that may bring +the story into a connected whole, as nearly as possible on the old Saga lines; +and those readers to whom the old romance is new will hardly wish that I should +pull the story to pieces again, to no purpose so far as they are concerned. +And, at least, for a fairly free treatment of the subject, I have the authority +of those previous authors whom I have mentioned. +</p> + +<p> +In the different versions, the founder of Grimsby is variously described as a +steward of the Danish king’s castle, a merchant, a fisher, and in the English +poem—probably because it was felt that none other would have undertaken the +drowning of the prince—as a thrall. Another version gives no account of the +sack episode, but says that Grim finds both queen and prince wandering on the +shore. Grim the fisher is certainly a historic character in his own town, and +it has not been hard to combine the various callings of the worthy +foster-father of Havelok and the troubles of both mother and son. A third local +variant tells that Havelok was found at Grimsby by the fisher adrift in an open +boat; and I have given that boat also a place in the story, in a different way. +</p> + +<p> +The names of the kings are too far lost to be set back in their place in +history, but Professor Skeet gives the probable date of Havelok and Grim as at +the end of the sixth century, with a possible identification of the former with +the “governor of Lincoln” baptized by Paulinus. I have, therefore, assumed this +period where required. But a legend of this kind is a romance of all time, and +needs no confinement to date and place. Briton and Saxon, Norman and +Englishman, and maybe Norseman and Dane, have loved the old story, and with its +tale of right and love triumphant it still has its own power. +</p> + +<p> +Stockland, <i>1899</i> +</p> + +<p class="right"> +Chas. W. Whistler +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap01">CHAPTER I.<br/> +GRIM THE FISHER AND HIS SONS.</a></h2> + +<p> +This story is not about myself, though, because I tell of things that I have +seen, my name must needs come into it now and then. The man whose deeds I would +not have forgotten is my foster-brother, Havelok, of whom I suppose every one +in England has heard. Havelok the Dane men call him here, and that is how he +will always be known, as I think. +</p> + +<p> +He being so well known, it is likely that some will write down his doings, and, +not knowing them save by hearsay, will write them wrongly and in different +ways, whereof will come confusion, and at last none will be believed. +Wherefore, as he will not set them down himself, it is best that I do so. Not +that I would have anyone think that the penmanship is mine. Well may I handle +oar, and fairly well axe and sword, as is fitting for a seaman, but the pen +made of goose feather is beyond my rough grip in its littleness, though I may +make shift to use a sail-needle, for it is stiff and straightforward in its +ways, and no scrawling goeth therewith. +</p> + +<p> +Therefore my friend Wislac, the English priest, will be the penman, having +skill thereto. I would have it known that I can well trust him to write even as +I speak, though he has full leave to set aside all hard words and unseemly, +such as a sailor is apt to use unawares; and where my Danish way of speaking +goeth not altogether with the English, he may alter the wording as he will, so +long as the sense is always the same. Then, also, will he read over to me what +he has written, and therefore all may be sure that this is indeed my true +story. +</p> + +<hr /> + +<p> +Now, as it is needful that one begins at the beginning, it happens that the +first thing to be told is how I came to be Havelok’s foster-brother, and that +seems like beginning with myself after all. But all the story hangs on this, +and so there is no help for it. +</p> + +<p> +If it is asked when this beginning might be, I would say, for an Englishman who +knows not the names of Danish kings, that it was before the first days of the +greatness of Ethelbert of Kent, the overlord of all England, the Bretwalda, and +therefore, as Father Wislac counts, about the year of grace 580. But King +Ethelbert does not come into the story, nor does the overlord of all Denmark; +for the kings of whom I must speak were under-kings, though none the less +kingly for all that. One must ever be the mightiest of many; and, as in +England, there were at that time many kings in Denmark, some over wide lands +and others over but small realms, with that one who was strong enough to make +the rest pay tribute to him as overlord, and only keeping that place by the +power of the strong hand, not for any greater worth. +</p> + +<p> +Our king on the west coast of Denmark, where the story of Havelok the Dane must +needs begin, was Gunnar Kirkeban—so called because, being a heathen altogether, +as were we all in Denmark at that time, he had been the bane of many churches +in the western isles of Scotland, and in Wales and Ireland, and made a boast +thereof. However, that cruelty of his was his own bane in the end, as will be +seen. Otherwise he was a well-loved king and a great warrior, tall, and +stronger than any man in Denmark, as was said. His wife, the queen, was a +foreigner, but the fairest of women. Her name was Eleyn, and from this it was +thought that she came from the far south. Certainly Gunnar had brought her back +from Gardariki,<a href="#fn2" name="fnref2"><sup>[2]</sup></a> whither he had +gone on a trading journey one year. Gunnar and she had two daughters and but +one son, and that son was Havelok, at this time seven years old. +</p> + +<p> +Next to the king came our own lord, Jarl Sigurd, older than Gunnar, and his +best counsellor, though in the matter of sparing harmless and helpless church +folk his advice was never listened to. His hall was many miles from the king’s +place, southward down the coast. +</p> + +<p> +Here, too, lived my father, Grim, with us in a good house which had been his +father’s before him. Well loved by Jarl Sigurd was Grim, who had ever been his +faithful follower, and was the best seaman in all the town. He was also the +most skilful fisher on our coasts, being by birth a well-to-do freeman enough, +and having boats of his own since he could first sail one. At one time the jarl +had made him steward of his house; but the sea drew him ever, and he waxed +restless away from it. Therefore, after a time, he asked the jarl’s leave to +take to the sea again, and so prospered in the fishery that at last he bought a +large trading buss from the Frisian coast, and took to the calling of the +merchant. +</p> + +<p> +So for some years my father, stout warrior as he proved himself in many a fight +at his lord’s side, traded peacefully—that is, so long as men would suffer him +to do so; for it happened more than once that his ship was boarded by Vikings, +who in the end went away, finding that they had made a mistake in thinking that +they had found a prize in a harmless trader, for Grim was wont to man his ship +with warriors, saying that what was worth trading was worth keeping. I mind me +how once he came to England with a second cargo, won on the high seas from a +Viking’s plunder, which the Viking brought alongside our ship, thinking to add +our goods thereto. Things went the other way, and we left him only an empty +ship, which maybe was more than he would have spared to us. That was on my +second voyage, when I was fifteen. +</p> + +<p> +Mostly my father traded to England, for there are few of the Saxon kin who take +ship for themselves, and the havens to which he went were Tetney and Saltfleet, +on the Lindsey shore of Humber, where he soon had friends. +</p> + +<p> +So Grim prospered and waxed rich fast, and in the spring of the year wherein +the story begins was getting the ship ready for the first cruise of the season, +meaning to be afloat early; for then there was less trouble with the wild Norse +Viking folk, for one cruise at least. Then happened that which set all things +going otherwise than he had planned, and makes my story worth telling. +</p> + +<p> +We—that is my father Grim, Leva my mother, my two brothers and myself, and our +two little sisters, Gunhild and Solva—sat quietly in our great room, busy at +one little thing or another, each in his way, before the bright fire that +burned on the hearth in the middle of the floor. There was no trouble at all +for us to think of more than that the wind had held for several weeks in the +southwest and northwest, and we wondered when it would shift to its wonted +springtide easting, so that we could get the ship under way once more for the +voyage she was prepared for. Pleasant talk it was, and none could have thought +that it was to be the last of many such quiet evenings that had gone before. +</p> + +<p> +Yet it seemed that my father was uneasy, and we had been laughing at him for +his silence, until he said, looking into the fire, “I will tell you what is on +my mind, and then maybe you will laugh at me the more for thinking aught of the +matter. Were I in any but a peaceful land, I should say that a great battle had +been fought not so far from us, and to the northward.” +</p> + +<p> +Then my mother looked up at him, knowing that he had seen many fights, and was +wise in the signs that men look for before them; but she asked nothing, and so +I said, “What makes you think this, father?” +</p> + +<p> +He answered me with another question. +</p> + +<p> +“How many kites will you see overhead at any time, sons?” +</p> + +<p> +I wondered at this, but it was easy to answer—to Raven, at least. +</p> + +<p> +“Always one, and sometimes another within sight of the first,” Raven said. +</p> + +<p> +“And if there is food, what then?” +</p> + +<p> +“The first swoops down on it, and the next follows, and the one that watches +the second follows that, and so on until there are many kites gathered.” +</p> + +<p> +“What if one comes late?” +</p> + +<p> +“He swings overhead and screams, and goes back to his place; then no more +come.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay,” he said; “you will make a sailor yet, son Raven, for you watch things. +Now I will tell you what I saw today. There was the one kite sailing over my +head as I was at the ship garth, and presently it screamed so that I looked up. +Then it left its wide circles over the town, and flew northward, straight as an +arrow. Then from the southward came another, following it, and after that +another, and yet others, all going north. And far off I could see where others +flew, and they too went north. And presently flapped over me the ravens in the +wake of the kites, and the great sea eagles came in screaming and went the same +way, and so for all the time that I was at the ship, and until I came home.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is a sacrifice to the Asir somewhere,” I said, “for the birds of Odin +and Thor have always their share.” +</p> + +<p> +My father shook his head. +</p> + +<p> +“The birds cry to one another, as I think, and say when the feast is but enough +for those that have gathered. They have cried now that there is room for all at +some great feasting. Once have I seen the like before, and that was when I was +with the ship guard when the jarl fought his great battle in the Orkneys; we +knew that he had fought by the same token.” +</p> + +<p> +But my mother said that I was surely right. There was no fear of battle here, +and indeed with Gunnar and Sigurd to guard the land we had had peace for many a +long year on our own coasts, if other lands had had to fear them. My father +laughed a little, saying that perhaps it was so, and then my mother took the +two little ones and went with them into the sleeping room to put them to rest, +while I and my two brothers went out to the cattle garth to see that all was +well for the night. +</p> + +<p> +Then, when our eyes were used to the moonlight, which was not very bright, away +to the northward we saw a red glow that was not that of the sunset or of the +northern lights, dying down now and then, and then again flaring up as will a +far-off fire; and even as we looked we heard the croak of an unseen raven +flying thitherward overhead. +</p> + +<p> +“Call father,” I said to Withelm, who was the youngest of us three. The boy ran +in, and presently my father came out and looked long at the glow in the sky. +</p> + +<p> +“Even as I thought,” he said. “The king’s town is burning, and I must go to +tell the jarl. Strange that we have had no message. Surely the king’s men must +be hard pressed if this is a foe’s work.” +</p> + +<p> +So he went at once, leaving us full of wonder and excited, as boys will be at +anything that is new and has a touch of fear in it. But he had hardly gone +beyond the outbuildings when one came running and calling him. The jarl had +sent for him, for there was strange news from the king. Then he and this +messenger hastened off together. +</p> + +<p> +In half an hour the war horns were blowing fiercely, and all the quiet town was +awake, for my father’s forebodings were true, and the foe was on us. In our +house my mother was preparing the food that her husband should carry with him, +and I was putting a last polish on the arms that should keep him, while the +tramp of men who went to the gathering rang down the street, one by one at +first, and then in twos and threes. My mother neither wept nor trembled, but +worked with a set face that would not show fear. +</p> + +<p> +Then came in my father, and I armed him, begging at the same time that I might +go also, for I could use <i>my</i> weapons well enough; but he told me that +some must needs bide at home as a guard, and that I was as much wanted there as +at the king’s place, wherewith I had to be content. It was by no means unlikely +that we also might be attacked, if it was true that the king’s men were +outnumbered, as was said. +</p> + +<p> +Now when my father went to say farewell to us, nowhere could be found my +brother Withelm. +</p> + +<p> +“The boy has gone to watch the muster,” my father said. “I shall see him there +presently.” +</p> + +<p> +Then, because he saw that my mother was troubled more than her wont, he added, +“Have no fear for me. This will be no more than a raid of Norsemen, and they +will plunder and be away with the tide before we get to the place.” +</p> + +<p> +So he laughed and went out, having done his best to cheer us all, and I went +with him to where the men were gathered in their arms in the wide space in the +midst of the houses. There I sought for little Withelm, but could not find him +among the women and children who looked on; and before we had been there more +than a few minutes the jarl gave the word, and the march was begun. There were +about fifteen miles to be covered between our town and the king’s. +</p> + +<p> +I watched them out of sight, and then went home, having learned that I was to +be called out only in case of need. And as I drew near the homestead I saw a +light in the little ash grove that was behind the garth.<a href="#fn3" +name="fnref3"><sup>[3]</sup></a> In the midst of the trees, where this light +seemed to be, was our wooden image of Thor the Hammer Bearer, older than any of +us could tell; and in front of this was what we used as his altar—four +roughly-squared stones set together. These stones were blue-black in colour, +and whence they came I do not know, unless it was true that my forefathers +brought them here when first Odin led his folk to the northern lands. Always +they had been the altar for my people, and my father held that we should have +no luck away from them. +</p> + +<p> +So it was strange to see a light in that place, where none would willingly go +after dark, and half was I feared to go and see what it might mean. But then it +came into my mind that the enemy might be creeping on the house through the +grove, and that therefore I must needs find out all about it. So I went softly +to the nearest trees, and crept from one to another, ever getting closer to the +light; and I will say that I feared more that I might see some strange thing +that was more than mortal than that I should see the leading foeman stealing +towards me. But presently it was plain that the light did not move as if men +carried it, but it flickered as a little fire; and at last I saw that it burned +on the altar stones, and that frightened me so that I almost fled. +</p> + +<p> +Maybe I should have done so, but that I heard a voice that I knew; and so, +looking once more, I saw a figure standing before the fire, and knew it. It was +little Withelm, and why a ten-year-old boy should be here I could not think. +But I called him softly, and he started somewhat, turning and trying to look +through the darkness towards me, though he did not seem afraid. There was a +little fire of dry sticks burning on the stones, and the gaunt old statue +seemed to look more terrible than ever in its red blaze. One might have thought +that the worn face writhed itself as the light played over it. +</p> + +<p> +“It is I, Withelm,” I said softly, for the fear of the place was on me. “We +have sought you everywhere, and father would have wished you farewell. What are +you doing here?” +</p> + +<p> +I came forward then, for it was plain that the child feared nothing, so that I +was put to shame. And as I came I asked once more what he was doing in this +place. +</p> + +<p> +“The jarl has surely forgotten the sacrifice to the Asir before the warriors +went to fight, and they will be angry,” he answered very calmly. “It is right +that one should remember, and I feared for father, and therefore—” +</p> + +<p> +He pointed to the altar, and I saw that he had laid his own untasted supper on +the fire that he had lighted, and I had naught to say. The thing was +over-strange to me, who thought nothing of these things. It was true that the +host always sacrificed before sailing on the Viking path, but tonight had been +urgent haste. +</p> + +<p> +“Thor will not listen to any but a warrior,” I said. “Come home, brother, for +mother waits us.” +</p> + +<p> +“If not Thor, who is maybe busy at the battle they talk of, then do I think +that All Father will listen,” he said stoutly. “But this was all that I had to +make sacrifice withal, and it may not be enough.” +</p> + +<p> +“The jarl will make amends when he comes back,” I said, wishing to get home and +away from this place, and yet unwilling to chide the child. “Now let us go, for +mother will grow anxious.” +</p> + +<p> +With that he put his hand in mine, and we both saluted Thor, as was fitting, +and then went homeward. It seemed to me that the glare in the north was fiercer +now than when I had first seen it. +</p> + +<p> +Now, after my mother had put Withelm to bed, I told her how I had found him; +and thereat she wept a little, as I could see in the firelight. +</p> + +<p> +After a long silence she said, “Strange things and good come into the mind of a +child, and one may learn what his fate shall be in the days to come. I am sure +from this that Withelm will be a priest.” +</p> + +<p> +Now as one may buy the place of a godar, with the right to have a temple of the +Asir for a district and the authority that goes therewith, if so be that one +falls vacant or is to be given up by the holder, this did not seem unlikely, +seeing how rich we were fast growing. And indeed my mother’s saying came to +pass hereafter, though not at all in the way of which we both thought. +</p> + +<p> +There was no alarm that night. The old warriors watched round the town and +along the northern tracks, but saw nothing, and in the morning the black smoke +hung over the place of the burning, drifting slowly seaward. The wind had +changed, and they said that it would doubtless have taken the foe away with it, +as my father had hoped. So I went down to the ship with Raven, and worked at +the few things that were still left to be done to her as she lay in her long +shed on the slips, ready to take the water at any tide. She was only waiting +for cargo and stores to be put on board her with the shift of wind that had +come at last, and I thought that my father would see to these things as soon as +he came back. +</p> + +<p> +Now in the evening we had news from the Jarl, and strange enough it was. My +father came back two days afterwards and told us all, and so I may as well make +a short story of it. The ways of Gunnar Kirkeban had been his end, for a +certain Viking chief, a Norseman, had wintered in Wales during the past winter, +and there he had heard from the Welsh of the wrongs that they had suffered at +his hands. Also he had heard of the great booty of Welsh gold that Gunnar had +taken thence in the last summer; and so, when these Welsh asked that he would +bide with them and help fight the next Danes who came, he had offered to do +more than that—he would lead them to Gunnar’s place if they would find men to +man three ships that he had taken, and would be content to share the booty with +them. +</p> + +<p> +The Welsh king was of the line of Arthur, and one who yet hoped to win back the +land of his fathers from the Saxons and English; and so he listened to this +Hodulf, thinking to gain a powerful ally in him for attack on the eastern coast +of England after this. So, favoured by the wind that had kept us from the sea, +Hodulf, with twenty ships in all, had fallen on Gunnar unawares, and had had an +easy victory, besetting the town in such wise that only in the confusion while +the wild Welsh were burning and plundering on every side had the messenger to +the jarl been able to slip away. +</p> + +<p> +But when the jarl and our men reached the town there was naught to be done but +to make terms with Hodulf as best he might, that the whole country might not be +overrun. For Gunnar had been slain in his own hall, with his two young +daughters and with the queen also, as was supposed. Havelok the prince was in +his hands, and for his sake therefore Sigurd had been the more ready to come to +terms. +</p> + +<p> +Then Hodulf sent messengers to the overlord of all Denmark, saying that he +would hold this kingdom as for him, and backed up that promise with a great +present from Gunnar’s treasure, so that he was listened to. Therefore our jarl +was helpless; and there being no other king strong enough to aid him if he +rose, in the end he had to take Hodulf for lord altogether, though it went +sorely against the grain. +</p> + +<p> +I have heard it said by the Welsh folk that Hodulf held the kingdom for their +lord; and it is likely that he humoured them by saying that he would do so, +which was a safe promise to make, as even King Arthur himself could never have +reached him to make him pay scatt. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap02">CHAPTER II.<br/> +KING HODULF’S SECRET.</a></h2> + +<p> +My father came home heavy and anxious enough, for he did not know how things +would go under this new king, though he had promised peace to all men who would +own him. We in our place saw nothing of him or his men for the next few weeks, +but he was well spoken of by those who had aught to do with him elsewhere. So +my father went on trying to gather a cargo for England; but it was a slow +business, as the burnt and plundered folk of the great town had naught for us, +and others sold to them. But he would never be idle, and every day when weather +served we went fishing, for he loved his old calling well, as a man will love +that which he can do best. Our two boats and their gear were always in the best +of order, and our kinsman, Arngeir, used and tended them when we were away in +the ship in summertime. +</p> + +<p> +Now, one evening, as we came up from the shore after beaching the boat on the +hard below the town, and half a mile from the nearest houses, and being, as one +may suppose, not altogether in holiday trim, so that Grim and his boys with +their loads of fish and nets looked as though a fisher’s hovel were all the +home that they might own, we saw a horseman, followed at a little distance by +two more, riding towards us. The dusk was gathering, and at first we thought +that this was Jarl Sigurd, who would ask us maybe to send fish to his hall, and +so we set our loads down and waited for him. +</p> + +<p> +But it was not our lord, and I had never seen this man before. From his arms, +which were of a new pattern to me, he might be one of the host of Hodulf, as I +thought. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, fisher!” he cried, when he was yet some way from us; “leave your lads, and +come hither. I have a word for you.” +</p> + +<p> +He reined up and waited, and now I was sure that he was a Norseman, for his +speech was rougher than ours. He was a tall, handsome man enough; but I liked +neither his voice nor face, nor did I care to hear Grim, my father, summoned in +such wise, not remembering that just now a stranger could not tell that he was +aught but a fisher thrall of the jarl’s. +</p> + +<p> +But my father did as he was asked, setting down the nets that he was carrying, +and only taking with him the long boathook on which he had slung them as he +went forward. I suppose he remembered the old saying, that a man should not +stir a step on land without his weapons, as one never knows when there may be +need of them; and so, having no other, he took this. +</p> + +<p> +I heard the first questions that the man asked, for he spoke loudly. +</p> + +<p> +“Whose man are you?” +</p> + +<p> +“Sigurd’s,” answered my father shortly. +</p> + +<p> +“Whose are the boats?” +</p> + +<p> +“Mine, seeing that I built them.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, there is somewhat that you can do for me,” the horseman said. “Is +your time your own, however?” +</p> + +<p> +“If the jarl needs me not.” +</p> + +<p> +“Tonight, then?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have naught to do after I have carried the nets home.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is well,” said the stranger; and after that he dropped his voice so that +I heard no more, but he and my father talked long together. +</p> + +<p> +We waited, and at last the talk ended, and my father came hack to us, while the +stranger rode away northward along the sands. Then I asked who the man was, and +what he wanted. +</p> + +<p> +“He is some chief of these Norsemen, and one who asks more questions of a +thrall, as he thinks me, than he would dare ask Sigurd the jarl, or Grim the +merchant either, for that matter.” +</p> + +<p> +Seeing that my father did not wish to say more at this time, we asked nothing +else, but went homeward in silence. It seemed as if he was ill at ease, and he +went more quickly than was his wont, so that presently Raven and little Withelm +lagged behind us with their burdens, for our catch had been a good one. +</p> + +<p> +Then he stopped outside the garth when we reached home, and told me not to go +in yet. And when the others came up he said to them, “Do you two take in the +things and the fish, and tell mother that Radbard and I have to go down to the +ship. There is cargo to be seen to, and it is likely that we shall he late, so +bid her not wait up for us.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told me to come, and we left the two boys at once and turned away +towards the haven. There was nothing strange in this, for cargo often came at +odd times, and we were wont to work late in stowing it. I did wonder that we +had not stayed to snatch a bit of supper, but it crossed my mind that the +Norseman had told my father of some goods that had maybe been waiting for the +whole day while we were at sea. And then that did not seem likely, for he had +taken us for thralls. So I was puzzled, but held my peace until it should seem +good to my father to tell me what we were about. +</p> + +<p> +When we reached a place where there was no house very near and no man about, he +said to me at last, “What is on hand I do not rightly know, but yon man was +Hodulf, the new king, as I suppose we must call him. He would not tell me his +name, but I saw him when he and the jarl made terms the other day. Now he has +bidden me meet him on the road a mile from the town as soon as it is dark, and +alone. He has somewhat secret for me to do.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is a risk to go alone and unarmed,” I answered; “let me go home and get +your weapons, for the errand does not seem honest.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is what I think also,” said my father, “and that is why I am going to +meet him. It is a bad sign when a king has a secret to share with a thrall, and +I have a mind to find out what it is. There may be some plot against our jarl.” +</p> + +<p> +He was silent for a few minutes, as if thinking, and then he went on. +</p> + +<p> +“I cannot take arms, or he would suspect me, and would tell me nothing; but if +there is any plotting to be done whereof I must tell the jarl, it will be as +well that you should hear it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he said that he thought it possible for me to creep very close to the +place where he was to meet Hodulf, so that I could hear all or most of what +went on, and that I might as well be armed in case of foul play, for he did not +suppose that the Norseman would think twice about cutting down a thrall who did +not please him. +</p> + +<p> +It was almost dark by this time, and therefore he must be going. I was not to +go home for arms, but to borrow from Arngeir as we passed his house. And this I +did, saying that I had an errand beyond the town and feared prowling men of the +Norse host. Which danger being a very reasonable one, Arngeir offered to go +with me; and I had some difficulty in preventing him from doing so, for he was +like an elder brother to all of us. However, I said that I had no great +distance to go, and feigned to be ashamed of myself for my fears; and he +laughed at me, and let me go my way with sword and spear and seax<a href="#fn4" +name="fnref4"><sup>[4]</sup></a> also, which last my father would take under +his fisher’s jerkin. +</p> + +<p> +I caught up my father quickly, and we went along the sands northwards until we +came to the place where we must separate. The road was but a quarter of a mile +inland from this spot, for it ran near the shore, and it was not much more than +that to the place where Hodulf would be waiting. +</p> + +<p> +“Creep as near as you can,” my father said; “but come to help only if I call. I +do not think that I am likely to do so.” +</p> + +<p> +Then we went our ways, he making straight for the road, and I turning to my +left a little. It was dark, for there was no moon now, but save that I was +soundly scratched by the brambles of the fringe of brushwood that grew all +along the low hills of the coast, there was nothing to prevent my going on +quickly, for I knew the ground well enough, by reason of yearly bird nesting. +When I reached the roadway the meeting place was yet to my left, and I could +hear my father’s footsteps coming steadily in the distance. So I skirted the +road for a little way, and then came to an open bit of heath and rising land, +beyond which I thought I should find Hodulf. Up this I ran quickly, dropping +into the heather at the top; and sure enough, in a hollow just off the road I +could dimly make out the figure of a mounted man waiting. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father came along the road past me, and I crawled among the tall +heather clumps until I was not more than twenty paces from the hollow, which +was a little below me. +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf’s horse winded me, as I think, and threw up its head snorting, and I +heard its bit rattle. But my father was close at hand, and that was lucky. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, fisher, is that you?” he called softly. +</p> + +<p> +“I am here,” was the answer, and at once my father came into the hollow from +the road. +</p> + +<p> +“Are any folk about?” Hodulf said. +</p> + +<p> +“I have met none. Now, what is all this business?” answered my father. +</p> + +<p> +“Business that will make a free man of you for the rest of your days, and rich, +moreover, master thrall,” said Hodulf. “That is, if you do as I bid you.” +</p> + +<p> +“A thrall can do naught else than what he is bidden.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but he can do that in a way that will earn great reward, now and then; +and your reward for obedience and silence thereafter in this matter shall be +aught that you like to ask.” +</p> + +<p> +“This sounds as if I were to peril my life,” my father said. “I know naught +else that can be worth so much as that might be.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is no peril,” said Hodulf scornfully; “your skin shall not be so much as +scratched—ay, and if this is well done it will know a master’s dog whip no +more.” +</p> + +<p> +I heard my father chuckle with a thrall’s cunning laugh at this, and then he +said eagerly, “Well, master, what is it?” +</p> + +<p> +“I will tell you. But first will you swear as on the holy ring that of what you +shall do for me no man shall know hereafter?” +</p> + +<p> +“What I do at your bidding none shall know, and that I swear,” answered my +father slowly, as if trying to repeat the king’s words. +</p> + +<p> +“See here, then,” said Hodulf, and I heard his armour clatter as he dismounted. +</p> + +<p> +Then the footsteps of both men shuffled together for a little while, and once I +thought I heard a strange sound as of a muffled cry, at which Hodulf muttered +under his breath. I could see that they took something large from the saddle +bow, and set it on the ground, and then they spoke again. +</p> + +<p> +“Have you a heavy anchor?” asked the king. +</p> + +<p> +“A great one.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, tie it to this sack and sink it tonight where tide will never +shift it. Then you may come to me and claim what reward you will.” +</p> + +<p> +“Freedom, and gold enough to buy a new boat—two new boats!” said my father +eagerly. +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf laughed at that, and got on his horse again. I saw his tall form lift +itself against the dim sky as he did so. +</p> + +<p> +“What is in the sack?” asked my father. +</p> + +<p> +“That is not your concern,” Hodulf answered sharply. “If you know not, then you +can tell no man, even in your sleep. Put off at once and sink it.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is in my mind,” said my father, “that I had better not look in the sack. +Where shall I find you, lord, when the thing is in the sea? For as yet I have +not heard your name.” +</p> + +<p> +I think that Hodulf had forgotten that he would have to answer this question, +or else he thought that everyone knew him, for he did not reply all at once. +</p> + +<p> +“You may ask the king for your reward,” he said, after a little thought, “for +this is his business. Now you know that it will be best for you to be secret +and sure. Not much worth will your chance of escape from torture be if this +becomes known. But you know also that the reward is certain.” +</p> + +<p> +“The king!” cried my father, with a sort of gasp of surprise. +</p> + +<p> +I could almost think that I saw him staring with mouth agape as would a silly +thrall; for so well had he taken the thrall’s part that had I not known who was +speaking all the time, I had certainly had no doubt that one was there. +</p> + +<p> +“Come to Hodulf, the king, and pray for freedom and your gold as a boon of his +goodness, saying naught else, or making what tale you will of a hard master, or +justice, so that you speak naught of what you have done, and that—and maybe +more—shall be granted.” +</p> + +<p> +“You yourself will speak for me?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am the king—and think not that the darkness will prevent my knowing your +face again,” Hodulf replied. +</p> + +<p> +There was a threat in the words, and with them he turned his horse and rode +away quickly northwards. I heard the hoofs of his men’s horses rattle on the +road as they joined him, before he had gone far. +</p> + +<p> +When the sounds died away altogether, and there was no fear of his coming back +suddenly on us, my father whistled and I joined him. He almost started to find +how near I was. +</p> + +<p> +“You have heard all, then?” he said. +</p> + +<p> +“Every word,” I answered, “and I like it not. Where is this sack he spoke of?” +</p> + +<p> +It lay at his feet. A large sack it was, and full of somewhat heavy and warm +that seemed to move a little when I put my hand on it. Still less did I like +the business as I felt that. +</p> + +<p> +“More also!” quoth my father, as if thinking of the king’s last words. “If that +does not mean a halter for my neck, I am mistaken. What have we here, son, do +you think?” +</p> + +<p> +“Somewhat that should not be here, certainly,” I answered. “There would not be +so much talk about drowning a dog, as one might think this to be.” +</p> + +<p> +“Unless it were his wife’s,” answered my father, with a laugh. +</p> + +<p> +Then he stooped, and I helped him to get the sack on his shoulders. It was +heavy, but not very—not so heavy as a young calf in a sack would be; and he +carried it easily, taking my spear to help him. +</p> + +<p> +“The thrall is even going to take this to the house of Grim the merchant, whom +the king will not know again, though he may see in the dark,” said he; “then we +shall know how we stand.” +</p> + +<p> +We met no one on our way back, for the town had gone to sleep, until the +watchman passed the time of night with us, thinking no doubt that we had fish +or goods in the burden. And when we came home a sleepy thrall opened to us, for +all were at rest save him. And he too went his way to the shed where his place +was when he had stirred the fire to a blaze and lit a torch that we might see +to eat the supper that was left for us. +</p> + +<p> +Then we were alone, and while I set Arngeir’s weapons in a corner, my father +put down the sack, and stood looking at it. It seemed to sway a little, and to +toss as it settled down. And now that there was light it was plain that the +shape of what was inside it was strangely like that of a child, doubled up with +knees to chin, as it showed through the sacking. +</p> + +<p> +“Hodulf or no Hodulf,” said my father, “I am going to see more of this.” +</p> + +<p> +With that he took a knife from the table and cut the cord that fastened the +mouth, turning back the sack quickly. +</p> + +<p> +And lo! gagged and bound hand and foot in such wise that he could not move, in +the sack was a wondrously handsome boy of about the size of Withelm; and for +all his terrible journey across the king’s saddle, and in spite of our rough +handling, his eyes were bright and fearless as he looked up at us. +</p> + +<p> +“Radbard,” said my father, “what if Hodulf had met with a thrall who had done +his bidding in truth?” +</p> + +<p> +I would not think thereof, for surely by this time there had been no light in +the eyes that seemed to me to be grateful to us. +</p> + +<p> +Now my father knelt down by the boy’s side, and began to take the lashings from +him, telling him at the same time to be silent when the gag was gone. +</p> + +<p> +And hard work enough the poor child had to keep himself from screaming when his +limbs were loosed, so cramped was he, for he had been bound almost into a ball. +And even as we rubbed and chafed the cold hands and feet he swooned with the +pain of the blood running freely once more. +</p> + +<p> +“This is a business for mother,” said my father, on that; “get your supper, and +take it to bed with you, and say naught to the boys in the morning. This is a +thing that may not be talked of.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I should have liked to stay, but my father meant what he said, and I could +be of no more use; so I took my food, and went up to the loft where we three +slept, and knew no more of what trouble that night might have for others. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap03">CHAPTER III.<br/> +HAVELOK, SON OF GUNNAR.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now after I had gone, Grim, my father, tried to bring the child round, but he +could not do so; and therefore, leaving him near the fire, he went softly to +call Leva, my mother, to help him; and all the while he was wondering who the +child might be, though indeed a fear that he knew only too well was growing in +his heart, for there would surely he only one whom Hodulf could wish out of his +way. +</p> + +<p> +As he opened the door that led to the sleeping room beyond the high seat, the +light shone on Leva, and showed her sitting up in bed with wide eyes that +seemed to gaze on somewhat that was terrible, and at first he thought her +awake. But she yet slept, and so he called her gently, and she started and +woke. +</p> + +<p> +“Husband, is that you?” she said. “I had a strange dream even now which surely +portends somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +Now, as all men know, our folk in the north are most careful in the matter of +attending to dreams, specially those that come in troubled times, holding that +often warning or good counsel comes from them. I cannot say that I have ever +had any profit in that way myself, being no dreamer at all; but it is certain +that others have, as may be seen hereafter. Wherefore my father asked Leva what +this dream might be. +</p> + +<p> +“In my dream,” she answered, “it seemed that you came into the house bearing a +sack, which you gave into my charge, saying that therein lay wealth and good +fortune for us. And I would not believe this, for you said presently that to +gain this the sack and all that was therein was to be thrown into the sea, +which seemed foolishness. Whereon I cast it into a corner in anger, and +thereout came pitiful cries and wailings. Then said I that it were ill to drown +aught that had a voice as of a child, and so you bade me leave it. Then I +seemed to sleep here; but presently in my dream I rose and looked on the sack +again, and lo! round about it shone a great light, so that all the place was +bright, and I was afraid. Then you came and opened the sack, and therein was a +wondrous child, from whose mouth came a flame, as it were the shaft of a +sunbeam, that stretched over all Denmark, and across the sea to England, +whereby I knew that this child was one who should hereafter be king of both +these lands. And on this I stared even as you woke me.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Grim was silent, for this was passing strange, and moreover it fitted with +his thought of who this child might be, since Hodulf. would make away with him +thus secretly. +</p> + +<p> +“What make you of the dream?” asked Leva, seeing that he pondered on it. +</p> + +<p> +“It is in my mind that your dream will come true altogether, for already it has +begun to do so,” he answered. “Rise and come into the hall, and I will show you +somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +On that Leva made haste and dressed and came out, and there, lying as if in +sleep before the fire, was the wondrous child of her dream, and the sack was +under his head as he lay; and she was wont to say to those few who knew the +story, that the kingliness of that child was plain to be seen, as had been the +flame of which she had dreamed, so that all might know it, though the clothes +that he wore were such as a churl might be ashamed of. +</p> + +<p> +Then she cried out a little, but not loudly, and knelt by the child to see him +the better; and whether he had come to himself before and had dropped asleep +for very weariness, or out of his swoon had passed into sleep, I cannot say, +but at her touch he stirred a little. +</p> + +<p> +“What child is this? and how came he here?” she asked, wondering. +</p> + +<p> +“Already your dream has told you truly how he came,” Grim answered, “but who he +is I do not rightly know yet. Take him up and bathe him, wife; and if he is the +one I think him, there will be a mark whereby we may know him.” +</p> + +<p> +“How should he be marked? And why look you to find any sign thus?” +</p> + +<p> +But Grim had turned down the rough shirt and bared the child’s neck and right +shoulder, whereon were bruises that made Leva well-nigh weep as she saw them, +for it was plain that he had been evilly treated for many days before this. But +there on the white skin was the mark of the king’s line—the red four-armed +cross with bent ends which Gunnar and all his forebears had borne. +</p> + +<p> +Seeing that, Leva looked up wondering in her husband’s face, and he answered +the question that he saw written in her eyes. +</p> + +<p> +“He is as I thought—he is Havelok, the son of Gunnar, our king. Hodulf gave him +to me that I might drown him.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told her all that had happened, and how from the first time that he had +lifted the sack and felt what was within it he had feared that this was what +was being done. Hodulf would have no rival growing up beside him, and as he +dared not slay him openly, he would have it thought that he had been stolen +away by his father’s friends, and then folk would maybe wait quietly in hopes +that he would come again when time went on. +</p> + +<p> +Now Leva bathed Havelok in the great tub, and with the warmth and comfort of +the hot water he waked and was well content, so that straightway, when he was +dressed in Withelm’s holiday clothes, which fitted him, though he was but seven +years old at this time, and Withelm was a well-grown boy enough for his ten +winters, he asked for food, and they gave him what was yet on the board; and we +lived well in Denmark. +</p> + +<p> +“There is no doubt that he hath a kingly hunger,” quoth Grim as he watched him. +</p> + +<p> +“Friend,” said Havelok, hearing this, though it was not meant for his ears, “it +is likely, seeing that this is the third day since I have had food given me. +And I thank you, good people, though I would have you know that it is the +custom to serve the king’s son kneeling.” +</p> + +<p> +“How should we know that you are the king’s son indeed?” asked Grim. +</p> + +<p> +“I am Havelok, son of Gunnar,” the boy said gravely. “Yon traitor, Hodulf, has +slain my father, and my two sisters, and driven out my mother, whither I cannot +tell, and now he would drown me.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the boy could hardly keep a brave front any longer, and he added, “Yet I +do not think that you will do to me as I heard him bid you.” +</p> + +<p> +Then came over Grim a great pity and sorrow that it should seem needful thus to +sue to him, and there grew a lump in his throat, so that for a while he might +not answer, and the boy thought him in doubt, so that in his eyes there was a +great fear. But Leva wept outright, and threw herself on her knees beside him, +putting her arms round him as he sat, speaking words of comfort. +</p> + +<p> +Then Grim knelt also, and said, “Thralls of yours are we, Havelok, son of +Gunnar, and for you shall our lives be given before Hodulf shall harm you. Nor +shall he know that you live until the day comes when you can go to him sword in +hand and helm on head, with half the men of this realm at your back, and speak +to him of what he did and what he planned, and the vengeance that shall be +therefor.” +</p> + +<p> +So Grim took on himself to be Havelok’s foster-father, and, as he ended, the +boy said with glowing eyes, “I would that I were grown up. How long shall this +be before it comes to pass?” +</p> + +<p> +And then of a sudden he said, as a tired child will, “Friends, I am sorely +weary. Let me sleep.” +</p> + +<p> +So Leva took him in her arms and laid him in their own bed; and at once he +slept, so that she left him and came back to Grim by the fireside, for there +was much to be said. +</p> + +<p> +First of all it was clear that Havelok must be hidden, and it was not to be +supposed that Hodulf would be satisfied until he had seen the thrall to whom he +had trusted such a secret come back for his reward. If he came not he would be +sought; and then he would find out to whom he had spoken, and there would be +trouble enough. +</p> + +<p> +But it seemed easy to hide Havelok on board the ship, and sail with him to +England as soon as possible. A few days might well pass before a thrall could +get to Hodulf, so that he would suspect nothing just at first. There were +merchants in England who would care for the boy well, and the two boats might +be sunk, so that the king should not ask whose they were. So when Grim came +home again the fisher would be thought of as drowned on his errand, and Hodulf +would be content. +</p> + +<p> +But then, after a little talk of this, it was plain that all the town could not +be told to say that the fisher was drowned on such a night, and Hodulf would +leave naught undone to find the truth of the matter. So the puzzle became +greater, and the one thing that was clear was that Grim was in sore danger, and +Havelok also. +</p> + +<p> +Then suddenly outside the dogs barked, and a voice which they obeyed quieted +them. Grim sprang for his axe, which hung on the wall, and went to the door, +whereon someone was knocking gently. +</p> + +<p> +“Open, uncle; it is I, Arngeir.” +</p> + +<p> +“What does the boy want at this time?” said Grim, taking down the great bar +that kept the door, axe in hand, for one must be cautious in such times as +these. +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir came in—a tall young man of twenty, handsome, and like Grim in ways, +for he was his brother’s son. +</p> + +<p> +“Lucky am I in finding you astir,” he said. “I thought I should have had to +wake you all. Are you just home from sea, or just going out?” +</p> + +<p> +“Not long home,” answered Leva; “but what has brought you?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have a guest for you, if I may bring one here at this hour.” +</p> + +<p> +“A friend of yours never comes at the wrong time,” Grim said. “Why not bring +him in?” +</p> + +<p> +“If it were a friend of mine and a man he would do well enough at my house for +the night,” said Arngeir, smiling; “but the one for whom I have come is a lady, +and, I think, one in sore trouble.” +</p> + +<p> +“Who is she?” asked my mother, wondering much. +</p> + +<p> +“From the king’s town, certainly,” answered Arngeir, “but I do not know her +name. Truth to tell, I forgot to ask it, for she is sorely spent; and so I made +haste to come to you.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Leva would know how a lady came at this time to Arngeir’s house, for he +was alone, save for his four men, being an orphan without other kin beside us, +and his house was close to our shipyard and the sea. +</p> + +<p> +“She came not to me, but I found her,” he replied. “My horse is sick, and I +must get up an hour ago and see to it for the second time tonight. Then as I +came from the stable I saw someone go towards the shipyard, and, as I thought, +into the open warehouse. It was dark, and I could not tell then if this was man +or woman; but I knew that no one had business there, and there are a few things +that a thief might pick up. So I took an axe and one of the dogs, and went to +see what was on hand, but at first there was naught to be found of anyone. If +it had not been for the dog, I think that I should have gone away, but he went +into the corner where the bales of wool are set, and there he whined strangely, +and when I looked, there was this lady on the bales, and she was weeping and +sore afraid. So I asked her what was amiss, and it was not easy to get an +answer at first. But at last she told me that she had escaped from the burning +of the king’s town, and would fain be taken across the sea into some place of +peace. So I cheered her by saying that you would surely help her; and then I +took her to my house and came to you. Worn and rent are her garments, but one +may see that they have been rich, and I deem her some great lady.” +</p> + +<p> +“Go and bring her here, husband,” said my mother, on hearing that. +</p> + +<p> +But he was already going, and at once he and Arngeir went out and down the +street. There were many other ladies and their children who had taken refuge +here with the townsfolk after the burning, and the coming of this one was but +another count in the long tale of trouble that began on the Welsh shore with +the ways of Gunnar, the church’s bane. +</p> + +<p> +My father was long gone, and the day was breaking when he came back. My mother +slept in the great chair before the fire, for waiting had wearied her, but she +woke as she heard Grim’s footstep, and unbarred the door to him, ready to +welcome the guest that she looked for. But he was alone, and on his face was +the mark of some new trouble, and that a great one. +</p> + +<p> +He came in and barred the door after him, and then sat down wearily and ate for +the first time since we had had our meal at sea; and while he did so Leva asked +him nothing, wondering what was wrong, but knowing that she would hear in good +time. And when he had eaten well he spoke. +</p> + +<p> +“The lady is Eleyn the queen. She has been wandering for these many days from +place to place, sometimes in the woods, and sometimes in hiding in the cottages +of the poor folk, always with a fear of staying in one place, lest Hodulf +should find her, for it is known that he is seeking her. Then at last one told +her of my ship, and she is here to seek me.” +</p> + +<p> +Now one may know what the wonder and pity of my mother was, and she would fain +have gone to her. But Grim had left her at Arngeir’s house, for folk were +stirring in the town, and there were many who would know the queen if they saw +her. +</p> + +<p> +“It will soon be known that Arngeir has a guest,” my mother said, “whereas none +would have wondered had she been here.” +</p> + +<p> +“By this time tomorrow it will not matter if Hodulf knows,” answered Grim, “for +she will be safe.” +</p> + +<p> +“Where will you hide her then and what of Havelok?” +</p> + +<p> +“For those two there is no safety but across the sea, and they are the most +precious cargo that I shall ever have carried. Already Arngeir and the men are +at work on the ship, getting the rollers under her keel, that she may take the +water with the next tide. I shall sail with the tide that comes with the +darkness again, saying that I shall find cargo elsewhere in other ports, as I +have done once before.” +</p> + +<p> +“I had not looked to say farewell to you quite so soon,” my mother said; “but +this is right. Now I will have all things ready, that the queen shall be in +what comfort she may on the voyage. But it will be well that none shall know, +even of your seamen, who the passengers are, else will word go to Hodulf in +some way hereafter that Havelok has escaped.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have thought of that,” answered Grim. “It will be best that none, not even +Radbard, shall know who this is whom we have in the house. A chance word goes +far sometimes.” +</p> + +<p> +“The boy will tell his name.” +</p> + +<p> +“There are many who are named after him, and that is no matter. Do you speak to +him, for it is plain that he has sense enough, and bid him say naught but that +he and his mother have escaped from the town, and, if you will, that he escaped +in the sack. I will speak to Radbard, and there will be no trouble. Only +Arngeir must know the truth, and that not until we are on the high seas +perhaps.” +</p> + +<p> +So there seemed to be no more fear, and in an hour the house was astir, and +there was work enough for all in preparing for the voyage. As for me, I went +down to the ship with my father, and worked there. +</p> + +<p> +Now, I will say that not for many a long year did I know who this +foster-brother of mine was. It was enough for me to be told that he was the son +of some great man or other with whom Hodulf had a private feud. Nor did I ever +speak of that night’s work to any, for my father bade me not to do so. +Presently I knew, of course, that the lady was Havelok’s mother; but that told +me nothing, for I never heard her name. +</p> + +<p> +We worked at the ship for three hours or so, stowing the bales of wool and the +other little cargo we had; and then my father sent me to the fishing-boats for +a pair of oars belonging to the ship’s boat that were there, and, as it fell +out, it was a good thing that I and not one of the men went. When I came to the +place where they were drawn up on the beach, as we had left them last night, +there was a stranger talking to some of the fisher folk, who were working at +their nets not far off; and though another might have paid no heed to this, I, +with the remembrance of last night fresh in my mind, wondered if he was by any +chance there on an errand from Hodulf. I thought that, were I he, I should +surely send someone to know, at least, if the fisher went out last night after +I had spoken with him. So I loitered about until the man went away, which he +did slowly, passing close to me, and looking at the boats carefully, as if he +would remember them. Then I went and asked the men to whom he had been speaking +what he wanted. They said that they wondered that he had not spoken to me, for +he had been asking about my father and of his ship, and if he took any +passenger with him this voyage. It would seem that he wanted to sail with us, +from all he said. +</p> + +<p> +Certainly he had begun by asking whose boats these were, and wondered that a +merchant should go fishing at all, when there was no need for him to do so. +Also he had asked if Grim had been out last night, and they had of course told +him that he had not, for neither boat had been shifted from the berth she had +been given when we came in at dusk. +</p> + +<p> +“Ah,” he had said, “well did I wot that your merchant would do no night work,” +and so made a jest of the matter, saying that in his country it were below the +state of a merchant to have aught to do with a thrall’s work. He was certainly +a Norseman, and they thought that I should find him with my father. Now I +thought otherwise, and also I saw that all was known. This man was a spy of +Hodulf’s, and would go straight back to his master. My father must hear of this +at once; and I hurried back to the ship, and took him aside and told him. And +as I did so his face grew grey under the tan that sea and wind had given it, +and I knew not altogether why. +</p> + +<p> +“Tell Arngeir to come to me,” he said; “I am going to the jarl. Tell no one, +but go home and say to mother that I shall be with her in an hour. Then come +back and work here.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he and Arngeir went to Sigurd, and told him all from the beginning. And +when the jarl heard, he was glad for the safety of the queen and of Havelok, +but he said that there was no doubt that Denmark was no place for Grim any +longer. +</p> + +<p> +“That is my thought also,” said my father; “but now am I Havelok’s +foster-father, and for him I can make a home across the sea, where I will train +him up for the time that shall surely come, when he shall return and take his +father’s kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is well,” the jarl said, “but you have little time. What Hodulf will do +one cannot say, but he may come here with his men behind him to force me to +give you up, and the town will be searched for Havelok, and both he and the +queen will be lost.” +</p> + +<p> +“If that is so,” my father answered, “we have time enough. Two hours for the +spy to reach his master; one hour for Hodulf to hear him, and to bethink +himself; an hour for gathering his men; and four hours, at the least, in which +to get here. Eight hours, at the least, have we, and the tide serves in six. I +had thought of waiting till dark, but that is of no use now. We may as well go, +for there are true men here, who will wait to welcome him who flies when he +comes again.” +</p> + +<p> +“This is a sore wrench for you and yours, good friend and faithful,” Sigurd +said, “but it must be. Nevertheless I can make your loss as little as it may +be. You shall sell all that is yours to me at your own price, that you may have +the means to make a new home well, wherever you may choose.” +</p> + +<p> +At first my father would not have that, saying that there would be much trouble +on his account presently. +</p> + +<p> +But Sigurd said that, first, the trouble was not of his making at all; and +next, that if Hodulf plundered the place, it was as well to send away as much +as possible beforehand; and lastly—and this was what touched my father +most—that he must think of his charge. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, old friend, you are giving up all for Havelok, as would I. And am I to +have no share in the training of him for the days to come?” +</p> + +<p> +Therewith he waited for no more words, but went to his great chest, and took +thereout chain after chain of linked gold rings, and put them in a canvas bag, +without weighing or counting them, and gave them to Grim. +</p> + +<p> +“Lord, here is enough to buy half the town!” my father said. +</p> + +<p> +“What of that? The town is Havelok’s by right, and maybe you can buy him a +village across seas with it. But give me a full quittance for my purchase of +your goods and cattle and house, that I may have right to them.” +</p> + +<p> +That Grim did at once, before witnesses who were called in, none wondering that +he chose thus to secure his property while he was away, because Hodulf might +make demands on it. They did not know that any money changed hands, and thought +it formal only, and a wise thing to be done. +</p> + +<p> +After that Grim and Arngeir took leave of the jarl, thanking him, and they went +to our house. +</p> + +<p> +There waited my mother anxiously enough, for she knew from my message that +there was somewhat new to be told, or my father had not left the ship. Nor do I +think that what was to be done was altogether a surprise to her, for she had +thought much, and knew the dangers that might crop up. So, being very brave, +she strove to make light of the trouble that leaving her home cost her, and set +about gathering the few things that she could take. +</p> + +<p> +Now on the hearth sat Withelm, tending the fire, and he heard presently that we +were all to go to sea; and that pleased him well, for he had ever longed to +sail with his father. As for Havelok, he had waked once, and had well eaten, +and now was sleeping again. +</p> + +<p> +Then said Withelm, “When will the sacrifice to Aegir and Ran<a href="#fn5" +name="fnref5"><sup>[5]</sup></a> for luck on the swan’s path be?” +</p> + +<p> +“Scant time have we for that,” my father said, “for tide will not wait.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said the boy, “it were well to take the stone altar with us, and make +sacrifice on board. I have heard that Aegir is wrathful and strong.” +</p> + +<p> +Then my father said to Leva, “The boy is right in one thing, and that is, that +if we are to make a new home beyond the sea, the blue stones that have belonged +to our family since time untold should go with us, else will there be no luck +in this flitting.” +</p> + +<p> +“What matter?” +</p> + +<p> +“West they came with us in the days of Odin, and west they shall go with us +once more,” my father said. +</p> + +<p> +And there was an end of question on the matter, for presently Arngeir came up +with the team of oxen and a sled, and my father hastily cried to Thor as in +time of sudden war, and then on the sled they loaded the stones easily. I +helped, and it is certain that they were no trouble to uproot or lift, though +they were bedded in the ground and heavy. Wherefrom we all thought that the +flitting was by the will of the Norns, and likely to turn out well. +</p> + +<p> +But in no way could we lift Thor himself. It was as if he were rooted, and +maybe he was so. Therefore we left him, but sadly. +</p> + +<p> +One may suppose that, had any noticed that Grim was taking these sacred things +with him, there would have been a talk; but as we sailed light, none thought +them aught but needed ballast; and we brought other stones to the ship with +them and afterwards. +</p> + +<p> +Of course folk did wonder at this sudden sailing of ours, but my father made no +secret of his wish to get out of the way of Hodulf, who had taken the ships of +one or two other men elsewhere, so that all thought he feared that his would be +the next to be seized, and deemed him prudent in going. As for our own crew, +they were told that it was certain that the ship would be taken unless we went +on this tide, and so they worked well. +</p> + +<p> +Very early in the morning, and unseen, Arngeir had brought Eleyn, the queen, on +board, and she was in the cabin under the raised after deck all the while that +the bustle of making ready was going on. Only my father went in there at any +time, unless he gave the key to one of us, for there he kept his valuables and +the arms. +</p> + +<p> +Presently, when all the men were forward and busy, I got Havelok on board +unnoticed. We had kept Withelm running to and fro from ship to house with +little burdens all the morning, mightily busy; and then, when the chance came, +Havelok in Withelm’s clothes, and with a bundle on his head, came running to +me. I waited by the after cabin, and I opened the door quickly and let him in. +Then he saw his mother; and how those two met, who had thought each other lost +beyond finding, I will not try to say. +</p> + +<p> +I closed the door softly and left them, locking it again, and found Withelm +close to me, and Arngeir watching to see that all went well. +</p> + +<p> +Soon after that there came a Norseman, dressed as a merchant, who talked with +my father of goods, and lading, and whither he was bound, and the like. When he +went away, he thought that he had found out that we were for the Texel, but I +do not know that he was from Hodulf. There had been time for him to send a spy +in haste, however, if he wished to watch us; but at any rate this man heard +naught of our charges. +</p> + +<p> +Then, at the last moment, my mother and the children came on board, and at once +we hauled out of the harbour. I mind that an old woman ran along the wharf when +she found that all were going, and cried that Dame Leva had not paid for +certain fowls bought of her; and my father laughed in lightness of heart, and +threw her a silver penny, so that she let us go with a blessing. And after that +it did not matter what the people thought of this going of ours, for in an hour +we were far at sea with a fair wind on the quarter, heading south at first, +that the Norseman might see us, but when the land was dim astern, and there was +no more fear, bearing away south and west for the Humber in far-off England. +</p> + +<p> +Now that was the last I saw of Denmark for many a long year, and I knew it must +be so. But, as I have told, none but my father and mother, and now Arngeir, +knew all that we were carrying with us. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap04">CHAPTER IV.<br/> +ACROSS THE SWAN’S PATH.</a></h2> + +<p> +All that night, and during the morning of the next day, we sailed steadily with +a fresh northwest breeze that bade fair to strengthen by-and-by. If it held, we +should see the cliffs of Northumbria on our bow tomorrow morning, and then +would run down the coast to the Humber, where my father meant to put in first. +He thought to leave the queen and Havelok with merchants whom he knew in +Lindsey, and with them would stay my mother and the little ones while he made a +trading voyage elsewhere. There would be time enough to find out the best place +in which to make a home when the autumn came, and after he had been to an +English port or two that he did not know yet. +</p> + +<p> +When half the morning was past, the sun shone out warmly, and all came on deck +from the after cabin, where the ladies and children were. Our men knew by this +time that we had passengers, flying like ourselves from Hodulf, and therefore +they were not at all surprised to see Havelok and his mother with their +mistress. None of them had ever seen either of them before, as it happened, +though I do not think that any could have recognized the queen as she was then, +wan and worn with the terror of her long hiding. Very silent was she as she sat +on deck gazing ever at the long white wake of the ship that seemed to stretch +for a little way towards Denmark, only to fade away as a track over which one +may never go back. And silent, too, was my mother; but the children, who had no +care, were pleased with all things, and Raven and I were full of the ways of +old seamen. +</p> + +<p> +So everything went quietly until after we had our midday meal. We were all +amidships on the wide deck, except my father and Arngeir, who sat side by side +on the steersman’s bench on the high poop. There was no spray coming on board, +for we were running, and the ship was very steady. Raven and I were forward +with the men, busy with the many little things yet to be done to the rigging +and such like that had been left in the haste at last, and there was no thought +but that this quiet, save for some shift of wind maybe, would last until we saw +the English shore. +</p> + +<p> +Now I do not know if my father had seen aught from the after deck, but +presently he came forward, and passed up the steps to the forecastle, and there +sat down on the weather rail, looking out to leeward for some time quietly. I +thought that maybe he had sighted some of the high land on the Scots coast, for +it was clear enough to see very far, and so I went to see also. But there was +nothing, and we talked of this and that for ten minutes, when he said, “Look +and see if you can catch sight of aught on the skyline just aft of the fore +stay as you sit.” +</p> + +<p> +I looked long, and presently caught sight of something white that showed for a +moment as we heaved up on a wave, and then was gone. +</p> + +<p> +“Somewhat I saw,” I said, “but it has gone. It might have been the top of a +sail.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I caught a glimpse of it again, and my father saw it also, and, as we +watched, it hove up slowly until it was plain to be seen. The vessel it +belonged to was sailing in such a way as to cross our course in the end, though +she was only a few points nearer the wind than we were. It seemed that she was +swifter than ourselves, too, from the way she kept her place on our bow. Now a +merchant must needs look on every sail with more or less distrust, as there is +always a chance of meeting with ship-plundering Vikings, though the best of +them will do naught but take toll from a trader on the high seas. So before +long all our men were watching the stranger, and soon it was plain that she was +a longship, fresh from her winter quarters. We thought, therefore, that she was +not likely to trouble about us, having no need of stores as yet, and we being +plainly in ballast only. Nor did she alter her course in any way, but mile +after mile she sailed with us, always edging up nearer as she went, until at +last we could see the men on her bows and the helmsman at his place. +</p> + +<p> +I thought that one could hardly see a more handsome ship than she was, fresh +with new paint, and with her dragon head shining golden in the sun. But I had +seen her before, and that in no pleasant way. She was the ship of which I have +already spoken—that which we beat off two years ago, taking their cargo of +plunder by way of amends for being attacked. +</p> + +<p> +There was this difference, however, at that time, that then we had all our men +on board, and the Viking was short-handed after a fighting raid, whereas now we +had but fifteen men instead of five-and-twenty, because in the hurry we had not +had time to summon any who lived beyond the town, and it was plain that the +Viking had a full crew, maybe of sixty men. +</p> + +<p> +“It is in my mind,” my father said to Arngeir, “that our old foe will think +twice before he attacks us again; but seeing whom we have to deal with, it is +as well to be ready. We might keep him off with arrows, if he does not find out +how few we are, should he make an attempt on us; but if he boards, we must +submit, and make the best bargain we can.” +</p> + +<p> +So he passed word that the men were to lie down on deck, leaving only a few to +be seen, that the Viking might think us as he had known us before; and then the +arms-chests were opened, and the bows and throwing weapons were set to hand by +us boys while the men armed themselves. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father spoke to them, saying, “I do not know if this Viking will pass +us by as too hard a nut to crack, seeing that he knows of us already; but if he +does not, it will be of no use our trying to fight him, as you can see. I would +not waste your lives for naught. But it may be that a show of force will keep +him off, so we will wait under arms until we are sure what he will do.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the men broke out, saying that they had beaten this man before with him as +leader, and they were in no mind to give up without a fight. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then,” my father answered, “it is plain that you will back me, and so I +will call on you if there is need or chance. But we have the women folk to +think of now, and we must not risk aught.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the longship held on her course steadily, never shifting her helm for so +much as a point. In half an hour or so we must be alongside one another, at +this rate, and that Arngeir did not altogether like the look of, for it would +seem as if she meant to find out all about us at least. There was some little +sea running, and it might be thought easier to board us on the lee side, +therefore. We could not get away from her in any way, for even now, while she +was closer hauled than we, she kept pace with us, and had she paid off to the +same course as ourselves, she would have left us astern in a very short time. +</p> + +<p> +Presently a man swarmed up her rigging in order to look down on our decks, and +as he went up, my father bade our men crawl over to windward, so that he should +see all one gunwale lined with men, and so think that both were, and deem that +we were setting a trap for them in order to entice them alongside by pretending +to be hardly manned. At the same time, he sent the ladies and children into the +cabin, so that they might not be seen. +</p> + +<p> +That did not please Havelok at all, for he seemed to scent a fight in the air, +and wanted weapons, that he might stand beside the other men, asking for an axe +for choice. It was all that I could do to quiet him by saying that if there was +any need of him I would call him, but that just now we thought the Vikings +would go away if they saw many warriors on deck. Which indeed was all that we +hoped, but he thought that would spoil sport, and so hastened into the shelter. +</p> + +<p> +After that there fell a silence on us, for at any moment now we might be hailed +by the other ship. And when we were but a bow shot apart the hail came. The two +vessels were then broadside on to each other, we a little ahead, if anything. +My father was steering now, fully armed, and Arngeir was beside him with +myself. I had the big shield wherewith one guards the helmsman if arrows are +flying. +</p> + +<p> +The Viking bade us strike sail, and let him come alongside, but my father made +no answer. Still we held on, and the Viking paid off a little, as though he +were not so sure if it were wise to fall on us, as we showed no fear of him. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father spoke to Arngeir in a stern voice that I had heard only when we +met this same ship before. +</p> + +<p> +“This will not last long. If there is one chance for us, it is to run him down +and it may be done. Our ship will stand the blow, for these longships are but +eggshells beside her. Pass the word for the men to shoot the steersman when I +give the word. Then they must run forward, lest the Vikings climb over the bows +as we strike her.” +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir’s eyes flashed at that, and at once he went to the men, and there was a +click and rattle as the arrows went to string, and they gathered themselves +together in readiness to leap up when the word came. There seemed every chance +that we should be upon the longship before they knew what we were about, for we +had the weather gauge. +</p> + +<p> +Now the Viking hailed again, and again bore up for us a little, whereat my +father smiled grimly, for it helped his plan. And this time, as there was no +answer, his men sent an arrow or two on board, which did no harm. +</p> + +<p> +“It is plain that we are to be taken,” my father said on that, “so we will wait +no longer. Stand by, men, and one lucky shot will do all. Shoot!” +</p> + +<p> +The helm went up as he spoke, and the men leaped to their feet, raining arrows +round the two men who were at the helm, and down on the Viking we swept with a +great cheer. +</p> + +<p> +But in a moment there were four men on her after deck, and whether the first +helmsman was shot I cannot say; but I think not, for quickly as we had borne +down on her she was ready, rushing away from us, instead of luffing helplessly, +as we had expected. It would almost have seemed that our move had been looked +for. +</p> + +<p> +Ten more minutes passed while we exchanged arrow flights, and then the longship +had so gained on us that she struck sail and waited for us with her long oars +run out and ready. +</p> + +<p> +“That is all we can do,” said my father, with a sort of groan. “Put up your +weapons, men, for it is no good fighting now.” +</p> + +<p> +They did so, growling; and as we neared the longship, her oars took the water, +and she flew alongside of us, and a grappling hook flung deftly from her bows +caught our after gunwale, and at once she dropped astern, and swung to its +chain as to a tow line. We were not so much as bidden to strike sail now, and +the Vikings began to crowd forward in order to board us by the stern, as the +grappling chain was hove short by their windlass. +</p> + +<p> +“Hold on,” my father cried to them “we give up. Where is your chief?” +</p> + +<p> +Now the men were making way for him when a strange thing happened. Out of the +after cabin ran Havelok when he heard that word, crying that it was not the +part of good warriors to give up while they could wield sword—words that surely +he had learned from Gunnar, his father. And after him came his mother, silent, +and terrified lest he should be harmed. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok ran up the steps to my father, and the queen followed. I have said that +there was a little sea running, and this made the ships jerk and strain at the +chain that held them together fiercely, now that it was so short. And even as +the queen came to the top step, where there was no rail, for the steps were not +amidships, but alongside the gunwale, one of these jerks came; and in a moment +she was in the sea, and in a moment also Arngeir was after her, for he was a +fine swimmer. +</p> + +<p> +The Vikings cried out as they saw this, but the poor queen said no word, nor +did she ever rise again after the first time. It is likely that she was drawn +under the longship at once. +</p> + +<p> +So for a little while there was no talk of terms or fighting, but all held +their breath as they watched to see if the queen floated alongside anywhere; +but there was only Arngeir, who swam under the lee of the Viking, and called to +her men for guidance. They threw him a rope’s end as he came to the stern, and +he clung to it for a little while, hoping to see the flash of a white hood that +the queen wore, over the white wave crests: but at last he gave up, and the +Vikings hauled him on board, praising him for his swimming, as he had on his +mail. +</p> + +<p> +Then the chief turned to my father, and spoke to him across the few fathoms of +water that were between the ships. +</p> + +<p> +“We meet again, Grim, as time comes round; and now I have a mind to let you go, +though I have that old grudge against you, for I think that your wife is loss +enough.” +</p> + +<p> +“Not my wife, Arnvid, but a passenger—one whom I would not have lost for all +that you can take from me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I am glad it is no worse. But it seems that you are in ballast. How +comes it that you have no cargo for me, for you owe me one?” +</p> + +<p> +Then my father told him shortly that he had fled from Hodulf; and all those +doings were news to the Viking, so that they talked in friendly wise, while the +men listened, and the ships crept on together down the wind. +</p> + +<p> +But when all was told, save of the matter of Havelok, and who the lost lady +was, the Viking laughed shortly, and said, “Pleasant gossip, Grim, but not +business. What will you give us to go away in peace? I do not forget that you +all but ran us down just now, and that one or two of us have arrows sticking in +us which came from your ship. But that first was a good bit of seamanship, and +there is not much harm from the last.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said my father, “it seems to me that you owe me a ship, for it is +certain that I once had that one, and gave her back to you.” +</p> + +<p> +The Viking laughed. +</p> + +<p> +“True enough, and therefore I give you back your ship now, and we are quits. +But I am coming on board to see what property I can lift.” +</p> + +<p> +My father shrugged his shoulders, and turned away, and at once the Vikings +hauled on the chain until their dragon head was against our quarter, when the +chief and some twenty of his men came on board. The way in which they took off +the hatches without staying to question where they should begin told a tale of +many a like plundering. +</p> + +<p> +Then, I do not know how it was rightly, for I was aft with my father, there +began a quarrel between the Vikings and our men; and though both Grim and the +chief tried to stop it, five of our few were slain outright, and three more +badly hurt before it was ended. The rest of our crew took refuge on the fore +deck, and there bided after that. The whole fray was over in a few minutes, and +it seemed that the Vikings half expected somewhat of the sort. +</p> + +<p> +Then they took all the linen and woollen goods, and our spare sails, and all +the arms and armour from the men and from the chests to their own ship. Only +they left my father and Arngeir their war gear, saying that it were a shame to +disarm two brave men. +</p> + +<p> +Then the chief said, “Little cargo have you, friend Grim, and therefore I am +the more sure that you have store of money with you. Even flight from Hodulf +would not prevent you from taking that wherewith to trade. So I must have it; +and it rests with you whether we tear your ship to splinters in hunting for +your hiding place or not.” +</p> + +<p> +“I suppose there is no help for it, but I will say that the most of what I have +is not mine,” said my father. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, what matter? When one gives gold into the hands of a seafarer, one has to +reckon with such chances as this. You must needs hand it over.” +</p> + +<p> +So, as there was naught else to do, Grim brought out the jarl’s heavy bag, and +gave it to the chief, who whistled to himself as he hefted it. +</p> + +<p> +“Grim,” he said, “for half this I would have let you go without sending a man +on board. What is this foolishness? You must have known that.” +</p> + +<p> +“The gold is not mine,” my father answered; “it was my hope that you would have +been content with the cargo.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I have met with an honest man for once,” the Viking said; and he called +his men, and they cast off and left us. +</p> + +<p> +But we were in no happy plight when he had gone away to the eastward on his old +course. Half our men were gone, for the wounded were of no use, and the loss of +the queen weighed heavily on us. And before long it began to blow hard from the +north, and we had to shorten sail before there was real need, lest it should be +too much for us few presently, as it certainly would have been by the time that +darkness fell, for the gale strengthened. +</p> + +<p> +Then, added to all this, there was trouble in the cabin under the after deck, +for since his mother was lost, Havelok had spoken no word. I had brought him +down to my mother from the deck, and had left him with her, hoping that he did +not know what had happened; but now he was in a high fever, and sorely ill. +Perhaps he would have been so in any case, after the long days of Hodulf’s +cruelty, but he had borne them well. A child is apt, however, to give up, as it +were, suddenly. +</p> + +<p> +So, burdened with trouble, we drove before the gale, and the only pleasant +thing was to see how the good ship behaved in it, while at least we were on our +course all the time. Therefore, one could not say that there was any danger; +and but for these other things, none would have thought much of wind or sea, +which were no worse than we had weathered many a time before. We had sea room, +and no lee shore to fear, and the ship was stanch, and no sailor can ask for +more than that. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap05">CHAPTER V.<br/> +STORM AND SHIPWRECK.</a></h2> + +<p> +The gale held without much change through the night, and then with morning +shifted a few points to the westward, which was nothing to complain of. The sea +rose, and a few rain squalls came up and passed; but they had no weight in +them, and did not keep the waves down as a steady fall will. And all day long +it was the same, and the ship fled ever before it. There was no thought now of +reaching any port we might wish, but least of all did we think of making the +Lindsey shore, which lies open to the north and east. When the gale broke, we +must find harbour where we could; and indeed; to my father at this time all +ports were alike, as refuge from Hodulf. When darkness came again one of the +wounded men died, and Havelok was yet ill in the after cabin, so that my mother +was most anxious for him. The plunging ship was no place for a sick child. +</p> + +<p> +Now it was not possible for us to tell how far we had run since we had parted +from the Viking, and all we knew was that we had no shore to fear with the wind +as it was, and therefore nothing but patience was needed. But in the night came +a sudden lull in the gale that told of a change at hand, and in half an hour it +was blowing harder than ever from the northeast, and setting us down to the +English coast fast, for we could do naught but run before such a wind. It +thickened up also, and was very dark even until full sunrise, so that one could +hardly tell when the sun was above the sea’s rim. +</p> + +<p> +I crept from the fore cabin about this time, after trying in vain to sleep, and +found the men sheltering under the break of the deck and looking always to +leeward. Two of them were at the steering oar with my father, for Arngeir was +worn out, and I had left him in the cabin, sleeping heavily in spite of the +noise of waves and straining planking. Maybe he would have waked in a moment +had that turmoil ceased. +</p> + +<p> +It was of no use trying to speak to the men without shouting in their ears, and +getting to windward to do that, moreover, and so I looked round to see if there +was any change coming. But all was grey overhead, and a grey wall of rain and +flying drift from the wave tops was all round us, blotting out all things that +were half a mile from us, if there were anything to be blotted out. It always +seems as if there must be somewhat beyond a thickness of any sort at sea. But +there was one thing that I did notice, and that was that the sea was no longer +grey, as it had been yesterday, but was browner against the cold sky, while the +foam of the following wave crests was surely not so white as it had been, and +at this I wondered. +</p> + +<p> +Then I crawled aft and went to my father and asked him what he thought of the +wind and the chance of its dropping. He had had the lead going for long now. +</p> + +<p> +“We are right off the Humber mouth, to judge by the colour of the water,” he +told me, “or else off the Wash, which is more to the south. I cannot tell which +rightly, for we have run far, and maybe faster than I know. If only one could +see—” +</p> + +<p> +There he stopped, and I knew enough to understand that we were in some peril +unless a shift of wind came very soon, since the shore was under our lee now, +if by good luck we were not carried straight into the great river itself. So +for an hour or more I watched, and all the time it seemed that hope grew less, +for the sea grew shorter, as if against tide, and ever its colour was browner +with the mud of the Trent and her sisters. +</p> + +<p> +Presently, as I clung to the rail, there seemed to grow a new sound over and +amid all those to which I had become used—as it were a low roaring that swelled +up in the lulls, and sank and rose again. And I knew what it was, and held up +my hand to my father, listening, and he heard also. It was the thunder of +breakers on a sandy coast to leeward. +</p> + +<p> +He put his whistle to his lips and called shrilly, and the men saw him if they +could not hear, and sprang up, clawing aft through the water that flooded the +waist along the rail. +</p> + +<p> +“Breakers to leeward, men,” he cried “we must wear ship, and then shall clear +them. We shall be standing right into Humber after that, as I think.” +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir heard the men trampling, if not the whistle, and he was with us +directly, and heard what was to be done. +</p> + +<p> +“It is a chance if the yard stands it,” he said, looking aloft. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, but we cannot chance going about in this sea, and we are too short of men +to lower and hoist again. Listen!” +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir did so, and heard for the first time the growing anger of the surf on +the shore, and had no more doubt. We were then running with the wind on the +port quarter, and it was useless to haul closer to the wind on that tack, +whereas if we could wear safely we should be leaving the shore at once by a +little closer sailing. +</p> + +<p> +“Ran is spreading her nets,” said Arngeir, “but if all holds, she will have no +luck with her fishing.”<a href="#fn6" name="fnref6"><sup>[6]</sup></a> +</p> + +<p> +Then we manned the main sheet and the guys from the great yards, but we were +all too few for the task, which needed every man of the fifteen that we had +sailed with. There was the back stay to be set up afresh on the weather quarter +for the new tack also, and three men must see to that. +</p> + +<p> +We watched my father’s hand for the word, and steadily sheeted home until all +seemed to be going well. But the next moment there was a crash and a cry, and +we were a mastless wreck, drifting helplessly. Maybe some flaw of wind took us +as the head of the great sail went over, but its power was too much for the men +at guys and back stay, and they had the tackle torn through their hands. The +mast snapped six feet above the deck, smashing the gunwales as it fell forward +and overboard, but hurting none of us. +</p> + +<p> +Then a following sea or two broke over the stern, and I was washed from the +poop, for I had been at the sheet, down to the deck, and there saved myself +among the fallen rigging, half drowned. One of the men was washed overboard at +the same time, but a bight of the rigging that was over the side caught him +under the chin, and his mates hauled him on board again by the head, as it +were. He was wont to make a jest of it afterward, saying that he was not likely +to be hanged twice, but he had a wry neck from that day forward. +</p> + +<p> +No more seas came over us, for the wreck over the bows brought us head to wind, +though we shipped a lot of water across the decks as she rolled in the sea. +Then we rode to the drag of the fallen sail for a time, and it seemed quiet now +that there was no noise of wind screaming in rigging above us. But all the +while the thunder of the breakers grew nearer and plainer. +</p> + +<p> +I bided where I was, for the breath was knocked out of me for the moment. I saw +my father lash the helm, and then he and the rest got the two axes that hung by +the cabin door, and came forward with them. The mast was pounding our side in a +way that would start the planking before long, and it must be cut adrift, and +by that time I could join him. +</p> + +<p> +When that was done, and it did not take long, we cleared the anchor and cable +and let go, for it was time. The sound of the surf was drowning all else. But +the anchor held, and the danger was over for the while, and as one might think +altogether; but the tide was running against the gale, and what might happen +when it turned was another matter. +</p> + +<p> +Now we got the sail on deck again, and unlaced it from the yard, setting that +in place with some sort of rigging, ready to be stepped as a mast if the wind +shifted to any point that might help us off shore. +</p> + +<p> +It may be thought how we watched that one cable that held us from the waves and +the place where they broke, for therein lay our only chance, and we longed for +the clear light that comes after rain, that we might see the worst, at least, +if we were to feel it. But the anchor held, and presently we lost the feeling +of a coming terror that had been over us, the utmost peril being past. My +father went to the after cabin now, and though the poor children were bruised +with the heavy rolling of the ship as she came into the wind, they were all +well save Havelok, and he had fallen asleep in my mother’s arms at last. +</p> + +<p> +With the turn of the tide, which came about three hours after midday, the +clouds broke, and slowly the land grew out of the mists until we could see it +plainly, though it was hardly higher than the sea that broke over it in +whirling masses of spindrift. By-and-by we could see far-off hills beyond +wide-stretching marshlands that looked green and rich across yellow sandhills +that fringed the shore. And from them we were not a mile, and at their feet +were such breakers as no ship might win through, though, if we might wait until +they were at rest, the level sand was good for beaching at the neap tides. For +we were well into Humber mouth, and to the northward of us, across the yellow +water, was the long point of Spurn, and the ancient port of Ravenspur, with its +Roman jetties falling into decay under the careless hand of the Saxon, under +its shelter. There was no port on this southern side of the Humber, though +farther south was Tetney Haven and again Saltfleet, to which my father had +been, but neither in nor out of them might a vessel get in a northeast gale. +</p> + +<p> +I have said that this clearness came with the turn of the tide, and now that +began to flow strongly, setting in with the wind with more than its wonted +force, for the northwest shift of the gale had kept it from falling, as it +always will on this coast. That, of course, I learned later, but it makes plain +what happened next. Our anchor began to drag with the weight of both tide and +wind, and that was the uttermost of our dread. +</p> + +<p> +Slowly it tore through its holding, and as it were step by step at first, and +once we thought it stopped when we had paid out all the cable. But wind and sea +were too strong, and presently again we saw the shore marks shifting, and we +knew that there was no hope. The ship must touch the ground sooner or later, +and then the end would come with one last struggle in the surf, and on shore +was no man whose hand might be stretched to drag a spent man to the land, if he +won through. It would have seemed less lonely had one watched us, but I did not +know then that no pity for the wrecked need be looked for from the marshmen of +the Lindsey shore. There was not so much as a fisher’s boat of wicker and skins +in sight on the sandhills, where one might have looked to see some drawn up. +</p> + +<p> +Now my father went to the cabin and told my mother that things were at their +worst, and she was very brave. +</p> + +<p> +“If you are to die at this time, husband,” she said, “it is good that I shall +die with you. Better it is, as I think, than a sickness that comes to one and +leaves the other. But after that you will go to the place of Odin, to Valhalla; +but I whither?” +</p> + +<p> +Then spoke little Withelm, ever thoughtful, and now not at all afraid. +</p> + +<p> +“If Freya wants not a sailor’s wife who is willing to fight the waves with +Grim, my father, it will be strange.” +</p> + +<p> +My mother was wont to say that this saying of the child’s did much to cheer her +at that time, but there is little place for a woman in the old faiths. So she +smiled at him, and that made him bold to speak of what he had surely been +thinking since the storm began. +</p> + +<p> +“I suppose that Aegir is wroth because we made no sacrifice to him before we +set sail. I think that I would cast the altar stones to him, that he may know +that we meant to do so.” +</p> + +<p> +This sounds a child’s thought only, and so it was; but it set my father +thinking, and in the end helped us out of trouble. +</p> + +<p> +“I have heard,” my father said, “that men in our case have thrown overboard the +high-seat pillars, and have followed them to shore safely. We have none, but +the stones are more sacred yet. Overboard they shall go, and as the boat with +them goes through the surf we may learn somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +With that he hastened on deck, and told the men what he would do; and they +thought it a good plan, as maybe they would have deemed anything that seemed to +call for help from the strong ones of the sea. So they got the boat ready to +launch over the quarter, and the four stones, being uncovered since the Vikings +took our cargo, were easily got on deck, and they were placed in the bottom of +the boat, and steadied there with coils of fallen rigging, so that they could +not shift. They were just a fair load for the boat. Then my father cried for +help to the Asir, bidding Aegir take the altar as full sacrifice; and when we +had done so we waited for a chance as a long wave foamed past us, and launched +the boat fairly on its back, so that she seemed to fly from our hands, and was +far astern in a moment. +</p> + +<p> +Now we looked to see her make straight for the breakers, lift on the first of +them, and then capsize. That first line was not a quarter of a mile from us +now. +</p> + +<p> +But she never reached them. She plunged away at first, heading right for the +surf, and then went steadily westward, and up the shore line outside it, until +she was lost to sight among the wild waves, for she was very low in the water. +</p> + +<p> +“Cheer up, men,” my father said, as he saw that; “we are not ashore yet, nor +will be so long as the tide takes that current along shore. We shall stop +dragging directly.” +</p> + +<p> +And so it was, for when the ship slowly came to the place where the boat had +changed her course, the anchor held once more for a while until the gathering +strength of the tide forced it to drag again. Now, however, it was not toward +the shore that we drifted, but up the Humber, as the boat had gone; and as we +went the sea became less heavy, for we were getting into the lee of the Spurn +headland. +</p> + +<p> +Soon the clouds began to break, flying wildly overhead with patches of blue sky +and passing sunshine in between them that gladdened us. The wind worked round +to the eastward at the same time, and we knew that the end of the gale had +come. But, blowing as it did right into the mouth of the river, the sea became +more angry, and it would be worse yet when the tide set again outwards. Already +we had shipped more water than was good, and we might not stand much more. It +seemed best, therefore, to my father that we should try to run as far up the +Humber as we might while we had the chance, for the current that held us safe +might change as tide altered in force and depth. +</p> + +<p> +So we buoyed the cable, not being able to get the anchor in this sea, and then +stepped the yard in the mast’s place, and hoisted the peak of the sail +corner-wise as best we might; and that was enough to heel us almost gunwale +under as the cable was slipped and the ship headed about up the river mouth. We +shipped one or two more heavy seas as she paid off before the wind, but we were +on the watch for them, and no harm was done. +</p> + +<p> +After that the worst was past, for every mile we flew over brought us into +safer waters; and now we began to wonder where the boat with its strange cargo +had gone, and we looked out for her along the shore as we sailed, and at last +saw her, though it was a wonder that we did so. +</p> + +<p> +The tide had set her into a little creek that opened out suddenly, and there +Arngeir saw her first, aground on a sandbank, with the lift of each wave that +crept into the haven she had found sending her higher on it. And my father +cried to us that we had best follow her; and he put the helm over, while we +sheeted home and stood by for the shock of grounding. +</p> + +<p> +Then in a few minutes we were in a smother of foam across a little sand bar, +and after that in quiet water, and the sorely-tried ship was safe. She took the +ground gently enough in the little creek, not ten score paces from where the +boat was lying, and we were but an arrow flight from the shore. As the tide +rose the ship drifted inward toward it, so that we had to wait only for the ebb +that we might go dry shod to the land. +</p> + +<p> +Before that time came there was rest for us all, and we needed it sorely. It +was a wonder that none of the children had been hurt in the wild tossing of the +ship, but children come safely through things that would be hard on a man. +Bruised they were and very hungry, but somehow my mother had managed to steady +them on the cabin floor, and they were none the worse, only Havelok slept even +yet with a sleep that was too heavy to be broken by the worst of the tossing as +he lay in my mother’s lap. She could not tell if this heavy sleep was good or +not. +</p> + +<p> +Then we saw to the wounded men, and thereafter slept in the sun or in the fore +cabin as each chose, leaving Arngeir only on watch. It was possible that the +shore folk would be down to the strand soon, seeking for what the waves might +have sent them, and the tide must be watched also. +</p> + +<p> +Just before its turn he woke us, for it was needful that we should get a line +ashore to prevent the ship from going out with the ebb, and with one I swam +ashore. There was not so much as a stump to which to make fast, and so one of +the men followed me, and we went to the boat, set the altar stones carefully +ashore, then fetched the spare anchor, and moored her with that in a place +where the water seemed deep to the bank. +</p> + +<p> +It was a bad place. For when the tide fell, which it did very fast, we found +that we had put her on a ledge. Presently therefore, and while we were trying +to bail out the water that was in her, the ship took the ground aft, and we +could not move her before the worst happened. Swiftly the tide left her, and +her long keel bent and twisted, and her planks gaped with the strain of her own +weight, all the greater for the water yet in her that flowed to the hanging +bows. The good ship might sail no more. Her back was broken. +</p> + +<p> +That was the only time that I have ever seen my father weep. But as the stout +timbers cracked and groaned under the strain it seemed to him as if the ship +that he loved was calling piteously to him for help that he could not give, and +it was too much for him. The gale that was yet raging overhead and the sea that +was still terrible in the wide waters of the river had been things that had not +moved him, for that the ship should break up in a last struggle with them was, +as it were, a fitting end for her. But that by his fault here in the hardly-won +haven she should meet her end was not to be borne, and he turned away from us +and wept. +</p> + +<p> +Then came my mother and set her hand on his shoulder and spoke softly to him +with wise words. +</p> + +<p> +“Husband, but a little while ago it would have been wonderful if there were one +of us left alive, or one plank of the ship on another. And now we are all safe +and unhurt, and the loss of the ship is the least of ills that might have +been.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, wife,” he said; “you cannot understand.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then it is woe for the—for the one who is with us. But how had it been if you +had seen Hodulf and his men round our house, and all the children slain that +one might not escape, while on the roof crowed the red cock, and naught was +left to us? We have lost less than if we had stayed for that, and we have +gained what we sought, even safety. See, to the shore have come the ancient +holy things of our house, and that not by your guidance. Surely here shall be +the place for us that is best.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, wife; you are right in all these things, but it is not for them.” +</p> + +<p> +Then she laughed a little, forcing herself to do so, as it seemed. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, it is for the ship that I was ever jealous of, for she took you +away from me. Now I think that I should be glad that she can do so no more. But +I am not, for well I know what the trouble must be, and I would have you think +no more of it. The good ship has saved us all, and so her work is done, and +well done. Never, if she sailed many a long sea mile with you, would anything +be worth telling of her besides this. And the burden of common things would +surely be all unmeet for her after what she has borne hither.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is well said, Leva, my wife,” my father answered. +</p> + +<p> +From that time he was cheerful, and told us how it was certain that we had been +brought here for good, seeing that the Norns<a href="#fn7" +name="fnref7"><sup>[7]</sup></a> must have led the stones to the haven, so that +this must be the place that we sought. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap06">CHAPTER VI.<br/> +THE BEGINNING OF GRIMSBY TOWN.</a></h2> + +<p> +Easily we went ashore when the tide fell, across the spits of sand that ran +between the mud banks, and we climbed the low sandhill range that hid the land +from us, and saw the place where we should bide. And it might have been worse; +for all the level country between us and the hills was fat, green meadow and +marsh, on which were many cattle and sheep feeding. Here and there were groves +of great trees, hemmed in with the quickset fences that are as good as +stockades for defence round the farmsteads of the English folk, and on other +patches of rising ground were the huts of thralls or herdsmen, and across the +wide meadows glittered and flashed streams and meres, above which the wildfowl +that the storm had driven inland wheeled in clouds. All the lower hills seemed +to be wooded thickly, and the alder copses that would shelter boar and deer and +maybe wolves stretched in some places thence across the marsh. Pleasant and +homely seemed all this after long looking at the restless sea. +</p> + +<p> +Then said my father, “Now am I no longer Grim the merchant, and that pride of +mine is at an end. But here is a place where Grim the fisher may do well +enough, if I am any judge of shore and sea. Here have we haven for the boats, +and yonder swim the fish, and inland are the towns that need them. Nor have we +seen a sign of a fisher so far as we have come.” +</p> + +<p> +Now we had been seen as soon as we stood on the sandhills; and before long the +herdsman and thralls began to gather to us, keeping aloof somewhat at first, as +if fearing my father’s arms. But when we spoke with them we could learn +nothing, for they were Welsh marshmen who knew but little of the tongue of +their English masters. Serfs they were now in these old fastnesses of theirs to +the English folk of the Lindiswaras, who had won their land and called it after +their own name, Lindsey. +</p> + +<p> +But before long there rode from one of the farmsteads an Englishman of some +rank, who had been sent for, as it would seem, and he came with half a dozen +armed housecarls behind him to see what was going on. Him we could understand +well enough, for there is not so much difference between our tongue and that of +the English; and when he learned our plight he was very kindly. His name was +Witlaf Stalling, and he was the great man of these parts, being lord over many +a mile of the marsh and upland, and dwelling at his own place, Stallingborough, +some five miles to the north and inland hence. +</p> + +<p> +Now it had been in this man’s power to seize us and all we had as his own, +seeing that we were cast on his shore; but he treated us as guests rather, +bidding us shelter in one of his near farmsteads as long as we would, and +telling my father to come and speak with him when we had saved what we could +from the wreck. He bade the thralls help at that also, so that we had fallen in +with a friend, and our troubles were less for his kindness. +</p> + +<p> +We saved what cargo we had left during the next few days, while we dwelt at the +farm. Then at the height of the spring tides the ship broke up, for a second +gale came before the sea that the last had raised was gone. And then I went +with my father to speak with Witlaf the thane at Stallingborough, that we might +ask his leave to make our home on the little haven, and there become fishers +once more. +</p> + +<p> +That he granted readily, asking many questions about our troubles, for he +wondered that one who had owned so good a ship seemed so content to become a +mere fisher in a strange land, without thought of making his way home. But all +that my father told him was that he had had to fly from the new king of our +land, and that he had been a fisher before, so that there was no hardship in +the change. +</p> + +<p> +“Friend Grim,” said Witlaf when he had heard this, “you are a brave man, as it +seems to me, and well may you prosper here, as once before. I will not stand in +your way. Now, if you will hold it from me on condition of service in any time +of war, to be rendered by yourself and your sons and any men you may hire, I +will grant you what land you will along the coast, so that none may question +you in anything. Not that the land is worth aught to any but a fisher who needs +a place for boats and nets; but if you prosper, others will come to the place, +and you shall be master.” +</p> + +<p> +One could hardly have sought so much as that, and heartily did we thank the +kindly thane, gladly taking the fore shore as he wished. But he said that he +thought the gain was on his side, seeing what men he had won. +</p> + +<p> +“Now we must call the place by a name, for it has none,” he said, laughing. +“Grim’s Stead, maybe?” +</p> + +<p> +“Call the place a town at once,” answered my father, laughing also. “Grimsby +has a good sound to a homeless man.” +</p> + +<p> +So Grimsby the place has been from that day forward, and, as I suppose, will be +now to the end of time. But for a while there was only the one house that we +built of the timbers and planks of our ship by the side of the haven—a good +house enough for a fisher and his family, but not what one would look for from +the name. +</p> + +<p> +By the time that was built Havelok was himself again, though he had been near +to his death. Soon he waxed strong and rosy in the sea winds, and out-went +Withelm both in stature and strength. But it seemed that of all that had +happened he remembered naught, either of the storm, or of his mother’s death, +or of the time of Hodulf. My mother thought that the sickness had taken away +his memory, and that it might come back in time. But from the day we came to +the house on the shore he was content to call Grim and Leva father and mother, +and ourselves were his brothers, even as he will hold us even now. Yet my +father would never take him with us to the fishing, as was right, seeing who he +was and what might lie before him. Nor did he ever ask to go, as we had asked +since we were able to climb into the boat as she lay on the shore; and we who +knew not who he was, and almost forgot how he came to us, ceased to wonder at +this after a while; and it seemed right that he should be the home-stayer, as +if there must needs be one in every household. +</p> + +<p> +Nevertheless he was always the foremost in all our sports, loving the weapon +play best of all, so that it was no softness that kept him from the sea. I hold +that the old saw that says, “What is bred in the bone cometh out in the flesh,” +is true, and never truer than in the ways of Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +For it is not to be thought that because my father went back perforce to the +fisher’s calling he forgot that the son of Gunnar Kirkeban should be brought up +always in such wise that when the time came he should be ready to go to the +slayer of his father, sword in hand, and knowing how to use it. Therefore both +Havelok and we were trained always in the craft of the warrior. +</p> + +<p> +Witlaf the thane was right when he said that men would draw to the place if we +prospered, and it was not so long before the name that had been a jest at first +was so no longer. Truly we had hard times at first, for our one ship’s boat was +all unfitted for the fishing; but the Humber teemed with fish, and there were +stake nets to be set that need no boat. None seemed to care for taking the fish +but ourselves, for the English folk had no knowledge of the riches to be won +from the sea, and the eels of the river were the best that they ever saw. So +they were very ready to buy, and soon the name of Grim the fisher was known far +and wide in Lindsey, for my father made great baskets of the willows of the +marsh, and carried his burden of fish through the land, alone at first, until +we were able to help him, while Arngeir and we minded the nets. +</p> + +<p> +Only two of our men stayed here with us, being fishers and old comrades of my +father. The rest he bade find their way home to Denmark to their wives and +children, from the Northumbrian coast, or else take service with the king, +Ethelwald, who ruled in East Anglia, beyond the Wash, who, being a Dane by +descent from the Jutes who took part with Angles and Saxons in winning this new +land, was glad to have Danish men for his housecarls. Some went to him, and +were well received there, as we knew long afterwards. +</p> + +<p> +The man who had been washed overboard and hauled back at risk of his neck was +one of these. His name was Mord, and he would have stayed with us; but my +father thought it hard that he should not have some better chance than we could +give him here, for it was not easy to live at first. Somewhat of the same kind +he said to Arngeir, for he had heard of this king when he had been in the +king’s new haven in the Wash some time ago. But Arngeir would by no means leave +the uncle who had been as a father to him. +</p> + +<p> +Now when we marked out the land that Witlaf gave us, there was a good omen. My +father set the four blue altar stones at each corner of the land as the +boundaries, saying that thus they would hallow all the place, rather than make +an altar again of them here where there was no grove to shelter them, or, +indeed, any other spot that was not open, where a holy place might be. And when +we measured the distances between them a second time they were greater than at +first, which betokens the best of luck to him whose house is to be there. I +suppose that they will bide in these places now while Grimsby is a town, for, +as every one knows, it is unlucky to move a boundary stone. +</p> + +<p> +Soon my father found a man who had some skill in the shipwright’s craft, and +brought him to our place from Saltfleet. Then we built as good a boat as one +could wish, and, not long after that, another. But my father was careful that +none of the Lindsey folk whom he had known should think that this fisher was +the Grim whom they had once traded with, lest word should go to Hodulf in any +way. +</p> + +<p> +Now we soon hired men to help us, and the fishing throve apace. We carried the +fish even to the great city of Lincoln, where Alsi the Lindsey king had his +court, though it was thirty miles away. For we had men in the villages on the +road who took the great baskets on from one to another, and always Grim and one +of us were there on the market day, and men said that never had the town and +court seen such fish as Grim’s before. Soon, therefore, he was rich, for a +fisher; and that was heard of by other fishers from far off, and they drew to +Grimsby, so that the town spread, and Witlaf the good thane said that it was a +lucky day which drove us to his shore, for he waxed rich with dues that they +were willing to pay. We built boats and let them out to these men, so that one +might truly say that all the fishery was Grim’s. +</p> + +<p> +Then a trading ship put in, hearing of the new haven, and that was a great day +for us. But her coming made my father anxious, since Hodulf was likely to seek +for news of Grim the merchant from any who had been to England; and hearing at +last of him, he would perhaps be down on us, Vikingwise, with fire and sword. +But after that traders came and went, and we heard naught of him except we +asked for news; for he left us in peace, if he knew that his enemy lived yet. +Men said that he was not much loved in Denmark. +</p> + +<p> +So the town grew, and well did we prosper, so that there is naught to be said +of any more trouble, which is what my story seems to be made up of so far. Yet +we had come well through all at last; and that, I suppose, is what makes the +tale of any man worth hearing. +</p> + +<p> +Twelve years went all well thus, and in those years Havelok came to manhood, +though not yet to his full strength. What that would be in a few more summers +none could tell, for he was already almost a giant in build and power, so that +he could lift and carry at once the four great fish baskets, which we bore one +at a time when full of fish, easily, and it was he who could get a stranded +boat afloat when we could hardly move her between us, though all three of us +were strong as we grew up. +</p> + +<p> +Very handsome was Havelok also, and, like many very strong men, very quiet. And +all loved him, from the children who played along the water’s edge to the +oldest dame in the town; for he had a good word for all, and there was not one +in the place whom he had not helped at one time or another. More than one there +was who owed him life—either his own, or that of a child saved from the water. +</p> + +<p> +Most of all Havelok loved my father; and once, when he was about eighteen, he +took it into his head that he was burdensome to him by reason of his great +growth. So nothing would satisfy him but that he must go with us to the +fishing, though it was against Grim’s will somewhat. But he could make no hand +at it, seeing that he could pull any two of us round if he took an oar, and +being as likely as not to break that moreover. Nor could he bear the quiet of +the long waiting at the drift nets, when hour after hour of the night goes by +in silence before the herring shoal comes in a river of blue and silver and the +buoys sink with its weight; rather would he be at the weapon play with the sons +of Witlaf, our friend, who loved him. +</p> + +<p> +But though the fishing was not for him, after a while he would not be idle, +saying, when my father tried to persuade him to trouble not at all about our +work, that it was no shame for a man to work, but, rather, that he should not +do so. So one day he went to the old Welsh basket maker who served us, and bade +him make a great basket after his own pattern, the like of which the old man +had never so much as thought of. +</p> + +<p> +“Indeed, master,” he said, when it was done, “you will never be able to carry +so great a load of fish as that will hold.” +</p> + +<p> +“Let us see,” quoth Havelok, laughing; and with that he put him gently into it, +and lifted him into the air, and on to his mighty shoulder, carrying him +easily, and setting him down in safety. +</p> + +<p> +The basket maker was cross at first, but none was able to be angry with Havelok +long, and he too began to smile. +</p> + +<p> +“It is ‘curan’ that you are, master,” he said; “not even Arthur himself could +have done that.” +</p> + +<p> +“Many times have I heard your folk call me that. I would learn what it means,” +said Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +But the old man could hardly find the English word for the name, which means “a +wonder,” and nothing more. Nevertheless the marsh folk were wont to call their +friend “Hablok Curan” in their talk, for a wonder he was to all who knew him. +</p> + +<p> +So he came home with his great basket, and said, “Here sit I by the fire, +eating more than my share, and helping to win it not at all. Now will I make +amends, for I will go the fisher’s rounds through the marshlands with my +basket, and I think that I shall do well.” +</p> + +<p> +Now my father tried to prevent him doing this, because, as I know now, it was +not work for a king’s son. But Havelok would not be denied. +</p> + +<p> +“Fat and idle am I, and my muscles need hardening,” he said. “Let me go, +father, for I was restless at home.” +</p> + +<p> +So from that time he went out into the marshland far and wide, and the people +grew to know and love him well. Always he came back with his fish sold, and +gave money and full account to my father, and mostly the account would end +thus: +</p> + +<p> +“Four fish also there were more, but the burden was heavy, and so I even gave +them to a certain old dame.” +</p> + +<p> +And my mother would say, “It is likely that the burden was lighter for her +blessing.” +</p> + +<p> +And, truly, if the love of poor folk did help, Havelok’s burden weighed naught, +great though it was. +</p> + +<p> +Yet we thought little of the blessings of the Welsh folk of the marsh in those +days, for they blessed not in the names of the Asir, being sons of the British +Christians of long ago, and many, as I think, Christians yet. Witlaf and all +the English folk were Odin’s men, as we were, having a temple at the place +called Thor’s Way, among the hills. But we had naught to do with the faith of +the thralls, which was not our business. Only Withelm was curious in the +matter, and was wont to ask them thereof at times, though at first they feared +to tell him anything, seeing how the Saxons and English had treated the +Christian folk at their first coming. But that was forgotten now, by the +English at least, and times were quiet for these poor folk. There was a wise +man, too, of their faith, who lived in the wild hills not far from the city, +and they were wont to go to him for advice if they needed it. They said also +that the king of Lindsey had once been a Christian, for he was Welsh by birth +on his mother’s side, and had been so brought up. It is certain that his sister +Orwenna, who married Ethelwald of East Anglia, was one, but I have seen Alsi +the king at the feasts of the Asir at Thor’s Way when Yuletide was kept, so it +is not so certain about him. He had many Welsh nobles about him at the court, +kinsmen of his mother mostly, so that it did not seem strange, though there is +not much love lost between the English and the folk whom they conquered, as one +might suppose. +</p> + +<p> +Now, as I have said, none but Withelm thought twice about these things; but in +the end the love of the marsh folk was a thing that was needed, and that +Withelm had learned somewhat of their faith was the greatest help that could +be, as will be seen. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap07">CHAPTER VII.<br/> +BROTHERHOOD.</a></h2> + +<p> +True are the words of the Havamal, the song of the wisdom of Odin, which say, +“One may know and no other, but all men know if three know.” +</p> + +<p> +Therefore for all these years my father told none of us the secret of Havelok’s +birth; and when Arngeir married my sister Solva he made him take oath that he +would not tell what he knew to her, while she, being but a child at the time of +the flight, had forgotten how this well-loved brother of hers came to us. But +it happened once that Grim was sick, and it seemed likely that he would die, so +that this secret weighed on him, and he did not rightly know what to do for the +best, Havelok at the time being but seventeen, and the time that he should +think of his own place not being yet come. At that time he told Arngeir all +that he foresaw, and set things in order, that we three should not be backward +when need was. +</p> + +<p> +He called us to him, Havelok not being present, and spoke to us. +</p> + +<p> +“Sons,” he said, “well have you all obeyed me all these years, and I think that +you will listen to me now, for I must speak to you of Havelok, who came to us +as you know. Out of his saving from his foes came our flight here; and I will +not find fault with any of the things that happened, for they have turned out +well, save that it seems that I may never see the land of my birth again, and +at times I weary for it. For me Denmark seems to lie within the four square of +the ancient stones; but if you will do my bidding, you and Havelok shall see +her again, though how I cannot tell.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I could hardly speak for trouble, but Withelm said softly, “As we have +been wont to do, father, so it shall be.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well shall my word be kept, therefore,” Grim said, smiling on us. “Listen, +therefore. In the days to come, when time is ripe, Arngeir shall tell you more +of Havelok your foster-brother, and there will be signs enough by which he +shall know that it is time to speak. And then Havelok will need all the help +that you can give him; and as your lord shall you serve him, with both hands, +and with life itself if need be. And I seem to see that each of you has his +place beside him—Radbard as his strong helper, and Raven as his watchful +comrade, and Withelm as his counsellor. For ‘Bare is back without brother +behind it,’ son Radbard and ‘Ere one goes out, give heed to the doorways,’ son +Raven; and ‘Wisdom is wanted by him who fares widely’ son Withelm. So say the +old proverbs, and they are true. No quarreller is Havelok; but if he must +fight, that will be no playground. Careful is he; but he has met with no guile +as yet, and he trusts all men. Slow to think, if sure, are so mighty frames as +his becomes, even when quick wit is needed.” +</p> + +<p> +He was silent for a while, and I thought that he had no more to say, and I knew +that he had spoken rightly of what each was best fitted for, but he went on +once more. +</p> + +<p> +“This is my will, therefore, that to you shall Havelok be as the eldest brother +from this time forward, that these places shall not have to come suddenly to +you hereafter. Then will you know that I have spoken rightly, though maybe it +seems hard to Radbard and Raven now, they being so much older.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I said truly that already Havelok was first in our hearts. And that was +true, for he was as a king among us—a king who was served by all with loving +readiness, and yet one who served all. Maybe that is just what makes a good +king when all is said and done. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father bade us carry him out of the house and down to the shore where +there was a lonely place in the sandhills, covered with the sweet, short grass +that the sheep love; and, while Raven and I bore him, Withelm went and brought +Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“This is well, father,” he said gladly. “I had not thought you strong enough to +come thus far.” +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe it is the last time that I come living out of the house,” Grim said; +“but there is one thing yet to be done, and it must be done here. See, son +Havelok, these are your brothers in all but blood, and they must be that also +in the old Danish way.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nothing more is needed, father,” Havelok said, wondering. “I have no brothers +but these of mine, and they could be no more so.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat my father smiled, as well content, but he said that the ancient way +must he kept. +</p> + +<p> +“But I am sorely weak,” he added. “Fetch hither Arngeir.” +</p> + +<p> +It was because of this illness that none of us were at the fishing on that day, +and Arngeir was not long in coming. And while we waited for that little while +my father was silent, looking ever northward to the land that he had given up +for Havelok; and I think that foster-son of his knew it, for he knelt beside +him and set his strong arm round him, saying nothing. So Arngeir came with +Raven, who went for him, and my father told him what he needed to be done; and +Arngeir said that it was well thought of, and went to work with his seax on the +smooth turf. +</p> + +<p> +He cut a long strip where it seemed to be toughest, leaving the ends yet fast, +and carefully he raised it and stretched it until it would make an arch some +three spans high, and so propped it at either end with more turf that it stayed +in that position. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father said, “This is the old custom, that they who are of different +family should be brothers indeed. Out of one earth should they be made afresh, +as it were, that on the face of earth they shall be one. Pass therefore under +the arch, beginning with Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +Then, while my father spoke strange and ancient runes, Havelok did as he was +bidden, kneeling down and creeping under the uplifted turf; and as I came after +him he gave me his hand and raised me, and so with each of the other two. And +then, unbidden, Arngeir followed, for he too loved Havelok, and would fain be +his brother indeed. +</p> + +<p> +After that my father took a sharp flint knife that he had brought with him, and +with it cut Havelok’s arm a little, and each of us set his lips to that wound, +and afterwards he to the like marks in our right arms, and so the ancient rite +was complete. +</p> + +<p> +Yet it had not been needed, as I know, for not even I ever thought of him but +as the dearest of brothers, though I minded how he came. +</p> + +<p> +Now after this my father grew stronger, maybe because this was off his mind; +but he might never go to sea again, nor even to Lincoln town, for he was not +strong enough. What his illness was I do not rightly know, hut I do not think +that any one here overlooked him, though it might be that from across the sea +Hodulf had power to work him harm. It was said that he had Finnish wizards +about his court; but if that was so, he never harmed the one whom he had most +to fear—even Havelok. But then I suppose that even a Finn could not harm one +for whom great things are in store. +</p> + +<p> +So two years more passed over, and then came the time of which one almost fears +to think—the time of the great famine. Slowly it came on the land; but we could +see it coming, and the dread of it was fearsome, but for the hope that never +quite leaves a man until the end. For first the wheat that was winter sown came +not up but in scattered blades here and there, and then ere the spring-sown +grain had lain in the land for three weeks it had rotted, and over the rich, +ploughed lands seemed to rise a sour smell in the springtime air, when one +longs for the sweetness of growing things. And then came drought in April, and +all day long the sun shone, or if it were not shining the clouds that hid it +were hard and grey and high and still over land and sea. +</p> + +<p> +Then before the marsh folk knew what they were doing, the merchants of Lincoln +had bought the stored corn, giving prices that should have told men that it was +precious to those who sold as to the buyers; and then the grass failed in the +drought, and the farmers were glad to sell the cattle and sheep for what they +could gain, rather than see them starve. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father bade us dry and store all the fish we might against the time +that he saw was coming, and hard we worked at that. And even as we toiled, from +day to day we caught less, for the fish were leaving the shores, and we had to +go farther and farther for them, until at last a day came when the boats came +home empty, and the women wept at the shore as the men drew them up silently, +looking away from those whom they could feed no longer. +</p> + +<p> +That was the worst day, as I think, and it was in high summer. I mind that I +went to Stallingborough that day with the last of the fresh fish of yesterday’s +catch for Witlaf’s household, and it was hotter than ever; and in all the +orchards hung not one green apple, and even the hardy blackberry briers had no +leaves or sign of blossom, and in the dikes the watercress was blackened and +evil to see. +</p> + +<p> +But I will say that in Grimsby we felt not the worst, by reason of that wisdom +of my father, and always Witlaf and his house shared with us. Hard it was here, +but elsewhere harder. +</p> + +<p> +And then came the pestilence that goes with famine always. I have heard that +men have prayed to their gods for that, for it has seemed better to them to die +than live. +</p> + +<p> +With the first breath of the pestilence died Grim my father, and about that I +do not like to say much. He bade us remember the words he had spoken of Havelok +our brother, and he spoke long to Arngeir in private of the same; and then he +told us to lay him in mound in the ancient way, but with his face toward +Denmark, whence we came. And thereafter he said no more, but lay still until +there came up suddenly through the thick air a thunderstorm from the north; and +in that he passed, and with his passing the rain came. +</p> + +<p> +Thereof Withelm said that surely Odin fetched him, and that at once he had made +prayer for us. But the Welsh folk said that not Odin but the White Christ had +taken the man who had been a father to them, and had staved off the worst of +the famine from them. +</p> + +<p> +Then pined and died my mother Leva, for she passed in her sleep on the day +before we made the mound over her husband, and so we laid them in it together, +and that was well for both, as I think, for so they would have wished. +</p> + +<p> +So we made a great bale fire over my father’s mound, where it stood over the +highest sandhill; and no warrior was ever more wept, for English and Welsh and +Danes were at one in this. We set his weapons with him, and laid him in the +boat that was the best—and a Saxon gave that—and in it oars and mast and sail, +and so covered him therein. And so he waits for the end of all things that are +now, and the beginning of those better ones that shall be. +</p> + +<p> +That thunderstorm was nothing to the land, for it skirted the shores and died +away to the south, and after it came the heat again; but at least it brought a +little hope. There were fish along the shore that night, too, if not many; and +though they were gone again in the morning, there was a better store in every +house, for men were mindful of Grim’s teaching. +</p> + +<p> +Now, of all men, Havelok seemed to feel the trouble of the famine the most, +because he could not bear to see the children hungry in the cottages of the +fishers. It seemed to him that he had more than his share of the stores, +because so mighty a frame of his needed feeding mightily, as he said. And so +for two days after my father died and was left in his last resting, Havelok +went silent about the place. Here by the shore the pestilence hardly came, and +so that trouble was not added to us, though the weak and old went, as had Grim +and Leva, here and there. +</p> + +<p> +Then, on the third day, Havelok called Arngeir and us, and spoke what was in +his mind. +</p> + +<p> +“Brothers, I may not bear this any longer, and I must go away. I can do no more +to help than can the weakest in the town; and even my strength is an added +trouble to those who have not enough without me. Day by day grows the store in +the house less; and it will waste more slowly if I am elsewhere.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Arngeir said quickly, “This is foolishness, Havelok, my brother. Whither +will you go? For worse is the famine inland; and I think that we may last out +here. The fish will come back presently.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will go to Lincoln. All know that there is plenty there, for the townsfolk +were wise in time. There is the court, and at the court a strong man is likely +to be welcome, if only as one who shall keep the starving poor from the doors, +as porter.” +</p> + +<p> +He spoke bitterly, for Alsi, the king, had no good name for kindness, and at +that Withelm laughed sadly. +</p> + +<p> +“Few poor would Havelok turn away,” he said, under his breath; “rather were he +likely to take the king’s food from the very board, and share it among them.” +</p> + +<p> +That made us laugh a little, for it was true enough; and one might seem to see +our mighty one sweeping the table, while none dared try to stay him. +</p> + +<p> +But many times of late Havelok had gone dinnerless, that he might feed some +weak one in the village. Maybe some of us did likewise; but, if so, we learned +from him. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then,” Havelok said, when we had had our wretched laugh, “Alsi, the +king, can better afford to feed me than can anyone else. Therefore, I will go +and see about it. And if not the king, then, doubtless, some rich merchant will +give me food for work, seeing that I can lift things handily. But Radbard here +is a great and hungry man also, and it will be well that he come with me; or +else, being young and helpless, I may fall into bad hands.” +</p> + +<p> +So he spoke, jesting and making little of the matter. But I saw that he was +right, and that we who were strong to take what might come should go away. It +was likely that a day of our meals would make a week’s fare for Arngeir’s three +little ones, and they were to be thought for. +</p> + +<p> +Now for a little while Arngeir tried to keep us back; but it was plain that he +knew also that our going was well thought of, and only his care for Havelok +stood in the way. Indeed, he said that I and Raven might go. +</p> + +<p> +“Raven knows as much about the fish as did our father,” Havelok said. “He will +go out in the morning, and look at sky and sea, and sniff at the wind; and if I +say it will be fine, he says that the herrings will be in such a place; and so +they are, while maybe it rains all day to spite my weather wisdom. You cannot +do without Raven; for it is ill to miss any chance of the sea just now. Nor can +Withelm go, for he knows all in the place, and who is most in want. It will not +do to be without house steward. So we two will go. Never have I been to Lincoln +yet, and Radbard knows the place well.” +</p> + +<p> +I think that I have never said that Grim would never take Havelok to the city, +lest he should be known by some of the Danish folk who came now and then to the +court, some from over seas, and others from the court of King Ethelwald, of +whom I have spoken, the Norfolk king. But that danger was surely over now, for +Havelok would be forgotten in Denmark; and Ethelwald was long dead, and his +wife also, leaving his daughter Goldberga to her uncle Alsi, as his ward. So +Alsi held both kingdoms until the princess was of age, when she would take her +own. It was said that she lived at Dover until that time, and so none of her +Danes were likely to be at court if we went there and found places. +</p> + +<p> +So Havelok’s plan was to be carried out, and he and I were to set forth next +morning. Arngeir was yet uneasy about it, nevertheless, as one could see; but I +did not at that time know why it should be so doubtful a matter that two strong +men should go forth and seek their fortune but thirty miles away. So we laughed +at him. +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” he said, “every one knows Radbard; but they will want to know who his +tall comrade may be. Old foes has Havelok, as Radbard knows, and therefore it +may be well to find a new name for him.” +</p> + +<p> +“No need to go far for that,” Withelm said. “The marsh folk call him Curan.” +</p> + +<p> +“Curan, the wonder, is good,” Arngeir said, after a little thought, for we all +knew Welsh enough by this time. “Or if you like a Danish name better, brother, +call it ‘Kwaran,’ but silent about yourself you must surely be.” +</p> + +<p> +We used to call him that at times—for it means “the quiet” in our old +tongue—seeing how gentle and courtly he was in all his ways. So the name was +well fitting in either way. +</p> + +<p> +“Silent and thoughtful should the son of a king be,” says the Havamal, and so +it was with Havelok, son of Gunnar. +</p> + +<p> +Now when I came to think, it was plain that we three stood in the mind of our +brother in the place which my father had boded for us, and I was glad. Well I +knew that Raven, the watchful, and Withelm, the wise and thoughtful, would do +their parts; and I thought that whether I could do mine was to be seen very +shortly. If I failed in help at need it should not be my fault. It had been +long growing in my mind who Havelok must be, though I said nothing of what I +thought, because my father had bidden me be silent long ago, and I thought that +I knew why. +</p> + +<p> +We were to start early in the morning, so that we should get to the city +betimes in the evening; and there was one thing that troubled the good sisters +more than it did us. They would have had us go in all our finery, such as we +were wont to wear on holidays and at feastings; but none of that was left. It +had gone in buying corn, while there was any left to buy, along with every +silver penny that we had. So we must go in the plain fisher gear, that is made +for use and not for show, frayed and stained, and a trifle tarry, but good +enough. It would not do to go in our war gear into a peaceful city; and so we +took but the seax that every Englishman wears, and the short travelling spear +that all wayfarers use. Hardly was it likely that even the most hungry outlaw +of the wild woldland would care to fall on us; for by this time such as we +seemed had spent their all in food for themselves and their families, and all +the money in Lindsey seemed to have gone away to places where there was yet +somewhat to buy. +</p> + +<p> +Busy were those kind sisters of ours that night in making ready the last meal +that we should need to take from them. And all the while they foretold pleasant +things for us at the king’s court—how that we should find high honour and the +like. So they set us forth well and cheerfully. +</p> + +<p> +With the dawn we started, and Havelok was thoughtful beyond his wont after we +had bidden farewell to the home folk, so that I thought that he grieved for +leaving them at the last. +</p> + +<p> +“Downhearted, are you, brother?” I said, when we had gone a couple of miles in +silence across the level. “I have been to Lincoln two or three times in a month +sometimes in the summer, and it is no great distance after all. I think nothing +of the journey, or of going so short a way from home.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nor do I,” he answered. “First, I was thinking of the many times my father, +Grim, went this way, and now he can walk no more; and then I was thinking of +that empty cottage we passed just now, where there was a pleasant little family +enough three months ago, who are all gone. And then—ay, I will tell you—I had a +dream last night that stays in my mind, so that I think that out of this +journey of ours will come somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +“Food and shelter, to wit,” said I, “which is all we want for a month or two. +Let us hear it.” +</p> + +<p> +“If we get all that I had in that dream, we shall want no more all our lives,” +he said, with a smile; “but it seems a foolish dream, now that I come to tell +it.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is mostly the way with dreams. It is strange how wonderful they seem +until daylight comes. I have heard Witlaf’s gleeman say that the best lays he +ever made were in his sleep; but if he remembered aught of them, they were +naught.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is not like that altogether with my dream,” Havelok said, “for it went +thus. I thought that I was in Denmark—though how I knew it was Denmark I cannot +say—and on a hill I sat, and at my feet was stretched out all the land, so that +I could see all over it at once. Then I longed for it, and I stretched out my +arms to gather it in, and so long were they that they could well fathom it, and +so I drew it to myself. With towns and castles it was gathered in, and the keys +of the strongholds fell rattling at my feet, while the weight of the great land +seemed to lie on my knees. Then said one, and the voice was the voice of Grim, +‘This is not all the dream that I have made for you, but it is enough for now.’ +That is the dream, therefore, and what make you of it?” +</p> + +<p> +“A most amazing hunger, brother, certainly, and promise of enough to satisfy it +withal. I think that the sisters have talked about our advancement at court +until you have dreamed thereof.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why,” he said, “that is surely at the bottom of the dream, and I am foolish to +think more of it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then we went on, and grew light hearted as the miles passed. But though I had +seemed to think little of the dream, it went strangely with my thoughts of what +might lie before Havelok in days to come. +</p> + +<p> +As we went inland from the sea, the track of the pestilence was more dread, for +we passed house after house that had none living in them, and some held the +deserted dead. I might say many things of what we saw, but I do not like to +think of them much. Many a battlefield have I seen since that day, but I do not +think them so terrible as the field over which has gone the foe that is unseen +ere he smites. One knows the worst of the battle when it is over and the roll +is called, but who knows where famine and pestilence stay? And those have given +life for king or land willingly, but these were helpless. +</p> + +<p> +It was good to climb the welds and look back, for in the high lands there was +none of this. Below us the levels, with their bright waters, were wrapped in a +strange blue haze, that had come with the famine at its worst, and, as men +said, had brought or made the sickness. I had heard of it; but it was not so +plain when one was in it, or else our shore was free, which is likely, seeing +how little we suffered. +</p> + +<p> +After that we kept to the high land, not so much fearing the blue robe of the +pestilence as what things of its working we might see; and so it was late in +the afternoon that we came in sight of Lincoln town, on its hill, with the wide +meres and river at its feet. I have seen no city that stands more wonderfully +than this of ours, with the grey walls of the Roman town to crown the gathering +of red and brown roofs that nestle on the slope and within them. And ever as we +drew nearer Havelok became more silent, as I thought because he had never seen +so great a town before, until we passed the gates of the stockade that keeps +the town that lies without the old walls, and then he said, looking round him +strangely, “Brother, you will laugh at me, no doubt, for an arrant dreamer, but +this is the place whereto in dreams I have been many a time. Now we shall come +to yon turn of the road among the houses, and beyond that we shall surely see a +stone-arched gate in a great wall, and spearmen on guard thereat.” +</p> + +<p> +It was so, and the gate and guard were before us in a few more steps. It was +the gate of the old Roman town, inside which was the palace of the king and one +or two more great houses only. Our English kin hate a walled town or a stone +house, and they would not live within the strong walls, whose wide span was, +save for the king’s palace, which was built partly of the house of the Roman +governor, and these other halls, which went for naught in so wide a meadow, +empty and green, and crossed by two paved roads, with grass growing between the +stones. There were brown marks, as of the buried stones of other foundations, +on the grass where the old streets had been. +</p> + +<p> +All the straggling English town was outside the walls, and only in time of war +would the people use them as a stronghold, as they used the still more ancient +camps on the hills. +</p> + +<p> +“Many times have you heard us tell of this place, Havelok,” I said. “It is no +wonder that you seem to know it.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” he answered, “but this is the city of my dreams, and somewhat is to +happen here.” +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap08">CHAPTER VIII.<br/> +BERTHUN THE COOK.</a></h2> + +<p> +For that night we went to the house of the old dame with whom my father and I +were wont to lodge when we came to the market, and she took us in willingly, +though she could make little cheer for us. Truly, as had been said, the +scarcity was not so great in Lincoln, but everything was terribly dear, and +that to some is almost as bad. +</p> + +<p> +“No money have I now, dame,” I said ruefully, “but I think that for old sake’s +sake you will not turn us away.” +</p> + +<p> +“Not I, faith,” she answered. “I mind the first day your father came here, and +never a penny had he, and since then there has been no want in this house. Luck +comes with Grim and his folk, as I think. But this is a son whom I have not +seen before, if he is indeed your brother.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am Grim’s son Curan,” said Havelok, “and I have not been to Lincoln ere +this. But I have heard of you many times.” +</p> + +<p> +That pleased our old hostess, and then she asked after Grim. Hard it was to +have to tell her that he was gone, and hard it was for her to hear, for the +little house had been open to us for ten years. +</p> + +<p> +“What will you do now, masters?” she asked, when she had told us of many a +kindness done to her and her husband, who was long dead now, by my father. +</p> + +<p> +I told her that we were too many at home since the fishing had failed, and had +therefore come to find some work here, at the court if possible. +</p> + +<p> +“Doubtless two strong men will not have to go far to find somewhat,” she said; +“but the court is full of idle folk, and maybe no place is empty. Now I will +have you bide with me while you are at a loose end, for there are yet a few +silver pennies in store, and I ween that they came out of Grim’s pouch to me. +Lonely am I, and it is no good hoarding them when his sons are hungry.” +</p> + +<p> +We thanked her for that kind saying, but she made light of it, saying that +almost did she hope that we should find no work, that we might bide and lighten +her loneliness for a time. +</p> + +<p> +“But if an old woman’s advice is good for aught, you shall not go to the court +first of all. Sour is King Alsi, and he is likely to turn you away offhand +rather than grant the smallest boon. But there is Berthun the cook, as we call +him—steward is his court name though—and he orders the household, and is +good-natured, so that all like him. Every morning he comes into the market, and +there you can ask him if there is a place for you, and he loves to look on a +man such as Curan. But if it is weapons you want—and I suppose that is in the +minds of tall men always, though it brings sorrow in the end—there is the +captain of the guard who lives over the gate, and he might be glad to see you +enough.” +</p> + +<p> +We said that we would see the steward, for we wanted no long employment. We +would go back to Grimsby when the famine ended, if it were only by the coming +of the fish again. +</p> + +<p> +Then she gave us of the best she had—black bread and milk to wit; and after +that we slept soundly before the fire, as I had done many times before in that +humble house. Black bread and milk it was again in the morning; but there was +plenty, and goodwill to season it. Then the old dame sent us forth cheerfully +and early, that we might not miss Berthun the steward, from whom she hoped +great things for us. +</p> + +<p> +So we sat in the marketplace for an hour or more watching the gates of the wall +for his coming; and men stared at Havelok, so that we went to the bridge and +waited there. One could see all the market from thence. There were a good many +of the market folk coming in presently, and most of them knew me, and more than +one stopped and spoke. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok grew restless, and wandered here and there looking at things, +though not going far from me; and while I was thus alone on the bridge, a man I +knew by sight came and leaned on the rail by me, and told me that he had just +seen the most handsome man and the goodliest to look on that was in the +kingdom, as he thought. +</p> + +<p> +“Yonder he stands,” he said, “like a king who has fallen on bad times. I mind +that I thought that Alsi, our king, would look like that, before I saw him, and +sorely disappointed was I in him therefore. Now I wonder who yon man may be?” +</p> + +<p> +I did not say that I knew, but I looked at Havelok, and for the first time, +perhaps because I had never seen him among strangers before, I knew that he was +wondrous to look on. Full head and shoulders was he above all the folk, and the +Lindseymen are no babes in stature. And at the same moment it came to me that +it were not well that men should know him as the son of Grim the fisher. If my +father, who was the wisest of men, had been so careful for all these years, I +must not be less so; for if there were ever any fear of the spies of Hodulf, it +would be now when his foe might be strong enough in years to think of giving +trouble. Not that I ever thought much of the said Hodulf, seeing how far off he +was; but my father had brought me up to dread him for this brother of mine. +Certainly by this time Hodulf knew that Grim had come to England in safety, for +the name of the new town must have come to his ears: and if Grim, then the boy +he had given to him. +</p> + +<p> +The man who spoke to me went away soon, and Havelok strolled back to me. +</p> + +<p> +“I would that the cook, or whoever he is, would come,” he said. “I grow weary +of this crowd that seems to have naught to do but stare at a stranger.” +</p> + +<p> +“What shall we ask, when he does come? and supposing that there is a place for +but one of us?” I said. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, the one it fits best will take it, and the other must seek some +other chance. That is all.” +</p> + +<p> +“As you will, brother,” I answered, “but I would rather that we should be +together.” +</p> + +<p> +“And I also. But after all, both will be in Lincoln, and we must take what +comes. It is but for a little while, and we shall not like to burden that good +old dame by being too hard to please. We want somewhat to do until we can go +home, not for a day longer, and I care not what it is.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is right,” I said; “and the sooner I see one of our folk coming over this +bridge with a full basket of fish, the better I shall like it. But it may be a +long day before that. Now, I have been thinking that it were not well that you +should say that you are the son of Grim.” +</p> + +<p> +I did not quite know how he would take this, for he was proud of my father as +I. But that very pride made it easy. +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe not,” he said thoughtfully, “for it seems unworthy of his sons that we +have to ask for service from any man. But I do not think that he could blame +us, as things are. Nevertheless, folk shall not talk.” +</p> + +<p> +“Men know me,” said I, “but that cannot be helped.” +</p> + +<p> +He laughed gaily at that. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, here we speak as if one man in a hundred knew you. And after all it may +be that we shall get a place that none need be ashamed of. Look, here comes a +mighty fine lord from the gateway.” +</p> + +<p> +It was Berthun the steward, for whom we were waiting, and I knew him well by +sight. Often had he bought our fish, but I did not think that he would remember +me by name, if he had ever heard it. He was a portly and well-favoured man, not +old, and as he came down the street to the marketplace at the hill foot he +laughed and talked with one and another of the townsfolk, whether high or low, +in very pleasant wise. +</p> + +<p> +Presently he stopped at a stall, and priced some meat; and when he had bought +it he looked round and called for some men to carry it for him; and at that the +idlers made a rush for him, tripping over one another in haste to be first, +while he laughed at them. +</p> + +<p> +He chose two or three, and sent them up the hill to the palace with their +burdens, and then went to another booth and bought. +</p> + +<p> +“This is work at which I should make a good hand,” said Havelok, laughing at +the scrambling men who ran forward when the steward again called for porters. +“Well paid also the job must be, to judge of their eagerness.” +</p> + +<p> +The three men who had been chosen took their burden and went away, and the +steward came near us, to a bakery that was close to the bridge end. +</p> + +<p> +“I have a mind to do porter for once,” Havelok said. “Then I can at least earn +somewhat to take back to the dame tonight.” +</p> + +<p> +“If you do so,” I answered, “I will wait here for you. But you will have to +fight for the place.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the steward bought all that he needed, and that was bread for the whole +palace for the day, and again he called for porters. Whereon Havelok got up +from the bridge rail and went towards him in no great hurry, so that the idlers +were in a crowd before him. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho! friends,” cried Havelok, “let the good cook see all of us and make his +choice. He can only take one at a time.” +</p> + +<p> +“One, forsooth,” said a man from the crowd; “why, there is a load for four men +there.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, let him pick four little ones, and give these little ones a chance +of being seen.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I do not think that he would have troubled with the matter any more; but +whether the men knew that this was the last load that the steward had to send +home, or whether they quarrelled, I cannot say, but in their eagerness to raise +the two great baskets they fell to struggling over them, and the steward tried +to quiet the turmoil by a free use of his staff, and there was a danger that +the bread should be scattered. +</p> + +<p> +“Here will be waste of what there is none too much of just now,” said Havelok; +and with that he went to the aid of the steward, picking up and setting aside +the men before him, and then brushing the struggling rivals into a ruefully +wondering heap from about the baskets, so that he and the steward faced each +other, while there fell a silence on the little crowd that had gathered. Even +the men who had been put aside stayed their abuse as they saw what manner of +man had come to the rescue of the baskets, and Havelok and the cook began to +laugh. +</p> + +<p> +“Fe, fi, fo, fum!” said Berthun; “here is surely a Cornish giant among us! Now +I thank you, good Blunderbore, or whatever your name is, for brushing off these +flies.” +</p> + +<p> +“The folk in this place are unmannerly,” said Havelok; “hut if you want the +bread carried up the hill I will do it for you.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun looked him up and down in a puzzled sort of way once or twice ere he +answered, “Well, as that is your own proposal, pick your helpers and do so; I +would not have asked such a thing of you myself.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is not much help needed,” said Havelok. “I think this may be managed if +I get a fair hold.” +</p> + +<p> +Now we were used to seeing him carry such loads as would try the strength of +even Raven and myself, who could lift a load for three men; but when he took +the two great baskets of bread and swung them into place on either arm, a +smothered shout went round the crowd, and more than once I heard the old Welsh +name that the marsh folk had given him spoken. +</p> + +<p> +“Let us be going,” said Havelok to the steward on that. “One would think that +none of these had ever hefted a fair load in his life, to listen to them.” +</p> + +<p> +So he nodded to me across the heads of the crowd, and followed Berthun, and the +idlers followed him for a little. The guard turned these back at the gate, and +Havelok went through, and I could see him no more. +</p> + +<p> +Presently the crowd drifted back to their places, and I heard them talking. +Havelok and his strength was likely to be a nine days’ wonder in Lincoln, and I +was glad that I had asked him not to say whence he was. +</p> + +<p> +“He is some thane’s son who is disguised,” said one. +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe he is under a vow,” said another; and then one chimed in with a story of +some prince of Arthur’s time, by name Gareth, who hid his state at his mother’s +command. +</p> + +<p> +“As for me,” said the baker, “I think that he is a fisher, as he looks—at +least, that is, as his clothes make him.” +</p> + +<p> +So even he had his doubts, and I will say that I understood well enough now why +my father never brought him here before. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok was long in coming back, as I thought, and I seemed to be wasting time +here, and so I bethought me of the other man to whom the old dame had said we +might go—namely, the captain of the gate. I should see Havelok if I stood +there. +</p> + +<p> +The captain was talking with some of his men as I came up, and of course it was +of Havelok that they spoke; and seeing that I wore the same dress as he, they +asked me if I knew who he was. +</p> + +<p> +“He is a fisher from the coast,” I answered. “I have heard him called Curan.” +</p> + +<p> +“Welsh then,” the captain answered, somewhat disappointed, as it seemed. “If he +had been a Mercian, or even a Saxon, I would have had him here, but a fisher +has had no training in arms after all.” +</p> + +<p> +“Some of us have,” said I. +</p> + +<p> +The captain looked me up and down, and then walked round me, saying nothing +until we were face to face again. +</p> + +<p> +“That, I take it, is a hint that you might like to be a housecarl of the +king’s,” he said. “Are you a Lindseyman?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am the son of Grim of Grimsby,” I said. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, I suppose you would not think of it, seeing that my place is not +empty; but if you will dress in that way you must not wonder if I took you for +a likely man for a housecarl. We know Grim well by repute. Come in and tell me +about the famine, and this new town of yours that one hears of.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I could not see Havelok as yet, and so I went into the stone-arched Roman +guardroom, and Eglaf the captain fetched out a pot of wine and some meat, and +made me very welcome while we talked. And presently I thought that I might do +worse than be a housecarl for a time, if Eglaf would have me. I should be armed +at least, and with comrades to help if Havelok needed me; though all the while +I thought myself foolish for thinking that any harm could come to him who was +so strong. Nevertheless, what my father had laid on us all was to be heeded, +and I was to be his helper in arms. So presently I told Eglaf that the +housecarl’s life seemed an easy one, and that it would be pleasant to go armed +for a while, if he would have me for a short time, seeing that the famine had +left us naught to do. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, there is plenty to eat and drink,” he said, “and good lodging in the +great hall or here, as one’s post may be, and a silver penny every day; but no +fighting to be done, seeing that Alsi will sooner pay a foe to go away than let +us see to the matter. Doing naught is mighty hard work at times.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he asked if I had arms, and I said that I would send for them at once, and +that settled the matter. If I chose to come with my own arms I should be +welcome. +</p> + +<p> +“I am glad to get you,” he said, “for there will be a crowd in the place ere +long, for the Witan is to meet, and the thanes will come with their men, and +there will be fine doings, so that we need another strong arm or two that we +may keep the peace,” +</p> + +<p> +He took a long pull at the wine pot, and then went on, “Moreover, the +princess’s Danes are sure to want to fight some of the English folk for sport.” +</p> + +<p> +“What! is she here?” +</p> + +<p> +“Not yet. They say that she is coming when the Witan meets, because the Witan +wants to see her, not because Alsi does. But he dare not go against them, and +so it must be.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Goldberga, the princess, was, as I have said, Alsi’s ward, and was at this +time just eighteen, so that it would be time for her to take the kingdom that +was hers by right. It was common talk, however, that Alsi by no means liked the +thought of giving the wide lands of East Anglia up to her, and that he would +not do so if he could anywise help it. Maybe the Witan thought so also, and +would see fair play. Ethelwald and his wife Orwenna had been well loved both +here and in Norfolk, and it was said that Goldberga their daughter grew +wondrous fair and queenly. +</p> + +<p> +I had learned one thing though, and that was that we should have Ethelwald’s +Danes here shortly, and that I did not like; but after all, what did these few +men of an old household know of the past days in Denmark? There had been no +going backwards and forwards between the two countries since the king died ten +years ago. Nevertheless I was glad that I had found a friend in Eglaf, and that +I was to be here. +</p> + +<p> +Then I got up to go, and the captain bade me come as soon as I could, for he +could talk to me as he could not to the men, maybe. So I bade him farewell, and +went slowly back, down the street, sitting down in the old place. +</p> + +<p> +It was not long after that before Havelok came, and I saw Berthun the steward +come as far as the gate with him, and stand looking after him as he walked +away; then Eglaf came out, and both looked and talked for a while, and +therefore, as soon as I knew that Havelok saw me, I went away and across the +bridge to a place that was quiet, and waited for him there. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, brother,” I said, “you have had a long job with the cook. What is the +end of it all?” +</p> + +<p> +“I do not know,” he answered slowly. “That is to be seen yet.” +</p> + +<p> +I looked at him, for his voice was strange, and I saw that he seemed to have +the same puzzled look in his eyes as he had last night when we came first into +the city. I asked if anything was amiss. +</p> + +<p> +“Nothing,” he said; “but this is a place of dreams. I think that I shall wake +presently in Grimsby.” +</p> + +<p> +We walked on, and past the straggling houses outside the stockade, and so into +the fields; and little by little he told me what was troubling him. +</p> + +<p> +Berthun the steward had said nothing until the palace was reached, and had led +him to the great servants’ hall, and there had bidden him set down his load and +rest. Then he had asked if he would like to see the place, and of course +Havelok had said that he would, wondering at the same time if this was all the +pay that the porters got. So he was shown the king’s hall, and the arms on the +wall, and the high seat, and the king’s own chamber, and many more things, and +all the while they seemed nothing strange to Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“This Berthun watched me as a cat watches a mouse all the while,” he said, “and +at last he asked if I had ever seen a king’s house before. I told him that I +had a dream palace which had all these things, but was not the same. And at +that he smiled and asked my name. ‘Curan,’ I said, of course; and at that he +smiled yet more, in a way that seemed to say that he did not believe me. ‘It is +a good name for the purpose,’ he said, ‘but I have to ask your pardon for +calling you by the old giant’s name just now.’ I said that as he did not know +my name, and it was a jest that fitted, it was no matter. Then he made a little +bow, and asked if I would take any food before I went from the place; so I told +him that it was just what I came for, and he laughed, and I had such a meal as +I have not seen for months. It is in my mind that I left a famine in that +house, so hungry was I. There is no pride about this Berthun, for he served me +himself, and I thanked him.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok stopped and passed his hand over his face, and he laughed a +little, uneasy laugh. +</p> + +<p> +“And all the while I could not get it out of my head that he ought to be +kneeling before me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” he went on after a little, “when I had done, this Berthun asked me a +question, saying that he was a discreet man, and that if he could help me in +any way he would do so. Had I a vow on me? Nothing more than to earn my keep +until the famine was over, I said. I had left poor folk who would have the more +for my absence, and he seemed to think that this was a wondrous good deed. So I +told him that if he could help me in this I should be glad. Whereon he lowered +his voice and asked if I must follow the way of Gareth the prince. I had not +heard of this worthy, and so I said that what was good enough for a prince was +doubtless good enough for me, and that pleased him wonderfully. +</p> + +<p> +“‘Gladly will I take you into my service,’ he said, ‘if that will content you.’ +Which it certainly would; and so I am to be porter again tomorrow. Then I said +that I had a comrade to whom I must speak first. He said that no doubt word +must be sent home of my welfare, and he saw me as far as the gate.” +</p> + +<p> +“Which of you went out of the hall first?” I asked. +</p> + +<p> +“Now I come to think of it, I did. I went to let him pass, as the elder, though +it was in my mind to walk out as if the place belonged to me; and why, I do not +know, for no such thought ever came to me in Witlaf’s house, or even in a +cottage; but he stood aside and made me go first.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I longed for Withelm and his counsel, for one thing was plain to me, and +that was that with the once familiar things of the kingship before him the lost +memory of his childhood was waking in Havelok, and I thought that the time my +father boded was at hand. The steward had seen that a court and its ways were +no new thing to him, and had seen too that he had been wont to take the first +place somewhere; so he had deemed that this princely-looking youth was under a +vow of service, in the old way. It is likely that the Welsh name would make him +think that he was from beyond the marches to the west, and that was just as +well. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok said, “Let us go back to the widow’s house and sleep. My head +aches sorely, and it is full of things that are confused, so that I do not know +rightly who I am or where. Maybe it will pass with rest.” +</p> + +<p> +We turned hack, and then I told him what I meant to do; and that pleased him, +for we should see one another often. +</p> + +<p> +“We are in luck, brother, so far,” he said, “having lit on what we needed so +soon; but I would that these dreams would pass.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is the poor food of many days gone by,” I said. “Berthun will cure that for +you very shortly.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is likely enough,” he answered more gaily. +</p> + +<p> +“Little want is in that house, but honest Berthun does not know what a +trencherman he has hired. But I would that we had somewhat to take back to our +good old dame tonight.” +</p> + +<p> +But she was more than satisfied with our news; and when she saw that Havelok +was silent, she made some curious draught of herbs for him, which he swallowed, +protesting, and after that he slept peacefully. +</p> + +<p> +I went out to the marketplace and found a man whom I knew—one of those who +carried our fish at times; and him I sent, with promise of two silver pennies +presently, to Arngeir for my arms, telling him that all was well. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap09">CHAPTER IX.<br/> +CURAN THE PORTER.</a></h2> + +<p> +There is no need for me to say how my arms came to me from Grimsby, and how I +went to Eglaf as I had promised. I will only say that the life was pleasant +enough, if idle, as a housecarl, and that I saw Havelok every day at one time +or another, which was all that I could wish. +</p> + +<p> +But as I had to wait a day or two while the messenger went and the arms came +from home, I saw Havelok meet the steward on the next day: and a quaint meeting +enough it was, for Berthun hardly knew how he should behave to this man, whom +he had made up his mind was a wandering prince. +</p> + +<p> +There was the crowd who waited for the call for porters, as ever; hut the +steward would have none of them, until he saw his new man towering over the +rest, and then he half made a motion to unbonnet, which he checked and turned +into a beckoning wave of the hand, whereon the idlers made their rush for him, +and Havelok walked through and over them, more or less, as they would not make +way for him. But so good-naturedly was this done, that even those whom he +lifted from his path and dropped on one side laughed when they saw who had +cleared a way for himself, and stood gaping to see what came next. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho—why, yes—Curan—that was the name certainly. I have been looking for you, as +we said,” stammered the steward. +</p> + +<p> +“Here am I, therefore,” answered Havelok, “and where is the load?” +</p> + +<p> +“Truth to tell, I have bought but this at present,” said the steward, pointing +to a small basket of green stuff on the stall at which he stood. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I suppose there is more to come,” Havelok said, taking it up; “it will +be a beginning.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will not ask you to carry more than that,” Berthun began. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, man, this is foolishness. If you have a porter, make him carry all he +can, else he will not earn his keep.” +</p> + +<p> +“As you will,” answered the steward, shrugging his shoulders as one who cannot +account for some folk’s whims, and going on to the next booth. +</p> + +<p> +Now, I suppose that the idlers looked to see Havelok walk away with this light +load gladly, as any one of them would have done, and that then their turn would +have come; but this was not what they expected. Maybe they would have liked to +see the strong man sweep up all the palace marketing and carry it, as a show, +but it might interfere with their own gains. So there was a murmur or two among +them, and this grew when Havelok took the next burden in like manner. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, master cook,” cried a ragged man at last, “this is not the custom, and it +is not fair that one man should do all the work, and all for one wage.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun took no notice of this; and so the cry was repeated, and that by more +than one. And at last he turned round and answered. +</p> + +<p> +“Go to, ye knaves,” he said with a red face and angrily; “if I find a man who +will save me the trouble of your wrangles every day, shall I not do as I +please?” +</p> + +<p> +Then there was a tumult of voices, and some of them seemed sad, as if a last +hope was gone, and that Havelok heard. +</p> + +<p> +“There is somewhat in this,” he said to the cook. “What pay have you given to +each man who carries for you?” +</p> + +<p> +“A yesterday’s loaf each,” answered Berthun, wondering plainly that Havelok +paid any heed to the noise. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, let us go on, and we will think of somewhat,” Havelok said; and +then he turned to the people, who were silent at once. +</p> + +<p> +“I am a newcomer, and a hungry one,” he said, smiling quietly, “and I have a +mind to earn my loaf well. Hinder me not for today, and hereafter I will take +my chance with the rest, if need is.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat the folk began to laugh also, for it was plain that none had any chance +at all if he chose to put forth his strength; but an old man said loudly, “Let +the good youth alone now, and he shall talk with us when he has done his errand +and fed that great bulk of his. He has an honest face, and will be fair to +all.” +</p> + +<p> +That seemed to please the crowd; and after that they said no more, but followed +and watched the gathering up of Havelok’s mighty burden. And presently there +was more than he could manage; and he spoke to Berthun, who checked himself in +a half bow as he answered. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok looked over the faces before him, and beckoned to two men who +seemed weakly and could not press forward, and to them he gave the lighter +wares, and so left the market with his master, as one must call the steward. +</p> + +<p> +“What told I you?” said the old man, as they came back from the great gate. +“Never saw I one with a face like that who harmed any man, either in word or +deed.” +</p> + +<p> +Now when Havelok had set down his load in the kitchen, he straightened himself +and said to Berthun, who was, as one may say, waiting his pleasure. +</p> + +<p> +“This is today’s task; but it is in my mind that I would stay up here and +work.” +</p> + +<p> +“What would you do?” +</p> + +<p> +“There are men yonder who will miss the carrying if I am market porter always. +But here are things I can earn my keep at, and help the other servants with at +the same time. Water drawing there is, and carrying of logs for the fire, and +cleaving them also, and many other things that will be but hardening my +muscles, while they are over heavy to be pleasant for other folk.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” answered Berthun, “that is all I could wish, and welcome to some here +will you be. Let it be so.” +</p> + +<p> +“Now, I do not think that you would make a gain by my work this morning?” +</p> + +<p> +“Truly not, if any one is wronged by my doing so,” the puzzled steward said. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok asked how many men would have been needed to carry up the goods +that he had brought, and Berthun said that he was wont to send one at least +from each stall, and more if the burden was heavy. +</p> + +<p> +“Then today four poor knaves must go dinnerless by reason of my strength, and +that does not please me altogether,” said Havelok gravely. “Give these two +their loaves; and then, I pray you, give me the other four, and let me go back +to the market.” +</p> + +<p> +And then he added, with a smile, “I think that I can order matters there so +that things will be more fair, and that you will have less trouble with that +unmannerly scramble.” +</p> + +<p> +“If you can do that, you are even as your name calls you. Take them and +welcome, Curan, and then come here and do what work you will,” Berthun said in +haste. +</p> + +<p> +“Tasks you must set me, or I shall grow idle. That is the failing of over-big +men,” Havelok said; and he took the loaves and left the palace with the two +market men at his heels. +</p> + +<p> +I saw him come back, and at once the crowd of idlers made for him, but in a +respectful way enough. I knew, however, how easily these folks took to throwing +mud and stones in their own quarrels, and I was a little anxious, for to +interfere with the ways of the market is a high offence among them. +</p> + +<p> +But Havelok knew naught of that, and went his way with his loaves to the bridge +end, and there sat on the rail and looked at the men before him. And <i>lo!</i> +back to my mind came old days in Denmark, and how I once saw Gunnar the king +sitting in open court to do justice, and then I knew for certain that I was +looking on his son. And when Havelok spoke it was in the voice of Gunnar that I +had long forgotten, but which came back to me clear and plain, as if it were +yesterday that I had heard it. Never does a boy forget his first sight of the +king. +</p> + +<p> +“Friends,” said Havelok, “if I do two men’s work I get two men’s pay, or else I +might want to know the reason why. But I am only one man, all the same, and it +seems right to me that none should be the loser. Wherefore I have a mind to +share my pay fairly.” +</p> + +<p> +There was a sort of shout at that and Havelok set his four loaves in a row on +the rail beside him. But then some of the rougher men went to make a rush at +them, and he took the foremost two and shook them, so that others laughed and +bade the rest beware. +</p> + +<p> +“So that is just where the trouble comes in,” said Havelok coolly; “the strong +get the first chance, as I did this morning, by reason of there being none to +see fair play.” +</p> + +<p> +“Bide in the market, master, and we will make you judge among us,” cried a +small man from the edge of the crowd. +</p> + +<p> +“Fair and softly,” Havelok answered. “I am not going to bide here longer than I +can help. Come hither, grandfer,” and he beckoned to the old man who had bidden +them wait his return, “tell me the names of the men who have been longest +without any work.” +</p> + +<p> +The old man pointed out three, and then Havelok stopped him. +</p> + +<p> +“One of these loaves is my own wage,” he said; “but you three shall have the +others, and that will be the easiest day’s work you ever did. But think not +that I am going to do the like every day, for Lincoln hill is no easy climb, +and the loaf is well earned at the top. Moreover, it is not good to encourage +the idle by working for them.” +</p> + +<p> +So the three men had their loaves, and Havelok began to eat his own slowly, +swinging his legs on the bridge rail while the men watched him. +</p> + +<p> +“Master,” said the small man from behind, pushing forward a little, now that +the crowd was looser, “make a law for the market, I pray you, that all may have +a chance.” +</p> + +<p> +“Who am I to make laws?” said my brother slowly, and, as he said this, his hand +went up to his brows as it had gone last night when the palace had wearied him. +</p> + +<p> +“The strong make laws for the weak,” the old man said to him in a low voice. +“If the strong is honest, for the weak it is well. Things are hard for the weak +here; and therefore say somewhat, for it may be of use.” +</p> + +<p> +“It can be none, unless the strong is at hand to see that the law is kept.” +</p> + +<p> +“Sometimes the market will see that a rule is not broken, for itself. There is +no rule for this matter.” +</p> + +<p> +Again Havelok passed his hand over his eyes, and he was long in answering. The +loaf lay at his side now. Presently he looked straight before him, and, as if +he saw far beyond Lincoln Hill and away to the north, he said, “This is my +will, therefore, that from this time forward it shall be the law that men shall +have one among them who may fairly and without favour so order this matter that +all shall come to Berthun the steward in turns that shall be kept, and so also +with the carrying for any other man. There shall be a company of porters, +therefore, which a man must join before he shall do this work, save that every +stranger who comes shall be suffered to take a burden once, and then shall be +told of this company, and the custom that is to be. And I will that this old +man shall see to this matter.” +</p> + +<p> +And then he stopped suddenly, and seemed to start as a great shout went up from +the men, a shout as of praise; and his eyes looked again on them, and that +wonderingly. +</p> + +<p> +“They will keep this law,” said the old man. “Well have you spoken.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have said a lot of foolishness, maybe,” answered Havelok. “For the life of +me I could not say it again.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is not one of us that could not do so,” said his adviser. “But bide you +here, master, in the town?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am in service at the palace.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the old man turned round to the others and said, “This is good that we +have heard, and it is nothing fresh, for all trades have their companies, and +why should not we? Is this stranger’s word to be kept?” +</p> + +<p> +Maybe there were one or two of the rougher men who held their peace, for they +had had more than their share of work, but from the rest came a shout of “Ay!” +as it were at the Witan. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then,” said Havelok suddenly, getting down from his seat and giving his +loaf to the old man, “see you to it; and if any give trouble hereafter, I shall +hear from the cook, and, by Odin, I will even come down and knock their heads +together for them. So farewell.” +</p> + +<p> +He smiled round pleasantly, yet in that way which has a meaning at the back of +it; and at that every cap went off and the men did him reverence as to a thane +at least, and he nodded to them and came across to me. +</p> + +<p> +“Come out into the fields, brother, for I shall weep if I bide here longer.” +</p> + +<p> +So he said; and we went away quickly, while the men gathered round the old +leader who was to be, and talked earnestly. +</p> + +<p> +“This famine plays strange tricks with me,” he said when we were away from +every one. “Did you hear all that I said?” +</p> + +<p> +“I heard all, and you have spoken the best thing that could have been said. +Eight years have I been to this market, and a porters’ guild is just what is +needed. And it will come about now.” +</p> + +<p> +“It was more dreaming, and so I must be a wise man in my dream. Even as in the +palace yesterday it came on me, and I seemed to be at the gate of a great hall, +and it was someone else that was speaking, and yet myself. It is in my mind +that I told these knaves what my lordly will was, forsooth; and the words came +to me in our old Danish tongue, so that it was hard not to use it. But it seems +to me that long ago I did these things, or saw them, I know not which, +somewhere. Tell me, did the king live in our town across the sea?” +</p> + +<p> +“No, but in another some way off. My father took me there once or twice.” +</p> + +<p> +“Can you mind that he took me also?” +</p> + +<p> +I shook my head, and longed for Withelm. Surely I would send for him, or for +Arngeir, if this went on. Arngeir for choice, for I could tell him what I +thought; and that would only puzzle Withelm, who knew less than I. +</p> + +<p> +“We will ask Arngeir some day,” I said; “he can remember.” +</p> + +<p> +“I suppose he did take me,” mused Havelok; “and I suppose that I want more +sleep or more food or somewhat. Now we will go and tell the old dame of my +luck, for she has lost her lodger.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told me of his fortune with the steward. +</p> + +<p> +“Half afraid of me he seems, for he will have me do just what I will. That will +be no hard place therefore.” +</p> + +<p> +But I thought that if I knew anything of Havelok my brother, he would be likely +to make it hard by doing every one’s work for him, and that Berthun saw this; +or else that, as I had thought last night, the shrewd courtier saw the prince +behind the fisher’s garb. +</p> + +<p> +So we parted presently at the gate of the palace wall, and I went back to the +widow to wait for my arms, while he went to his master. And I may as well tell +the end of Havelok’s lawmaking. +</p> + +<p> +Berthun went down to the market next day, and came back with a wonder to be +told. And it was to Havelok that he went first to tell it, as he was drawing +bucket after bucket of water from the deep old Roman well in the courtyard to +fill the great tub which he considered a fair load to carry at once. +</p> + +<p> +“There is something strange happening in the market,” he said, “and I think +that you have a hand in it. The decency of the place is wonderful, and you said +that you thought I might have less trouble with the men than I was wont if you +went down with the loaves. What did you? For I went to the baker’s stalls and +bought, and looked round for the tail that is after me always; and I was alone, +and all the market folk were agape to see what was to be done. I thought that I +had offended the market by yesterday’s business, as they had called out on me, +and I thought that I should have to come and fetch your—that is, if it pleased +you. But first I called, as is my wont, for porters. Now all that rabble sat in +a row along a wall, and, by Baldur, when I looked, they had cleaned themselves! +Whereupon an old gaffer, who has carried things once or twice for me when there +has been no crowd and he has been able to come forward, lifted up his voice and +asked how many men I wanted, so please me. +</p> + +<p> +“‘Two,’I said, wondering, and at that two got up and came to me, and I sent +them off. It was the same at the next booth, and the next, for he told off men +as I wanted them; and here am I back a full half-hour earlier than ever before, +and no mud splashes from the crowd either. It is said that they have made a +porters’ guild; and who has put that sense into their heads unless your—that +is, unless you have done so, I cannot say.” +</p> + +<p> +Havelok laughed. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I did tell them that they should take turns, or somewhat like that; and +I also told them that if you complained of them I would see to it.” +</p> + +<p> +“Did you say that you would pay them, may I ask—that is, of course, if they +were orderly? For if so, I thank—” +</p> + +<p> +“I told them that if you complained I would knock their heads together,” said +Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +And that was the beginning of the Lincoln porters’ guild; and in after days +Havelok was wont to say that he would that all lawmaking was as easy as that +first trial of his. Certainly from that day forward there was no man in all the +market who would not have done aught for my brother, and many a dispute was he +called on to settle. It is not always that a law, however good it may be, finds +not a single one to set himself against it. But then Havelok was a strong man. +</p> + +<p> +Now there is naught to tell of either Havelok or myself for a little while, for +we went on in our new places comfortably enough. One heard much of Havelok, +though, for word of him and his strength and goodliness, and of his kindness +moreover, went through the town, with tales of what he had done. But I never +heard that any dared to ask him to make a show of himself by doing feats of +strength. Only when he came down to the guardroom sometimes with me would he +take part in the weapon play that he loved, and the housecarls, who were all +tried and good warriors, said that he was their master in the use of every +weapon, and it puzzled them to know where he had learned so well, for he yet +wore his fisher’s garb. They sent his arms with mine from Grimsby, thinking +that he also needed them; but he left them with the widow. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok used to laugh if they asked him this, and tell them that it came by +nature, and in that saying there was more than a little truth. So the +housecarls, when they heard how Berthun was wont to treat him, thought also +that he was some great man in hiding, and that the steward knew who he was. +They did not know but that my close friendship with him had sprung up since he +came, and that was well, and Eglaf and he and I were soon much together. The +captain wanted him to leave the cook and be one of his men, but we thought that +he had better bide where he was, rather than let Alsi the king have him always +about him. For now and then that strange feeling, as of the old days, came over +him when he was in the great hall, and he had to go away and brood over it for +a while until he would set himself some mighty task and forget it. +</p> + +<p> +But one day he came to me and said that he was sure he knew the ways of a king +too well for it all to be a dream, adding that Berthun saw that also, and was +curious about him. +</p> + +<p> +“Tell me, brother, whence came I? <i>Was</i> I truly brought up in a court?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have never heard,” I answered. “All that I know for certain is that you fled +with us from Hodulf, the new king, and that for reasons which my father never +told me.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Havelok, “There was naught worth telling, therefore. I suppose I was +the child of some steward like Berthun; but yet—” +</p> + +<p> +So he went away, and I wondered long if it were not time that Arngeir should +tell all that he knew. It was of no good for me to say that in voice and ways +and deed he had brought back to me the Gunnar whom I had not seen for so many +long years, for that was as likely as not to be a fancy of mine, or if not a +fancy, he might be only a sister’s son or the like. But in all that he said +there was no word of his mother, and by that I knew that his remembrance must +be but a shadow, if a growing one. +</p> + +<p> +But there was no head in all the wide street that was not turned to look after +him; and now he went his way from me with two children, whom he had caught up +from somewhere, perched on either shoulder, and another in his arms, and they +crowed with delight as he made believe to be some giant who was to eat them +forthwith, and ran up the hill with them. No such playmate had the Lincoln +children before Havelok came. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap10">CHAPTER X.<br/> +KING ALSI OF LINDSEY.</a></h2> + +<p> +Three weeks after we came the Witan<a href="#fn8" +name="fnref8"><sup>[8]</sup></a> began to gather, and that was a fine sight as +the great nobles of Lindsey, and of the North folk of East Anglia, came day by +day into the town with their followings, taking up their quarters either in the +better houses of the place or else pitching bright-coloured tents and pavilions +on the hillside meadows beyond the stockades. Many brought their ladies with +them, and all day long was feasting and mirth at one place or another, as +friend met with friend. Never had I seen such a gay sight as the marketplace +was at midday, when the young thanes and their men met there and matched their +followers at all sorts of sports. The English nobles are far more fond of gay +dress and jewels than our Danish folk, though I must say that when the few +Danes of Ethelwald’s household came it would seem that they had taken kindly to +the fashion of their home. +</p> + +<p> +Our housecarls grumbled a bit for a while, for with all the newcomers dressed +span new for the gathering, we had had nothing fresh for it from the king, as +was the custom, and I for one was ashamed of myself, for under my mail was +naught but the fisher’s coat, which is good enough for hard wear, but not for +show. But one day we were fitted out fresh by the king’s bounty in blue and +scarlet jerkins and hose, and we swaggered after that with the best, as one may +suppose. +</p> + +<p> +Berthun had the ordering of that business, and he came and sat with Eglaf in +the gatehouse and talked of it. +</p> + +<p> +“Pity that you do not put your man Curan into decent gear,” the captain said. +“That old sailcloth rig does not do either him or you or the court credit.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is what I would do,” said the steward, “but he will not take aught but +the food that he calls his hire. He is a strange man altogether, and I think +that he is not what he seems.” +</p> + +<p> +“So you have told me many times, and I think with you. He will be some +crack-brained Welsh princeling who has been crossed in love, and so has taken +some vow on him, as the King Arthur that they prate of taught them to do. Well, +if he is such, it is an easy matter to make him clothe himself decently. It is +only to tell him that the clothes are from the king, and no man who has been +well brought up may refuse such a gift.” +</p> + +<p> +“But suppose that he thanks the king for the gift. Both he and the king will be +wroth with me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Not Curan, when he has once got the things on; and as for >Alsi, he will take +the thanks to himself, and chuckle to think that the mistake has gained him +credit for a good deed that he never did.” +</p> + +<p> +“Hush, comrade, hush!” said Berthun quickly; “naught but good of the king!” +</p> + +<p> +“I said naught ill. But if Woden or Frey, or whoever looks after good deeds, +scores the mistake to Alsi as well, it will be the first on the count of +charity that—” +</p> + +<p> +But at this Berthun rose up in stately wise. +</p> + +<p> +“I may not listen to this. To think that here in the guardroom I should hear +such—” +</p> + +<p> +“Sit down, comrade,” said Eglaf, laughing, and pulling the steward into his +seat again. “Well you know that I would be cut to pieces for the king tomorrow +if need were, and so I earn free speech of him I guard. If I may not say what I +think of him to a man who knows as much of him as I, who may?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have no doubt that the king would clothe Curan if I asked him,” said Berthun +stiffly, but noways loth to take his seat again. +</p> + +<p> +“But it is as much as your place is worth to do it. I know what you would say.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun laughed. +</p> + +<p> +“I will do it myself, and if Alsi does get the credit, what matter?” +</p> + +<p> +Wherefore it came to pass that as I was on guard at the gate leading to the +town next day I saw a most noble-looking man coming towards me, and I looked a +second time, for I thought him one of the noblest of all the thanes who had yet +come, and the second look told me that it was Havelok in this new array. I will +say that honest Berthun had done his part well; and if the king was supposed to +be the giver, he had nothing to complain of. Eglaf had told me of the way in +which the dressing of Havelok was to be done. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho!” said I, “I thought you some newcomer.” +</p> + +<p> +“I hardly know myself,” he answered, “and I am not going to grumble at the +change, seeing that this is holiday time. Berthun came to me last evening, and +called me aside, and said that it was the king’s wont to dress his folk anew at +the time of the Witan, and then wanted to know if my vow prevented me from +wearing aught but fisher’s clothes. And when I said that if new clothes went as +wage for service about the place I was glad to hear it, he was pleased, as if +it had been likely that I would refuse a good offer. So the tailor went to work +on me, and hence this finery. But you are as fine, and this is more than we +counted on when we left Grimsby. I suppose it is all in honour of the lady of +the North folk, Goldberga.” +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe, for I have heard that she is to come.” +</p> + +<p> +“To be fetched rather, if one is to believe all that one hears. They say that +Alsi has kept her almost as a captive in Dover, having given her into the +charge of some friend of his there, that she may be far from her own kingdom +and people. Now the Norfolk Witan has made him bring her here. Berthun seems to +think there will be trouble.” +</p> + +<p> +“Only because Alsi will not want to let the kingdom go from his hand to her. +But that will not matter. He is bound by the old promise to her father.” +</p> + +<p> +Now we were talking to one another in broad Danish, there being none near to +hear us. We had always used it among ourselves at Grimsby, for my father loved +his old tongue. But at that moment there rode up to the gate a splendid +horseman, young and handsome, and with great gold bracelets on his arms, one or +two of which caught my eye at once, for they were of the old Danish patterns, +and just such as Jarl Sigurd used to wear. But if I was quick to notice these +tokens of the old land, he had been yet quicker, for he reined up before I +stayed him, as was my duty if he would pass through this gate to the palace, so +that I might know his authority. +</p> + +<p> +“If I am not mistaken,” he said in our own tongue, “I heard you two talking in +the way I love best. Skoal, therefore, to the first Northman I have met between +here and London town, for it is good to hear a friendly voice.” +</p> + +<p> +“Skoal to the jarl!” I answered, and I gave the salute of Sigurd’s courtmen, +which came into my mind on the moment with the familiar greeting of long years +ago. And “Skoal,” said Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Jarl! How know you that I am that?” +</p> + +<p> +“By the jarl’s bracelet that you wear, surely.” +</p> + +<p> +“So you are a real Dane—not an English-bred one like myself. That is good. You +and I will have many a talk together. Odin, how good it is to meet a housecarl +who speaks as man to man and does not cringe to me! Who are you?” +</p> + +<p> +“Radbard Grimsson of Grimsby, housecarl just now to this King of Lindsey.” +</p> + +<p> +“And your comrade?” +</p> + +<p> +I was about to tell this friendly countryman Havelok’s name without thought, +but stopped in time. Of all the things I had been brought up to dread most for +him, that an English Dane should find him out was the worst, so I said, “He is +called Curan, and he is a Lindsey marshman.” +</p> + +<p> +“Who can talk Danish though his name is Welsh. That is strange. Well, you are +right about me. I am Ragnar of Norwich, the earl, as the English for jarl goes. +Now I want to see Alsi the king straightway.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is a matter for the captain,” I said, and I called for him. +</p> + +<p> +Eglaf came out and made a deep reverence when he saw the earl, knowing at once +who he was, and as this was just what the earl had said that he did not like, +he looked quaintly at me across Eglaf’s broad bent back, so that I had to grin +perforce. +</p> + +<p> +All unknowing of which the captain heard the earl’s business, and then told me +to see him to the palace gates, and take his horse to the stables when he had +dismounted and was in the hands of Berthun. +</p> + +<p> +So I went, and Havelok turned away and went on some errand down the steep +street. +</p> + +<p> +This Ragnar was one of whom I had often heard, for he was the governor of all +the North folk for Alsi until the Lady Goldberga should take her place. He was +her cousin, being the son of Ethelwald’s sister, who was of course a Dane. +Danish, and from the old country, was his father also, being one of the men who +had come over to the court of East Anglia when Ethelwald was made king. +</p> + +<p> +All the way to the door we talked of Denmark, but it was not far. There Berthun +came out and greeted the earl in court fashion, and I thought that I was done +with, because the grooms had run to take the great bay horse as they heard the +trampling. But, as it happened, I was wanted. +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar went in, saying to me that he would find me out again presently; and I +saw him walk across the great hall to the hearth, and stand there while Berthun +went to the king’s presence to tell him of the new arrival. Then I stood for a +minute to look at the horse, for the grooms had had no orders to take him away; +and mindful of Eglaf’s word to me, I was going to tell them to do so, and to +see it done, when Berthun came hurriedly and called me. +</p> + +<p> +“Master Housecarl,” he said rather breathlessly, “by the king’s order you are +to come within the hall and guard the doorway.” +</p> + +<p> +I shouldered my spear and followed him, and as we were out of hearing of the +grooms I said that the captain had ordered me to take the horse to the stables. +</p> + +<p> +“I will see to that,” he said. “Now you are to bide at the door while the king +speaks with Earl Ragnar, for there will be none else present. Let no one pass +in without the king’s leave.” +</p> + +<p> +We passed through the great door as he said that, and he closed it after him. +Ragnar was yet standing near the high seat, and turned as he heard the sound, +and smiled when he saw me. Berthun went quickly away through a side entrance, +and the hail was empty save for us two. The midday meal was over an hour since, +and the long tables had been cleared away, so that the place seemed desolate to +me, as I had only seen it before when I sat with the other men at the cross +tables for meals. It was not so good a hall as was Jarl Sigurd’s in Denmark, +for it was not rich with carving and colour as was his, and the arms on the +wall were few, and the hangings might have been brighter and better in a king’s +place. +</p> + +<p> +“Our king does not seem to keep much state,” Ragnar said, looking round as I +was looking, and we both laughed. +</p> + +<p> +Then the door on the high place opened, and the king came in, soberly dressed, +and with a smile on his face which seemed to me to have been made on purpose +for this greeting, for he mostly looked sour enough. Nor did it seem that his +eyes had any pleasure in them. +</p> + +<p> +“Welcome, kinsman,” he said, seeming hearty enough, however; “I had looked for +you before this. What news from our good town of Norwich?” +</p> + +<p> +He held out his hand to Ragnar, who took it frankly, and his strong grip +twisted the king’s set smile into a grin of pain for a moment. +</p> + +<p> +“All was well there three weeks ago when I left there to go to London. Now, I +have ridden on to say that the Lady Goldberga is not far hence, so that her +coming may be prepared for.” +</p> + +<p> +Now, as the earl said this, the king’s smile went from his face, and black +enough he looked for a moment. The look passed quickly, and the smile came +back, but it seemed hard to keep it up. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, that is well,” he said; “so you fell in with her on the way.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have attended her from London,” answered the earl, looking steadfastly at +Alsi, “and it was as well that I did so, as it happened.” +</p> + +<p> +“What has been amiss?” asked the king sharply, and trying to look troubled. He +let the smile go now altogether. +</p> + +<p> +“Your henchman, Griffin the Welshman, had no guard with her that was fitting +for our princess,” Ragnar said. “He had but twenty men, and these not of the +best. It is in my mind also that I should have been told of this journey, for I +am surely the right man to have guarded my queen who is to be.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Alsi’s face went ashy pale, and I did not rightly know why at the time, +but it seemed more in anger than aught else. But he had to make some answer. +</p> + +<p> +“We sent a messenger to you,” he said hastily; “I cannot tell why he did not +reach you.” +</p> + +<p> +“He must have come too late, and after I had heard of this from others; so I +had already gone to meet the princess. I am glad that I was sent for, and it +may pass. Well, it is lucky that I was in time, for we were attacked on the +road, and but for my men there would have been trouble.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi broke into wrath, which was real enough. +</p> + +<p> +“This passes all. Where and by whom were you attacked? and why should any fall +on the party?” +</p> + +<p> +“Five miles on the other side of Ancaster town, where the Ermin Street runs +among woods, we were fallen on, but who the men were I cannot say. Why they +should fall on us seems plain enough, seeing that the ransom of a princess is +likely to be a great sum.” +</p> + +<p> +“Was it a sharp fight?” +</p> + +<p> +“It was not,” answered Ragnar, “for it seemed to me that the men looked only to +find your Welsh thane Griffin and his men. When they saw my Norfolk housecarls, +they waited no longer, and we only rode down one or two of them. But I have +somewhat against this Griffin, for he helped me not at all. Until this day he +and his men had ridden fairly with us, but by the time this attack came they +were half a mile behind us.” +</p> + +<p> +“Do you mean to say that you think Griffin in league with these—outlaws, as one +may suppose them?” said Alsi, with wrath and more else written in twitching +mouth and crafty eyes. +</p> + +<p> +“I would not have said that,” Ragnar answered, looking in some surprise at the +king, “it had never come into my head. But I will say that as the Ermin Street +is straight as an arrow, and he was in full sight of us, he might have spurred +his horses to our help, whereas he never quickened his pace till he saw that +the outlaws, or whoever they were, had gone. I put this as a complaint to you.” +</p> + +<p> +“These men seem to have scared you, at least,” sneered the king. +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar flushed deeply. +</p> + +<p> +“For the princess—yes. It is not fitting that a man who is in charge of so +precious a lady should hold back in danger, even of the least seeming, as did +Griffin. And I told him so.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I thought that Alsi would have been as angry with Griffin as was the earl, +and that he would add that he also would speak his mind to him, hut instead of +that he went off in another way. +</p> + +<p> +“It was a pity that a pleasant journey with a fair companion was thus broken in +upon. But it was doubtless pleasant that the lady should see that her kinsman +was not unwilling to draw sword for her. A pretty little jest this, got up +between Griffin and yourself, and such as a young man may be forgiven for +playing. I shall hear Goldberga complain of honest Griffin presently, and now I +shall know how to answer her. Ay, I will promise him the like talking to that +you gave him, and then we three will laugh over it all together.” +</p> + +<p> +And with that the king broke into a cackle of laughter, catching hold of the +earl’s arm in his glee. And I never saw any man look so altogether bewildered +as did Ragnar. +</p> + +<p> +“Little jest was there in the matter, lord king, let me tell you,” he said, +trying to draw his arm away. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, I am not angry with you, kinsman; indeed, I am not. We have been young +and eager that bright eyes should see our valour ourselves ere now,” and he +shook his finger at the earl gaily. “I only wonder that you induced that fiery +Welshman to take a rating in the hearing of the princess quietly.” +</p> + +<p> +“What I had to say to him I said apart. I will not say that he did take it +quietly.” +</p> + +<p> +“Meaning—that you had a good laugh over it;” and Alsi shook the earl’s arm as +in glee. “There now, you have made a clean breast, and I am not one to spoil +sport. Go and meet Goldberga at the gates, and bring her to me in state, and +you shall be lodged here, if you will. Quite right of you to tell me this, or +Griffin would have been in trouble. But I must not have the lady scared again, +mind you.” +</p> + +<p> +He turned quickly away, then, with a sort of stifled laugh, as if he wanted to +get away to enjoy a good jest, and left Ragnar staring speechless at him as he +crossed the high place and went through the private door. +</p> + +<p> +Then the earl turned to me, “By Loki, fellow countryman, there is somewhat +wrong here. What does he mean by feigning to think the whole affair a jest? It +won’t be much of a jest if Griffin and I slay one another tomorrow, as we mean +to do, because of what was not done, and what was said about it.” +</p> + +<p> +“It has seemed to me, jarl,” I said plainly, “that all this is more like a jest +between the king and Griffin.” +</p> + +<p> +“Call it a jest, as that is loyal, at least. But I think that you are right. If +Goldberga had been carried off—Come, we shall be saying too much in these +walls.” +</p> + +<p> +I had only been told to wait while the king and earl spoke together, and so I +opened the door and followed him out. The horse was yet there waiting for him, +and it was plain that the king had not meant him to stay. +</p> + +<p> +“Bid the grooms lead the horse after us, and we will go to your captain. Then +you shall take me to one of my friends, for you will know where their houses +are.” +</p> + +<p> +But at that moment a man from the palace ran after us, bringing an order from +the king that I was to go back to him. So Ragnar bade me farewell. +</p> + +<p> +“Come to me tonight at the gatehouse,” he said. “I will speak to the captain to +let you off duty.” +</p> + +<p> +“Say nothing to him, jarl, for it is needless. I am only with him for a time, +and am my own master. I have no turn on watch tonight, and so am free.” +</p> + +<p> +So I went back, and found the king in the hall again, and he was still smiling. +If he had looked me straight in the face, I suppose that he might have seen +that I was not a man to whom he was used, but he did not. He seemed not to wish +to do so. +</p> + +<p> +“So, good fellow,” he said, “you have heard a pleasant jest of our young +kinsman’s contriving, but I will that you say nothing of it. It is a pity to +take a good guardroom story from you, however, without some recompense, and +therefore—” +</p> + +<p> +With that he put a little bag into my hand, and it was heavy. I said nothing, +but bowed in the English way, and he went on, “You understand; no word is to be +said of what you have heard unless I bid you repeat it. That I may have to do, +lest it is said that Griffin the thane is ‘nidring’<a href="#fn9" +name="fnref9"><sup>[9]</sup></a> by any of his enemies. You know all the +story—how the earl and he planned a sham attack on the princess’s party, that +Ragnar might show his valour, which, of course, he could not do if Griffin was +there. Therefore the thane held back. But maybe you heard all, and understood +it.” +</p> + +<p> +“I heard all, lord king, and I will say naught.” +</p> + +<p> +The king waved his hand in sign that I was dismissed, and I bowed and went. +There were five rings of gold in the bag, worth about the whole year’s wage of +a courtman, and I thought that for keeping a jest to myself that was good pay +indeed. There must be more behind that business, as it had seemed to me +already. +</p> + +<p> +Now, as I crossed the green within the old walls on my way to the gate, it +happened that Havelok came back from the town, and as he came I heard him +whistling softly to himself a strange wild call, as it were, of a hunting horn, +very sweet, and one that I had never heard before. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, brother!” I said, for there was no one near us. “What is that call you are +whistling?” +</p> + +<p> +He started and looked up at me suddenly, and I saw that his trouble was on him +again. +</p> + +<p> +“In my dream,” he said slowly, “there is a man on a great horse, and he wears +such bracelets as Ragnar of Norwich, and he winds his horn with that call, and +I run to him; and then I myself am on the horse, and I go to the stables, and +after that there is nothing but the call that I hear. Now it has gone again.” +</p> + +<p> +And his hand went up in the way that made me sad to see. +</p> + +<p> +“It will come back by-and-by. Trouble not about it.” +</p> + +<p> +“I would that we were back in Grimsby,” he said, with a great sigh. “This is a +place of shadows. Ghosts are these of days that I think can never have been.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said I, wanting to take him out of himself, “this is no ghost, at all +events. I would that one of our brothers would come from home that I might send +it to them in Grimsby. We do not need it.” +</p> + +<p> +So I showed him the gold, and he wondered at it, and laughed, saying that the +housecarls had the best place after all. And so he went on, and I back to the +gate. +</p> + +<p> +Surely he minded at last the days when Gunnar his father had ridden home to the +gate, as the Danish earl had ridden even now, and had called his son to him +with that call. It was all coming back, as one thing or another brought it to +his mind; and I wondered what should be when he knew that the dream was the +truth. For what should Havelok, foster-son of the fisher, do against a king who +for twelve long years had held his throne? And who in all the old land would +believe that he was indeed the son of the lost king? Better, it seemed to me, +that this had not happened, and that he had been yet the happy, careless, +well-loved son of Grim, with no thought of aught higher than the good of the +folk he knew. +</p> + +<p> +When I got back to the gate, we were marched down the town, that we might be +ready to receive the princess; and as I went through the market, I saw one of +the porters whom I knew, and I beckoned to him, so that he came alongside me in +the ranks, and I asked him if he would go to Grimsby for me for a silver penny. +He would do it gladly; and so I sent him with word to Arngeir that I needed one +of them here to take a gift that I had for them. I would meet whoever came at +the widow’s house, and I set a time when I would look for them. I thought it +was well that the king’s gold should not be wasted, even for a day’s use, if I +could help it. And I wearied to see one of the brothers, and hear all that was +going on. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap11">CHAPTER XI.<br/> +THE COMING OF THE PRINCESS.</a></h2> + +<p> +There is no need for me to tell aught of the entry of the Lady Goldberga into +the town, for anyone may know how the people cheered her, and how the party +were met by the Norfolk thanes and many others, and so rode on up the hill to +the palace. What the princess was like I hardly noticed at that time, for she +was closely hooded, and her maidens were round her. And I had something else to +think of; for foremost, and richly dressed, with a gold chain round his neck, +rode a man whose strange way of carrying his head caught my eye at once, so +that I looked more than a second time at him. +</p> + +<p> +And at last I knew him. It was that man of ours whose neck had been twisted by +the way in which he had been hauled on board at the time of the wreck, and had +afterwards gone to Ethelwald’s court. One would say that this Mord had +prospered exceedingly, for he was plainly a man of some consequence in the +princess’s household. He did not know me, though it happened that he looked +right at me for a moment; but I did not expect him to do so after twelve years, +seeing that I was but a boy when we parted. I thought that I would seek him +presently. +</p> + +<p> +Then I saw Griffin, the Welsh thane, and I did not like the looks of him at +all. He was a black-haired man, clean shaven, so that the cruel thinness of his +lips was not hidden, and his black eyes were restless, and never stayed +anywhere, unless he looked at Ragnar for a moment, and then that was a look of +deadly hatred. He wore his armour well, and had a steady seat on his horse; +but, if all that I had heard of him was true, his looks did not belie him. Men +had much to say of him here, for, being some far-off kin to Alsi’s Welsh +mother, he was always about the court, and was hated. He had gone to Dover to +fetch the princess before we came here, but it happened that I had once or +twice seen him at other times when I was in Lincoln, so that I knew him now. +</p> + +<p> +There was great feasting that night in the king’s hall, as one may suppose, and +I sat with the housecarls at the cross tables beyond the fire, and I could see +the Lady Goldberga at Alsi’s side. Tired she was with her long journey, and she +did not remain long at the table; but I had never seen so wondrously beautiful +a lady. Griffin sat next to her on the king’s right hand, for Ragnar was at the +king’s left, in the seat of next honour; and I saw that the lady had no love +for the Welsh thane. But I also thought that I saw how he would give his all +for a kindly glance from her; and if, as Alsi had seemed to hint, Ragnar was a +favoured lover, I did not wonder that Griffin had been ready to do him a bad +turn. I had rather that the thane was my friend than my foe, for he would be no +open enemy. +</p> + +<p> +I left the feast when the first change of guard went out, for I saw that the +ale cup was passing faster than we Danes think fitting, being less given to it +than the English. And when the guard was set I waited alone in the guardroom of +the old gate, for Eglaf was yet at the hall, and would be there all night +maybe. And presently Earl Ragnar came in and sat down with me. +</p> + +<p> +He was silent for a while, and I waited for him to speak, until he looked up at +me with a little laugh, and said, “I told you that I had to fight Griffin +tomorrow?” +</p> + +<p> +“You did, earl. Is that matter settled otherwise?” +</p> + +<p> +“Not at all,” he answered. “I believe now that he was acting under orders, but +I have said things to him which he cannot pass over. I called him ‘nidring’ to +his face, and that I still mean; for though I thought of cowardice at the time, +he is none the less so if he has plotted against the princess. So naught but +the sword will end the feud.” +</p> + +<p> +He pondered for some moments, and then went on, “It is a bad business; for if I +slay Griffin, he is the king’s favourite; and if he slays me, the Norfolk +thanes will have somewhat to say. And all is bad for the Lady Goldberga, who +needs all the friends that she has, for in either case there will be trouble +between the two kingdoms that Alsi holds just now.” +</p> + +<p> +“If Griffin is slain,” I said, “I think that the lady has one trouble out of +the way.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay; and the king will make out, as you heard him do even now, that I am +looking that way myself. It is not so, for I will say to you at once that to me +there is but one lady in all the world, and she is in Norfolk at this time. Now +I am going to ask you something that is a favour.” +</p> + +<p> +I thought that he would give me some message for this lady, in case he fell; +but he had more to ask than that. Nothing more or less than that I should be +his second in the fight, because I was a fellow countryman, while to ask an +East Anglian thane would he to make things harder yet for Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +“I am no thane, earl,” I said plainly. “This is an honour that is over high for +me.” +</p> + +<p> +“It seems that you own a town, for I asked Eglaf just now,” he answered; “and +that is enough surely to give you thane’s rank in a matter like this. But that +is neither here nor there; it is as Dane to Dane that I ask you. If I could +find another of us I would ask him also, that you might not have to stand +alone. I am asking you to break the law that bids the keeping of the peace at +the time of the meeting of the Witan.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is no matter,” I said. “If I have to fly, it will be with you as victor; +and if it is but a matter of a fine, I have had that from the king today which +will surely pay it.” +</p> + +<p> +And I told him of the gift for silence, whereat he laughed heartily, and then +said that the secret was more worth than he thought. This looked very bad, and +like proof that the king was at the bottom of the whole business. +</p> + +<p> +Now I had been thinking, and it seemed better that there should be two +witnesses of the fight on our side, and I thought that Havelok was the man who +would make the second. So I told Ragnar that I could find another Dane who was +at least as worthy as I, and he was well pleased. Then he told me where the +meeting was to be, and where we should meet him just before daylight; and so he +went back to the hall, where the lights were yet burning redly, and the songs +were wilder than ever. +</p> + +<p> +And I found Havelok, and told him of the fight that was to be, and asked him to +come with us. His arms were at the widow’s, and he could get them without any +noticing him. +</p> + +<p> +There is no need to say that he was ready as I to help Ragnar, and so we spoke +of time and place, and parted for the night. +</p> + +<p> +Very early came Havelok to the house, for I lodged at the widow’s when I was +not on night duty; and we armed ourselves, and then came Ragnar. He greeted me +first, and then looked at Havelok in amaze, as it seemed, and then bowed a +little, and asked me to make my friend known to him. +</p> + +<p> +“If you are the friend of whom Radbard has told me, I think that I am fortunate +in having come to him.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am his brother, lord earl,” answered Havelok, “and I am at your service.” +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar looked from one of us to the other, and then smiled. +</p> + +<p> +“A brother Dane and a brother in arms, truly,” he said. “Well, that is all that +I need ask, except your name, as I am to be another brother of the same sort.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok looked at me, and I nodded. I knew what he meant; but it was not +right that the earl should not know who he was. +</p> + +<p> +“Men call me Curan here, lord earl, and that I must be to you hereafter. But I +am Havelok of Grimsby, son of Grim.” +</p> + +<p> +In a moment I saw that the earl knew more of that name than I had deemed +possible; and then I minded Mord, the wry-necked, who was the chamberlain now. +But Ragnar said nothing beyond that he would remember the request, and that he +was well seconded. And then we went out into the grey morning, and without +recrossing the bridge, away to the level meadows on the south of the river, far +from any roadway. +</p> + +<p> +“There is not an island in the stream,” said Ragnar, “or I should have wanted +the old northern holmgang battle. I doubt if we could even get these Welshmen +to peg out the lists.” +</p> + +<p> +“That we must see to,” I said. “We will have all things fair in some way.” +</p> + +<p> +Half a mile from the town we came to what they call a carr—a woody rise in the +level marsh—and on the skirts of this two men waited us. They were the seconds +of Griffin, Welsh or half Welsh both of them by their looks, and both were well +armed. Their greeting was courteous enough, and they led us by a little track +into the heart of the thickets, and there was a wide and level clearing, most +fit for a fight, in which waited Griffin himself. +</p> + +<p> +Now I had never taken any part in a fight before, and I did not rightly know +what I had to do to begin with. However, one of the other side seemed to be +well up in the matter, and at once he came to me and Havelok and took us aside. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is a little trouble,” he said: “our men have said nothing of what weapons +they will use.” +</p> + +<p> +“I take it,” said Havelok at once, “that they meant to use those which were +most handy to them, therefore.” +</p> + +<p> +The Welshman stared, and answered rather stiffly, “This is not a matter of +chance medley, young sir, but an ordered affair. But doubtless this is the +first time you have been in this case, and do not know the rules. Let me tell +you, therefore, that your earl, being the challenged man, has choice of +weapons. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then,” answered Havelok, “it seems to me that if we say as I have already +said, it is fair on our part. For it is certain that the earl will want to use +the axe, and your man is about half his weight, so that would be uneven.” +</p> + +<p> +“As the challenged man, the earl is entitled to any advantage in weapons.” +</p> + +<p> +“He needs none. Let us fight fairly or not at all. The earl takes the axe.—What +say you, Radbard? Griffin takes what he likes.” +</p> + +<p> +“You keep to the axe after all, and yet say that it gives an advantage.” +</p> + +<p> +“Axe against axe it does, but if your man chooses to take a twenty-foot spear +and keep out of its way, we do not object. We give him his own choice.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the other second said frankly, “This is generous, Cadwal. No more need be +said. But this young thane has not yet asked his earl whether it will suit +him.” +</p> + +<p> +“Faith, no,” said Havelok, laughing; “I was thinking what I should like myself, +and nothing at all of the earl.” +</p> + +<p> +So I went across to Ragnar, who was waiting patiently at one end of the +clearing, while Griffin was pacing with uneven steps backward and forward at +the other, and I told him what the question was. +</p> + +<p> +“I thought it would be a matter of swords,” he said, “but I am Dane enough to +like the axe best. Settle it as you will. Of course he knows naught of axe +play, so that you are right in not pressing it on him. He is a light man, and +active, and maybe will be glad not even to try sword to sword; for look at the +sort of bodkin he is wearing.” +</p> + +<p> +The earl and we had the northern long sword, of course; but when I looked I saw +that the Welsh had short, straight, and heavy weapons of about half the length +of ours, and so even sword to sword seemed hard on the lighter man; wherein I +was wrong, as I had yet to learn. +</p> + +<p> +I went back, therefore, and told the others. +</p> + +<p> +“The earl takes the axe, and the thane has his choice, as we have said.” +</p> + +<p> +“We have to thank you,” said the other second, while Cadwal only laughed a +short laugh, and bade us choose the ground with them. +</p> + +<p> +There was no difficulty about that, for the light was clear and bright, and +though the sun was up, the trees bid any bright rays that might be in the eyes +of the fighters. However, we set them across the light, so that all there was +might be even; and then we agreed that if one was forced back to the edge of +the clearing he was to be held beaten, as if we had been on an island. It was +nearly as good, for the shore of trees and brushwood was very plain and sharp. +</p> + +<p> +Now Ragnar unslung his round shield from his shoulders, and took his axe from +me, for I had carried it for him, and his face was quiet and steady, as the +face of one should be who has a deed to do that must be seen through to the +end. But Griffin and his men talked quickly in their own tongue, and I had to +tell them that we understood it well enough. Then they looked at each other, +and were silent suddenly. I wondered what they, were about to say, for it +seemed that my warning came just in time for them. +</p> + +<p> +Griffin took a shield from the thane they called Cadwal, and it was square—a +shape that I had not seen before in use, though Witlaf had one like it on the +wall at Stallingborough. He said that it had been won from a chief by his +forefathers when the English first came into the land, and that it was the old +Roman shape. It seemed unhandy to me, but I had no time to think of it for a +moment, for now Cadwal had a last question. +</p> + +<p> +“Is this fight to be to the death?” +</p> + +<p> +“No,” I answered; “else were the rule we made about the boundary of no use.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Griffin cried in a sort of choked voice, “It shall be to the death.” +</p> + +<p> +But I said nothing, and the other second, with Cadwal, shook his head. +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar made no sign, but Cadwal said to Havelok, “You were foremost in the +matter just now. What say you?” +</p> + +<p> +“Rules are rules, and what my comrade says is right. If the first blow slays, +we cannot help it, but there shall be no second wound. The man who is first +struck is defeated.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will not have it so,” said Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, thane, after you have wounded the earl you will have to reckon +with me, if you must slay someone.” +</p> + +<p> +Griffin looked at the towering form of my brother and made no answer, and the +other second told him that it was right. There was naught but an angry word or +two to be atoned for. So there was an end, and Ragnar went on guard. Griffin +made ready also, and at once it was plain that here was no uneven match after +all. +</p> + +<p> +Both of them wore ring mail of the best. We had set the two six paces apart, +and they must step forward to get within striking distance. At once Griffin +seemed to grow smaller, for he crouched down as a cat that is going to spring, +and raised his shield before him, so that from where I stood behind Ragnar I +could only see his black glittering eyes and round helm above its edge. And his +right arm was drawn back, so that only the point of his heavy leaf-bladed sword +was to be seen glancing from the right edge steadily. And now his eyes were +steady as the sword point, which was no brighter than they. If once he got +inside the sweep of the great axe it would be bad for Ragnar. +</p> + +<p> +One step forward went the earl, shield up and axe balanced, but Griffin never +moved. Then Ragnar leapt forward and struck out, but I could see that it was a +feint, and he recovered at once. Griffin’s shield had gone up in a moment above +his head, and in a moment it was back in its place, and over it his eyes glared +as before, unwavering. And then, like a wildcat, he sprang at Ragnar, making no +sweeping blow with his sword, but thrusting with straight arm, so that the +whole weight of his flying body was behind the point. Ragnar struck out, but +the square shield was overhead to stay the blow, and full on the round Danish +buckler the point of the short sword rang, for the earl was ready to meet it. +</p> + +<p> +In a moment the Welshman was back in his crouching guard, leaving a great +ragged hole in the shield whence he had wrenched his weapon point in a way that +told of a wrist turn that had been long practised. Ragnar had needed no leech, +had his quick eye not saved him from that thrust. +</p> + +<p> +Then for a breathing space the two watched each other, while we held our +breath, motionless. And then Griffin slowly began to circle round his foe, +still crouching. +</p> + +<p> +Then, like a thunderbolt, Ragnar’s axe swept down on the thane, and neither +shield nor helm would have been of avail had that blow gone home. Back leapt +Griffin, and the axe shore the edge only of his shield; and then, shield aloft +and point foremost, he flew on the earl before the axe had recovered from its +swing, and I surely thought that the end had come, for the earl’s shield was +lowered, and his face was unguarded. +</p> + +<p> +But that was what he looked for. Up and forward flew the round shield, catching +the thane’s straightened arm along its whole length, and then, as sword and arm +were dashed upwards, smiting him fairly in the face; and, like a stone, the +Welshman was hurled from it, and fell backward in a heap on the grass three +paces away. It seemed to me that he was off his feet in his spring as the +shield smote him. +</p> + +<p> +There he lay, and Havelok strode forward and stood between the two, with his +face to Griffin, for Ragnar had dropped his axe to rest when his foe fell. +</p> + +<p> +“No blood drawn,” said my brother, “but no more fighting can there be. The +man’s arm is out.” +</p> + +<p> +And so it was, for the mighty heave that turned the thrust had ended Griffin’s +fighting for a long day. But he did not think so. +</p> + +<p> +The sweat was standing on his face in great beads from the pain, but he got up +and shifted his sword to his left hand. +</p> + +<p> +“It is to the death,” he cried; “I can fight as well with the left. Stand +aside.” +</p> + +<p> +“An it had been so, you were a dead man now,” said Havelok, “for the earl held +his hand where he might have slain. If he had chosen, you might have felt his +axe before you touched the ground.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat, without warning other than a snarl of “Your own saying,” Griffin leapt +at my brother fiercely, only to meet a swing of his axe that sent his sword +flying from his hand. And that was deft of Havelok, for there is nothing more +hard to meet than a left-handed attack at any time, and this seemed unlooked +for. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I did say somewhat of this sort,” said Havelok; “but it was lucky that I +had not forgotten it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he took the thane by the waist and left arm and set him down gently; and +after that all the fury went from him, and he grew pale with the pain of the +arm that was hurt. But both I and the Welshmen had shouted to Griffin to hold, +all uselessly, so quick had been his onset on his new foe. +</p> + +<p> +Cadwal held his peace, biting his lip, but the other Welshman began to blame +Griffin loudly for this. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” said Havelok, smiling; “it was my own fault maybe. The thane was +overhasty certainly, but one does not think with pain gnawing at one. Let that +pass. +</p> + +<p> +“Now, earl, I think that you may say what you have to say that will set things +right once more.” +</p> + +<p> +“Can none of us put the arm back first?” I said. “I will try, if none else has +done such a thing before, for it will not be the first time.” +</p> + +<p> +“Put it back, if you can,” said Cadwal. “If there is anything to be said, it +had better be in some sort of comfort.” +</p> + +<p> +So I put the arm back, for when once the trick is learned there is not, as a +rule, much trouble. But Griffin never thanked me. He left that to his seconds, +who did so well enough. +</p> + +<p> +Then Ragnar came forward and said gravely, “I was wrong when I called you +‘nidring,’ and I take back the word and ask you to forget it. No man who is +that will face the Danish axe as you have faced it, and I will say that the +British sword is a thing to be feared.” +</p> + +<p> +But Griffin made no answer, and when Ragnar held out his hand he would not see +it. +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe I have not yet made amends,” Ragnar went on. “I will add, therefore, as +I know that my words will go no farther, that I am sure that the thing +concerning which we quarrelled yesterday was done by you at the orders of +another. It was not your own doing, and no thought of cowardice is in my mind +now.” +</p> + +<p> +But Griffin never answered; and now he turned his back on the earl, who was +plainly grieved, and said no more to him, but turned to us and the two +Welshmen. +</p> + +<p> +“I do not think that I can say more. If there is aught that is needed, tell me. +We have fought a fair fight, and I have taken back the words that caused it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Cadwal, “No more is needed. I did not think that we had met with so +generous a foe. If Griffin will say naught, we say this for him. He has no +cause for enmity left. And I say also that he has to thank this thane for his +life as well as the earl.” +</p> + +<p> +“No thane am I,” said Havelok, “but only Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby. And even +that name is set aside for a while, so that I must ask you to forget it. I have +seen a good fight, if a short one, and one could not smite a wounded man who +forgot himself for a moment.” +</p> + +<p> +There was nothing more to be had from Griffin, for we waited a minute or two in +silence to see if he would speak, and then we saluted and left the wood. +</p> + +<p> +The last thing that I saw seemed to be a matter of high words between Griffin +and his seconds; and, indeed, if they were telling him what they thought, it is +likely that he wished he had been more courteous. It is easy enough for a man +who wants a quarrel to have done with one and then start another. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap12">CHAPTER XII.<br/> +IN LINCOLN MARKETPLACE.</a></h2> + +<p> +We went quietly back to the town, and there was only one thing that I wished, +and that was that Havelok had not had to tell his name twice. Ragnar was full +of thanks to us for our help, and said that he would that we would come to +Norfolk with him. +</p> + +<p> +“We have a man who knows you also,” he said, “but he has been with our princess +for a long time now. He is called Mord, and is her chamberlain. He has often +told me how he came by his wry-neck at the time of your shipwreck.” +</p> + +<p> +So he said, and looked at Havelok. But this was a thing that he had not seen, +as he was so sick at the time. I said that I remembered Mord well, and would +seek him some time in the day. +</p> + +<p> +And as I said this I was thinking that I must find out from Mord whether he +knew and had told more than I could of who Havelok was and whence he came to +us. It seemed to me that the earl had heard some tale or other, and unless it +was from him I could not think from whence. +</p> + +<p> +Now the earl said, “This business has ended better than I could have hoped, and +I think that Alsi will not hear of it. Griffin can well account for a slipped +shoulder by any sort of fall that he likes to own to, and Alsi would be hardly +pleased to hear that he had run the risk of setting all Norfolk against him for +nothing after all.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is no doubt that he meant you to know that he does not consider the +quarrel done with,” I said. “You have an enemy there.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nothing new, that,” answered Ragnar, laughing. “He thinks that I stand in his +way with the princess. I suppose it is common talk that if he wedded her Alsi +would still hold the East Anglian kingdom, making him ealdorman, if only I were +out of the way. But were I to wed the lady, then it is certain that she would +take the crown at once. I do not mean to do so, for then it is likely that +three people would be unhappy for the rest of their days. But that would be +less wretched for her than to wed Griffin.” +</p> + +<p> +“This is no pleasant strait for the poor lady,” said Havelok grimly. “Do none +ask what she herself can wish?” +</p> + +<p> +“That is the trouble,” said the earl, “for she is in Alsi’s hand, and there is +some old promise and oath sworn between him and Ethelwald her father that holds +him back. Else had she been wedded to Griffin before now.” +</p> + +<p> +Then we came to the widow’s house, and Havelok left his arms there, and we went +on to the marketplace. As we crossed the bridge we saw that there was something +going forward, for there was a gathering in the wide space, and a shouting and +cheering now and then, and even Berthun himself was there looking on and +seeming to be highly entertained. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is a crowd that I will not face just now, in my arms,” said the earl; +“for this hole in my shield looks bad, not having been there when I went out. +Farewell for the time, therefore, and think of what I said about your coming to +Norwich with me.” +</p> + +<p> +He turned away therefore, and Havelok looked after him for a moment. The shield +hung at his back, plain to be seen. +</p> + +<p> +“It is a hole, for certain,” he said; “but there is no need to show it in that +wise.” +</p> + +<p> +So he strode after him. +</p> + +<p> +“By your leave, earl, I will arrange your cloak across the shield, and then you +can get it to your armourer without notice.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is well thought of,” answered Ragnar, as Havelok did as he had said. “I +do not forget that I think that I owe you my life, though I have said nothing +as yet.” +</p> + +<p> +“How is that?” +</p> + +<p> +“Griffin would have flown on me as he did on you, certainly; and it is in my +mind that you foresaw it, which I did not. I could not have stayed him.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well I did,” answered my brother; “else had either I or you a hole in us like +the one that is well covered now. But I feared what came to pass.” +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar held out his hand, and Havelok took it, and so they parted without more +words; but I knew that these two were friends from that time forward, whatever +happened. +</p> + +<p> +There were some sports of some sort on hand, when we came to see what all the +noise was; and Berthun, seeing us, called Havelok to him. +</p> + +<p> +“I have been looking for you,” he said, with that curious tone of his that +always seemed to be asking pardon for his boldness in speaking to my brother; +“for here are games at which they need some one to show the way.” +</p> + +<p> +“This is a sport that I have not seen before,” answered Havelok, looking over +the heads of the crowd. “I should make a poor hand at it.” +</p> + +<p> +They had been tossing a great fir pole, which was now laid on one side, with +its top split from its falls, and they, thanes and freemen in turn, were +putting a great stone, so heavy that a matter of a few inches beyond the +longest cast yet made would be something to be proud of. Good sport enough it +was to see the brawny housecarls heave it from the ground and swing it. But no +one could lift it above his knee, so that one may suppose that it flew no great +distance at a cast. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but the thanes are trying,” Berthun said. “It is open to all to do what +they can. One of your porters is best man so far.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I will not try to outdo him.” +</p> + +<p> +“I would that you would lift the stone, Curan. That is a thing that I should +most like to see.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well then, master, as you bid me, I will try. But do not expect too much.” +</p> + +<p> +The man who had the stone made his cast, which was nothing to speak of; and +then the stone lay unclaimed for a time, while all the onlookers waited to see +who came forward next. Then Havelok made his way through the crowd, and a +silence as of wonder fell on the people; for some knew him, and had heard of +his strength, and those who did not stared at him as at a wonder. But the +silence did not last long, for the porters who were there set up a sort of +shout of delight, and that one who had made the longest cast so far began to +tell him how best to heft the stone and swing it. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok bent to raise the stone, and the noise hushed again. I saw his +mighty limbs harden and knot under the strain, and up to his knee he heaved it, +and to his middle, and yet higher, to his chest, while we all held our breaths, +and then with a mighty lift it was at his shoulder, and he poised it, and swung +as one who balances for a moment, and then hurled it from him. Then was a shout +that Alsi might have heard in his hilltop palace, for full four paces beyond +the strong porter’s cast it flew, lighting with a mighty crash, and bedding +itself in the ground where it lit. And I saw the young thanes with wide eyes +looking at my brother, and from beside me Berthun the cook fairly roared with +delight. +</p> + +<p> +And then from across the space between the two lines of onlookers I saw a man +in a fisher’s dress that caught my eye. It was Withelm, and we nodded to each +other, well pleased. +</p> + +<p> +Now there seemed to be a strife as to who should get nearest to Havelok, for +men crowded to pat him and to look up at him, and that pleased him not at all. +One came and bade him take the silver pennies that the thanes had set out for +the prize, but he shook his head and smiled. +</p> + +<p> +“I threw the thing because I was bidden, and not for any prize,” he said. “I +would have it given to the porter who fairly won it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he elbowed his way to Berthun, and said, “let us go, master; we have +stayed here too long already.” +</p> + +<p> +“As it pleases you,” the steward said; and Havelok waved his hand to me, and +they went their way. +</p> + +<p> +He had not seen Withelm, and I was glad, for I wanted to speak to him alone +first. +</p> + +<p> +Now men began to ask who this was, and many voices answered, while the porter +went to claim the prize from the thane who held it. +</p> + +<p> +Two silver pennies the thane gave him, and said, “This seems to be a friend of +yours, and it was good to hear you try to help him without acrimony. Not that +he needed any hints from any one, however. Who is he?” +</p> + +<p> +“Men call him Curan, that being the name he gives himself; but he came as a +stranger to the place, and none know from whence, unless Berthun the cook may +do so. Surely he is a friend of mine, for he shook me once, and that shaking +made an honest man of me. He himself taught me what fair play is, at that same +time.” +</p> + +<p> +So said the porter, and laughed, and the thane joined him. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, he has made a sort of name for himself as a wonder, certainly, now. I +think that this cast of his will be told of every time men lift a stone here in +Lincoln,” said the thane. +</p> + +<p> +They left the stone where he had set it, and any one may see it there to this +day, and there I suppose it will be for a wonder while Havelok’s name is +remembered. +</p> + +<p> +Then they began wrestling and the like, and I left the crowd and went to +Withelm, going afterwards to the widow’s. I was not yet wanted by Eglaf for any +housecarl duty. +</p> + +<p> +“I sent a man to Grimsby yesterday,” I said; “but you must have passed him on +the way somewhere, for he could not have started soon enough to take you a +message before you left.” +</p> + +<p> +“I met him on the road last night, for I myself thought it time to come and see +how you two fared. I bided at Cabourn for the night, and your messenger came on +with me.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told me that all were well at Grimsby; for fish came now and then and +kept the famine from the town, though there were none to send elsewhere; and it +was well that we had left, though they all missed us sorely. +</p> + +<p> +Then we began to talk of the doings here; and at last I spoke of Havelok’s +trouble, as one may well call it, telling him also of the strange dream with +which it all began. +</p> + +<p> +“All this is strange,” he said thoughtfully; “but if Havelok our brother is +indeed a king’s son, it is only what he is like in all his ways. Wise was our +father Grim, and I mind how he seemed always to be careful of him in every way, +and good reason must he have had not to say what he knew. We will not ask aught +until the time of which Arngeir knows has come. Nor can we say aught to +Havelok, though he is troubled, for we know nothing. As for the dream, that is +part of it all, and it is a portent, as I think.” +</p> + +<p> +“Did I know the man who could read it, I would go to him and tell him it.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is one man who can read dreams well,” Withelm answered, flushing a +little, “but I do not know if you would care to seek him. I stayed with him +last night, and he is on his way even now to Lincoln, driven by the famine. I +mean the old British priest David, who has his little hut and chapel in the +Cabourn woods. His people have no more to give him.” +</p> + +<p> +I knew that Withelm thought much of this old man of late, and I was not +surprised to hear him speak of him now. All knew his wisdom, and the marsh folk +were wont to seek him when they were in any trouble or difficulty. But I did +not care to go to him, for he seemed to belong to the thralls, as one might +say. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, if he comes here, no doubt you will know where to find him if we need +him,” I said. “Bide with us for a few days at least, for here is plenty, and +there is much going on.” +</p> + +<p> +So we went into the town, and then to the palace, and found Havelok, and after +that I had to go to the gate on guard. And what these two did I cannot say, +but, at all events, there is nothing worth telling of. +</p> + +<p> +Now, however, I have to tell things that I did not see or hear myself, and +therefore I would have it understood that I heard all from those who took some +part or other in the matter, and so know all well. +</p> + +<p> +I have not said much of the meetings of the Witan, for I had naught more to do +with them than to guard the doors of the hall where they met now and then; but +since the princess and Ragnar came they seem to have somewhat to do with the +story, as will be seen. +</p> + +<p> +On this day one of the Norfolk thanes asked in full meeting what plans the king +had for his ward Goldberga, and her coming into her kingdom, saying that she, +being eighteen years of age, was old enough to take her place. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi had thought of this beforehand, and was ready at once. +</p> + +<p> +“It is a matter of concern to us always,” he said, “and much have I thought +thereof. It is full time that she took her father’s place with the consent of +the Witan, which is needed.” +</p> + +<p> +He looked round us for reply to this, and at once the Norfolk thanes said, “We +will have Goldberga for our queen, as was the will of Ethelwald.” +</p> + +<p> +“That,” said Alsi, “is as I thought. I needed only to hear it said openly. Now, +therefore, it remains but to speak of one other thing and that is a weighty +one. It was her father’s will and I swore to carry it out, that she should be +wedded to the most goodly and mightiest man in the realm. It seems to me that +on her marriage hangs all the wealth of her kingdom; and ill it would be if, +after she took the throne, she took to herself one who made himself an evil +adviser. I would say that it were better to see her married first, for it does +not follow that you would choose to have the man whom I thought fitting to be +over you, as he certainly would be.” +</p> + +<p> +Now all this was so straightforward in all seeming that none of the thanes +could be aught but pleased. Moreover, it took away a fear that they had had +lest Griffin was to be the man. None could say that he fulfilled the conditions +of the will of Ethelwald. The spokesman said, therefore, that it was well set +before them, and that it was best to wait, saying at the end, “For, after all, +we might have to change our minds concerning the princess, if with her we must +take a man who will prove a burden or tyrant to us all.” +</p> + +<p> +Then they asked the king to find a good husband for the princess as soon as +might be, so that he was not against her liking. +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said Alsi, “it is a hard task for a man who has no wife to help him; +but we will trust to the good sense of my niece. Now, I had thought of Ragnar +of Norwich; but it is in my mind that the old laws of near kin are somewhat +against this.” +</p> + +<p> +I suppose that he had no intention of letting the earl marry the princess; but +this was policy, as it might please the thanes. However, the matter of kinship +did not please some, and that was all that he needed, for there was excuse then +for him if he forbade that match, which was the last he wanted. +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar sat in his place and heard all this, and he wished himself back at +Norwich. +</p> + +<p> +So there the matter ended, and that was the last sitting of the Witan. There +was to be a great breaking-up feast that night before the thanes scattered to +their homes. +</p> + +<p> +Now while this was going on I ended my spell of duty, and bethought me of Mord +the chamberlain, and so went to Berthun and asked for him. He said that if I +had any special business with Mord I might see him; and I said, truly enough, +that my errand was special, having to do with friends of his; so it was not +long before they took me to him. He was in a long room that was built on the +side of the great hall, as it were, and I could hear the murmur of the voices +of those who spoke at the Witan while I waited. +</p> + +<p> +Now Mord was not so much changed as I, and at first he did not know me at all. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, master housecarl, what may your message be, and from whom is it?” he +said, without more than a glance at me. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, there are some old friends of yours who are anxious to know if you have +forgotten the feeling of a halter round your neck,” I said in good Danish. +</p> + +<p> +Then, after one look, he knew me at once, and ran to me, and took my hand, and +almost kissed me in his pleasure, for since I could handle an oar he had known +me, and had taught me how to do that, moreover. +</p> + +<p> +Then he called for wine and food; and we sat down together and had a long talk +of the old days, and of how we had fared after he left, and of all else that +came uppermost. And sorely he grieved at my father’s death, and at the trouble +that was on us. The famine had not been so sore in the south, and pestilence +had not been at all. +</p> + +<p> +As for himself, he had been courtman, as we call the housecarls, at first, and +so had risen to be chamberlain to the king, and now to the princess, and had +been with her everywhere that Alsi had sent her since her father died. +</p> + +<p> +“It was a good day for me, and wise was Grim when he bade me go to Ethelwald to +seek service,” he said; “yet I would that I had seen him once more. I have +never been to this place before, else I should have sought him.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I was going to ask him about Havelok, but hardly knew how to begin. He +saved me the trouble however, by speaking first. +</p> + +<p> +“Who were the lady and the boy we had on board when we came to England?” he +said. “I never heard, and maybe it was as well that I did not.” +</p> + +<p> +“My father never told me. But why do you think that it was well not to know?” +</p> + +<p> +“Because I am sure that Grim had good reason for not telling. Before I had been +a year at Norwich there came a ship from Denmark into the river, and soon men +told me that her master was asking for news of one Grim, a merchant, who was +lost. So I saw him, not saying who I was or that I had anything to do with +Grim; and then I found that it was not so much of the master that he wanted +news as of the boy we had with us. He did not ask of the lady at all, and I was +sure that this was the man who came and spoke to Grim just as we were sailing, +if you remember. So then it came to me that we knew nothing of the coming on +board of these two, only learning of their presence when we were far at sea. +And now, if Hodulf troubled himself so much about this boy, there must be +something that he was not meant to know about his flight, for he must be of +some note. Did I not know that the king’s son was in his hands at that time, I +should have thought that our passenger was he. However, I told him of the +shipwreck as of a thing that I had seen, saying that Grim and his family and a +few men only had been saved; and I told him also that I had heard that he had +lost some folk in an attack by Vikings. With that he seemed well satisfied, and +I heard no more of him. I have wondered ever since who the boy was, and if he +was yet alive. I mind that he was like to die when he came ashore.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I laughed, and said that he would hear of him soon enough, for all the +town was talking of him; and he guessed whom I meant, for he had heard of the +cook’s mighty man. +</p> + +<p> +Now I said no more but this: +</p> + +<p> +“My father kept this matter secret all these years, and with reason, as we have +seen; and so, while he is here, we call this foster-brother of mine Curan, +until the time comes when his name may he known. Maybe it will be best for you +not to say much of your knowledge of him. What does Earl Ragnar know of our +wreck? For he told me that you knew me.” +</p> + +<p> +“I told him all about it at one time or another,” Mord answered. “He always +wanted to hear of Denmark.” +</p> + +<p> +So that was all that the chamberlain knew; but it was plain to me that the earl +had put two and two together when he heard Havelok’s name, and had remembered +that this was also the name of Gunnar’s son. Afterwards I found that Mord had +heard from Denmark that Hodulf was said to have made away with Havelok, but he +never remembered that at this time. Ragnar knew this, and did remember it. +</p> + +<p> +Pleasant it was to talk of old days with an old friend thus, and the time went +quickly. Then Mord must go to his mistress and I to my place, and so we parted +for the time. But my last doubt of who Havelok my brother might be was gone. I +was sure that he was the son of Gunnar the king. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap13">CHAPTER XIII.<br/> +THE WITAN’S FEASTING.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now I have to tell of a strange thing that happened in the night that was just +past, the first that the Lady Goldberga had spent here in Lincoln for many a +year, for on that happening hangs a great deal, and it will make clear what I +myself saw presently at the breaking-up feast of the Witan. That puzzled me +mightily at the time, as it did many at the feast, but I see no reason why it +should not be told at once. +</p> + +<p> +Now I have said that Goldberga left the hall early overnight, being wearied +with the journey, and having the remembrance of the attack on her party so near +to Lincoln to trouble her also. Not much cause to love her uncle Alsi had she; +though perhaps, also, not much to make her hate him, except that he had kept +her so far away from her own people of late, in a sort of honourable captivity. +Now it was plain to her that had it not been for the presence of Ragnar and his +men, her guard would not have been able to drive off the attackers; and the +strange way in which Griffin had held back had been too plain for her not to +notice. Already she feared him, and it seemed that he might have plotted her +carrying off thus. That Alsi might have had a hand in the matter did not come +into her mind, as it did into the minds of others, for she knew little of him, +thinking him honest if not very pleasant in his ways, else had not her father +made him her guardian. +</p> + +<p> +I will say now that in the attack he did have a hand. Many a long year +afterward it all came out in some way. He dared not give his niece to Griffin +openly, but he wished to do so, as then he would have an under-king in East +Anglia of his own choosing. Sorely against the grain with him was it that he +should have to give up those fair lands to this girl, who would hold the throne +by her own right, and not at all under him. So he and Griffin had plotted thus, +and only Ragnar’s presence had spoilt the plan, though Griffin had tried to +save it by holding back. But I must say also that up to this time none had had +aught to say against Alsi as a ruler, though he was over close, and not at all +hearty in his ways at home. But now, for the sake of the kingdom, he had begun +to plot; and this plan having come to naught, he must make others, as will be +seen. I do not think that this planning to keep Ethelwald’s kingdom from his +daughter was anything fresh to Alsi, but the time for action had come now. +</p> + +<p> +He had made ready by keeping the fair princess far away, and there were none +who could speak of her goodness, or, indeed, had heard much of her since she +was a child. Therefore, as men were content enough with him, none would trouble +much if the princess came not to the throne, given good reason why she should +not do so. And the very best reason would be that which Alsi had given at the +Witan—if her husband was not fit to be king. +</p> + +<p> +It is possible that Goldberga knew that her marriage would be talked of at this +Witan: but I do not think that she troubled herself much about it, not by any +means intending to be married against her will. I have heard that so ran the +will of Ethelwald, that she was to have choice to some extent. However that may +be, with so many thoughts to trouble her she went to rest, and her sleep was +not easy until the morning was near, and then came quiet. +</p> + +<p> +But presently, in the grey of the dawn, she woke, and called her old nurse, who +was in the chamber with her; and when she came she told her that she had had a +strange vision or dream, so real that she did not know which it was. And what +it portended she could not say, for it was wonderful altogether, and surely was +good. +</p> + +<p> +“I thought that a voice wakened me, calling me to look on somewhat; and so I +rose as I was bidden, and saw before me the most mighty and comeliest man that +could be thought of. Kinglike he was, though he had no crown and was meanly +clad, without brooch or bracelet that a king should wear. But the wonder was +that from his mouth came a bright shaft of flame, as it were of a sunbeam, that +lighted all the place, and on his shoulder shone a cross of burning light as of +red-hot gold, and I knew that it was the mark of a mighty king. +</p> + +<p> +“Then I heard the voice again, and I turned, and saw that it was an angel who +spoke to me, and his face was bright and kind. +</p> + +<p> +“‘Fear not, Goldberga,’ he said, ‘for this is your husband that shall be. +King’s son and heir is he, as that token of the fiery cross shows. More, also, +it will betoken—that he shall reign in England and in Denmark, a great king and +mighty. And this you shall see, and with him shall you reign as queen and +well-loved lady.’ +</p> + +<p> +“So the voice ceased, and the angel was gone, and when I looked up there was +naught but the growing dawn across yon window, and the voice of the thrush that +sings outside.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the old nurse pondered over the dream for a while without speaking, for she +could not see what it might mean at first. +</p> + +<p> +But at last she said, “It is a good dream surely, because of the angel that +spoke; but there seems only one way in which it can come to pass. A prince must +come for you from Denmark, for there he would reign by his own right, and here +he would do so by yours. Yet I have heard that the Danish kings are most +terrible heathen, worse than the Saxon kin, of whom we know the worst now. +Maybe that is why the angel told you to have no fear. I mind Gunnar Kirkeban, +and what he wrought on the churches and Christian folk in Wales—in Gower on the +Severn Sea, and on the holy Dee—when I was young.” +</p> + +<p> +For both Goldberga and this old nurse of hers were Christian, as had been +Orwenna, Ethelwald’s wife, her mother. It had been a great day for them when +the King of Kent had brought over his fair wife, Bertha, from France, for she, +too, was Christian, and had restored the ancient church in the very castle +where Goldberga was kept. +</p> + +<p> +Now the princess went to sleep again, and woke refreshed; but all day long the +memory of the dream and of him whom she saw in it bided with her, until it was +time for her to go to the great hall for the feast of the Witan. +</p> + +<p> +Now it happened that on this night I must be one of the two housecarls who +should stand, torch in hand, behind the king. It was a place that none of the +men cared for much, since they saw their comrades feasting at the end of the +room, while they must bide hungry till the end, and mind that no sparks from +the flaring pine fell on the guests, moreover. Eglaf would have excused me this +had I wished; but I would take my turn with the rest, and maybe did not mind +losing the best of the feast so much as the others. There were some three +hundred guests at that feast, and it was a wondrous fair sight to me as I stood +on the high place and saw them gather. The long table behind which I was ran +right across the dais, rich with gold and silver and glass work: and below +this, all down the hall, ran long tables again, set lengthwise, that none might +have their backs to the king. And at the end of the hall, crosswise, were the +tables for the housecarls, and the men of the house, and of the thanes who were +guests. And as the housecarls came in they hung their shields and weapons on +the walls in order, so that they flashed bright from above the hangings that +Berthun and his men had set up afresh and more gaily than I had seen yet in +this place. +</p> + +<p> +There was a fire on the great hearth in the midst of the hall; but as it was +high summer, only a little one, and over it were no cauldrons, as there would +have been in the winter. Berthun was doing his cookery elsewhere. But between +the tables were spaces where his thralls and the women could pass as they bore +round the food and drink. And backwards and forwards among them went Berthun +until the very last, anxious and important, seeing that all was right, and +showing one guest after another to their places. No light matter was that +either, for to set a thane in too low a place for his rank was likely to be a +cause of strife and complaint. Also he must know if there were old feuds still +remembered, lest he should set deadly enemies side by side. I did not envy him, +by any means. +</p> + +<p> +When it seemed that there were few more guests to come, and only half a dozen +seats were vacant on the high place, Berthun passed into the room beyond the +hall, and at once a hush fell on the noisy folk, who had been talking to one +another as though they had never met before. The gleemen tuned their harps, and +I and my comrade lit our torches from those already burning on the wall, and +stood ready, for the king was coming. +</p> + +<p> +Out of the door backed Berthun with many bows, and loud sang the gleemen, while +all in the hall stood up at once; and then came Alsi, leading the princess, +first; and then Ragnar, with the wife of some great noble; and after him that +noble and another lady; but Griffin was not there. Bright looked Goldberga in +her blue dress, with wondrous jewels on arm and neck, and maybe the brighter +for the absence of the Welsh thane, as I thought. +</p> + +<p> +So they sat as last night, save that the noble who had come next to Ragnar was +in Griffin’s place; and therefore I stood behind the king and the princess, +with the light of my torch falling between the two. +</p> + +<p> +Now they were set, and at once Berthun bore a great beaker of wine to the king, +and all down the hall ran his men with the pitchers of wine and mead and ale, +and with them the women of the household and the wives of the courtmen, filling +every drinking horn for the welcome cup. +</p> + +<p> +Then the gleemen hushed their song, and Alsi stood up with the gold-rimmed horn +of the king in his hand, and high he raised it, and cried, “Waeshael!” +</p> + +<p> +And all the guests rose up, cup in hand, with a wonderful flashing of the +glorious English jewels, and cried with one voice, “Drinc hael, Cyning!” +</p> + +<p> +Then all sat them down, and at once came Berthun’s men with the laden spits and +the cauldrons, and first they served the high table, kneeling on the dais steps +while each noble helped himself and the lady next him with what he would. And +then down the hall the feast began, and for a time befell a silence—the silence +of hungry folk who have before them a good reason for not saying much for a +little while. +</p> + +<p> +I looked for Havelok among Berthun’s men, but he was not there. Nor was he at +the lower cross tables with the other people of the palace. But Withelm was +there, for Eglaf had seen him with me not an hour ago, and had bidden him come, +as a stranger from far off. There were a few other strangers there also, as one +might suppose, for the king’s hall must be open at these times. +</p> + +<p> +Now I looked on all this, and it pleased me; and then I began to hear the talk +of those at the high table, and that was pleasant also. First I heard that +Griffin had fallen off his horse, and had put his arm out. Whereon one said +that he only needed one hand to feed with, and marvelled that so small a hurt +kept him away from so pleasant a place as was his. +</p> + +<p> +“It seems that he fell on his face,” answered a thane who had seen him. “He is +not as handsome as he was last night. That is what keeps him away. Some +passerby put his arm in straightway.” +</p> + +<p> +At that I almost laughed, but kept a face wooden as that of our old statue of +Thor, for Eglaf had warned me that I was but a torch, as it were, unless by any +chance I was spoken to. But Ragnar glanced my way with a half smile. Presently +they began to talk of the stone putting, and of the mighty man who had come +with Berthun, and I saw several looking idly down the hall to see if they could +spy him. One of the thanes on the high seat, at the end, was he who had held +the prizes at these sports. +</p> + +<p> +Now it seemed that Alsi had not heard of this before; and when he had been told +all about it, he said that he did not know that he had any man who was strong +enough to make such a cast as they spoke of, though Eglaf had picked up a big +man somewhere lately, whom he had noticed at the hall end once or twice. +</p> + +<p> +Then he ran his eyes over the tables, for now the women folk had sat down among +the men, and one could see everywhere. But he did not see the man he meant, and +so turned sharply on us two housecarls behind him. +</p> + +<p> +“Here he is,” he said, laughing and looking at me. “Were you the mighty stone +putter they make such a talk of?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am not, lord,” I said, somewhat out of countenance, because every one looked +at me together. It had never seemed to me that I was so big before; perhaps +because I was used to Havelok, and to Raven, who was nigh as tall as myself, +and maybe a bit broader. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, who was he?” said the king. “We must ask Berthun, unless anyone can +see him in the hall.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the thane of the prizes said, “He is not here, lord; for little trouble +would there be in seeing him, if he were, seeing that he is a full head and +shoulders over even this housecarl of yours.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the princess had turned to look at me, and she saw that I was abashed, and +so she smiled at me pleasantly, as much as to say that she was a little sorry +for me, and turned away. Then thought I that if ever the princess needed one to +fight for her, even to death, I would do so for the sake of that smile and the +thought for a rough housecarl that was behind it. +</p> + +<p> +Now came Berthun with more wine, before the matter of the stone was forgotten +in other talk, and the king said, “It seems that you have found a new man, +steward, for all are talking of him. I mean the man who is said to have thrown +a big stone certain miles, or somewhat like it, from all accounts. Where is +he?” +</p> + +<p> +“He is my new porter,” answered Berthun, with much pride; “but he is not in the +hail, for he does not like to hear much of himself, being quiet in his ways, +although so strong.” +</p> + +<p> +“Here is a marvel,” laughed Alsi, “and by-and-by we must see him. I wonder that +Eglaf let you have him.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Eglaf sat at the head of the nearest of the lower tables, and all in +hearing of the king were of course listening by this time. So he said, “The man +had his choice, and chose the heavier place, if you will believe me, lord. It +is terrible to see how Berthun loads him at times; so that I may get him yet.” +</p> + +<p> +Then all laughed at the steward, whose face grew red; but he had to laugh also, +because the jest pleased the king. He went away quickly; and one told Eglaf +that he had better eat no more, else would he run risk of somewhat deadly at +the cook’s hands. But those two were old friends, as has been seen, and they +were ever seeking jests at each other’s expense. +</p> + +<p> +Now the talk drifted away to other things, and I hoped that Havelok had been +forgotten, for no more than I would he like being stared at. The feast went on, +and twice I had to take new torches, but Berthun saw that I had wine, if I +could not eat as yet. Then had men finished eating, and the tables were +cleared, and the singing began, very pleasant to hearken. Not only the gleemen +sang, but the harp went round, and all who could did so. Well do the Lindsey +folk sing, after their own manner, three men at a time, in a gladsome way, with +well-matched voices, and that for just long enough to be pleasant. +</p> + +<p> +So the harp went its way down the hall, and the great folk fell to talk again; +and at last one said, so that Alsi heard him, “Why, we have not seen the strong +man yet. Strange that he is not feasting with the rest.” +</p> + +<p> +Whereat the king beckoned Berthun. +</p> + +<p> +“Bring your new wonder here,” he said. “Say that I have heard of his deed, and +would look on him.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun bowed and went his way; and I wondered how my brother would bear this, +for the hall and its ordering was wont, as I have said, to bring back his +troubled thoughts of things half remembered. +</p> + +<p> +Presently he came in at the door at the lower end of the hall, and at first +none noticed him, for there was singing going on, and through that door came +and went many with things for the feast from the kitchens. Then some one turned +to see who towered over them thus, and when he saw Havelok he went on looking, +so that others looked also. Then one of the three singers looked, and his voice +stayed, for he was a stranger, and had heard nothing of this newcomer, and then +Havelok followed Berthun up the hall in a kind of hush that fell, and he was +smiling a little, as if it amused him. He had on the things that the steward +had given him, and they were good enough—as good as, if more sober than, my +housecarl finery. But I suppose that not one in all the gathering looked at +what he wore; for as he passed up the long tables, it seemed that there was no +man worth looking at but he, and even Ragnar seemed to be but a common man when +one turned to him with eyes that had seen Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi the king sat staring at him, still as a carven image, with his hand +halfway to his mouth, as he raised his horn from the table; and Ragnar looked +wide-eyed, for he knew him again, and I saw a little smile curl the corners of +his lips and pass; and then Havelok was at the step of the high place, and +there he gave the salute of the courtmen of a Danish king, heeding Berthun, who +tried to make him do reverence, not at all. +</p> + +<p> +Now a spark from my torch drew my eyes from him, lest it should fall on the +princess’s robe; and when it went out, I saw that the fair hand that rested on +the arm of the great chair was shaking like a leaf. When I looked, her face was +white and troubled, and she half rose from her seat and then sank back in it +gently, and the thane who sat next her spoke anxiously to her in a low voice, +and the lady by his side rose up and came to her. +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi turned, and he too spoke, asking if aught was amiss. +</p> + +<p> +“The princess faints with the heat of the hall,” said the thane’s wife. “She +yet feels the long journey. May she not go hence?” +</p> + +<p> +Then Goldberga said bravely, “It is naught, and it will pass.” +</p> + +<p> +But they made her rise and leave the hall; and the guests stood up as she went +with her ladies round her, and many were the murmurs of pity that I heard. +</p> + +<p> +“As though she had seen a ghost, so white is she,” one whispered. +</p> + +<p> +But none knew how much the lady was to be pitied. She had seen the man of her +vision; and, lo! for all that she knew, he was a thrall who toiled in the +palace kitchens. +</p> + +<p> +And after her, as she withdrew, looked Havelok with eyes in which there was +more than pity. I could see him well, but I did not know how he had seen the +fair princess tremble and grow white as she gazed on him. I know that, as he +saw her for this first time, it was with the wish that he were in Ragnar’s +place. But I thought that if Havelok were king, here was the queen for him. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi bade the feast go on, and be spoke a few words only to Havelok, +letting him go at once, and I was glad. This sudden faintness of the princess +had put all out somewhat, and none cared to take up a jest where it had stayed. +Nevertheless, I saw the king’s eyes follow my brother down the hall, and in +them was a new and strange look that was not pleasant at all. +</p> + +<p> +Then it seemed that one was staring at me, and as will happen, I must look in a +certain place; and there was Cadwal, the Welsh thane, halfway down one of the +long tables, glaring first at me, and then at Havelok, as he went. It came into +my mind that he would be wroth with Ragnar for bringing a kitchen knave as his +second, as it were, in derision of Griffin. I thought that I would find a +chance presently to tell him why my fellow second chose to be serving thus, and +so make things right with him, for this seemed to be due to Ragnar, if not to +all concerned. +</p> + +<p> +Not long after Goldberga had gone, the king withdrew also, and then the hall +grew noisy enough, and I could leave my place. But by that time Cadwal had left +also; and next day, when I sought him, both he and Griffin were no longer in +Lincoln, none knowing whither they had gone. So I troubled no more about them. +</p> + +<p> +But had I known that these two had been among the Welshmen that Hodulf led to +Denmark when he slew Gunnar Kirkeban, and therefore knew all the story of the +loss of Havelok, and how Hodulf had sought for news of him, I should have been +in fear enough that we had not yet done with them. Rightly, too, should I have +feared that, as will be seen. +</p> + +<p> +Now while I looked about the hall for Cadwal, Mord the chamberlain saw me, and +made me sit down by him while I ate. Hungry enough was I by that time, as may +be supposed, for one cannot make a meal off the sight of a feast; and as I ate, +the noise of the hall grew apace as the cups went round. Then some of the older +thanes left, and soon Mord and I had that table to ourselves. It was plain that +he was full of something that he would say to me, and when I was ready to +listen he bent near me and said, “So that was the boy who fled with us.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay. He has grown since you saw him last.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is not all,” answered Mord. “Well I knew Gunnar, our king, and tonight I +thought he had come back to us from Valhalla, goodlier yet and mightier than +ever, as one who has feasted with the Asir might well be. For if this boy of +ours is not Gunnar’s son, then he is Gunnar himself.” +</p> + +<p> +Now that was no new thought to me, as I have shown, and I was ready for it, +seeing that even I had seen the likeness to the king as I remembered him. +</p> + +<p> +“Keep that thought to yourself for a while, Mord,” I said. “It is in my mind +that you are right, but the time has not yet come for me to know.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is wisdom, too,” he answered; “for if once he gathers a following, there +is a bad time in store for Hodulf. And it will be better that we fall on him +unawares, before he knows that Havelok, son of Gunnar, lives.” +</p> + +<p> +“We fall on him?” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, you and I, mail on chest and weapon in hand, with Havelok to lead us. +What? think you that I would hold back when Gunnar’s son is calling?” +</p> + +<p> +“Steady, friend,” I said, laughing; “men will be looking at us.” +</p> + +<p> +So he was silent again; and now I thought that the time of which my father +spoke had surely come, for it was plain that Havelok was a man whom men would +gladly follow as he went to win back his kingdom. And I went and fetched +Withelm from where he sat, and so we three talked long and pleasantly, until it +was time for us to go forth from the hall. And we thought that it was good for +Arngeir to come here, for the secret was coming to light of itself, as it were, +and we would have him speak with Mord. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap14">CHAPTER XIV.<br/> +THE CRAFT OF ALSI THE KING.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now Alsi the king went from the feast with a new and cruel thought in his mind +under the smiling face that he wore, and long he sat in his own chamber, chin +on hand and eyes far off, thinking; and at last he called Berthun. +</p> + +<p> +“What is the name of this big knave of yours?” he asked, when the steward stood +before him. +</p> + +<p> +“He calls himself Curan, lord.” +</p> + +<p> +“Calls himself. Well, it is likely that he knows his own name best. Is he +Welsh, therefore?” +</p> + +<p> +“So I think, lord.” +</p> + +<p> +“You might have been certain by this time, surely. I like Welshmen about the +place, and I was giving you credit for finding me a good one. Whence comes he?” +</p> + +<p> +Now it was on Berthun’s tongue to say that he thought that Curan came from the +marshland, yet clinging to his own thoughts of what he was. He did not at all +believe that he came from that refuge of thralls. But he must seem certain +unless he was to be laughed at again. +</p> + +<p> +So he said, “He comes from the marsh-country.” +</p> + +<p> +“Does he speak Welsh?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have heard him do so to the market people, if he happened to meet a Briton +there.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, of course he is Welsh: and here have I found out in two minutes +what you have taken I do not know how long to think about. Go to, Berthun; you +grow slow of mind with good living.” +</p> + +<p> +The king chuckled, and Berthun bowed humbly; but now the steward was determined +to say no more than he was obliged in answer to more questions. Also he began +to hope that Alsi would ask nothing about the clothes this man of his wore, +else he would be well laughed at for spending his money on a stranger. +</p> + +<p> +But Alsi seemed pleased with himself, or else with what he had heard, and went +on. +</p> + +<p> +“Has this Curan friends in the town?” +</p> + +<p> +“None, lord, so far as I know.” +</p> + +<p> +“Let me tell you that you may know a man’s friends by the company he keeps. +With whom does he talk?” +</p> + +<p> +“None come to seek him, lord, except one of the housecarls—the big man to whom +you spoke tonight. Seldom does he go into the town, and then only the porters +seem to know him, for he was among them, as a stranger, when I met him first.” +</p> + +<p> +“A big man will always make an acquaintance with another,” Alsi said, “and the +porters are the lowest in the place. One may be sure that he has left his +friends in some starving village in the marsh, and has none here. That will do, +Berthun. Take care of him, for I may have use for him. But next time you hire a +man, use your wits to learn somewhat of him, if it is too much trouble to ask.” +</p> + +<p> +So Berthun was dismissed, and went out in a bad temper with himself. Yet he +knew that he would have been laughed at for a fool if he had said that he +thought Curan more than he seemed. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi was alone, and he fell to thought again. By-and-by it was plain to be +understood what his thoughts had been, and they were bad. And after he had +slept on them they were no better, seeing what came of them. But I think that +he was pleased to find that Havelok was, as he thought, a Welsh marshman, and +well-nigh friendless, for so he would be the more ready to do what he was +bidden; though, indeed, there seemed little doubt that the plan Alsi made for +himself would find no stumbling block in Curan, if it might meet with a check +elsewhere. That, however, was to be seen. +</p> + +<p> +Well pleased was Alsi the king with somewhat, men said in the morning. +</p> + +<p> +But there was one who rose heavy and sorely troubled, and that was the Lady +Goldberga, for all the fancies that had been brought to her by the vision had +come to nothing, or worse than nothing, as she looked on Havelok and saw in the +cook’s knave the very form of him of whom she had dreamed, and whom she could +not forget. Glad had she been to go to her own chamber and away from the kindly +ladies who could not know her real trouble; but not even to her old nurse did +she tell what that was. Her one thought now was to seek someone who was skilful +in the reading of dreams, and so find some new hope from it all. But no one +could tell her of such a one here, unless it were to be a priest of Woden, and +that she would not hear of. +</p> + +<p> +Then, early in the morning, Alsi sent for her, saying that he would speak with +her alone for a while. So she went to him, where he sat in the chamber beyond +the high place; and he greeted her kindly, asking after her rest, and saying +that he hoped that the sudden faintness had hurt her not. Then he led her to a +seat, and bade her rest while he talked of state affairs. +</p> + +<p> +“For it must be known to you, my niece, that the Witan thinks it time that you +should take your father’s kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Goldberga knew that, and had long made up her mind that when the time came +she would not shrink from the burden of the crown. +</p> + +<p> +It may well have been that Alsi thought that she would wish to wait for a time +yet, for he did not seem altogether pleased when she answered, “If the Witan +thinks right, I am ready.” +</p> + +<p> +“But,” he said, “there is one thing to come before that. The Witan must know +who your husband shall be. And that is reasonable, for he will have a share in +ruling the kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Goldberga, “They need have no fear in that matter, for I will wed +none but a king or the heir of a king.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said Alsi, dryly enough, “they are not so plentiful as are +blackberries, and there may be two words to that.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am not anxious to be wedded,” answered the princess, “and I can wait. It is, +as you say, a matter that is much to the country.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi tried another plan, seeing that Goldberga was not at all put out by +this. So he forced a cunning smile that was meant to be pleasant, and said, “I +had thought that your mind ran somewhat on Ragnar.” +</p> + +<p> +He looked to see the lady change colour, but she did not. +</p> + +<p> +“Ragnar is my cousin,” she said, “or a good brother to me, if you will. +Moreover, until the other day when he met me in London by some good fortune, I +had hardly seen him since my father died.” +</p> + +<p> +“What think you of Griffin?” +</p> + +<p> +“Nothing at all, for nidring he is,” answered Goldberga with curling lip. +</p> + +<p> +Now that angered Alsi, for he had so much to do with that business; and if +Griffin was to be called thus by his fault, he was likely to lose a friend. +</p> + +<p> +“I would have you remember,” he said, “that in all this choosing it remains for +me to give consent or withhold it.” +</p> + +<p> +“I shall only ask your consent to my wedding such a man as I have told you of, +uncle—a king or a king’s son.” +</p> + +<p> +“So,” said Alsi, “you would choose first, and ask me afterwards, forsooth! That +is not the way that things are to be between us. It is for me to choose, and +that according to the oath which I took when your father made me guardian of +you and his realm.” +</p> + +<p> +“Yet,” said Goldberga very gently, “I think that my father would not have meant +that I should be the only one not to be asked.” +</p> + +<p> +“I can only go by what I swore, and that I will carry out. I promised to see +you married to the most goodly and mightiest man in the land.” +</p> + +<p> +“That can be none but a king, as I think.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi grew impatient, for he meant to settle one matter before he went much +farther. +</p> + +<p> +“I will say at once that I can have no king over the East Anglian kingdom. It +is not to be thought of that after all these years I should have to take second +place there. You will hold the kingdom from me, and I shall be overlord there. +I will send you some atheling who can keep the land in order for you, but there +shall be no king to bring that land under the power of his own kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +That was plain speaking, and it roused Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +“Never have you been overlord of my kingdom,” she said. “Well have you ruled it +for me while I could not rule it myself, and for that I thank you heartily. But +it is not right that I should seem to hold it from you.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is to be seen,” sneered Alsi, “for it lies with me to say what marriage +you make, and on that depends whether the Witan, in its wisdom, sees fit to +hail you as queen. Not until you are married will you take the kingdom at all.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said the princess, growing pale, “I will speak to the Witan myself, and +learn their will.” +</p> + +<p> +“The Witan has broken up,” answered Alsi, “and the good thanes are miles on +their way homewards by this time. You are too late.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will call them up again.” +</p> + +<p> +“Certainly—that is, if I let my men run hither and thither to fetch them. But +after all, in this matter I am master. Whom you wed lies with me.” +</p> + +<p> +Goldberga saw that she was in the hands of the king, and maybe as much a +prisoner as at Dover. So her spirits fled, and she asked what the king willed. +</p> + +<p> +Alsi knew now that nothing but his utmost plan would be of any avail to save +that kingdom for himself, and so he broke out into wrath, working up his fury +that he might not go back. +</p> + +<p> +“My will is that you obey me in this carrying out of the oath I took on the +holy ring, <a href="#fn10" name="fnref10"><sup>[10]</sup></a> and on the +Gospels also to please your mother. You shall marry the man whom I choose, so +that he be according to the words of that oath.” +</p> + +<p> +“So that he be king or son of a king, I will obey you,” answered Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +“Then you defy me. For that I have told you that I will not have. Now shall we +see who is master. You mind yon kitchen knave of last night? There can be none +in all England mightier or more goodly than he is to look on, and him shall you +wed. So will my oath be well kept. Then if your precious Witan will have him, +well and good, for his master shall I be.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat the princess said that it were better that she should die; but now Alsi +had set out all his plan to her, and he did not mean to flinch from carrying it +out. There was no doubt that the Norfolk people would hold that she had +disgraced herself by the marriage, and so would refuse to have her as queen. +And that was all he needed. +</p> + +<p> +But Goldberga had no more to say, for she was past speaking, and the king was +fain to call her ladies. And when they came he went away quickly, and gave +orders for the safe keeping of the princess, lest she should try to fly, or to +get any message to Ragnar or other of the Norfolk thanes. +</p> + +<p> +Now he must go through with this marriage, for he had shown himself too +plainly, and never would the princess trust him again. I have heard that he +sent for Griffin at this time; but, as I found, he was gone; and if the king +thought that perhaps the princess would wed him now to escape from the kitchen +knave, he had no chance to bring him forward. I suppose he could have made out +that Griffin, or for that matter any one else he chose, was such a one as his +oath to Ethelwald demanded. +</p> + +<p> +Sore wept Goldberga when she was back in her own place, and at first it was +hard for her to believe that Alsi could mean what he had threatened. But then +she could not forget her dream, and in that she had most certainly seen the +very form of him who stood before her at the high place last night; and that +perhaps troubled her more than aught, for it seemed to say that him she must +wed. But no king’s son could he be, so that there must be yet such another +mighty man to be found. +</p> + +<p> +And then in her heart she knew that there could not be two such men, both alike +in all points to him of the vision. And she knew also, though maybe she would +not own it, that if this Curan had been but a thane of little estate, she could +have had naught to say against the matter. +</p> + +<p> +And so at last she found that in her trouble and doubt and wish for peace she +was thinking, “Would that he were not the kitchen knave!” +</p> + +<p> +Now, it chanced that the old nurse had gone out into the town, and was away all +this while, so that she knew nothing of this new trouble; and presently she was +coming back with her arms full of what she had bought, and there met her +Havelok and Withelm, who had been to the widow’s, and were on their way to find +me at the gate. +</p> + +<p> +“Mother,” said Havelok, “let me help you up with these things.” +</p> + +<p> +That frightened the old lady, for she had been looking at him, and had made up +her mind that he was some mighty noble, as did most strangers. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, lord,” she said; “that is not fitting for you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Less fitting is it that a strong man should see you thus burdened and not +help. No lord am I, but only the cook’s man. So I am going to the palace.” +</p> + +<p> +But this she would not believe at first, and still refused. However, Lincoln +Hill is very steep, and she was not sorry when Havelok laughed and took the +things from her so soon as she had to halt for breath. +</p> + +<p> +“Curan will carry you up also, if you will, mother,” said Withelm. +</p> + +<p> +The nurse tossed her head at him and made no answer, being on her dignity at +once. Moreover, she had heard of Curan by this time, though she had not seen +him before. So she said no more, and went on proudly enough, with her mighty +attendant after her; but all the while it was in her mind that there was some +jest, or maybe wager, between the two. +</p> + +<p> +Now Withelm stopped at the gate; but I was not there, for I had been sent to +the palace, where guards were to be at each door. The word was that some plot +had been found out against the princess, and that therefore we had to be +careful. One easily believed that with all the talk about the attack made on +her party that was flying about. So he came on to the palace kitchens, for +Berthun knew him well, having so often bought fish from him in the market; and +there he sat down to talk with the steward, for there was nothing much going on +at the time, and I was on guard. +</p> + +<p> +Now, the old nurse went to her mistress; and Goldberga sat in the shadow, and +was weeping no longer, seeing that it would not help at all. +</p> + +<p> +“There is a wonder down yonder,” said the old lady, not seeing that there had +been any trouble yet—“such a man as I never saw in all my days; and he even +carried my goods up all the hill for me, old and ugly as I am. That is not what +every young man would do nowadays. Maybe it was different when I was young, or +else my being young made the difference. The youth with him called him Curan, +which is the name of the strong porter they prate of, but doubtless that was a +jest. This is the most kingly man that could be; and I ween that those two made +a wager that he dared not carry a bundle up to the palace, whereby I was the +gainer, for breath grows short up that pitch. And when I thanked him he bowed +in that wise that can only come of being rightly taught when one is young. Now, +I am going to ask Berthun who he is, for he spoke to him when he saw him, and +that humbly, as it seemed.” +</p> + +<p> +So talked the nurse, and to all Goldberga answered never a word, for all the +trouble came back again, and with it the thought that she hated, that if only— +</p> + +<p> +Then, as the nurse was leaving her, she called her back. +</p> + +<p> +“Nurse,” she said, “I am in sore trouble about the dream. It bides with me, and +will not cease to puzzle me until I weary for some one to read it plainly. I +would that Queen Bertha’s good chaplain were here, for I might have been helped +by him.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the nurse came back, quick to hear the sad tone in the voice of her whom +she had tended and loved since she was a child. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, my pretty, have you been weeping?” she said. “There was naught in a dream +like that to fray you thus.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but it has come to me that this place is altogether heathen; and it may +have come from the hand of Freya, the false fiend that they worship as a +goddess, so that I may be ready to wed a heathen. Is there no Christian in all +this place?” +</p> + +<p> +“There are Welsh folk yet left in the marsh,” said the nurse, pondering; “and +where there is a Briton there is a Christian, and there, also, will be a hidden +priest. But it would be as much as his life is worth to come here, even could +we find one.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Goldberga said, “Alsi is not altogether heathen. If I asked he would +surely grant this.” +</p> + +<p> +For she thought that she knew how to gain consent. +</p> + +<p> +“If one can be found, and that is not likely. Well, then, I will ask Berthun, +who is good-natured enough, and most likely will not trouble about a Christian +coming here; and if so, we need not even ask Alsi.” +</p> + +<p> +So she went, not thinking for a moment that there was a priest of the faith to +be heard of. Mostly she wanted to hear more of Havelok, but she would honestly +do her other errand. +</p> + +<p> +But on her way across the courtyard she met Mord, and he was a great friend of +hers. +</p> + +<p> +“Whither now, nurse? They will not let you go out of the palace. They say that +there is trouble on hand with those folk that fell on us, and we have to bide +in shelter for a day or two.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I have been down the town this hour, and all is quiet enough. This Alsi +is an over-timid man. But I was seeking Berthun with a strange message from the +princess, and one that is not over safe here.” +</p> + +<p> +“Let me give it then.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, it is nothing more or less than to ask if he can find a Christian +priest. Our mistress has had a strange dream, and it is true that it sorely +troubles her. So she wants one to whom she may tell it, that it may be read +aright. But though I must ask, I do not hope to find one.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why,” said Mord, “there is not one Christian in all Lindsey.” +</p> + +<p> +“I would not say that. When I was first here with Orwenna the queen, before she +married Ethelwald, there were some in the marsh; for one day I heard my own +tongue spoken there, hunting with my mistress; and so she stayed and talked +with these poor folk, though the Welsh they spoke was bad enough. But they were +Christians, as they told her in fear and trembling. They have not so much need +to fear now.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then I can help you,” said Mord gladly. “Say nothing to the cook, for I have +found old friends who come from far in the marsh, and they will tell me at once +if they have heard of any priest. Why, when I think, they know Welsh, and one +has called himself by a Welsh name, and you have seen him—Curan the porter.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay; then do you ask these friends, and tell them that the sooner they can +bring a priest the better shall they be rewarded. I would give much to have +Goldberga’s mind set at rest.” +</p> + +<p> +So Mord said that he would go at once; and glad he was to see Withelm sitting +with Berthun, +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said the steward, “I have known Withelm of Grimsby for the last ten +years or so, and I do not suppose that it matters if you speak with him.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why should it matter if I speak with any one I choose?” asked Mord, somewhat +angrily. +</p> + +<p> +“That you must ask the king; for his orders are that the people of the princess +have no dealings with outsiders for two days.” +</p> + +<p> +“Mighty careful of us is Alsi all of a sudden,” said Mord. “I suppose he thinks +that someone will stick a seax into some of us in all friendly wise while we +are talking.” +</p> + +<p> +But Berthun only laughed, and went to where the nurse was beckoning to him. He +told her his own thoughts of Havelok, being glad to have a ready hearer. +</p> + +<p> +At once Withelm was able to tell Mord that the old priest who was his friend +was in Lincoln at this time by good chance, and that he would surely come to +the princess at need. But when they came to talk of when and how, it did not +seem all so easy; and Mord went to the nurse to tell her all. +</p> + +<p> +Then they had to speak to Berthun about it, and he was kindly and willing to +help; but he said that none might come to speak with the princess without leave +from the king. No doubt he would grant it easily, if asked by Goldberga +herself. +</p> + +<p> +“I will go and tell her,” said the old lady. “Keep your man here till I +return.” +</p> + +<p> +Now she brought this good news to the princess, and one need not say how she +rejoiced. And now a thought had come to her, and she was eager to send a +message to Alsi. +</p> + +<p> +“Surely,” she thought, “he does but threaten me with the kitchen knave, that he +may make me change my will. And, therefore, if I say that I am ready to obey +him, he will be pleased; and then time is gained at the least, and it is not +possible that he will choose so badly for me after all.” +</p> + +<p> +So when the nurse asked her what she would do about getting the priest to her +presence, she said, “Go and tell my uncle first that I am willing to obey him +in the matter of which we spoke this morning.” +</p> + +<p> +“So that was what has troubled you after all, and not the dream? I thought it +should not have made all these tear marks,” said the nurse quickly. “Now, why +did you not tell me? I dare give Alsi a talking to if he needs it.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, nurse, but it was the dream. My uncle and I did but disagree on somewhat, +and maybe I was wrong. By-and-by I will tell you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Tell me now, and then I shall know better how to ask for what you need.” +</p> + +<p> +But Goldberga could not bring herself to say what Alsi had threatened, and now +felt sure that she would hear no more of that. So she told the nurse that she +had vowed only to marry a king, and that Alsi had been angry, saying that kings +were not so easily found. Also, that he was the man who had to find her a +husband. +</p> + +<p> +“That is the best sense that this king ever spoke,” said the nurse. “Many a +long year might you wait if you had your way thus. You are wise in sending that +message. Well, after that I will ask him to let you see the priest, saying, if +he is cross-grained, that a talk with him will make your mind even better +fitted to obey. Many things like that I can say. We shall have him here +presently.” +</p> + +<p> +Now, all that seemed very good to both of them, and the nurse went her way. And +when she came to Alsi, she gave the message plainly. +</p> + +<p> +“That will save a great deal of trouble,” said the king. “Tell her that I am +glad to hear it. She says this of her own accord, and not at your advice?” +</p> + +<p> +“She told me before I had heard a word of what the trouble was between you. It +was no word of mine.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am glad of it. But I will say that I am somewhat surprised.” +</p> + +<p> +And that was true, for this message seemed to Alsi to be nothing more or less +than that Goldberga would marry his man. When he thought for a moment, however, +he saw that it could not be thus; and also, it was plain to him what the poor +girl had in her mind. And now he chuckled to think what a weapon he had against +her. Nor would he be slow to use it. +</p> + +<p> +Then the nurse said that he need have no surprise, for Goldberga was ever +gentle and willing to be led, though sometimes the pride of her race came +uppermost for a time. And then she asked if a certain priest of the faith might +come and speak with her. +</p> + +<p> +Now, Alsi knew that only one could be meant—namely, the hermit who bided at +Cabourn. He had heard of him often, and would not suffer him to be hurt, for +his sister Orwenna had protected him. The heathen English minded him not at all +by this time, for he was the best leech in the land, and so useful to them. So +Alsi said pleasantly that he was quite willing that the priest should come, +deeming that he was at Cabourn, and that it would be a day or two before he +would be brought. +</p> + +<p> +So he called the housecarl from outside the door, and when he came he said, +“Pass the word that when one who calls himself David comes and asks for the +princess, he is to be admitted to her.” +</p> + +<p> +So that was made easy, and the nurse thanked him and withdrew; and when he was +alone, Alsi grinned evilly and rubbed his hands. +</p> + +<p> +“Now is East Anglia mine in truth,” he said; and with that he bade the +housecarl fetch Curan, the cook’s porter, to him. And then he sent one to +Ragnar with such a message that he rode out that night and away to Norwich. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap15">CHAPTER XV.<br/> +THE FORTUNE OF CURAN THE PORTER.</a></h2> + +<p> +While the nurse told Withelm to fetch the priest when Alsi was in the hall that +evening, the housecarl came for Havelok; and much wondering, he followed the +man to the king, and presently stood before him and saluted. +</p> + +<p> +“Where did you get that salute?” said Alsi sharply, seeing at once that it was +not English; and, indeed, it was that of Gunnar’s courtmen. +</p> + +<p> +“I cannot tell,” answered my brother. “It seems to be there when needed.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, it is not that used here. Get the housecarls to teach you better +manners.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok bowed a little, in token that he would do so; and when Alsi spoke +to him next it was in Welsh. +</p> + +<p> +“You are a marshman, as I hear?” +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok had learned fairly well from the poor folk who loved him, but +carelessly, so that when he answered Alsi frowned at his way of speaking. +</p> + +<p> +“I am from the marsh,” he said simply. +</p> + +<p> +“We had better get back to English!” the king said; “you people forget your own +tongue. Now, are you married?” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat Havelok laughed lightly. +</p> + +<p> +“That I am not,” he answered. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, if I find you a fair wife, you would be willing, doubtless?” +</p> + +<p> +“That I should not,” answered Havelok bluntly, and wondering what this +crafty-looking king was driving at. “What could I do with a wife? For I have +neither house nor goods, nor where to take her, nor withal to keep her; else +had I not been the cook’s knave.” +</p> + +<p> +“It would seem that you carry all your fortune on your back, therefore,” said +Alsi, looking at Havelok’s gay attire with somewhat of a sneer. +</p> + +<p> +“That may well be, King Alsi, for even these clothes are not my own. Berthun +gave them me, and I think that they come from yourself.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi grinned, for Eglaf’s saying of him was not so far wrong; but he had more +serious business on hand than to talk of these things with a churl. +</p> + +<p> +“Now, if I bid you, it is your part to obey. I have a wife for you, and her you +shall wed.” +</p> + +<p> +“There are two words to that, King Alsi. Neither will I wed against my will, +nor will I wed one who is unwilling.” +</p> + +<p> +“As to that first,” said the king, for he began to be angered with Havelok’s +boldness, “if a man will not do my bidding, I have dungeons where he can have +time to think things over, and men who can keep him there, be he never so +mighty; and if a man will not see with my eyes when I bid him, blinded shall he +be.” +</p> + +<p> +This he said somewhat hurriedly, for a dark flush came on the face of the man +before him, and he thought that he must try some other plan than force with +him. +</p> + +<p> +“And as for that other point, I did not so much as hint that the bride was +likely to be unwilling. I will say that she is willing, rather.” +</p> + +<p> +Now that troubled Havelok, for it seemed that all was arranged already, and the +thought of the dungeon was not pleasant. There was no doubt that if the king +chose he could cast him into one until he was forgotten; and the light and the +breath of the wind from the sea were very dear to Havelok. So he thought that +he would at least gain time by seeming to listen to the proposal; for, after +all, it might come to nothing, and maybe it was but a jest, though a strange +one. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, lord king,” he said, “if the bride knows enough of me to be willing, it +is but fair that I should have the like chance of choice.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi thought that it was impossible that this churl, as he deemed him, +would not be overjoyed to hear of the match he had made for him, and he must +needs know it soon. Yet there was that about Havelok that puzzled him, for his +ways were not those of a churl, and he spoke as a freeman should speak. +</p> + +<p> +So much the more likely that the people would believe him when he said that +Goldberga wedded him of her own wish, he thought. It was as well that he was +not altogether a common-seeming man. +</p> + +<p> +“You have seen the damsel already,” he said therefore. “Now I will not say that +this match is altogether of my choosing; but I have an oath to keep, and it +seems that I can only keep it by making you her husband. But, as I say, she is +willing, and, I will add, well dowered.” +</p> + +<p> +Now it grew plain to my brother that there was something strange in all this, +so he said, “An oath is a thing that must not be hindered in the fulfilling, if +a man can further it. But what has a king’s oath to do with me?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have sworn to find her the goodliest and mightiest man alive; and, though I +must needs say it to your face, there is none like yourself. No flattery this +to bend you to my will, but sober truth—at least, as I see it.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Havelok grew impatient. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, if that be so, who is the bride?” he asked, not caring to give the king +his title, or forgetting to do so, for on him was coming the feeling that he +was this man’s equal here in the palace. And at last, not seeming to notice +this, Alsi answered plainly. +</p> + +<p> +“The Princess Goldberga.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok stared at him in blank wonder for some moments; and Alsi grew red +under his gaze, and his eyes were shifty, and would not meet the honest look +that was on him. +</p> + +<p> +Then at last said Havelok slowly, and watching the king intently all the while, +“What this means I cannot tell. If you speak truth, it is wonderful; and if +not, it is unkingly.” +</p> + +<p> +“On my word as a king, truth it is,” said Alsi hastily, for there was that in +Havelok’s face that he did not like. +</p> + +<p> +One might think that the king was growing afraid of his own kitchen knave. +</p> + +<p> +“If that is so, there is no more to be said,” answered Havelok. “Yet you will +forgive me if I say that I must have this from the lips of the princess herself +as well. It may be that her mind will change.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is but fair,” answered Alsi; “and you are a wise man. The mind of a +damsel is unsteady, whether she be princess or milkmaid; but have no fear.” +</p> + +<p> +“No man fear I; but I do fear to hurt any lady, and I would not do that.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi thought that all was well, and he spoke smooth words to my brother, +so that Havelok doubted him more than ever. Therefore it came into his mind +that all he could do for the best was to seem to agree, and wait for what the +princess herself said. And if Alsi was working some subtlety, then he would +wring his neck for him, if need be; and after that—well, the housecarls would +cut him in pieces, and he would slay some of them, and so go to Valhalla, and +dreams would be at an end. And he would have died to some purpose here, for he +knew that Goldberga would come to her kingdom, ay, and maybe Alsi’s as well, +for she was his sister’s daughter, and his next of kin, and well loved by those +who had been allowed to know aught of her. +</p> + +<p> +But I would not have any think that the promise of so wondrous a bride was not +pleasing to him. It was more, for he had seen her grow white and troubled as +she looked on him, and he had seen her bear well whatever pain had caused that; +and he had known that in the one sight he had of Goldberga somewhat had taught +him what it was to have one face unforgotten in his mind. +</p> + +<p> +So he said to Alsi, “All this fortune that you hold out to me is most unlooked +for, seeing what I am in your hall; and I have not thanked you yet, King Alsi. +That, however, is hard to do, as you may understand.” +</p> + +<p> +“I understand well enough,” answered the king, in high good humour again, now +that all seemed to be going well. “And after all, it is the lady whom you must +thank.” +</p> + +<p> +“But when shall I see her to do so?” +</p> + +<p> +“Tomorrow, surely; ay, tomorrow early shall you speak with her,” answered the +king quickly. “Now go, and hold your peace. Let me warn you that there are +those about the court who would go any lengths to remove you from the face of +the earth if they knew of this. Tell no man of the honour that has come to you +as yet. Be the porter for a short time longer, and then you will be the man +whom all envy. It is likely that I must make you a thane, by right of the +choice of the princess.” +</p> + +<p> +“I know well when to speak and when to keep silence, lord king,” said my +brother, and with that he bowed and left the hall. +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi put his lips to a silver whistle that he carried, and blew a call +that brought Eglaf hurriedly to him from the outer door. +</p> + +<p> +“The guards may go,” said the king; “but see that the porter Curan leaves not +the palace until I myself send him forth tomorrow.” +</p> + +<p> +The captain saluted and went his way. He had had six men within call of the +king all the time that he spoke with Havelok, and one may make what one likes +of that. At least the threat of the dungeon was no idle one. +</p> + +<p> +Now went Havelok from the hall very heavy and troubled, for beyond the fair +talk of the king lurked surely some plan that was not fair at all. It was not +to be thought that he could not prevent, if he chose, a foolish marriage of the +princess, even did she desire it ever so much. And my brother could not believe +that she had set her heart on one whom she had but seen once, and then in the +midst of faintness. That, however, might be known easily when he was face to +face with her. It was a thing that could not be made a matter of pretence. +</p> + +<p> +Now when he came back to the great kitchen, which was nigh as big as the hall, +Withelm was yet there, for the priest was at the widow’s, and there was no +haste to bring him; and by that time I had come in also, and was sitting with +him at the far end, where none had need to come. It was Berthun’s own end, as +one might say, and he was lord in his own place. Only a few thralls were about, +and the cook himself had gone into the town. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is our brother,” I said, “and there is somewhat wrong.” +</p> + +<p> +He came moodily up to us, and sat him down, saying nothing, and he leaned his +head on his hands for a while. +</p> + +<p> +“What is amiss, brother?” said Withelm. +</p> + +<p> +“Wait,” he answered. “I will think before I speak.” +</p> + +<p> +I could see that this was not the old puzzlement, but something new and heavy, +so we held our peace. Long was he before he moved or spoke, and when he did so +it was wearily. +</p> + +<p> +“Well knew I that somewhat was to happen to me in this town, even as I told +you, brother, when we first passed its gates. And now it seems to be coming to +pass. For this is what is on me, as it seems to me—either that I must see the +light of day no more, or must live to be a scorn and sorrow to one for whom it +were meet that a man should die.” +</p> + +<p> +“Surely the black dream is on you, my brother! Neither of these things can be +for you!” I cried. +</p> + +<p> +“Would that it were the dream, for that is not all of sorrow, and that also is +of things so long past that they are forgotten. I can bear that, for your voice +always drives it away. But now the hand of Alsi the king is on me for some ill +of his own—” +</p> + +<p> +“Stay,” said Withelm. “Let us go out and speak, if that name is to be heard. It +were safer.” +</p> + +<p> +“Less safe, brother,” answered Havelok. “At once we should be kept apart. +Listen, and I will tell you all, and then say your say.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told us, word for word, all that had just passed between him and the +king. And as we listened, it grew on us that here was no wrong to the princess, +but rather the beginning of honour. I could see the downfall that was in store +for Alsi, and I thought also that I saw hope for the winning back of the Danish +kingdom, with an East Anglian host to back us. And this also saw Withelm, and +his eyes sparkled. But Havelok knew not yet all that had grown so plain to us. +</p> + +<p> +He ended, and we said nothing for a moment. +</p> + +<p> +“Well?” he said, not looking up, but with eyes that sought the floor, as if +ashamed. +</p> + +<p> +“By Odin,” said I, speaking the thought that was uppermost, “here will be a +downfall for Alsi!” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, you are right, brother. I will not wed her.” +</p> + +<p> +But that was by no means what I meant, as may be known; and now Withelm held up +a warning hand to me, and I knew that his advice was always best. +</p> + +<p> +“If the maiden is unwilling, wed her not,” he said. “If she is willing, even as +the king said, that is another matter. We have no reason to doubt his word as +yet.” +</p> + +<p> +“You saw not his face as he spoke. And then, how should the princess think of +me?” +</p> + +<p> +“Who knows? Even Odin owned that the minds of maids were hard to fathom. But +one may find a reason or two. Maybe that oath has somewhat to do with it. A +good daughter will go far to carry out her father’s will, and, in the plain +sense thereof, she will certainly do it thus. Then it is likely that she knows +that you are no churl, but the son of Grim, though we have fallen on hard times +for a while. I have heard say that it is the custom here that a man who has +crossed the seas in his own ship so many times is a thane by right of that +hardihood. Thane’s son, therefore, might we call you. Then there is the +jealousy of every other thane, if she chooses an East Anglian. Then she needs +one who shall be mighty to lead her forces. Even the greatest thane will be +content to follow a man who is a warrior of warriors. Ragnar can have told her +what you are in that way. Faith, brother, there are reasons enough.” +</p> + +<p> +Havelok laughed a short laugh at all this, and he grew brighter. There was +sense in Withelm’s words, if they would not bear looking deeply into. +</p> + +<p> +Then I said, adding to these words, “Moreover, Alsi could stop the whole +foolishness of his niece if he did not think it a fitting match in some way.” +</p> + +<p> +“So he could,” answered Havelok. “But yet—I tell you that there was naught but +evil in his face. Why did he try to force me?” +</p> + +<p> +Then he went back to the thing that weighed mostly on his noble heart—the +thought that he was unworthy altogether. +</p> + +<p> +“I fear that the princess does but think of me because she must. It is in my +mind that Alsi may have threatened her also until she has consented. How shall +I know this?” +</p> + +<p> +“Most easily, as she speaks with you,” answered Withelm. “Tomorrow will tell +you that. And then, if you find things thus, what shall prevent your flying?” +</p> + +<p> +“Brother Radbard and the other housecarls,” said Havelok grimly. +</p> + +<p> +“Not if you ask the princess to help you out of her own way by pretending to be +most willing. If Alsi thinks you a gladsome couple, there is no difficulty. You +walk out of the palace as a master there. Then you fly to Ragnar. That is all.” +</p> + +<p> +Now that was such an easy way out of the whole coil that we planned it out. And +yet it seemed to me that it was a pity that Havelok knew not more of what +seemed to us so sure now. So, seeing that things were fairly straightened by +this last thought, I got up and said that I must be going, making a sign to +Withelm to come also; and, with a few more words, we went out. I saw Havelok +set himself to a mighty task of water drawing as I looked back. +</p> + +<p> +“Now,” said I, “here is a strange affair with a vengeance. Neither head nor +tail can I make of it. But if all we think is right, this is the marriage for +the son of Gunnar.” +</p> + +<p> +“Son of Gunnar, or son of Grim,” said Withelm, “princess or not, happy is the +maiden who gains Havelok for a husband. Maybe her woman’s wit has told her so. +She will have many suitors whom she knows to be seeking her throne only, and to +him she gives it as a gift unsought.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is all beyond me,” I said; “but he would fill a throne well. But his own +modesty in the matter of his worthiness is likely to stand in the way. Why +should we not tell him all that we know? Then he will feel that he is doing no +wrong.” +</p> + +<p> +“Because we are not sure, and because it is not for us to choose the time. I +have sent for Arngeir this morning, as we said would be well last night. If the +princess is unwilling, there are many things that may be said; and if not, +there must be many days before the wedding; and, ere the day, Havelok may feel +that he is her equal in birth at least, if we are not wrong. But since I have +waited here, Mord has told me the dream that has troubled the princess, that I +may tell the priest, so that he can think it over. She has dreamed that she is +to wed a man who shall be king both in Denmark and England, and she saw the +man, moreover. Strangely like Havelok’s dream is that. Now what else made her +turn faint but that this vision was like Havelok? And does not that make it +possible that she wishes to wed him? Therefore I am going to tell the priest +the story of Havelok, so far as I know it.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well thought of. Tell him this also, for now I may surely tell you what you +have not yet heard thereof.” +</p> + +<p> +So I told him how Grim and I had taken Havelok from Hodulf, and then he was the +more certain that we had saved the son of our king. +</p> + +<p> +Now we thought that we had got to the bottom of the whole matter of the +wedding. Of course the dream had all to do with the fainting, but nothing to do +with the supposed wish. But we did not know that. +</p> + +<p> +“Speak not of Gunnar by name, however,” I said; “he was a terror to Christian +folk. The priest is likely to hinder the marriage with all his might else.” +</p> + +<p> +Withelm flushed as he had when he first spoke of the priest to me. +</p> + +<p> +“I think not, brother; for he knows Havelok well, and loves him.” +</p> + +<p> +“So,” said I shortly, “he hopes to make him a Christian, doubtless.” +</p> + +<p> +“I think that he will do so, if he has a Christian wife to help.” +</p> + +<p> +“That would not suit Havelok,” I said, laughing. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but such a mind as his it seems to suit well already, though he has not +heard much.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then,” said I, wondering, “if it suits our best and bravest, it must be a +wondrous faith. It seems strange, however; but I know naught of it. What is +good for him and you, my brother, is sure to be best.” +</p> + +<p> +“I feared that you would be angry.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but with you and Havelok? How should that be? Why, if you two said that +we must turn Christian, I should hold it right; so would Raven. I suppose that +I go to the Ve<a href="#fn11" name="fnref11"><sup>[11]</sup></a> because you +do.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I troubled no more about the matter, being nothing but a sea dog who could +use a weapon. And now I said that I was going to Eglaf to say that I might have +to leave him at any time for home, in case we had to fly with Havelok. So +Withelm went his way to the old priest with a light heart, and I to the +captain. +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said Eglaf, “this is about what I expected when your brother came. Good +it has been to have you here; and I think that I shall see you as a housecarl +for good yet. When do you go?” +</p> + +<p> +“The first time that I do not turn up on guard I am gone, not till then.” +</p> + +<p> +“Come and drink a farewell cup first.” +</p> + +<p> +“I shall be in a great hurry if I do not do that,” I answered, laughing. +</p> + +<p> +But it was my thought that maybe when once my back was turned on the town, I +should not have time to think of going near King Alsi’s guard. +</p> + +<p> +Then I went to find Ragnar the earl, for we thought it well that he should know +what was on hand. But when I came to the house of the thane with whom he was +quartered, they told me that he had gone hastily with all his men, for word had +come of some rising in his land that must be seen to at once. That was bad; and +as one must find a reason for everything, I thought that the going of Griffin +had much to do with the outbreak. There I was wrong, as I found later. But +then, too, I knew that the craft of Alsi was at work in this message. He had +his own reasons for wishing the earl out of the way. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap16">CHAPTER XVI.<br/> +A STRANGEST WEDDING.</a></h2> + +<p> +Long spoke Withelm and the priest David together, until it was time for them to +seek the palace; and when they came there, they spoke to Mord also. Then David +thought it was well to say naught to Havelok until more was learned from +Goldberga herself, for he would soon see how things stood with her. Then he +would see Withelm again, and they would plan together for the best. So Withelm +waited for the return of the priest, whom Mord took to his mistress. Alsi and +his men were supping in the hall, but Goldberga was waiting in her own chamber. +</p> + +<p> +Now the princess thought that, after her message to the king, she would hear no +more of the kitchen knave, and so was happier. But all the while she pondered +over her dream the thought of Havelok must needs come into it, and that was +troublesome. Nevertheless, it was not to be helped, seeing that there was no +doubt at all that he and the man of the vision were like to each other as ever +were twins. Wherefore if the thought of one must be pleasant so at last must be +that of the other. And then came the nurse with tales of what Berthun thought +of this man of his—how that he was surely a wandering prince, with a vow of +service on him, like Gareth of the Round Table in the days of Arthur. +</p> + +<p> +So presently it seemed to the princess that the churl was gone, as it were, and +in his place was a wandering atheling, at least, who was not a terror at all. +Then at length the slow time wore away until Mord came with David the priest. +</p> + +<p> +No priestly garb had the old man on, for that had made his danger certain; but +though he was clad in a thrall’s rough dress, he was not to be mistaken for +aught but a most reverend man. +</p> + +<p> +“Peace be with you, my daughter,” he said; “it is good to look on the child of +Orwenna, the queen whom we loved.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the chamberlain left those two alone, and at once Goldberga told the +priest why she had asked him to run the risk of coming to her, for there is no +doubt that he was in peril, though not from Alsi himself. +</p> + +<p> +At first she asked him many things about her mother, and learned much of her +goodness to the poor folk, and of their love to her; and presently, when she +grew more sure of the kindness and seeming wisdom of the priest, she told him +all her dream, adding no thoughts of her own, as she mistrusted them. +</p> + +<p> +Then said David, “There seems naught but good in this, and it is not hard to +unravel. I think that all shall come to pass even as it was told you.” +</p> + +<p> +“I feared the heathen ways of the place, and thought that it might be some +snare of the old gods,” said Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +But David told her that they could have no power on her, and asked her if the +king knew of the vision, that being one thing of which he was not sure; and +when he found that he did not, the whole affair seemed more strange than +before. +</p> + +<p> +But now the princess asked him, “Plain were the words that I heard, hut what +meant the light as of a sunbeam that came from the mouth of the man of the +vision?” +</p> + +<p> +“That surely means that in word and in heart and in all else the man shall be +kingly altogether, so that there shall be no mistaking the same; and it may +also mean that you shall know the man at once when you see him.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Goldberga grew pale and red by turns, so that David, quick to read the +thoughts of those who came to him for help, asked if she had seen anyone who +she thought must be meant, not at all knowing that she must needs say that this +was Curan. +</p> + +<p> +Not at all willingly did she tell him this; but she did so, adding at last that +Alsi had threatened to wed her to this man. +</p> + +<p> +Now it was plain to David that all was pulling the same way, for surely Alsi +wrought, unknowing, for the fulfilling of the dream; and all seemed to prove +that Havelok was the son of the Danish king, and that he would win back his +kingdom. Then he found out that the princess had no knowledge that the king had +spoken to Havelok, but it did not seem to be needful that he should tell her +that he had done so. That would be told by Alsi himself if he meant, as seemed +certain, to carry out his threat. So he thought awhile, and at last he saw what +he might do without saying anything to bend the choice of the princess in any +way. +</p> + +<p> +“It will soon be plain in what way the dream shall be fulfilled,” he said; “and +this is certain, that you shall be wedded to none but the right man, else had +it not been sent. Have no fear, therefore, even as it was bidden you.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the princess said that the only thing which troubled her was the fear lest +Alsi should yet force her to wed this one who was so like him she had seen in +her dream. +</p> + +<p> +“That,” said the priest, “is doubtless the most strange part of the whole +matter, yet I think that even thus there need be no fear. I will tell you now +that I know this one who is called Curan well, and I, and all who know him, +love him. Truly he is not a Christian, but he is no hater of the faith, and +that is much in these days. Nor is he a churl, but rather one of the most noble +of men. It is certain that, whatever Alsi might wish, he would not wed you +against your will. He has but to know your thoughts in order to help you in any +way. But I must also tell you this, that he is a Dane, who fled from his land +when he was a child; and it is thought that he is the son of the Danish king, +who was slain at the time when Mord, your servant, fled also. He came to +England in the same ship as did Mord, who can tell you more of him. It is +certain that there is a secret about his birth, and the one who knows that +secret is not far off. If need is, we can learn it, for there was a set time +for its telling, and maybe this is it. Now, if it is true that he is the son of +the Danish king, it does seem as if your dream might be bidding you to have no +fear of what seems doubtful in the matter, though I cannot tell, and do not +like to say so for certain. His name is not Curan, but Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Goldberga said, “I have heard of that flight and of the wreck from Mord +often. He was wont to tell me of the child, and of the lady who was drowned, +and he said that he thought him the king’s son.” +</p> + +<p> +After that she was greatly cheered, for the worst of the trouble seemed to be +over and gone. It was in her mind now that Alsi knew who Havelok was, and that +he tried her, for she was not one to think ill of any. +</p> + +<p> +So she let the priest go, with many thanks, saying, “Now I know that whatever +happens is the will of Heaven, and must be for the best. I am ready for +whatever shall befall.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I do not know what had seemed good to Alsi, for he had changed his mind +concerning David’s visit to Goldberga, and had suddenly given orders that if he +came he was to be put in ward at once. So Mord met the old man as he left the +chamber, and told him that he must fly; and after that Withelm took him away in +the dusk, for none hindered his going, and went to the widow’s with him, +hearing all that had been said; and that which they thought was even as +Goldberga had said, that all must needs be for the best. In a day or two all +would he plain, for Arngeir would have come. So Withelm sent forth the old man +to his own place with a good store of food, going with him for some miles, and +promising him help for coming days until the dearth was ended. +</p> + +<p> +Now into the palace none might come after the feast was set; and all this time +I was on guard, for there were double posts round the place, by reason of +Alsi’s fear of the attackers of the princess, as was said. So it happened that +neither of us saw Havelok until next morning; and now I have to tell how we saw +him, and what happened with the first sunlight, when men were thinking of +breaking their fast. +</p> + +<p> +We of the housecarls took that first meal of the day in the great hall—so many +of us, that is, who were not on duty; and when we had nigh finished, Alsi would +come in and seat himself on the high place, where Eglaf and half a dozen other +thanes sat also at times when there was no special state to be kept. +</p> + +<p> +I was early this morning, having just taken my spell of watching at the gate, +and being, therefore, free for the rest of the day, and I was hungry with the +sweet air of the July weather and the freshness that comes with sunrise. So I +was not altogether pleased to see that there was seemingly some new affair of +state on hand, while the breakfast was not yet set out by reason of +preparations that were going on where the king’s chair was wont to stand. There +was Berthun, looking puzzled and by no means pleased, and his men were busy +setting out benches on the high place, of a sort that were not those that were +wont to be there, in three sides of a square, the open side facing the hall. +One bench made each side, and all three were carved from back rail to clawed +feet wondrously. Old they seemed also. Then, too, instead of the sweet sedges +that strewed the high place, men had spread a cloth of bright hues underfoot +there, and the sedges had been swept among the rushes of the lower places. All +this was so strange that I went forward, and when I had a chance I asked the +steward what was on hand. +</p> + +<p> +“If you know not, master housecarl, no more do I. ‘Justice to be done,’ says +the king, and so I suppose that you have some notable prisoner in ward—maybe +the leader of those villains who scared our fair princess.” +</p> + +<p> +“But we had taken no man, and I will say that we had wondered that we had not +been sent out to hunt those people, instead of biding to see if they came to +trouble us here.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then,” said Berthun, “some thane must be bringing a captive shortly. But +why Alsi orders these benches, it passes me to make out. They are those that +have been used for the weddings of his kin since the days of Hengist. Last time +was when Orwenna, his sister, wedded Ethelwald of Norfolk. Maybe he thinks that +they need airing.” +</p> + +<p> +He laughed and went on directing his men; but knowing what I knew, I wondered +what it all might mean, for there was one wedding that I could not help +thinking of. +</p> + +<p> +Presently the hall began to fill as men came in, and every one had somewhat to +say, and all marvelled at this that was going on. Then Berthun came and +beckoned to me, for I must fetch Eglaf the captain at once, as the king had +need of him, in haste. Then Eglaf hurried to the hall; and after a word or two +with Alsi, the horns were blown outside the hall door to call every man of the +guard to the place. And when they came, we were all set round the wall as if +guarding all that were in it. But there were none but the folk of the palace to +guard, and they were wondering as were we; and when that was done, and the +click and rattle of arms as we moved to our places was ended, there was a +silence on all—the silence of men who wait for somewhat to happen. +</p> + +<p> +Now Berthun went to the door on the high place, as he was wont when all was +ready for the king’s presence, and the hush deepened, none knowing what they +expected to see. +</p> + +<p> +Forth came Berthun backward, as was the custom, and he turned aside to let the +king pass him. His face was red and angry, as I thought, but amazed also. I was +standing next to Eglaf, and he was at the foot of the dais, at the end of his +line of men, so that I could see all plainly. +</p> + +<p> +Then came Alsi, leading the princess, and after Goldberga came her nurse. No +other ladies were with her; and now I noticed that there was not one thane on +the high place, which was strange, and the first time that such a thing had +been since I came here. I looked down the hall, and none were present. Now I +looked at Alsi; and on his pale face was a smile that might have been as of one +who will be glad, though he does not feel so. But the eyes of the princess were +bright with tears, and hardly did she look from the floor. Hers was a face to +make one sad to see at that time, wondrously beautiful as it was. +</p> + +<p> +Alsi led her by the hand, and set her on the bench that was to his left, and +signed to the nurse to sit beside her, which the old lady did, bridling and +looking with scorn at the king as she took her place. There she sought the hand +of the princess, and held it tightly, as in comforting wise. Very rich garments +had the nurse, but Goldberga was dressed in some plain robe of white that shone +when the light caught it. Mostly I do not see these things, but now I wished +that she always wore that same. +</p> + +<p> +As for Alsi, he had on his finest gear, even as at the great feast of the +Witan—crimson cloak, fur-lined, and dark-green hose, gold-gartered across, and +white and gold tunic. He had a little crown on also, and that was the only +thing kingly about him, to my mind. +</p> + +<p> +Now he cast one look at Goldberga, which made her shrink into herself, as it +were, and turned with a smile to us all. +</p> + +<p> +“Friends,” he said, “this is short notice for a wedding, but all men know that +‘Happy is the wooing that is not long a-doing,’ so no more need be said of +that. All men know also that when good Ethelwald died he made me swear to him +that I would wed his daughter to the mightiest and goodliest and fairest man +that was in the land. I have ever been mindful of that oath, and now it seems +that the time for keeping it has come. Whether the man whom my niece will wed +is all that the oath requires, you shall judge; and if he is such a one, I must +not stand in the way. I do not myself know that I have ever seen one who is so +fully set forth in words as is this bridegroom in those of the oath.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I heard one whisper near me, “Whom has Goldberga chosen?” +</p> + +<p> +And that was what Alsi would have liked to hear, for his speech seemed to say +that thus it was, and maybe that he did not altogether like the choice. +</p> + +<p> +But now Alsi said to Berthun, “Bring in the bridegroom.” +</p> + +<p> +“Whom shall I bring, lord?” the steward asked in blank wonder, and Alsi +whispered his answer. +</p> + +<p> +At that Berthun’s hands flew up, and his mouth opened, and he did not stir. +</p> + +<p> +“Go, fool,” said Alsi, and I thought that he would have stamped his foot. +</p> + +<p> +Now I knew who was meant in a moment, and even as the steward took his first +step from off the dais to go down the hail to his own entrance, I said to +Eglaf, “Here is an end to my service with you. My time is up.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, what is amiss?” +</p> + +<p> +“The bridegroom is my brother—that is all; and I must be free to serve him as I +may.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, if that is so, you are in luck. But I do not think that either of Grim’s +sons can be the man. Big enough are you, certainly, but goodly? Nay, but that +red head of yours spoils you.” +</p> + +<p> +I daresay that he would have said more about Raven and Withelm, for a talk was +going round; but a hush came suddenly, and then a strange murmur of stifled +wonder, for Havelok came into the hall after Berthun, and all eyes were turned +to him. +</p> + +<p> +Now I saw my brother smile as he came, seeing someone whom he liked first of +all; and then he looked up the hall, and at once his face became ashy pale, for +he saw what was to be done. Yet he went on firmly, looking neither to right nor +left, until he came to the high place. There he caught my eye, and I made a +little sign to him to show that I knew his trouble. +</p> + +<p> +They came to the step, and Berthun stood aside to let Havelok pass, and then +Alsi held out his hand to raise my brother to the high place. But Havelok +seemed not to see that, stepping up by himself as the king bade him come. Then +the women who were in the hall spoke to one another in a murmur that seemed of +praise; but whiter and more white grew the princess, so that I feared that she +would faint. But she did not; and presently there seemed to come into her eyes +some brave resolve, and she was herself again, looking from Alsi to Havelok, +and again at Alsi. +</p> + +<p> +Now, too, the king looked at him up and down, as one who measures his man +before a fight. And when he met Havelok’s eyes he grew red, and turned away to +the folk below him. +</p> + +<p> +“So, friends,” he cried, “what say you? Am I true to the words of my oath in +allowing this marriage?” +</p> + +<p> +There was not one there who did not know Havelok, whom they called Curan; and +though all thought these doings strange, there was a hum of assent, for the +oath said naught of the station in life of the bridegroom. Good King Ethelwald +had been too trustful. +</p> + +<p> +“That is well,” said Alsi, with a grave face. “All here will bear witness that +this was not done without counsel taken. Now, let the bridegroom sit in his +place here to my right.” +</p> + +<p> +He waved his hand, and Havelok sat down on the bench that faced Goldberga; and +now he looked long at her with a look that seemed to be questioning. Alsi was +going to his seat in the cross bench, where the parents of the couple are wont +to sit at a wedding while the vows are made, but he seemed to bethink himself. +It is my belief that he said what he did in order to shame both Havelok and +Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, it is not seemly that the bridegroom should sit alone without one to be +by him. Where are your friends, Curan?” +</p> + +<p> +At that Alsi met with more than he bargained for. At once Berthun came forward, +and forth came I, and without a word we sat one on each side of him. There were +others who would have come also, for I saw even Eglaf take a step towards the +high place, had we not done so. +</p> + +<p> +Alsi’s face became black at that, for here was not the friendless churl he was +scoffing at. But he tried to smile, as if pleased. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, this is well,” he said. “Good it is to see a master helping his man, and +a soldier ready to back a comrade of a sort. Now we have witnesses. Let us go +on with the wedding.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the golden loving cup that was used at the feasts had been filled and set +at a little side table that stood there, and it was to be the bride cup that +should be drunk between the twain when all was settled. So Alsi took this cup +and held it, while he sat in the place of the father of the bride. Now, I knew +nothing of what should he done, but Berthun did so, and well he took my +brother’s part, having undertaken for him thus. +</p> + +<p> +“It is the custom,” said Alsi, “that the bridegroom should state what he sets +forth of the dowry to the bride.” +</p> + +<p> +Whereat Berthun, without hesitation, spoke hastily to Havelok, and told him to +let him answer, meaning, as I have not the least doubt, to promise all that he +had saved in long years of service. But Havelok smiled a little, and set his +hand to his neck, and I remembered one thing that he had—a ring which had +always hung on a cord under his jerkin since he came to Grimsby, and which my +father had bidden him keep ever. +</p> + +<p> +“This give I,” he said, setting it on the floor at his feet, “and with it all +that I am, and all that I shall hereafter be, and all that shall be mine at any +time.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi looked at the ring as it flashed before him, and his face changed. No such +jewel had he in all his treasures, for it was of dwarf work in gold, set with a +deep crimson stone that was like the setting sun for brightness. I do not know +whence these stones came, unless it were from the East. Eleyn the queen, his +mother, was thence, and I know now that the ring was hers. But I think that +when Alsi saw this he half repented of the match, though he had gone too far +now to draw back. So he bowed, and said that it was well, as he would have said +had there been nothing forthcoming. +</p> + +<p> +Then Berthun, in his turn, asked for the bridegroom that the dowry of the bride +should be stated for all to hear. +</p> + +<p> +“The wealth left my niece by her father,” said Alsi. “The matter of the kingdom +is for the Witan of the East Anglians to settle.” +</p> + +<p> +Then came from out the king’s chamber two men bearing bags of gold, and that +was set before the princess. It was a noble dowry, and honest was the king in +this matter at least. +</p> + +<p> +Now were the vows to be said and the bride cup to be drunk, and that was the +hardest part of all to Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +Slowly he rose as the king held it out to him, and he took it from his hand and +stood before Goldberga; and she, too, rose and faced him, and for a moment they +stood thus, surely the most handsome couple that had ever been. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok said, looking in the clear eyes of the princess, “This have I +sworn, that I will wed no unwilling bride. It is but for you to say one word, +and the cup falls, and all is ended.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi started at that, and I thought he was going to speak, but he held his +peace. Still as a rock was Havelok while he waited for the answer, and the folk +in the hall were as still as he. They began to see that all was not right as +the king would have it thought. +</p> + +<p> +Once the princess looked at Alsi, and that with pride in her face, and then she +looked long and steadfastly at Havelok, and one by one his fingers loosened +themselves on the golden stem of the cup, that she might know him ready for her +word. +</p> + +<p> +Then she put forth her hand and closed it round his strong fingers, that he +must hold it fast by her doing, and that was all that was needed. It was more +than words could have told. And she smiled as she did it. +</p> + +<p> +And at that a light came on Havelok’s face, and he smiled gravely back at her, +and he said in a low voice that shook a little, “May the gods so treat me as I +treat you, my princess. Can it be that you will trust me thus?” +</p> + +<p> +She answered in no words, but I saw her hand tighten over his, and her eyes +never left his face. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok raised his other hand, and took that of Goldberga, which was on +the cup, and faced to the people. +</p> + +<p> +“Thus do I pledge her who shall be henceforward my wife through good and ill; +and may Odin, Freya, and Niord be witnesses of my oath of faith to her in all +that the word may mean.” +</p> + +<p> +So he drank, and I stole a glance at the king. Never saw I a man so amazed, for +to him the Danish names of the Asir had come as some sort of a shock, seeing +that he had deemed this man, with the name of Curan, a Briton. And he looked at +Berthun with a look that seemed to say more than was likely to be pleasant +by-and-by. But the steward paid no heed to him. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok had made his vow, and he gave the cup to the princess; and she, +too, turned a little toward the people, but still she looked on Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Faith shall answer to faith,” she said in a clear voice. “Here do I take this +man for my husband, in the sight of God, and with you all as witnesses, and I +pray that the blessing of Him may be on us both.” +</p> + +<p> +So she drank also, and Havelok stopped and raised the wondrous ring from where +it had been unheeded on the floor, and took the band of Goldberga, and set it +on her finger, and kissed the hand ere he let it go. +</p> + +<p> +But Goldberga lifted her face toward him, and he bent and kissed her forehead, +and so they were wedded. +</p> + +<p> +I have heard men scoff at the thought of love at first sight, but never can any +one of us do so who saw this wedding. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap17">CHAPTER XVII.<br/> +HOW THE BRIDE WENT HOME.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now the folk cheered, and loudest of all honest Eglaf and his warriors. I +wondered what should come next, for neither feast nor bride ale was prepared, +and Berthun was looking puzzled. Then I saw that the only face in all the wide +hall which was not bright was that of Alsi, and his brow was black as a thunder +cloud, while his fingers were white with the force with which he clutched and +twisted the end of his jewelled belt. Plainly he was in a royal rage that none +had scoffed at this wedding, but that all had taken it as a matter that was +right altogether. +</p> + +<p> +But he had one more evil thing in his mind that must be seen through; and he +came forward, smoothing his face, as best he might, to the fixed smile that I +had seen when he spoke with Ragnar, and learned that his first plot had +miscarried. +</p> + +<p> +“Now, friends,” he said, “all this has been so hasty that we have prepared no +feast. Even now, it seems that the horses stand at the door to take bride and +bridegroom hence, and doubtless there waits somewhere the feast that has been +bespoken without my knowledge. Well, strange are the ways of lovers, and we +will pardon them. I have therefore only to bid them farewell.” +</p> + +<p> +With that he turned to Havelok, and held out his hand, as in all good +fellowship, but Havelok would not see it. +</p> + +<p> +“Fare as it shall be meted to you by the Asir, King Alsi,” he said, “for at +least Loki loves craft.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he turned to me, and asked hurriedly where we should go if we must leave +thus. +</p> + +<p> +“To Grimsby,” I said. “That is home.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi spoke to the princess now, and maybe it was as well that he did not offer +so much as his hand. Wise was he in his way. +</p> + +<p> +“Farewell, niece,” he said; “all this shall come shortly before the Witan of +Ethelwald’s folk.” +</p> + +<p> +“Farewell, uncle,” she answered calmly. “That is a matter which I will see to +myself. You have carried out your oath to the letter, so far, and now it +remains that you should leave the government of the realm to me.” +</p> + +<p> +With that she put her hand on Havelok’s arm. +</p> + +<p> +“Come, husband; we have heard that the horses wait. Let us be gone.” +</p> + +<p> +And then in a quick whisper she added, as if nigh overdone, “Take me hence +quickly, for I may not bear more.” +</p> + +<p> +They wasted no more words; and through a lane of folk, who blessed them, those +two went to the great door down the long hall, and I followed, and Berthun and +the nurse came after me. One flung the door open; and on the steps, all unaware +of what had happened, lounged Mord, waiting, and up and down on the green the +grooms led the horses of the princess—six in all. On two were packed her goods, +and the third had a pack saddle that waited for the bags that held her dowry. +The other three were for herself and Mord and the nurse. There was not one for +Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“This is hasty, my princess,” Mord said. “Whither are we bound?” +</p> + +<p> +“For Grimsby, Mord,” I answered quickly. “Are there no more horses to be had?” +</p> + +<p> +“Never a one, unless we steal from the king,” he answered. +</p> + +<p> +The people were crowding out now that they might see the start, and I saw +Berthun speak to a man among them who was a stranger to me. And from him he +turned directly with a glad face. +</p> + +<p> +“Go down to such a hostelry,” he said to me, “and there ask for what horses you +will. Maybe I shall have to follow you for my part in this matter—that is, if I +am not put in the dungeon.” +</p> + +<p> +“Faith,” I answered, “better had you come with us than run that risk. Alsi is +in a bad mood.” +</p> + +<p> +He shook his head; and then the people behind him made way, for the king was +coming. +</p> + +<p> +“Almost had you forgotten this,” he said; “and I think you will want it.” +</p> + +<p> +The men with the money were there, and he waved his hand to them. Havelok +lifted the princess to her horse without heeding him, and the men set the bags +on the pack horses. +</p> + +<p> +“See the bridegroom down the street, you who were his witnesses,” the king went +on, with a curling lip; “and if you are a wise man, master Berthun, you will +not come back again.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun bowed and went into the hail, past the king, and across to his own +door, without a word. After him the thronging people closed up, and though I +thought that a housecarl would have been sent to see what he was about, this +would have made an open talk, and Alsi forbore. +</p> + +<p> +“Let Havelok take your horse, Mord,” I whispered to him; “I will tell you why +directly.” +</p> + +<p> +He nodded, and I told Havelok to mount. Then I helped up the nurse, who wept +and muttered to herself; and so we started, Alsi standing on the steps with +words of feigned goodspeed as we did so. +</p> + +<p> +But the housecarls and the people shouted with wishes that were real, no doubt +thinking that we were bound for the far-off kingdom of the prince who had won +Goldberga by service as a kitchen knave in her uncle’s hall for very love of +her. +</p> + +<p> +Directly we were outside the gate that leads down the hill, I saw Withelm, who +was there waiting for me, and he knew at once what had happened. +</p> + +<p> +He came to my side, and asked only, “Already?” +</p> + +<p> +“Already,” I answered; “but it is well. Go to the widow’s straightway, and +bring Havelok’s arms to him at the hostelry at the end of the marketplace, +where we have to find more horses.” +</p> + +<p> +He went at once, and silently we came down the street and to the courtyard of +the inn. Some few folk stared at us; but the princess was hardly known here, +and she had cast her long, white mantle hoodwise over her head and face, so +that one could not tell who she was. So early in the day there were few people +in the marketplace either. +</p> + +<p> +Berthun was in the courtyard of the inn, and I was glad to see him, for I did +not know what would happen to him. It was likely that Alsi would seek for +someone on whom to visit his anger at the way things had gone. But the steward +had been warned, and was not one to run any risk. +</p> + +<p> +“I did but go back for a few things that I did not care to leave,” he said; and +he showed me that he had brought his own horse from the stables, and on it were +large saddlebags. No poor man was Berthun after years of service in the palace, +where gifts from thane and lady are always ready for the man who has had the +care of them. Across the saddle bow also were his mail shirt and arms, and his +shield hung with his helm from the peak. +</p> + +<p> +“You see that I must needs cast in my lot with yours, or rather Curan’s,” he +said, laughing; “but it is in my mind that in the end I shall not be sorry to +have done so. I think that I am tired of the fireside, and want adventure for a +while.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” I answered, “you are likely to have them, and that shortly, if I am not +mistaken; but we shall see. Now about these horses, for we had better get out +of Lincoln as soon as we may.” +</p> + +<p> +The man he had spoken with was a merchant, who came yearly, and was a friend of +his. He had more horses than he meant to keep, as he had here each year; for +every one knows that a horse can always be sold in Lincoln, and they were good +ones. Then my gold came in well, and I bought three, one for each of us +brothers. I daresay that I paid dearly for them, but there was no time for +haggling in the way that a horse dealer loves. Out of the way of Alsi we must +get, before he bethought him of more crafty devices. And I thought, moreover, +that we should be riding towards East Anglia shortly, and it was not everywhere +that a steed fit to carry Havelok on a long journey was to be had. +</p> + +<p> +I had bidden him leave all this to me as we came down the hill, and glad he was +to do so. Now he had dismounted, and stood by the side of the princess, +speaking earnestly to her. It was plain that what he said was pleasant to her +also. But we left them apart, as one might suppose. +</p> + +<p> +Now came a warrior into the courtyard, and he bore more arms. It was Withelm, +who had borrowed the gear of the widow’s dead husband, that he might be ready +for whatever might happen: and it was good to see Havelok’s eyes grow bright as +he spied the well-known weapons that his brother had in his arms. He said one +word to Goldberga, and then came to us. +</p> + +<p> +“Let me get into war gear at once,” he said, laughing in a way that lightened +my heart. “I shall not feel that I have shaken off service to Alsi until I have +done so.” +</p> + +<p> +And then he saw Berthun here for the first time. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but here is my master,” he added. “And I will say that I owe him much for +his kindness.” +</p> + +<p> +“Now the kindness shall be on your part, if any was on mine. Take me into your +service, I pray you, henceforward.” +</p> + +<p> +“Good friend of mine,” said Havelok, “naught have I to offer you. And how +should one serve me?” +</p> + +<p> +“With heart and hand and head, neither more nor less,” answered Berthun. “I +have seen you serve, and now will see you command. Let me bide with you, my +master, at least, giving you such service as I may.” +</p> + +<p> +“Such help as you may, rather. For now we all serve the princess,” Havelok +said. +</p> + +<p> +And with that Berthun was well content for the time. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then,” said I, “see to Havelok’s arms, while we get the horses ready, +for I want Withelm here.” +</p> + +<p> +So Havelok and his new man went into the house with his arms, and then I saw +Goldberga beckoning to us. It was the first time that I had spoken to her, and +I think that I was frightened, if that is what they call the feeling that makes +one wish to be elsewhere. But there was nothing to fear in the sweet face that +she turned to us. +</p> + +<p> +“Brothers,” she said, “Havelok tells me that it was one of you who brought +David the priest to me. I do not rightly know yet which is Withelm.” +</p> + +<p> +With that she smiled and blushed a little, and I stood, helm in hand, stupidly +enough. But my brother was more ready. +</p> + +<p> +“I am Withelm, my princess—” he began. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay; but ‘sister’ it shall be between me and my husband’s brothers. Now, +brother Withelm, there is one thing that is next my heart, and in it I know you +will help me.” +</p> + +<p> +There she wavered for a moment, and then went on bravely. +</p> + +<p> +“Christian am I, and I do not think that we are rightly wedded until the priest +has done his part. And to that Havelok agrees most willingly, saying that I +must ask you thereof, for he does not know where the old man is now.” +</p> + +<p> +“Wedded in the little chapel that is in the thick of Cabourn woods shall you +be, for David has gone there already. We can ride and find him before many +hours are over, sweet lady of ours.” +</p> + +<p> +She thanked him in few words, and with much content. +</p> + +<p> +Then came forth from the house Havelok, in the arms that suited him so +well—golden, shining mail shirt of hard bronze scales, and steel, horned helm, +plain and strong, and girt with sword and seax, and with axe and shield slung +over shoulder, as noble a warrior surely as was in all England, ay, or in the +Northlands that gave him birth either; and what wonder that the eyes of the +princess glowed with a new pride as she looked at her mighty husband? +</p> + +<p> +But Mord almost shouted when he saw him come thus, and to me he said, +</p> + +<p> +“It is Gunnar—Gunnar, I tell you—come back from Asgard to help my princess.” +</p> + +<p> +“Wait till we get to Grimsby, and Arngeir will make all clear,” I said. “Get +into your arms, and we will start. All is ready now.” +</p> + +<p> +We did not wait for Mord, but mounted and rode out, and the princess looked +round at us as she rode first beside Havelok, and said, “Never have I ridden so +well attended, as I think.” +</p> + +<p> +And from beside me, with broad face from under his helm, Berthun answered for +us all, “Never with men so ready to die for you, at least, my mistress.” +</p> + +<p> +And that was true. +</p> + +<p> +Half a mile out of the town we rode at a quick trot, and then thundered Mord +after us, and his hurry surely meant something. I reined up and waited for him. +</p> + +<p> +“What is the hurry, Mord?” said I. +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe it is nothing, and maybe it is much,” he answered; “but Griffin of +Chester has gone up to the palace, for I saw him. He has his arm in a sling, +and his face looks as if it had been trodden on. Now Alsi will tell him all +this, and if we are not followed I am mistaken. He would think nothing of +wiping out our party to take the princess, and Alsi will not mind if he does. +How shall we give him the slip?” +</p> + +<p> +Withelm rode with his chin over his shoulder, and I beckoned him and told him +this. Not long was his quick wit in seeing a way out of what might be a danger. +</p> + +<p> +“Let us ride on quickly down the Ermin Street, and he will think us making for +the south and Norwich. Then we will turn off to Cabourn, and he will lose us. +After that he may hear that some of us belong to Grimsby, and will go there; +but he will be too late to hurt us. Hard men are our fishers, and they would +fight for Havelok and the sons of Grim.” +</p> + +<p> +So we did that, riding down the old Roman way to a wide, waste forest land +where none should see us turn off, and then across the forest paths to Cabourn; +and there we found the hermit, and there Havelok and Goldberga were wedded +again with all the rites of Holy Church, and the bride was well content. +</p> + +<p> +Now while that was our way, I will say what we escaped by this plan of my +brother’s, though we did not hear all for a long time. Presently we did hear +what had happened at Grimsby towards this business, as will be seen. +</p> + +<p> +To Lincoln comes Griffin, with Cadwal his thane, just as we had left the town +thus by another road, and straightway he betakes himself to the palace. There +he finds Alsi in an evil mood, and in the hall the people are talking fast, and +there is no Berthun to receive him. +</p> + +<p> +So, as he sits at the high table and breaks his fast beside the king, he asks +what all the wonderment may be. And Alsi tells him, speaking in Welsh. +</p> + +<p> +“East Anglia is mine,” he says, “for I have rid myself of the girl.” +</p> + +<p> +Griffin sets his hand on his dagger. +</p> + +<p> +“Hast killed her?” he says sharply. +</p> + +<p> +“No; married her.” +</p> + +<p> +“To whom, then?” +</p> + +<p> +“To a man whom the Witan will not have as a king at any price.” +</p> + +<p> +“There you broke faith with me,” says Griffin, snarling. “I would have taken +her, and chanced that.” +</p> + +<p> +“My oath was in the way of that. You missed the chance on the road the other +day, which would have made things easy for us both. There was no other for +you.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Griffin curses Ragnar, and the Welsh tongue is good for that business. +</p> + +<p> +“Who is the man, then?” he says, when he has done. +</p> + +<p> +“The biggest and best-looking countryman of yours that I have ever set eyes +on,” answers Alsi, looking askance at Griffin’s angry face. “There is a sort of +consolation for you.” +</p> + +<p> +“His name,” fairly shouts Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +“Curan, the kitchen knave,” says Alsi, chuckling. +</p> + +<p> +“O fool, and doubly fool!” cries Griffin; “now have you outdone yourself. Was +it not plain to you that the man could be no thrall? Even Ragnar looks mean +beside him, and I hate Ragnar, so that I know well how goodly he is.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi grows uneasy, knowing that this had become plainer and plainer to him +as the wedding went on. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, what do you know of this knave of mine?” he asks. “He was goodly enough +for the sake of my oath, and the Witan will have none of him. That is all I +care for.” +</p> + +<p> +“What do I know of him? Just this—that you have married the queen of the East +Angles to Havelok, son of Gunnar Kirkeban of Denmark, for whom men wait over +there even now. The Witan not have him? I tell you that every man in the land +will follow him and Goldberga if they so much as lift their finger. Done are +the days of your kingship, and that by your own deed.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi grows white at this and trembles, for he minds the wondrous ring and the +names of the Asir, but he asks for more certainty. +</p> + +<p> +Then Griffin tells him that he was with Hodulf, and knew all the secret of the +making away with the boy, and how that came to naught. Then he says that Hodulf +had heard from certain Vikings that they had fallen on Grim’s ship, and that in +the grappling of the vessel the boy and a lady had been drowned. It is quite +likely that they, or some of them, thought so in truth, seeing how that +happened. After that Hodulf had made inquiry, and was told that there were none +but the children of Grim with him, and so was content. So my father’s wisdom +was justified. +</p> + +<p> +“Now I learned his name the other day; and I have a ship waiting to take me at +once to Hodulf, that I may warn him. I have ridden back from Grimsby even now +to say that, given a chance, say on some lonely ride, that might well have been +contrived, I would take Goldberga with me beyond the sea. I thought more of +that than of Hodulf, to say the truth.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi breaks down altogether, and prays Griffin to help him out of this. +</p> + +<p> +“Follow the party and take her. They are few and unarmed, and it will be easy, +for men think that there is a plot to carry her off, and this will not surprise +any. Go to the sheriff and tell him that it has happened, and he will hang the +men on sight when you have taken them. Then get to sea with the girl, and to +Hodulf, and both he and I will reward you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Thanks,” says Griffin, with a sneer; “I have my own men. Yours might have +orders that I am the one to be hanged. It would be worth your while now to make +a friend of your kitchen knave. You are not to be trusted.” +</p> + +<p> +So these two wrangle for a while bitterly, for Alsi is not overlord of Griffin +in any way. And the end is that the thane rides towards Grimsby first of all, +with twenty men at his heels, knowing more than we thought. But he hears naught +of us, and presently meets Arngeir on his way thence to see us. Him he knows, +for already he has had dealings with him in the hiring of the ship. So he +learns from him that certainly no such party as he seeks is on the road, and +therefore rides off to the Ermin Street to stay us from going south. +</p> + +<p> +But now we had time for a long start; and so he follows the Roman road when he +reaches it all that day and part of next, and we hear no more of him at that +time. There are many parties travelling on that way, and he follows one after +another. +</p> + +<p> +Now Arngeir knew at once that somewhat had happened when he heard from Griffin +that the most notable man of those whom he sought was named Curan, and +therefore he turned back at once and waited for us. And when we came in sight +of the long roof of the house that Grim, our father, had built, standing among +the clustering cottages of our fishers, with the masts of a trading ship or two +showing above it in the haven, he was there on the road to greet us, having +watched anxiously for our coming from the beacon tower that we had made. +</p> + +<p> +Maybe we were two miles out of Grimsby at this time, for one can see far along +the level marsh tracks from our tower; and Withelm and Mord and I rode on to +him as soon as we saw him, that we might tell him all that had happened, and we +rode slowly and talked for half a mile or so. +</p> + +<p> +Then Withelm waited and brought Havelok to us, staying himself with the +princess, that he might tell her the wondrous story of her husband; for we +thought that it would be easier for him than for our brother maybe. Havelok was +not one to speak freely of himself. +</p> + +<p> +And when Goldberga had heard all, she was silent for a long way, and then wept +a little, but at last told Withelm that all this had been foretold to her in +her dream. +</p> + +<p> +“Yet I am glad,” she said, “that I did not know this for certain, else had my +Havelok thought that I did but wed him for his birth. Tell him, brother, that +it was not so; say that I knew him as the husband Heaven sent for me when first +I saw him.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok listened to Arngeir as he told him the well-kept secret, and now +and again asked a question. +</p> + +<p> +And when all was told he said, “Now have the dreams passed, and the light is +come. I mind all plainly from the first.” +</p> + +<p> +And he told all that had happened after Hodulf caught him, from the murder of +his sisters to the time when I helped my father to take him from the sack. Only +he never remembered the death of his mother or the storm, or how we came to +Grimsby. Maybe it is rather a wonder that after all those hard things gone +through he should recall anything, for he was nearly dying when we came ashore, +as I have told. +</p> + +<p> +“But I am Grim’s son,” he said, “for all this, and never shall I forget it. By +right of life saved, and by right of upbringing, am I his, and by right of +brotherhood to his sons. Gunnar, who was my father, would have me say this, if +I am like him, as Mord tells me I am.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he looked at us in brotherly wise, as if we would maybe not allow that +claim now; but there needed naught to be said between us when he met our eyes. +He was Grim’s son indeed to us, and we his younger brothers for all the days +that were to come. +</p> + +<p> +“One thing there is that makes me glad,” he said, “and that is because I may +now be held worthy of this sweet bride of mine so strangely given, as indeed I +fear that I am not. Men will say that she has done no wrong in wedding me; and +for all that Alsi may say, it will be believed that she knew well whom she was +wedding. There will be no blame to her.” +</p> + +<p> +That seemed to be all his thought of the matter now, and it was like him. Then +he went back to his princess, and we spurred on to Grimsby, and set all to +work, that the greeting might be all that we could make it. +</p> + +<p> +And so, when those two rode into our garth, and the gates were closed after +them, we reined our horses round them, and drew our swords, and cried the +ancient greeting with one mighty shout: +</p> + +<p> +“Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson—Skoal to Goldberga, Havelok’s wife! Skoal! Yours +we are, and for you we will die! Skoal!” +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap18">CHAPTER XVIII.<br/> +JARL SIGURD OF DENMARK.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now one would like to tell of quiet days at Grimsby; but they were not to be. +Three days after Havelok’s homecoming we were on the “swan’s path,” and heading +for Denmark, with the soft south wind of high summer speeding us on the way. +And I will tell how that came about, for else it may seem strange that Havelok +did not see to the rights of his wife first of all. +</p> + +<p> +That was his first thought, in truth, and we brothers planned many ways of +getting to work for her, for it was certain that Alsi would be on his guard. +And on the next day came a man from Lincoln to seek Berthun, with news. That +good friend had done what none of us had been able to manage, for he had told +the merchant, his friend, to bide in the hall and hear what went on, and then +to let him know all else that seemed needful that we should hear. Now he had +learned all from the words of Griffin and Alsi, who took no care in their +speech, thinking that none in the hall knew the Welsh tongue that they used. +</p> + +<p> +It being the business of a merchant to know that of every place where he +trades, and he travelling widely, there was no difficulty to him, and mightily +he enjoyed the sport. Then he sent off straightway to us; and now it was plain +that we were in danger—not at once, maybe, but ere long. Griffin would hear +sooner or later that his quarry was in Grimsby after all. So we went to our +good old friend, Witlaf of Stallingborough, and told him all. +</p> + +<p> +“Why,” he said, “I will have no Welsh outsiders harrying my friends. Light up +your beacon if he comes, and shut your gates in his face, and I and the +housecarls will take him in the rear, and he will not wait here long. I have +not had a fight for these twenty years or so, and it does me good to think of +one.” +</p> + +<p> +So we thought that there was little fear of the Welshman. +</p> + +<p> +When I came back from this errand, however, I chose to pass the mound where my +father slept, and on it, hand in hand, sat Havelok and Goldberga—for it was a +quiet place, and none came near it often. It was good to see them thus in that +place, and happy they seemed together. +</p> + +<p> +Goldberga called me when I came near, and I sat down beside them as she bade +me. +</p> + +<p> +“Here we have been talking of what we shall do now, for it seems that to both +of us are many things to hand,” she said. “Good it would be if we could set +them aside; but we were born to them, and we cannot let them be. And, most of +all, here in this place we may not forget the duty that Grim would remind us +of. Havelok must go to Denmark and win back his kingdom from Hodulf first of +all.” +</p> + +<p> +“We have thought that East Anglia was to be won first from Alsi,” I said. +</p> + +<p> +“So says Havelok; but I do not think so. For, indeed, I am but the wife, and +the things of the husband come first of all. Now, this is what I would say. +Sail to Denmark before Hodulf knows what is coming, and there will be less +trouble.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am slow at seeing things,” said Havelok; “but the same might be said of your +kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +“Alsi is ready, and Hodulf is not,” she answered, laughing; “any one can see +that. +</p> + +<p> +“Is it not so, brother?” +</p> + +<p> +So it was; and I thought that she was right. +</p> + +<p> +“Let us ask the brothers,” I said, “for here are many things to be thought of; +and, first of all, where to get men.” +</p> + +<p> +That was the greatest trouble to our minds, but none at all to hers. +</p> + +<p> +“Get them in Denmark,” she said, when we were all together in the great room of +the house that evening. “Let us go as merchant folk, and find Sigurd, or his +son if he is dead. If I am not much mistaken, all the land will rise for the +son of Gunnar so soon as it is known that he has come again.” +</p> + +<p> +“Sigurd is yet alive,” Arngeir said; “and more than that, he is waiting. For he +promised Grim that he would be ready, and I heard the promise. I think that +this plan is good, and can well be managed. Here is the ship that Griffin was +to have taken today, and he is not here. Gold enough I have, for Grim hoarded +against this time.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he showed us the store that, through long years, my father had brought +together to take the place of that of Sigurd’s which had been lost; and it was +no small one. And so we planned at once; and in the end we three brothers were +to go with Havelok and Goldberga, leaving Mord to get to Ragnar and tell him +that Goldberga was following the fortunes of her husband, and would return to +see to her own if all went well. Berthun would go with him, and Arngeir would +bide at home, for we needed one to whom messages might come; and while none +would know us now in Denmark, either Arngeir or Mord might be seen, and men +would tell Hodulf that the men of Grim had come home, and so perhaps spoil all. +Word might go to Denmark from Griffin even yet. +</p> + +<p> +We had little thought of any sorry ending to our plans, for the dreams that had +come so true so far cheered us. And so, with the evening tide of the next day, +we sailed in the same ship that had been hired for Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +But first Havelok spent a long hour on my father’s mound alone, thinking of all +that he owed to him who rested there. And to him came Goldberga softly, +presently, lest he should be lonely in that place. And there she spoke to him +of her own faith, saying that already he owed much to it. For he was making his +vows to the Asir for success. +</p> + +<p> +“Shall you pray yet again to the Asir, my husband?” she asked. +</p> + +<p> +“Why should I? I have vowed my vows, and there is an end. If they heed them, +all is well; and if not, the Norns hinder.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is One whom the Norns hinder not at all,” she said gently, and so told +him how that her prayers would go up every day. +</p> + +<p> +Fain was she that he also prayed in that wise to her God, that naught might be +apart in their minds. +</p> + +<p> +Then he said, “I have heard this from David and Withelm also, and it is good. +Teach me to vow to your God, sweet wife, and I will do so; and you shall teach +me to pray as you pray.” +</p> + +<p> +So it came to pass that Havelok in the after days was more than ready to help +the Christian teachers when they came to him; for that was how the vow that he +made ran, that he would do so if he was king, and had the power. +</p> + +<p> +Now there is nothing to tell of our voyage, for one could not wish for a better +passage, if the ship was slow. Indeed, she was so slow that a smaller vessel +that left Tetney haven on the next day reached the same port that we were bound +for on the night that we came to our old home. And that we learned soon after +she had come. +</p> + +<p> +Into Sigurd’s haven we sailed on the morning tide, and strange it seemed to me +to see the well-known place unchanged as we neared it. My father’s house was +there, and Arngeir’s, and the great hall of the jarl towered over all, as I +remembered it. Men were building a ship in the long shed where ours had been +built, and where the queen had hidden; and the fishing boats lay on the hard as +on the day when Havelok had come to us. The little grove was yet behind our +house, and it seemed strange when I remembered that the old stones of its altar +were far beyond the seas. I wondered if Thor yet stood under his great ash +tree; and then I saw one change, for that tree was gone, and in its place stood +a watchtower, stone built, and broad and high, for haven beacon. +</p> + +<p> +On the high fore deck stood Havelok, and his arm was round Goldberga as we ran +in, but they were silent. The land held overmuch of coming wonder for them to +put into words, as I think. +</p> + +<p> +Presently the boats came off to us in the old way, and here and there I seemed +to know the faces of the men, but I was not sure. It was but the remembrance of +the old Danish cast of face, maybe. I could put no names to any of them. And as +we were warped alongside the wharf, there rode down to see who we were Sigurd +the jarl himself, seeming unchanged, although twelve years had gone over him. +He was younger than my father, I think, and was at that age when a man changes +too slowly for a boy to notice aught but that the one he left as a man he +thought old is so yet. He was just the noble-looking warrior that I had always +wondered at and admired. +</p> + +<p> +We had arranged in this way: Havelok was to be the merchant, and we his +partners in the venture, trading with the goods in the ship as our own. That +the owner, who was also ship master, had agreed to willingly enough, as we +promised to make good any loss that might be from our want of skill in +bargaining. One may say that we bought the cargo, which was not a great one, on +our own risk, therefore, hiring the vessel to wait our needs, in case we found +it better to fly or to land elsewhere presently. Then Havelok was to ask the +jarl’s leave to trade in the land, and so find a chance to speak with him in +private. After that the goods might be an excuse for going far and wide through +the villages to let men know who had come, without rousing Hodulf’s fears. +</p> + +<p> +And as we thought of all this on the voyage, Goldberga remembered that it was +likely that Sigurd would know again the ring that had been the queen’s, and she +said that it had better be shown him at once, that he might begin to suspect +who his guest was. For we knew that he was true to the son of Gunnar, if none +else might still be so. +</p> + +<p> +This seemed good to us all; and, indeed, everything seemed to be well planned, +though we knew that there are always some happenings that have been overlooked. +We thought we had provided against these by keeping the ship as our own to wait +for us, however, and it will be seen how it all worked out in the end. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok went ashore as soon as the ship was moored; and the moment that he +touched land he made a sign on his breast, and I think that it was not that of +the hammer of Thor, for Goldberga watched him with bright eyes, and she seemed +content as she did so. He went at once to where the jarl sat on his horse +waiting him, and greetings passed. I was so used to seeing men stare at my +brother that I thought little of the long look that Sigurd gave him; but +presently it seemed that he was mightily taken with this newcomer, for he came +on board the ship, that he might speak more with him and us. +</p> + +<p> +“Presently,” he said, “you must come and dine with me at my hall; for the lady +whom I saw as you came in will be weary, and a meal on shore after a long +voyage is ever pleasant. Now what is your errand here?” +</p> + +<p> +“Trading, jarl,” answered Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“I thought you somewhat over warlike-looking for a merchant,” said Sigurd; +“what is your merchandise?” +</p> + +<p> +“Lincoln cloth, and bar iron, and such like; and with it all one thing that is +worth showing to you, jarl, for I will sell it to none but yourself.” +</p> + +<p> +Now we went aft slowly, and presently Havelok and the jarl were alone by the +steering oar, by design on our part. +</p> + +<p> +“This seems to be somewhat special,” said Sigurd. “What is it?” +</p> + +<p> +Havelok took the ring from his pouch, and set it in the jarl’s hand without a +word; and long Sigurd looked at it. I saw the red on his cheek deepen as he did +so, but he said never a word for a long time. And next he looked at Havelok, +and the eyes of these two met. +</p> + +<p> +“This is beyond price,” said the jarl slowly. “Not my whole town would buy +this. It is such as a queen might wear and be proud of.” +</p> + +<p> +“Should I show it to Hodulf the king, therefore?” asked Havelok, with his eyes +on those of the jarl. +</p> + +<p> +“Let no man see it until I know if I can buy it,” answered Sigurd. “Trust it to +my keeping, if you will, for I would have it valued maybe.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is my wife’s, and you must ask her that.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok called Goldberga from her cabin under the after deck, and the jarl +greeted her in most courtly wise. +</p> + +<p> +“I will trust it with you, Jarl Sigurd,” she said, when he asked her if he +might keep the ring for a time. “Yet it is a great trust, as you know, and it +will be well to show the ring to none but men who are true.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is to true men that I would show it,” he answered, with that look that had +passed between him and Havelok already; and I was sure that he knew now pretty +certainly who we were. Yet he could not say more at this time, for the many men +who waited for Havelok must be told somewhat of his coming first. +</p> + +<p> +Now men were gathering on the wharf to see the newcomers, and so the jarl spoke +openly for all to hear. +</p> + +<p> +“Come up to my hall, all of you, and take a meal ashore with me; for good is +the first food on dry land after days at sea and the fare of the ship.” +</p> + +<p> +So he went across the gangway, and to his horse, and rode away quickly, calling +back to us, “Hasten, for we wait for you. And I will find you lodgings in the +town for the time that you bide with us.” +</p> + +<p> +Now at first that seemed somewhat hazardous, for we had meant to stay in the +ship, lest we should have to fly for any reason suddenly. But it seemed that we +had no choice but to do as he bade us, and we could not doubt him in any way. +We should go armed, of course, as in a strange place; and, after all, unless +Hodulf heard of us, and wanted to see us, he was not to be feared as yet. So I +fell to wondering where our lodgings would he, and if the old families still +dwelt in the houses that I had known, and then who had ours. Many such thoughts +will crowd into the mind of one who sees his old land again after many years, +and finds naught changed, to the eye at least. +</p> + +<p> +Men have told me that, as we came into the hall presently, they thought us the +most goodly company that had ever crossed its threshold; and that is likely, +for at our head were Havelok and Goldberga. Raven was a mighty warrior to look +on as he came next, grave and silent, with far-seeing grey eyes that were full +of watching, as it were, from his long seafaring, and yet had the seaman’s +ready smile in them. And Withelm was the pattern of a well-made youth who has +his strength yet to gather, and already knows how to make the best use of that +he has. There were none but thought that he was the most handsome of the three +sons of Grim. And last came I, and I am big enough, at least, to stand at +Havelok’s back; and for the rest, one remembers what Eglaf said of me. But I do +not think that any noticed us with those twain to look at, unless they scanned +our arms, which were more after the English sort than the Danish, so far as +mail and helms are concerned, and therefore might seem strange. +</p> + +<p> +The old hall was not changed at all; and handsome it seemed after Alsi’s, +though it was not so large. There were more and better weapons on the walls, +and carved work was everywhere, so that in the swirl and heat-flicker of the +torches the beams, and door posts, and bench ends, and the pillars of the high +seat seemed alive with knotted dragons that began, and ended, and writhed +everywhere, wondrous to look on. Our English have not the long winter nights, +and cruel frosts, and deep snow that make time for such work as this for the +men of the household. +</p> + +<p> +There fell a silence as we came in, and then Sigurd greeted us; and we were set +on the high seat, and feasted royally. On right and left of our host sat +Havelok and Goldberga, and the jarl’s wife next to Havelok, and Biorn the +Brown, the sheriff, next to our princess. This was a newcomer here since my +days, but well we liked him. +</p> + +<p> +There is nothing to tell of what happened at this feast, for Sigurd asked no +questions of us but the most common ones of sea, and wind, and voyage, and +never a word that would have been hard for Havelok to answer in this company, +where men of Hodulf’s might well be present. Withelm noticed this, and said +that no doubt it was done purposely, and he thought much of it. +</p> + +<p> +When we had ended with song and tale, and it was near time for rest, Sigurd +bade Biorn, the sheriff, take us to his house for the night, telling him that +he must answer for our safety, and specially that of the fair lady who had come +from so far. And then he gave us a good guard of his housecarls to take us down +the street, as if he feared some danger. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, jarl,” said Biorn, “our guests will have a bad night if they think that +in our quiet place they need twenty men to see them to bed thus!” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but the town is strange to the lady,” answered Sigurd; “and who knows +what she may fear in a foreign land!” +</p> + +<p> +So Biorn laughed, and was content; and we bade farewell to the jarl, and went +out. And then I found that it was to my father’s house we were to go, for it +had been given to Biorn. +</p> + +<p> +Now, I was next to Goldberga as we came to the door, and there was a step into +the house which we always had to warn strangers of when it was dark; and so, in +the old way, without thinking for a moment, I said to her, “One step into the +house, sister.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, Master Radbard, if that is you, you have sharp eyes in the dark,” said +Biorn at once; “I was just about to say that myself.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have some feeling in my toes,” I answered; and that turned the matter, for +they laughed. +</p> + +<p> +And then, when we were inside, and the courtmen had gone clattering down the +street homewards, Biorn took the great door bar from its old place and ran it +into the sockets in the doorposts, as I had done so many times; and the runes +that my father had cut on it when he made the house were still plain to be seen +on it, with the notches I had made with the first knife that I ever had. More I +will not say, but everywhere that my eyes fell were things that I knew, even to +fishing gear, for it seemed that Biorn was somewhat of a fisher, like Grim +himself. +</p> + +<p> +Then they put me and my brothers into our old loft, and Havelok and Goldberga +had the room that had been my father’s. As for Biorn, he would be in the great +room, before the fire. There was only this one door to the house, and therefore +he would guard that. His thralls were in the sheds, as ours used to be, so that +we and he were alone in the house. +</p> + +<p> +Now, as soon as we three had gone into our old place of rest, Raven went at +once, as in the old days, to the little square window that was in the +high-pitched gable, and looked out over the town and sea. We used to laugh at +him for this, for he was never happy until he had seen, as we said, if all was +yet there. +</p> + +<p> +“There are yet lights in the jarl’s hall,” he said, “and there are one or two +moving about down in the haven. I think that there is a vessel coming in.” +</p> + +<p> +“Come and lie down, brother,” I said. “We are not in Grimsby, and you cannot go +and take toll from her if there is.” +</p> + +<p> +He laughed, and came to his bed; but we talked of old days and of many things +more for a long while before we slept. And most of all, we thought that Sigurd +the jarl knew Havelok by the token of the ring and by that likeness to Gunnar +which Mord had seen, and that our errand was almost told. +</p> + +<p> +So we slept without thought of any danger; but the first hour of the night in +that house was not so quiet to Goldberga, for presently she woke Havelok, and +she was trembling. +</p> + +<p> +“Husband,” she said, “it is in my mind that we are in danger in this place; for +I cannot sleep by reason of a dream that will come to me so soon as my eyes are +closed.” +</p> + +<p> +“You are overtired with the voyage,” Havelok told her gently; and then he asked +her what the dream was. +</p> + +<p> +“It seems that I see you attacked by a boar and many foxes, and hard pressed, +and then that a bear and good hounds help you. Yet we have to flee to a great +tree, and there is safety. Then come two lions, and they obey you.” +</p> + +<p> +“I think that is a dream that comes of waves, and the foam that has followed +us, and the shrill wind in the rigging, and the humming of the sail, sweet +wife; and the tree is the tall mast maybe, and the lions are the surges that +you saw along this shore, where is no danger.” +</p> + +<p> +So she was content; and then all in the house slept. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap19">CHAPTER XIX.<br/> +THE LAST OF GRIFFIN OF WALES.</a></h2> + +<p> +Maybe it was about an hour before midnight when the first waking came to any of +us, and then it was Biorn himself who was roused by footsteps that stayed at +the doorway itself, after coming across the garth, and then a voice that was +strange to him which bade him open. At once he caught up his axe and went to +the door, and asked quietly who was there. +</p> + +<p> +“Open at once,” said the man who was without; “we must speak with you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Go hence, I pray you, and wait for morning,” said the sheriff. “Here are +guests of the jarl’s, and they must not be disturbed.” +</p> + +<p> +“Open, or we will open for ourselves,” was the answer. “We have no time to stay +here talking.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is no honest speech,” quoth Biorn. “Go hence, or give me your errand from +without.” +</p> + +<p> +“Open, fool, or we will have the door down.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is an axe waiting for you if you do that. I rede you go hence in peace, +or it may be worse for you in the end.” +</p> + +<p> +I suppose it was in the mind of the sheriff that here were some friends of his +who had been overlong at the ale bench in the hall that evening; but on this +there was a little talk outside, and then the crash of a great stone that was +hurled against the door; and at that he started back and got his mail shirt on +him, for the door was strong enough to stand many such blows yet. It seemed +that there was more than a drunken frolic on hand. Then came another stone +against the door, and it shook; and at the same moment Havelok came from his +chamber to see what was amiss, for the noise had waked him. He had thrown on +the feasting gear that he had been wearing; but he had neither mail nor helm, +though he had his axe in his hand. +</p> + +<p> +“What is the noise?” he said anxiously, seeing that Biorn was arming. +</p> + +<p> +The sheriff told him quickly, and again the door was battered. +</p> + +<p> +“It is a pity that a good door should be spoilt,” said Havelok, “for down it is +bound to come thus. Stand you there with the axe, and I will even save them the +trouble of breaking in.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” said Biorn; “we know not how many are there, and it were better that you +should arm first. There is time.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, they think that you are alone in the house, no doubt, and will run when +they find out their mistake. They are common thieves from the forest, or +outlaws. Stand you by to cut down the first man that dares to enter, if there +happen to be one bold enough.” +</p> + +<p> +He set his axe down, and went to the bar, and began to slide it back into the +deep socket that would let it free, and the men outside stayed their blows as +they heard it scraping. It was a very heavy bar of oak, some seven feet long, +and over a palm square. +</p> + +<p> +“Now!” cried Havelok, and caught the bar from its place. +</p> + +<p> +He did not take the trouble to set it down and get his axe; but as the door +opened a little he stood back balancing the great beam in his hands, as a boy +would handle a quarterstaff, ready for the rush of the thieves that he +expected, and so he was in the way of Biorn more or less. +</p> + +<p> +Now there was silence outside, and one saw that the door was free, and set his +foot to it, and flung it open, for it went inwards. And then Havelok knew that +there was a stern fight before him, for the moonlight showed the grim form of +Griffin, the Welsh thane, fully armed and ready. +</p> + +<p> +“Stand back, friend,” cried Biorn hastily, fearing for the unarmed man, and +caring nothing that beyond the foremost was a group of some half dozen more +warriors. +</p> + +<p> +But he spoke too late, for as Griffin stepped back a pace on seeing his enemy +himself in the doorway, Havelok had gone a pace forward, and now was outside, +where he had a clear swing of his unhandy weapon. +</p> + +<p> +Now Griffin gathered himself together, and spoke some few words to his men in +his own tongue; but my brother paid no heed to them, for he knew what the way +of the Briton was likely to be. And he was not wrong, for without warning +Griffin flew on him, sword point foremost, and left handed, for he might not +use the right for many a long day yet. +</p> + +<p> +Biorn shouted; but Havelok was ready, and the heavy bar caught and shivered the +light sword, and then swung and hurled the thane back among his men with a rib +broken. Havelok followed that up, falling on the men even as their leader was +among their feet. Two he felled with downright strokes, and another shrank away +in time to save himself from the like fate. Then a fourth got in under his +guard, and wounded Havelok slightly in the left arm; and unless Biorn had been +out and beside him by that time it would have gone hard with him, for both +those who were left were on him, and another was hanging back for a chance to +come. +</p> + +<p> +There was shouting enough now, for the Briton does not fight in silence as do +the northern men, and we had waked. First of all Raven ran down to the great +room, half dazed with sleep, and blaming himself for all this trouble, for he +had seen that a ship was coming in, and he might have thought it possible that +it had brought Griffin and his men, whose tongue had told him at once what had +happened. +</p> + +<p> +Now he called to us to arm quickly, and sought for a weapon for himself; and in +that familiar place he went to the old corner where the oars were wont to be +set. There was one, for I have said that this Biorn was a fisher, and the place +that was handy for us had been so for him. That was a homely weapon to Raven, +and out into the moonlight he came with it, and swept a Welshman away from +Havelok’s side as he came. But now more men were coming—townsfolk who had been +roused by the noise—and they knew nothing of the attackers, and so thought them +friends of ours, who joined us in falling on their sheriff; and there was a +wild confusion when Withelm and I came down armed. +</p> + +<p> +But what we saw first was a dim, white figure in the doorway of the other room; +and there stood Goldberga, wide eyed and trembling. +</p> + +<p> +“My dream, my dream!” she said. +</p> + +<p> +But of that we knew nothing; and we could but tell her to be of good courage, +for we would win through yet, and so went out to the fight. +</p> + +<p> +By this time Griffin was up again, and as I came from the door he was once more +ready to fall on Havelok from behind. So I thought it best to stay him, and I +shouted his name, and he turned and made for me. But there was no skill in his +coming, or he did not think me worth it, for the axe had the better, and there +was an end of Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +Withelm saw at once that Havelok had no weapon but the bar, and he ran to him +and held out his own axe. +</p> + +<p> +“Thanks, brother. Mine is inside the door. Get it for me,” said he; but now he +was laughing, and doing not much harm to anyone, and as I got behind his back I +saw why this was. +</p> + +<p> +There was only one of Griffin’s men left, and all the rest of the crowd of +half-armed men were townsfolk. Havelok and Raven were keeping these back with +sweeps of their long weapons, and behind them against the wall was the sheriff, +swearing and shouting vainly to bid his people hold off and listen to him. And +the noise was so great that they did but think that he was calling them to +rescue him from these who had taken him prisoner. It seemed that the Welshman +was keeping this up also; but neither he nor any of the men cared to risk any +nearness to the sweep of bar and long oar in such hands. There were many broken +heads in that crowd; but it was growing greater every minute, and those who +were coming were well armed, having taken their time over it. They say that +there were sixty men there at one time. +</p> + +<p> +Now ran Withelm with the axe, and at that Havelok parted with the door bar, and +ended the last Welshman at the same time, for he hurled it at him endwise, like +a spear, and it took him full in the chest, and he went down to rise no more. +And at that the townsmen ran in, and we were busy for a space, until once more +they were in a howling circle round us. But they had wounded Havelok again; and +Biorn was at his wit’s end, for he had had to take part in the fight this time. +The men were mad with battle, and forgot who he was, as it seemed. And now some +raised a cry for bows. +</p> + +<p> +That was the worst thing that we had to fear, and Raven called to us, “Into the +house, brothers, and keep them out of it till the jarl comes. He will hear, or +be sent for.” +</p> + +<p> +So we went back and got into the doorway, and we could not bar it at first. But +Withelm hewed off the blade of Raven’s oar, and I went out and cleared the folk +away for a space, and leapt back; and Havelok and I got the door shut quickly +against them as they came back on it, and we barred it with the oar loom. That +was but pine, however, and it would not last long. +</p> + +<p> +Outside, the people were quiet for a little, wondering, no doubt, how to rescue +Biorn. He wanted to go out to them, but it did not seem safe just yet. If they +grew more reasonable it might be so. +</p> + +<p> +Then, as we rested thus, Goldberga came quickly, for she saw that her husband +was wounded, and she began to bind his hurts with a scarf she had. She was very +pale, but she was not weeping, and her hands did not shake as she went to work. +</p> + +<p> +“This is my dream,” she said. “Was that the voice of Griffin that I heard? It +does not seem possible; but there is none other who speaks in the old tongue of +Britain here, surely.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is no more fear of him,” said Havelok, looking tenderly at her. “Your +dream has come true so far, if he was in it. How did it end?” +</p> + +<p> +“We fled to a tree,” she said, smiling faintly. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok smiled also, for this seemed dream stuff only to all of us—all of us +but Withelm, that is, for at once he said, “This door will be down with a few +blows. What of that tower of yours, Biorn? Might we not get there and wait till +the jarl comes?” +</p> + +<p> +At that Biorn almost shouted. +</p> + +<p> +“That is a good thought, and we can get there easily. Well it will be, also, +for the men are wild now, and there have been too many slain and hurt for them +to listen to reason.” +</p> + +<p> +“Bide you here,” said Withelm, “for it is we whom they seek. Then you can talk +to them.” +</p> + +<p> +But he would not do that, seeing that we had been put in his charge by the +jarl. +</p> + +<p> +“I go with you,” he said. “Now, if we climb out of the window that is in the +back of the house we can get to the tower before they know we are gone.” +</p> + +<p> +We went into that chamber where Havelok had once been when he was taken from +the sack, and even as I unbarred the heavy shutter and took it down, the door +began to shake with a fresh attack on it. The trees of the grove were two +hundred yards from the house, maybe, and among them loomed high and black the +watchtower I had seen from the sea. A wide path had been cut to it, and the +moonlight shone straight down this to the door of the building. +</p> + +<p> +Now Biorn went out first, and then he helped out Goldberga, and after her we +made Havelok go; and we called to these three to get to the tower as Withelm +came next, for every moment I looked to see our enemies—if they are to be +called so when I hardly suppose they knew what they were fighting about—come +round to fall on the back of the house. +</p> + +<p> +Because of Goldberga they went; and Biorn opened the tower door, and she passed +into the blackness of its entry, but the two men stayed outside for us. And we +three were all out of the house when the first of the crowd bethought +themselves, and made for the back, and saw us. +</p> + +<p> +At once they raised a shout and a rush, and we did not think it worth while to +wait for them, as they would get between us and the tower, which was open for +us. So we ran, and they were, some twenty of them, hard at our heels as we +reached the door, and half fell inside, for the winding stairway was close to +the entry. I think that Biorn and Havelok had made their plans as they saw what +was coming, for Havelok followed us and stood in the doorway, while Biorn was +just outside with his axe ready. +</p> + +<p> +“Hold hard, friends!” he called, as the men came up and halted before him; +“what is all this?” +</p> + +<p> +“Stand aside and let us get at them,” said the foremost, panting. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” said Biorn; “what harm have they done?” +</p> + +<p> +“Slain a dozen men and lamed twice as many more,” answered several voices; +“have them forth straightway.” +</p> + +<p> +“They were attacked, and defended themselves,” said the sheriff, “and it is no +fault of theirs that they had to do their best. Get you home, and I will answer +to the jarl for them. They are the jarl’s guests.” +</p> + +<p> +Then was a howl that was strange, and with it voices which seemed to let some +light on the matter. +</p> + +<p> +“They have slain the jarl’s guests.” +</p> + +<p> +And then came forward a big black-bearded man whom I had seen in the crowd +already, and he squared up to Biorn. +</p> + +<p> +“Lies are no good, master sheriff, for we know that the outlanders who spoke +the strange tongue must be the guests who came.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am no liar,” answered Biorn. “Is there not one man here who saw the ship and +her folk this afternoon?” +</p> + +<p> +Now this man seemed not to want that question answered, for he shouted to the +crowd not to waste time in wrangling, but to have out the murderers; and he +took a step towards Biorn, bidding him side no more with the men, but let the +folk deal with them. +</p> + +<p> +“You overdo your business as sheriff!” he said. +</p> + +<p> +It was Biorn who wasted no more time, for he saw that here was deeper trouble +than a common riot. He lifted his axe. +</p> + +<p> +“Come nearer at your peril,” he said. +</p> + +<p> +Then the black-bearded man sprang at him, and axe met sword for a parry or two, +flashing white in the moonlight. Then one weapon flashed red suddenly, and it +was Biorn’s, and back into the tower he sprang as his foe fell, and Havelok +flung the door to, and I barred it. +</p> + +<p> +“Up,” said Biorn; and in the dark we stumbled from stair to stair, while the +crowd howled and beat on the door below us. It was good to get out into the +moonlight on the roof, where we could rest. I was glad that the tower was there +instead of Thor, and also that it was strong. It was no great height, but wide, +and the men below looked comfortably far off at all events. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is a fine affair,” quoth Biorn, sitting himself down with his back +against the high stone wall round the tower top. “It will take me all my time +to set this right.” +</p> + +<p> +“You have stood by us well, friend,” Havelok said, “and it is a pity that you +have had to share our trouble so far as this. Who was the man who fell on you?” +</p> + +<p> +“That is the trouble,” answered Biorn, “for there will be more noise over him +than all the rest. He was Hodulf’s steward, the man who gathers the scatt, and +therefore is not liked. And all men know that there was no love lost between +him and me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Hodulf’s man,” said I; “how long has he been here, and is he a Norseman?” +</p> + +<p> +For I knew him. He was the man who had spoken to me at the boat side when we +had to fly—one, therefore, who knew all of the secret of Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, one of the Norsemen who came here with the king at the first, and is +almost the last left of that crew. I suppose that you have heard the story.” +</p> + +<p> +We had, in a way that the honest sheriff did not guess, and I only nodded. But +I thought that we had got rid of an enemy in him, and that Griffin had fallen +in with him on landing, and known him, and taken him into his counsel about us. +He would have gone down to see the vessel and collect the king’s dues from her +and from us at the same time. He had not come into the town till late, as we +heard afterwards. +</p> + +<p> +There was no time for asking more now, however, for the shouts of the men round +the door ceased, and someone gave orders, as if there was a plan to be carried +out. So I went and looked over on the side where the door was to see what was +on hand. +</p> + +<p> +It was about what one would have expected. They had got the trunk of a tree, +and were going to batter the door in. But now we were all armed, for Raven had +brought Havelok’s gear with him when he fetched his own. He had thought also +for Goldberga, and she was sitting in the corner of the tower walls wrapped in +a great cloak that she had used at sea, with her eyes on her husband, +unfearing, and as it seemed waiting for the end that her dream foretold. +</p> + +<p> +I called the rest, and we looked down on the men. They saw us, and an arrow or +two flew at us, badly aimed in the moonlight. +</p> + +<p> +“Waste of good arrows,” said Havelok; “but we must keep them from the door +somehow.” +</p> + +<p> +“Would that the jarl would come,” growled Biorn, “for I do not see how we are +to do that.” +</p> + +<p> +“If they do break in,” said I, “any one can hold a stairway like this against a +crowd.” +</p> + +<p> +“I do not want to hurt more of these,” answered Havelok, looking round him. And +then his eyes lit up, and he laughed. “Why, we can keep them back easily +enough, after all.” +</p> + +<p> +He went to the tower corner, and shouted to the men below. Four or five had the +heavy log that they were to use as a ram, and they were just about to charge +the door with it, and no timber planking can stand that sort of thing. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, men,” he cried; “set that down, or some of you may get hurt.” +</p> + +<p> +They set up a roar of laughter at him as they heard, and then Havelok laid hold +of the great square block of stone that was on the very corner of the wall, and +tore it from its setting. +</p> + +<p> +“Odin!” said Biorn, as he saw that, “where do they breed such men as this?” +</p> + +<p> +“Here,” answered Withelm, looking at the sheriff. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok hove up the stone over his head, and a sort of gasp went up from +the crowd below. One saw what was coming, and ran to drag back the men with the +beam, and stopped short before he reached them in terror, crying to them to +beware. But their heads were down, and they were starting into a run. +</p> + +<p> +“Halt!” cried Havelok, but they did not stay. “Stand clear!” he shouted in the +sailor’s way. +</p> + +<p> +And then he swung the stone and let it go, while those who watched fled back as +if it was cast at them. Down is crashed on the attackers, felling the man whom +it struck, and dashing the timber from the grasp of the others, so that one +fell with it across his leg and lay howling, while the rest gathered themselves +up and got away from under the tower as soon as they might. +</p> + +<p> +Now no man dared to come forward, and that angered Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Are you going to let these two bide there?” he said. “Pick the poor knaves +from under the stone and timber, and see to them.” +</p> + +<p> +But they hung back yet, and he called them “nidring.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat two or three made a step forward, and one said, “Lord, let us do as you +bid us, and harm us not.” +</p> + +<p> +“You are safe,” he answered, and Biorn laughed and said that this was the most +wholesome word that he had heard tonight. +</p> + +<p> +“Lord, forsooth! Mighty little of that was there five minutes ago.” +</p> + +<p> +But it was not the terrible stone throwing only that wrung this from them, as I +think. They had seen Havelok in his arms, with the light of battle on his face +in the broad moonlight, and knew him for a king among men. +</p> + +<p> +They took the hurt men from under the tower, and then crowded together, +watching us. And some man must needs loose an arrow at us, and it rang on my +mail, and that let loose the crowd again. Soon we had to shelter under the +battlement, but they were not able to lodge any arrows among us, for that is a +bit of skill that needs daylight. Then they dared to get to the timber once +more, and we saw them coming. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok took his helm, and set it on his sword point, and raised it slowly +above the wall, and that drew all the arrows in a moment. Then he leapt up, and +tore the stone from the other corner; and again, but this time without warning, +it fell on the men below, and that wrought more harm than before. But it stayed +them for a time, though not so long, for now their blood was up, and the +berserk spirit was waking in them. Already the third stone was poised in the +mighty hands, and would have fallen, when there was a cry of, “The jarl! the +jarl!” and along the path into the clearing galloped Sigurd himself, with his +courtmen running behind him, and he called on the men to stay. +</p> + +<p> +They dropped the beam at the command, and were silent. And Sigurd looked up at +the tower, and saw who was there, and stayed with his face raised, motionless +for a space. I minded how Mord had stared and cried out when first he saw +Havelok, the son of Gunnar, in his war gear. +</p> + +<p> +“Biorn! where is Biorn?” cried Sigurd, looking back on the crowd as if he +thought he would be there. +</p> + +<p> +“Here am I, jarl,” came the answer, and the sheriff looked out from beside +Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“What is all this?” +</p> + +<p> +“On my word, jarl, I cannot tell. Here have I been beset in my own house, and +but for your guests some of us would have come off badly. There were outlanders +who fell on us, and, as I think, stirred up the folk to carry on the business, +telling them that we had slain ourselves, as one might say, for it was the cry +that we had slain the jarl’s guests.” +</p> + +<p> +“O fools, to take up the word of a chance stranger against that of your own +sheriff!” Sigurd cried, facing the people. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but the steward said so likewise,” cried some. +</p> + +<p> +“Hodulf’s steward?” said the jarl suddenly; “where is he?” +</p> + +<p> +“Yonder. Biorn slew him.” +</p> + +<p> +“He was leading this crowd,” said Biorn from above, “tried to force his way +into the tower past me, and would not be warned.” +</p> + +<p> +“What of the outlanders?” +</p> + +<p> +“All slain. Seven Welshmen they were.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I said plainly, remembering that the jarl would have known him, “Their +leader was Griffin, who came with Hodulf at the first. What brought him here, +think you, Sigurd the jarl?” +</p> + +<p> +But Sigurd looked round on the people, and scanned them for a long time, and at +last he said, in a hush that fell when he began to speak, “Men who mind the old +days, look at the man whom you have sought to kill, and say if there is that +about him which will tell you why Hodulf’s men have set you on him thus.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the white faces turned with one accord to Havelok, as he stood resting the +great cornerstone on the battlement before him, and there grew a whisper that +became a word and that was almost a shout from the many voices that answered. +</p> + +<p> +“Gunnar! Gunnar Kirkeban come again!” +</p> + +<p> +Then was silence, and the jarl spoke to Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Tell us your name, and whence you come.” +</p> + +<p> +“Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby men call me,” he said. +</p> + +<p> +And then men knew who he was indeed, for little by little the secret had been +pieced together, if not told from the king’s place, in the years that had +passed. And at that there rose and grew a murmur and a cry. +</p> + +<p> +“Havelok, son of Gunnar! Havelok the king!” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Sigurd in a great voice, “Who is for Hodulf of us all? Let no man go +hence who is for him.” +</p> + +<p> +And I saw two or three men cut down then and there, and after that there was a +roar of voices that called for Havelok to lead them. +</p> + +<p> +“Come down, lord,” said Sigurd, unhelming and looking up. +</p> + +<p> +So we went from the tower, and round Havelok the men crowded, kissing his hand +and asking pardon for what they had wrought in error; and Sigurd dismounted and +knelt before him, holding forth his sword hilt in token of homage, that his +king might touch it. +</p> + +<p> +“Only Havelok son of Gunnar dares call himself son of Grim also, and in that +word all the tale is told. But I have known you from the first by the token of +the ring and by this likeness. Yet I waited for you to speak, and for the time +that should be best; and now that has come of itself, and I am glad.” +</p> + +<p> +So said Sigurd, as we went from the tower to the hall, with the townsmen at our +heels in a wondering crowd. There were many among them who would show the +wounds that Havelok had given them with pride hereafter, as tokens that they +had known him well. +</p> + +<p> +Then we stayed on the steps of the hall door, and the jarl called out man by +man, and the war arrow was put in their hands with the names of those men who +waited for the coming of Havelok, that all through the night the message that +should bring him a mighty host on the morrow should go far and wide. +</p> + +<p> +And the gathering word was, “Come, for the horn of the king is sounding.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Sigurd said, “Speak to the people, my king, and all is done.” +</p> + +<p> +So Havelok smiled, and lifted his voice, and spoke. +</p> + +<p> +“Stand by me, friends, as steadfastly as you have fought against me, and I +shall be well content. And see, here is the queen for whom you will fight also. +There is not one of you but will play the man under her eyes.” +</p> + +<p> +Not many words or crafty, but men saw his face, and heard that which was in the +voice, and they needed no word of reward to come, but shouted as we had shouted +when the bride came home to Grimsby, and I thought that with the shout the +throne of Hodulf was rocking. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap20">CHAPTER XX.<br/> +THE OWNING OF THE HEIR.</a></h2> + +<p> +Worn out we were with that long fight, and we all had some small wounds—not +much worth speaking of; and when these were seen to, we slept. Only my brother +Raven waked, and he sat through all the rest of the short night on the high +place, with his sword across his knees, watching, for he blamed himself, +overmuch as we all thought, for the happenings of the attack. +</p> + +<p> +“Trouble not, brother, for we were in the keeping of Biorn, and he could not +have dreamt that foes could follow us over seas. It was not for you to be on +guard.” +</p> + +<p> +These were Withelm’s words, but for once Raven did not heed them. +</p> + +<p> +“Would Grim, our father, have slept with a lee shore under him, leaving a +stranger to keep watch? That is not how he taught me my duty; and I have been +careless, and I know it. I should have thought of Griffin when I saw the ship +come in.” +</p> + +<p> +So he had his way, and the last that I saw ere my eyes closed was his stern +form guarding us; and when I woke he was yet there, motionless, with far-off +eyes that noted the little movement that I made, and glanced at me to see that +all was well. +</p> + +<p> +In the grey of the morning the first of the chiefs to whom the arrow had sped +began to come in; but the jarl would not have Havelok waked, for he was greatly +troubled at the little wounds that had befallen this long-waited guest. So the +chiefs gathered very silently in the great hall, and sat waiting while the +light broadened and shone, gleam by gleam, on their bright arms and anxious +faces. It was not possible for those who had not yet seen Havelok to be all so +sure that it was indeed he. They longed to see him, and to know him for the +very son of Gunnar for themselves. +</p> + +<p> +Presently there were maybe twenty chiefs in the hall—men who had fought beside +Kirkeban, and men who had been boys with Havelok, and some who had known his +grandfather—and the jarl thought that it was time that they had the surety that +they needed, for time went on, and there was certainty that Hodulf must hear of +all this morning. One could not expect that no man would earn reward by warning +him. +</p> + +<p> +So Sigurd went softly to the place where Havelok lay in the little guest +chamber that opened out of the inner room that was the jarl’s own, and he slid +the boards that closed it apart gently and looked in to wake him. But instead +of doing that, he came back to the hall and beckoned the chiefs, and they rose +and followed him silently. And when they went Raven went also, without a word, +that he might be near his charge while these many strangers spoke with him. +</p> + +<p> +Now Sigurd stood at the spot where the little shifting of the sliding board +made it possible to see within the chamber, and one by one the chiefs came and +peered through the chink for a moment, and stood aside for the next. And it was +wondrous to see how each man went and looked with doubt or wonder or just +carelessly, and then turned away with a great light of joy on his face and a +new life in the whole turn and sway of the body. +</p> + +<p> +It was dark in the chamber, save for the dim spaces under the eaves that let in +the sweet air from the sea to the sleepers. But from somewhere aloft, where the +timbering of the upper walls toward the east had shrunk, so that there was a +little hole that faced the newly-risen sun, came the long shaft of a sunbeam +that pierced the darkness like a glorious spear, and lit on the mighty shoulder +of Havelok that lay bare of covering, and on the white hand of Goldberga that +was across it. And on the one they saw the crimson bent-armed cross that was +the mark of the line whence he and his father had sprung, and on the other +glowed and flashed the blood-red stone of the ring of Eleyn the queen. And +round that circle of sunshine was light enough for the chiefs to see those two +noble faces, and they were content. +</p> + +<p> +“Gunnar’s son,” said one old chief: “but were he only the son of Grim, for +those twain would I die.” +</p> + +<p> +So the warriors crept back to the hall silently as they had come; and now they +went out to their men and told them that all doubt had gone, and along the road +that led to Hodulf’s town the jarl sent mounted men to watch for his coming. +And always fresh men were pouring in, and among them went the chiefs who had +seen Havelok, and told them the news. +</p> + +<p> +Now it was not long before there was a gathering of all the chiefs in the hall +of Sigurd, that they might break their fast, and then they saw Havelok as he +led in the princess to meet them. He stood on the high place in his arms, and a +shout of greeting went up; and when it was over, Sigurd asked him to tell all +that had happened to him; and he did that in as few words as might be, for he +was no great speaker, though what he did say was always to the point, and left +little to be asked. +</p> + +<p> +And when he had ended, there rose up a grey-headed old chief, and said, “Give +this warrior the horn of Gunnar, that we may hear him wind it. I would not say +that unless I were sure that he was the right man to have it.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I stood beside Havelok, and while Sigurd went from the hall to some +treasure chamber to get this that had been asked for, I said to him, “Mind you +the day when we met Ragnar. and a call came into your dream? Wind that call +now; for, if I am not wrong, it will be welcome to those who knew your father.” +</p> + +<p> +“I mind the day but not the call. I have never remembered it since,” he said, +and I was sorry. +</p> + +<p> +Sigurd brought the horn, and it was a wondrous one, golden and heavy. It seemed +to be a hunting horn, not very long, and little curved, but from end to end it +was wrought with strange figures of men and beasts in rings that ran round it. +</p> + +<p> +“Have you seen this before?” asked Sigurd wistfully, and looking into Havelok’s +face as he gave it into his hand. +</p> + +<p> +One could feel that men waited his answer, and it came slowly. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, friend, I am sure that I have, but I cannot yet say when or where. I am +sure that it is not the first time that I have had it in my hand.” +</p> + +<p> +And as he said this, Havelok’s face flushed a little, and his brow wrinkled as +if he tried to bring back the things of that which he had thought his dream for +so long. +</p> + +<p> +It would seem that in the years there had grown up a tale that this was a magic +horn, which none but the very son of Gunnar could wind, and to the chiefs who +saw Havelok now for the first time this was a test to prove him. But all knew +that the words he spoke of it were proof enough, for a pretender would have +said plainly that it had been Gunnar’s, and that he knew it. I think that +Sigurd was wise in what he did next, for he set another horn in my brother’s +hand, and asked him the same question; and at this Havelok looked for a moment +and shook his head. +</p> + +<p> +“I have not seen that one before, nor one like it. I am sure that I have seen +this, or its fellow.” +</p> + +<p> +At that the faces that watched brightened, for there was no doubt in the way +that Havelok spoke; and then the old chief who had asked for the horn said, +“That—‘The horn of the king is sounding’—was the gathering word of the night +that has brought us here, and long have we waited for it. Let Havelok wind his +father’s horn, that we may hear it once again.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok set it to his lips, and at once the call that he had remembered +came back to him, and clear and sweet and full of longing its strange notes +rang under the arched roof, unfaltering until the last; and then over him came +the full remembrance of all that it had been to him, and he turned away from +the many eyes and sank on the high seat, and set his head in his arms on the +table, that men might not see that he needs must weep; and Goldberga stepped a +little before him, and set her hand on his, for I think that she knew the +loneliness that came on him. +</p> + +<p> +Yet he was not alone in his sorrow, for down in the hall were men to whom the +lost call brought back the memory of a bright young king riding to his home, +and calling the son whom he loved with the call that he had made for him alone; +and they saw the fair child running from the hall, and the mother following +more slowly with smiles of welcome; and they saw the grim courtmen, who looked +on and were glad; and they minded how they had lifted the boy to the war +saddle; and their eyes grew hot with tears also, and they had no need to be +ashamed. +</p> + +<p> +And as men stood motionless, with the last notes of the wild horn yet ringing +in their ears, there drifted a shadow across the days, and, lo! beside Havelok, +with his hand on his shoulder, stood the form of Gunnar the king for a long +moment, bright as any one of us who lived, in the morning sunlight, and his +face was full of joy and of hope and promise for the time to come. And then he +passed, but as he faded from us his hand was on the hand of Goldberga that +clasped her husband’s, as though he would wed them afresh there on the high +place of his friend’s hall. +</p> + +<p> +Now there went a sigh of wonder among the chiefs, and Havelok looked up as if +he followed the going of one whom he would not lose, and I know that he saw +Gunnar after he was unseen to us. +</p> + +<p> +“Surely,” he said, “surely that was my father who was here?” +</p> + +<p> +And Sigurd answered, “With your own call you called him, and he was here.” +</p> + +<p> +But now the last lurking doubt was gone, and there was no more delay, for the +chiefs crowded with shouts of joy to the high place, and they knelt to Havelok +and hailed him as king then and there; and so they led him to the great door of +the hall, and the mightiest of them raised him high on a wide shield before all +the freemen who waited on the green that is round the jarl’s house, and they +cried, “Skoal to Havelok the king!” +</p> + +<p> +And there was in answer the most stirring shout that a man may hear—the shout +of a host that hail the one for whom they are content to die. +</p> + +<p> +That was the first day of the reign of Havelok the king; and now there were two +kings in the land, and one was loved as few have been loved, and the other was +hated. And one was weak in men, as yet, while the other was strong. +</p> + +<p> +Now Sigurd bade all those who were present gather in solemn Thing, that they +might make Havelok king indeed; and that was a gathering of all the best in our +quarter of the land, so that all would uphold what they had done. And when they +were gathered in the great hall in due order, the doors were set wide open, and +outside the freemen who followed the chiefs sat in silence to see what they +might and hear. +</p> + +<p> +Then swore Havelok to keep the ancient laws and customs, and to do even-handed +justice to all men, and to be bound by all else that a good king should hold +by. Sometimes these oaths are not kept as well as they might be, but I was +certain that here was one who would keep them. +</p> + +<p> +Thereafter Sigurd brought forth a crown that he had had made hastily by his +craftsmen from two gold arm rings, and they set it on Havelok’s head, and +hailed him as king indeed; and one by one the chiefs came and swore all fealty +to him, beginning with Sigurd, and ending with a boy of some seventeen winters, +who looked at the king he bent before as though he was Thor himself. +</p> + +<p> +Then they would have had Havelok forth to the people at once; but he bade them +hearken for a moment, and said, taking Goldberga by the hand, “Were it not for +this my wife, I do not think that I had been here today, and without her I am +nothing. Now I am king by your word, and I think that I might bid you take her +as queen. But I had rather that she was made queen by your word also, that +whither I live or fall in the strife that is to come, you may fight for her.” +</p> + +<p> +At that there was a murmur of praise, and all agreed that she should be crowned +at once. So Havelok set the crown on her head while the chiefs in one voice +swore to uphold her through good and ill, as though she were Havelok himself. +</p> + +<p> +Then said Havelok, “Now have you taken her for queen for her own sake, and I +will tell you a thing that has not been heard here as yet. On this throne sits +the queen of two lands, and there shall come a day when you and I shall set +your lady on that other throne which is hers by right. King’s daughter she is, +for Ethelwald of the East Angles was her father, and out of her right has she +been kept by Alsi of Lindsey, her evil kinsman.” +</p> + +<p> +At that men were glad, for great is the magic of kingly descent. And thereupon +that old warrior who had bidden Havelok sound the horn said, “We have heard of +Ethelwald the good king, and of this Alsi moreover, and we know men who have +seen both, and also Orwenna, the mother of our own queen here. I followed your +father across the seas in the old days, and I seem to hear his voice again as +you speak to us. And I saw him—ay, I saw him yonder even now, and I am content. +When the time comes that for the sake of Goldberga you will gather a host and +cross the ‘swan’s path,’ I will not hold back, if you will have me.” +</p> + +<p> +There was spoken the mind of all that company, and they were not backward to +say so. For in the heart of the Dane is ever the love of the sea, and of the +clash of arms on a far-off strand that comes after battle with wind and wave. +</p> + +<p> +Very bravely did Goldberga thank the chiefs for their love to her husband and +herself in a few words that were all that were needed to bind the hearers to +her, so well and truly were they chosen. And she said that if the Anglian land +was to be won it was for Havelok and not for herself altogether, and she added, +“Here we have spoken as if already Hodulf was overthrown, and it is good that +we are in such brave heart. Yet this has been foretold to me, and I am sure +that there will be no mishap.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Sigurd said, “What gift do we give our queen, now that she has come among +us?” +</p> + +<p> +But Goldberga replied, “If it is the custom that one shall be given, I will +mind you of the promise hereafter, when Anglia is won, and you and I are +Havelok’s upholders on that throne. There is one thing that I will ask then, +that a wrong may be righted.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but we will give you some gift now, and then you shall ask what you will +also.” +</p> + +<p> +“You have given me more than I dared hope,” she said, “even the brave hearts +and hands that have hailed us here. I can ask no more. Only promise to give me +one boon when I need it, and I am happy.” +</p> + +<p> +Then they said, “What you will, and when you will, Goldberga, the queen. There +is naught that you will ask amiss.” +</p> + +<p> +Now they showed Havelok to the warriors as crowned king, and I need not tell +how he was greeted. And after that we all went back into the hall to speak of +the way in which we were to meet Hodulf. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok would have a message sent to him, bidding him give up the land in +peace. +</p> + +<p> +“It may be that thus we shall save the sadness of fighting our own people, +though, indeed, they love the playground of Hodulf. He is an outlander, and +perhaps he may think well to make terms with us.” +</p> + +<p> +Some said that it was of no use, but then Havelok answered that even so it was +good to send a challenge to him. +</p> + +<p> +“For the sake of peace we will do this, though I would rather meet him in open +fight, for I have my father to avenge.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I rose up and said, “Let me go and speak with him, taking Withelm as my +counsellor. For I know all the story, and that will make him sure that he has +the right man to fight against. I will speak with him in open hall, and more +than he shall learn how he thought to slay Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +All thought that this was good, and I was to go at once. It was but a few +hours’ ride, as has been said, to his town, and the matter was as well done +with. +</p> + +<p> +So they gave me a guard of twenty of the jarl’s courtmen, and in half an hour I +was riding northward on my errand. And to say the truth I did not know if it +was certain that I should come back, for Hodulf was hardly to be trusted. +</p> + +<p> +I did wait to break my fast, and that was all, for I had no mind to spend the +night on the road back from the talk that I should have had; but though I +wasted so little time, the people were already beginning to prepare for +rejoicing in their own way with games of all sorts and with feasting in the +open. I saw, as we rode down the street, the piles of firewood that were to +roast oxen whole, and near them were the butts that held ale for all comers. +There were men who set up the marks for the archers, and others who staked out +the rings for the wrestling and sword play. And as we left the town we met two +men who led a great brown bear by a ring in his nose, for the baiting. I was +sorry for the poor beast, but the men called him “Hodulf,” already, and I +thought that a good sign in its way. +</p> + +<p> +Another good sign, and that one which could not be mistaken, was to see the +warriors coming in by twos and threes as the news reached them. They were +dotted along the roads from all quarters, and across the heaths we saw the +flash of the arms of more. +</p> + +<p> +And ever as they met us they hailed us with, “What cheer, comrades? Is the news +true? Is Havelok come to his own?” and the like, and they would hurry on, +rejoicing in the answer that they had. +</p> + +<p> +But I will say that presently, when we passed a stretch of wild moor where we +saw no man, the same was going on towards the town of Hodulf; for if the news +came to a village, some would be for the king that was, and other and older men +for the king that might be. Yet all asked that question; and more than once, +when they heard the reply, there would be a halt and a talk, and then the men +would turn and cast in their lot with the son of Gunnar, hastening to him with +more eager steps than had taken them to Hodulf. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap21">CHAPTER XXI.<br/> +THE TOKEN OF SACK AND ANCHOR.</a></h2> + +<p> +It seemed only the other day that I had passed over the well-known ways, and I +showed Withelm the hollow where Grim had met with the king and taken his +precious burden from him. Then we passed along the wild shore, and the linnets +were singing and the whinchats were calling as ever, and the old mounds of the +heroes of the bygone were awesome to me now as long ago, when I looked at them +standing lonesome along the shore with only the wash of the waves to disturb +them. And so we came to the town at high noon, and already there was the bustle +of a gathering host in the place, for the news had fled before us. +</p> + +<p> +They had built a new and greater hall in place of that which had been burned; +and there sat Hodulf with his chiefs, wondering and planning, and maybe waiting +for more certain news of what had happened. Not long would they wait for that +now. +</p> + +<p> +We rode to the door, and one came to meet us with words of welcome, thinking +that we were men who came to the levy that was gathering; but his words stayed +when I asked to be taken to the presence of Hodulf, as I came with a message +from Havelok Gunnarsson the king. +</p> + +<p> +The man, chamberlain or steward, or whatever he was, stared at me, and said in +a low voice, “It is true then?” +</p> + +<p> +“True as I am Radbard Grimsson, who helped Havelok to fly from hence.” +</p> + +<p> +“Unwelcome will you be, for Hodulf is in no good mood,” the man said. “I hardly +think it safe for you to trust yourself with him.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said I, “open the door of the hall, and I will go in with my men, and +see what he says.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, that will be bad for me, but I have a mind to see Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +So I told Withelm to come at my side, and bade half the courtmen follow us +closely, and when they were inside to see that the door was not barred after us +on any pretence. The rest would bide with the horses outside. +</p> + +<p> +Then we loosed the peace strings of our weapons, and in we went, quietly and in +order; and the chiefs turned to look at us, thinking us more of themselves. +Hodulf sat on his place on the dais, and there were thirty-one others with him, +sitting on the benches that were set along the walls. Withelm counted them. +</p> + +<p> +Then the door was closed, and the man with whom I had spoken set his back +against it, but it was not barred; and I went forward to the steps of the high +place, and stood before Hodulf. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, what now?” he said, seeing that I was a stranger. +</p> + +<p> +“First of all, I ask for safe conduct from this hall as a messenger from king +to king.” +</p> + +<p> +“That you have, of course,” he answered. “What is your message?” +</p> + +<p> +It did not seem that he thought of Havelok at all, but rather that I came from +some king to whom he had sent. There were two living not so far off. I thought +that there was no good in beating about the bush, for such an errand as mine +had better he told boldly. So I spoke out for all to hear. +</p> + +<p> +“This is the word of Havelok, son of Gunnar the king, to Hodulf of Norway, who +sits in his place. Home he has come to take his own, and now he would tell you +that the time has come that he is able to rule the kingdom for himself.” +</p> + +<p> +“And what if he has?” said Hodulf, without the least change of face, as if he +had been expecting this, and nothing more or less. +</p> + +<p> +But if he was quiet, the chiefs had heard my words in a very different way. +Some had leaped up, and others bent forward, to hear the answer to my words the +better. I heard one or two laugh; but there were some on whose faces seemed to +be written doubt and anxiety. I think that some would have spoken, for Hodulf +held up his hand for silence, and looked to me for answer. +</p> + +<p> +“It will be well for you to give up the throne to him, making such terms as you +may,” I said. +</p> + +<p> +“That is a fair offer,” said Hodulf, quite unmoved, to all seeming, but looking +at me in a way that told me how his anger was held back by main force, as it +were; “but how am I to know that this one who sends so bold a message is the +real Havelok? I am not a fool that I should give up my throne to the first who +asks it. Doubtless you bring some token that you come from the very son of +Gunnar.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is right that you should ask one, and also that you should have one that +there can be no mistaking,” I said. “This is it. By the token of the sack and +the anchor I bid you know that Havelok sends me to you.” +</p> + +<p> +At that the face of Hodulf became ashy grey beneath the tan of wind and sea, +and I saw that his hand clutched the hilt of his sword so that the knuckles of +his fingers grew white. He had never thought to hear of that deed again, and he +knew that he had to deal with the one whom he had thought dead. Some of the +young chiefs in the hall laughed at that token, but he flashed a glance at them +which stayed the laugh on their lips. +</p> + +<p> +“I know not what you mean,” he said, altogether staggered. +</p> + +<p> +“It is right,” I said, “that if the token is not plain I should make it so. It +is but fair also to the chiefs who are here.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he stayed me. True it is that old sin makes new shame. +</p> + +<p> +“I will take it as enough,” he said hastily. “I mind some old saying of the +kind. Ay, that is it—a hidden king and a voyage across the sea. It is enough.” +</p> + +<p> +“Not enough,” said a chief in the hall close to the high seat. “Let this +warrior say what he means plainly.” +</p> + +<p> +There were many who agreed to this, and I did not wait for Hodulf any longer. I +told them who I was, and then showed them why that token was to be held enough +for any man; and as I spoke, there were black looks toward the high seat among +the older men. As for Hodulf, he sat with a forced smile, and seemed to listen +indulgently, as to a well-made tale. +</p> + +<p> +And after that the matter was out of my hands, for the same chief who had asked +for the tale came and stood by my side, and he faced Hodulf and spoke. +</p> + +<p> +“For twelve years have I served you as king, and now I know that I have wasted +the faith I gave you. What became of the sisters of Havelok? Answer me that, +Hodulf, or I will go and ask their brother concerning whom you have lied to +me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Go and ask him,” answered Hodulf, biting his lips; “go and hear more lies. Who +can know the son of Gunnar when he sees him?” +</p> + +<p> +“That is answered out of your own mouth,” said the chief. “Is Sigurd a fool +that he should hail the first man who asks him to do so?” +</p> + +<p> +And from beside me Withelm answered also, “Maybe it is a pity that Griffin of +Wales was slain last night in trying to kill Havelok. He knew him, and I have +heard that he came here to warn Hodulf that his time was come.” +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf’s face grew whiter when he heard that; but it was what he needed, as +some sort of excuse to let loose his passion. +</p> + +<p> +White and shaking with wrath and fear, he rose up and he cried, “Murdered is +Griffin! Ho, warriors, let not these go forth!” +</p> + +<p> +Whereon the old chief lifted his voice also, “Ho, Gunnar’s men! Ho, men who +love the old line! To Grim’s son, ahoy!” +</p> + +<p> +And he drew his sword, snapping the thongs that had bound it to the sheath, so +manfully tugged he at them in his wrath, and there was a rush of men to us, and +another to Hodulf. +</p> + +<p> +Now I think that we might have slain him there, and after that have been slain +ourselves, for the odds were against us, even though I had the courtmen; but +that was Havelok’s deed to do, for the sake of father and sisters to be +avenged, and so we only cut our way out of the hall to the door, which my men +threw open at once. There were two of Hodulf’s men hurt only, for the most of +them had run to the high place, and few were between us and our going. So we +took five chiefs and their followers back with us, and that was worth the +errand. +</p> + +<p> +We thought that it would not be long now before Hodulf was on us; but the days +passed, and there was no news of him, and all the while we grew stronger. I do +not know if the same could be said of him, and it is doubtful if time made much +difference to his forces. Those who followed him were the men who owed all to +him, either as men raised to some sort of power when he first came, or else +strangers whom he had brought in with him. Some of the younger chiefs of the +old families held by him also, for they had known no other, and then there were +old feuds with Gunnar that held back some from us; but these few took part with +neither side. +</p> + +<p> +So before a week was out we had a matter of six thousand men in and about the +town; and it seemed that, with so good a force, it was as well to march on +Hodulf as to wait for him. And that was good hearing for us all, for there was +not a man who did not long to be up and doing, though to smite a blow for +Havelok should be the last deed that he might do. +</p> + +<p> +They made me captain of the courtmen who were Havelok’s own, maybe because I +had served with Alsi, and Withelm was captain of Goldberga’s own guard. High +honour was that for the sons of Grim, for there was not one in either of these +companies but was of high birth; but then we were Havelok’s brothers, and all +seemed well content to serve under us. I wanted Raven to be in my place, but he +said that he was no warrior on shore. +</p> + +<p> +“Just now I am Havelok’s watchdog, to be at his heels always. Presently, if he +likes to give me a ship when we sail to England, that will suit me.” +</p> + +<p> +So Havelok made him his standard bearer; and as that would keep him at the +king’s side in the thickest fight, he was well pleased. Goldberga wrought the +standard that he bore, with the help of Sigurd’s wife, and on it was the figure +of Grim, sword and shield in hand, but with his helm at his feet, as showing +that he had laid it by; and on either side of him stood Havelok and his wife, +each with a crown above their heads, as though they waited for the coming time +when they should be set there firmly by the bearing forward of this banner. +Havelok bore his axe, holding out the ring to Goldberga with the other hand, +while she had her sceptre in the left, and stretched the right hand to her +husband. There were runes that told the names of these three, for that is +needful in such work, as it passes the skill of woman to make a good likeness, +nor do I think it would be lucky to do so if it could be compassed. Wondrous +was the banner with gold and bright colours, and it was hung from a gilded +spear, ashen hafted, and long, that it might be seen afar in battle. +</p> + +<p> +Now on the day when Havelok set his men in order for the march on Hodulf word +came that he was coming at last. It is likely that he knew we were on the point +of marching, and would choose his own ground on which to wait for us. So we +went to certain battle, as it seemed, and none were sorry for that. So in the +bright sunshine of a cloudless morning Havelok and Goldberga rode down the line +of the men, who would fight to the death for them, and those two were good to +look on. Day and night Sigurd’s weapon smiths had wrought to make a mail shirt +that should be worthy of a king, and I thought that they had wrought well. They +had set a crown round the helm that they made for him, and Sigurd had given him +a sword that had been his father’s at one time, golden hilted, and with runes +on its blue blade. But Havelok would not part with the axe that Grim had given +him, plain as it was, and that was his chosen weapon. +</p> + +<p> +But for once I think that men looked more at her who rode at Havelok’s side +than at him, goodly and kingly as he was in the war gear. For Goldberga had on +a silver coat of chain mail, and a little gold circlet was round the silver +helm that she wore, while at her saddle bow was an axe, on which were runes +written in gold, and a sword light enough for her hand was in a gem-studded +baldric from her shoulder. There was a chief who had given her these, and it +was said that they had first of all belonged to one who had fought as a shield +maiden at the great battle of Dunheidi, by the side of Hervoer, the sister of +the mighty hero Angantyr. His forefather had won them at that time, and now +they were worn by one who was surely like the Valkyries, for no fairer or more +wondrous to look on in war gear could they be than our English queen. +</p> + +<p> +She would have gone even into the battle with Havelok, but that neither he nor +we would suffer. She was to bide here in the town until we came back in triumph +or defeat; and as men looked on her, they grew strong, that no tears might be +for those bright eyes. +</p> + +<p> +Now I left them before the march began, for I and the courtmen were to go +forward and see where the foe was posted, and so bring word again. And we went +some five miles before we saw the first sign of them. Then on a rise in the +wild heath waited a few horsemen, who watched us for a little while, and then +rode away from us and beyond it. We followed them, and when we came to where +they had been, we saw that they had fallen back on a company of about the same +strength as ours, save that there were more horsemen. I was the only mounted +man of my little force, and that rather to save my strength than because I +liked riding. I should certainly fight on foot, as would Havelok himself, in +the old way. It is not good to trust to the four feet of a horse when one means +business. +</p> + +<p> +We bided where we were, waiting to see what these men did, and soon beyond them +grew the long cloud of dust starred with shifting sparks that told us that the +host of Hodulf was on foot and advancing. It seemed to me that here we had a +good place to meet it, for the land went down in a long slope that was in our +favour, and therefore I set a man on my horse, and sent him back with all speed +to Havelok to bid him hasten. Our host was not so far behind me, and I could +see both from this hill. We had full time to take position here before Hodulf’s +army was in reach. +</p> + +<p> +Now it seemed that the foemen would see what they could also, and they began to +move toward us. It was plain that we should have a small fight on our own +account directly, for I did not mean to let them take our place. We moved, +therefore, toward them, and at that the half-dozen horsemen made for us at a +trot. Then I saw that their leader was Hodulf himself. +</p> + +<p> +We were in a track that led across the hill, and here on the slope it was worn +deep with ages of traffic between the two towns, and on either side the heather +grew thick and high, so that the horsemen could not get round us. So Hodulf +rode forward to where we barred the way, and told me to stand aside. +</p> + +<p> +“What next?” I asked. “I may as well bid you go back, for I came here to stop +you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Come over to me, and leave this half-crowned kinglet of yours. It shall be +worth your while.” +</p> + +<p> +“Hard up for men must you be, Hodulf,” said one of my courtmen, laughing. +</p> + +<p> +At that he made a sign to his followers, for they came on us at the gallop, +with levelled spears. We closed up, and hewed the spear points off, and then +dealt with the horses and men who foundered among us, and they struggled back, +leaving three men and four horses in the roadway. It was bravely done, too, for +there were only eight of them, and they did us no harm beyond a bruise or two. +I wished that we had taken or slain Hodulf, however, for that might have made +things easier in the end. +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf got back to his courtmen, and now they came on. At that moment over the +hill behind us rode Havelok and Raven, and saw at once what was on hand. They +had ridden on, but the host was hard after them. +</p> + +<p> +“Send a man to bid the host halt,” Havelok said to me, “for we can end the +matter here. Now shall I be hand to hand with Hodulf, even as I would wish.” +</p> + +<p> +I sent a man back as he bade me, and he stayed the host half a mile beyond the +hill, where they were not seen. Hodulf’s army was yet two miles away across the +heath, and none had gone back to hasten it. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok went forward, holding up his hand in token of parley, and his enemy +rode from his men to meet him. +</p> + +<p> +“There is much between us, Hodulf,” Havelok said, “and we have been together +along this road before. Yet for the sake of the men who follow us it may be +that we can make peace.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is for me to say,” answered Hodulf, “for you have invaded my land, and +are the peace breaker.” +</p> + +<p> +“I might mind you of a blood feud between us two,” said Havelok, “but that is +not the business of the host. For the sake of the land I will say this. Give up +the throne that you have held for me, and you shall go hence with what treasure +you have gathered, taking your Norsemen with you. There will be no shame in +doing that, for I am able now to hold the land for myself.” +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf laughed a short laugh. +</p> + +<p> +“Fine talk that for the son of Grim the thrall, who drowned Havelok for me! +‘Nidring’ should I be if I gave up to you.” +</p> + +<p> +“If things must go in that way, we will settle the matter here and now. Will +you that we fight hand to hand while our men look on, or shall we go back to +them and charge? I like the first plan best myself, as I would avenge my father +and sisters, and also that insult of the way in which we passed this road +together twelve years ago.” +</p> + +<p> +So said Havelok, and his words fell like ice from his lips, and he was very +still as he spoke, though the red flush crept into his cheek and his brows +lowered. +</p> + +<p> +And Hodulf did not answer at once. He looked at the towering young warrior +before him, and maybe into his mind there crept the thought of the children +whom he had slain, whom this one would avenge. Well he knew that the true +Havelok was speaking with him, though he would not own it, and branded my +father with the name of thrall for the sake of insult to his foster son. +</p> + +<p> +At last he said, “We will go back to the men, for you have advantage in that +bulk of yours.” +</p> + +<p> +“As you will,” answered Havelok. “Twelve years ago that was on your side.” +</p> + +<p> +He reined round at once, and touched his horse with the spur without another +glance at his enemy. And then we shouted, and Raven spurred forward with a +great oath, for Hodulf plucked his sword from the scabbard, and with a new +treachery in his heart, rode after our brother and was almost on him. The shout +was just in time, for Havelok turned in his saddle as the blow was falling. +</p> + +<p> +Quick as light, he took it on the shaft of the spear he carried, and turned it, +wheeling his horse short round at the same time. Lindsey training was there in +that horsemanship of his. Hodulf’s horse shot past as the blow failed, and then +Raven seemed to be the next man to be dealt with. +</p> + +<p> +But Havelok called to him to stand aside, for this was his own fight; and at +that Hodulf had his horse in hand again, and was ready to meet his foe fairly. +</p> + +<p> +And now Havelok had cast aside the spear, and taken the axe from the saddle +bow; and these two met, unshielded, for neither had time to unsling the round +buckler from his shoulder. +</p> + +<p> +It was no long fight, for now Hodulf’s men were coming up, and there need be no +more thought of aught but ending one who was ready to smite a foul blow before +us all shamelessly. Havelok spurred his horse, and the two met and closed for +one moment. Then down went the Norseman with cleft helm, and the old wrongs +were avenged, and there was but one king in the land. +</p> + +<p> +Then Hodulf’s men were on Havelok, but not before Raven was at his back, and +over Hodulf there was a struggle in which Havelok was in peril for a short time +before we closed round him. Well fought the courtmen of the fallen king, and +well fought my men, and we bore them back, fighting every foot of ground, until +there were only five of them left, and these five yielded in all honour, being +outnumbered. Yet ours was a smaller band by half ere there was an end. +</p> + +<p> +It had not lasted long, and still the host of Hodulf was so far off that they +knew not so much as that there was any fighting. Then we went to the hilltop, +and set the banner there, and our line came on and halted along the crest. +</p> + +<p> +One hardly need say what wonder and rejoicing there was when it was known how +Hodulf had met his end, and Sigurd and other chiefs went to where we had +fought, and looked on him. And one took the helm, which had round it the stolen +crown, and gave it to Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Set it on the standard,” he said, “for we may need that it shall be shown +presently. As for Hodulf, bear him aside out of the path of the host, that we +may lay him in mound when all is ended.” +</p> + +<p> +One cried that he did not deserve honour of any kind, and there were some who +agreed to that openly. I will not say that I was not one of them, for I had +seen the foul play, and heard the insult to Grim, my father. +</p> + +<p> +But Havelok answered gravely, “He has been a king, and I have not heard that he +was altogether a bad one. All else was between him and me, and that is paid for +by his death. Think only of the twelve years in which you have owned him as +lord, and then you will know that it is right that he should be given the last +honours. You had no feud as had I.” +</p> + +<p> +Then they did as he bade them, and that gladly, for the words were king-like, +and of good omen for the days to come. I saw Sigurd and the older chiefs glance +at each other, and it was plain that they were well pleased. +</p> + +<p> +Now the host came on, and it was greater than ours; but when there was no sign +of its leader the march wavered, and at last halted altogether. Whereon some +chiefs rode to speak to us, and Havelok met them with his leaders. He had to +speak first, for they could not well ask where Hodulf was. The helm was a token +that told them much. +</p> + +<p> +“I met your king even now,” he said, “and I offered him peace and honourable +return to Norway with his property if he would give up the throne that is mine +by right. Maybe I was wrong in thinking that he might do so, but he refused. +There were certain matters between us two, besides that of the crown, which +needed settling; and therefore, after that, I challenged him to fight on these +points, that being needful before they were done with. So we fought, and our +feud was ended. Hodulf is dead, and his courtmen would not live after him while +there was a chance of avenging his fall. That was before the host came up. Now +I offer peace and friendship to all, and I can blame none who have held to the +king who has fallen. It was not to be expected that all would own me at once. +Only those Norsemen who came with Hodulf or have come hither since must leave +the land, and they shall go in honour, taking their goods with them. Their time +is up; that is all.” +</p> + +<p> +It was a long speech for Havelok, but in it was all that could be said. Long +and closely did the chiefs look at him as he spoke, for none of them had seen +him before. His words were not idly to be set aside either, and they spoke +together in a low voice when he had ended. +</p> + +<p> +“This is a matter for the whole host to settle,” one said at last. “We will +speak to them, and give you an answer shortly.” +</p> + +<p> +“Take one of Hodulf’s courtmen with you, that he may tell all of the fight,” +Havelok said: “he need not come back.” +</p> + +<p> +I gave the man his arms again, for he might as well have them if he stayed. +</p> + +<p> +“Thanks, lord,” he said. “Here is one who will tell the truth for Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +Then our host sat down, and we watched the foemen as the news came to them. We +could not hear, of course, for they were a quarter of a mile away, but if any +tumult rose we should be warned in time. They were very still, however. There +was a long talk, and then one chief came back to us. +</p> + +<p> +“I am going to ask a strange thing,” he said, “but the men wish to see Havelok +face to face.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Sigurd said that this was too great a risk, and even Withelm agreed with +him. +</p> + +<p> +But Havelok answered, “The men are my own men, but they are not sure that I am +the right king. It is plain that I am like my father, and therefore it is safe +for me to go.” +</p> + +<p> +“That,” said the chief, “is what we told them, and what they wish to see.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said Havelok, “I will come. Bid your men sit down, and bid the horsemen +dismount, and I will ride to them with five others. Then can be no fear on +either side.” +</p> + +<p> +“That will do well,” said Sigurd; and the chief went back, and at once the host +sat down. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok rode to them, and with him went we three and Sigurd and Biorn. +</p> + +<p> +There was a murmur of wonder as he came, and it grew louder as he unhelmed and +stayed before them. +</p> + +<p> +And then one shouted, “Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson!” and at once the shout was +taken up along the line. And that shout grew until the chiefs joined in it, for +it was the voice of the host, which cannot be gainsaid; and without more delay, +one by one the leaders pressed forward and knelt on one knee to their king, and +did homage to him. Only the Norsemen held back; and presently, when we were +talking to the Danish chiefs in all friendly wise, they drew apart with their +men, and formed up into a close-ranked body that looked dangerous. +</p> + +<p> +“Surely they do not mean to fight!” said Withelm. +</p> + +<p> +Then one of them shouted that he must speak to the king, and that seemed as if +they owned him at least, so Havelok went to them. +</p> + +<p> +“You have heard my terms,” he said, “and I think that they are all that you +could ask. What is amiss?” +</p> + +<p> +“Your terms are good enough,” the speaker said, “and we know that our time is +come. But we must have surety that the people will not fall on us, for we are +flying, as it were. And we want the body of our king. We would not have him +buried any wise, as if he was a thrall.” +</p> + +<p> +“He shall be given to you, and as for the rest none shall harm you. Moreover, +for that saying about your king I will add this: that if there are any of you +who hold lands to which there is no Danish heir, he shall take service with me +if he will, and so keep them.” +</p> + +<p> +So there was no man in all the host who was not content; and that was the +second king-making of Havelok, as it were, for now there was no man against +him. The hosts were disbanded then and there, and we went that day to Hodulf’s +town, and took possession of all that had been in his hands. Then was rejoicing +over all the land, for a king of the old line was on the throne once more, and +his way was full of promise. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap22">CHAPTER XXII.<br/> +KING ALSI’S WELCOME.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now there was one thing that was in the minds of all of us, and that was the +winning of Goldberga’s kingdom for her; but that was a matter which was not to +be thought of yet for a long while. Two years were we in Denmark, and well +loved was Havelok by all, whether one speaks of the other kings who owned him +as Gunnar’s heir at once, or the people over whom he and Goldberga reigned. But +we sent messages to Arngeir and to Ragnar to say that all was well, and we +heard from them in time how Alsi feared what was to come, and had rather make +friends with the Anglians than offend them. So he had not given out anything +that was against the princess, but had told all how she had wedded the heir of +Denmark, and that she had given up her land to himself, and followed her +husband across the sea. It was not hard for him to feign gladness in her +well-doing; and Berthun counselled Ragnar to let things be thus, and yet +prepare for her return. +</p> + +<p> +In my own heart was the wish to go back to England always, for there was my +home; and I found that it was the same with my brothers, for there is that in +the English land which makes all who touch it love it. And there was the mound +that held my father, and there were the folk among whom we had been brought up +in the town that we had made; and I longed to see once more the green marshes +and the grey wolds of Lindsey, and the brown waves of the wide Humber rolling +shorewards, line after line. I tired of the heaths and forests and peat mosses +of this land of my birth. And if that was so to me, it was a yet deeper longing +in the hearts of the brothers who hardly remembered this place; and after a +while we spoke of it more often. +</p> + +<p> +I do not know if we said much to others, but at last the younger chiefs began +to wonder when the promised time when they should cross the “swan’s path” for +Goldberga should come. Maybe they tired of the long peace, as a Dane will. But +when that talk began, Withelm knew that things were ripe, and he told Havelok. +That was in the third spring of Havelok’s kingship, when it grew near to the +time when men fit out their ships. +</p> + +<p> +“This is what I have looked for,” he said; “and now we will delay no longer, +for here am I king indeed, and there is none who will rise against me. +Wonderful it is that men have hailed me thus. And now I will tell you, brother, +that I long for England. If I might take my friends with me, I do not think +that I should care if I never came here again. It is not my home; and here my +Goldberga is not altogether happy, well as the folk love her.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereafter he called a great Thing<a href="#fn12" +name="fnref12"><sup>[12]</sup></a> of all the freemen in the land, and set the +matter plainly before them, asking if they minded the words he spoke when they +crowned the queen, and if they were still ready to follow him to the winning of +her crown beyond the sea. +</p> + +<p> +There was no doubt what the answer would be; and it was said at once that the +sooner the ships were got ready the better. +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said Havelok, “who shall mind this land while I am away? It may be long +ere I come back.” +</p> + +<p> +Now there was a cry that I should be king while Havelok was away, forsooth! and +a poor hand I should have made at the business. But I said that it was +foolishness, and that, moreover, I would go with Havelok. And when they said +that this was modesty on my part, I answered that I had seen several kings, and +that there was but one who was worth thinking of, and that was my brother; +therefore, I would go on serving him where I could see him. +</p> + +<p> +“This is what Grim, my father, said to me long ago,” I said—“I was to mind the +old saying, ‘Bare is back without brother behind it;’ and, therefore, I must +see Havelok safe through this.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, brother,” says Havelok, laughing, “if that saying must be remembered—and +I at least know it is true—it would make for leaving you behind me here to see +all fair when my back was turned.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he saw that I was grieved, for I thought for the moment that he would bid +me to stay, and so I should have to do so; but he took my part. +</p> + +<p> +“I cannot be without my brothers,” he said. “If I had any word in the +matter—which mainly concerns the folk to be ruled, as it seems to me (for I do +not know of any man who would not uphold me)—I should say that Sigurd the jarl +was the right man, for all know that he is a good ruler, nor will it be any new +thing to submit to him.” +</p> + +<p> +That pleased all, and the end of it was that Sigurd was chosen to hold the land +for Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +Then Sigurd sat on the steps of the high place at Havelok’s feet, and the king +said, “I have no need to tell any man here who this is, and why I think him +worthy of the highest honour, for all know him and his worth as well as I. +Mainly by him was the thought of my return kept in the minds of men, so that +when the time came all were ready to hail me, as you have done. Therefore, as +by him I am king, so I make him king also for me. He shall rule all the land +while I am away, and to him shall all men account as to me. And because it is +right that his kingship should be certain, I give him all his jarldom as a +kingdom from henceforth, only subject to me and my heirs as overlord. King +therefore he is, and none can say that you are ruled by naught but a jarl.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok girt on the new king’s sword, and set his own crowned helm on his +head for a moment; and all the Thing hailed him gladly, for he was the right +man without doubt. +</p> + +<p> +Then Sigurd did homage for his new honour; and after that he rose up, and grew +red and uneasy, as if there was somewhat that he wished to say, and was half +afraid to do so. +</p> + +<p> +Thereat some friend in the hall said, “You take your kingship worse than did +Radbard himself, as it seems. What is amiss?” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, I wanted to go on the Viking path with Havelok, and now it seems that I +cannot.” +</p> + +<p> +Then one shouted, “I never heard of a land going wrong while its king was away +risking his life to get property for his men. There is no man here who is going +to rise against either you or Havelok. And it is only to send a message to our +great overlord to say what we are about, and he will see that the land is in +peace. Nor do I think that any king would harry Havelok’s land, for he is well +loved by all his peers.” +</p> + +<p> +Wherefore it seemed that Sigurd must go also, and we had to set Biorn as head +man while Sigurd was away; but that would only be for a month or two. So all +things were ordered well, and in a month we set sail with twenty ships, and in +them a matter of fifteen hundred men. +</p> + +<p> +At first we thought that we would make for Grimsby; but then it seemed best to +land elsewhere, and more to the south, for we would have messages sent at once +to Ragnar to call East Anglia to Havelok’s banner, and Alsi would have less +chance of cutting us off from him. So we sailed to Saltfleet haven, which lies +some twenty-five miles southward from Grimsby. Raven piloted us in safely, and +there were none to hinder our landing. The town was empty, indeed, when the +ships came into the haven, for all had fled in haste, except a few thralls, for +fear of the Vikings. +</p> + +<p> +Yet when we sent these thralls to say that Goldberga had come for her own, the +people came back and made us welcome, for her story was in every mouth; and +after that we fared well in Saltfleet, and men began to gather to us. +</p> + +<p> +We sent to Arngeir and to Ragnar at once, and next day the Grimsby folk were +with us, but long before any word could come to Norwich, Alsi had set about +gathering a host against us. +</p> + +<p> +But we had not come to fight him for Lindsey, and our errand was to bid him +give up her own rights to Goldberga. One must be ready with the strong hand if +one expects to find justice from such a man; and Havelok had thought it +possible that if we came here first we should bring him to reason at once, +whereas if we went to Norfolk there would be fighting with all the host of the +Lindsey kingdom before long; while if he did fight here we might save +Goldberga’s land from that trouble, and maybe have fewer to deal with. +</p> + +<p> +So a message was to be sent to Alsi at once, bidding him know that Goldberga +had come to ask for her rights, and that he might give them to her in all +honour. Arngeir was to take this, for it did not seem right that a Dane should +do so, and he was one who would be listened to. I was to go with him, with my +courtmen as guard; and we rode to Lincoln on the fourth day after our coming to +Saltfleet. Good it was to ride over the old land again, and I thought that it +had never looked more fair with the ripening harvest, for when last I had seen +it there was none. The track of the famine was yet on all the villages, for +fewer folk were in them than in the days before the pestilence and the dearth, +but these had enough and to spare. +</p> + +<p> +And when these poor folk heard from us that Curan and his princess had come +again for what was hers, they took rusty weapons and flint-tipped arrows and +stone hammers from the hiding places in the thatch of their hovels, and went +across the marshlands to where the little hill of Saltfleet stands above its +haven, that they might help the one whom they had loved as a fisher lad to +become a mighty king. +</p> + +<p> +So we came to Lincoln, and already there was a gathering of thanes and their +men in the town, and they knew on what errand we had come well enough. But they +were courteous, and we were given quarters in the town at once, that we might +see Alsi with the first light in the morning. +</p> + +<p> +I will not say that we had a quiet night there, for we did not trust Alsi; but +we had no need to fear. In the morning Eglaf came to bid us to the palace to +speak with the king. +</p> + +<p> +“This is about what I expected, when I heard of the mistake that our king had +made,” he said, “and so far you are in luck. It is not everyone who is a fisher +one day and captain of the courtmen next, as one might say. I like the look of +your men, and I am going to take some of the credit of that to myself, for a +man has to learn before he can command.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will not deny your share in the matter,” I answered, laughing, “for had it +not been for my time with you I had been at sea altogether. Now, shall we have +to fight you?” +</p> + +<p> +He shrugged his broad shoulders. +</p> + +<p> +“Who knows what is in the mind of our king? I do not, and you know enough of +him by this time to be certain that one cannot guess. He may be all smiles and +rejoicing that his dear niece has come back safely, or just the other way. He +has been very careful how he has dealt with the Norfolk thanes of late, and +what that means I do not know.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he asked what had become of Griffin, and I told him. I do not think that +he was surprised, for some word of the matter had reached here by the news that +chapmen bring from all parts. +</p> + +<p> +Now there was no more time for talk, for we came to the hall; and we went in, +Arngeir leading, and the rest of us following two by two. The hall was pretty +full of thanes and their men, and it was just as I had last seen it. Alsi sat +alone on his high seat, and there was no man with him on the dais. I thought +that he looked thinner and anxious. +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir went up the hall at once, and stood before the king, and greeted him in +the English way, which seemed strange to me after the two years of Danish +customs; and then Alsi bade him tell his errand. +</p> + +<p> +“I have come from Goldberga of East Anglia, and from Havelok the Dane, her +husband, to say that she has returned to her land, and would ask that you would +give her the throne that you have held for her since the day that her father +made you her guardian. It has been said that she might ask you to give account +of your management of the realm to her; but that she does not wish to do, being +sure that all will be rightly done in the matter, and she only asks to be set +in the place that was her father’s.” +</p> + +<p> +So said Arngeir, plainly, and I could see that the thanes thought the words +good. +</p> + +<p> +And Alsi answered, “Has this matter been put before the Witan of the East +Angles?” +</p> + +<p> +I suppose that he thought to hear Arngeir say that there had been no time for +so doing at present, but my brother was readier than I should have been. +</p> + +<p> +“Doubtless it has,” he said, “for that was your own promise to Goldberga on her +marriage.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Alsi flushed, and his brows wrinkled. He had said nothing to the Witan +at all, but had waited in hopes that he should hear no more of his niece, +telling the tale that we had heard. +</p> + +<p> +“I have had no answer from them,” he said at last, for Arngeir was looking at +him in a way that he could not meet. “It was her saying that she would do this +for herself.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then they do not refuse,” said Arngeir quietly, “nor did I think that they +would do so. It only remains therefore, that you, King Alsi, should do your +part. Then can the queen speak to the Witan, even as she said, concerning her +husband.” +</p> + +<p> +Now it must have been clear to the king that nothing short of a plain answer +would be taken, and he sat and thought for a while. One could see that he was +planning what to say, as if things had not gone as he expected. Maybe he hoped +to put off the matter by talk of asking the Witan, and so to gain time, for we +had certainly taken him unawares. +</p> + +<p> +At last he said, “How am I to know that you are here with full power to speak +for Goldberga? For this is a weighty matter.” +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir held out his hand, and on it was the ring of Orwenna the queen, which +Alsi had last seen here on the high place. +</p> + +<p> +“There is the token, King Alsi, and it is one which you know well,” he +answered. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, I know it,” answered the king with a grin that was not pleasant. +</p> + +<p> +And then he said, “I will speak with my thanes, and give you word to carry back +in an hour’s time, now that I know you to be a true messenger.” +</p> + +<p> +“There should be no reason for waiting so long as that, nor do I think that the +matter of the throne of East Anglia is a question for Lindsey thanes,” answered +Arngeir at once. “All this is between you and the princess.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat one of the thanes rose up and said, “If a kingdom has been handed over +to our king, it is not to be taken again without our having a good deal to say +about it. I do not know, moreover, if we can have a foreigner over any part of +our land.” +</p> + +<p> +“Goldberga never gave up her right to the kingdom,” Arngeir answered, “as +anyone who was here at the wedding would tell you. And as for Havelok, her +husband, being a foreigner, it seems to me that a Jute who has been brought up +here in Lindsey since he was seven winters old is less a foreigner than a +Briton is to us.” +</p> + +<p> +None made any answer to that, and I could see that the king was growing angry +at being met thus at every turn. But he began to smile in that way of his that +I had learned to mistrust. +</p> + +<p> +“That is not altogether courteous to either Goldberga or myself,” he said, as +if he would think the words a jest, seeing that he was half Welsh. “Give me +time, I pray you, to think of this, as I have asked, and you shall go back with +your answer.” +</p> + +<p> +There was no help for it, and we had to leave the hall in order that Alsi might +say what he had to say to his thanes. And I said to Arngeir that it seemed that +we should have to fight the matter out. +</p> + +<p> +“Alsi risks losing both kingdoms if he does that,” he answered, “for we shall +take what we choose if we are the victors. The visions that have been thus +right so far say that we shall be so.” +</p> + +<p> +“I shall be glad if we do come out on the right side,” I said; “but I have not +so much faith in these dream tellings as some. Nor do I think that it seems +altogether fair to fight on a certainty.” +</p> + +<p> +“When it is a matter of punishing one who does not keep faith, I do not think +that it matters much,” he answered, laughing. “I should like certainty that he +would not get the best of the honest side in that case.” +</p> + +<p> +We were outside on the wide green within the square of the Roman walls at this +time, and now from within the hall came the sound of shouts and cheering which +we heard plainly enough. But whether it meant that the thanes cheered Alsi +because he would fight, rather than that they applauded his justice to his +niece, was not to be known as yet. As for me, I thought that it was hardly +likely to be the latter. +</p> + +<p> +Then came three thanes from the hail with the message, and it was this, “Alsi +bids Havelok go back to his own land and bide content therewith.” +</p> + +<p> +“What word is there for Goldberga, then?” asked Arngeir. +</p> + +<p> +“None. She has thrown in her lot with the Dane, and it is he with whom we will +not deal.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said I, “How was it that she had to throw in her lot with Havelok? He was +Alsi’s own choice for her.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is not what we have heard,” the spokesman answered. “Now it is best that +you go hence, for you have the answer.” +</p> + +<p> +“This means fighting for Goldberga’s rights,” said Arngeir, “and I will tell +you that Havelok will not be backward in the matter.” +</p> + +<p> +“In that case we shall meet again on the battlefield ere long,” answered the +thane. “I will not say that Havelok is in the wrong, and things might have been +better settled. Farewell till then. The Norns will show who is right.” +</p> + +<p> +So we went, and I thought, as did Arngeir, that there was some little feeling +among his men that Alsi was wrong. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi set to work to gather forces in earnest, and he went to work in a way +that was all his own: for, saying nothing about Goldberga, he sent to all his +thanes with word that the Vikings had come in force and invaded the land, led +by the son of Gunnar Kirkeban, whose ways were worse than those of his father, +for he spared none, whereas Kirkeban harried but the Welsh Christian folk. He +prayed them therefore to hasten, that this scourge might be driven back to the +sea whence he came. And that brought men to him fast, for no Englishman can +bear that an invader shall set foot on his shore, be he who he may. Few knew +who the wife of Havelok was at that time, but I do not know that it would have +made so much difference if they had. None thought that into England had come +the fair princess who was so well loved. +</p> + +<p> +Sorely troubled was Goldberga when she heard this answer, but it was all that +the rest of us looked for. And the next question was how best to meet the false +king. +</p> + +<p> +In the end we did a thing that may seem to some to have been rash altogether, +but it was our wish to compel Alsi to fight before his force was great enough +to crush us. It might be long before Ragnar could raise a host and join us, for +there was always a chance that he might have trouble in getting the Norfolk +thanes to come to his standard for a march on Lindsey. If we had gone to +Norfolk at once there would have been no fear of that kind, but the fighting +might have been more bitter and longer drawn out. +</p> + +<p> +We sent the fleet southward into the Wash, that it might wait for us at the +port of the Fossdyke, on what men call the Frieston shore; and then we left +Saltfleet and marched across country to the wolds, and southward and westward +along them, that we might draw Alsi from Lincoln. And all the way men joined us +for the sake of Curan, whom they knew, and of Goldberga, of whom they had +heard, so that in numbers at least our host was a great one. Ragged it might +be, as one may say, with the wild marshmen, who had no sort of training and no +chiefs to keep them in hand; but I knew that no host Alsi could get together +had any such trained force in it as we had in the fifteen hundred Vikings, for +they had seen many fights, and the ways of the sea teach men to hold together +and to obey orders at once and without hesitating. +</p> + +<p> +So we went until we came to Tetford, above Horncastle town; and there is a +great camp on a hilltop, made by the British, no doubt, in the days when they +fought with Rome. There we stayed, for Alsi was upon us. We saw the fires of +his camp in the village and on the hillsides across the valley, but a mile or +two from us that night; and it seemed that his host was greater than ours, as +we thought it would be, but not so much so as to cause dread of the battle that +was to come. +</p> + +<p> +Now there were two men who came to us that night, and we thought that they had +brought some message from Alsi at first. But all that they wanted was to join +Havelok, and we were glad of them. They were those two seconds of Griffin’s, +Cadwal and the other, whose name was Idrys, and with them was David the priest, +who had fled to us. +</p> + +<p> +“We know that Havelok is one who is worth fighting for,” they said, “for we +have proved it already. We are not Alsi’s men, and our fathers fought for his +mother’s Welsh kin against the English long ago. Let us fight for the rights of +Goldberga, at least.” +</p> + +<p> +Havelok welcomed them in all friendliness, though he asked them if they had no +grudge against him for the slaying of Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +“As to that,” they said, “after the duel we think that he deserved all that has +befallen him. We were ashamed to be his seconds.” +</p> + +<p> +Now these two took in hand to lead the marshmen, and set to work with them at +once, for they were ready to follow them as known thanes of the British. And +that was something gained. +</p> + +<p> +We slept on our arms that night, and all night long David woke and prayed for +our success, and I think that his prayers were not lost. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap23">CHAPTER XXIII.<br/> +BY TETFORD STREAM.</a></h2> + +<p> +In the early morning Alsi set his men in order in the valley, and seemed to +wait for us to come down to him, for it was of no use to try to take the strong +camp which sheltered us. And so, after council held, we did not keep him +waiting, but left the hill and marched on him. We had the camp to fall back on +if things went the wrong way, and beyond that the road to the sea and the ships +was open, with a chance of meeting Ragnar on the way, moreover. +</p> + +<p> +Very long and deep seemed the line as we neared it, and it was formed on the +banks of a stream that runs down the valley, so that we must cross the water to +attack. But the stream was shallow now with the August heat, and it was not +much sunk between its banks. +</p> + +<p> +When he saw that, Sigurd, who was a man of many fights, said that we had better +send the marshmen round to fall on the wings of the foe, while we went straight +for the centre of the line in the wedge formation that the Viking loves. For so +we should have no trouble in crossing the stream, and should cut the force +against us in two. +</p> + +<p> +So the two Welsh thanes led their wild levies out on either side of us Danes, +who were in the centre, and then we formed the wedge. Havelok himself would +have gone first of all at its point: but that we would not suffer, for if he +fell the battle was lost at its beginning. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” he said, “for we fight for Goldberga.” +</p> + +<p> +“And what would she say were we to set you foremost of us all?” asked Withelm. +“Little love were there to either of you in that. You are the heart of the +host, and one shields that although it gives strength to all the hands which +obey it.” +</p> + +<p> +So Withelm and Arngeir and I went foremost, and behind us came the courtmen, +and in the midst of their shield wall was Havelok, with Raven and the banner at +his side. After them, rank on rank and with close-locked shields, was such a +force as had not been seen in Lindsey for many a long day. Alsi’s men grew very +silent as they saw us come on, until we reached, through a storm of arrows that +could not stay us, the bank of the stream, and then they raised a war song that +roared and thundered among the hills as though the tide was coming up the +valley in one great wave. But we saved our breath until the first of us were on +the banks of the stream, and then I shouted, and with a great shout of “Ahoy!” +in answer, we charged through the stream and up the far bank, where Alsi’s +spearmen waited for us. +</p> + +<p> +They crowded together as they saw how narrow our front was, and there was a +hedge of steel before us three brothers; but the spear is not the weapon to use +if one would check the onrush of the Northman’s wedge, and shield and axe +between them dashed and hewed a way to the men who got to their swords too +late, and then we were in the midst of Alsi’s line, with the gap that we had +made widening behind us with each step that we took forward. +</p> + +<p> +Now it was sheer hewing at the mass who crowded on us; and I mind how we seemed +to fight in silence, although the battle cries were unceasing, and waxed ever +louder; for it was as when one walks by the shore and thinks not at all of the +noise of breakers that never ends. Now and then there was one shout that was +new, and it seemed to be the only voice. Most of all, the noise grew on the +wings where the savage Welsh fell on their masters and ancient foes in wild +tumult. +</p> + +<p> +We tried to cut our way to Alsi, for we could see him as he sat on his +horse—the only mounted man in all the hosts; but we could not reach him. And +presently the time came when we who were foremost must let fresh men take our +places. Sigurd stepped to my side, and Withelm fell back, and another took the +place of Arngeir, and then my turn came, and we went slowly from the front to +where the hollow centre of the wedge gave us rest. Only a few arrows fell there +now and then; but the time for using bows was past, seeing that we were hand to +hand with all the Lindsey host. And then I saw that Sigurd had done what we had +failed in, for he had reached the shield wall that was round the king himself. +And for a moment I was savage that the chance came to him so soon after I had +left the fighting line; but then I minded that Eglaf, my friend, would be +there, and I was glad that I need not cross swords with him after all. I had +thought of that happening before the fight began, but in the turmoil of hottest +struggle I had forgotten it. +</p> + +<p> +Now Sigurd was before the thick mass of the housecarls, and hand to hand with +them; and then he was among them, and he leapt at the bridle of Alsi’s horse +and grasped it. I saw the king’s sword flash down on his helm, and he reeled +under the stroke, but without letting go of the rein. Then the housecarls made +a rush, and bore back our men, and the horse reared suddenly. There was a wild +shout, and the war saddle was empty; and again our men surged forward, so that +I could not see what had happened. +</p> + +<p> +But now our Welshmen had been beaten back from the wings—not easily, but for +want of training—and they were forced back across the brook, and there held our +bank well, giving way no step further. The water kept them in an even front, +against their will, as it were; and Alsi’s men charged them in vain, knee deep +in the stream that ran red. But that let loose the men who had been held back +from us; and now we were overborne by numbers, and we began to go back. That +was the worst part of the whole fight, and the hardest hour of all the battle, +as may be supposed, for the wedge grew closer, as it was forced together by +sheer weight. None ever broke into it. +</p> + +<p> +Presently our rear was on the water’s edge, and it seemed likely that in +crossing there might be a breaking of the line; and when he saw that, Havelok +called to me, and he went to the front with the courtmen round him. It was good +to hear the cheers of our men as they saw the dancing banner above the fight, +and beneath it, in the bright sun, the gold-circled helm of their king. The +Lindseymen drew back a foot’s pace as they saw the giant who came on them, and +I heard some call that this was Curan of Grimsby, as if in wonder. Then we had +to fight hard, and Sigurd fell back past me, with a wound on his shoulder where +Alsi’s sword had glanced from the helm. No life had been left to Sigurd had a +better hand wielded the weapon; but he was not badly hurt. I could not see Alsi +anywhere, nor Eglaf. +</p> + +<p> +Steadily the numbers drove us back, though before Havelok was always a space +into which men hardly dared to come. The wedge was pushed away from us, and we +had to fall back with it, until we crossed the stream; and there Sigurd swung +the massed men into line, and then came the first pause in the fight. The two +hosts stood, with the narrow water between them, and glared on each other, +silent now. And then the bowmen began to get to work from either side, until +the arrows were all gone. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok called to the foe, and they were silent while he spoke to them. +</p> + +<p> +“Is Alsi yet alive?” he said; “for if not, I have no war with his men. If he +is, let me speak with him.” +</p> + +<p> +None answered for a while, and the men looked at each other as if they knew not +if the man they were fighting for lived or not. +</p> + +<p> +Then one came forward and said, “Alsi lives, and we have not done with you yet. +Get you back to your home beyond the sea!” +</p> + +<p> +And then they charged us again; but the water was a better front for us than it +had been for them, and across it they could not win. We drove them back once +and twice; and again came a time when both sides were wearied and must needs +rest. +</p> + +<p> +So it went on until night fell. We never stirred from that water’s edge, and +the stream was choked with valiant English and hardy Danes; and yet the attacks +came with the shout of “Out! out!” and the answer from us of “Havelok, ahoy!” +</p> + +<p> +At last one who seemed a great chief came and cried a truce, for night was +falling; and he said that if Havelok would claim no advantage therefrom, the +men of Lindsey would get back from the field, and leave it free for us to take +our fallen. +</p> + +<p> +“But I must have your word that with the end of that task you go back to the +place you now hold, that we may begin afresh, if it seems good to us, in the +morning.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Havelok, “That is well spoken, and I cannot but agree. Who are you, +however, for I must know that this is said with authority?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am the Earl of Chester,” he answered. “Alsi has set the leading of the host +in my hands, for he is hurt somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +“I did not think that Mercians would have troubled to fight to uphold Alsi of +Lindsey in his ways with his niece,” Havelok said. +</p> + +<p> +“What is that?” said the earl. “Hither came I for love of fighting, maybe, in +the first place; and next to drive out certain Vikings. I know naught of the +business of which you speak.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said I, “go and ask Eglaf, the captain of the housecarls, for he knows +all about it. We are no raiding Danes, but those who fight for Goldberga of +East Anglia.” +</p> + +<p> +At that a hum of voices went down the English line, and this earl bit his lip +in doubt. +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” he said, “that is Alsi’s affair, and I will speak to him. We have had a +good fight, and I will not say that either of us has the best of it. Shall it +be as I have said?” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay,” answered Havelok; and the earl drew off his men for half a mile, and in +the gathering dusk we crossed the brook, and went on our errand across the +field. It was not hard to find our men, for they lay in a great wedge as we had +fought. There had been no straggling from that array, and no break had been +made in its lines. Alsi had lost more than we, for his men had beaten against +that steel wall in vain, and the arms of the Northman are better than those of +any other nation. +</p> + +<p> +We took the wounded back to the camp, and there Goldberga and the wives of our +English thanes tended them; and as we gathered up the slain the Lindsey men +were among us at the same work, and we spoke to them as if naught was amiss +between us, nor any fight to begin again in the morning. And then we learned +how few knew what we had come for. It was with them as with the Earl of +Chester. They had no knowledge of Goldberga’s homecoming, and least of all +thought that at the back of the trouble were the wiles of Alsi. It was two +years ago that Goldberga had gone, and her wedding had seemed to end her story. +Now the men heard and wondered; and it is said that very many left Alsi that +night and went home, angry with him for his falsehood. +</p> + +<p> +Now when all was done we sought rest, and weary we were. I will say for myself +that I did not feel like fighting next morning at all, for I was tired out, and +the one or two wounds that I had were getting sorely stiff. Raven was much in +the same case, and grumbled, sailor-wise, at the weight of the banner and aught +else that came uppermost in his mind. Yet I knew that he would be the first to +go forward again when the time came. +</p> + +<p> +The host slept on their arms along the bank of the stream through the hot +night, and the banner was pitched in their midst. Soon the moon rose, and only +the footsteps of the sentries along our front went up and down, while across +the water was the same silence; for both hosts were wearied out, and each had +learned that the other were true men, and there was no mistrust on either side. +When the light came once more we should fight to prove who were the best men at +arms, and with no hatred between us. +</p> + +<p> +Presently the mists crept up from the stream and wreathed the sleepers on +either bank with white, swaying clouds, and I mind that the last thought I had +before I closed my eyes was that my armour would be rusted by the clinging +damp—as if it were not war-stained from helm to deerskin shoe already with +stains that needed more cleansing than any rust. +</p> + +<p> +Then I waked suddenly, for someone went past me, and I sat up to see who it +might be. The moon was very bright and high now, but the figure that I saw +wading in the white mist was shadowy, and I could not tell who it was. And then +another and yet another figure came from the rear of our line, and passed among +the sleeping ranks, and joined the first noiselessly; and after a little while +many came, hurrying, and they formed up on the bank of the stream into the +mighty wedge. And I feared greatly, for not one of the sleepers stirred as the +warriors went among us, and I had looked on the faces of those who passed me, +and I knew that they were the dead whom I had seen the men gather even now and +lay in their last rank beyond our line. +</p> + +<p> +Then I saw that on the far bank was gathered another host, and that was of +Alsi’s men, and among them I knew the forms of some who had fallen in the first +onset when I led the charge. +</p> + +<p> +I tried to put forth my hand to wake Withelm, but I could not stir, and when I +would have spoken, I could frame no word, so that alone in all the host I saw +the slain men fight their battle over again, step by step. The wedge of the +Northmen won to the far shore as we had won—as they had won in life but a few +hours ago—and into the line of foemen they cut their way, and on the far side +of the stream they stayed and fought, as it had been in the battle. Yet though +one could see that the men shouted and cried, there was no sound at all, and +among the wildest turmoil walked the sentries of Alsi’s host unconcerned and +unknowing. And to me they seemed to be the ghosts, and the phantom strife that +which was real. +</p> + +<p> +Then I was ware of a stranger thing yet than all I had seen so far, for on the +field were more than those whom I knew. There stood watching on either side of +the battle two other ghostly hosts, taking no part in the struggle, but +watching it as we had watched from our place when we fell back into the rear to +rest, pointing and seeming to cheer strokes that were good and deeds that were +valiant. And I knew that these were men who had fought and died on this same +field in older days, for on one side were the white-clad Britons, and on the +other the stern, dark-faced Romans, steel and bronze from head to foot. +</p> + +<p> +So the battle went onward to where we had won and had been pressed back; and +then, little by little, the hosts faded away, and with them went the watchers, +and surely across the field went the quick gallop of no earthly steeds, the +passing to Odin of the choosers of the slain, the Valkyries. +</p> + +<p> +Then came across the brook to me one through the mist, and the sentries paid no +heed to him, and he came to my side and spoke to me. It was Cadwal, the Welsh +thane, and his breast was gashed so that I thought that he could not have +lived. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, I am dead,” he said, “as men count death, and yet I would have part in +victory over Alsi, for the sake of Havelok and of Goldberga. Stay up my body on +the morrow, that I may seem to fight at least, that I may bide in the ranks +once more in the day of victory. Little victory have the British seen since +Hengist came. Say that you will do this.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he looked wistfully at me, and I gave him some token of assent; and at +that came back all the shadows of our men, and seemed to pray the same. And +then was a stir of feet near me, and a shadow across the trampled grass, and +instead of the dead the voice of Havelok spoke softly to me, and with him was +Goldberga, clad in her mail. And I thought that they and I were slain also, and +I cried to this one who seemed to be one of Odin’s maidens that I too would +fain be stayed up with Cadwal and the rest, that I might have part in victory. +</p> + +<p> +Then Goldberga stooped to me, and laid her soft hand on my forehead, and took +off my helm, so that the air came to me, and thereat I woke altogether. +</p> + +<p> +“Brother,” she said, “you are restless and sorely wounded, as it seems. It is +not good that you should lie in this mist.” +</p> + +<p> +At her voice the others woke, and for a while she talked with us in a low tone, +cheering us. And presently she asked of that strange request that I had made to +her. +</p> + +<p> +I told her, for it was a message that should not be kept back, thus given; and +when he heard it, Withelm sighed a little, and said, “Would that we had all +those who have fallen. Yet if it is as they have asked our brother, our host +will seem as strong as before we joined battle in the morning. Leave this to +me, brother, for it may be done.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he rose up and went softly to where Idrys, the friend of Cadwal, lay, and +spoke long with him. It was true that Cadwal was slain, though I had not yet +heard of it until he told me himself thus. +</p> + +<p> +Then I slept heavily, while the others talked for a while. It is a hard place +at a wedge tip when Englishmen are against one; and I am not much use in a +council. Presently they would wake me if my word was wanted. +</p> + +<p> +But it was not needed, for the sunlight woke me. There was a growing stir in +our lines and across the water also, and I looked round. The mists were yet +dense, for there was not enough breeze to stir the heavy folds of the banner, +and Raven slept still with his arm round its staff. Havelok was not here now, +and I thought that he had gone to the camp with Goldberga, and would be back +shortly. +</p> + +<p> +Then I saw that our rear rank was already formed up, as I thought, and that is +not quite the order of things, as a rule, and it seemed far off from the +stream. I thought that they should have asked me about this, for there were +some of my courtmen in that line. +</p> + +<p> +And then I saw that in the line was no movement, and no flash of arms, as when +one man speaks to another, turning a little. And before that line stood the +form of a chief who leant on his broad spear, motionless and seeming watchful. +I knew him at once, and it was Cadwal, and those he commanded were the dead. +That was even to me an awesome sight, for in the mists they seemed ready and +waiting for the word that would never come to their ears, resting on the spears +that they could use no more. It had been done by the marshmen in the dark hours +of the morning, and from across the stream I saw Alsi’s men staring at the new +force that they thought had come to help us. There were men enough moving along +our bank with food to us to prevent them seeing that this line stirred not at +all. +</p> + +<p> +There was a scald who came with us from Denmark, and now with the full rising +of the sun he took his harp and went along the stream bank singing the song of +Dunheidi fight and so sweet was his voice, and so strong, that even Alsi’s men +gathered to hearken to him. His name was Heidrek, and he has set all that he +saw with Havelok into a saga; but we, here, mostly remember the brave waking +that he gave us that morning. It was wonderful how the bright song cheered us. +One saw that the stiffened limbs shook themselves into litheness once more, and +the listless faces brightened, and into the hearts that were heavy came new +hope, and that was the song’s work. +</p> + +<p> +Now men began to jest with their foes across the stream, and those who had +Danish loaves threw them across in exchange for English, that they might have +somewhat to talk of. Ours were rye, and theirs of barley; but it was not a fair +change after ours had been so long a voyage. +</p> + +<p> +It was not long before our war horns sounded for the mustering, and men ran to +their arms. The Lindsey host drew back from the talk with our men at the same +time, and, without waiting for word from their leaders, began to get in line +along the stream, where they had been when we halted last night. But we had no +thought of falling on them until we had had some parley with the king or the +Earl of Chester. And now it was plain that with the grim rearguard behind us we +outnumbered the men of Alsi who were left. +</p> + +<p> +Now came from the village in rear of the foe a little company, in the midst of +which was one horseman, and that was the king himself. His arm was slung to his +breast, and he sat his horse weakly, so that it was true enough that he had +been hurt. With him were the earl and Eglaf, and the housecarls, and I sent one +to fetch Havelok quickly, that there might be no delay in the words that were +to be said. +</p> + +<p> +Alsi rode to the water’s edge and looked out over our host, and his white face +became whiter, and his thin lips twitched as he saw that our line was no weaker +than it had seemed when first he saw it. He spoke to the earl, and he too +counted the odds before him, and he smiled a little to himself. He had not much +to say to Alsi. +</p> + +<p> +Then broke out a thunderous cheer from all our men, for with Havelok and Sigurd +at her horse’s rein, and with Withelm’s courtmen of her own guard behind her, +came Goldberga the queen to speak with the man who had broken his trust. She +had on her mail, as on the day when we ended Hodulf; and she rode to the centre +of our line, and there stayed, with a flush on her cheek that the wild shouts +of our men had called there. +</p> + +<p> +Then I heard the name of “Goldberga, Goldberga!” run down the English line, and +I saw Alsi shrink back into himself, as it were; and then some Lincoln men +close to him began to grow restless, and all at once they lifted their helms +and cheered also, and that cheer was taken up by all the host, as it seemed, +until the ring of hills seemed alive with voices. And with that Alsi half +turned his horse to fly. +</p> + +<p> +Yet his men did not mean to leave him. It was but the hailing of the lady whom +they knew, and her coming thus was more than the simple warriors had wit or +mind to fathom. But now Goldberga held up her hand, and the cries ceased, and +silence came. Then she lifted her voice, clear as a silver bell, and said, “It +seems strange to me that English folk should be fighting against me and my +husband’s men who have brought me home. I would know the meaning of this, King +Alsi, for it would seem that your oath to my father is badly kept. Maybe I have +thought that the people would not have me in his place; but their voice does +not ring in those shouts, for which I thank them with all my heart, as if they +hated me. Now, therefore, I myself ask that my guardian will give up to me that +which is my own.” +</p> + +<p> +We held our peace, but a hum of talk went all through the English ranks. The +Earl of Chester sat down on the bank, and set his sword across his knees, and +began to tie the peace strings round the hilt, in token that he was going to +fight no more. Now and then he looked at Goldberga, and smiled at her earnest +face. But Alsi made no sign of answer. +</p> + +<p> +Then the queen spoke again to him. +</p> + +<p> +“There must be some reason why you have thus set a host in arms against me,” +she said, “and what that may be I would know.” +</p> + +<p> +Then, as Alsi answered not at all, the earl spoke frankly. +</p> + +<p> +“We were told that we had to drive out the Vikings, and I must say that they do +not go easily. But it was not told us that they came here to right a wrong, +else had I not fought.” +</p> + +<p> +Many called out in the same words, and then sat down as the earl had done. +</p> + +<p> +And at last Alsi spoke for himself. +</p> + +<p> +“We do not fight against you, my niece, but against the Danes. We cannot have +them in the country.” +</p> + +<p> +“They do not mean to bide here, but they will not go before my throne is given +to me. Never came a foreign host into a land in more friendly wise than this of +mine.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Alsi’s face seemed to clear, and his forced smile came to him. He +looked round on the thanes who were nearest him, and coughed, and then +answered, “Here has been some mistake, my niece, and it has cost many good +lives. If it is even as you say, get you to your land of Anglia, and there +shall be peace. I myself will send word to Ragnar that he shall hail you as +queen.” +</p> + +<p> +Then up spoke a new voice, and it was one that I knew well. +</p> + +<p> +“No need to do that, lord king,” said Berthun the cook. “Here have I come +posthaste, and riding day and night, to say that Ragnar is but a day’s march +from here, that he and all Norfolk may see that their queen comes to her own.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi’s face grew ashy pale, and without another word he swung his horse +round and went his way. I saw him reel in the saddle before he had gone far, +and Eglaf set his arm round him and stayed him up. After him Goldberga looked +wistfully, for she was forgiving, and had fain that he had spoken one word of +sorrow. But none else heeded him, for now the thanes, led by the earl himself, +came thronging across the water, that they might ask forgiveness for even +seeming to withstand Goldberga. And on both sides the men set down their arms, +and began to pile mighty fires, that the peace made should not want its +handfasting feast. +</p> + +<p> +For the fair princess had won her own, and there was naught but gladness. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap24">CHAPTER XXIV.<br/> +PEACE, AND FAREWELL.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now there was feasting enough, and somewhere they found at a thane’s house a +great tent, and they set that up, so that Havelok and Goldberga might have +their own court round them, as it were. Gladly did Berthun rid himself of war +gear and take to his old trade again. I suppose that the little Tetford valley +had never heard the like sounds of rejoicing before. +</p> + +<p> +Near midnight a man came to me and said that a message had come to me from the +other side, and I rose from the board and went out, to find Eglaf waiting for +me in the moonlight. He was armed, and his face was wan and tired. +</p> + +<p> +“Come apart, friend,” he said; “I have a message from the king.” +</p> + +<p> +“To me?” +</p> + +<p> +“No, to Havelok. But you must hear it first, and then tell him as you will.” +</p> + +<p> +We walked away from the tent and across the hillside for some way, and then he +said without more words, “This is the message that Alsi sends to Havelok, whose +name was Curan. ‘Forgive the things that are past, for many there are that need +forgiving. I have no heir, and it is for myself that I have schemed amiss. In +Lincoln town lies a great treasure, of which Eglaf and I alone know. Give it, I +pray you, to your Danes, that they may harm the land not at all, and so shall I +ward off some of the evil that might come through me even yet. I think that, +after me, you shall be king.’” +</p> + +<p> +“That is wise of Alsi; but is there no word for Goldberga?” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, but not by my mouth. I fetched David the priest two hours ago, and he +bears those messages.” +</p> + +<p> +“Is there yet more to say?” I asked, for it seemed to me that there was. +</p> + +<p> +“There is,” he answered. “Alsi is dead.” +</p> + +<p> +So there was an end of all his schemings, and I will say no more of them. It +was Eglaf’s thought that it was not so much his hurts that had killed the king, +but a broken heart because of this failure. For the second time now I knew that +it is true that “old sin makes new shame.” +</p> + +<p> +Now how we told Havelok this, and how Goldberga was somewhat comforted by the +words that David the priest brought her from her uncle, there is no need to +say. But when the news was known in all the host of Lindsey, there was a great +gathering of all in the wide meadow, and we sat in the camp and wondered what +end should be to the talk. Ragnar had come; but his host was now no great one, +for we had sent word to him of the peace, and there was a great welcome for him +and his men. +</p> + +<p> +The Lindsey thanes did not talk long, and presently some half dozen of the best +of them came to us, and said that with one accord the gathering would ask that +Havelok and Goldberga should reign over them. +</p> + +<p> +“We will answer for all in the land,” they said. “If there are other thanes who +should have had a word in the matter, they are not here because, knowing more +than we, they would not fight for Alsi in this quarrel. If there is any other +man to be thought of, he cannot go against the word of the host.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have my kingdom in Denmark,” said Havelok, “and my wife has hers in Anglia. +How should we take this? See, here is Ragnar of Norwich; he is worthy to be +king, if any. Here, too, is the Earl of Chester, who led you. It will be well +to set these two names before the host.” +</p> + +<p> +“The host will have none but Havelok and Goldberga,” they said. +</p> + +<p> +So the long-ago visions came to pass, and in a few days more we were feasting +in the old hall at Lincoln. But before we left the valley of the battle we laid +in mound in all honour those who had fallen. Seven great mounds we made, at +which men wonder and will wonder while they stand at Tetford. For well fought +the Danes of Goldberga, and well fought the Lindseymen on that day. Yet I think +that those who would fain have lived to see the victory had their share in it, +as they stood in their grim and silent ranks behind us. +</p> + +<p> +Then was a new crowning of those two, and messages to the overlord of Lindsey, +sent by the thanes, to say that all was settled on the old lines of peaceful +tribute to be paid; and then, when word and presents came back from him, +Goldberga rose up on the high place where she had been so strangely wedded, and +looked down at the joyous faces of her nobles at the long tables. +</p> + +<p> +“When I was crowned in Denmark,” she said, “there was a promise made me, that +when this day came to me in Norfolk I might ask one boon of all who upheld me. +I do not know if I may ask it here and now, for the promise was made by my +husband’s people. Yet it is a matter that is dear to my heart that I shall seek +from you all, if I may.” +</p> + +<p> +Then all the hall rang with voices that bade her ask what she would; and she +bowed and flushed red, and hesitated a little. Then she took heart and spoke. +</p> + +<p> +“It is but this,” she said. “Let the poor Christian folk bide in peace; and if +teachers come from the south or from the north presently who will speak of that +faith, bear with them, I pray you, for they work no harm indeed.” +</p> + +<p> +Almost was she weeping as she said this, and her white hands were clasped +tightly before her. But she looked bravely at the thanes, and waited for the +answer, though I think that she feared what it would be. +</p> + +<p> +But an old thane rose up in his place, smiling, and he answered, “If you had +commanded us this, my queen, it would have been done. The Christian folk, if +there are any, shall have no hurt. I think that we had forgotten the old days +of trouble with them. Yet I hear that in Kent the new faith, as it seems to us, +is being taught, and that the king looks on it with favour. It may be that here +it will come also. For your sake I will listen if a teacher comes to me.” +</p> + +<p> +The thanes thought little of this boon, and they all answered that it was +freely granted. But they said that it was no boon to give, and bade her ask +somewhat that was better. +</p> + +<p> +“Why then,” she said, “if I must ask more, think no more of me as queen save as +that I am the wife of the king. Havelok is your ruler in good sooth.” +</p> + +<p> +That pleased them all well, and they laughed and wished that all had wives who +had no mind to rule. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is word that is going home to my wife,” said one to his neighbour. “If +the queen sets the fashion of obedience, it behoves all good wives to follow +her leading.” +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe I would let some other than yourself tell the lady that,” answered the +other thane with a great laugh, for he knew that household and its ruler. +</p> + +<p> +So Goldberga had her will, and then began the long years of peace and happiness +to the kingdoms of which all men know. Wherefore I think that my story is done. +What I have told is halting maybe, and rough, but it is true. And Goldberga, my +sister, says that it is good. Which is all the praise that I need. +</p> + +<hr /> + +<p> +So far went Radbard, my friend, and then he would tell no more. So it is left +to me, Wislac the priest, who have written for him, to finish. He says that +everyone knows the rest, and so they do just now. But in the years to come, +when this story is read, men will want to know more. So it is fit that I should +end the story, telling things that I myself know to be true also. +</p> + +<p> +Sigurd’s host went back in the autumn, rich with the treasure of Alsi the king; +and from that time forward no Danish host ever sought our shores. Wars enough +have been in England here, but they have not harmed us. No host has been +suffered to cross the borders of Lindsey or East Anglia, save in peace, and in +the wars of Penda of Mercia Havelok has taken no part. Yet he has had to fight +to hold his own more than once, but always with victory, for always the prayers +of the few Christians have been with him. +</p> + +<p> +They set Earl Ragnar to hold the southern kingdom for Havelok and his wife; and +presently, when he was left a widower, he wedded the youngest daughter of Grim, +Havelok’s foster father. Eglaf was captain of the Lincoln courtmen or +housecarls, whichever the right name may be among those who speak of them. One +name is Danish and the other English, but they mean the same. As for my good +friend Radbard, he was high sheriff before long, and that he is yet. He wedded +Ragnar’s sister the year that Havelok was crowned in Norwich, which was the +next year after the crowning at Lincoln. +</p> + +<p> +Raven went back to the sea, and he will now be in Denmark or else on the Viking +path with Sigurd, for that is what he best loves. Arngeir bides at Grimsby, +high in honour with all, and the port and town grow greater and more prosperous +year by year. Wise was Grim when he chose to stay in the place where he had +chanced to come, if it were not more than chance that brought him. I suppose +that for all time the ships that are from Grimsby will be free from all dues in +the ports that are Havelok’s in the Danish land. Witlaf, the good old thane, +bides in his place yet, and he rejoices ever that he had a hand in bringing +Havelok up. Nor does our king forget that. +</p> + +<p> +Indeed, I think that he forgets naught but ill done toward him. Never is a man +who has done one little thing for him overlooked, if he is met by our king +after many years, and that is a royal gift indeed. +</p> + +<p> +I would that all married folk were as are this royal couple of ours. Never are +they happy apart, and never has a word gone awry between them. If one speaks of +Havelok, one must needs think of Goldberga; and if one says a word of the +queen, one means the king also. Happy in their people and in their wondrous +fair children are they, and that is all that can be wished for them. +</p> + +<p> +There was one thing wanting for long years, that I and Withelm ever longed for +for Havelok—a thing for which Goldberga prayed ever. I came to them from Queen +Bertha in Kent, when good old David died; and at that time Havelok was not a +Christian, but surely the most Christian heathen that ever was. I knew that he +must come into the faith at some time; and I, at least, could not find it in my +heart to blame him altogether for holding to the Asir whom his fathers +worshipped. It was in sheer honesty and singleness of heart that he did so, and +I had never skill enough to show him the right. But Withelm, who has long been +a priest of the faith, and shall surely be our bishop ere long, had more to do +with his conversion than any other. +</p> + +<p> +Yet it did not come until the days when Paulinus came from York and preached +with the fire of the missionary to us all. And then we saw the mighty warrior +go down to the water in the white robe of the catechumen, and come therefrom +with his face shining with a new and wondrous light. +</p> + +<p> +Then he founded a monastery at Grimsby, that there the men of the marsh, who +had been kind to him in the old days, might find teachers in all that was good; +and there it will surely be after many a long year, until there is need for its +work no more, if such a time ever comes. +</p> + +<p> +So the land grows Christian fast, and good will be its folk if they follow the +way of king and queen and their brothers. +</p> + +<p> +Now have I finished also, and this is farewell. Look you, husbands and wives, +that you may be said to be like Havelok and Goldberga; and see, brothers, that +you mind the words that Grim spoke to his sons, and which they heeded so well— +</p> + +<p> +“Bare is back without brother behind it.” And that is a true word, though it +was a heathen who spoke it. +</p> + +<p> +THE END. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn1"></a> <a href="#fnref1">[1]</a> +I have to thank the Mayor of Grimsby for most kindly furnishing me with an +impression of this ancient seal. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn2"></a> <a href="#fnref2">[2]</a> +Now Nishni-Novgorod, from time immemorial the great meetingplace of north and +south, east and west. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn3"></a> <a href="#fnref3">[3]</a> +The <i>garth</i> was the fenced and stockaded enclosure round a northern +homestead. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn4"></a> <a href="#fnref4">[4]</a> +The <i>seax</i> was the heavy, curved dagger carried by men of all ranks. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn5"></a> <a href="#fnref5">[5]</a> +The northern sea god and goddess. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn6"></a> <a href="#fnref6">[6]</a> +Men drowned at sea were thought to go to the halls of Pan and Aegir. Ran is +represented as fishing for heroes in time of storm. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn7"></a> <a href="#fnref7">[7]</a> +The Norns were the Fates of the northern mythology. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn8"></a> <a href="#fnref8">[8]</a> +The “Witanagemot,” the representative assembly for the kingdom, whence our +Parliament sprang. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn9"></a> <a href="#fnref9">[9]</a> +The greatest term of reproach for a coward. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn10"></a> <a href="#fnref10">[10]</a> +The gold ring kept in the Temple of the Asir, on which all oaths must be sworn. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn11"></a> <a href="#fnref11">[11]</a> +The sanctuary of the Asir. Thorsway and Withern in Lincolnshire both preserve +the name in the last and first syllable respectively, both meaning “Thor’s +sanctuary.” +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn12"></a> <a href="#fnref12">[12]</a> +The northern equivalent of the Saxon “Folkmote,” or general assembly of the +people. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div>*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 12847 ***</div> +</body> +</html> diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6312041 --- /dev/null +++ b/LICENSE.txt @@ -0,0 +1,11 @@ +This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements, +metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be +in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES. + +Procedures for determining public domain status are described in +the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org. + +No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in +jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize +this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright +status under the laws that apply to them. diff --git a/README.md b/README.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000..9558122 --- /dev/null +++ b/README.md @@ -0,0 +1,2 @@ +Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for +eBook #12847 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/12847) diff --git a/old/12847-0.txt b/old/12847-0.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..50135a5 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/12847-0.txt @@ -0,0 +1,10704 @@ +The Project Gutenberg eBook of Havelok The Dane, by Charles Whistler + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and +most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions +whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms +of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at +www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you +will have to check the laws of the country where you are located before +using this eBook. + +Title: Havelok The Dane + A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln + +Author: Charles Whistler + +Release Date: July 7, 2004 [eBook #12847] +[Most recently updated: March 31, 2023] + +Language: English + +Produced by: Martin Robb + +*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK HAVELOK THE DANE *** + + + + +Havelok the Dane: A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln. + +By Charles W. Whistler, M.R.C.S. + + + + +CONTENTS + + PREFACE. + CHAPTER I. GRIM THE FISHER AND HIS SONS. + CHAPTER II. KING HODULF’S SECRET. + CHAPTER III. HAVELOK, SON OF GUNNAR. + CHAPTER IV. ACROSS THE SWAN’S PATH. + CHAPTER V. STORM AND SHIPWRECK. + CHAPTER VI. THE BEGINNING OF GRIMSBY TOWN. + CHAPTER VII. BROTHERHOOD. + CHAPTER VIII. BERTHUN THE COOK. + CHAPTER IX. CURAN THE PORTER. + CHAPTER X. KING ALSI OF LINDSEY. + CHAPTER XI. THE COMING OF THE PRINCESS. + CHAPTER XII. IN LINCOLN MARKETPLACE. + CHAPTER XIII. THE WITAN’S FEASTING. + CHAPTER XIV. THE CRAFT OF ALSI THE KING. + CHAPTER XV. THE FORTUNE OF CURAN THE PORTER. + CHAPTER XVI. A STRANGEST WEDDING. + CHAPTER XVII. HOW THE BRIDE WENT HOME. + CHAPTER XVIII. JARL SIGURD OF DENMARK. + CHAPTER XIX. THE LAST OF GRIFFIN OF WALES. + CHAPTER XX. THE OWNING OF THE HEIR. + CHAPTER XXI. THE TOKEN OF SACK AND ANCHOR. + CHAPTER XXII. KING ALSI’S WELCOME. + CHAPTER XXIII. BY TETFORD STREAM. + CHAPTER XXIV. PEACE, AND FAREWELL. + + + + +PREFACE. + + +If any excuse is needed for recasting the ancient legend of Grim the +fisher and his foster-son Havelok the Dane, it may be found in the +fascination of the story itself, which made it one of the most popular +legends in England from the time of the Norman conquest, at least, to +that of Elizabeth. From the eleventh to the thirteenth centuries it +seems to have been almost classic; and during that period two full +metrical versions—one in Norman-French and the other in English—were +written, besides many other short versions and abridgments, which still +exist. These are given exhaustively by Professor Skeat in his edition +of the English poem for the Early English Text Society, and it is +needless to do more than refer to them here as the sources from which +this story is gathered. + +These versions differ most materially from one another in names and +incidents, while yet preserving the main outlines of the whole history. +It is evident that there has been a far more ancient, orally-preserved +tradition, which has been the original of the freely-treated poems and +concise prose statements of the legend which we have. And it seems +possible, from among the many variations, and from under the disguise +of the mediaeval forms in which it has been hidden, to piece together +what this original may have been, at least with some probability. + +We have one clue to the age of the legend of Havelok in the statement +by the eleventh-century Norman poet that his tale comes from a British +source, which at least gives a very early date for the happenings +related; while another version tells us that the king of “Lindesie” was +a Briton. Welsh names occur, accordingly, in several places; and it is +more than likely that the old legend preserved a record of actual +events in the early days of the Anglo-Saxon settlement in England, when +there were yet marriages between conquerors and conquered, and the +origins of Angle and Jute and Saxon were not yet forgotten in the +pedigrees of the many petty kings. + +One of the most curious proofs of the actual British origin of the +legend is in the statement that the death of Havelok’s father occurred +as the result of a British invasion of Denmark for King Arthur, by a +force under a leader with the distinctly Norse name of Hodulf. The +claim for conquest of the north by Arthur is very old, and is repeated +by Geoffrey of Monmouth, and may well have originated in the +remembrance of some successful raid on the Danish coasts by the Norse +settlers in the Gower district of Pembrokeshire, in company with a +contingent of their Welsh neighbours. + +This episode does not occur in the English version; but here an attack +on Havelok on his return home to Denmark is made by men led by one +Griffin, and this otherwise unexplainable survival of a Welsh name +seems to connect the two accounts in some way that recalls the ancient +legend at the back of both. + +I have therefore treated the Welsh element in the story as deserving a +more prominent place, at least in subsidiary incidents, than it has in +the two old metrical versions. It has been possible to follow neither +of these exactly, as in names and details they are widely apart; but to +one who knows both, the sequence of events will, I think, be clear +enough. + +I have, for the same reason of the British origin of the legend, +preferred the simple and apposite derivation of the name of “Curan,” +taken by the hero during his servitude, from the Welsh _Cwran_, “a +wonder,” to the Norman explanation of the name as meaning a “scullion,” +which seems to be rather a guess, based on the menial position of the +prince, than a translation. + +For the long existence of a Welsh servile population in the lowlands of +Lincolnshire there is evidence enough in the story of Guthlac of +Crowland, and the type may still be found there. There need be little +excuse for claiming some remains of their old Christianity among them, +and the “hermit” who reads the dream for the princess may well have +been a half-forgotten Welsh priest. But the mediaeval poems have +Christianized the ancient legend, until it would seem to stand in +somewhat the same relationship to what it was as the German +“Niebelungen Lied” does to the “Volsunga Saga.” + +With regard to the dreams which recur so constantly, I have in the case +of the princess transferred the date of hers to the day previous to her +marriage, the change only involving a difference of a day, but seeming +to he needed, as explanatory of her sudden submission to her guardian. +And instead of crediting Havelok with the supernatural light bodily, it +has been transferred to the dream which seems to haunt those who have +to do with him. + +As to the names of the various characters, they are in the old versions +hardly twice alike. I have, therefore, taken those which seem to have +been modernized from their originals, or preserved by simple +transliteration, and have set them back in what seems to have been +their first form. Gunther, William, and Bertram, for instance, seem to +be modernized from Gunnar, Withelm, and perhaps Berthun; while Sykar, +Aunger, and Gryme are but alternative English spellings of the northern +Sigurd, Arngeir, and Grim. + +The device on Havelok’s banner in chapter xxi. is exactly copied from +the ancient seal of the Corporation of Grimsby,[1] which is of the date +of Edward the First. The existence of this is perhaps the best proof +that the story of Grim and Havelok is more than a romance. Certainly +the Norse “Heimskringla” record claims an older northern origin for the +town than that of the Danish invasion of Alfred’s time; and the +historic freedom of its ships from toll in the port of Elsinore has +always been held to date from the days of its founder. + +The strange and mysterious “blue stones” of Grimsby and Louth are yet +in evidence, and those of the former town are connected by legend with +Grim. Certainly they have some very ancient if long-forgotten +associations, and it is more than likely that they have been brought as +“palladia” with the earliest northern settlers. A similar stone exists +in the centre of the little East Anglian town of Harleston, with a +definite legend of settlement attached to it; and there may be others. +The Coronation Stone of Westminster and the stone in Kingston-on-Thames +are well-known proofs of the ancient sanctity that surrounded such +objects for original reasons that are now lost. + +The final battle at Tetford, with its details, are from the Norman +poem. The later English account is rounded off with the disgrace and +burning alive of the false guardian; but for many reasons the earlier +seems to be the more correct account. Certainly the mounds of some +great forgotten fight remain in the Tetford valley, and Havelok is said +to have come to “Carleflure,” which, being near Saltfleet, and on the +road to Tetford, may be Canton, where there is a strong camp of what is +apparently Danish type. + +Those who can read with any comfort the crabbed Norman-French and Early +English poetic versions will see at once where I have added incidents +that may bring the story into a connected whole, as nearly as possible +on the old Saga lines; and those readers to whom the old romance is new +will hardly wish that I should pull the story to pieces again, to no +purpose so far as they are concerned. And, at least, for a fairly free +treatment of the subject, I have the authority of those previous +authors whom I have mentioned. + +In the different versions, the founder of Grimsby is variously +described as a steward of the Danish king’s castle, a merchant, a +fisher, and in the English poem—probably because it was felt that none +other would have undertaken the drowning of the prince—as a thrall. +Another version gives no account of the sack episode, but says that +Grim finds both queen and prince wandering on the shore. Grim the +fisher is certainly a historic character in his own town, and it has +not been hard to combine the various callings of the worthy +foster-father of Havelok and the troubles of both mother and son. A +third local variant tells that Havelok was found at Grimsby by the +fisher adrift in an open boat; and I have given that boat also a place +in the story, in a different way. + +The names of the kings are too far lost to be set back in their place +in history, but Professor Skeet gives the probable date of Havelok and +Grim as at the end of the sixth century, with a possible identification +of the former with the “governor of Lincoln” baptized by Paulinus. I +have, therefore, assumed this period where required. But a legend of +this kind is a romance of all time, and needs no confinement to date +and place. Briton and Saxon, Norman and Englishman, and maybe Norseman +and Dane, have loved the old story, and with its tale of right and love +triumphant it still has its own power. + +Stockland, _1899_ + +Chas. W. Whistler + + + + +CHAPTER I. +GRIM THE FISHER AND HIS SONS. + + +This story is not about myself, though, because I tell of things that I +have seen, my name must needs come into it now and then. The man whose +deeds I would not have forgotten is my foster-brother, Havelok, of whom +I suppose every one in England has heard. Havelok the Dane men call him +here, and that is how he will always be known, as I think. + +He being so well known, it is likely that some will write down his +doings, and, not knowing them save by hearsay, will write them wrongly +and in different ways, whereof will come confusion, and at last none +will be believed. Wherefore, as he will not set them down himself, it +is best that I do so. Not that I would have anyone think that the +penmanship is mine. Well may I handle oar, and fairly well axe and +sword, as is fitting for a seaman, but the pen made of goose feather is +beyond my rough grip in its littleness, though I may make shift to use +a sail-needle, for it is stiff and straightforward in its ways, and no +scrawling goeth therewith. + +Therefore my friend Wislac, the English priest, will be the penman, +having skill thereto. I would have it known that I can well trust him +to write even as I speak, though he has full leave to set aside all +hard words and unseemly, such as a sailor is apt to use unawares; and +where my Danish way of speaking goeth not altogether with the English, +he may alter the wording as he will, so long as the sense is always the +same. Then, also, will he read over to me what he has written, and +therefore all may be sure that this is indeed my true story. + + +Now, as it is needful that one begins at the beginning, it happens that +the first thing to be told is how I came to be Havelok’s +foster-brother, and that seems like beginning with myself after all. +But all the story hangs on this, and so there is no help for it. + +If it is asked when this beginning might be, I would say, for an +Englishman who knows not the names of Danish kings, that it was before +the first days of the greatness of Ethelbert of Kent, the overlord of +all England, the Bretwalda, and therefore, as Father Wislac counts, +about the year of grace 580. But King Ethelbert does not come into the +story, nor does the overlord of all Denmark; for the kings of whom I +must speak were under-kings, though none the less kingly for all that. +One must ever be the mightiest of many; and, as in England, there were +at that time many kings in Denmark, some over wide lands and others +over but small realms, with that one who was strong enough to make the +rest pay tribute to him as overlord, and only keeping that place by the +power of the strong hand, not for any greater worth. + +Our king on the west coast of Denmark, where the story of Havelok the +Dane must needs begin, was Gunnar Kirkeban—so called because, being a +heathen altogether, as were we all in Denmark at that time, he had been +the bane of many churches in the western isles of Scotland, and in +Wales and Ireland, and made a boast thereof. However, that cruelty of +his was his own bane in the end, as will be seen. Otherwise he was a +well-loved king and a great warrior, tall, and stronger than any man in +Denmark, as was said. His wife, the queen, was a foreigner, but the +fairest of women. Her name was Eleyn, and from this it was thought that +she came from the far south. Certainly Gunnar had brought her back from +Gardariki,[2] whither he had gone on a trading journey one year. Gunnar +and she had two daughters and but one son, and that son was Havelok, at +this time seven years old. + +Next to the king came our own lord, Jarl Sigurd, older than Gunnar, and +his best counsellor, though in the matter of sparing harmless and +helpless church folk his advice was never listened to. His hall was +many miles from the king’s place, southward down the coast. + +Here, too, lived my father, Grim, with us in a good house which had +been his father’s before him. Well loved by Jarl Sigurd was Grim, who +had ever been his faithful follower, and was the best seaman in all the +town. He was also the most skilful fisher on our coasts, being by birth +a well-to-do freeman enough, and having boats of his own since he could +first sail one. At one time the jarl had made him steward of his house; +but the sea drew him ever, and he waxed restless away from it. +Therefore, after a time, he asked the jarl’s leave to take to the sea +again, and so prospered in the fishery that at last he bought a large +trading buss from the Frisian coast, and took to the calling of the +merchant. + +So for some years my father, stout warrior as he proved himself in many +a fight at his lord’s side, traded peacefully—that is, so long as men +would suffer him to do so; for it happened more than once that his ship +was boarded by Vikings, who in the end went away, finding that they had +made a mistake in thinking that they had found a prize in a harmless +trader, for Grim was wont to man his ship with warriors, saying that +what was worth trading was worth keeping. I mind me how once he came to +England with a second cargo, won on the high seas from a Viking’s +plunder, which the Viking brought alongside our ship, thinking to add +our goods thereto. Things went the other way, and we left him only an +empty ship, which maybe was more than he would have spared to us. That +was on my second voyage, when I was fifteen. + +Mostly my father traded to England, for there are few of the Saxon kin +who take ship for themselves, and the havens to which he went were +Tetney and Saltfleet, on the Lindsey shore of Humber, where he soon had +friends. + +So Grim prospered and waxed rich fast, and in the spring of the year +wherein the story begins was getting the ship ready for the first +cruise of the season, meaning to be afloat early; for then there was +less trouble with the wild Norse Viking folk, for one cruise at least. +Then happened that which set all things going otherwise than he had +planned, and makes my story worth telling. + +We—that is my father Grim, Leva my mother, my two brothers and myself, +and our two little sisters, Gunhild and Solva—sat quietly in our great +room, busy at one little thing or another, each in his way, before the +bright fire that burned on the hearth in the middle of the floor. There +was no trouble at all for us to think of more than that the wind had +held for several weeks in the southwest and northwest, and we wondered +when it would shift to its wonted springtide easting, so that we could +get the ship under way once more for the voyage she was prepared for. +Pleasant talk it was, and none could have thought that it was to be the +last of many such quiet evenings that had gone before. + +Yet it seemed that my father was uneasy, and we had been laughing at +him for his silence, until he said, looking into the fire, “I will tell +you what is on my mind, and then maybe you will laugh at me the more +for thinking aught of the matter. Were I in any but a peaceful land, I +should say that a great battle had been fought not so far from us, and +to the northward.” + +Then my mother looked up at him, knowing that he had seen many fights, +and was wise in the signs that men look for before them; but she asked +nothing, and so I said, “What makes you think this, father?” + +He answered me with another question. + +“How many kites will you see overhead at any time, sons?” + +I wondered at this, but it was easy to answer—to Raven, at least. + +“Always one, and sometimes another within sight of the first,” Raven +said. + +“And if there is food, what then?” + +“The first swoops down on it, and the next follows, and the one that +watches the second follows that, and so on until there are many kites +gathered.” + +“What if one comes late?” + +“He swings overhead and screams, and goes back to his place; then no +more come.” + +“Ay,” he said; “you will make a sailor yet, son Raven, for you watch +things. Now I will tell you what I saw today. There was the one kite +sailing over my head as I was at the ship garth, and presently it +screamed so that I looked up. Then it left its wide circles over the +town, and flew northward, straight as an arrow. Then from the southward +came another, following it, and after that another, and yet others, all +going north. And far off I could see where others flew, and they too +went north. And presently flapped over me the ravens in the wake of the +kites, and the great sea eagles came in screaming and went the same +way, and so for all the time that I was at the ship, and until I came +home.” + +“There is a sacrifice to the Asir somewhere,” I said, “for the birds of +Odin and Thor have always their share.” + +My father shook his head. + +“The birds cry to one another, as I think, and say when the feast is +but enough for those that have gathered. They have cried now that there +is room for all at some great feasting. Once have I seen the like +before, and that was when I was with the ship guard when the jarl +fought his great battle in the Orkneys; we knew that he had fought by +the same token.” + +But my mother said that I was surely right. There was no fear of battle +here, and indeed with Gunnar and Sigurd to guard the land we had had +peace for many a long year on our own coasts, if other lands had had to +fear them. My father laughed a little, saying that perhaps it was so, +and then my mother took the two little ones and went with them into the +sleeping room to put them to rest, while I and my two brothers went out +to the cattle garth to see that all was well for the night. + +Then, when our eyes were used to the moonlight, which was not very +bright, away to the northward we saw a red glow that was not that of +the sunset or of the northern lights, dying down now and then, and then +again flaring up as will a far-off fire; and even as we looked we heard +the croak of an unseen raven flying thitherward overhead. + +“Call father,” I said to Withelm, who was the youngest of us three. The +boy ran in, and presently my father came out and looked long at the +glow in the sky. + +“Even as I thought,” he said. “The king’s town is burning, and I must +go to tell the jarl. Strange that we have had no message. Surely the +king’s men must be hard pressed if this is a foe’s work.” + +So he went at once, leaving us full of wonder and excited, as boys will +be at anything that is new and has a touch of fear in it. But he had +hardly gone beyond the outbuildings when one came running and calling +him. The jarl had sent for him, for there was strange news from the +king. Then he and this messenger hastened off together. + +In half an hour the war horns were blowing fiercely, and all the quiet +town was awake, for my father’s forebodings were true, and the foe was +on us. In our house my mother was preparing the food that her husband +should carry with him, and I was putting a last polish on the arms that +should keep him, while the tramp of men who went to the gathering rang +down the street, one by one at first, and then in twos and threes. My +mother neither wept nor trembled, but worked with a set face that would +not show fear. + +Then came in my father, and I armed him, begging at the same time that +I might go also, for I could use _my_ weapons well enough; but he told +me that some must needs bide at home as a guard, and that I was as much +wanted there as at the king’s place, wherewith I had to be content. It +was by no means unlikely that we also might be attacked, if it was true +that the king’s men were outnumbered, as was said. + +Now when my father went to say farewell to us, nowhere could be found +my brother Withelm. + +“The boy has gone to watch the muster,” my father said. “I shall see +him there presently.” + +Then, because he saw that my mother was troubled more than her wont, he +added, “Have no fear for me. This will be no more than a raid of +Norsemen, and they will plunder and be away with the tide before we get +to the place.” + +So he laughed and went out, having done his best to cheer us all, and I +went with him to where the men were gathered in their arms in the wide +space in the midst of the houses. There I sought for little Withelm, +but could not find him among the women and children who looked on; and +before we had been there more than a few minutes the jarl gave the +word, and the march was begun. There were about fifteen miles to be +covered between our town and the king’s. + +I watched them out of sight, and then went home, having learned that I +was to be called out only in case of need. And as I drew near the +homestead I saw a light in the little ash grove that was behind the +garth.[3] In the midst of the trees, where this light seemed to be, was +our wooden image of Thor the Hammer Bearer, older than any of us could +tell; and in front of this was what we used as his altar—four +roughly-squared stones set together. These stones were blue-black in +colour, and whence they came I do not know, unless it was true that my +forefathers brought them here when first Odin led his folk to the +northern lands. Always they had been the altar for my people, and my +father held that we should have no luck away from them. + +So it was strange to see a light in that place, where none would +willingly go after dark, and half was I feared to go and see what it +might mean. But then it came into my mind that the enemy might be +creeping on the house through the grove, and that therefore I must +needs find out all about it. So I went softly to the nearest trees, and +crept from one to another, ever getting closer to the light; and I will +say that I feared more that I might see some strange thing that was +more than mortal than that I should see the leading foeman stealing +towards me. But presently it was plain that the light did not move as +if men carried it, but it flickered as a little fire; and at last I saw +that it burned on the altar stones, and that frightened me so that I +almost fled. + +Maybe I should have done so, but that I heard a voice that I knew; and +so, looking once more, I saw a figure standing before the fire, and +knew it. It was little Withelm, and why a ten-year-old boy should be +here I could not think. But I called him softly, and he started +somewhat, turning and trying to look through the darkness towards me, +though he did not seem afraid. There was a little fire of dry sticks +burning on the stones, and the gaunt old statue seemed to look more +terrible than ever in its red blaze. One might have thought that the +worn face writhed itself as the light played over it. + +“It is I, Withelm,” I said softly, for the fear of the place was on me. +“We have sought you everywhere, and father would have wished you +farewell. What are you doing here?” + +I came forward then, for it was plain that the child feared nothing, so +that I was put to shame. And as I came I asked once more what he was +doing in this place. + +“The jarl has surely forgotten the sacrifice to the Asir before the +warriors went to fight, and they will be angry,” he answered very +calmly. “It is right that one should remember, and I feared for father, +and therefore—” + +He pointed to the altar, and I saw that he had laid his own untasted +supper on the fire that he had lighted, and I had naught to say. The +thing was over-strange to me, who thought nothing of these things. It +was true that the host always sacrificed before sailing on the Viking +path, but tonight had been urgent haste. + +“Thor will not listen to any but a warrior,” I said. “Come home, +brother, for mother waits us.” + +“If not Thor, who is maybe busy at the battle they talk of, then do I +think that All Father will listen,” he said stoutly. “But this was all +that I had to make sacrifice withal, and it may not be enough.” + +“The jarl will make amends when he comes back,” I said, wishing to get +home and away from this place, and yet unwilling to chide the child. +“Now let us go, for mother will grow anxious.” + +With that he put his hand in mine, and we both saluted Thor, as was +fitting, and then went homeward. It seemed to me that the glare in the +north was fiercer now than when I had first seen it. + +Now, after my mother had put Withelm to bed, I told her how I had found +him; and thereat she wept a little, as I could see in the firelight. + +After a long silence she said, “Strange things and good come into the +mind of a child, and one may learn what his fate shall be in the days +to come. I am sure from this that Withelm will be a priest.” + +Now as one may buy the place of a godar, with the right to have a +temple of the Asir for a district and the authority that goes +therewith, if so be that one falls vacant or is to be given up by the +holder, this did not seem unlikely, seeing how rich we were fast +growing. And indeed my mother’s saying came to pass hereafter, though +not at all in the way of which we both thought. + +There was no alarm that night. The old warriors watched round the town +and along the northern tracks, but saw nothing, and in the morning the +black smoke hung over the place of the burning, drifting slowly +seaward. The wind had changed, and they said that it would doubtless +have taken the foe away with it, as my father had hoped. So I went down +to the ship with Raven, and worked at the few things that were still +left to be done to her as she lay in her long shed on the slips, ready +to take the water at any tide. She was only waiting for cargo and +stores to be put on board her with the shift of wind that had come at +last, and I thought that my father would see to these things as soon as +he came back. + +Now in the evening we had news from the Jarl, and strange enough it +was. My father came back two days afterwards and told us all, and so I +may as well make a short story of it. The ways of Gunnar Kirkeban had +been his end, for a certain Viking chief, a Norseman, had wintered in +Wales during the past winter, and there he had heard from the Welsh of +the wrongs that they had suffered at his hands. Also he had heard of +the great booty of Welsh gold that Gunnar had taken thence in the last +summer; and so, when these Welsh asked that he would bide with them and +help fight the next Danes who came, he had offered to do more than +that—he would lead them to Gunnar’s place if they would find men to man +three ships that he had taken, and would be content to share the booty +with them. + +The Welsh king was of the line of Arthur, and one who yet hoped to win +back the land of his fathers from the Saxons and English; and so he +listened to this Hodulf, thinking to gain a powerful ally in him for +attack on the eastern coast of England after this. So, favoured by the +wind that had kept us from the sea, Hodulf, with twenty ships in all, +had fallen on Gunnar unawares, and had had an easy victory, besetting +the town in such wise that only in the confusion while the wild Welsh +were burning and plundering on every side had the messenger to the jarl +been able to slip away. + +But when the jarl and our men reached the town there was naught to be +done but to make terms with Hodulf as best he might, that the whole +country might not be overrun. For Gunnar had been slain in his own +hall, with his two young daughters and with the queen also, as was +supposed. Havelok the prince was in his hands, and for his sake +therefore Sigurd had been the more ready to come to terms. + +Then Hodulf sent messengers to the overlord of all Denmark, saying that +he would hold this kingdom as for him, and backed up that promise with +a great present from Gunnar’s treasure, so that he was listened to. +Therefore our jarl was helpless; and there being no other king strong +enough to aid him if he rose, in the end he had to take Hodulf for lord +altogether, though it went sorely against the grain. + +I have heard it said by the Welsh folk that Hodulf held the kingdom for +their lord; and it is likely that he humoured them by saying that he +would do so, which was a safe promise to make, as even King Arthur +himself could never have reached him to make him pay scatt. + + + + +CHAPTER II. +KING HODULF’S SECRET. + + +My father came home heavy and anxious enough, for he did not know how +things would go under this new king, though he had promised peace to +all men who would own him. We in our place saw nothing of him or his +men for the next few weeks, but he was well spoken of by those who had +aught to do with him elsewhere. So my father went on trying to gather a +cargo for England; but it was a slow business, as the burnt and +plundered folk of the great town had naught for us, and others sold to +them. But he would never be idle, and every day when weather served we +went fishing, for he loved his old calling well, as a man will love +that which he can do best. Our two boats and their gear were always in +the best of order, and our kinsman, Arngeir, used and tended them when +we were away in the ship in summertime. + +Now, one evening, as we came up from the shore after beaching the boat +on the hard below the town, and half a mile from the nearest houses, +and being, as one may suppose, not altogether in holiday trim, so that +Grim and his boys with their loads of fish and nets looked as though a +fisher’s hovel were all the home that they might own, we saw a +horseman, followed at a little distance by two more, riding towards us. +The dusk was gathering, and at first we thought that this was Jarl +Sigurd, who would ask us maybe to send fish to his hall, and so we set +our loads down and waited for him. + +But it was not our lord, and I had never seen this man before. From his +arms, which were of a new pattern to me, he might be one of the host of +Hodulf, as I thought. + +“Ho, fisher!” he cried, when he was yet some way from us; “leave your +lads, and come hither. I have a word for you.” + +He reined up and waited, and now I was sure that he was a Norseman, for +his speech was rougher than ours. He was a tall, handsome man enough; +but I liked neither his voice nor face, nor did I care to hear Grim, my +father, summoned in such wise, not remembering that just now a stranger +could not tell that he was aught but a fisher thrall of the jarl’s. + +But my father did as he was asked, setting down the nets that he was +carrying, and only taking with him the long boathook on which he had +slung them as he went forward. I suppose he remembered the old saying, +that a man should not stir a step on land without his weapons, as one +never knows when there may be need of them; and so, having no other, he +took this. + +I heard the first questions that the man asked, for he spoke loudly. + +“Whose man are you?” + +“Sigurd’s,” answered my father shortly. + +“Whose are the boats?” + +“Mine, seeing that I built them.” + +“Why, then, there is somewhat that you can do for me,” the horseman +said. “Is your time your own, however?” + +“If the jarl needs me not.” + +“Tonight, then?” + +“I have naught to do after I have carried the nets home.” + +“That is well,” said the stranger; and after that he dropped his voice +so that I heard no more, but he and my father talked long together. + +We waited, and at last the talk ended, and my father came hack to us, +while the stranger rode away northward along the sands. Then I asked +who the man was, and what he wanted. + +“He is some chief of these Norsemen, and one who asks more questions of +a thrall, as he thinks me, than he would dare ask Sigurd the jarl, or +Grim the merchant either, for that matter.” + +Seeing that my father did not wish to say more at this time, we asked +nothing else, but went homeward in silence. It seemed as if he was ill +at ease, and he went more quickly than was his wont, so that presently +Raven and little Withelm lagged behind us with their burdens, for our +catch had been a good one. + +Then he stopped outside the garth when we reached home, and told me not +to go in yet. And when the others came up he said to them, “Do you two +take in the things and the fish, and tell mother that Radbard and I +have to go down to the ship. There is cargo to be seen to, and it is +likely that we shall he late, so bid her not wait up for us.” + +Then he told me to come, and we left the two boys at once and turned +away towards the haven. There was nothing strange in this, for cargo +often came at odd times, and we were wont to work late in stowing it. I +did wonder that we had not stayed to snatch a bit of supper, but it +crossed my mind that the Norseman had told my father of some goods that +had maybe been waiting for the whole day while we were at sea. And then +that did not seem likely, for he had taken us for thralls. So I was +puzzled, but held my peace until it should seem good to my father to +tell me what we were about. + +When we reached a place where there was no house very near and no man +about, he said to me at last, “What is on hand I do not rightly know, +but yon man was Hodulf, the new king, as I suppose we must call him. He +would not tell me his name, but I saw him when he and the jarl made +terms the other day. Now he has bidden me meet him on the road a mile +from the town as soon as it is dark, and alone. He has somewhat secret +for me to do.” + +“It is a risk to go alone and unarmed,” I answered; “let me go home and +get your weapons, for the errand does not seem honest.” + +“That is what I think also,” said my father, “and that is why I am +going to meet him. It is a bad sign when a king has a secret to share +with a thrall, and I have a mind to find out what it is. There may be +some plot against our jarl.” + +He was silent for a few minutes, as if thinking, and then he went on. + +“I cannot take arms, or he would suspect me, and would tell me nothing; +but if there is any plotting to be done whereof I must tell the jarl, +it will be as well that you should hear it.” + +Then he said that he thought it possible for me to creep very close to +the place where he was to meet Hodulf, so that I could hear all or most +of what went on, and that I might as well be armed in case of foul +play, for he did not suppose that the Norseman would think twice about +cutting down a thrall who did not please him. + +It was almost dark by this time, and therefore he must be going. I was +not to go home for arms, but to borrow from Arngeir as we passed his +house. And this I did, saying that I had an errand beyond the town and +feared prowling men of the Norse host. Which danger being a very +reasonable one, Arngeir offered to go with me; and I had some +difficulty in preventing him from doing so, for he was like an elder +brother to all of us. However, I said that I had no great distance to +go, and feigned to be ashamed of myself for my fears; and he laughed at +me, and let me go my way with sword and spear and seax[4] also, which +last my father would take under his fisher’s jerkin. + +I caught up my father quickly, and we went along the sands northwards +until we came to the place where we must separate. The road was but a +quarter of a mile inland from this spot, for it ran near the shore, and +it was not much more than that to the place where Hodulf would be +waiting. + +“Creep as near as you can,” my father said; “but come to help only if I +call. I do not think that I am likely to do so.” + +Then we went our ways, he making straight for the road, and I turning +to my left a little. It was dark, for there was no moon now, but save +that I was soundly scratched by the brambles of the fringe of brushwood +that grew all along the low hills of the coast, there was nothing to +prevent my going on quickly, for I knew the ground well enough, by +reason of yearly bird nesting. When I reached the roadway the meeting +place was yet to my left, and I could hear my father’s footsteps coming +steadily in the distance. So I skirted the road for a little way, and +then came to an open bit of heath and rising land, beyond which I +thought I should find Hodulf. Up this I ran quickly, dropping into the +heather at the top; and sure enough, in a hollow just off the road I +could dimly make out the figure of a mounted man waiting. + +Then my father came along the road past me, and I crawled among the +tall heather clumps until I was not more than twenty paces from the +hollow, which was a little below me. + +Hodulf’s horse winded me, as I think, and threw up its head snorting, +and I heard its bit rattle. But my father was close at hand, and that +was lucky. + +“Ho, fisher, is that you?” he called softly. + +“I am here,” was the answer, and at once my father came into the hollow +from the road. + +“Are any folk about?” Hodulf said. + +“I have met none. Now, what is all this business?” answered my father. + +“Business that will make a free man of you for the rest of your days, +and rich, moreover, master thrall,” said Hodulf. “That is, if you do as +I bid you.” + +“A thrall can do naught else than what he is bidden.” + +“Nay, but he can do that in a way that will earn great reward, now and +then; and your reward for obedience and silence thereafter in this +matter shall be aught that you like to ask.” + +“This sounds as if I were to peril my life,” my father said. “I know +naught else that can be worth so much as that might be.” + +“There is no peril,” said Hodulf scornfully; “your skin shall not be so +much as scratched—ay, and if this is well done it will know a master’s +dog whip no more.” + +I heard my father chuckle with a thrall’s cunning laugh at this, and +then he said eagerly, “Well, master, what is it?” + +“I will tell you. But first will you swear as on the holy ring that of +what you shall do for me no man shall know hereafter?” + +“What I do at your bidding none shall know, and that I swear,” answered +my father slowly, as if trying to repeat the king’s words. + +“See here, then,” said Hodulf, and I heard his armour clatter as he +dismounted. + +Then the footsteps of both men shuffled together for a little while, +and once I thought I heard a strange sound as of a muffled cry, at +which Hodulf muttered under his breath. I could see that they took +something large from the saddle bow, and set it on the ground, and then +they spoke again. + +“Have you a heavy anchor?” asked the king. + +“A great one.” + +“Well, then, tie it to this sack and sink it tonight where tide will +never shift it. Then you may come to me and claim what reward you +will.” + +“Freedom, and gold enough to buy a new boat—two new boats!” said my +father eagerly. + +Hodulf laughed at that, and got on his horse again. I saw his tall form +lift itself against the dim sky as he did so. + +“What is in the sack?” asked my father. + +“That is not your concern,” Hodulf answered sharply. “If you know not, +then you can tell no man, even in your sleep. Put off at once and sink +it.” + +“It is in my mind,” said my father, “that I had better not look in the +sack. Where shall I find you, lord, when the thing is in the sea? For +as yet I have not heard your name.” + +I think that Hodulf had forgotten that he would have to answer this +question, or else he thought that everyone knew him, for he did not +reply all at once. + +“You may ask the king for your reward,” he said, after a little +thought, “for this is his business. Now you know that it will be best +for you to be secret and sure. Not much worth will your chance of +escape from torture be if this becomes known. But you know also that +the reward is certain.” + +“The king!” cried my father, with a sort of gasp of surprise. + +I could almost think that I saw him staring with mouth agape as would a +silly thrall; for so well had he taken the thrall’s part that had I not +known who was speaking all the time, I had certainly had no doubt that +one was there. + +“Come to Hodulf, the king, and pray for freedom and your gold as a boon +of his goodness, saying naught else, or making what tale you will of a +hard master, or justice, so that you speak naught of what you have +done, and that—and maybe more—shall be granted.” + +“You yourself will speak for me?” + +“I am the king—and think not that the darkness will prevent my knowing +your face again,” Hodulf replied. + +There was a threat in the words, and with them he turned his horse and +rode away quickly northwards. I heard the hoofs of his men’s horses +rattle on the road as they joined him, before he had gone far. + +When the sounds died away altogether, and there was no fear of his +coming back suddenly on us, my father whistled and I joined him. He +almost started to find how near I was. + +“You have heard all, then?” he said. + +“Every word,” I answered, “and I like it not. Where is this sack he +spoke of?” + +It lay at his feet. A large sack it was, and full of somewhat heavy and +warm that seemed to move a little when I put my hand on it. Still less +did I like the business as I felt that. + +“More also!” quoth my father, as if thinking of the king’s last words. +“If that does not mean a halter for my neck, I am mistaken. What have +we here, son, do you think?” + +“Somewhat that should not be here, certainly,” I answered. “There would +not be so much talk about drowning a dog, as one might think this to +be.” + +“Unless it were his wife’s,” answered my father, with a laugh. + +Then he stooped, and I helped him to get the sack on his shoulders. It +was heavy, but not very—not so heavy as a young calf in a sack would +be; and he carried it easily, taking my spear to help him. + +“The thrall is even going to take this to the house of Grim the +merchant, whom the king will not know again, though he may see in the +dark,” said he; “then we shall know how we stand.” + +We met no one on our way back, for the town had gone to sleep, until +the watchman passed the time of night with us, thinking no doubt that +we had fish or goods in the burden. And when we came home a sleepy +thrall opened to us, for all were at rest save him. And he too went his +way to the shed where his place was when he had stirred the fire to a +blaze and lit a torch that we might see to eat the supper that was left +for us. + +Then we were alone, and while I set Arngeir’s weapons in a corner, my +father put down the sack, and stood looking at it. It seemed to sway a +little, and to toss as it settled down. And now that there was light it +was plain that the shape of what was inside it was strangely like that +of a child, doubled up with knees to chin, as it showed through the +sacking. + +“Hodulf or no Hodulf,” said my father, “I am going to see more of +this.” + +With that he took a knife from the table and cut the cord that fastened +the mouth, turning back the sack quickly. + +And lo! gagged and bound hand and foot in such wise that he could not +move, in the sack was a wondrously handsome boy of about the size of +Withelm; and for all his terrible journey across the king’s saddle, and +in spite of our rough handling, his eyes were bright and fearless as he +looked up at us. + +“Radbard,” said my father, “what if Hodulf had met with a thrall who +had done his bidding in truth?” + +I would not think thereof, for surely by this time there had been no +light in the eyes that seemed to me to be grateful to us. + +Now my father knelt down by the boy’s side, and began to take the +lashings from him, telling him at the same time to be silent when the +gag was gone. + +And hard work enough the poor child had to keep himself from screaming +when his limbs were loosed, so cramped was he, for he had been bound +almost into a ball. And even as we rubbed and chafed the cold hands and +feet he swooned with the pain of the blood running freely once more. + +“This is a business for mother,” said my father, on that; “get your +supper, and take it to bed with you, and say naught to the boys in the +morning. This is a thing that may not be talked of.” + +Now I should have liked to stay, but my father meant what he said, and +I could be of no more use; so I took my food, and went up to the loft +where we three slept, and knew no more of what trouble that night might +have for others. + + + + +CHAPTER III. +HAVELOK, SON OF GUNNAR. + + +Now after I had gone, Grim, my father, tried to bring the child round, +but he could not do so; and therefore, leaving him near the fire, he +went softly to call Leva, my mother, to help him; and all the while he +was wondering who the child might be, though indeed a fear that he knew +only too well was growing in his heart, for there would surely he only +one whom Hodulf could wish out of his way. + +As he opened the door that led to the sleeping room beyond the high +seat, the light shone on Leva, and showed her sitting up in bed with +wide eyes that seemed to gaze on somewhat that was terrible, and at +first he thought her awake. But she yet slept, and so he called her +gently, and she started and woke. + +“Husband, is that you?” she said. “I had a strange dream even now which +surely portends somewhat.” + +Now, as all men know, our folk in the north are most careful in the +matter of attending to dreams, specially those that come in troubled +times, holding that often warning or good counsel comes from them. I +cannot say that I have ever had any profit in that way myself, being no +dreamer at all; but it is certain that others have, as may be seen +hereafter. Wherefore my father asked Leva what this dream might be. + +“In my dream,” she answered, “it seemed that you came into the house +bearing a sack, which you gave into my charge, saying that therein lay +wealth and good fortune for us. And I would not believe this, for you +said presently that to gain this the sack and all that was therein was +to be thrown into the sea, which seemed foolishness. Whereon I cast it +into a corner in anger, and thereout came pitiful cries and wailings. +Then said I that it were ill to drown aught that had a voice as of a +child, and so you bade me leave it. Then I seemed to sleep here; but +presently in my dream I rose and looked on the sack again, and lo! +round about it shone a great light, so that all the place was bright, +and I was afraid. Then you came and opened the sack, and therein was a +wondrous child, from whose mouth came a flame, as it were the shaft of +a sunbeam, that stretched over all Denmark, and across the sea to +England, whereby I knew that this child was one who should hereafter be +king of both these lands. And on this I stared even as you woke me.” + +Now Grim was silent, for this was passing strange, and moreover it +fitted with his thought of who this child might be, since Hodulf. would +make away with him thus secretly. + +“What make you of the dream?” asked Leva, seeing that he pondered on +it. + +“It is in my mind that your dream will come true altogether, for +already it has begun to do so,” he answered. “Rise and come into the +hall, and I will show you somewhat.” + +On that Leva made haste and dressed and came out, and there, lying as +if in sleep before the fire, was the wondrous child of her dream, and +the sack was under his head as he lay; and she was wont to say to those +few who knew the story, that the kingliness of that child was plain to +be seen, as had been the flame of which she had dreamed, so that all +might know it, though the clothes that he wore were such as a churl +might be ashamed of. + +Then she cried out a little, but not loudly, and knelt by the child to +see him the better; and whether he had come to himself before and had +dropped asleep for very weariness, or out of his swoon had passed into +sleep, I cannot say, but at her touch he stirred a little. + +“What child is this? and how came he here?” she asked, wondering. + +“Already your dream has told you truly how he came,” Grim answered, +“but who he is I do not rightly know yet. Take him up and bathe him, +wife; and if he is the one I think him, there will be a mark whereby we +may know him.” + +“How should he be marked? And why look you to find any sign thus?” + +But Grim had turned down the rough shirt and bared the child’s neck and +right shoulder, whereon were bruises that made Leva well-nigh weep as +she saw them, for it was plain that he had been evilly treated for many +days before this. But there on the white skin was the mark of the +king’s line—the red four-armed cross with bent ends which Gunnar and +all his forebears had borne. + +Seeing that, Leva looked up wondering in her husband’s face, and he +answered the question that he saw written in her eyes. + +“He is as I thought—he is Havelok, the son of Gunnar, our king. Hodulf +gave him to me that I might drown him.” + +Then he told her all that had happened, and how from the first time +that he had lifted the sack and felt what was within it he had feared +that this was what was being done. Hodulf would have no rival growing +up beside him, and as he dared not slay him openly, he would have it +thought that he had been stolen away by his father’s friends, and then +folk would maybe wait quietly in hopes that he would come again when +time went on. + +Now Leva bathed Havelok in the great tub, and with the warmth and +comfort of the hot water he waked and was well content, so that +straightway, when he was dressed in Withelm’s holiday clothes, which +fitted him, though he was but seven years old at this time, and Withelm +was a well-grown boy enough for his ten winters, he asked for food, and +they gave him what was yet on the board; and we lived well in Denmark. + +“There is no doubt that he hath a kingly hunger,” quoth Grim as he +watched him. + +“Friend,” said Havelok, hearing this, though it was not meant for his +ears, “it is likely, seeing that this is the third day since I have had +food given me. And I thank you, good people, though I would have you +know that it is the custom to serve the king’s son kneeling.” + +“How should we know that you are the king’s son indeed?” asked Grim. + +“I am Havelok, son of Gunnar,” the boy said gravely. “Yon traitor, +Hodulf, has slain my father, and my two sisters, and driven out my +mother, whither I cannot tell, and now he would drown me.” + +Then the boy could hardly keep a brave front any longer, and he added, +“Yet I do not think that you will do to me as I heard him bid you.” + +Then came over Grim a great pity and sorrow that it should seem needful +thus to sue to him, and there grew a lump in his throat, so that for a +while he might not answer, and the boy thought him in doubt, so that in +his eyes there was a great fear. But Leva wept outright, and threw +herself on her knees beside him, putting her arms round him as he sat, +speaking words of comfort. + +Then Grim knelt also, and said, “Thralls of yours are we, Havelok, son +of Gunnar, and for you shall our lives be given before Hodulf shall +harm you. Nor shall he know that you live until the day comes when you +can go to him sword in hand and helm on head, with half the men of this +realm at your back, and speak to him of what he did and what he +planned, and the vengeance that shall be therefor.” + +So Grim took on himself to be Havelok’s foster-father, and, as he +ended, the boy said with glowing eyes, “I would that I were grown up. +How long shall this be before it comes to pass?” + +And then of a sudden he said, as a tired child will, “Friends, I am +sorely weary. Let me sleep.” + +So Leva took him in her arms and laid him in their own bed; and at once +he slept, so that she left him and came back to Grim by the fireside, +for there was much to be said. + +First of all it was clear that Havelok must be hidden, and it was not +to be supposed that Hodulf would be satisfied until he had seen the +thrall to whom he had trusted such a secret come back for his reward. +If he came not he would be sought; and then he would find out to whom +he had spoken, and there would be trouble enough. + +But it seemed easy to hide Havelok on board the ship, and sail with him +to England as soon as possible. A few days might well pass before a +thrall could get to Hodulf, so that he would suspect nothing just at +first. There were merchants in England who would care for the boy well, +and the two boats might be sunk, so that the king should not ask whose +they were. So when Grim came home again the fisher would be thought of +as drowned on his errand, and Hodulf would be content. + +But then, after a little talk of this, it was plain that all the town +could not be told to say that the fisher was drowned on such a night, +and Hodulf would leave naught undone to find the truth of the matter. +So the puzzle became greater, and the one thing that was clear was that +Grim was in sore danger, and Havelok also. + +Then suddenly outside the dogs barked, and a voice which they obeyed +quieted them. Grim sprang for his axe, which hung on the wall, and went +to the door, whereon someone was knocking gently. + +“Open, uncle; it is I, Arngeir.” + +“What does the boy want at this time?” said Grim, taking down the great +bar that kept the door, axe in hand, for one must be cautious in such +times as these. + +Arngeir came in—a tall young man of twenty, handsome, and like Grim in +ways, for he was his brother’s son. + +“Lucky am I in finding you astir,” he said. “I thought I should have +had to wake you all. Are you just home from sea, or just going out?” + +“Not long home,” answered Leva; “but what has brought you?” + +“I have a guest for you, if I may bring one here at this hour.” + +“A friend of yours never comes at the wrong time,” Grim said. “Why not +bring him in?” + +“If it were a friend of mine and a man he would do well enough at my +house for the night,” said Arngeir, smiling; “but the one for whom I +have come is a lady, and, I think, one in sore trouble.” + +“Who is she?” asked my mother, wondering much. + +“From the king’s town, certainly,” answered Arngeir, “but I do not know +her name. Truth to tell, I forgot to ask it, for she is sorely spent; +and so I made haste to come to you.” + +Then Leva would know how a lady came at this time to Arngeir’s house, +for he was alone, save for his four men, being an orphan without other +kin beside us, and his house was close to our shipyard and the sea. + +“She came not to me, but I found her,” he replied. “My horse is sick, +and I must get up an hour ago and see to it for the second time +tonight. Then as I came from the stable I saw someone go towards the +shipyard, and, as I thought, into the open warehouse. It was dark, and +I could not tell then if this was man or woman; but I knew that no one +had business there, and there are a few things that a thief might pick +up. So I took an axe and one of the dogs, and went to see what was on +hand, but at first there was naught to be found of anyone. If it had +not been for the dog, I think that I should have gone away, but he went +into the corner where the bales of wool are set, and there he whined +strangely, and when I looked, there was this lady on the bales, and she +was weeping and sore afraid. So I asked her what was amiss, and it was +not easy to get an answer at first. But at last she told me that she +had escaped from the burning of the king’s town, and would fain be +taken across the sea into some place of peace. So I cheered her by +saying that you would surely help her; and then I took her to my house +and came to you. Worn and rent are her garments, but one may see that +they have been rich, and I deem her some great lady.” + +“Go and bring her here, husband,” said my mother, on hearing that. + +But he was already going, and at once he and Arngeir went out and down +the street. There were many other ladies and their children who had +taken refuge here with the townsfolk after the burning, and the coming +of this one was but another count in the long tale of trouble that +began on the Welsh shore with the ways of Gunnar, the church’s bane. + +My father was long gone, and the day was breaking when he came back. My +mother slept in the great chair before the fire, for waiting had +wearied her, but she woke as she heard Grim’s footstep, and unbarred +the door to him, ready to welcome the guest that she looked for. But he +was alone, and on his face was the mark of some new trouble, and that a +great one. + +He came in and barred the door after him, and then sat down wearily and +ate for the first time since we had had our meal at sea; and while he +did so Leva asked him nothing, wondering what was wrong, but knowing +that she would hear in good time. And when he had eaten well he spoke. + +“The lady is Eleyn the queen. She has been wandering for these many +days from place to place, sometimes in the woods, and sometimes in +hiding in the cottages of the poor folk, always with a fear of staying +in one place, lest Hodulf should find her, for it is known that he is +seeking her. Then at last one told her of my ship, and she is here to +seek me.” + +Now one may know what the wonder and pity of my mother was, and she +would fain have gone to her. But Grim had left her at Arngeir’s house, +for folk were stirring in the town, and there were many who would know +the queen if they saw her. + +“It will soon be known that Arngeir has a guest,” my mother said, +“whereas none would have wondered had she been here.” + +“By this time tomorrow it will not matter if Hodulf knows,” answered +Grim, “for she will be safe.” + +“Where will you hide her then and what of Havelok?” + +“For those two there is no safety but across the sea, and they are the +most precious cargo that I shall ever have carried. Already Arngeir and +the men are at work on the ship, getting the rollers under her keel, +that she may take the water with the next tide. I shall sail with the +tide that comes with the darkness again, saying that I shall find cargo +elsewhere in other ports, as I have done once before.” + +“I had not looked to say farewell to you quite so soon,” my mother +said; “but this is right. Now I will have all things ready, that the +queen shall be in what comfort she may on the voyage. But it will be +well that none shall know, even of your seamen, who the passengers are, +else will word go to Hodulf in some way hereafter that Havelok has +escaped.” + +“I have thought of that,” answered Grim. “It will be best that none, +not even Radbard, shall know who this is whom we have in the house. A +chance word goes far sometimes.” + +“The boy will tell his name.” + +“There are many who are named after him, and that is no matter. Do you +speak to him, for it is plain that he has sense enough, and bid him say +naught but that he and his mother have escaped from the town, and, if +you will, that he escaped in the sack. I will speak to Radbard, and +there will be no trouble. Only Arngeir must know the truth, and that +not until we are on the high seas perhaps.” + +So there seemed to be no more fear, and in an hour the house was astir, +and there was work enough for all in preparing for the voyage. As for +me, I went down to the ship with my father, and worked there. + +Now, I will say that not for many a long year did I know who this +foster-brother of mine was. It was enough for me to be told that he was +the son of some great man or other with whom Hodulf had a private feud. +Nor did I ever speak of that night’s work to any, for my father bade me +not to do so. Presently I knew, of course, that the lady was Havelok’s +mother; but that told me nothing, for I never heard her name. + +We worked at the ship for three hours or so, stowing the bales of wool +and the other little cargo we had; and then my father sent me to the +fishing-boats for a pair of oars belonging to the ship’s boat that were +there, and, as it fell out, it was a good thing that I and not one of +the men went. When I came to the place where they were drawn up on the +beach, as we had left them last night, there was a stranger talking to +some of the fisher folk, who were working at their nets not far off; +and though another might have paid no heed to this, I, with the +remembrance of last night fresh in my mind, wondered if he was by any +chance there on an errand from Hodulf. I thought that, were I he, I +should surely send someone to know, at least, if the fisher went out +last night after I had spoken with him. So I loitered about until the +man went away, which he did slowly, passing close to me, and looking at +the boats carefully, as if he would remember them. Then I went and +asked the men to whom he had been speaking what he wanted. They said +that they wondered that he had not spoken to me, for he had been asking +about my father and of his ship, and if he took any passenger with him +this voyage. It would seem that he wanted to sail with us, from all he +said. + +Certainly he had begun by asking whose boats these were, and wondered +that a merchant should go fishing at all, when there was no need for +him to do so. Also he had asked if Grim had been out last night, and +they had of course told him that he had not, for neither boat had been +shifted from the berth she had been given when we came in at dusk. + +“Ah,” he had said, “well did I wot that your merchant would do no night +work,” and so made a jest of the matter, saying that in his country it +were below the state of a merchant to have aught to do with a thrall’s +work. He was certainly a Norseman, and they thought that I should find +him with my father. Now I thought otherwise, and also I saw that all +was known. This man was a spy of Hodulf’s, and would go straight back +to his master. My father must hear of this at once; and I hurried back +to the ship, and took him aside and told him. And as I did so his face +grew grey under the tan that sea and wind had given it, and I knew not +altogether why. + +“Tell Arngeir to come to me,” he said; “I am going to the jarl. Tell no +one, but go home and say to mother that I shall be with her in an hour. +Then come back and work here.” + +Then he and Arngeir went to Sigurd, and told him all from the +beginning. And when the jarl heard, he was glad for the safety of the +queen and of Havelok, but he said that there was no doubt that Denmark +was no place for Grim any longer. + +“That is my thought also,” said my father; “but now am I Havelok’s +foster-father, and for him I can make a home across the sea, where I +will train him up for the time that shall surely come, when he shall +return and take his father’s kingdom.” + +“That is well,” the jarl said, “but you have little time. What Hodulf +will do one cannot say, but he may come here with his men behind him to +force me to give you up, and the town will be searched for Havelok, and +both he and the queen will be lost.” + +“If that is so,” my father answered, “we have time enough. Two hours +for the spy to reach his master; one hour for Hodulf to hear him, and +to bethink himself; an hour for gathering his men; and four hours, at +the least, in which to get here. Eight hours, at the least, have we, +and the tide serves in six. I had thought of waiting till dark, but +that is of no use now. We may as well go, for there are true men here, +who will wait to welcome him who flies when he comes again.” + +“This is a sore wrench for you and yours, good friend and faithful,” +Sigurd said, “but it must be. Nevertheless I can make your loss as +little as it may be. You shall sell all that is yours to me at your own +price, that you may have the means to make a new home well, wherever +you may choose.” + +At first my father would not have that, saying that there would be much +trouble on his account presently. + +But Sigurd said that, first, the trouble was not of his making at all; +and next, that if Hodulf plundered the place, it was as well to send +away as much as possible beforehand; and lastly—and this was what +touched my father most—that he must think of his charge. + +“Why, old friend, you are giving up all for Havelok, as would I. And am +I to have no share in the training of him for the days to come?” + +Therewith he waited for no more words, but went to his great chest, and +took thereout chain after chain of linked gold rings, and put them in a +canvas bag, without weighing or counting them, and gave them to Grim. + +“Lord, here is enough to buy half the town!” my father said. + +“What of that? The town is Havelok’s by right, and maybe you can buy +him a village across seas with it. But give me a full quittance for my +purchase of your goods and cattle and house, that I may have right to +them.” + +That Grim did at once, before witnesses who were called in, none +wondering that he chose thus to secure his property while he was away, +because Hodulf might make demands on it. They did not know that any +money changed hands, and thought it formal only, and a wise thing to be +done. + +After that Grim and Arngeir took leave of the jarl, thanking him, and +they went to our house. + +There waited my mother anxiously enough, for she knew from my message +that there was somewhat new to be told, or my father had not left the +ship. Nor do I think that what was to be done was altogether a surprise +to her, for she had thought much, and knew the dangers that might crop +up. So, being very brave, she strove to make light of the trouble that +leaving her home cost her, and set about gathering the few things that +she could take. + +Now on the hearth sat Withelm, tending the fire, and he heard presently +that we were all to go to sea; and that pleased him well, for he had +ever longed to sail with his father. As for Havelok, he had waked once, +and had well eaten, and now was sleeping again. + +Then said Withelm, “When will the sacrifice to Aegir and Ran[5] for +luck on the swan’s path be?” + +“Scant time have we for that,” my father said, “for tide will not +wait.” + +“Then,” said the boy, “it were well to take the stone altar with us, +and make sacrifice on board. I have heard that Aegir is wrathful and +strong.” + +Then my father said to Leva, “The boy is right in one thing, and that +is, that if we are to make a new home beyond the sea, the blue stones +that have belonged to our family since time untold should go with us, +else will there be no luck in this flitting.” + +“What matter?” + +“West they came with us in the days of Odin, and west they shall go +with us once more,” my father said. + +And there was an end of question on the matter, for presently Arngeir +came up with the team of oxen and a sled, and my father hastily cried +to Thor as in time of sudden war, and then on the sled they loaded the +stones easily. I helped, and it is certain that they were no trouble to +uproot or lift, though they were bedded in the ground and heavy. +Wherefrom we all thought that the flitting was by the will of the +Norns, and likely to turn out well. + +But in no way could we lift Thor himself. It was as if he were rooted, +and maybe he was so. Therefore we left him, but sadly. + +One may suppose that, had any noticed that Grim was taking these sacred +things with him, there would have been a talk; but as we sailed light, +none thought them aught but needed ballast; and we brought other stones +to the ship with them and afterwards. + +Of course folk did wonder at this sudden sailing of ours, but my father +made no secret of his wish to get out of the way of Hodulf, who had +taken the ships of one or two other men elsewhere, so that all thought +he feared that his would be the next to be seized, and deemed him +prudent in going. As for our own crew, they were told that it was +certain that the ship would be taken unless we went on this tide, and +so they worked well. + +Very early in the morning, and unseen, Arngeir had brought Eleyn, the +queen, on board, and she was in the cabin under the raised after deck +all the while that the bustle of making ready was going on. Only my +father went in there at any time, unless he gave the key to one of us, +for there he kept his valuables and the arms. + +Presently, when all the men were forward and busy, I got Havelok on +board unnoticed. We had kept Withelm running to and fro from ship to +house with little burdens all the morning, mightily busy; and then, +when the chance came, Havelok in Withelm’s clothes, and with a bundle +on his head, came running to me. I waited by the after cabin, and I +opened the door quickly and let him in. Then he saw his mother; and how +those two met, who had thought each other lost beyond finding, I will +not try to say. + +I closed the door softly and left them, locking it again, and found +Withelm close to me, and Arngeir watching to see that all went well. + +Soon after that there came a Norseman, dressed as a merchant, who +talked with my father of goods, and lading, and whither he was bound, +and the like. When he went away, he thought that he had found out that +we were for the Texel, but I do not know that he was from Hodulf. There +had been time for him to send a spy in haste, however, if he wished to +watch us; but at any rate this man heard naught of our charges. + +Then, at the last moment, my mother and the children came on board, and +at once we hauled out of the harbour. I mind that an old woman ran +along the wharf when she found that all were going, and cried that Dame +Leva had not paid for certain fowls bought of her; and my father +laughed in lightness of heart, and threw her a silver penny, so that +she let us go with a blessing. And after that it did not matter what +the people thought of this going of ours, for in an hour we were far at +sea with a fair wind on the quarter, heading south at first, that the +Norseman might see us, but when the land was dim astern, and there was +no more fear, bearing away south and west for the Humber in far-off +England. + +Now that was the last I saw of Denmark for many a long year, and I knew +it must be so. But, as I have told, none but my father and mother, and +now Arngeir, knew all that we were carrying with us. + + + + +CHAPTER IV. +ACROSS THE SWAN’S PATH. + + +All that night, and during the morning of the next day, we sailed +steadily with a fresh northwest breeze that bade fair to strengthen +by-and-by. If it held, we should see the cliffs of Northumbria on our +bow tomorrow morning, and then would run down the coast to the Humber, +where my father meant to put in first. He thought to leave the queen +and Havelok with merchants whom he knew in Lindsey, and with them would +stay my mother and the little ones while he made a trading voyage +elsewhere. There would be time enough to find out the best place in +which to make a home when the autumn came, and after he had been to an +English port or two that he did not know yet. + +When half the morning was past, the sun shone out warmly, and all came +on deck from the after cabin, where the ladies and children were. Our +men knew by this time that we had passengers, flying like ourselves +from Hodulf, and therefore they were not at all surprised to see +Havelok and his mother with their mistress. None of them had ever seen +either of them before, as it happened, though I do not think that any +could have recognized the queen as she was then, wan and worn with the +terror of her long hiding. Very silent was she as she sat on deck +gazing ever at the long white wake of the ship that seemed to stretch +for a little way towards Denmark, only to fade away as a track over +which one may never go back. And silent, too, was my mother; but the +children, who had no care, were pleased with all things, and Raven and +I were full of the ways of old seamen. + +So everything went quietly until after we had our midday meal. We were +all amidships on the wide deck, except my father and Arngeir, who sat +side by side on the steersman’s bench on the high poop. There was no +spray coming on board, for we were running, and the ship was very +steady. Raven and I were forward with the men, busy with the many +little things yet to be done to the rigging and such like that had been +left in the haste at last, and there was no thought but that this +quiet, save for some shift of wind maybe, would last until we saw the +English shore. + +Now I do not know if my father had seen aught from the after deck, but +presently he came forward, and passed up the steps to the forecastle, +and there sat down on the weather rail, looking out to leeward for some +time quietly. I thought that maybe he had sighted some of the high land +on the Scots coast, for it was clear enough to see very far, and so I +went to see also. But there was nothing, and we talked of this and that +for ten minutes, when he said, “Look and see if you can catch sight of +aught on the skyline just aft of the fore stay as you sit.” + +I looked long, and presently caught sight of something white that +showed for a moment as we heaved up on a wave, and then was gone. + +“Somewhat I saw,” I said, “but it has gone. It might have been the top +of a sail.” + +Then I caught a glimpse of it again, and my father saw it also, and, as +we watched, it hove up slowly until it was plain to be seen. The vessel +it belonged to was sailing in such a way as to cross our course in the +end, though she was only a few points nearer the wind than we were. It +seemed that she was swifter than ourselves, too, from the way she kept +her place on our bow. Now a merchant must needs look on every sail with +more or less distrust, as there is always a chance of meeting with +ship-plundering Vikings, though the best of them will do naught but +take toll from a trader on the high seas. So before long all our men +were watching the stranger, and soon it was plain that she was a +longship, fresh from her winter quarters. We thought, therefore, that +she was not likely to trouble about us, having no need of stores as +yet, and we being plainly in ballast only. Nor did she alter her course +in any way, but mile after mile she sailed with us, always edging up +nearer as she went, until at last we could see the men on her bows and +the helmsman at his place. + +I thought that one could hardly see a more handsome ship than she was, +fresh with new paint, and with her dragon head shining golden in the +sun. But I had seen her before, and that in no pleasant way. She was +the ship of which I have already spoken—that which we beat off two +years ago, taking their cargo of plunder by way of amends for being +attacked. + +There was this difference, however, at that time, that then we had all +our men on board, and the Viking was short-handed after a fighting +raid, whereas now we had but fifteen men instead of five-and-twenty, +because in the hurry we had not had time to summon any who lived beyond +the town, and it was plain that the Viking had a full crew, maybe of +sixty men. + +“It is in my mind,” my father said to Arngeir, “that our old foe will +think twice before he attacks us again; but seeing whom we have to deal +with, it is as well to be ready. We might keep him off with arrows, if +he does not find out how few we are, should he make an attempt on us; +but if he boards, we must submit, and make the best bargain we can.” + +So he passed word that the men were to lie down on deck, leaving only a +few to be seen, that the Viking might think us as he had known us +before; and then the arms-chests were opened, and the bows and throwing +weapons were set to hand by us boys while the men armed themselves. + +Then my father spoke to them, saying, “I do not know if this Viking +will pass us by as too hard a nut to crack, seeing that he knows of us +already; but if he does not, it will be of no use our trying to fight +him, as you can see. I would not waste your lives for naught. But it +may be that a show of force will keep him off, so we will wait under +arms until we are sure what he will do.” + +Then the men broke out, saying that they had beaten this man before +with him as leader, and they were in no mind to give up without a +fight. + +“Well, then,” my father answered, “it is plain that you will back me, +and so I will call on you if there is need or chance. But we have the +women folk to think of now, and we must not risk aught.” + +Now the longship held on her course steadily, never shifting her helm +for so much as a point. In half an hour or so we must be alongside one +another, at this rate, and that Arngeir did not altogether like the +look of, for it would seem as if she meant to find out all about us at +least. There was some little sea running, and it might be thought +easier to board us on the lee side, therefore. We could not get away +from her in any way, for even now, while she was closer hauled than we, +she kept pace with us, and had she paid off to the same course as +ourselves, she would have left us astern in a very short time. + +Presently a man swarmed up her rigging in order to look down on our +decks, and as he went up, my father bade our men crawl over to +windward, so that he should see all one gunwale lined with men, and so +think that both were, and deem that we were setting a trap for them in +order to entice them alongside by pretending to be hardly manned. At +the same time, he sent the ladies and children into the cabin, so that +they might not be seen. + +That did not please Havelok at all, for he seemed to scent a fight in +the air, and wanted weapons, that he might stand beside the other men, +asking for an axe for choice. It was all that I could do to quiet him +by saying that if there was any need of him I would call him, but that +just now we thought the Vikings would go away if they saw many warriors +on deck. Which indeed was all that we hoped, but he thought that would +spoil sport, and so hastened into the shelter. + +After that there fell a silence on us, for at any moment now we might +be hailed by the other ship. And when we were but a bow shot apart the +hail came. The two vessels were then broadside on to each other, we a +little ahead, if anything. My father was steering now, fully armed, and +Arngeir was beside him with myself. I had the big shield wherewith one +guards the helmsman if arrows are flying. + +The Viking bade us strike sail, and let him come alongside, but my +father made no answer. Still we held on, and the Viking paid off a +little, as though he were not so sure if it were wise to fall on us, as +we showed no fear of him. + +Then my father spoke to Arngeir in a stern voice that I had heard only +when we met this same ship before. + +“This will not last long. If there is one chance for us, it is to run +him down and it may be done. Our ship will stand the blow, for these +longships are but eggshells beside her. Pass the word for the men to +shoot the steersman when I give the word. Then they must run forward, +lest the Vikings climb over the bows as we strike her.” + +Arngeir’s eyes flashed at that, and at once he went to the men, and +there was a click and rattle as the arrows went to string, and they +gathered themselves together in readiness to leap up when the word +came. There seemed every chance that we should be upon the longship +before they knew what we were about, for we had the weather gauge. + +Now the Viking hailed again, and again bore up for us a little, whereat +my father smiled grimly, for it helped his plan. And this time, as +there was no answer, his men sent an arrow or two on board, which did +no harm. + +“It is plain that we are to be taken,” my father said on that, “so we +will wait no longer. Stand by, men, and one lucky shot will do all. +Shoot!” + +The helm went up as he spoke, and the men leaped to their feet, raining +arrows round the two men who were at the helm, and down on the Viking +we swept with a great cheer. + +But in a moment there were four men on her after deck, and whether the +first helmsman was shot I cannot say; but I think not, for quickly as +we had borne down on her she was ready, rushing away from us, instead +of luffing helplessly, as we had expected. It would almost have seemed +that our move had been looked for. + +Ten more minutes passed while we exchanged arrow flights, and then the +longship had so gained on us that she struck sail and waited for us +with her long oars run out and ready. + +“That is all we can do,” said my father, with a sort of groan. “Put up +your weapons, men, for it is no good fighting now.” + +They did so, growling; and as we neared the longship, her oars took the +water, and she flew alongside of us, and a grappling hook flung deftly +from her bows caught our after gunwale, and at once she dropped astern, +and swung to its chain as to a tow line. We were not so much as bidden +to strike sail now, and the Vikings began to crowd forward in order to +board us by the stern, as the grappling chain was hove short by their +windlass. + +“Hold on,” my father cried to them “we give up. Where is your chief?” + +Now the men were making way for him when a strange thing happened. Out +of the after cabin ran Havelok when he heard that word, crying that it +was not the part of good warriors to give up while they could wield +sword—words that surely he had learned from Gunnar, his father. And +after him came his mother, silent, and terrified lest he should be +harmed. + +Havelok ran up the steps to my father, and the queen followed. I have +said that there was a little sea running, and this made the ships jerk +and strain at the chain that held them together fiercely, now that it +was so short. And even as the queen came to the top step, where there +was no rail, for the steps were not amidships, but alongside the +gunwale, one of these jerks came; and in a moment she was in the sea, +and in a moment also Arngeir was after her, for he was a fine swimmer. + +The Vikings cried out as they saw this, but the poor queen said no +word, nor did she ever rise again after the first time. It is likely +that she was drawn under the longship at once. + +So for a little while there was no talk of terms or fighting, but all +held their breath as they watched to see if the queen floated alongside +anywhere; but there was only Arngeir, who swam under the lee of the +Viking, and called to her men for guidance. They threw him a rope’s end +as he came to the stern, and he clung to it for a little while, hoping +to see the flash of a white hood that the queen wore, over the white +wave crests: but at last he gave up, and the Vikings hauled him on +board, praising him for his swimming, as he had on his mail. + +Then the chief turned to my father, and spoke to him across the few +fathoms of water that were between the ships. + +“We meet again, Grim, as time comes round; and now I have a mind to let +you go, though I have that old grudge against you, for I think that +your wife is loss enough.” + +“Not my wife, Arnvid, but a passenger—one whom I would not have lost +for all that you can take from me.” + +“Well, I am glad it is no worse. But it seems that you are in ballast. +How comes it that you have no cargo for me, for you owe me one?” + +Then my father told him shortly that he had fled from Hodulf; and all +those doings were news to the Viking, so that they talked in friendly +wise, while the men listened, and the ships crept on together down the +wind. + +But when all was told, save of the matter of Havelok, and who the lost +lady was, the Viking laughed shortly, and said, “Pleasant gossip, Grim, +but not business. What will you give us to go away in peace? I do not +forget that you all but ran us down just now, and that one or two of us +have arrows sticking in us which came from your ship. But that first +was a good bit of seamanship, and there is not much harm from the +last.” + +“Well,” said my father, “it seems to me that you owe me a ship, for it +is certain that I once had that one, and gave her back to you.” + +The Viking laughed. + +“True enough, and therefore I give you back your ship now, and we are +quits. But I am coming on board to see what property I can lift.” + +My father shrugged his shoulders, and turned away, and at once the +Vikings hauled on the chain until their dragon head was against our +quarter, when the chief and some twenty of his men came on board. The +way in which they took off the hatches without staying to question +where they should begin told a tale of many a like plundering. + +Then, I do not know how it was rightly, for I was aft with my father, +there began a quarrel between the Vikings and our men; and though both +Grim and the chief tried to stop it, five of our few were slain +outright, and three more badly hurt before it was ended. The rest of +our crew took refuge on the fore deck, and there bided after that. The +whole fray was over in a few minutes, and it seemed that the Vikings +half expected somewhat of the sort. + +Then they took all the linen and woollen goods, and our spare sails, +and all the arms and armour from the men and from the chests to their +own ship. Only they left my father and Arngeir their war gear, saying +that it were a shame to disarm two brave men. + +Then the chief said, “Little cargo have you, friend Grim, and therefore +I am the more sure that you have store of money with you. Even flight +from Hodulf would not prevent you from taking that wherewith to trade. +So I must have it; and it rests with you whether we tear your ship to +splinters in hunting for your hiding place or not.” + +“I suppose there is no help for it, but I will say that the most of +what I have is not mine,” said my father. + +“Why, what matter? When one gives gold into the hands of a seafarer, +one has to reckon with such chances as this. You must needs hand it +over.” + +So, as there was naught else to do, Grim brought out the jarl’s heavy +bag, and gave it to the chief, who whistled to himself as he hefted it. + +“Grim,” he said, “for half this I would have let you go without sending +a man on board. What is this foolishness? You must have known that.” + +“The gold is not mine,” my father answered; “it was my hope that you +would have been content with the cargo.” + +“Well, I have met with an honest man for once,” the Viking said; and he +called his men, and they cast off and left us. + +But we were in no happy plight when he had gone away to the eastward on +his old course. Half our men were gone, for the wounded were of no use, +and the loss of the queen weighed heavily on us. And before long it +began to blow hard from the north, and we had to shorten sail before +there was real need, lest it should be too much for us few presently, +as it certainly would have been by the time that darkness fell, for the +gale strengthened. + +Then, added to all this, there was trouble in the cabin under the after +deck, for since his mother was lost, Havelok had spoken no word. I had +brought him down to my mother from the deck, and had left him with her, +hoping that he did not know what had happened; but now he was in a high +fever, and sorely ill. Perhaps he would have been so in any case, after +the long days of Hodulf’s cruelty, but he had borne them well. A child +is apt, however, to give up, as it were, suddenly. + +So, burdened with trouble, we drove before the gale, and the only +pleasant thing was to see how the good ship behaved in it, while at +least we were on our course all the time. Therefore, one could not say +that there was any danger; and but for these other things, none would +have thought much of wind or sea, which were no worse than we had +weathered many a time before. We had sea room, and no lee shore to +fear, and the ship was stanch, and no sailor can ask for more than +that. + + + + +CHAPTER V. +STORM AND SHIPWRECK. + + +The gale held without much change through the night, and then with +morning shifted a few points to the westward, which was nothing to +complain of. The sea rose, and a few rain squalls came up and passed; +but they had no weight in them, and did not keep the waves down as a +steady fall will. And all day long it was the same, and the ship fled +ever before it. There was no thought now of reaching any port we might +wish, but least of all did we think of making the Lindsey shore, which +lies open to the north and east. When the gale broke, we must find +harbour where we could; and indeed; to my father at this time all ports +were alike, as refuge from Hodulf. When darkness came again one of the +wounded men died, and Havelok was yet ill in the after cabin, so that +my mother was most anxious for him. The plunging ship was no place for +a sick child. + +Now it was not possible for us to tell how far we had run since we had +parted from the Viking, and all we knew was that we had no shore to +fear with the wind as it was, and therefore nothing but patience was +needed. But in the night came a sudden lull in the gale that told of a +change at hand, and in half an hour it was blowing harder than ever +from the northeast, and setting us down to the English coast fast, for +we could do naught but run before such a wind. It thickened up also, +and was very dark even until full sunrise, so that one could hardly +tell when the sun was above the sea’s rim. + +I crept from the fore cabin about this time, after trying in vain to +sleep, and found the men sheltering under the break of the deck and +looking always to leeward. Two of them were at the steering oar with my +father, for Arngeir was worn out, and I had left him in the cabin, +sleeping heavily in spite of the noise of waves and straining planking. +Maybe he would have waked in a moment had that turmoil ceased. + +It was of no use trying to speak to the men without shouting in their +ears, and getting to windward to do that, moreover, and so I looked +round to see if there was any change coming. But all was grey overhead, +and a grey wall of rain and flying drift from the wave tops was all +round us, blotting out all things that were half a mile from us, if +there were anything to be blotted out. It always seems as if there must +be somewhat beyond a thickness of any sort at sea. But there was one +thing that I did notice, and that was that the sea was no longer grey, +as it had been yesterday, but was browner against the cold sky, while +the foam of the following wave crests was surely not so white as it had +been, and at this I wondered. + +Then I crawled aft and went to my father and asked him what he thought +of the wind and the chance of its dropping. He had had the lead going +for long now. + +“We are right off the Humber mouth, to judge by the colour of the +water,” he told me, “or else off the Wash, which is more to the south. +I cannot tell which rightly, for we have run far, and maybe faster than +I know. If only one could see—” + +There he stopped, and I knew enough to understand that we were in some +peril unless a shift of wind came very soon, since the shore was under +our lee now, if by good luck we were not carried straight into the +great river itself. So for an hour or more I watched, and all the time +it seemed that hope grew less, for the sea grew shorter, as if against +tide, and ever its colour was browner with the mud of the Trent and her +sisters. + +Presently, as I clung to the rail, there seemed to grow a new sound +over and amid all those to which I had become used—as it were a low +roaring that swelled up in the lulls, and sank and rose again. And I +knew what it was, and held up my hand to my father, listening, and he +heard also. It was the thunder of breakers on a sandy coast to leeward. + +He put his whistle to his lips and called shrilly, and the men saw him +if they could not hear, and sprang up, clawing aft through the water +that flooded the waist along the rail. + +“Breakers to leeward, men,” he cried “we must wear ship, and then shall +clear them. We shall be standing right into Humber after that, as I +think.” + +Arngeir heard the men trampling, if not the whistle, and he was with us +directly, and heard what was to be done. + +“It is a chance if the yard stands it,” he said, looking aloft. + +“Ay, but we cannot chance going about in this sea, and we are too short +of men to lower and hoist again. Listen!” + +Arngeir did so, and heard for the first time the growing anger of the +surf on the shore, and had no more doubt. We were then running with the +wind on the port quarter, and it was useless to haul closer to the wind +on that tack, whereas if we could wear safely we should be leaving the +shore at once by a little closer sailing. + +“Ran is spreading her nets,” said Arngeir, “but if all holds, she will +have no luck with her fishing.”[6] + +Then we manned the main sheet and the guys from the great yards, but we +were all too few for the task, which needed every man of the fifteen +that we had sailed with. There was the back stay to be set up afresh on +the weather quarter for the new tack also, and three men must see to +that. + +We watched my father’s hand for the word, and steadily sheeted home +until all seemed to be going well. But the next moment there was a +crash and a cry, and we were a mastless wreck, drifting helplessly. +Maybe some flaw of wind took us as the head of the great sail went +over, but its power was too much for the men at guys and back stay, and +they had the tackle torn through their hands. The mast snapped six feet +above the deck, smashing the gunwales as it fell forward and overboard, +but hurting none of us. + +Then a following sea or two broke over the stern, and I was washed from +the poop, for I had been at the sheet, down to the deck, and there +saved myself among the fallen rigging, half drowned. One of the men was +washed overboard at the same time, but a bight of the rigging that was +over the side caught him under the chin, and his mates hauled him on +board again by the head, as it were. He was wont to make a jest of it +afterward, saying that he was not likely to be hanged twice, but he had +a wry neck from that day forward. + +No more seas came over us, for the wreck over the bows brought us head +to wind, though we shipped a lot of water across the decks as she +rolled in the sea. Then we rode to the drag of the fallen sail for a +time, and it seemed quiet now that there was no noise of wind screaming +in rigging above us. But all the while the thunder of the breakers grew +nearer and plainer. + +I bided where I was, for the breath was knocked out of me for the +moment. I saw my father lash the helm, and then he and the rest got the +two axes that hung by the cabin door, and came forward with them. The +mast was pounding our side in a way that would start the planking +before long, and it must be cut adrift, and by that time I could join +him. + +When that was done, and it did not take long, we cleared the anchor and +cable and let go, for it was time. The sound of the surf was drowning +all else. But the anchor held, and the danger was over for the while, +and as one might think altogether; but the tide was running against the +gale, and what might happen when it turned was another matter. + +Now we got the sail on deck again, and unlaced it from the yard, +setting that in place with some sort of rigging, ready to be stepped as +a mast if the wind shifted to any point that might help us off shore. + +It may be thought how we watched that one cable that held us from the +waves and the place where they broke, for therein lay our only chance, +and we longed for the clear light that comes after rain, that we might +see the worst, at least, if we were to feel it. But the anchor held, +and presently we lost the feeling of a coming terror that had been over +us, the utmost peril being past. My father went to the after cabin now, +and though the poor children were bruised with the heavy rolling of the +ship as she came into the wind, they were all well save Havelok, and he +had fallen asleep in my mother’s arms at last. + +With the turn of the tide, which came about three hours after midday, +the clouds broke, and slowly the land grew out of the mists until we +could see it plainly, though it was hardly higher than the sea that +broke over it in whirling masses of spindrift. By-and-by we could see +far-off hills beyond wide-stretching marshlands that looked green and +rich across yellow sandhills that fringed the shore. And from them we +were not a mile, and at their feet were such breakers as no ship might +win through, though, if we might wait until they were at rest, the +level sand was good for beaching at the neap tides. For we were well +into Humber mouth, and to the northward of us, across the yellow water, +was the long point of Spurn, and the ancient port of Ravenspur, with +its Roman jetties falling into decay under the careless hand of the +Saxon, under its shelter. There was no port on this southern side of +the Humber, though farther south was Tetney Haven and again Saltfleet, +to which my father had been, but neither in nor out of them might a +vessel get in a northeast gale. + +I have said that this clearness came with the turn of the tide, and now +that began to flow strongly, setting in with the wind with more than +its wonted force, for the northwest shift of the gale had kept it from +falling, as it always will on this coast. That, of course, I learned +later, but it makes plain what happened next. Our anchor began to drag +with the weight of both tide and wind, and that was the uttermost of +our dread. + +Slowly it tore through its holding, and as it were step by step at +first, and once we thought it stopped when we had paid out all the +cable. But wind and sea were too strong, and presently again we saw the +shore marks shifting, and we knew that there was no hope. The ship must +touch the ground sooner or later, and then the end would come with one +last struggle in the surf, and on shore was no man whose hand might be +stretched to drag a spent man to the land, if he won through. It would +have seemed less lonely had one watched us, but I did not know then +that no pity for the wrecked need be looked for from the marshmen of +the Lindsey shore. There was not so much as a fisher’s boat of wicker +and skins in sight on the sandhills, where one might have looked to see +some drawn up. + +Now my father went to the cabin and told my mother that things were at +their worst, and she was very brave. + +“If you are to die at this time, husband,” she said, “it is good that I +shall die with you. Better it is, as I think, than a sickness that +comes to one and leaves the other. But after that you will go to the +place of Odin, to Valhalla; but I whither?” + +Then spoke little Withelm, ever thoughtful, and now not at all afraid. + +“If Freya wants not a sailor’s wife who is willing to fight the waves +with Grim, my father, it will be strange.” + +My mother was wont to say that this saying of the child’s did much to +cheer her at that time, but there is little place for a woman in the +old faiths. So she smiled at him, and that made him bold to speak of +what he had surely been thinking since the storm began. + +“I suppose that Aegir is wroth because we made no sacrifice to him +before we set sail. I think that I would cast the altar stones to him, +that he may know that we meant to do so.” + +This sounds a child’s thought only, and so it was; but it set my father +thinking, and in the end helped us out of trouble. + +“I have heard,” my father said, “that men in our case have thrown +overboard the high-seat pillars, and have followed them to shore +safely. We have none, but the stones are more sacred yet. Overboard +they shall go, and as the boat with them goes through the surf we may +learn somewhat.” + +With that he hastened on deck, and told the men what he would do; and +they thought it a good plan, as maybe they would have deemed anything +that seemed to call for help from the strong ones of the sea. So they +got the boat ready to launch over the quarter, and the four stones, +being uncovered since the Vikings took our cargo, were easily got on +deck, and they were placed in the bottom of the boat, and steadied +there with coils of fallen rigging, so that they could not shift. They +were just a fair load for the boat. Then my father cried for help to +the Asir, bidding Aegir take the altar as full sacrifice; and when we +had done so we waited for a chance as a long wave foamed past us, and +launched the boat fairly on its back, so that she seemed to fly from +our hands, and was far astern in a moment. + +Now we looked to see her make straight for the breakers, lift on the +first of them, and then capsize. That first line was not a quarter of a +mile from us now. + +But she never reached them. She plunged away at first, heading right +for the surf, and then went steadily westward, and up the shore line +outside it, until she was lost to sight among the wild waves, for she +was very low in the water. + +“Cheer up, men,” my father said, as he saw that; “we are not ashore +yet, nor will be so long as the tide takes that current along shore. We +shall stop dragging directly.” + +And so it was, for when the ship slowly came to the place where the +boat had changed her course, the anchor held once more for a while +until the gathering strength of the tide forced it to drag again. Now, +however, it was not toward the shore that we drifted, but up the +Humber, as the boat had gone; and as we went the sea became less heavy, +for we were getting into the lee of the Spurn headland. + +Soon the clouds began to break, flying wildly overhead with patches of +blue sky and passing sunshine in between them that gladdened us. The +wind worked round to the eastward at the same time, and we knew that +the end of the gale had come. But, blowing as it did right into the +mouth of the river, the sea became more angry, and it would be worse +yet when the tide set again outwards. Already we had shipped more water +than was good, and we might not stand much more. It seemed best, +therefore, to my father that we should try to run as far up the Humber +as we might while we had the chance, for the current that held us safe +might change as tide altered in force and depth. + +So we buoyed the cable, not being able to get the anchor in this sea, +and then stepped the yard in the mast’s place, and hoisted the peak of +the sail corner-wise as best we might; and that was enough to heel us +almost gunwale under as the cable was slipped and the ship headed about +up the river mouth. We shipped one or two more heavy seas as she paid +off before the wind, but we were on the watch for them, and no harm was +done. + +After that the worst was past, for every mile we flew over brought us +into safer waters; and now we began to wonder where the boat with its +strange cargo had gone, and we looked out for her along the shore as we +sailed, and at last saw her, though it was a wonder that we did so. + +The tide had set her into a little creek that opened out suddenly, and +there Arngeir saw her first, aground on a sandbank, with the lift of +each wave that crept into the haven she had found sending her higher on +it. And my father cried to us that we had best follow her; and he put +the helm over, while we sheeted home and stood by for the shock of +grounding. + +Then in a few minutes we were in a smother of foam across a little sand +bar, and after that in quiet water, and the sorely-tried ship was safe. +She took the ground gently enough in the little creek, not ten score +paces from where the boat was lying, and we were but an arrow flight +from the shore. As the tide rose the ship drifted inward toward it, so +that we had to wait only for the ebb that we might go dry shod to the +land. + +Before that time came there was rest for us all, and we needed it +sorely. It was a wonder that none of the children had been hurt in the +wild tossing of the ship, but children come safely through things that +would be hard on a man. Bruised they were and very hungry, but somehow +my mother had managed to steady them on the cabin floor, and they were +none the worse, only Havelok slept even yet with a sleep that was too +heavy to be broken by the worst of the tossing as he lay in my mother’s +lap. She could not tell if this heavy sleep was good or not. + +Then we saw to the wounded men, and thereafter slept in the sun or in +the fore cabin as each chose, leaving Arngeir only on watch. It was +possible that the shore folk would be down to the strand soon, seeking +for what the waves might have sent them, and the tide must be watched +also. + +Just before its turn he woke us, for it was needful that we should get +a line ashore to prevent the ship from going out with the ebb, and with +one I swam ashore. There was not so much as a stump to which to make +fast, and so one of the men followed me, and we went to the boat, set +the altar stones carefully ashore, then fetched the spare anchor, and +moored her with that in a place where the water seemed deep to the +bank. + +It was a bad place. For when the tide fell, which it did very fast, we +found that we had put her on a ledge. Presently therefore, and while we +were trying to bail out the water that was in her, the ship took the +ground aft, and we could not move her before the worst happened. +Swiftly the tide left her, and her long keel bent and twisted, and her +planks gaped with the strain of her own weight, all the greater for the +water yet in her that flowed to the hanging bows. The good ship might +sail no more. Her back was broken. + +That was the only time that I have ever seen my father weep. But as the +stout timbers cracked and groaned under the strain it seemed to him as +if the ship that he loved was calling piteously to him for help that he +could not give, and it was too much for him. The gale that was yet +raging overhead and the sea that was still terrible in the wide waters +of the river had been things that had not moved him, for that the ship +should break up in a last struggle with them was, as it were, a fitting +end for her. But that by his fault here in the hardly-won haven she +should meet her end was not to be borne, and he turned away from us and +wept. + +Then came my mother and set her hand on his shoulder and spoke softly +to him with wise words. + +“Husband, but a little while ago it would have been wonderful if there +were one of us left alive, or one plank of the ship on another. And now +we are all safe and unhurt, and the loss of the ship is the least of +ills that might have been.” + +“Nay, wife,” he said; “you cannot understand.” + +“Then it is woe for the—for the one who is with us. But how had it been +if you had seen Hodulf and his men round our house, and all the +children slain that one might not escape, while on the roof crowed the +red cock, and naught was left to us? We have lost less than if we had +stayed for that, and we have gained what we sought, even safety. See, +to the shore have come the ancient holy things of our house, and that +not by your guidance. Surely here shall be the place for us that is +best.” + +“Ay, wife; you are right in all these things, but it is not for them.” + +Then she laughed a little, forcing herself to do so, as it seemed. + +“Why, then, it is for the ship that I was ever jealous of, for she took +you away from me. Now I think that I should be glad that she can do so +no more. But I am not, for well I know what the trouble must be, and I +would have you think no more of it. The good ship has saved us all, and +so her work is done, and well done. Never, if she sailed many a long +sea mile with you, would anything be worth telling of her besides this. +And the burden of common things would surely be all unmeet for her +after what she has borne hither.” + +“It is well said, Leva, my wife,” my father answered. + +From that time he was cheerful, and told us how it was certain that we +had been brought here for good, seeing that the Norns[7] must have led +the stones to the haven, so that this must be the place that we sought. + + + + +CHAPTER VI. +THE BEGINNING OF GRIMSBY TOWN. + + +Easily we went ashore when the tide fell, across the spits of sand that +ran between the mud banks, and we climbed the low sandhill range that +hid the land from us, and saw the place where we should bide. And it +might have been worse; for all the level country between us and the +hills was fat, green meadow and marsh, on which were many cattle and +sheep feeding. Here and there were groves of great trees, hemmed in +with the quickset fences that are as good as stockades for defence +round the farmsteads of the English folk, and on other patches of +rising ground were the huts of thralls or herdsmen, and across the wide +meadows glittered and flashed streams and meres, above which the +wildfowl that the storm had driven inland wheeled in clouds. All the +lower hills seemed to be wooded thickly, and the alder copses that +would shelter boar and deer and maybe wolves stretched in some places +thence across the marsh. Pleasant and homely seemed all this after long +looking at the restless sea. + +Then said my father, “Now am I no longer Grim the merchant, and that +pride of mine is at an end. But here is a place where Grim the fisher +may do well enough, if I am any judge of shore and sea. Here have we +haven for the boats, and yonder swim the fish, and inland are the towns +that need them. Nor have we seen a sign of a fisher so far as we have +come.” + +Now we had been seen as soon as we stood on the sandhills; and before +long the herdsman and thralls began to gather to us, keeping aloof +somewhat at first, as if fearing my father’s arms. But when we spoke +with them we could learn nothing, for they were Welsh marshmen who knew +but little of the tongue of their English masters. Serfs they were now +in these old fastnesses of theirs to the English folk of the +Lindiswaras, who had won their land and called it after their own name, +Lindsey. + +But before long there rode from one of the farmsteads an Englishman of +some rank, who had been sent for, as it would seem, and he came with +half a dozen armed housecarls behind him to see what was going on. Him +we could understand well enough, for there is not so much difference +between our tongue and that of the English; and when he learned our +plight he was very kindly. His name was Witlaf Stalling, and he was the +great man of these parts, being lord over many a mile of the marsh and +upland, and dwelling at his own place, Stallingborough, some five miles +to the north and inland hence. + +Now it had been in this man’s power to seize us and all we had as his +own, seeing that we were cast on his shore; but he treated us as guests +rather, bidding us shelter in one of his near farmsteads as long as we +would, and telling my father to come and speak with him when we had +saved what we could from the wreck. He bade the thralls help at that +also, so that we had fallen in with a friend, and our troubles were +less for his kindness. + +We saved what cargo we had left during the next few days, while we +dwelt at the farm. Then at the height of the spring tides the ship +broke up, for a second gale came before the sea that the last had +raised was gone. And then I went with my father to speak with Witlaf +the thane at Stallingborough, that we might ask his leave to make our +home on the little haven, and there become fishers once more. + +That he granted readily, asking many questions about our troubles, for +he wondered that one who had owned so good a ship seemed so content to +become a mere fisher in a strange land, without thought of making his +way home. But all that my father told him was that he had had to fly +from the new king of our land, and that he had been a fisher before, so +that there was no hardship in the change. + +“Friend Grim,” said Witlaf when he had heard this, “you are a brave +man, as it seems to me, and well may you prosper here, as once before. +I will not stand in your way. Now, if you will hold it from me on +condition of service in any time of war, to be rendered by yourself and +your sons and any men you may hire, I will grant you what land you will +along the coast, so that none may question you in anything. Not that +the land is worth aught to any but a fisher who needs a place for boats +and nets; but if you prosper, others will come to the place, and you +shall be master.” + +One could hardly have sought so much as that, and heartily did we thank +the kindly thane, gladly taking the fore shore as he wished. But he +said that he thought the gain was on his side, seeing what men he had +won. + +“Now we must call the place by a name, for it has none,” he said, +laughing. “Grim’s Stead, maybe?” + +“Call the place a town at once,” answered my father, laughing also. +“Grimsby has a good sound to a homeless man.” + +So Grimsby the place has been from that day forward, and, as I suppose, +will be now to the end of time. But for a while there was only the one +house that we built of the timbers and planks of our ship by the side +of the haven—a good house enough for a fisher and his family, but not +what one would look for from the name. + +By the time that was built Havelok was himself again, though he had +been near to his death. Soon he waxed strong and rosy in the sea winds, +and out-went Withelm both in stature and strength. But it seemed that +of all that had happened he remembered naught, either of the storm, or +of his mother’s death, or of the time of Hodulf. My mother thought that +the sickness had taken away his memory, and that it might come back in +time. But from the day we came to the house on the shore he was content +to call Grim and Leva father and mother, and ourselves were his +brothers, even as he will hold us even now. Yet my father would never +take him with us to the fishing, as was right, seeing who he was and +what might lie before him. Nor did he ever ask to go, as we had asked +since we were able to climb into the boat as she lay on the shore; and +we who knew not who he was, and almost forgot how he came to us, ceased +to wonder at this after a while; and it seemed right that he should be +the home-stayer, as if there must needs be one in every household. + +Nevertheless he was always the foremost in all our sports, loving the +weapon play best of all, so that it was no softness that kept him from +the sea. I hold that the old saw that says, “What is bred in the bone +cometh out in the flesh,” is true, and never truer than in the ways of +Havelok. + +For it is not to be thought that because my father went back perforce +to the fisher’s calling he forgot that the son of Gunnar Kirkeban +should be brought up always in such wise that when the time came he +should be ready to go to the slayer of his father, sword in hand, and +knowing how to use it. Therefore both Havelok and we were trained +always in the craft of the warrior. + +Witlaf the thane was right when he said that men would draw to the +place if we prospered, and it was not so long before the name that had +been a jest at first was so no longer. Truly we had hard times at +first, for our one ship’s boat was all unfitted for the fishing; but +the Humber teemed with fish, and there were stake nets to be set that +need no boat. None seemed to care for taking the fish but ourselves, +for the English folk had no knowledge of the riches to be won from the +sea, and the eels of the river were the best that they ever saw. So +they were very ready to buy, and soon the name of Grim the fisher was +known far and wide in Lindsey, for my father made great baskets of the +willows of the marsh, and carried his burden of fish through the land, +alone at first, until we were able to help him, while Arngeir and we +minded the nets. + +Only two of our men stayed here with us, being fishers and old comrades +of my father. The rest he bade find their way home to Denmark to their +wives and children, from the Northumbrian coast, or else take service +with the king, Ethelwald, who ruled in East Anglia, beyond the Wash, +who, being a Dane by descent from the Jutes who took part with Angles +and Saxons in winning this new land, was glad to have Danish men for +his housecarls. Some went to him, and were well received there, as we +knew long afterwards. + +The man who had been washed overboard and hauled back at risk of his +neck was one of these. His name was Mord, and he would have stayed with +us; but my father thought it hard that he should not have some better +chance than we could give him here, for it was not easy to live at +first. Somewhat of the same kind he said to Arngeir, for he had heard +of this king when he had been in the king’s new haven in the Wash some +time ago. But Arngeir would by no means leave the uncle who had been as +a father to him. + +Now when we marked out the land that Witlaf gave us, there was a good +omen. My father set the four blue altar stones at each corner of the +land as the boundaries, saying that thus they would hallow all the +place, rather than make an altar again of them here where there was no +grove to shelter them, or, indeed, any other spot that was not open, +where a holy place might be. And when we measured the distances between +them a second time they were greater than at first, which betokens the +best of luck to him whose house is to be there. I suppose that they +will bide in these places now while Grimsby is a town, for, as every +one knows, it is unlucky to move a boundary stone. + +Soon my father found a man who had some skill in the shipwright’s +craft, and brought him to our place from Saltfleet. Then we built as +good a boat as one could wish, and, not long after that, another. But +my father was careful that none of the Lindsey folk whom he had known +should think that this fisher was the Grim whom they had once traded +with, lest word should go to Hodulf in any way. + +Now we soon hired men to help us, and the fishing throve apace. We +carried the fish even to the great city of Lincoln, where Alsi the +Lindsey king had his court, though it was thirty miles away. For we had +men in the villages on the road who took the great baskets on from one +to another, and always Grim and one of us were there on the market day, +and men said that never had the town and court seen such fish as Grim’s +before. Soon, therefore, he was rich, for a fisher; and that was heard +of by other fishers from far off, and they drew to Grimsby, so that the +town spread, and Witlaf the good thane said that it was a lucky day +which drove us to his shore, for he waxed rich with dues that they were +willing to pay. We built boats and let them out to these men, so that +one might truly say that all the fishery was Grim’s. + +Then a trading ship put in, hearing of the new haven, and that was a +great day for us. But her coming made my father anxious, since Hodulf +was likely to seek for news of Grim the merchant from any who had been +to England; and hearing at last of him, he would perhaps be down on us, +Vikingwise, with fire and sword. But after that traders came and went, +and we heard naught of him except we asked for news; for he left us in +peace, if he knew that his enemy lived yet. Men said that he was not +much loved in Denmark. + +So the town grew, and well did we prosper, so that there is naught to +be said of any more trouble, which is what my story seems to be made up +of so far. Yet we had come well through all at last; and that, I +suppose, is what makes the tale of any man worth hearing. + +Twelve years went all well thus, and in those years Havelok came to +manhood, though not yet to his full strength. What that would be in a +few more summers none could tell, for he was already almost a giant in +build and power, so that he could lift and carry at once the four great +fish baskets, which we bore one at a time when full of fish, easily, +and it was he who could get a stranded boat afloat when we could hardly +move her between us, though all three of us were strong as we grew up. + +Very handsome was Havelok also, and, like many very strong men, very +quiet. And all loved him, from the children who played along the +water’s edge to the oldest dame in the town; for he had a good word for +all, and there was not one in the place whom he had not helped at one +time or another. More than one there was who owed him life—either his +own, or that of a child saved from the water. + +Most of all Havelok loved my father; and once, when he was about +eighteen, he took it into his head that he was burdensome to him by +reason of his great growth. So nothing would satisfy him but that he +must go with us to the fishing, though it was against Grim’s will +somewhat. But he could make no hand at it, seeing that he could pull +any two of us round if he took an oar, and being as likely as not to +break that moreover. Nor could he bear the quiet of the long waiting at +the drift nets, when hour after hour of the night goes by in silence +before the herring shoal comes in a river of blue and silver and the +buoys sink with its weight; rather would he be at the weapon play with +the sons of Witlaf, our friend, who loved him. + +But though the fishing was not for him, after a while he would not be +idle, saying, when my father tried to persuade him to trouble not at +all about our work, that it was no shame for a man to work, but, +rather, that he should not do so. So one day he went to the old Welsh +basket maker who served us, and bade him make a great basket after his +own pattern, the like of which the old man had never so much as thought +of. + +“Indeed, master,” he said, when it was done, “you will never be able to +carry so great a load of fish as that will hold.” + +“Let us see,” quoth Havelok, laughing; and with that he put him gently +into it, and lifted him into the air, and on to his mighty shoulder, +carrying him easily, and setting him down in safety. + +The basket maker was cross at first, but none was able to be angry with +Havelok long, and he too began to smile. + +“It is ‘curan’ that you are, master,” he said; “not even Arthur himself +could have done that.” + +“Many times have I heard your folk call me that. I would learn what it +means,” said Havelok. + +But the old man could hardly find the English word for the name, which +means “a wonder,” and nothing more. Nevertheless the marsh folk were +wont to call their friend “Hablok Curan” in their talk, for a wonder he +was to all who knew him. + +So he came home with his great basket, and said, “Here sit I by the +fire, eating more than my share, and helping to win it not at all. Now +will I make amends, for I will go the fisher’s rounds through the +marshlands with my basket, and I think that I shall do well.” + +Now my father tried to prevent him doing this, because, as I know now, +it was not work for a king’s son. But Havelok would not be denied. + +“Fat and idle am I, and my muscles need hardening,” he said. “Let me +go, father, for I was restless at home.” + +So from that time he went out into the marshland far and wide, and the +people grew to know and love him well. Always he came back with his +fish sold, and gave money and full account to my father, and mostly the +account would end thus: + +“Four fish also there were more, but the burden was heavy, and so I +even gave them to a certain old dame.” + +And my mother would say, “It is likely that the burden was lighter for +her blessing.” + +And, truly, if the love of poor folk did help, Havelok’s burden weighed +naught, great though it was. + +Yet we thought little of the blessings of the Welsh folk of the marsh +in those days, for they blessed not in the names of the Asir, being +sons of the British Christians of long ago, and many, as I think, +Christians yet. Witlaf and all the English folk were Odin’s men, as we +were, having a temple at the place called Thor’s Way, among the hills. +But we had naught to do with the faith of the thralls, which was not +our business. Only Withelm was curious in the matter, and was wont to +ask them thereof at times, though at first they feared to tell him +anything, seeing how the Saxons and English had treated the Christian +folk at their first coming. But that was forgotten now, by the English +at least, and times were quiet for these poor folk. There was a wise +man, too, of their faith, who lived in the wild hills not far from the +city, and they were wont to go to him for advice if they needed it. +They said also that the king of Lindsey had once been a Christian, for +he was Welsh by birth on his mother’s side, and had been so brought up. +It is certain that his sister Orwenna, who married Ethelwald of East +Anglia, was one, but I have seen Alsi the king at the feasts of the +Asir at Thor’s Way when Yuletide was kept, so it is not so certain +about him. He had many Welsh nobles about him at the court, kinsmen of +his mother mostly, so that it did not seem strange, though there is not +much love lost between the English and the folk whom they conquered, as +one might suppose. + +Now, as I have said, none but Withelm thought twice about these things; +but in the end the love of the marsh folk was a thing that was needed, +and that Withelm had learned somewhat of their faith was the greatest +help that could be, as will be seen. + + + + +CHAPTER VII. +BROTHERHOOD. + + +True are the words of the Havamal, the song of the wisdom of Odin, +which say, “One may know and no other, but all men know if three know.” + +Therefore for all these years my father told none of us the secret of +Havelok’s birth; and when Arngeir married my sister Solva he made him +take oath that he would not tell what he knew to her, while she, being +but a child at the time of the flight, had forgotten how this +well-loved brother of hers came to us. But it happened once that Grim +was sick, and it seemed likely that he would die, so that this secret +weighed on him, and he did not rightly know what to do for the best, +Havelok at the time being but seventeen, and the time that he should +think of his own place not being yet come. At that time he told Arngeir +all that he foresaw, and set things in order, that we three should not +be backward when need was. + +He called us to him, Havelok not being present, and spoke to us. + +“Sons,” he said, “well have you all obeyed me all these years, and I +think that you will listen to me now, for I must speak to you of +Havelok, who came to us as you know. Out of his saving from his foes +came our flight here; and I will not find fault with any of the things +that happened, for they have turned out well, save that it seems that I +may never see the land of my birth again, and at times I weary for it. +For me Denmark seems to lie within the four square of the ancient +stones; but if you will do my bidding, you and Havelok shall see her +again, though how I cannot tell.” + +Then I could hardly speak for trouble, but Withelm said softly, “As we +have been wont to do, father, so it shall be.” + +“Well shall my word be kept, therefore,” Grim said, smiling on us. +“Listen, therefore. In the days to come, when time is ripe, Arngeir +shall tell you more of Havelok your foster-brother, and there will be +signs enough by which he shall know that it is time to speak. And then +Havelok will need all the help that you can give him; and as your lord +shall you serve him, with both hands, and with life itself if need be. +And I seem to see that each of you has his place beside him—Radbard as +his strong helper, and Raven as his watchful comrade, and Withelm as +his counsellor. For ‘Bare is back without brother behind it,’ son +Radbard and ‘Ere one goes out, give heed to the doorways,’ son Raven; +and ‘Wisdom is wanted by him who fares widely’ son Withelm. So say the +old proverbs, and they are true. No quarreller is Havelok; but if he +must fight, that will be no playground. Careful is he; but he has met +with no guile as yet, and he trusts all men. Slow to think, if sure, +are so mighty frames as his becomes, even when quick wit is needed.” + +He was silent for a while, and I thought that he had no more to say, +and I knew that he had spoken rightly of what each was best fitted for, +but he went on once more. + +“This is my will, therefore, that to you shall Havelok be as the eldest +brother from this time forward, that these places shall not have to +come suddenly to you hereafter. Then will you know that I have spoken +rightly, though maybe it seems hard to Radbard and Raven now, they +being so much older.” + +Then I said truly that already Havelok was first in our hearts. And +that was true, for he was as a king among us—a king who was served by +all with loving readiness, and yet one who served all. Maybe that is +just what makes a good king when all is said and done. + +Then my father bade us carry him out of the house and down to the shore +where there was a lonely place in the sandhills, covered with the +sweet, short grass that the sheep love; and, while Raven and I bore +him, Withelm went and brought Havelok. + +“This is well, father,” he said gladly. “I had not thought you strong +enough to come thus far.” + +“Maybe it is the last time that I come living out of the house,” Grim +said; “but there is one thing yet to be done, and it must be done here. +See, son Havelok, these are your brothers in all but blood, and they +must be that also in the old Danish way.” + +“Nothing more is needed, father,” Havelok said, wondering. “I have no +brothers but these of mine, and they could be no more so.” + +Thereat my father smiled, as well content, but he said that the ancient +way must he kept. + +“But I am sorely weak,” he added. “Fetch hither Arngeir.” + +It was because of this illness that none of us were at the fishing on +that day, and Arngeir was not long in coming. And while we waited for +that little while my father was silent, looking ever northward to the +land that he had given up for Havelok; and I think that foster-son of +his knew it, for he knelt beside him and set his strong arm round him, +saying nothing. So Arngeir came with Raven, who went for him, and my +father told him what he needed to be done; and Arngeir said that it was +well thought of, and went to work with his seax on the smooth turf. + +He cut a long strip where it seemed to be toughest, leaving the ends +yet fast, and carefully he raised it and stretched it until it would +make an arch some three spans high, and so propped it at either end +with more turf that it stayed in that position. + +Then my father said, “This is the old custom, that they who are of +different family should be brothers indeed. Out of one earth should +they be made afresh, as it were, that on the face of earth they shall +be one. Pass therefore under the arch, beginning with Havelok.” + +Then, while my father spoke strange and ancient runes, Havelok did as +he was bidden, kneeling down and creeping under the uplifted turf; and +as I came after him he gave me his hand and raised me, and so with each +of the other two. And then, unbidden, Arngeir followed, for he too +loved Havelok, and would fain be his brother indeed. + +After that my father took a sharp flint knife that he had brought with +him, and with it cut Havelok’s arm a little, and each of us set his +lips to that wound, and afterwards he to the like marks in our right +arms, and so the ancient rite was complete. + +Yet it had not been needed, as I know, for not even I ever thought of +him but as the dearest of brothers, though I minded how he came. + +Now after this my father grew stronger, maybe because this was off his +mind; but he might never go to sea again, nor even to Lincoln town, for +he was not strong enough. What his illness was I do not rightly know, +hut I do not think that any one here overlooked him, though it might be +that from across the sea Hodulf had power to work him harm. It was said +that he had Finnish wizards about his court; but if that was so, he +never harmed the one whom he had most to fear—even Havelok. But then I +suppose that even a Finn could not harm one for whom great things are +in store. + +So two years more passed over, and then came the time of which one +almost fears to think—the time of the great famine. Slowly it came on +the land; but we could see it coming, and the dread of it was fearsome, +but for the hope that never quite leaves a man until the end. For first +the wheat that was winter sown came not up but in scattered blades here +and there, and then ere the spring-sown grain had lain in the land for +three weeks it had rotted, and over the rich, ploughed lands seemed to +rise a sour smell in the springtime air, when one longs for the +sweetness of growing things. And then came drought in April, and all +day long the sun shone, or if it were not shining the clouds that hid +it were hard and grey and high and still over land and sea. + +Then before the marsh folk knew what they were doing, the merchants of +Lincoln had bought the stored corn, giving prices that should have told +men that it was precious to those who sold as to the buyers; and then +the grass failed in the drought, and the farmers were glad to sell the +cattle and sheep for what they could gain, rather than see them starve. + +Then my father bade us dry and store all the fish we might against the +time that he saw was coming, and hard we worked at that. And even as we +toiled, from day to day we caught less, for the fish were leaving the +shores, and we had to go farther and farther for them, until at last a +day came when the boats came home empty, and the women wept at the +shore as the men drew them up silently, looking away from those whom +they could feed no longer. + +That was the worst day, as I think, and it was in high summer. I mind +that I went to Stallingborough that day with the last of the fresh fish +of yesterday’s catch for Witlaf’s household, and it was hotter than +ever; and in all the orchards hung not one green apple, and even the +hardy blackberry briers had no leaves or sign of blossom, and in the +dikes the watercress was blackened and evil to see. + +But I will say that in Grimsby we felt not the worst, by reason of that +wisdom of my father, and always Witlaf and his house shared with us. +Hard it was here, but elsewhere harder. + +And then came the pestilence that goes with famine always. I have heard +that men have prayed to their gods for that, for it has seemed better +to them to die than live. + +With the first breath of the pestilence died Grim my father, and about +that I do not like to say much. He bade us remember the words he had +spoken of Havelok our brother, and he spoke long to Arngeir in private +of the same; and then he told us to lay him in mound in the ancient +way, but with his face toward Denmark, whence we came. And thereafter +he said no more, but lay still until there came up suddenly through the +thick air a thunderstorm from the north; and in that he passed, and +with his passing the rain came. + +Thereof Withelm said that surely Odin fetched him, and that at once he +had made prayer for us. But the Welsh folk said that not Odin but the +White Christ had taken the man who had been a father to them, and had +staved off the worst of the famine from them. + +Then pined and died my mother Leva, for she passed in her sleep on the +day before we made the mound over her husband, and so we laid them in +it together, and that was well for both, as I think, for so they would +have wished. + +So we made a great bale fire over my father’s mound, where it stood +over the highest sandhill; and no warrior was ever more wept, for +English and Welsh and Danes were at one in this. We set his weapons +with him, and laid him in the boat that was the best—and a Saxon gave +that—and in it oars and mast and sail, and so covered him therein. And +so he waits for the end of all things that are now, and the beginning +of those better ones that shall be. + +That thunderstorm was nothing to the land, for it skirted the shores +and died away to the south, and after it came the heat again; but at +least it brought a little hope. There were fish along the shore that +night, too, if not many; and though they were gone again in the +morning, there was a better store in every house, for men were mindful +of Grim’s teaching. + +Now, of all men, Havelok seemed to feel the trouble of the famine the +most, because he could not bear to see the children hungry in the +cottages of the fishers. It seemed to him that he had more than his +share of the stores, because so mighty a frame of his needed feeding +mightily, as he said. And so for two days after my father died and was +left in his last resting, Havelok went silent about the place. Here by +the shore the pestilence hardly came, and so that trouble was not added +to us, though the weak and old went, as had Grim and Leva, here and +there. + +Then, on the third day, Havelok called Arngeir and us, and spoke what +was in his mind. + +“Brothers, I may not bear this any longer, and I must go away. I can do +no more to help than can the weakest in the town; and even my strength +is an added trouble to those who have not enough without me. Day by day +grows the store in the house less; and it will waste more slowly if I +am elsewhere.” + +Then Arngeir said quickly, “This is foolishness, Havelok, my brother. +Whither will you go? For worse is the famine inland; and I think that +we may last out here. The fish will come back presently.” + +“I will go to Lincoln. All know that there is plenty there, for the +townsfolk were wise in time. There is the court, and at the court a +strong man is likely to be welcome, if only as one who shall keep the +starving poor from the doors, as porter.” + +He spoke bitterly, for Alsi, the king, had no good name for kindness, +and at that Withelm laughed sadly. + +“Few poor would Havelok turn away,” he said, under his breath; “rather +were he likely to take the king’s food from the very board, and share +it among them.” + +That made us laugh a little, for it was true enough; and one might seem +to see our mighty one sweeping the table, while none dared try to stay +him. + +But many times of late Havelok had gone dinnerless, that he might feed +some weak one in the village. Maybe some of us did likewise; but, if +so, we learned from him. + +“Well, then,” Havelok said, when we had had our wretched laugh, “Alsi, +the king, can better afford to feed me than can anyone else. Therefore, +I will go and see about it. And if not the king, then, doubtless, some +rich merchant will give me food for work, seeing that I can lift things +handily. But Radbard here is a great and hungry man also, and it will +be well that he come with me; or else, being young and helpless, I may +fall into bad hands.” + +So he spoke, jesting and making little of the matter. But I saw that he +was right, and that we who were strong to take what might come should +go away. It was likely that a day of our meals would make a week’s fare +for Arngeir’s three little ones, and they were to be thought for. + +Now for a little while Arngeir tried to keep us back; but it was plain +that he knew also that our going was well thought of, and only his care +for Havelok stood in the way. Indeed, he said that I and Raven might +go. + +“Raven knows as much about the fish as did our father,” Havelok said. +“He will go out in the morning, and look at sky and sea, and sniff at +the wind; and if I say it will be fine, he says that the herrings will +be in such a place; and so they are, while maybe it rains all day to +spite my weather wisdom. You cannot do without Raven; for it is ill to +miss any chance of the sea just now. Nor can Withelm go, for he knows +all in the place, and who is most in want. It will not do to be without +house steward. So we two will go. Never have I been to Lincoln yet, and +Radbard knows the place well.” + +I think that I have never said that Grim would never take Havelok to +the city, lest he should be known by some of the Danish folk who came +now and then to the court, some from over seas, and others from the +court of King Ethelwald, of whom I have spoken, the Norfolk king. But +that danger was surely over now, for Havelok would be forgotten in +Denmark; and Ethelwald was long dead, and his wife also, leaving his +daughter Goldberga to her uncle Alsi, as his ward. So Alsi held both +kingdoms until the princess was of age, when she would take her own. It +was said that she lived at Dover until that time, and so none of her +Danes were likely to be at court if we went there and found places. + +So Havelok’s plan was to be carried out, and he and I were to set forth +next morning. Arngeir was yet uneasy about it, nevertheless, as one +could see; but I did not at that time know why it should be so doubtful +a matter that two strong men should go forth and seek their fortune but +thirty miles away. So we laughed at him. + +“Well,” he said, “every one knows Radbard; but they will want to know +who his tall comrade may be. Old foes has Havelok, as Radbard knows, +and therefore it may be well to find a new name for him.” + +“No need to go far for that,” Withelm said. “The marsh folk call him +Curan.” + +“Curan, the wonder, is good,” Arngeir said, after a little thought, for +we all knew Welsh enough by this time. “Or if you like a Danish name +better, brother, call it ‘Kwaran,’ but silent about yourself you must +surely be.” + +We used to call him that at times—for it means “the quiet” in our old +tongue—seeing how gentle and courtly he was in all his ways. So the +name was well fitting in either way. + +“Silent and thoughtful should the son of a king be,” says the Havamal, +and so it was with Havelok, son of Gunnar. + +Now when I came to think, it was plain that we three stood in the mind +of our brother in the place which my father had boded for us, and I was +glad. Well I knew that Raven, the watchful, and Withelm, the wise and +thoughtful, would do their parts; and I thought that whether I could do +mine was to be seen very shortly. If I failed in help at need it should +not be my fault. It had been long growing in my mind who Havelok must +be, though I said nothing of what I thought, because my father had +bidden me be silent long ago, and I thought that I knew why. + +We were to start early in the morning, so that we should get to the +city betimes in the evening; and there was one thing that troubled the +good sisters more than it did us. They would have had us go in all our +finery, such as we were wont to wear on holidays and at feastings; but +none of that was left. It had gone in buying corn, while there was any +left to buy, along with every silver penny that we had. So we must go +in the plain fisher gear, that is made for use and not for show, frayed +and stained, and a trifle tarry, but good enough. It would not do to go +in our war gear into a peaceful city; and so we took but the seax that +every Englishman wears, and the short travelling spear that all +wayfarers use. Hardly was it likely that even the most hungry outlaw of +the wild woldland would care to fall on us; for by this time such as we +seemed had spent their all in food for themselves and their families, +and all the money in Lindsey seemed to have gone away to places where +there was yet somewhat to buy. + +Busy were those kind sisters of ours that night in making ready the +last meal that we should need to take from them. And all the while they +foretold pleasant things for us at the king’s court—how that we should +find high honour and the like. So they set us forth well and +cheerfully. + +With the dawn we started, and Havelok was thoughtful beyond his wont +after we had bidden farewell to the home folk, so that I thought that +he grieved for leaving them at the last. + +“Downhearted, are you, brother?” I said, when we had gone a couple of +miles in silence across the level. “I have been to Lincoln two or three +times in a month sometimes in the summer, and it is no great distance +after all. I think nothing of the journey, or of going so short a way +from home.” + +“Nor do I,” he answered. “First, I was thinking of the many times my +father, Grim, went this way, and now he can walk no more; and then I +was thinking of that empty cottage we passed just now, where there was +a pleasant little family enough three months ago, who are all gone. And +then—ay, I will tell you—I had a dream last night that stays in my +mind, so that I think that out of this journey of ours will come +somewhat.” + +“Food and shelter, to wit,” said I, “which is all we want for a month +or two. Let us hear it.” + +“If we get all that I had in that dream, we shall want no more all our +lives,” he said, with a smile; “but it seems a foolish dream, now that +I come to tell it.” + +“That is mostly the way with dreams. It is strange how wonderful they +seem until daylight comes. I have heard Witlaf’s gleeman say that the +best lays he ever made were in his sleep; but if he remembered aught of +them, they were naught.” + +“It is not like that altogether with my dream,” Havelok said, “for it +went thus. I thought that I was in Denmark—though how I knew it was +Denmark I cannot say—and on a hill I sat, and at my feet was stretched +out all the land, so that I could see all over it at once. Then I +longed for it, and I stretched out my arms to gather it in, and so long +were they that they could well fathom it, and so I drew it to myself. +With towns and castles it was gathered in, and the keys of the +strongholds fell rattling at my feet, while the weight of the great +land seemed to lie on my knees. Then said one, and the voice was the +voice of Grim, ‘This is not all the dream that I have made for you, but +it is enough for now.’ That is the dream, therefore, and what make you +of it?” + +“A most amazing hunger, brother, certainly, and promise of enough to +satisfy it withal. I think that the sisters have talked about our +advancement at court until you have dreamed thereof.” + +“Why,” he said, “that is surely at the bottom of the dream, and I am +foolish to think more of it.” + +Then we went on, and grew light hearted as the miles passed. But though +I had seemed to think little of the dream, it went strangely with my +thoughts of what might lie before Havelok in days to come. + +As we went inland from the sea, the track of the pestilence was more +dread, for we passed house after house that had none living in them, +and some held the deserted dead. I might say many things of what we +saw, but I do not like to think of them much. Many a battlefield have I +seen since that day, but I do not think them so terrible as the field +over which has gone the foe that is unseen ere he smites. One knows the +worst of the battle when it is over and the roll is called, but who +knows where famine and pestilence stay? And those have given life for +king or land willingly, but these were helpless. + +It was good to climb the welds and look back, for in the high lands +there was none of this. Below us the levels, with their bright waters, +were wrapped in a strange blue haze, that had come with the famine at +its worst, and, as men said, had brought or made the sickness. I had +heard of it; but it was not so plain when one was in it, or else our +shore was free, which is likely, seeing how little we suffered. + +After that we kept to the high land, not so much fearing the blue robe +of the pestilence as what things of its working we might see; and so it +was late in the afternoon that we came in sight of Lincoln town, on its +hill, with the wide meres and river at its feet. I have seen no city +that stands more wonderfully than this of ours, with the grey walls of +the Roman town to crown the gathering of red and brown roofs that +nestle on the slope and within them. And ever as we drew nearer Havelok +became more silent, as I thought because he had never seen so great a +town before, until we passed the gates of the stockade that keeps the +town that lies without the old walls, and then he said, looking round +him strangely, “Brother, you will laugh at me, no doubt, for an arrant +dreamer, but this is the place whereto in dreams I have been many a +time. Now we shall come to yon turn of the road among the houses, and +beyond that we shall surely see a stone-arched gate in a great wall, +and spearmen on guard thereat.” + +It was so, and the gate and guard were before us in a few more steps. +It was the gate of the old Roman town, inside which was the palace of +the king and one or two more great houses only. Our English kin hate a +walled town or a stone house, and they would not live within the strong +walls, whose wide span was, save for the king’s palace, which was built +partly of the house of the Roman governor, and these other halls, which +went for naught in so wide a meadow, empty and green, and crossed by +two paved roads, with grass growing between the stones. There were +brown marks, as of the buried stones of other foundations, on the grass +where the old streets had been. + +All the straggling English town was outside the walls, and only in time +of war would the people use them as a stronghold, as they used the +still more ancient camps on the hills. + +“Many times have you heard us tell of this place, Havelok,” I said. “It +is no wonder that you seem to know it.” + +“Nay,” he answered, “but this is the city of my dreams, and somewhat is +to happen here.” + + + + +CHAPTER VIII. +BERTHUN THE COOK. + + +For that night we went to the house of the old dame with whom my father +and I were wont to lodge when we came to the market, and she took us in +willingly, though she could make little cheer for us. Truly, as had +been said, the scarcity was not so great in Lincoln, but everything was +terribly dear, and that to some is almost as bad. + +“No money have I now, dame,” I said ruefully, “but I think that for old +sake’s sake you will not turn us away.” + +“Not I, faith,” she answered. “I mind the first day your father came +here, and never a penny had he, and since then there has been no want +in this house. Luck comes with Grim and his folk, as I think. But this +is a son whom I have not seen before, if he is indeed your brother.” + +“I am Grim’s son Curan,” said Havelok, “and I have not been to Lincoln +ere this. But I have heard of you many times.” + +That pleased our old hostess, and then she asked after Grim. Hard it +was to have to tell her that he was gone, and hard it was for her to +hear, for the little house had been open to us for ten years. + +“What will you do now, masters?” she asked, when she had told us of +many a kindness done to her and her husband, who was long dead now, by +my father. + +I told her that we were too many at home since the fishing had failed, +and had therefore come to find some work here, at the court if +possible. + +“Doubtless two strong men will not have to go far to find somewhat,” +she said; “but the court is full of idle folk, and maybe no place is +empty. Now I will have you bide with me while you are at a loose end, +for there are yet a few silver pennies in store, and I ween that they +came out of Grim’s pouch to me. Lonely am I, and it is no good hoarding +them when his sons are hungry.” + +We thanked her for that kind saying, but she made light of it, saying +that almost did she hope that we should find no work, that we might +bide and lighten her loneliness for a time. + +“But if an old woman’s advice is good for aught, you shall not go to +the court first of all. Sour is King Alsi, and he is likely to turn you +away offhand rather than grant the smallest boon. But there is Berthun +the cook, as we call him—steward is his court name though—and he orders +the household, and is good-natured, so that all like him. Every morning +he comes into the market, and there you can ask him if there is a place +for you, and he loves to look on a man such as Curan. But if it is +weapons you want—and I suppose that is in the minds of tall men always, +though it brings sorrow in the end—there is the captain of the guard +who lives over the gate, and he might be glad to see you enough.” + +We said that we would see the steward, for we wanted no long +employment. We would go back to Grimsby when the famine ended, if it +were only by the coming of the fish again. + +Then she gave us of the best she had—black bread and milk to wit; and +after that we slept soundly before the fire, as I had done many times +before in that humble house. Black bread and milk it was again in the +morning; but there was plenty, and goodwill to season it. Then the old +dame sent us forth cheerfully and early, that we might not miss Berthun +the steward, from whom she hoped great things for us. + +So we sat in the marketplace for an hour or more watching the gates of +the wall for his coming; and men stared at Havelok, so that we went to +the bridge and waited there. One could see all the market from thence. +There were a good many of the market folk coming in presently, and most +of them knew me, and more than one stopped and spoke. + +Now Havelok grew restless, and wandered here and there looking at +things, though not going far from me; and while I was thus alone on the +bridge, a man I knew by sight came and leaned on the rail by me, and +told me that he had just seen the most handsome man and the goodliest +to look on that was in the kingdom, as he thought. + +“Yonder he stands,” he said, “like a king who has fallen on bad times. +I mind that I thought that Alsi, our king, would look like that, before +I saw him, and sorely disappointed was I in him therefore. Now I wonder +who yon man may be?” + +I did not say that I knew, but I looked at Havelok, and for the first +time, perhaps because I had never seen him among strangers before, I +knew that he was wondrous to look on. Full head and shoulders was he +above all the folk, and the Lindseymen are no babes in stature. And at +the same moment it came to me that it were not well that men should +know him as the son of Grim the fisher. If my father, who was the +wisest of men, had been so careful for all these years, I must not be +less so; for if there were ever any fear of the spies of Hodulf, it +would be now when his foe might be strong enough in years to think of +giving trouble. Not that I ever thought much of the said Hodulf, seeing +how far off he was; but my father had brought me up to dread him for +this brother of mine. Certainly by this time Hodulf knew that Grim had +come to England in safety, for the name of the new town must have come +to his ears: and if Grim, then the boy he had given to him. + +The man who spoke to me went away soon, and Havelok strolled back to +me. + +“I would that the cook, or whoever he is, would come,” he said. “I grow +weary of this crowd that seems to have naught to do but stare at a +stranger.” + +“What shall we ask, when he does come? and supposing that there is a +place for but one of us?” I said. + +“Why, then, the one it fits best will take it, and the other must seek +some other chance. That is all.” + +“As you will, brother,” I answered, “but I would rather that we should +be together.” + +“And I also. But after all, both will be in Lincoln, and we must take +what comes. It is but for a little while, and we shall not like to +burden that good old dame by being too hard to please. We want somewhat +to do until we can go home, not for a day longer, and I care not what +it is.” + +“That is right,” I said; “and the sooner I see one of our folk coming +over this bridge with a full basket of fish, the better I shall like +it. But it may be a long day before that. Now, I have been thinking +that it were not well that you should say that you are the son of +Grim.” + +I did not quite know how he would take this, for he was proud of my +father as I. But that very pride made it easy. + +“Maybe not,” he said thoughtfully, “for it seems unworthy of his sons +that we have to ask for service from any man. But I do not think that +he could blame us, as things are. Nevertheless, folk shall not talk.” + +“Men know me,” said I, “but that cannot be helped.” + +He laughed gaily at that. + +“Why, here we speak as if one man in a hundred knew you. And after all +it may be that we shall get a place that none need be ashamed of. Look, +here comes a mighty fine lord from the gateway.” + +It was Berthun the steward, for whom we were waiting, and I knew him +well by sight. Often had he bought our fish, but I did not think that +he would remember me by name, if he had ever heard it. He was a portly +and well-favoured man, not old, and as he came down the street to the +marketplace at the hill foot he laughed and talked with one and another +of the townsfolk, whether high or low, in very pleasant wise. + +Presently he stopped at a stall, and priced some meat; and when he had +bought it he looked round and called for some men to carry it for him; +and at that the idlers made a rush for him, tripping over one another +in haste to be first, while he laughed at them. + +He chose two or three, and sent them up the hill to the palace with +their burdens, and then went to another booth and bought. + +“This is work at which I should make a good hand,” said Havelok, +laughing at the scrambling men who ran forward when the steward again +called for porters. “Well paid also the job must be, to judge of their +eagerness.” + +The three men who had been chosen took their burden and went away, and +the steward came near us, to a bakery that was close to the bridge end. + +“I have a mind to do porter for once,” Havelok said. “Then I can at +least earn somewhat to take back to the dame tonight.” + +“If you do so,” I answered, “I will wait here for you. But you will +have to fight for the place.” + +Now the steward bought all that he needed, and that was bread for the +whole palace for the day, and again he called for porters. Whereon +Havelok got up from the bridge rail and went towards him in no great +hurry, so that the idlers were in a crowd before him. + +“Ho! friends,” cried Havelok, “let the good cook see all of us and make +his choice. He can only take one at a time.” + +“One, forsooth,” said a man from the crowd; “why, there is a load for +four men there.” + +“Well, then, let him pick four little ones, and give these little ones +a chance of being seen.” + +Now I do not think that he would have troubled with the matter any +more; but whether the men knew that this was the last load that the +steward had to send home, or whether they quarrelled, I cannot say, but +in their eagerness to raise the two great baskets they fell to +struggling over them, and the steward tried to quiet the turmoil by a +free use of his staff, and there was a danger that the bread should be +scattered. + +“Here will be waste of what there is none too much of just now,” said +Havelok; and with that he went to the aid of the steward, picking up +and setting aside the men before him, and then brushing the struggling +rivals into a ruefully wondering heap from about the baskets, so that +he and the steward faced each other, while there fell a silence on the +little crowd that had gathered. Even the men who had been put aside +stayed their abuse as they saw what manner of man had come to the +rescue of the baskets, and Havelok and the cook began to laugh. + +“Fe, fi, fo, fum!” said Berthun; “here is surely a Cornish giant among +us! Now I thank you, good Blunderbore, or whatever your name is, for +brushing off these flies.” + +“The folk in this place are unmannerly,” said Havelok; “hut if you want +the bread carried up the hill I will do it for you.” + +Berthun looked him up and down in a puzzled sort of way once or twice +ere he answered, “Well, as that is your own proposal, pick your helpers +and do so; I would not have asked such a thing of you myself.” + +“There is not much help needed,” said Havelok. “I think this may be +managed if I get a fair hold.” + +Now we were used to seeing him carry such loads as would try the +strength of even Raven and myself, who could lift a load for three men; +but when he took the two great baskets of bread and swung them into +place on either arm, a smothered shout went round the crowd, and more +than once I heard the old Welsh name that the marsh folk had given him +spoken. + +“Let us be going,” said Havelok to the steward on that. “One would +think that none of these had ever hefted a fair load in his life, to +listen to them.” + +So he nodded to me across the heads of the crowd, and followed Berthun, +and the idlers followed him for a little. The guard turned these back +at the gate, and Havelok went through, and I could see him no more. + +Presently the crowd drifted back to their places, and I heard them +talking. Havelok and his strength was likely to be a nine days’ wonder +in Lincoln, and I was glad that I had asked him not to say whence he +was. + +“He is some thane’s son who is disguised,” said one. + +“Maybe he is under a vow,” said another; and then one chimed in with a +story of some prince of Arthur’s time, by name Gareth, who hid his +state at his mother’s command. + +“As for me,” said the baker, “I think that he is a fisher, as he +looks—at least, that is, as his clothes make him.” + +So even he had his doubts, and I will say that I understood well enough +now why my father never brought him here before. + +Havelok was long in coming back, as I thought, and I seemed to be +wasting time here, and so I bethought me of the other man to whom the +old dame had said we might go—namely, the captain of the gate. I should +see Havelok if I stood there. + +The captain was talking with some of his men as I came up, and of +course it was of Havelok that they spoke; and seeing that I wore the +same dress as he, they asked me if I knew who he was. + +“He is a fisher from the coast,” I answered. “I have heard him called +Curan.” + +“Welsh then,” the captain answered, somewhat disappointed, as it +seemed. “If he had been a Mercian, or even a Saxon, I would have had +him here, but a fisher has had no training in arms after all.” + +“Some of us have,” said I. + +The captain looked me up and down, and then walked round me, saying +nothing until we were face to face again. + +“That, I take it, is a hint that you might like to be a housecarl of +the king’s,” he said. “Are you a Lindseyman?” + +“I am the son of Grim of Grimsby,” I said. + +“Why, then, I suppose you would not think of it, seeing that my place +is not empty; but if you will dress in that way you must not wonder if +I took you for a likely man for a housecarl. We know Grim well by +repute. Come in and tell me about the famine, and this new town of +yours that one hears of.” + +Now I could not see Havelok as yet, and so I went into the stone-arched +Roman guardroom, and Eglaf the captain fetched out a pot of wine and +some meat, and made me very welcome while we talked. And presently I +thought that I might do worse than be a housecarl for a time, if Eglaf +would have me. I should be armed at least, and with comrades to help if +Havelok needed me; though all the while I thought myself foolish for +thinking that any harm could come to him who was so strong. +Nevertheless, what my father had laid on us all was to be heeded, and I +was to be his helper in arms. So presently I told Eglaf that the +housecarl’s life seemed an easy one, and that it would be pleasant to +go armed for a while, if he would have me for a short time, seeing that +the famine had left us naught to do. + +“Well, there is plenty to eat and drink,” he said, “and good lodging in +the great hall or here, as one’s post may be, and a silver penny every +day; but no fighting to be done, seeing that Alsi will sooner pay a foe +to go away than let us see to the matter. Doing naught is mighty hard +work at times.” + +Then he asked if I had arms, and I said that I would send for them at +once, and that settled the matter. If I chose to come with my own arms +I should be welcome. + +“I am glad to get you,” he said, “for there will be a crowd in the +place ere long, for the Witan is to meet, and the thanes will come with +their men, and there will be fine doings, so that we need another +strong arm or two that we may keep the peace,” + +He took a long pull at the wine pot, and then went on, “Moreover, the +princess’s Danes are sure to want to fight some of the English folk for +sport.” + +“What! is she here?” + +“Not yet. They say that she is coming when the Witan meets, because the +Witan wants to see her, not because Alsi does. But he dare not go +against them, and so it must be.” + +Now Goldberga, the princess, was, as I have said, Alsi’s ward, and was +at this time just eighteen, so that it would be time for her to take +the kingdom that was hers by right. It was common talk, however, that +Alsi by no means liked the thought of giving the wide lands of East +Anglia up to her, and that he would not do so if he could anywise help +it. Maybe the Witan thought so also, and would see fair play. Ethelwald +and his wife Orwenna had been well loved both here and in Norfolk, and +it was said that Goldberga their daughter grew wondrous fair and +queenly. + +I had learned one thing though, and that was that we should have +Ethelwald’s Danes here shortly, and that I did not like; but after all, +what did these few men of an old household know of the past days in +Denmark? There had been no going backwards and forwards between the two +countries since the king died ten years ago. Nevertheless I was glad +that I had found a friend in Eglaf, and that I was to be here. + +Then I got up to go, and the captain bade me come as soon as I could, +for he could talk to me as he could not to the men, maybe. So I bade +him farewell, and went slowly back, down the street, sitting down in +the old place. + +It was not long after that before Havelok came, and I saw Berthun the +steward come as far as the gate with him, and stand looking after him +as he walked away; then Eglaf came out, and both looked and talked for +a while, and therefore, as soon as I knew that Havelok saw me, I went +away and across the bridge to a place that was quiet, and waited for +him there. + +“Well, brother,” I said, “you have had a long job with the cook. What +is the end of it all?” + +“I do not know,” he answered slowly. “That is to be seen yet.” + +I looked at him, for his voice was strange, and I saw that he seemed to +have the same puzzled look in his eyes as he had last night when we +came first into the city. I asked if anything was amiss. + +“Nothing,” he said; “but this is a place of dreams. I think that I +shall wake presently in Grimsby.” + +We walked on, and past the straggling houses outside the stockade, and +so into the fields; and little by little he told me what was troubling +him. + +Berthun the steward had said nothing until the palace was reached, and +had led him to the great servants’ hall, and there had bidden him set +down his load and rest. Then he had asked if he would like to see the +place, and of course Havelok had said that he would, wondering at the +same time if this was all the pay that the porters got. So he was shown +the king’s hall, and the arms on the wall, and the high seat, and the +king’s own chamber, and many more things, and all the while they seemed +nothing strange to Havelok. + +“This Berthun watched me as a cat watches a mouse all the while,” he +said, “and at last he asked if I had ever seen a king’s house before. I +told him that I had a dream palace which had all these things, but was +not the same. And at that he smiled and asked my name. ‘Curan,’ I said, +of course; and at that he smiled yet more, in a way that seemed to say +that he did not believe me. ‘It is a good name for the purpose,’ he +said, ‘but I have to ask your pardon for calling you by the old giant’s +name just now.’ I said that as he did not know my name, and it was a +jest that fitted, it was no matter. Then he made a little bow, and +asked if I would take any food before I went from the place; so I told +him that it was just what I came for, and he laughed, and I had such a +meal as I have not seen for months. It is in my mind that I left a +famine in that house, so hungry was I. There is no pride about this +Berthun, for he served me himself, and I thanked him.” + +Then Havelok stopped and passed his hand over his face, and he laughed +a little, uneasy laugh. + +“And all the while I could not get it out of my head that he ought to +be kneeling before me.” + +“Well,” he went on after a little, “when I had done, this Berthun asked +me a question, saying that he was a discreet man, and that if he could +help me in any way he would do so. Had I a vow on me? Nothing more than +to earn my keep until the famine was over, I said. I had left poor folk +who would have the more for my absence, and he seemed to think that +this was a wondrous good deed. So I told him that if he could help me +in this I should be glad. Whereon he lowered his voice and asked if I +must follow the way of Gareth the prince. I had not heard of this +worthy, and so I said that what was good enough for a prince was +doubtless good enough for me, and that pleased him wonderfully. + +“‘Gladly will I take you into my service,’ he said, ‘if that will +content you.’ Which it certainly would; and so I am to be porter again +tomorrow. Then I said that I had a comrade to whom I must speak first. +He said that no doubt word must be sent home of my welfare, and he saw +me as far as the gate.” + +“Which of you went out of the hall first?” I asked. + +“Now I come to think of it, I did. I went to let him pass, as the +elder, though it was in my mind to walk out as if the place belonged to +me; and why, I do not know, for no such thought ever came to me in +Witlaf’s house, or even in a cottage; but he stood aside and made me go +first.” + +Now I longed for Withelm and his counsel, for one thing was plain to +me, and that was that with the once familiar things of the kingship +before him the lost memory of his childhood was waking in Havelok, and +I thought that the time my father boded was at hand. The steward had +seen that a court and its ways were no new thing to him, and had seen +too that he had been wont to take the first place somewhere; so he had +deemed that this princely-looking youth was under a vow of service, in +the old way. It is likely that the Welsh name would make him think that +he was from beyond the marches to the west, and that was just as well. + +Then Havelok said, “Let us go back to the widow’s house and sleep. My +head aches sorely, and it is full of things that are confused, so that +I do not know rightly who I am or where. Maybe it will pass with rest.” + +We turned hack, and then I told him what I meant to do; and that +pleased him, for we should see one another often. + +“We are in luck, brother, so far,” he said, “having lit on what we +needed so soon; but I would that these dreams would pass.” + +“It is the poor food of many days gone by,” I said. “Berthun will cure +that for you very shortly.” + +“It is likely enough,” he answered more gaily. + +“Little want is in that house, but honest Berthun does not know what a +trencherman he has hired. But I would that we had somewhat to take back +to our good old dame tonight.” + +But she was more than satisfied with our news; and when she saw that +Havelok was silent, she made some curious draught of herbs for him, +which he swallowed, protesting, and after that he slept peacefully. + +I went out to the marketplace and found a man whom I knew—one of those +who carried our fish at times; and him I sent, with promise of two +silver pennies presently, to Arngeir for my arms, telling him that all +was well. + + + + +CHAPTER IX. +CURAN THE PORTER. + + +There is no need for me to say how my arms came to me from Grimsby, and +how I went to Eglaf as I had promised. I will only say that the life +was pleasant enough, if idle, as a housecarl, and that I saw Havelok +every day at one time or another, which was all that I could wish. + +But as I had to wait a day or two while the messenger went and the arms +came from home, I saw Havelok meet the steward on the next day: and a +quaint meeting enough it was, for Berthun hardly knew how he should +behave to this man, whom he had made up his mind was a wandering +prince. + +There was the crowd who waited for the call for porters, as ever; hut +the steward would have none of them, until he saw his new man towering +over the rest, and then he half made a motion to unbonnet, which he +checked and turned into a beckoning wave of the hand, whereon the +idlers made their rush for him, and Havelok walked through and over +them, more or less, as they would not make way for him. But so +good-naturedly was this done, that even those whom he lifted from his +path and dropped on one side laughed when they saw who had cleared a +way for himself, and stood gaping to see what came next. + +“Ho—why, yes—Curan—that was the name certainly. I have been looking for +you, as we said,” stammered the steward. + +“Here am I, therefore,” answered Havelok, “and where is the load?” + +“Truth to tell, I have bought but this at present,” said the steward, +pointing to a small basket of green stuff on the stall at which he +stood. + +“Well, I suppose there is more to come,” Havelok said, taking it up; +“it will be a beginning.” + +“I will not ask you to carry more than that,” Berthun began. + +“Why, man, this is foolishness. If you have a porter, make him carry +all he can, else he will not earn his keep.” + +“As you will,” answered the steward, shrugging his shoulders as one who +cannot account for some folk’s whims, and going on to the next booth. + +Now, I suppose that the idlers looked to see Havelok walk away with +this light load gladly, as any one of them would have done, and that +then their turn would have come; but this was not what they expected. +Maybe they would have liked to see the strong man sweep up all the +palace marketing and carry it, as a show, but it might interfere with +their own gains. So there was a murmur or two among them, and this grew +when Havelok took the next burden in like manner. + +“Ho, master cook,” cried a ragged man at last, “this is not the custom, +and it is not fair that one man should do all the work, and all for one +wage.” + +Berthun took no notice of this; and so the cry was repeated, and that +by more than one. And at last he turned round and answered. + +“Go to, ye knaves,” he said with a red face and angrily; “if I find a +man who will save me the trouble of your wrangles every day, shall I +not do as I please?” + +Then there was a tumult of voices, and some of them seemed sad, as if a +last hope was gone, and that Havelok heard. + +“There is somewhat in this,” he said to the cook. “What pay have you +given to each man who carries for you?” + +“A yesterday’s loaf each,” answered Berthun, wondering plainly that +Havelok paid any heed to the noise. + +“Well, then, let us go on, and we will think of somewhat,” Havelok +said; and then he turned to the people, who were silent at once. + +“I am a newcomer, and a hungry one,” he said, smiling quietly, “and I +have a mind to earn my loaf well. Hinder me not for today, and +hereafter I will take my chance with the rest, if need is.” + +Thereat the folk began to laugh also, for it was plain that none had +any chance at all if he chose to put forth his strength; but an old man +said loudly, “Let the good youth alone now, and he shall talk with us +when he has done his errand and fed that great bulk of his. He has an +honest face, and will be fair to all.” + +That seemed to please the crowd; and after that they said no more, but +followed and watched the gathering up of Havelok’s mighty burden. And +presently there was more than he could manage; and he spoke to Berthun, +who checked himself in a half bow as he answered. + +Then Havelok looked over the faces before him, and beckoned to two men +who seemed weakly and could not press forward, and to them he gave the +lighter wares, and so left the market with his master, as one must call +the steward. + +“What told I you?” said the old man, as they came back from the great +gate. “Never saw I one with a face like that who harmed any man, either +in word or deed.” + +Now when Havelok had set down his load in the kitchen, he straightened +himself and said to Berthun, who was, as one may say, waiting his +pleasure. + +“This is today’s task; but it is in my mind that I would stay up here +and work.” + +“What would you do?” + +“There are men yonder who will miss the carrying if I am market porter +always. But here are things I can earn my keep at, and help the other +servants with at the same time. Water drawing there is, and carrying of +logs for the fire, and cleaving them also, and many other things that +will be but hardening my muscles, while they are over heavy to be +pleasant for other folk.” + +“Well,” answered Berthun, “that is all I could wish, and welcome to +some here will you be. Let it be so.” + +“Now, I do not think that you would make a gain by my work this +morning?” + +“Truly not, if any one is wronged by my doing so,” the puzzled steward +said. + +Then Havelok asked how many men would have been needed to carry up the +goods that he had brought, and Berthun said that he was wont to send +one at least from each stall, and more if the burden was heavy. + +“Then today four poor knaves must go dinnerless by reason of my +strength, and that does not please me altogether,” said Havelok +gravely. “Give these two their loaves; and then, I pray you, give me +the other four, and let me go back to the market.” + +And then he added, with a smile, “I think that I can order matters +there so that things will be more fair, and that you will have less +trouble with that unmannerly scramble.” + +“If you can do that, you are even as your name calls you. Take them and +welcome, Curan, and then come here and do what work you will,” Berthun +said in haste. + +“Tasks you must set me, or I shall grow idle. That is the failing of +over-big men,” Havelok said; and he took the loaves and left the palace +with the two market men at his heels. + +I saw him come back, and at once the crowd of idlers made for him, but +in a respectful way enough. I knew, however, how easily these folks +took to throwing mud and stones in their own quarrels, and I was a +little anxious, for to interfere with the ways of the market is a high +offence among them. + +But Havelok knew naught of that, and went his way with his loaves to +the bridge end, and there sat on the rail and looked at the men before +him. And _lo!_ back to my mind came old days in Denmark, and how I once +saw Gunnar the king sitting in open court to do justice, and then I +knew for certain that I was looking on his son. And when Havelok spoke +it was in the voice of Gunnar that I had long forgotten, but which came +back to me clear and plain, as if it were yesterday that I had heard +it. Never does a boy forget his first sight of the king. + +“Friends,” said Havelok, “if I do two men’s work I get two men’s pay, +or else I might want to know the reason why. But I am only one man, all +the same, and it seems right to me that none should be the loser. +Wherefore I have a mind to share my pay fairly.” + +There was a sort of shout at that and Havelok set his four loaves in a +row on the rail beside him. But then some of the rougher men went to +make a rush at them, and he took the foremost two and shook them, so +that others laughed and bade the rest beware. + +“So that is just where the trouble comes in,” said Havelok coolly; “the +strong get the first chance, as I did this morning, by reason of there +being none to see fair play.” + +“Bide in the market, master, and we will make you judge among us,” +cried a small man from the edge of the crowd. + +“Fair and softly,” Havelok answered. “I am not going to bide here +longer than I can help. Come hither, grandfer,” and he beckoned to the +old man who had bidden them wait his return, “tell me the names of the +men who have been longest without any work.” + +The old man pointed out three, and then Havelok stopped him. + +“One of these loaves is my own wage,” he said; “but you three shall +have the others, and that will be the easiest day’s work you ever did. +But think not that I am going to do the like every day, for Lincoln +hill is no easy climb, and the loaf is well earned at the top. +Moreover, it is not good to encourage the idle by working for them.” + +So the three men had their loaves, and Havelok began to eat his own +slowly, swinging his legs on the bridge rail while the men watched him. + +“Master,” said the small man from behind, pushing forward a little, now +that the crowd was looser, “make a law for the market, I pray you, that +all may have a chance.” + +“Who am I to make laws?” said my brother slowly, and, as he said this, +his hand went up to his brows as it had gone last night when the palace +had wearied him. + +“The strong make laws for the weak,” the old man said to him in a low +voice. “If the strong is honest, for the weak it is well. Things are +hard for the weak here; and therefore say somewhat, for it may be of +use.” + +“It can be none, unless the strong is at hand to see that the law is +kept.” + +“Sometimes the market will see that a rule is not broken, for itself. +There is no rule for this matter.” + +Again Havelok passed his hand over his eyes, and he was long in +answering. The loaf lay at his side now. Presently he looked straight +before him, and, as if he saw far beyond Lincoln Hill and away to the +north, he said, “This is my will, therefore, that from this time +forward it shall be the law that men shall have one among them who may +fairly and without favour so order this matter that all shall come to +Berthun the steward in turns that shall be kept, and so also with the +carrying for any other man. There shall be a company of porters, +therefore, which a man must join before he shall do this work, save +that every stranger who comes shall be suffered to take a burden once, +and then shall be told of this company, and the custom that is to be. +And I will that this old man shall see to this matter.” + +And then he stopped suddenly, and seemed to start as a great shout went +up from the men, a shout as of praise; and his eyes looked again on +them, and that wonderingly. + +“They will keep this law,” said the old man. “Well have you spoken.” + +“I have said a lot of foolishness, maybe,” answered Havelok. “For the +life of me I could not say it again.” + +“There is not one of us that could not do so,” said his adviser. “But +bide you here, master, in the town?” + +“I am in service at the palace.” + +Then the old man turned round to the others and said, “This is good +that we have heard, and it is nothing fresh, for all trades have their +companies, and why should not we? Is this stranger’s word to be kept?” + +Maybe there were one or two of the rougher men who held their peace, +for they had had more than their share of work, but from the rest came +a shout of “Ay!” as it were at the Witan. + +“Well, then,” said Havelok suddenly, getting down from his seat and +giving his loaf to the old man, “see you to it; and if any give trouble +hereafter, I shall hear from the cook, and, by Odin, I will even come +down and knock their heads together for them. So farewell.” + +He smiled round pleasantly, yet in that way which has a meaning at the +back of it; and at that every cap went off and the men did him +reverence as to a thane at least, and he nodded to them and came across +to me. + +“Come out into the fields, brother, for I shall weep if I bide here +longer.” + +So he said; and we went away quickly, while the men gathered round the +old leader who was to be, and talked earnestly. + +“This famine plays strange tricks with me,” he said when we were away +from every one. “Did you hear all that I said?” + +“I heard all, and you have spoken the best thing that could have been +said. Eight years have I been to this market, and a porters’ guild is +just what is needed. And it will come about now.” + +“It was more dreaming, and so I must be a wise man in my dream. Even as +in the palace yesterday it came on me, and I seemed to be at the gate +of a great hall, and it was someone else that was speaking, and yet +myself. It is in my mind that I told these knaves what my lordly will +was, forsooth; and the words came to me in our old Danish tongue, so +that it was hard not to use it. But it seems to me that long ago I did +these things, or saw them, I know not which, somewhere. Tell me, did +the king live in our town across the sea?” + +“No, but in another some way off. My father took me there once or +twice.” + +“Can you mind that he took me also?” + +I shook my head, and longed for Withelm. Surely I would send for him, +or for Arngeir, if this went on. Arngeir for choice, for I could tell +him what I thought; and that would only puzzle Withelm, who knew less +than I. + +“We will ask Arngeir some day,” I said; “he can remember.” + +“I suppose he did take me,” mused Havelok; “and I suppose that I want +more sleep or more food or somewhat. Now we will go and tell the old +dame of my luck, for she has lost her lodger.” + +Then he told me of his fortune with the steward. + +“Half afraid of me he seems, for he will have me do just what I will. +That will be no hard place therefore.” + +But I thought that if I knew anything of Havelok my brother, he would +be likely to make it hard by doing every one’s work for him, and that +Berthun saw this; or else that, as I had thought last night, the shrewd +courtier saw the prince behind the fisher’s garb. + +So we parted presently at the gate of the palace wall, and I went back +to the widow to wait for my arms, while he went to his master. And I +may as well tell the end of Havelok’s lawmaking. + +Berthun went down to the market next day, and came back with a wonder +to be told. And it was to Havelok that he went first to tell it, as he +was drawing bucket after bucket of water from the deep old Roman well +in the courtyard to fill the great tub which he considered a fair load +to carry at once. + +“There is something strange happening in the market,” he said, “and I +think that you have a hand in it. The decency of the place is +wonderful, and you said that you thought I might have less trouble with +the men than I was wont if you went down with the loaves. What did you? +For I went to the baker’s stalls and bought, and looked round for the +tail that is after me always; and I was alone, and all the market folk +were agape to see what was to be done. I thought that I had offended +the market by yesterday’s business, as they had called out on me, and I +thought that I should have to come and fetch your—that is, if it +pleased you. But first I called, as is my wont, for porters. Now all +that rabble sat in a row along a wall, and, by Baldur, when I looked, +they had cleaned themselves! Whereupon an old gaffer, who has carried +things once or twice for me when there has been no crowd and he has +been able to come forward, lifted up his voice and asked how many men I +wanted, so please me. + +“‘Two,’I said, wondering, and at that two got up and came to me, and I +sent them off. It was the same at the next booth, and the next, for he +told off men as I wanted them; and here am I back a full half-hour +earlier than ever before, and no mud splashes from the crowd either. It +is said that they have made a porters’ guild; and who has put that +sense into their heads unless your—that is, unless you have done so, I +cannot say.” + +Havelok laughed. + +“Well, I did tell them that they should take turns, or somewhat like +that; and I also told them that if you complained of them I would see +to it.” + +“Did you say that you would pay them, may I ask—that is, of course, if +they were orderly? For if so, I thank—” + +“I told them that if you complained I would knock their heads +together,” said Havelok. + +And that was the beginning of the Lincoln porters’ guild; and in after +days Havelok was wont to say that he would that all lawmaking was as +easy as that first trial of his. Certainly from that day forward there +was no man in all the market who would not have done aught for my +brother, and many a dispute was he called on to settle. It is not +always that a law, however good it may be, finds not a single one to +set himself against it. But then Havelok was a strong man. + +Now there is naught to tell of either Havelok or myself for a little +while, for we went on in our new places comfortably enough. One heard +much of Havelok, though, for word of him and his strength and +goodliness, and of his kindness moreover, went through the town, with +tales of what he had done. But I never heard that any dared to ask him +to make a show of himself by doing feats of strength. Only when he came +down to the guardroom sometimes with me would he take part in the +weapon play that he loved, and the housecarls, who were all tried and +good warriors, said that he was their master in the use of every +weapon, and it puzzled them to know where he had learned so well, for +he yet wore his fisher’s garb. They sent his arms with mine from +Grimsby, thinking that he also needed them; but he left them with the +widow. + +Havelok used to laugh if they asked him this, and tell them that it +came by nature, and in that saying there was more than a little truth. +So the housecarls, when they heard how Berthun was wont to treat him, +thought also that he was some great man in hiding, and that the steward +knew who he was. They did not know but that my close friendship with +him had sprung up since he came, and that was well, and Eglaf and he +and I were soon much together. The captain wanted him to leave the cook +and be one of his men, but we thought that he had better bide where he +was, rather than let Alsi the king have him always about him. For now +and then that strange feeling, as of the old days, came over him when +he was in the great hall, and he had to go away and brood over it for a +while until he would set himself some mighty task and forget it. + +But one day he came to me and said that he was sure he knew the ways of +a king too well for it all to be a dream, adding that Berthun saw that +also, and was curious about him. + +“Tell me, brother, whence came I? _Was_ I truly brought up in a court?” + +“I have never heard,” I answered. “All that I know for certain is that +you fled with us from Hodulf, the new king, and that for reasons which +my father never told me.” + +Then said Havelok, “There was naught worth telling, therefore. I +suppose I was the child of some steward like Berthun; but yet—” + +So he went away, and I wondered long if it were not time that Arngeir +should tell all that he knew. It was of no good for me to say that in +voice and ways and deed he had brought back to me the Gunnar whom I had +not seen for so many long years, for that was as likely as not to be a +fancy of mine, or if not a fancy, he might be only a sister’s son or +the like. But in all that he said there was no word of his mother, and +by that I knew that his remembrance must be but a shadow, if a growing +one. + +But there was no head in all the wide street that was not turned to +look after him; and now he went his way from me with two children, whom +he had caught up from somewhere, perched on either shoulder, and +another in his arms, and they crowed with delight as he made believe to +be some giant who was to eat them forthwith, and ran up the hill with +them. No such playmate had the Lincoln children before Havelok came. + + + + +CHAPTER X. +KING ALSI OF LINDSEY. + + +Three weeks after we came the Witan[8] began to gather, and that was a +fine sight as the great nobles of Lindsey, and of the North folk of +East Anglia, came day by day into the town with their followings, +taking up their quarters either in the better houses of the place or +else pitching bright-coloured tents and pavilions on the hillside +meadows beyond the stockades. Many brought their ladies with them, and +all day long was feasting and mirth at one place or another, as friend +met with friend. Never had I seen such a gay sight as the marketplace +was at midday, when the young thanes and their men met there and +matched their followers at all sorts of sports. The English nobles are +far more fond of gay dress and jewels than our Danish folk, though I +must say that when the few Danes of Ethelwald’s household came it would +seem that they had taken kindly to the fashion of their home. + +Our housecarls grumbled a bit for a while, for with all the newcomers +dressed span new for the gathering, we had had nothing fresh for it +from the king, as was the custom, and I for one was ashamed of myself, +for under my mail was naught but the fisher’s coat, which is good +enough for hard wear, but not for show. But one day we were fitted out +fresh by the king’s bounty in blue and scarlet jerkins and hose, and we +swaggered after that with the best, as one may suppose. + +Berthun had the ordering of that business, and he came and sat with +Eglaf in the gatehouse and talked of it. + +“Pity that you do not put your man Curan into decent gear,” the captain +said. “That old sailcloth rig does not do either him or you or the +court credit.” + +“That is what I would do,” said the steward, “but he will not take +aught but the food that he calls his hire. He is a strange man +altogether, and I think that he is not what he seems.” + +“So you have told me many times, and I think with you. He will be some +crack-brained Welsh princeling who has been crossed in love, and so has +taken some vow on him, as the King Arthur that they prate of taught +them to do. Well, if he is such, it is an easy matter to make him +clothe himself decently. It is only to tell him that the clothes are +from the king, and no man who has been well brought up may refuse such +a gift.” + +“But suppose that he thanks the king for the gift. Both he and the king +will be wroth with me.” + +“Not Curan, when he has once got the things on; and as for >Alsi, he +will take the thanks to himself, and chuckle to think that the mistake +has gained him credit for a good deed that he never did.” + +“Hush, comrade, hush!” said Berthun quickly; “naught but good of the +king!” + +“I said naught ill. But if Woden or Frey, or whoever looks after good +deeds, scores the mistake to Alsi as well, it will be the first on the +count of charity that—” + +But at this Berthun rose up in stately wise. + +“I may not listen to this. To think that here in the guardroom I should +hear such—” + +“Sit down, comrade,” said Eglaf, laughing, and pulling the steward into +his seat again. “Well you know that I would be cut to pieces for the +king tomorrow if need were, and so I earn free speech of him I guard. +If I may not say what I think of him to a man who knows as much of him +as I, who may?” + +“I have no doubt that the king would clothe Curan if I asked him,” said +Berthun stiffly, but noways loth to take his seat again. + +“But it is as much as your place is worth to do it. I know what you +would say.” + +Berthun laughed. + +“I will do it myself, and if Alsi does get the credit, what matter?” + +Wherefore it came to pass that as I was on guard at the gate leading to +the town next day I saw a most noble-looking man coming towards me, and +I looked a second time, for I thought him one of the noblest of all the +thanes who had yet come, and the second look told me that it was +Havelok in this new array. I will say that honest Berthun had done his +part well; and if the king was supposed to be the giver, he had nothing +to complain of. Eglaf had told me of the way in which the dressing of +Havelok was to be done. + +“Ho!” said I, “I thought you some newcomer.” + +“I hardly know myself,” he answered, “and I am not going to grumble at +the change, seeing that this is holiday time. Berthun came to me last +evening, and called me aside, and said that it was the king’s wont to +dress his folk anew at the time of the Witan, and then wanted to know +if my vow prevented me from wearing aught but fisher’s clothes. And +when I said that if new clothes went as wage for service about the +place I was glad to hear it, he was pleased, as if it had been likely +that I would refuse a good offer. So the tailor went to work on me, and +hence this finery. But you are as fine, and this is more than we +counted on when we left Grimsby. I suppose it is all in honour of the +lady of the North folk, Goldberga.” + +“Maybe, for I have heard that she is to come.” + +“To be fetched rather, if one is to believe all that one hears. They +say that Alsi has kept her almost as a captive in Dover, having given +her into the charge of some friend of his there, that she may be far +from her own kingdom and people. Now the Norfolk Witan has made him +bring her here. Berthun seems to think there will be trouble.” + +“Only because Alsi will not want to let the kingdom go from his hand to +her. But that will not matter. He is bound by the old promise to her +father.” + +Now we were talking to one another in broad Danish, there being none +near to hear us. We had always used it among ourselves at Grimsby, for +my father loved his old tongue. But at that moment there rode up to the +gate a splendid horseman, young and handsome, and with great gold +bracelets on his arms, one or two of which caught my eye at once, for +they were of the old Danish patterns, and just such as Jarl Sigurd used +to wear. But if I was quick to notice these tokens of the old land, he +had been yet quicker, for he reined up before I stayed him, as was my +duty if he would pass through this gate to the palace, so that I might +know his authority. + +“If I am not mistaken,” he said in our own tongue, “I heard you two +talking in the way I love best. Skoal, therefore, to the first Northman +I have met between here and London town, for it is good to hear a +friendly voice.” + +“Skoal to the jarl!” I answered, and I gave the salute of Sigurd’s +courtmen, which came into my mind on the moment with the familiar +greeting of long years ago. And “Skoal,” said Havelok. + +“Jarl! How know you that I am that?” + +“By the jarl’s bracelet that you wear, surely.” + +“So you are a real Dane—not an English-bred one like myself. That is +good. You and I will have many a talk together. Odin, how good it is to +meet a housecarl who speaks as man to man and does not cringe to me! +Who are you?” + +“Radbard Grimsson of Grimsby, housecarl just now to this King of +Lindsey.” + +“And your comrade?” + +I was about to tell this friendly countryman Havelok’s name without +thought, but stopped in time. Of all the things I had been brought up +to dread most for him, that an English Dane should find him out was the +worst, so I said, “He is called Curan, and he is a Lindsey marshman.” + +“Who can talk Danish though his name is Welsh. That is strange. Well, +you are right about me. I am Ragnar of Norwich, the earl, as the +English for jarl goes. Now I want to see Alsi the king straightway.” + +“That is a matter for the captain,” I said, and I called for him. + +Eglaf came out and made a deep reverence when he saw the earl, knowing +at once who he was, and as this was just what the earl had said that he +did not like, he looked quaintly at me across Eglaf’s broad bent back, +so that I had to grin perforce. + +All unknowing of which the captain heard the earl’s business, and then +told me to see him to the palace gates, and take his horse to the +stables when he had dismounted and was in the hands of Berthun. + +So I went, and Havelok turned away and went on some errand down the +steep street. + +This Ragnar was one of whom I had often heard, for he was the governor +of all the North folk for Alsi until the Lady Goldberga should take her +place. He was her cousin, being the son of Ethelwald’s sister, who was +of course a Dane. Danish, and from the old country, was his father +also, being one of the men who had come over to the court of East +Anglia when Ethelwald was made king. + +All the way to the door we talked of Denmark, but it was not far. There +Berthun came out and greeted the earl in court fashion, and I thought +that I was done with, because the grooms had run to take the great bay +horse as they heard the trampling. But, as it happened, I was wanted. + +Ragnar went in, saying to me that he would find me out again presently; +and I saw him walk across the great hall to the hearth, and stand there +while Berthun went to the king’s presence to tell him of the new +arrival. Then I stood for a minute to look at the horse, for the grooms +had had no orders to take him away; and mindful of Eglaf’s word to me, +I was going to tell them to do so, and to see it done, when Berthun +came hurriedly and called me. + +“Master Housecarl,” he said rather breathlessly, “by the king’s order +you are to come within the hall and guard the doorway.” + +I shouldered my spear and followed him, and as we were out of hearing +of the grooms I said that the captain had ordered me to take the horse +to the stables. + +“I will see to that,” he said. “Now you are to bide at the door while +the king speaks with Earl Ragnar, for there will be none else present. +Let no one pass in without the king’s leave.” + +We passed through the great door as he said that, and he closed it +after him. Ragnar was yet standing near the high seat, and turned as he +heard the sound, and smiled when he saw me. Berthun went quickly away +through a side entrance, and the hail was empty save for us two. The +midday meal was over an hour since, and the long tables had been +cleared away, so that the place seemed desolate to me, as I had only +seen it before when I sat with the other men at the cross tables for +meals. It was not so good a hall as was Jarl Sigurd’s in Denmark, for +it was not rich with carving and colour as was his, and the arms on the +wall were few, and the hangings might have been brighter and better in +a king’s place. + +“Our king does not seem to keep much state,” Ragnar said, looking round +as I was looking, and we both laughed. + +Then the door on the high place opened, and the king came in, soberly +dressed, and with a smile on his face which seemed to me to have been +made on purpose for this greeting, for he mostly looked sour enough. +Nor did it seem that his eyes had any pleasure in them. + +“Welcome, kinsman,” he said, seeming hearty enough, however; “I had +looked for you before this. What news from our good town of Norwich?” + +He held out his hand to Ragnar, who took it frankly, and his strong +grip twisted the king’s set smile into a grin of pain for a moment. + +“All was well there three weeks ago when I left there to go to London. +Now, I have ridden on to say that the Lady Goldberga is not far hence, +so that her coming may be prepared for.” + +Now, as the earl said this, the king’s smile went from his face, and +black enough he looked for a moment. The look passed quickly, and the +smile came back, but it seemed hard to keep it up. + +“Why, that is well,” he said; “so you fell in with her on the way.” + +“I have attended her from London,” answered the earl, looking +steadfastly at Alsi, “and it was as well that I did so, as it +happened.” + +“What has been amiss?” asked the king sharply, and trying to look +troubled. He let the smile go now altogether. + +“Your henchman, Griffin the Welshman, had no guard with her that was +fitting for our princess,” Ragnar said. “He had but twenty men, and +these not of the best. It is in my mind also that I should have been +told of this journey, for I am surely the right man to have guarded my +queen who is to be.” + +At that Alsi’s face went ashy pale, and I did not rightly know why at +the time, but it seemed more in anger than aught else. But he had to +make some answer. + +“We sent a messenger to you,” he said hastily; “I cannot tell why he +did not reach you.” + +“He must have come too late, and after I had heard of this from others; +so I had already gone to meet the princess. I am glad that I was sent +for, and it may pass. Well, it is lucky that I was in time, for we were +attacked on the road, and but for my men there would have been +trouble.” + +Then Alsi broke into wrath, which was real enough. + +“This passes all. Where and by whom were you attacked? and why should +any fall on the party?” + +“Five miles on the other side of Ancaster town, where the Ermin Street +runs among woods, we were fallen on, but who the men were I cannot say. +Why they should fall on us seems plain enough, seeing that the ransom +of a princess is likely to be a great sum.” + +“Was it a sharp fight?” + +“It was not,” answered Ragnar, “for it seemed to me that the men looked +only to find your Welsh thane Griffin and his men. When they saw my +Norfolk housecarls, they waited no longer, and we only rode down one or +two of them. But I have somewhat against this Griffin, for he helped me +not at all. Until this day he and his men had ridden fairly with us, +but by the time this attack came they were half a mile behind us.” + +“Do you mean to say that you think Griffin in league with +these—outlaws, as one may suppose them?” said Alsi, with wrath and more +else written in twitching mouth and crafty eyes. + +“I would not have said that,” Ragnar answered, looking in some surprise +at the king, “it had never come into my head. But I will say that as +the Ermin Street is straight as an arrow, and he was in full sight of +us, he might have spurred his horses to our help, whereas he never +quickened his pace till he saw that the outlaws, or whoever they were, +had gone. I put this as a complaint to you.” + +“These men seem to have scared you, at least,” sneered the king. + +Ragnar flushed deeply. + +“For the princess—yes. It is not fitting that a man who is in charge of +so precious a lady should hold back in danger, even of the least +seeming, as did Griffin. And I told him so.” + +Now I thought that Alsi would have been as angry with Griffin as was +the earl, and that he would add that he also would speak his mind to +him, hut instead of that he went off in another way. + +“It was a pity that a pleasant journey with a fair companion was thus +broken in upon. But it was doubtless pleasant that the lady should see +that her kinsman was not unwilling to draw sword for her. A pretty +little jest this, got up between Griffin and yourself, and such as a +young man may be forgiven for playing. I shall hear Goldberga complain +of honest Griffin presently, and now I shall know how to answer her. +Ay, I will promise him the like talking to that you gave him, and then +we three will laugh over it all together.” + +And with that the king broke into a cackle of laughter, catching hold +of the earl’s arm in his glee. And I never saw any man look so +altogether bewildered as did Ragnar. + +“Little jest was there in the matter, lord king, let me tell you,” he +said, trying to draw his arm away. + +“Nay, I am not angry with you, kinsman; indeed, I am not. We have been +young and eager that bright eyes should see our valour ourselves ere +now,” and he shook his finger at the earl gaily. “I only wonder that +you induced that fiery Welshman to take a rating in the hearing of the +princess quietly.” + +“What I had to say to him I said apart. I will not say that he did take +it quietly.” + +“Meaning—that you had a good laugh over it;” and Alsi shook the earl’s +arm as in glee. “There now, you have made a clean breast, and I am not +one to spoil sport. Go and meet Goldberga at the gates, and bring her +to me in state, and you shall be lodged here, if you will. Quite right +of you to tell me this, or Griffin would have been in trouble. But I +must not have the lady scared again, mind you.” + +He turned quickly away, then, with a sort of stifled laugh, as if he +wanted to get away to enjoy a good jest, and left Ragnar staring +speechless at him as he crossed the high place and went through the +private door. + +Then the earl turned to me, “By Loki, fellow countryman, there is +somewhat wrong here. What does he mean by feigning to think the whole +affair a jest? It won’t be much of a jest if Griffin and I slay one +another tomorrow, as we mean to do, because of what was not done, and +what was said about it.” + +“It has seemed to me, jarl,” I said plainly, “that all this is more +like a jest between the king and Griffin.” + +“Call it a jest, as that is loyal, at least. But I think that you are +right. If Goldberga had been carried off—Come, we shall be saying too +much in these walls.” + +I had only been told to wait while the king and earl spoke together, +and so I opened the door and followed him out. The horse was yet there +waiting for him, and it was plain that the king had not meant him to +stay. + +“Bid the grooms lead the horse after us, and we will go to your +captain. Then you shall take me to one of my friends, for you will know +where their houses are.” + +But at that moment a man from the palace ran after us, bringing an +order from the king that I was to go back to him. So Ragnar bade me +farewell. + +“Come to me tonight at the gatehouse,” he said. “I will speak to the +captain to let you off duty.” + +“Say nothing to him, jarl, for it is needless. I am only with him for a +time, and am my own master. I have no turn on watch tonight, and so am +free.” + +So I went back, and found the king in the hall again, and he was still +smiling. If he had looked me straight in the face, I suppose that he +might have seen that I was not a man to whom he was used, but he did +not. He seemed not to wish to do so. + +“So, good fellow,” he said, “you have heard a pleasant jest of our +young kinsman’s contriving, but I will that you say nothing of it. It +is a pity to take a good guardroom story from you, however, without +some recompense, and therefore—” + +With that he put a little bag into my hand, and it was heavy. I said +nothing, but bowed in the English way, and he went on, “You understand; +no word is to be said of what you have heard unless I bid you repeat +it. That I may have to do, lest it is said that Griffin the thane is +‘nidring’[9] by any of his enemies. You know all the story—how the earl +and he planned a sham attack on the princess’s party, that Ragnar might +show his valour, which, of course, he could not do if Griffin was +there. Therefore the thane held back. But maybe you heard all, and +understood it.” + +“I heard all, lord king, and I will say naught.” + +The king waved his hand in sign that I was dismissed, and I bowed and +went. There were five rings of gold in the bag, worth about the whole +year’s wage of a courtman, and I thought that for keeping a jest to +myself that was good pay indeed. There must be more behind that +business, as it had seemed to me already. + +Now, as I crossed the green within the old walls on my way to the gate, +it happened that Havelok came back from the town, and as he came I +heard him whistling softly to himself a strange wild call, as it were, +of a hunting horn, very sweet, and one that I had never heard before. + +“Ho, brother!” I said, for there was no one near us. “What is that call +you are whistling?” + +He started and looked up at me suddenly, and I saw that his trouble was +on him again. + +“In my dream,” he said slowly, “there is a man on a great horse, and he +wears such bracelets as Ragnar of Norwich, and he winds his horn with +that call, and I run to him; and then I myself am on the horse, and I +go to the stables, and after that there is nothing but the call that I +hear. Now it has gone again.” + +And his hand went up in the way that made me sad to see. + +“It will come back by-and-by. Trouble not about it.” + +“I would that we were back in Grimsby,” he said, with a great sigh. +“This is a place of shadows. Ghosts are these of days that I think can +never have been.” + +“Well,” said I, wanting to take him out of himself, “this is no ghost, +at all events. I would that one of our brothers would come from home +that I might send it to them in Grimsby. We do not need it.” + +So I showed him the gold, and he wondered at it, and laughed, saying +that the housecarls had the best place after all. And so he went on, +and I back to the gate. + +Surely he minded at last the days when Gunnar his father had ridden +home to the gate, as the Danish earl had ridden even now, and had +called his son to him with that call. It was all coming back, as one +thing or another brought it to his mind; and I wondered what should be +when he knew that the dream was the truth. For what should Havelok, +foster-son of the fisher, do against a king who for twelve long years +had held his throne? And who in all the old land would believe that he +was indeed the son of the lost king? Better, it seemed to me, that this +had not happened, and that he had been yet the happy, careless, +well-loved son of Grim, with no thought of aught higher than the good +of the folk he knew. + +When I got back to the gate, we were marched down the town, that we +might be ready to receive the princess; and as I went through the +market, I saw one of the porters whom I knew, and I beckoned to him, so +that he came alongside me in the ranks, and I asked him if he would go +to Grimsby for me for a silver penny. He would do it gladly; and so I +sent him with word to Arngeir that I needed one of them here to take a +gift that I had for them. I would meet whoever came at the widow’s +house, and I set a time when I would look for them. I thought it was +well that the king’s gold should not be wasted, even for a day’s use, +if I could help it. And I wearied to see one of the brothers, and hear +all that was going on. + + + + +CHAPTER XI. +THE COMING OF THE PRINCESS. + + +There is no need for me to tell aught of the entry of the Lady +Goldberga into the town, for anyone may know how the people cheered +her, and how the party were met by the Norfolk thanes and many others, +and so rode on up the hill to the palace. What the princess was like I +hardly noticed at that time, for she was closely hooded, and her +maidens were round her. And I had something else to think of; for +foremost, and richly dressed, with a gold chain round his neck, rode a +man whose strange way of carrying his head caught my eye at once, so +that I looked more than a second time at him. + +And at last I knew him. It was that man of ours whose neck had been +twisted by the way in which he had been hauled on board at the time of +the wreck, and had afterwards gone to Ethelwald’s court. One would say +that this Mord had prospered exceedingly, for he was plainly a man of +some consequence in the princess’s household. He did not know me, +though it happened that he looked right at me for a moment; but I did +not expect him to do so after twelve years, seeing that I was but a boy +when we parted. I thought that I would seek him presently. + +Then I saw Griffin, the Welsh thane, and I did not like the looks of +him at all. He was a black-haired man, clean shaven, so that the cruel +thinness of his lips was not hidden, and his black eyes were restless, +and never stayed anywhere, unless he looked at Ragnar for a moment, and +then that was a look of deadly hatred. He wore his armour well, and had +a steady seat on his horse; but, if all that I had heard of him was +true, his looks did not belie him. Men had much to say of him here, +for, being some far-off kin to Alsi’s Welsh mother, he was always about +the court, and was hated. He had gone to Dover to fetch the princess +before we came here, but it happened that I had once or twice seen him +at other times when I was in Lincoln, so that I knew him now. + +There was great feasting that night in the king’s hall, as one may +suppose, and I sat with the housecarls at the cross tables beyond the +fire, and I could see the Lady Goldberga at Alsi’s side. Tired she was +with her long journey, and she did not remain long at the table; but I +had never seen so wondrously beautiful a lady. Griffin sat next to her +on the king’s right hand, for Ragnar was at the king’s left, in the +seat of next honour; and I saw that the lady had no love for the Welsh +thane. But I also thought that I saw how he would give his all for a +kindly glance from her; and if, as Alsi had seemed to hint, Ragnar was +a favoured lover, I did not wonder that Griffin had been ready to do +him a bad turn. I had rather that the thane was my friend than my foe, +for he would be no open enemy. + +I left the feast when the first change of guard went out, for I saw +that the ale cup was passing faster than we Danes think fitting, being +less given to it than the English. And when the guard was set I waited +alone in the guardroom of the old gate, for Eglaf was yet at the hall, +and would be there all night maybe. And presently Earl Ragnar came in +and sat down with me. + +He was silent for a while, and I waited for him to speak, until he +looked up at me with a little laugh, and said, “I told you that I had +to fight Griffin tomorrow?” + +“You did, earl. Is that matter settled otherwise?” + +“Not at all,” he answered. “I believe now that he was acting under +orders, but I have said things to him which he cannot pass over. I +called him ‘nidring’ to his face, and that I still mean; for though I +thought of cowardice at the time, he is none the less so if he has +plotted against the princess. So naught but the sword will end the +feud.” + +He pondered for some moments, and then went on, “It is a bad business; +for if I slay Griffin, he is the king’s favourite; and if he slays me, +the Norfolk thanes will have somewhat to say. And all is bad for the +Lady Goldberga, who needs all the friends that she has, for in either +case there will be trouble between the two kingdoms that Alsi holds +just now.” + +“If Griffin is slain,” I said, “I think that the lady has one trouble +out of the way.” + +“Ay; and the king will make out, as you heard him do even now, that I +am looking that way myself. It is not so, for I will say to you at once +that to me there is but one lady in all the world, and she is in +Norfolk at this time. Now I am going to ask you something that is a +favour.” + +I thought that he would give me some message for this lady, in case he +fell; but he had more to ask than that. Nothing more or less than that +I should be his second in the fight, because I was a fellow countryman, +while to ask an East Anglian thane would he to make things harder yet +for Goldberga. + +“I am no thane, earl,” I said plainly. “This is an honour that is over +high for me.” + +“It seems that you own a town, for I asked Eglaf just now,” he +answered; “and that is enough surely to give you thane’s rank in a +matter like this. But that is neither here nor there; it is as Dane to +Dane that I ask you. If I could find another of us I would ask him +also, that you might not have to stand alone. I am asking you to break +the law that bids the keeping of the peace at the time of the meeting +of the Witan.” + +“That is no matter,” I said. “If I have to fly, it will be with you as +victor; and if it is but a matter of a fine, I have had that from the +king today which will surely pay it.” + +And I told him of the gift for silence, whereat he laughed heartily, +and then said that the secret was more worth than he thought. This +looked very bad, and like proof that the king was at the bottom of the +whole business. + +Now I had been thinking, and it seemed better that there should be two +witnesses of the fight on our side, and I thought that Havelok was the +man who would make the second. So I told Ragnar that I could find +another Dane who was at least as worthy as I, and he was well pleased. +Then he told me where the meeting was to be, and where we should meet +him just before daylight; and so he went back to the hall, where the +lights were yet burning redly, and the songs were wilder than ever. + +And I found Havelok, and told him of the fight that was to be, and +asked him to come with us. His arms were at the widow’s, and he could +get them without any noticing him. + +There is no need to say that he was ready as I to help Ragnar, and so +we spoke of time and place, and parted for the night. + +Very early came Havelok to the house, for I lodged at the widow’s when +I was not on night duty; and we armed ourselves, and then came Ragnar. +He greeted me first, and then looked at Havelok in amaze, as it seemed, +and then bowed a little, and asked me to make my friend known to him. + +“If you are the friend of whom Radbard has told me, I think that I am +fortunate in having come to him.” + +“I am his brother, lord earl,” answered Havelok, “and I am at your +service.” + +Ragnar looked from one of us to the other, and then smiled. + +“A brother Dane and a brother in arms, truly,” he said. “Well, that is +all that I need ask, except your name, as I am to be another brother of +the same sort.” + +Then Havelok looked at me, and I nodded. I knew what he meant; but it +was not right that the earl should not know who he was. + +“Men call me Curan here, lord earl, and that I must be to you +hereafter. But I am Havelok of Grimsby, son of Grim.” + +In a moment I saw that the earl knew more of that name than I had +deemed possible; and then I minded Mord, the wry-necked, who was the +chamberlain now. But Ragnar said nothing beyond that he would remember +the request, and that he was well seconded. And then we went out into +the grey morning, and without recrossing the bridge, away to the level +meadows on the south of the river, far from any roadway. + +“There is not an island in the stream,” said Ragnar, “or I should have +wanted the old northern holmgang battle. I doubt if we could even get +these Welshmen to peg out the lists.” + +“That we must see to,” I said. “We will have all things fair in some +way.” + +Half a mile from the town we came to what they call a carr—a woody rise +in the level marsh—and on the skirts of this two men waited us. They +were the seconds of Griffin, Welsh or half Welsh both of them by their +looks, and both were well armed. Their greeting was courteous enough, +and they led us by a little track into the heart of the thickets, and +there was a wide and level clearing, most fit for a fight, in which +waited Griffin himself. + +Now I had never taken any part in a fight before, and I did not rightly +know what I had to do to begin with. However, one of the other side +seemed to be well up in the matter, and at once he came to me and +Havelok and took us aside. + +“Here is a little trouble,” he said: “our men have said nothing of what +weapons they will use.” + +“I take it,” said Havelok at once, “that they meant to use those which +were most handy to them, therefore.” + +The Welshman stared, and answered rather stiffly, “This is not a matter +of chance medley, young sir, but an ordered affair. But doubtless this +is the first time you have been in this case, and do not know the +rules. Let me tell you, therefore, that your earl, being the challenged +man, has choice of weapons. + +“Why, then,” answered Havelok, “it seems to me that if we say as I have +already said, it is fair on our part. For it is certain that the earl +will want to use the axe, and your man is about half his weight, so +that would be uneven.” + +“As the challenged man, the earl is entitled to any advantage in +weapons.” + +“He needs none. Let us fight fairly or not at all. The earl takes the +axe.—What say you, Radbard? Griffin takes what he likes.” + +“You keep to the axe after all, and yet say that it gives an +advantage.” + +“Axe against axe it does, but if your man chooses to take a twenty-foot +spear and keep out of its way, we do not object. We give him his own +choice.” + +Then the other second said frankly, “This is generous, Cadwal. No more +need be said. But this young thane has not yet asked his earl whether +it will suit him.” + +“Faith, no,” said Havelok, laughing; “I was thinking what I should like +myself, and nothing at all of the earl.” + +So I went across to Ragnar, who was waiting patiently at one end of the +clearing, while Griffin was pacing with uneven steps backward and +forward at the other, and I told him what the question was. + +“I thought it would be a matter of swords,” he said, “but I am Dane +enough to like the axe best. Settle it as you will. Of course he knows +naught of axe play, so that you are right in not pressing it on him. He +is a light man, and active, and maybe will be glad not even to try +sword to sword; for look at the sort of bodkin he is wearing.” + +The earl and we had the northern long sword, of course; but when I +looked I saw that the Welsh had short, straight, and heavy weapons of +about half the length of ours, and so even sword to sword seemed hard +on the lighter man; wherein I was wrong, as I had yet to learn. + +I went back, therefore, and told the others. + +“The earl takes the axe, and the thane has his choice, as we have +said.” + +“We have to thank you,” said the other second, while Cadwal only +laughed a short laugh, and bade us choose the ground with them. + +There was no difficulty about that, for the light was clear and bright, +and though the sun was up, the trees bid any bright rays that might be +in the eyes of the fighters. However, we set them across the light, so +that all there was might be even; and then we agreed that if one was +forced back to the edge of the clearing he was to be held beaten, as if +we had been on an island. It was nearly as good, for the shore of trees +and brushwood was very plain and sharp. + +Now Ragnar unslung his round shield from his shoulders, and took his +axe from me, for I had carried it for him, and his face was quiet and +steady, as the face of one should be who has a deed to do that must be +seen through to the end. But Griffin and his men talked quickly in +their own tongue, and I had to tell them that we understood it well +enough. Then they looked at each other, and were silent suddenly. I +wondered what they, were about to say, for it seemed that my warning +came just in time for them. + +Griffin took a shield from the thane they called Cadwal, and it was +square—a shape that I had not seen before in use, though Witlaf had one +like it on the wall at Stallingborough. He said that it had been won +from a chief by his forefathers when the English first came into the +land, and that it was the old Roman shape. It seemed unhandy to me, but +I had no time to think of it for a moment, for now Cadwal had a last +question. + +“Is this fight to be to the death?” + +“No,” I answered; “else were the rule we made about the boundary of no +use.” + +Then Griffin cried in a sort of choked voice, “It shall be to the +death.” + +But I said nothing, and the other second, with Cadwal, shook his head. + +Ragnar made no sign, but Cadwal said to Havelok, “You were foremost in +the matter just now. What say you?” + +“Rules are rules, and what my comrade says is right. If the first blow +slays, we cannot help it, but there shall be no second wound. The man +who is first struck is defeated.” + +“I will not have it so,” said Griffin. + +“Well, then, thane, after you have wounded the earl you will have to +reckon with me, if you must slay someone.” + +Griffin looked at the towering form of my brother and made no answer, +and the other second told him that it was right. There was naught but +an angry word or two to be atoned for. So there was an end, and Ragnar +went on guard. Griffin made ready also, and at once it was plain that +here was no uneven match after all. + +Both of them wore ring mail of the best. We had set the two six paces +apart, and they must step forward to get within striking distance. At +once Griffin seemed to grow smaller, for he crouched down as a cat that +is going to spring, and raised his shield before him, so that from +where I stood behind Ragnar I could only see his black glittering eyes +and round helm above its edge. And his right arm was drawn back, so +that only the point of his heavy leaf-bladed sword was to be seen +glancing from the right edge steadily. And now his eyes were steady as +the sword point, which was no brighter than they. If once he got inside +the sweep of the great axe it would be bad for Ragnar. + +One step forward went the earl, shield up and axe balanced, but Griffin +never moved. Then Ragnar leapt forward and struck out, but I could see +that it was a feint, and he recovered at once. Griffin’s shield had +gone up in a moment above his head, and in a moment it was back in its +place, and over it his eyes glared as before, unwavering. And then, +like a wildcat, he sprang at Ragnar, making no sweeping blow with his +sword, but thrusting with straight arm, so that the whole weight of his +flying body was behind the point. Ragnar struck out, but the square +shield was overhead to stay the blow, and full on the round Danish +buckler the point of the short sword rang, for the earl was ready to +meet it. + +In a moment the Welshman was back in his crouching guard, leaving a +great ragged hole in the shield whence he had wrenched his weapon point +in a way that told of a wrist turn that had been long practised. Ragnar +had needed no leech, had his quick eye not saved him from that thrust. + +Then for a breathing space the two watched each other, while we held +our breath, motionless. And then Griffin slowly began to circle round +his foe, still crouching. + +Then, like a thunderbolt, Ragnar’s axe swept down on the thane, and +neither shield nor helm would have been of avail had that blow gone +home. Back leapt Griffin, and the axe shore the edge only of his +shield; and then, shield aloft and point foremost, he flew on the earl +before the axe had recovered from its swing, and I surely thought that +the end had come, for the earl’s shield was lowered, and his face was +unguarded. + +But that was what he looked for. Up and forward flew the round shield, +catching the thane’s straightened arm along its whole length, and then, +as sword and arm were dashed upwards, smiting him fairly in the face; +and, like a stone, the Welshman was hurled from it, and fell backward +in a heap on the grass three paces away. It seemed to me that he was +off his feet in his spring as the shield smote him. + +There he lay, and Havelok strode forward and stood between the two, +with his face to Griffin, for Ragnar had dropped his axe to rest when +his foe fell. + +“No blood drawn,” said my brother, “but no more fighting can there be. +The man’s arm is out.” + +And so it was, for the mighty heave that turned the thrust had ended +Griffin’s fighting for a long day. But he did not think so. + +The sweat was standing on his face in great beads from the pain, but he +got up and shifted his sword to his left hand. + +“It is to the death,” he cried; “I can fight as well with the left. +Stand aside.” + +“An it had been so, you were a dead man now,” said Havelok, “for the +earl held his hand where he might have slain. If he had chosen, you +might have felt his axe before you touched the ground.” + +Thereat, without warning other than a snarl of “Your own saying,” +Griffin leapt at my brother fiercely, only to meet a swing of his axe +that sent his sword flying from his hand. And that was deft of Havelok, +for there is nothing more hard to meet than a left-handed attack at any +time, and this seemed unlooked for. + +“Well, I did say somewhat of this sort,” said Havelok; “but it was +lucky that I had not forgotten it.” + +Then he took the thane by the waist and left arm and set him down +gently; and after that all the fury went from him, and he grew pale +with the pain of the arm that was hurt. But both I and the Welshmen had +shouted to Griffin to hold, all uselessly, so quick had been his onset +on his new foe. + +Cadwal held his peace, biting his lip, but the other Welshman began to +blame Griffin loudly for this. + +“Nay,” said Havelok, smiling; “it was my own fault maybe. The thane was +overhasty certainly, but one does not think with pain gnawing at one. +Let that pass. + +“Now, earl, I think that you may say what you have to say that will set +things right once more.” + +“Can none of us put the arm back first?” I said. “I will try, if none +else has done such a thing before, for it will not be the first time.” + +“Put it back, if you can,” said Cadwal. “If there is anything to be +said, it had better be in some sort of comfort.” + +So I put the arm back, for when once the trick is learned there is not, +as a rule, much trouble. But Griffin never thanked me. He left that to +his seconds, who did so well enough. + +Then Ragnar came forward and said gravely, “I was wrong when I called +you ‘nidring,’ and I take back the word and ask you to forget it. No +man who is that will face the Danish axe as you have faced it, and I +will say that the British sword is a thing to be feared.” + +But Griffin made no answer, and when Ragnar held out his hand he would +not see it. + +“Maybe I have not yet made amends,” Ragnar went on. “I will add, +therefore, as I know that my words will go no farther, that I am sure +that the thing concerning which we quarrelled yesterday was done by you +at the orders of another. It was not your own doing, and no thought of +cowardice is in my mind now.” + +But Griffin never answered; and now he turned his back on the earl, who +was plainly grieved, and said no more to him, but turned to us and the +two Welshmen. + +“I do not think that I can say more. If there is aught that is needed, +tell me. We have fought a fair fight, and I have taken back the words +that caused it.” + +Then said Cadwal, “No more is needed. I did not think that we had met +with so generous a foe. If Griffin will say naught, we say this for +him. He has no cause for enmity left. And I say also that he has to +thank this thane for his life as well as the earl.” + +“No thane am I,” said Havelok, “but only Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby. +And even that name is set aside for a while, so that I must ask you to +forget it. I have seen a good fight, if a short one, and one could not +smite a wounded man who forgot himself for a moment.” + +There was nothing more to be had from Griffin, for we waited a minute +or two in silence to see if he would speak, and then we saluted and +left the wood. + +The last thing that I saw seemed to be a matter of high words between +Griffin and his seconds; and, indeed, if they were telling him what +they thought, it is likely that he wished he had been more courteous. +It is easy enough for a man who wants a quarrel to have done with one +and then start another. + + + + +CHAPTER XII. +IN LINCOLN MARKETPLACE. + + +We went quietly back to the town, and there was only one thing that I +wished, and that was that Havelok had not had to tell his name twice. +Ragnar was full of thanks to us for our help, and said that he would +that we would come to Norfolk with him. + +“We have a man who knows you also,” he said, “but he has been with our +princess for a long time now. He is called Mord, and is her +chamberlain. He has often told me how he came by his wry-neck at the +time of your shipwreck.” + +So he said, and looked at Havelok. But this was a thing that he had not +seen, as he was so sick at the time. I said that I remembered Mord +well, and would seek him some time in the day. + +And as I said this I was thinking that I must find out from Mord +whether he knew and had told more than I could of who Havelok was and +whence he came to us. It seemed to me that the earl had heard some tale +or other, and unless it was from him I could not think from whence. + +Now the earl said, “This business has ended better than I could have +hoped, and I think that Alsi will not hear of it. Griffin can well +account for a slipped shoulder by any sort of fall that he likes to own +to, and Alsi would be hardly pleased to hear that he had run the risk +of setting all Norfolk against him for nothing after all.” + +“There is no doubt that he meant you to know that he does not consider +the quarrel done with,” I said. “You have an enemy there.” + +“Nothing new, that,” answered Ragnar, laughing. “He thinks that I stand +in his way with the princess. I suppose it is common talk that if he +wedded her Alsi would still hold the East Anglian kingdom, making him +ealdorman, if only I were out of the way. But were I to wed the lady, +then it is certain that she would take the crown at once. I do not mean +to do so, for then it is likely that three people would be unhappy for +the rest of their days. But that would be less wretched for her than to +wed Griffin.” + +“This is no pleasant strait for the poor lady,” said Havelok grimly. +“Do none ask what she herself can wish?” + +“That is the trouble,” said the earl, “for she is in Alsi’s hand, and +there is some old promise and oath sworn between him and Ethelwald her +father that holds him back. Else had she been wedded to Griffin before +now.” + +Then we came to the widow’s house, and Havelok left his arms there, and +we went on to the marketplace. As we crossed the bridge we saw that +there was something going forward, for there was a gathering in the +wide space, and a shouting and cheering now and then, and even Berthun +himself was there looking on and seeming to be highly entertained. + +“Here is a crowd that I will not face just now, in my arms,” said the +earl; “for this hole in my shield looks bad, not having been there when +I went out. Farewell for the time, therefore, and think of what I said +about your coming to Norwich with me.” + +He turned away therefore, and Havelok looked after him for a moment. +The shield hung at his back, plain to be seen. + +“It is a hole, for certain,” he said; “but there is no need to show it +in that wise.” + +So he strode after him. + +“By your leave, earl, I will arrange your cloak across the shield, and +then you can get it to your armourer without notice.” + +“That is well thought of,” answered Ragnar, as Havelok did as he had +said. “I do not forget that I think that I owe you my life, though I +have said nothing as yet.” + +“How is that?” + +“Griffin would have flown on me as he did on you, certainly; and it is +in my mind that you foresaw it, which I did not. I could not have +stayed him.” + +“Well I did,” answered my brother; “else had either I or you a hole in +us like the one that is well covered now. But I feared what came to +pass.” + +Ragnar held out his hand, and Havelok took it, and so they parted +without more words; but I knew that these two were friends from that +time forward, whatever happened. + +There were some sports of some sort on hand, when we came to see what +all the noise was; and Berthun, seeing us, called Havelok to him. + +“I have been looking for you,” he said, with that curious tone of his +that always seemed to be asking pardon for his boldness in speaking to +my brother; “for here are games at which they need some one to show the +way.” + +“This is a sport that I have not seen before,” answered Havelok, +looking over the heads of the crowd. “I should make a poor hand at it.” + +They had been tossing a great fir pole, which was now laid on one side, +with its top split from its falls, and they, thanes and freemen in +turn, were putting a great stone, so heavy that a matter of a few +inches beyond the longest cast yet made would be something to be proud +of. Good sport enough it was to see the brawny housecarls heave it from +the ground and swing it. But no one could lift it above his knee, so +that one may suppose that it flew no great distance at a cast. + +“Nay, but the thanes are trying,” Berthun said. “It is open to all to +do what they can. One of your porters is best man so far.” + +“Well, I will not try to outdo him.” + +“I would that you would lift the stone, Curan. That is a thing that I +should most like to see.” + +“Well then, master, as you bid me, I will try. But do not expect too +much.” + +The man who had the stone made his cast, which was nothing to speak of; +and then the stone lay unclaimed for a time, while all the onlookers +waited to see who came forward next. Then Havelok made his way through +the crowd, and a silence as of wonder fell on the people; for some knew +him, and had heard of his strength, and those who did not stared at him +as at a wonder. But the silence did not last long, for the porters who +were there set up a sort of shout of delight, and that one who had made +the longest cast so far began to tell him how best to heft the stone +and swing it. + +Then Havelok bent to raise the stone, and the noise hushed again. I saw +his mighty limbs harden and knot under the strain, and up to his knee +he heaved it, and to his middle, and yet higher, to his chest, while we +all held our breaths, and then with a mighty lift it was at his +shoulder, and he poised it, and swung as one who balances for a moment, +and then hurled it from him. Then was a shout that Alsi might have +heard in his hilltop palace, for full four paces beyond the strong +porter’s cast it flew, lighting with a mighty crash, and bedding itself +in the ground where it lit. And I saw the young thanes with wide eyes +looking at my brother, and from beside me Berthun the cook fairly +roared with delight. + +And then from across the space between the two lines of onlookers I saw +a man in a fisher’s dress that caught my eye. It was Withelm, and we +nodded to each other, well pleased. + +Now there seemed to be a strife as to who should get nearest to +Havelok, for men crowded to pat him and to look up at him, and that +pleased him not at all. One came and bade him take the silver pennies +that the thanes had set out for the prize, but he shook his head and +smiled. + +“I threw the thing because I was bidden, and not for any prize,” he +said. “I would have it given to the porter who fairly won it.” + +Then he elbowed his way to Berthun, and said, “let us go, master; we +have stayed here too long already.” + +“As it pleases you,” the steward said; and Havelok waved his hand to +me, and they went their way. + +He had not seen Withelm, and I was glad, for I wanted to speak to him +alone first. + +Now men began to ask who this was, and many voices answered, while the +porter went to claim the prize from the thane who held it. + +Two silver pennies the thane gave him, and said, “This seems to be a +friend of yours, and it was good to hear you try to help him without +acrimony. Not that he needed any hints from any one, however. Who is +he?” + +“Men call him Curan, that being the name he gives himself; but he came +as a stranger to the place, and none know from whence, unless Berthun +the cook may do so. Surely he is a friend of mine, for he shook me +once, and that shaking made an honest man of me. He himself taught me +what fair play is, at that same time.” + +So said the porter, and laughed, and the thane joined him. + +“Well, he has made a sort of name for himself as a wonder, certainly, +now. I think that this cast of his will be told of every time men lift +a stone here in Lincoln,” said the thane. + +They left the stone where he had set it, and any one may see it there +to this day, and there I suppose it will be for a wonder while +Havelok’s name is remembered. + +Then they began wrestling and the like, and I left the crowd and went +to Withelm, going afterwards to the widow’s. I was not yet wanted by +Eglaf for any housecarl duty. + +“I sent a man to Grimsby yesterday,” I said; “but you must have passed +him on the way somewhere, for he could not have started soon enough to +take you a message before you left.” + +“I met him on the road last night, for I myself thought it time to come +and see how you two fared. I bided at Cabourn for the night, and your +messenger came on with me.” + +Then he told me that all were well at Grimsby; for fish came now and +then and kept the famine from the town, though there were none to send +elsewhere; and it was well that we had left, though they all missed us +sorely. + +Then we began to talk of the doings here; and at last I spoke of +Havelok’s trouble, as one may well call it, telling him also of the +strange dream with which it all began. + +“All this is strange,” he said thoughtfully; “but if Havelok our +brother is indeed a king’s son, it is only what he is like in all his +ways. Wise was our father Grim, and I mind how he seemed always to be +careful of him in every way, and good reason must he have had not to +say what he knew. We will not ask aught until the time of which Arngeir +knows has come. Nor can we say aught to Havelok, though he is troubled, +for we know nothing. As for the dream, that is part of it all, and it +is a portent, as I think.” + +“Did I know the man who could read it, I would go to him and tell him +it.” + +“There is one man who can read dreams well,” Withelm answered, flushing +a little, “but I do not know if you would care to seek him. I stayed +with him last night, and he is on his way even now to Lincoln, driven +by the famine. I mean the old British priest David, who has his little +hut and chapel in the Cabourn woods. His people have no more to give +him.” + +I knew that Withelm thought much of this old man of late, and I was not +surprised to hear him speak of him now. All knew his wisdom, and the +marsh folk were wont to seek him when they were in any trouble or +difficulty. But I did not care to go to him, for he seemed to belong to +the thralls, as one might say. + +“Well, if he comes here, no doubt you will know where to find him if we +need him,” I said. “Bide with us for a few days at least, for here is +plenty, and there is much going on.” + +So we went into the town, and then to the palace, and found Havelok, +and after that I had to go to the gate on guard. And what these two did +I cannot say, but, at all events, there is nothing worth telling of. + +Now, however, I have to tell things that I did not see or hear myself, +and therefore I would have it understood that I heard all from those +who took some part or other in the matter, and so know all well. + +I have not said much of the meetings of the Witan, for I had naught +more to do with them than to guard the doors of the hall where they met +now and then; but since the princess and Ragnar came they seem to have +somewhat to do with the story, as will be seen. + +On this day one of the Norfolk thanes asked in full meeting what plans +the king had for his ward Goldberga, and her coming into her kingdom, +saying that she, being eighteen years of age, was old enough to take +her place. + +Now Alsi had thought of this beforehand, and was ready at once. + +“It is a matter of concern to us always,” he said, “and much have I +thought thereof. It is full time that she took her father’s place with +the consent of the Witan, which is needed.” + +He looked round us for reply to this, and at once the Norfolk thanes +said, “We will have Goldberga for our queen, as was the will of +Ethelwald.” + +“That,” said Alsi, “is as I thought. I needed only to hear it said +openly. Now, therefore, it remains but to speak of one other thing and +that is a weighty one. It was her father’s will and I swore to carry it +out, that she should be wedded to the most goodly and mightiest man in +the realm. It seems to me that on her marriage hangs all the wealth of +her kingdom; and ill it would be if, after she took the throne, she +took to herself one who made himself an evil adviser. I would say that +it were better to see her married first, for it does not follow that +you would choose to have the man whom I thought fitting to be over you, +as he certainly would be.” + +Now all this was so straightforward in all seeming that none of the +thanes could be aught but pleased. Moreover, it took away a fear that +they had had lest Griffin was to be the man. None could say that he +fulfilled the conditions of the will of Ethelwald. The spokesman said, +therefore, that it was well set before them, and that it was best to +wait, saying at the end, “For, after all, we might have to change our +minds concerning the princess, if with her we must take a man who will +prove a burden or tyrant to us all.” + +Then they asked the king to find a good husband for the princess as +soon as might be, so that he was not against her liking. + +“Well,” said Alsi, “it is a hard task for a man who has no wife to help +him; but we will trust to the good sense of my niece. Now, I had +thought of Ragnar of Norwich; but it is in my mind that the old laws of +near kin are somewhat against this.” + +I suppose that he had no intention of letting the earl marry the +princess; but this was policy, as it might please the thanes. However, +the matter of kinship did not please some, and that was all that he +needed, for there was excuse then for him if he forbade that match, +which was the last he wanted. + +Ragnar sat in his place and heard all this, and he wished himself back +at Norwich. + +So there the matter ended, and that was the last sitting of the Witan. +There was to be a great breaking-up feast that night before the thanes +scattered to their homes. + +Now while this was going on I ended my spell of duty, and bethought me +of Mord the chamberlain, and so went to Berthun and asked for him. He +said that if I had any special business with Mord I might see him; and +I said, truly enough, that my errand was special, having to do with +friends of his; so it was not long before they took me to him. He was +in a long room that was built on the side of the great hall, as it +were, and I could hear the murmur of the voices of those who spoke at +the Witan while I waited. + +Now Mord was not so much changed as I, and at first he did not know me +at all. + +“Well, master housecarl, what may your message be, and from whom is +it?” he said, without more than a glance at me. + +“Why, there are some old friends of yours who are anxious to know if +you have forgotten the feeling of a halter round your neck,” I said in +good Danish. + +Then, after one look, he knew me at once, and ran to me, and took my +hand, and almost kissed me in his pleasure, for since I could handle an +oar he had known me, and had taught me how to do that, moreover. + +Then he called for wine and food; and we sat down together and had a +long talk of the old days, and of how we had fared after he left, and +of all else that came uppermost. And sorely he grieved at my father’s +death, and at the trouble that was on us. The famine had not been so +sore in the south, and pestilence had not been at all. + +As for himself, he had been courtman, as we call the housecarls, at +first, and so had risen to be chamberlain to the king, and now to the +princess, and had been with her everywhere that Alsi had sent her since +her father died. + +“It was a good day for me, and wise was Grim when he bade me go to +Ethelwald to seek service,” he said; “yet I would that I had seen him +once more. I have never been to this place before, else I should have +sought him.” + +Now I was going to ask him about Havelok, but hardly knew how to begin. +He saved me the trouble however, by speaking first. + +“Who were the lady and the boy we had on board when we came to +England?” he said. “I never heard, and maybe it was as well that I did +not.” + +“My father never told me. But why do you think that it was well not to +know?” + +“Because I am sure that Grim had good reason for not telling. Before I +had been a year at Norwich there came a ship from Denmark into the +river, and soon men told me that her master was asking for news of one +Grim, a merchant, who was lost. So I saw him, not saying who I was or +that I had anything to do with Grim; and then I found that it was not +so much of the master that he wanted news as of the boy we had with us. +He did not ask of the lady at all, and I was sure that this was the man +who came and spoke to Grim just as we were sailing, if you remember. So +then it came to me that we knew nothing of the coming on board of these +two, only learning of their presence when we were far at sea. And now, +if Hodulf troubled himself so much about this boy, there must be +something that he was not meant to know about his flight, for he must +be of some note. Did I not know that the king’s son was in his hands at +that time, I should have thought that our passenger was he. However, I +told him of the shipwreck as of a thing that I had seen, saying that +Grim and his family and a few men only had been saved; and I told him +also that I had heard that he had lost some folk in an attack by +Vikings. With that he seemed well satisfied, and I heard no more of +him. I have wondered ever since who the boy was, and if he was yet +alive. I mind that he was like to die when he came ashore.” + +Then I laughed, and said that he would hear of him soon enough, for all +the town was talking of him; and he guessed whom I meant, for he had +heard of the cook’s mighty man. + +Now I said no more but this: + +“My father kept this matter secret all these years, and with reason, as +we have seen; and so, while he is here, we call this foster-brother of +mine Curan, until the time comes when his name may he known. Maybe it +will be best for you not to say much of your knowledge of him. What +does Earl Ragnar know of our wreck? For he told me that you knew me.” + +“I told him all about it at one time or another,” Mord answered. “He +always wanted to hear of Denmark.” + +So that was all that the chamberlain knew; but it was plain to me that +the earl had put two and two together when he heard Havelok’s name, and +had remembered that this was also the name of Gunnar’s son. Afterwards +I found that Mord had heard from Denmark that Hodulf was said to have +made away with Havelok, but he never remembered that at this time. +Ragnar knew this, and did remember it. + +Pleasant it was to talk of old days with an old friend thus, and the +time went quickly. Then Mord must go to his mistress and I to my place, +and so we parted for the time. But my last doubt of who Havelok my +brother might be was gone. I was sure that he was the son of Gunnar the +king. + + + + +CHAPTER XIII. +THE WITAN’S FEASTING. + + +Now I have to tell of a strange thing that happened in the night that +was just past, the first that the Lady Goldberga had spent here in +Lincoln for many a year, for on that happening hangs a great deal, and +it will make clear what I myself saw presently at the breaking-up feast +of the Witan. That puzzled me mightily at the time, as it did many at +the feast, but I see no reason why it should not be told at once. + +Now I have said that Goldberga left the hall early overnight, being +wearied with the journey, and having the remembrance of the attack on +her party so near to Lincoln to trouble her also. Not much cause to +love her uncle Alsi had she; though perhaps, also, not much to make her +hate him, except that he had kept her so far away from her own people +of late, in a sort of honourable captivity. Now it was plain to her +that had it not been for the presence of Ragnar and his men, her guard +would not have been able to drive off the attackers; and the strange +way in which Griffin had held back had been too plain for her not to +notice. Already she feared him, and it seemed that he might have +plotted her carrying off thus. That Alsi might have had a hand in the +matter did not come into her mind, as it did into the minds of others, +for she knew little of him, thinking him honest if not very pleasant in +his ways, else had not her father made him her guardian. + +I will say now that in the attack he did have a hand. Many a long year +afterward it all came out in some way. He dared not give his niece to +Griffin openly, but he wished to do so, as then he would have an +under-king in East Anglia of his own choosing. Sorely against the grain +with him was it that he should have to give up those fair lands to this +girl, who would hold the throne by her own right, and not at all under +him. So he and Griffin had plotted thus, and only Ragnar’s presence had +spoilt the plan, though Griffin had tried to save it by holding back. +But I must say also that up to this time none had had aught to say +against Alsi as a ruler, though he was over close, and not at all +hearty in his ways at home. But now, for the sake of the kingdom, he +had begun to plot; and this plan having come to naught, he must make +others, as will be seen. I do not think that this planning to keep +Ethelwald’s kingdom from his daughter was anything fresh to Alsi, but +the time for action had come now. + +He had made ready by keeping the fair princess far away, and there were +none who could speak of her goodness, or, indeed, had heard much of her +since she was a child. Therefore, as men were content enough with him, +none would trouble much if the princess came not to the throne, given +good reason why she should not do so. And the very best reason would be +that which Alsi had given at the Witan—if her husband was not fit to be +king. + +It is possible that Goldberga knew that her marriage would be talked of +at this Witan: but I do not think that she troubled herself much about +it, not by any means intending to be married against her will. I have +heard that so ran the will of Ethelwald, that she was to have choice to +some extent. However that may be, with so many thoughts to trouble her +she went to rest, and her sleep was not easy until the morning was +near, and then came quiet. + +But presently, in the grey of the dawn, she woke, and called her old +nurse, who was in the chamber with her; and when she came she told her +that she had had a strange vision or dream, so real that she did not +know which it was. And what it portended she could not say, for it was +wonderful altogether, and surely was good. + +“I thought that a voice wakened me, calling me to look on somewhat; and +so I rose as I was bidden, and saw before me the most mighty and +comeliest man that could be thought of. Kinglike he was, though he had +no crown and was meanly clad, without brooch or bracelet that a king +should wear. But the wonder was that from his mouth came a bright shaft +of flame, as it were of a sunbeam, that lighted all the place, and on +his shoulder shone a cross of burning light as of red-hot gold, and I +knew that it was the mark of a mighty king. + +“Then I heard the voice again, and I turned, and saw that it was an +angel who spoke to me, and his face was bright and kind. + +“‘Fear not, Goldberga,’ he said, ‘for this is your husband that shall +be. King’s son and heir is he, as that token of the fiery cross shows. +More, also, it will betoken—that he shall reign in England and in +Denmark, a great king and mighty. And this you shall see, and with him +shall you reign as queen and well-loved lady.’ + +“So the voice ceased, and the angel was gone, and when I looked up +there was naught but the growing dawn across yon window, and the voice +of the thrush that sings outside.” + +Now the old nurse pondered over the dream for a while without speaking, +for she could not see what it might mean at first. + +But at last she said, “It is a good dream surely, because of the angel +that spoke; but there seems only one way in which it can come to pass. +A prince must come for you from Denmark, for there he would reign by +his own right, and here he would do so by yours. Yet I have heard that +the Danish kings are most terrible heathen, worse than the Saxon kin, +of whom we know the worst now. Maybe that is why the angel told you to +have no fear. I mind Gunnar Kirkeban, and what he wrought on the +churches and Christian folk in Wales—in Gower on the Severn Sea, and on +the holy Dee—when I was young.” + +For both Goldberga and this old nurse of hers were Christian, as had +been Orwenna, Ethelwald’s wife, her mother. It had been a great day for +them when the King of Kent had brought over his fair wife, Bertha, from +France, for she, too, was Christian, and had restored the ancient +church in the very castle where Goldberga was kept. + +Now the princess went to sleep again, and woke refreshed; but all day +long the memory of the dream and of him whom she saw in it bided with +her, until it was time for her to go to the great hall for the feast of +the Witan. + +Now it happened that on this night I must be one of the two housecarls +who should stand, torch in hand, behind the king. It was a place that +none of the men cared for much, since they saw their comrades feasting +at the end of the room, while they must bide hungry till the end, and +mind that no sparks from the flaring pine fell on the guests, moreover. +Eglaf would have excused me this had I wished; but I would take my turn +with the rest, and maybe did not mind losing the best of the feast so +much as the others. There were some three hundred guests at that feast, +and it was a wondrous fair sight to me as I stood on the high place and +saw them gather. The long table behind which I was ran right across the +dais, rich with gold and silver and glass work: and below this, all +down the hall, ran long tables again, set lengthwise, that none might +have their backs to the king. And at the end of the hall, crosswise, +were the tables for the housecarls, and the men of the house, and of +the thanes who were guests. And as the housecarls came in they hung +their shields and weapons on the walls in order, so that they flashed +bright from above the hangings that Berthun and his men had set up +afresh and more gaily than I had seen yet in this place. + +There was a fire on the great hearth in the midst of the hall; but as +it was high summer, only a little one, and over it were no cauldrons, +as there would have been in the winter. Berthun was doing his cookery +elsewhere. But between the tables were spaces where his thralls and the +women could pass as they bore round the food and drink. And backwards +and forwards among them went Berthun until the very last, anxious and +important, seeing that all was right, and showing one guest after +another to their places. No light matter was that either, for to set a +thane in too low a place for his rank was likely to be a cause of +strife and complaint. Also he must know if there were old feuds still +remembered, lest he should set deadly enemies side by side. I did not +envy him, by any means. + +When it seemed that there were few more guests to come, and only half a +dozen seats were vacant on the high place, Berthun passed into the room +beyond the hall, and at once a hush fell on the noisy folk, who had +been talking to one another as though they had never met before. The +gleemen tuned their harps, and I and my comrade lit our torches from +those already burning on the wall, and stood ready, for the king was +coming. + +Out of the door backed Berthun with many bows, and loud sang the +gleemen, while all in the hall stood up at once; and then came Alsi, +leading the princess, first; and then Ragnar, with the wife of some +great noble; and after him that noble and another lady; but Griffin was +not there. Bright looked Goldberga in her blue dress, with wondrous +jewels on arm and neck, and maybe the brighter for the absence of the +Welsh thane, as I thought. + +So they sat as last night, save that the noble who had come next to +Ragnar was in Griffin’s place; and therefore I stood behind the king +and the princess, with the light of my torch falling between the two. + +Now they were set, and at once Berthun bore a great beaker of wine to +the king, and all down the hall ran his men with the pitchers of wine +and mead and ale, and with them the women of the household and the +wives of the courtmen, filling every drinking horn for the welcome cup. + +Then the gleemen hushed their song, and Alsi stood up with the +gold-rimmed horn of the king in his hand, and high he raised it, and +cried, “Waeshael!” + +And all the guests rose up, cup in hand, with a wonderful flashing of +the glorious English jewels, and cried with one voice, “Drinc hael, +Cyning!” + +Then all sat them down, and at once came Berthun’s men with the laden +spits and the cauldrons, and first they served the high table, kneeling +on the dais steps while each noble helped himself and the lady next him +with what he would. And then down the hall the feast began, and for a +time befell a silence—the silence of hungry folk who have before them a +good reason for not saying much for a little while. + +I looked for Havelok among Berthun’s men, but he was not there. Nor was +he at the lower cross tables with the other people of the palace. But +Withelm was there, for Eglaf had seen him with me not an hour ago, and +had bidden him come, as a stranger from far off. There were a few other +strangers there also, as one might suppose, for the king’s hall must be +open at these times. + +Now I looked on all this, and it pleased me; and then I began to hear +the talk of those at the high table, and that was pleasant also. First +I heard that Griffin had fallen off his horse, and had put his arm out. +Whereon one said that he only needed one hand to feed with, and +marvelled that so small a hurt kept him away from so pleasant a place +as was his. + +“It seems that he fell on his face,” answered a thane who had seen him. +“He is not as handsome as he was last night. That is what keeps him +away. Some passerby put his arm in straightway.” + +At that I almost laughed, but kept a face wooden as that of our old +statue of Thor, for Eglaf had warned me that I was but a torch, as it +were, unless by any chance I was spoken to. But Ragnar glanced my way +with a half smile. Presently they began to talk of the stone putting, +and of the mighty man who had come with Berthun, and I saw several +looking idly down the hall to see if they could spy him. One of the +thanes on the high seat, at the end, was he who had held the prizes at +these sports. + +Now it seemed that Alsi had not heard of this before; and when he had +been told all about it, he said that he did not know that he had any +man who was strong enough to make such a cast as they spoke of, though +Eglaf had picked up a big man somewhere lately, whom he had noticed at +the hall end once or twice. + +Then he ran his eyes over the tables, for now the women folk had sat +down among the men, and one could see everywhere. But he did not see +the man he meant, and so turned sharply on us two housecarls behind +him. + +“Here he is,” he said, laughing and looking at me. “Were you the mighty +stone putter they make such a talk of?” + +“I am not, lord,” I said, somewhat out of countenance, because every +one looked at me together. It had never seemed to me that I was so big +before; perhaps because I was used to Havelok, and to Raven, who was +nigh as tall as myself, and maybe a bit broader. + +“Why, then, who was he?” said the king. “We must ask Berthun, unless +anyone can see him in the hall.” + +Then the thane of the prizes said, “He is not here, lord; for little +trouble would there be in seeing him, if he were, seeing that he is a +full head and shoulders over even this housecarl of yours.” + +Now the princess had turned to look at me, and she saw that I was +abashed, and so she smiled at me pleasantly, as much as to say that she +was a little sorry for me, and turned away. Then thought I that if ever +the princess needed one to fight for her, even to death, I would do so +for the sake of that smile and the thought for a rough housecarl that +was behind it. + +Now came Berthun with more wine, before the matter of the stone was +forgotten in other talk, and the king said, “It seems that you have +found a new man, steward, for all are talking of him. I mean the man +who is said to have thrown a big stone certain miles, or somewhat like +it, from all accounts. Where is he?” + +“He is my new porter,” answered Berthun, with much pride; “but he is +not in the hail, for he does not like to hear much of himself, being +quiet in his ways, although so strong.” + +“Here is a marvel,” laughed Alsi, “and by-and-by we must see him. I +wonder that Eglaf let you have him.” + +Now Eglaf sat at the head of the nearest of the lower tables, and all +in hearing of the king were of course listening by this time. So he +said, “The man had his choice, and chose the heavier place, if you will +believe me, lord. It is terrible to see how Berthun loads him at times; +so that I may get him yet.” + +Then all laughed at the steward, whose face grew red; but he had to +laugh also, because the jest pleased the king. He went away quickly; +and one told Eglaf that he had better eat no more, else would he run +risk of somewhat deadly at the cook’s hands. But those two were old +friends, as has been seen, and they were ever seeking jests at each +other’s expense. + +Now the talk drifted away to other things, and I hoped that Havelok had +been forgotten, for no more than I would he like being stared at. The +feast went on, and twice I had to take new torches, but Berthun saw +that I had wine, if I could not eat as yet. Then had men finished +eating, and the tables were cleared, and the singing began, very +pleasant to hearken. Not only the gleemen sang, but the harp went +round, and all who could did so. Well do the Lindsey folk sing, after +their own manner, three men at a time, in a gladsome way, with +well-matched voices, and that for just long enough to be pleasant. + +So the harp went its way down the hall, and the great folk fell to talk +again; and at last one said, so that Alsi heard him, “Why, we have not +seen the strong man yet. Strange that he is not feasting with the +rest.” + +Whereat the king beckoned Berthun. + +“Bring your new wonder here,” he said. “Say that I have heard of his +deed, and would look on him.” + +Berthun bowed and went his way; and I wondered how my brother would +bear this, for the hall and its ordering was wont, as I have said, to +bring back his troubled thoughts of things half remembered. + +Presently he came in at the door at the lower end of the hall, and at +first none noticed him, for there was singing going on, and through +that door came and went many with things for the feast from the +kitchens. Then some one turned to see who towered over them thus, and +when he saw Havelok he went on looking, so that others looked also. +Then one of the three singers looked, and his voice stayed, for he was +a stranger, and had heard nothing of this newcomer, and then Havelok +followed Berthun up the hall in a kind of hush that fell, and he was +smiling a little, as if it amused him. He had on the things that the +steward had given him, and they were good enough—as good as, if more +sober than, my housecarl finery. But I suppose that not one in all the +gathering looked at what he wore; for as he passed up the long tables, +it seemed that there was no man worth looking at but he, and even +Ragnar seemed to be but a common man when one turned to him with eyes +that had seen Havelok. + +Now Alsi the king sat staring at him, still as a carven image, with his +hand halfway to his mouth, as he raised his horn from the table; and +Ragnar looked wide-eyed, for he knew him again, and I saw a little +smile curl the corners of his lips and pass; and then Havelok was at +the step of the high place, and there he gave the salute of the +courtmen of a Danish king, heeding Berthun, who tried to make him do +reverence, not at all. + +Now a spark from my torch drew my eyes from him, lest it should fall on +the princess’s robe; and when it went out, I saw that the fair hand +that rested on the arm of the great chair was shaking like a leaf. When +I looked, her face was white and troubled, and she half rose from her +seat and then sank back in it gently, and the thane who sat next her +spoke anxiously to her in a low voice, and the lady by his side rose up +and came to her. + +Then Alsi turned, and he too spoke, asking if aught was amiss. + +“The princess faints with the heat of the hall,” said the thane’s wife. +“She yet feels the long journey. May she not go hence?” + +Then Goldberga said bravely, “It is naught, and it will pass.” + +But they made her rise and leave the hall; and the guests stood up as +she went with her ladies round her, and many were the murmurs of pity +that I heard. + +“As though she had seen a ghost, so white is she,” one whispered. + +But none knew how much the lady was to be pitied. She had seen the man +of her vision; and, lo! for all that she knew, he was a thrall who +toiled in the palace kitchens. + +And after her, as she withdrew, looked Havelok with eyes in which there +was more than pity. I could see him well, but I did not know how he had +seen the fair princess tremble and grow white as she gazed on him. I +know that, as he saw her for this first time, it was with the wish that +he were in Ragnar’s place. But I thought that if Havelok were king, +here was the queen for him. + +Now Alsi bade the feast go on, and be spoke a few words only to +Havelok, letting him go at once, and I was glad. This sudden faintness +of the princess had put all out somewhat, and none cared to take up a +jest where it had stayed. Nevertheless, I saw the king’s eyes follow my +brother down the hall, and in them was a new and strange look that was +not pleasant at all. + +Then it seemed that one was staring at me, and as will happen, I must +look in a certain place; and there was Cadwal, the Welsh thane, halfway +down one of the long tables, glaring first at me, and then at Havelok, +as he went. It came into my mind that he would be wroth with Ragnar for +bringing a kitchen knave as his second, as it were, in derision of +Griffin. I thought that I would find a chance presently to tell him why +my fellow second chose to be serving thus, and so make things right +with him, for this seemed to be due to Ragnar, if not to all concerned. + +Not long after Goldberga had gone, the king withdrew also, and then the +hall grew noisy enough, and I could leave my place. But by that time +Cadwal had left also; and next day, when I sought him, both he and +Griffin were no longer in Lincoln, none knowing whither they had gone. +So I troubled no more about them. + +But had I known that these two had been among the Welshmen that Hodulf +led to Denmark when he slew Gunnar Kirkeban, and therefore knew all the +story of the loss of Havelok, and how Hodulf had sought for news of +him, I should have been in fear enough that we had not yet done with +them. Rightly, too, should I have feared that, as will be seen. + +Now while I looked about the hall for Cadwal, Mord the chamberlain saw +me, and made me sit down by him while I ate. Hungry enough was I by +that time, as may be supposed, for one cannot make a meal off the sight +of a feast; and as I ate, the noise of the hall grew apace as the cups +went round. Then some of the older thanes left, and soon Mord and I had +that table to ourselves. It was plain that he was full of something +that he would say to me, and when I was ready to listen he bent near me +and said, “So that was the boy who fled with us.” + +“Ay. He has grown since you saw him last.” + +“That is not all,” answered Mord. “Well I knew Gunnar, our king, and +tonight I thought he had come back to us from Valhalla, goodlier yet +and mightier than ever, as one who has feasted with the Asir might well +be. For if this boy of ours is not Gunnar’s son, then he is Gunnar +himself.” + +Now that was no new thought to me, as I have shown, and I was ready for +it, seeing that even I had seen the likeness to the king as I +remembered him. + +“Keep that thought to yourself for a while, Mord,” I said. “It is in my +mind that you are right, but the time has not yet come for me to know.” + +“That is wisdom, too,” he answered; “for if once he gathers a +following, there is a bad time in store for Hodulf. And it will be +better that we fall on him unawares, before he knows that Havelok, son +of Gunnar, lives.” + +“We fall on him?” + +“Ay, you and I, mail on chest and weapon in hand, with Havelok to lead +us. What? think you that I would hold back when Gunnar’s son is +calling?” + +“Steady, friend,” I said, laughing; “men will be looking at us.” + +So he was silent again; and now I thought that the time of which my +father spoke had surely come, for it was plain that Havelok was a man +whom men would gladly follow as he went to win back his kingdom. And I +went and fetched Withelm from where he sat, and so we three talked long +and pleasantly, until it was time for us to go forth from the hall. And +we thought that it was good for Arngeir to come here, for the secret +was coming to light of itself, as it were, and we would have him speak +with Mord. + + + + +CHAPTER XIV. +THE CRAFT OF ALSI THE KING. + + +Now Alsi the king went from the feast with a new and cruel thought in +his mind under the smiling face that he wore, and long he sat in his +own chamber, chin on hand and eyes far off, thinking; and at last he +called Berthun. + +“What is the name of this big knave of yours?” he asked, when the +steward stood before him. + +“He calls himself Curan, lord.” + +“Calls himself. Well, it is likely that he knows his own name best. Is +he Welsh, therefore?” + +“So I think, lord.” + +“You might have been certain by this time, surely. I like Welshmen +about the place, and I was giving you credit for finding me a good one. +Whence comes he?” + +Now it was on Berthun’s tongue to say that he thought that Curan came +from the marshland, yet clinging to his own thoughts of what he was. He +did not at all believe that he came from that refuge of thralls. But he +must seem certain unless he was to be laughed at again. + +So he said, “He comes from the marsh-country.” + +“Does he speak Welsh?” + +“I have heard him do so to the market people, if he happened to meet a +Briton there.” + +“Why, then, of course he is Welsh: and here have I found out in two +minutes what you have taken I do not know how long to think about. Go +to, Berthun; you grow slow of mind with good living.” + +The king chuckled, and Berthun bowed humbly; but now the steward was +determined to say no more than he was obliged in answer to more +questions. Also he began to hope that Alsi would ask nothing about the +clothes this man of his wore, else he would be well laughed at for +spending his money on a stranger. + +But Alsi seemed pleased with himself, or else with what he had heard, +and went on. + +“Has this Curan friends in the town?” + +“None, lord, so far as I know.” + +“Let me tell you that you may know a man’s friends by the company he +keeps. With whom does he talk?” + +“None come to seek him, lord, except one of the housecarls—the big man +to whom you spoke tonight. Seldom does he go into the town, and then +only the porters seem to know him, for he was among them, as a +stranger, when I met him first.” + +“A big man will always make an acquaintance with another,” Alsi said, +“and the porters are the lowest in the place. One may be sure that he +has left his friends in some starving village in the marsh, and has +none here. That will do, Berthun. Take care of him, for I may have use +for him. But next time you hire a man, use your wits to learn somewhat +of him, if it is too much trouble to ask.” + +So Berthun was dismissed, and went out in a bad temper with himself. +Yet he knew that he would have been laughed at for a fool if he had +said that he thought Curan more than he seemed. + +Now Alsi was alone, and he fell to thought again. By-and-by it was +plain to be understood what his thoughts had been, and they were bad. +And after he had slept on them they were no better, seeing what came of +them. But I think that he was pleased to find that Havelok was, as he +thought, a Welsh marshman, and well-nigh friendless, for so he would be +the more ready to do what he was bidden; though, indeed, there seemed +little doubt that the plan Alsi made for himself would find no +stumbling block in Curan, if it might meet with a check elsewhere. +That, however, was to be seen. + +Well pleased was Alsi the king with somewhat, men said in the morning. + +But there was one who rose heavy and sorely troubled, and that was the +Lady Goldberga, for all the fancies that had been brought to her by the +vision had come to nothing, or worse than nothing, as she looked on +Havelok and saw in the cook’s knave the very form of him of whom she +had dreamed, and whom she could not forget. Glad had she been to go to +her own chamber and away from the kindly ladies who could not know her +real trouble; but not even to her old nurse did she tell what that was. +Her one thought now was to seek someone who was skilful in the reading +of dreams, and so find some new hope from it all. But no one could tell +her of such a one here, unless it were to be a priest of Woden, and +that she would not hear of. + +Then, early in the morning, Alsi sent for her, saying that he would +speak with her alone for a while. So she went to him, where he sat in +the chamber beyond the high place; and he greeted her kindly, asking +after her rest, and saying that he hoped that the sudden faintness had +hurt her not. Then he led her to a seat, and bade her rest while he +talked of state affairs. + +“For it must be known to you, my niece, that the Witan thinks it time +that you should take your father’s kingdom.” + +Now Goldberga knew that, and had long made up her mind that when the +time came she would not shrink from the burden of the crown. + +It may well have been that Alsi thought that she would wish to wait for +a time yet, for he did not seem altogether pleased when she answered, +“If the Witan thinks right, I am ready.” + +“But,” he said, “there is one thing to come before that. The Witan must +know who your husband shall be. And that is reasonable, for he will +have a share in ruling the kingdom.” + +Then said Goldberga, “They need have no fear in that matter, for I will +wed none but a king or the heir of a king.” + +“Well,” said Alsi, dryly enough, “they are not so plentiful as are +blackberries, and there may be two words to that.” + +“I am not anxious to be wedded,” answered the princess, “and I can +wait. It is, as you say, a matter that is much to the country.” + +Then Alsi tried another plan, seeing that Goldberga was not at all put +out by this. So he forced a cunning smile that was meant to be +pleasant, and said, “I had thought that your mind ran somewhat on +Ragnar.” + +He looked to see the lady change colour, but she did not. + +“Ragnar is my cousin,” she said, “or a good brother to me, if you will. +Moreover, until the other day when he met me in London by some good +fortune, I had hardly seen him since my father died.” + +“What think you of Griffin?” + +“Nothing at all, for nidring he is,” answered Goldberga with curling +lip. + +Now that angered Alsi, for he had so much to do with that business; and +if Griffin was to be called thus by his fault, he was likely to lose a +friend. + +“I would have you remember,” he said, “that in all this choosing it +remains for me to give consent or withhold it.” + +“I shall only ask your consent to my wedding such a man as I have told +you of, uncle—a king or a king’s son.” + +“So,” said Alsi, “you would choose first, and ask me afterwards, +forsooth! That is not the way that things are to be between us. It is +for me to choose, and that according to the oath which I took when your +father made me guardian of you and his realm.” + +“Yet,” said Goldberga very gently, “I think that my father would not +have meant that I should be the only one not to be asked.” + +“I can only go by what I swore, and that I will carry out. I promised +to see you married to the most goodly and mightiest man in the land.” + +“That can be none but a king, as I think.” + +Now Alsi grew impatient, for he meant to settle one matter before he +went much farther. + +“I will say at once that I can have no king over the East Anglian +kingdom. It is not to be thought of that after all these years I should +have to take second place there. You will hold the kingdom from me, and +I shall be overlord there. I will send you some atheling who can keep +the land in order for you, but there shall be no king to bring that +land under the power of his own kingdom.” + +That was plain speaking, and it roused Goldberga. + +“Never have you been overlord of my kingdom,” she said. “Well have you +ruled it for me while I could not rule it myself, and for that I thank +you heartily. But it is not right that I should seem to hold it from +you.” + +“That is to be seen,” sneered Alsi, “for it lies with me to say what +marriage you make, and on that depends whether the Witan, in its +wisdom, sees fit to hail you as queen. Not until you are married will +you take the kingdom at all.” + +“Then,” said the princess, growing pale, “I will speak to the Witan +myself, and learn their will.” + +“The Witan has broken up,” answered Alsi, “and the good thanes are +miles on their way homewards by this time. You are too late.” + +“I will call them up again.” + +“Certainly—that is, if I let my men run hither and thither to fetch +them. But after all, in this matter I am master. Whom you wed lies with +me.” + +Goldberga saw that she was in the hands of the king, and maybe as much +a prisoner as at Dover. So her spirits fled, and she asked what the +king willed. + +Alsi knew now that nothing but his utmost plan would be of any avail to +save that kingdom for himself, and so he broke out into wrath, working +up his fury that he might not go back. + +“My will is that you obey me in this carrying out of the oath I took on +the holy ring, [10] and on the Gospels also to please your mother. You +shall marry the man whom I choose, so that he be according to the words +of that oath.” + +“So that he be king or son of a king, I will obey you,” answered +Goldberga. + +“Then you defy me. For that I have told you that I will not have. Now +shall we see who is master. You mind yon kitchen knave of last night? +There can be none in all England mightier or more goodly than he is to +look on, and him shall you wed. So will my oath be well kept. Then if +your precious Witan will have him, well and good, for his master shall +I be.” + +Thereat the princess said that it were better that she should die; but +now Alsi had set out all his plan to her, and he did not mean to flinch +from carrying it out. There was no doubt that the Norfolk people would +hold that she had disgraced herself by the marriage, and so would +refuse to have her as queen. And that was all he needed. + +But Goldberga had no more to say, for she was past speaking, and the +king was fain to call her ladies. And when they came he went away +quickly, and gave orders for the safe keeping of the princess, lest she +should try to fly, or to get any message to Ragnar or other of the +Norfolk thanes. + +Now he must go through with this marriage, for he had shown himself too +plainly, and never would the princess trust him again. I have heard +that he sent for Griffin at this time; but, as I found, he was gone; +and if the king thought that perhaps the princess would wed him now to +escape from the kitchen knave, he had no chance to bring him forward. I +suppose he could have made out that Griffin, or for that matter any one +else he chose, was such a one as his oath to Ethelwald demanded. + +Sore wept Goldberga when she was back in her own place, and at first it +was hard for her to believe that Alsi could mean what he had +threatened. But then she could not forget her dream, and in that she +had most certainly seen the very form of him who stood before her at +the high place last night; and that perhaps troubled her more than +aught, for it seemed to say that him she must wed. But no king’s son +could he be, so that there must be yet such another mighty man to be +found. + +And then in her heart she knew that there could not be two such men, +both alike in all points to him of the vision. And she knew also, +though maybe she would not own it, that if this Curan had been but a +thane of little estate, she could have had naught to say against the +matter. + +And so at last she found that in her trouble and doubt and wish for +peace she was thinking, “Would that he were not the kitchen knave!” + +Now, it chanced that the old nurse had gone out into the town, and was +away all this while, so that she knew nothing of this new trouble; and +presently she was coming back with her arms full of what she had +bought, and there met her Havelok and Withelm, who had been to the +widow’s, and were on their way to find me at the gate. + +“Mother,” said Havelok, “let me help you up with these things.” + +That frightened the old lady, for she had been looking at him, and had +made up her mind that he was some mighty noble, as did most strangers. + +“Nay, lord,” she said; “that is not fitting for you.” + +“Less fitting is it that a strong man should see you thus burdened and +not help. No lord am I, but only the cook’s man. So I am going to the +palace.” + +But this she would not believe at first, and still refused. However, +Lincoln Hill is very steep, and she was not sorry when Havelok laughed +and took the things from her so soon as she had to halt for breath. + +“Curan will carry you up also, if you will, mother,” said Withelm. + +The nurse tossed her head at him and made no answer, being on her +dignity at once. Moreover, she had heard of Curan by this time, though +she had not seen him before. So she said no more, and went on proudly +enough, with her mighty attendant after her; but all the while it was +in her mind that there was some jest, or maybe wager, between the two. + +Now Withelm stopped at the gate; but I was not there, for I had been +sent to the palace, where guards were to be at each door. The word was +that some plot had been found out against the princess, and that +therefore we had to be careful. One easily believed that with all the +talk about the attack made on her party that was flying about. So he +came on to the palace kitchens, for Berthun knew him well, having so +often bought fish from him in the market; and there he sat down to talk +with the steward, for there was nothing much going on at the time, and +I was on guard. + +Now, the old nurse went to her mistress; and Goldberga sat in the +shadow, and was weeping no longer, seeing that it would not help at +all. + +“There is a wonder down yonder,” said the old lady, not seeing that +there had been any trouble yet—“such a man as I never saw in all my +days; and he even carried my goods up all the hill for me, old and ugly +as I am. That is not what every young man would do nowadays. Maybe it +was different when I was young, or else my being young made the +difference. The youth with him called him Curan, which is the name of +the strong porter they prate of, but doubtless that was a jest. This is +the most kingly man that could be; and I ween that those two made a +wager that he dared not carry a bundle up to the palace, whereby I was +the gainer, for breath grows short up that pitch. And when I thanked +him he bowed in that wise that can only come of being rightly taught +when one is young. Now, I am going to ask Berthun who he is, for he +spoke to him when he saw him, and that humbly, as it seemed.” + +So talked the nurse, and to all Goldberga answered never a word, for +all the trouble came back again, and with it the thought that she +hated, that if only— + +Then, as the nurse was leaving her, she called her back. + +“Nurse,” she said, “I am in sore trouble about the dream. It bides with +me, and will not cease to puzzle me until I weary for some one to read +it plainly. I would that Queen Bertha’s good chaplain were here, for I +might have been helped by him.” + +Then the nurse came back, quick to hear the sad tone in the voice of +her whom she had tended and loved since she was a child. + +“Why, my pretty, have you been weeping?” she said. “There was naught in +a dream like that to fray you thus.” + +“Nay, but it has come to me that this place is altogether heathen; and +it may have come from the hand of Freya, the false fiend that they +worship as a goddess, so that I may be ready to wed a heathen. Is there +no Christian in all this place?” + +“There are Welsh folk yet left in the marsh,” said the nurse, +pondering; “and where there is a Briton there is a Christian, and +there, also, will be a hidden priest. But it would be as much as his +life is worth to come here, even could we find one.” + +Then Goldberga said, “Alsi is not altogether heathen. If I asked he +would surely grant this.” + +For she thought that she knew how to gain consent. + +“If one can be found, and that is not likely. Well, then, I will ask +Berthun, who is good-natured enough, and most likely will not trouble +about a Christian coming here; and if so, we need not even ask Alsi.” + +So she went, not thinking for a moment that there was a priest of the +faith to be heard of. Mostly she wanted to hear more of Havelok, but +she would honestly do her other errand. + +But on her way across the courtyard she met Mord, and he was a great +friend of hers. + +“Whither now, nurse? They will not let you go out of the palace. They +say that there is trouble on hand with those folk that fell on us, and +we have to bide in shelter for a day or two.” + +“Well, I have been down the town this hour, and all is quiet enough. +This Alsi is an over-timid man. But I was seeking Berthun with a +strange message from the princess, and one that is not over safe here.” + +“Let me give it then.” + +“Well, it is nothing more or less than to ask if he can find a +Christian priest. Our mistress has had a strange dream, and it is true +that it sorely troubles her. So she wants one to whom she may tell it, +that it may be read aright. But though I must ask, I do not hope to +find one.” + +“Why,” said Mord, “there is not one Christian in all Lindsey.” + +“I would not say that. When I was first here with Orwenna the queen, +before she married Ethelwald, there were some in the marsh; for one day +I heard my own tongue spoken there, hunting with my mistress; and so +she stayed and talked with these poor folk, though the Welsh they spoke +was bad enough. But they were Christians, as they told her in fear and +trembling. They have not so much need to fear now.” + +“Then I can help you,” said Mord gladly. “Say nothing to the cook, for +I have found old friends who come from far in the marsh, and they will +tell me at once if they have heard of any priest. Why, when I think, +they know Welsh, and one has called himself by a Welsh name, and you +have seen him—Curan the porter.” + +“Ay; then do you ask these friends, and tell them that the sooner they +can bring a priest the better shall they be rewarded. I would give much +to have Goldberga’s mind set at rest.” + +So Mord said that he would go at once; and glad he was to see Withelm +sitting with Berthun, + +“Well,” said the steward, “I have known Withelm of Grimsby for the last +ten years or so, and I do not suppose that it matters if you speak with +him.” + +“Why should it matter if I speak with any one I choose?” asked Mord, +somewhat angrily. + +“That you must ask the king; for his orders are that the people of the +princess have no dealings with outsiders for two days.” + +“Mighty careful of us is Alsi all of a sudden,” said Mord. “I suppose +he thinks that someone will stick a seax into some of us in all +friendly wise while we are talking.” + +But Berthun only laughed, and went to where the nurse was beckoning to +him. He told her his own thoughts of Havelok, being glad to have a +ready hearer. + +At once Withelm was able to tell Mord that the old priest who was his +friend was in Lincoln at this time by good chance, and that he would +surely come to the princess at need. But when they came to talk of when +and how, it did not seem all so easy; and Mord went to the nurse to +tell her all. + +Then they had to speak to Berthun about it, and he was kindly and +willing to help; but he said that none might come to speak with the +princess without leave from the king. No doubt he would grant it +easily, if asked by Goldberga herself. + +“I will go and tell her,” said the old lady. “Keep your man here till I +return.” + +Now she brought this good news to the princess, and one need not say +how she rejoiced. And now a thought had come to her, and she was eager +to send a message to Alsi. + +“Surely,” she thought, “he does but threaten me with the kitchen knave, +that he may make me change my will. And, therefore, if I say that I am +ready to obey him, he will be pleased; and then time is gained at the +least, and it is not possible that he will choose so badly for me after +all.” + +So when the nurse asked her what she would do about getting the priest +to her presence, she said, “Go and tell my uncle first that I am +willing to obey him in the matter of which we spoke this morning.” + +“So that was what has troubled you after all, and not the dream? I +thought it should not have made all these tear marks,” said the nurse +quickly. “Now, why did you not tell me? I dare give Alsi a talking to +if he needs it.” + +“Nay, nurse, but it was the dream. My uncle and I did but disagree on +somewhat, and maybe I was wrong. By-and-by I will tell you.” + +“Tell me now, and then I shall know better how to ask for what you +need.” + +But Goldberga could not bring herself to say what Alsi had threatened, +and now felt sure that she would hear no more of that. So she told the +nurse that she had vowed only to marry a king, and that Alsi had been +angry, saying that kings were not so easily found. Also, that he was +the man who had to find her a husband. + +“That is the best sense that this king ever spoke,” said the nurse. +“Many a long year might you wait if you had your way thus. You are wise +in sending that message. Well, after that I will ask him to let you see +the priest, saying, if he is cross-grained, that a talk with him will +make your mind even better fitted to obey. Many things like that I can +say. We shall have him here presently.” + +Now, all that seemed very good to both of them, and the nurse went her +way. And when she came to Alsi, she gave the message plainly. + +“That will save a great deal of trouble,” said the king. “Tell her that +I am glad to hear it. She says this of her own accord, and not at your +advice?” + +“She told me before I had heard a word of what the trouble was between +you. It was no word of mine.” + +“I am glad of it. But I will say that I am somewhat surprised.” + +And that was true, for this message seemed to Alsi to be nothing more +or less than that Goldberga would marry his man. When he thought for a +moment, however, he saw that it could not be thus; and also, it was +plain to him what the poor girl had in her mind. And now he chuckled to +think what a weapon he had against her. Nor would he be slow to use it. + +Then the nurse said that he need have no surprise, for Goldberga was +ever gentle and willing to be led, though sometimes the pride of her +race came uppermost for a time. And then she asked if a certain priest +of the faith might come and speak with her. + +Now, Alsi knew that only one could be meant—namely, the hermit who +bided at Cabourn. He had heard of him often, and would not suffer him +to be hurt, for his sister Orwenna had protected him. The heathen +English minded him not at all by this time, for he was the best leech +in the land, and so useful to them. So Alsi said pleasantly that he was +quite willing that the priest should come, deeming that he was at +Cabourn, and that it would be a day or two before he would be brought. + +So he called the housecarl from outside the door, and when he came he +said, “Pass the word that when one who calls himself David comes and +asks for the princess, he is to be admitted to her.” + +So that was made easy, and the nurse thanked him and withdrew; and when +he was alone, Alsi grinned evilly and rubbed his hands. + +“Now is East Anglia mine in truth,” he said; and with that he bade the +housecarl fetch Curan, the cook’s porter, to him. And then he sent one +to Ragnar with such a message that he rode out that night and away to +Norwich. + + + + +CHAPTER XV. +THE FORTUNE OF CURAN THE PORTER. + + +While the nurse told Withelm to fetch the priest when Alsi was in the +hall that evening, the housecarl came for Havelok; and much wondering, +he followed the man to the king, and presently stood before him and +saluted. + +“Where did you get that salute?” said Alsi sharply, seeing at once that +it was not English; and, indeed, it was that of Gunnar’s courtmen. + +“I cannot tell,” answered my brother. “It seems to be there when +needed.” + +“Well, it is not that used here. Get the housecarls to teach you better +manners.” + +Then Havelok bowed a little, in token that he would do so; and when +Alsi spoke to him next it was in Welsh. + +“You are a marshman, as I hear?” + +Now Havelok had learned fairly well from the poor folk who loved him, +but carelessly, so that when he answered Alsi frowned at his way of +speaking. + +“I am from the marsh,” he said simply. + +“We had better get back to English!” the king said; “you people forget +your own tongue. Now, are you married?” + +Thereat Havelok laughed lightly. + +“That I am not,” he answered. + +“Well, then, if I find you a fair wife, you would be willing, +doubtless?” + +“That I should not,” answered Havelok bluntly, and wondering what this +crafty-looking king was driving at. “What could I do with a wife? For I +have neither house nor goods, nor where to take her, nor withal to keep +her; else had I not been the cook’s knave.” + +“It would seem that you carry all your fortune on your back, +therefore,” said Alsi, looking at Havelok’s gay attire with somewhat of +a sneer. + +“That may well be, King Alsi, for even these clothes are not my own. +Berthun gave them me, and I think that they come from yourself.” + +Alsi grinned, for Eglaf’s saying of him was not so far wrong; but he +had more serious business on hand than to talk of these things with a +churl. + +“Now, if I bid you, it is your part to obey. I have a wife for you, and +her you shall wed.” + +“There are two words to that, King Alsi. Neither will I wed against my +will, nor will I wed one who is unwilling.” + +“As to that first,” said the king, for he began to be angered with +Havelok’s boldness, “if a man will not do my bidding, I have dungeons +where he can have time to think things over, and men who can keep him +there, be he never so mighty; and if a man will not see with my eyes +when I bid him, blinded shall he be.” + +This he said somewhat hurriedly, for a dark flush came on the face of +the man before him, and he thought that he must try some other plan +than force with him. + +“And as for that other point, I did not so much as hint that the bride +was likely to be unwilling. I will say that she is willing, rather.” + +Now that troubled Havelok, for it seemed that all was arranged already, +and the thought of the dungeon was not pleasant. There was no doubt +that if the king chose he could cast him into one until he was +forgotten; and the light and the breath of the wind from the sea were +very dear to Havelok. So he thought that he would at least gain time by +seeming to listen to the proposal; for, after all, it might come to +nothing, and maybe it was but a jest, though a strange one. + +“Well, lord king,” he said, “if the bride knows enough of me to be +willing, it is but fair that I should have the like chance of choice.” + +Now Alsi thought that it was impossible that this churl, as he deemed +him, would not be overjoyed to hear of the match he had made for him, +and he must needs know it soon. Yet there was that about Havelok that +puzzled him, for his ways were not those of a churl, and he spoke as a +freeman should speak. + +So much the more likely that the people would believe him when he said +that Goldberga wedded him of her own wish, he thought. It was as well +that he was not altogether a common-seeming man. + +“You have seen the damsel already,” he said therefore. “Now I will not +say that this match is altogether of my choosing; but I have an oath to +keep, and it seems that I can only keep it by making you her husband. +But, as I say, she is willing, and, I will add, well dowered.” + +Now it grew plain to my brother that there was something strange in all +this, so he said, “An oath is a thing that must not be hindered in the +fulfilling, if a man can further it. But what has a king’s oath to do +with me?” + +“I have sworn to find her the goodliest and mightiest man alive; and, +though I must needs say it to your face, there is none like yourself. +No flattery this to bend you to my will, but sober truth—at least, as I +see it.” + +At that Havelok grew impatient. + +“Well, if that be so, who is the bride?” he asked, not caring to give +the king his title, or forgetting to do so, for on him was coming the +feeling that he was this man’s equal here in the palace. And at last, +not seeming to notice this, Alsi answered plainly. + +“The Princess Goldberga.” + +Then Havelok stared at him in blank wonder for some moments; and Alsi +grew red under his gaze, and his eyes were shifty, and would not meet +the honest look that was on him. + +Then at last said Havelok slowly, and watching the king intently all +the while, “What this means I cannot tell. If you speak truth, it is +wonderful; and if not, it is unkingly.” + +“On my word as a king, truth it is,” said Alsi hastily, for there was +that in Havelok’s face that he did not like. + +One might think that the king was growing afraid of his own kitchen +knave. + +“If that is so, there is no more to be said,” answered Havelok. “Yet +you will forgive me if I say that I must have this from the lips of the +princess herself as well. It may be that her mind will change.” + +“That is but fair,” answered Alsi; “and you are a wise man. The mind of +a damsel is unsteady, whether she be princess or milkmaid; but have no +fear.” + +“No man fear I; but I do fear to hurt any lady, and I would not do +that.” + +Then Alsi thought that all was well, and he spoke smooth words to my +brother, so that Havelok doubted him more than ever. Therefore it came +into his mind that all he could do for the best was to seem to agree, +and wait for what the princess herself said. And if Alsi was working +some subtlety, then he would wring his neck for him, if need be; and +after that—well, the housecarls would cut him in pieces, and he would +slay some of them, and so go to Valhalla, and dreams would be at an +end. And he would have died to some purpose here, for he knew that +Goldberga would come to her kingdom, ay, and maybe Alsi’s as well, for +she was his sister’s daughter, and his next of kin, and well loved by +those who had been allowed to know aught of her. + +But I would not have any think that the promise of so wondrous a bride +was not pleasing to him. It was more, for he had seen her grow white +and troubled as she looked on him, and he had seen her bear well +whatever pain had caused that; and he had known that in the one sight +he had of Goldberga somewhat had taught him what it was to have one +face unforgotten in his mind. + +So he said to Alsi, “All this fortune that you hold out to me is most +unlooked for, seeing what I am in your hall; and I have not thanked you +yet, King Alsi. That, however, is hard to do, as you may understand.” + +“I understand well enough,” answered the king, in high good humour +again, now that all seemed to be going well. “And after all, it is the +lady whom you must thank.” + +“But when shall I see her to do so?” + +“Tomorrow, surely; ay, tomorrow early shall you speak with her,” +answered the king quickly. “Now go, and hold your peace. Let me warn +you that there are those about the court who would go any lengths to +remove you from the face of the earth if they knew of this. Tell no man +of the honour that has come to you as yet. Be the porter for a short +time longer, and then you will be the man whom all envy. It is likely +that I must make you a thane, by right of the choice of the princess.” + +“I know well when to speak and when to keep silence, lord king,” said +my brother, and with that he bowed and left the hall. + +Then Alsi put his lips to a silver whistle that he carried, and blew a +call that brought Eglaf hurriedly to him from the outer door. + +“The guards may go,” said the king; “but see that the porter Curan +leaves not the palace until I myself send him forth tomorrow.” + +The captain saluted and went his way. He had had six men within call of +the king all the time that he spoke with Havelok, and one may make what +one likes of that. At least the threat of the dungeon was no idle one. + +Now went Havelok from the hall very heavy and troubled, for beyond the +fair talk of the king lurked surely some plan that was not fair at all. +It was not to be thought that he could not prevent, if he chose, a +foolish marriage of the princess, even did she desire it ever so much. +And my brother could not believe that she had set her heart on one whom +she had but seen once, and then in the midst of faintness. That, +however, might be known easily when he was face to face with her. It +was a thing that could not be made a matter of pretence. + +Now when he came back to the great kitchen, which was nigh as big as +the hall, Withelm was yet there, for the priest was at the widow’s, and +there was no haste to bring him; and by that time I had come in also, +and was sitting with him at the far end, where none had need to come. +It was Berthun’s own end, as one might say, and he was lord in his own +place. Only a few thralls were about, and the cook himself had gone +into the town. + +“Here is our brother,” I said, “and there is somewhat wrong.” + +He came moodily up to us, and sat him down, saying nothing, and he +leaned his head on his hands for a while. + +“What is amiss, brother?” said Withelm. + +“Wait,” he answered. “I will think before I speak.” + +I could see that this was not the old puzzlement, but something new and +heavy, so we held our peace. Long was he before he moved or spoke, and +when he did so it was wearily. + +“Well knew I that somewhat was to happen to me in this town, even as I +told you, brother, when we first passed its gates. And now it seems to +be coming to pass. For this is what is on me, as it seems to me—either +that I must see the light of day no more, or must live to be a scorn +and sorrow to one for whom it were meet that a man should die.” + +“Surely the black dream is on you, my brother! Neither of these things +can be for you!” I cried. + +“Would that it were the dream, for that is not all of sorrow, and that +also is of things so long past that they are forgotten. I can bear +that, for your voice always drives it away. But now the hand of Alsi +the king is on me for some ill of his own—” + +“Stay,” said Withelm. “Let us go out and speak, if that name is to be +heard. It were safer.” + +“Less safe, brother,” answered Havelok. “At once we should be kept +apart. Listen, and I will tell you all, and then say your say.” + +Then he told us, word for word, all that had just passed between him +and the king. And as we listened, it grew on us that here was no wrong +to the princess, but rather the beginning of honour. I could see the +downfall that was in store for Alsi, and I thought also that I saw hope +for the winning back of the Danish kingdom, with an East Anglian host +to back us. And this also saw Withelm, and his eyes sparkled. But +Havelok knew not yet all that had grown so plain to us. + +He ended, and we said nothing for a moment. + +“Well?” he said, not looking up, but with eyes that sought the floor, +as if ashamed. + +“By Odin,” said I, speaking the thought that was uppermost, “here will +be a downfall for Alsi!” + +“Ay, you are right, brother. I will not wed her.” + +But that was by no means what I meant, as may be known; and now Withelm +held up a warning hand to me, and I knew that his advice was always +best. + +“If the maiden is unwilling, wed her not,” he said. “If she is willing, +even as the king said, that is another matter. We have no reason to +doubt his word as yet.” + +“You saw not his face as he spoke. And then, how should the princess +think of me?” + +“Who knows? Even Odin owned that the minds of maids were hard to +fathom. But one may find a reason or two. Maybe that oath has somewhat +to do with it. A good daughter will go far to carry out her father’s +will, and, in the plain sense thereof, she will certainly do it thus. +Then it is likely that she knows that you are no churl, but the son of +Grim, though we have fallen on hard times for a while. I have heard say +that it is the custom here that a man who has crossed the seas in his +own ship so many times is a thane by right of that hardihood. Thane’s +son, therefore, might we call you. Then there is the jealousy of every +other thane, if she chooses an East Anglian. Then she needs one who +shall be mighty to lead her forces. Even the greatest thane will be +content to follow a man who is a warrior of warriors. Ragnar can have +told her what you are in that way. Faith, brother, there are reasons +enough.” + +Havelok laughed a short laugh at all this, and he grew brighter. There +was sense in Withelm’s words, if they would not bear looking deeply +into. + +Then I said, adding to these words, “Moreover, Alsi could stop the +whole foolishness of his niece if he did not think it a fitting match +in some way.” + +“So he could,” answered Havelok. “But yet—I tell you that there was +naught but evil in his face. Why did he try to force me?” + +Then he went back to the thing that weighed mostly on his noble +heart—the thought that he was unworthy altogether. + +“I fear that the princess does but think of me because she must. It is +in my mind that Alsi may have threatened her also until she has +consented. How shall I know this?” + +“Most easily, as she speaks with you,” answered Withelm. “Tomorrow will +tell you that. And then, if you find things thus, what shall prevent +your flying?” + +“Brother Radbard and the other housecarls,” said Havelok grimly. + +“Not if you ask the princess to help you out of her own way by +pretending to be most willing. If Alsi thinks you a gladsome couple, +there is no difficulty. You walk out of the palace as a master there. +Then you fly to Ragnar. That is all.” + +Now that was such an easy way out of the whole coil that we planned it +out. And yet it seemed to me that it was a pity that Havelok knew not +more of what seemed to us so sure now. So, seeing that things were +fairly straightened by this last thought, I got up and said that I must +be going, making a sign to Withelm to come also; and, with a few more +words, we went out. I saw Havelok set himself to a mighty task of water +drawing as I looked back. + +“Now,” said I, “here is a strange affair with a vengeance. Neither head +nor tail can I make of it. But if all we think is right, this is the +marriage for the son of Gunnar.” + +“Son of Gunnar, or son of Grim,” said Withelm, “princess or not, happy +is the maiden who gains Havelok for a husband. Maybe her woman’s wit +has told her so. She will have many suitors whom she knows to be +seeking her throne only, and to him she gives it as a gift unsought.” + +“That is all beyond me,” I said; “but he would fill a throne well. But +his own modesty in the matter of his worthiness is likely to stand in +the way. Why should we not tell him all that we know? Then he will feel +that he is doing no wrong.” + +“Because we are not sure, and because it is not for us to choose the +time. I have sent for Arngeir this morning, as we said would be well +last night. If the princess is unwilling, there are many things that +may be said; and if not, there must be many days before the wedding; +and, ere the day, Havelok may feel that he is her equal in birth at +least, if we are not wrong. But since I have waited here, Mord has told +me the dream that has troubled the princess, that I may tell the +priest, so that he can think it over. She has dreamed that she is to +wed a man who shall be king both in Denmark and England, and she saw +the man, moreover. Strangely like Havelok’s dream is that. Now what +else made her turn faint but that this vision was like Havelok? And +does not that make it possible that she wishes to wed him? Therefore I +am going to tell the priest the story of Havelok, so far as I know it.” + +“Well thought of. Tell him this also, for now I may surely tell you +what you have not yet heard thereof.” + +So I told him how Grim and I had taken Havelok from Hodulf, and then he +was the more certain that we had saved the son of our king. + +Now we thought that we had got to the bottom of the whole matter of the +wedding. Of course the dream had all to do with the fainting, but +nothing to do with the supposed wish. But we did not know that. + +“Speak not of Gunnar by name, however,” I said; “he was a terror to +Christian folk. The priest is likely to hinder the marriage with all +his might else.” + +Withelm flushed as he had when he first spoke of the priest to me. + +“I think not, brother; for he knows Havelok well, and loves him.” + +“So,” said I shortly, “he hopes to make him a Christian, doubtless.” + +“I think that he will do so, if he has a Christian wife to help.” + +“That would not suit Havelok,” I said, laughing. + +“Nay, but such a mind as his it seems to suit well already, though he +has not heard much.” + +“Why, then,” said I, wondering, “if it suits our best and bravest, it +must be a wondrous faith. It seems strange, however; but I know naught +of it. What is good for him and you, my brother, is sure to be best.” + +“I feared that you would be angry.” + +“Nay, but with you and Havelok? How should that be? Why, if you two +said that we must turn Christian, I should hold it right; so would +Raven. I suppose that I go to the Ve[11] because you do.” + +Now I troubled no more about the matter, being nothing but a sea dog +who could use a weapon. And now I said that I was going to Eglaf to say +that I might have to leave him at any time for home, in case we had to +fly with Havelok. So Withelm went his way to the old priest with a +light heart, and I to the captain. + +“Well,” said Eglaf, “this is about what I expected when your brother +came. Good it has been to have you here; and I think that I shall see +you as a housecarl for good yet. When do you go?” + +“The first time that I do not turn up on guard I am gone, not till +then.” + +“Come and drink a farewell cup first.” + +“I shall be in a great hurry if I do not do that,” I answered, +laughing. + +But it was my thought that maybe when once my back was turned on the +town, I should not have time to think of going near King Alsi’s guard. + +Then I went to find Ragnar the earl, for we thought it well that he +should know what was on hand. But when I came to the house of the thane +with whom he was quartered, they told me that he had gone hastily with +all his men, for word had come of some rising in his land that must be +seen to at once. That was bad; and as one must find a reason for +everything, I thought that the going of Griffin had much to do with the +outbreak. There I was wrong, as I found later. But then, too, I knew +that the craft of Alsi was at work in this message. He had his own +reasons for wishing the earl out of the way. + + + + +CHAPTER XVI. +A STRANGEST WEDDING. + + +Long spoke Withelm and the priest David together, until it was time for +them to seek the palace; and when they came there, they spoke to Mord +also. Then David thought it was well to say naught to Havelok until +more was learned from Goldberga herself, for he would soon see how +things stood with her. Then he would see Withelm again, and they would +plan together for the best. So Withelm waited for the return of the +priest, whom Mord took to his mistress. Alsi and his men were supping +in the hall, but Goldberga was waiting in her own chamber. + +Now the princess thought that, after her message to the king, she would +hear no more of the kitchen knave, and so was happier. But all the +while she pondered over her dream the thought of Havelok must needs +come into it, and that was troublesome. Nevertheless, it was not to be +helped, seeing that there was no doubt at all that he and the man of +the vision were like to each other as ever were twins. Wherefore if the +thought of one must be pleasant so at last must be that of the other. +And then came the nurse with tales of what Berthun thought of this man +of his—how that he was surely a wandering prince, with a vow of service +on him, like Gareth of the Round Table in the days of Arthur. + +So presently it seemed to the princess that the churl was gone, as it +were, and in his place was a wandering atheling, at least, who was not +a terror at all. Then at length the slow time wore away until Mord came +with David the priest. + +No priestly garb had the old man on, for that had made his danger +certain; but though he was clad in a thrall’s rough dress, he was not +to be mistaken for aught but a most reverend man. + +“Peace be with you, my daughter,” he said; “it is good to look on the +child of Orwenna, the queen whom we loved.” + +Then the chamberlain left those two alone, and at once Goldberga told +the priest why she had asked him to run the risk of coming to her, for +there is no doubt that he was in peril, though not from Alsi himself. + +At first she asked him many things about her mother, and learned much +of her goodness to the poor folk, and of their love to her; and +presently, when she grew more sure of the kindness and seeming wisdom +of the priest, she told him all her dream, adding no thoughts of her +own, as she mistrusted them. + +Then said David, “There seems naught but good in this, and it is not +hard to unravel. I think that all shall come to pass even as it was +told you.” + +“I feared the heathen ways of the place, and thought that it might be +some snare of the old gods,” said Goldberga. + +But David told her that they could have no power on her, and asked her +if the king knew of the vision, that being one thing of which he was +not sure; and when he found that he did not, the whole affair seemed +more strange than before. + +But now the princess asked him, “Plain were the words that I heard, hut +what meant the light as of a sunbeam that came from the mouth of the +man of the vision?” + +“That surely means that in word and in heart and in all else the man +shall be kingly altogether, so that there shall be no mistaking the +same; and it may also mean that you shall know the man at once when you +see him.” + +At that Goldberga grew pale and red by turns, so that David, quick to +read the thoughts of those who came to him for help, asked if she had +seen anyone who she thought must be meant, not at all knowing that she +must needs say that this was Curan. + +Not at all willingly did she tell him this; but she did so, adding at +last that Alsi had threatened to wed her to this man. + +Now it was plain to David that all was pulling the same way, for surely +Alsi wrought, unknowing, for the fulfilling of the dream; and all +seemed to prove that Havelok was the son of the Danish king, and that +he would win back his kingdom. Then he found out that the princess had +no knowledge that the king had spoken to Havelok, but it did not seem +to be needful that he should tell her that he had done so. That would +be told by Alsi himself if he meant, as seemed certain, to carry out +his threat. So he thought awhile, and at last he saw what he might do +without saying anything to bend the choice of the princess in any way. + +“It will soon be plain in what way the dream shall be fulfilled,” he +said; “and this is certain, that you shall be wedded to none but the +right man, else had it not been sent. Have no fear, therefore, even as +it was bidden you.” + +Then the princess said that the only thing which troubled her was the +fear lest Alsi should yet force her to wed this one who was so like him +she had seen in her dream. + +“That,” said the priest, “is doubtless the most strange part of the +whole matter, yet I think that even thus there need be no fear. I will +tell you now that I know this one who is called Curan well, and I, and +all who know him, love him. Truly he is not a Christian, but he is no +hater of the faith, and that is much in these days. Nor is he a churl, +but rather one of the most noble of men. It is certain that, whatever +Alsi might wish, he would not wed you against your will. He has but to +know your thoughts in order to help you in any way. But I must also +tell you this, that he is a Dane, who fled from his land when he was a +child; and it is thought that he is the son of the Danish king, who was +slain at the time when Mord, your servant, fled also. He came to +England in the same ship as did Mord, who can tell you more of him. It +is certain that there is a secret about his birth, and the one who +knows that secret is not far off. If need is, we can learn it, for +there was a set time for its telling, and maybe this is it. Now, if it +is true that he is the son of the Danish king, it does seem as if your +dream might be bidding you to have no fear of what seems doubtful in +the matter, though I cannot tell, and do not like to say so for +certain. His name is not Curan, but Havelok.” + +Then Goldberga said, “I have heard of that flight and of the wreck from +Mord often. He was wont to tell me of the child, and of the lady who +was drowned, and he said that he thought him the king’s son.” + +After that she was greatly cheered, for the worst of the trouble seemed +to be over and gone. It was in her mind now that Alsi knew who Havelok +was, and that he tried her, for she was not one to think ill of any. + +So she let the priest go, with many thanks, saying, “Now I know that +whatever happens is the will of Heaven, and must be for the best. I am +ready for whatever shall befall.” + +Now I do not know what had seemed good to Alsi, for he had changed his +mind concerning David’s visit to Goldberga, and had suddenly given +orders that if he came he was to be put in ward at once. So Mord met +the old man as he left the chamber, and told him that he must fly; and +after that Withelm took him away in the dusk, for none hindered his +going, and went to the widow’s with him, hearing all that had been +said; and that which they thought was even as Goldberga had said, that +all must needs be for the best. In a day or two all would he plain, for +Arngeir would have come. So Withelm sent forth the old man to his own +place with a good store of food, going with him for some miles, and +promising him help for coming days until the dearth was ended. + +Now into the palace none might come after the feast was set; and all +this time I was on guard, for there were double posts round the place, +by reason of Alsi’s fear of the attackers of the princess, as was said. +So it happened that neither of us saw Havelok until next morning; and +now I have to tell how we saw him, and what happened with the first +sunlight, when men were thinking of breaking their fast. + +We of the housecarls took that first meal of the day in the great +hall—so many of us, that is, who were not on duty; and when we had nigh +finished, Alsi would come in and seat himself on the high place, where +Eglaf and half a dozen other thanes sat also at times when there was no +special state to be kept. + +I was early this morning, having just taken my spell of watching at the +gate, and being, therefore, free for the rest of the day, and I was +hungry with the sweet air of the July weather and the freshness that +comes with sunrise. So I was not altogether pleased to see that there +was seemingly some new affair of state on hand, while the breakfast was +not yet set out by reason of preparations that were going on where the +king’s chair was wont to stand. There was Berthun, looking puzzled and +by no means pleased, and his men were busy setting out benches on the +high place, of a sort that were not those that were wont to be there, +in three sides of a square, the open side facing the hall. One bench +made each side, and all three were carved from back rail to clawed feet +wondrously. Old they seemed also. Then, too, instead of the sweet +sedges that strewed the high place, men had spread a cloth of bright +hues underfoot there, and the sedges had been swept among the rushes of +the lower places. All this was so strange that I went forward, and when +I had a chance I asked the steward what was on hand. + +“If you know not, master housecarl, no more do I. ‘Justice to be done,’ +says the king, and so I suppose that you have some notable prisoner in +ward—maybe the leader of those villains who scared our fair princess.” + +“But we had taken no man, and I will say that we had wondered that we +had not been sent out to hunt those people, instead of biding to see if +they came to trouble us here.” + +“Why, then,” said Berthun, “some thane must be bringing a captive +shortly. But why Alsi orders these benches, it passes me to make out. +They are those that have been used for the weddings of his kin since +the days of Hengist. Last time was when Orwenna, his sister, wedded +Ethelwald of Norfolk. Maybe he thinks that they need airing.” + +He laughed and went on directing his men; but knowing what I knew, I +wondered what it all might mean, for there was one wedding that I could +not help thinking of. + +Presently the hall began to fill as men came in, and every one had +somewhat to say, and all marvelled at this that was going on. Then +Berthun came and beckoned to me, for I must fetch Eglaf the captain at +once, as the king had need of him, in haste. Then Eglaf hurried to the +hall; and after a word or two with Alsi, the horns were blown outside +the hall door to call every man of the guard to the place. And when +they came, we were all set round the wall as if guarding all that were +in it. But there were none but the folk of the palace to guard, and +they were wondering as were we; and when that was done, and the click +and rattle of arms as we moved to our places was ended, there was a +silence on all—the silence of men who wait for somewhat to happen. + +Now Berthun went to the door on the high place, as he was wont when all +was ready for the king’s presence, and the hush deepened, none knowing +what they expected to see. + +Forth came Berthun backward, as was the custom, and he turned aside to +let the king pass him. His face was red and angry, as I thought, but +amazed also. I was standing next to Eglaf, and he was at the foot of +the dais, at the end of his line of men, so that I could see all +plainly. + +Then came Alsi, leading the princess, and after Goldberga came her +nurse. No other ladies were with her; and now I noticed that there was +not one thane on the high place, which was strange, and the first time +that such a thing had been since I came here. I looked down the hall, +and none were present. Now I looked at Alsi; and on his pale face was a +smile that might have been as of one who will be glad, though he does +not feel so. But the eyes of the princess were bright with tears, and +hardly did she look from the floor. Hers was a face to make one sad to +see at that time, wondrously beautiful as it was. + +Alsi led her by the hand, and set her on the bench that was to his +left, and signed to the nurse to sit beside her, which the old lady +did, bridling and looking with scorn at the king as she took her place. +There she sought the hand of the princess, and held it tightly, as in +comforting wise. Very rich garments had the nurse, but Goldberga was +dressed in some plain robe of white that shone when the light caught +it. Mostly I do not see these things, but now I wished that she always +wore that same. + +As for Alsi, he had on his finest gear, even as at the great feast of +the Witan—crimson cloak, fur-lined, and dark-green hose, gold-gartered +across, and white and gold tunic. He had a little crown on also, and +that was the only thing kingly about him, to my mind. + +Now he cast one look at Goldberga, which made her shrink into herself, +as it were, and turned with a smile to us all. + +“Friends,” he said, “this is short notice for a wedding, but all men +know that ‘Happy is the wooing that is not long a-doing,’ so no more +need be said of that. All men know also that when good Ethelwald died +he made me swear to him that I would wed his daughter to the mightiest +and goodliest and fairest man that was in the land. I have ever been +mindful of that oath, and now it seems that the time for keeping it has +come. Whether the man whom my niece will wed is all that the oath +requires, you shall judge; and if he is such a one, I must not stand in +the way. I do not myself know that I have ever seen one who is so fully +set forth in words as is this bridegroom in those of the oath.” + +Now I heard one whisper near me, “Whom has Goldberga chosen?” + +And that was what Alsi would have liked to hear, for his speech seemed +to say that thus it was, and maybe that he did not altogether like the +choice. + +But now Alsi said to Berthun, “Bring in the bridegroom.” + +“Whom shall I bring, lord?” the steward asked in blank wonder, and Alsi +whispered his answer. + +At that Berthun’s hands flew up, and his mouth opened, and he did not +stir. + +“Go, fool,” said Alsi, and I thought that he would have stamped his +foot. + +Now I knew who was meant in a moment, and even as the steward took his +first step from off the dais to go down the hail to his own entrance, I +said to Eglaf, “Here is an end to my service with you. My time is up.” + +“Why, what is amiss?” + +“The bridegroom is my brother—that is all; and I must be free to serve +him as I may.” + +“Well, if that is so, you are in luck. But I do not think that either +of Grim’s sons can be the man. Big enough are you, certainly, but +goodly? Nay, but that red head of yours spoils you.” + +I daresay that he would have said more about Raven and Withelm, for a +talk was going round; but a hush came suddenly, and then a strange +murmur of stifled wonder, for Havelok came into the hall after Berthun, +and all eyes were turned to him. + +Now I saw my brother smile as he came, seeing someone whom he liked +first of all; and then he looked up the hall, and at once his face +became ashy pale, for he saw what was to be done. Yet he went on +firmly, looking neither to right nor left, until he came to the high +place. There he caught my eye, and I made a little sign to him to show +that I knew his trouble. + +They came to the step, and Berthun stood aside to let Havelok pass, and +then Alsi held out his hand to raise my brother to the high place. But +Havelok seemed not to see that, stepping up by himself as the king bade +him come. Then the women who were in the hall spoke to one another in a +murmur that seemed of praise; but whiter and more white grew the +princess, so that I feared that she would faint. But she did not; and +presently there seemed to come into her eyes some brave resolve, and +she was herself again, looking from Alsi to Havelok, and again at Alsi. + +Now, too, the king looked at him up and down, as one who measures his +man before a fight. And when he met Havelok’s eyes he grew red, and +turned away to the folk below him. + +“So, friends,” he cried, “what say you? Am I true to the words of my +oath in allowing this marriage?” + +There was not one there who did not know Havelok, whom they called +Curan; and though all thought these doings strange, there was a hum of +assent, for the oath said naught of the station in life of the +bridegroom. Good King Ethelwald had been too trustful. + +“That is well,” said Alsi, with a grave face. “All here will bear +witness that this was not done without counsel taken. Now, let the +bridegroom sit in his place here to my right.” + +He waved his hand, and Havelok sat down on the bench that faced +Goldberga; and now he looked long at her with a look that seemed to be +questioning. Alsi was going to his seat in the cross bench, where the +parents of the couple are wont to sit at a wedding while the vows are +made, but he seemed to bethink himself. It is my belief that he said +what he did in order to shame both Havelok and Goldberga. + +“Why, it is not seemly that the bridegroom should sit alone without one +to be by him. Where are your friends, Curan?” + +At that Alsi met with more than he bargained for. At once Berthun came +forward, and forth came I, and without a word we sat one on each side +of him. There were others who would have come also, for I saw even +Eglaf take a step towards the high place, had we not done so. + +Alsi’s face became black at that, for here was not the friendless churl +he was scoffing at. But he tried to smile, as if pleased. + +“Why, this is well,” he said. “Good it is to see a master helping his +man, and a soldier ready to back a comrade of a sort. Now we have +witnesses. Let us go on with the wedding.” + +Now the golden loving cup that was used at the feasts had been filled +and set at a little side table that stood there, and it was to be the +bride cup that should be drunk between the twain when all was settled. +So Alsi took this cup and held it, while he sat in the place of the +father of the bride. Now, I knew nothing of what should he done, but +Berthun did so, and well he took my brother’s part, having undertaken +for him thus. + +“It is the custom,” said Alsi, “that the bridegroom should state what +he sets forth of the dowry to the bride.” + +Whereat Berthun, without hesitation, spoke hastily to Havelok, and told +him to let him answer, meaning, as I have not the least doubt, to +promise all that he had saved in long years of service. But Havelok +smiled a little, and set his hand to his neck, and I remembered one +thing that he had—a ring which had always hung on a cord under his +jerkin since he came to Grimsby, and which my father had bidden him +keep ever. + +“This give I,” he said, setting it on the floor at his feet, “and with +it all that I am, and all that I shall hereafter be, and all that shall +be mine at any time.” + +Alsi looked at the ring as it flashed before him, and his face changed. +No such jewel had he in all his treasures, for it was of dwarf work in +gold, set with a deep crimson stone that was like the setting sun for +brightness. I do not know whence these stones came, unless it were from +the East. Eleyn the queen, his mother, was thence, and I know now that +the ring was hers. But I think that when Alsi saw this he half repented +of the match, though he had gone too far now to draw back. So he bowed, +and said that it was well, as he would have said had there been nothing +forthcoming. + +Then Berthun, in his turn, asked for the bridegroom that the dowry of +the bride should be stated for all to hear. + +“The wealth left my niece by her father,” said Alsi. “The matter of the +kingdom is for the Witan of the East Anglians to settle.” + +Then came from out the king’s chamber two men bearing bags of gold, and +that was set before the princess. It was a noble dowry, and honest was +the king in this matter at least. + +Now were the vows to be said and the bride cup to be drunk, and that +was the hardest part of all to Havelok. + +Slowly he rose as the king held it out to him, and he took it from his +hand and stood before Goldberga; and she, too, rose and faced him, and +for a moment they stood thus, surely the most handsome couple that had +ever been. + +Then Havelok said, looking in the clear eyes of the princess, “This +have I sworn, that I will wed no unwilling bride. It is but for you to +say one word, and the cup falls, and all is ended.” + +Alsi started at that, and I thought he was going to speak, but he held +his peace. Still as a rock was Havelok while he waited for the answer, +and the folk in the hall were as still as he. They began to see that +all was not right as the king would have it thought. + +Once the princess looked at Alsi, and that with pride in her face, and +then she looked long and steadfastly at Havelok, and one by one his +fingers loosened themselves on the golden stem of the cup, that she +might know him ready for her word. + +Then she put forth her hand and closed it round his strong fingers, +that he must hold it fast by her doing, and that was all that was +needed. It was more than words could have told. And she smiled as she +did it. + +And at that a light came on Havelok’s face, and he smiled gravely back +at her, and he said in a low voice that shook a little, “May the gods +so treat me as I treat you, my princess. Can it be that you will trust +me thus?” + +She answered in no words, but I saw her hand tighten over his, and her +eyes never left his face. + +Then Havelok raised his other hand, and took that of Goldberga, which +was on the cup, and faced to the people. + +“Thus do I pledge her who shall be henceforward my wife through good +and ill; and may Odin, Freya, and Niord be witnesses of my oath of +faith to her in all that the word may mean.” + +So he drank, and I stole a glance at the king. Never saw I a man so +amazed, for to him the Danish names of the Asir had come as some sort +of a shock, seeing that he had deemed this man, with the name of Curan, +a Briton. And he looked at Berthun with a look that seemed to say more +than was likely to be pleasant by-and-by. But the steward paid no heed +to him. + +Now Havelok had made his vow, and he gave the cup to the princess; and +she, too, turned a little toward the people, but still she looked on +Havelok. + +“Faith shall answer to faith,” she said in a clear voice. “Here do I +take this man for my husband, in the sight of God, and with you all as +witnesses, and I pray that the blessing of Him may be on us both.” + +So she drank also, and Havelok stopped and raised the wondrous ring +from where it had been unheeded on the floor, and took the band of +Goldberga, and set it on her finger, and kissed the hand ere he let it +go. + +But Goldberga lifted her face toward him, and he bent and kissed her +forehead, and so they were wedded. + +I have heard men scoff at the thought of love at first sight, but never +can any one of us do so who saw this wedding. + + + + +CHAPTER XVII. +HOW THE BRIDE WENT HOME. + + +Now the folk cheered, and loudest of all honest Eglaf and his warriors. +I wondered what should come next, for neither feast nor bride ale was +prepared, and Berthun was looking puzzled. Then I saw that the only +face in all the wide hall which was not bright was that of Alsi, and +his brow was black as a thunder cloud, while his fingers were white +with the force with which he clutched and twisted the end of his +jewelled belt. Plainly he was in a royal rage that none had scoffed at +this wedding, but that all had taken it as a matter that was right +altogether. + +But he had one more evil thing in his mind that must be seen through; +and he came forward, smoothing his face, as best he might, to the fixed +smile that I had seen when he spoke with Ragnar, and learned that his +first plot had miscarried. + +“Now, friends,” he said, “all this has been so hasty that we have +prepared no feast. Even now, it seems that the horses stand at the door +to take bride and bridegroom hence, and doubtless there waits somewhere +the feast that has been bespoken without my knowledge. Well, strange +are the ways of lovers, and we will pardon them. I have therefore only +to bid them farewell.” + +With that he turned to Havelok, and held out his hand, as in all good +fellowship, but Havelok would not see it. + +“Fare as it shall be meted to you by the Asir, King Alsi,” he said, +“for at least Loki loves craft.” + +Then he turned to me, and asked hurriedly where we should go if we must +leave thus. + +“To Grimsby,” I said. “That is home.” + +Alsi spoke to the princess now, and maybe it was as well that he did +not offer so much as his hand. Wise was he in his way. + +“Farewell, niece,” he said; “all this shall come shortly before the +Witan of Ethelwald’s folk.” + +“Farewell, uncle,” she answered calmly. “That is a matter which I will +see to myself. You have carried out your oath to the letter, so far, +and now it remains that you should leave the government of the realm to +me.” + +With that she put her hand on Havelok’s arm. + +“Come, husband; we have heard that the horses wait. Let us be gone.” + +And then in a quick whisper she added, as if nigh overdone, “Take me +hence quickly, for I may not bear more.” + +They wasted no more words; and through a lane of folk, who blessed +them, those two went to the great door down the long hall, and I +followed, and Berthun and the nurse came after me. One flung the door +open; and on the steps, all unaware of what had happened, lounged Mord, +waiting, and up and down on the green the grooms led the horses of the +princess—six in all. On two were packed her goods, and the third had a +pack saddle that waited for the bags that held her dowry. The other +three were for herself and Mord and the nurse. There was not one for +Havelok. + +“This is hasty, my princess,” Mord said. “Whither are we bound?” + +“For Grimsby, Mord,” I answered quickly. “Are there no more horses to +be had?” + +“Never a one, unless we steal from the king,” he answered. + +The people were crowding out now that they might see the start, and I +saw Berthun speak to a man among them who was a stranger to me. And +from him he turned directly with a glad face. + +“Go down to such a hostelry,” he said to me, “and there ask for what +horses you will. Maybe I shall have to follow you for my part in this +matter—that is, if I am not put in the dungeon.” + +“Faith,” I answered, “better had you come with us than run that risk. +Alsi is in a bad mood.” + +He shook his head; and then the people behind him made way, for the +king was coming. + +“Almost had you forgotten this,” he said; “and I think you will want +it.” + +The men with the money were there, and he waved his hand to them. +Havelok lifted the princess to her horse without heeding him, and the +men set the bags on the pack horses. + +“See the bridegroom down the street, you who were his witnesses,” the +king went on, with a curling lip; “and if you are a wise man, master +Berthun, you will not come back again.” + +Berthun bowed and went into the hail, past the king, and across to his +own door, without a word. After him the thronging people closed up, and +though I thought that a housecarl would have been sent to see what he +was about, this would have made an open talk, and Alsi forbore. + +“Let Havelok take your horse, Mord,” I whispered to him; “I will tell +you why directly.” + +He nodded, and I told Havelok to mount. Then I helped up the nurse, who +wept and muttered to herself; and so we started, Alsi standing on the +steps with words of feigned goodspeed as we did so. + +But the housecarls and the people shouted with wishes that were real, +no doubt thinking that we were bound for the far-off kingdom of the +prince who had won Goldberga by service as a kitchen knave in her +uncle’s hall for very love of her. + +Directly we were outside the gate that leads down the hill, I saw +Withelm, who was there waiting for me, and he knew at once what had +happened. + +He came to my side, and asked only, “Already?” + +“Already,” I answered; “but it is well. Go to the widow’s straightway, +and bring Havelok’s arms to him at the hostelry at the end of the +marketplace, where we have to find more horses.” + +He went at once, and silently we came down the street and to the +courtyard of the inn. Some few folk stared at us; but the princess was +hardly known here, and she had cast her long, white mantle hoodwise +over her head and face, so that one could not tell who she was. So +early in the day there were few people in the marketplace either. + +Berthun was in the courtyard of the inn, and I was glad to see him, for +I did not know what would happen to him. It was likely that Alsi would +seek for someone on whom to visit his anger at the way things had gone. +But the steward had been warned, and was not one to run any risk. + +“I did but go back for a few things that I did not care to leave,” he +said; and he showed me that he had brought his own horse from the +stables, and on it were large saddlebags. No poor man was Berthun after +years of service in the palace, where gifts from thane and lady are +always ready for the man who has had the care of them. Across the +saddle bow also were his mail shirt and arms, and his shield hung with +his helm from the peak. + +“You see that I must needs cast in my lot with yours, or rather +Curan’s,” he said, laughing; “but it is in my mind that in the end I +shall not be sorry to have done so. I think that I am tired of the +fireside, and want adventure for a while.” + +“Well,” I answered, “you are likely to have them, and that shortly, if +I am not mistaken; but we shall see. Now about these horses, for we had +better get out of Lincoln as soon as we may.” + +The man he had spoken with was a merchant, who came yearly, and was a +friend of his. He had more horses than he meant to keep, as he had here +each year; for every one knows that a horse can always be sold in +Lincoln, and they were good ones. Then my gold came in well, and I +bought three, one for each of us brothers. I daresay that I paid dearly +for them, but there was no time for haggling in the way that a horse +dealer loves. Out of the way of Alsi we must get, before he bethought +him of more crafty devices. And I thought, moreover, that we should be +riding towards East Anglia shortly, and it was not everywhere that a +steed fit to carry Havelok on a long journey was to be had. + +I had bidden him leave all this to me as we came down the hill, and +glad he was to do so. Now he had dismounted, and stood by the side of +the princess, speaking earnestly to her. It was plain that what he said +was pleasant to her also. But we left them apart, as one might suppose. + +Now came a warrior into the courtyard, and he bore more arms. It was +Withelm, who had borrowed the gear of the widow’s dead husband, that he +might be ready for whatever might happen: and it was good to see +Havelok’s eyes grow bright as he spied the well-known weapons that his +brother had in his arms. He said one word to Goldberga, and then came +to us. + +“Let me get into war gear at once,” he said, laughing in a way that +lightened my heart. “I shall not feel that I have shaken off service to +Alsi until I have done so.” + +And then he saw Berthun here for the first time. + +“Nay, but here is my master,” he added. “And I will say that I owe him +much for his kindness.” + +“Now the kindness shall be on your part, if any was on mine. Take me +into your service, I pray you, henceforward.” + +“Good friend of mine,” said Havelok, “naught have I to offer you. And +how should one serve me?” + +“With heart and hand and head, neither more nor less,” answered +Berthun. “I have seen you serve, and now will see you command. Let me +bide with you, my master, at least, giving you such service as I may.” + +“Such help as you may, rather. For now we all serve the princess,” +Havelok said. + +And with that Berthun was well content for the time. + +“Well, then,” said I, “see to Havelok’s arms, while we get the horses +ready, for I want Withelm here.” + +So Havelok and his new man went into the house with his arms, and then +I saw Goldberga beckoning to us. It was the first time that I had +spoken to her, and I think that I was frightened, if that is what they +call the feeling that makes one wish to be elsewhere. But there was +nothing to fear in the sweet face that she turned to us. + +“Brothers,” she said, “Havelok tells me that it was one of you who +brought David the priest to me. I do not rightly know yet which is +Withelm.” + +With that she smiled and blushed a little, and I stood, helm in hand, +stupidly enough. But my brother was more ready. + +“I am Withelm, my princess—” he began. + +“Nay; but ‘sister’ it shall be between me and my husband’s brothers. +Now, brother Withelm, there is one thing that is next my heart, and in +it I know you will help me.” + +There she wavered for a moment, and then went on bravely. + +“Christian am I, and I do not think that we are rightly wedded until +the priest has done his part. And to that Havelok agrees most +willingly, saying that I must ask you thereof, for he does not know +where the old man is now.” + +“Wedded in the little chapel that is in the thick of Cabourn woods +shall you be, for David has gone there already. We can ride and find +him before many hours are over, sweet lady of ours.” + +She thanked him in few words, and with much content. + +Then came forth from the house Havelok, in the arms that suited him so +well—golden, shining mail shirt of hard bronze scales, and steel, +horned helm, plain and strong, and girt with sword and seax, and with +axe and shield slung over shoulder, as noble a warrior surely as was in +all England, ay, or in the Northlands that gave him birth either; and +what wonder that the eyes of the princess glowed with a new pride as +she looked at her mighty husband? + +But Mord almost shouted when he saw him come thus, and to me he said, + +“It is Gunnar—Gunnar, I tell you—come back from Asgard to help my +princess.” + +“Wait till we get to Grimsby, and Arngeir will make all clear,” I said. +“Get into your arms, and we will start. All is ready now.” + +We did not wait for Mord, but mounted and rode out, and the princess +looked round at us as she rode first beside Havelok, and said, “Never +have I ridden so well attended, as I think.” + +And from beside me, with broad face from under his helm, Berthun +answered for us all, “Never with men so ready to die for you, at least, +my mistress.” + +And that was true. + +Half a mile out of the town we rode at a quick trot, and then thundered +Mord after us, and his hurry surely meant something. I reined up and +waited for him. + +“What is the hurry, Mord?” said I. + +“Maybe it is nothing, and maybe it is much,” he answered; “but Griffin +of Chester has gone up to the palace, for I saw him. He has his arm in +a sling, and his face looks as if it had been trodden on. Now Alsi will +tell him all this, and if we are not followed I am mistaken. He would +think nothing of wiping out our party to take the princess, and Alsi +will not mind if he does. How shall we give him the slip?” + +Withelm rode with his chin over his shoulder, and I beckoned him and +told him this. Not long was his quick wit in seeing a way out of what +might be a danger. + +“Let us ride on quickly down the Ermin Street, and he will think us +making for the south and Norwich. Then we will turn off to Cabourn, and +he will lose us. After that he may hear that some of us belong to +Grimsby, and will go there; but he will be too late to hurt us. Hard +men are our fishers, and they would fight for Havelok and the sons of +Grim.” + +So we did that, riding down the old Roman way to a wide, waste forest +land where none should see us turn off, and then across the forest +paths to Cabourn; and there we found the hermit, and there Havelok and +Goldberga were wedded again with all the rites of Holy Church, and the +bride was well content. + +Now while that was our way, I will say what we escaped by this plan of +my brother’s, though we did not hear all for a long time. Presently we +did hear what had happened at Grimsby towards this business, as will be +seen. + +To Lincoln comes Griffin, with Cadwal his thane, just as we had left +the town thus by another road, and straightway he betakes himself to +the palace. There he finds Alsi in an evil mood, and in the hall the +people are talking fast, and there is no Berthun to receive him. + +So, as he sits at the high table and breaks his fast beside the king, +he asks what all the wonderment may be. And Alsi tells him, speaking in +Welsh. + +“East Anglia is mine,” he says, “for I have rid myself of the girl.” + +Griffin sets his hand on his dagger. + +“Hast killed her?” he says sharply. + +“No; married her.” + +“To whom, then?” + +“To a man whom the Witan will not have as a king at any price.” + +“There you broke faith with me,” says Griffin, snarling. “I would have +taken her, and chanced that.” + +“My oath was in the way of that. You missed the chance on the road the +other day, which would have made things easy for us both. There was no +other for you.” + +Now Griffin curses Ragnar, and the Welsh tongue is good for that +business. + +“Who is the man, then?” he says, when he has done. + +“The biggest and best-looking countryman of yours that I have ever set +eyes on,” answers Alsi, looking askance at Griffin’s angry face. “There +is a sort of consolation for you.” + +“His name,” fairly shouts Griffin. + +“Curan, the kitchen knave,” says Alsi, chuckling. + +“O fool, and doubly fool!” cries Griffin; “now have you outdone +yourself. Was it not plain to you that the man could be no thrall? Even +Ragnar looks mean beside him, and I hate Ragnar, so that I know well +how goodly he is.” + +Now Alsi grows uneasy, knowing that this had become plainer and plainer +to him as the wedding went on. + +“Why, what do you know of this knave of mine?” he asks. “He was goodly +enough for the sake of my oath, and the Witan will have none of him. +That is all I care for.” + +“What do I know of him? Just this—that you have married the queen of +the East Angles to Havelok, son of Gunnar Kirkeban of Denmark, for whom +men wait over there even now. The Witan not have him? I tell you that +every man in the land will follow him and Goldberga if they so much as +lift their finger. Done are the days of your kingship, and that by your +own deed.” + +Alsi grows white at this and trembles, for he minds the wondrous ring +and the names of the Asir, but he asks for more certainty. + +Then Griffin tells him that he was with Hodulf, and knew all the secret +of the making away with the boy, and how that came to naught. Then he +says that Hodulf had heard from certain Vikings that they had fallen on +Grim’s ship, and that in the grappling of the vessel the boy and a lady +had been drowned. It is quite likely that they, or some of them, +thought so in truth, seeing how that happened. After that Hodulf had +made inquiry, and was told that there were none but the children of +Grim with him, and so was content. So my father’s wisdom was justified. + +“Now I learned his name the other day; and I have a ship waiting to +take me at once to Hodulf, that I may warn him. I have ridden back from +Grimsby even now to say that, given a chance, say on some lonely ride, +that might well have been contrived, I would take Goldberga with me +beyond the sea. I thought more of that than of Hodulf, to say the +truth.” + +Now Alsi breaks down altogether, and prays Griffin to help him out of +this. + +“Follow the party and take her. They are few and unarmed, and it will +be easy, for men think that there is a plot to carry her off, and this +will not surprise any. Go to the sheriff and tell him that it has +happened, and he will hang the men on sight when you have taken them. +Then get to sea with the girl, and to Hodulf, and both he and I will +reward you.” + +“Thanks,” says Griffin, with a sneer; “I have my own men. Yours might +have orders that I am the one to be hanged. It would be worth your +while now to make a friend of your kitchen knave. You are not to be +trusted.” + +So these two wrangle for a while bitterly, for Alsi is not overlord of +Griffin in any way. And the end is that the thane rides towards Grimsby +first of all, with twenty men at his heels, knowing more than we +thought. But he hears naught of us, and presently meets Arngeir on his +way thence to see us. Him he knows, for already he has had dealings +with him in the hiring of the ship. So he learns from him that +certainly no such party as he seeks is on the road, and therefore rides +off to the Ermin Street to stay us from going south. + +But now we had time for a long start; and so he follows the Roman road +when he reaches it all that day and part of next, and we hear no more +of him at that time. There are many parties travelling on that way, and +he follows one after another. + +Now Arngeir knew at once that somewhat had happened when he heard from +Griffin that the most notable man of those whom he sought was named +Curan, and therefore he turned back at once and waited for us. And when +we came in sight of the long roof of the house that Grim, our father, +had built, standing among the clustering cottages of our fishers, with +the masts of a trading ship or two showing above it in the haven, he +was there on the road to greet us, having watched anxiously for our +coming from the beacon tower that we had made. + +Maybe we were two miles out of Grimsby at this time, for one can see +far along the level marsh tracks from our tower; and Withelm and Mord +and I rode on to him as soon as we saw him, that we might tell him all +that had happened, and we rode slowly and talked for half a mile or so. + +Then Withelm waited and brought Havelok to us, staying himself with the +princess, that he might tell her the wondrous story of her husband; for +we thought that it would be easier for him than for our brother maybe. +Havelok was not one to speak freely of himself. + +And when Goldberga had heard all, she was silent for a long way, and +then wept a little, but at last told Withelm that all this had been +foretold to her in her dream. + +“Yet I am glad,” she said, “that I did not know this for certain, else +had my Havelok thought that I did but wed him for his birth. Tell him, +brother, that it was not so; say that I knew him as the husband Heaven +sent for me when first I saw him.” + +Now Havelok listened to Arngeir as he told him the well-kept secret, +and now and again asked a question. + +And when all was told he said, “Now have the dreams passed, and the +light is come. I mind all plainly from the first.” + +And he told all that had happened after Hodulf caught him, from the +murder of his sisters to the time when I helped my father to take him +from the sack. Only he never remembered the death of his mother or the +storm, or how we came to Grimsby. Maybe it is rather a wonder that +after all those hard things gone through he should recall anything, for +he was nearly dying when we came ashore, as I have told. + +“But I am Grim’s son,” he said, “for all this, and never shall I forget +it. By right of life saved, and by right of upbringing, am I his, and +by right of brotherhood to his sons. Gunnar, who was my father, would +have me say this, if I am like him, as Mord tells me I am.” + +Then he looked at us in brotherly wise, as if we would maybe not allow +that claim now; but there needed naught to be said between us when he +met our eyes. He was Grim’s son indeed to us, and we his younger +brothers for all the days that were to come. + +“One thing there is that makes me glad,” he said, “and that is because +I may now be held worthy of this sweet bride of mine so strangely +given, as indeed I fear that I am not. Men will say that she has done +no wrong in wedding me; and for all that Alsi may say, it will be +believed that she knew well whom she was wedding. There will be no +blame to her.” + +That seemed to be all his thought of the matter now, and it was like +him. Then he went back to his princess, and we spurred on to Grimsby, +and set all to work, that the greeting might be all that we could make +it. + +And so, when those two rode into our garth, and the gates were closed +after them, we reined our horses round them, and drew our swords, and +cried the ancient greeting with one mighty shout: + +“Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson—Skoal to Goldberga, Havelok’s wife! Skoal! +Yours we are, and for you we will die! Skoal!” + + + + +CHAPTER XVIII. +JARL SIGURD OF DENMARK. + + +Now one would like to tell of quiet days at Grimsby; but they were not +to be. Three days after Havelok’s homecoming we were on the “swan’s +path,” and heading for Denmark, with the soft south wind of high summer +speeding us on the way. And I will tell how that came about, for else +it may seem strange that Havelok did not see to the rights of his wife +first of all. + +That was his first thought, in truth, and we brothers planned many ways +of getting to work for her, for it was certain that Alsi would be on +his guard. And on the next day came a man from Lincoln to seek Berthun, +with news. That good friend had done what none of us had been able to +manage, for he had told the merchant, his friend, to bide in the hall +and hear what went on, and then to let him know all else that seemed +needful that we should hear. Now he had learned all from the words of +Griffin and Alsi, who took no care in their speech, thinking that none +in the hall knew the Welsh tongue that they used. + +It being the business of a merchant to know that of every place where +he trades, and he travelling widely, there was no difficulty to him, +and mightily he enjoyed the sport. Then he sent off straightway to us; +and now it was plain that we were in danger—not at once, maybe, but ere +long. Griffin would hear sooner or later that his quarry was in Grimsby +after all. So we went to our good old friend, Witlaf of +Stallingborough, and told him all. + +“Why,” he said, “I will have no Welsh outsiders harrying my friends. +Light up your beacon if he comes, and shut your gates in his face, and +I and the housecarls will take him in the rear, and he will not wait +here long. I have not had a fight for these twenty years or so, and it +does me good to think of one.” + +So we thought that there was little fear of the Welshman. + +When I came back from this errand, however, I chose to pass the mound +where my father slept, and on it, hand in hand, sat Havelok and +Goldberga—for it was a quiet place, and none came near it often. It was +good to see them thus in that place, and happy they seemed together. + +Goldberga called me when I came near, and I sat down beside them as she +bade me. + +“Here we have been talking of what we shall do now, for it seems that +to both of us are many things to hand,” she said. “Good it would be if +we could set them aside; but we were born to them, and we cannot let +them be. And, most of all, here in this place we may not forget the +duty that Grim would remind us of. Havelok must go to Denmark and win +back his kingdom from Hodulf first of all.” + +“We have thought that East Anglia was to be won first from Alsi,” I +said. + +“So says Havelok; but I do not think so. For, indeed, I am but the +wife, and the things of the husband come first of all. Now, this is +what I would say. Sail to Denmark before Hodulf knows what is coming, +and there will be less trouble.” + +“I am slow at seeing things,” said Havelok; “but the same might be said +of your kingdom.” + +“Alsi is ready, and Hodulf is not,” she answered, laughing; “any one +can see that. + +“Is it not so, brother?” + +So it was; and I thought that she was right. + +“Let us ask the brothers,” I said, “for here are many things to be +thought of; and, first of all, where to get men.” + +That was the greatest trouble to our minds, but none at all to hers. + +“Get them in Denmark,” she said, when we were all together in the great +room of the house that evening. “Let us go as merchant folk, and find +Sigurd, or his son if he is dead. If I am not much mistaken, all the +land will rise for the son of Gunnar so soon as it is known that he has +come again.” + +“Sigurd is yet alive,” Arngeir said; “and more than that, he is +waiting. For he promised Grim that he would be ready, and I heard the +promise. I think that this plan is good, and can well be managed. Here +is the ship that Griffin was to have taken today, and he is not here. +Gold enough I have, for Grim hoarded against this time.” + +Then he showed us the store that, through long years, my father had +brought together to take the place of that of Sigurd’s which had been +lost; and it was no small one. And so we planned at once; and in the +end we three brothers were to go with Havelok and Goldberga, leaving +Mord to get to Ragnar and tell him that Goldberga was following the +fortunes of her husband, and would return to see to her own if all went +well. Berthun would go with him, and Arngeir would bide at home, for we +needed one to whom messages might come; and while none would know us +now in Denmark, either Arngeir or Mord might be seen, and men would +tell Hodulf that the men of Grim had come home, and so perhaps spoil +all. Word might go to Denmark from Griffin even yet. + +We had little thought of any sorry ending to our plans, for the dreams +that had come so true so far cheered us. And so, with the evening tide +of the next day, we sailed in the same ship that had been hired for +Griffin. + +But first Havelok spent a long hour on my father’s mound alone, +thinking of all that he owed to him who rested there. And to him came +Goldberga softly, presently, lest he should be lonely in that place. +And there she spoke to him of her own faith, saying that already he +owed much to it. For he was making his vows to the Asir for success. + +“Shall you pray yet again to the Asir, my husband?” she asked. + +“Why should I? I have vowed my vows, and there is an end. If they heed +them, all is well; and if not, the Norns hinder.” + +“There is One whom the Norns hinder not at all,” she said gently, and +so told him how that her prayers would go up every day. + +Fain was she that he also prayed in that wise to her God, that naught +might be apart in their minds. + +Then he said, “I have heard this from David and Withelm also, and it is +good. Teach me to vow to your God, sweet wife, and I will do so; and +you shall teach me to pray as you pray.” + +So it came to pass that Havelok in the after days was more than ready +to help the Christian teachers when they came to him; for that was how +the vow that he made ran, that he would do so if he was king, and had +the power. + +Now there is nothing to tell of our voyage, for one could not wish for +a better passage, if the ship was slow. Indeed, she was so slow that a +smaller vessel that left Tetney haven on the next day reached the same +port that we were bound for on the night that we came to our old home. +And that we learned soon after she had come. + +Into Sigurd’s haven we sailed on the morning tide, and strange it +seemed to me to see the well-known place unchanged as we neared it. My +father’s house was there, and Arngeir’s, and the great hall of the jarl +towered over all, as I remembered it. Men were building a ship in the +long shed where ours had been built, and where the queen had hidden; +and the fishing boats lay on the hard as on the day when Havelok had +come to us. The little grove was yet behind our house, and it seemed +strange when I remembered that the old stones of its altar were far +beyond the seas. I wondered if Thor yet stood under his great ash tree; +and then I saw one change, for that tree was gone, and in its place +stood a watchtower, stone built, and broad and high, for haven beacon. + +On the high fore deck stood Havelok, and his arm was round Goldberga as +we ran in, but they were silent. The land held overmuch of coming +wonder for them to put into words, as I think. + +Presently the boats came off to us in the old way, and here and there I +seemed to know the faces of the men, but I was not sure. It was but the +remembrance of the old Danish cast of face, maybe. I could put no names +to any of them. And as we were warped alongside the wharf, there rode +down to see who we were Sigurd the jarl himself, seeming unchanged, +although twelve years had gone over him. He was younger than my father, +I think, and was at that age when a man changes too slowly for a boy to +notice aught but that the one he left as a man he thought old is so +yet. He was just the noble-looking warrior that I had always wondered +at and admired. + +We had arranged in this way: Havelok was to be the merchant, and we his +partners in the venture, trading with the goods in the ship as our own. +That the owner, who was also ship master, had agreed to willingly +enough, as we promised to make good any loss that might be from our +want of skill in bargaining. One may say that we bought the cargo, +which was not a great one, on our own risk, therefore, hiring the +vessel to wait our needs, in case we found it better to fly or to land +elsewhere presently. Then Havelok was to ask the jarl’s leave to trade +in the land, and so find a chance to speak with him in private. After +that the goods might be an excuse for going far and wide through the +villages to let men know who had come, without rousing Hodulf’s fears. + +And as we thought of all this on the voyage, Goldberga remembered that +it was likely that Sigurd would know again the ring that had been the +queen’s, and she said that it had better be shown him at once, that he +might begin to suspect who his guest was. For we knew that he was true +to the son of Gunnar, if none else might still be so. + +This seemed good to us all; and, indeed, everything seemed to be well +planned, though we knew that there are always some happenings that have +been overlooked. We thought we had provided against these by keeping +the ship as our own to wait for us, however, and it will be seen how it +all worked out in the end. + +Now Havelok went ashore as soon as the ship was moored; and the moment +that he touched land he made a sign on his breast, and I think that it +was not that of the hammer of Thor, for Goldberga watched him with +bright eyes, and she seemed content as she did so. He went at once to +where the jarl sat on his horse waiting him, and greetings passed. I +was so used to seeing men stare at my brother that I thought little of +the long look that Sigurd gave him; but presently it seemed that he was +mightily taken with this newcomer, for he came on board the ship, that +he might speak more with him and us. + +“Presently,” he said, “you must come and dine with me at my hall; for +the lady whom I saw as you came in will be weary, and a meal on shore +after a long voyage is ever pleasant. Now what is your errand here?” + +“Trading, jarl,” answered Havelok. + +“I thought you somewhat over warlike-looking for a merchant,” said +Sigurd; “what is your merchandise?” + +“Lincoln cloth, and bar iron, and such like; and with it all one thing +that is worth showing to you, jarl, for I will sell it to none but +yourself.” + +Now we went aft slowly, and presently Havelok and the jarl were alone +by the steering oar, by design on our part. + +“This seems to be somewhat special,” said Sigurd. “What is it?” + +Havelok took the ring from his pouch, and set it in the jarl’s hand +without a word; and long Sigurd looked at it. I saw the red on his +cheek deepen as he did so, but he said never a word for a long time. +And next he looked at Havelok, and the eyes of these two met. + +“This is beyond price,” said the jarl slowly. “Not my whole town would +buy this. It is such as a queen might wear and be proud of.” + +“Should I show it to Hodulf the king, therefore?” asked Havelok, with +his eyes on those of the jarl. + +“Let no man see it until I know if I can buy it,” answered Sigurd. +“Trust it to my keeping, if you will, for I would have it valued +maybe.” + +“It is my wife’s, and you must ask her that.” + +Then Havelok called Goldberga from her cabin under the after deck, and +the jarl greeted her in most courtly wise. + +“I will trust it with you, Jarl Sigurd,” she said, when he asked her if +he might keep the ring for a time. “Yet it is a great trust, as you +know, and it will be well to show the ring to none but men who are +true.” + +“It is to true men that I would show it,” he answered, with that look +that had passed between him and Havelok already; and I was sure that he +knew now pretty certainly who we were. Yet he could not say more at +this time, for the many men who waited for Havelok must be told +somewhat of his coming first. + +Now men were gathering on the wharf to see the newcomers, and so the +jarl spoke openly for all to hear. + +“Come up to my hall, all of you, and take a meal ashore with me; for +good is the first food on dry land after days at sea and the fare of +the ship.” + +So he went across the gangway, and to his horse, and rode away quickly, +calling back to us, “Hasten, for we wait for you. And I will find you +lodgings in the town for the time that you bide with us.” + +Now at first that seemed somewhat hazardous, for we had meant to stay +in the ship, lest we should have to fly for any reason suddenly. But it +seemed that we had no choice but to do as he bade us, and we could not +doubt him in any way. We should go armed, of course, as in a strange +place; and, after all, unless Hodulf heard of us, and wanted to see us, +he was not to be feared as yet. So I fell to wondering where our +lodgings would he, and if the old families still dwelt in the houses +that I had known, and then who had ours. Many such thoughts will crowd +into the mind of one who sees his old land again after many years, and +finds naught changed, to the eye at least. + +Men have told me that, as we came into the hall presently, they thought +us the most goodly company that had ever crossed its threshold; and +that is likely, for at our head were Havelok and Goldberga. Raven was a +mighty warrior to look on as he came next, grave and silent, with +far-seeing grey eyes that were full of watching, as it were, from his +long seafaring, and yet had the seaman’s ready smile in them. And +Withelm was the pattern of a well-made youth who has his strength yet +to gather, and already knows how to make the best use of that he has. +There were none but thought that he was the most handsome of the three +sons of Grim. And last came I, and I am big enough, at least, to stand +at Havelok’s back; and for the rest, one remembers what Eglaf said of +me. But I do not think that any noticed us with those twain to look at, +unless they scanned our arms, which were more after the English sort +than the Danish, so far as mail and helms are concerned, and therefore +might seem strange. + +The old hall was not changed at all; and handsome it seemed after +Alsi’s, though it was not so large. There were more and better weapons +on the walls, and carved work was everywhere, so that in the swirl and +heat-flicker of the torches the beams, and door posts, and bench ends, +and the pillars of the high seat seemed alive with knotted dragons that +began, and ended, and writhed everywhere, wondrous to look on. Our +English have not the long winter nights, and cruel frosts, and deep +snow that make time for such work as this for the men of the household. + +There fell a silence as we came in, and then Sigurd greeted us; and we +were set on the high seat, and feasted royally. On right and left of +our host sat Havelok and Goldberga, and the jarl’s wife next to +Havelok, and Biorn the Brown, the sheriff, next to our princess. This +was a newcomer here since my days, but well we liked him. + +There is nothing to tell of what happened at this feast, for Sigurd +asked no questions of us but the most common ones of sea, and wind, and +voyage, and never a word that would have been hard for Havelok to +answer in this company, where men of Hodulf’s might well be present. +Withelm noticed this, and said that no doubt it was done purposely, and +he thought much of it. + +When we had ended with song and tale, and it was near time for rest, +Sigurd bade Biorn, the sheriff, take us to his house for the night, +telling him that he must answer for our safety, and specially that of +the fair lady who had come from so far. And then he gave us a good +guard of his housecarls to take us down the street, as if he feared +some danger. + +“Why, jarl,” said Biorn, “our guests will have a bad night if they +think that in our quiet place they need twenty men to see them to bed +thus!” + +“Nay, but the town is strange to the lady,” answered Sigurd; “and who +knows what she may fear in a foreign land!” + +So Biorn laughed, and was content; and we bade farewell to the jarl, +and went out. And then I found that it was to my father’s house we were +to go, for it had been given to Biorn. + +Now, I was next to Goldberga as we came to the door, and there was a +step into the house which we always had to warn strangers of when it +was dark; and so, in the old way, without thinking for a moment, I said +to her, “One step into the house, sister.” + +“Ho, Master Radbard, if that is you, you have sharp eyes in the dark,” +said Biorn at once; “I was just about to say that myself.” + +“I have some feeling in my toes,” I answered; and that turned the +matter, for they laughed. + +And then, when we were inside, and the courtmen had gone clattering +down the street homewards, Biorn took the great door bar from its old +place and ran it into the sockets in the doorposts, as I had done so +many times; and the runes that my father had cut on it when he made the +house were still plain to be seen on it, with the notches I had made +with the first knife that I ever had. More I will not say, but +everywhere that my eyes fell were things that I knew, even to fishing +gear, for it seemed that Biorn was somewhat of a fisher, like Grim +himself. + +Then they put me and my brothers into our old loft, and Havelok and +Goldberga had the room that had been my father’s. As for Biorn, he +would be in the great room, before the fire. There was only this one +door to the house, and therefore he would guard that. His thralls were +in the sheds, as ours used to be, so that we and he were alone in the +house. + +Now, as soon as we three had gone into our old place of rest, Raven +went at once, as in the old days, to the little square window that was +in the high-pitched gable, and looked out over the town and sea. We +used to laugh at him for this, for he was never happy until he had +seen, as we said, if all was yet there. + +“There are yet lights in the jarl’s hall,” he said, “and there are one +or two moving about down in the haven. I think that there is a vessel +coming in.” + +“Come and lie down, brother,” I said. “We are not in Grimsby, and you +cannot go and take toll from her if there is.” + +He laughed, and came to his bed; but we talked of old days and of many +things more for a long while before we slept. And most of all, we +thought that Sigurd the jarl knew Havelok by the token of the ring and +by that likeness to Gunnar which Mord had seen, and that our errand was +almost told. + +So we slept without thought of any danger; but the first hour of the +night in that house was not so quiet to Goldberga, for presently she +woke Havelok, and she was trembling. + +“Husband,” she said, “it is in my mind that we are in danger in this +place; for I cannot sleep by reason of a dream that will come to me so +soon as my eyes are closed.” + +“You are overtired with the voyage,” Havelok told her gently; and then +he asked her what the dream was. + +“It seems that I see you attacked by a boar and many foxes, and hard +pressed, and then that a bear and good hounds help you. Yet we have to +flee to a great tree, and there is safety. Then come two lions, and +they obey you.” + +“I think that is a dream that comes of waves, and the foam that has +followed us, and the shrill wind in the rigging, and the humming of the +sail, sweet wife; and the tree is the tall mast maybe, and the lions +are the surges that you saw along this shore, where is no danger.” + +So she was content; and then all in the house slept. + + + + +CHAPTER XIX. +THE LAST OF GRIFFIN OF WALES. + + +Maybe it was about an hour before midnight when the first waking came +to any of us, and then it was Biorn himself who was roused by footsteps +that stayed at the doorway itself, after coming across the garth, and +then a voice that was strange to him which bade him open. At once he +caught up his axe and went to the door, and asked quietly who was +there. + +“Open at once,” said the man who was without; “we must speak with you.” + +“Go hence, I pray you, and wait for morning,” said the sheriff. “Here +are guests of the jarl’s, and they must not be disturbed.” + +“Open, or we will open for ourselves,” was the answer. “We have no time +to stay here talking.” + +“That is no honest speech,” quoth Biorn. “Go hence, or give me your +errand from without.” + +“Open, fool, or we will have the door down.” + +“There is an axe waiting for you if you do that. I rede you go hence in +peace, or it may be worse for you in the end.” + +I suppose it was in the mind of the sheriff that here were some friends +of his who had been overlong at the ale bench in the hall that evening; +but on this there was a little talk outside, and then the crash of a +great stone that was hurled against the door; and at that he started +back and got his mail shirt on him, for the door was strong enough to +stand many such blows yet. It seemed that there was more than a drunken +frolic on hand. Then came another stone against the door, and it shook; +and at the same moment Havelok came from his chamber to see what was +amiss, for the noise had waked him. He had thrown on the feasting gear +that he had been wearing; but he had neither mail nor helm, though he +had his axe in his hand. + +“What is the noise?” he said anxiously, seeing that Biorn was arming. + +The sheriff told him quickly, and again the door was battered. + +“It is a pity that a good door should be spoilt,” said Havelok, “for +down it is bound to come thus. Stand you there with the axe, and I will +even save them the trouble of breaking in.” + +“Nay,” said Biorn; “we know not how many are there, and it were better +that you should arm first. There is time.” + +“Why, they think that you are alone in the house, no doubt, and will +run when they find out their mistake. They are common thieves from the +forest, or outlaws. Stand you by to cut down the first man that dares +to enter, if there happen to be one bold enough.” + +He set his axe down, and went to the bar, and began to slide it back +into the deep socket that would let it free, and the men outside stayed +their blows as they heard it scraping. It was a very heavy bar of oak, +some seven feet long, and over a palm square. + +“Now!” cried Havelok, and caught the bar from its place. + +He did not take the trouble to set it down and get his axe; but as the +door opened a little he stood back balancing the great beam in his +hands, as a boy would handle a quarterstaff, ready for the rush of the +thieves that he expected, and so he was in the way of Biorn more or +less. + +Now there was silence outside, and one saw that the door was free, and +set his foot to it, and flung it open, for it went inwards. And then +Havelok knew that there was a stern fight before him, for the moonlight +showed the grim form of Griffin, the Welsh thane, fully armed and +ready. + +“Stand back, friend,” cried Biorn hastily, fearing for the unarmed man, +and caring nothing that beyond the foremost was a group of some half +dozen more warriors. + +But he spoke too late, for as Griffin stepped back a pace on seeing his +enemy himself in the doorway, Havelok had gone a pace forward, and now +was outside, where he had a clear swing of his unhandy weapon. + +Now Griffin gathered himself together, and spoke some few words to his +men in his own tongue; but my brother paid no heed to them, for he knew +what the way of the Briton was likely to be. And he was not wrong, for +without warning Griffin flew on him, sword point foremost, and left +handed, for he might not use the right for many a long day yet. + +Biorn shouted; but Havelok was ready, and the heavy bar caught and +shivered the light sword, and then swung and hurled the thane back +among his men with a rib broken. Havelok followed that up, falling on +the men even as their leader was among their feet. Two he felled with +downright strokes, and another shrank away in time to save himself from +the like fate. Then a fourth got in under his guard, and wounded +Havelok slightly in the left arm; and unless Biorn had been out and +beside him by that time it would have gone hard with him, for both +those who were left were on him, and another was hanging back for a +chance to come. + +There was shouting enough now, for the Briton does not fight in silence +as do the northern men, and we had waked. First of all Raven ran down +to the great room, half dazed with sleep, and blaming himself for all +this trouble, for he had seen that a ship was coming in, and he might +have thought it possible that it had brought Griffin and his men, whose +tongue had told him at once what had happened. + +Now he called to us to arm quickly, and sought for a weapon for +himself; and in that familiar place he went to the old corner where the +oars were wont to be set. There was one, for I have said that this +Biorn was a fisher, and the place that was handy for us had been so for +him. That was a homely weapon to Raven, and out into the moonlight he +came with it, and swept a Welshman away from Havelok’s side as he came. +But now more men were coming—townsfolk who had been roused by the +noise—and they knew nothing of the attackers, and so thought them +friends of ours, who joined us in falling on their sheriff; and there +was a wild confusion when Withelm and I came down armed. + +But what we saw first was a dim, white figure in the doorway of the +other room; and there stood Goldberga, wide eyed and trembling. + +“My dream, my dream!” she said. + +But of that we knew nothing; and we could but tell her to be of good +courage, for we would win through yet, and so went out to the fight. + +By this time Griffin was up again, and as I came from the door he was +once more ready to fall on Havelok from behind. So I thought it best to +stay him, and I shouted his name, and he turned and made for me. But +there was no skill in his coming, or he did not think me worth it, for +the axe had the better, and there was an end of Griffin. + +Withelm saw at once that Havelok had no weapon but the bar, and he ran +to him and held out his own axe. + +“Thanks, brother. Mine is inside the door. Get it for me,” said he; but +now he was laughing, and doing not much harm to anyone, and as I got +behind his back I saw why this was. + +There was only one of Griffin’s men left, and all the rest of the crowd +of half-armed men were townsfolk. Havelok and Raven were keeping these +back with sweeps of their long weapons, and behind them against the +wall was the sheriff, swearing and shouting vainly to bid his people +hold off and listen to him. And the noise was so great that they did +but think that he was calling them to rescue him from these who had +taken him prisoner. It seemed that the Welshman was keeping this up +also; but neither he nor any of the men cared to risk any nearness to +the sweep of bar and long oar in such hands. There were many broken +heads in that crowd; but it was growing greater every minute, and those +who were coming were well armed, having taken their time over it. They +say that there were sixty men there at one time. + +Now ran Withelm with the axe, and at that Havelok parted with the door +bar, and ended the last Welshman at the same time, for he hurled it at +him endwise, like a spear, and it took him full in the chest, and he +went down to rise no more. And at that the townsmen ran in, and we were +busy for a space, until once more they were in a howling circle round +us. But they had wounded Havelok again; and Biorn was at his wit’s end, +for he had had to take part in the fight this time. The men were mad +with battle, and forgot who he was, as it seemed. And now some raised a +cry for bows. + +That was the worst thing that we had to fear, and Raven called to us, +“Into the house, brothers, and keep them out of it till the jarl comes. +He will hear, or be sent for.” + +So we went back and got into the doorway, and we could not bar it at +first. But Withelm hewed off the blade of Raven’s oar, and I went out +and cleared the folk away for a space, and leapt back; and Havelok and +I got the door shut quickly against them as they came back on it, and +we barred it with the oar loom. That was but pine, however, and it +would not last long. + +Outside, the people were quiet for a little, wondering, no doubt, how +to rescue Biorn. He wanted to go out to them, but it did not seem safe +just yet. If they grew more reasonable it might be so. + +Then, as we rested thus, Goldberga came quickly, for she saw that her +husband was wounded, and she began to bind his hurts with a scarf she +had. She was very pale, but she was not weeping, and her hands did not +shake as she went to work. + +“This is my dream,” she said. “Was that the voice of Griffin that I +heard? It does not seem possible; but there is none other who speaks in +the old tongue of Britain here, surely.” + +“There is no more fear of him,” said Havelok, looking tenderly at her. +“Your dream has come true so far, if he was in it. How did it end?” + +“We fled to a tree,” she said, smiling faintly. + +Havelok smiled also, for this seemed dream stuff only to all of us—all +of us but Withelm, that is, for at once he said, “This door will be +down with a few blows. What of that tower of yours, Biorn? Might we not +get there and wait till the jarl comes?” + +At that Biorn almost shouted. + +“That is a good thought, and we can get there easily. Well it will be, +also, for the men are wild now, and there have been too many slain and +hurt for them to listen to reason.” + +“Bide you here,” said Withelm, “for it is we whom they seek. Then you +can talk to them.” + +But he would not do that, seeing that we had been put in his charge by +the jarl. + +“I go with you,” he said. “Now, if we climb out of the window that is +in the back of the house we can get to the tower before they know we +are gone.” + +We went into that chamber where Havelok had once been when he was taken +from the sack, and even as I unbarred the heavy shutter and took it +down, the door began to shake with a fresh attack on it. The trees of +the grove were two hundred yards from the house, maybe, and among them +loomed high and black the watchtower I had seen from the sea. A wide +path had been cut to it, and the moonlight shone straight down this to +the door of the building. + +Now Biorn went out first, and then he helped out Goldberga, and after +her we made Havelok go; and we called to these three to get to the +tower as Withelm came next, for every moment I looked to see our +enemies—if they are to be called so when I hardly suppose they knew +what they were fighting about—come round to fall on the back of the +house. + +Because of Goldberga they went; and Biorn opened the tower door, and +she passed into the blackness of its entry, but the two men stayed +outside for us. And we three were all out of the house when the first +of the crowd bethought themselves, and made for the back, and saw us. + +At once they raised a shout and a rush, and we did not think it worth +while to wait for them, as they would get between us and the tower, +which was open for us. So we ran, and they were, some twenty of them, +hard at our heels as we reached the door, and half fell inside, for the +winding stairway was close to the entry. I think that Biorn and Havelok +had made their plans as they saw what was coming, for Havelok followed +us and stood in the doorway, while Biorn was just outside with his axe +ready. + +“Hold hard, friends!” he called, as the men came up and halted before +him; “what is all this?” + +“Stand aside and let us get at them,” said the foremost, panting. + +“Nay,” said Biorn; “what harm have they done?” + +“Slain a dozen men and lamed twice as many more,” answered several +voices; “have them forth straightway.” + +“They were attacked, and defended themselves,” said the sheriff, “and +it is no fault of theirs that they had to do their best. Get you home, +and I will answer to the jarl for them. They are the jarl’s guests.” + +Then was a howl that was strange, and with it voices which seemed to +let some light on the matter. + +“They have slain the jarl’s guests.” + +And then came forward a big black-bearded man whom I had seen in the +crowd already, and he squared up to Biorn. + +“Lies are no good, master sheriff, for we know that the outlanders who +spoke the strange tongue must be the guests who came.” + +“I am no liar,” answered Biorn. “Is there not one man here who saw the +ship and her folk this afternoon?” + +Now this man seemed not to want that question answered, for he shouted +to the crowd not to waste time in wrangling, but to have out the +murderers; and he took a step towards Biorn, bidding him side no more +with the men, but let the folk deal with them. + +“You overdo your business as sheriff!” he said. + +It was Biorn who wasted no more time, for he saw that here was deeper +trouble than a common riot. He lifted his axe. + +“Come nearer at your peril,” he said. + +Then the black-bearded man sprang at him, and axe met sword for a parry +or two, flashing white in the moonlight. Then one weapon flashed red +suddenly, and it was Biorn’s, and back into the tower he sprang as his +foe fell, and Havelok flung the door to, and I barred it. + +“Up,” said Biorn; and in the dark we stumbled from stair to stair, +while the crowd howled and beat on the door below us. It was good to +get out into the moonlight on the roof, where we could rest. I was glad +that the tower was there instead of Thor, and also that it was strong. +It was no great height, but wide, and the men below looked comfortably +far off at all events. + +“Here is a fine affair,” quoth Biorn, sitting himself down with his +back against the high stone wall round the tower top. “It will take me +all my time to set this right.” + +“You have stood by us well, friend,” Havelok said, “and it is a pity +that you have had to share our trouble so far as this. Who was the man +who fell on you?” + +“That is the trouble,” answered Biorn, “for there will be more noise +over him than all the rest. He was Hodulf’s steward, the man who +gathers the scatt, and therefore is not liked. And all men know that +there was no love lost between him and me.” + +“Hodulf’s man,” said I; “how long has he been here, and is he a +Norseman?” + +For I knew him. He was the man who had spoken to me at the boat side +when we had to fly—one, therefore, who knew all of the secret of +Havelok. + +“Ay, one of the Norsemen who came here with the king at the first, and +is almost the last left of that crew. I suppose that you have heard the +story.” + +We had, in a way that the honest sheriff did not guess, and I only +nodded. But I thought that we had got rid of an enemy in him, and that +Griffin had fallen in with him on landing, and known him, and taken him +into his counsel about us. He would have gone down to see the vessel +and collect the king’s dues from her and from us at the same time. He +had not come into the town till late, as we heard afterwards. + +There was no time for asking more now, however, for the shouts of the +men round the door ceased, and someone gave orders, as if there was a +plan to be carried out. So I went and looked over on the side where the +door was to see what was on hand. + +It was about what one would have expected. They had got the trunk of a +tree, and were going to batter the door in. But now we were all armed, +for Raven had brought Havelok’s gear with him when he fetched his own. +He had thought also for Goldberga, and she was sitting in the corner of +the tower walls wrapped in a great cloak that she had used at sea, with +her eyes on her husband, unfearing, and as it seemed waiting for the +end that her dream foretold. + +I called the rest, and we looked down on the men. They saw us, and an +arrow or two flew at us, badly aimed in the moonlight. + +“Waste of good arrows,” said Havelok; “but we must keep them from the +door somehow.” + +“Would that the jarl would come,” growled Biorn, “for I do not see how +we are to do that.” + +“If they do break in,” said I, “any one can hold a stairway like this +against a crowd.” + +“I do not want to hurt more of these,” answered Havelok, looking round +him. And then his eyes lit up, and he laughed. “Why, we can keep them +back easily enough, after all.” + +He went to the tower corner, and shouted to the men below. Four or five +had the heavy log that they were to use as a ram, and they were just +about to charge the door with it, and no timber planking can stand that +sort of thing. + +“Ho, men,” he cried; “set that down, or some of you may get hurt.” + +They set up a roar of laughter at him as they heard, and then Havelok +laid hold of the great square block of stone that was on the very +corner of the wall, and tore it from its setting. + +“Odin!” said Biorn, as he saw that, “where do they breed such men as +this?” + +“Here,” answered Withelm, looking at the sheriff. + +Now Havelok hove up the stone over his head, and a sort of gasp went up +from the crowd below. One saw what was coming, and ran to drag back the +men with the beam, and stopped short before he reached them in terror, +crying to them to beware. But their heads were down, and they were +starting into a run. + +“Halt!” cried Havelok, but they did not stay. “Stand clear!” he shouted +in the sailor’s way. + +And then he swung the stone and let it go, while those who watched fled +back as if it was cast at them. Down is crashed on the attackers, +felling the man whom it struck, and dashing the timber from the grasp +of the others, so that one fell with it across his leg and lay howling, +while the rest gathered themselves up and got away from under the tower +as soon as they might. + +Now no man dared to come forward, and that angered Havelok. + +“Are you going to let these two bide there?” he said. “Pick the poor +knaves from under the stone and timber, and see to them.” + +But they hung back yet, and he called them “nidring.” + +Thereat two or three made a step forward, and one said, “Lord, let us +do as you bid us, and harm us not.” + +“You are safe,” he answered, and Biorn laughed and said that this was +the most wholesome word that he had heard tonight. + +“Lord, forsooth! Mighty little of that was there five minutes ago.” + +But it was not the terrible stone throwing only that wrung this from +them, as I think. They had seen Havelok in his arms, with the light of +battle on his face in the broad moonlight, and knew him for a king +among men. + +They took the hurt men from under the tower, and then crowded together, +watching us. And some man must needs loose an arrow at us, and it rang +on my mail, and that let loose the crowd again. Soon we had to shelter +under the battlement, but they were not able to lodge any arrows among +us, for that is a bit of skill that needs daylight. Then they dared to +get to the timber once more, and we saw them coming. + +Havelok took his helm, and set it on his sword point, and raised it +slowly above the wall, and that drew all the arrows in a moment. Then +he leapt up, and tore the stone from the other corner; and again, but +this time without warning, it fell on the men below, and that wrought +more harm than before. But it stayed them for a time, though not so +long, for now their blood was up, and the berserk spirit was waking in +them. Already the third stone was poised in the mighty hands, and would +have fallen, when there was a cry of, “The jarl! the jarl!” and along +the path into the clearing galloped Sigurd himself, with his courtmen +running behind him, and he called on the men to stay. + +They dropped the beam at the command, and were silent. And Sigurd +looked up at the tower, and saw who was there, and stayed with his face +raised, motionless for a space. I minded how Mord had stared and cried +out when first he saw Havelok, the son of Gunnar, in his war gear. + +“Biorn! where is Biorn?” cried Sigurd, looking back on the crowd as if +he thought he would be there. + +“Here am I, jarl,” came the answer, and the sheriff looked out from +beside Havelok. + +“What is all this?” + +“On my word, jarl, I cannot tell. Here have I been beset in my own +house, and but for your guests some of us would have come off badly. +There were outlanders who fell on us, and, as I think, stirred up the +folk to carry on the business, telling them that we had slain +ourselves, as one might say, for it was the cry that we had slain the +jarl’s guests.” + +“O fools, to take up the word of a chance stranger against that of your +own sheriff!” Sigurd cried, facing the people. + +“Nay, but the steward said so likewise,” cried some. + +“Hodulf’s steward?” said the jarl suddenly; “where is he?” + +“Yonder. Biorn slew him.” + +“He was leading this crowd,” said Biorn from above, “tried to force his +way into the tower past me, and would not be warned.” + +“What of the outlanders?” + +“All slain. Seven Welshmen they were.” + +Then I said plainly, remembering that the jarl would have known him, +“Their leader was Griffin, who came with Hodulf at the first. What +brought him here, think you, Sigurd the jarl?” + +But Sigurd looked round on the people, and scanned them for a long +time, and at last he said, in a hush that fell when he began to speak, +“Men who mind the old days, look at the man whom you have sought to +kill, and say if there is that about him which will tell you why +Hodulf’s men have set you on him thus.” + +Then the white faces turned with one accord to Havelok, as he stood +resting the great cornerstone on the battlement before him, and there +grew a whisper that became a word and that was almost a shout from the +many voices that answered. + +“Gunnar! Gunnar Kirkeban come again!” + +Then was silence, and the jarl spoke to Havelok. + +“Tell us your name, and whence you come.” + +“Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby men call me,” he said. + +And then men knew who he was indeed, for little by little the secret +had been pieced together, if not told from the king’s place, in the +years that had passed. And at that there rose and grew a murmur and a +cry. + +“Havelok, son of Gunnar! Havelok the king!” + +Then said Sigurd in a great voice, “Who is for Hodulf of us all? Let no +man go hence who is for him.” + +And I saw two or three men cut down then and there, and after that +there was a roar of voices that called for Havelok to lead them. + +“Come down, lord,” said Sigurd, unhelming and looking up. + +So we went from the tower, and round Havelok the men crowded, kissing +his hand and asking pardon for what they had wrought in error; and +Sigurd dismounted and knelt before him, holding forth his sword hilt in +token of homage, that his king might touch it. + +“Only Havelok son of Gunnar dares call himself son of Grim also, and in +that word all the tale is told. But I have known you from the first by +the token of the ring and by this likeness. Yet I waited for you to +speak, and for the time that should be best; and now that has come of +itself, and I am glad.” + +So said Sigurd, as we went from the tower to the hall, with the +townsmen at our heels in a wondering crowd. There were many among them +who would show the wounds that Havelok had given them with pride +hereafter, as tokens that they had known him well. + +Then we stayed on the steps of the hall door, and the jarl called out +man by man, and the war arrow was put in their hands with the names of +those men who waited for the coming of Havelok, that all through the +night the message that should bring him a mighty host on the morrow +should go far and wide. + +And the gathering word was, “Come, for the horn of the king is +sounding.” + +Then Sigurd said, “Speak to the people, my king, and all is done.” + +So Havelok smiled, and lifted his voice, and spoke. + +“Stand by me, friends, as steadfastly as you have fought against me, +and I shall be well content. And see, here is the queen for whom you +will fight also. There is not one of you but will play the man under +her eyes.” + +Not many words or crafty, but men saw his face, and heard that which +was in the voice, and they needed no word of reward to come, but +shouted as we had shouted when the bride came home to Grimsby, and I +thought that with the shout the throne of Hodulf was rocking. + + + + +CHAPTER XX. +THE OWNING OF THE HEIR. + + +Worn out we were with that long fight, and we all had some small +wounds—not much worth speaking of; and when these were seen to, we +slept. Only my brother Raven waked, and he sat through all the rest of +the short night on the high place, with his sword across his knees, +watching, for he blamed himself, overmuch as we all thought, for the +happenings of the attack. + +“Trouble not, brother, for we were in the keeping of Biorn, and he +could not have dreamt that foes could follow us over seas. It was not +for you to be on guard.” + +These were Withelm’s words, but for once Raven did not heed them. + +“Would Grim, our father, have slept with a lee shore under him, leaving +a stranger to keep watch? That is not how he taught me my duty; and I +have been careless, and I know it. I should have thought of Griffin +when I saw the ship come in.” + +So he had his way, and the last that I saw ere my eyes closed was his +stern form guarding us; and when I woke he was yet there, motionless, +with far-off eyes that noted the little movement that I made, and +glanced at me to see that all was well. + +In the grey of the morning the first of the chiefs to whom the arrow +had sped began to come in; but the jarl would not have Havelok waked, +for he was greatly troubled at the little wounds that had befallen this +long-waited guest. So the chiefs gathered very silently in the great +hall, and sat waiting while the light broadened and shone, gleam by +gleam, on their bright arms and anxious faces. It was not possible for +those who had not yet seen Havelok to be all so sure that it was indeed +he. They longed to see him, and to know him for the very son of Gunnar +for themselves. + +Presently there were maybe twenty chiefs in the hall—men who had fought +beside Kirkeban, and men who had been boys with Havelok, and some who +had known his grandfather—and the jarl thought that it was time that +they had the surety that they needed, for time went on, and there was +certainty that Hodulf must hear of all this morning. One could not +expect that no man would earn reward by warning him. + +So Sigurd went softly to the place where Havelok lay in the little +guest chamber that opened out of the inner room that was the jarl’s +own, and he slid the boards that closed it apart gently and looked in +to wake him. But instead of doing that, he came back to the hall and +beckoned the chiefs, and they rose and followed him silently. And when +they went Raven went also, without a word, that he might be near his +charge while these many strangers spoke with him. + +Now Sigurd stood at the spot where the little shifting of the sliding +board made it possible to see within the chamber, and one by one the +chiefs came and peered through the chink for a moment, and stood aside +for the next. And it was wondrous to see how each man went and looked +with doubt or wonder or just carelessly, and then turned away with a +great light of joy on his face and a new life in the whole turn and +sway of the body. + +It was dark in the chamber, save for the dim spaces under the eaves +that let in the sweet air from the sea to the sleepers. But from +somewhere aloft, where the timbering of the upper walls toward the east +had shrunk, so that there was a little hole that faced the newly-risen +sun, came the long shaft of a sunbeam that pierced the darkness like a +glorious spear, and lit on the mighty shoulder of Havelok that lay bare +of covering, and on the white hand of Goldberga that was across it. And +on the one they saw the crimson bent-armed cross that was the mark of +the line whence he and his father had sprung, and on the other glowed +and flashed the blood-red stone of the ring of Eleyn the queen. And +round that circle of sunshine was light enough for the chiefs to see +those two noble faces, and they were content. + +“Gunnar’s son,” said one old chief: “but were he only the son of Grim, +for those twain would I die.” + +So the warriors crept back to the hall silently as they had come; and +now they went out to their men and told them that all doubt had gone, +and along the road that led to Hodulf’s town the jarl sent mounted men +to watch for his coming. And always fresh men were pouring in, and +among them went the chiefs who had seen Havelok, and told them the +news. + +Now it was not long before there was a gathering of all the chiefs in +the hall of Sigurd, that they might break their fast, and then they saw +Havelok as he led in the princess to meet them. He stood on the high +place in his arms, and a shout of greeting went up; and when it was +over, Sigurd asked him to tell all that had happened to him; and he did +that in as few words as might be, for he was no great speaker, though +what he did say was always to the point, and left little to be asked. + +And when he had ended, there rose up a grey-headed old chief, and said, +“Give this warrior the horn of Gunnar, that we may hear him wind it. I +would not say that unless I were sure that he was the right man to have +it.” + +Now I stood beside Havelok, and while Sigurd went from the hall to some +treasure chamber to get this that had been asked for, I said to him, +“Mind you the day when we met Ragnar. and a call came into your dream? +Wind that call now; for, if I am not wrong, it will be welcome to those +who knew your father.” + +“I mind the day but not the call. I have never remembered it since,” he +said, and I was sorry. + +Sigurd brought the horn, and it was a wondrous one, golden and heavy. +It seemed to be a hunting horn, not very long, and little curved, but +from end to end it was wrought with strange figures of men and beasts +in rings that ran round it. + +“Have you seen this before?” asked Sigurd wistfully, and looking into +Havelok’s face as he gave it into his hand. + +One could feel that men waited his answer, and it came slowly. + +“Ay, friend, I am sure that I have, but I cannot yet say when or where. +I am sure that it is not the first time that I have had it in my hand.” + +And as he said this, Havelok’s face flushed a little, and his brow +wrinkled as if he tried to bring back the things of that which he had +thought his dream for so long. + +It would seem that in the years there had grown up a tale that this was +a magic horn, which none but the very son of Gunnar could wind, and to +the chiefs who saw Havelok now for the first time this was a test to +prove him. But all knew that the words he spoke of it were proof +enough, for a pretender would have said plainly that it had been +Gunnar’s, and that he knew it. I think that Sigurd was wise in what he +did next, for he set another horn in my brother’s hand, and asked him +the same question; and at this Havelok looked for a moment and shook +his head. + +“I have not seen that one before, nor one like it. I am sure that I +have seen this, or its fellow.” + +At that the faces that watched brightened, for there was no doubt in +the way that Havelok spoke; and then the old chief who had asked for +the horn said, “That—‘The horn of the king is sounding’—was the +gathering word of the night that has brought us here, and long have we +waited for it. Let Havelok wind his father’s horn, that we may hear it +once again.” + +Then Havelok set it to his lips, and at once the call that he had +remembered came back to him, and clear and sweet and full of longing +its strange notes rang under the arched roof, unfaltering until the +last; and then over him came the full remembrance of all that it had +been to him, and he turned away from the many eyes and sank on the high +seat, and set his head in his arms on the table, that men might not see +that he needs must weep; and Goldberga stepped a little before him, and +set her hand on his, for I think that she knew the loneliness that came +on him. + +Yet he was not alone in his sorrow, for down in the hall were men to +whom the lost call brought back the memory of a bright young king +riding to his home, and calling the son whom he loved with the call +that he had made for him alone; and they saw the fair child running +from the hall, and the mother following more slowly with smiles of +welcome; and they saw the grim courtmen, who looked on and were glad; +and they minded how they had lifted the boy to the war saddle; and +their eyes grew hot with tears also, and they had no need to be +ashamed. + +And as men stood motionless, with the last notes of the wild horn yet +ringing in their ears, there drifted a shadow across the days, and, lo! +beside Havelok, with his hand on his shoulder, stood the form of Gunnar +the king for a long moment, bright as any one of us who lived, in the +morning sunlight, and his face was full of joy and of hope and promise +for the time to come. And then he passed, but as he faded from us his +hand was on the hand of Goldberga that clasped her husband’s, as though +he would wed them afresh there on the high place of his friend’s hall. + +Now there went a sigh of wonder among the chiefs, and Havelok looked up +as if he followed the going of one whom he would not lose, and I know +that he saw Gunnar after he was unseen to us. + +“Surely,” he said, “surely that was my father who was here?” + +And Sigurd answered, “With your own call you called him, and he was +here.” + +But now the last lurking doubt was gone, and there was no more delay, +for the chiefs crowded with shouts of joy to the high place, and they +knelt to Havelok and hailed him as king then and there; and so they led +him to the great door of the hall, and the mightiest of them raised him +high on a wide shield before all the freemen who waited on the green +that is round the jarl’s house, and they cried, “Skoal to Havelok the +king!” + +And there was in answer the most stirring shout that a man may hear—the +shout of a host that hail the one for whom they are content to die. + +That was the first day of the reign of Havelok the king; and now there +were two kings in the land, and one was loved as few have been loved, +and the other was hated. And one was weak in men, as yet, while the +other was strong. + +Now Sigurd bade all those who were present gather in solemn Thing, that +they might make Havelok king indeed; and that was a gathering of all +the best in our quarter of the land, so that all would uphold what they +had done. And when they were gathered in the great hall in due order, +the doors were set wide open, and outside the freemen who followed the +chiefs sat in silence to see what they might and hear. + +Then swore Havelok to keep the ancient laws and customs, and to do +even-handed justice to all men, and to be bound by all else that a good +king should hold by. Sometimes these oaths are not kept as well as they +might be, but I was certain that here was one who would keep them. + +Thereafter Sigurd brought forth a crown that he had had made hastily by +his craftsmen from two gold arm rings, and they set it on Havelok’s +head, and hailed him as king indeed; and one by one the chiefs came and +swore all fealty to him, beginning with Sigurd, and ending with a boy +of some seventeen winters, who looked at the king he bent before as +though he was Thor himself. + +Then they would have had Havelok forth to the people at once; but he +bade them hearken for a moment, and said, taking Goldberga by the hand, +“Were it not for this my wife, I do not think that I had been here +today, and without her I am nothing. Now I am king by your word, and I +think that I might bid you take her as queen. But I had rather that she +was made queen by your word also, that whither I live or fall in the +strife that is to come, you may fight for her.” + +At that there was a murmur of praise, and all agreed that she should be +crowned at once. So Havelok set the crown on her head while the chiefs +in one voice swore to uphold her through good and ill, as though she +were Havelok himself. + +Then said Havelok, “Now have you taken her for queen for her own sake, +and I will tell you a thing that has not been heard here as yet. On +this throne sits the queen of two lands, and there shall come a day +when you and I shall set your lady on that other throne which is hers +by right. King’s daughter she is, for Ethelwald of the East Angles was +her father, and out of her right has she been kept by Alsi of Lindsey, +her evil kinsman.” + +At that men were glad, for great is the magic of kingly descent. And +thereupon that old warrior who had bidden Havelok sound the horn said, +“We have heard of Ethelwald the good king, and of this Alsi moreover, +and we know men who have seen both, and also Orwenna, the mother of our +own queen here. I followed your father across the seas in the old days, +and I seem to hear his voice again as you speak to us. And I saw +him—ay, I saw him yonder even now, and I am content. When the time +comes that for the sake of Goldberga you will gather a host and cross +the ‘swan’s path,’ I will not hold back, if you will have me.” + +There was spoken the mind of all that company, and they were not +backward to say so. For in the heart of the Dane is ever the love of +the sea, and of the clash of arms on a far-off strand that comes after +battle with wind and wave. + +Very bravely did Goldberga thank the chiefs for their love to her +husband and herself in a few words that were all that were needed to +bind the hearers to her, so well and truly were they chosen. And she +said that if the Anglian land was to be won it was for Havelok and not +for herself altogether, and she added, “Here we have spoken as if +already Hodulf was overthrown, and it is good that we are in such brave +heart. Yet this has been foretold to me, and I am sure that there will +be no mishap.” + +Then Sigurd said, “What gift do we give our queen, now that she has +come among us?” + +But Goldberga replied, “If it is the custom that one shall be given, I +will mind you of the promise hereafter, when Anglia is won, and you and +I are Havelok’s upholders on that throne. There is one thing that I +will ask then, that a wrong may be righted.” + +“Nay, but we will give you some gift now, and then you shall ask what +you will also.” + +“You have given me more than I dared hope,” she said, “even the brave +hearts and hands that have hailed us here. I can ask no more. Only +promise to give me one boon when I need it, and I am happy.” + +Then they said, “What you will, and when you will, Goldberga, the +queen. There is naught that you will ask amiss.” + +Now they showed Havelok to the warriors as crowned king, and I need not +tell how he was greeted. And after that we all went back into the hall +to speak of the way in which we were to meet Hodulf. + +Havelok would have a message sent to him, bidding him give up the land +in peace. + +“It may be that thus we shall save the sadness of fighting our own +people, though, indeed, they love the playground of Hodulf. He is an +outlander, and perhaps he may think well to make terms with us.” + +Some said that it was of no use, but then Havelok answered that even so +it was good to send a challenge to him. + +“For the sake of peace we will do this, though I would rather meet him +in open fight, for I have my father to avenge.” + +Now I rose up and said, “Let me go and speak with him, taking Withelm +as my counsellor. For I know all the story, and that will make him sure +that he has the right man to fight against. I will speak with him in +open hall, and more than he shall learn how he thought to slay +Havelok.” + +All thought that this was good, and I was to go at once. It was but a +few hours’ ride, as has been said, to his town, and the matter was as +well done with. + +So they gave me a guard of twenty of the jarl’s courtmen, and in half +an hour I was riding northward on my errand. And to say the truth I did +not know if it was certain that I should come back, for Hodulf was +hardly to be trusted. + +I did wait to break my fast, and that was all, for I had no mind to +spend the night on the road back from the talk that I should have had; +but though I wasted so little time, the people were already beginning +to prepare for rejoicing in their own way with games of all sorts and +with feasting in the open. I saw, as we rode down the street, the piles +of firewood that were to roast oxen whole, and near them were the butts +that held ale for all comers. There were men who set up the marks for +the archers, and others who staked out the rings for the wrestling and +sword play. And as we left the town we met two men who led a great +brown bear by a ring in his nose, for the baiting. I was sorry for the +poor beast, but the men called him “Hodulf,” already, and I thought +that a good sign in its way. + +Another good sign, and that one which could not be mistaken, was to see +the warriors coming in by twos and threes as the news reached them. +They were dotted along the roads from all quarters, and across the +heaths we saw the flash of the arms of more. + +And ever as they met us they hailed us with, “What cheer, comrades? Is +the news true? Is Havelok come to his own?” and the like, and they +would hurry on, rejoicing in the answer that they had. + +But I will say that presently, when we passed a stretch of wild moor +where we saw no man, the same was going on towards the town of Hodulf; +for if the news came to a village, some would be for the king that was, +and other and older men for the king that might be. Yet all asked that +question; and more than once, when they heard the reply, there would be +a halt and a talk, and then the men would turn and cast in their lot +with the son of Gunnar, hastening to him with more eager steps than had +taken them to Hodulf. + + + + +CHAPTER XXI. +THE TOKEN OF SACK AND ANCHOR. + + +It seemed only the other day that I had passed over the well-known +ways, and I showed Withelm the hollow where Grim had met with the king +and taken his precious burden from him. Then we passed along the wild +shore, and the linnets were singing and the whinchats were calling as +ever, and the old mounds of the heroes of the bygone were awesome to me +now as long ago, when I looked at them standing lonesome along the +shore with only the wash of the waves to disturb them. And so we came +to the town at high noon, and already there was the bustle of a +gathering host in the place, for the news had fled before us. + +They had built a new and greater hall in place of that which had been +burned; and there sat Hodulf with his chiefs, wondering and planning, +and maybe waiting for more certain news of what had happened. Not long +would they wait for that now. + +We rode to the door, and one came to meet us with words of welcome, +thinking that we were men who came to the levy that was gathering; but +his words stayed when I asked to be taken to the presence of Hodulf, as +I came with a message from Havelok Gunnarsson the king. + +The man, chamberlain or steward, or whatever he was, stared at me, and +said in a low voice, “It is true then?” + +“True as I am Radbard Grimsson, who helped Havelok to fly from hence.” + +“Unwelcome will you be, for Hodulf is in no good mood,” the man said. +“I hardly think it safe for you to trust yourself with him.” + +“Then,” said I, “open the door of the hall, and I will go in with my +men, and see what he says.” + +“Well, that will be bad for me, but I have a mind to see Havelok.” + +So I told Withelm to come at my side, and bade half the courtmen follow +us closely, and when they were inside to see that the door was not +barred after us on any pretence. The rest would bide with the horses +outside. + +Then we loosed the peace strings of our weapons, and in we went, +quietly and in order; and the chiefs turned to look at us, thinking us +more of themselves. Hodulf sat on his place on the dais, and there were +thirty-one others with him, sitting on the benches that were set along +the walls. Withelm counted them. + +Then the door was closed, and the man with whom I had spoken set his +back against it, but it was not barred; and I went forward to the steps +of the high place, and stood before Hodulf. + +“Well, what now?” he said, seeing that I was a stranger. + +“First of all, I ask for safe conduct from this hall as a messenger +from king to king.” + +“That you have, of course,” he answered. “What is your message?” + +It did not seem that he thought of Havelok at all, but rather that I +came from some king to whom he had sent. There were two living not so +far off. I thought that there was no good in beating about the bush, +for such an errand as mine had better he told boldly. So I spoke out +for all to hear. + +“This is the word of Havelok, son of Gunnar the king, to Hodulf of +Norway, who sits in his place. Home he has come to take his own, and +now he would tell you that the time has come that he is able to rule +the kingdom for himself.” + +“And what if he has?” said Hodulf, without the least change of face, as +if he had been expecting this, and nothing more or less. + +But if he was quiet, the chiefs had heard my words in a very different +way. Some had leaped up, and others bent forward, to hear the answer to +my words the better. I heard one or two laugh; but there were some on +whose faces seemed to be written doubt and anxiety. I think that some +would have spoken, for Hodulf held up his hand for silence, and looked +to me for answer. + +“It will be well for you to give up the throne to him, making such +terms as you may,” I said. + +“That is a fair offer,” said Hodulf, quite unmoved, to all seeming, but +looking at me in a way that told me how his anger was held back by main +force, as it were; “but how am I to know that this one who sends so +bold a message is the real Havelok? I am not a fool that I should give +up my throne to the first who asks it. Doubtless you bring some token +that you come from the very son of Gunnar.” + +“It is right that you should ask one, and also that you should have one +that there can be no mistaking,” I said. “This is it. By the token of +the sack and the anchor I bid you know that Havelok sends me to you.” + +At that the face of Hodulf became ashy grey beneath the tan of wind and +sea, and I saw that his hand clutched the hilt of his sword so that the +knuckles of his fingers grew white. He had never thought to hear of +that deed again, and he knew that he had to deal with the one whom he +had thought dead. Some of the young chiefs in the hall laughed at that +token, but he flashed a glance at them which stayed the laugh on their +lips. + +“I know not what you mean,” he said, altogether staggered. + +“It is right,” I said, “that if the token is not plain I should make it +so. It is but fair also to the chiefs who are here.” + +Then he stayed me. True it is that old sin makes new shame. + +“I will take it as enough,” he said hastily. “I mind some old saying of +the kind. Ay, that is it—a hidden king and a voyage across the sea. It +is enough.” + +“Not enough,” said a chief in the hall close to the high seat. “Let +this warrior say what he means plainly.” + +There were many who agreed to this, and I did not wait for Hodulf any +longer. I told them who I was, and then showed them why that token was +to be held enough for any man; and as I spoke, there were black looks +toward the high seat among the older men. As for Hodulf, he sat with a +forced smile, and seemed to listen indulgently, as to a well-made tale. + +And after that the matter was out of my hands, for the same chief who +had asked for the tale came and stood by my side, and he faced Hodulf +and spoke. + +“For twelve years have I served you as king, and now I know that I have +wasted the faith I gave you. What became of the sisters of Havelok? +Answer me that, Hodulf, or I will go and ask their brother concerning +whom you have lied to me.” + +“Go and ask him,” answered Hodulf, biting his lips; “go and hear more +lies. Who can know the son of Gunnar when he sees him?” + +“That is answered out of your own mouth,” said the chief. “Is Sigurd a +fool that he should hail the first man who asks him to do so?” + +And from beside me Withelm answered also, “Maybe it is a pity that +Griffin of Wales was slain last night in trying to kill Havelok. He +knew him, and I have heard that he came here to warn Hodulf that his +time was come.” + +Hodulf’s face grew whiter when he heard that; but it was what he +needed, as some sort of excuse to let loose his passion. + +White and shaking with wrath and fear, he rose up and he cried, +“Murdered is Griffin! Ho, warriors, let not these go forth!” + +Whereon the old chief lifted his voice also, “Ho, Gunnar’s men! Ho, men +who love the old line! To Grim’s son, ahoy!” + +And he drew his sword, snapping the thongs that had bound it to the +sheath, so manfully tugged he at them in his wrath, and there was a +rush of men to us, and another to Hodulf. + +Now I think that we might have slain him there, and after that have +been slain ourselves, for the odds were against us, even though I had +the courtmen; but that was Havelok’s deed to do, for the sake of father +and sisters to be avenged, and so we only cut our way out of the hall +to the door, which my men threw open at once. There were two of +Hodulf’s men hurt only, for the most of them had run to the high place, +and few were between us and our going. So we took five chiefs and their +followers back with us, and that was worth the errand. + +We thought that it would not be long now before Hodulf was on us; but +the days passed, and there was no news of him, and all the while we +grew stronger. I do not know if the same could be said of him, and it +is doubtful if time made much difference to his forces. Those who +followed him were the men who owed all to him, either as men raised to +some sort of power when he first came, or else strangers whom he had +brought in with him. Some of the younger chiefs of the old families +held by him also, for they had known no other, and then there were old +feuds with Gunnar that held back some from us; but these few took part +with neither side. + +So before a week was out we had a matter of six thousand men in and +about the town; and it seemed that, with so good a force, it was as +well to march on Hodulf as to wait for him. And that was good hearing +for us all, for there was not a man who did not long to be up and +doing, though to smite a blow for Havelok should be the last deed that +he might do. + +They made me captain of the courtmen who were Havelok’s own, maybe +because I had served with Alsi, and Withelm was captain of Goldberga’s +own guard. High honour was that for the sons of Grim, for there was not +one in either of these companies but was of high birth; but then we +were Havelok’s brothers, and all seemed well content to serve under us. +I wanted Raven to be in my place, but he said that he was no warrior on +shore. + +“Just now I am Havelok’s watchdog, to be at his heels always. +Presently, if he likes to give me a ship when we sail to England, that +will suit me.” + +So Havelok made him his standard bearer; and as that would keep him at +the king’s side in the thickest fight, he was well pleased. Goldberga +wrought the standard that he bore, with the help of Sigurd’s wife, and +on it was the figure of Grim, sword and shield in hand, but with his +helm at his feet, as showing that he had laid it by; and on either side +of him stood Havelok and his wife, each with a crown above their heads, +as though they waited for the coming time when they should be set there +firmly by the bearing forward of this banner. Havelok bore his axe, +holding out the ring to Goldberga with the other hand, while she had +her sceptre in the left, and stretched the right hand to her husband. +There were runes that told the names of these three, for that is +needful in such work, as it passes the skill of woman to make a good +likeness, nor do I think it would be lucky to do so if it could be +compassed. Wondrous was the banner with gold and bright colours, and it +was hung from a gilded spear, ashen hafted, and long, that it might be +seen afar in battle. + +Now on the day when Havelok set his men in order for the march on +Hodulf word came that he was coming at last. It is likely that he knew +we were on the point of marching, and would choose his own ground on +which to wait for us. So we went to certain battle, as it seemed, and +none were sorry for that. So in the bright sunshine of a cloudless +morning Havelok and Goldberga rode down the line of the men, who would +fight to the death for them, and those two were good to look on. Day +and night Sigurd’s weapon smiths had wrought to make a mail shirt that +should be worthy of a king, and I thought that they had wrought well. +They had set a crown round the helm that they made for him, and Sigurd +had given him a sword that had been his father’s at one time, golden +hilted, and with runes on its blue blade. But Havelok would not part +with the axe that Grim had given him, plain as it was, and that was his +chosen weapon. + +But for once I think that men looked more at her who rode at Havelok’s +side than at him, goodly and kingly as he was in the war gear. For +Goldberga had on a silver coat of chain mail, and a little gold circlet +was round the silver helm that she wore, while at her saddle bow was an +axe, on which were runes written in gold, and a sword light enough for +her hand was in a gem-studded baldric from her shoulder. There was a +chief who had given her these, and it was said that they had first of +all belonged to one who had fought as a shield maiden at the great +battle of Dunheidi, by the side of Hervoer, the sister of the mighty +hero Angantyr. His forefather had won them at that time, and now they +were worn by one who was surely like the Valkyries, for no fairer or +more wondrous to look on in war gear could they be than our English +queen. + +She would have gone even into the battle with Havelok, but that neither +he nor we would suffer. She was to bide here in the town until we came +back in triumph or defeat; and as men looked on her, they grew strong, +that no tears might be for those bright eyes. + +Now I left them before the march began, for I and the courtmen were to +go forward and see where the foe was posted, and so bring word again. +And we went some five miles before we saw the first sign of them. Then +on a rise in the wild heath waited a few horsemen, who watched us for a +little while, and then rode away from us and beyond it. We followed +them, and when we came to where they had been, we saw that they had +fallen back on a company of about the same strength as ours, save that +there were more horsemen. I was the only mounted man of my little +force, and that rather to save my strength than because I liked riding. +I should certainly fight on foot, as would Havelok himself, in the old +way. It is not good to trust to the four feet of a horse when one means +business. + +We bided where we were, waiting to see what these men did, and soon +beyond them grew the long cloud of dust starred with shifting sparks +that told us that the host of Hodulf was on foot and advancing. It +seemed to me that here we had a good place to meet it, for the land +went down in a long slope that was in our favour, and therefore I set a +man on my horse, and sent him back with all speed to Havelok to bid him +hasten. Our host was not so far behind me, and I could see both from +this hill. We had full time to take position here before Hodulf’s army +was in reach. + +Now it seemed that the foemen would see what they could also, and they +began to move toward us. It was plain that we should have a small fight +on our own account directly, for I did not mean to let them take our +place. We moved, therefore, toward them, and at that the half-dozen +horsemen made for us at a trot. Then I saw that their leader was Hodulf +himself. + +We were in a track that led across the hill, and here on the slope it +was worn deep with ages of traffic between the two towns, and on either +side the heather grew thick and high, so that the horsemen could not +get round us. So Hodulf rode forward to where we barred the way, and +told me to stand aside. + +“What next?” I asked. “I may as well bid you go back, for I came here +to stop you.” + +“Come over to me, and leave this half-crowned kinglet of yours. It +shall be worth your while.” + +“Hard up for men must you be, Hodulf,” said one of my courtmen, +laughing. + +At that he made a sign to his followers, for they came on us at the +gallop, with levelled spears. We closed up, and hewed the spear points +off, and then dealt with the horses and men who foundered among us, and +they struggled back, leaving three men and four horses in the roadway. +It was bravely done, too, for there were only eight of them, and they +did us no harm beyond a bruise or two. I wished that we had taken or +slain Hodulf, however, for that might have made things easier in the +end. + +Hodulf got back to his courtmen, and now they came on. At that moment +over the hill behind us rode Havelok and Raven, and saw at once what +was on hand. They had ridden on, but the host was hard after them. + +“Send a man to bid the host halt,” Havelok said to me, “for we can end +the matter here. Now shall I be hand to hand with Hodulf, even as I +would wish.” + +I sent a man back as he bade me, and he stayed the host half a mile +beyond the hill, where they were not seen. Hodulf’s army was yet two +miles away across the heath, and none had gone back to hasten it. + +Now Havelok went forward, holding up his hand in token of parley, and +his enemy rode from his men to meet him. + +“There is much between us, Hodulf,” Havelok said, “and we have been +together along this road before. Yet for the sake of the men who follow +us it may be that we can make peace.” + +“That is for me to say,” answered Hodulf, “for you have invaded my +land, and are the peace breaker.” + +“I might mind you of a blood feud between us two,” said Havelok, “but +that is not the business of the host. For the sake of the land I will +say this. Give up the throne that you have held for me, and you shall +go hence with what treasure you have gathered, taking your Norsemen +with you. There will be no shame in doing that, for I am able now to +hold the land for myself.” + +Hodulf laughed a short laugh. + +“Fine talk that for the son of Grim the thrall, who drowned Havelok for +me! ‘Nidring’ should I be if I gave up to you.” + +“If things must go in that way, we will settle the matter here and now. +Will you that we fight hand to hand while our men look on, or shall we +go back to them and charge? I like the first plan best myself, as I +would avenge my father and sisters, and also that insult of the way in +which we passed this road together twelve years ago.” + +So said Havelok, and his words fell like ice from his lips, and he was +very still as he spoke, though the red flush crept into his cheek and +his brows lowered. + +And Hodulf did not answer at once. He looked at the towering young +warrior before him, and maybe into his mind there crept the thought of +the children whom he had slain, whom this one would avenge. Well he +knew that the true Havelok was speaking with him, though he would not +own it, and branded my father with the name of thrall for the sake of +insult to his foster son. + +At last he said, “We will go back to the men, for you have advantage in +that bulk of yours.” + +“As you will,” answered Havelok. “Twelve years ago that was on your +side.” + +He reined round at once, and touched his horse with the spur without +another glance at his enemy. And then we shouted, and Raven spurred +forward with a great oath, for Hodulf plucked his sword from the +scabbard, and with a new treachery in his heart, rode after our brother +and was almost on him. The shout was just in time, for Havelok turned +in his saddle as the blow was falling. + +Quick as light, he took it on the shaft of the spear he carried, and +turned it, wheeling his horse short round at the same time. Lindsey +training was there in that horsemanship of his. Hodulf’s horse shot +past as the blow failed, and then Raven seemed to be the next man to be +dealt with. + +But Havelok called to him to stand aside, for this was his own fight; +and at that Hodulf had his horse in hand again, and was ready to meet +his foe fairly. + +And now Havelok had cast aside the spear, and taken the axe from the +saddle bow; and these two met, unshielded, for neither had time to +unsling the round buckler from his shoulder. + +It was no long fight, for now Hodulf’s men were coming up, and there +need be no more thought of aught but ending one who was ready to smite +a foul blow before us all shamelessly. Havelok spurred his horse, and +the two met and closed for one moment. Then down went the Norseman with +cleft helm, and the old wrongs were avenged, and there was but one king +in the land. + +Then Hodulf’s men were on Havelok, but not before Raven was at his +back, and over Hodulf there was a struggle in which Havelok was in +peril for a short time before we closed round him. Well fought the +courtmen of the fallen king, and well fought my men, and we bore them +back, fighting every foot of ground, until there were only five of them +left, and these five yielded in all honour, being outnumbered. Yet ours +was a smaller band by half ere there was an end. + +It had not lasted long, and still the host of Hodulf was so far off +that they knew not so much as that there was any fighting. Then we went +to the hilltop, and set the banner there, and our line came on and +halted along the crest. + +One hardly need say what wonder and rejoicing there was when it was +known how Hodulf had met his end, and Sigurd and other chiefs went to +where we had fought, and looked on him. And one took the helm, which +had round it the stolen crown, and gave it to Havelok. + +“Set it on the standard,” he said, “for we may need that it shall be +shown presently. As for Hodulf, bear him aside out of the path of the +host, that we may lay him in mound when all is ended.” + +One cried that he did not deserve honour of any kind, and there were +some who agreed to that openly. I will not say that I was not one of +them, for I had seen the foul play, and heard the insult to Grim, my +father. + +But Havelok answered gravely, “He has been a king, and I have not heard +that he was altogether a bad one. All else was between him and me, and +that is paid for by his death. Think only of the twelve years in which +you have owned him as lord, and then you will know that it is right +that he should be given the last honours. You had no feud as had I.” + +Then they did as he bade them, and that gladly, for the words were +king-like, and of good omen for the days to come. I saw Sigurd and the +older chiefs glance at each other, and it was plain that they were well +pleased. + +Now the host came on, and it was greater than ours; but when there was +no sign of its leader the march wavered, and at last halted altogether. +Whereon some chiefs rode to speak to us, and Havelok met them with his +leaders. He had to speak first, for they could not well ask where +Hodulf was. The helm was a token that told them much. + +“I met your king even now,” he said, “and I offered him peace and +honourable return to Norway with his property if he would give up the +throne that is mine by right. Maybe I was wrong in thinking that he +might do so, but he refused. There were certain matters between us two, +besides that of the crown, which needed settling; and therefore, after +that, I challenged him to fight on these points, that being needful +before they were done with. So we fought, and our feud was ended. +Hodulf is dead, and his courtmen would not live after him while there +was a chance of avenging his fall. That was before the host came up. +Now I offer peace and friendship to all, and I can blame none who have +held to the king who has fallen. It was not to be expected that all +would own me at once. Only those Norsemen who came with Hodulf or have +come hither since must leave the land, and they shall go in honour, +taking their goods with them. Their time is up; that is all.” + +It was a long speech for Havelok, but in it was all that could be said. +Long and closely did the chiefs look at him as he spoke, for none of +them had seen him before. His words were not idly to be set aside +either, and they spoke together in a low voice when he had ended. + +“This is a matter for the whole host to settle,” one said at last. “We +will speak to them, and give you an answer shortly.” + +“Take one of Hodulf’s courtmen with you, that he may tell all of the +fight,” Havelok said: “he need not come back.” + +I gave the man his arms again, for he might as well have them if he +stayed. + +“Thanks, lord,” he said. “Here is one who will tell the truth for +Havelok.” + +Then our host sat down, and we watched the foemen as the news came to +them. We could not hear, of course, for they were a quarter of a mile +away, but if any tumult rose we should be warned in time. They were +very still, however. There was a long talk, and then one chief came +back to us. + +“I am going to ask a strange thing,” he said, “but the men wish to see +Havelok face to face.” + +Now Sigurd said that this was too great a risk, and even Withelm agreed +with him. + +But Havelok answered, “The men are my own men, but they are not sure +that I am the right king. It is plain that I am like my father, and +therefore it is safe for me to go.” + +“That,” said the chief, “is what we told them, and what they wish to +see.” + +“Then,” said Havelok, “I will come. Bid your men sit down, and bid the +horsemen dismount, and I will ride to them with five others. Then can +be no fear on either side.” + +“That will do well,” said Sigurd; and the chief went back, and at once +the host sat down. + +Then Havelok rode to them, and with him went we three and Sigurd and +Biorn. + +There was a murmur of wonder as he came, and it grew louder as he +unhelmed and stayed before them. + +And then one shouted, “Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson!” and at once the +shout was taken up along the line. And that shout grew until the chiefs +joined in it, for it was the voice of the host, which cannot be +gainsaid; and without more delay, one by one the leaders pressed +forward and knelt on one knee to their king, and did homage to him. +Only the Norsemen held back; and presently, when we were talking to the +Danish chiefs in all friendly wise, they drew apart with their men, and +formed up into a close-ranked body that looked dangerous. + +“Surely they do not mean to fight!” said Withelm. + +Then one of them shouted that he must speak to the king, and that +seemed as if they owned him at least, so Havelok went to them. + +“You have heard my terms,” he said, “and I think that they are all that +you could ask. What is amiss?” + +“Your terms are good enough,” the speaker said, “and we know that our +time is come. But we must have surety that the people will not fall on +us, for we are flying, as it were. And we want the body of our king. We +would not have him buried any wise, as if he was a thrall.” + +“He shall be given to you, and as for the rest none shall harm you. +Moreover, for that saying about your king I will add this: that if +there are any of you who hold lands to which there is no Danish heir, +he shall take service with me if he will, and so keep them.” + +So there was no man in all the host who was not content; and that was +the second king-making of Havelok, as it were, for now there was no man +against him. The hosts were disbanded then and there, and we went that +day to Hodulf’s town, and took possession of all that had been in his +hands. Then was rejoicing over all the land, for a king of the old line +was on the throne once more, and his way was full of promise. + + + + +CHAPTER XXII. +KING ALSI’S WELCOME. + + +Now there was one thing that was in the minds of all of us, and that +was the winning of Goldberga’s kingdom for her; but that was a matter +which was not to be thought of yet for a long while. Two years were we +in Denmark, and well loved was Havelok by all, whether one speaks of +the other kings who owned him as Gunnar’s heir at once, or the people +over whom he and Goldberga reigned. But we sent messages to Arngeir and +to Ragnar to say that all was well, and we heard from them in time how +Alsi feared what was to come, and had rather make friends with the +Anglians than offend them. So he had not given out anything that was +against the princess, but had told all how she had wedded the heir of +Denmark, and that she had given up her land to himself, and followed +her husband across the sea. It was not hard for him to feign gladness +in her well-doing; and Berthun counselled Ragnar to let things be thus, +and yet prepare for her return. + +In my own heart was the wish to go back to England always, for there +was my home; and I found that it was the same with my brothers, for +there is that in the English land which makes all who touch it love it. +And there was the mound that held my father, and there were the folk +among whom we had been brought up in the town that we had made; and I +longed to see once more the green marshes and the grey wolds of +Lindsey, and the brown waves of the wide Humber rolling shorewards, +line after line. I tired of the heaths and forests and peat mosses of +this land of my birth. And if that was so to me, it was a yet deeper +longing in the hearts of the brothers who hardly remembered this place; +and after a while we spoke of it more often. + +I do not know if we said much to others, but at last the younger chiefs +began to wonder when the promised time when they should cross the +“swan’s path” for Goldberga should come. Maybe they tired of the long +peace, as a Dane will. But when that talk began, Withelm knew that +things were ripe, and he told Havelok. That was in the third spring of +Havelok’s kingship, when it grew near to the time when men fit out +their ships. + +“This is what I have looked for,” he said; “and now we will delay no +longer, for here am I king indeed, and there is none who will rise +against me. Wonderful it is that men have hailed me thus. And now I +will tell you, brother, that I long for England. If I might take my +friends with me, I do not think that I should care if I never came here +again. It is not my home; and here my Goldberga is not altogether +happy, well as the folk love her.” + +Thereafter he called a great Thing[12] of all the freemen in the land, +and set the matter plainly before them, asking if they minded the words +he spoke when they crowned the queen, and if they were still ready to +follow him to the winning of her crown beyond the sea. + +There was no doubt what the answer would be; and it was said at once +that the sooner the ships were got ready the better. + +“Then,” said Havelok, “who shall mind this land while I am away? It may +be long ere I come back.” + +Now there was a cry that I should be king while Havelok was away, +forsooth! and a poor hand I should have made at the business. But I +said that it was foolishness, and that, moreover, I would go with +Havelok. And when they said that this was modesty on my part, I +answered that I had seen several kings, and that there was but one who +was worth thinking of, and that was my brother; therefore, I would go +on serving him where I could see him. + +“This is what Grim, my father, said to me long ago,” I said—“I was to +mind the old saying, ‘Bare is back without brother behind it;’ and, +therefore, I must see Havelok safe through this.” + +“Why, brother,” says Havelok, laughing, “if that saying must be +remembered—and I at least know it is true—it would make for leaving you +behind me here to see all fair when my back was turned.” + +Then he saw that I was grieved, for I thought for the moment that he +would bid me to stay, and so I should have to do so; but he took my +part. + +“I cannot be without my brothers,” he said. “If I had any word in the +matter—which mainly concerns the folk to be ruled, as it seems to me +(for I do not know of any man who would not uphold me)—I should say +that Sigurd the jarl was the right man, for all know that he is a good +ruler, nor will it be any new thing to submit to him.” + +That pleased all, and the end of it was that Sigurd was chosen to hold +the land for Havelok. + +Then Sigurd sat on the steps of the high place at Havelok’s feet, and +the king said, “I have no need to tell any man here who this is, and +why I think him worthy of the highest honour, for all know him and his +worth as well as I. Mainly by him was the thought of my return kept in +the minds of men, so that when the time came all were ready to hail me, +as you have done. Therefore, as by him I am king, so I make him king +also for me. He shall rule all the land while I am away, and to him +shall all men account as to me. And because it is right that his +kingship should be certain, I give him all his jarldom as a kingdom +from henceforth, only subject to me and my heirs as overlord. King +therefore he is, and none can say that you are ruled by naught but a +jarl.” + +Then Havelok girt on the new king’s sword, and set his own crowned helm +on his head for a moment; and all the Thing hailed him gladly, for he +was the right man without doubt. + +Then Sigurd did homage for his new honour; and after that he rose up, +and grew red and uneasy, as if there was somewhat that he wished to +say, and was half afraid to do so. + +Thereat some friend in the hall said, “You take your kingship worse +than did Radbard himself, as it seems. What is amiss?” + +“Why, I wanted to go on the Viking path with Havelok, and now it seems +that I cannot.” + +Then one shouted, “I never heard of a land going wrong while its king +was away risking his life to get property for his men. There is no man +here who is going to rise against either you or Havelok. And it is only +to send a message to our great overlord to say what we are about, and +he will see that the land is in peace. Nor do I think that any king +would harry Havelok’s land, for he is well loved by all his peers.” + +Wherefore it seemed that Sigurd must go also, and we had to set Biorn +as head man while Sigurd was away; but that would only be for a month +or two. So all things were ordered well, and in a month we set sail +with twenty ships, and in them a matter of fifteen hundred men. + +At first we thought that we would make for Grimsby; but then it seemed +best to land elsewhere, and more to the south, for we would have +messages sent at once to Ragnar to call East Anglia to Havelok’s +banner, and Alsi would have less chance of cutting us off from him. So +we sailed to Saltfleet haven, which lies some twenty-five miles +southward from Grimsby. Raven piloted us in safely, and there were none +to hinder our landing. The town was empty, indeed, when the ships came +into the haven, for all had fled in haste, except a few thralls, for +fear of the Vikings. + +Yet when we sent these thralls to say that Goldberga had come for her +own, the people came back and made us welcome, for her story was in +every mouth; and after that we fared well in Saltfleet, and men began +to gather to us. + +We sent to Arngeir and to Ragnar at once, and next day the Grimsby folk +were with us, but long before any word could come to Norwich, Alsi had +set about gathering a host against us. + +But we had not come to fight him for Lindsey, and our errand was to bid +him give up her own rights to Goldberga. One must be ready with the +strong hand if one expects to find justice from such a man; and Havelok +had thought it possible that if we came here first we should bring him +to reason at once, whereas if we went to Norfolk there would be +fighting with all the host of the Lindsey kingdom before long; while if +he did fight here we might save Goldberga’s land from that trouble, and +maybe have fewer to deal with. + +So a message was to be sent to Alsi at once, bidding him know that +Goldberga had come to ask for her rights, and that he might give them +to her in all honour. Arngeir was to take this, for it did not seem +right that a Dane should do so, and he was one who would be listened +to. I was to go with him, with my courtmen as guard; and we rode to +Lincoln on the fourth day after our coming to Saltfleet. Good it was to +ride over the old land again, and I thought that it had never looked +more fair with the ripening harvest, for when last I had seen it there +was none. The track of the famine was yet on all the villages, for +fewer folk were in them than in the days before the pestilence and the +dearth, but these had enough and to spare. + +And when these poor folk heard from us that Curan and his princess had +come again for what was hers, they took rusty weapons and flint-tipped +arrows and stone hammers from the hiding places in the thatch of their +hovels, and went across the marshlands to where the little hill of +Saltfleet stands above its haven, that they might help the one whom +they had loved as a fisher lad to become a mighty king. + +So we came to Lincoln, and already there was a gathering of thanes and +their men in the town, and they knew on what errand we had come well +enough. But they were courteous, and we were given quarters in the town +at once, that we might see Alsi with the first light in the morning. + +I will not say that we had a quiet night there, for we did not trust +Alsi; but we had no need to fear. In the morning Eglaf came to bid us +to the palace to speak with the king. + +“This is about what I expected, when I heard of the mistake that our +king had made,” he said, “and so far you are in luck. It is not +everyone who is a fisher one day and captain of the courtmen next, as +one might say. I like the look of your men, and I am going to take some +of the credit of that to myself, for a man has to learn before he can +command.” + +“I will not deny your share in the matter,” I answered, laughing, “for +had it not been for my time with you I had been at sea altogether. Now, +shall we have to fight you?” + +He shrugged his broad shoulders. + +“Who knows what is in the mind of our king? I do not, and you know +enough of him by this time to be certain that one cannot guess. He may +be all smiles and rejoicing that his dear niece has come back safely, +or just the other way. He has been very careful how he has dealt with +the Norfolk thanes of late, and what that means I do not know.” + +Then he asked what had become of Griffin, and I told him. I do not +think that he was surprised, for some word of the matter had reached +here by the news that chapmen bring from all parts. + +Now there was no more time for talk, for we came to the hall; and we +went in, Arngeir leading, and the rest of us following two by two. The +hall was pretty full of thanes and their men, and it was just as I had +last seen it. Alsi sat alone on his high seat, and there was no man +with him on the dais. I thought that he looked thinner and anxious. + +Arngeir went up the hall at once, and stood before the king, and +greeted him in the English way, which seemed strange to me after the +two years of Danish customs; and then Alsi bade him tell his errand. + +“I have come from Goldberga of East Anglia, and from Havelok the Dane, +her husband, to say that she has returned to her land, and would ask +that you would give her the throne that you have held for her since the +day that her father made you her guardian. It has been said that she +might ask you to give account of your management of the realm to her; +but that she does not wish to do, being sure that all will be rightly +done in the matter, and she only asks to be set in the place that was +her father’s.” + +So said Arngeir, plainly, and I could see that the thanes thought the +words good. + +And Alsi answered, “Has this matter been put before the Witan of the +East Angles?” + +I suppose that he thought to hear Arngeir say that there had been no +time for so doing at present, but my brother was readier than I should +have been. + +“Doubtless it has,” he said, “for that was your own promise to +Goldberga on her marriage.” + +At that Alsi flushed, and his brows wrinkled. He had said nothing to +the Witan at all, but had waited in hopes that he should hear no more +of his niece, telling the tale that we had heard. + +“I have had no answer from them,” he said at last, for Arngeir was +looking at him in a way that he could not meet. “It was her saying that +she would do this for herself.” + +“Then they do not refuse,” said Arngeir quietly, “nor did I think that +they would do so. It only remains therefore, that you, King Alsi, +should do your part. Then can the queen speak to the Witan, even as she +said, concerning her husband.” + +Now it must have been clear to the king that nothing short of a plain +answer would be taken, and he sat and thought for a while. One could +see that he was planning what to say, as if things had not gone as he +expected. Maybe he hoped to put off the matter by talk of asking the +Witan, and so to gain time, for we had certainly taken him unawares. + +At last he said, “How am I to know that you are here with full power to +speak for Goldberga? For this is a weighty matter.” + +Arngeir held out his hand, and on it was the ring of Orwenna the queen, +which Alsi had last seen here on the high place. + +“There is the token, King Alsi, and it is one which you know well,” he +answered. + +“Ay, I know it,” answered the king with a grin that was not pleasant. + +And then he said, “I will speak with my thanes, and give you word to +carry back in an hour’s time, now that I know you to be a true +messenger.” + +“There should be no reason for waiting so long as that, nor do I think +that the matter of the throne of East Anglia is a question for Lindsey +thanes,” answered Arngeir at once. “All this is between you and the +princess.” + +Thereat one of the thanes rose up and said, “If a kingdom has been +handed over to our king, it is not to be taken again without our having +a good deal to say about it. I do not know, moreover, if we can have a +foreigner over any part of our land.” + +“Goldberga never gave up her right to the kingdom,” Arngeir answered, +“as anyone who was here at the wedding would tell you. And as for +Havelok, her husband, being a foreigner, it seems to me that a Jute who +has been brought up here in Lindsey since he was seven winters old is +less a foreigner than a Briton is to us.” + +None made any answer to that, and I could see that the king was growing +angry at being met thus at every turn. But he began to smile in that +way of his that I had learned to mistrust. + +“That is not altogether courteous to either Goldberga or myself,” he +said, as if he would think the words a jest, seeing that he was half +Welsh. “Give me time, I pray you, to think of this, as I have asked, +and you shall go back with your answer.” + +There was no help for it, and we had to leave the hall in order that +Alsi might say what he had to say to his thanes. And I said to Arngeir +that it seemed that we should have to fight the matter out. + +“Alsi risks losing both kingdoms if he does that,” he answered, “for we +shall take what we choose if we are the victors. The visions that have +been thus right so far say that we shall be so.” + +“I shall be glad if we do come out on the right side,” I said; “but I +have not so much faith in these dream tellings as some. Nor do I think +that it seems altogether fair to fight on a certainty.” + +“When it is a matter of punishing one who does not keep faith, I do not +think that it matters much,” he answered, laughing. “I should like +certainty that he would not get the best of the honest side in that +case.” + +We were outside on the wide green within the square of the Roman walls +at this time, and now from within the hall came the sound of shouts and +cheering which we heard plainly enough. But whether it meant that the +thanes cheered Alsi because he would fight, rather than that they +applauded his justice to his niece, was not to be known as yet. As for +me, I thought that it was hardly likely to be the latter. + +Then came three thanes from the hail with the message, and it was this, +“Alsi bids Havelok go back to his own land and bide content therewith.” + +“What word is there for Goldberga, then?” asked Arngeir. + +“None. She has thrown in her lot with the Dane, and it is he with whom +we will not deal.” + +Then said I, “How was it that she had to throw in her lot with Havelok? +He was Alsi’s own choice for her.” + +“That is not what we have heard,” the spokesman answered. “Now it is +best that you go hence, for you have the answer.” + +“This means fighting for Goldberga’s rights,” said Arngeir, “and I will +tell you that Havelok will not be backward in the matter.” + +“In that case we shall meet again on the battlefield ere long,” +answered the thane. “I will not say that Havelok is in the wrong, and +things might have been better settled. Farewell till then. The Norns +will show who is right.” + +So we went, and I thought, as did Arngeir, that there was some little +feeling among his men that Alsi was wrong. + +Now Alsi set to work to gather forces in earnest, and he went to work +in a way that was all his own: for, saying nothing about Goldberga, he +sent to all his thanes with word that the Vikings had come in force and +invaded the land, led by the son of Gunnar Kirkeban, whose ways were +worse than those of his father, for he spared none, whereas Kirkeban +harried but the Welsh Christian folk. He prayed them therefore to +hasten, that this scourge might be driven back to the sea whence he +came. And that brought men to him fast, for no Englishman can bear that +an invader shall set foot on his shore, be he who he may. Few knew who +the wife of Havelok was at that time, but I do not know that it would +have made so much difference if they had. None thought that into +England had come the fair princess who was so well loved. + +Sorely troubled was Goldberga when she heard this answer, but it was +all that the rest of us looked for. And the next question was how best +to meet the false king. + +In the end we did a thing that may seem to some to have been rash +altogether, but it was our wish to compel Alsi to fight before his +force was great enough to crush us. It might be long before Ragnar +could raise a host and join us, for there was always a chance that he +might have trouble in getting the Norfolk thanes to come to his +standard for a march on Lindsey. If we had gone to Norfolk at once +there would have been no fear of that kind, but the fighting might have +been more bitter and longer drawn out. + +We sent the fleet southward into the Wash, that it might wait for us at +the port of the Fossdyke, on what men call the Frieston shore; and then +we left Saltfleet and marched across country to the wolds, and +southward and westward along them, that we might draw Alsi from +Lincoln. And all the way men joined us for the sake of Curan, whom they +knew, and of Goldberga, of whom they had heard, so that in numbers at +least our host was a great one. Ragged it might be, as one may say, +with the wild marshmen, who had no sort of training and no chiefs to +keep them in hand; but I knew that no host Alsi could get together had +any such trained force in it as we had in the fifteen hundred Vikings, +for they had seen many fights, and the ways of the sea teach men to +hold together and to obey orders at once and without hesitating. + +So we went until we came to Tetford, above Horncastle town; and there +is a great camp on a hilltop, made by the British, no doubt, in the +days when they fought with Rome. There we stayed, for Alsi was upon us. +We saw the fires of his camp in the village and on the hillsides across +the valley, but a mile or two from us that night; and it seemed that +his host was greater than ours, as we thought it would be, but not so +much so as to cause dread of the battle that was to come. + +Now there were two men who came to us that night, and we thought that +they had brought some message from Alsi at first. But all that they +wanted was to join Havelok, and we were glad of them. They were those +two seconds of Griffin’s, Cadwal and the other, whose name was Idrys, +and with them was David the priest, who had fled to us. + +“We know that Havelok is one who is worth fighting for,” they said, +“for we have proved it already. We are not Alsi’s men, and our fathers +fought for his mother’s Welsh kin against the English long ago. Let us +fight for the rights of Goldberga, at least.” + +Havelok welcomed them in all friendliness, though he asked them if they +had no grudge against him for the slaying of Griffin. + +“As to that,” they said, “after the duel we think that he deserved all +that has befallen him. We were ashamed to be his seconds.” + +Now these two took in hand to lead the marshmen, and set to work with +them at once, for they were ready to follow them as known thanes of the +British. And that was something gained. + +We slept on our arms that night, and all night long David woke and +prayed for our success, and I think that his prayers were not lost. + + + + +CHAPTER XXIII. +BY TETFORD STREAM. + + +In the early morning Alsi set his men in order in the valley, and +seemed to wait for us to come down to him, for it was of no use to try +to take the strong camp which sheltered us. And so, after council held, +we did not keep him waiting, but left the hill and marched on him. We +had the camp to fall back on if things went the wrong way, and beyond +that the road to the sea and the ships was open, with a chance of +meeting Ragnar on the way, moreover. + +Very long and deep seemed the line as we neared it, and it was formed +on the banks of a stream that runs down the valley, so that we must +cross the water to attack. But the stream was shallow now with the +August heat, and it was not much sunk between its banks. + +When he saw that, Sigurd, who was a man of many fights, said that we +had better send the marshmen round to fall on the wings of the foe, +while we went straight for the centre of the line in the wedge +formation that the Viking loves. For so we should have no trouble in +crossing the stream, and should cut the force against us in two. + +So the two Welsh thanes led their wild levies out on either side of us +Danes, who were in the centre, and then we formed the wedge. Havelok +himself would have gone first of all at its point: but that we would +not suffer, for if he fell the battle was lost at its beginning. + +“Nay,” he said, “for we fight for Goldberga.” + +“And what would she say were we to set you foremost of us all?” asked +Withelm. “Little love were there to either of you in that. You are the +heart of the host, and one shields that although it gives strength to +all the hands which obey it.” + +So Withelm and Arngeir and I went foremost, and behind us came the +courtmen, and in the midst of their shield wall was Havelok, with Raven +and the banner at his side. After them, rank on rank and with +close-locked shields, was such a force as had not been seen in Lindsey +for many a long day. Alsi’s men grew very silent as they saw us come +on, until we reached, through a storm of arrows that could not stay us, +the bank of the stream, and then they raised a war song that roared and +thundered among the hills as though the tide was coming up the valley +in one great wave. But we saved our breath until the first of us were +on the banks of the stream, and then I shouted, and with a great shout +of “Ahoy!” in answer, we charged through the stream and up the far +bank, where Alsi’s spearmen waited for us. + +They crowded together as they saw how narrow our front was, and there +was a hedge of steel before us three brothers; but the spear is not the +weapon to use if one would check the onrush of the Northman’s wedge, +and shield and axe between them dashed and hewed a way to the men who +got to their swords too late, and then we were in the midst of Alsi’s +line, with the gap that we had made widening behind us with each step +that we took forward. + +Now it was sheer hewing at the mass who crowded on us; and I mind how +we seemed to fight in silence, although the battle cries were +unceasing, and waxed ever louder; for it was as when one walks by the +shore and thinks not at all of the noise of breakers that never ends. +Now and then there was one shout that was new, and it seemed to be the +only voice. Most of all, the noise grew on the wings where the savage +Welsh fell on their masters and ancient foes in wild tumult. + +We tried to cut our way to Alsi, for we could see him as he sat on his +horse—the only mounted man in all the hosts; but we could not reach +him. And presently the time came when we who were foremost must let +fresh men take our places. Sigurd stepped to my side, and Withelm fell +back, and another took the place of Arngeir, and then my turn came, and +we went slowly from the front to where the hollow centre of the wedge +gave us rest. Only a few arrows fell there now and then; but the time +for using bows was past, seeing that we were hand to hand with all the +Lindsey host. And then I saw that Sigurd had done what we had failed +in, for he had reached the shield wall that was round the king himself. +And for a moment I was savage that the chance came to him so soon after +I had left the fighting line; but then I minded that Eglaf, my friend, +would be there, and I was glad that I need not cross swords with him +after all. I had thought of that happening before the fight began, but +in the turmoil of hottest struggle I had forgotten it. + +Now Sigurd was before the thick mass of the housecarls, and hand to +hand with them; and then he was among them, and he leapt at the bridle +of Alsi’s horse and grasped it. I saw the king’s sword flash down on +his helm, and he reeled under the stroke, but without letting go of the +rein. Then the housecarls made a rush, and bore back our men, and the +horse reared suddenly. There was a wild shout, and the war saddle was +empty; and again our men surged forward, so that I could not see what +had happened. + +But now our Welshmen had been beaten back from the wings—not easily, +but for want of training—and they were forced back across the brook, +and there held our bank well, giving way no step further. The water +kept them in an even front, against their will, as it were; and Alsi’s +men charged them in vain, knee deep in the stream that ran red. But +that let loose the men who had been held back from us; and now we were +overborne by numbers, and we began to go back. That was the worst part +of the whole fight, and the hardest hour of all the battle, as may be +supposed, for the wedge grew closer, as it was forced together by sheer +weight. None ever broke into it. + +Presently our rear was on the water’s edge, and it seemed likely that +in crossing there might be a breaking of the line; and when he saw +that, Havelok called to me, and he went to the front with the courtmen +round him. It was good to hear the cheers of our men as they saw the +dancing banner above the fight, and beneath it, in the bright sun, the +gold-circled helm of their king. The Lindseymen drew back a foot’s pace +as they saw the giant who came on them, and I heard some call that this +was Curan of Grimsby, as if in wonder. Then we had to fight hard, and +Sigurd fell back past me, with a wound on his shoulder where Alsi’s +sword had glanced from the helm. No life had been left to Sigurd had a +better hand wielded the weapon; but he was not badly hurt. I could not +see Alsi anywhere, nor Eglaf. + +Steadily the numbers drove us back, though before Havelok was always a +space into which men hardly dared to come. The wedge was pushed away +from us, and we had to fall back with it, until we crossed the stream; +and there Sigurd swung the massed men into line, and then came the +first pause in the fight. The two hosts stood, with the narrow water +between them, and glared on each other, silent now. And then the bowmen +began to get to work from either side, until the arrows were all gone. + +Now Havelok called to the foe, and they were silent while he spoke to +them. + +“Is Alsi yet alive?” he said; “for if not, I have no war with his men. +If he is, let me speak with him.” + +None answered for a while, and the men looked at each other as if they +knew not if the man they were fighting for lived or not. + +Then one came forward and said, “Alsi lives, and we have not done with +you yet. Get you back to your home beyond the sea!” + +And then they charged us again; but the water was a better front for us +than it had been for them, and across it they could not win. We drove +them back once and twice; and again came a time when both sides were +wearied and must needs rest. + +So it went on until night fell. We never stirred from that water’s +edge, and the stream was choked with valiant English and hardy Danes; +and yet the attacks came with the shout of “Out! out!” and the answer +from us of “Havelok, ahoy!” + +At last one who seemed a great chief came and cried a truce, for night +was falling; and he said that if Havelok would claim no advantage +therefrom, the men of Lindsey would get back from the field, and leave +it free for us to take our fallen. + +“But I must have your word that with the end of that task you go back +to the place you now hold, that we may begin afresh, if it seems good +to us, in the morning.” + +Then said Havelok, “That is well spoken, and I cannot but agree. Who +are you, however, for I must know that this is said with authority?” + +“I am the Earl of Chester,” he answered. “Alsi has set the leading of +the host in my hands, for he is hurt somewhat.” + +“I did not think that Mercians would have troubled to fight to uphold +Alsi of Lindsey in his ways with his niece,” Havelok said. + +“What is that?” said the earl. “Hither came I for love of fighting, +maybe, in the first place; and next to drive out certain Vikings. I +know naught of the business of which you speak.” + +“Then,” said I, “go and ask Eglaf, the captain of the housecarls, for +he knows all about it. We are no raiding Danes, but those who fight for +Goldberga of East Anglia.” + +At that a hum of voices went down the English line, and this earl bit +his lip in doubt. + +“Well,” he said, “that is Alsi’s affair, and I will speak to him. We +have had a good fight, and I will not say that either of us has the +best of it. Shall it be as I have said?” + +“Ay,” answered Havelok; and the earl drew off his men for half a mile, +and in the gathering dusk we crossed the brook, and went on our errand +across the field. It was not hard to find our men, for they lay in a +great wedge as we had fought. There had been no straggling from that +array, and no break had been made in its lines. Alsi had lost more than +we, for his men had beaten against that steel wall in vain, and the +arms of the Northman are better than those of any other nation. + +We took the wounded back to the camp, and there Goldberga and the wives +of our English thanes tended them; and as we gathered up the slain the +Lindsey men were among us at the same work, and we spoke to them as if +naught was amiss between us, nor any fight to begin again in the +morning. And then we learned how few knew what we had come for. It was +with them as with the Earl of Chester. They had no knowledge of +Goldberga’s homecoming, and least of all thought that at the back of +the trouble were the wiles of Alsi. It was two years ago that Goldberga +had gone, and her wedding had seemed to end her story. Now the men +heard and wondered; and it is said that very many left Alsi that night +and went home, angry with him for his falsehood. + +Now when all was done we sought rest, and weary we were. I will say for +myself that I did not feel like fighting next morning at all, for I was +tired out, and the one or two wounds that I had were getting sorely +stiff. Raven was much in the same case, and grumbled, sailor-wise, at +the weight of the banner and aught else that came uppermost in his +mind. Yet I knew that he would be the first to go forward again when +the time came. + +The host slept on their arms along the bank of the stream through the +hot night, and the banner was pitched in their midst. Soon the moon +rose, and only the footsteps of the sentries along our front went up +and down, while across the water was the same silence; for both hosts +were wearied out, and each had learned that the other were true men, +and there was no mistrust on either side. When the light came once more +we should fight to prove who were the best men at arms, and with no +hatred between us. + +Presently the mists crept up from the stream and wreathed the sleepers +on either bank with white, swaying clouds, and I mind that the last +thought I had before I closed my eyes was that my armour would be +rusted by the clinging damp—as if it were not war-stained from helm to +deerskin shoe already with stains that needed more cleansing than any +rust. + +Then I waked suddenly, for someone went past me, and I sat up to see +who it might be. The moon was very bright and high now, but the figure +that I saw wading in the white mist was shadowy, and I could not tell +who it was. And then another and yet another figure came from the rear +of our line, and passed among the sleeping ranks, and joined the first +noiselessly; and after a little while many came, hurrying, and they +formed up on the bank of the stream into the mighty wedge. And I feared +greatly, for not one of the sleepers stirred as the warriors went among +us, and I had looked on the faces of those who passed me, and I knew +that they were the dead whom I had seen the men gather even now and lay +in their last rank beyond our line. + +Then I saw that on the far bank was gathered another host, and that was +of Alsi’s men, and among them I knew the forms of some who had fallen +in the first onset when I led the charge. + +I tried to put forth my hand to wake Withelm, but I could not stir, and +when I would have spoken, I could frame no word, so that alone in all +the host I saw the slain men fight their battle over again, step by +step. The wedge of the Northmen won to the far shore as we had won—as +they had won in life but a few hours ago—and into the line of foemen +they cut their way, and on the far side of the stream they stayed and +fought, as it had been in the battle. Yet though one could see that the +men shouted and cried, there was no sound at all, and among the wildest +turmoil walked the sentries of Alsi’s host unconcerned and unknowing. +And to me they seemed to be the ghosts, and the phantom strife that +which was real. + +Then I was ware of a stranger thing yet than all I had seen so far, for +on the field were more than those whom I knew. There stood watching on +either side of the battle two other ghostly hosts, taking no part in +the struggle, but watching it as we had watched from our place when we +fell back into the rear to rest, pointing and seeming to cheer strokes +that were good and deeds that were valiant. And I knew that these were +men who had fought and died on this same field in older days, for on +one side were the white-clad Britons, and on the other the stern, +dark-faced Romans, steel and bronze from head to foot. + +So the battle went onward to where we had won and had been pressed +back; and then, little by little, the hosts faded away, and with them +went the watchers, and surely across the field went the quick gallop of +no earthly steeds, the passing to Odin of the choosers of the slain, +the Valkyries. + +Then came across the brook to me one through the mist, and the sentries +paid no heed to him, and he came to my side and spoke to me. It was +Cadwal, the Welsh thane, and his breast was gashed so that I thought +that he could not have lived. + +“Ay, I am dead,” he said, “as men count death, and yet I would have +part in victory over Alsi, for the sake of Havelok and of Goldberga. +Stay up my body on the morrow, that I may seem to fight at least, that +I may bide in the ranks once more in the day of victory. Little victory +have the British seen since Hengist came. Say that you will do this.” + +Then he looked wistfully at me, and I gave him some token of assent; +and at that came back all the shadows of our men, and seemed to pray +the same. And then was a stir of feet near me, and a shadow across the +trampled grass, and instead of the dead the voice of Havelok spoke +softly to me, and with him was Goldberga, clad in her mail. And I +thought that they and I were slain also, and I cried to this one who +seemed to be one of Odin’s maidens that I too would fain be stayed up +with Cadwal and the rest, that I might have part in victory. + +Then Goldberga stooped to me, and laid her soft hand on my forehead, +and took off my helm, so that the air came to me, and thereat I woke +altogether. + +“Brother,” she said, “you are restless and sorely wounded, as it seems. +It is not good that you should lie in this mist.” + +At her voice the others woke, and for a while she talked with us in a +low tone, cheering us. And presently she asked of that strange request +that I had made to her. + +I told her, for it was a message that should not be kept back, thus +given; and when he heard it, Withelm sighed a little, and said, “Would +that we had all those who have fallen. Yet if it is as they have asked +our brother, our host will seem as strong as before we joined battle in +the morning. Leave this to me, brother, for it may be done.” + +Then he rose up and went softly to where Idrys, the friend of Cadwal, +lay, and spoke long with him. It was true that Cadwal was slain, though +I had not yet heard of it until he told me himself thus. + +Then I slept heavily, while the others talked for a while. It is a hard +place at a wedge tip when Englishmen are against one; and I am not much +use in a council. Presently they would wake me if my word was wanted. + +But it was not needed, for the sunlight woke me. There was a growing +stir in our lines and across the water also, and I looked round. The +mists were yet dense, for there was not enough breeze to stir the heavy +folds of the banner, and Raven slept still with his arm round its +staff. Havelok was not here now, and I thought that he had gone to the +camp with Goldberga, and would be back shortly. + +Then I saw that our rear rank was already formed up, as I thought, and +that is not quite the order of things, as a rule, and it seemed far off +from the stream. I thought that they should have asked me about this, +for there were some of my courtmen in that line. + +And then I saw that in the line was no movement, and no flash of arms, +as when one man speaks to another, turning a little. And before that +line stood the form of a chief who leant on his broad spear, motionless +and seeming watchful. I knew him at once, and it was Cadwal, and those +he commanded were the dead. That was even to me an awesome sight, for +in the mists they seemed ready and waiting for the word that would +never come to their ears, resting on the spears that they could use no +more. It had been done by the marshmen in the dark hours of the +morning, and from across the stream I saw Alsi’s men staring at the new +force that they thought had come to help us. There were men enough +moving along our bank with food to us to prevent them seeing that this +line stirred not at all. + +There was a scald who came with us from Denmark, and now with the full +rising of the sun he took his harp and went along the stream bank +singing the song of Dunheidi fight and so sweet was his voice, and so +strong, that even Alsi’s men gathered to hearken to him. His name was +Heidrek, and he has set all that he saw with Havelok into a saga; but +we, here, mostly remember the brave waking that he gave us that +morning. It was wonderful how the bright song cheered us. One saw that +the stiffened limbs shook themselves into litheness once more, and the +listless faces brightened, and into the hearts that were heavy came new +hope, and that was the song’s work. + +Now men began to jest with their foes across the stream, and those who +had Danish loaves threw them across in exchange for English, that they +might have somewhat to talk of. Ours were rye, and theirs of barley; +but it was not a fair change after ours had been so long a voyage. + +It was not long before our war horns sounded for the mustering, and men +ran to their arms. The Lindsey host drew back from the talk with our +men at the same time, and, without waiting for word from their leaders, +began to get in line along the stream, where they had been when we +halted last night. But we had no thought of falling on them until we +had had some parley with the king or the Earl of Chester. And now it +was plain that with the grim rearguard behind us we outnumbered the men +of Alsi who were left. + +Now came from the village in rear of the foe a little company, in the +midst of which was one horseman, and that was the king himself. His arm +was slung to his breast, and he sat his horse weakly, so that it was +true enough that he had been hurt. With him were the earl and Eglaf, +and the housecarls, and I sent one to fetch Havelok quickly, that there +might be no delay in the words that were to be said. + +Alsi rode to the water’s edge and looked out over our host, and his +white face became whiter, and his thin lips twitched as he saw that our +line was no weaker than it had seemed when first he saw it. He spoke to +the earl, and he too counted the odds before him, and he smiled a +little to himself. He had not much to say to Alsi. + +Then broke out a thunderous cheer from all our men, for with Havelok +and Sigurd at her horse’s rein, and with Withelm’s courtmen of her own +guard behind her, came Goldberga the queen to speak with the man who +had broken his trust. She had on her mail, as on the day when we ended +Hodulf; and she rode to the centre of our line, and there stayed, with +a flush on her cheek that the wild shouts of our men had called there. + +Then I heard the name of “Goldberga, Goldberga!” run down the English +line, and I saw Alsi shrink back into himself, as it were; and then +some Lincoln men close to him began to grow restless, and all at once +they lifted their helms and cheered also, and that cheer was taken up +by all the host, as it seemed, until the ring of hills seemed alive +with voices. And with that Alsi half turned his horse to fly. + +Yet his men did not mean to leave him. It was but the hailing of the +lady whom they knew, and her coming thus was more than the simple +warriors had wit or mind to fathom. But now Goldberga held up her hand, +and the cries ceased, and silence came. Then she lifted her voice, +clear as a silver bell, and said, “It seems strange to me that English +folk should be fighting against me and my husband’s men who have +brought me home. I would know the meaning of this, King Alsi, for it +would seem that your oath to my father is badly kept. Maybe I have +thought that the people would not have me in his place; but their voice +does not ring in those shouts, for which I thank them with all my +heart, as if they hated me. Now, therefore, I myself ask that my +guardian will give up to me that which is my own.” + +We held our peace, but a hum of talk went all through the English +ranks. The Earl of Chester sat down on the bank, and set his sword +across his knees, and began to tie the peace strings round the hilt, in +token that he was going to fight no more. Now and then he looked at +Goldberga, and smiled at her earnest face. But Alsi made no sign of +answer. + +Then the queen spoke again to him. + +“There must be some reason why you have thus set a host in arms against +me,” she said, “and what that may be I would know.” + +Then, as Alsi answered not at all, the earl spoke frankly. + +“We were told that we had to drive out the Vikings, and I must say that +they do not go easily. But it was not told us that they came here to +right a wrong, else had I not fought.” + +Many called out in the same words, and then sat down as the earl had +done. + +And at last Alsi spoke for himself. + +“We do not fight against you, my niece, but against the Danes. We +cannot have them in the country.” + +“They do not mean to bide here, but they will not go before my throne +is given to me. Never came a foreign host into a land in more friendly +wise than this of mine.” + +At that Alsi’s face seemed to clear, and his forced smile came to him. +He looked round on the thanes who were nearest him, and coughed, and +then answered, “Here has been some mistake, my niece, and it has cost +many good lives. If it is even as you say, get you to your land of +Anglia, and there shall be peace. I myself will send word to Ragnar +that he shall hail you as queen.” + +Then up spoke a new voice, and it was one that I knew well. + +“No need to do that, lord king,” said Berthun the cook. “Here have I +come posthaste, and riding day and night, to say that Ragnar is but a +day’s march from here, that he and all Norfolk may see that their queen +comes to her own.” + +Then Alsi’s face grew ashy pale, and without another word he swung his +horse round and went his way. I saw him reel in the saddle before he +had gone far, and Eglaf set his arm round him and stayed him up. After +him Goldberga looked wistfully, for she was forgiving, and had fain +that he had spoken one word of sorrow. But none else heeded him, for +now the thanes, led by the earl himself, came thronging across the +water, that they might ask forgiveness for even seeming to withstand +Goldberga. And on both sides the men set down their arms, and began to +pile mighty fires, that the peace made should not want its handfasting +feast. + +For the fair princess had won her own, and there was naught but +gladness. + + + + +CHAPTER XXIV. +PEACE, AND FAREWELL. + + +Now there was feasting enough, and somewhere they found at a thane’s +house a great tent, and they set that up, so that Havelok and Goldberga +might have their own court round them, as it were. Gladly did Berthun +rid himself of war gear and take to his old trade again. I suppose that +the little Tetford valley had never heard the like sounds of rejoicing +before. + +Near midnight a man came to me and said that a message had come to me +from the other side, and I rose from the board and went out, to find +Eglaf waiting for me in the moonlight. He was armed, and his face was +wan and tired. + +“Come apart, friend,” he said; “I have a message from the king.” + +“To me?” + +“No, to Havelok. But you must hear it first, and then tell him as you +will.” + +We walked away from the tent and across the hillside for some way, and +then he said without more words, “This is the message that Alsi sends +to Havelok, whose name was Curan. ‘Forgive the things that are past, +for many there are that need forgiving. I have no heir, and it is for +myself that I have schemed amiss. In Lincoln town lies a great +treasure, of which Eglaf and I alone know. Give it, I pray you, to your +Danes, that they may harm the land not at all, and so shall I ward off +some of the evil that might come through me even yet. I think that, +after me, you shall be king.’” + +“That is wise of Alsi; but is there no word for Goldberga?” + +“Ay, but not by my mouth. I fetched David the priest two hours ago, and +he bears those messages.” + +“Is there yet more to say?” I asked, for it seemed to me that there +was. + +“There is,” he answered. “Alsi is dead.” + +So there was an end of all his schemings, and I will say no more of +them. It was Eglaf’s thought that it was not so much his hurts that had +killed the king, but a broken heart because of this failure. For the +second time now I knew that it is true that “old sin makes new shame.” + +Now how we told Havelok this, and how Goldberga was somewhat comforted +by the words that David the priest brought her from her uncle, there is +no need to say. But when the news was known in all the host of Lindsey, +there was a great gathering of all in the wide meadow, and we sat in +the camp and wondered what end should be to the talk. Ragnar had come; +but his host was now no great one, for we had sent word to him of the +peace, and there was a great welcome for him and his men. + +The Lindsey thanes did not talk long, and presently some half dozen of +the best of them came to us, and said that with one accord the +gathering would ask that Havelok and Goldberga should reign over them. + +“We will answer for all in the land,” they said. “If there are other +thanes who should have had a word in the matter, they are not here +because, knowing more than we, they would not fight for Alsi in this +quarrel. If there is any other man to be thought of, he cannot go +against the word of the host.” + +“I have my kingdom in Denmark,” said Havelok, “and my wife has hers in +Anglia. How should we take this? See, here is Ragnar of Norwich; he is +worthy to be king, if any. Here, too, is the Earl of Chester, who led +you. It will be well to set these two names before the host.” + +“The host will have none but Havelok and Goldberga,” they said. + +So the long-ago visions came to pass, and in a few days more we were +feasting in the old hall at Lincoln. But before we left the valley of +the battle we laid in mound in all honour those who had fallen. Seven +great mounds we made, at which men wonder and will wonder while they +stand at Tetford. For well fought the Danes of Goldberga, and well +fought the Lindseymen on that day. Yet I think that those who would +fain have lived to see the victory had their share in it, as they stood +in their grim and silent ranks behind us. + +Then was a new crowning of those two, and messages to the overlord of +Lindsey, sent by the thanes, to say that all was settled on the old +lines of peaceful tribute to be paid; and then, when word and presents +came back from him, Goldberga rose up on the high place where she had +been so strangely wedded, and looked down at the joyous faces of her +nobles at the long tables. + +“When I was crowned in Denmark,” she said, “there was a promise made +me, that when this day came to me in Norfolk I might ask one boon of +all who upheld me. I do not know if I may ask it here and now, for the +promise was made by my husband’s people. Yet it is a matter that is +dear to my heart that I shall seek from you all, if I may.” + +Then all the hall rang with voices that bade her ask what she would; +and she bowed and flushed red, and hesitated a little. Then she took +heart and spoke. + +“It is but this,” she said. “Let the poor Christian folk bide in peace; +and if teachers come from the south or from the north presently who +will speak of that faith, bear with them, I pray you, for they work no +harm indeed.” + +Almost was she weeping as she said this, and her white hands were +clasped tightly before her. But she looked bravely at the thanes, and +waited for the answer, though I think that she feared what it would be. + +But an old thane rose up in his place, smiling, and he answered, “If +you had commanded us this, my queen, it would have been done. The +Christian folk, if there are any, shall have no hurt. I think that we +had forgotten the old days of trouble with them. Yet I hear that in +Kent the new faith, as it seems to us, is being taught, and that the +king looks on it with favour. It may be that here it will come also. +For your sake I will listen if a teacher comes to me.” + +The thanes thought little of this boon, and they all answered that it +was freely granted. But they said that it was no boon to give, and bade +her ask somewhat that was better. + +“Why then,” she said, “if I must ask more, think no more of me as queen +save as that I am the wife of the king. Havelok is your ruler in good +sooth.” + +That pleased them all well, and they laughed and wished that all had +wives who had no mind to rule. + +“Here is word that is going home to my wife,” said one to his +neighbour. “If the queen sets the fashion of obedience, it behoves all +good wives to follow her leading.” + +“Maybe I would let some other than yourself tell the lady that,” +answered the other thane with a great laugh, for he knew that household +and its ruler. + +So Goldberga had her will, and then began the long years of peace and +happiness to the kingdoms of which all men know. Wherefore I think that +my story is done. What I have told is halting maybe, and rough, but it +is true. And Goldberga, my sister, says that it is good. Which is all +the praise that I need. + + +So far went Radbard, my friend, and then he would tell no more. So it +is left to me, Wislac the priest, who have written for him, to finish. +He says that everyone knows the rest, and so they do just now. But in +the years to come, when this story is read, men will want to know more. +So it is fit that I should end the story, telling things that I myself +know to be true also. + +Sigurd’s host went back in the autumn, rich with the treasure of Alsi +the king; and from that time forward no Danish host ever sought our +shores. Wars enough have been in England here, but they have not harmed +us. No host has been suffered to cross the borders of Lindsey or East +Anglia, save in peace, and in the wars of Penda of Mercia Havelok has +taken no part. Yet he has had to fight to hold his own more than once, +but always with victory, for always the prayers of the few Christians +have been with him. + +They set Earl Ragnar to hold the southern kingdom for Havelok and his +wife; and presently, when he was left a widower, he wedded the youngest +daughter of Grim, Havelok’s foster father. Eglaf was captain of the +Lincoln courtmen or housecarls, whichever the right name may be among +those who speak of them. One name is Danish and the other English, but +they mean the same. As for my good friend Radbard, he was high sheriff +before long, and that he is yet. He wedded Ragnar’s sister the year +that Havelok was crowned in Norwich, which was the next year after the +crowning at Lincoln. + +Raven went back to the sea, and he will now be in Denmark or else on +the Viking path with Sigurd, for that is what he best loves. Arngeir +bides at Grimsby, high in honour with all, and the port and town grow +greater and more prosperous year by year. Wise was Grim when he chose +to stay in the place where he had chanced to come, if it were not more +than chance that brought him. I suppose that for all time the ships +that are from Grimsby will be free from all dues in the ports that are +Havelok’s in the Danish land. Witlaf, the good old thane, bides in his +place yet, and he rejoices ever that he had a hand in bringing Havelok +up. Nor does our king forget that. + +Indeed, I think that he forgets naught but ill done toward him. Never +is a man who has done one little thing for him overlooked, if he is met +by our king after many years, and that is a royal gift indeed. + +I would that all married folk were as are this royal couple of ours. +Never are they happy apart, and never has a word gone awry between +them. If one speaks of Havelok, one must needs think of Goldberga; and +if one says a word of the queen, one means the king also. Happy in +their people and in their wondrous fair children are they, and that is +all that can be wished for them. + +There was one thing wanting for long years, that I and Withelm ever +longed for for Havelok—a thing for which Goldberga prayed ever. I came +to them from Queen Bertha in Kent, when good old David died; and at +that time Havelok was not a Christian, but surely the most Christian +heathen that ever was. I knew that he must come into the faith at some +time; and I, at least, could not find it in my heart to blame him +altogether for holding to the Asir whom his fathers worshipped. It was +in sheer honesty and singleness of heart that he did so, and I had +never skill enough to show him the right. But Withelm, who has long +been a priest of the faith, and shall surely be our bishop ere long, +had more to do with his conversion than any other. + +Yet it did not come until the days when Paulinus came from York and +preached with the fire of the missionary to us all. And then we saw the +mighty warrior go down to the water in the white robe of the +catechumen, and come therefrom with his face shining with a new and +wondrous light. + +Then he founded a monastery at Grimsby, that there the men of the +marsh, who had been kind to him in the old days, might find teachers in +all that was good; and there it will surely be after many a long year, +until there is need for its work no more, if such a time ever comes. + +So the land grows Christian fast, and good will be its folk if they +follow the way of king and queen and their brothers. + +Now have I finished also, and this is farewell. Look you, husbands and +wives, that you may be said to be like Havelok and Goldberga; and see, +brothers, that you mind the words that Grim spoke to his sons, and +which they heeded so well— + +“Bare is back without brother behind it.” And that is a true word, +though it was a heathen who spoke it. + +THE END. + + + + + [1] I have to thank the Mayor of Grimsby for most kindly furnishing me + with an impression of this ancient seal. + + [2] Now Nishni-Novgorod, from time immemorial the great meetingplace + of north and south, east and west. + + [3] The _garth_ was the fenced and stockaded enclosure round a + northern homestead. + + [4] The _seax_ was the heavy, curved dagger carried by men of all + ranks. + + [5] The northern sea god and goddess. + + [6] Men drowned at sea were thought to go to the halls of Pan and + Aegir. Ran is represented as fishing for heroes in time of storm. + + [7] The Norns were the Fates of the northern mythology. + + [8] The “Witanagemot,” the representative assembly for the kingdom, + whence our Parliament sprang. + + [9] The greatest term of reproach for a coward. + + [10] The gold ring kept in the Temple of the Asir, on which all oaths + must be sworn. + + [11] The sanctuary of the Asir. Thorsway and Withern in Lincolnshire + both preserve the name in the last and first syllable respectively, + both meaning “Thor’s sanctuary.” + + [12] The northern equivalent of the Saxon “Folkmote,” or general + assembly of the people. + + + + +*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK HAVELOK THE DANE *** + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will +be renamed. + +Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright +law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works, +so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the +United States without permission and without paying copyright +royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part +of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project +Gutenberg™ electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG™ +concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark, +and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following +the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use +of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for +copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very +easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation +of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project +Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away--you may +do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected +by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark +license, especially commercial redistribution. + +START: FULL LICENSE + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase “Project +Gutenberg”), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full +Project Gutenberg™ License available with this file or online at +www.gutenberg.org/license. + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project +Gutenberg™ electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg™ +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or +destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works in your +possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a +Project Gutenberg™ electronic work and you do not agree to be bound +by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the +person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph +1.E.8. + +1.B. “Project Gutenberg” is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg™ electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg™ electronic works if you follow the terms of this +agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg™ +electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (“the +Foundation” or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection +of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works. Nearly all the individual +works in the collection are in the public domain in the United +States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the +United States and you are located in the United States, we do not +claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing, +displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as +all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope +that you will support the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting +free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg™ +works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the +Project Gutenberg™ name associated with the work. You can easily +comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the +same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg™ License when +you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are +in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, +check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this +agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, +distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any +other Project Gutenberg™ work. The Foundation makes no +representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any +country other than the United States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other +immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg™ License must appear +prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg™ work (any work +on which the phrase “Project Gutenberg” appears, or with which the +phrase “Project Gutenberg” is associated) is accessed, displayed, +performed, viewed, copied or distributed: + + This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and + most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no + restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it + under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this + eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the + United States, you will have to check the laws of the country where + you are located before using this eBook. + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is +derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not +contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the +copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in +the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are +redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase “Project +Gutenberg” associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply +either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or +obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg™ +trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any +additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms +will be linked to the Project Gutenberg™ License for all works +posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the +beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg™ +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg™. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg™ License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including +any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access +to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg™ work in a format +other than “Plain Vanilla ASCII” or other format used in the official +version posted on the official Project Gutenberg™ website +(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense +to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means +of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original “Plain +Vanilla ASCII” or other form. Any alternate format must include the +full Project Gutenberg™ License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg™ works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg™ electronic works +provided that: + +• You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg™ works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed + to the owner of the Project Gutenberg™ trademark, but he has + agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project + Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid + within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are + legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty + payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project + Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in + Section 4, “Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg + Literary Archive Foundation.” + +• You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg™ + License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all + copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue + all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg™ + works. + +• You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of + any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of + receipt of the work. + +• You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg™ works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project +Gutenberg™ electronic work or group of works on different terms than +are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing +from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of +the Project Gutenberg™ trademark. Contact the Foundation as set +forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project +Gutenberg™ collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg™ +electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may +contain “Defects,” such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate +or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other +intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or +other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or +cannot be read by your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the “Right +of Replacement or Refund” described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg™ trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg™ electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium +with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you +with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in +lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person +or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second +opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If +the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing +without further opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you “AS-IS”, WITH NO +OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT +LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of +damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement +violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the +agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or +limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or +unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the +remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works in +accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the +production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg™ +electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, +including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of +the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this +or any Project Gutenberg™ work, (b) alteration, modification, or +additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg™ work, and (c) any +Defect you cause. + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg™ + +Project Gutenberg™ is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of +computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It +exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations +from people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg™'s +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg™ collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg™ and future +generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see +Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at +www.gutenberg.org + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by +U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, +Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up +to date contact information can be found at the Foundation's website +and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg™ depends upon and cannot survive without +widespread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND +DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular +state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To +donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg™ electronic works + +Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project +Gutenberg™ concept of a library of electronic works that could be +freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and +distributed Project Gutenberg™ eBooks with only a loose network of +volunteer support. + +Project Gutenberg™ eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in +the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not +necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper +edition. + +Most people start at our website which has the main PG search +facility: www.gutenberg.org + +This website includes information about Project Gutenberg™, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. + + diff --git a/old/12847-0.zip b/old/12847-0.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..20140dc --- /dev/null +++ b/old/12847-0.zip diff --git a/old/12847-h.zip b/old/12847-h.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..45a61ec --- /dev/null +++ b/old/12847-h.zip diff --git a/old/12847-h/12847-h.htm b/old/12847-h/12847-h.htm new file mode 100644 index 0000000..61c06b0 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/12847-h/12847-h.htm @@ -0,0 +1,14199 @@ +<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN" +"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd"> +<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en"> +<head> +<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=utf-8" /> +<meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" /> +<title>The Project Gutenberg eBook of Havelok the Dane: A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln, by Charles Whistler</title> + +<style type="text/css"> + +body { margin-left: 20%; + margin-right: 20%; + text-align: justify; } + +h1, h2, h3, h4, h5 {text-align: center; font-style: normal; font-weight: +normal; line-height: 1.5; margin-top: .5em; margin-bottom: .5em;} + +h1 {font-size: 300%; + margin-top: 0.6em; + margin-bottom: 0.6em; + letter-spacing: 0.12em; + word-spacing: 0.2em; + text-indent: 0em;} +h2 {font-size: 150%; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 1em;} +h3 {font-size: 130%; margin-top: 1em;} +h4 {font-size: 120%;} +h5 {font-size: 110%;} + +.no-break {page-break-before: avoid;} /* for epubs */ + +div.chapter {page-break-before: always; margin-top: 4em;} + +hr {width: 80%; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em;} + +p {text-indent: 1em; + margin-top: 0.25em; + margin-bottom: 0.25em; } + +p.right {text-align: right; + margin-right: 10%; + margin-top: 1em; + margin-bottom: 1em; } + +p.footnote {font-size: 90%; + text-indent: 0%; + margin-left: 10%; + margin-right: 10%; + margin-top: 1em; + margin-bottom: 1em; } + +sup { vertical-align: top; font-size: 0.6em; } + +a:link {color:blue; text-decoration:none} +a:visited {color:blue; text-decoration:none} +a:hover {color:red} + +</style> +</head> +<body> + +<div style='text-align:center; font-size:1.2em; font-weight:bold'>The Project Gutenberg eBook of Havelok The Dane, by Charles Whistler</div> +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and +most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions +whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms +of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online +at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you +are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws of the +country where you are located before using this eBook. +</div> +<div style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:1em; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Title: Havelok The Dane<br /> + A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln</div> +<div style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:1em; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Author: Charles Whistler</div> +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>Release Date: July 7, 2004 [eBook #12847]<br /> +[Most recently updated: March 31, 2023]</div> +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>Language: English</div> +<div style='display:block; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Produced by: Martin Robb</div> +<div style='margin-top:2em; margin-bottom:4em'>*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK HAVELOK THE DANE ***</div> + +<h1>Havelok the Dane: A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln.</h1> + +<h2 class="no-break">By Charles W. Whistler, M.R.C.S.</h2> + +<hr /> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2>CONTENTS</h2> + +<table summary="" style=""> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap00">PREFACE.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap01">CHAPTER I. GRIM THE FISHER AND HIS SONS.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap02">CHAPTER II. KING HODULF’S SECRET.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap03">CHAPTER III. HAVELOK, SON OF GUNNAR.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap04">CHAPTER IV. ACROSS THE SWAN’S PATH.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap05">CHAPTER V. STORM AND SHIPWRECK.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap06">CHAPTER VI. THE BEGINNING OF GRIMSBY TOWN.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap07">CHAPTER VII. BROTHERHOOD.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap08">CHAPTER VIII. BERTHUN THE COOK.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap09">CHAPTER IX. CURAN THE PORTER.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap10">CHAPTER X. KING ALSI OF LINDSEY.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap11">CHAPTER XI. THE COMING OF THE PRINCESS.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap12">CHAPTER XII. IN LINCOLN MARKETPLACE.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap13">CHAPTER XIII. THE WITAN’S FEASTING.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap14">CHAPTER XIV. THE CRAFT OF ALSI THE KING.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap15">CHAPTER XV. THE FORTUNE OF CURAN THE PORTER.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap16">CHAPTER XVI. A STRANGEST WEDDING.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap17">CHAPTER XVII. HOW THE BRIDE WENT HOME.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap18">CHAPTER XVIII. JARL SIGURD OF DENMARK.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap19">CHAPTER XIX. THE LAST OF GRIFFIN OF WALES.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap20">CHAPTER XX. THE OWNING OF THE HEIR.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap21">CHAPTER XXI. THE TOKEN OF SACK AND ANCHOR.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap22">CHAPTER XXII. KING ALSI’S WELCOME.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap23">CHAPTER XXIII. BY TETFORD STREAM.</a></td> +</tr> + +<tr> +<td> <a href="#chap24">CHAPTER XXIV. PEACE, AND FAREWELL.</a></td> +</tr> + +</table> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap00">PREFACE.</a></h2> + +<p> +If any excuse is needed for recasting the ancient legend of Grim the fisher and +his foster-son Havelok the Dane, it may be found in the fascination of the +story itself, which made it one of the most popular legends in England from the +time of the Norman conquest, at least, to that of Elizabeth. From the eleventh +to the thirteenth centuries it seems to have been almost classic; and during +that period two full metrical versions—one in Norman-French and the other in +English—were written, besides many other short versions and abridgments, which +still exist. These are given exhaustively by Professor Skeat in his edition of +the English poem for the Early English Text Society, and it is needless to do +more than refer to them here as the sources from which this story is gathered. +</p> + +<p> +These versions differ most materially from one another in names and incidents, +while yet preserving the main outlines of the whole history. It is evident that +there has been a far more ancient, orally-preserved tradition, which has been +the original of the freely-treated poems and concise prose statements of the +legend which we have. And it seems possible, from among the many variations, +and from under the disguise of the mediaeval forms in which it has been hidden, +to piece together what this original may have been, at least with some +probability. +</p> + +<p> +We have one clue to the age of the legend of Havelok in the statement by the +eleventh-century Norman poet that his tale comes from a British source, which +at least gives a very early date for the happenings related; while another +version tells us that the king of “Lindesie” was a Briton. Welsh names occur, +accordingly, in several places; and it is more than likely that the old legend +preserved a record of actual events in the early days of the Anglo-Saxon +settlement in England, when there were yet marriages between conquerors and +conquered, and the origins of Angle and Jute and Saxon were not yet forgotten +in the pedigrees of the many petty kings. +</p> + +<p> +One of the most curious proofs of the actual British origin of the legend is in +the statement that the death of Havelok’s father occurred as the result of a +British invasion of Denmark for King Arthur, by a force under a leader with the +distinctly Norse name of Hodulf. The claim for conquest of the north by Arthur +is very old, and is repeated by Geoffrey of Monmouth, and may well have +originated in the remembrance of some successful raid on the Danish coasts by +the Norse settlers in the Gower district of Pembrokeshire, in company with a +contingent of their Welsh neighbours. +</p> + +<p> +This episode does not occur in the English version; but here an attack on +Havelok on his return home to Denmark is made by men led by one Griffin, and +this otherwise unexplainable survival of a Welsh name seems to connect the two +accounts in some way that recalls the ancient legend at the back of both. +</p> + +<p> +I have therefore treated the Welsh element in the story as deserving a more +prominent place, at least in subsidiary incidents, than it has in the two old +metrical versions. It has been possible to follow neither of these exactly, as +in names and details they are widely apart; but to one who knows both, the +sequence of events will, I think, be clear enough. +</p> + +<p> +I have, for the same reason of the British origin of the legend, preferred the +simple and apposite derivation of the name of “Curan,” taken by the hero during +his servitude, from the Welsh <i>Cwran</i>, “a wonder,” to the Norman +explanation of the name as meaning a “scullion,” which seems to be rather a +guess, based on the menial position of the prince, than a translation. +</p> + +<p> +For the long existence of a Welsh servile population in the lowlands of +Lincolnshire there is evidence enough in the story of Guthlac of Crowland, and +the type may still be found there. There need be little excuse for claiming +some remains of their old Christianity among them, and the “hermit” who reads +the dream for the princess may well have been a half-forgotten Welsh priest. +But the mediaeval poems have Christianized the ancient legend, until it would +seem to stand in somewhat the same relationship to what it was as the German +“Niebelungen Lied” does to the “Volsunga Saga.” +</p> + +<p> +With regard to the dreams which recur so constantly, I have in the case of the +princess transferred the date of hers to the day previous to her marriage, the +change only involving a difference of a day, but seeming to he needed, as +explanatory of her sudden submission to her guardian. And instead of crediting +Havelok with the supernatural light bodily, it has been transferred to the +dream which seems to haunt those who have to do with him. +</p> + +<p> +As to the names of the various characters, they are in the old versions hardly +twice alike. I have, therefore, taken those which seem to have been modernized +from their originals, or preserved by simple transliteration, and have set them +back in what seems to have been their first form. Gunther, William, and +Bertram, for instance, seem to be modernized from Gunnar, Withelm, and perhaps +Berthun; while Sykar, Aunger, and Gryme are but alternative English spellings +of the northern Sigurd, Arngeir, and Grim. +</p> + +<p> +The device on Havelok’s banner in chapter xxi. is exactly copied from the +ancient seal of the Corporation of Grimsby,<a href="#fn1" +name="fnref1"><sup>[1]</sup></a> which is of the date of Edward the First. The +existence of this is perhaps the best proof that the story of Grim and Havelok +is more than a romance. Certainly the Norse “Heimskringla” record claims an +older northern origin for the town than that of the Danish invasion of Alfred’s +time; and the historic freedom of its ships from toll in the port of Elsinore +has always been held to date from the days of its founder. +</p> + +<p> +The strange and mysterious “blue stones” of Grimsby and Louth are yet in +evidence, and those of the former town are connected by legend with Grim. +Certainly they have some very ancient if long-forgotten associations, and it is +more than likely that they have been brought as “palladia” with the earliest +northern settlers. A similar stone exists in the centre of the little East +Anglian town of Harleston, with a definite legend of settlement attached to it; +and there may be others. The Coronation Stone of Westminster and the stone in +Kingston-on-Thames are well-known proofs of the ancient sanctity that +surrounded such objects for original reasons that are now lost. +</p> + +<p> +The final battle at Tetford, with its details, are from the Norman poem. The +later English account is rounded off with the disgrace and burning alive of the +false guardian; but for many reasons the earlier seems to be the more correct +account. Certainly the mounds of some great forgotten fight remain in the +Tetford valley, and Havelok is said to have come to “Carleflure,” which, being +near Saltfleet, and on the road to Tetford, may be Canton, where there is a +strong camp of what is apparently Danish type. +</p> + +<p> +Those who can read with any comfort the crabbed Norman-French and Early English +poetic versions will see at once where I have added incidents that may bring +the story into a connected whole, as nearly as possible on the old Saga lines; +and those readers to whom the old romance is new will hardly wish that I should +pull the story to pieces again, to no purpose so far as they are concerned. +And, at least, for a fairly free treatment of the subject, I have the authority +of those previous authors whom I have mentioned. +</p> + +<p> +In the different versions, the founder of Grimsby is variously described as a +steward of the Danish king’s castle, a merchant, a fisher, and in the English +poem—probably because it was felt that none other would have undertaken the +drowning of the prince—as a thrall. Another version gives no account of the +sack episode, but says that Grim finds both queen and prince wandering on the +shore. Grim the fisher is certainly a historic character in his own town, and +it has not been hard to combine the various callings of the worthy +foster-father of Havelok and the troubles of both mother and son. A third local +variant tells that Havelok was found at Grimsby by the fisher adrift in an open +boat; and I have given that boat also a place in the story, in a different way. +</p> + +<p> +The names of the kings are too far lost to be set back in their place in +history, but Professor Skeet gives the probable date of Havelok and Grim as at +the end of the sixth century, with a possible identification of the former with +the “governor of Lincoln” baptized by Paulinus. I have, therefore, assumed this +period where required. But a legend of this kind is a romance of all time, and +needs no confinement to date and place. Briton and Saxon, Norman and +Englishman, and maybe Norseman and Dane, have loved the old story, and with its +tale of right and love triumphant it still has its own power. +</p> + +<p> +Stockland, <i>1899</i> +</p> + +<p class="right"> +Chas. W. Whistler +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap01">CHAPTER I.<br/> +GRIM THE FISHER AND HIS SONS.</a></h2> + +<p> +This story is not about myself, though, because I tell of things that I have +seen, my name must needs come into it now and then. The man whose deeds I would +not have forgotten is my foster-brother, Havelok, of whom I suppose every one +in England has heard. Havelok the Dane men call him here, and that is how he +will always be known, as I think. +</p> + +<p> +He being so well known, it is likely that some will write down his doings, and, +not knowing them save by hearsay, will write them wrongly and in different +ways, whereof will come confusion, and at last none will be believed. +Wherefore, as he will not set them down himself, it is best that I do so. Not +that I would have anyone think that the penmanship is mine. Well may I handle +oar, and fairly well axe and sword, as is fitting for a seaman, but the pen +made of goose feather is beyond my rough grip in its littleness, though I may +make shift to use a sail-needle, for it is stiff and straightforward in its +ways, and no scrawling goeth therewith. +</p> + +<p> +Therefore my friend Wislac, the English priest, will be the penman, having +skill thereto. I would have it known that I can well trust him to write even as +I speak, though he has full leave to set aside all hard words and unseemly, +such as a sailor is apt to use unawares; and where my Danish way of speaking +goeth not altogether with the English, he may alter the wording as he will, so +long as the sense is always the same. Then, also, will he read over to me what +he has written, and therefore all may be sure that this is indeed my true +story. +</p> + +<hr /> + +<p> +Now, as it is needful that one begins at the beginning, it happens that the +first thing to be told is how I came to be Havelok’s foster-brother, and that +seems like beginning with myself after all. But all the story hangs on this, +and so there is no help for it. +</p> + +<p> +If it is asked when this beginning might be, I would say, for an Englishman who +knows not the names of Danish kings, that it was before the first days of the +greatness of Ethelbert of Kent, the overlord of all England, the Bretwalda, and +therefore, as Father Wislac counts, about the year of grace 580. But King +Ethelbert does not come into the story, nor does the overlord of all Denmark; +for the kings of whom I must speak were under-kings, though none the less +kingly for all that. One must ever be the mightiest of many; and, as in +England, there were at that time many kings in Denmark, some over wide lands +and others over but small realms, with that one who was strong enough to make +the rest pay tribute to him as overlord, and only keeping that place by the +power of the strong hand, not for any greater worth. +</p> + +<p> +Our king on the west coast of Denmark, where the story of Havelok the Dane must +needs begin, was Gunnar Kirkeban—so called because, being a heathen altogether, +as were we all in Denmark at that time, he had been the bane of many churches +in the western isles of Scotland, and in Wales and Ireland, and made a boast +thereof. However, that cruelty of his was his own bane in the end, as will be +seen. Otherwise he was a well-loved king and a great warrior, tall, and +stronger than any man in Denmark, as was said. His wife, the queen, was a +foreigner, but the fairest of women. Her name was Eleyn, and from this it was +thought that she came from the far south. Certainly Gunnar had brought her back +from Gardariki,<a href="#fn2" name="fnref2"><sup>[2]</sup></a> whither he had +gone on a trading journey one year. Gunnar and she had two daughters and but +one son, and that son was Havelok, at this time seven years old. +</p> + +<p> +Next to the king came our own lord, Jarl Sigurd, older than Gunnar, and his +best counsellor, though in the matter of sparing harmless and helpless church +folk his advice was never listened to. His hall was many miles from the king’s +place, southward down the coast. +</p> + +<p> +Here, too, lived my father, Grim, with us in a good house which had been his +father’s before him. Well loved by Jarl Sigurd was Grim, who had ever been his +faithful follower, and was the best seaman in all the town. He was also the +most skilful fisher on our coasts, being by birth a well-to-do freeman enough, +and having boats of his own since he could first sail one. At one time the jarl +had made him steward of his house; but the sea drew him ever, and he waxed +restless away from it. Therefore, after a time, he asked the jarl’s leave to +take to the sea again, and so prospered in the fishery that at last he bought a +large trading buss from the Frisian coast, and took to the calling of the +merchant. +</p> + +<p> +So for some years my father, stout warrior as he proved himself in many a fight +at his lord’s side, traded peacefully—that is, so long as men would suffer him +to do so; for it happened more than once that his ship was boarded by Vikings, +who in the end went away, finding that they had made a mistake in thinking that +they had found a prize in a harmless trader, for Grim was wont to man his ship +with warriors, saying that what was worth trading was worth keeping. I mind me +how once he came to England with a second cargo, won on the high seas from a +Viking’s plunder, which the Viking brought alongside our ship, thinking to add +our goods thereto. Things went the other way, and we left him only an empty +ship, which maybe was more than he would have spared to us. That was on my +second voyage, when I was fifteen. +</p> + +<p> +Mostly my father traded to England, for there are few of the Saxon kin who take +ship for themselves, and the havens to which he went were Tetney and Saltfleet, +on the Lindsey shore of Humber, where he soon had friends. +</p> + +<p> +So Grim prospered and waxed rich fast, and in the spring of the year wherein +the story begins was getting the ship ready for the first cruise of the season, +meaning to be afloat early; for then there was less trouble with the wild Norse +Viking folk, for one cruise at least. Then happened that which set all things +going otherwise than he had planned, and makes my story worth telling. +</p> + +<p> +We—that is my father Grim, Leva my mother, my two brothers and myself, and our +two little sisters, Gunhild and Solva—sat quietly in our great room, busy at +one little thing or another, each in his way, before the bright fire that +burned on the hearth in the middle of the floor. There was no trouble at all +for us to think of more than that the wind had held for several weeks in the +southwest and northwest, and we wondered when it would shift to its wonted +springtide easting, so that we could get the ship under way once more for the +voyage she was prepared for. Pleasant talk it was, and none could have thought +that it was to be the last of many such quiet evenings that had gone before. +</p> + +<p> +Yet it seemed that my father was uneasy, and we had been laughing at him for +his silence, until he said, looking into the fire, “I will tell you what is on +my mind, and then maybe you will laugh at me the more for thinking aught of the +matter. Were I in any but a peaceful land, I should say that a great battle had +been fought not so far from us, and to the northward.” +</p> + +<p> +Then my mother looked up at him, knowing that he had seen many fights, and was +wise in the signs that men look for before them; but she asked nothing, and so +I said, “What makes you think this, father?” +</p> + +<p> +He answered me with another question. +</p> + +<p> +“How many kites will you see overhead at any time, sons?” +</p> + +<p> +I wondered at this, but it was easy to answer—to Raven, at least. +</p> + +<p> +“Always one, and sometimes another within sight of the first,” Raven said. +</p> + +<p> +“And if there is food, what then?” +</p> + +<p> +“The first swoops down on it, and the next follows, and the one that watches +the second follows that, and so on until there are many kites gathered.” +</p> + +<p> +“What if one comes late?” +</p> + +<p> +“He swings overhead and screams, and goes back to his place; then no more +come.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay,” he said; “you will make a sailor yet, son Raven, for you watch things. +Now I will tell you what I saw today. There was the one kite sailing over my +head as I was at the ship garth, and presently it screamed so that I looked up. +Then it left its wide circles over the town, and flew northward, straight as an +arrow. Then from the southward came another, following it, and after that +another, and yet others, all going north. And far off I could see where others +flew, and they too went north. And presently flapped over me the ravens in the +wake of the kites, and the great sea eagles came in screaming and went the same +way, and so for all the time that I was at the ship, and until I came home.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is a sacrifice to the Asir somewhere,” I said, “for the birds of Odin +and Thor have always their share.” +</p> + +<p> +My father shook his head. +</p> + +<p> +“The birds cry to one another, as I think, and say when the feast is but enough +for those that have gathered. They have cried now that there is room for all at +some great feasting. Once have I seen the like before, and that was when I was +with the ship guard when the jarl fought his great battle in the Orkneys; we +knew that he had fought by the same token.” +</p> + +<p> +But my mother said that I was surely right. There was no fear of battle here, +and indeed with Gunnar and Sigurd to guard the land we had had peace for many a +long year on our own coasts, if other lands had had to fear them. My father +laughed a little, saying that perhaps it was so, and then my mother took the +two little ones and went with them into the sleeping room to put them to rest, +while I and my two brothers went out to the cattle garth to see that all was +well for the night. +</p> + +<p> +Then, when our eyes were used to the moonlight, which was not very bright, away +to the northward we saw a red glow that was not that of the sunset or of the +northern lights, dying down now and then, and then again flaring up as will a +far-off fire; and even as we looked we heard the croak of an unseen raven +flying thitherward overhead. +</p> + +<p> +“Call father,” I said to Withelm, who was the youngest of us three. The boy ran +in, and presently my father came out and looked long at the glow in the sky. +</p> + +<p> +“Even as I thought,” he said. “The king’s town is burning, and I must go to +tell the jarl. Strange that we have had no message. Surely the king’s men must +be hard pressed if this is a foe’s work.” +</p> + +<p> +So he went at once, leaving us full of wonder and excited, as boys will be at +anything that is new and has a touch of fear in it. But he had hardly gone +beyond the outbuildings when one came running and calling him. The jarl had +sent for him, for there was strange news from the king. Then he and this +messenger hastened off together. +</p> + +<p> +In half an hour the war horns were blowing fiercely, and all the quiet town was +awake, for my father’s forebodings were true, and the foe was on us. In our +house my mother was preparing the food that her husband should carry with him, +and I was putting a last polish on the arms that should keep him, while the +tramp of men who went to the gathering rang down the street, one by one at +first, and then in twos and threes. My mother neither wept nor trembled, but +worked with a set face that would not show fear. +</p> + +<p> +Then came in my father, and I armed him, begging at the same time that I might +go also, for I could use <i>my</i> weapons well enough; but he told me that +some must needs bide at home as a guard, and that I was as much wanted there as +at the king’s place, wherewith I had to be content. It was by no means unlikely +that we also might be attacked, if it was true that the king’s men were +outnumbered, as was said. +</p> + +<p> +Now when my father went to say farewell to us, nowhere could be found my +brother Withelm. +</p> + +<p> +“The boy has gone to watch the muster,” my father said. “I shall see him there +presently.” +</p> + +<p> +Then, because he saw that my mother was troubled more than her wont, he added, +“Have no fear for me. This will be no more than a raid of Norsemen, and they +will plunder and be away with the tide before we get to the place.” +</p> + +<p> +So he laughed and went out, having done his best to cheer us all, and I went +with him to where the men were gathered in their arms in the wide space in the +midst of the houses. There I sought for little Withelm, but could not find him +among the women and children who looked on; and before we had been there more +than a few minutes the jarl gave the word, and the march was begun. There were +about fifteen miles to be covered between our town and the king’s. +</p> + +<p> +I watched them out of sight, and then went home, having learned that I was to +be called out only in case of need. And as I drew near the homestead I saw a +light in the little ash grove that was behind the garth.<a href="#fn3" +name="fnref3"><sup>[3]</sup></a> In the midst of the trees, where this light +seemed to be, was our wooden image of Thor the Hammer Bearer, older than any of +us could tell; and in front of this was what we used as his altar—four +roughly-squared stones set together. These stones were blue-black in colour, +and whence they came I do not know, unless it was true that my forefathers +brought them here when first Odin led his folk to the northern lands. Always +they had been the altar for my people, and my father held that we should have +no luck away from them. +</p> + +<p> +So it was strange to see a light in that place, where none would willingly go +after dark, and half was I feared to go and see what it might mean. But then it +came into my mind that the enemy might be creeping on the house through the +grove, and that therefore I must needs find out all about it. So I went softly +to the nearest trees, and crept from one to another, ever getting closer to the +light; and I will say that I feared more that I might see some strange thing +that was more than mortal than that I should see the leading foeman stealing +towards me. But presently it was plain that the light did not move as if men +carried it, but it flickered as a little fire; and at last I saw that it burned +on the altar stones, and that frightened me so that I almost fled. +</p> + +<p> +Maybe I should have done so, but that I heard a voice that I knew; and so, +looking once more, I saw a figure standing before the fire, and knew it. It was +little Withelm, and why a ten-year-old boy should be here I could not think. +But I called him softly, and he started somewhat, turning and trying to look +through the darkness towards me, though he did not seem afraid. There was a +little fire of dry sticks burning on the stones, and the gaunt old statue +seemed to look more terrible than ever in its red blaze. One might have thought +that the worn face writhed itself as the light played over it. +</p> + +<p> +“It is I, Withelm,” I said softly, for the fear of the place was on me. “We +have sought you everywhere, and father would have wished you farewell. What are +you doing here?” +</p> + +<p> +I came forward then, for it was plain that the child feared nothing, so that I +was put to shame. And as I came I asked once more what he was doing in this +place. +</p> + +<p> +“The jarl has surely forgotten the sacrifice to the Asir before the warriors +went to fight, and they will be angry,” he answered very calmly. “It is right +that one should remember, and I feared for father, and therefore—” +</p> + +<p> +He pointed to the altar, and I saw that he had laid his own untasted supper on +the fire that he had lighted, and I had naught to say. The thing was +over-strange to me, who thought nothing of these things. It was true that the +host always sacrificed before sailing on the Viking path, but tonight had been +urgent haste. +</p> + +<p> +“Thor will not listen to any but a warrior,” I said. “Come home, brother, for +mother waits us.” +</p> + +<p> +“If not Thor, who is maybe busy at the battle they talk of, then do I think +that All Father will listen,” he said stoutly. “But this was all that I had to +make sacrifice withal, and it may not be enough.” +</p> + +<p> +“The jarl will make amends when he comes back,” I said, wishing to get home and +away from this place, and yet unwilling to chide the child. “Now let us go, for +mother will grow anxious.” +</p> + +<p> +With that he put his hand in mine, and we both saluted Thor, as was fitting, +and then went homeward. It seemed to me that the glare in the north was fiercer +now than when I had first seen it. +</p> + +<p> +Now, after my mother had put Withelm to bed, I told her how I had found him; +and thereat she wept a little, as I could see in the firelight. +</p> + +<p> +After a long silence she said, “Strange things and good come into the mind of a +child, and one may learn what his fate shall be in the days to come. I am sure +from this that Withelm will be a priest.” +</p> + +<p> +Now as one may buy the place of a godar, with the right to have a temple of the +Asir for a district and the authority that goes therewith, if so be that one +falls vacant or is to be given up by the holder, this did not seem unlikely, +seeing how rich we were fast growing. And indeed my mother’s saying came to +pass hereafter, though not at all in the way of which we both thought. +</p> + +<p> +There was no alarm that night. The old warriors watched round the town and +along the northern tracks, but saw nothing, and in the morning the black smoke +hung over the place of the burning, drifting slowly seaward. The wind had +changed, and they said that it would doubtless have taken the foe away with it, +as my father had hoped. So I went down to the ship with Raven, and worked at +the few things that were still left to be done to her as she lay in her long +shed on the slips, ready to take the water at any tide. She was only waiting +for cargo and stores to be put on board her with the shift of wind that had +come at last, and I thought that my father would see to these things as soon as +he came back. +</p> + +<p> +Now in the evening we had news from the Jarl, and strange enough it was. My +father came back two days afterwards and told us all, and so I may as well make +a short story of it. The ways of Gunnar Kirkeban had been his end, for a +certain Viking chief, a Norseman, had wintered in Wales during the past winter, +and there he had heard from the Welsh of the wrongs that they had suffered at +his hands. Also he had heard of the great booty of Welsh gold that Gunnar had +taken thence in the last summer; and so, when these Welsh asked that he would +bide with them and help fight the next Danes who came, he had offered to do +more than that—he would lead them to Gunnar’s place if they would find men to +man three ships that he had taken, and would be content to share the booty with +them. +</p> + +<p> +The Welsh king was of the line of Arthur, and one who yet hoped to win back the +land of his fathers from the Saxons and English; and so he listened to this +Hodulf, thinking to gain a powerful ally in him for attack on the eastern coast +of England after this. So, favoured by the wind that had kept us from the sea, +Hodulf, with twenty ships in all, had fallen on Gunnar unawares, and had had an +easy victory, besetting the town in such wise that only in the confusion while +the wild Welsh were burning and plundering on every side had the messenger to +the jarl been able to slip away. +</p> + +<p> +But when the jarl and our men reached the town there was naught to be done but +to make terms with Hodulf as best he might, that the whole country might not be +overrun. For Gunnar had been slain in his own hall, with his two young +daughters and with the queen also, as was supposed. Havelok the prince was in +his hands, and for his sake therefore Sigurd had been the more ready to come to +terms. +</p> + +<p> +Then Hodulf sent messengers to the overlord of all Denmark, saying that he +would hold this kingdom as for him, and backed up that promise with a great +present from Gunnar’s treasure, so that he was listened to. Therefore our jarl +was helpless; and there being no other king strong enough to aid him if he +rose, in the end he had to take Hodulf for lord altogether, though it went +sorely against the grain. +</p> + +<p> +I have heard it said by the Welsh folk that Hodulf held the kingdom for their +lord; and it is likely that he humoured them by saying that he would do so, +which was a safe promise to make, as even King Arthur himself could never have +reached him to make him pay scatt. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap02">CHAPTER II.<br/> +KING HODULF’S SECRET.</a></h2> + +<p> +My father came home heavy and anxious enough, for he did not know how things +would go under this new king, though he had promised peace to all men who would +own him. We in our place saw nothing of him or his men for the next few weeks, +but he was well spoken of by those who had aught to do with him elsewhere. So +my father went on trying to gather a cargo for England; but it was a slow +business, as the burnt and plundered folk of the great town had naught for us, +and others sold to them. But he would never be idle, and every day when weather +served we went fishing, for he loved his old calling well, as a man will love +that which he can do best. Our two boats and their gear were always in the best +of order, and our kinsman, Arngeir, used and tended them when we were away in +the ship in summertime. +</p> + +<p> +Now, one evening, as we came up from the shore after beaching the boat on the +hard below the town, and half a mile from the nearest houses, and being, as one +may suppose, not altogether in holiday trim, so that Grim and his boys with +their loads of fish and nets looked as though a fisher’s hovel were all the +home that they might own, we saw a horseman, followed at a little distance by +two more, riding towards us. The dusk was gathering, and at first we thought +that this was Jarl Sigurd, who would ask us maybe to send fish to his hall, and +so we set our loads down and waited for him. +</p> + +<p> +But it was not our lord, and I had never seen this man before. From his arms, +which were of a new pattern to me, he might be one of the host of Hodulf, as I +thought. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, fisher!” he cried, when he was yet some way from us; “leave your lads, and +come hither. I have a word for you.” +</p> + +<p> +He reined up and waited, and now I was sure that he was a Norseman, for his +speech was rougher than ours. He was a tall, handsome man enough; but I liked +neither his voice nor face, nor did I care to hear Grim, my father, summoned in +such wise, not remembering that just now a stranger could not tell that he was +aught but a fisher thrall of the jarl’s. +</p> + +<p> +But my father did as he was asked, setting down the nets that he was carrying, +and only taking with him the long boathook on which he had slung them as he +went forward. I suppose he remembered the old saying, that a man should not +stir a step on land without his weapons, as one never knows when there may be +need of them; and so, having no other, he took this. +</p> + +<p> +I heard the first questions that the man asked, for he spoke loudly. +</p> + +<p> +“Whose man are you?” +</p> + +<p> +“Sigurd’s,” answered my father shortly. +</p> + +<p> +“Whose are the boats?” +</p> + +<p> +“Mine, seeing that I built them.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, there is somewhat that you can do for me,” the horseman said. “Is +your time your own, however?” +</p> + +<p> +“If the jarl needs me not.” +</p> + +<p> +“Tonight, then?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have naught to do after I have carried the nets home.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is well,” said the stranger; and after that he dropped his voice so that +I heard no more, but he and my father talked long together. +</p> + +<p> +We waited, and at last the talk ended, and my father came hack to us, while the +stranger rode away northward along the sands. Then I asked who the man was, and +what he wanted. +</p> + +<p> +“He is some chief of these Norsemen, and one who asks more questions of a +thrall, as he thinks me, than he would dare ask Sigurd the jarl, or Grim the +merchant either, for that matter.” +</p> + +<p> +Seeing that my father did not wish to say more at this time, we asked nothing +else, but went homeward in silence. It seemed as if he was ill at ease, and he +went more quickly than was his wont, so that presently Raven and little Withelm +lagged behind us with their burdens, for our catch had been a good one. +</p> + +<p> +Then he stopped outside the garth when we reached home, and told me not to go +in yet. And when the others came up he said to them, “Do you two take in the +things and the fish, and tell mother that Radbard and I have to go down to the +ship. There is cargo to be seen to, and it is likely that we shall he late, so +bid her not wait up for us.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told me to come, and we left the two boys at once and turned away +towards the haven. There was nothing strange in this, for cargo often came at +odd times, and we were wont to work late in stowing it. I did wonder that we +had not stayed to snatch a bit of supper, but it crossed my mind that the +Norseman had told my father of some goods that had maybe been waiting for the +whole day while we were at sea. And then that did not seem likely, for he had +taken us for thralls. So I was puzzled, but held my peace until it should seem +good to my father to tell me what we were about. +</p> + +<p> +When we reached a place where there was no house very near and no man about, he +said to me at last, “What is on hand I do not rightly know, but yon man was +Hodulf, the new king, as I suppose we must call him. He would not tell me his +name, but I saw him when he and the jarl made terms the other day. Now he has +bidden me meet him on the road a mile from the town as soon as it is dark, and +alone. He has somewhat secret for me to do.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is a risk to go alone and unarmed,” I answered; “let me go home and get +your weapons, for the errand does not seem honest.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is what I think also,” said my father, “and that is why I am going to +meet him. It is a bad sign when a king has a secret to share with a thrall, and +I have a mind to find out what it is. There may be some plot against our jarl.” +</p> + +<p> +He was silent for a few minutes, as if thinking, and then he went on. +</p> + +<p> +“I cannot take arms, or he would suspect me, and would tell me nothing; but if +there is any plotting to be done whereof I must tell the jarl, it will be as +well that you should hear it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he said that he thought it possible for me to creep very close to the +place where he was to meet Hodulf, so that I could hear all or most of what +went on, and that I might as well be armed in case of foul play, for he did not +suppose that the Norseman would think twice about cutting down a thrall who did +not please him. +</p> + +<p> +It was almost dark by this time, and therefore he must be going. I was not to +go home for arms, but to borrow from Arngeir as we passed his house. And this I +did, saying that I had an errand beyond the town and feared prowling men of the +Norse host. Which danger being a very reasonable one, Arngeir offered to go +with me; and I had some difficulty in preventing him from doing so, for he was +like an elder brother to all of us. However, I said that I had no great +distance to go, and feigned to be ashamed of myself for my fears; and he +laughed at me, and let me go my way with sword and spear and seax<a href="#fn4" +name="fnref4"><sup>[4]</sup></a> also, which last my father would take under +his fisher’s jerkin. +</p> + +<p> +I caught up my father quickly, and we went along the sands northwards until we +came to the place where we must separate. The road was but a quarter of a mile +inland from this spot, for it ran near the shore, and it was not much more than +that to the place where Hodulf would be waiting. +</p> + +<p> +“Creep as near as you can,” my father said; “but come to help only if I call. I +do not think that I am likely to do so.” +</p> + +<p> +Then we went our ways, he making straight for the road, and I turning to my +left a little. It was dark, for there was no moon now, but save that I was +soundly scratched by the brambles of the fringe of brushwood that grew all +along the low hills of the coast, there was nothing to prevent my going on +quickly, for I knew the ground well enough, by reason of yearly bird nesting. +When I reached the roadway the meeting place was yet to my left, and I could +hear my father’s footsteps coming steadily in the distance. So I skirted the +road for a little way, and then came to an open bit of heath and rising land, +beyond which I thought I should find Hodulf. Up this I ran quickly, dropping +into the heather at the top; and sure enough, in a hollow just off the road I +could dimly make out the figure of a mounted man waiting. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father came along the road past me, and I crawled among the tall +heather clumps until I was not more than twenty paces from the hollow, which +was a little below me. +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf’s horse winded me, as I think, and threw up its head snorting, and I +heard its bit rattle. But my father was close at hand, and that was lucky. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, fisher, is that you?” he called softly. +</p> + +<p> +“I am here,” was the answer, and at once my father came into the hollow from +the road. +</p> + +<p> +“Are any folk about?” Hodulf said. +</p> + +<p> +“I have met none. Now, what is all this business?” answered my father. +</p> + +<p> +“Business that will make a free man of you for the rest of your days, and rich, +moreover, master thrall,” said Hodulf. “That is, if you do as I bid you.” +</p> + +<p> +“A thrall can do naught else than what he is bidden.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but he can do that in a way that will earn great reward, now and then; +and your reward for obedience and silence thereafter in this matter shall be +aught that you like to ask.” +</p> + +<p> +“This sounds as if I were to peril my life,” my father said. “I know naught +else that can be worth so much as that might be.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is no peril,” said Hodulf scornfully; “your skin shall not be so much as +scratched—ay, and if this is well done it will know a master’s dog whip no +more.” +</p> + +<p> +I heard my father chuckle with a thrall’s cunning laugh at this, and then he +said eagerly, “Well, master, what is it?” +</p> + +<p> +“I will tell you. But first will you swear as on the holy ring that of what you +shall do for me no man shall know hereafter?” +</p> + +<p> +“What I do at your bidding none shall know, and that I swear,” answered my +father slowly, as if trying to repeat the king’s words. +</p> + +<p> +“See here, then,” said Hodulf, and I heard his armour clatter as he dismounted. +</p> + +<p> +Then the footsteps of both men shuffled together for a little while, and once I +thought I heard a strange sound as of a muffled cry, at which Hodulf muttered +under his breath. I could see that they took something large from the saddle +bow, and set it on the ground, and then they spoke again. +</p> + +<p> +“Have you a heavy anchor?” asked the king. +</p> + +<p> +“A great one.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, tie it to this sack and sink it tonight where tide will never +shift it. Then you may come to me and claim what reward you will.” +</p> + +<p> +“Freedom, and gold enough to buy a new boat—two new boats!” said my father +eagerly. +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf laughed at that, and got on his horse again. I saw his tall form lift +itself against the dim sky as he did so. +</p> + +<p> +“What is in the sack?” asked my father. +</p> + +<p> +“That is not your concern,” Hodulf answered sharply. “If you know not, then you +can tell no man, even in your sleep. Put off at once and sink it.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is in my mind,” said my father, “that I had better not look in the sack. +Where shall I find you, lord, when the thing is in the sea? For as yet I have +not heard your name.” +</p> + +<p> +I think that Hodulf had forgotten that he would have to answer this question, +or else he thought that everyone knew him, for he did not reply all at once. +</p> + +<p> +“You may ask the king for your reward,” he said, after a little thought, “for +this is his business. Now you know that it will be best for you to be secret +and sure. Not much worth will your chance of escape from torture be if this +becomes known. But you know also that the reward is certain.” +</p> + +<p> +“The king!” cried my father, with a sort of gasp of surprise. +</p> + +<p> +I could almost think that I saw him staring with mouth agape as would a silly +thrall; for so well had he taken the thrall’s part that had I not known who was +speaking all the time, I had certainly had no doubt that one was there. +</p> + +<p> +“Come to Hodulf, the king, and pray for freedom and your gold as a boon of his +goodness, saying naught else, or making what tale you will of a hard master, or +justice, so that you speak naught of what you have done, and that—and maybe +more—shall be granted.” +</p> + +<p> +“You yourself will speak for me?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am the king—and think not that the darkness will prevent my knowing your +face again,” Hodulf replied. +</p> + +<p> +There was a threat in the words, and with them he turned his horse and rode +away quickly northwards. I heard the hoofs of his men’s horses rattle on the +road as they joined him, before he had gone far. +</p> + +<p> +When the sounds died away altogether, and there was no fear of his coming back +suddenly on us, my father whistled and I joined him. He almost started to find +how near I was. +</p> + +<p> +“You have heard all, then?” he said. +</p> + +<p> +“Every word,” I answered, “and I like it not. Where is this sack he spoke of?” +</p> + +<p> +It lay at his feet. A large sack it was, and full of somewhat heavy and warm +that seemed to move a little when I put my hand on it. Still less did I like +the business as I felt that. +</p> + +<p> +“More also!” quoth my father, as if thinking of the king’s last words. “If that +does not mean a halter for my neck, I am mistaken. What have we here, son, do +you think?” +</p> + +<p> +“Somewhat that should not be here, certainly,” I answered. “There would not be +so much talk about drowning a dog, as one might think this to be.” +</p> + +<p> +“Unless it were his wife’s,” answered my father, with a laugh. +</p> + +<p> +Then he stooped, and I helped him to get the sack on his shoulders. It was +heavy, but not very—not so heavy as a young calf in a sack would be; and he +carried it easily, taking my spear to help him. +</p> + +<p> +“The thrall is even going to take this to the house of Grim the merchant, whom +the king will not know again, though he may see in the dark,” said he; “then we +shall know how we stand.” +</p> + +<p> +We met no one on our way back, for the town had gone to sleep, until the +watchman passed the time of night with us, thinking no doubt that we had fish +or goods in the burden. And when we came home a sleepy thrall opened to us, for +all were at rest save him. And he too went his way to the shed where his place +was when he had stirred the fire to a blaze and lit a torch that we might see +to eat the supper that was left for us. +</p> + +<p> +Then we were alone, and while I set Arngeir’s weapons in a corner, my father +put down the sack, and stood looking at it. It seemed to sway a little, and to +toss as it settled down. And now that there was light it was plain that the +shape of what was inside it was strangely like that of a child, doubled up with +knees to chin, as it showed through the sacking. +</p> + +<p> +“Hodulf or no Hodulf,” said my father, “I am going to see more of this.” +</p> + +<p> +With that he took a knife from the table and cut the cord that fastened the +mouth, turning back the sack quickly. +</p> + +<p> +And lo! gagged and bound hand and foot in such wise that he could not move, in +the sack was a wondrously handsome boy of about the size of Withelm; and for +all his terrible journey across the king’s saddle, and in spite of our rough +handling, his eyes were bright and fearless as he looked up at us. +</p> + +<p> +“Radbard,” said my father, “what if Hodulf had met with a thrall who had done +his bidding in truth?” +</p> + +<p> +I would not think thereof, for surely by this time there had been no light in +the eyes that seemed to me to be grateful to us. +</p> + +<p> +Now my father knelt down by the boy’s side, and began to take the lashings from +him, telling him at the same time to be silent when the gag was gone. +</p> + +<p> +And hard work enough the poor child had to keep himself from screaming when his +limbs were loosed, so cramped was he, for he had been bound almost into a ball. +And even as we rubbed and chafed the cold hands and feet he swooned with the +pain of the blood running freely once more. +</p> + +<p> +“This is a business for mother,” said my father, on that; “get your supper, and +take it to bed with you, and say naught to the boys in the morning. This is a +thing that may not be talked of.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I should have liked to stay, but my father meant what he said, and I could +be of no more use; so I took my food, and went up to the loft where we three +slept, and knew no more of what trouble that night might have for others. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap03">CHAPTER III.<br/> +HAVELOK, SON OF GUNNAR.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now after I had gone, Grim, my father, tried to bring the child round, but he +could not do so; and therefore, leaving him near the fire, he went softly to +call Leva, my mother, to help him; and all the while he was wondering who the +child might be, though indeed a fear that he knew only too well was growing in +his heart, for there would surely he only one whom Hodulf could wish out of his +way. +</p> + +<p> +As he opened the door that led to the sleeping room beyond the high seat, the +light shone on Leva, and showed her sitting up in bed with wide eyes that +seemed to gaze on somewhat that was terrible, and at first he thought her +awake. But she yet slept, and so he called her gently, and she started and +woke. +</p> + +<p> +“Husband, is that you?” she said. “I had a strange dream even now which surely +portends somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +Now, as all men know, our folk in the north are most careful in the matter of +attending to dreams, specially those that come in troubled times, holding that +often warning or good counsel comes from them. I cannot say that I have ever +had any profit in that way myself, being no dreamer at all; but it is certain +that others have, as may be seen hereafter. Wherefore my father asked Leva what +this dream might be. +</p> + +<p> +“In my dream,” she answered, “it seemed that you came into the house bearing a +sack, which you gave into my charge, saying that therein lay wealth and good +fortune for us. And I would not believe this, for you said presently that to +gain this the sack and all that was therein was to be thrown into the sea, +which seemed foolishness. Whereon I cast it into a corner in anger, and +thereout came pitiful cries and wailings. Then said I that it were ill to drown +aught that had a voice as of a child, and so you bade me leave it. Then I +seemed to sleep here; but presently in my dream I rose and looked on the sack +again, and lo! round about it shone a great light, so that all the place was +bright, and I was afraid. Then you came and opened the sack, and therein was a +wondrous child, from whose mouth came a flame, as it were the shaft of a +sunbeam, that stretched over all Denmark, and across the sea to England, +whereby I knew that this child was one who should hereafter be king of both +these lands. And on this I stared even as you woke me.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Grim was silent, for this was passing strange, and moreover it fitted with +his thought of who this child might be, since Hodulf. would make away with him +thus secretly. +</p> + +<p> +“What make you of the dream?” asked Leva, seeing that he pondered on it. +</p> + +<p> +“It is in my mind that your dream will come true altogether, for already it has +begun to do so,” he answered. “Rise and come into the hall, and I will show you +somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +On that Leva made haste and dressed and came out, and there, lying as if in +sleep before the fire, was the wondrous child of her dream, and the sack was +under his head as he lay; and she was wont to say to those few who knew the +story, that the kingliness of that child was plain to be seen, as had been the +flame of which she had dreamed, so that all might know it, though the clothes +that he wore were such as a churl might be ashamed of. +</p> + +<p> +Then she cried out a little, but not loudly, and knelt by the child to see him +the better; and whether he had come to himself before and had dropped asleep +for very weariness, or out of his swoon had passed into sleep, I cannot say, +but at her touch he stirred a little. +</p> + +<p> +“What child is this? and how came he here?” she asked, wondering. +</p> + +<p> +“Already your dream has told you truly how he came,” Grim answered, “but who he +is I do not rightly know yet. Take him up and bathe him, wife; and if he is the +one I think him, there will be a mark whereby we may know him.” +</p> + +<p> +“How should he be marked? And why look you to find any sign thus?” +</p> + +<p> +But Grim had turned down the rough shirt and bared the child’s neck and right +shoulder, whereon were bruises that made Leva well-nigh weep as she saw them, +for it was plain that he had been evilly treated for many days before this. But +there on the white skin was the mark of the king’s line—the red four-armed +cross with bent ends which Gunnar and all his forebears had borne. +</p> + +<p> +Seeing that, Leva looked up wondering in her husband’s face, and he answered +the question that he saw written in her eyes. +</p> + +<p> +“He is as I thought—he is Havelok, the son of Gunnar, our king. Hodulf gave him +to me that I might drown him.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told her all that had happened, and how from the first time that he had +lifted the sack and felt what was within it he had feared that this was what +was being done. Hodulf would have no rival growing up beside him, and as he +dared not slay him openly, he would have it thought that he had been stolen +away by his father’s friends, and then folk would maybe wait quietly in hopes +that he would come again when time went on. +</p> + +<p> +Now Leva bathed Havelok in the great tub, and with the warmth and comfort of +the hot water he waked and was well content, so that straightway, when he was +dressed in Withelm’s holiday clothes, which fitted him, though he was but seven +years old at this time, and Withelm was a well-grown boy enough for his ten +winters, he asked for food, and they gave him what was yet on the board; and we +lived well in Denmark. +</p> + +<p> +“There is no doubt that he hath a kingly hunger,” quoth Grim as he watched him. +</p> + +<p> +“Friend,” said Havelok, hearing this, though it was not meant for his ears, “it +is likely, seeing that this is the third day since I have had food given me. +And I thank you, good people, though I would have you know that it is the +custom to serve the king’s son kneeling.” +</p> + +<p> +“How should we know that you are the king’s son indeed?” asked Grim. +</p> + +<p> +“I am Havelok, son of Gunnar,” the boy said gravely. “Yon traitor, Hodulf, has +slain my father, and my two sisters, and driven out my mother, whither I cannot +tell, and now he would drown me.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the boy could hardly keep a brave front any longer, and he added, “Yet I +do not think that you will do to me as I heard him bid you.” +</p> + +<p> +Then came over Grim a great pity and sorrow that it should seem needful thus to +sue to him, and there grew a lump in his throat, so that for a while he might +not answer, and the boy thought him in doubt, so that in his eyes there was a +great fear. But Leva wept outright, and threw herself on her knees beside him, +putting her arms round him as he sat, speaking words of comfort. +</p> + +<p> +Then Grim knelt also, and said, “Thralls of yours are we, Havelok, son of +Gunnar, and for you shall our lives be given before Hodulf shall harm you. Nor +shall he know that you live until the day comes when you can go to him sword in +hand and helm on head, with half the men of this realm at your back, and speak +to him of what he did and what he planned, and the vengeance that shall be +therefor.” +</p> + +<p> +So Grim took on himself to be Havelok’s foster-father, and, as he ended, the +boy said with glowing eyes, “I would that I were grown up. How long shall this +be before it comes to pass?” +</p> + +<p> +And then of a sudden he said, as a tired child will, “Friends, I am sorely +weary. Let me sleep.” +</p> + +<p> +So Leva took him in her arms and laid him in their own bed; and at once he +slept, so that she left him and came back to Grim by the fireside, for there +was much to be said. +</p> + +<p> +First of all it was clear that Havelok must be hidden, and it was not to be +supposed that Hodulf would be satisfied until he had seen the thrall to whom he +had trusted such a secret come back for his reward. If he came not he would be +sought; and then he would find out to whom he had spoken, and there would be +trouble enough. +</p> + +<p> +But it seemed easy to hide Havelok on board the ship, and sail with him to +England as soon as possible. A few days might well pass before a thrall could +get to Hodulf, so that he would suspect nothing just at first. There were +merchants in England who would care for the boy well, and the two boats might +be sunk, so that the king should not ask whose they were. So when Grim came +home again the fisher would be thought of as drowned on his errand, and Hodulf +would be content. +</p> + +<p> +But then, after a little talk of this, it was plain that all the town could not +be told to say that the fisher was drowned on such a night, and Hodulf would +leave naught undone to find the truth of the matter. So the puzzle became +greater, and the one thing that was clear was that Grim was in sore danger, and +Havelok also. +</p> + +<p> +Then suddenly outside the dogs barked, and a voice which they obeyed quieted +them. Grim sprang for his axe, which hung on the wall, and went to the door, +whereon someone was knocking gently. +</p> + +<p> +“Open, uncle; it is I, Arngeir.” +</p> + +<p> +“What does the boy want at this time?” said Grim, taking down the great bar +that kept the door, axe in hand, for one must be cautious in such times as +these. +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir came in—a tall young man of twenty, handsome, and like Grim in ways, +for he was his brother’s son. +</p> + +<p> +“Lucky am I in finding you astir,” he said. “I thought I should have had to +wake you all. Are you just home from sea, or just going out?” +</p> + +<p> +“Not long home,” answered Leva; “but what has brought you?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have a guest for you, if I may bring one here at this hour.” +</p> + +<p> +“A friend of yours never comes at the wrong time,” Grim said. “Why not bring +him in?” +</p> + +<p> +“If it were a friend of mine and a man he would do well enough at my house for +the night,” said Arngeir, smiling; “but the one for whom I have come is a lady, +and, I think, one in sore trouble.” +</p> + +<p> +“Who is she?” asked my mother, wondering much. +</p> + +<p> +“From the king’s town, certainly,” answered Arngeir, “but I do not know her +name. Truth to tell, I forgot to ask it, for she is sorely spent; and so I made +haste to come to you.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Leva would know how a lady came at this time to Arngeir’s house, for he +was alone, save for his four men, being an orphan without other kin beside us, +and his house was close to our shipyard and the sea. +</p> + +<p> +“She came not to me, but I found her,” he replied. “My horse is sick, and I +must get up an hour ago and see to it for the second time tonight. Then as I +came from the stable I saw someone go towards the shipyard, and, as I thought, +into the open warehouse. It was dark, and I could not tell then if this was man +or woman; but I knew that no one had business there, and there are a few things +that a thief might pick up. So I took an axe and one of the dogs, and went to +see what was on hand, but at first there was naught to be found of anyone. If +it had not been for the dog, I think that I should have gone away, but he went +into the corner where the bales of wool are set, and there he whined strangely, +and when I looked, there was this lady on the bales, and she was weeping and +sore afraid. So I asked her what was amiss, and it was not easy to get an +answer at first. But at last she told me that she had escaped from the burning +of the king’s town, and would fain be taken across the sea into some place of +peace. So I cheered her by saying that you would surely help her; and then I +took her to my house and came to you. Worn and rent are her garments, but one +may see that they have been rich, and I deem her some great lady.” +</p> + +<p> +“Go and bring her here, husband,” said my mother, on hearing that. +</p> + +<p> +But he was already going, and at once he and Arngeir went out and down the +street. There were many other ladies and their children who had taken refuge +here with the townsfolk after the burning, and the coming of this one was but +another count in the long tale of trouble that began on the Welsh shore with +the ways of Gunnar, the church’s bane. +</p> + +<p> +My father was long gone, and the day was breaking when he came back. My mother +slept in the great chair before the fire, for waiting had wearied her, but she +woke as she heard Grim’s footstep, and unbarred the door to him, ready to +welcome the guest that she looked for. But he was alone, and on his face was +the mark of some new trouble, and that a great one. +</p> + +<p> +He came in and barred the door after him, and then sat down wearily and ate for +the first time since we had had our meal at sea; and while he did so Leva asked +him nothing, wondering what was wrong, but knowing that she would hear in good +time. And when he had eaten well he spoke. +</p> + +<p> +“The lady is Eleyn the queen. She has been wandering for these many days from +place to place, sometimes in the woods, and sometimes in hiding in the cottages +of the poor folk, always with a fear of staying in one place, lest Hodulf +should find her, for it is known that he is seeking her. Then at last one told +her of my ship, and she is here to seek me.” +</p> + +<p> +Now one may know what the wonder and pity of my mother was, and she would fain +have gone to her. But Grim had left her at Arngeir’s house, for folk were +stirring in the town, and there were many who would know the queen if they saw +her. +</p> + +<p> +“It will soon be known that Arngeir has a guest,” my mother said, “whereas none +would have wondered had she been here.” +</p> + +<p> +“By this time tomorrow it will not matter if Hodulf knows,” answered Grim, “for +she will be safe.” +</p> + +<p> +“Where will you hide her then and what of Havelok?” +</p> + +<p> +“For those two there is no safety but across the sea, and they are the most +precious cargo that I shall ever have carried. Already Arngeir and the men are +at work on the ship, getting the rollers under her keel, that she may take the +water with the next tide. I shall sail with the tide that comes with the +darkness again, saying that I shall find cargo elsewhere in other ports, as I +have done once before.” +</p> + +<p> +“I had not looked to say farewell to you quite so soon,” my mother said; “but +this is right. Now I will have all things ready, that the queen shall be in +what comfort she may on the voyage. But it will be well that none shall know, +even of your seamen, who the passengers are, else will word go to Hodulf in +some way hereafter that Havelok has escaped.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have thought of that,” answered Grim. “It will be best that none, not even +Radbard, shall know who this is whom we have in the house. A chance word goes +far sometimes.” +</p> + +<p> +“The boy will tell his name.” +</p> + +<p> +“There are many who are named after him, and that is no matter. Do you speak to +him, for it is plain that he has sense enough, and bid him say naught but that +he and his mother have escaped from the town, and, if you will, that he escaped +in the sack. I will speak to Radbard, and there will be no trouble. Only +Arngeir must know the truth, and that not until we are on the high seas +perhaps.” +</p> + +<p> +So there seemed to be no more fear, and in an hour the house was astir, and +there was work enough for all in preparing for the voyage. As for me, I went +down to the ship with my father, and worked there. +</p> + +<p> +Now, I will say that not for many a long year did I know who this +foster-brother of mine was. It was enough for me to be told that he was the son +of some great man or other with whom Hodulf had a private feud. Nor did I ever +speak of that night’s work to any, for my father bade me not to do so. +Presently I knew, of course, that the lady was Havelok’s mother; but that told +me nothing, for I never heard her name. +</p> + +<p> +We worked at the ship for three hours or so, stowing the bales of wool and the +other little cargo we had; and then my father sent me to the fishing-boats for +a pair of oars belonging to the ship’s boat that were there, and, as it fell +out, it was a good thing that I and not one of the men went. When I came to the +place where they were drawn up on the beach, as we had left them last night, +there was a stranger talking to some of the fisher folk, who were working at +their nets not far off; and though another might have paid no heed to this, I, +with the remembrance of last night fresh in my mind, wondered if he was by any +chance there on an errand from Hodulf. I thought that, were I he, I should +surely send someone to know, at least, if the fisher went out last night after +I had spoken with him. So I loitered about until the man went away, which he +did slowly, passing close to me, and looking at the boats carefully, as if he +would remember them. Then I went and asked the men to whom he had been speaking +what he wanted. They said that they wondered that he had not spoken to me, for +he had been asking about my father and of his ship, and if he took any +passenger with him this voyage. It would seem that he wanted to sail with us, +from all he said. +</p> + +<p> +Certainly he had begun by asking whose boats these were, and wondered that a +merchant should go fishing at all, when there was no need for him to do so. +Also he had asked if Grim had been out last night, and they had of course told +him that he had not, for neither boat had been shifted from the berth she had +been given when we came in at dusk. +</p> + +<p> +“Ah,” he had said, “well did I wot that your merchant would do no night work,” +and so made a jest of the matter, saying that in his country it were below the +state of a merchant to have aught to do with a thrall’s work. He was certainly +a Norseman, and they thought that I should find him with my father. Now I +thought otherwise, and also I saw that all was known. This man was a spy of +Hodulf’s, and would go straight back to his master. My father must hear of this +at once; and I hurried back to the ship, and took him aside and told him. And +as I did so his face grew grey under the tan that sea and wind had given it, +and I knew not altogether why. +</p> + +<p> +“Tell Arngeir to come to me,” he said; “I am going to the jarl. Tell no one, +but go home and say to mother that I shall be with her in an hour. Then come +back and work here.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he and Arngeir went to Sigurd, and told him all from the beginning. And +when the jarl heard, he was glad for the safety of the queen and of Havelok, +but he said that there was no doubt that Denmark was no place for Grim any +longer. +</p> + +<p> +“That is my thought also,” said my father; “but now am I Havelok’s +foster-father, and for him I can make a home across the sea, where I will train +him up for the time that shall surely come, when he shall return and take his +father’s kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is well,” the jarl said, “but you have little time. What Hodulf will do +one cannot say, but he may come here with his men behind him to force me to +give you up, and the town will be searched for Havelok, and both he and the +queen will be lost.” +</p> + +<p> +“If that is so,” my father answered, “we have time enough. Two hours for the +spy to reach his master; one hour for Hodulf to hear him, and to bethink +himself; an hour for gathering his men; and four hours, at the least, in which +to get here. Eight hours, at the least, have we, and the tide serves in six. I +had thought of waiting till dark, but that is of no use now. We may as well go, +for there are true men here, who will wait to welcome him who flies when he +comes again.” +</p> + +<p> +“This is a sore wrench for you and yours, good friend and faithful,” Sigurd +said, “but it must be. Nevertheless I can make your loss as little as it may +be. You shall sell all that is yours to me at your own price, that you may have +the means to make a new home well, wherever you may choose.” +</p> + +<p> +At first my father would not have that, saying that there would be much trouble +on his account presently. +</p> + +<p> +But Sigurd said that, first, the trouble was not of his making at all; and +next, that if Hodulf plundered the place, it was as well to send away as much +as possible beforehand; and lastly—and this was what touched my father +most—that he must think of his charge. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, old friend, you are giving up all for Havelok, as would I. And am I to +have no share in the training of him for the days to come?” +</p> + +<p> +Therewith he waited for no more words, but went to his great chest, and took +thereout chain after chain of linked gold rings, and put them in a canvas bag, +without weighing or counting them, and gave them to Grim. +</p> + +<p> +“Lord, here is enough to buy half the town!” my father said. +</p> + +<p> +“What of that? The town is Havelok’s by right, and maybe you can buy him a +village across seas with it. But give me a full quittance for my purchase of +your goods and cattle and house, that I may have right to them.” +</p> + +<p> +That Grim did at once, before witnesses who were called in, none wondering that +he chose thus to secure his property while he was away, because Hodulf might +make demands on it. They did not know that any money changed hands, and thought +it formal only, and a wise thing to be done. +</p> + +<p> +After that Grim and Arngeir took leave of the jarl, thanking him, and they went +to our house. +</p> + +<p> +There waited my mother anxiously enough, for she knew from my message that +there was somewhat new to be told, or my father had not left the ship. Nor do I +think that what was to be done was altogether a surprise to her, for she had +thought much, and knew the dangers that might crop up. So, being very brave, +she strove to make light of the trouble that leaving her home cost her, and set +about gathering the few things that she could take. +</p> + +<p> +Now on the hearth sat Withelm, tending the fire, and he heard presently that we +were all to go to sea; and that pleased him well, for he had ever longed to +sail with his father. As for Havelok, he had waked once, and had well eaten, +and now was sleeping again. +</p> + +<p> +Then said Withelm, “When will the sacrifice to Aegir and Ran<a href="#fn5" +name="fnref5"><sup>[5]</sup></a> for luck on the swan’s path be?” +</p> + +<p> +“Scant time have we for that,” my father said, “for tide will not wait.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said the boy, “it were well to take the stone altar with us, and make +sacrifice on board. I have heard that Aegir is wrathful and strong.” +</p> + +<p> +Then my father said to Leva, “The boy is right in one thing, and that is, that +if we are to make a new home beyond the sea, the blue stones that have belonged +to our family since time untold should go with us, else will there be no luck +in this flitting.” +</p> + +<p> +“What matter?” +</p> + +<p> +“West they came with us in the days of Odin, and west they shall go with us +once more,” my father said. +</p> + +<p> +And there was an end of question on the matter, for presently Arngeir came up +with the team of oxen and a sled, and my father hastily cried to Thor as in +time of sudden war, and then on the sled they loaded the stones easily. I +helped, and it is certain that they were no trouble to uproot or lift, though +they were bedded in the ground and heavy. Wherefrom we all thought that the +flitting was by the will of the Norns, and likely to turn out well. +</p> + +<p> +But in no way could we lift Thor himself. It was as if he were rooted, and +maybe he was so. Therefore we left him, but sadly. +</p> + +<p> +One may suppose that, had any noticed that Grim was taking these sacred things +with him, there would have been a talk; but as we sailed light, none thought +them aught but needed ballast; and we brought other stones to the ship with +them and afterwards. +</p> + +<p> +Of course folk did wonder at this sudden sailing of ours, but my father made no +secret of his wish to get out of the way of Hodulf, who had taken the ships of +one or two other men elsewhere, so that all thought he feared that his would be +the next to be seized, and deemed him prudent in going. As for our own crew, +they were told that it was certain that the ship would be taken unless we went +on this tide, and so they worked well. +</p> + +<p> +Very early in the morning, and unseen, Arngeir had brought Eleyn, the queen, on +board, and she was in the cabin under the raised after deck all the while that +the bustle of making ready was going on. Only my father went in there at any +time, unless he gave the key to one of us, for there he kept his valuables and +the arms. +</p> + +<p> +Presently, when all the men were forward and busy, I got Havelok on board +unnoticed. We had kept Withelm running to and fro from ship to house with +little burdens all the morning, mightily busy; and then, when the chance came, +Havelok in Withelm’s clothes, and with a bundle on his head, came running to +me. I waited by the after cabin, and I opened the door quickly and let him in. +Then he saw his mother; and how those two met, who had thought each other lost +beyond finding, I will not try to say. +</p> + +<p> +I closed the door softly and left them, locking it again, and found Withelm +close to me, and Arngeir watching to see that all went well. +</p> + +<p> +Soon after that there came a Norseman, dressed as a merchant, who talked with +my father of goods, and lading, and whither he was bound, and the like. When he +went away, he thought that he had found out that we were for the Texel, but I +do not know that he was from Hodulf. There had been time for him to send a spy +in haste, however, if he wished to watch us; but at any rate this man heard +naught of our charges. +</p> + +<p> +Then, at the last moment, my mother and the children came on board, and at once +we hauled out of the harbour. I mind that an old woman ran along the wharf when +she found that all were going, and cried that Dame Leva had not paid for +certain fowls bought of her; and my father laughed in lightness of heart, and +threw her a silver penny, so that she let us go with a blessing. And after that +it did not matter what the people thought of this going of ours, for in an hour +we were far at sea with a fair wind on the quarter, heading south at first, +that the Norseman might see us, but when the land was dim astern, and there was +no more fear, bearing away south and west for the Humber in far-off England. +</p> + +<p> +Now that was the last I saw of Denmark for many a long year, and I knew it must +be so. But, as I have told, none but my father and mother, and now Arngeir, +knew all that we were carrying with us. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap04">CHAPTER IV.<br/> +ACROSS THE SWAN’S PATH.</a></h2> + +<p> +All that night, and during the morning of the next day, we sailed steadily with +a fresh northwest breeze that bade fair to strengthen by-and-by. If it held, we +should see the cliffs of Northumbria on our bow tomorrow morning, and then +would run down the coast to the Humber, where my father meant to put in first. +He thought to leave the queen and Havelok with merchants whom he knew in +Lindsey, and with them would stay my mother and the little ones while he made a +trading voyage elsewhere. There would be time enough to find out the best place +in which to make a home when the autumn came, and after he had been to an +English port or two that he did not know yet. +</p> + +<p> +When half the morning was past, the sun shone out warmly, and all came on deck +from the after cabin, where the ladies and children were. Our men knew by this +time that we had passengers, flying like ourselves from Hodulf, and therefore +they were not at all surprised to see Havelok and his mother with their +mistress. None of them had ever seen either of them before, as it happened, +though I do not think that any could have recognized the queen as she was then, +wan and worn with the terror of her long hiding. Very silent was she as she sat +on deck gazing ever at the long white wake of the ship that seemed to stretch +for a little way towards Denmark, only to fade away as a track over which one +may never go back. And silent, too, was my mother; but the children, who had no +care, were pleased with all things, and Raven and I were full of the ways of +old seamen. +</p> + +<p> +So everything went quietly until after we had our midday meal. We were all +amidships on the wide deck, except my father and Arngeir, who sat side by side +on the steersman’s bench on the high poop. There was no spray coming on board, +for we were running, and the ship was very steady. Raven and I were forward +with the men, busy with the many little things yet to be done to the rigging +and such like that had been left in the haste at last, and there was no thought +but that this quiet, save for some shift of wind maybe, would last until we saw +the English shore. +</p> + +<p> +Now I do not know if my father had seen aught from the after deck, but +presently he came forward, and passed up the steps to the forecastle, and there +sat down on the weather rail, looking out to leeward for some time quietly. I +thought that maybe he had sighted some of the high land on the Scots coast, for +it was clear enough to see very far, and so I went to see also. But there was +nothing, and we talked of this and that for ten minutes, when he said, “Look +and see if you can catch sight of aught on the skyline just aft of the fore +stay as you sit.” +</p> + +<p> +I looked long, and presently caught sight of something white that showed for a +moment as we heaved up on a wave, and then was gone. +</p> + +<p> +“Somewhat I saw,” I said, “but it has gone. It might have been the top of a +sail.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I caught a glimpse of it again, and my father saw it also, and, as we +watched, it hove up slowly until it was plain to be seen. The vessel it +belonged to was sailing in such a way as to cross our course in the end, though +she was only a few points nearer the wind than we were. It seemed that she was +swifter than ourselves, too, from the way she kept her place on our bow. Now a +merchant must needs look on every sail with more or less distrust, as there is +always a chance of meeting with ship-plundering Vikings, though the best of +them will do naught but take toll from a trader on the high seas. So before +long all our men were watching the stranger, and soon it was plain that she was +a longship, fresh from her winter quarters. We thought, therefore, that she was +not likely to trouble about us, having no need of stores as yet, and we being +plainly in ballast only. Nor did she alter her course in any way, but mile +after mile she sailed with us, always edging up nearer as she went, until at +last we could see the men on her bows and the helmsman at his place. +</p> + +<p> +I thought that one could hardly see a more handsome ship than she was, fresh +with new paint, and with her dragon head shining golden in the sun. But I had +seen her before, and that in no pleasant way. She was the ship of which I have +already spoken—that which we beat off two years ago, taking their cargo of +plunder by way of amends for being attacked. +</p> + +<p> +There was this difference, however, at that time, that then we had all our men +on board, and the Viking was short-handed after a fighting raid, whereas now we +had but fifteen men instead of five-and-twenty, because in the hurry we had not +had time to summon any who lived beyond the town, and it was plain that the +Viking had a full crew, maybe of sixty men. +</p> + +<p> +“It is in my mind,” my father said to Arngeir, “that our old foe will think +twice before he attacks us again; but seeing whom we have to deal with, it is +as well to be ready. We might keep him off with arrows, if he does not find out +how few we are, should he make an attempt on us; but if he boards, we must +submit, and make the best bargain we can.” +</p> + +<p> +So he passed word that the men were to lie down on deck, leaving only a few to +be seen, that the Viking might think us as he had known us before; and then the +arms-chests were opened, and the bows and throwing weapons were set to hand by +us boys while the men armed themselves. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father spoke to them, saying, “I do not know if this Viking will pass +us by as too hard a nut to crack, seeing that he knows of us already; but if he +does not, it will be of no use our trying to fight him, as you can see. I would +not waste your lives for naught. But it may be that a show of force will keep +him off, so we will wait under arms until we are sure what he will do.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the men broke out, saying that they had beaten this man before with him as +leader, and they were in no mind to give up without a fight. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then,” my father answered, “it is plain that you will back me, and so I +will call on you if there is need or chance. But we have the women folk to +think of now, and we must not risk aught.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the longship held on her course steadily, never shifting her helm for so +much as a point. In half an hour or so we must be alongside one another, at +this rate, and that Arngeir did not altogether like the look of, for it would +seem as if she meant to find out all about us at least. There was some little +sea running, and it might be thought easier to board us on the lee side, +therefore. We could not get away from her in any way, for even now, while she +was closer hauled than we, she kept pace with us, and had she paid off to the +same course as ourselves, she would have left us astern in a very short time. +</p> + +<p> +Presently a man swarmed up her rigging in order to look down on our decks, and +as he went up, my father bade our men crawl over to windward, so that he should +see all one gunwale lined with men, and so think that both were, and deem that +we were setting a trap for them in order to entice them alongside by pretending +to be hardly manned. At the same time, he sent the ladies and children into the +cabin, so that they might not be seen. +</p> + +<p> +That did not please Havelok at all, for he seemed to scent a fight in the air, +and wanted weapons, that he might stand beside the other men, asking for an axe +for choice. It was all that I could do to quiet him by saying that if there was +any need of him I would call him, but that just now we thought the Vikings +would go away if they saw many warriors on deck. Which indeed was all that we +hoped, but he thought that would spoil sport, and so hastened into the shelter. +</p> + +<p> +After that there fell a silence on us, for at any moment now we might be hailed +by the other ship. And when we were but a bow shot apart the hail came. The two +vessels were then broadside on to each other, we a little ahead, if anything. +My father was steering now, fully armed, and Arngeir was beside him with +myself. I had the big shield wherewith one guards the helmsman if arrows are +flying. +</p> + +<p> +The Viking bade us strike sail, and let him come alongside, but my father made +no answer. Still we held on, and the Viking paid off a little, as though he +were not so sure if it were wise to fall on us, as we showed no fear of him. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father spoke to Arngeir in a stern voice that I had heard only when we +met this same ship before. +</p> + +<p> +“This will not last long. If there is one chance for us, it is to run him down +and it may be done. Our ship will stand the blow, for these longships are but +eggshells beside her. Pass the word for the men to shoot the steersman when I +give the word. Then they must run forward, lest the Vikings climb over the bows +as we strike her.” +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir’s eyes flashed at that, and at once he went to the men, and there was a +click and rattle as the arrows went to string, and they gathered themselves +together in readiness to leap up when the word came. There seemed every chance +that we should be upon the longship before they knew what we were about, for we +had the weather gauge. +</p> + +<p> +Now the Viking hailed again, and again bore up for us a little, whereat my +father smiled grimly, for it helped his plan. And this time, as there was no +answer, his men sent an arrow or two on board, which did no harm. +</p> + +<p> +“It is plain that we are to be taken,” my father said on that, “so we will wait +no longer. Stand by, men, and one lucky shot will do all. Shoot!” +</p> + +<p> +The helm went up as he spoke, and the men leaped to their feet, raining arrows +round the two men who were at the helm, and down on the Viking we swept with a +great cheer. +</p> + +<p> +But in a moment there were four men on her after deck, and whether the first +helmsman was shot I cannot say; but I think not, for quickly as we had borne +down on her she was ready, rushing away from us, instead of luffing helplessly, +as we had expected. It would almost have seemed that our move had been looked +for. +</p> + +<p> +Ten more minutes passed while we exchanged arrow flights, and then the longship +had so gained on us that she struck sail and waited for us with her long oars +run out and ready. +</p> + +<p> +“That is all we can do,” said my father, with a sort of groan. “Put up your +weapons, men, for it is no good fighting now.” +</p> + +<p> +They did so, growling; and as we neared the longship, her oars took the water, +and she flew alongside of us, and a grappling hook flung deftly from her bows +caught our after gunwale, and at once she dropped astern, and swung to its +chain as to a tow line. We were not so much as bidden to strike sail now, and +the Vikings began to crowd forward in order to board us by the stern, as the +grappling chain was hove short by their windlass. +</p> + +<p> +“Hold on,” my father cried to them “we give up. Where is your chief?” +</p> + +<p> +Now the men were making way for him when a strange thing happened. Out of the +after cabin ran Havelok when he heard that word, crying that it was not the +part of good warriors to give up while they could wield sword—words that surely +he had learned from Gunnar, his father. And after him came his mother, silent, +and terrified lest he should be harmed. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok ran up the steps to my father, and the queen followed. I have said that +there was a little sea running, and this made the ships jerk and strain at the +chain that held them together fiercely, now that it was so short. And even as +the queen came to the top step, where there was no rail, for the steps were not +amidships, but alongside the gunwale, one of these jerks came; and in a moment +she was in the sea, and in a moment also Arngeir was after her, for he was a +fine swimmer. +</p> + +<p> +The Vikings cried out as they saw this, but the poor queen said no word, nor +did she ever rise again after the first time. It is likely that she was drawn +under the longship at once. +</p> + +<p> +So for a little while there was no talk of terms or fighting, but all held +their breath as they watched to see if the queen floated alongside anywhere; +but there was only Arngeir, who swam under the lee of the Viking, and called to +her men for guidance. They threw him a rope’s end as he came to the stern, and +he clung to it for a little while, hoping to see the flash of a white hood that +the queen wore, over the white wave crests: but at last he gave up, and the +Vikings hauled him on board, praising him for his swimming, as he had on his +mail. +</p> + +<p> +Then the chief turned to my father, and spoke to him across the few fathoms of +water that were between the ships. +</p> + +<p> +“We meet again, Grim, as time comes round; and now I have a mind to let you go, +though I have that old grudge against you, for I think that your wife is loss +enough.” +</p> + +<p> +“Not my wife, Arnvid, but a passenger—one whom I would not have lost for all +that you can take from me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I am glad it is no worse. But it seems that you are in ballast. How +comes it that you have no cargo for me, for you owe me one?” +</p> + +<p> +Then my father told him shortly that he had fled from Hodulf; and all those +doings were news to the Viking, so that they talked in friendly wise, while the +men listened, and the ships crept on together down the wind. +</p> + +<p> +But when all was told, save of the matter of Havelok, and who the lost lady +was, the Viking laughed shortly, and said, “Pleasant gossip, Grim, but not +business. What will you give us to go away in peace? I do not forget that you +all but ran us down just now, and that one or two of us have arrows sticking in +us which came from your ship. But that first was a good bit of seamanship, and +there is not much harm from the last.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said my father, “it seems to me that you owe me a ship, for it is +certain that I once had that one, and gave her back to you.” +</p> + +<p> +The Viking laughed. +</p> + +<p> +“True enough, and therefore I give you back your ship now, and we are quits. +But I am coming on board to see what property I can lift.” +</p> + +<p> +My father shrugged his shoulders, and turned away, and at once the Vikings +hauled on the chain until their dragon head was against our quarter, when the +chief and some twenty of his men came on board. The way in which they took off +the hatches without staying to question where they should begin told a tale of +many a like plundering. +</p> + +<p> +Then, I do not know how it was rightly, for I was aft with my father, there +began a quarrel between the Vikings and our men; and though both Grim and the +chief tried to stop it, five of our few were slain outright, and three more +badly hurt before it was ended. The rest of our crew took refuge on the fore +deck, and there bided after that. The whole fray was over in a few minutes, and +it seemed that the Vikings half expected somewhat of the sort. +</p> + +<p> +Then they took all the linen and woollen goods, and our spare sails, and all +the arms and armour from the men and from the chests to their own ship. Only +they left my father and Arngeir their war gear, saying that it were a shame to +disarm two brave men. +</p> + +<p> +Then the chief said, “Little cargo have you, friend Grim, and therefore I am +the more sure that you have store of money with you. Even flight from Hodulf +would not prevent you from taking that wherewith to trade. So I must have it; +and it rests with you whether we tear your ship to splinters in hunting for +your hiding place or not.” +</p> + +<p> +“I suppose there is no help for it, but I will say that the most of what I have +is not mine,” said my father. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, what matter? When one gives gold into the hands of a seafarer, one has to +reckon with such chances as this. You must needs hand it over.” +</p> + +<p> +So, as there was naught else to do, Grim brought out the jarl’s heavy bag, and +gave it to the chief, who whistled to himself as he hefted it. +</p> + +<p> +“Grim,” he said, “for half this I would have let you go without sending a man +on board. What is this foolishness? You must have known that.” +</p> + +<p> +“The gold is not mine,” my father answered; “it was my hope that you would have +been content with the cargo.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I have met with an honest man for once,” the Viking said; and he called +his men, and they cast off and left us. +</p> + +<p> +But we were in no happy plight when he had gone away to the eastward on his old +course. Half our men were gone, for the wounded were of no use, and the loss of +the queen weighed heavily on us. And before long it began to blow hard from the +north, and we had to shorten sail before there was real need, lest it should be +too much for us few presently, as it certainly would have been by the time that +darkness fell, for the gale strengthened. +</p> + +<p> +Then, added to all this, there was trouble in the cabin under the after deck, +for since his mother was lost, Havelok had spoken no word. I had brought him +down to my mother from the deck, and had left him with her, hoping that he did +not know what had happened; but now he was in a high fever, and sorely ill. +Perhaps he would have been so in any case, after the long days of Hodulf’s +cruelty, but he had borne them well. A child is apt, however, to give up, as it +were, suddenly. +</p> + +<p> +So, burdened with trouble, we drove before the gale, and the only pleasant +thing was to see how the good ship behaved in it, while at least we were on our +course all the time. Therefore, one could not say that there was any danger; +and but for these other things, none would have thought much of wind or sea, +which were no worse than we had weathered many a time before. We had sea room, +and no lee shore to fear, and the ship was stanch, and no sailor can ask for +more than that. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap05">CHAPTER V.<br/> +STORM AND SHIPWRECK.</a></h2> + +<p> +The gale held without much change through the night, and then with morning +shifted a few points to the westward, which was nothing to complain of. The sea +rose, and a few rain squalls came up and passed; but they had no weight in +them, and did not keep the waves down as a steady fall will. And all day long +it was the same, and the ship fled ever before it. There was no thought now of +reaching any port we might wish, but least of all did we think of making the +Lindsey shore, which lies open to the north and east. When the gale broke, we +must find harbour where we could; and indeed; to my father at this time all +ports were alike, as refuge from Hodulf. When darkness came again one of the +wounded men died, and Havelok was yet ill in the after cabin, so that my mother +was most anxious for him. The plunging ship was no place for a sick child. +</p> + +<p> +Now it was not possible for us to tell how far we had run since we had parted +from the Viking, and all we knew was that we had no shore to fear with the wind +as it was, and therefore nothing but patience was needed. But in the night came +a sudden lull in the gale that told of a change at hand, and in half an hour it +was blowing harder than ever from the northeast, and setting us down to the +English coast fast, for we could do naught but run before such a wind. It +thickened up also, and was very dark even until full sunrise, so that one could +hardly tell when the sun was above the sea’s rim. +</p> + +<p> +I crept from the fore cabin about this time, after trying in vain to sleep, and +found the men sheltering under the break of the deck and looking always to +leeward. Two of them were at the steering oar with my father, for Arngeir was +worn out, and I had left him in the cabin, sleeping heavily in spite of the +noise of waves and straining planking. Maybe he would have waked in a moment +had that turmoil ceased. +</p> + +<p> +It was of no use trying to speak to the men without shouting in their ears, and +getting to windward to do that, moreover, and so I looked round to see if there +was any change coming. But all was grey overhead, and a grey wall of rain and +flying drift from the wave tops was all round us, blotting out all things that +were half a mile from us, if there were anything to be blotted out. It always +seems as if there must be somewhat beyond a thickness of any sort at sea. But +there was one thing that I did notice, and that was that the sea was no longer +grey, as it had been yesterday, but was browner against the cold sky, while the +foam of the following wave crests was surely not so white as it had been, and +at this I wondered. +</p> + +<p> +Then I crawled aft and went to my father and asked him what he thought of the +wind and the chance of its dropping. He had had the lead going for long now. +</p> + +<p> +“We are right off the Humber mouth, to judge by the colour of the water,” he +told me, “or else off the Wash, which is more to the south. I cannot tell which +rightly, for we have run far, and maybe faster than I know. If only one could +see—” +</p> + +<p> +There he stopped, and I knew enough to understand that we were in some peril +unless a shift of wind came very soon, since the shore was under our lee now, +if by good luck we were not carried straight into the great river itself. So +for an hour or more I watched, and all the time it seemed that hope grew less, +for the sea grew shorter, as if against tide, and ever its colour was browner +with the mud of the Trent and her sisters. +</p> + +<p> +Presently, as I clung to the rail, there seemed to grow a new sound over and +amid all those to which I had become used—as it were a low roaring that swelled +up in the lulls, and sank and rose again. And I knew what it was, and held up +my hand to my father, listening, and he heard also. It was the thunder of +breakers on a sandy coast to leeward. +</p> + +<p> +He put his whistle to his lips and called shrilly, and the men saw him if they +could not hear, and sprang up, clawing aft through the water that flooded the +waist along the rail. +</p> + +<p> +“Breakers to leeward, men,” he cried “we must wear ship, and then shall clear +them. We shall be standing right into Humber after that, as I think.” +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir heard the men trampling, if not the whistle, and he was with us +directly, and heard what was to be done. +</p> + +<p> +“It is a chance if the yard stands it,” he said, looking aloft. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, but we cannot chance going about in this sea, and we are too short of men +to lower and hoist again. Listen!” +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir did so, and heard for the first time the growing anger of the surf on +the shore, and had no more doubt. We were then running with the wind on the +port quarter, and it was useless to haul closer to the wind on that tack, +whereas if we could wear safely we should be leaving the shore at once by a +little closer sailing. +</p> + +<p> +“Ran is spreading her nets,” said Arngeir, “but if all holds, she will have no +luck with her fishing.”<a href="#fn6" name="fnref6"><sup>[6]</sup></a> +</p> + +<p> +Then we manned the main sheet and the guys from the great yards, but we were +all too few for the task, which needed every man of the fifteen that we had +sailed with. There was the back stay to be set up afresh on the weather quarter +for the new tack also, and three men must see to that. +</p> + +<p> +We watched my father’s hand for the word, and steadily sheeted home until all +seemed to be going well. But the next moment there was a crash and a cry, and +we were a mastless wreck, drifting helplessly. Maybe some flaw of wind took us +as the head of the great sail went over, but its power was too much for the men +at guys and back stay, and they had the tackle torn through their hands. The +mast snapped six feet above the deck, smashing the gunwales as it fell forward +and overboard, but hurting none of us. +</p> + +<p> +Then a following sea or two broke over the stern, and I was washed from the +poop, for I had been at the sheet, down to the deck, and there saved myself +among the fallen rigging, half drowned. One of the men was washed overboard at +the same time, but a bight of the rigging that was over the side caught him +under the chin, and his mates hauled him on board again by the head, as it +were. He was wont to make a jest of it afterward, saying that he was not likely +to be hanged twice, but he had a wry neck from that day forward. +</p> + +<p> +No more seas came over us, for the wreck over the bows brought us head to wind, +though we shipped a lot of water across the decks as she rolled in the sea. +Then we rode to the drag of the fallen sail for a time, and it seemed quiet now +that there was no noise of wind screaming in rigging above us. But all the +while the thunder of the breakers grew nearer and plainer. +</p> + +<p> +I bided where I was, for the breath was knocked out of me for the moment. I saw +my father lash the helm, and then he and the rest got the two axes that hung by +the cabin door, and came forward with them. The mast was pounding our side in a +way that would start the planking before long, and it must be cut adrift, and +by that time I could join him. +</p> + +<p> +When that was done, and it did not take long, we cleared the anchor and cable +and let go, for it was time. The sound of the surf was drowning all else. But +the anchor held, and the danger was over for the while, and as one might think +altogether; but the tide was running against the gale, and what might happen +when it turned was another matter. +</p> + +<p> +Now we got the sail on deck again, and unlaced it from the yard, setting that +in place with some sort of rigging, ready to be stepped as a mast if the wind +shifted to any point that might help us off shore. +</p> + +<p> +It may be thought how we watched that one cable that held us from the waves and +the place where they broke, for therein lay our only chance, and we longed for +the clear light that comes after rain, that we might see the worst, at least, +if we were to feel it. But the anchor held, and presently we lost the feeling +of a coming terror that had been over us, the utmost peril being past. My +father went to the after cabin now, and though the poor children were bruised +with the heavy rolling of the ship as she came into the wind, they were all +well save Havelok, and he had fallen asleep in my mother’s arms at last. +</p> + +<p> +With the turn of the tide, which came about three hours after midday, the +clouds broke, and slowly the land grew out of the mists until we could see it +plainly, though it was hardly higher than the sea that broke over it in +whirling masses of spindrift. By-and-by we could see far-off hills beyond +wide-stretching marshlands that looked green and rich across yellow sandhills +that fringed the shore. And from them we were not a mile, and at their feet +were such breakers as no ship might win through, though, if we might wait until +they were at rest, the level sand was good for beaching at the neap tides. For +we were well into Humber mouth, and to the northward of us, across the yellow +water, was the long point of Spurn, and the ancient port of Ravenspur, with its +Roman jetties falling into decay under the careless hand of the Saxon, under +its shelter. There was no port on this southern side of the Humber, though +farther south was Tetney Haven and again Saltfleet, to which my father had +been, but neither in nor out of them might a vessel get in a northeast gale. +</p> + +<p> +I have said that this clearness came with the turn of the tide, and now that +began to flow strongly, setting in with the wind with more than its wonted +force, for the northwest shift of the gale had kept it from falling, as it +always will on this coast. That, of course, I learned later, but it makes plain +what happened next. Our anchor began to drag with the weight of both tide and +wind, and that was the uttermost of our dread. +</p> + +<p> +Slowly it tore through its holding, and as it were step by step at first, and +once we thought it stopped when we had paid out all the cable. But wind and sea +were too strong, and presently again we saw the shore marks shifting, and we +knew that there was no hope. The ship must touch the ground sooner or later, +and then the end would come with one last struggle in the surf, and on shore +was no man whose hand might be stretched to drag a spent man to the land, if he +won through. It would have seemed less lonely had one watched us, but I did not +know then that no pity for the wrecked need be looked for from the marshmen of +the Lindsey shore. There was not so much as a fisher’s boat of wicker and skins +in sight on the sandhills, where one might have looked to see some drawn up. +</p> + +<p> +Now my father went to the cabin and told my mother that things were at their +worst, and she was very brave. +</p> + +<p> +“If you are to die at this time, husband,” she said, “it is good that I shall +die with you. Better it is, as I think, than a sickness that comes to one and +leaves the other. But after that you will go to the place of Odin, to Valhalla; +but I whither?” +</p> + +<p> +Then spoke little Withelm, ever thoughtful, and now not at all afraid. +</p> + +<p> +“If Freya wants not a sailor’s wife who is willing to fight the waves with +Grim, my father, it will be strange.” +</p> + +<p> +My mother was wont to say that this saying of the child’s did much to cheer her +at that time, but there is little place for a woman in the old faiths. So she +smiled at him, and that made him bold to speak of what he had surely been +thinking since the storm began. +</p> + +<p> +“I suppose that Aegir is wroth because we made no sacrifice to him before we +set sail. I think that I would cast the altar stones to him, that he may know +that we meant to do so.” +</p> + +<p> +This sounds a child’s thought only, and so it was; but it set my father +thinking, and in the end helped us out of trouble. +</p> + +<p> +“I have heard,” my father said, “that men in our case have thrown overboard the +high-seat pillars, and have followed them to shore safely. We have none, but +the stones are more sacred yet. Overboard they shall go, and as the boat with +them goes through the surf we may learn somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +With that he hastened on deck, and told the men what he would do; and they +thought it a good plan, as maybe they would have deemed anything that seemed to +call for help from the strong ones of the sea. So they got the boat ready to +launch over the quarter, and the four stones, being uncovered since the Vikings +took our cargo, were easily got on deck, and they were placed in the bottom of +the boat, and steadied there with coils of fallen rigging, so that they could +not shift. They were just a fair load for the boat. Then my father cried for +help to the Asir, bidding Aegir take the altar as full sacrifice; and when we +had done so we waited for a chance as a long wave foamed past us, and launched +the boat fairly on its back, so that she seemed to fly from our hands, and was +far astern in a moment. +</p> + +<p> +Now we looked to see her make straight for the breakers, lift on the first of +them, and then capsize. That first line was not a quarter of a mile from us +now. +</p> + +<p> +But she never reached them. She plunged away at first, heading right for the +surf, and then went steadily westward, and up the shore line outside it, until +she was lost to sight among the wild waves, for she was very low in the water. +</p> + +<p> +“Cheer up, men,” my father said, as he saw that; “we are not ashore yet, nor +will be so long as the tide takes that current along shore. We shall stop +dragging directly.” +</p> + +<p> +And so it was, for when the ship slowly came to the place where the boat had +changed her course, the anchor held once more for a while until the gathering +strength of the tide forced it to drag again. Now, however, it was not toward +the shore that we drifted, but up the Humber, as the boat had gone; and as we +went the sea became less heavy, for we were getting into the lee of the Spurn +headland. +</p> + +<p> +Soon the clouds began to break, flying wildly overhead with patches of blue sky +and passing sunshine in between them that gladdened us. The wind worked round +to the eastward at the same time, and we knew that the end of the gale had +come. But, blowing as it did right into the mouth of the river, the sea became +more angry, and it would be worse yet when the tide set again outwards. Already +we had shipped more water than was good, and we might not stand much more. It +seemed best, therefore, to my father that we should try to run as far up the +Humber as we might while we had the chance, for the current that held us safe +might change as tide altered in force and depth. +</p> + +<p> +So we buoyed the cable, not being able to get the anchor in this sea, and then +stepped the yard in the mast’s place, and hoisted the peak of the sail +corner-wise as best we might; and that was enough to heel us almost gunwale +under as the cable was slipped and the ship headed about up the river mouth. We +shipped one or two more heavy seas as she paid off before the wind, but we were +on the watch for them, and no harm was done. +</p> + +<p> +After that the worst was past, for every mile we flew over brought us into +safer waters; and now we began to wonder where the boat with its strange cargo +had gone, and we looked out for her along the shore as we sailed, and at last +saw her, though it was a wonder that we did so. +</p> + +<p> +The tide had set her into a little creek that opened out suddenly, and there +Arngeir saw her first, aground on a sandbank, with the lift of each wave that +crept into the haven she had found sending her higher on it. And my father +cried to us that we had best follow her; and he put the helm over, while we +sheeted home and stood by for the shock of grounding. +</p> + +<p> +Then in a few minutes we were in a smother of foam across a little sand bar, +and after that in quiet water, and the sorely-tried ship was safe. She took the +ground gently enough in the little creek, not ten score paces from where the +boat was lying, and we were but an arrow flight from the shore. As the tide +rose the ship drifted inward toward it, so that we had to wait only for the ebb +that we might go dry shod to the land. +</p> + +<p> +Before that time came there was rest for us all, and we needed it sorely. It +was a wonder that none of the children had been hurt in the wild tossing of the +ship, but children come safely through things that would be hard on a man. +Bruised they were and very hungry, but somehow my mother had managed to steady +them on the cabin floor, and they were none the worse, only Havelok slept even +yet with a sleep that was too heavy to be broken by the worst of the tossing as +he lay in my mother’s lap. She could not tell if this heavy sleep was good or +not. +</p> + +<p> +Then we saw to the wounded men, and thereafter slept in the sun or in the fore +cabin as each chose, leaving Arngeir only on watch. It was possible that the +shore folk would be down to the strand soon, seeking for what the waves might +have sent them, and the tide must be watched also. +</p> + +<p> +Just before its turn he woke us, for it was needful that we should get a line +ashore to prevent the ship from going out with the ebb, and with one I swam +ashore. There was not so much as a stump to which to make fast, and so one of +the men followed me, and we went to the boat, set the altar stones carefully +ashore, then fetched the spare anchor, and moored her with that in a place +where the water seemed deep to the bank. +</p> + +<p> +It was a bad place. For when the tide fell, which it did very fast, we found +that we had put her on a ledge. Presently therefore, and while we were trying +to bail out the water that was in her, the ship took the ground aft, and we +could not move her before the worst happened. Swiftly the tide left her, and +her long keel bent and twisted, and her planks gaped with the strain of her own +weight, all the greater for the water yet in her that flowed to the hanging +bows. The good ship might sail no more. Her back was broken. +</p> + +<p> +That was the only time that I have ever seen my father weep. But as the stout +timbers cracked and groaned under the strain it seemed to him as if the ship +that he loved was calling piteously to him for help that he could not give, and +it was too much for him. The gale that was yet raging overhead and the sea that +was still terrible in the wide waters of the river had been things that had not +moved him, for that the ship should break up in a last struggle with them was, +as it were, a fitting end for her. But that by his fault here in the hardly-won +haven she should meet her end was not to be borne, and he turned away from us +and wept. +</p> + +<p> +Then came my mother and set her hand on his shoulder and spoke softly to him +with wise words. +</p> + +<p> +“Husband, but a little while ago it would have been wonderful if there were one +of us left alive, or one plank of the ship on another. And now we are all safe +and unhurt, and the loss of the ship is the least of ills that might have +been.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, wife,” he said; “you cannot understand.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then it is woe for the—for the one who is with us. But how had it been if you +had seen Hodulf and his men round our house, and all the children slain that +one might not escape, while on the roof crowed the red cock, and naught was +left to us? We have lost less than if we had stayed for that, and we have +gained what we sought, even safety. See, to the shore have come the ancient +holy things of our house, and that not by your guidance. Surely here shall be +the place for us that is best.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, wife; you are right in all these things, but it is not for them.” +</p> + +<p> +Then she laughed a little, forcing herself to do so, as it seemed. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, it is for the ship that I was ever jealous of, for she took you +away from me. Now I think that I should be glad that she can do so no more. But +I am not, for well I know what the trouble must be, and I would have you think +no more of it. The good ship has saved us all, and so her work is done, and +well done. Never, if she sailed many a long sea mile with you, would anything +be worth telling of her besides this. And the burden of common things would +surely be all unmeet for her after what she has borne hither.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is well said, Leva, my wife,” my father answered. +</p> + +<p> +From that time he was cheerful, and told us how it was certain that we had been +brought here for good, seeing that the Norns<a href="#fn7" +name="fnref7"><sup>[7]</sup></a> must have led the stones to the haven, so that +this must be the place that we sought. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap06">CHAPTER VI.<br/> +THE BEGINNING OF GRIMSBY TOWN.</a></h2> + +<p> +Easily we went ashore when the tide fell, across the spits of sand that ran +between the mud banks, and we climbed the low sandhill range that hid the land +from us, and saw the place where we should bide. And it might have been worse; +for all the level country between us and the hills was fat, green meadow and +marsh, on which were many cattle and sheep feeding. Here and there were groves +of great trees, hemmed in with the quickset fences that are as good as +stockades for defence round the farmsteads of the English folk, and on other +patches of rising ground were the huts of thralls or herdsmen, and across the +wide meadows glittered and flashed streams and meres, above which the wildfowl +that the storm had driven inland wheeled in clouds. All the lower hills seemed +to be wooded thickly, and the alder copses that would shelter boar and deer and +maybe wolves stretched in some places thence across the marsh. Pleasant and +homely seemed all this after long looking at the restless sea. +</p> + +<p> +Then said my father, “Now am I no longer Grim the merchant, and that pride of +mine is at an end. But here is a place where Grim the fisher may do well +enough, if I am any judge of shore and sea. Here have we haven for the boats, +and yonder swim the fish, and inland are the towns that need them. Nor have we +seen a sign of a fisher so far as we have come.” +</p> + +<p> +Now we had been seen as soon as we stood on the sandhills; and before long the +herdsman and thralls began to gather to us, keeping aloof somewhat at first, as +if fearing my father’s arms. But when we spoke with them we could learn +nothing, for they were Welsh marshmen who knew but little of the tongue of +their English masters. Serfs they were now in these old fastnesses of theirs to +the English folk of the Lindiswaras, who had won their land and called it after +their own name, Lindsey. +</p> + +<p> +But before long there rode from one of the farmsteads an Englishman of some +rank, who had been sent for, as it would seem, and he came with half a dozen +armed housecarls behind him to see what was going on. Him we could understand +well enough, for there is not so much difference between our tongue and that of +the English; and when he learned our plight he was very kindly. His name was +Witlaf Stalling, and he was the great man of these parts, being lord over many +a mile of the marsh and upland, and dwelling at his own place, Stallingborough, +some five miles to the north and inland hence. +</p> + +<p> +Now it had been in this man’s power to seize us and all we had as his own, +seeing that we were cast on his shore; but he treated us as guests rather, +bidding us shelter in one of his near farmsteads as long as we would, and +telling my father to come and speak with him when we had saved what we could +from the wreck. He bade the thralls help at that also, so that we had fallen in +with a friend, and our troubles were less for his kindness. +</p> + +<p> +We saved what cargo we had left during the next few days, while we dwelt at the +farm. Then at the height of the spring tides the ship broke up, for a second +gale came before the sea that the last had raised was gone. And then I went +with my father to speak with Witlaf the thane at Stallingborough, that we might +ask his leave to make our home on the little haven, and there become fishers +once more. +</p> + +<p> +That he granted readily, asking many questions about our troubles, for he +wondered that one who had owned so good a ship seemed so content to become a +mere fisher in a strange land, without thought of making his way home. But all +that my father told him was that he had had to fly from the new king of our +land, and that he had been a fisher before, so that there was no hardship in +the change. +</p> + +<p> +“Friend Grim,” said Witlaf when he had heard this, “you are a brave man, as it +seems to me, and well may you prosper here, as once before. I will not stand in +your way. Now, if you will hold it from me on condition of service in any time +of war, to be rendered by yourself and your sons and any men you may hire, I +will grant you what land you will along the coast, so that none may question +you in anything. Not that the land is worth aught to any but a fisher who needs +a place for boats and nets; but if you prosper, others will come to the place, +and you shall be master.” +</p> + +<p> +One could hardly have sought so much as that, and heartily did we thank the +kindly thane, gladly taking the fore shore as he wished. But he said that he +thought the gain was on his side, seeing what men he had won. +</p> + +<p> +“Now we must call the place by a name, for it has none,” he said, laughing. +“Grim’s Stead, maybe?” +</p> + +<p> +“Call the place a town at once,” answered my father, laughing also. “Grimsby +has a good sound to a homeless man.” +</p> + +<p> +So Grimsby the place has been from that day forward, and, as I suppose, will be +now to the end of time. But for a while there was only the one house that we +built of the timbers and planks of our ship by the side of the haven—a good +house enough for a fisher and his family, but not what one would look for from +the name. +</p> + +<p> +By the time that was built Havelok was himself again, though he had been near +to his death. Soon he waxed strong and rosy in the sea winds, and out-went +Withelm both in stature and strength. But it seemed that of all that had +happened he remembered naught, either of the storm, or of his mother’s death, +or of the time of Hodulf. My mother thought that the sickness had taken away +his memory, and that it might come back in time. But from the day we came to +the house on the shore he was content to call Grim and Leva father and mother, +and ourselves were his brothers, even as he will hold us even now. Yet my +father would never take him with us to the fishing, as was right, seeing who he +was and what might lie before him. Nor did he ever ask to go, as we had asked +since we were able to climb into the boat as she lay on the shore; and we who +knew not who he was, and almost forgot how he came to us, ceased to wonder at +this after a while; and it seemed right that he should be the home-stayer, as +if there must needs be one in every household. +</p> + +<p> +Nevertheless he was always the foremost in all our sports, loving the weapon +play best of all, so that it was no softness that kept him from the sea. I hold +that the old saw that says, “What is bred in the bone cometh out in the flesh,” +is true, and never truer than in the ways of Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +For it is not to be thought that because my father went back perforce to the +fisher’s calling he forgot that the son of Gunnar Kirkeban should be brought up +always in such wise that when the time came he should be ready to go to the +slayer of his father, sword in hand, and knowing how to use it. Therefore both +Havelok and we were trained always in the craft of the warrior. +</p> + +<p> +Witlaf the thane was right when he said that men would draw to the place if we +prospered, and it was not so long before the name that had been a jest at first +was so no longer. Truly we had hard times at first, for our one ship’s boat was +all unfitted for the fishing; but the Humber teemed with fish, and there were +stake nets to be set that need no boat. None seemed to care for taking the fish +but ourselves, for the English folk had no knowledge of the riches to be won +from the sea, and the eels of the river were the best that they ever saw. So +they were very ready to buy, and soon the name of Grim the fisher was known far +and wide in Lindsey, for my father made great baskets of the willows of the +marsh, and carried his burden of fish through the land, alone at first, until +we were able to help him, while Arngeir and we minded the nets. +</p> + +<p> +Only two of our men stayed here with us, being fishers and old comrades of my +father. The rest he bade find their way home to Denmark to their wives and +children, from the Northumbrian coast, or else take service with the king, +Ethelwald, who ruled in East Anglia, beyond the Wash, who, being a Dane by +descent from the Jutes who took part with Angles and Saxons in winning this new +land, was glad to have Danish men for his housecarls. Some went to him, and +were well received there, as we knew long afterwards. +</p> + +<p> +The man who had been washed overboard and hauled back at risk of his neck was +one of these. His name was Mord, and he would have stayed with us; but my +father thought it hard that he should not have some better chance than we could +give him here, for it was not easy to live at first. Somewhat of the same kind +he said to Arngeir, for he had heard of this king when he had been in the +king’s new haven in the Wash some time ago. But Arngeir would by no means leave +the uncle who had been as a father to him. +</p> + +<p> +Now when we marked out the land that Witlaf gave us, there was a good omen. My +father set the four blue altar stones at each corner of the land as the +boundaries, saying that thus they would hallow all the place, rather than make +an altar again of them here where there was no grove to shelter them, or, +indeed, any other spot that was not open, where a holy place might be. And when +we measured the distances between them a second time they were greater than at +first, which betokens the best of luck to him whose house is to be there. I +suppose that they will bide in these places now while Grimsby is a town, for, +as every one knows, it is unlucky to move a boundary stone. +</p> + +<p> +Soon my father found a man who had some skill in the shipwright’s craft, and +brought him to our place from Saltfleet. Then we built as good a boat as one +could wish, and, not long after that, another. But my father was careful that +none of the Lindsey folk whom he had known should think that this fisher was +the Grim whom they had once traded with, lest word should go to Hodulf in any +way. +</p> + +<p> +Now we soon hired men to help us, and the fishing throve apace. We carried the +fish even to the great city of Lincoln, where Alsi the Lindsey king had his +court, though it was thirty miles away. For we had men in the villages on the +road who took the great baskets on from one to another, and always Grim and one +of us were there on the market day, and men said that never had the town and +court seen such fish as Grim’s before. Soon, therefore, he was rich, for a +fisher; and that was heard of by other fishers from far off, and they drew to +Grimsby, so that the town spread, and Witlaf the good thane said that it was a +lucky day which drove us to his shore, for he waxed rich with dues that they +were willing to pay. We built boats and let them out to these men, so that one +might truly say that all the fishery was Grim’s. +</p> + +<p> +Then a trading ship put in, hearing of the new haven, and that was a great day +for us. But her coming made my father anxious, since Hodulf was likely to seek +for news of Grim the merchant from any who had been to England; and hearing at +last of him, he would perhaps be down on us, Vikingwise, with fire and sword. +But after that traders came and went, and we heard naught of him except we +asked for news; for he left us in peace, if he knew that his enemy lived yet. +Men said that he was not much loved in Denmark. +</p> + +<p> +So the town grew, and well did we prosper, so that there is naught to be said +of any more trouble, which is what my story seems to be made up of so far. Yet +we had come well through all at last; and that, I suppose, is what makes the +tale of any man worth hearing. +</p> + +<p> +Twelve years went all well thus, and in those years Havelok came to manhood, +though not yet to his full strength. What that would be in a few more summers +none could tell, for he was already almost a giant in build and power, so that +he could lift and carry at once the four great fish baskets, which we bore one +at a time when full of fish, easily, and it was he who could get a stranded +boat afloat when we could hardly move her between us, though all three of us +were strong as we grew up. +</p> + +<p> +Very handsome was Havelok also, and, like many very strong men, very quiet. And +all loved him, from the children who played along the water’s edge to the +oldest dame in the town; for he had a good word for all, and there was not one +in the place whom he had not helped at one time or another. More than one there +was who owed him life—either his own, or that of a child saved from the water. +</p> + +<p> +Most of all Havelok loved my father; and once, when he was about eighteen, he +took it into his head that he was burdensome to him by reason of his great +growth. So nothing would satisfy him but that he must go with us to the +fishing, though it was against Grim’s will somewhat. But he could make no hand +at it, seeing that he could pull any two of us round if he took an oar, and +being as likely as not to break that moreover. Nor could he bear the quiet of +the long waiting at the drift nets, when hour after hour of the night goes by +in silence before the herring shoal comes in a river of blue and silver and the +buoys sink with its weight; rather would he be at the weapon play with the sons +of Witlaf, our friend, who loved him. +</p> + +<p> +But though the fishing was not for him, after a while he would not be idle, +saying, when my father tried to persuade him to trouble not at all about our +work, that it was no shame for a man to work, but, rather, that he should not +do so. So one day he went to the old Welsh basket maker who served us, and bade +him make a great basket after his own pattern, the like of which the old man +had never so much as thought of. +</p> + +<p> +“Indeed, master,” he said, when it was done, “you will never be able to carry +so great a load of fish as that will hold.” +</p> + +<p> +“Let us see,” quoth Havelok, laughing; and with that he put him gently into it, +and lifted him into the air, and on to his mighty shoulder, carrying him +easily, and setting him down in safety. +</p> + +<p> +The basket maker was cross at first, but none was able to be angry with Havelok +long, and he too began to smile. +</p> + +<p> +“It is ‘curan’ that you are, master,” he said; “not even Arthur himself could +have done that.” +</p> + +<p> +“Many times have I heard your folk call me that. I would learn what it means,” +said Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +But the old man could hardly find the English word for the name, which means “a +wonder,” and nothing more. Nevertheless the marsh folk were wont to call their +friend “Hablok Curan” in their talk, for a wonder he was to all who knew him. +</p> + +<p> +So he came home with his great basket, and said, “Here sit I by the fire, +eating more than my share, and helping to win it not at all. Now will I make +amends, for I will go the fisher’s rounds through the marshlands with my +basket, and I think that I shall do well.” +</p> + +<p> +Now my father tried to prevent him doing this, because, as I know now, it was +not work for a king’s son. But Havelok would not be denied. +</p> + +<p> +“Fat and idle am I, and my muscles need hardening,” he said. “Let me go, +father, for I was restless at home.” +</p> + +<p> +So from that time he went out into the marshland far and wide, and the people +grew to know and love him well. Always he came back with his fish sold, and +gave money and full account to my father, and mostly the account would end +thus: +</p> + +<p> +“Four fish also there were more, but the burden was heavy, and so I even gave +them to a certain old dame.” +</p> + +<p> +And my mother would say, “It is likely that the burden was lighter for her +blessing.” +</p> + +<p> +And, truly, if the love of poor folk did help, Havelok’s burden weighed naught, +great though it was. +</p> + +<p> +Yet we thought little of the blessings of the Welsh folk of the marsh in those +days, for they blessed not in the names of the Asir, being sons of the British +Christians of long ago, and many, as I think, Christians yet. Witlaf and all +the English folk were Odin’s men, as we were, having a temple at the place +called Thor’s Way, among the hills. But we had naught to do with the faith of +the thralls, which was not our business. Only Withelm was curious in the +matter, and was wont to ask them thereof at times, though at first they feared +to tell him anything, seeing how the Saxons and English had treated the +Christian folk at their first coming. But that was forgotten now, by the +English at least, and times were quiet for these poor folk. There was a wise +man, too, of their faith, who lived in the wild hills not far from the city, +and they were wont to go to him for advice if they needed it. They said also +that the king of Lindsey had once been a Christian, for he was Welsh by birth +on his mother’s side, and had been so brought up. It is certain that his sister +Orwenna, who married Ethelwald of East Anglia, was one, but I have seen Alsi +the king at the feasts of the Asir at Thor’s Way when Yuletide was kept, so it +is not so certain about him. He had many Welsh nobles about him at the court, +kinsmen of his mother mostly, so that it did not seem strange, though there is +not much love lost between the English and the folk whom they conquered, as one +might suppose. +</p> + +<p> +Now, as I have said, none but Withelm thought twice about these things; but in +the end the love of the marsh folk was a thing that was needed, and that +Withelm had learned somewhat of their faith was the greatest help that could +be, as will be seen. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap07">CHAPTER VII.<br/> +BROTHERHOOD.</a></h2> + +<p> +True are the words of the Havamal, the song of the wisdom of Odin, which say, +“One may know and no other, but all men know if three know.” +</p> + +<p> +Therefore for all these years my father told none of us the secret of Havelok’s +birth; and when Arngeir married my sister Solva he made him take oath that he +would not tell what he knew to her, while she, being but a child at the time of +the flight, had forgotten how this well-loved brother of hers came to us. But +it happened once that Grim was sick, and it seemed likely that he would die, so +that this secret weighed on him, and he did not rightly know what to do for the +best, Havelok at the time being but seventeen, and the time that he should +think of his own place not being yet come. At that time he told Arngeir all +that he foresaw, and set things in order, that we three should not be backward +when need was. +</p> + +<p> +He called us to him, Havelok not being present, and spoke to us. +</p> + +<p> +“Sons,” he said, “well have you all obeyed me all these years, and I think that +you will listen to me now, for I must speak to you of Havelok, who came to us +as you know. Out of his saving from his foes came our flight here; and I will +not find fault with any of the things that happened, for they have turned out +well, save that it seems that I may never see the land of my birth again, and +at times I weary for it. For me Denmark seems to lie within the four square of +the ancient stones; but if you will do my bidding, you and Havelok shall see +her again, though how I cannot tell.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I could hardly speak for trouble, but Withelm said softly, “As we have +been wont to do, father, so it shall be.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well shall my word be kept, therefore,” Grim said, smiling on us. “Listen, +therefore. In the days to come, when time is ripe, Arngeir shall tell you more +of Havelok your foster-brother, and there will be signs enough by which he +shall know that it is time to speak. And then Havelok will need all the help +that you can give him; and as your lord shall you serve him, with both hands, +and with life itself if need be. And I seem to see that each of you has his +place beside him—Radbard as his strong helper, and Raven as his watchful +comrade, and Withelm as his counsellor. For ‘Bare is back without brother +behind it,’ son Radbard and ‘Ere one goes out, give heed to the doorways,’ son +Raven; and ‘Wisdom is wanted by him who fares widely’ son Withelm. So say the +old proverbs, and they are true. No quarreller is Havelok; but if he must +fight, that will be no playground. Careful is he; but he has met with no guile +as yet, and he trusts all men. Slow to think, if sure, are so mighty frames as +his becomes, even when quick wit is needed.” +</p> + +<p> +He was silent for a while, and I thought that he had no more to say, and I knew +that he had spoken rightly of what each was best fitted for, but he went on +once more. +</p> + +<p> +“This is my will, therefore, that to you shall Havelok be as the eldest brother +from this time forward, that these places shall not have to come suddenly to +you hereafter. Then will you know that I have spoken rightly, though maybe it +seems hard to Radbard and Raven now, they being so much older.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I said truly that already Havelok was first in our hearts. And that was +true, for he was as a king among us—a king who was served by all with loving +readiness, and yet one who served all. Maybe that is just what makes a good +king when all is said and done. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father bade us carry him out of the house and down to the shore where +there was a lonely place in the sandhills, covered with the sweet, short grass +that the sheep love; and, while Raven and I bore him, Withelm went and brought +Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“This is well, father,” he said gladly. “I had not thought you strong enough to +come thus far.” +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe it is the last time that I come living out of the house,” Grim said; +“but there is one thing yet to be done, and it must be done here. See, son +Havelok, these are your brothers in all but blood, and they must be that also +in the old Danish way.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nothing more is needed, father,” Havelok said, wondering. “I have no brothers +but these of mine, and they could be no more so.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat my father smiled, as well content, but he said that the ancient way +must he kept. +</p> + +<p> +“But I am sorely weak,” he added. “Fetch hither Arngeir.” +</p> + +<p> +It was because of this illness that none of us were at the fishing on that day, +and Arngeir was not long in coming. And while we waited for that little while +my father was silent, looking ever northward to the land that he had given up +for Havelok; and I think that foster-son of his knew it, for he knelt beside +him and set his strong arm round him, saying nothing. So Arngeir came with +Raven, who went for him, and my father told him what he needed to be done; and +Arngeir said that it was well thought of, and went to work with his seax on the +smooth turf. +</p> + +<p> +He cut a long strip where it seemed to be toughest, leaving the ends yet fast, +and carefully he raised it and stretched it until it would make an arch some +three spans high, and so propped it at either end with more turf that it stayed +in that position. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father said, “This is the old custom, that they who are of different +family should be brothers indeed. Out of one earth should they be made afresh, +as it were, that on the face of earth they shall be one. Pass therefore under +the arch, beginning with Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +Then, while my father spoke strange and ancient runes, Havelok did as he was +bidden, kneeling down and creeping under the uplifted turf; and as I came after +him he gave me his hand and raised me, and so with each of the other two. And +then, unbidden, Arngeir followed, for he too loved Havelok, and would fain be +his brother indeed. +</p> + +<p> +After that my father took a sharp flint knife that he had brought with him, and +with it cut Havelok’s arm a little, and each of us set his lips to that wound, +and afterwards he to the like marks in our right arms, and so the ancient rite +was complete. +</p> + +<p> +Yet it had not been needed, as I know, for not even I ever thought of him but +as the dearest of brothers, though I minded how he came. +</p> + +<p> +Now after this my father grew stronger, maybe because this was off his mind; +but he might never go to sea again, nor even to Lincoln town, for he was not +strong enough. What his illness was I do not rightly know, hut I do not think +that any one here overlooked him, though it might be that from across the sea +Hodulf had power to work him harm. It was said that he had Finnish wizards +about his court; but if that was so, he never harmed the one whom he had most +to fear—even Havelok. But then I suppose that even a Finn could not harm one +for whom great things are in store. +</p> + +<p> +So two years more passed over, and then came the time of which one almost fears +to think—the time of the great famine. Slowly it came on the land; but we could +see it coming, and the dread of it was fearsome, but for the hope that never +quite leaves a man until the end. For first the wheat that was winter sown came +not up but in scattered blades here and there, and then ere the spring-sown +grain had lain in the land for three weeks it had rotted, and over the rich, +ploughed lands seemed to rise a sour smell in the springtime air, when one +longs for the sweetness of growing things. And then came drought in April, and +all day long the sun shone, or if it were not shining the clouds that hid it +were hard and grey and high and still over land and sea. +</p> + +<p> +Then before the marsh folk knew what they were doing, the merchants of Lincoln +had bought the stored corn, giving prices that should have told men that it was +precious to those who sold as to the buyers; and then the grass failed in the +drought, and the farmers were glad to sell the cattle and sheep for what they +could gain, rather than see them starve. +</p> + +<p> +Then my father bade us dry and store all the fish we might against the time +that he saw was coming, and hard we worked at that. And even as we toiled, from +day to day we caught less, for the fish were leaving the shores, and we had to +go farther and farther for them, until at last a day came when the boats came +home empty, and the women wept at the shore as the men drew them up silently, +looking away from those whom they could feed no longer. +</p> + +<p> +That was the worst day, as I think, and it was in high summer. I mind that I +went to Stallingborough that day with the last of the fresh fish of yesterday’s +catch for Witlaf’s household, and it was hotter than ever; and in all the +orchards hung not one green apple, and even the hardy blackberry briers had no +leaves or sign of blossom, and in the dikes the watercress was blackened and +evil to see. +</p> + +<p> +But I will say that in Grimsby we felt not the worst, by reason of that wisdom +of my father, and always Witlaf and his house shared with us. Hard it was here, +but elsewhere harder. +</p> + +<p> +And then came the pestilence that goes with famine always. I have heard that +men have prayed to their gods for that, for it has seemed better to them to die +than live. +</p> + +<p> +With the first breath of the pestilence died Grim my father, and about that I +do not like to say much. He bade us remember the words he had spoken of Havelok +our brother, and he spoke long to Arngeir in private of the same; and then he +told us to lay him in mound in the ancient way, but with his face toward +Denmark, whence we came. And thereafter he said no more, but lay still until +there came up suddenly through the thick air a thunderstorm from the north; and +in that he passed, and with his passing the rain came. +</p> + +<p> +Thereof Withelm said that surely Odin fetched him, and that at once he had made +prayer for us. But the Welsh folk said that not Odin but the White Christ had +taken the man who had been a father to them, and had staved off the worst of +the famine from them. +</p> + +<p> +Then pined and died my mother Leva, for she passed in her sleep on the day +before we made the mound over her husband, and so we laid them in it together, +and that was well for both, as I think, for so they would have wished. +</p> + +<p> +So we made a great bale fire over my father’s mound, where it stood over the +highest sandhill; and no warrior was ever more wept, for English and Welsh and +Danes were at one in this. We set his weapons with him, and laid him in the +boat that was the best—and a Saxon gave that—and in it oars and mast and sail, +and so covered him therein. And so he waits for the end of all things that are +now, and the beginning of those better ones that shall be. +</p> + +<p> +That thunderstorm was nothing to the land, for it skirted the shores and died +away to the south, and after it came the heat again; but at least it brought a +little hope. There were fish along the shore that night, too, if not many; and +though they were gone again in the morning, there was a better store in every +house, for men were mindful of Grim’s teaching. +</p> + +<p> +Now, of all men, Havelok seemed to feel the trouble of the famine the most, +because he could not bear to see the children hungry in the cottages of the +fishers. It seemed to him that he had more than his share of the stores, +because so mighty a frame of his needed feeding mightily, as he said. And so +for two days after my father died and was left in his last resting, Havelok +went silent about the place. Here by the shore the pestilence hardly came, and +so that trouble was not added to us, though the weak and old went, as had Grim +and Leva, here and there. +</p> + +<p> +Then, on the third day, Havelok called Arngeir and us, and spoke what was in +his mind. +</p> + +<p> +“Brothers, I may not bear this any longer, and I must go away. I can do no more +to help than can the weakest in the town; and even my strength is an added +trouble to those who have not enough without me. Day by day grows the store in +the house less; and it will waste more slowly if I am elsewhere.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Arngeir said quickly, “This is foolishness, Havelok, my brother. Whither +will you go? For worse is the famine inland; and I think that we may last out +here. The fish will come back presently.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will go to Lincoln. All know that there is plenty there, for the townsfolk +were wise in time. There is the court, and at the court a strong man is likely +to be welcome, if only as one who shall keep the starving poor from the doors, +as porter.” +</p> + +<p> +He spoke bitterly, for Alsi, the king, had no good name for kindness, and at +that Withelm laughed sadly. +</p> + +<p> +“Few poor would Havelok turn away,” he said, under his breath; “rather were he +likely to take the king’s food from the very board, and share it among them.” +</p> + +<p> +That made us laugh a little, for it was true enough; and one might seem to see +our mighty one sweeping the table, while none dared try to stay him. +</p> + +<p> +But many times of late Havelok had gone dinnerless, that he might feed some +weak one in the village. Maybe some of us did likewise; but, if so, we learned +from him. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then,” Havelok said, when we had had our wretched laugh, “Alsi, the +king, can better afford to feed me than can anyone else. Therefore, I will go +and see about it. And if not the king, then, doubtless, some rich merchant will +give me food for work, seeing that I can lift things handily. But Radbard here +is a great and hungry man also, and it will be well that he come with me; or +else, being young and helpless, I may fall into bad hands.” +</p> + +<p> +So he spoke, jesting and making little of the matter. But I saw that he was +right, and that we who were strong to take what might come should go away. It +was likely that a day of our meals would make a week’s fare for Arngeir’s three +little ones, and they were to be thought for. +</p> + +<p> +Now for a little while Arngeir tried to keep us back; but it was plain that he +knew also that our going was well thought of, and only his care for Havelok +stood in the way. Indeed, he said that I and Raven might go. +</p> + +<p> +“Raven knows as much about the fish as did our father,” Havelok said. “He will +go out in the morning, and look at sky and sea, and sniff at the wind; and if I +say it will be fine, he says that the herrings will be in such a place; and so +they are, while maybe it rains all day to spite my weather wisdom. You cannot +do without Raven; for it is ill to miss any chance of the sea just now. Nor can +Withelm go, for he knows all in the place, and who is most in want. It will not +do to be without house steward. So we two will go. Never have I been to Lincoln +yet, and Radbard knows the place well.” +</p> + +<p> +I think that I have never said that Grim would never take Havelok to the city, +lest he should be known by some of the Danish folk who came now and then to the +court, some from over seas, and others from the court of King Ethelwald, of +whom I have spoken, the Norfolk king. But that danger was surely over now, for +Havelok would be forgotten in Denmark; and Ethelwald was long dead, and his +wife also, leaving his daughter Goldberga to her uncle Alsi, as his ward. So +Alsi held both kingdoms until the princess was of age, when she would take her +own. It was said that she lived at Dover until that time, and so none of her +Danes were likely to be at court if we went there and found places. +</p> + +<p> +So Havelok’s plan was to be carried out, and he and I were to set forth next +morning. Arngeir was yet uneasy about it, nevertheless, as one could see; but I +did not at that time know why it should be so doubtful a matter that two strong +men should go forth and seek their fortune but thirty miles away. So we laughed +at him. +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” he said, “every one knows Radbard; but they will want to know who his +tall comrade may be. Old foes has Havelok, as Radbard knows, and therefore it +may be well to find a new name for him.” +</p> + +<p> +“No need to go far for that,” Withelm said. “The marsh folk call him Curan.” +</p> + +<p> +“Curan, the wonder, is good,” Arngeir said, after a little thought, for we all +knew Welsh enough by this time. “Or if you like a Danish name better, brother, +call it ‘Kwaran,’ but silent about yourself you must surely be.” +</p> + +<p> +We used to call him that at times—for it means “the quiet” in our old +tongue—seeing how gentle and courtly he was in all his ways. So the name was +well fitting in either way. +</p> + +<p> +“Silent and thoughtful should the son of a king be,” says the Havamal, and so +it was with Havelok, son of Gunnar. +</p> + +<p> +Now when I came to think, it was plain that we three stood in the mind of our +brother in the place which my father had boded for us, and I was glad. Well I +knew that Raven, the watchful, and Withelm, the wise and thoughtful, would do +their parts; and I thought that whether I could do mine was to be seen very +shortly. If I failed in help at need it should not be my fault. It had been +long growing in my mind who Havelok must be, though I said nothing of what I +thought, because my father had bidden me be silent long ago, and I thought that +I knew why. +</p> + +<p> +We were to start early in the morning, so that we should get to the city +betimes in the evening; and there was one thing that troubled the good sisters +more than it did us. They would have had us go in all our finery, such as we +were wont to wear on holidays and at feastings; but none of that was left. It +had gone in buying corn, while there was any left to buy, along with every +silver penny that we had. So we must go in the plain fisher gear, that is made +for use and not for show, frayed and stained, and a trifle tarry, but good +enough. It would not do to go in our war gear into a peaceful city; and so we +took but the seax that every Englishman wears, and the short travelling spear +that all wayfarers use. Hardly was it likely that even the most hungry outlaw +of the wild woldland would care to fall on us; for by this time such as we +seemed had spent their all in food for themselves and their families, and all +the money in Lindsey seemed to have gone away to places where there was yet +somewhat to buy. +</p> + +<p> +Busy were those kind sisters of ours that night in making ready the last meal +that we should need to take from them. And all the while they foretold pleasant +things for us at the king’s court—how that we should find high honour and the +like. So they set us forth well and cheerfully. +</p> + +<p> +With the dawn we started, and Havelok was thoughtful beyond his wont after we +had bidden farewell to the home folk, so that I thought that he grieved for +leaving them at the last. +</p> + +<p> +“Downhearted, are you, brother?” I said, when we had gone a couple of miles in +silence across the level. “I have been to Lincoln two or three times in a month +sometimes in the summer, and it is no great distance after all. I think nothing +of the journey, or of going so short a way from home.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nor do I,” he answered. “First, I was thinking of the many times my father, +Grim, went this way, and now he can walk no more; and then I was thinking of +that empty cottage we passed just now, where there was a pleasant little family +enough three months ago, who are all gone. And then—ay, I will tell you—I had a +dream last night that stays in my mind, so that I think that out of this +journey of ours will come somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +“Food and shelter, to wit,” said I, “which is all we want for a month or two. +Let us hear it.” +</p> + +<p> +“If we get all that I had in that dream, we shall want no more all our lives,” +he said, with a smile; “but it seems a foolish dream, now that I come to tell +it.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is mostly the way with dreams. It is strange how wonderful they seem +until daylight comes. I have heard Witlaf’s gleeman say that the best lays he +ever made were in his sleep; but if he remembered aught of them, they were +naught.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is not like that altogether with my dream,” Havelok said, “for it went +thus. I thought that I was in Denmark—though how I knew it was Denmark I cannot +say—and on a hill I sat, and at my feet was stretched out all the land, so that +I could see all over it at once. Then I longed for it, and I stretched out my +arms to gather it in, and so long were they that they could well fathom it, and +so I drew it to myself. With towns and castles it was gathered in, and the keys +of the strongholds fell rattling at my feet, while the weight of the great land +seemed to lie on my knees. Then said one, and the voice was the voice of Grim, +‘This is not all the dream that I have made for you, but it is enough for now.’ +That is the dream, therefore, and what make you of it?” +</p> + +<p> +“A most amazing hunger, brother, certainly, and promise of enough to satisfy it +withal. I think that the sisters have talked about our advancement at court +until you have dreamed thereof.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why,” he said, “that is surely at the bottom of the dream, and I am foolish to +think more of it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then we went on, and grew light hearted as the miles passed. But though I had +seemed to think little of the dream, it went strangely with my thoughts of what +might lie before Havelok in days to come. +</p> + +<p> +As we went inland from the sea, the track of the pestilence was more dread, for +we passed house after house that had none living in them, and some held the +deserted dead. I might say many things of what we saw, but I do not like to +think of them much. Many a battlefield have I seen since that day, but I do not +think them so terrible as the field over which has gone the foe that is unseen +ere he smites. One knows the worst of the battle when it is over and the roll +is called, but who knows where famine and pestilence stay? And those have given +life for king or land willingly, but these were helpless. +</p> + +<p> +It was good to climb the welds and look back, for in the high lands there was +none of this. Below us the levels, with their bright waters, were wrapped in a +strange blue haze, that had come with the famine at its worst, and, as men +said, had brought or made the sickness. I had heard of it; but it was not so +plain when one was in it, or else our shore was free, which is likely, seeing +how little we suffered. +</p> + +<p> +After that we kept to the high land, not so much fearing the blue robe of the +pestilence as what things of its working we might see; and so it was late in +the afternoon that we came in sight of Lincoln town, on its hill, with the wide +meres and river at its feet. I have seen no city that stands more wonderfully +than this of ours, with the grey walls of the Roman town to crown the gathering +of red and brown roofs that nestle on the slope and within them. And ever as we +drew nearer Havelok became more silent, as I thought because he had never seen +so great a town before, until we passed the gates of the stockade that keeps +the town that lies without the old walls, and then he said, looking round him +strangely, “Brother, you will laugh at me, no doubt, for an arrant dreamer, but +this is the place whereto in dreams I have been many a time. Now we shall come +to yon turn of the road among the houses, and beyond that we shall surely see a +stone-arched gate in a great wall, and spearmen on guard thereat.” +</p> + +<p> +It was so, and the gate and guard were before us in a few more steps. It was +the gate of the old Roman town, inside which was the palace of the king and one +or two more great houses only. Our English kin hate a walled town or a stone +house, and they would not live within the strong walls, whose wide span was, +save for the king’s palace, which was built partly of the house of the Roman +governor, and these other halls, which went for naught in so wide a meadow, +empty and green, and crossed by two paved roads, with grass growing between the +stones. There were brown marks, as of the buried stones of other foundations, +on the grass where the old streets had been. +</p> + +<p> +All the straggling English town was outside the walls, and only in time of war +would the people use them as a stronghold, as they used the still more ancient +camps on the hills. +</p> + +<p> +“Many times have you heard us tell of this place, Havelok,” I said. “It is no +wonder that you seem to know it.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” he answered, “but this is the city of my dreams, and somewhat is to +happen here.” +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap08">CHAPTER VIII.<br/> +BERTHUN THE COOK.</a></h2> + +<p> +For that night we went to the house of the old dame with whom my father and I +were wont to lodge when we came to the market, and she took us in willingly, +though she could make little cheer for us. Truly, as had been said, the +scarcity was not so great in Lincoln, but everything was terribly dear, and +that to some is almost as bad. +</p> + +<p> +“No money have I now, dame,” I said ruefully, “but I think that for old sake’s +sake you will not turn us away.” +</p> + +<p> +“Not I, faith,” she answered. “I mind the first day your father came here, and +never a penny had he, and since then there has been no want in this house. Luck +comes with Grim and his folk, as I think. But this is a son whom I have not +seen before, if he is indeed your brother.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am Grim’s son Curan,” said Havelok, “and I have not been to Lincoln ere +this. But I have heard of you many times.” +</p> + +<p> +That pleased our old hostess, and then she asked after Grim. Hard it was to +have to tell her that he was gone, and hard it was for her to hear, for the +little house had been open to us for ten years. +</p> + +<p> +“What will you do now, masters?” she asked, when she had told us of many a +kindness done to her and her husband, who was long dead now, by my father. +</p> + +<p> +I told her that we were too many at home since the fishing had failed, and had +therefore come to find some work here, at the court if possible. +</p> + +<p> +“Doubtless two strong men will not have to go far to find somewhat,” she said; +“but the court is full of idle folk, and maybe no place is empty. Now I will +have you bide with me while you are at a loose end, for there are yet a few +silver pennies in store, and I ween that they came out of Grim’s pouch to me. +Lonely am I, and it is no good hoarding them when his sons are hungry.” +</p> + +<p> +We thanked her for that kind saying, but she made light of it, saying that +almost did she hope that we should find no work, that we might bide and lighten +her loneliness for a time. +</p> + +<p> +“But if an old woman’s advice is good for aught, you shall not go to the court +first of all. Sour is King Alsi, and he is likely to turn you away offhand +rather than grant the smallest boon. But there is Berthun the cook, as we call +him—steward is his court name though—and he orders the household, and is +good-natured, so that all like him. Every morning he comes into the market, and +there you can ask him if there is a place for you, and he loves to look on a +man such as Curan. But if it is weapons you want—and I suppose that is in the +minds of tall men always, though it brings sorrow in the end—there is the +captain of the guard who lives over the gate, and he might be glad to see you +enough.” +</p> + +<p> +We said that we would see the steward, for we wanted no long employment. We +would go back to Grimsby when the famine ended, if it were only by the coming +of the fish again. +</p> + +<p> +Then she gave us of the best she had—black bread and milk to wit; and after +that we slept soundly before the fire, as I had done many times before in that +humble house. Black bread and milk it was again in the morning; but there was +plenty, and goodwill to season it. Then the old dame sent us forth cheerfully +and early, that we might not miss Berthun the steward, from whom she hoped +great things for us. +</p> + +<p> +So we sat in the marketplace for an hour or more watching the gates of the wall +for his coming; and men stared at Havelok, so that we went to the bridge and +waited there. One could see all the market from thence. There were a good many +of the market folk coming in presently, and most of them knew me, and more than +one stopped and spoke. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok grew restless, and wandered here and there looking at things, +though not going far from me; and while I was thus alone on the bridge, a man I +knew by sight came and leaned on the rail by me, and told me that he had just +seen the most handsome man and the goodliest to look on that was in the +kingdom, as he thought. +</p> + +<p> +“Yonder he stands,” he said, “like a king who has fallen on bad times. I mind +that I thought that Alsi, our king, would look like that, before I saw him, and +sorely disappointed was I in him therefore. Now I wonder who yon man may be?” +</p> + +<p> +I did not say that I knew, but I looked at Havelok, and for the first time, +perhaps because I had never seen him among strangers before, I knew that he was +wondrous to look on. Full head and shoulders was he above all the folk, and the +Lindseymen are no babes in stature. And at the same moment it came to me that +it were not well that men should know him as the son of Grim the fisher. If my +father, who was the wisest of men, had been so careful for all these years, I +must not be less so; for if there were ever any fear of the spies of Hodulf, it +would be now when his foe might be strong enough in years to think of giving +trouble. Not that I ever thought much of the said Hodulf, seeing how far off he +was; but my father had brought me up to dread him for this brother of mine. +Certainly by this time Hodulf knew that Grim had come to England in safety, for +the name of the new town must have come to his ears: and if Grim, then the boy +he had given to him. +</p> + +<p> +The man who spoke to me went away soon, and Havelok strolled back to me. +</p> + +<p> +“I would that the cook, or whoever he is, would come,” he said. “I grow weary +of this crowd that seems to have naught to do but stare at a stranger.” +</p> + +<p> +“What shall we ask, when he does come? and supposing that there is a place for +but one of us?” I said. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, the one it fits best will take it, and the other must seek some +other chance. That is all.” +</p> + +<p> +“As you will, brother,” I answered, “but I would rather that we should be +together.” +</p> + +<p> +“And I also. But after all, both will be in Lincoln, and we must take what +comes. It is but for a little while, and we shall not like to burden that good +old dame by being too hard to please. We want somewhat to do until we can go +home, not for a day longer, and I care not what it is.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is right,” I said; “and the sooner I see one of our folk coming over this +bridge with a full basket of fish, the better I shall like it. But it may be a +long day before that. Now, I have been thinking that it were not well that you +should say that you are the son of Grim.” +</p> + +<p> +I did not quite know how he would take this, for he was proud of my father as +I. But that very pride made it easy. +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe not,” he said thoughtfully, “for it seems unworthy of his sons that we +have to ask for service from any man. But I do not think that he could blame +us, as things are. Nevertheless, folk shall not talk.” +</p> + +<p> +“Men know me,” said I, “but that cannot be helped.” +</p> + +<p> +He laughed gaily at that. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, here we speak as if one man in a hundred knew you. And after all it may +be that we shall get a place that none need be ashamed of. Look, here comes a +mighty fine lord from the gateway.” +</p> + +<p> +It was Berthun the steward, for whom we were waiting, and I knew him well by +sight. Often had he bought our fish, but I did not think that he would remember +me by name, if he had ever heard it. He was a portly and well-favoured man, not +old, and as he came down the street to the marketplace at the hill foot he +laughed and talked with one and another of the townsfolk, whether high or low, +in very pleasant wise. +</p> + +<p> +Presently he stopped at a stall, and priced some meat; and when he had bought +it he looked round and called for some men to carry it for him; and at that the +idlers made a rush for him, tripping over one another in haste to be first, +while he laughed at them. +</p> + +<p> +He chose two or three, and sent them up the hill to the palace with their +burdens, and then went to another booth and bought. +</p> + +<p> +“This is work at which I should make a good hand,” said Havelok, laughing at +the scrambling men who ran forward when the steward again called for porters. +“Well paid also the job must be, to judge of their eagerness.” +</p> + +<p> +The three men who had been chosen took their burden and went away, and the +steward came near us, to a bakery that was close to the bridge end. +</p> + +<p> +“I have a mind to do porter for once,” Havelok said. “Then I can at least earn +somewhat to take back to the dame tonight.” +</p> + +<p> +“If you do so,” I answered, “I will wait here for you. But you will have to +fight for the place.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the steward bought all that he needed, and that was bread for the whole +palace for the day, and again he called for porters. Whereon Havelok got up +from the bridge rail and went towards him in no great hurry, so that the idlers +were in a crowd before him. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho! friends,” cried Havelok, “let the good cook see all of us and make his +choice. He can only take one at a time.” +</p> + +<p> +“One, forsooth,” said a man from the crowd; “why, there is a load for four men +there.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, let him pick four little ones, and give these little ones a chance +of being seen.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I do not think that he would have troubled with the matter any more; but +whether the men knew that this was the last load that the steward had to send +home, or whether they quarrelled, I cannot say, but in their eagerness to raise +the two great baskets they fell to struggling over them, and the steward tried +to quiet the turmoil by a free use of his staff, and there was a danger that +the bread should be scattered. +</p> + +<p> +“Here will be waste of what there is none too much of just now,” said Havelok; +and with that he went to the aid of the steward, picking up and setting aside +the men before him, and then brushing the struggling rivals into a ruefully +wondering heap from about the baskets, so that he and the steward faced each +other, while there fell a silence on the little crowd that had gathered. Even +the men who had been put aside stayed their abuse as they saw what manner of +man had come to the rescue of the baskets, and Havelok and the cook began to +laugh. +</p> + +<p> +“Fe, fi, fo, fum!” said Berthun; “here is surely a Cornish giant among us! Now +I thank you, good Blunderbore, or whatever your name is, for brushing off these +flies.” +</p> + +<p> +“The folk in this place are unmannerly,” said Havelok; “hut if you want the +bread carried up the hill I will do it for you.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun looked him up and down in a puzzled sort of way once or twice ere he +answered, “Well, as that is your own proposal, pick your helpers and do so; I +would not have asked such a thing of you myself.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is not much help needed,” said Havelok. “I think this may be managed if +I get a fair hold.” +</p> + +<p> +Now we were used to seeing him carry such loads as would try the strength of +even Raven and myself, who could lift a load for three men; but when he took +the two great baskets of bread and swung them into place on either arm, a +smothered shout went round the crowd, and more than once I heard the old Welsh +name that the marsh folk had given him spoken. +</p> + +<p> +“Let us be going,” said Havelok to the steward on that. “One would think that +none of these had ever hefted a fair load in his life, to listen to them.” +</p> + +<p> +So he nodded to me across the heads of the crowd, and followed Berthun, and the +idlers followed him for a little. The guard turned these back at the gate, and +Havelok went through, and I could see him no more. +</p> + +<p> +Presently the crowd drifted back to their places, and I heard them talking. +Havelok and his strength was likely to be a nine days’ wonder in Lincoln, and I +was glad that I had asked him not to say whence he was. +</p> + +<p> +“He is some thane’s son who is disguised,” said one. +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe he is under a vow,” said another; and then one chimed in with a story of +some prince of Arthur’s time, by name Gareth, who hid his state at his mother’s +command. +</p> + +<p> +“As for me,” said the baker, “I think that he is a fisher, as he looks—at +least, that is, as his clothes make him.” +</p> + +<p> +So even he had his doubts, and I will say that I understood well enough now why +my father never brought him here before. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok was long in coming back, as I thought, and I seemed to be wasting time +here, and so I bethought me of the other man to whom the old dame had said we +might go—namely, the captain of the gate. I should see Havelok if I stood +there. +</p> + +<p> +The captain was talking with some of his men as I came up, and of course it was +of Havelok that they spoke; and seeing that I wore the same dress as he, they +asked me if I knew who he was. +</p> + +<p> +“He is a fisher from the coast,” I answered. “I have heard him called Curan.” +</p> + +<p> +“Welsh then,” the captain answered, somewhat disappointed, as it seemed. “If he +had been a Mercian, or even a Saxon, I would have had him here, but a fisher +has had no training in arms after all.” +</p> + +<p> +“Some of us have,” said I. +</p> + +<p> +The captain looked me up and down, and then walked round me, saying nothing +until we were face to face again. +</p> + +<p> +“That, I take it, is a hint that you might like to be a housecarl of the +king’s,” he said. “Are you a Lindseyman?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am the son of Grim of Grimsby,” I said. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, I suppose you would not think of it, seeing that my place is not +empty; but if you will dress in that way you must not wonder if I took you for +a likely man for a housecarl. We know Grim well by repute. Come in and tell me +about the famine, and this new town of yours that one hears of.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I could not see Havelok as yet, and so I went into the stone-arched Roman +guardroom, and Eglaf the captain fetched out a pot of wine and some meat, and +made me very welcome while we talked. And presently I thought that I might do +worse than be a housecarl for a time, if Eglaf would have me. I should be armed +at least, and with comrades to help if Havelok needed me; though all the while +I thought myself foolish for thinking that any harm could come to him who was +so strong. Nevertheless, what my father had laid on us all was to be heeded, +and I was to be his helper in arms. So presently I told Eglaf that the +housecarl’s life seemed an easy one, and that it would be pleasant to go armed +for a while, if he would have me for a short time, seeing that the famine had +left us naught to do. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, there is plenty to eat and drink,” he said, “and good lodging in the +great hall or here, as one’s post may be, and a silver penny every day; but no +fighting to be done, seeing that Alsi will sooner pay a foe to go away than let +us see to the matter. Doing naught is mighty hard work at times.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he asked if I had arms, and I said that I would send for them at once, and +that settled the matter. If I chose to come with my own arms I should be +welcome. +</p> + +<p> +“I am glad to get you,” he said, “for there will be a crowd in the place ere +long, for the Witan is to meet, and the thanes will come with their men, and +there will be fine doings, so that we need another strong arm or two that we +may keep the peace,” +</p> + +<p> +He took a long pull at the wine pot, and then went on, “Moreover, the +princess’s Danes are sure to want to fight some of the English folk for sport.” +</p> + +<p> +“What! is she here?” +</p> + +<p> +“Not yet. They say that she is coming when the Witan meets, because the Witan +wants to see her, not because Alsi does. But he dare not go against them, and +so it must be.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Goldberga, the princess, was, as I have said, Alsi’s ward, and was at this +time just eighteen, so that it would be time for her to take the kingdom that +was hers by right. It was common talk, however, that Alsi by no means liked the +thought of giving the wide lands of East Anglia up to her, and that he would +not do so if he could anywise help it. Maybe the Witan thought so also, and +would see fair play. Ethelwald and his wife Orwenna had been well loved both +here and in Norfolk, and it was said that Goldberga their daughter grew +wondrous fair and queenly. +</p> + +<p> +I had learned one thing though, and that was that we should have Ethelwald’s +Danes here shortly, and that I did not like; but after all, what did these few +men of an old household know of the past days in Denmark? There had been no +going backwards and forwards between the two countries since the king died ten +years ago. Nevertheless I was glad that I had found a friend in Eglaf, and that +I was to be here. +</p> + +<p> +Then I got up to go, and the captain bade me come as soon as I could, for he +could talk to me as he could not to the men, maybe. So I bade him farewell, and +went slowly back, down the street, sitting down in the old place. +</p> + +<p> +It was not long after that before Havelok came, and I saw Berthun the steward +come as far as the gate with him, and stand looking after him as he walked +away; then Eglaf came out, and both looked and talked for a while, and +therefore, as soon as I knew that Havelok saw me, I went away and across the +bridge to a place that was quiet, and waited for him there. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, brother,” I said, “you have had a long job with the cook. What is the +end of it all?” +</p> + +<p> +“I do not know,” he answered slowly. “That is to be seen yet.” +</p> + +<p> +I looked at him, for his voice was strange, and I saw that he seemed to have +the same puzzled look in his eyes as he had last night when we came first into +the city. I asked if anything was amiss. +</p> + +<p> +“Nothing,” he said; “but this is a place of dreams. I think that I shall wake +presently in Grimsby.” +</p> + +<p> +We walked on, and past the straggling houses outside the stockade, and so into +the fields; and little by little he told me what was troubling him. +</p> + +<p> +Berthun the steward had said nothing until the palace was reached, and had led +him to the great servants’ hall, and there had bidden him set down his load and +rest. Then he had asked if he would like to see the place, and of course +Havelok had said that he would, wondering at the same time if this was all the +pay that the porters got. So he was shown the king’s hall, and the arms on the +wall, and the high seat, and the king’s own chamber, and many more things, and +all the while they seemed nothing strange to Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“This Berthun watched me as a cat watches a mouse all the while,” he said, “and +at last he asked if I had ever seen a king’s house before. I told him that I +had a dream palace which had all these things, but was not the same. And at +that he smiled and asked my name. ‘Curan,’ I said, of course; and at that he +smiled yet more, in a way that seemed to say that he did not believe me. ‘It is +a good name for the purpose,’ he said, ‘but I have to ask your pardon for +calling you by the old giant’s name just now.’ I said that as he did not know +my name, and it was a jest that fitted, it was no matter. Then he made a little +bow, and asked if I would take any food before I went from the place; so I told +him that it was just what I came for, and he laughed, and I had such a meal as +I have not seen for months. It is in my mind that I left a famine in that +house, so hungry was I. There is no pride about this Berthun, for he served me +himself, and I thanked him.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok stopped and passed his hand over his face, and he laughed a +little, uneasy laugh. +</p> + +<p> +“And all the while I could not get it out of my head that he ought to be +kneeling before me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” he went on after a little, “when I had done, this Berthun asked me a +question, saying that he was a discreet man, and that if he could help me in +any way he would do so. Had I a vow on me? Nothing more than to earn my keep +until the famine was over, I said. I had left poor folk who would have the more +for my absence, and he seemed to think that this was a wondrous good deed. So I +told him that if he could help me in this I should be glad. Whereon he lowered +his voice and asked if I must follow the way of Gareth the prince. I had not +heard of this worthy, and so I said that what was good enough for a prince was +doubtless good enough for me, and that pleased him wonderfully. +</p> + +<p> +“‘Gladly will I take you into my service,’ he said, ‘if that will content you.’ +Which it certainly would; and so I am to be porter again tomorrow. Then I said +that I had a comrade to whom I must speak first. He said that no doubt word +must be sent home of my welfare, and he saw me as far as the gate.” +</p> + +<p> +“Which of you went out of the hall first?” I asked. +</p> + +<p> +“Now I come to think of it, I did. I went to let him pass, as the elder, though +it was in my mind to walk out as if the place belonged to me; and why, I do not +know, for no such thought ever came to me in Witlaf’s house, or even in a +cottage; but he stood aside and made me go first.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I longed for Withelm and his counsel, for one thing was plain to me, and +that was that with the once familiar things of the kingship before him the lost +memory of his childhood was waking in Havelok, and I thought that the time my +father boded was at hand. The steward had seen that a court and its ways were +no new thing to him, and had seen too that he had been wont to take the first +place somewhere; so he had deemed that this princely-looking youth was under a +vow of service, in the old way. It is likely that the Welsh name would make him +think that he was from beyond the marches to the west, and that was just as +well. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok said, “Let us go back to the widow’s house and sleep. My head +aches sorely, and it is full of things that are confused, so that I do not know +rightly who I am or where. Maybe it will pass with rest.” +</p> + +<p> +We turned hack, and then I told him what I meant to do; and that pleased him, +for we should see one another often. +</p> + +<p> +“We are in luck, brother, so far,” he said, “having lit on what we needed so +soon; but I would that these dreams would pass.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is the poor food of many days gone by,” I said. “Berthun will cure that for +you very shortly.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is likely enough,” he answered more gaily. +</p> + +<p> +“Little want is in that house, but honest Berthun does not know what a +trencherman he has hired. But I would that we had somewhat to take back to our +good old dame tonight.” +</p> + +<p> +But she was more than satisfied with our news; and when she saw that Havelok +was silent, she made some curious draught of herbs for him, which he swallowed, +protesting, and after that he slept peacefully. +</p> + +<p> +I went out to the marketplace and found a man whom I knew—one of those who +carried our fish at times; and him I sent, with promise of two silver pennies +presently, to Arngeir for my arms, telling him that all was well. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap09">CHAPTER IX.<br/> +CURAN THE PORTER.</a></h2> + +<p> +There is no need for me to say how my arms came to me from Grimsby, and how I +went to Eglaf as I had promised. I will only say that the life was pleasant +enough, if idle, as a housecarl, and that I saw Havelok every day at one time +or another, which was all that I could wish. +</p> + +<p> +But as I had to wait a day or two while the messenger went and the arms came +from home, I saw Havelok meet the steward on the next day: and a quaint meeting +enough it was, for Berthun hardly knew how he should behave to this man, whom +he had made up his mind was a wandering prince. +</p> + +<p> +There was the crowd who waited for the call for porters, as ever; hut the +steward would have none of them, until he saw his new man towering over the +rest, and then he half made a motion to unbonnet, which he checked and turned +into a beckoning wave of the hand, whereon the idlers made their rush for him, +and Havelok walked through and over them, more or less, as they would not make +way for him. But so good-naturedly was this done, that even those whom he +lifted from his path and dropped on one side laughed when they saw who had +cleared a way for himself, and stood gaping to see what came next. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho—why, yes—Curan—that was the name certainly. I have been looking for you, as +we said,” stammered the steward. +</p> + +<p> +“Here am I, therefore,” answered Havelok, “and where is the load?” +</p> + +<p> +“Truth to tell, I have bought but this at present,” said the steward, pointing +to a small basket of green stuff on the stall at which he stood. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I suppose there is more to come,” Havelok said, taking it up; “it will +be a beginning.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will not ask you to carry more than that,” Berthun began. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, man, this is foolishness. If you have a porter, make him carry all he +can, else he will not earn his keep.” +</p> + +<p> +“As you will,” answered the steward, shrugging his shoulders as one who cannot +account for some folk’s whims, and going on to the next booth. +</p> + +<p> +Now, I suppose that the idlers looked to see Havelok walk away with this light +load gladly, as any one of them would have done, and that then their turn would +have come; but this was not what they expected. Maybe they would have liked to +see the strong man sweep up all the palace marketing and carry it, as a show, +but it might interfere with their own gains. So there was a murmur or two among +them, and this grew when Havelok took the next burden in like manner. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, master cook,” cried a ragged man at last, “this is not the custom, and it +is not fair that one man should do all the work, and all for one wage.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun took no notice of this; and so the cry was repeated, and that by more +than one. And at last he turned round and answered. +</p> + +<p> +“Go to, ye knaves,” he said with a red face and angrily; “if I find a man who +will save me the trouble of your wrangles every day, shall I not do as I +please?” +</p> + +<p> +Then there was a tumult of voices, and some of them seemed sad, as if a last +hope was gone, and that Havelok heard. +</p> + +<p> +“There is somewhat in this,” he said to the cook. “What pay have you given to +each man who carries for you?” +</p> + +<p> +“A yesterday’s loaf each,” answered Berthun, wondering plainly that Havelok +paid any heed to the noise. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, let us go on, and we will think of somewhat,” Havelok said; and +then he turned to the people, who were silent at once. +</p> + +<p> +“I am a newcomer, and a hungry one,” he said, smiling quietly, “and I have a +mind to earn my loaf well. Hinder me not for today, and hereafter I will take +my chance with the rest, if need is.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat the folk began to laugh also, for it was plain that none had any chance +at all if he chose to put forth his strength; but an old man said loudly, “Let +the good youth alone now, and he shall talk with us when he has done his errand +and fed that great bulk of his. He has an honest face, and will be fair to +all.” +</p> + +<p> +That seemed to please the crowd; and after that they said no more, but followed +and watched the gathering up of Havelok’s mighty burden. And presently there +was more than he could manage; and he spoke to Berthun, who checked himself in +a half bow as he answered. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok looked over the faces before him, and beckoned to two men who +seemed weakly and could not press forward, and to them he gave the lighter +wares, and so left the market with his master, as one must call the steward. +</p> + +<p> +“What told I you?” said the old man, as they came back from the great gate. +“Never saw I one with a face like that who harmed any man, either in word or +deed.” +</p> + +<p> +Now when Havelok had set down his load in the kitchen, he straightened himself +and said to Berthun, who was, as one may say, waiting his pleasure. +</p> + +<p> +“This is today’s task; but it is in my mind that I would stay up here and +work.” +</p> + +<p> +“What would you do?” +</p> + +<p> +“There are men yonder who will miss the carrying if I am market porter always. +But here are things I can earn my keep at, and help the other servants with at +the same time. Water drawing there is, and carrying of logs for the fire, and +cleaving them also, and many other things that will be but hardening my +muscles, while they are over heavy to be pleasant for other folk.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” answered Berthun, “that is all I could wish, and welcome to some here +will you be. Let it be so.” +</p> + +<p> +“Now, I do not think that you would make a gain by my work this morning?” +</p> + +<p> +“Truly not, if any one is wronged by my doing so,” the puzzled steward said. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok asked how many men would have been needed to carry up the goods +that he had brought, and Berthun said that he was wont to send one at least +from each stall, and more if the burden was heavy. +</p> + +<p> +“Then today four poor knaves must go dinnerless by reason of my strength, and +that does not please me altogether,” said Havelok gravely. “Give these two +their loaves; and then, I pray you, give me the other four, and let me go back +to the market.” +</p> + +<p> +And then he added, with a smile, “I think that I can order matters there so +that things will be more fair, and that you will have less trouble with that +unmannerly scramble.” +</p> + +<p> +“If you can do that, you are even as your name calls you. Take them and +welcome, Curan, and then come here and do what work you will,” Berthun said in +haste. +</p> + +<p> +“Tasks you must set me, or I shall grow idle. That is the failing of over-big +men,” Havelok said; and he took the loaves and left the palace with the two +market men at his heels. +</p> + +<p> +I saw him come back, and at once the crowd of idlers made for him, but in a +respectful way enough. I knew, however, how easily these folks took to throwing +mud and stones in their own quarrels, and I was a little anxious, for to +interfere with the ways of the market is a high offence among them. +</p> + +<p> +But Havelok knew naught of that, and went his way with his loaves to the bridge +end, and there sat on the rail and looked at the men before him. And <i>lo!</i> +back to my mind came old days in Denmark, and how I once saw Gunnar the king +sitting in open court to do justice, and then I knew for certain that I was +looking on his son. And when Havelok spoke it was in the voice of Gunnar that I +had long forgotten, but which came back to me clear and plain, as if it were +yesterday that I had heard it. Never does a boy forget his first sight of the +king. +</p> + +<p> +“Friends,” said Havelok, “if I do two men’s work I get two men’s pay, or else I +might want to know the reason why. But I am only one man, all the same, and it +seems right to me that none should be the loser. Wherefore I have a mind to +share my pay fairly.” +</p> + +<p> +There was a sort of shout at that and Havelok set his four loaves in a row on +the rail beside him. But then some of the rougher men went to make a rush at +them, and he took the foremost two and shook them, so that others laughed and +bade the rest beware. +</p> + +<p> +“So that is just where the trouble comes in,” said Havelok coolly; “the strong +get the first chance, as I did this morning, by reason of there being none to +see fair play.” +</p> + +<p> +“Bide in the market, master, and we will make you judge among us,” cried a +small man from the edge of the crowd. +</p> + +<p> +“Fair and softly,” Havelok answered. “I am not going to bide here longer than I +can help. Come hither, grandfer,” and he beckoned to the old man who had bidden +them wait his return, “tell me the names of the men who have been longest +without any work.” +</p> + +<p> +The old man pointed out three, and then Havelok stopped him. +</p> + +<p> +“One of these loaves is my own wage,” he said; “but you three shall have the +others, and that will be the easiest day’s work you ever did. But think not +that I am going to do the like every day, for Lincoln hill is no easy climb, +and the loaf is well earned at the top. Moreover, it is not good to encourage +the idle by working for them.” +</p> + +<p> +So the three men had their loaves, and Havelok began to eat his own slowly, +swinging his legs on the bridge rail while the men watched him. +</p> + +<p> +“Master,” said the small man from behind, pushing forward a little, now that +the crowd was looser, “make a law for the market, I pray you, that all may have +a chance.” +</p> + +<p> +“Who am I to make laws?” said my brother slowly, and, as he said this, his hand +went up to his brows as it had gone last night when the palace had wearied him. +</p> + +<p> +“The strong make laws for the weak,” the old man said to him in a low voice. +“If the strong is honest, for the weak it is well. Things are hard for the weak +here; and therefore say somewhat, for it may be of use.” +</p> + +<p> +“It can be none, unless the strong is at hand to see that the law is kept.” +</p> + +<p> +“Sometimes the market will see that a rule is not broken, for itself. There is +no rule for this matter.” +</p> + +<p> +Again Havelok passed his hand over his eyes, and he was long in answering. The +loaf lay at his side now. Presently he looked straight before him, and, as if +he saw far beyond Lincoln Hill and away to the north, he said, “This is my +will, therefore, that from this time forward it shall be the law that men shall +have one among them who may fairly and without favour so order this matter that +all shall come to Berthun the steward in turns that shall be kept, and so also +with the carrying for any other man. There shall be a company of porters, +therefore, which a man must join before he shall do this work, save that every +stranger who comes shall be suffered to take a burden once, and then shall be +told of this company, and the custom that is to be. And I will that this old +man shall see to this matter.” +</p> + +<p> +And then he stopped suddenly, and seemed to start as a great shout went up from +the men, a shout as of praise; and his eyes looked again on them, and that +wonderingly. +</p> + +<p> +“They will keep this law,” said the old man. “Well have you spoken.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have said a lot of foolishness, maybe,” answered Havelok. “For the life of +me I could not say it again.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is not one of us that could not do so,” said his adviser. “But bide you +here, master, in the town?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am in service at the palace.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the old man turned round to the others and said, “This is good that we +have heard, and it is nothing fresh, for all trades have their companies, and +why should not we? Is this stranger’s word to be kept?” +</p> + +<p> +Maybe there were one or two of the rougher men who held their peace, for they +had had more than their share of work, but from the rest came a shout of “Ay!” +as it were at the Witan. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then,” said Havelok suddenly, getting down from his seat and giving his +loaf to the old man, “see you to it; and if any give trouble hereafter, I shall +hear from the cook, and, by Odin, I will even come down and knock their heads +together for them. So farewell.” +</p> + +<p> +He smiled round pleasantly, yet in that way which has a meaning at the back of +it; and at that every cap went off and the men did him reverence as to a thane +at least, and he nodded to them and came across to me. +</p> + +<p> +“Come out into the fields, brother, for I shall weep if I bide here longer.” +</p> + +<p> +So he said; and we went away quickly, while the men gathered round the old +leader who was to be, and talked earnestly. +</p> + +<p> +“This famine plays strange tricks with me,” he said when we were away from +every one. “Did you hear all that I said?” +</p> + +<p> +“I heard all, and you have spoken the best thing that could have been said. +Eight years have I been to this market, and a porters’ guild is just what is +needed. And it will come about now.” +</p> + +<p> +“It was more dreaming, and so I must be a wise man in my dream. Even as in the +palace yesterday it came on me, and I seemed to be at the gate of a great hall, +and it was someone else that was speaking, and yet myself. It is in my mind +that I told these knaves what my lordly will was, forsooth; and the words came +to me in our old Danish tongue, so that it was hard not to use it. But it seems +to me that long ago I did these things, or saw them, I know not which, +somewhere. Tell me, did the king live in our town across the sea?” +</p> + +<p> +“No, but in another some way off. My father took me there once or twice.” +</p> + +<p> +“Can you mind that he took me also?” +</p> + +<p> +I shook my head, and longed for Withelm. Surely I would send for him, or for +Arngeir, if this went on. Arngeir for choice, for I could tell him what I +thought; and that would only puzzle Withelm, who knew less than I. +</p> + +<p> +“We will ask Arngeir some day,” I said; “he can remember.” +</p> + +<p> +“I suppose he did take me,” mused Havelok; “and I suppose that I want more +sleep or more food or somewhat. Now we will go and tell the old dame of my +luck, for she has lost her lodger.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told me of his fortune with the steward. +</p> + +<p> +“Half afraid of me he seems, for he will have me do just what I will. That will +be no hard place therefore.” +</p> + +<p> +But I thought that if I knew anything of Havelok my brother, he would be likely +to make it hard by doing every one’s work for him, and that Berthun saw this; +or else that, as I had thought last night, the shrewd courtier saw the prince +behind the fisher’s garb. +</p> + +<p> +So we parted presently at the gate of the palace wall, and I went back to the +widow to wait for my arms, while he went to his master. And I may as well tell +the end of Havelok’s lawmaking. +</p> + +<p> +Berthun went down to the market next day, and came back with a wonder to be +told. And it was to Havelok that he went first to tell it, as he was drawing +bucket after bucket of water from the deep old Roman well in the courtyard to +fill the great tub which he considered a fair load to carry at once. +</p> + +<p> +“There is something strange happening in the market,” he said, “and I think +that you have a hand in it. The decency of the place is wonderful, and you said +that you thought I might have less trouble with the men than I was wont if you +went down with the loaves. What did you? For I went to the baker’s stalls and +bought, and looked round for the tail that is after me always; and I was alone, +and all the market folk were agape to see what was to be done. I thought that I +had offended the market by yesterday’s business, as they had called out on me, +and I thought that I should have to come and fetch your—that is, if it pleased +you. But first I called, as is my wont, for porters. Now all that rabble sat in +a row along a wall, and, by Baldur, when I looked, they had cleaned themselves! +Whereupon an old gaffer, who has carried things once or twice for me when there +has been no crowd and he has been able to come forward, lifted up his voice and +asked how many men I wanted, so please me. +</p> + +<p> +“‘Two,’I said, wondering, and at that two got up and came to me, and I sent +them off. It was the same at the next booth, and the next, for he told off men +as I wanted them; and here am I back a full half-hour earlier than ever before, +and no mud splashes from the crowd either. It is said that they have made a +porters’ guild; and who has put that sense into their heads unless your—that +is, unless you have done so, I cannot say.” +</p> + +<p> +Havelok laughed. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I did tell them that they should take turns, or somewhat like that; and +I also told them that if you complained of them I would see to it.” +</p> + +<p> +“Did you say that you would pay them, may I ask—that is, of course, if they +were orderly? For if so, I thank—” +</p> + +<p> +“I told them that if you complained I would knock their heads together,” said +Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +And that was the beginning of the Lincoln porters’ guild; and in after days +Havelok was wont to say that he would that all lawmaking was as easy as that +first trial of his. Certainly from that day forward there was no man in all the +market who would not have done aught for my brother, and many a dispute was he +called on to settle. It is not always that a law, however good it may be, finds +not a single one to set himself against it. But then Havelok was a strong man. +</p> + +<p> +Now there is naught to tell of either Havelok or myself for a little while, for +we went on in our new places comfortably enough. One heard much of Havelok, +though, for word of him and his strength and goodliness, and of his kindness +moreover, went through the town, with tales of what he had done. But I never +heard that any dared to ask him to make a show of himself by doing feats of +strength. Only when he came down to the guardroom sometimes with me would he +take part in the weapon play that he loved, and the housecarls, who were all +tried and good warriors, said that he was their master in the use of every +weapon, and it puzzled them to know where he had learned so well, for he yet +wore his fisher’s garb. They sent his arms with mine from Grimsby, thinking +that he also needed them; but he left them with the widow. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok used to laugh if they asked him this, and tell them that it came by +nature, and in that saying there was more than a little truth. So the +housecarls, when they heard how Berthun was wont to treat him, thought also +that he was some great man in hiding, and that the steward knew who he was. +They did not know but that my close friendship with him had sprung up since he +came, and that was well, and Eglaf and he and I were soon much together. The +captain wanted him to leave the cook and be one of his men, but we thought that +he had better bide where he was, rather than let Alsi the king have him always +about him. For now and then that strange feeling, as of the old days, came over +him when he was in the great hall, and he had to go away and brood over it for +a while until he would set himself some mighty task and forget it. +</p> + +<p> +But one day he came to me and said that he was sure he knew the ways of a king +too well for it all to be a dream, adding that Berthun saw that also, and was +curious about him. +</p> + +<p> +“Tell me, brother, whence came I? <i>Was</i> I truly brought up in a court?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have never heard,” I answered. “All that I know for certain is that you fled +with us from Hodulf, the new king, and that for reasons which my father never +told me.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Havelok, “There was naught worth telling, therefore. I suppose I was +the child of some steward like Berthun; but yet—” +</p> + +<p> +So he went away, and I wondered long if it were not time that Arngeir should +tell all that he knew. It was of no good for me to say that in voice and ways +and deed he had brought back to me the Gunnar whom I had not seen for so many +long years, for that was as likely as not to be a fancy of mine, or if not a +fancy, he might be only a sister’s son or the like. But in all that he said +there was no word of his mother, and by that I knew that his remembrance must +be but a shadow, if a growing one. +</p> + +<p> +But there was no head in all the wide street that was not turned to look after +him; and now he went his way from me with two children, whom he had caught up +from somewhere, perched on either shoulder, and another in his arms, and they +crowed with delight as he made believe to be some giant who was to eat them +forthwith, and ran up the hill with them. No such playmate had the Lincoln +children before Havelok came. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap10">CHAPTER X.<br/> +KING ALSI OF LINDSEY.</a></h2> + +<p> +Three weeks after we came the Witan<a href="#fn8" +name="fnref8"><sup>[8]</sup></a> began to gather, and that was a fine sight as +the great nobles of Lindsey, and of the North folk of East Anglia, came day by +day into the town with their followings, taking up their quarters either in the +better houses of the place or else pitching bright-coloured tents and pavilions +on the hillside meadows beyond the stockades. Many brought their ladies with +them, and all day long was feasting and mirth at one place or another, as +friend met with friend. Never had I seen such a gay sight as the marketplace +was at midday, when the young thanes and their men met there and matched their +followers at all sorts of sports. The English nobles are far more fond of gay +dress and jewels than our Danish folk, though I must say that when the few +Danes of Ethelwald’s household came it would seem that they had taken kindly to +the fashion of their home. +</p> + +<p> +Our housecarls grumbled a bit for a while, for with all the newcomers dressed +span new for the gathering, we had had nothing fresh for it from the king, as +was the custom, and I for one was ashamed of myself, for under my mail was +naught but the fisher’s coat, which is good enough for hard wear, but not for +show. But one day we were fitted out fresh by the king’s bounty in blue and +scarlet jerkins and hose, and we swaggered after that with the best, as one may +suppose. +</p> + +<p> +Berthun had the ordering of that business, and he came and sat with Eglaf in +the gatehouse and talked of it. +</p> + +<p> +“Pity that you do not put your man Curan into decent gear,” the captain said. +“That old sailcloth rig does not do either him or you or the court credit.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is what I would do,” said the steward, “but he will not take aught but +the food that he calls his hire. He is a strange man altogether, and I think +that he is not what he seems.” +</p> + +<p> +“So you have told me many times, and I think with you. He will be some +crack-brained Welsh princeling who has been crossed in love, and so has taken +some vow on him, as the King Arthur that they prate of taught them to do. Well, +if he is such, it is an easy matter to make him clothe himself decently. It is +only to tell him that the clothes are from the king, and no man who has been +well brought up may refuse such a gift.” +</p> + +<p> +“But suppose that he thanks the king for the gift. Both he and the king will be +wroth with me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Not Curan, when he has once got the things on; and as for >Alsi, he will take +the thanks to himself, and chuckle to think that the mistake has gained him +credit for a good deed that he never did.” +</p> + +<p> +“Hush, comrade, hush!” said Berthun quickly; “naught but good of the king!” +</p> + +<p> +“I said naught ill. But if Woden or Frey, or whoever looks after good deeds, +scores the mistake to Alsi as well, it will be the first on the count of +charity that—” +</p> + +<p> +But at this Berthun rose up in stately wise. +</p> + +<p> +“I may not listen to this. To think that here in the guardroom I should hear +such—” +</p> + +<p> +“Sit down, comrade,” said Eglaf, laughing, and pulling the steward into his +seat again. “Well you know that I would be cut to pieces for the king tomorrow +if need were, and so I earn free speech of him I guard. If I may not say what I +think of him to a man who knows as much of him as I, who may?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have no doubt that the king would clothe Curan if I asked him,” said Berthun +stiffly, but noways loth to take his seat again. +</p> + +<p> +“But it is as much as your place is worth to do it. I know what you would say.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun laughed. +</p> + +<p> +“I will do it myself, and if Alsi does get the credit, what matter?” +</p> + +<p> +Wherefore it came to pass that as I was on guard at the gate leading to the +town next day I saw a most noble-looking man coming towards me, and I looked a +second time, for I thought him one of the noblest of all the thanes who had yet +come, and the second look told me that it was Havelok in this new array. I will +say that honest Berthun had done his part well; and if the king was supposed to +be the giver, he had nothing to complain of. Eglaf had told me of the way in +which the dressing of Havelok was to be done. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho!” said I, “I thought you some newcomer.” +</p> + +<p> +“I hardly know myself,” he answered, “and I am not going to grumble at the +change, seeing that this is holiday time. Berthun came to me last evening, and +called me aside, and said that it was the king’s wont to dress his folk anew at +the time of the Witan, and then wanted to know if my vow prevented me from +wearing aught but fisher’s clothes. And when I said that if new clothes went as +wage for service about the place I was glad to hear it, he was pleased, as if +it had been likely that I would refuse a good offer. So the tailor went to work +on me, and hence this finery. But you are as fine, and this is more than we +counted on when we left Grimsby. I suppose it is all in honour of the lady of +the North folk, Goldberga.” +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe, for I have heard that she is to come.” +</p> + +<p> +“To be fetched rather, if one is to believe all that one hears. They say that +Alsi has kept her almost as a captive in Dover, having given her into the +charge of some friend of his there, that she may be far from her own kingdom +and people. Now the Norfolk Witan has made him bring her here. Berthun seems to +think there will be trouble.” +</p> + +<p> +“Only because Alsi will not want to let the kingdom go from his hand to her. +But that will not matter. He is bound by the old promise to her father.” +</p> + +<p> +Now we were talking to one another in broad Danish, there being none near to +hear us. We had always used it among ourselves at Grimsby, for my father loved +his old tongue. But at that moment there rode up to the gate a splendid +horseman, young and handsome, and with great gold bracelets on his arms, one or +two of which caught my eye at once, for they were of the old Danish patterns, +and just such as Jarl Sigurd used to wear. But if I was quick to notice these +tokens of the old land, he had been yet quicker, for he reined up before I +stayed him, as was my duty if he would pass through this gate to the palace, so +that I might know his authority. +</p> + +<p> +“If I am not mistaken,” he said in our own tongue, “I heard you two talking in +the way I love best. Skoal, therefore, to the first Northman I have met between +here and London town, for it is good to hear a friendly voice.” +</p> + +<p> +“Skoal to the jarl!” I answered, and I gave the salute of Sigurd’s courtmen, +which came into my mind on the moment with the familiar greeting of long years +ago. And “Skoal,” said Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Jarl! How know you that I am that?” +</p> + +<p> +“By the jarl’s bracelet that you wear, surely.” +</p> + +<p> +“So you are a real Dane—not an English-bred one like myself. That is good. You +and I will have many a talk together. Odin, how good it is to meet a housecarl +who speaks as man to man and does not cringe to me! Who are you?” +</p> + +<p> +“Radbard Grimsson of Grimsby, housecarl just now to this King of Lindsey.” +</p> + +<p> +“And your comrade?” +</p> + +<p> +I was about to tell this friendly countryman Havelok’s name without thought, +but stopped in time. Of all the things I had been brought up to dread most for +him, that an English Dane should find him out was the worst, so I said, “He is +called Curan, and he is a Lindsey marshman.” +</p> + +<p> +“Who can talk Danish though his name is Welsh. That is strange. Well, you are +right about me. I am Ragnar of Norwich, the earl, as the English for jarl goes. +Now I want to see Alsi the king straightway.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is a matter for the captain,” I said, and I called for him. +</p> + +<p> +Eglaf came out and made a deep reverence when he saw the earl, knowing at once +who he was, and as this was just what the earl had said that he did not like, +he looked quaintly at me across Eglaf’s broad bent back, so that I had to grin +perforce. +</p> + +<p> +All unknowing of which the captain heard the earl’s business, and then told me +to see him to the palace gates, and take his horse to the stables when he had +dismounted and was in the hands of Berthun. +</p> + +<p> +So I went, and Havelok turned away and went on some errand down the steep +street. +</p> + +<p> +This Ragnar was one of whom I had often heard, for he was the governor of all +the North folk for Alsi until the Lady Goldberga should take her place. He was +her cousin, being the son of Ethelwald’s sister, who was of course a Dane. +Danish, and from the old country, was his father also, being one of the men who +had come over to the court of East Anglia when Ethelwald was made king. +</p> + +<p> +All the way to the door we talked of Denmark, but it was not far. There Berthun +came out and greeted the earl in court fashion, and I thought that I was done +with, because the grooms had run to take the great bay horse as they heard the +trampling. But, as it happened, I was wanted. +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar went in, saying to me that he would find me out again presently; and I +saw him walk across the great hall to the hearth, and stand there while Berthun +went to the king’s presence to tell him of the new arrival. Then I stood for a +minute to look at the horse, for the grooms had had no orders to take him away; +and mindful of Eglaf’s word to me, I was going to tell them to do so, and to +see it done, when Berthun came hurriedly and called me. +</p> + +<p> +“Master Housecarl,” he said rather breathlessly, “by the king’s order you are +to come within the hall and guard the doorway.” +</p> + +<p> +I shouldered my spear and followed him, and as we were out of hearing of the +grooms I said that the captain had ordered me to take the horse to the stables. +</p> + +<p> +“I will see to that,” he said. “Now you are to bide at the door while the king +speaks with Earl Ragnar, for there will be none else present. Let no one pass +in without the king’s leave.” +</p> + +<p> +We passed through the great door as he said that, and he closed it after him. +Ragnar was yet standing near the high seat, and turned as he heard the sound, +and smiled when he saw me. Berthun went quickly away through a side entrance, +and the hail was empty save for us two. The midday meal was over an hour since, +and the long tables had been cleared away, so that the place seemed desolate to +me, as I had only seen it before when I sat with the other men at the cross +tables for meals. It was not so good a hall as was Jarl Sigurd’s in Denmark, +for it was not rich with carving and colour as was his, and the arms on the +wall were few, and the hangings might have been brighter and better in a king’s +place. +</p> + +<p> +“Our king does not seem to keep much state,” Ragnar said, looking round as I +was looking, and we both laughed. +</p> + +<p> +Then the door on the high place opened, and the king came in, soberly dressed, +and with a smile on his face which seemed to me to have been made on purpose +for this greeting, for he mostly looked sour enough. Nor did it seem that his +eyes had any pleasure in them. +</p> + +<p> +“Welcome, kinsman,” he said, seeming hearty enough, however; “I had looked for +you before this. What news from our good town of Norwich?” +</p> + +<p> +He held out his hand to Ragnar, who took it frankly, and his strong grip +twisted the king’s set smile into a grin of pain for a moment. +</p> + +<p> +“All was well there three weeks ago when I left there to go to London. Now, I +have ridden on to say that the Lady Goldberga is not far hence, so that her +coming may be prepared for.” +</p> + +<p> +Now, as the earl said this, the king’s smile went from his face, and black +enough he looked for a moment. The look passed quickly, and the smile came +back, but it seemed hard to keep it up. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, that is well,” he said; “so you fell in with her on the way.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have attended her from London,” answered the earl, looking steadfastly at +Alsi, “and it was as well that I did so, as it happened.” +</p> + +<p> +“What has been amiss?” asked the king sharply, and trying to look troubled. He +let the smile go now altogether. +</p> + +<p> +“Your henchman, Griffin the Welshman, had no guard with her that was fitting +for our princess,” Ragnar said. “He had but twenty men, and these not of the +best. It is in my mind also that I should have been told of this journey, for I +am surely the right man to have guarded my queen who is to be.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Alsi’s face went ashy pale, and I did not rightly know why at the time, +but it seemed more in anger than aught else. But he had to make some answer. +</p> + +<p> +“We sent a messenger to you,” he said hastily; “I cannot tell why he did not +reach you.” +</p> + +<p> +“He must have come too late, and after I had heard of this from others; so I +had already gone to meet the princess. I am glad that I was sent for, and it +may pass. Well, it is lucky that I was in time, for we were attacked on the +road, and but for my men there would have been trouble.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi broke into wrath, which was real enough. +</p> + +<p> +“This passes all. Where and by whom were you attacked? and why should any fall +on the party?” +</p> + +<p> +“Five miles on the other side of Ancaster town, where the Ermin Street runs +among woods, we were fallen on, but who the men were I cannot say. Why they +should fall on us seems plain enough, seeing that the ransom of a princess is +likely to be a great sum.” +</p> + +<p> +“Was it a sharp fight?” +</p> + +<p> +“It was not,” answered Ragnar, “for it seemed to me that the men looked only to +find your Welsh thane Griffin and his men. When they saw my Norfolk housecarls, +they waited no longer, and we only rode down one or two of them. But I have +somewhat against this Griffin, for he helped me not at all. Until this day he +and his men had ridden fairly with us, but by the time this attack came they +were half a mile behind us.” +</p> + +<p> +“Do you mean to say that you think Griffin in league with these—outlaws, as one +may suppose them?” said Alsi, with wrath and more else written in twitching +mouth and crafty eyes. +</p> + +<p> +“I would not have said that,” Ragnar answered, looking in some surprise at the +king, “it had never come into my head. But I will say that as the Ermin Street +is straight as an arrow, and he was in full sight of us, he might have spurred +his horses to our help, whereas he never quickened his pace till he saw that +the outlaws, or whoever they were, had gone. I put this as a complaint to you.” +</p> + +<p> +“These men seem to have scared you, at least,” sneered the king. +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar flushed deeply. +</p> + +<p> +“For the princess—yes. It is not fitting that a man who is in charge of so +precious a lady should hold back in danger, even of the least seeming, as did +Griffin. And I told him so.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I thought that Alsi would have been as angry with Griffin as was the earl, +and that he would add that he also would speak his mind to him, hut instead of +that he went off in another way. +</p> + +<p> +“It was a pity that a pleasant journey with a fair companion was thus broken in +upon. But it was doubtless pleasant that the lady should see that her kinsman +was not unwilling to draw sword for her. A pretty little jest this, got up +between Griffin and yourself, and such as a young man may be forgiven for +playing. I shall hear Goldberga complain of honest Griffin presently, and now I +shall know how to answer her. Ay, I will promise him the like talking to that +you gave him, and then we three will laugh over it all together.” +</p> + +<p> +And with that the king broke into a cackle of laughter, catching hold of the +earl’s arm in his glee. And I never saw any man look so altogether bewildered +as did Ragnar. +</p> + +<p> +“Little jest was there in the matter, lord king, let me tell you,” he said, +trying to draw his arm away. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, I am not angry with you, kinsman; indeed, I am not. We have been young +and eager that bright eyes should see our valour ourselves ere now,” and he +shook his finger at the earl gaily. “I only wonder that you induced that fiery +Welshman to take a rating in the hearing of the princess quietly.” +</p> + +<p> +“What I had to say to him I said apart. I will not say that he did take it +quietly.” +</p> + +<p> +“Meaning—that you had a good laugh over it;” and Alsi shook the earl’s arm as +in glee. “There now, you have made a clean breast, and I am not one to spoil +sport. Go and meet Goldberga at the gates, and bring her to me in state, and +you shall be lodged here, if you will. Quite right of you to tell me this, or +Griffin would have been in trouble. But I must not have the lady scared again, +mind you.” +</p> + +<p> +He turned quickly away, then, with a sort of stifled laugh, as if he wanted to +get away to enjoy a good jest, and left Ragnar staring speechless at him as he +crossed the high place and went through the private door. +</p> + +<p> +Then the earl turned to me, “By Loki, fellow countryman, there is somewhat +wrong here. What does he mean by feigning to think the whole affair a jest? It +won’t be much of a jest if Griffin and I slay one another tomorrow, as we mean +to do, because of what was not done, and what was said about it.” +</p> + +<p> +“It has seemed to me, jarl,” I said plainly, “that all this is more like a jest +between the king and Griffin.” +</p> + +<p> +“Call it a jest, as that is loyal, at least. But I think that you are right. If +Goldberga had been carried off—Come, we shall be saying too much in these +walls.” +</p> + +<p> +I had only been told to wait while the king and earl spoke together, and so I +opened the door and followed him out. The horse was yet there waiting for him, +and it was plain that the king had not meant him to stay. +</p> + +<p> +“Bid the grooms lead the horse after us, and we will go to your captain. Then +you shall take me to one of my friends, for you will know where their houses +are.” +</p> + +<p> +But at that moment a man from the palace ran after us, bringing an order from +the king that I was to go back to him. So Ragnar bade me farewell. +</p> + +<p> +“Come to me tonight at the gatehouse,” he said. “I will speak to the captain to +let you off duty.” +</p> + +<p> +“Say nothing to him, jarl, for it is needless. I am only with him for a time, +and am my own master. I have no turn on watch tonight, and so am free.” +</p> + +<p> +So I went back, and found the king in the hall again, and he was still smiling. +If he had looked me straight in the face, I suppose that he might have seen +that I was not a man to whom he was used, but he did not. He seemed not to wish +to do so. +</p> + +<p> +“So, good fellow,” he said, “you have heard a pleasant jest of our young +kinsman’s contriving, but I will that you say nothing of it. It is a pity to +take a good guardroom story from you, however, without some recompense, and +therefore—” +</p> + +<p> +With that he put a little bag into my hand, and it was heavy. I said nothing, +but bowed in the English way, and he went on, “You understand; no word is to be +said of what you have heard unless I bid you repeat it. That I may have to do, +lest it is said that Griffin the thane is ‘nidring’<a href="#fn9" +name="fnref9"><sup>[9]</sup></a> by any of his enemies. You know all the +story—how the earl and he planned a sham attack on the princess’s party, that +Ragnar might show his valour, which, of course, he could not do if Griffin was +there. Therefore the thane held back. But maybe you heard all, and understood +it.” +</p> + +<p> +“I heard all, lord king, and I will say naught.” +</p> + +<p> +The king waved his hand in sign that I was dismissed, and I bowed and went. +There were five rings of gold in the bag, worth about the whole year’s wage of +a courtman, and I thought that for keeping a jest to myself that was good pay +indeed. There must be more behind that business, as it had seemed to me +already. +</p> + +<p> +Now, as I crossed the green within the old walls on my way to the gate, it +happened that Havelok came back from the town, and as he came I heard him +whistling softly to himself a strange wild call, as it were, of a hunting horn, +very sweet, and one that I had never heard before. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, brother!” I said, for there was no one near us. “What is that call you are +whistling?” +</p> + +<p> +He started and looked up at me suddenly, and I saw that his trouble was on him +again. +</p> + +<p> +“In my dream,” he said slowly, “there is a man on a great horse, and he wears +such bracelets as Ragnar of Norwich, and he winds his horn with that call, and +I run to him; and then I myself am on the horse, and I go to the stables, and +after that there is nothing but the call that I hear. Now it has gone again.” +</p> + +<p> +And his hand went up in the way that made me sad to see. +</p> + +<p> +“It will come back by-and-by. Trouble not about it.” +</p> + +<p> +“I would that we were back in Grimsby,” he said, with a great sigh. “This is a +place of shadows. Ghosts are these of days that I think can never have been.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said I, wanting to take him out of himself, “this is no ghost, at all +events. I would that one of our brothers would come from home that I might send +it to them in Grimsby. We do not need it.” +</p> + +<p> +So I showed him the gold, and he wondered at it, and laughed, saying that the +housecarls had the best place after all. And so he went on, and I back to the +gate. +</p> + +<p> +Surely he minded at last the days when Gunnar his father had ridden home to the +gate, as the Danish earl had ridden even now, and had called his son to him +with that call. It was all coming back, as one thing or another brought it to +his mind; and I wondered what should be when he knew that the dream was the +truth. For what should Havelok, foster-son of the fisher, do against a king who +for twelve long years had held his throne? And who in all the old land would +believe that he was indeed the son of the lost king? Better, it seemed to me, +that this had not happened, and that he had been yet the happy, careless, +well-loved son of Grim, with no thought of aught higher than the good of the +folk he knew. +</p> + +<p> +When I got back to the gate, we were marched down the town, that we might be +ready to receive the princess; and as I went through the market, I saw one of +the porters whom I knew, and I beckoned to him, so that he came alongside me in +the ranks, and I asked him if he would go to Grimsby for me for a silver penny. +He would do it gladly; and so I sent him with word to Arngeir that I needed one +of them here to take a gift that I had for them. I would meet whoever came at +the widow’s house, and I set a time when I would look for them. I thought it +was well that the king’s gold should not be wasted, even for a day’s use, if I +could help it. And I wearied to see one of the brothers, and hear all that was +going on. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap11">CHAPTER XI.<br/> +THE COMING OF THE PRINCESS.</a></h2> + +<p> +There is no need for me to tell aught of the entry of the Lady Goldberga into +the town, for anyone may know how the people cheered her, and how the party +were met by the Norfolk thanes and many others, and so rode on up the hill to +the palace. What the princess was like I hardly noticed at that time, for she +was closely hooded, and her maidens were round her. And I had something else to +think of; for foremost, and richly dressed, with a gold chain round his neck, +rode a man whose strange way of carrying his head caught my eye at once, so +that I looked more than a second time at him. +</p> + +<p> +And at last I knew him. It was that man of ours whose neck had been twisted by +the way in which he had been hauled on board at the time of the wreck, and had +afterwards gone to Ethelwald’s court. One would say that this Mord had +prospered exceedingly, for he was plainly a man of some consequence in the +princess’s household. He did not know me, though it happened that he looked +right at me for a moment; but I did not expect him to do so after twelve years, +seeing that I was but a boy when we parted. I thought that I would seek him +presently. +</p> + +<p> +Then I saw Griffin, the Welsh thane, and I did not like the looks of him at +all. He was a black-haired man, clean shaven, so that the cruel thinness of his +lips was not hidden, and his black eyes were restless, and never stayed +anywhere, unless he looked at Ragnar for a moment, and then that was a look of +deadly hatred. He wore his armour well, and had a steady seat on his horse; +but, if all that I had heard of him was true, his looks did not belie him. Men +had much to say of him here, for, being some far-off kin to Alsi’s Welsh +mother, he was always about the court, and was hated. He had gone to Dover to +fetch the princess before we came here, but it happened that I had once or +twice seen him at other times when I was in Lincoln, so that I knew him now. +</p> + +<p> +There was great feasting that night in the king’s hall, as one may suppose, and +I sat with the housecarls at the cross tables beyond the fire, and I could see +the Lady Goldberga at Alsi’s side. Tired she was with her long journey, and she +did not remain long at the table; but I had never seen so wondrously beautiful +a lady. Griffin sat next to her on the king’s right hand, for Ragnar was at the +king’s left, in the seat of next honour; and I saw that the lady had no love +for the Welsh thane. But I also thought that I saw how he would give his all +for a kindly glance from her; and if, as Alsi had seemed to hint, Ragnar was a +favoured lover, I did not wonder that Griffin had been ready to do him a bad +turn. I had rather that the thane was my friend than my foe, for he would be no +open enemy. +</p> + +<p> +I left the feast when the first change of guard went out, for I saw that the +ale cup was passing faster than we Danes think fitting, being less given to it +than the English. And when the guard was set I waited alone in the guardroom of +the old gate, for Eglaf was yet at the hall, and would be there all night +maybe. And presently Earl Ragnar came in and sat down with me. +</p> + +<p> +He was silent for a while, and I waited for him to speak, until he looked up at +me with a little laugh, and said, “I told you that I had to fight Griffin +tomorrow?” +</p> + +<p> +“You did, earl. Is that matter settled otherwise?” +</p> + +<p> +“Not at all,” he answered. “I believe now that he was acting under orders, but +I have said things to him which he cannot pass over. I called him ‘nidring’ to +his face, and that I still mean; for though I thought of cowardice at the time, +he is none the less so if he has plotted against the princess. So naught but +the sword will end the feud.” +</p> + +<p> +He pondered for some moments, and then went on, “It is a bad business; for if I +slay Griffin, he is the king’s favourite; and if he slays me, the Norfolk +thanes will have somewhat to say. And all is bad for the Lady Goldberga, who +needs all the friends that she has, for in either case there will be trouble +between the two kingdoms that Alsi holds just now.” +</p> + +<p> +“If Griffin is slain,” I said, “I think that the lady has one trouble out of +the way.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay; and the king will make out, as you heard him do even now, that I am +looking that way myself. It is not so, for I will say to you at once that to me +there is but one lady in all the world, and she is in Norfolk at this time. Now +I am going to ask you something that is a favour.” +</p> + +<p> +I thought that he would give me some message for this lady, in case he fell; +but he had more to ask than that. Nothing more or less than that I should be +his second in the fight, because I was a fellow countryman, while to ask an +East Anglian thane would he to make things harder yet for Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +“I am no thane, earl,” I said plainly. “This is an honour that is over high for +me.” +</p> + +<p> +“It seems that you own a town, for I asked Eglaf just now,” he answered; “and +that is enough surely to give you thane’s rank in a matter like this. But that +is neither here nor there; it is as Dane to Dane that I ask you. If I could +find another of us I would ask him also, that you might not have to stand +alone. I am asking you to break the law that bids the keeping of the peace at +the time of the meeting of the Witan.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is no matter,” I said. “If I have to fly, it will be with you as victor; +and if it is but a matter of a fine, I have had that from the king today which +will surely pay it.” +</p> + +<p> +And I told him of the gift for silence, whereat he laughed heartily, and then +said that the secret was more worth than he thought. This looked very bad, and +like proof that the king was at the bottom of the whole business. +</p> + +<p> +Now I had been thinking, and it seemed better that there should be two +witnesses of the fight on our side, and I thought that Havelok was the man who +would make the second. So I told Ragnar that I could find another Dane who was +at least as worthy as I, and he was well pleased. Then he told me where the +meeting was to be, and where we should meet him just before daylight; and so he +went back to the hall, where the lights were yet burning redly, and the songs +were wilder than ever. +</p> + +<p> +And I found Havelok, and told him of the fight that was to be, and asked him to +come with us. His arms were at the widow’s, and he could get them without any +noticing him. +</p> + +<p> +There is no need to say that he was ready as I to help Ragnar, and so we spoke +of time and place, and parted for the night. +</p> + +<p> +Very early came Havelok to the house, for I lodged at the widow’s when I was +not on night duty; and we armed ourselves, and then came Ragnar. He greeted me +first, and then looked at Havelok in amaze, as it seemed, and then bowed a +little, and asked me to make my friend known to him. +</p> + +<p> +“If you are the friend of whom Radbard has told me, I think that I am fortunate +in having come to him.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am his brother, lord earl,” answered Havelok, “and I am at your service.” +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar looked from one of us to the other, and then smiled. +</p> + +<p> +“A brother Dane and a brother in arms, truly,” he said. “Well, that is all that +I need ask, except your name, as I am to be another brother of the same sort.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok looked at me, and I nodded. I knew what he meant; but it was not +right that the earl should not know who he was. +</p> + +<p> +“Men call me Curan here, lord earl, and that I must be to you hereafter. But I +am Havelok of Grimsby, son of Grim.” +</p> + +<p> +In a moment I saw that the earl knew more of that name than I had deemed +possible; and then I minded Mord, the wry-necked, who was the chamberlain now. +But Ragnar said nothing beyond that he would remember the request, and that he +was well seconded. And then we went out into the grey morning, and without +recrossing the bridge, away to the level meadows on the south of the river, far +from any roadway. +</p> + +<p> +“There is not an island in the stream,” said Ragnar, “or I should have wanted +the old northern holmgang battle. I doubt if we could even get these Welshmen +to peg out the lists.” +</p> + +<p> +“That we must see to,” I said. “We will have all things fair in some way.” +</p> + +<p> +Half a mile from the town we came to what they call a carr—a woody rise in the +level marsh—and on the skirts of this two men waited us. They were the seconds +of Griffin, Welsh or half Welsh both of them by their looks, and both were well +armed. Their greeting was courteous enough, and they led us by a little track +into the heart of the thickets, and there was a wide and level clearing, most +fit for a fight, in which waited Griffin himself. +</p> + +<p> +Now I had never taken any part in a fight before, and I did not rightly know +what I had to do to begin with. However, one of the other side seemed to be +well up in the matter, and at once he came to me and Havelok and took us aside. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is a little trouble,” he said: “our men have said nothing of what weapons +they will use.” +</p> + +<p> +“I take it,” said Havelok at once, “that they meant to use those which were +most handy to them, therefore.” +</p> + +<p> +The Welshman stared, and answered rather stiffly, “This is not a matter of +chance medley, young sir, but an ordered affair. But doubtless this is the +first time you have been in this case, and do not know the rules. Let me tell +you, therefore, that your earl, being the challenged man, has choice of +weapons. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then,” answered Havelok, “it seems to me that if we say as I have already +said, it is fair on our part. For it is certain that the earl will want to use +the axe, and your man is about half his weight, so that would be uneven.” +</p> + +<p> +“As the challenged man, the earl is entitled to any advantage in weapons.” +</p> + +<p> +“He needs none. Let us fight fairly or not at all. The earl takes the axe.—What +say you, Radbard? Griffin takes what he likes.” +</p> + +<p> +“You keep to the axe after all, and yet say that it gives an advantage.” +</p> + +<p> +“Axe against axe it does, but if your man chooses to take a twenty-foot spear +and keep out of its way, we do not object. We give him his own choice.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the other second said frankly, “This is generous, Cadwal. No more need be +said. But this young thane has not yet asked his earl whether it will suit +him.” +</p> + +<p> +“Faith, no,” said Havelok, laughing; “I was thinking what I should like myself, +and nothing at all of the earl.” +</p> + +<p> +So I went across to Ragnar, who was waiting patiently at one end of the +clearing, while Griffin was pacing with uneven steps backward and forward at +the other, and I told him what the question was. +</p> + +<p> +“I thought it would be a matter of swords,” he said, “but I am Dane enough to +like the axe best. Settle it as you will. Of course he knows naught of axe +play, so that you are right in not pressing it on him. He is a light man, and +active, and maybe will be glad not even to try sword to sword; for look at the +sort of bodkin he is wearing.” +</p> + +<p> +The earl and we had the northern long sword, of course; but when I looked I saw +that the Welsh had short, straight, and heavy weapons of about half the length +of ours, and so even sword to sword seemed hard on the lighter man; wherein I +was wrong, as I had yet to learn. +</p> + +<p> +I went back, therefore, and told the others. +</p> + +<p> +“The earl takes the axe, and the thane has his choice, as we have said.” +</p> + +<p> +“We have to thank you,” said the other second, while Cadwal only laughed a +short laugh, and bade us choose the ground with them. +</p> + +<p> +There was no difficulty about that, for the light was clear and bright, and +though the sun was up, the trees bid any bright rays that might be in the eyes +of the fighters. However, we set them across the light, so that all there was +might be even; and then we agreed that if one was forced back to the edge of +the clearing he was to be held beaten, as if we had been on an island. It was +nearly as good, for the shore of trees and brushwood was very plain and sharp. +</p> + +<p> +Now Ragnar unslung his round shield from his shoulders, and took his axe from +me, for I had carried it for him, and his face was quiet and steady, as the +face of one should be who has a deed to do that must be seen through to the +end. But Griffin and his men talked quickly in their own tongue, and I had to +tell them that we understood it well enough. Then they looked at each other, +and were silent suddenly. I wondered what they, were about to say, for it +seemed that my warning came just in time for them. +</p> + +<p> +Griffin took a shield from the thane they called Cadwal, and it was square—a +shape that I had not seen before in use, though Witlaf had one like it on the +wall at Stallingborough. He said that it had been won from a chief by his +forefathers when the English first came into the land, and that it was the old +Roman shape. It seemed unhandy to me, but I had no time to think of it for a +moment, for now Cadwal had a last question. +</p> + +<p> +“Is this fight to be to the death?” +</p> + +<p> +“No,” I answered; “else were the rule we made about the boundary of no use.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Griffin cried in a sort of choked voice, “It shall be to the death.” +</p> + +<p> +But I said nothing, and the other second, with Cadwal, shook his head. +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar made no sign, but Cadwal said to Havelok, “You were foremost in the +matter just now. What say you?” +</p> + +<p> +“Rules are rules, and what my comrade says is right. If the first blow slays, +we cannot help it, but there shall be no second wound. The man who is first +struck is defeated.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will not have it so,” said Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, thane, after you have wounded the earl you will have to reckon +with me, if you must slay someone.” +</p> + +<p> +Griffin looked at the towering form of my brother and made no answer, and the +other second told him that it was right. There was naught but an angry word or +two to be atoned for. So there was an end, and Ragnar went on guard. Griffin +made ready also, and at once it was plain that here was no uneven match after +all. +</p> + +<p> +Both of them wore ring mail of the best. We had set the two six paces apart, +and they must step forward to get within striking distance. At once Griffin +seemed to grow smaller, for he crouched down as a cat that is going to spring, +and raised his shield before him, so that from where I stood behind Ragnar I +could only see his black glittering eyes and round helm above its edge. And his +right arm was drawn back, so that only the point of his heavy leaf-bladed sword +was to be seen glancing from the right edge steadily. And now his eyes were +steady as the sword point, which was no brighter than they. If once he got +inside the sweep of the great axe it would be bad for Ragnar. +</p> + +<p> +One step forward went the earl, shield up and axe balanced, but Griffin never +moved. Then Ragnar leapt forward and struck out, but I could see that it was a +feint, and he recovered at once. Griffin’s shield had gone up in a moment above +his head, and in a moment it was back in its place, and over it his eyes glared +as before, unwavering. And then, like a wildcat, he sprang at Ragnar, making no +sweeping blow with his sword, but thrusting with straight arm, so that the +whole weight of his flying body was behind the point. Ragnar struck out, but +the square shield was overhead to stay the blow, and full on the round Danish +buckler the point of the short sword rang, for the earl was ready to meet it. +</p> + +<p> +In a moment the Welshman was back in his crouching guard, leaving a great +ragged hole in the shield whence he had wrenched his weapon point in a way that +told of a wrist turn that had been long practised. Ragnar had needed no leech, +had his quick eye not saved him from that thrust. +</p> + +<p> +Then for a breathing space the two watched each other, while we held our +breath, motionless. And then Griffin slowly began to circle round his foe, +still crouching. +</p> + +<p> +Then, like a thunderbolt, Ragnar’s axe swept down on the thane, and neither +shield nor helm would have been of avail had that blow gone home. Back leapt +Griffin, and the axe shore the edge only of his shield; and then, shield aloft +and point foremost, he flew on the earl before the axe had recovered from its +swing, and I surely thought that the end had come, for the earl’s shield was +lowered, and his face was unguarded. +</p> + +<p> +But that was what he looked for. Up and forward flew the round shield, catching +the thane’s straightened arm along its whole length, and then, as sword and arm +were dashed upwards, smiting him fairly in the face; and, like a stone, the +Welshman was hurled from it, and fell backward in a heap on the grass three +paces away. It seemed to me that he was off his feet in his spring as the +shield smote him. +</p> + +<p> +There he lay, and Havelok strode forward and stood between the two, with his +face to Griffin, for Ragnar had dropped his axe to rest when his foe fell. +</p> + +<p> +“No blood drawn,” said my brother, “but no more fighting can there be. The +man’s arm is out.” +</p> + +<p> +And so it was, for the mighty heave that turned the thrust had ended Griffin’s +fighting for a long day. But he did not think so. +</p> + +<p> +The sweat was standing on his face in great beads from the pain, but he got up +and shifted his sword to his left hand. +</p> + +<p> +“It is to the death,” he cried; “I can fight as well with the left. Stand +aside.” +</p> + +<p> +“An it had been so, you were a dead man now,” said Havelok, “for the earl held +his hand where he might have slain. If he had chosen, you might have felt his +axe before you touched the ground.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat, without warning other than a snarl of “Your own saying,” Griffin leapt +at my brother fiercely, only to meet a swing of his axe that sent his sword +flying from his hand. And that was deft of Havelok, for there is nothing more +hard to meet than a left-handed attack at any time, and this seemed unlooked +for. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I did say somewhat of this sort,” said Havelok; “but it was lucky that I +had not forgotten it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he took the thane by the waist and left arm and set him down gently; and +after that all the fury went from him, and he grew pale with the pain of the +arm that was hurt. But both I and the Welshmen had shouted to Griffin to hold, +all uselessly, so quick had been his onset on his new foe. +</p> + +<p> +Cadwal held his peace, biting his lip, but the other Welshman began to blame +Griffin loudly for this. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” said Havelok, smiling; “it was my own fault maybe. The thane was +overhasty certainly, but one does not think with pain gnawing at one. Let that +pass. +</p> + +<p> +“Now, earl, I think that you may say what you have to say that will set things +right once more.” +</p> + +<p> +“Can none of us put the arm back first?” I said. “I will try, if none else has +done such a thing before, for it will not be the first time.” +</p> + +<p> +“Put it back, if you can,” said Cadwal. “If there is anything to be said, it +had better be in some sort of comfort.” +</p> + +<p> +So I put the arm back, for when once the trick is learned there is not, as a +rule, much trouble. But Griffin never thanked me. He left that to his seconds, +who did so well enough. +</p> + +<p> +Then Ragnar came forward and said gravely, “I was wrong when I called you +‘nidring,’ and I take back the word and ask you to forget it. No man who is +that will face the Danish axe as you have faced it, and I will say that the +British sword is a thing to be feared.” +</p> + +<p> +But Griffin made no answer, and when Ragnar held out his hand he would not see +it. +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe I have not yet made amends,” Ragnar went on. “I will add, therefore, as +I know that my words will go no farther, that I am sure that the thing +concerning which we quarrelled yesterday was done by you at the orders of +another. It was not your own doing, and no thought of cowardice is in my mind +now.” +</p> + +<p> +But Griffin never answered; and now he turned his back on the earl, who was +plainly grieved, and said no more to him, but turned to us and the two +Welshmen. +</p> + +<p> +“I do not think that I can say more. If there is aught that is needed, tell me. +We have fought a fair fight, and I have taken back the words that caused it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Cadwal, “No more is needed. I did not think that we had met with so +generous a foe. If Griffin will say naught, we say this for him. He has no +cause for enmity left. And I say also that he has to thank this thane for his +life as well as the earl.” +</p> + +<p> +“No thane am I,” said Havelok, “but only Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby. And even +that name is set aside for a while, so that I must ask you to forget it. I have +seen a good fight, if a short one, and one could not smite a wounded man who +forgot himself for a moment.” +</p> + +<p> +There was nothing more to be had from Griffin, for we waited a minute or two in +silence to see if he would speak, and then we saluted and left the wood. +</p> + +<p> +The last thing that I saw seemed to be a matter of high words between Griffin +and his seconds; and, indeed, if they were telling him what they thought, it is +likely that he wished he had been more courteous. It is easy enough for a man +who wants a quarrel to have done with one and then start another. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap12">CHAPTER XII.<br/> +IN LINCOLN MARKETPLACE.</a></h2> + +<p> +We went quietly back to the town, and there was only one thing that I wished, +and that was that Havelok had not had to tell his name twice. Ragnar was full +of thanks to us for our help, and said that he would that we would come to +Norfolk with him. +</p> + +<p> +“We have a man who knows you also,” he said, “but he has been with our princess +for a long time now. He is called Mord, and is her chamberlain. He has often +told me how he came by his wry-neck at the time of your shipwreck.” +</p> + +<p> +So he said, and looked at Havelok. But this was a thing that he had not seen, +as he was so sick at the time. I said that I remembered Mord well, and would +seek him some time in the day. +</p> + +<p> +And as I said this I was thinking that I must find out from Mord whether he +knew and had told more than I could of who Havelok was and whence he came to +us. It seemed to me that the earl had heard some tale or other, and unless it +was from him I could not think from whence. +</p> + +<p> +Now the earl said, “This business has ended better than I could have hoped, and +I think that Alsi will not hear of it. Griffin can well account for a slipped +shoulder by any sort of fall that he likes to own to, and Alsi would be hardly +pleased to hear that he had run the risk of setting all Norfolk against him for +nothing after all.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is no doubt that he meant you to know that he does not consider the +quarrel done with,” I said. “You have an enemy there.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nothing new, that,” answered Ragnar, laughing. “He thinks that I stand in his +way with the princess. I suppose it is common talk that if he wedded her Alsi +would still hold the East Anglian kingdom, making him ealdorman, if only I were +out of the way. But were I to wed the lady, then it is certain that she would +take the crown at once. I do not mean to do so, for then it is likely that +three people would be unhappy for the rest of their days. But that would be +less wretched for her than to wed Griffin.” +</p> + +<p> +“This is no pleasant strait for the poor lady,” said Havelok grimly. “Do none +ask what she herself can wish?” +</p> + +<p> +“That is the trouble,” said the earl, “for she is in Alsi’s hand, and there is +some old promise and oath sworn between him and Ethelwald her father that holds +him back. Else had she been wedded to Griffin before now.” +</p> + +<p> +Then we came to the widow’s house, and Havelok left his arms there, and we went +on to the marketplace. As we crossed the bridge we saw that there was something +going forward, for there was a gathering in the wide space, and a shouting and +cheering now and then, and even Berthun himself was there looking on and +seeming to be highly entertained. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is a crowd that I will not face just now, in my arms,” said the earl; +“for this hole in my shield looks bad, not having been there when I went out. +Farewell for the time, therefore, and think of what I said about your coming to +Norwich with me.” +</p> + +<p> +He turned away therefore, and Havelok looked after him for a moment. The shield +hung at his back, plain to be seen. +</p> + +<p> +“It is a hole, for certain,” he said; “but there is no need to show it in that +wise.” +</p> + +<p> +So he strode after him. +</p> + +<p> +“By your leave, earl, I will arrange your cloak across the shield, and then you +can get it to your armourer without notice.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is well thought of,” answered Ragnar, as Havelok did as he had said. “I +do not forget that I think that I owe you my life, though I have said nothing +as yet.” +</p> + +<p> +“How is that?” +</p> + +<p> +“Griffin would have flown on me as he did on you, certainly; and it is in my +mind that you foresaw it, which I did not. I could not have stayed him.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well I did,” answered my brother; “else had either I or you a hole in us like +the one that is well covered now. But I feared what came to pass.” +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar held out his hand, and Havelok took it, and so they parted without more +words; but I knew that these two were friends from that time forward, whatever +happened. +</p> + +<p> +There were some sports of some sort on hand, when we came to see what all the +noise was; and Berthun, seeing us, called Havelok to him. +</p> + +<p> +“I have been looking for you,” he said, with that curious tone of his that +always seemed to be asking pardon for his boldness in speaking to my brother; +“for here are games at which they need some one to show the way.” +</p> + +<p> +“This is a sport that I have not seen before,” answered Havelok, looking over +the heads of the crowd. “I should make a poor hand at it.” +</p> + +<p> +They had been tossing a great fir pole, which was now laid on one side, with +its top split from its falls, and they, thanes and freemen in turn, were +putting a great stone, so heavy that a matter of a few inches beyond the +longest cast yet made would be something to be proud of. Good sport enough it +was to see the brawny housecarls heave it from the ground and swing it. But no +one could lift it above his knee, so that one may suppose that it flew no great +distance at a cast. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but the thanes are trying,” Berthun said. “It is open to all to do what +they can. One of your porters is best man so far.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I will not try to outdo him.” +</p> + +<p> +“I would that you would lift the stone, Curan. That is a thing that I should +most like to see.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well then, master, as you bid me, I will try. But do not expect too much.” +</p> + +<p> +The man who had the stone made his cast, which was nothing to speak of; and +then the stone lay unclaimed for a time, while all the onlookers waited to see +who came forward next. Then Havelok made his way through the crowd, and a +silence as of wonder fell on the people; for some knew him, and had heard of +his strength, and those who did not stared at him as at a wonder. But the +silence did not last long, for the porters who were there set up a sort of +shout of delight, and that one who had made the longest cast so far began to +tell him how best to heft the stone and swing it. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok bent to raise the stone, and the noise hushed again. I saw his +mighty limbs harden and knot under the strain, and up to his knee he heaved it, +and to his middle, and yet higher, to his chest, while we all held our breaths, +and then with a mighty lift it was at his shoulder, and he poised it, and swung +as one who balances for a moment, and then hurled it from him. Then was a shout +that Alsi might have heard in his hilltop palace, for full four paces beyond +the strong porter’s cast it flew, lighting with a mighty crash, and bedding +itself in the ground where it lit. And I saw the young thanes with wide eyes +looking at my brother, and from beside me Berthun the cook fairly roared with +delight. +</p> + +<p> +And then from across the space between the two lines of onlookers I saw a man +in a fisher’s dress that caught my eye. It was Withelm, and we nodded to each +other, well pleased. +</p> + +<p> +Now there seemed to be a strife as to who should get nearest to Havelok, for +men crowded to pat him and to look up at him, and that pleased him not at all. +One came and bade him take the silver pennies that the thanes had set out for +the prize, but he shook his head and smiled. +</p> + +<p> +“I threw the thing because I was bidden, and not for any prize,” he said. “I +would have it given to the porter who fairly won it.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he elbowed his way to Berthun, and said, “let us go, master; we have +stayed here too long already.” +</p> + +<p> +“As it pleases you,” the steward said; and Havelok waved his hand to me, and +they went their way. +</p> + +<p> +He had not seen Withelm, and I was glad, for I wanted to speak to him alone +first. +</p> + +<p> +Now men began to ask who this was, and many voices answered, while the porter +went to claim the prize from the thane who held it. +</p> + +<p> +Two silver pennies the thane gave him, and said, “This seems to be a friend of +yours, and it was good to hear you try to help him without acrimony. Not that +he needed any hints from any one, however. Who is he?” +</p> + +<p> +“Men call him Curan, that being the name he gives himself; but he came as a +stranger to the place, and none know from whence, unless Berthun the cook may +do so. Surely he is a friend of mine, for he shook me once, and that shaking +made an honest man of me. He himself taught me what fair play is, at that same +time.” +</p> + +<p> +So said the porter, and laughed, and the thane joined him. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, he has made a sort of name for himself as a wonder, certainly, now. I +think that this cast of his will be told of every time men lift a stone here in +Lincoln,” said the thane. +</p> + +<p> +They left the stone where he had set it, and any one may see it there to this +day, and there I suppose it will be for a wonder while Havelok’s name is +remembered. +</p> + +<p> +Then they began wrestling and the like, and I left the crowd and went to +Withelm, going afterwards to the widow’s. I was not yet wanted by Eglaf for any +housecarl duty. +</p> + +<p> +“I sent a man to Grimsby yesterday,” I said; “but you must have passed him on +the way somewhere, for he could not have started soon enough to take you a +message before you left.” +</p> + +<p> +“I met him on the road last night, for I myself thought it time to come and see +how you two fared. I bided at Cabourn for the night, and your messenger came on +with me.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told me that all were well at Grimsby; for fish came now and then and +kept the famine from the town, though there were none to send elsewhere; and it +was well that we had left, though they all missed us sorely. +</p> + +<p> +Then we began to talk of the doings here; and at last I spoke of Havelok’s +trouble, as one may well call it, telling him also of the strange dream with +which it all began. +</p> + +<p> +“All this is strange,” he said thoughtfully; “but if Havelok our brother is +indeed a king’s son, it is only what he is like in all his ways. Wise was our +father Grim, and I mind how he seemed always to be careful of him in every way, +and good reason must he have had not to say what he knew. We will not ask aught +until the time of which Arngeir knows has come. Nor can we say aught to +Havelok, though he is troubled, for we know nothing. As for the dream, that is +part of it all, and it is a portent, as I think.” +</p> + +<p> +“Did I know the man who could read it, I would go to him and tell him it.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is one man who can read dreams well,” Withelm answered, flushing a +little, “but I do not know if you would care to seek him. I stayed with him +last night, and he is on his way even now to Lincoln, driven by the famine. I +mean the old British priest David, who has his little hut and chapel in the +Cabourn woods. His people have no more to give him.” +</p> + +<p> +I knew that Withelm thought much of this old man of late, and I was not +surprised to hear him speak of him now. All knew his wisdom, and the marsh folk +were wont to seek him when they were in any trouble or difficulty. But I did +not care to go to him, for he seemed to belong to the thralls, as one might +say. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, if he comes here, no doubt you will know where to find him if we need +him,” I said. “Bide with us for a few days at least, for here is plenty, and +there is much going on.” +</p> + +<p> +So we went into the town, and then to the palace, and found Havelok, and after +that I had to go to the gate on guard. And what these two did I cannot say, +but, at all events, there is nothing worth telling of. +</p> + +<p> +Now, however, I have to tell things that I did not see or hear myself, and +therefore I would have it understood that I heard all from those who took some +part or other in the matter, and so know all well. +</p> + +<p> +I have not said much of the meetings of the Witan, for I had naught more to do +with them than to guard the doors of the hall where they met now and then; but +since the princess and Ragnar came they seem to have somewhat to do with the +story, as will be seen. +</p> + +<p> +On this day one of the Norfolk thanes asked in full meeting what plans the king +had for his ward Goldberga, and her coming into her kingdom, saying that she, +being eighteen years of age, was old enough to take her place. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi had thought of this beforehand, and was ready at once. +</p> + +<p> +“It is a matter of concern to us always,” he said, “and much have I thought +thereof. It is full time that she took her father’s place with the consent of +the Witan, which is needed.” +</p> + +<p> +He looked round us for reply to this, and at once the Norfolk thanes said, “We +will have Goldberga for our queen, as was the will of Ethelwald.” +</p> + +<p> +“That,” said Alsi, “is as I thought. I needed only to hear it said openly. Now, +therefore, it remains but to speak of one other thing and that is a weighty +one. It was her father’s will and I swore to carry it out, that she should be +wedded to the most goodly and mightiest man in the realm. It seems to me that +on her marriage hangs all the wealth of her kingdom; and ill it would be if, +after she took the throne, she took to herself one who made himself an evil +adviser. I would say that it were better to see her married first, for it does +not follow that you would choose to have the man whom I thought fitting to be +over you, as he certainly would be.” +</p> + +<p> +Now all this was so straightforward in all seeming that none of the thanes +could be aught but pleased. Moreover, it took away a fear that they had had +lest Griffin was to be the man. None could say that he fulfilled the conditions +of the will of Ethelwald. The spokesman said, therefore, that it was well set +before them, and that it was best to wait, saying at the end, “For, after all, +we might have to change our minds concerning the princess, if with her we must +take a man who will prove a burden or tyrant to us all.” +</p> + +<p> +Then they asked the king to find a good husband for the princess as soon as +might be, so that he was not against her liking. +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said Alsi, “it is a hard task for a man who has no wife to help him; +but we will trust to the good sense of my niece. Now, I had thought of Ragnar +of Norwich; but it is in my mind that the old laws of near kin are somewhat +against this.” +</p> + +<p> +I suppose that he had no intention of letting the earl marry the princess; but +this was policy, as it might please the thanes. However, the matter of kinship +did not please some, and that was all that he needed, for there was excuse then +for him if he forbade that match, which was the last he wanted. +</p> + +<p> +Ragnar sat in his place and heard all this, and he wished himself back at +Norwich. +</p> + +<p> +So there the matter ended, and that was the last sitting of the Witan. There +was to be a great breaking-up feast that night before the thanes scattered to +their homes. +</p> + +<p> +Now while this was going on I ended my spell of duty, and bethought me of Mord +the chamberlain, and so went to Berthun and asked for him. He said that if I +had any special business with Mord I might see him; and I said, truly enough, +that my errand was special, having to do with friends of his; so it was not +long before they took me to him. He was in a long room that was built on the +side of the great hall, as it were, and I could hear the murmur of the voices +of those who spoke at the Witan while I waited. +</p> + +<p> +Now Mord was not so much changed as I, and at first he did not know me at all. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, master housecarl, what may your message be, and from whom is it?” he +said, without more than a glance at me. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, there are some old friends of yours who are anxious to know if you have +forgotten the feeling of a halter round your neck,” I said in good Danish. +</p> + +<p> +Then, after one look, he knew me at once, and ran to me, and took my hand, and +almost kissed me in his pleasure, for since I could handle an oar he had known +me, and had taught me how to do that, moreover. +</p> + +<p> +Then he called for wine and food; and we sat down together and had a long talk +of the old days, and of how we had fared after he left, and of all else that +came uppermost. And sorely he grieved at my father’s death, and at the trouble +that was on us. The famine had not been so sore in the south, and pestilence +had not been at all. +</p> + +<p> +As for himself, he had been courtman, as we call the housecarls, at first, and +so had risen to be chamberlain to the king, and now to the princess, and had +been with her everywhere that Alsi had sent her since her father died. +</p> + +<p> +“It was a good day for me, and wise was Grim when he bade me go to Ethelwald to +seek service,” he said; “yet I would that I had seen him once more. I have +never been to this place before, else I should have sought him.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I was going to ask him about Havelok, but hardly knew how to begin. He +saved me the trouble however, by speaking first. +</p> + +<p> +“Who were the lady and the boy we had on board when we came to England?” he +said. “I never heard, and maybe it was as well that I did not.” +</p> + +<p> +“My father never told me. But why do you think that it was well not to know?” +</p> + +<p> +“Because I am sure that Grim had good reason for not telling. Before I had been +a year at Norwich there came a ship from Denmark into the river, and soon men +told me that her master was asking for news of one Grim, a merchant, who was +lost. So I saw him, not saying who I was or that I had anything to do with +Grim; and then I found that it was not so much of the master that he wanted +news as of the boy we had with us. He did not ask of the lady at all, and I was +sure that this was the man who came and spoke to Grim just as we were sailing, +if you remember. So then it came to me that we knew nothing of the coming on +board of these two, only learning of their presence when we were far at sea. +And now, if Hodulf troubled himself so much about this boy, there must be +something that he was not meant to know about his flight, for he must be of +some note. Did I not know that the king’s son was in his hands at that time, I +should have thought that our passenger was he. However, I told him of the +shipwreck as of a thing that I had seen, saying that Grim and his family and a +few men only had been saved; and I told him also that I had heard that he had +lost some folk in an attack by Vikings. With that he seemed well satisfied, and +I heard no more of him. I have wondered ever since who the boy was, and if he +was yet alive. I mind that he was like to die when he came ashore.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I laughed, and said that he would hear of him soon enough, for all the +town was talking of him; and he guessed whom I meant, for he had heard of the +cook’s mighty man. +</p> + +<p> +Now I said no more but this: +</p> + +<p> +“My father kept this matter secret all these years, and with reason, as we have +seen; and so, while he is here, we call this foster-brother of mine Curan, +until the time comes when his name may he known. Maybe it will be best for you +not to say much of your knowledge of him. What does Earl Ragnar know of our +wreck? For he told me that you knew me.” +</p> + +<p> +“I told him all about it at one time or another,” Mord answered. “He always +wanted to hear of Denmark.” +</p> + +<p> +So that was all that the chamberlain knew; but it was plain to me that the earl +had put two and two together when he heard Havelok’s name, and had remembered +that this was also the name of Gunnar’s son. Afterwards I found that Mord had +heard from Denmark that Hodulf was said to have made away with Havelok, but he +never remembered that at this time. Ragnar knew this, and did remember it. +</p> + +<p> +Pleasant it was to talk of old days with an old friend thus, and the time went +quickly. Then Mord must go to his mistress and I to my place, and so we parted +for the time. But my last doubt of who Havelok my brother might be was gone. I +was sure that he was the son of Gunnar the king. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap13">CHAPTER XIII.<br/> +THE WITAN’S FEASTING.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now I have to tell of a strange thing that happened in the night that was just +past, the first that the Lady Goldberga had spent here in Lincoln for many a +year, for on that happening hangs a great deal, and it will make clear what I +myself saw presently at the breaking-up feast of the Witan. That puzzled me +mightily at the time, as it did many at the feast, but I see no reason why it +should not be told at once. +</p> + +<p> +Now I have said that Goldberga left the hall early overnight, being wearied +with the journey, and having the remembrance of the attack on her party so near +to Lincoln to trouble her also. Not much cause to love her uncle Alsi had she; +though perhaps, also, not much to make her hate him, except that he had kept +her so far away from her own people of late, in a sort of honourable captivity. +Now it was plain to her that had it not been for the presence of Ragnar and his +men, her guard would not have been able to drive off the attackers; and the +strange way in which Griffin had held back had been too plain for her not to +notice. Already she feared him, and it seemed that he might have plotted her +carrying off thus. That Alsi might have had a hand in the matter did not come +into her mind, as it did into the minds of others, for she knew little of him, +thinking him honest if not very pleasant in his ways, else had not her father +made him her guardian. +</p> + +<p> +I will say now that in the attack he did have a hand. Many a long year +afterward it all came out in some way. He dared not give his niece to Griffin +openly, but he wished to do so, as then he would have an under-king in East +Anglia of his own choosing. Sorely against the grain with him was it that he +should have to give up those fair lands to this girl, who would hold the throne +by her own right, and not at all under him. So he and Griffin had plotted thus, +and only Ragnar’s presence had spoilt the plan, though Griffin had tried to +save it by holding back. But I must say also that up to this time none had had +aught to say against Alsi as a ruler, though he was over close, and not at all +hearty in his ways at home. But now, for the sake of the kingdom, he had begun +to plot; and this plan having come to naught, he must make others, as will be +seen. I do not think that this planning to keep Ethelwald’s kingdom from his +daughter was anything fresh to Alsi, but the time for action had come now. +</p> + +<p> +He had made ready by keeping the fair princess far away, and there were none +who could speak of her goodness, or, indeed, had heard much of her since she +was a child. Therefore, as men were content enough with him, none would trouble +much if the princess came not to the throne, given good reason why she should +not do so. And the very best reason would be that which Alsi had given at the +Witan—if her husband was not fit to be king. +</p> + +<p> +It is possible that Goldberga knew that her marriage would be talked of at this +Witan: but I do not think that she troubled herself much about it, not by any +means intending to be married against her will. I have heard that so ran the +will of Ethelwald, that she was to have choice to some extent. However that may +be, with so many thoughts to trouble her she went to rest, and her sleep was +not easy until the morning was near, and then came quiet. +</p> + +<p> +But presently, in the grey of the dawn, she woke, and called her old nurse, who +was in the chamber with her; and when she came she told her that she had had a +strange vision or dream, so real that she did not know which it was. And what +it portended she could not say, for it was wonderful altogether, and surely was +good. +</p> + +<p> +“I thought that a voice wakened me, calling me to look on somewhat; and so I +rose as I was bidden, and saw before me the most mighty and comeliest man that +could be thought of. Kinglike he was, though he had no crown and was meanly +clad, without brooch or bracelet that a king should wear. But the wonder was +that from his mouth came a bright shaft of flame, as it were of a sunbeam, that +lighted all the place, and on his shoulder shone a cross of burning light as of +red-hot gold, and I knew that it was the mark of a mighty king. +</p> + +<p> +“Then I heard the voice again, and I turned, and saw that it was an angel who +spoke to me, and his face was bright and kind. +</p> + +<p> +“‘Fear not, Goldberga,’ he said, ‘for this is your husband that shall be. +King’s son and heir is he, as that token of the fiery cross shows. More, also, +it will betoken—that he shall reign in England and in Denmark, a great king and +mighty. And this you shall see, and with him shall you reign as queen and +well-loved lady.’ +</p> + +<p> +“So the voice ceased, and the angel was gone, and when I looked up there was +naught but the growing dawn across yon window, and the voice of the thrush that +sings outside.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the old nurse pondered over the dream for a while without speaking, for she +could not see what it might mean at first. +</p> + +<p> +But at last she said, “It is a good dream surely, because of the angel that +spoke; but there seems only one way in which it can come to pass. A prince must +come for you from Denmark, for there he would reign by his own right, and here +he would do so by yours. Yet I have heard that the Danish kings are most +terrible heathen, worse than the Saxon kin, of whom we know the worst now. +Maybe that is why the angel told you to have no fear. I mind Gunnar Kirkeban, +and what he wrought on the churches and Christian folk in Wales—in Gower on the +Severn Sea, and on the holy Dee—when I was young.” +</p> + +<p> +For both Goldberga and this old nurse of hers were Christian, as had been +Orwenna, Ethelwald’s wife, her mother. It had been a great day for them when +the King of Kent had brought over his fair wife, Bertha, from France, for she, +too, was Christian, and had restored the ancient church in the very castle +where Goldberga was kept. +</p> + +<p> +Now the princess went to sleep again, and woke refreshed; but all day long the +memory of the dream and of him whom she saw in it bided with her, until it was +time for her to go to the great hall for the feast of the Witan. +</p> + +<p> +Now it happened that on this night I must be one of the two housecarls who +should stand, torch in hand, behind the king. It was a place that none of the +men cared for much, since they saw their comrades feasting at the end of the +room, while they must bide hungry till the end, and mind that no sparks from +the flaring pine fell on the guests, moreover. Eglaf would have excused me this +had I wished; but I would take my turn with the rest, and maybe did not mind +losing the best of the feast so much as the others. There were some three +hundred guests at that feast, and it was a wondrous fair sight to me as I stood +on the high place and saw them gather. The long table behind which I was ran +right across the dais, rich with gold and silver and glass work: and below +this, all down the hall, ran long tables again, set lengthwise, that none might +have their backs to the king. And at the end of the hall, crosswise, were the +tables for the housecarls, and the men of the house, and of the thanes who were +guests. And as the housecarls came in they hung their shields and weapons on +the walls in order, so that they flashed bright from above the hangings that +Berthun and his men had set up afresh and more gaily than I had seen yet in +this place. +</p> + +<p> +There was a fire on the great hearth in the midst of the hall; but as it was +high summer, only a little one, and over it were no cauldrons, as there would +have been in the winter. Berthun was doing his cookery elsewhere. But between +the tables were spaces where his thralls and the women could pass as they bore +round the food and drink. And backwards and forwards among them went Berthun +until the very last, anxious and important, seeing that all was right, and +showing one guest after another to their places. No light matter was that +either, for to set a thane in too low a place for his rank was likely to be a +cause of strife and complaint. Also he must know if there were old feuds still +remembered, lest he should set deadly enemies side by side. I did not envy him, +by any means. +</p> + +<p> +When it seemed that there were few more guests to come, and only half a dozen +seats were vacant on the high place, Berthun passed into the room beyond the +hall, and at once a hush fell on the noisy folk, who had been talking to one +another as though they had never met before. The gleemen tuned their harps, and +I and my comrade lit our torches from those already burning on the wall, and +stood ready, for the king was coming. +</p> + +<p> +Out of the door backed Berthun with many bows, and loud sang the gleemen, while +all in the hall stood up at once; and then came Alsi, leading the princess, +first; and then Ragnar, with the wife of some great noble; and after him that +noble and another lady; but Griffin was not there. Bright looked Goldberga in +her blue dress, with wondrous jewels on arm and neck, and maybe the brighter +for the absence of the Welsh thane, as I thought. +</p> + +<p> +So they sat as last night, save that the noble who had come next to Ragnar was +in Griffin’s place; and therefore I stood behind the king and the princess, +with the light of my torch falling between the two. +</p> + +<p> +Now they were set, and at once Berthun bore a great beaker of wine to the king, +and all down the hall ran his men with the pitchers of wine and mead and ale, +and with them the women of the household and the wives of the courtmen, filling +every drinking horn for the welcome cup. +</p> + +<p> +Then the gleemen hushed their song, and Alsi stood up with the gold-rimmed horn +of the king in his hand, and high he raised it, and cried, “Waeshael!” +</p> + +<p> +And all the guests rose up, cup in hand, with a wonderful flashing of the +glorious English jewels, and cried with one voice, “Drinc hael, Cyning!” +</p> + +<p> +Then all sat them down, and at once came Berthun’s men with the laden spits and +the cauldrons, and first they served the high table, kneeling on the dais steps +while each noble helped himself and the lady next him with what he would. And +then down the hall the feast began, and for a time befell a silence—the silence +of hungry folk who have before them a good reason for not saying much for a +little while. +</p> + +<p> +I looked for Havelok among Berthun’s men, but he was not there. Nor was he at +the lower cross tables with the other people of the palace. But Withelm was +there, for Eglaf had seen him with me not an hour ago, and had bidden him come, +as a stranger from far off. There were a few other strangers there also, as one +might suppose, for the king’s hall must be open at these times. +</p> + +<p> +Now I looked on all this, and it pleased me; and then I began to hear the talk +of those at the high table, and that was pleasant also. First I heard that +Griffin had fallen off his horse, and had put his arm out. Whereon one said +that he only needed one hand to feed with, and marvelled that so small a hurt +kept him away from so pleasant a place as was his. +</p> + +<p> +“It seems that he fell on his face,” answered a thane who had seen him. “He is +not as handsome as he was last night. That is what keeps him away. Some +passerby put his arm in straightway.” +</p> + +<p> +At that I almost laughed, but kept a face wooden as that of our old statue of +Thor, for Eglaf had warned me that I was but a torch, as it were, unless by any +chance I was spoken to. But Ragnar glanced my way with a half smile. Presently +they began to talk of the stone putting, and of the mighty man who had come +with Berthun, and I saw several looking idly down the hall to see if they could +spy him. One of the thanes on the high seat, at the end, was he who had held +the prizes at these sports. +</p> + +<p> +Now it seemed that Alsi had not heard of this before; and when he had been told +all about it, he said that he did not know that he had any man who was strong +enough to make such a cast as they spoke of, though Eglaf had picked up a big +man somewhere lately, whom he had noticed at the hall end once or twice. +</p> + +<p> +Then he ran his eyes over the tables, for now the women folk had sat down among +the men, and one could see everywhere. But he did not see the man he meant, and +so turned sharply on us two housecarls behind him. +</p> + +<p> +“Here he is,” he said, laughing and looking at me. “Were you the mighty stone +putter they make such a talk of?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am not, lord,” I said, somewhat out of countenance, because every one looked +at me together. It had never seemed to me that I was so big before; perhaps +because I was used to Havelok, and to Raven, who was nigh as tall as myself, +and maybe a bit broader. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, who was he?” said the king. “We must ask Berthun, unless anyone can +see him in the hall.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the thane of the prizes said, “He is not here, lord; for little trouble +would there be in seeing him, if he were, seeing that he is a full head and +shoulders over even this housecarl of yours.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the princess had turned to look at me, and she saw that I was abashed, and +so she smiled at me pleasantly, as much as to say that she was a little sorry +for me, and turned away. Then thought I that if ever the princess needed one to +fight for her, even to death, I would do so for the sake of that smile and the +thought for a rough housecarl that was behind it. +</p> + +<p> +Now came Berthun with more wine, before the matter of the stone was forgotten +in other talk, and the king said, “It seems that you have found a new man, +steward, for all are talking of him. I mean the man who is said to have thrown +a big stone certain miles, or somewhat like it, from all accounts. Where is +he?” +</p> + +<p> +“He is my new porter,” answered Berthun, with much pride; “but he is not in the +hail, for he does not like to hear much of himself, being quiet in his ways, +although so strong.” +</p> + +<p> +“Here is a marvel,” laughed Alsi, “and by-and-by we must see him. I wonder that +Eglaf let you have him.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Eglaf sat at the head of the nearest of the lower tables, and all in +hearing of the king were of course listening by this time. So he said, “The man +had his choice, and chose the heavier place, if you will believe me, lord. It +is terrible to see how Berthun loads him at times; so that I may get him yet.” +</p> + +<p> +Then all laughed at the steward, whose face grew red; but he had to laugh also, +because the jest pleased the king. He went away quickly; and one told Eglaf +that he had better eat no more, else would he run risk of somewhat deadly at +the cook’s hands. But those two were old friends, as has been seen, and they +were ever seeking jests at each other’s expense. +</p> + +<p> +Now the talk drifted away to other things, and I hoped that Havelok had been +forgotten, for no more than I would he like being stared at. The feast went on, +and twice I had to take new torches, but Berthun saw that I had wine, if I +could not eat as yet. Then had men finished eating, and the tables were +cleared, and the singing began, very pleasant to hearken. Not only the gleemen +sang, but the harp went round, and all who could did so. Well do the Lindsey +folk sing, after their own manner, three men at a time, in a gladsome way, with +well-matched voices, and that for just long enough to be pleasant. +</p> + +<p> +So the harp went its way down the hall, and the great folk fell to talk again; +and at last one said, so that Alsi heard him, “Why, we have not seen the strong +man yet. Strange that he is not feasting with the rest.” +</p> + +<p> +Whereat the king beckoned Berthun. +</p> + +<p> +“Bring your new wonder here,” he said. “Say that I have heard of his deed, and +would look on him.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun bowed and went his way; and I wondered how my brother would bear this, +for the hall and its ordering was wont, as I have said, to bring back his +troubled thoughts of things half remembered. +</p> + +<p> +Presently he came in at the door at the lower end of the hall, and at first +none noticed him, for there was singing going on, and through that door came +and went many with things for the feast from the kitchens. Then some one turned +to see who towered over them thus, and when he saw Havelok he went on looking, +so that others looked also. Then one of the three singers looked, and his voice +stayed, for he was a stranger, and had heard nothing of this newcomer, and then +Havelok followed Berthun up the hall in a kind of hush that fell, and he was +smiling a little, as if it amused him. He had on the things that the steward +had given him, and they were good enough—as good as, if more sober than, my +housecarl finery. But I suppose that not one in all the gathering looked at +what he wore; for as he passed up the long tables, it seemed that there was no +man worth looking at but he, and even Ragnar seemed to be but a common man when +one turned to him with eyes that had seen Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi the king sat staring at him, still as a carven image, with his hand +halfway to his mouth, as he raised his horn from the table; and Ragnar looked +wide-eyed, for he knew him again, and I saw a little smile curl the corners of +his lips and pass; and then Havelok was at the step of the high place, and +there he gave the salute of the courtmen of a Danish king, heeding Berthun, who +tried to make him do reverence, not at all. +</p> + +<p> +Now a spark from my torch drew my eyes from him, lest it should fall on the +princess’s robe; and when it went out, I saw that the fair hand that rested on +the arm of the great chair was shaking like a leaf. When I looked, her face was +white and troubled, and she half rose from her seat and then sank back in it +gently, and the thane who sat next her spoke anxiously to her in a low voice, +and the lady by his side rose up and came to her. +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi turned, and he too spoke, asking if aught was amiss. +</p> + +<p> +“The princess faints with the heat of the hall,” said the thane’s wife. “She +yet feels the long journey. May she not go hence?” +</p> + +<p> +Then Goldberga said bravely, “It is naught, and it will pass.” +</p> + +<p> +But they made her rise and leave the hall; and the guests stood up as she went +with her ladies round her, and many were the murmurs of pity that I heard. +</p> + +<p> +“As though she had seen a ghost, so white is she,” one whispered. +</p> + +<p> +But none knew how much the lady was to be pitied. She had seen the man of her +vision; and, lo! for all that she knew, he was a thrall who toiled in the +palace kitchens. +</p> + +<p> +And after her, as she withdrew, looked Havelok with eyes in which there was +more than pity. I could see him well, but I did not know how he had seen the +fair princess tremble and grow white as she gazed on him. I know that, as he +saw her for this first time, it was with the wish that he were in Ragnar’s +place. But I thought that if Havelok were king, here was the queen for him. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi bade the feast go on, and be spoke a few words only to Havelok, +letting him go at once, and I was glad. This sudden faintness of the princess +had put all out somewhat, and none cared to take up a jest where it had stayed. +Nevertheless, I saw the king’s eyes follow my brother down the hall, and in +them was a new and strange look that was not pleasant at all. +</p> + +<p> +Then it seemed that one was staring at me, and as will happen, I must look in a +certain place; and there was Cadwal, the Welsh thane, halfway down one of the +long tables, glaring first at me, and then at Havelok, as he went. It came into +my mind that he would be wroth with Ragnar for bringing a kitchen knave as his +second, as it were, in derision of Griffin. I thought that I would find a +chance presently to tell him why my fellow second chose to be serving thus, and +so make things right with him, for this seemed to be due to Ragnar, if not to +all concerned. +</p> + +<p> +Not long after Goldberga had gone, the king withdrew also, and then the hall +grew noisy enough, and I could leave my place. But by that time Cadwal had left +also; and next day, when I sought him, both he and Griffin were no longer in +Lincoln, none knowing whither they had gone. So I troubled no more about them. +</p> + +<p> +But had I known that these two had been among the Welshmen that Hodulf led to +Denmark when he slew Gunnar Kirkeban, and therefore knew all the story of the +loss of Havelok, and how Hodulf had sought for news of him, I should have been +in fear enough that we had not yet done with them. Rightly, too, should I have +feared that, as will be seen. +</p> + +<p> +Now while I looked about the hall for Cadwal, Mord the chamberlain saw me, and +made me sit down by him while I ate. Hungry enough was I by that time, as may +be supposed, for one cannot make a meal off the sight of a feast; and as I ate, +the noise of the hall grew apace as the cups went round. Then some of the older +thanes left, and soon Mord and I had that table to ourselves. It was plain that +he was full of something that he would say to me, and when I was ready to +listen he bent near me and said, “So that was the boy who fled with us.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay. He has grown since you saw him last.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is not all,” answered Mord. “Well I knew Gunnar, our king, and tonight I +thought he had come back to us from Valhalla, goodlier yet and mightier than +ever, as one who has feasted with the Asir might well be. For if this boy of +ours is not Gunnar’s son, then he is Gunnar himself.” +</p> + +<p> +Now that was no new thought to me, as I have shown, and I was ready for it, +seeing that even I had seen the likeness to the king as I remembered him. +</p> + +<p> +“Keep that thought to yourself for a while, Mord,” I said. “It is in my mind +that you are right, but the time has not yet come for me to know.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is wisdom, too,” he answered; “for if once he gathers a following, there +is a bad time in store for Hodulf. And it will be better that we fall on him +unawares, before he knows that Havelok, son of Gunnar, lives.” +</p> + +<p> +“We fall on him?” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, you and I, mail on chest and weapon in hand, with Havelok to lead us. +What? think you that I would hold back when Gunnar’s son is calling?” +</p> + +<p> +“Steady, friend,” I said, laughing; “men will be looking at us.” +</p> + +<p> +So he was silent again; and now I thought that the time of which my father +spoke had surely come, for it was plain that Havelok was a man whom men would +gladly follow as he went to win back his kingdom. And I went and fetched +Withelm from where he sat, and so we three talked long and pleasantly, until it +was time for us to go forth from the hall. And we thought that it was good for +Arngeir to come here, for the secret was coming to light of itself, as it were, +and we would have him speak with Mord. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap14">CHAPTER XIV.<br/> +THE CRAFT OF ALSI THE KING.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now Alsi the king went from the feast with a new and cruel thought in his mind +under the smiling face that he wore, and long he sat in his own chamber, chin +on hand and eyes far off, thinking; and at last he called Berthun. +</p> + +<p> +“What is the name of this big knave of yours?” he asked, when the steward stood +before him. +</p> + +<p> +“He calls himself Curan, lord.” +</p> + +<p> +“Calls himself. Well, it is likely that he knows his own name best. Is he +Welsh, therefore?” +</p> + +<p> +“So I think, lord.” +</p> + +<p> +“You might have been certain by this time, surely. I like Welshmen about the +place, and I was giving you credit for finding me a good one. Whence comes he?” +</p> + +<p> +Now it was on Berthun’s tongue to say that he thought that Curan came from the +marshland, yet clinging to his own thoughts of what he was. He did not at all +believe that he came from that refuge of thralls. But he must seem certain +unless he was to be laughed at again. +</p> + +<p> +So he said, “He comes from the marsh-country.” +</p> + +<p> +“Does he speak Welsh?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have heard him do so to the market people, if he happened to meet a Briton +there.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then, of course he is Welsh: and here have I found out in two minutes +what you have taken I do not know how long to think about. Go to, Berthun; you +grow slow of mind with good living.” +</p> + +<p> +The king chuckled, and Berthun bowed humbly; but now the steward was determined +to say no more than he was obliged in answer to more questions. Also he began +to hope that Alsi would ask nothing about the clothes this man of his wore, +else he would be well laughed at for spending his money on a stranger. +</p> + +<p> +But Alsi seemed pleased with himself, or else with what he had heard, and went +on. +</p> + +<p> +“Has this Curan friends in the town?” +</p> + +<p> +“None, lord, so far as I know.” +</p> + +<p> +“Let me tell you that you may know a man’s friends by the company he keeps. +With whom does he talk?” +</p> + +<p> +“None come to seek him, lord, except one of the housecarls—the big man to whom +you spoke tonight. Seldom does he go into the town, and then only the porters +seem to know him, for he was among them, as a stranger, when I met him first.” +</p> + +<p> +“A big man will always make an acquaintance with another,” Alsi said, “and the +porters are the lowest in the place. One may be sure that he has left his +friends in some starving village in the marsh, and has none here. That will do, +Berthun. Take care of him, for I may have use for him. But next time you hire a +man, use your wits to learn somewhat of him, if it is too much trouble to ask.” +</p> + +<p> +So Berthun was dismissed, and went out in a bad temper with himself. Yet he +knew that he would have been laughed at for a fool if he had said that he +thought Curan more than he seemed. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi was alone, and he fell to thought again. By-and-by it was plain to be +understood what his thoughts had been, and they were bad. And after he had +slept on them they were no better, seeing what came of them. But I think that +he was pleased to find that Havelok was, as he thought, a Welsh marshman, and +well-nigh friendless, for so he would be the more ready to do what he was +bidden; though, indeed, there seemed little doubt that the plan Alsi made for +himself would find no stumbling block in Curan, if it might meet with a check +elsewhere. That, however, was to be seen. +</p> + +<p> +Well pleased was Alsi the king with somewhat, men said in the morning. +</p> + +<p> +But there was one who rose heavy and sorely troubled, and that was the Lady +Goldberga, for all the fancies that had been brought to her by the vision had +come to nothing, or worse than nothing, as she looked on Havelok and saw in the +cook’s knave the very form of him of whom she had dreamed, and whom she could +not forget. Glad had she been to go to her own chamber and away from the kindly +ladies who could not know her real trouble; but not even to her old nurse did +she tell what that was. Her one thought now was to seek someone who was skilful +in the reading of dreams, and so find some new hope from it all. But no one +could tell her of such a one here, unless it were to be a priest of Woden, and +that she would not hear of. +</p> + +<p> +Then, early in the morning, Alsi sent for her, saying that he would speak with +her alone for a while. So she went to him, where he sat in the chamber beyond +the high place; and he greeted her kindly, asking after her rest, and saying +that he hoped that the sudden faintness had hurt her not. Then he led her to a +seat, and bade her rest while he talked of state affairs. +</p> + +<p> +“For it must be known to you, my niece, that the Witan thinks it time that you +should take your father’s kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Goldberga knew that, and had long made up her mind that when the time came +she would not shrink from the burden of the crown. +</p> + +<p> +It may well have been that Alsi thought that she would wish to wait for a time +yet, for he did not seem altogether pleased when she answered, “If the Witan +thinks right, I am ready.” +</p> + +<p> +“But,” he said, “there is one thing to come before that. The Witan must know +who your husband shall be. And that is reasonable, for he will have a share in +ruling the kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Goldberga, “They need have no fear in that matter, for I will wed +none but a king or the heir of a king.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said Alsi, dryly enough, “they are not so plentiful as are +blackberries, and there may be two words to that.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am not anxious to be wedded,” answered the princess, “and I can wait. It is, +as you say, a matter that is much to the country.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi tried another plan, seeing that Goldberga was not at all put out by +this. So he forced a cunning smile that was meant to be pleasant, and said, “I +had thought that your mind ran somewhat on Ragnar.” +</p> + +<p> +He looked to see the lady change colour, but she did not. +</p> + +<p> +“Ragnar is my cousin,” she said, “or a good brother to me, if you will. +Moreover, until the other day when he met me in London by some good fortune, I +had hardly seen him since my father died.” +</p> + +<p> +“What think you of Griffin?” +</p> + +<p> +“Nothing at all, for nidring he is,” answered Goldberga with curling lip. +</p> + +<p> +Now that angered Alsi, for he had so much to do with that business; and if +Griffin was to be called thus by his fault, he was likely to lose a friend. +</p> + +<p> +“I would have you remember,” he said, “that in all this choosing it remains for +me to give consent or withhold it.” +</p> + +<p> +“I shall only ask your consent to my wedding such a man as I have told you of, +uncle—a king or a king’s son.” +</p> + +<p> +“So,” said Alsi, “you would choose first, and ask me afterwards, forsooth! That +is not the way that things are to be between us. It is for me to choose, and +that according to the oath which I took when your father made me guardian of +you and his realm.” +</p> + +<p> +“Yet,” said Goldberga very gently, “I think that my father would not have meant +that I should be the only one not to be asked.” +</p> + +<p> +“I can only go by what I swore, and that I will carry out. I promised to see +you married to the most goodly and mightiest man in the land.” +</p> + +<p> +“That can be none but a king, as I think.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi grew impatient, for he meant to settle one matter before he went much +farther. +</p> + +<p> +“I will say at once that I can have no king over the East Anglian kingdom. It +is not to be thought of that after all these years I should have to take second +place there. You will hold the kingdom from me, and I shall be overlord there. +I will send you some atheling who can keep the land in order for you, but there +shall be no king to bring that land under the power of his own kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +That was plain speaking, and it roused Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +“Never have you been overlord of my kingdom,” she said. “Well have you ruled it +for me while I could not rule it myself, and for that I thank you heartily. But +it is not right that I should seem to hold it from you.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is to be seen,” sneered Alsi, “for it lies with me to say what marriage +you make, and on that depends whether the Witan, in its wisdom, sees fit to +hail you as queen. Not until you are married will you take the kingdom at all.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said the princess, growing pale, “I will speak to the Witan myself, and +learn their will.” +</p> + +<p> +“The Witan has broken up,” answered Alsi, “and the good thanes are miles on +their way homewards by this time. You are too late.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will call them up again.” +</p> + +<p> +“Certainly—that is, if I let my men run hither and thither to fetch them. But +after all, in this matter I am master. Whom you wed lies with me.” +</p> + +<p> +Goldberga saw that she was in the hands of the king, and maybe as much a +prisoner as at Dover. So her spirits fled, and she asked what the king willed. +</p> + +<p> +Alsi knew now that nothing but his utmost plan would be of any avail to save +that kingdom for himself, and so he broke out into wrath, working up his fury +that he might not go back. +</p> + +<p> +“My will is that you obey me in this carrying out of the oath I took on the +holy ring, <a href="#fn10" name="fnref10"><sup>[10]</sup></a> and on the +Gospels also to please your mother. You shall marry the man whom I choose, so +that he be according to the words of that oath.” +</p> + +<p> +“So that he be king or son of a king, I will obey you,” answered Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +“Then you defy me. For that I have told you that I will not have. Now shall we +see who is master. You mind yon kitchen knave of last night? There can be none +in all England mightier or more goodly than he is to look on, and him shall you +wed. So will my oath be well kept. Then if your precious Witan will have him, +well and good, for his master shall I be.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat the princess said that it were better that she should die; but now Alsi +had set out all his plan to her, and he did not mean to flinch from carrying it +out. There was no doubt that the Norfolk people would hold that she had +disgraced herself by the marriage, and so would refuse to have her as queen. +And that was all he needed. +</p> + +<p> +But Goldberga had no more to say, for she was past speaking, and the king was +fain to call her ladies. And when they came he went away quickly, and gave +orders for the safe keeping of the princess, lest she should try to fly, or to +get any message to Ragnar or other of the Norfolk thanes. +</p> + +<p> +Now he must go through with this marriage, for he had shown himself too +plainly, and never would the princess trust him again. I have heard that he +sent for Griffin at this time; but, as I found, he was gone; and if the king +thought that perhaps the princess would wed him now to escape from the kitchen +knave, he had no chance to bring him forward. I suppose he could have made out +that Griffin, or for that matter any one else he chose, was such a one as his +oath to Ethelwald demanded. +</p> + +<p> +Sore wept Goldberga when she was back in her own place, and at first it was +hard for her to believe that Alsi could mean what he had threatened. But then +she could not forget her dream, and in that she had most certainly seen the +very form of him who stood before her at the high place last night; and that +perhaps troubled her more than aught, for it seemed to say that him she must +wed. But no king’s son could he be, so that there must be yet such another +mighty man to be found. +</p> + +<p> +And then in her heart she knew that there could not be two such men, both alike +in all points to him of the vision. And she knew also, though maybe she would +not own it, that if this Curan had been but a thane of little estate, she could +have had naught to say against the matter. +</p> + +<p> +And so at last she found that in her trouble and doubt and wish for peace she +was thinking, “Would that he were not the kitchen knave!” +</p> + +<p> +Now, it chanced that the old nurse had gone out into the town, and was away all +this while, so that she knew nothing of this new trouble; and presently she was +coming back with her arms full of what she had bought, and there met her +Havelok and Withelm, who had been to the widow’s, and were on their way to find +me at the gate. +</p> + +<p> +“Mother,” said Havelok, “let me help you up with these things.” +</p> + +<p> +That frightened the old lady, for she had been looking at him, and had made up +her mind that he was some mighty noble, as did most strangers. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, lord,” she said; “that is not fitting for you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Less fitting is it that a strong man should see you thus burdened and not +help. No lord am I, but only the cook’s man. So I am going to the palace.” +</p> + +<p> +But this she would not believe at first, and still refused. However, Lincoln +Hill is very steep, and she was not sorry when Havelok laughed and took the +things from her so soon as she had to halt for breath. +</p> + +<p> +“Curan will carry you up also, if you will, mother,” said Withelm. +</p> + +<p> +The nurse tossed her head at him and made no answer, being on her dignity at +once. Moreover, she had heard of Curan by this time, though she had not seen +him before. So she said no more, and went on proudly enough, with her mighty +attendant after her; but all the while it was in her mind that there was some +jest, or maybe wager, between the two. +</p> + +<p> +Now Withelm stopped at the gate; but I was not there, for I had been sent to +the palace, where guards were to be at each door. The word was that some plot +had been found out against the princess, and that therefore we had to be +careful. One easily believed that with all the talk about the attack made on +her party that was flying about. So he came on to the palace kitchens, for +Berthun knew him well, having so often bought fish from him in the market; and +there he sat down to talk with the steward, for there was nothing much going on +at the time, and I was on guard. +</p> + +<p> +Now, the old nurse went to her mistress; and Goldberga sat in the shadow, and +was weeping no longer, seeing that it would not help at all. +</p> + +<p> +“There is a wonder down yonder,” said the old lady, not seeing that there had +been any trouble yet—“such a man as I never saw in all my days; and he even +carried my goods up all the hill for me, old and ugly as I am. That is not what +every young man would do nowadays. Maybe it was different when I was young, or +else my being young made the difference. The youth with him called him Curan, +which is the name of the strong porter they prate of, but doubtless that was a +jest. This is the most kingly man that could be; and I ween that those two made +a wager that he dared not carry a bundle up to the palace, whereby I was the +gainer, for breath grows short up that pitch. And when I thanked him he bowed +in that wise that can only come of being rightly taught when one is young. Now, +I am going to ask Berthun who he is, for he spoke to him when he saw him, and +that humbly, as it seemed.” +</p> + +<p> +So talked the nurse, and to all Goldberga answered never a word, for all the +trouble came back again, and with it the thought that she hated, that if only— +</p> + +<p> +Then, as the nurse was leaving her, she called her back. +</p> + +<p> +“Nurse,” she said, “I am in sore trouble about the dream. It bides with me, and +will not cease to puzzle me until I weary for some one to read it plainly. I +would that Queen Bertha’s good chaplain were here, for I might have been helped +by him.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the nurse came back, quick to hear the sad tone in the voice of her whom +she had tended and loved since she was a child. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, my pretty, have you been weeping?” she said. “There was naught in a dream +like that to fray you thus.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but it has come to me that this place is altogether heathen; and it may +have come from the hand of Freya, the false fiend that they worship as a +goddess, so that I may be ready to wed a heathen. Is there no Christian in all +this place?” +</p> + +<p> +“There are Welsh folk yet left in the marsh,” said the nurse, pondering; “and +where there is a Briton there is a Christian, and there, also, will be a hidden +priest. But it would be as much as his life is worth to come here, even could +we find one.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Goldberga said, “Alsi is not altogether heathen. If I asked he would +surely grant this.” +</p> + +<p> +For she thought that she knew how to gain consent. +</p> + +<p> +“If one can be found, and that is not likely. Well, then, I will ask Berthun, +who is good-natured enough, and most likely will not trouble about a Christian +coming here; and if so, we need not even ask Alsi.” +</p> + +<p> +So she went, not thinking for a moment that there was a priest of the faith to +be heard of. Mostly she wanted to hear more of Havelok, but she would honestly +do her other errand. +</p> + +<p> +But on her way across the courtyard she met Mord, and he was a great friend of +hers. +</p> + +<p> +“Whither now, nurse? They will not let you go out of the palace. They say that +there is trouble on hand with those folk that fell on us, and we have to bide +in shelter for a day or two.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, I have been down the town this hour, and all is quiet enough. This Alsi +is an over-timid man. But I was seeking Berthun with a strange message from the +princess, and one that is not over safe here.” +</p> + +<p> +“Let me give it then.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, it is nothing more or less than to ask if he can find a Christian +priest. Our mistress has had a strange dream, and it is true that it sorely +troubles her. So she wants one to whom she may tell it, that it may be read +aright. But though I must ask, I do not hope to find one.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why,” said Mord, “there is not one Christian in all Lindsey.” +</p> + +<p> +“I would not say that. When I was first here with Orwenna the queen, before she +married Ethelwald, there were some in the marsh; for one day I heard my own +tongue spoken there, hunting with my mistress; and so she stayed and talked +with these poor folk, though the Welsh they spoke was bad enough. But they were +Christians, as they told her in fear and trembling. They have not so much need +to fear now.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then I can help you,” said Mord gladly. “Say nothing to the cook, for I have +found old friends who come from far in the marsh, and they will tell me at once +if they have heard of any priest. Why, when I think, they know Welsh, and one +has called himself by a Welsh name, and you have seen him—Curan the porter.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay; then do you ask these friends, and tell them that the sooner they can +bring a priest the better shall they be rewarded. I would give much to have +Goldberga’s mind set at rest.” +</p> + +<p> +So Mord said that he would go at once; and glad he was to see Withelm sitting +with Berthun, +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said the steward, “I have known Withelm of Grimsby for the last ten +years or so, and I do not suppose that it matters if you speak with him.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why should it matter if I speak with any one I choose?” asked Mord, somewhat +angrily. +</p> + +<p> +“That you must ask the king; for his orders are that the people of the princess +have no dealings with outsiders for two days.” +</p> + +<p> +“Mighty careful of us is Alsi all of a sudden,” said Mord. “I suppose he thinks +that someone will stick a seax into some of us in all friendly wise while we +are talking.” +</p> + +<p> +But Berthun only laughed, and went to where the nurse was beckoning to him. He +told her his own thoughts of Havelok, being glad to have a ready hearer. +</p> + +<p> +At once Withelm was able to tell Mord that the old priest who was his friend +was in Lincoln at this time by good chance, and that he would surely come to +the princess at need. But when they came to talk of when and how, it did not +seem all so easy; and Mord went to the nurse to tell her all. +</p> + +<p> +Then they had to speak to Berthun about it, and he was kindly and willing to +help; but he said that none might come to speak with the princess without leave +from the king. No doubt he would grant it easily, if asked by Goldberga +herself. +</p> + +<p> +“I will go and tell her,” said the old lady. “Keep your man here till I +return.” +</p> + +<p> +Now she brought this good news to the princess, and one need not say how she +rejoiced. And now a thought had come to her, and she was eager to send a +message to Alsi. +</p> + +<p> +“Surely,” she thought, “he does but threaten me with the kitchen knave, that he +may make me change my will. And, therefore, if I say that I am ready to obey +him, he will be pleased; and then time is gained at the least, and it is not +possible that he will choose so badly for me after all.” +</p> + +<p> +So when the nurse asked her what she would do about getting the priest to her +presence, she said, “Go and tell my uncle first that I am willing to obey him +in the matter of which we spoke this morning.” +</p> + +<p> +“So that was what has troubled you after all, and not the dream? I thought it +should not have made all these tear marks,” said the nurse quickly. “Now, why +did you not tell me? I dare give Alsi a talking to if he needs it.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, nurse, but it was the dream. My uncle and I did but disagree on somewhat, +and maybe I was wrong. By-and-by I will tell you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Tell me now, and then I shall know better how to ask for what you need.” +</p> + +<p> +But Goldberga could not bring herself to say what Alsi had threatened, and now +felt sure that she would hear no more of that. So she told the nurse that she +had vowed only to marry a king, and that Alsi had been angry, saying that kings +were not so easily found. Also, that he was the man who had to find her a +husband. +</p> + +<p> +“That is the best sense that this king ever spoke,” said the nurse. “Many a +long year might you wait if you had your way thus. You are wise in sending that +message. Well, after that I will ask him to let you see the priest, saying, if +he is cross-grained, that a talk with him will make your mind even better +fitted to obey. Many things like that I can say. We shall have him here +presently.” +</p> + +<p> +Now, all that seemed very good to both of them, and the nurse went her way. And +when she came to Alsi, she gave the message plainly. +</p> + +<p> +“That will save a great deal of trouble,” said the king. “Tell her that I am +glad to hear it. She says this of her own accord, and not at your advice?” +</p> + +<p> +“She told me before I had heard a word of what the trouble was between you. It +was no word of mine.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am glad of it. But I will say that I am somewhat surprised.” +</p> + +<p> +And that was true, for this message seemed to Alsi to be nothing more or less +than that Goldberga would marry his man. When he thought for a moment, however, +he saw that it could not be thus; and also, it was plain to him what the poor +girl had in her mind. And now he chuckled to think what a weapon he had against +her. Nor would he be slow to use it. +</p> + +<p> +Then the nurse said that he need have no surprise, for Goldberga was ever +gentle and willing to be led, though sometimes the pride of her race came +uppermost for a time. And then she asked if a certain priest of the faith might +come and speak with her. +</p> + +<p> +Now, Alsi knew that only one could be meant—namely, the hermit who bided at +Cabourn. He had heard of him often, and would not suffer him to be hurt, for +his sister Orwenna had protected him. The heathen English minded him not at all +by this time, for he was the best leech in the land, and so useful to them. So +Alsi said pleasantly that he was quite willing that the priest should come, +deeming that he was at Cabourn, and that it would be a day or two before he +would be brought. +</p> + +<p> +So he called the housecarl from outside the door, and when he came he said, +“Pass the word that when one who calls himself David comes and asks for the +princess, he is to be admitted to her.” +</p> + +<p> +So that was made easy, and the nurse thanked him and withdrew; and when he was +alone, Alsi grinned evilly and rubbed his hands. +</p> + +<p> +“Now is East Anglia mine in truth,” he said; and with that he bade the +housecarl fetch Curan, the cook’s porter, to him. And then he sent one to +Ragnar with such a message that he rode out that night and away to Norwich. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap15">CHAPTER XV.<br/> +THE FORTUNE OF CURAN THE PORTER.</a></h2> + +<p> +While the nurse told Withelm to fetch the priest when Alsi was in the hall that +evening, the housecarl came for Havelok; and much wondering, he followed the +man to the king, and presently stood before him and saluted. +</p> + +<p> +“Where did you get that salute?” said Alsi sharply, seeing at once that it was +not English; and, indeed, it was that of Gunnar’s courtmen. +</p> + +<p> +“I cannot tell,” answered my brother. “It seems to be there when needed.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, it is not that used here. Get the housecarls to teach you better +manners.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok bowed a little, in token that he would do so; and when Alsi spoke +to him next it was in Welsh. +</p> + +<p> +“You are a marshman, as I hear?” +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok had learned fairly well from the poor folk who loved him, but +carelessly, so that when he answered Alsi frowned at his way of speaking. +</p> + +<p> +“I am from the marsh,” he said simply. +</p> + +<p> +“We had better get back to English!” the king said; “you people forget your own +tongue. Now, are you married?” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat Havelok laughed lightly. +</p> + +<p> +“That I am not,” he answered. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then, if I find you a fair wife, you would be willing, doubtless?” +</p> + +<p> +“That I should not,” answered Havelok bluntly, and wondering what this +crafty-looking king was driving at. “What could I do with a wife? For I have +neither house nor goods, nor where to take her, nor withal to keep her; else +had I not been the cook’s knave.” +</p> + +<p> +“It would seem that you carry all your fortune on your back, therefore,” said +Alsi, looking at Havelok’s gay attire with somewhat of a sneer. +</p> + +<p> +“That may well be, King Alsi, for even these clothes are not my own. Berthun +gave them me, and I think that they come from yourself.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi grinned, for Eglaf’s saying of him was not so far wrong; but he had more +serious business on hand than to talk of these things with a churl. +</p> + +<p> +“Now, if I bid you, it is your part to obey. I have a wife for you, and her you +shall wed.” +</p> + +<p> +“There are two words to that, King Alsi. Neither will I wed against my will, +nor will I wed one who is unwilling.” +</p> + +<p> +“As to that first,” said the king, for he began to be angered with Havelok’s +boldness, “if a man will not do my bidding, I have dungeons where he can have +time to think things over, and men who can keep him there, be he never so +mighty; and if a man will not see with my eyes when I bid him, blinded shall he +be.” +</p> + +<p> +This he said somewhat hurriedly, for a dark flush came on the face of the man +before him, and he thought that he must try some other plan than force with +him. +</p> + +<p> +“And as for that other point, I did not so much as hint that the bride was +likely to be unwilling. I will say that she is willing, rather.” +</p> + +<p> +Now that troubled Havelok, for it seemed that all was arranged already, and the +thought of the dungeon was not pleasant. There was no doubt that if the king +chose he could cast him into one until he was forgotten; and the light and the +breath of the wind from the sea were very dear to Havelok. So he thought that +he would at least gain time by seeming to listen to the proposal; for, after +all, it might come to nothing, and maybe it was but a jest, though a strange +one. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, lord king,” he said, “if the bride knows enough of me to be willing, it +is but fair that I should have the like chance of choice.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi thought that it was impossible that this churl, as he deemed him, +would not be overjoyed to hear of the match he had made for him, and he must +needs know it soon. Yet there was that about Havelok that puzzled him, for his +ways were not those of a churl, and he spoke as a freeman should speak. +</p> + +<p> +So much the more likely that the people would believe him when he said that +Goldberga wedded him of her own wish, he thought. It was as well that he was +not altogether a common-seeming man. +</p> + +<p> +“You have seen the damsel already,” he said therefore. “Now I will not say that +this match is altogether of my choosing; but I have an oath to keep, and it +seems that I can only keep it by making you her husband. But, as I say, she is +willing, and, I will add, well dowered.” +</p> + +<p> +Now it grew plain to my brother that there was something strange in all this, +so he said, “An oath is a thing that must not be hindered in the fulfilling, if +a man can further it. But what has a king’s oath to do with me?” +</p> + +<p> +“I have sworn to find her the goodliest and mightiest man alive; and, though I +must needs say it to your face, there is none like yourself. No flattery this +to bend you to my will, but sober truth—at least, as I see it.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Havelok grew impatient. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, if that be so, who is the bride?” he asked, not caring to give the king +his title, or forgetting to do so, for on him was coming the feeling that he +was this man’s equal here in the palace. And at last, not seeming to notice +this, Alsi answered plainly. +</p> + +<p> +“The Princess Goldberga.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok stared at him in blank wonder for some moments; and Alsi grew red +under his gaze, and his eyes were shifty, and would not meet the honest look +that was on him. +</p> + +<p> +Then at last said Havelok slowly, and watching the king intently all the while, +“What this means I cannot tell. If you speak truth, it is wonderful; and if +not, it is unkingly.” +</p> + +<p> +“On my word as a king, truth it is,” said Alsi hastily, for there was that in +Havelok’s face that he did not like. +</p> + +<p> +One might think that the king was growing afraid of his own kitchen knave. +</p> + +<p> +“If that is so, there is no more to be said,” answered Havelok. “Yet you will +forgive me if I say that I must have this from the lips of the princess herself +as well. It may be that her mind will change.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is but fair,” answered Alsi; “and you are a wise man. The mind of a +damsel is unsteady, whether she be princess or milkmaid; but have no fear.” +</p> + +<p> +“No man fear I; but I do fear to hurt any lady, and I would not do that.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi thought that all was well, and he spoke smooth words to my brother, +so that Havelok doubted him more than ever. Therefore it came into his mind +that all he could do for the best was to seem to agree, and wait for what the +princess herself said. And if Alsi was working some subtlety, then he would +wring his neck for him, if need be; and after that—well, the housecarls would +cut him in pieces, and he would slay some of them, and so go to Valhalla, and +dreams would be at an end. And he would have died to some purpose here, for he +knew that Goldberga would come to her kingdom, ay, and maybe Alsi’s as well, +for she was his sister’s daughter, and his next of kin, and well loved by those +who had been allowed to know aught of her. +</p> + +<p> +But I would not have any think that the promise of so wondrous a bride was not +pleasing to him. It was more, for he had seen her grow white and troubled as +she looked on him, and he had seen her bear well whatever pain had caused that; +and he had known that in the one sight he had of Goldberga somewhat had taught +him what it was to have one face unforgotten in his mind. +</p> + +<p> +So he said to Alsi, “All this fortune that you hold out to me is most unlooked +for, seeing what I am in your hall; and I have not thanked you yet, King Alsi. +That, however, is hard to do, as you may understand.” +</p> + +<p> +“I understand well enough,” answered the king, in high good humour again, now +that all seemed to be going well. “And after all, it is the lady whom you must +thank.” +</p> + +<p> +“But when shall I see her to do so?” +</p> + +<p> +“Tomorrow, surely; ay, tomorrow early shall you speak with her,” answered the +king quickly. “Now go, and hold your peace. Let me warn you that there are +those about the court who would go any lengths to remove you from the face of +the earth if they knew of this. Tell no man of the honour that has come to you +as yet. Be the porter for a short time longer, and then you will be the man +whom all envy. It is likely that I must make you a thane, by right of the +choice of the princess.” +</p> + +<p> +“I know well when to speak and when to keep silence, lord king,” said my +brother, and with that he bowed and left the hall. +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi put his lips to a silver whistle that he carried, and blew a call +that brought Eglaf hurriedly to him from the outer door. +</p> + +<p> +“The guards may go,” said the king; “but see that the porter Curan leaves not +the palace until I myself send him forth tomorrow.” +</p> + +<p> +The captain saluted and went his way. He had had six men within call of the +king all the time that he spoke with Havelok, and one may make what one likes +of that. At least the threat of the dungeon was no idle one. +</p> + +<p> +Now went Havelok from the hall very heavy and troubled, for beyond the fair +talk of the king lurked surely some plan that was not fair at all. It was not +to be thought that he could not prevent, if he chose, a foolish marriage of the +princess, even did she desire it ever so much. And my brother could not believe +that she had set her heart on one whom she had but seen once, and then in the +midst of faintness. That, however, might be known easily when he was face to +face with her. It was a thing that could not be made a matter of pretence. +</p> + +<p> +Now when he came back to the great kitchen, which was nigh as big as the hall, +Withelm was yet there, for the priest was at the widow’s, and there was no +haste to bring him; and by that time I had come in also, and was sitting with +him at the far end, where none had need to come. It was Berthun’s own end, as +one might say, and he was lord in his own place. Only a few thralls were about, +and the cook himself had gone into the town. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is our brother,” I said, “and there is somewhat wrong.” +</p> + +<p> +He came moodily up to us, and sat him down, saying nothing, and he leaned his +head on his hands for a while. +</p> + +<p> +“What is amiss, brother?” said Withelm. +</p> + +<p> +“Wait,” he answered. “I will think before I speak.” +</p> + +<p> +I could see that this was not the old puzzlement, but something new and heavy, +so we held our peace. Long was he before he moved or spoke, and when he did so +it was wearily. +</p> + +<p> +“Well knew I that somewhat was to happen to me in this town, even as I told +you, brother, when we first passed its gates. And now it seems to be coming to +pass. For this is what is on me, as it seems to me—either that I must see the +light of day no more, or must live to be a scorn and sorrow to one for whom it +were meet that a man should die.” +</p> + +<p> +“Surely the black dream is on you, my brother! Neither of these things can be +for you!” I cried. +</p> + +<p> +“Would that it were the dream, for that is not all of sorrow, and that also is +of things so long past that they are forgotten. I can bear that, for your voice +always drives it away. But now the hand of Alsi the king is on me for some ill +of his own—” +</p> + +<p> +“Stay,” said Withelm. “Let us go out and speak, if that name is to be heard. It +were safer.” +</p> + +<p> +“Less safe, brother,” answered Havelok. “At once we should be kept apart. +Listen, and I will tell you all, and then say your say.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he told us, word for word, all that had just passed between him and the +king. And as we listened, it grew on us that here was no wrong to the princess, +but rather the beginning of honour. I could see the downfall that was in store +for Alsi, and I thought also that I saw hope for the winning back of the Danish +kingdom, with an East Anglian host to back us. And this also saw Withelm, and +his eyes sparkled. But Havelok knew not yet all that had grown so plain to us. +</p> + +<p> +He ended, and we said nothing for a moment. +</p> + +<p> +“Well?” he said, not looking up, but with eyes that sought the floor, as if +ashamed. +</p> + +<p> +“By Odin,” said I, speaking the thought that was uppermost, “here will be a +downfall for Alsi!” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, you are right, brother. I will not wed her.” +</p> + +<p> +But that was by no means what I meant, as may be known; and now Withelm held up +a warning hand to me, and I knew that his advice was always best. +</p> + +<p> +“If the maiden is unwilling, wed her not,” he said. “If she is willing, even as +the king said, that is another matter. We have no reason to doubt his word as +yet.” +</p> + +<p> +“You saw not his face as he spoke. And then, how should the princess think of +me?” +</p> + +<p> +“Who knows? Even Odin owned that the minds of maids were hard to fathom. But +one may find a reason or two. Maybe that oath has somewhat to do with it. A +good daughter will go far to carry out her father’s will, and, in the plain +sense thereof, she will certainly do it thus. Then it is likely that she knows +that you are no churl, but the son of Grim, though we have fallen on hard times +for a while. I have heard say that it is the custom here that a man who has +crossed the seas in his own ship so many times is a thane by right of that +hardihood. Thane’s son, therefore, might we call you. Then there is the +jealousy of every other thane, if she chooses an East Anglian. Then she needs +one who shall be mighty to lead her forces. Even the greatest thane will be +content to follow a man who is a warrior of warriors. Ragnar can have told her +what you are in that way. Faith, brother, there are reasons enough.” +</p> + +<p> +Havelok laughed a short laugh at all this, and he grew brighter. There was +sense in Withelm’s words, if they would not bear looking deeply into. +</p> + +<p> +Then I said, adding to these words, “Moreover, Alsi could stop the whole +foolishness of his niece if he did not think it a fitting match in some way.” +</p> + +<p> +“So he could,” answered Havelok. “But yet—I tell you that there was naught but +evil in his face. Why did he try to force me?” +</p> + +<p> +Then he went back to the thing that weighed mostly on his noble heart—the +thought that he was unworthy altogether. +</p> + +<p> +“I fear that the princess does but think of me because she must. It is in my +mind that Alsi may have threatened her also until she has consented. How shall +I know this?” +</p> + +<p> +“Most easily, as she speaks with you,” answered Withelm. “Tomorrow will tell +you that. And then, if you find things thus, what shall prevent your flying?” +</p> + +<p> +“Brother Radbard and the other housecarls,” said Havelok grimly. +</p> + +<p> +“Not if you ask the princess to help you out of her own way by pretending to be +most willing. If Alsi thinks you a gladsome couple, there is no difficulty. You +walk out of the palace as a master there. Then you fly to Ragnar. That is all.” +</p> + +<p> +Now that was such an easy way out of the whole coil that we planned it out. And +yet it seemed to me that it was a pity that Havelok knew not more of what +seemed to us so sure now. So, seeing that things were fairly straightened by +this last thought, I got up and said that I must be going, making a sign to +Withelm to come also; and, with a few more words, we went out. I saw Havelok +set himself to a mighty task of water drawing as I looked back. +</p> + +<p> +“Now,” said I, “here is a strange affair with a vengeance. Neither head nor +tail can I make of it. But if all we think is right, this is the marriage for +the son of Gunnar.” +</p> + +<p> +“Son of Gunnar, or son of Grim,” said Withelm, “princess or not, happy is the +maiden who gains Havelok for a husband. Maybe her woman’s wit has told her so. +She will have many suitors whom she knows to be seeking her throne only, and to +him she gives it as a gift unsought.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is all beyond me,” I said; “but he would fill a throne well. But his own +modesty in the matter of his worthiness is likely to stand in the way. Why +should we not tell him all that we know? Then he will feel that he is doing no +wrong.” +</p> + +<p> +“Because we are not sure, and because it is not for us to choose the time. I +have sent for Arngeir this morning, as we said would be well last night. If the +princess is unwilling, there are many things that may be said; and if not, +there must be many days before the wedding; and, ere the day, Havelok may feel +that he is her equal in birth at least, if we are not wrong. But since I have +waited here, Mord has told me the dream that has troubled the princess, that I +may tell the priest, so that he can think it over. She has dreamed that she is +to wed a man who shall be king both in Denmark and England, and she saw the +man, moreover. Strangely like Havelok’s dream is that. Now what else made her +turn faint but that this vision was like Havelok? And does not that make it +possible that she wishes to wed him? Therefore I am going to tell the priest +the story of Havelok, so far as I know it.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well thought of. Tell him this also, for now I may surely tell you what you +have not yet heard thereof.” +</p> + +<p> +So I told him how Grim and I had taken Havelok from Hodulf, and then he was the +more certain that we had saved the son of our king. +</p> + +<p> +Now we thought that we had got to the bottom of the whole matter of the +wedding. Of course the dream had all to do with the fainting, but nothing to do +with the supposed wish. But we did not know that. +</p> + +<p> +“Speak not of Gunnar by name, however,” I said; “he was a terror to Christian +folk. The priest is likely to hinder the marriage with all his might else.” +</p> + +<p> +Withelm flushed as he had when he first spoke of the priest to me. +</p> + +<p> +“I think not, brother; for he knows Havelok well, and loves him.” +</p> + +<p> +“So,” said I shortly, “he hopes to make him a Christian, doubtless.” +</p> + +<p> +“I think that he will do so, if he has a Christian wife to help.” +</p> + +<p> +“That would not suit Havelok,” I said, laughing. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but such a mind as his it seems to suit well already, though he has not +heard much.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then,” said I, wondering, “if it suits our best and bravest, it must be a +wondrous faith. It seems strange, however; but I know naught of it. What is +good for him and you, my brother, is sure to be best.” +</p> + +<p> +“I feared that you would be angry.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but with you and Havelok? How should that be? Why, if you two said that +we must turn Christian, I should hold it right; so would Raven. I suppose that +I go to the Ve<a href="#fn11" name="fnref11"><sup>[11]</sup></a> because you +do.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I troubled no more about the matter, being nothing but a sea dog who could +use a weapon. And now I said that I was going to Eglaf to say that I might have +to leave him at any time for home, in case we had to fly with Havelok. So +Withelm went his way to the old priest with a light heart, and I to the +captain. +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” said Eglaf, “this is about what I expected when your brother came. Good +it has been to have you here; and I think that I shall see you as a housecarl +for good yet. When do you go?” +</p> + +<p> +“The first time that I do not turn up on guard I am gone, not till then.” +</p> + +<p> +“Come and drink a farewell cup first.” +</p> + +<p> +“I shall be in a great hurry if I do not do that,” I answered, laughing. +</p> + +<p> +But it was my thought that maybe when once my back was turned on the town, I +should not have time to think of going near King Alsi’s guard. +</p> + +<p> +Then I went to find Ragnar the earl, for we thought it well that he should know +what was on hand. But when I came to the house of the thane with whom he was +quartered, they told me that he had gone hastily with all his men, for word had +come of some rising in his land that must be seen to at once. That was bad; and +as one must find a reason for everything, I thought that the going of Griffin +had much to do with the outbreak. There I was wrong, as I found later. But +then, too, I knew that the craft of Alsi was at work in this message. He had +his own reasons for wishing the earl out of the way. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap16">CHAPTER XVI.<br/> +A STRANGEST WEDDING.</a></h2> + +<p> +Long spoke Withelm and the priest David together, until it was time for them to +seek the palace; and when they came there, they spoke to Mord also. Then David +thought it was well to say naught to Havelok until more was learned from +Goldberga herself, for he would soon see how things stood with her. Then he +would see Withelm again, and they would plan together for the best. So Withelm +waited for the return of the priest, whom Mord took to his mistress. Alsi and +his men were supping in the hall, but Goldberga was waiting in her own chamber. +</p> + +<p> +Now the princess thought that, after her message to the king, she would hear no +more of the kitchen knave, and so was happier. But all the while she pondered +over her dream the thought of Havelok must needs come into it, and that was +troublesome. Nevertheless, it was not to be helped, seeing that there was no +doubt at all that he and the man of the vision were like to each other as ever +were twins. Wherefore if the thought of one must be pleasant so at last must be +that of the other. And then came the nurse with tales of what Berthun thought +of this man of his—how that he was surely a wandering prince, with a vow of +service on him, like Gareth of the Round Table in the days of Arthur. +</p> + +<p> +So presently it seemed to the princess that the churl was gone, as it were, and +in his place was a wandering atheling, at least, who was not a terror at all. +Then at length the slow time wore away until Mord came with David the priest. +</p> + +<p> +No priestly garb had the old man on, for that had made his danger certain; but +though he was clad in a thrall’s rough dress, he was not to be mistaken for +aught but a most reverend man. +</p> + +<p> +“Peace be with you, my daughter,” he said; “it is good to look on the child of +Orwenna, the queen whom we loved.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the chamberlain left those two alone, and at once Goldberga told the +priest why she had asked him to run the risk of coming to her, for there is no +doubt that he was in peril, though not from Alsi himself. +</p> + +<p> +At first she asked him many things about her mother, and learned much of her +goodness to the poor folk, and of their love to her; and presently, when she +grew more sure of the kindness and seeming wisdom of the priest, she told him +all her dream, adding no thoughts of her own, as she mistrusted them. +</p> + +<p> +Then said David, “There seems naught but good in this, and it is not hard to +unravel. I think that all shall come to pass even as it was told you.” +</p> + +<p> +“I feared the heathen ways of the place, and thought that it might be some +snare of the old gods,” said Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +But David told her that they could have no power on her, and asked her if the +king knew of the vision, that being one thing of which he was not sure; and +when he found that he did not, the whole affair seemed more strange than +before. +</p> + +<p> +But now the princess asked him, “Plain were the words that I heard, hut what +meant the light as of a sunbeam that came from the mouth of the man of the +vision?” +</p> + +<p> +“That surely means that in word and in heart and in all else the man shall be +kingly altogether, so that there shall be no mistaking the same; and it may +also mean that you shall know the man at once when you see him.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Goldberga grew pale and red by turns, so that David, quick to read the +thoughts of those who came to him for help, asked if she had seen anyone who +she thought must be meant, not at all knowing that she must needs say that this +was Curan. +</p> + +<p> +Not at all willingly did she tell him this; but she did so, adding at last that +Alsi had threatened to wed her to this man. +</p> + +<p> +Now it was plain to David that all was pulling the same way, for surely Alsi +wrought, unknowing, for the fulfilling of the dream; and all seemed to prove +that Havelok was the son of the Danish king, and that he would win back his +kingdom. Then he found out that the princess had no knowledge that the king had +spoken to Havelok, but it did not seem to be needful that he should tell her +that he had done so. That would be told by Alsi himself if he meant, as seemed +certain, to carry out his threat. So he thought awhile, and at last he saw what +he might do without saying anything to bend the choice of the princess in any +way. +</p> + +<p> +“It will soon be plain in what way the dream shall be fulfilled,” he said; “and +this is certain, that you shall be wedded to none but the right man, else had +it not been sent. Have no fear, therefore, even as it was bidden you.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the princess said that the only thing which troubled her was the fear lest +Alsi should yet force her to wed this one who was so like him she had seen in +her dream. +</p> + +<p> +“That,” said the priest, “is doubtless the most strange part of the whole +matter, yet I think that even thus there need be no fear. I will tell you now +that I know this one who is called Curan well, and I, and all who know him, +love him. Truly he is not a Christian, but he is no hater of the faith, and +that is much in these days. Nor is he a churl, but rather one of the most noble +of men. It is certain that, whatever Alsi might wish, he would not wed you +against your will. He has but to know your thoughts in order to help you in any +way. But I must also tell you this, that he is a Dane, who fled from his land +when he was a child; and it is thought that he is the son of the Danish king, +who was slain at the time when Mord, your servant, fled also. He came to +England in the same ship as did Mord, who can tell you more of him. It is +certain that there is a secret about his birth, and the one who knows that +secret is not far off. If need is, we can learn it, for there was a set time +for its telling, and maybe this is it. Now, if it is true that he is the son of +the Danish king, it does seem as if your dream might be bidding you to have no +fear of what seems doubtful in the matter, though I cannot tell, and do not +like to say so for certain. His name is not Curan, but Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Goldberga said, “I have heard of that flight and of the wreck from Mord +often. He was wont to tell me of the child, and of the lady who was drowned, +and he said that he thought him the king’s son.” +</p> + +<p> +After that she was greatly cheered, for the worst of the trouble seemed to be +over and gone. It was in her mind now that Alsi knew who Havelok was, and that +he tried her, for she was not one to think ill of any. +</p> + +<p> +So she let the priest go, with many thanks, saying, “Now I know that whatever +happens is the will of Heaven, and must be for the best. I am ready for +whatever shall befall.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I do not know what had seemed good to Alsi, for he had changed his mind +concerning David’s visit to Goldberga, and had suddenly given orders that if he +came he was to be put in ward at once. So Mord met the old man as he left the +chamber, and told him that he must fly; and after that Withelm took him away in +the dusk, for none hindered his going, and went to the widow’s with him, +hearing all that had been said; and that which they thought was even as +Goldberga had said, that all must needs be for the best. In a day or two all +would he plain, for Arngeir would have come. So Withelm sent forth the old man +to his own place with a good store of food, going with him for some miles, and +promising him help for coming days until the dearth was ended. +</p> + +<p> +Now into the palace none might come after the feast was set; and all this time +I was on guard, for there were double posts round the place, by reason of +Alsi’s fear of the attackers of the princess, as was said. So it happened that +neither of us saw Havelok until next morning; and now I have to tell how we saw +him, and what happened with the first sunlight, when men were thinking of +breaking their fast. +</p> + +<p> +We of the housecarls took that first meal of the day in the great hall—so many +of us, that is, who were not on duty; and when we had nigh finished, Alsi would +come in and seat himself on the high place, where Eglaf and half a dozen other +thanes sat also at times when there was no special state to be kept. +</p> + +<p> +I was early this morning, having just taken my spell of watching at the gate, +and being, therefore, free for the rest of the day, and I was hungry with the +sweet air of the July weather and the freshness that comes with sunrise. So I +was not altogether pleased to see that there was seemingly some new affair of +state on hand, while the breakfast was not yet set out by reason of +preparations that were going on where the king’s chair was wont to stand. There +was Berthun, looking puzzled and by no means pleased, and his men were busy +setting out benches on the high place, of a sort that were not those that were +wont to be there, in three sides of a square, the open side facing the hall. +One bench made each side, and all three were carved from back rail to clawed +feet wondrously. Old they seemed also. Then, too, instead of the sweet sedges +that strewed the high place, men had spread a cloth of bright hues underfoot +there, and the sedges had been swept among the rushes of the lower places. All +this was so strange that I went forward, and when I had a chance I asked the +steward what was on hand. +</p> + +<p> +“If you know not, master housecarl, no more do I. ‘Justice to be done,’ says +the king, and so I suppose that you have some notable prisoner in ward—maybe +the leader of those villains who scared our fair princess.” +</p> + +<p> +“But we had taken no man, and I will say that we had wondered that we had not +been sent out to hunt those people, instead of biding to see if they came to +trouble us here.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, then,” said Berthun, “some thane must be bringing a captive shortly. But +why Alsi orders these benches, it passes me to make out. They are those that +have been used for the weddings of his kin since the days of Hengist. Last time +was when Orwenna, his sister, wedded Ethelwald of Norfolk. Maybe he thinks that +they need airing.” +</p> + +<p> +He laughed and went on directing his men; but knowing what I knew, I wondered +what it all might mean, for there was one wedding that I could not help +thinking of. +</p> + +<p> +Presently the hall began to fill as men came in, and every one had somewhat to +say, and all marvelled at this that was going on. Then Berthun came and +beckoned to me, for I must fetch Eglaf the captain at once, as the king had +need of him, in haste. Then Eglaf hurried to the hall; and after a word or two +with Alsi, the horns were blown outside the hall door to call every man of the +guard to the place. And when they came, we were all set round the wall as if +guarding all that were in it. But there were none but the folk of the palace to +guard, and they were wondering as were we; and when that was done, and the +click and rattle of arms as we moved to our places was ended, there was a +silence on all—the silence of men who wait for somewhat to happen. +</p> + +<p> +Now Berthun went to the door on the high place, as he was wont when all was +ready for the king’s presence, and the hush deepened, none knowing what they +expected to see. +</p> + +<p> +Forth came Berthun backward, as was the custom, and he turned aside to let the +king pass him. His face was red and angry, as I thought, but amazed also. I was +standing next to Eglaf, and he was at the foot of the dais, at the end of his +line of men, so that I could see all plainly. +</p> + +<p> +Then came Alsi, leading the princess, and after Goldberga came her nurse. No +other ladies were with her; and now I noticed that there was not one thane on +the high place, which was strange, and the first time that such a thing had +been since I came here. I looked down the hall, and none were present. Now I +looked at Alsi; and on his pale face was a smile that might have been as of one +who will be glad, though he does not feel so. But the eyes of the princess were +bright with tears, and hardly did she look from the floor. Hers was a face to +make one sad to see at that time, wondrously beautiful as it was. +</p> + +<p> +Alsi led her by the hand, and set her on the bench that was to his left, and +signed to the nurse to sit beside her, which the old lady did, bridling and +looking with scorn at the king as she took her place. There she sought the hand +of the princess, and held it tightly, as in comforting wise. Very rich garments +had the nurse, but Goldberga was dressed in some plain robe of white that shone +when the light caught it. Mostly I do not see these things, but now I wished +that she always wore that same. +</p> + +<p> +As for Alsi, he had on his finest gear, even as at the great feast of the +Witan—crimson cloak, fur-lined, and dark-green hose, gold-gartered across, and +white and gold tunic. He had a little crown on also, and that was the only +thing kingly about him, to my mind. +</p> + +<p> +Now he cast one look at Goldberga, which made her shrink into herself, as it +were, and turned with a smile to us all. +</p> + +<p> +“Friends,” he said, “this is short notice for a wedding, but all men know that +‘Happy is the wooing that is not long a-doing,’ so no more need be said of +that. All men know also that when good Ethelwald died he made me swear to him +that I would wed his daughter to the mightiest and goodliest and fairest man +that was in the land. I have ever been mindful of that oath, and now it seems +that the time for keeping it has come. Whether the man whom my niece will wed +is all that the oath requires, you shall judge; and if he is such a one, I must +not stand in the way. I do not myself know that I have ever seen one who is so +fully set forth in words as is this bridegroom in those of the oath.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I heard one whisper near me, “Whom has Goldberga chosen?” +</p> + +<p> +And that was what Alsi would have liked to hear, for his speech seemed to say +that thus it was, and maybe that he did not altogether like the choice. +</p> + +<p> +But now Alsi said to Berthun, “Bring in the bridegroom.” +</p> + +<p> +“Whom shall I bring, lord?” the steward asked in blank wonder, and Alsi +whispered his answer. +</p> + +<p> +At that Berthun’s hands flew up, and his mouth opened, and he did not stir. +</p> + +<p> +“Go, fool,” said Alsi, and I thought that he would have stamped his foot. +</p> + +<p> +Now I knew who was meant in a moment, and even as the steward took his first +step from off the dais to go down the hail to his own entrance, I said to +Eglaf, “Here is an end to my service with you. My time is up.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, what is amiss?” +</p> + +<p> +“The bridegroom is my brother—that is all; and I must be free to serve him as I +may.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, if that is so, you are in luck. But I do not think that either of Grim’s +sons can be the man. Big enough are you, certainly, but goodly? Nay, but that +red head of yours spoils you.” +</p> + +<p> +I daresay that he would have said more about Raven and Withelm, for a talk was +going round; but a hush came suddenly, and then a strange murmur of stifled +wonder, for Havelok came into the hall after Berthun, and all eyes were turned +to him. +</p> + +<p> +Now I saw my brother smile as he came, seeing someone whom he liked first of +all; and then he looked up the hall, and at once his face became ashy pale, for +he saw what was to be done. Yet he went on firmly, looking neither to right nor +left, until he came to the high place. There he caught my eye, and I made a +little sign to him to show that I knew his trouble. +</p> + +<p> +They came to the step, and Berthun stood aside to let Havelok pass, and then +Alsi held out his hand to raise my brother to the high place. But Havelok +seemed not to see that, stepping up by himself as the king bade him come. Then +the women who were in the hall spoke to one another in a murmur that seemed of +praise; but whiter and more white grew the princess, so that I feared that she +would faint. But she did not; and presently there seemed to come into her eyes +some brave resolve, and she was herself again, looking from Alsi to Havelok, +and again at Alsi. +</p> + +<p> +Now, too, the king looked at him up and down, as one who measures his man +before a fight. And when he met Havelok’s eyes he grew red, and turned away to +the folk below him. +</p> + +<p> +“So, friends,” he cried, “what say you? Am I true to the words of my oath in +allowing this marriage?” +</p> + +<p> +There was not one there who did not know Havelok, whom they called Curan; and +though all thought these doings strange, there was a hum of assent, for the +oath said naught of the station in life of the bridegroom. Good King Ethelwald +had been too trustful. +</p> + +<p> +“That is well,” said Alsi, with a grave face. “All here will bear witness that +this was not done without counsel taken. Now, let the bridegroom sit in his +place here to my right.” +</p> + +<p> +He waved his hand, and Havelok sat down on the bench that faced Goldberga; and +now he looked long at her with a look that seemed to be questioning. Alsi was +going to his seat in the cross bench, where the parents of the couple are wont +to sit at a wedding while the vows are made, but he seemed to bethink himself. +It is my belief that he said what he did in order to shame both Havelok and +Goldberga. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, it is not seemly that the bridegroom should sit alone without one to be +by him. Where are your friends, Curan?” +</p> + +<p> +At that Alsi met with more than he bargained for. At once Berthun came forward, +and forth came I, and without a word we sat one on each side of him. There were +others who would have come also, for I saw even Eglaf take a step towards the +high place, had we not done so. +</p> + +<p> +Alsi’s face became black at that, for here was not the friendless churl he was +scoffing at. But he tried to smile, as if pleased. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, this is well,” he said. “Good it is to see a master helping his man, and +a soldier ready to back a comrade of a sort. Now we have witnesses. Let us go +on with the wedding.” +</p> + +<p> +Now the golden loving cup that was used at the feasts had been filled and set +at a little side table that stood there, and it was to be the bride cup that +should be drunk between the twain when all was settled. So Alsi took this cup +and held it, while he sat in the place of the father of the bride. Now, I knew +nothing of what should he done, but Berthun did so, and well he took my +brother’s part, having undertaken for him thus. +</p> + +<p> +“It is the custom,” said Alsi, “that the bridegroom should state what he sets +forth of the dowry to the bride.” +</p> + +<p> +Whereat Berthun, without hesitation, spoke hastily to Havelok, and told him to +let him answer, meaning, as I have not the least doubt, to promise all that he +had saved in long years of service. But Havelok smiled a little, and set his +hand to his neck, and I remembered one thing that he had—a ring which had +always hung on a cord under his jerkin since he came to Grimsby, and which my +father had bidden him keep ever. +</p> + +<p> +“This give I,” he said, setting it on the floor at his feet, “and with it all +that I am, and all that I shall hereafter be, and all that shall be mine at any +time.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi looked at the ring as it flashed before him, and his face changed. No such +jewel had he in all his treasures, for it was of dwarf work in gold, set with a +deep crimson stone that was like the setting sun for brightness. I do not know +whence these stones came, unless it were from the East. Eleyn the queen, his +mother, was thence, and I know now that the ring was hers. But I think that +when Alsi saw this he half repented of the match, though he had gone too far +now to draw back. So he bowed, and said that it was well, as he would have said +had there been nothing forthcoming. +</p> + +<p> +Then Berthun, in his turn, asked for the bridegroom that the dowry of the bride +should be stated for all to hear. +</p> + +<p> +“The wealth left my niece by her father,” said Alsi. “The matter of the kingdom +is for the Witan of the East Anglians to settle.” +</p> + +<p> +Then came from out the king’s chamber two men bearing bags of gold, and that +was set before the princess. It was a noble dowry, and honest was the king in +this matter at least. +</p> + +<p> +Now were the vows to be said and the bride cup to be drunk, and that was the +hardest part of all to Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +Slowly he rose as the king held it out to him, and he took it from his hand and +stood before Goldberga; and she, too, rose and faced him, and for a moment they +stood thus, surely the most handsome couple that had ever been. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok said, looking in the clear eyes of the princess, “This have I +sworn, that I will wed no unwilling bride. It is but for you to say one word, +and the cup falls, and all is ended.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi started at that, and I thought he was going to speak, but he held his +peace. Still as a rock was Havelok while he waited for the answer, and the folk +in the hall were as still as he. They began to see that all was not right as +the king would have it thought. +</p> + +<p> +Once the princess looked at Alsi, and that with pride in her face, and then she +looked long and steadfastly at Havelok, and one by one his fingers loosened +themselves on the golden stem of the cup, that she might know him ready for her +word. +</p> + +<p> +Then she put forth her hand and closed it round his strong fingers, that he +must hold it fast by her doing, and that was all that was needed. It was more +than words could have told. And she smiled as she did it. +</p> + +<p> +And at that a light came on Havelok’s face, and he smiled gravely back at her, +and he said in a low voice that shook a little, “May the gods so treat me as I +treat you, my princess. Can it be that you will trust me thus?” +</p> + +<p> +She answered in no words, but I saw her hand tighten over his, and her eyes +never left his face. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok raised his other hand, and took that of Goldberga, which was on +the cup, and faced to the people. +</p> + +<p> +“Thus do I pledge her who shall be henceforward my wife through good and ill; +and may Odin, Freya, and Niord be witnesses of my oath of faith to her in all +that the word may mean.” +</p> + +<p> +So he drank, and I stole a glance at the king. Never saw I a man so amazed, for +to him the Danish names of the Asir had come as some sort of a shock, seeing +that he had deemed this man, with the name of Curan, a Briton. And he looked at +Berthun with a look that seemed to say more than was likely to be pleasant +by-and-by. But the steward paid no heed to him. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok had made his vow, and he gave the cup to the princess; and she, +too, turned a little toward the people, but still she looked on Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Faith shall answer to faith,” she said in a clear voice. “Here do I take this +man for my husband, in the sight of God, and with you all as witnesses, and I +pray that the blessing of Him may be on us both.” +</p> + +<p> +So she drank also, and Havelok stopped and raised the wondrous ring from where +it had been unheeded on the floor, and took the band of Goldberga, and set it +on her finger, and kissed the hand ere he let it go. +</p> + +<p> +But Goldberga lifted her face toward him, and he bent and kissed her forehead, +and so they were wedded. +</p> + +<p> +I have heard men scoff at the thought of love at first sight, but never can any +one of us do so who saw this wedding. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap17">CHAPTER XVII.<br/> +HOW THE BRIDE WENT HOME.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now the folk cheered, and loudest of all honest Eglaf and his warriors. I +wondered what should come next, for neither feast nor bride ale was prepared, +and Berthun was looking puzzled. Then I saw that the only face in all the wide +hall which was not bright was that of Alsi, and his brow was black as a thunder +cloud, while his fingers were white with the force with which he clutched and +twisted the end of his jewelled belt. Plainly he was in a royal rage that none +had scoffed at this wedding, but that all had taken it as a matter that was +right altogether. +</p> + +<p> +But he had one more evil thing in his mind that must be seen through; and he +came forward, smoothing his face, as best he might, to the fixed smile that I +had seen when he spoke with Ragnar, and learned that his first plot had +miscarried. +</p> + +<p> +“Now, friends,” he said, “all this has been so hasty that we have prepared no +feast. Even now, it seems that the horses stand at the door to take bride and +bridegroom hence, and doubtless there waits somewhere the feast that has been +bespoken without my knowledge. Well, strange are the ways of lovers, and we +will pardon them. I have therefore only to bid them farewell.” +</p> + +<p> +With that he turned to Havelok, and held out his hand, as in all good +fellowship, but Havelok would not see it. +</p> + +<p> +“Fare as it shall be meted to you by the Asir, King Alsi,” he said, “for at +least Loki loves craft.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he turned to me, and asked hurriedly where we should go if we must leave +thus. +</p> + +<p> +“To Grimsby,” I said. “That is home.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi spoke to the princess now, and maybe it was as well that he did not offer +so much as his hand. Wise was he in his way. +</p> + +<p> +“Farewell, niece,” he said; “all this shall come shortly before the Witan of +Ethelwald’s folk.” +</p> + +<p> +“Farewell, uncle,” she answered calmly. “That is a matter which I will see to +myself. You have carried out your oath to the letter, so far, and now it +remains that you should leave the government of the realm to me.” +</p> + +<p> +With that she put her hand on Havelok’s arm. +</p> + +<p> +“Come, husband; we have heard that the horses wait. Let us be gone.” +</p> + +<p> +And then in a quick whisper she added, as if nigh overdone, “Take me hence +quickly, for I may not bear more.” +</p> + +<p> +They wasted no more words; and through a lane of folk, who blessed them, those +two went to the great door down the long hall, and I followed, and Berthun and +the nurse came after me. One flung the door open; and on the steps, all unaware +of what had happened, lounged Mord, waiting, and up and down on the green the +grooms led the horses of the princess—six in all. On two were packed her goods, +and the third had a pack saddle that waited for the bags that held her dowry. +The other three were for herself and Mord and the nurse. There was not one for +Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“This is hasty, my princess,” Mord said. “Whither are we bound?” +</p> + +<p> +“For Grimsby, Mord,” I answered quickly. “Are there no more horses to be had?” +</p> + +<p> +“Never a one, unless we steal from the king,” he answered. +</p> + +<p> +The people were crowding out now that they might see the start, and I saw +Berthun speak to a man among them who was a stranger to me. And from him he +turned directly with a glad face. +</p> + +<p> +“Go down to such a hostelry,” he said to me, “and there ask for what horses you +will. Maybe I shall have to follow you for my part in this matter—that is, if I +am not put in the dungeon.” +</p> + +<p> +“Faith,” I answered, “better had you come with us than run that risk. Alsi is +in a bad mood.” +</p> + +<p> +He shook his head; and then the people behind him made way, for the king was +coming. +</p> + +<p> +“Almost had you forgotten this,” he said; “and I think you will want it.” +</p> + +<p> +The men with the money were there, and he waved his hand to them. Havelok +lifted the princess to her horse without heeding him, and the men set the bags +on the pack horses. +</p> + +<p> +“See the bridegroom down the street, you who were his witnesses,” the king went +on, with a curling lip; “and if you are a wise man, master Berthun, you will +not come back again.” +</p> + +<p> +Berthun bowed and went into the hail, past the king, and across to his own +door, without a word. After him the thronging people closed up, and though I +thought that a housecarl would have been sent to see what he was about, this +would have made an open talk, and Alsi forbore. +</p> + +<p> +“Let Havelok take your horse, Mord,” I whispered to him; “I will tell you why +directly.” +</p> + +<p> +He nodded, and I told Havelok to mount. Then I helped up the nurse, who wept +and muttered to herself; and so we started, Alsi standing on the steps with +words of feigned goodspeed as we did so. +</p> + +<p> +But the housecarls and the people shouted with wishes that were real, no doubt +thinking that we were bound for the far-off kingdom of the prince who had won +Goldberga by service as a kitchen knave in her uncle’s hall for very love of +her. +</p> + +<p> +Directly we were outside the gate that leads down the hill, I saw Withelm, who +was there waiting for me, and he knew at once what had happened. +</p> + +<p> +He came to my side, and asked only, “Already?” +</p> + +<p> +“Already,” I answered; “but it is well. Go to the widow’s straightway, and +bring Havelok’s arms to him at the hostelry at the end of the marketplace, +where we have to find more horses.” +</p> + +<p> +He went at once, and silently we came down the street and to the courtyard of +the inn. Some few folk stared at us; but the princess was hardly known here, +and she had cast her long, white mantle hoodwise over her head and face, so +that one could not tell who she was. So early in the day there were few people +in the marketplace either. +</p> + +<p> +Berthun was in the courtyard of the inn, and I was glad to see him, for I did +not know what would happen to him. It was likely that Alsi would seek for +someone on whom to visit his anger at the way things had gone. But the steward +had been warned, and was not one to run any risk. +</p> + +<p> +“I did but go back for a few things that I did not care to leave,” he said; and +he showed me that he had brought his own horse from the stables, and on it were +large saddlebags. No poor man was Berthun after years of service in the palace, +where gifts from thane and lady are always ready for the man who has had the +care of them. Across the saddle bow also were his mail shirt and arms, and his +shield hung with his helm from the peak. +</p> + +<p> +“You see that I must needs cast in my lot with yours, or rather Curan’s,” he +said, laughing; “but it is in my mind that in the end I shall not be sorry to +have done so. I think that I am tired of the fireside, and want adventure for a +while.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” I answered, “you are likely to have them, and that shortly, if I am not +mistaken; but we shall see. Now about these horses, for we had better get out +of Lincoln as soon as we may.” +</p> + +<p> +The man he had spoken with was a merchant, who came yearly, and was a friend of +his. He had more horses than he meant to keep, as he had here each year; for +every one knows that a horse can always be sold in Lincoln, and they were good +ones. Then my gold came in well, and I bought three, one for each of us +brothers. I daresay that I paid dearly for them, but there was no time for +haggling in the way that a horse dealer loves. Out of the way of Alsi we must +get, before he bethought him of more crafty devices. And I thought, moreover, +that we should be riding towards East Anglia shortly, and it was not everywhere +that a steed fit to carry Havelok on a long journey was to be had. +</p> + +<p> +I had bidden him leave all this to me as we came down the hill, and glad he was +to do so. Now he had dismounted, and stood by the side of the princess, +speaking earnestly to her. It was plain that what he said was pleasant to her +also. But we left them apart, as one might suppose. +</p> + +<p> +Now came a warrior into the courtyard, and he bore more arms. It was Withelm, +who had borrowed the gear of the widow’s dead husband, that he might be ready +for whatever might happen: and it was good to see Havelok’s eyes grow bright as +he spied the well-known weapons that his brother had in his arms. He said one +word to Goldberga, and then came to us. +</p> + +<p> +“Let me get into war gear at once,” he said, laughing in a way that lightened +my heart. “I shall not feel that I have shaken off service to Alsi until I have +done so.” +</p> + +<p> +And then he saw Berthun here for the first time. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but here is my master,” he added. “And I will say that I owe him much for +his kindness.” +</p> + +<p> +“Now the kindness shall be on your part, if any was on mine. Take me into your +service, I pray you, henceforward.” +</p> + +<p> +“Good friend of mine,” said Havelok, “naught have I to offer you. And how +should one serve me?” +</p> + +<p> +“With heart and hand and head, neither more nor less,” answered Berthun. “I +have seen you serve, and now will see you command. Let me bide with you, my +master, at least, giving you such service as I may.” +</p> + +<p> +“Such help as you may, rather. For now we all serve the princess,” Havelok +said. +</p> + +<p> +And with that Berthun was well content for the time. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, then,” said I, “see to Havelok’s arms, while we get the horses ready, +for I want Withelm here.” +</p> + +<p> +So Havelok and his new man went into the house with his arms, and then I saw +Goldberga beckoning to us. It was the first time that I had spoken to her, and +I think that I was frightened, if that is what they call the feeling that makes +one wish to be elsewhere. But there was nothing to fear in the sweet face that +she turned to us. +</p> + +<p> +“Brothers,” she said, “Havelok tells me that it was one of you who brought +David the priest to me. I do not rightly know yet which is Withelm.” +</p> + +<p> +With that she smiled and blushed a little, and I stood, helm in hand, stupidly +enough. But my brother was more ready. +</p> + +<p> +“I am Withelm, my princess—” he began. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay; but ‘sister’ it shall be between me and my husband’s brothers. Now, +brother Withelm, there is one thing that is next my heart, and in it I know you +will help me.” +</p> + +<p> +There she wavered for a moment, and then went on bravely. +</p> + +<p> +“Christian am I, and I do not think that we are rightly wedded until the priest +has done his part. And to that Havelok agrees most willingly, saying that I +must ask you thereof, for he does not know where the old man is now.” +</p> + +<p> +“Wedded in the little chapel that is in the thick of Cabourn woods shall you +be, for David has gone there already. We can ride and find him before many +hours are over, sweet lady of ours.” +</p> + +<p> +She thanked him in few words, and with much content. +</p> + +<p> +Then came forth from the house Havelok, in the arms that suited him so +well—golden, shining mail shirt of hard bronze scales, and steel, horned helm, +plain and strong, and girt with sword and seax, and with axe and shield slung +over shoulder, as noble a warrior surely as was in all England, ay, or in the +Northlands that gave him birth either; and what wonder that the eyes of the +princess glowed with a new pride as she looked at her mighty husband? +</p> + +<p> +But Mord almost shouted when he saw him come thus, and to me he said, +</p> + +<p> +“It is Gunnar—Gunnar, I tell you—come back from Asgard to help my princess.” +</p> + +<p> +“Wait till we get to Grimsby, and Arngeir will make all clear,” I said. “Get +into your arms, and we will start. All is ready now.” +</p> + +<p> +We did not wait for Mord, but mounted and rode out, and the princess looked +round at us as she rode first beside Havelok, and said, “Never have I ridden so +well attended, as I think.” +</p> + +<p> +And from beside me, with broad face from under his helm, Berthun answered for +us all, “Never with men so ready to die for you, at least, my mistress.” +</p> + +<p> +And that was true. +</p> + +<p> +Half a mile out of the town we rode at a quick trot, and then thundered Mord +after us, and his hurry surely meant something. I reined up and waited for him. +</p> + +<p> +“What is the hurry, Mord?” said I. +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe it is nothing, and maybe it is much,” he answered; “but Griffin of +Chester has gone up to the palace, for I saw him. He has his arm in a sling, +and his face looks as if it had been trodden on. Now Alsi will tell him all +this, and if we are not followed I am mistaken. He would think nothing of +wiping out our party to take the princess, and Alsi will not mind if he does. +How shall we give him the slip?” +</p> + +<p> +Withelm rode with his chin over his shoulder, and I beckoned him and told him +this. Not long was his quick wit in seeing a way out of what might be a danger. +</p> + +<p> +“Let us ride on quickly down the Ermin Street, and he will think us making for +the south and Norwich. Then we will turn off to Cabourn, and he will lose us. +After that he may hear that some of us belong to Grimsby, and will go there; +but he will be too late to hurt us. Hard men are our fishers, and they would +fight for Havelok and the sons of Grim.” +</p> + +<p> +So we did that, riding down the old Roman way to a wide, waste forest land +where none should see us turn off, and then across the forest paths to Cabourn; +and there we found the hermit, and there Havelok and Goldberga were wedded +again with all the rites of Holy Church, and the bride was well content. +</p> + +<p> +Now while that was our way, I will say what we escaped by this plan of my +brother’s, though we did not hear all for a long time. Presently we did hear +what had happened at Grimsby towards this business, as will be seen. +</p> + +<p> +To Lincoln comes Griffin, with Cadwal his thane, just as we had left the town +thus by another road, and straightway he betakes himself to the palace. There +he finds Alsi in an evil mood, and in the hall the people are talking fast, and +there is no Berthun to receive him. +</p> + +<p> +So, as he sits at the high table and breaks his fast beside the king, he asks +what all the wonderment may be. And Alsi tells him, speaking in Welsh. +</p> + +<p> +“East Anglia is mine,” he says, “for I have rid myself of the girl.” +</p> + +<p> +Griffin sets his hand on his dagger. +</p> + +<p> +“Hast killed her?” he says sharply. +</p> + +<p> +“No; married her.” +</p> + +<p> +“To whom, then?” +</p> + +<p> +“To a man whom the Witan will not have as a king at any price.” +</p> + +<p> +“There you broke faith with me,” says Griffin, snarling. “I would have taken +her, and chanced that.” +</p> + +<p> +“My oath was in the way of that. You missed the chance on the road the other +day, which would have made things easy for us both. There was no other for +you.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Griffin curses Ragnar, and the Welsh tongue is good for that business. +</p> + +<p> +“Who is the man, then?” he says, when he has done. +</p> + +<p> +“The biggest and best-looking countryman of yours that I have ever set eyes +on,” answers Alsi, looking askance at Griffin’s angry face. “There is a sort of +consolation for you.” +</p> + +<p> +“His name,” fairly shouts Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +“Curan, the kitchen knave,” says Alsi, chuckling. +</p> + +<p> +“O fool, and doubly fool!” cries Griffin; “now have you outdone yourself. Was +it not plain to you that the man could be no thrall? Even Ragnar looks mean +beside him, and I hate Ragnar, so that I know well how goodly he is.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi grows uneasy, knowing that this had become plainer and plainer to him +as the wedding went on. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, what do you know of this knave of mine?” he asks. “He was goodly enough +for the sake of my oath, and the Witan will have none of him. That is all I +care for.” +</p> + +<p> +“What do I know of him? Just this—that you have married the queen of the East +Angles to Havelok, son of Gunnar Kirkeban of Denmark, for whom men wait over +there even now. The Witan not have him? I tell you that every man in the land +will follow him and Goldberga if they so much as lift their finger. Done are +the days of your kingship, and that by your own deed.” +</p> + +<p> +Alsi grows white at this and trembles, for he minds the wondrous ring and the +names of the Asir, but he asks for more certainty. +</p> + +<p> +Then Griffin tells him that he was with Hodulf, and knew all the secret of the +making away with the boy, and how that came to naught. Then he says that Hodulf +had heard from certain Vikings that they had fallen on Grim’s ship, and that in +the grappling of the vessel the boy and a lady had been drowned. It is quite +likely that they, or some of them, thought so in truth, seeing how that +happened. After that Hodulf had made inquiry, and was told that there were none +but the children of Grim with him, and so was content. So my father’s wisdom +was justified. +</p> + +<p> +“Now I learned his name the other day; and I have a ship waiting to take me at +once to Hodulf, that I may warn him. I have ridden back from Grimsby even now +to say that, given a chance, say on some lonely ride, that might well have been +contrived, I would take Goldberga with me beyond the sea. I thought more of +that than of Hodulf, to say the truth.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi breaks down altogether, and prays Griffin to help him out of this. +</p> + +<p> +“Follow the party and take her. They are few and unarmed, and it will be easy, +for men think that there is a plot to carry her off, and this will not surprise +any. Go to the sheriff and tell him that it has happened, and he will hang the +men on sight when you have taken them. Then get to sea with the girl, and to +Hodulf, and both he and I will reward you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Thanks,” says Griffin, with a sneer; “I have my own men. Yours might have +orders that I am the one to be hanged. It would be worth your while now to make +a friend of your kitchen knave. You are not to be trusted.” +</p> + +<p> +So these two wrangle for a while bitterly, for Alsi is not overlord of Griffin +in any way. And the end is that the thane rides towards Grimsby first of all, +with twenty men at his heels, knowing more than we thought. But he hears naught +of us, and presently meets Arngeir on his way thence to see us. Him he knows, +for already he has had dealings with him in the hiring of the ship. So he +learns from him that certainly no such party as he seeks is on the road, and +therefore rides off to the Ermin Street to stay us from going south. +</p> + +<p> +But now we had time for a long start; and so he follows the Roman road when he +reaches it all that day and part of next, and we hear no more of him at that +time. There are many parties travelling on that way, and he follows one after +another. +</p> + +<p> +Now Arngeir knew at once that somewhat had happened when he heard from Griffin +that the most notable man of those whom he sought was named Curan, and +therefore he turned back at once and waited for us. And when we came in sight +of the long roof of the house that Grim, our father, had built, standing among +the clustering cottages of our fishers, with the masts of a trading ship or two +showing above it in the haven, he was there on the road to greet us, having +watched anxiously for our coming from the beacon tower that we had made. +</p> + +<p> +Maybe we were two miles out of Grimsby at this time, for one can see far along +the level marsh tracks from our tower; and Withelm and Mord and I rode on to +him as soon as we saw him, that we might tell him all that had happened, and we +rode slowly and talked for half a mile or so. +</p> + +<p> +Then Withelm waited and brought Havelok to us, staying himself with the +princess, that he might tell her the wondrous story of her husband; for we +thought that it would be easier for him than for our brother maybe. Havelok was +not one to speak freely of himself. +</p> + +<p> +And when Goldberga had heard all, she was silent for a long way, and then wept +a little, but at last told Withelm that all this had been foretold to her in +her dream. +</p> + +<p> +“Yet I am glad,” she said, “that I did not know this for certain, else had my +Havelok thought that I did but wed him for his birth. Tell him, brother, that +it was not so; say that I knew him as the husband Heaven sent for me when first +I saw him.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok listened to Arngeir as he told him the well-kept secret, and now +and again asked a question. +</p> + +<p> +And when all was told he said, “Now have the dreams passed, and the light is +come. I mind all plainly from the first.” +</p> + +<p> +And he told all that had happened after Hodulf caught him, from the murder of +his sisters to the time when I helped my father to take him from the sack. Only +he never remembered the death of his mother or the storm, or how we came to +Grimsby. Maybe it is rather a wonder that after all those hard things gone +through he should recall anything, for he was nearly dying when we came ashore, +as I have told. +</p> + +<p> +“But I am Grim’s son,” he said, “for all this, and never shall I forget it. By +right of life saved, and by right of upbringing, am I his, and by right of +brotherhood to his sons. Gunnar, who was my father, would have me say this, if +I am like him, as Mord tells me I am.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he looked at us in brotherly wise, as if we would maybe not allow that +claim now; but there needed naught to be said between us when he met our eyes. +He was Grim’s son indeed to us, and we his younger brothers for all the days +that were to come. +</p> + +<p> +“One thing there is that makes me glad,” he said, “and that is because I may +now be held worthy of this sweet bride of mine so strangely given, as indeed I +fear that I am not. Men will say that she has done no wrong in wedding me; and +for all that Alsi may say, it will be believed that she knew well whom she was +wedding. There will be no blame to her.” +</p> + +<p> +That seemed to be all his thought of the matter now, and it was like him. Then +he went back to his princess, and we spurred on to Grimsby, and set all to +work, that the greeting might be all that we could make it. +</p> + +<p> +And so, when those two rode into our garth, and the gates were closed after +them, we reined our horses round them, and drew our swords, and cried the +ancient greeting with one mighty shout: +</p> + +<p> +“Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson—Skoal to Goldberga, Havelok’s wife! Skoal! Yours +we are, and for you we will die! Skoal!” +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap18">CHAPTER XVIII.<br/> +JARL SIGURD OF DENMARK.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now one would like to tell of quiet days at Grimsby; but they were not to be. +Three days after Havelok’s homecoming we were on the “swan’s path,” and heading +for Denmark, with the soft south wind of high summer speeding us on the way. +And I will tell how that came about, for else it may seem strange that Havelok +did not see to the rights of his wife first of all. +</p> + +<p> +That was his first thought, in truth, and we brothers planned many ways of +getting to work for her, for it was certain that Alsi would be on his guard. +And on the next day came a man from Lincoln to seek Berthun, with news. That +good friend had done what none of us had been able to manage, for he had told +the merchant, his friend, to bide in the hall and hear what went on, and then +to let him know all else that seemed needful that we should hear. Now he had +learned all from the words of Griffin and Alsi, who took no care in their +speech, thinking that none in the hall knew the Welsh tongue that they used. +</p> + +<p> +It being the business of a merchant to know that of every place where he +trades, and he travelling widely, there was no difficulty to him, and mightily +he enjoyed the sport. Then he sent off straightway to us; and now it was plain +that we were in danger—not at once, maybe, but ere long. Griffin would hear +sooner or later that his quarry was in Grimsby after all. So we went to our +good old friend, Witlaf of Stallingborough, and told him all. +</p> + +<p> +“Why,” he said, “I will have no Welsh outsiders harrying my friends. Light up +your beacon if he comes, and shut your gates in his face, and I and the +housecarls will take him in the rear, and he will not wait here long. I have +not had a fight for these twenty years or so, and it does me good to think of +one.” +</p> + +<p> +So we thought that there was little fear of the Welshman. +</p> + +<p> +When I came back from this errand, however, I chose to pass the mound where my +father slept, and on it, hand in hand, sat Havelok and Goldberga—for it was a +quiet place, and none came near it often. It was good to see them thus in that +place, and happy they seemed together. +</p> + +<p> +Goldberga called me when I came near, and I sat down beside them as she bade +me. +</p> + +<p> +“Here we have been talking of what we shall do now, for it seems that to both +of us are many things to hand,” she said. “Good it would be if we could set +them aside; but we were born to them, and we cannot let them be. And, most of +all, here in this place we may not forget the duty that Grim would remind us +of. Havelok must go to Denmark and win back his kingdom from Hodulf first of +all.” +</p> + +<p> +“We have thought that East Anglia was to be won first from Alsi,” I said. +</p> + +<p> +“So says Havelok; but I do not think so. For, indeed, I am but the wife, and +the things of the husband come first of all. Now, this is what I would say. +Sail to Denmark before Hodulf knows what is coming, and there will be less +trouble.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am slow at seeing things,” said Havelok; “but the same might be said of your +kingdom.” +</p> + +<p> +“Alsi is ready, and Hodulf is not,” she answered, laughing; “any one can see +that. +</p> + +<p> +“Is it not so, brother?” +</p> + +<p> +So it was; and I thought that she was right. +</p> + +<p> +“Let us ask the brothers,” I said, “for here are many things to be thought of; +and, first of all, where to get men.” +</p> + +<p> +That was the greatest trouble to our minds, but none at all to hers. +</p> + +<p> +“Get them in Denmark,” she said, when we were all together in the great room of +the house that evening. “Let us go as merchant folk, and find Sigurd, or his +son if he is dead. If I am not much mistaken, all the land will rise for the +son of Gunnar so soon as it is known that he has come again.” +</p> + +<p> +“Sigurd is yet alive,” Arngeir said; “and more than that, he is waiting. For he +promised Grim that he would be ready, and I heard the promise. I think that +this plan is good, and can well be managed. Here is the ship that Griffin was +to have taken today, and he is not here. Gold enough I have, for Grim hoarded +against this time.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he showed us the store that, through long years, my father had brought +together to take the place of that of Sigurd’s which had been lost; and it was +no small one. And so we planned at once; and in the end we three brothers were +to go with Havelok and Goldberga, leaving Mord to get to Ragnar and tell him +that Goldberga was following the fortunes of her husband, and would return to +see to her own if all went well. Berthun would go with him, and Arngeir would +bide at home, for we needed one to whom messages might come; and while none +would know us now in Denmark, either Arngeir or Mord might be seen, and men +would tell Hodulf that the men of Grim had come home, and so perhaps spoil all. +Word might go to Denmark from Griffin even yet. +</p> + +<p> +We had little thought of any sorry ending to our plans, for the dreams that had +come so true so far cheered us. And so, with the evening tide of the next day, +we sailed in the same ship that had been hired for Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +But first Havelok spent a long hour on my father’s mound alone, thinking of all +that he owed to him who rested there. And to him came Goldberga softly, +presently, lest he should be lonely in that place. And there she spoke to him +of her own faith, saying that already he owed much to it. For he was making his +vows to the Asir for success. +</p> + +<p> +“Shall you pray yet again to the Asir, my husband?” she asked. +</p> + +<p> +“Why should I? I have vowed my vows, and there is an end. If they heed them, +all is well; and if not, the Norns hinder.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is One whom the Norns hinder not at all,” she said gently, and so told +him how that her prayers would go up every day. +</p> + +<p> +Fain was she that he also prayed in that wise to her God, that naught might be +apart in their minds. +</p> + +<p> +Then he said, “I have heard this from David and Withelm also, and it is good. +Teach me to vow to your God, sweet wife, and I will do so; and you shall teach +me to pray as you pray.” +</p> + +<p> +So it came to pass that Havelok in the after days was more than ready to help +the Christian teachers when they came to him; for that was how the vow that he +made ran, that he would do so if he was king, and had the power. +</p> + +<p> +Now there is nothing to tell of our voyage, for one could not wish for a better +passage, if the ship was slow. Indeed, she was so slow that a smaller vessel +that left Tetney haven on the next day reached the same port that we were bound +for on the night that we came to our old home. And that we learned soon after +she had come. +</p> + +<p> +Into Sigurd’s haven we sailed on the morning tide, and strange it seemed to me +to see the well-known place unchanged as we neared it. My father’s house was +there, and Arngeir’s, and the great hall of the jarl towered over all, as I +remembered it. Men were building a ship in the long shed where ours had been +built, and where the queen had hidden; and the fishing boats lay on the hard as +on the day when Havelok had come to us. The little grove was yet behind our +house, and it seemed strange when I remembered that the old stones of its altar +were far beyond the seas. I wondered if Thor yet stood under his great ash +tree; and then I saw one change, for that tree was gone, and in its place stood +a watchtower, stone built, and broad and high, for haven beacon. +</p> + +<p> +On the high fore deck stood Havelok, and his arm was round Goldberga as we ran +in, but they were silent. The land held overmuch of coming wonder for them to +put into words, as I think. +</p> + +<p> +Presently the boats came off to us in the old way, and here and there I seemed +to know the faces of the men, but I was not sure. It was but the remembrance of +the old Danish cast of face, maybe. I could put no names to any of them. And as +we were warped alongside the wharf, there rode down to see who we were Sigurd +the jarl himself, seeming unchanged, although twelve years had gone over him. +He was younger than my father, I think, and was at that age when a man changes +too slowly for a boy to notice aught but that the one he left as a man he +thought old is so yet. He was just the noble-looking warrior that I had always +wondered at and admired. +</p> + +<p> +We had arranged in this way: Havelok was to be the merchant, and we his +partners in the venture, trading with the goods in the ship as our own. That +the owner, who was also ship master, had agreed to willingly enough, as we +promised to make good any loss that might be from our want of skill in +bargaining. One may say that we bought the cargo, which was not a great one, on +our own risk, therefore, hiring the vessel to wait our needs, in case we found +it better to fly or to land elsewhere presently. Then Havelok was to ask the +jarl’s leave to trade in the land, and so find a chance to speak with him in +private. After that the goods might be an excuse for going far and wide through +the villages to let men know who had come, without rousing Hodulf’s fears. +</p> + +<p> +And as we thought of all this on the voyage, Goldberga remembered that it was +likely that Sigurd would know again the ring that had been the queen’s, and she +said that it had better be shown him at once, that he might begin to suspect +who his guest was. For we knew that he was true to the son of Gunnar, if none +else might still be so. +</p> + +<p> +This seemed good to us all; and, indeed, everything seemed to be well planned, +though we knew that there are always some happenings that have been overlooked. +We thought we had provided against these by keeping the ship as our own to wait +for us, however, and it will be seen how it all worked out in the end. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok went ashore as soon as the ship was moored; and the moment that he +touched land he made a sign on his breast, and I think that it was not that of +the hammer of Thor, for Goldberga watched him with bright eyes, and she seemed +content as she did so. He went at once to where the jarl sat on his horse +waiting him, and greetings passed. I was so used to seeing men stare at my +brother that I thought little of the long look that Sigurd gave him; but +presently it seemed that he was mightily taken with this newcomer, for he came +on board the ship, that he might speak more with him and us. +</p> + +<p> +“Presently,” he said, “you must come and dine with me at my hall; for the lady +whom I saw as you came in will be weary, and a meal on shore after a long +voyage is ever pleasant. Now what is your errand here?” +</p> + +<p> +“Trading, jarl,” answered Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“I thought you somewhat over warlike-looking for a merchant,” said Sigurd; +“what is your merchandise?” +</p> + +<p> +“Lincoln cloth, and bar iron, and such like; and with it all one thing that is +worth showing to you, jarl, for I will sell it to none but yourself.” +</p> + +<p> +Now we went aft slowly, and presently Havelok and the jarl were alone by the +steering oar, by design on our part. +</p> + +<p> +“This seems to be somewhat special,” said Sigurd. “What is it?” +</p> + +<p> +Havelok took the ring from his pouch, and set it in the jarl’s hand without a +word; and long Sigurd looked at it. I saw the red on his cheek deepen as he did +so, but he said never a word for a long time. And next he looked at Havelok, +and the eyes of these two met. +</p> + +<p> +“This is beyond price,” said the jarl slowly. “Not my whole town would buy +this. It is such as a queen might wear and be proud of.” +</p> + +<p> +“Should I show it to Hodulf the king, therefore?” asked Havelok, with his eyes +on those of the jarl. +</p> + +<p> +“Let no man see it until I know if I can buy it,” answered Sigurd. “Trust it to +my keeping, if you will, for I would have it valued maybe.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is my wife’s, and you must ask her that.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok called Goldberga from her cabin under the after deck, and the jarl +greeted her in most courtly wise. +</p> + +<p> +“I will trust it with you, Jarl Sigurd,” she said, when he asked her if he +might keep the ring for a time. “Yet it is a great trust, as you know, and it +will be well to show the ring to none but men who are true.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is to true men that I would show it,” he answered, with that look that had +passed between him and Havelok already; and I was sure that he knew now pretty +certainly who we were. Yet he could not say more at this time, for the many men +who waited for Havelok must be told somewhat of his coming first. +</p> + +<p> +Now men were gathering on the wharf to see the newcomers, and so the jarl spoke +openly for all to hear. +</p> + +<p> +“Come up to my hall, all of you, and take a meal ashore with me; for good is +the first food on dry land after days at sea and the fare of the ship.” +</p> + +<p> +So he went across the gangway, and to his horse, and rode away quickly, calling +back to us, “Hasten, for we wait for you. And I will find you lodgings in the +town for the time that you bide with us.” +</p> + +<p> +Now at first that seemed somewhat hazardous, for we had meant to stay in the +ship, lest we should have to fly for any reason suddenly. But it seemed that we +had no choice but to do as he bade us, and we could not doubt him in any way. +We should go armed, of course, as in a strange place; and, after all, unless +Hodulf heard of us, and wanted to see us, he was not to be feared as yet. So I +fell to wondering where our lodgings would he, and if the old families still +dwelt in the houses that I had known, and then who had ours. Many such thoughts +will crowd into the mind of one who sees his old land again after many years, +and finds naught changed, to the eye at least. +</p> + +<p> +Men have told me that, as we came into the hall presently, they thought us the +most goodly company that had ever crossed its threshold; and that is likely, +for at our head were Havelok and Goldberga. Raven was a mighty warrior to look +on as he came next, grave and silent, with far-seeing grey eyes that were full +of watching, as it were, from his long seafaring, and yet had the seaman’s +ready smile in them. And Withelm was the pattern of a well-made youth who has +his strength yet to gather, and already knows how to make the best use of that +he has. There were none but thought that he was the most handsome of the three +sons of Grim. And last came I, and I am big enough, at least, to stand at +Havelok’s back; and for the rest, one remembers what Eglaf said of me. But I do +not think that any noticed us with those twain to look at, unless they scanned +our arms, which were more after the English sort than the Danish, so far as +mail and helms are concerned, and therefore might seem strange. +</p> + +<p> +The old hall was not changed at all; and handsome it seemed after Alsi’s, +though it was not so large. There were more and better weapons on the walls, +and carved work was everywhere, so that in the swirl and heat-flicker of the +torches the beams, and door posts, and bench ends, and the pillars of the high +seat seemed alive with knotted dragons that began, and ended, and writhed +everywhere, wondrous to look on. Our English have not the long winter nights, +and cruel frosts, and deep snow that make time for such work as this for the +men of the household. +</p> + +<p> +There fell a silence as we came in, and then Sigurd greeted us; and we were set +on the high seat, and feasted royally. On right and left of our host sat +Havelok and Goldberga, and the jarl’s wife next to Havelok, and Biorn the +Brown, the sheriff, next to our princess. This was a newcomer here since my +days, but well we liked him. +</p> + +<p> +There is nothing to tell of what happened at this feast, for Sigurd asked no +questions of us but the most common ones of sea, and wind, and voyage, and +never a word that would have been hard for Havelok to answer in this company, +where men of Hodulf’s might well be present. Withelm noticed this, and said +that no doubt it was done purposely, and he thought much of it. +</p> + +<p> +When we had ended with song and tale, and it was near time for rest, Sigurd +bade Biorn, the sheriff, take us to his house for the night, telling him that +he must answer for our safety, and specially that of the fair lady who had come +from so far. And then he gave us a good guard of his housecarls to take us down +the street, as if he feared some danger. +</p> + +<p> +“Why, jarl,” said Biorn, “our guests will have a bad night if they think that +in our quiet place they need twenty men to see them to bed thus!” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but the town is strange to the lady,” answered Sigurd; “and who knows +what she may fear in a foreign land!” +</p> + +<p> +So Biorn laughed, and was content; and we bade farewell to the jarl, and went +out. And then I found that it was to my father’s house we were to go, for it +had been given to Biorn. +</p> + +<p> +Now, I was next to Goldberga as we came to the door, and there was a step into +the house which we always had to warn strangers of when it was dark; and so, in +the old way, without thinking for a moment, I said to her, “One step into the +house, sister.” +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, Master Radbard, if that is you, you have sharp eyes in the dark,” said +Biorn at once; “I was just about to say that myself.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have some feeling in my toes,” I answered; and that turned the matter, for +they laughed. +</p> + +<p> +And then, when we were inside, and the courtmen had gone clattering down the +street homewards, Biorn took the great door bar from its old place and ran it +into the sockets in the doorposts, as I had done so many times; and the runes +that my father had cut on it when he made the house were still plain to be seen +on it, with the notches I had made with the first knife that I ever had. More I +will not say, but everywhere that my eyes fell were things that I knew, even to +fishing gear, for it seemed that Biorn was somewhat of a fisher, like Grim +himself. +</p> + +<p> +Then they put me and my brothers into our old loft, and Havelok and Goldberga +had the room that had been my father’s. As for Biorn, he would be in the great +room, before the fire. There was only this one door to the house, and therefore +he would guard that. His thralls were in the sheds, as ours used to be, so that +we and he were alone in the house. +</p> + +<p> +Now, as soon as we three had gone into our old place of rest, Raven went at +once, as in the old days, to the little square window that was in the +high-pitched gable, and looked out over the town and sea. We used to laugh at +him for this, for he was never happy until he had seen, as we said, if all was +yet there. +</p> + +<p> +“There are yet lights in the jarl’s hall,” he said, “and there are one or two +moving about down in the haven. I think that there is a vessel coming in.” +</p> + +<p> +“Come and lie down, brother,” I said. “We are not in Grimsby, and you cannot go +and take toll from her if there is.” +</p> + +<p> +He laughed, and came to his bed; but we talked of old days and of many things +more for a long while before we slept. And most of all, we thought that Sigurd +the jarl knew Havelok by the token of the ring and by that likeness to Gunnar +which Mord had seen, and that our errand was almost told. +</p> + +<p> +So we slept without thought of any danger; but the first hour of the night in +that house was not so quiet to Goldberga, for presently she woke Havelok, and +she was trembling. +</p> + +<p> +“Husband,” she said, “it is in my mind that we are in danger in this place; for +I cannot sleep by reason of a dream that will come to me so soon as my eyes are +closed.” +</p> + +<p> +“You are overtired with the voyage,” Havelok told her gently; and then he asked +her what the dream was. +</p> + +<p> +“It seems that I see you attacked by a boar and many foxes, and hard pressed, +and then that a bear and good hounds help you. Yet we have to flee to a great +tree, and there is safety. Then come two lions, and they obey you.” +</p> + +<p> +“I think that is a dream that comes of waves, and the foam that has followed +us, and the shrill wind in the rigging, and the humming of the sail, sweet +wife; and the tree is the tall mast maybe, and the lions are the surges that +you saw along this shore, where is no danger.” +</p> + +<p> +So she was content; and then all in the house slept. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap19">CHAPTER XIX.<br/> +THE LAST OF GRIFFIN OF WALES.</a></h2> + +<p> +Maybe it was about an hour before midnight when the first waking came to any of +us, and then it was Biorn himself who was roused by footsteps that stayed at +the doorway itself, after coming across the garth, and then a voice that was +strange to him which bade him open. At once he caught up his axe and went to +the door, and asked quietly who was there. +</p> + +<p> +“Open at once,” said the man who was without; “we must speak with you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Go hence, I pray you, and wait for morning,” said the sheriff. “Here are +guests of the jarl’s, and they must not be disturbed.” +</p> + +<p> +“Open, or we will open for ourselves,” was the answer. “We have no time to stay +here talking.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is no honest speech,” quoth Biorn. “Go hence, or give me your errand from +without.” +</p> + +<p> +“Open, fool, or we will have the door down.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is an axe waiting for you if you do that. I rede you go hence in peace, +or it may be worse for you in the end.” +</p> + +<p> +I suppose it was in the mind of the sheriff that here were some friends of his +who had been overlong at the ale bench in the hall that evening; but on this +there was a little talk outside, and then the crash of a great stone that was +hurled against the door; and at that he started back and got his mail shirt on +him, for the door was strong enough to stand many such blows yet. It seemed +that there was more than a drunken frolic on hand. Then came another stone +against the door, and it shook; and at the same moment Havelok came from his +chamber to see what was amiss, for the noise had waked him. He had thrown on +the feasting gear that he had been wearing; but he had neither mail nor helm, +though he had his axe in his hand. +</p> + +<p> +“What is the noise?” he said anxiously, seeing that Biorn was arming. +</p> + +<p> +The sheriff told him quickly, and again the door was battered. +</p> + +<p> +“It is a pity that a good door should be spoilt,” said Havelok, “for down it is +bound to come thus. Stand you there with the axe, and I will even save them the +trouble of breaking in.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” said Biorn; “we know not how many are there, and it were better that you +should arm first. There is time.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, they think that you are alone in the house, no doubt, and will run when +they find out their mistake. They are common thieves from the forest, or +outlaws. Stand you by to cut down the first man that dares to enter, if there +happen to be one bold enough.” +</p> + +<p> +He set his axe down, and went to the bar, and began to slide it back into the +deep socket that would let it free, and the men outside stayed their blows as +they heard it scraping. It was a very heavy bar of oak, some seven feet long, +and over a palm square. +</p> + +<p> +“Now!” cried Havelok, and caught the bar from its place. +</p> + +<p> +He did not take the trouble to set it down and get his axe; but as the door +opened a little he stood back balancing the great beam in his hands, as a boy +would handle a quarterstaff, ready for the rush of the thieves that he +expected, and so he was in the way of Biorn more or less. +</p> + +<p> +Now there was silence outside, and one saw that the door was free, and set his +foot to it, and flung it open, for it went inwards. And then Havelok knew that +there was a stern fight before him, for the moonlight showed the grim form of +Griffin, the Welsh thane, fully armed and ready. +</p> + +<p> +“Stand back, friend,” cried Biorn hastily, fearing for the unarmed man, and +caring nothing that beyond the foremost was a group of some half dozen more +warriors. +</p> + +<p> +But he spoke too late, for as Griffin stepped back a pace on seeing his enemy +himself in the doorway, Havelok had gone a pace forward, and now was outside, +where he had a clear swing of his unhandy weapon. +</p> + +<p> +Now Griffin gathered himself together, and spoke some few words to his men in +his own tongue; but my brother paid no heed to them, for he knew what the way +of the Briton was likely to be. And he was not wrong, for without warning +Griffin flew on him, sword point foremost, and left handed, for he might not +use the right for many a long day yet. +</p> + +<p> +Biorn shouted; but Havelok was ready, and the heavy bar caught and shivered the +light sword, and then swung and hurled the thane back among his men with a rib +broken. Havelok followed that up, falling on the men even as their leader was +among their feet. Two he felled with downright strokes, and another shrank away +in time to save himself from the like fate. Then a fourth got in under his +guard, and wounded Havelok slightly in the left arm; and unless Biorn had been +out and beside him by that time it would have gone hard with him, for both +those who were left were on him, and another was hanging back for a chance to +come. +</p> + +<p> +There was shouting enough now, for the Briton does not fight in silence as do +the northern men, and we had waked. First of all Raven ran down to the great +room, half dazed with sleep, and blaming himself for all this trouble, for he +had seen that a ship was coming in, and he might have thought it possible that +it had brought Griffin and his men, whose tongue had told him at once what had +happened. +</p> + +<p> +Now he called to us to arm quickly, and sought for a weapon for himself; and in +that familiar place he went to the old corner where the oars were wont to be +set. There was one, for I have said that this Biorn was a fisher, and the place +that was handy for us had been so for him. That was a homely weapon to Raven, +and out into the moonlight he came with it, and swept a Welshman away from +Havelok’s side as he came. But now more men were coming—townsfolk who had been +roused by the noise—and they knew nothing of the attackers, and so thought them +friends of ours, who joined us in falling on their sheriff; and there was a +wild confusion when Withelm and I came down armed. +</p> + +<p> +But what we saw first was a dim, white figure in the doorway of the other room; +and there stood Goldberga, wide eyed and trembling. +</p> + +<p> +“My dream, my dream!” she said. +</p> + +<p> +But of that we knew nothing; and we could but tell her to be of good courage, +for we would win through yet, and so went out to the fight. +</p> + +<p> +By this time Griffin was up again, and as I came from the door he was once more +ready to fall on Havelok from behind. So I thought it best to stay him, and I +shouted his name, and he turned and made for me. But there was no skill in his +coming, or he did not think me worth it, for the axe had the better, and there +was an end of Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +Withelm saw at once that Havelok had no weapon but the bar, and he ran to him +and held out his own axe. +</p> + +<p> +“Thanks, brother. Mine is inside the door. Get it for me,” said he; but now he +was laughing, and doing not much harm to anyone, and as I got behind his back I +saw why this was. +</p> + +<p> +There was only one of Griffin’s men left, and all the rest of the crowd of +half-armed men were townsfolk. Havelok and Raven were keeping these back with +sweeps of their long weapons, and behind them against the wall was the sheriff, +swearing and shouting vainly to bid his people hold off and listen to him. And +the noise was so great that they did but think that he was calling them to +rescue him from these who had taken him prisoner. It seemed that the Welshman +was keeping this up also; but neither he nor any of the men cared to risk any +nearness to the sweep of bar and long oar in such hands. There were many broken +heads in that crowd; but it was growing greater every minute, and those who +were coming were well armed, having taken their time over it. They say that +there were sixty men there at one time. +</p> + +<p> +Now ran Withelm with the axe, and at that Havelok parted with the door bar, and +ended the last Welshman at the same time, for he hurled it at him endwise, like +a spear, and it took him full in the chest, and he went down to rise no more. +And at that the townsmen ran in, and we were busy for a space, until once more +they were in a howling circle round us. But they had wounded Havelok again; and +Biorn was at his wit’s end, for he had had to take part in the fight this time. +The men were mad with battle, and forgot who he was, as it seemed. And now some +raised a cry for bows. +</p> + +<p> +That was the worst thing that we had to fear, and Raven called to us, “Into the +house, brothers, and keep them out of it till the jarl comes. He will hear, or +be sent for.” +</p> + +<p> +So we went back and got into the doorway, and we could not bar it at first. But +Withelm hewed off the blade of Raven’s oar, and I went out and cleared the folk +away for a space, and leapt back; and Havelok and I got the door shut quickly +against them as they came back on it, and we barred it with the oar loom. That +was but pine, however, and it would not last long. +</p> + +<p> +Outside, the people were quiet for a little, wondering, no doubt, how to rescue +Biorn. He wanted to go out to them, but it did not seem safe just yet. If they +grew more reasonable it might be so. +</p> + +<p> +Then, as we rested thus, Goldberga came quickly, for she saw that her husband +was wounded, and she began to bind his hurts with a scarf she had. She was very +pale, but she was not weeping, and her hands did not shake as she went to work. +</p> + +<p> +“This is my dream,” she said. “Was that the voice of Griffin that I heard? It +does not seem possible; but there is none other who speaks in the old tongue of +Britain here, surely.” +</p> + +<p> +“There is no more fear of him,” said Havelok, looking tenderly at her. “Your +dream has come true so far, if he was in it. How did it end?” +</p> + +<p> +“We fled to a tree,” she said, smiling faintly. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok smiled also, for this seemed dream stuff only to all of us—all of us +but Withelm, that is, for at once he said, “This door will be down with a few +blows. What of that tower of yours, Biorn? Might we not get there and wait till +the jarl comes?” +</p> + +<p> +At that Biorn almost shouted. +</p> + +<p> +“That is a good thought, and we can get there easily. Well it will be, also, +for the men are wild now, and there have been too many slain and hurt for them +to listen to reason.” +</p> + +<p> +“Bide you here,” said Withelm, “for it is we whom they seek. Then you can talk +to them.” +</p> + +<p> +But he would not do that, seeing that we had been put in his charge by the +jarl. +</p> + +<p> +“I go with you,” he said. “Now, if we climb out of the window that is in the +back of the house we can get to the tower before they know we are gone.” +</p> + +<p> +We went into that chamber where Havelok had once been when he was taken from +the sack, and even as I unbarred the heavy shutter and took it down, the door +began to shake with a fresh attack on it. The trees of the grove were two +hundred yards from the house, maybe, and among them loomed high and black the +watchtower I had seen from the sea. A wide path had been cut to it, and the +moonlight shone straight down this to the door of the building. +</p> + +<p> +Now Biorn went out first, and then he helped out Goldberga, and after her we +made Havelok go; and we called to these three to get to the tower as Withelm +came next, for every moment I looked to see our enemies—if they are to be +called so when I hardly suppose they knew what they were fighting about—come +round to fall on the back of the house. +</p> + +<p> +Because of Goldberga they went; and Biorn opened the tower door, and she passed +into the blackness of its entry, but the two men stayed outside for us. And we +three were all out of the house when the first of the crowd bethought +themselves, and made for the back, and saw us. +</p> + +<p> +At once they raised a shout and a rush, and we did not think it worth while to +wait for them, as they would get between us and the tower, which was open for +us. So we ran, and they were, some twenty of them, hard at our heels as we +reached the door, and half fell inside, for the winding stairway was close to +the entry. I think that Biorn and Havelok had made their plans as they saw what +was coming, for Havelok followed us and stood in the doorway, while Biorn was +just outside with his axe ready. +</p> + +<p> +“Hold hard, friends!” he called, as the men came up and halted before him; +“what is all this?” +</p> + +<p> +“Stand aside and let us get at them,” said the foremost, panting. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” said Biorn; “what harm have they done?” +</p> + +<p> +“Slain a dozen men and lamed twice as many more,” answered several voices; +“have them forth straightway.” +</p> + +<p> +“They were attacked, and defended themselves,” said the sheriff, “and it is no +fault of theirs that they had to do their best. Get you home, and I will answer +to the jarl for them. They are the jarl’s guests.” +</p> + +<p> +Then was a howl that was strange, and with it voices which seemed to let some +light on the matter. +</p> + +<p> +“They have slain the jarl’s guests.” +</p> + +<p> +And then came forward a big black-bearded man whom I had seen in the crowd +already, and he squared up to Biorn. +</p> + +<p> +“Lies are no good, master sheriff, for we know that the outlanders who spoke +the strange tongue must be the guests who came.” +</p> + +<p> +“I am no liar,” answered Biorn. “Is there not one man here who saw the ship and +her folk this afternoon?” +</p> + +<p> +Now this man seemed not to want that question answered, for he shouted to the +crowd not to waste time in wrangling, but to have out the murderers; and he +took a step towards Biorn, bidding him side no more with the men, but let the +folk deal with them. +</p> + +<p> +“You overdo your business as sheriff!” he said. +</p> + +<p> +It was Biorn who wasted no more time, for he saw that here was deeper trouble +than a common riot. He lifted his axe. +</p> + +<p> +“Come nearer at your peril,” he said. +</p> + +<p> +Then the black-bearded man sprang at him, and axe met sword for a parry or two, +flashing white in the moonlight. Then one weapon flashed red suddenly, and it +was Biorn’s, and back into the tower he sprang as his foe fell, and Havelok +flung the door to, and I barred it. +</p> + +<p> +“Up,” said Biorn; and in the dark we stumbled from stair to stair, while the +crowd howled and beat on the door below us. It was good to get out into the +moonlight on the roof, where we could rest. I was glad that the tower was there +instead of Thor, and also that it was strong. It was no great height, but wide, +and the men below looked comfortably far off at all events. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is a fine affair,” quoth Biorn, sitting himself down with his back +against the high stone wall round the tower top. “It will take me all my time +to set this right.” +</p> + +<p> +“You have stood by us well, friend,” Havelok said, “and it is a pity that you +have had to share our trouble so far as this. Who was the man who fell on you?” +</p> + +<p> +“That is the trouble,” answered Biorn, “for there will be more noise over him +than all the rest. He was Hodulf’s steward, the man who gathers the scatt, and +therefore is not liked. And all men know that there was no love lost between +him and me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Hodulf’s man,” said I; “how long has he been here, and is he a Norseman?” +</p> + +<p> +For I knew him. He was the man who had spoken to me at the boat side when we +had to fly—one, therefore, who knew all of the secret of Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, one of the Norsemen who came here with the king at the first, and is +almost the last left of that crew. I suppose that you have heard the story.” +</p> + +<p> +We had, in a way that the honest sheriff did not guess, and I only nodded. But +I thought that we had got rid of an enemy in him, and that Griffin had fallen +in with him on landing, and known him, and taken him into his counsel about us. +He would have gone down to see the vessel and collect the king’s dues from her +and from us at the same time. He had not come into the town till late, as we +heard afterwards. +</p> + +<p> +There was no time for asking more now, however, for the shouts of the men round +the door ceased, and someone gave orders, as if there was a plan to be carried +out. So I went and looked over on the side where the door was to see what was +on hand. +</p> + +<p> +It was about what one would have expected. They had got the trunk of a tree, +and were going to batter the door in. But now we were all armed, for Raven had +brought Havelok’s gear with him when he fetched his own. He had thought also +for Goldberga, and she was sitting in the corner of the tower walls wrapped in +a great cloak that she had used at sea, with her eyes on her husband, +unfearing, and as it seemed waiting for the end that her dream foretold. +</p> + +<p> +I called the rest, and we looked down on the men. They saw us, and an arrow or +two flew at us, badly aimed in the moonlight. +</p> + +<p> +“Waste of good arrows,” said Havelok; “but we must keep them from the door +somehow.” +</p> + +<p> +“Would that the jarl would come,” growled Biorn, “for I do not see how we are +to do that.” +</p> + +<p> +“If they do break in,” said I, “any one can hold a stairway like this against a +crowd.” +</p> + +<p> +“I do not want to hurt more of these,” answered Havelok, looking round him. And +then his eyes lit up, and he laughed. “Why, we can keep them back easily +enough, after all.” +</p> + +<p> +He went to the tower corner, and shouted to the men below. Four or five had the +heavy log that they were to use as a ram, and they were just about to charge +the door with it, and no timber planking can stand that sort of thing. +</p> + +<p> +“Ho, men,” he cried; “set that down, or some of you may get hurt.” +</p> + +<p> +They set up a roar of laughter at him as they heard, and then Havelok laid hold +of the great square block of stone that was on the very corner of the wall, and +tore it from its setting. +</p> + +<p> +“Odin!” said Biorn, as he saw that, “where do they breed such men as this?” +</p> + +<p> +“Here,” answered Withelm, looking at the sheriff. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok hove up the stone over his head, and a sort of gasp went up from +the crowd below. One saw what was coming, and ran to drag back the men with the +beam, and stopped short before he reached them in terror, crying to them to +beware. But their heads were down, and they were starting into a run. +</p> + +<p> +“Halt!” cried Havelok, but they did not stay. “Stand clear!” he shouted in the +sailor’s way. +</p> + +<p> +And then he swung the stone and let it go, while those who watched fled back as +if it was cast at them. Down is crashed on the attackers, felling the man whom +it struck, and dashing the timber from the grasp of the others, so that one +fell with it across his leg and lay howling, while the rest gathered themselves +up and got away from under the tower as soon as they might. +</p> + +<p> +Now no man dared to come forward, and that angered Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Are you going to let these two bide there?” he said. “Pick the poor knaves +from under the stone and timber, and see to them.” +</p> + +<p> +But they hung back yet, and he called them “nidring.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat two or three made a step forward, and one said, “Lord, let us do as you +bid us, and harm us not.” +</p> + +<p> +“You are safe,” he answered, and Biorn laughed and said that this was the most +wholesome word that he had heard tonight. +</p> + +<p> +“Lord, forsooth! Mighty little of that was there five minutes ago.” +</p> + +<p> +But it was not the terrible stone throwing only that wrung this from them, as I +think. They had seen Havelok in his arms, with the light of battle on his face +in the broad moonlight, and knew him for a king among men. +</p> + +<p> +They took the hurt men from under the tower, and then crowded together, +watching us. And some man must needs loose an arrow at us, and it rang on my +mail, and that let loose the crowd again. Soon we had to shelter under the +battlement, but they were not able to lodge any arrows among us, for that is a +bit of skill that needs daylight. Then they dared to get to the timber once +more, and we saw them coming. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok took his helm, and set it on his sword point, and raised it slowly +above the wall, and that drew all the arrows in a moment. Then he leapt up, and +tore the stone from the other corner; and again, but this time without warning, +it fell on the men below, and that wrought more harm than before. But it stayed +them for a time, though not so long, for now their blood was up, and the +berserk spirit was waking in them. Already the third stone was poised in the +mighty hands, and would have fallen, when there was a cry of, “The jarl! the +jarl!” and along the path into the clearing galloped Sigurd himself, with his +courtmen running behind him, and he called on the men to stay. +</p> + +<p> +They dropped the beam at the command, and were silent. And Sigurd looked up at +the tower, and saw who was there, and stayed with his face raised, motionless +for a space. I minded how Mord had stared and cried out when first he saw +Havelok, the son of Gunnar, in his war gear. +</p> + +<p> +“Biorn! where is Biorn?” cried Sigurd, looking back on the crowd as if he +thought he would be there. +</p> + +<p> +“Here am I, jarl,” came the answer, and the sheriff looked out from beside +Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“What is all this?” +</p> + +<p> +“On my word, jarl, I cannot tell. Here have I been beset in my own house, and +but for your guests some of us would have come off badly. There were outlanders +who fell on us, and, as I think, stirred up the folk to carry on the business, +telling them that we had slain ourselves, as one might say, for it was the cry +that we had slain the jarl’s guests.” +</p> + +<p> +“O fools, to take up the word of a chance stranger against that of your own +sheriff!” Sigurd cried, facing the people. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but the steward said so likewise,” cried some. +</p> + +<p> +“Hodulf’s steward?” said the jarl suddenly; “where is he?” +</p> + +<p> +“Yonder. Biorn slew him.” +</p> + +<p> +“He was leading this crowd,” said Biorn from above, “tried to force his way +into the tower past me, and would not be warned.” +</p> + +<p> +“What of the outlanders?” +</p> + +<p> +“All slain. Seven Welshmen they were.” +</p> + +<p> +Then I said plainly, remembering that the jarl would have known him, “Their +leader was Griffin, who came with Hodulf at the first. What brought him here, +think you, Sigurd the jarl?” +</p> + +<p> +But Sigurd looked round on the people, and scanned them for a long time, and at +last he said, in a hush that fell when he began to speak, “Men who mind the old +days, look at the man whom you have sought to kill, and say if there is that +about him which will tell you why Hodulf’s men have set you on him thus.” +</p> + +<p> +Then the white faces turned with one accord to Havelok, as he stood resting the +great cornerstone on the battlement before him, and there grew a whisper that +became a word and that was almost a shout from the many voices that answered. +</p> + +<p> +“Gunnar! Gunnar Kirkeban come again!” +</p> + +<p> +Then was silence, and the jarl spoke to Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Tell us your name, and whence you come.” +</p> + +<p> +“Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby men call me,” he said. +</p> + +<p> +And then men knew who he was indeed, for little by little the secret had been +pieced together, if not told from the king’s place, in the years that had +passed. And at that there rose and grew a murmur and a cry. +</p> + +<p> +“Havelok, son of Gunnar! Havelok the king!” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Sigurd in a great voice, “Who is for Hodulf of us all? Let no man go +hence who is for him.” +</p> + +<p> +And I saw two or three men cut down then and there, and after that there was a +roar of voices that called for Havelok to lead them. +</p> + +<p> +“Come down, lord,” said Sigurd, unhelming and looking up. +</p> + +<p> +So we went from the tower, and round Havelok the men crowded, kissing his hand +and asking pardon for what they had wrought in error; and Sigurd dismounted and +knelt before him, holding forth his sword hilt in token of homage, that his +king might touch it. +</p> + +<p> +“Only Havelok son of Gunnar dares call himself son of Grim also, and in that +word all the tale is told. But I have known you from the first by the token of +the ring and by this likeness. Yet I waited for you to speak, and for the time +that should be best; and now that has come of itself, and I am glad.” +</p> + +<p> +So said Sigurd, as we went from the tower to the hall, with the townsmen at our +heels in a wondering crowd. There were many among them who would show the +wounds that Havelok had given them with pride hereafter, as tokens that they +had known him well. +</p> + +<p> +Then we stayed on the steps of the hall door, and the jarl called out man by +man, and the war arrow was put in their hands with the names of those men who +waited for the coming of Havelok, that all through the night the message that +should bring him a mighty host on the morrow should go far and wide. +</p> + +<p> +And the gathering word was, “Come, for the horn of the king is sounding.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Sigurd said, “Speak to the people, my king, and all is done.” +</p> + +<p> +So Havelok smiled, and lifted his voice, and spoke. +</p> + +<p> +“Stand by me, friends, as steadfastly as you have fought against me, and I +shall be well content. And see, here is the queen for whom you will fight also. +There is not one of you but will play the man under her eyes.” +</p> + +<p> +Not many words or crafty, but men saw his face, and heard that which was in the +voice, and they needed no word of reward to come, but shouted as we had shouted +when the bride came home to Grimsby, and I thought that with the shout the +throne of Hodulf was rocking. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap20">CHAPTER XX.<br/> +THE OWNING OF THE HEIR.</a></h2> + +<p> +Worn out we were with that long fight, and we all had some small wounds—not +much worth speaking of; and when these were seen to, we slept. Only my brother +Raven waked, and he sat through all the rest of the short night on the high +place, with his sword across his knees, watching, for he blamed himself, +overmuch as we all thought, for the happenings of the attack. +</p> + +<p> +“Trouble not, brother, for we were in the keeping of Biorn, and he could not +have dreamt that foes could follow us over seas. It was not for you to be on +guard.” +</p> + +<p> +These were Withelm’s words, but for once Raven did not heed them. +</p> + +<p> +“Would Grim, our father, have slept with a lee shore under him, leaving a +stranger to keep watch? That is not how he taught me my duty; and I have been +careless, and I know it. I should have thought of Griffin when I saw the ship +come in.” +</p> + +<p> +So he had his way, and the last that I saw ere my eyes closed was his stern +form guarding us; and when I woke he was yet there, motionless, with far-off +eyes that noted the little movement that I made, and glanced at me to see that +all was well. +</p> + +<p> +In the grey of the morning the first of the chiefs to whom the arrow had sped +began to come in; but the jarl would not have Havelok waked, for he was greatly +troubled at the little wounds that had befallen this long-waited guest. So the +chiefs gathered very silently in the great hall, and sat waiting while the +light broadened and shone, gleam by gleam, on their bright arms and anxious +faces. It was not possible for those who had not yet seen Havelok to be all so +sure that it was indeed he. They longed to see him, and to know him for the +very son of Gunnar for themselves. +</p> + +<p> +Presently there were maybe twenty chiefs in the hall—men who had fought beside +Kirkeban, and men who had been boys with Havelok, and some who had known his +grandfather—and the jarl thought that it was time that they had the surety that +they needed, for time went on, and there was certainty that Hodulf must hear of +all this morning. One could not expect that no man would earn reward by warning +him. +</p> + +<p> +So Sigurd went softly to the place where Havelok lay in the little guest +chamber that opened out of the inner room that was the jarl’s own, and he slid +the boards that closed it apart gently and looked in to wake him. But instead +of doing that, he came back to the hall and beckoned the chiefs, and they rose +and followed him silently. And when they went Raven went also, without a word, +that he might be near his charge while these many strangers spoke with him. +</p> + +<p> +Now Sigurd stood at the spot where the little shifting of the sliding board +made it possible to see within the chamber, and one by one the chiefs came and +peered through the chink for a moment, and stood aside for the next. And it was +wondrous to see how each man went and looked with doubt or wonder or just +carelessly, and then turned away with a great light of joy on his face and a +new life in the whole turn and sway of the body. +</p> + +<p> +It was dark in the chamber, save for the dim spaces under the eaves that let in +the sweet air from the sea to the sleepers. But from somewhere aloft, where the +timbering of the upper walls toward the east had shrunk, so that there was a +little hole that faced the newly-risen sun, came the long shaft of a sunbeam +that pierced the darkness like a glorious spear, and lit on the mighty shoulder +of Havelok that lay bare of covering, and on the white hand of Goldberga that +was across it. And on the one they saw the crimson bent-armed cross that was +the mark of the line whence he and his father had sprung, and on the other +glowed and flashed the blood-red stone of the ring of Eleyn the queen. And +round that circle of sunshine was light enough for the chiefs to see those two +noble faces, and they were content. +</p> + +<p> +“Gunnar’s son,” said one old chief: “but were he only the son of Grim, for +those twain would I die.” +</p> + +<p> +So the warriors crept back to the hall silently as they had come; and now they +went out to their men and told them that all doubt had gone, and along the road +that led to Hodulf’s town the jarl sent mounted men to watch for his coming. +And always fresh men were pouring in, and among them went the chiefs who had +seen Havelok, and told them the news. +</p> + +<p> +Now it was not long before there was a gathering of all the chiefs in the hall +of Sigurd, that they might break their fast, and then they saw Havelok as he +led in the princess to meet them. He stood on the high place in his arms, and a +shout of greeting went up; and when it was over, Sigurd asked him to tell all +that had happened to him; and he did that in as few words as might be, for he +was no great speaker, though what he did say was always to the point, and left +little to be asked. +</p> + +<p> +And when he had ended, there rose up a grey-headed old chief, and said, “Give +this warrior the horn of Gunnar, that we may hear him wind it. I would not say +that unless I were sure that he was the right man to have it.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I stood beside Havelok, and while Sigurd went from the hall to some +treasure chamber to get this that had been asked for, I said to him, “Mind you +the day when we met Ragnar. and a call came into your dream? Wind that call +now; for, if I am not wrong, it will be welcome to those who knew your father.” +</p> + +<p> +“I mind the day but not the call. I have never remembered it since,” he said, +and I was sorry. +</p> + +<p> +Sigurd brought the horn, and it was a wondrous one, golden and heavy. It seemed +to be a hunting horn, not very long, and little curved, but from end to end it +was wrought with strange figures of men and beasts in rings that ran round it. +</p> + +<p> +“Have you seen this before?” asked Sigurd wistfully, and looking into Havelok’s +face as he gave it into his hand. +</p> + +<p> +One could feel that men waited his answer, and it came slowly. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, friend, I am sure that I have, but I cannot yet say when or where. I am +sure that it is not the first time that I have had it in my hand.” +</p> + +<p> +And as he said this, Havelok’s face flushed a little, and his brow wrinkled as +if he tried to bring back the things of that which he had thought his dream for +so long. +</p> + +<p> +It would seem that in the years there had grown up a tale that this was a magic +horn, which none but the very son of Gunnar could wind, and to the chiefs who +saw Havelok now for the first time this was a test to prove him. But all knew +that the words he spoke of it were proof enough, for a pretender would have +said plainly that it had been Gunnar’s, and that he knew it. I think that +Sigurd was wise in what he did next, for he set another horn in my brother’s +hand, and asked him the same question; and at this Havelok looked for a moment +and shook his head. +</p> + +<p> +“I have not seen that one before, nor one like it. I am sure that I have seen +this, or its fellow.” +</p> + +<p> +At that the faces that watched brightened, for there was no doubt in the way +that Havelok spoke; and then the old chief who had asked for the horn said, +“That—‘The horn of the king is sounding’—was the gathering word of the night +that has brought us here, and long have we waited for it. Let Havelok wind his +father’s horn, that we may hear it once again.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok set it to his lips, and at once the call that he had remembered +came back to him, and clear and sweet and full of longing its strange notes +rang under the arched roof, unfaltering until the last; and then over him came +the full remembrance of all that it had been to him, and he turned away from +the many eyes and sank on the high seat, and set his head in his arms on the +table, that men might not see that he needs must weep; and Goldberga stepped a +little before him, and set her hand on his, for I think that she knew the +loneliness that came on him. +</p> + +<p> +Yet he was not alone in his sorrow, for down in the hall were men to whom the +lost call brought back the memory of a bright young king riding to his home, +and calling the son whom he loved with the call that he had made for him alone; +and they saw the fair child running from the hall, and the mother following +more slowly with smiles of welcome; and they saw the grim courtmen, who looked +on and were glad; and they minded how they had lifted the boy to the war +saddle; and their eyes grew hot with tears also, and they had no need to be +ashamed. +</p> + +<p> +And as men stood motionless, with the last notes of the wild horn yet ringing +in their ears, there drifted a shadow across the days, and, lo! beside Havelok, +with his hand on his shoulder, stood the form of Gunnar the king for a long +moment, bright as any one of us who lived, in the morning sunlight, and his +face was full of joy and of hope and promise for the time to come. And then he +passed, but as he faded from us his hand was on the hand of Goldberga that +clasped her husband’s, as though he would wed them afresh there on the high +place of his friend’s hall. +</p> + +<p> +Now there went a sigh of wonder among the chiefs, and Havelok looked up as if +he followed the going of one whom he would not lose, and I know that he saw +Gunnar after he was unseen to us. +</p> + +<p> +“Surely,” he said, “surely that was my father who was here?” +</p> + +<p> +And Sigurd answered, “With your own call you called him, and he was here.” +</p> + +<p> +But now the last lurking doubt was gone, and there was no more delay, for the +chiefs crowded with shouts of joy to the high place, and they knelt to Havelok +and hailed him as king then and there; and so they led him to the great door of +the hall, and the mightiest of them raised him high on a wide shield before all +the freemen who waited on the green that is round the jarl’s house, and they +cried, “Skoal to Havelok the king!” +</p> + +<p> +And there was in answer the most stirring shout that a man may hear—the shout +of a host that hail the one for whom they are content to die. +</p> + +<p> +That was the first day of the reign of Havelok the king; and now there were two +kings in the land, and one was loved as few have been loved, and the other was +hated. And one was weak in men, as yet, while the other was strong. +</p> + +<p> +Now Sigurd bade all those who were present gather in solemn Thing, that they +might make Havelok king indeed; and that was a gathering of all the best in our +quarter of the land, so that all would uphold what they had done. And when they +were gathered in the great hall in due order, the doors were set wide open, and +outside the freemen who followed the chiefs sat in silence to see what they +might and hear. +</p> + +<p> +Then swore Havelok to keep the ancient laws and customs, and to do even-handed +justice to all men, and to be bound by all else that a good king should hold +by. Sometimes these oaths are not kept as well as they might be, but I was +certain that here was one who would keep them. +</p> + +<p> +Thereafter Sigurd brought forth a crown that he had had made hastily by his +craftsmen from two gold arm rings, and they set it on Havelok’s head, and +hailed him as king indeed; and one by one the chiefs came and swore all fealty +to him, beginning with Sigurd, and ending with a boy of some seventeen winters, +who looked at the king he bent before as though he was Thor himself. +</p> + +<p> +Then they would have had Havelok forth to the people at once; but he bade them +hearken for a moment, and said, taking Goldberga by the hand, “Were it not for +this my wife, I do not think that I had been here today, and without her I am +nothing. Now I am king by your word, and I think that I might bid you take her +as queen. But I had rather that she was made queen by your word also, that +whither I live or fall in the strife that is to come, you may fight for her.” +</p> + +<p> +At that there was a murmur of praise, and all agreed that she should be crowned +at once. So Havelok set the crown on her head while the chiefs in one voice +swore to uphold her through good and ill, as though she were Havelok himself. +</p> + +<p> +Then said Havelok, “Now have you taken her for queen for her own sake, and I +will tell you a thing that has not been heard here as yet. On this throne sits +the queen of two lands, and there shall come a day when you and I shall set +your lady on that other throne which is hers by right. King’s daughter she is, +for Ethelwald of the East Angles was her father, and out of her right has she +been kept by Alsi of Lindsey, her evil kinsman.” +</p> + +<p> +At that men were glad, for great is the magic of kingly descent. And thereupon +that old warrior who had bidden Havelok sound the horn said, “We have heard of +Ethelwald the good king, and of this Alsi moreover, and we know men who have +seen both, and also Orwenna, the mother of our own queen here. I followed your +father across the seas in the old days, and I seem to hear his voice again as +you speak to us. And I saw him—ay, I saw him yonder even now, and I am content. +When the time comes that for the sake of Goldberga you will gather a host and +cross the ‘swan’s path,’ I will not hold back, if you will have me.” +</p> + +<p> +There was spoken the mind of all that company, and they were not backward to +say so. For in the heart of the Dane is ever the love of the sea, and of the +clash of arms on a far-off strand that comes after battle with wind and wave. +</p> + +<p> +Very bravely did Goldberga thank the chiefs for their love to her husband and +herself in a few words that were all that were needed to bind the hearers to +her, so well and truly were they chosen. And she said that if the Anglian land +was to be won it was for Havelok and not for herself altogether, and she added, +“Here we have spoken as if already Hodulf was overthrown, and it is good that +we are in such brave heart. Yet this has been foretold to me, and I am sure +that there will be no mishap.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Sigurd said, “What gift do we give our queen, now that she has come among +us?” +</p> + +<p> +But Goldberga replied, “If it is the custom that one shall be given, I will +mind you of the promise hereafter, when Anglia is won, and you and I are +Havelok’s upholders on that throne. There is one thing that I will ask then, +that a wrong may be righted.” +</p> + +<p> +“Nay, but we will give you some gift now, and then you shall ask what you will +also.” +</p> + +<p> +“You have given me more than I dared hope,” she said, “even the brave hearts +and hands that have hailed us here. I can ask no more. Only promise to give me +one boon when I need it, and I am happy.” +</p> + +<p> +Then they said, “What you will, and when you will, Goldberga, the queen. There +is naught that you will ask amiss.” +</p> + +<p> +Now they showed Havelok to the warriors as crowned king, and I need not tell +how he was greeted. And after that we all went back into the hall to speak of +the way in which we were to meet Hodulf. +</p> + +<p> +Havelok would have a message sent to him, bidding him give up the land in +peace. +</p> + +<p> +“It may be that thus we shall save the sadness of fighting our own people, +though, indeed, they love the playground of Hodulf. He is an outlander, and +perhaps he may think well to make terms with us.” +</p> + +<p> +Some said that it was of no use, but then Havelok answered that even so it was +good to send a challenge to him. +</p> + +<p> +“For the sake of peace we will do this, though I would rather meet him in open +fight, for I have my father to avenge.” +</p> + +<p> +Now I rose up and said, “Let me go and speak with him, taking Withelm as my +counsellor. For I know all the story, and that will make him sure that he has +the right man to fight against. I will speak with him in open hall, and more +than he shall learn how he thought to slay Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +All thought that this was good, and I was to go at once. It was but a few +hours’ ride, as has been said, to his town, and the matter was as well done +with. +</p> + +<p> +So they gave me a guard of twenty of the jarl’s courtmen, and in half an hour I +was riding northward on my errand. And to say the truth I did not know if it +was certain that I should come back, for Hodulf was hardly to be trusted. +</p> + +<p> +I did wait to break my fast, and that was all, for I had no mind to spend the +night on the road back from the talk that I should have had; but though I +wasted so little time, the people were already beginning to prepare for +rejoicing in their own way with games of all sorts and with feasting in the +open. I saw, as we rode down the street, the piles of firewood that were to +roast oxen whole, and near them were the butts that held ale for all comers. +There were men who set up the marks for the archers, and others who staked out +the rings for the wrestling and sword play. And as we left the town we met two +men who led a great brown bear by a ring in his nose, for the baiting. I was +sorry for the poor beast, but the men called him “Hodulf,” already, and I +thought that a good sign in its way. +</p> + +<p> +Another good sign, and that one which could not be mistaken, was to see the +warriors coming in by twos and threes as the news reached them. They were +dotted along the roads from all quarters, and across the heaths we saw the +flash of the arms of more. +</p> + +<p> +And ever as they met us they hailed us with, “What cheer, comrades? Is the news +true? Is Havelok come to his own?” and the like, and they would hurry on, +rejoicing in the answer that they had. +</p> + +<p> +But I will say that presently, when we passed a stretch of wild moor where we +saw no man, the same was going on towards the town of Hodulf; for if the news +came to a village, some would be for the king that was, and other and older men +for the king that might be. Yet all asked that question; and more than once, +when they heard the reply, there would be a halt and a talk, and then the men +would turn and cast in their lot with the son of Gunnar, hastening to him with +more eager steps than had taken them to Hodulf. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap21">CHAPTER XXI.<br/> +THE TOKEN OF SACK AND ANCHOR.</a></h2> + +<p> +It seemed only the other day that I had passed over the well-known ways, and I +showed Withelm the hollow where Grim had met with the king and taken his +precious burden from him. Then we passed along the wild shore, and the linnets +were singing and the whinchats were calling as ever, and the old mounds of the +heroes of the bygone were awesome to me now as long ago, when I looked at them +standing lonesome along the shore with only the wash of the waves to disturb +them. And so we came to the town at high noon, and already there was the bustle +of a gathering host in the place, for the news had fled before us. +</p> + +<p> +They had built a new and greater hall in place of that which had been burned; +and there sat Hodulf with his chiefs, wondering and planning, and maybe waiting +for more certain news of what had happened. Not long would they wait for that +now. +</p> + +<p> +We rode to the door, and one came to meet us with words of welcome, thinking +that we were men who came to the levy that was gathering; but his words stayed +when I asked to be taken to the presence of Hodulf, as I came with a message +from Havelok Gunnarsson the king. +</p> + +<p> +The man, chamberlain or steward, or whatever he was, stared at me, and said in +a low voice, “It is true then?” +</p> + +<p> +“True as I am Radbard Grimsson, who helped Havelok to fly from hence.” +</p> + +<p> +“Unwelcome will you be, for Hodulf is in no good mood,” the man said. “I hardly +think it safe for you to trust yourself with him.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said I, “open the door of the hall, and I will go in with my men, and +see what he says.” +</p> + +<p> +“Well, that will be bad for me, but I have a mind to see Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +So I told Withelm to come at my side, and bade half the courtmen follow us +closely, and when they were inside to see that the door was not barred after us +on any pretence. The rest would bide with the horses outside. +</p> + +<p> +Then we loosed the peace strings of our weapons, and in we went, quietly and in +order; and the chiefs turned to look at us, thinking us more of themselves. +Hodulf sat on his place on the dais, and there were thirty-one others with him, +sitting on the benches that were set along the walls. Withelm counted them. +</p> + +<p> +Then the door was closed, and the man with whom I had spoken set his back +against it, but it was not barred; and I went forward to the steps of the high +place, and stood before Hodulf. +</p> + +<p> +“Well, what now?” he said, seeing that I was a stranger. +</p> + +<p> +“First of all, I ask for safe conduct from this hall as a messenger from king +to king.” +</p> + +<p> +“That you have, of course,” he answered. “What is your message?” +</p> + +<p> +It did not seem that he thought of Havelok at all, but rather that I came from +some king to whom he had sent. There were two living not so far off. I thought +that there was no good in beating about the bush, for such an errand as mine +had better he told boldly. So I spoke out for all to hear. +</p> + +<p> +“This is the word of Havelok, son of Gunnar the king, to Hodulf of Norway, who +sits in his place. Home he has come to take his own, and now he would tell you +that the time has come that he is able to rule the kingdom for himself.” +</p> + +<p> +“And what if he has?” said Hodulf, without the least change of face, as if he +had been expecting this, and nothing more or less. +</p> + +<p> +But if he was quiet, the chiefs had heard my words in a very different way. +Some had leaped up, and others bent forward, to hear the answer to my words the +better. I heard one or two laugh; but there were some on whose faces seemed to +be written doubt and anxiety. I think that some would have spoken, for Hodulf +held up his hand for silence, and looked to me for answer. +</p> + +<p> +“It will be well for you to give up the throne to him, making such terms as you +may,” I said. +</p> + +<p> +“That is a fair offer,” said Hodulf, quite unmoved, to all seeming, but looking +at me in a way that told me how his anger was held back by main force, as it +were; “but how am I to know that this one who sends so bold a message is the +real Havelok? I am not a fool that I should give up my throne to the first who +asks it. Doubtless you bring some token that you come from the very son of +Gunnar.” +</p> + +<p> +“It is right that you should ask one, and also that you should have one that +there can be no mistaking,” I said. “This is it. By the token of the sack and +the anchor I bid you know that Havelok sends me to you.” +</p> + +<p> +At that the face of Hodulf became ashy grey beneath the tan of wind and sea, +and I saw that his hand clutched the hilt of his sword so that the knuckles of +his fingers grew white. He had never thought to hear of that deed again, and he +knew that he had to deal with the one whom he had thought dead. Some of the +young chiefs in the hall laughed at that token, but he flashed a glance at them +which stayed the laugh on their lips. +</p> + +<p> +“I know not what you mean,” he said, altogether staggered. +</p> + +<p> +“It is right,” I said, “that if the token is not plain I should make it so. It +is but fair also to the chiefs who are here.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he stayed me. True it is that old sin makes new shame. +</p> + +<p> +“I will take it as enough,” he said hastily. “I mind some old saying of the +kind. Ay, that is it—a hidden king and a voyage across the sea. It is enough.” +</p> + +<p> +“Not enough,” said a chief in the hall close to the high seat. “Let this +warrior say what he means plainly.” +</p> + +<p> +There were many who agreed to this, and I did not wait for Hodulf any longer. I +told them who I was, and then showed them why that token was to be held enough +for any man; and as I spoke, there were black looks toward the high seat among +the older men. As for Hodulf, he sat with a forced smile, and seemed to listen +indulgently, as to a well-made tale. +</p> + +<p> +And after that the matter was out of my hands, for the same chief who had asked +for the tale came and stood by my side, and he faced Hodulf and spoke. +</p> + +<p> +“For twelve years have I served you as king, and now I know that I have wasted +the faith I gave you. What became of the sisters of Havelok? Answer me that, +Hodulf, or I will go and ask their brother concerning whom you have lied to +me.” +</p> + +<p> +“Go and ask him,” answered Hodulf, biting his lips; “go and hear more lies. Who +can know the son of Gunnar when he sees him?” +</p> + +<p> +“That is answered out of your own mouth,” said the chief. “Is Sigurd a fool +that he should hail the first man who asks him to do so?” +</p> + +<p> +And from beside me Withelm answered also, “Maybe it is a pity that Griffin of +Wales was slain last night in trying to kill Havelok. He knew him, and I have +heard that he came here to warn Hodulf that his time was come.” +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf’s face grew whiter when he heard that; but it was what he needed, as +some sort of excuse to let loose his passion. +</p> + +<p> +White and shaking with wrath and fear, he rose up and he cried, “Murdered is +Griffin! Ho, warriors, let not these go forth!” +</p> + +<p> +Whereon the old chief lifted his voice also, “Ho, Gunnar’s men! Ho, men who +love the old line! To Grim’s son, ahoy!” +</p> + +<p> +And he drew his sword, snapping the thongs that had bound it to the sheath, so +manfully tugged he at them in his wrath, and there was a rush of men to us, and +another to Hodulf. +</p> + +<p> +Now I think that we might have slain him there, and after that have been slain +ourselves, for the odds were against us, even though I had the courtmen; but +that was Havelok’s deed to do, for the sake of father and sisters to be +avenged, and so we only cut our way out of the hall to the door, which my men +threw open at once. There were two of Hodulf’s men hurt only, for the most of +them had run to the high place, and few were between us and our going. So we +took five chiefs and their followers back with us, and that was worth the +errand. +</p> + +<p> +We thought that it would not be long now before Hodulf was on us; but the days +passed, and there was no news of him, and all the while we grew stronger. I do +not know if the same could be said of him, and it is doubtful if time made much +difference to his forces. Those who followed him were the men who owed all to +him, either as men raised to some sort of power when he first came, or else +strangers whom he had brought in with him. Some of the younger chiefs of the +old families held by him also, for they had known no other, and then there were +old feuds with Gunnar that held back some from us; but these few took part with +neither side. +</p> + +<p> +So before a week was out we had a matter of six thousand men in and about the +town; and it seemed that, with so good a force, it was as well to march on +Hodulf as to wait for him. And that was good hearing for us all, for there was +not a man who did not long to be up and doing, though to smite a blow for +Havelok should be the last deed that he might do. +</p> + +<p> +They made me captain of the courtmen who were Havelok’s own, maybe because I +had served with Alsi, and Withelm was captain of Goldberga’s own guard. High +honour was that for the sons of Grim, for there was not one in either of these +companies but was of high birth; but then we were Havelok’s brothers, and all +seemed well content to serve under us. I wanted Raven to be in my place, but he +said that he was no warrior on shore. +</p> + +<p> +“Just now I am Havelok’s watchdog, to be at his heels always. Presently, if he +likes to give me a ship when we sail to England, that will suit me.” +</p> + +<p> +So Havelok made him his standard bearer; and as that would keep him at the +king’s side in the thickest fight, he was well pleased. Goldberga wrought the +standard that he bore, with the help of Sigurd’s wife, and on it was the figure +of Grim, sword and shield in hand, but with his helm at his feet, as showing +that he had laid it by; and on either side of him stood Havelok and his wife, +each with a crown above their heads, as though they waited for the coming time +when they should be set there firmly by the bearing forward of this banner. +Havelok bore his axe, holding out the ring to Goldberga with the other hand, +while she had her sceptre in the left, and stretched the right hand to her +husband. There were runes that told the names of these three, for that is +needful in such work, as it passes the skill of woman to make a good likeness, +nor do I think it would be lucky to do so if it could be compassed. Wondrous +was the banner with gold and bright colours, and it was hung from a gilded +spear, ashen hafted, and long, that it might be seen afar in battle. +</p> + +<p> +Now on the day when Havelok set his men in order for the march on Hodulf word +came that he was coming at last. It is likely that he knew we were on the point +of marching, and would choose his own ground on which to wait for us. So we +went to certain battle, as it seemed, and none were sorry for that. So in the +bright sunshine of a cloudless morning Havelok and Goldberga rode down the line +of the men, who would fight to the death for them, and those two were good to +look on. Day and night Sigurd’s weapon smiths had wrought to make a mail shirt +that should be worthy of a king, and I thought that they had wrought well. They +had set a crown round the helm that they made for him, and Sigurd had given him +a sword that had been his father’s at one time, golden hilted, and with runes +on its blue blade. But Havelok would not part with the axe that Grim had given +him, plain as it was, and that was his chosen weapon. +</p> + +<p> +But for once I think that men looked more at her who rode at Havelok’s side +than at him, goodly and kingly as he was in the war gear. For Goldberga had on +a silver coat of chain mail, and a little gold circlet was round the silver +helm that she wore, while at her saddle bow was an axe, on which were runes +written in gold, and a sword light enough for her hand was in a gem-studded +baldric from her shoulder. There was a chief who had given her these, and it +was said that they had first of all belonged to one who had fought as a shield +maiden at the great battle of Dunheidi, by the side of Hervoer, the sister of +the mighty hero Angantyr. His forefather had won them at that time, and now +they were worn by one who was surely like the Valkyries, for no fairer or more +wondrous to look on in war gear could they be than our English queen. +</p> + +<p> +She would have gone even into the battle with Havelok, but that neither he nor +we would suffer. She was to bide here in the town until we came back in triumph +or defeat; and as men looked on her, they grew strong, that no tears might be +for those bright eyes. +</p> + +<p> +Now I left them before the march began, for I and the courtmen were to go +forward and see where the foe was posted, and so bring word again. And we went +some five miles before we saw the first sign of them. Then on a rise in the +wild heath waited a few horsemen, who watched us for a little while, and then +rode away from us and beyond it. We followed them, and when we came to where +they had been, we saw that they had fallen back on a company of about the same +strength as ours, save that there were more horsemen. I was the only mounted +man of my little force, and that rather to save my strength than because I +liked riding. I should certainly fight on foot, as would Havelok himself, in +the old way. It is not good to trust to the four feet of a horse when one means +business. +</p> + +<p> +We bided where we were, waiting to see what these men did, and soon beyond them +grew the long cloud of dust starred with shifting sparks that told us that the +host of Hodulf was on foot and advancing. It seemed to me that here we had a +good place to meet it, for the land went down in a long slope that was in our +favour, and therefore I set a man on my horse, and sent him back with all speed +to Havelok to bid him hasten. Our host was not so far behind me, and I could +see both from this hill. We had full time to take position here before Hodulf’s +army was in reach. +</p> + +<p> +Now it seemed that the foemen would see what they could also, and they began to +move toward us. It was plain that we should have a small fight on our own +account directly, for I did not mean to let them take our place. We moved, +therefore, toward them, and at that the half-dozen horsemen made for us at a +trot. Then I saw that their leader was Hodulf himself. +</p> + +<p> +We were in a track that led across the hill, and here on the slope it was worn +deep with ages of traffic between the two towns, and on either side the heather +grew thick and high, so that the horsemen could not get round us. So Hodulf +rode forward to where we barred the way, and told me to stand aside. +</p> + +<p> +“What next?” I asked. “I may as well bid you go back, for I came here to stop +you.” +</p> + +<p> +“Come over to me, and leave this half-crowned kinglet of yours. It shall be +worth your while.” +</p> + +<p> +“Hard up for men must you be, Hodulf,” said one of my courtmen, laughing. +</p> + +<p> +At that he made a sign to his followers, for they came on us at the gallop, +with levelled spears. We closed up, and hewed the spear points off, and then +dealt with the horses and men who foundered among us, and they struggled back, +leaving three men and four horses in the roadway. It was bravely done, too, for +there were only eight of them, and they did us no harm beyond a bruise or two. +I wished that we had taken or slain Hodulf, however, for that might have made +things easier in the end. +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf got back to his courtmen, and now they came on. At that moment over the +hill behind us rode Havelok and Raven, and saw at once what was on hand. They +had ridden on, but the host was hard after them. +</p> + +<p> +“Send a man to bid the host halt,” Havelok said to me, “for we can end the +matter here. Now shall I be hand to hand with Hodulf, even as I would wish.” +</p> + +<p> +I sent a man back as he bade me, and he stayed the host half a mile beyond the +hill, where they were not seen. Hodulf’s army was yet two miles away across the +heath, and none had gone back to hasten it. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok went forward, holding up his hand in token of parley, and his enemy +rode from his men to meet him. +</p> + +<p> +“There is much between us, Hodulf,” Havelok said, “and we have been together +along this road before. Yet for the sake of the men who follow us it may be +that we can make peace.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is for me to say,” answered Hodulf, “for you have invaded my land, and +are the peace breaker.” +</p> + +<p> +“I might mind you of a blood feud between us two,” said Havelok, “but that is +not the business of the host. For the sake of the land I will say this. Give up +the throne that you have held for me, and you shall go hence with what treasure +you have gathered, taking your Norsemen with you. There will be no shame in +doing that, for I am able now to hold the land for myself.” +</p> + +<p> +Hodulf laughed a short laugh. +</p> + +<p> +“Fine talk that for the son of Grim the thrall, who drowned Havelok for me! +‘Nidring’ should I be if I gave up to you.” +</p> + +<p> +“If things must go in that way, we will settle the matter here and now. Will +you that we fight hand to hand while our men look on, or shall we go back to +them and charge? I like the first plan best myself, as I would avenge my father +and sisters, and also that insult of the way in which we passed this road +together twelve years ago.” +</p> + +<p> +So said Havelok, and his words fell like ice from his lips, and he was very +still as he spoke, though the red flush crept into his cheek and his brows +lowered. +</p> + +<p> +And Hodulf did not answer at once. He looked at the towering young warrior +before him, and maybe into his mind there crept the thought of the children +whom he had slain, whom this one would avenge. Well he knew that the true +Havelok was speaking with him, though he would not own it, and branded my +father with the name of thrall for the sake of insult to his foster son. +</p> + +<p> +At last he said, “We will go back to the men, for you have advantage in that +bulk of yours.” +</p> + +<p> +“As you will,” answered Havelok. “Twelve years ago that was on your side.” +</p> + +<p> +He reined round at once, and touched his horse with the spur without another +glance at his enemy. And then we shouted, and Raven spurred forward with a +great oath, for Hodulf plucked his sword from the scabbard, and with a new +treachery in his heart, rode after our brother and was almost on him. The shout +was just in time, for Havelok turned in his saddle as the blow was falling. +</p> + +<p> +Quick as light, he took it on the shaft of the spear he carried, and turned it, +wheeling his horse short round at the same time. Lindsey training was there in +that horsemanship of his. Hodulf’s horse shot past as the blow failed, and then +Raven seemed to be the next man to be dealt with. +</p> + +<p> +But Havelok called to him to stand aside, for this was his own fight; and at +that Hodulf had his horse in hand again, and was ready to meet his foe fairly. +</p> + +<p> +And now Havelok had cast aside the spear, and taken the axe from the saddle +bow; and these two met, unshielded, for neither had time to unsling the round +buckler from his shoulder. +</p> + +<p> +It was no long fight, for now Hodulf’s men were coming up, and there need be no +more thought of aught but ending one who was ready to smite a foul blow before +us all shamelessly. Havelok spurred his horse, and the two met and closed for +one moment. Then down went the Norseman with cleft helm, and the old wrongs +were avenged, and there was but one king in the land. +</p> + +<p> +Then Hodulf’s men were on Havelok, but not before Raven was at his back, and +over Hodulf there was a struggle in which Havelok was in peril for a short time +before we closed round him. Well fought the courtmen of the fallen king, and +well fought my men, and we bore them back, fighting every foot of ground, until +there were only five of them left, and these five yielded in all honour, being +outnumbered. Yet ours was a smaller band by half ere there was an end. +</p> + +<p> +It had not lasted long, and still the host of Hodulf was so far off that they +knew not so much as that there was any fighting. Then we went to the hilltop, +and set the banner there, and our line came on and halted along the crest. +</p> + +<p> +One hardly need say what wonder and rejoicing there was when it was known how +Hodulf had met his end, and Sigurd and other chiefs went to where we had +fought, and looked on him. And one took the helm, which had round it the stolen +crown, and gave it to Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +“Set it on the standard,” he said, “for we may need that it shall be shown +presently. As for Hodulf, bear him aside out of the path of the host, that we +may lay him in mound when all is ended.” +</p> + +<p> +One cried that he did not deserve honour of any kind, and there were some who +agreed to that openly. I will not say that I was not one of them, for I had +seen the foul play, and heard the insult to Grim, my father. +</p> + +<p> +But Havelok answered gravely, “He has been a king, and I have not heard that he +was altogether a bad one. All else was between him and me, and that is paid for +by his death. Think only of the twelve years in which you have owned him as +lord, and then you will know that it is right that he should be given the last +honours. You had no feud as had I.” +</p> + +<p> +Then they did as he bade them, and that gladly, for the words were king-like, +and of good omen for the days to come. I saw Sigurd and the older chiefs glance +at each other, and it was plain that they were well pleased. +</p> + +<p> +Now the host came on, and it was greater than ours; but when there was no sign +of its leader the march wavered, and at last halted altogether. Whereon some +chiefs rode to speak to us, and Havelok met them with his leaders. He had to +speak first, for they could not well ask where Hodulf was. The helm was a token +that told them much. +</p> + +<p> +“I met your king even now,” he said, “and I offered him peace and honourable +return to Norway with his property if he would give up the throne that is mine +by right. Maybe I was wrong in thinking that he might do so, but he refused. +There were certain matters between us two, besides that of the crown, which +needed settling; and therefore, after that, I challenged him to fight on these +points, that being needful before they were done with. So we fought, and our +feud was ended. Hodulf is dead, and his courtmen would not live after him while +there was a chance of avenging his fall. That was before the host came up. Now +I offer peace and friendship to all, and I can blame none who have held to the +king who has fallen. It was not to be expected that all would own me at once. +Only those Norsemen who came with Hodulf or have come hither since must leave +the land, and they shall go in honour, taking their goods with them. Their time +is up; that is all.” +</p> + +<p> +It was a long speech for Havelok, but in it was all that could be said. Long +and closely did the chiefs look at him as he spoke, for none of them had seen +him before. His words were not idly to be set aside either, and they spoke +together in a low voice when he had ended. +</p> + +<p> +“This is a matter for the whole host to settle,” one said at last. “We will +speak to them, and give you an answer shortly.” +</p> + +<p> +“Take one of Hodulf’s courtmen with you, that he may tell all of the fight,” +Havelok said: “he need not come back.” +</p> + +<p> +I gave the man his arms again, for he might as well have them if he stayed. +</p> + +<p> +“Thanks, lord,” he said. “Here is one who will tell the truth for Havelok.” +</p> + +<p> +Then our host sat down, and we watched the foemen as the news came to them. We +could not hear, of course, for they were a quarter of a mile away, but if any +tumult rose we should be warned in time. They were very still, however. There +was a long talk, and then one chief came back to us. +</p> + +<p> +“I am going to ask a strange thing,” he said, “but the men wish to see Havelok +face to face.” +</p> + +<p> +Now Sigurd said that this was too great a risk, and even Withelm agreed with +him. +</p> + +<p> +But Havelok answered, “The men are my own men, but they are not sure that I am +the right king. It is plain that I am like my father, and therefore it is safe +for me to go.” +</p> + +<p> +“That,” said the chief, “is what we told them, and what they wish to see.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said Havelok, “I will come. Bid your men sit down, and bid the horsemen +dismount, and I will ride to them with five others. Then can be no fear on +either side.” +</p> + +<p> +“That will do well,” said Sigurd; and the chief went back, and at once the host +sat down. +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok rode to them, and with him went we three and Sigurd and Biorn. +</p> + +<p> +There was a murmur of wonder as he came, and it grew louder as he unhelmed and +stayed before them. +</p> + +<p> +And then one shouted, “Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson!” and at once the shout was +taken up along the line. And that shout grew until the chiefs joined in it, for +it was the voice of the host, which cannot be gainsaid; and without more delay, +one by one the leaders pressed forward and knelt on one knee to their king, and +did homage to him. Only the Norsemen held back; and presently, when we were +talking to the Danish chiefs in all friendly wise, they drew apart with their +men, and formed up into a close-ranked body that looked dangerous. +</p> + +<p> +“Surely they do not mean to fight!” said Withelm. +</p> + +<p> +Then one of them shouted that he must speak to the king, and that seemed as if +they owned him at least, so Havelok went to them. +</p> + +<p> +“You have heard my terms,” he said, “and I think that they are all that you +could ask. What is amiss?” +</p> + +<p> +“Your terms are good enough,” the speaker said, “and we know that our time is +come. But we must have surety that the people will not fall on us, for we are +flying, as it were. And we want the body of our king. We would not have him +buried any wise, as if he was a thrall.” +</p> + +<p> +“He shall be given to you, and as for the rest none shall harm you. Moreover, +for that saying about your king I will add this: that if there are any of you +who hold lands to which there is no Danish heir, he shall take service with me +if he will, and so keep them.” +</p> + +<p> +So there was no man in all the host who was not content; and that was the +second king-making of Havelok, as it were, for now there was no man against +him. The hosts were disbanded then and there, and we went that day to Hodulf’s +town, and took possession of all that had been in his hands. Then was rejoicing +over all the land, for a king of the old line was on the throne once more, and +his way was full of promise. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap22">CHAPTER XXII.<br/> +KING ALSI’S WELCOME.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now there was one thing that was in the minds of all of us, and that was the +winning of Goldberga’s kingdom for her; but that was a matter which was not to +be thought of yet for a long while. Two years were we in Denmark, and well +loved was Havelok by all, whether one speaks of the other kings who owned him +as Gunnar’s heir at once, or the people over whom he and Goldberga reigned. But +we sent messages to Arngeir and to Ragnar to say that all was well, and we +heard from them in time how Alsi feared what was to come, and had rather make +friends with the Anglians than offend them. So he had not given out anything +that was against the princess, but had told all how she had wedded the heir of +Denmark, and that she had given up her land to himself, and followed her +husband across the sea. It was not hard for him to feign gladness in her +well-doing; and Berthun counselled Ragnar to let things be thus, and yet +prepare for her return. +</p> + +<p> +In my own heart was the wish to go back to England always, for there was my +home; and I found that it was the same with my brothers, for there is that in +the English land which makes all who touch it love it. And there was the mound +that held my father, and there were the folk among whom we had been brought up +in the town that we had made; and I longed to see once more the green marshes +and the grey wolds of Lindsey, and the brown waves of the wide Humber rolling +shorewards, line after line. I tired of the heaths and forests and peat mosses +of this land of my birth. And if that was so to me, it was a yet deeper longing +in the hearts of the brothers who hardly remembered this place; and after a +while we spoke of it more often. +</p> + +<p> +I do not know if we said much to others, but at last the younger chiefs began +to wonder when the promised time when they should cross the “swan’s path” for +Goldberga should come. Maybe they tired of the long peace, as a Dane will. But +when that talk began, Withelm knew that things were ripe, and he told Havelok. +That was in the third spring of Havelok’s kingship, when it grew near to the +time when men fit out their ships. +</p> + +<p> +“This is what I have looked for,” he said; “and now we will delay no longer, +for here am I king indeed, and there is none who will rise against me. +Wonderful it is that men have hailed me thus. And now I will tell you, brother, +that I long for England. If I might take my friends with me, I do not think +that I should care if I never came here again. It is not my home; and here my +Goldberga is not altogether happy, well as the folk love her.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereafter he called a great Thing<a href="#fn12" +name="fnref12"><sup>[12]</sup></a> of all the freemen in the land, and set the +matter plainly before them, asking if they minded the words he spoke when they +crowned the queen, and if they were still ready to follow him to the winning of +her crown beyond the sea. +</p> + +<p> +There was no doubt what the answer would be; and it was said at once that the +sooner the ships were got ready the better. +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said Havelok, “who shall mind this land while I am away? It may be long +ere I come back.” +</p> + +<p> +Now there was a cry that I should be king while Havelok was away, forsooth! and +a poor hand I should have made at the business. But I said that it was +foolishness, and that, moreover, I would go with Havelok. And when they said +that this was modesty on my part, I answered that I had seen several kings, and +that there was but one who was worth thinking of, and that was my brother; +therefore, I would go on serving him where I could see him. +</p> + +<p> +“This is what Grim, my father, said to me long ago,” I said—“I was to mind the +old saying, ‘Bare is back without brother behind it;’ and, therefore, I must +see Havelok safe through this.” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, brother,” says Havelok, laughing, “if that saying must be remembered—and +I at least know it is true—it would make for leaving you behind me here to see +all fair when my back was turned.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he saw that I was grieved, for I thought for the moment that he would bid +me to stay, and so I should have to do so; but he took my part. +</p> + +<p> +“I cannot be without my brothers,” he said. “If I had any word in the +matter—which mainly concerns the folk to be ruled, as it seems to me (for I do +not know of any man who would not uphold me)—I should say that Sigurd the jarl +was the right man, for all know that he is a good ruler, nor will it be any new +thing to submit to him.” +</p> + +<p> +That pleased all, and the end of it was that Sigurd was chosen to hold the land +for Havelok. +</p> + +<p> +Then Sigurd sat on the steps of the high place at Havelok’s feet, and the king +said, “I have no need to tell any man here who this is, and why I think him +worthy of the highest honour, for all know him and his worth as well as I. +Mainly by him was the thought of my return kept in the minds of men, so that +when the time came all were ready to hail me, as you have done. Therefore, as +by him I am king, so I make him king also for me. He shall rule all the land +while I am away, and to him shall all men account as to me. And because it is +right that his kingship should be certain, I give him all his jarldom as a +kingdom from henceforth, only subject to me and my heirs as overlord. King +therefore he is, and none can say that you are ruled by naught but a jarl.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Havelok girt on the new king’s sword, and set his own crowned helm on his +head for a moment; and all the Thing hailed him gladly, for he was the right +man without doubt. +</p> + +<p> +Then Sigurd did homage for his new honour; and after that he rose up, and grew +red and uneasy, as if there was somewhat that he wished to say, and was half +afraid to do so. +</p> + +<p> +Thereat some friend in the hall said, “You take your kingship worse than did +Radbard himself, as it seems. What is amiss?” +</p> + +<p> +“Why, I wanted to go on the Viking path with Havelok, and now it seems that I +cannot.” +</p> + +<p> +Then one shouted, “I never heard of a land going wrong while its king was away +risking his life to get property for his men. There is no man here who is going +to rise against either you or Havelok. And it is only to send a message to our +great overlord to say what we are about, and he will see that the land is in +peace. Nor do I think that any king would harry Havelok’s land, for he is well +loved by all his peers.” +</p> + +<p> +Wherefore it seemed that Sigurd must go also, and we had to set Biorn as head +man while Sigurd was away; but that would only be for a month or two. So all +things were ordered well, and in a month we set sail with twenty ships, and in +them a matter of fifteen hundred men. +</p> + +<p> +At first we thought that we would make for Grimsby; but then it seemed best to +land elsewhere, and more to the south, for we would have messages sent at once +to Ragnar to call East Anglia to Havelok’s banner, and Alsi would have less +chance of cutting us off from him. So we sailed to Saltfleet haven, which lies +some twenty-five miles southward from Grimsby. Raven piloted us in safely, and +there were none to hinder our landing. The town was empty, indeed, when the +ships came into the haven, for all had fled in haste, except a few thralls, for +fear of the Vikings. +</p> + +<p> +Yet when we sent these thralls to say that Goldberga had come for her own, the +people came back and made us welcome, for her story was in every mouth; and +after that we fared well in Saltfleet, and men began to gather to us. +</p> + +<p> +We sent to Arngeir and to Ragnar at once, and next day the Grimsby folk were +with us, but long before any word could come to Norwich, Alsi had set about +gathering a host against us. +</p> + +<p> +But we had not come to fight him for Lindsey, and our errand was to bid him +give up her own rights to Goldberga. One must be ready with the strong hand if +one expects to find justice from such a man; and Havelok had thought it +possible that if we came here first we should bring him to reason at once, +whereas if we went to Norfolk there would be fighting with all the host of the +Lindsey kingdom before long; while if he did fight here we might save +Goldberga’s land from that trouble, and maybe have fewer to deal with. +</p> + +<p> +So a message was to be sent to Alsi at once, bidding him know that Goldberga +had come to ask for her rights, and that he might give them to her in all +honour. Arngeir was to take this, for it did not seem right that a Dane should +do so, and he was one who would be listened to. I was to go with him, with my +courtmen as guard; and we rode to Lincoln on the fourth day after our coming to +Saltfleet. Good it was to ride over the old land again, and I thought that it +had never looked more fair with the ripening harvest, for when last I had seen +it there was none. The track of the famine was yet on all the villages, for +fewer folk were in them than in the days before the pestilence and the dearth, +but these had enough and to spare. +</p> + +<p> +And when these poor folk heard from us that Curan and his princess had come +again for what was hers, they took rusty weapons and flint-tipped arrows and +stone hammers from the hiding places in the thatch of their hovels, and went +across the marshlands to where the little hill of Saltfleet stands above its +haven, that they might help the one whom they had loved as a fisher lad to +become a mighty king. +</p> + +<p> +So we came to Lincoln, and already there was a gathering of thanes and their +men in the town, and they knew on what errand we had come well enough. But they +were courteous, and we were given quarters in the town at once, that we might +see Alsi with the first light in the morning. +</p> + +<p> +I will not say that we had a quiet night there, for we did not trust Alsi; but +we had no need to fear. In the morning Eglaf came to bid us to the palace to +speak with the king. +</p> + +<p> +“This is about what I expected, when I heard of the mistake that our king had +made,” he said, “and so far you are in luck. It is not everyone who is a fisher +one day and captain of the courtmen next, as one might say. I like the look of +your men, and I am going to take some of the credit of that to myself, for a +man has to learn before he can command.” +</p> + +<p> +“I will not deny your share in the matter,” I answered, laughing, “for had it +not been for my time with you I had been at sea altogether. Now, shall we have +to fight you?” +</p> + +<p> +He shrugged his broad shoulders. +</p> + +<p> +“Who knows what is in the mind of our king? I do not, and you know enough of +him by this time to be certain that one cannot guess. He may be all smiles and +rejoicing that his dear niece has come back safely, or just the other way. He +has been very careful how he has dealt with the Norfolk thanes of late, and +what that means I do not know.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he asked what had become of Griffin, and I told him. I do not think that +he was surprised, for some word of the matter had reached here by the news that +chapmen bring from all parts. +</p> + +<p> +Now there was no more time for talk, for we came to the hall; and we went in, +Arngeir leading, and the rest of us following two by two. The hall was pretty +full of thanes and their men, and it was just as I had last seen it. Alsi sat +alone on his high seat, and there was no man with him on the dais. I thought +that he looked thinner and anxious. +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir went up the hall at once, and stood before the king, and greeted him in +the English way, which seemed strange to me after the two years of Danish +customs; and then Alsi bade him tell his errand. +</p> + +<p> +“I have come from Goldberga of East Anglia, and from Havelok the Dane, her +husband, to say that she has returned to her land, and would ask that you would +give her the throne that you have held for her since the day that her father +made you her guardian. It has been said that she might ask you to give account +of your management of the realm to her; but that she does not wish to do, being +sure that all will be rightly done in the matter, and she only asks to be set +in the place that was her father’s.” +</p> + +<p> +So said Arngeir, plainly, and I could see that the thanes thought the words +good. +</p> + +<p> +And Alsi answered, “Has this matter been put before the Witan of the East +Angles?” +</p> + +<p> +I suppose that he thought to hear Arngeir say that there had been no time for +so doing at present, but my brother was readier than I should have been. +</p> + +<p> +“Doubtless it has,” he said, “for that was your own promise to Goldberga on her +marriage.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Alsi flushed, and his brows wrinkled. He had said nothing to the Witan +at all, but had waited in hopes that he should hear no more of his niece, +telling the tale that we had heard. +</p> + +<p> +“I have had no answer from them,” he said at last, for Arngeir was looking at +him in a way that he could not meet. “It was her saying that she would do this +for herself.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then they do not refuse,” said Arngeir quietly, “nor did I think that they +would do so. It only remains therefore, that you, King Alsi, should do your +part. Then can the queen speak to the Witan, even as she said, concerning her +husband.” +</p> + +<p> +Now it must have been clear to the king that nothing short of a plain answer +would be taken, and he sat and thought for a while. One could see that he was +planning what to say, as if things had not gone as he expected. Maybe he hoped +to put off the matter by talk of asking the Witan, and so to gain time, for we +had certainly taken him unawares. +</p> + +<p> +At last he said, “How am I to know that you are here with full power to speak +for Goldberga? For this is a weighty matter.” +</p> + +<p> +Arngeir held out his hand, and on it was the ring of Orwenna the queen, which +Alsi had last seen here on the high place. +</p> + +<p> +“There is the token, King Alsi, and it is one which you know well,” he +answered. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, I know it,” answered the king with a grin that was not pleasant. +</p> + +<p> +And then he said, “I will speak with my thanes, and give you word to carry back +in an hour’s time, now that I know you to be a true messenger.” +</p> + +<p> +“There should be no reason for waiting so long as that, nor do I think that the +matter of the throne of East Anglia is a question for Lindsey thanes,” answered +Arngeir at once. “All this is between you and the princess.” +</p> + +<p> +Thereat one of the thanes rose up and said, “If a kingdom has been handed over +to our king, it is not to be taken again without our having a good deal to say +about it. I do not know, moreover, if we can have a foreigner over any part of +our land.” +</p> + +<p> +“Goldberga never gave up her right to the kingdom,” Arngeir answered, “as +anyone who was here at the wedding would tell you. And as for Havelok, her +husband, being a foreigner, it seems to me that a Jute who has been brought up +here in Lindsey since he was seven winters old is less a foreigner than a +Briton is to us.” +</p> + +<p> +None made any answer to that, and I could see that the king was growing angry +at being met thus at every turn. But he began to smile in that way of his that +I had learned to mistrust. +</p> + +<p> +“That is not altogether courteous to either Goldberga or myself,” he said, as +if he would think the words a jest, seeing that he was half Welsh. “Give me +time, I pray you, to think of this, as I have asked, and you shall go back with +your answer.” +</p> + +<p> +There was no help for it, and we had to leave the hall in order that Alsi might +say what he had to say to his thanes. And I said to Arngeir that it seemed that +we should have to fight the matter out. +</p> + +<p> +“Alsi risks losing both kingdoms if he does that,” he answered, “for we shall +take what we choose if we are the victors. The visions that have been thus +right so far say that we shall be so.” +</p> + +<p> +“I shall be glad if we do come out on the right side,” I said; “but I have not +so much faith in these dream tellings as some. Nor do I think that it seems +altogether fair to fight on a certainty.” +</p> + +<p> +“When it is a matter of punishing one who does not keep faith, I do not think +that it matters much,” he answered, laughing. “I should like certainty that he +would not get the best of the honest side in that case.” +</p> + +<p> +We were outside on the wide green within the square of the Roman walls at this +time, and now from within the hall came the sound of shouts and cheering which +we heard plainly enough. But whether it meant that the thanes cheered Alsi +because he would fight, rather than that they applauded his justice to his +niece, was not to be known as yet. As for me, I thought that it was hardly +likely to be the latter. +</p> + +<p> +Then came three thanes from the hail with the message, and it was this, “Alsi +bids Havelok go back to his own land and bide content therewith.” +</p> + +<p> +“What word is there for Goldberga, then?” asked Arngeir. +</p> + +<p> +“None. She has thrown in her lot with the Dane, and it is he with whom we will +not deal.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said I, “How was it that she had to throw in her lot with Havelok? He was +Alsi’s own choice for her.” +</p> + +<p> +“That is not what we have heard,” the spokesman answered. “Now it is best that +you go hence, for you have the answer.” +</p> + +<p> +“This means fighting for Goldberga’s rights,” said Arngeir, “and I will tell +you that Havelok will not be backward in the matter.” +</p> + +<p> +“In that case we shall meet again on the battlefield ere long,” answered the +thane. “I will not say that Havelok is in the wrong, and things might have been +better settled. Farewell till then. The Norns will show who is right.” +</p> + +<p> +So we went, and I thought, as did Arngeir, that there was some little feeling +among his men that Alsi was wrong. +</p> + +<p> +Now Alsi set to work to gather forces in earnest, and he went to work in a way +that was all his own: for, saying nothing about Goldberga, he sent to all his +thanes with word that the Vikings had come in force and invaded the land, led +by the son of Gunnar Kirkeban, whose ways were worse than those of his father, +for he spared none, whereas Kirkeban harried but the Welsh Christian folk. He +prayed them therefore to hasten, that this scourge might be driven back to the +sea whence he came. And that brought men to him fast, for no Englishman can +bear that an invader shall set foot on his shore, be he who he may. Few knew +who the wife of Havelok was at that time, but I do not know that it would have +made so much difference if they had. None thought that into England had come +the fair princess who was so well loved. +</p> + +<p> +Sorely troubled was Goldberga when she heard this answer, but it was all that +the rest of us looked for. And the next question was how best to meet the false +king. +</p> + +<p> +In the end we did a thing that may seem to some to have been rash altogether, +but it was our wish to compel Alsi to fight before his force was great enough +to crush us. It might be long before Ragnar could raise a host and join us, for +there was always a chance that he might have trouble in getting the Norfolk +thanes to come to his standard for a march on Lindsey. If we had gone to +Norfolk at once there would have been no fear of that kind, but the fighting +might have been more bitter and longer drawn out. +</p> + +<p> +We sent the fleet southward into the Wash, that it might wait for us at the +port of the Fossdyke, on what men call the Frieston shore; and then we left +Saltfleet and marched across country to the wolds, and southward and westward +along them, that we might draw Alsi from Lincoln. And all the way men joined us +for the sake of Curan, whom they knew, and of Goldberga, of whom they had +heard, so that in numbers at least our host was a great one. Ragged it might +be, as one may say, with the wild marshmen, who had no sort of training and no +chiefs to keep them in hand; but I knew that no host Alsi could get together +had any such trained force in it as we had in the fifteen hundred Vikings, for +they had seen many fights, and the ways of the sea teach men to hold together +and to obey orders at once and without hesitating. +</p> + +<p> +So we went until we came to Tetford, above Horncastle town; and there is a +great camp on a hilltop, made by the British, no doubt, in the days when they +fought with Rome. There we stayed, for Alsi was upon us. We saw the fires of +his camp in the village and on the hillsides across the valley, but a mile or +two from us that night; and it seemed that his host was greater than ours, as +we thought it would be, but not so much so as to cause dread of the battle that +was to come. +</p> + +<p> +Now there were two men who came to us that night, and we thought that they had +brought some message from Alsi at first. But all that they wanted was to join +Havelok, and we were glad of them. They were those two seconds of Griffin’s, +Cadwal and the other, whose name was Idrys, and with them was David the priest, +who had fled to us. +</p> + +<p> +“We know that Havelok is one who is worth fighting for,” they said, “for we +have proved it already. We are not Alsi’s men, and our fathers fought for his +mother’s Welsh kin against the English long ago. Let us fight for the rights of +Goldberga, at least.” +</p> + +<p> +Havelok welcomed them in all friendliness, though he asked them if they had no +grudge against him for the slaying of Griffin. +</p> + +<p> +“As to that,” they said, “after the duel we think that he deserved all that has +befallen him. We were ashamed to be his seconds.” +</p> + +<p> +Now these two took in hand to lead the marshmen, and set to work with them at +once, for they were ready to follow them as known thanes of the British. And +that was something gained. +</p> + +<p> +We slept on our arms that night, and all night long David woke and prayed for +our success, and I think that his prayers were not lost. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap23">CHAPTER XXIII.<br/> +BY TETFORD STREAM.</a></h2> + +<p> +In the early morning Alsi set his men in order in the valley, and seemed to +wait for us to come down to him, for it was of no use to try to take the strong +camp which sheltered us. And so, after council held, we did not keep him +waiting, but left the hill and marched on him. We had the camp to fall back on +if things went the wrong way, and beyond that the road to the sea and the ships +was open, with a chance of meeting Ragnar on the way, moreover. +</p> + +<p> +Very long and deep seemed the line as we neared it, and it was formed on the +banks of a stream that runs down the valley, so that we must cross the water to +attack. But the stream was shallow now with the August heat, and it was not +much sunk between its banks. +</p> + +<p> +When he saw that, Sigurd, who was a man of many fights, said that we had better +send the marshmen round to fall on the wings of the foe, while we went straight +for the centre of the line in the wedge formation that the Viking loves. For so +we should have no trouble in crossing the stream, and should cut the force +against us in two. +</p> + +<p> +So the two Welsh thanes led their wild levies out on either side of us Danes, +who were in the centre, and then we formed the wedge. Havelok himself would +have gone first of all at its point: but that we would not suffer, for if he +fell the battle was lost at its beginning. +</p> + +<p> +“Nay,” he said, “for we fight for Goldberga.” +</p> + +<p> +“And what would she say were we to set you foremost of us all?” asked Withelm. +“Little love were there to either of you in that. You are the heart of the +host, and one shields that although it gives strength to all the hands which +obey it.” +</p> + +<p> +So Withelm and Arngeir and I went foremost, and behind us came the courtmen, +and in the midst of their shield wall was Havelok, with Raven and the banner at +his side. After them, rank on rank and with close-locked shields, was such a +force as had not been seen in Lindsey for many a long day. Alsi’s men grew very +silent as they saw us come on, until we reached, through a storm of arrows that +could not stay us, the bank of the stream, and then they raised a war song that +roared and thundered among the hills as though the tide was coming up the +valley in one great wave. But we saved our breath until the first of us were on +the banks of the stream, and then I shouted, and with a great shout of “Ahoy!” +in answer, we charged through the stream and up the far bank, where Alsi’s +spearmen waited for us. +</p> + +<p> +They crowded together as they saw how narrow our front was, and there was a +hedge of steel before us three brothers; but the spear is not the weapon to use +if one would check the onrush of the Northman’s wedge, and shield and axe +between them dashed and hewed a way to the men who got to their swords too +late, and then we were in the midst of Alsi’s line, with the gap that we had +made widening behind us with each step that we took forward. +</p> + +<p> +Now it was sheer hewing at the mass who crowded on us; and I mind how we seemed +to fight in silence, although the battle cries were unceasing, and waxed ever +louder; for it was as when one walks by the shore and thinks not at all of the +noise of breakers that never ends. Now and then there was one shout that was +new, and it seemed to be the only voice. Most of all, the noise grew on the +wings where the savage Welsh fell on their masters and ancient foes in wild +tumult. +</p> + +<p> +We tried to cut our way to Alsi, for we could see him as he sat on his +horse—the only mounted man in all the hosts; but we could not reach him. And +presently the time came when we who were foremost must let fresh men take our +places. Sigurd stepped to my side, and Withelm fell back, and another took the +place of Arngeir, and then my turn came, and we went slowly from the front to +where the hollow centre of the wedge gave us rest. Only a few arrows fell there +now and then; but the time for using bows was past, seeing that we were hand to +hand with all the Lindsey host. And then I saw that Sigurd had done what we had +failed in, for he had reached the shield wall that was round the king himself. +And for a moment I was savage that the chance came to him so soon after I had +left the fighting line; but then I minded that Eglaf, my friend, would be +there, and I was glad that I need not cross swords with him after all. I had +thought of that happening before the fight began, but in the turmoil of hottest +struggle I had forgotten it. +</p> + +<p> +Now Sigurd was before the thick mass of the housecarls, and hand to hand with +them; and then he was among them, and he leapt at the bridle of Alsi’s horse +and grasped it. I saw the king’s sword flash down on his helm, and he reeled +under the stroke, but without letting go of the rein. Then the housecarls made +a rush, and bore back our men, and the horse reared suddenly. There was a wild +shout, and the war saddle was empty; and again our men surged forward, so that +I could not see what had happened. +</p> + +<p> +But now our Welshmen had been beaten back from the wings—not easily, but for +want of training—and they were forced back across the brook, and there held our +bank well, giving way no step further. The water kept them in an even front, +against their will, as it were; and Alsi’s men charged them in vain, knee deep +in the stream that ran red. But that let loose the men who had been held back +from us; and now we were overborne by numbers, and we began to go back. That +was the worst part of the whole fight, and the hardest hour of all the battle, +as may be supposed, for the wedge grew closer, as it was forced together by +sheer weight. None ever broke into it. +</p> + +<p> +Presently our rear was on the water’s edge, and it seemed likely that in +crossing there might be a breaking of the line; and when he saw that, Havelok +called to me, and he went to the front with the courtmen round him. It was good +to hear the cheers of our men as they saw the dancing banner above the fight, +and beneath it, in the bright sun, the gold-circled helm of their king. The +Lindseymen drew back a foot’s pace as they saw the giant who came on them, and +I heard some call that this was Curan of Grimsby, as if in wonder. Then we had +to fight hard, and Sigurd fell back past me, with a wound on his shoulder where +Alsi’s sword had glanced from the helm. No life had been left to Sigurd had a +better hand wielded the weapon; but he was not badly hurt. I could not see Alsi +anywhere, nor Eglaf. +</p> + +<p> +Steadily the numbers drove us back, though before Havelok was always a space +into which men hardly dared to come. The wedge was pushed away from us, and we +had to fall back with it, until we crossed the stream; and there Sigurd swung +the massed men into line, and then came the first pause in the fight. The two +hosts stood, with the narrow water between them, and glared on each other, +silent now. And then the bowmen began to get to work from either side, until +the arrows were all gone. +</p> + +<p> +Now Havelok called to the foe, and they were silent while he spoke to them. +</p> + +<p> +“Is Alsi yet alive?” he said; “for if not, I have no war with his men. If he +is, let me speak with him.” +</p> + +<p> +None answered for a while, and the men looked at each other as if they knew not +if the man they were fighting for lived or not. +</p> + +<p> +Then one came forward and said, “Alsi lives, and we have not done with you yet. +Get you back to your home beyond the sea!” +</p> + +<p> +And then they charged us again; but the water was a better front for us than it +had been for them, and across it they could not win. We drove them back once +and twice; and again came a time when both sides were wearied and must needs +rest. +</p> + +<p> +So it went on until night fell. We never stirred from that water’s edge, and +the stream was choked with valiant English and hardy Danes; and yet the attacks +came with the shout of “Out! out!” and the answer from us of “Havelok, ahoy!” +</p> + +<p> +At last one who seemed a great chief came and cried a truce, for night was +falling; and he said that if Havelok would claim no advantage therefrom, the +men of Lindsey would get back from the field, and leave it free for us to take +our fallen. +</p> + +<p> +“But I must have your word that with the end of that task you go back to the +place you now hold, that we may begin afresh, if it seems good to us, in the +morning.” +</p> + +<p> +Then said Havelok, “That is well spoken, and I cannot but agree. Who are you, +however, for I must know that this is said with authority?” +</p> + +<p> +“I am the Earl of Chester,” he answered. “Alsi has set the leading of the host +in my hands, for he is hurt somewhat.” +</p> + +<p> +“I did not think that Mercians would have troubled to fight to uphold Alsi of +Lindsey in his ways with his niece,” Havelok said. +</p> + +<p> +“What is that?” said the earl. “Hither came I for love of fighting, maybe, in +the first place; and next to drive out certain Vikings. I know naught of the +business of which you speak.” +</p> + +<p> +“Then,” said I, “go and ask Eglaf, the captain of the housecarls, for he knows +all about it. We are no raiding Danes, but those who fight for Goldberga of +East Anglia.” +</p> + +<p> +At that a hum of voices went down the English line, and this earl bit his lip +in doubt. +</p> + +<p> +“Well,” he said, “that is Alsi’s affair, and I will speak to him. We have had a +good fight, and I will not say that either of us has the best of it. Shall it +be as I have said?” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay,” answered Havelok; and the earl drew off his men for half a mile, and in +the gathering dusk we crossed the brook, and went on our errand across the +field. It was not hard to find our men, for they lay in a great wedge as we had +fought. There had been no straggling from that array, and no break had been +made in its lines. Alsi had lost more than we, for his men had beaten against +that steel wall in vain, and the arms of the Northman are better than those of +any other nation. +</p> + +<p> +We took the wounded back to the camp, and there Goldberga and the wives of our +English thanes tended them; and as we gathered up the slain the Lindsey men +were among us at the same work, and we spoke to them as if naught was amiss +between us, nor any fight to begin again in the morning. And then we learned +how few knew what we had come for. It was with them as with the Earl of +Chester. They had no knowledge of Goldberga’s homecoming, and least of all +thought that at the back of the trouble were the wiles of Alsi. It was two +years ago that Goldberga had gone, and her wedding had seemed to end her story. +Now the men heard and wondered; and it is said that very many left Alsi that +night and went home, angry with him for his falsehood. +</p> + +<p> +Now when all was done we sought rest, and weary we were. I will say for myself +that I did not feel like fighting next morning at all, for I was tired out, and +the one or two wounds that I had were getting sorely stiff. Raven was much in +the same case, and grumbled, sailor-wise, at the weight of the banner and aught +else that came uppermost in his mind. Yet I knew that he would be the first to +go forward again when the time came. +</p> + +<p> +The host slept on their arms along the bank of the stream through the hot +night, and the banner was pitched in their midst. Soon the moon rose, and only +the footsteps of the sentries along our front went up and down, while across +the water was the same silence; for both hosts were wearied out, and each had +learned that the other were true men, and there was no mistrust on either side. +When the light came once more we should fight to prove who were the best men at +arms, and with no hatred between us. +</p> + +<p> +Presently the mists crept up from the stream and wreathed the sleepers on +either bank with white, swaying clouds, and I mind that the last thought I had +before I closed my eyes was that my armour would be rusted by the clinging +damp—as if it were not war-stained from helm to deerskin shoe already with +stains that needed more cleansing than any rust. +</p> + +<p> +Then I waked suddenly, for someone went past me, and I sat up to see who it +might be. The moon was very bright and high now, but the figure that I saw +wading in the white mist was shadowy, and I could not tell who it was. And then +another and yet another figure came from the rear of our line, and passed among +the sleeping ranks, and joined the first noiselessly; and after a little while +many came, hurrying, and they formed up on the bank of the stream into the +mighty wedge. And I feared greatly, for not one of the sleepers stirred as the +warriors went among us, and I had looked on the faces of those who passed me, +and I knew that they were the dead whom I had seen the men gather even now and +lay in their last rank beyond our line. +</p> + +<p> +Then I saw that on the far bank was gathered another host, and that was of +Alsi’s men, and among them I knew the forms of some who had fallen in the first +onset when I led the charge. +</p> + +<p> +I tried to put forth my hand to wake Withelm, but I could not stir, and when I +would have spoken, I could frame no word, so that alone in all the host I saw +the slain men fight their battle over again, step by step. The wedge of the +Northmen won to the far shore as we had won—as they had won in life but a few +hours ago—and into the line of foemen they cut their way, and on the far side +of the stream they stayed and fought, as it had been in the battle. Yet though +one could see that the men shouted and cried, there was no sound at all, and +among the wildest turmoil walked the sentries of Alsi’s host unconcerned and +unknowing. And to me they seemed to be the ghosts, and the phantom strife that +which was real. +</p> + +<p> +Then I was ware of a stranger thing yet than all I had seen so far, for on the +field were more than those whom I knew. There stood watching on either side of +the battle two other ghostly hosts, taking no part in the struggle, but +watching it as we had watched from our place when we fell back into the rear to +rest, pointing and seeming to cheer strokes that were good and deeds that were +valiant. And I knew that these were men who had fought and died on this same +field in older days, for on one side were the white-clad Britons, and on the +other the stern, dark-faced Romans, steel and bronze from head to foot. +</p> + +<p> +So the battle went onward to where we had won and had been pressed back; and +then, little by little, the hosts faded away, and with them went the watchers, +and surely across the field went the quick gallop of no earthly steeds, the +passing to Odin of the choosers of the slain, the Valkyries. +</p> + +<p> +Then came across the brook to me one through the mist, and the sentries paid no +heed to him, and he came to my side and spoke to me. It was Cadwal, the Welsh +thane, and his breast was gashed so that I thought that he could not have +lived. +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, I am dead,” he said, “as men count death, and yet I would have part in +victory over Alsi, for the sake of Havelok and of Goldberga. Stay up my body on +the morrow, that I may seem to fight at least, that I may bide in the ranks +once more in the day of victory. Little victory have the British seen since +Hengist came. Say that you will do this.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he looked wistfully at me, and I gave him some token of assent; and at +that came back all the shadows of our men, and seemed to pray the same. And +then was a stir of feet near me, and a shadow across the trampled grass, and +instead of the dead the voice of Havelok spoke softly to me, and with him was +Goldberga, clad in her mail. And I thought that they and I were slain also, and +I cried to this one who seemed to be one of Odin’s maidens that I too would +fain be stayed up with Cadwal and the rest, that I might have part in victory. +</p> + +<p> +Then Goldberga stooped to me, and laid her soft hand on my forehead, and took +off my helm, so that the air came to me, and thereat I woke altogether. +</p> + +<p> +“Brother,” she said, “you are restless and sorely wounded, as it seems. It is +not good that you should lie in this mist.” +</p> + +<p> +At her voice the others woke, and for a while she talked with us in a low tone, +cheering us. And presently she asked of that strange request that I had made to +her. +</p> + +<p> +I told her, for it was a message that should not be kept back, thus given; and +when he heard it, Withelm sighed a little, and said, “Would that we had all +those who have fallen. Yet if it is as they have asked our brother, our host +will seem as strong as before we joined battle in the morning. Leave this to +me, brother, for it may be done.” +</p> + +<p> +Then he rose up and went softly to where Idrys, the friend of Cadwal, lay, and +spoke long with him. It was true that Cadwal was slain, though I had not yet +heard of it until he told me himself thus. +</p> + +<p> +Then I slept heavily, while the others talked for a while. It is a hard place +at a wedge tip when Englishmen are against one; and I am not much use in a +council. Presently they would wake me if my word was wanted. +</p> + +<p> +But it was not needed, for the sunlight woke me. There was a growing stir in +our lines and across the water also, and I looked round. The mists were yet +dense, for there was not enough breeze to stir the heavy folds of the banner, +and Raven slept still with his arm round its staff. Havelok was not here now, +and I thought that he had gone to the camp with Goldberga, and would be back +shortly. +</p> + +<p> +Then I saw that our rear rank was already formed up, as I thought, and that is +not quite the order of things, as a rule, and it seemed far off from the +stream. I thought that they should have asked me about this, for there were +some of my courtmen in that line. +</p> + +<p> +And then I saw that in the line was no movement, and no flash of arms, as when +one man speaks to another, turning a little. And before that line stood the +form of a chief who leant on his broad spear, motionless and seeming watchful. +I knew him at once, and it was Cadwal, and those he commanded were the dead. +That was even to me an awesome sight, for in the mists they seemed ready and +waiting for the word that would never come to their ears, resting on the spears +that they could use no more. It had been done by the marshmen in the dark hours +of the morning, and from across the stream I saw Alsi’s men staring at the new +force that they thought had come to help us. There were men enough moving along +our bank with food to us to prevent them seeing that this line stirred not at +all. +</p> + +<p> +There was a scald who came with us from Denmark, and now with the full rising +of the sun he took his harp and went along the stream bank singing the song of +Dunheidi fight and so sweet was his voice, and so strong, that even Alsi’s men +gathered to hearken to him. His name was Heidrek, and he has set all that he +saw with Havelok into a saga; but we, here, mostly remember the brave waking +that he gave us that morning. It was wonderful how the bright song cheered us. +One saw that the stiffened limbs shook themselves into litheness once more, and +the listless faces brightened, and into the hearts that were heavy came new +hope, and that was the song’s work. +</p> + +<p> +Now men began to jest with their foes across the stream, and those who had +Danish loaves threw them across in exchange for English, that they might have +somewhat to talk of. Ours were rye, and theirs of barley; but it was not a fair +change after ours had been so long a voyage. +</p> + +<p> +It was not long before our war horns sounded for the mustering, and men ran to +their arms. The Lindsey host drew back from the talk with our men at the same +time, and, without waiting for word from their leaders, began to get in line +along the stream, where they had been when we halted last night. But we had no +thought of falling on them until we had had some parley with the king or the +Earl of Chester. And now it was plain that with the grim rearguard behind us we +outnumbered the men of Alsi who were left. +</p> + +<p> +Now came from the village in rear of the foe a little company, in the midst of +which was one horseman, and that was the king himself. His arm was slung to his +breast, and he sat his horse weakly, so that it was true enough that he had +been hurt. With him were the earl and Eglaf, and the housecarls, and I sent one +to fetch Havelok quickly, that there might be no delay in the words that were +to be said. +</p> + +<p> +Alsi rode to the water’s edge and looked out over our host, and his white face +became whiter, and his thin lips twitched as he saw that our line was no weaker +than it had seemed when first he saw it. He spoke to the earl, and he too +counted the odds before him, and he smiled a little to himself. He had not much +to say to Alsi. +</p> + +<p> +Then broke out a thunderous cheer from all our men, for with Havelok and Sigurd +at her horse’s rein, and with Withelm’s courtmen of her own guard behind her, +came Goldberga the queen to speak with the man who had broken his trust. She +had on her mail, as on the day when we ended Hodulf; and she rode to the centre +of our line, and there stayed, with a flush on her cheek that the wild shouts +of our men had called there. +</p> + +<p> +Then I heard the name of “Goldberga, Goldberga!” run down the English line, and +I saw Alsi shrink back into himself, as it were; and then some Lincoln men +close to him began to grow restless, and all at once they lifted their helms +and cheered also, and that cheer was taken up by all the host, as it seemed, +until the ring of hills seemed alive with voices. And with that Alsi half +turned his horse to fly. +</p> + +<p> +Yet his men did not mean to leave him. It was but the hailing of the lady whom +they knew, and her coming thus was more than the simple warriors had wit or +mind to fathom. But now Goldberga held up her hand, and the cries ceased, and +silence came. Then she lifted her voice, clear as a silver bell, and said, “It +seems strange to me that English folk should be fighting against me and my +husband’s men who have brought me home. I would know the meaning of this, King +Alsi, for it would seem that your oath to my father is badly kept. Maybe I have +thought that the people would not have me in his place; but their voice does +not ring in those shouts, for which I thank them with all my heart, as if they +hated me. Now, therefore, I myself ask that my guardian will give up to me that +which is my own.” +</p> + +<p> +We held our peace, but a hum of talk went all through the English ranks. The +Earl of Chester sat down on the bank, and set his sword across his knees, and +began to tie the peace strings round the hilt, in token that he was going to +fight no more. Now and then he looked at Goldberga, and smiled at her earnest +face. But Alsi made no sign of answer. +</p> + +<p> +Then the queen spoke again to him. +</p> + +<p> +“There must be some reason why you have thus set a host in arms against me,” +she said, “and what that may be I would know.” +</p> + +<p> +Then, as Alsi answered not at all, the earl spoke frankly. +</p> + +<p> +“We were told that we had to drive out the Vikings, and I must say that they do +not go easily. But it was not told us that they came here to right a wrong, +else had I not fought.” +</p> + +<p> +Many called out in the same words, and then sat down as the earl had done. +</p> + +<p> +And at last Alsi spoke for himself. +</p> + +<p> +“We do not fight against you, my niece, but against the Danes. We cannot have +them in the country.” +</p> + +<p> +“They do not mean to bide here, but they will not go before my throne is given +to me. Never came a foreign host into a land in more friendly wise than this of +mine.” +</p> + +<p> +At that Alsi’s face seemed to clear, and his forced smile came to him. He +looked round on the thanes who were nearest him, and coughed, and then +answered, “Here has been some mistake, my niece, and it has cost many good +lives. If it is even as you say, get you to your land of Anglia, and there +shall be peace. I myself will send word to Ragnar that he shall hail you as +queen.” +</p> + +<p> +Then up spoke a new voice, and it was one that I knew well. +</p> + +<p> +“No need to do that, lord king,” said Berthun the cook. “Here have I come +posthaste, and riding day and night, to say that Ragnar is but a day’s march +from here, that he and all Norfolk may see that their queen comes to her own.” +</p> + +<p> +Then Alsi’s face grew ashy pale, and without another word he swung his horse +round and went his way. I saw him reel in the saddle before he had gone far, +and Eglaf set his arm round him and stayed him up. After him Goldberga looked +wistfully, for she was forgiving, and had fain that he had spoken one word of +sorrow. But none else heeded him, for now the thanes, led by the earl himself, +came thronging across the water, that they might ask forgiveness for even +seeming to withstand Goldberga. And on both sides the men set down their arms, +and began to pile mighty fires, that the peace made should not want its +handfasting feast. +</p> + +<p> +For the fair princess had won her own, and there was naught but gladness. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div class="chapter"> + +<h2><a name="chap24">CHAPTER XXIV.<br/> +PEACE, AND FAREWELL.</a></h2> + +<p> +Now there was feasting enough, and somewhere they found at a thane’s house a +great tent, and they set that up, so that Havelok and Goldberga might have +their own court round them, as it were. Gladly did Berthun rid himself of war +gear and take to his old trade again. I suppose that the little Tetford valley +had never heard the like sounds of rejoicing before. +</p> + +<p> +Near midnight a man came to me and said that a message had come to me from the +other side, and I rose from the board and went out, to find Eglaf waiting for +me in the moonlight. He was armed, and his face was wan and tired. +</p> + +<p> +“Come apart, friend,” he said; “I have a message from the king.” +</p> + +<p> +“To me?” +</p> + +<p> +“No, to Havelok. But you must hear it first, and then tell him as you will.” +</p> + +<p> +We walked away from the tent and across the hillside for some way, and then he +said without more words, “This is the message that Alsi sends to Havelok, whose +name was Curan. ‘Forgive the things that are past, for many there are that need +forgiving. I have no heir, and it is for myself that I have schemed amiss. In +Lincoln town lies a great treasure, of which Eglaf and I alone know. Give it, I +pray you, to your Danes, that they may harm the land not at all, and so shall I +ward off some of the evil that might come through me even yet. I think that, +after me, you shall be king.’” +</p> + +<p> +“That is wise of Alsi; but is there no word for Goldberga?” +</p> + +<p> +“Ay, but not by my mouth. I fetched David the priest two hours ago, and he +bears those messages.” +</p> + +<p> +“Is there yet more to say?” I asked, for it seemed to me that there was. +</p> + +<p> +“There is,” he answered. “Alsi is dead.” +</p> + +<p> +So there was an end of all his schemings, and I will say no more of them. It +was Eglaf’s thought that it was not so much his hurts that had killed the king, +but a broken heart because of this failure. For the second time now I knew that +it is true that “old sin makes new shame.” +</p> + +<p> +Now how we told Havelok this, and how Goldberga was somewhat comforted by the +words that David the priest brought her from her uncle, there is no need to +say. But when the news was known in all the host of Lindsey, there was a great +gathering of all in the wide meadow, and we sat in the camp and wondered what +end should be to the talk. Ragnar had come; but his host was now no great one, +for we had sent word to him of the peace, and there was a great welcome for him +and his men. +</p> + +<p> +The Lindsey thanes did not talk long, and presently some half dozen of the best +of them came to us, and said that with one accord the gathering would ask that +Havelok and Goldberga should reign over them. +</p> + +<p> +“We will answer for all in the land,” they said. “If there are other thanes who +should have had a word in the matter, they are not here because, knowing more +than we, they would not fight for Alsi in this quarrel. If there is any other +man to be thought of, he cannot go against the word of the host.” +</p> + +<p> +“I have my kingdom in Denmark,” said Havelok, “and my wife has hers in Anglia. +How should we take this? See, here is Ragnar of Norwich; he is worthy to be +king, if any. Here, too, is the Earl of Chester, who led you. It will be well +to set these two names before the host.” +</p> + +<p> +“The host will have none but Havelok and Goldberga,” they said. +</p> + +<p> +So the long-ago visions came to pass, and in a few days more we were feasting +in the old hall at Lincoln. But before we left the valley of the battle we laid +in mound in all honour those who had fallen. Seven great mounds we made, at +which men wonder and will wonder while they stand at Tetford. For well fought +the Danes of Goldberga, and well fought the Lindseymen on that day. Yet I think +that those who would fain have lived to see the victory had their share in it, +as they stood in their grim and silent ranks behind us. +</p> + +<p> +Then was a new crowning of those two, and messages to the overlord of Lindsey, +sent by the thanes, to say that all was settled on the old lines of peaceful +tribute to be paid; and then, when word and presents came back from him, +Goldberga rose up on the high place where she had been so strangely wedded, and +looked down at the joyous faces of her nobles at the long tables. +</p> + +<p> +“When I was crowned in Denmark,” she said, “there was a promise made me, that +when this day came to me in Norfolk I might ask one boon of all who upheld me. +I do not know if I may ask it here and now, for the promise was made by my +husband’s people. Yet it is a matter that is dear to my heart that I shall seek +from you all, if I may.” +</p> + +<p> +Then all the hall rang with voices that bade her ask what she would; and she +bowed and flushed red, and hesitated a little. Then she took heart and spoke. +</p> + +<p> +“It is but this,” she said. “Let the poor Christian folk bide in peace; and if +teachers come from the south or from the north presently who will speak of that +faith, bear with them, I pray you, for they work no harm indeed.” +</p> + +<p> +Almost was she weeping as she said this, and her white hands were clasped +tightly before her. But she looked bravely at the thanes, and waited for the +answer, though I think that she feared what it would be. +</p> + +<p> +But an old thane rose up in his place, smiling, and he answered, “If you had +commanded us this, my queen, it would have been done. The Christian folk, if +there are any, shall have no hurt. I think that we had forgotten the old days +of trouble with them. Yet I hear that in Kent the new faith, as it seems to us, +is being taught, and that the king looks on it with favour. It may be that here +it will come also. For your sake I will listen if a teacher comes to me.” +</p> + +<p> +The thanes thought little of this boon, and they all answered that it was +freely granted. But they said that it was no boon to give, and bade her ask +somewhat that was better. +</p> + +<p> +“Why then,” she said, “if I must ask more, think no more of me as queen save as +that I am the wife of the king. Havelok is your ruler in good sooth.” +</p> + +<p> +That pleased them all well, and they laughed and wished that all had wives who +had no mind to rule. +</p> + +<p> +“Here is word that is going home to my wife,” said one to his neighbour. “If +the queen sets the fashion of obedience, it behoves all good wives to follow +her leading.” +</p> + +<p> +“Maybe I would let some other than yourself tell the lady that,” answered the +other thane with a great laugh, for he knew that household and its ruler. +</p> + +<p> +So Goldberga had her will, and then began the long years of peace and happiness +to the kingdoms of which all men know. Wherefore I think that my story is done. +What I have told is halting maybe, and rough, but it is true. And Goldberga, my +sister, says that it is good. Which is all the praise that I need. +</p> + +<hr /> + +<p> +So far went Radbard, my friend, and then he would tell no more. So it is left +to me, Wislac the priest, who have written for him, to finish. He says that +everyone knows the rest, and so they do just now. But in the years to come, +when this story is read, men will want to know more. So it is fit that I should +end the story, telling things that I myself know to be true also. +</p> + +<p> +Sigurd’s host went back in the autumn, rich with the treasure of Alsi the king; +and from that time forward no Danish host ever sought our shores. Wars enough +have been in England here, but they have not harmed us. No host has been +suffered to cross the borders of Lindsey or East Anglia, save in peace, and in +the wars of Penda of Mercia Havelok has taken no part. Yet he has had to fight +to hold his own more than once, but always with victory, for always the prayers +of the few Christians have been with him. +</p> + +<p> +They set Earl Ragnar to hold the southern kingdom for Havelok and his wife; and +presently, when he was left a widower, he wedded the youngest daughter of Grim, +Havelok’s foster father. Eglaf was captain of the Lincoln courtmen or +housecarls, whichever the right name may be among those who speak of them. One +name is Danish and the other English, but they mean the same. As for my good +friend Radbard, he was high sheriff before long, and that he is yet. He wedded +Ragnar’s sister the year that Havelok was crowned in Norwich, which was the +next year after the crowning at Lincoln. +</p> + +<p> +Raven went back to the sea, and he will now be in Denmark or else on the Viking +path with Sigurd, for that is what he best loves. Arngeir bides at Grimsby, +high in honour with all, and the port and town grow greater and more prosperous +year by year. Wise was Grim when he chose to stay in the place where he had +chanced to come, if it were not more than chance that brought him. I suppose +that for all time the ships that are from Grimsby will be free from all dues in +the ports that are Havelok’s in the Danish land. Witlaf, the good old thane, +bides in his place yet, and he rejoices ever that he had a hand in bringing +Havelok up. Nor does our king forget that. +</p> + +<p> +Indeed, I think that he forgets naught but ill done toward him. Never is a man +who has done one little thing for him overlooked, if he is met by our king +after many years, and that is a royal gift indeed. +</p> + +<p> +I would that all married folk were as are this royal couple of ours. Never are +they happy apart, and never has a word gone awry between them. If one speaks of +Havelok, one must needs think of Goldberga; and if one says a word of the +queen, one means the king also. Happy in their people and in their wondrous +fair children are they, and that is all that can be wished for them. +</p> + +<p> +There was one thing wanting for long years, that I and Withelm ever longed for +for Havelok—a thing for which Goldberga prayed ever. I came to them from Queen +Bertha in Kent, when good old David died; and at that time Havelok was not a +Christian, but surely the most Christian heathen that ever was. I knew that he +must come into the faith at some time; and I, at least, could not find it in my +heart to blame him altogether for holding to the Asir whom his fathers +worshipped. It was in sheer honesty and singleness of heart that he did so, and +I had never skill enough to show him the right. But Withelm, who has long been +a priest of the faith, and shall surely be our bishop ere long, had more to do +with his conversion than any other. +</p> + +<p> +Yet it did not come until the days when Paulinus came from York and preached +with the fire of the missionary to us all. And then we saw the mighty warrior +go down to the water in the white robe of the catechumen, and come therefrom +with his face shining with a new and wondrous light. +</p> + +<p> +Then he founded a monastery at Grimsby, that there the men of the marsh, who +had been kind to him in the old days, might find teachers in all that was good; +and there it will surely be after many a long year, until there is need for its +work no more, if such a time ever comes. +</p> + +<p> +So the land grows Christian fast, and good will be its folk if they follow the +way of king and queen and their brothers. +</p> + +<p> +Now have I finished also, and this is farewell. Look you, husbands and wives, +that you may be said to be like Havelok and Goldberga; and see, brothers, that +you mind the words that Grim spoke to his sons, and which they heeded so well— +</p> + +<p> +“Bare is back without brother behind it.” And that is a true word, though it +was a heathen who spoke it. +</p> + +<p> +THE END. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn1"></a> <a href="#fnref1">[1]</a> +I have to thank the Mayor of Grimsby for most kindly furnishing me with an +impression of this ancient seal. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn2"></a> <a href="#fnref2">[2]</a> +Now Nishni-Novgorod, from time immemorial the great meetingplace of north and +south, east and west. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn3"></a> <a href="#fnref3">[3]</a> +The <i>garth</i> was the fenced and stockaded enclosure round a northern +homestead. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn4"></a> <a href="#fnref4">[4]</a> +The <i>seax</i> was the heavy, curved dagger carried by men of all ranks. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn5"></a> <a href="#fnref5">[5]</a> +The northern sea god and goddess. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn6"></a> <a href="#fnref6">[6]</a> +Men drowned at sea were thought to go to the halls of Pan and Aegir. Ran is +represented as fishing for heroes in time of storm. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn7"></a> <a href="#fnref7">[7]</a> +The Norns were the Fates of the northern mythology. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn8"></a> <a href="#fnref8">[8]</a> +The “Witanagemot,” the representative assembly for the kingdom, whence our +Parliament sprang. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn9"></a> <a href="#fnref9">[9]</a> +The greatest term of reproach for a coward. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn10"></a> <a href="#fnref10">[10]</a> +The gold ring kept in the Temple of the Asir, on which all oaths must be sworn. +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn11"></a> <a href="#fnref11">[11]</a> +The sanctuary of the Asir. Thorsway and Withern in Lincolnshire both preserve +the name in the last and first syllable respectively, both meaning “Thor’s +sanctuary.” +</p> + +<p class="footnote"> +<a name="fn12"></a> <a href="#fnref12">[12]</a> +The northern equivalent of the Saxon “Folkmote,” or general assembly of the +people. +</p> + +</div><!--end chapter--> + +<div style='display:block; margin-top:4em'>*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK HAVELOK THE DANE ***</div> +<div style='text-align:left'> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +Updated editions will replace the previous one—the old editions will +be renamed. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright +law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works, +so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United +States without permission and without paying copyright +royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part +of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project +Gutenberg™ electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG™ +concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark, +and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following +the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use +of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for +copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very +easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation +of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project +Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away—you may +do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected +by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark +license, especially commercial redistribution. +</div> + +<div style='margin-top:1em; font-size:1.1em; text-align:center'>START: FULL LICENSE</div> +<div style='text-align:center;font-size:0.9em'>THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE</div> +<div style='text-align:center;font-size:0.9em'>PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +To protect the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase “Project +Gutenberg”), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full +Project Gutenberg™ License available with this file or online at +www.gutenberg.org/license. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg™ electronic works +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg™ +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or +destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works in your +possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a +Project Gutenberg™ electronic work and you do not agree to be bound +by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person +or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.B. “Project Gutenberg” is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg™ electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg™ electronic works if you follow the terms of this +agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg™ +electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (“the +Foundation” or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection +of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works. Nearly all the individual +works in the collection are in the public domain in the United +States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the +United States and you are located in the United States, we do not +claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing, +displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as +all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope +that you will support the Project Gutenberg™ mission of promoting +free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg™ +works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the +Project Gutenberg™ name associated with the work. You can easily +comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the +same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg™ License when +you share it without charge with others. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are +in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, +check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this +agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, +distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any +other Project Gutenberg™ work. The Foundation makes no +representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any +country other than the United States. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other +immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg™ License must appear +prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg™ work (any work +on which the phrase “Project Gutenberg” appears, or with which the +phrase “Project Gutenberg” is associated) is accessed, displayed, +performed, viewed, copied or distributed: +</div> + +<blockquote> + <div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> + This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most + other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions + whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms + of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online + at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you + are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws + of the country where you are located before using this eBook. + </div> +</blockquote> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is +derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not +contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the +copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in +the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are +redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase “Project +Gutenberg” associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply +either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or +obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg™ +trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg™ electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any +additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms +will be linked to the Project Gutenberg™ License for all works +posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the +beginning of this work. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg™ +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg™. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg™ License. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including +any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access +to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg™ work in a format +other than “Plain Vanilla ASCII” or other format used in the official +version posted on the official Project Gutenberg™ website +(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense +to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means +of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original “Plain +Vanilla ASCII” or other form. Any alternate format must include the +full Project Gutenberg™ License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg™ works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg™ electronic works +provided that: +</div> + +<div style='margin-left:0.7em;'> + <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'> + • You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg™ works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed + to the owner of the Project Gutenberg™ trademark, but he has + agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project + Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid + within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are + legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty + payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project + Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in + Section 4, “Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg + Literary Archive Foundation.” + </div> + + <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'> + • You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg™ + License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all + copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue + all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg™ + works. + </div> + + <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'> + • You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of + any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of + receipt of the work. + </div> + + <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'> + • You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg™ works. + </div> +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project +Gutenberg™ electronic work or group of works on different terms than +are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing +from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of +the Project Gutenberg™ trademark. Contact the Foundation as set +forth in Section 3 below. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.F. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project +Gutenberg™ collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg™ +electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may +contain “Defects,” such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate +or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other +intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or +other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or +cannot be read by your equipment. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the “Right +of Replacement or Refund” described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg™ trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg™ electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium +with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you +with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in +lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person +or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second +opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If +the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing +without further opportunities to fix the problem. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you ‘AS-IS’, WITH NO +OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT +LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of +damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement +violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the +agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or +limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or +unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the +remaining provisions. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg™ electronic works in +accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the +production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg™ +electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, +including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of +the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this +or any Project Gutenberg™ work, (b) alteration, modification, or +additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg™ work, and (c) any +Defect you cause. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg™ +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +Project Gutenberg™ is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of +computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It +exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations +from people in all walks of life. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg™’s +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg™ collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg™ and future +generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see +Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation’s EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by +U.S. federal laws and your state’s laws. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +The Foundation’s business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, +Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up +to date contact information can be found at the Foundation’s website +and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact +</div> + +<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +Project Gutenberg™ depends upon and cannot survive without widespread +public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND +DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular state +visit <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org/donate/">www.gutenberg.org/donate</a>. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To +donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate +</div> + +<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'> +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg™ electronic works +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project +Gutenberg™ concept of a library of electronic works that could be +freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and +distributed Project Gutenberg™ eBooks with only a loose network of +volunteer support. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +Project Gutenberg™ eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in +the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not +necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper +edition. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +Most people start at our website which has the main PG search +facility: <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. +</div> + +<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'> +This website includes information about Project Gutenberg™, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. +</div> + +</div> + +</body> +</html>
\ No newline at end of file diff --git a/old/old/12847.txt b/old/old/12847.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..58a6771 --- /dev/null +++ b/old/old/12847.txt @@ -0,0 +1,10368 @@ +The Project Gutenberg EBook of Havelok The Dane, by Charles Whistler + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + + +Title: Havelok The Dane + A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln + +Author: Charles Whistler + +Release Date: July 7, 2004 [EBook #12847] + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ASCII + +*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK HAVELOK THE DANE *** + + + + +Produced by Martin Robb. + + + + + +Havelok the Dane: A Legend of Old Grimsby and Lincoln. + +By Charles W. Whistler + + + + PREFACE. + +If any excuse is needed for recasting the ancient legend of Grim the +fisher and his foster-son Havelok the Dane, it may be found in the +fascination of the story itself, which made it one of the most popular +legends in England from the time of the Norman conquest, at least, to +that of Elizabeth. From the eleventh to the thirteenth centuries it +seems to have been almost classic; and during that period two full +metrical versions---one in Norman-French and the other in English--- +were written, besides many other short versions and abridgments, which +still exist. These are given exhaustively by Professor Skeat in his +edition of the English poem for the Early English Text Society, and it +is needless to do more than refer to them here as the sources from which +this story is gathered. + +These versions differ most materially from one another in names and +incidents, while yet preserving the main outlines of the whole history. +It is evident that there has been a far more ancient, orally-preserved +tradition, which has been the original of the freely-treated poems and +concise prose statements of the legend which we have. And it seems +possible, from among the many variations, and from under the disguise of +the mediaeval forms in which it has been hidden, to piece together what +this original may have been, at least with some probability. + +We have one clue to the age of the legend of Havelok in the statement by +the eleventh-century Norman poet that his tale comes from a British +source, which at least gives a very early date for the happenings +related; while another version tells us that the king of "Lindesie" was +a Briton. Welsh names occur, accordingly, in several places; and it is +more than likely that the old legend preserved a record of actual events +in the early days of the Anglo-Saxon settlement in England, when there +were yet marriages between conquerors and conquered, and the origins of +Angle and Jute and Saxon were not yet forgotten in the pedigrees of the +many petty kings. + +One of the most curious proofs of the actual British origin of the +legend is in the statement that the death of Havelok's father occurred +as the result of a British invasion of Denmark for King Arthur, by a +force under a leader with the distinctly Norse name of Hodulf. The claim +for conquest of the north by Arthur is very old, and is repeated by +Geoffrey of Monmouth, and may well have originated in the remembrance of +some successful raid on the Danish coasts by the Norse settlers in the +Gower district of Pembrokeshire, in company with a contingent of their +Welsh neighbours. + +This episode does not occur in the English version; but here an attack +on Havelok on his return home to Denmark is made by men led by one +Griffin, and this otherwise unexplainable survival of a Welsh name seems +to connect the two accounts in some way that recalls the ancient legend +at the back of both. + +I have therefore treated the Welsh element in the story as deserving a +more prominent place, at least in subsidiary incidents, than it has in +the two old metrical versions. It has been possible to follow neither of +these exactly, as in names and details they are widely apart; but to one +who knows both, the sequence of events will, I think, be clear enough. + +I have, for the same reason of the British origin of the legend, +preferred the simple and apposite derivation of the name of "Curan," +taken by the hero during his servitude, from the Welsh Cwran, "a +wonder," to the Norman explanation of the name as meaning a "scullion," +which seems to be rather a guess, based on the menial position of the +prince, than a translation. + +For the long existence of a Welsh servile population in the lowlands of +Lincolnshire there is evidence enough in the story of Guthlac of +Crowland, and the type may still be found there. There need be little +excuse for claiming some remains of their old Christianity among them, +and the "hermit" who reads the dream for the princess may well have been +a half-forgotten Welsh priest. But the mediaeval poems have +Christianized the ancient legend, until it would seem to stand in +somewhat the same relationship to what it was as the German "Niebelungen +Lied" does to the "Volsunga Saga." + +With regard to the dreams which recur so constantly, I have in the case +of the princess transferred the date of hers to the day previous to her +marriage, the change only involving a difference of a day, but seeming +to he needed, as explanatory of her sudden submission to her guardian. +And instead of crediting Havelok with the supernatural light bodily, it +has been transferred to the dream which seems to haunt those who have to +do with him. + +As to the names of the various characters, they are in the old versions +hardly twice alike. I have, therefore, taken those which seem to have +been modernized from their originals, or preserved by simple +transliteration, and have set them back in what seems to have been their +first form. Gunther, William, and Bertram, for instance, seem to be +modernized from Gunnar, Withelm, and perhaps Berthun; while Sykar, +Aunger, and Gryme are but alternative English spellings of the northern +Sigurd, Arngeir, and Grim. + +The device on Havelok's banner in chapter xxi. is exactly copied from +the ancient seal of the Corporation of Grimsby,[1] +which is of the date of Edward the First. The existence of this is +perhaps the best proof that the story of Grim and Havelok is more than a +romance. Certainly the Norse "Heimskringla" record claims an older +northern origin for the town than that of the Danish invasion of +Alfred's time; and the historic freedom of its ships from toll in the +port of Elsinore has always been held to date from the days of its founder. + +The strange and mysterious "blue stones" of Grimsby and Louth are yet in +evidence, and those of the former town are connected by legend with +Grim. Certainly they have some very ancient if long-forgotten +associations, and it is more than likely that they have been brought as +"palladia" with the earliest northern settlers. A similar stone exists +in the centre of the little East Anglian town of Harleston, with a +definite legend of settlement attached to it; and there may be others. +The Coronation Stone of Westminster and the stone in Kingston-on-Thames +are well-known proofs of the ancient sanctity that surrounded such +objects for original reasons that are now lost. + +The final battle at Tetford, with its details, are from the Norman poem. +The later English account is rounded off with the disgrace and burning +alive of the false guardian; but for many reasons the earlier seems to +be the more correct account. Certainly the mounds of some great +forgotten fight remain in the Tetford valley, and Havelok is said to +have come to "Carleflure," which, being near Saltfleet, and on the road +to Tetford, may be Canton, where there is a strong camp of what is +apparently Danish type. + +Those who can read with any comfort the crabbed Norman-French and Early +English poetic versions will see at once where I have added incidents +that may bring the story into a connected whole, as nearly as possible +on the old Saga lines; and those readers to whom the old romance is new +will hardly wish that I should pull the story to pieces again, to no +purpose so far as they are concerned. And, at least, for a fairly free +treatment of the subject, I have the authority of those previous authors +whom I have mentioned. + +In the different versions, the founder of Grimsby is variously described +as a steward of the Danish king's castle, a merchant, a fisher, and in +the English poem---probably because it was felt that none other would +have undertaken the drowning of the prince---as a thrall. Another +version gives no account of the sack episode, but says that Grim finds +both queen and prince wandering on the shore. Grim the fisher is +certainly a historic character in his own town, and it has not been hard +to combine the various callings of the worthy foster-father of Havelok +and the troubles of both mother and son. A third local variant tells +that Havelok was found at Grimsby by the fisher adrift in an open boat; +and I have given that boat also a place in the story, in a different way. + +The names of the kings are too far lost to be set back in their place in +history, but Professor Skeet gives the probable date of Havelok and Grim +as at the end of the sixth century, with a possible identification of +the former with the "governor of Lincoln" baptized by Paulinus. I have, +therefore, assumed this period where required. But a legend of this kind +is a romance of all time, and needs no confinement to date and place. +Briton and Saxon, Norman and Englishman, and maybe Norseman and Dane, +have loved the old story, and with its tale of right and love triumphant +it still has its own power. + +Stockland, 1899 + +Chas. W. Whistler + + + CHAPTER I. GRIM THE FISHER AND HIS SONS. + +This story is not about myself, though, because I tell of things that I +have seen, my name must needs come into it now and then. The man whose +deeds I would not have forgotten is my foster-brother, Havelok, of whom +I suppose every one in England has heard. Havelok the Dane men call him +here, and that is how he will always be known, as I think. + +He being so well known, it is likely that some will write down his +doings, and, not knowing them save by hearsay, will write them wrongly +and in different ways, whereof will come confusion, and at last none +will be believed. Wherefore, as he will not set them down himself, it is +best that I do so. Not that I would have anyone think that the +penmanship is mine. Well may I handle oar, and fairly well axe and +sword, as is fitting for a seaman, but the pen made of goose feather is +beyond my rough grip in its littleness, though I may make shift to use a +sail-needle, for it is stiff and straightforward in its ways, and no +scrawling goeth therewith. + +Therefore my friend Wislac, the English priest, will be the penman, +having skill thereto. I would have it known that I can well trust him to +write even as I speak, though he has full leave to set aside all hard +words and unseemly, such as a sailor is apt to use unawares; and where +my Danish way of speaking goeth not altogether with the English, he may +alter the wording as he will, so long as the sense is always the same. +Then, also, will he read over to me what he has written, and therefore +all may be sure that this is indeed my true story. + +------------------------------------------------------------------------ + +Now, as it is needful that one begins at the beginning, it happens that +the first thing to be told is how I came to be Havelok's foster-brother, +and that seems like beginning with myself after all. But all the story +hangs on this, and so there is no help for it. + +If it is asked when this beginning might be, I would say, for an +Englishman who knows not the names of Danish kings, that it was before +the first days of the greatness of Ethelbert of Kent, the overlord of +all England, the Bretwalda, and therefore, as Father Wislac counts, +about the year of grace 580. But King Ethelbert does not come into the +story, nor does the overlord of all Denmark; for the kings of whom I +must speak were under-kings, though none the less kingly for all that. +One must ever be the mightiest of many; and, as in England, there were +at that time many kings in Denmark, some over wide lands and others over +but small realms, with that one who was strong enough to make the rest +pay tribute to him as overlord, and only keeping that place by the power +of the strong hand, not for any greater worth. + +Our king on the west coast of Denmark, where the story of Havelok the +Dane must needs begin, was Gunnar Kirkeban--so called because, being a +heathen altogether, as were we all in Denmark at that time, he had been +the bane of many churches in the western isles of Scotland, and in Wales +and Ireland, and made a boast thereof. However, that cruelty of his was +his own bane in the end, as will be seen. Otherwise he was a well-loved +king and a great warrior, tall, and stronger than any man in Denmark, as +was said. His wife, the queen, was a foreigner, but the fairest of +women. Her name was Eleyn, and from this it was thought that she came +from the far south. Certainly Gunnar had brought her back from +Gardariki,[2] whither he had gone on a trading journey +one year. Gunnar and she had two daughters and but one son, and that son +was Havelok, at this time seven years old. + +Next to the king came our own lord, Jarl Sigurd, older than Gunnar, and +his best counsellor, though in the matter of sparing harmless and +helpless church folk his advice was never listened to. His hall was many +miles from the king's place, southward down the coast. + +Here, too, lived my father, Grim, with us in a good house which had been +his father's before him. Well loved by Jarl Sigurd was Grim, who had +ever been his faithful follower, and was the best seaman in all the +town. He was also the most skilful fisher on our coasts, being by birth +a well-to-do freeman enough, and having boats of his own since he could +first sail one. At one time the jarl had made him steward of his house; +but the sea drew him ever, and he waxed restless away from it. +Therefore, after a time, he asked the jarl's leave to take to the sea +again, and so prospered in the fishery that at last he bought a large +trading buss from the Frisian coast, and took to the calling of the +merchant. + +So for some years my father, stout warrior as he proved himself in many +a fight at his lord's side, traded peacefully---that is, so long as +men would suffer him to do so; for it happened more than once that his +ship was boarded by Vikings, who in the end went away, finding that they +had made a mistake in thinking that they had found a prize in a harmless +trader, for Grim was wont to man his ship with warriors, saying that +what was worth trading was worth keeping. I mind me how once he came to +England with a second cargo, won on the high seas from a Viking's +plunder, which the Viking brought alongside our ship, thinking to add +our goods thereto. Things went the other way, and we left him only an +empty ship, which maybe was more than he would have spared to us. That +was on my second voyage, when I was fifteen. + +Mostly my father traded to England, for there are few of the Saxon kin +who take ship for themselves, and the havens to which he went were +Tetney and Saltfleet, on the Lindsey shore of Humber, where he soon had +friends. + +So Grim prospered and waxed rich fast, and in the spring of the year +wherein the story begins was getting the ship ready for the first cruise +of the season, meaning to be afloat early; for then there was less +trouble with the wild Norse Viking folk, for one cruise at least. Then +happened that which set all things going otherwise than he had planned, +and makes my story worth telling. + +We---that is my father Grim, Leva my mother, my two brothers and +myself, and our two little sisters, Gunhild and Solva---sat quietly in +our great room, busy at one little thing or another, each in his way, +before the bright fire that burned on the hearth in the middle of the +floor. There was no trouble at all for us to think of more than that the +wind had held for several weeks in the southwest and northwest, and we +wondered when it would shift to its wonted springtide easting, so that +we could get the ship under way once more for the voyage she was +prepared for. Pleasant talk it was, and none could have thought that it +was to be the last of many such quiet evenings that had gone before. + +Yet it seemed that my father was uneasy, and we had been laughing at him +for his silence, until he said, looking into the fire, "I will tell you +what is on my mind, and then maybe you will laugh at me the more for +thinking aught of the matter. Were I in any but a peaceful land, I +should say that a great battle had been fought not so far from us, and +to the northward." + +Then my mother looked up at him, knowing that he had seen many fights, +and was wise in the signs that men look for before them; but she asked +nothing, and so I said, "What makes you think this, father?" + +He answered me with another question. + +"How many kites will you see overhead at any time, sons?" + +I wondered at this, but it was easy to answer---to Raven, at least. + +"Always one, and sometimes another within sight of the first," Raven said. + +"And if there is food, what then?" + +"The first swoops down on it, and the next follows, and the one that +watches the second follows that, and so on until there are many kites +gathered." + +"What if one comes late?" + +"He swings overhead and screams, and goes back to his place; then no +more come." + +"Ay," he said; "you will make a sailor yet, son Raven, for you watch +things. Now I will tell you what I saw today. There was the one kite +sailing over my head as I was at the ship garth, and presently it +screamed so that I looked up. Then it left its wide circles over the +town, and flew northward, straight as an arrow. Then from the southward +came another, following it, and after that another, and yet others, all +going north. And far off I could see where others flew, and they too +went north. And presently flapped over me the ravens in the wake of the +kites, and the great sea eagles came in screaming and went the same way, +and so for all the time that I was at the ship, and until I came home." + +"There is a sacrifice to the Asir somewhere," I said, "for the birds of +Odin and Thor have always their share." + +My father shook his head. + +"The birds cry to one another, as I think, and say when the feast is but +enough for those that have gathered. They have cried now that there is +room for all at some great feasting. Once have I seen the like before, +and that was when I was with the ship guard when the jarl fought his +great battle in the Orkneys; we knew that he had fought by the same token." + +But my mother said that I was surely right. There was no fear of battle +here, and indeed with Gunnar and Sigurd to guard the land we had had +peace for many a long year on our own coasts, if other lands had had to +fear them. My father laughed a little, saying that perhaps it was so, +and then my mother took the two little ones and went with them into the +sleeping room to put them to rest, while I and my two brothers went out +to the cattle garth to see that all was well for the night. + +Then, when our eyes were used to the moonlight, which was not very +bright, away to the northward we saw a red glow that was not that of the +sunset or of the northern lights, dying down now and then, and then +again flaring up as will a far-off fire; and even as we looked we heard +the croak of an unseen raven flying thitherward overhead. + +"Call father," I said to Withelm, who was the youngest of us three. The +boy ran in, and presently my father came out and looked long at the glow +in the sky. + +"Even as I thought," he said. "The king's town is burning, and I must go +to tell the jarl. Strange that we have had no message. Surely the king's +men must be hard pressed if this is a foe's work." + +So he went at once, leaving us full of wonder and excited, as boys will +be at anything that is new and has a touch of fear in it. But he had +hardly gone beyond the outbuildings when one came running and calling +him. The jarl had sent for him, for there was strange news from the +king. Then he and this messenger hastened off together. + +In half an hour the war horns were blowing fiercely, and all the quiet +town was awake, for my father's forebodings were true, and the foe was +on us. In our house my mother was preparing the food that her husband +should carry with him, and I was putting a last polish on the arms that +should keep him, while the tramp of men who went to the gathering rang +down the street, one by one at first, and then in twos and threes. My +mother neither wept nor trembled, but worked with a set face that would +not show fear. + +Then came in my father, and I armed him, begging at the same time that I +might go also, for I could use /my/ weapons well enough; but he told me +that some must needs bide at home as a guard, and that I was as much +wanted there as at the king's place, wherewith I had to be content. It +was by no means unlikely that we also might be attacked, if it was true +that the king's men were outnumbered, as was said. + +Now when my father went to say farewell to us, nowhere could be found my +brother Withelm. + +"The boy has gone to watch the muster," my father said. "I shall see him +there presently." + +Then, because he saw that my mother was troubled more than her wont, he +added, "Have no fear for me. This will be no more than a raid of +Norsemen, and they will plunder and be away with the tide before we get +to the place." + +So he laughed and went out, having done his best to cheer us all, and I +went with him to where the men were gathered in their arms in the wide +space in the midst of the houses. There I sought for little Withelm, but +could not find him among the women and children who looked on; and +before we had been there more than a few minutes the jarl gave the word, +and the march was begun. There were about fifteen miles to be covered +between our town and the king's. + +I watched them out of sight, and then went home, having learned that I +was to be called out only in case of need. And as I drew near the +homestead I saw a light in the little ash grove that was behind the +garth.[3] In the midst of the trees, where this light +seemed to be, was our wooden image of Thor the Hammer Bearer, older than +any of us could tell; and in front of this was what we used as his altar +---four roughly-squared stones set together. These stones were +blue-black in colour, and whence they came I do not know, unless it was +true that my forefathers brought them here when first Odin led his folk +to the northern lands. Always they had been the altar for my people, and +my father held that we should have no luck away from them. + +So it was strange to see a light in that place, where none would +willingly go after dark, and half was I feared to go and see what it +might mean. But then it came into my mind that the enemy might be +creeping on the house through the grove, and that therefore I must needs +find out all about it. So I went softly to the nearest trees, and crept +from one to another, ever getting closer to the light; and I will say +that I feared more that I might see some strange thing that was more +than mortal than that I should see the leading foeman stealing towards +me. But presently it was plain that the light did not move as if men +carried it, but it flickered as a little fire; and at last I saw that it +burned on the altar stones, and that frightened me so that I almost fled. + +Maybe I should have done so, but that I heard a voice that I knew; and +so, looking once more, I saw a figure standing before the fire, and knew +it. It was little Withelm, and why a ten-year-old boy should be here I +could not think. But I called him softly, and he started somewhat, +turning and trying to look through the darkness towards me, though he +did not seem afraid. There was a little fire of dry sticks burning on +the stones, and the gaunt old statue seemed to look more terrible than +ever in its red blaze. One might have thought that the worn face writhed +itself as the light played over it. + +"It is I, Withelm," I said softly, for the fear of the place was on me. +"We have sought you everywhere, and father would have wished you +farewell. What are you doing here?" + +I came forward then, for it was plain that the child feared nothing, so +that I was put to shame. And as I came I asked once more what he was +doing in this place. + +"The jarl has surely forgotten the sacrifice to the Asir before the +warriors went to fight, and they will be angry," he answered very +calmly. "It is right that one should remember, and I feared for father, +and therefore---" + +He pointed to the altar, and I saw that he had laid his own untasted +supper on the fire that he had lighted, and I had naught to say. The +thing was over-strange to me, who thought nothing of these things. It +was true that the host always sacrificed before sailing on the Viking +path, but tonight had been urgent haste. + +"Thor will not listen to any but a warrior," I said. "Come home, +brother, for mother waits us." + +"If not Thor, who is maybe busy at the battle they talk of, then do I +think that All Father will listen," he said stoutly. "But this was all +that I had to make sacrifice withal, and it may not be enough." + +"The jarl will make amends when he comes back," I said, wishing to get +home and away from this place, and yet unwilling to chide the child. +"Now let us go, for mother will grow anxious." + +With that he put his hand in mine, and we both saluted Thor, as was +fitting, and then went homeward. It seemed to me that the glare in the +north was fiercer now than when I had first seen it. + +Now, after my mother had put Withelm to bed, I told her how I had found +him; and thereat she wept a little, as I could see in the firelight. + +After a long silence she said, "Strange things and good come into the +mind of a child, and one may learn what his fate shall be in the days to +come. I am sure from this that Withelm will be a priest." + +Now as one may buy the place of a godar, with the right to have a temple +of the Asir for a district and the authority that goes therewith, if so +be that one falls vacant or is to be given up by the holder, this did +not seem unlikely, seeing how rich we were fast growing. And indeed my +mother's saying came to pass hereafter, though not at all in the way of +which we both thought. + +There was no alarm that night. The old warriors watched round the town +and along the northern tracks, but saw nothing, and in the morning the +black smoke hung over the place of the burning, drifting slowly seaward. +The wind had changed, and they said that it would doubtless have taken +the foe away with it, as my father had hoped. So I went down to the ship +with Raven, and worked at the few things that were still left to be done +to her as she lay in her long shed on the slips, ready to take the water +at any tide. She was only waiting for cargo and stores to be put on +board her with the shift of wind that had come at last, and I thought +that my father would see to these things as soon as he came back. + +Now in the evening we had news from the Jarl, and strange enough it was. +My father came back two days afterwards and told us all, and so I may as +well make a short story of it. The ways of Gunnar Kirkeban had been his +end, for a certain Viking chief, a Norseman, had wintered in Wales +during the past winter, and there he had heard from the Welsh of the +wrongs that they had suffered at his hands. Also he had heard of the +great booty of Welsh gold that Gunnar had taken thence in the last +summer; and so, when these Welsh asked that he would bide with them and +help fight the next Danes who came, he had offered to do more than that +---he would lead them to Gunnar's place if they would find men to man +three ships that he had taken, and would be content to share the booty +with them. + +The Welsh king was of the line of Arthur, and one who yet hoped to win +back the land of his fathers from the Saxons and English; and so he +listened to this Hodulf, thinking to gain a powerful ally in him for +attack on the eastern coast of England after this. So, favoured by the +wind that had kept us from the sea, Hodulf, with twenty ships in all, +had fallen on Gunnar unawares, and had had an easy victory, besetting +the town in such wise that only in the confusion while the wild Welsh +were burning and plundering on every side had the messenger to the jarl +been able to slip away. + +But when the jarl and our men reached the town there was naught to be +done but to make terms with Hodulf as best he might, that the whole +country might not be overrun. For Gunnar had been slain in his own hall, +with his two young daughters and with the queen also, as was supposed. +Havelok the prince was in his hands, and for his sake therefore Sigurd +had been the more ready to come to terms. + +Then Hodulf sent messengers to the overlord of all Denmark, saying that +he would hold this kingdom as for him, and backed up that promise with a +great present from Gunnar's treasure, so that he was listened to. +Therefore our jarl was helpless; and there being no other king strong +enough to aid him if he rose, in the end he had to take Hodulf for lord +altogether, though it went sorely against the grain. + +I have heard it said by the Welsh folk that Hodulf held the kingdom for +their lord; and it is likely that he humoured them by saying that he +would do so, which was a safe promise to make, as even King Arthur +himself could never have reached him to make him pay scatt. + + + CHAPTER II. KING HODULF'S SECRET. + +My father came home heavy and anxious enough, for he did not know how +things would go under this new king, though he had promised peace to all +men who would own him. We in our place saw nothing of him or his men for +the next few weeks, but he was well spoken of by those who had aught to +do with him elsewhere. So my father went on trying to gather a cargo for +England; but it was a slow business, as the burnt and plundered folk of +the great town had naught for us, and others sold to them. But he would +never be idle, and every day when weather served we went fishing, for he +loved his old calling well, as a man will love that which he can do +best. Our two boats and their gear were always in the best of order, and +our kinsman, Arngeir, used and tended them when we were away in the ship +in summertime. + +Now, one evening, as we came up from the shore after beaching the boat +on the hard below the town, and half a mile from the nearest houses, and +being, as one may suppose, not altogether in holiday trim, so that Grim +and his boys with their loads of fish and nets looked as though a +fisher's hovel were all the home that they might own, we saw a horseman, +followed at a little distance by two more, riding towards us. The dusk +was gathering, and at first we thought that this was Jarl Sigurd, who +would ask us maybe to send fish to his hall, and so we set our loads +down and waited for him. + +But it was not our lord, and I had never seen this man before. From his +arms, which were of a new pattern to me, he might be one of the host of +Hodulf, as I thought. + +"Ho, fisher!" he cried, when he was yet some way from us; "leave your +lads, and come hither. I have a word for you." + +He reined up and waited, and now I was sure that he was a Norseman, for +his speech was rougher than ours. He was a tall, handsome man enough; +but I liked neither his voice nor face, nor did I care to hear Grim, my +father, summoned in such wise, not remembering that just now a stranger +could not tell that he was aught but a fisher thrall of the jarl's. + +But my father did as he was asked, setting down the nets that he was +carrying, and only taking with him the long boathook on which he had +slung them as he went forward. I suppose he remembered the old saying, +that a man should not stir a step on land without his weapons, as one +never knows when there may be need of them; and so, having no other, he +took this. + +I heard the first questions that the man asked, for he spoke loudly. + +"Whose man are you?" + +"Sigurd's," answered my father shortly. + +"Whose are the boats?" + +"Mine, seeing that I built them." + +"Why, then, there is somewhat that you can do for me," the horseman +said. "Is your time your own, however?" + +"If the jarl needs me not." + +"Tonight, then?" + +"I have naught to do after I have carried the nets home." + +"That is well," said the stranger; and after that he dropped his voice +so that I heard no more, but he and my father talked long together. + +We waited, and at last the talk ended, and my father came hack to us, +while the stranger rode away northward along the sands. Then I asked who +the man was, and what he wanted. + +"He is some chief of these Norsemen, and one who asks more questions of +a thrall, as he thinks me, than he would dare ask Sigurd the jarl, or +Grim the merchant either, for that matter." + +Seeing that my father did not wish to say more at this time, we asked +nothing else, but went homeward in silence. It seemed as if he was ill +at ease, and he went more quickly than was his wont, so that presently +Raven and little Withelm lagged behind us with their burdens, for our +catch had been a good one. + +Then he stopped outside the garth when we reached home, and told me not +to go in yet. And when the others came up he said to them, "Do you two +take in the things and the fish, and tell mother that Radbard and I have +to go down to the ship. There is cargo to be seen to, and it is likely +that we shall he late, so bid her not wait up for us." + +Then he told me to come, and we left the two boys at once and turned +away towards the haven. There was nothing strange in this, for cargo +often came at odd times, and we were wont to work late in stowing it. I +did wonder that we had not stayed to snatch a bit of supper, but it +crossed my mind that the Norseman had told my father of some goods that +had maybe been waiting for the whole day while we were at sea. And then +that did not seem likely, for he had taken us for thralls. So I was +puzzled, but held my peace until it should seem good to my father to +tell me what we were about. + +When we reached a place where there was no house very near and no man +about, he said to me at last, "What is on hand I do not rightly know, +but yon man was Hodulf, the new king, as I suppose we must call him. He +would not tell me his name, but I saw him when he and the jarl made +terms the other day. Now he has bidden me meet him on the road a mile +from the town as soon as it is dark, and alone. He has somewhat secret +for me to do." + +"It is a risk to go alone and unarmed," I answered; "let me go home and +get your weapons, for the errand does not seem honest." + +"That is what I think also," said my father, "and that is why I am going +to meet him. It is a bad sign when a king has a secret to share with a +thrall, and I have a mind to find out what it is. There may be some plot +against our jarl." + +He was silent for a few minutes, as if thinking, and then he went on. + +"I cannot take arms, or he would suspect me, and would tell me nothing; +but if there is any plotting to be done whereof I must tell the jarl, it +will be as well that you should hear it." + +Then he said that he thought it possible for me to creep very close to +the place where he was to meet Hodulf, so that I could hear all or most +of what went on, and that I might as well be armed in case of foul play, +for he did not suppose that the Norseman would think twice about cutting +down a thrall who did not please him. + +It was almost dark by this time, and therefore he must be going. I was +not to go home for arms, but to borrow from Arngeir as we passed his +house. And this I did, saying that I had an errand beyond the town and +feared prowling men of the Norse host. Which danger being a very +reasonable one, Arngeir offered to go with me; and I had some difficulty +in preventing him from doing so, for he was like an elder brother to all +of us. However, I said that I had no great distance to go, and feigned +to be ashamed of myself for my fears; and he laughed at me, and let me +go my way with sword and spear and seax[4] also, which +last my father would take under his fisher's jerkin. + +I caught up my father quickly, and we went along the sands northwards +until we came to the place where we must separate. The road was but a +quarter of a mile inland from this spot, for it ran near the shore, and +it was not much more than that to the place where Hodulf would be waiting. + +"Creep as near as you can," my father said; "but come to help only if I +call. I do not think that I am likely to do so." + +Then we went our ways, he making straight for the road, and I turning to +my left a little. It was dark, for there was no moon now, but save that +I was soundly scratched by the brambles of the fringe of brushwood that +grew all along the low hills of the coast, there was nothing to prevent +my going on quickly, for I knew the ground well enough, by reason of +yearly bird nesting. When I reached the roadway the meeting place was +yet to my left, and I could hear my father's footsteps coming steadily +in the distance. So I skirted the road for a little way, and then came +to an open bit of heath and rising land, beyond which I thought I should +find Hodulf. Up this I ran quickly, dropping into the heather at the +top; and sure enough, in a hollow just off the road I could dimly make +out the figure of a mounted man waiting. + +Then my father came along the road past me, and I crawled among the tall +heather clumps until I was not more than twenty paces from the hollow, +which was a little below me. + +Hodulf's horse winded me, as I think, and threw up its head snorting, +and I heard its bit rattle. But my father was close at hand, and that +was lucky. + +"Ho, fisher, is that you?" he called softly. + +"I am here," was the answer, and at once my father came into the hollow +from the road. + +"Are any folk about?" Hodulf said. + +"I have met none. Now, what is all this business?" answered my father. + +"Business that will make a free man of you for the rest of your days, +and rich, moreover, master thrall," said Hodulf. "That is, if you do as +I bid you." + +"A thrall can do naught else than what he is bidden." + +"Nay, but he can do that in a way that will earn great reward, now and +then; and your reward for obedience and silence thereafter in this +matter shall be aught that you like to ask." + +"This sounds as if I were to peril my life," my father said. "I know +naught else that can be worth so much as that might be." + +"There is no peril," said Hodulf scornfully; "your skin shall not be so +much as scratched---ay, and if this is well done it will know a +master's dog whip no more." + +I heard my father chuckle with a thrall's cunning laugh at this, and +then he said eagerly, "Well, master, what is it?" + +"I will tell you. But first will you swear as on the holy ring that of +what you shall do for me no man shall know hereafter?" + +"What I do at your bidding none shall know, and that I swear," answered +my father slowly, as if trying to repeat the king's words. + +"See here, then," said Hodulf, and I heard his armour clatter as he +dismounted. + +Then the footsteps of both men shuffled together for a little while, and +once I thought I heard a strange sound as of a muffled cry, at which +Hodulf muttered under his breath. I could see that they took something +large from the saddle bow, and set it on the ground, and then they spoke +again. + +"Have you a heavy anchor?" asked the king. + +"A great one." + +"Well, then, tie it to this sack and sink it tonight where tide will +never shift it. Then you may come to me and claim what reward you will." + +"Freedom, and gold enough to buy a new boat---two new boats!" said my +father eagerly. + +Hodulf laughed at that, and got on his horse again. I saw his tall form +lift itself against the dim sky as he did so. + +"What is in the sack?" asked my father. + +"That is not your concern," Hodulf answered sharply. "If you know not, +then you can tell no man, even in your sleep. Put off at once and sink it." + +"It is in my mind," said my father, "that I had better not look in the +sack. Where shall I find you, lord, when the thing is in the sea? For as +yet I have not heard your name." + +I think that Hodulf had forgotten that he would have to answer this +question, or else he thought that everyone knew him, for he did not +reply all at once. + +"You may ask the king for your reward," he said, after a little thought, +"for this is his business. Now you know that it will be best for you to +be secret and sure. Not much worth will your chance of escape from +torture be if this becomes known. But you know also that the reward is +certain." + +"The king!" cried my father, with a sort of gasp of surprise. + +I could almost think that I saw him staring with mouth agape as would a +silly thrall; for so well had he taken the thrall's part that had I not +known who was speaking all the time, I had certainly had no doubt that +one was there. + +"Come to Hodulf, the king, and pray for freedom and your gold as a boon +of his goodness, saying naught else, or making what tale you will of a +hard master, or justice, so that you speak naught of what you have done, +and that---and maybe more---shall be granted." + +"You yourself will speak for me?" + +"I am the king---and think not that the darkness will prevent my +knowing your face again," Hodulf replied. + +There was a threat in the words, and with them he turned his horse and +rode away quickly northwards. I heard the hoofs of his men's horses +rattle on the road as they joined him, before he had gone far. + +When the sounds died away altogether, and there was no fear of his +coming back suddenly on us, my father whistled and I joined him. He +almost started to find how near I was. + +"You have heard all, then?" he said. + +"Every word," I answered, "and I like it not. Where is this sack he +spoke of?" + +It lay at his feet. A large sack it was, and full of somewhat heavy and +warm that seemed to move a little when I put my hand on it. Still less +did I like the business as I felt that. + +"More also!" quoth my father, as if thinking of the king's last words. +"If that does not mean a halter for my neck, I am mistaken. What have we +here, son, do you think?" + +"Somewhat that should not be here, certainly," I answered. "There would +not be so much talk about drowning a dog, as one might think this to be." + +"Unless it were his wife's," answered my father, with a laugh. + +Then he stooped, and I helped him to get the sack on his shoulders. It +was heavy, but not very---not so heavy as a young calf in a sack would +be; and he carried it easily, taking my spear to help him. + +"The thrall is even going to take this to the house of Grim the +merchant, whom the king will not know again, though he may see in the +dark," said he; "then we shall know how we stand." + +We met no one on our way back, for the town had gone to sleep, until the +watchman passed the time of night with us, thinking no doubt that we had +fish or goods in the burden. And when we came home a sleepy thrall +opened to us, for all were at rest save him. And he too went his way to +the shed where his place was when he had stirred the fire to a blaze and +lit a torch that we might see to eat the supper that was left for us. + +Then we were alone, and while I set Arngeir's weapons in a corner, my +father put down the sack, and stood looking at it. It seemed to sway a +little, and to toss as it settled down. And now that there was light it +was plain that the shape of what was inside it was strangely like that +of a child, doubled up with knees to chin, as it showed through the sacking. + +"Hodulf or no Hodulf," said my father, "I am going to see more of this." + +With that he took a knife from the table and cut the cord that fastened +the mouth, turning back the sack quickly. + +And lo! gagged and bound hand and foot in such wise that he could not +move, in the sack was a wondrously handsome boy of about the size of +Withelm; and for all his terrible journey across the king's saddle, and +in spite of our rough handling, his eyes were bright and fearless as he +looked up at us. + +"Radbard," said my father, "what if Hodulf had met with a thrall who had +done his bidding in truth?" + +I would not think thereof, for surely by this time there had been no +light in the eyes that seemed to me to be grateful to us. + +Now my father knelt down by the boy's side, and began to take the +lashings from him, telling him at the same time to be silent when the +gag was gone. + +And hard work enough the poor child had to keep himself from screaming +when his limbs were loosed, so cramped was he, for he had been bound +almost into a ball. And even as we rubbed and chafed the cold hands and +feet he swooned with the pain of the blood running freely once more. + +"This is a business for mother," said my father, on that; "get your +supper, and take it to bed with you, and say naught to the boys in the +morning. This is a thing that may not be talked of." + +Now I should have liked to stay, but my father meant what he said, and I +could be of no more use; so I took my food, and went up to the loft +where we three slept, and knew no more of what trouble that night might +have for others. + + + CHAPTER III. HAVELOK, SON OF GUNNAR. + +Now after I had gone, Grim, my father, tried to bring the child round, +but he could not do so; and therefore, leaving him near the fire, he +went softly to call Leva, my mother, to help him; and all the while he +was wondering who the child might be, though indeed a fear that he knew +only too well was growing in his heart, for there would surely he only +one whom Hodulf could wish out of his way. + +As he opened the door that led to the sleeping room beyond the high +seat, the light shone on Leva, and showed her sitting up in bed with +wide eyes that seemed to gaze on somewhat that was terrible, and at +first he thought her awake. But she yet slept, and so he called her +gently, and she started and woke. + +"Husband, is that you?" she said. "I had a strange dream even now which +surely portends somewhat." + +Now, as all men know, our folk in the north are most careful in the +matter of attending to dreams, specially those that come in troubled +times, holding that often warning or good counsel comes from them. I +cannot say that I have ever had any profit in that way myself, being no +dreamer at all; but it is certain that others have, as may be seen +hereafter. Wherefore my father asked Leva what this dream might be. + +"In my dream," she answered, "it seemed that you came into the house +bearing a sack, which you gave into my charge, saying that therein lay +wealth and good fortune for us. And I would not believe this, for you +said presently that to gain this the sack and all that was therein was +to be thrown into the sea, which seemed foolishness. Whereon I cast it +into a corner in anger, and thereout came pitiful cries and wailings. +Then said I that it were ill to drown aught that had a voice as of a +child, and so you bade me leave it. Then I seemed to sleep here; but +presently in my dream I rose and looked on the sack again, and lo! round +about it shone a great light, so that all the place was bright, and I +was afraid. Then you came and opened the sack, and therein was a +wondrous child, from whose mouth came a flame, as it were the shaft of a +sunbeam, that stretched over all Denmark, and across the sea to England, +whereby I knew that this child was one who should hereafter be king of +both these lands. And on this I stared even as you woke me." + +Now Grim was silent, for this was passing strange, and moreover it +fitted with his thought of who this child might be, since Hodulf. would +make away with him thus secretly. + +"What make you of the dream?" asked Leva, seeing that he pondered on it. + +"It is in my mind that your dream will come true altogether, for already +it has begun to do so," he answered. "Rise and come into the hall, and I +will show you somewhat." + +On that Leva made haste and dressed and came out, and there, lying as if +in sleep before the fire, was the wondrous child of her dream, and the +sack was under his head as he lay; and she was wont to say to those few +who knew the story, that the kingliness of that child was plain to be +seen, as had been the flame of which she had dreamed, so that all might +know it, though the clothes that he wore were such as a churl might be +ashamed of. + +Then she cried out a little, but not loudly, and knelt by the child to +see him the better; and whether he had come to himself before and had +dropped asleep for very weariness, or out of his swoon had passed into +sleep, I cannot say, but at her touch he stirred a little. + +"What child is this? and how came he here?" she asked, wondering. + +"Already your dream has told you truly how he came," Grim answered, "but +who he is I do not rightly know yet. Take him up and bathe him, wife; +and if he is the one I think him, there will be a mark whereby we may +know him." + +"How should he be marked? And why look you to find any sign thus?" + +But Grim had turned down the rough shirt and bared the child's neck and +right shoulder, whereon were bruises that made Leva well-nigh weep as +she saw them, for it was plain that he had been evilly treated for many +days before this. But there on the white skin was the mark of the king's +line---the red four-armed cross with bent ends which Gunnar and all +his forebears had borne. + +Seeing that, Leva looked up wondering in her husband's face, and he +answered the question that he saw written in her eyes. + +"He is as I thought---he is Havelok, the son of Gunnar, our king. +Hodulf gave him to me that I might drown him." + +Then he told her all that had happened, and how from the first time that +he had lifted the sack and felt what was within it he had feared that +this was what was being done. Hodulf would have no rival growing up +beside him, and as he dared not slay him openly, he would have it +thought that he had been stolen away by his father's friends, and then +folk would maybe wait quietly in hopes that he would come again when +time went on. + +Now Leva bathed Havelok in the great tub, and with the warmth and +comfort of the hot water he waked and was well content, so that +straightway, when he was dressed in Withelm's holiday clothes, which +fitted him, though he was but seven years old at this time, and Withelm +was a well-grown boy enough for his ten winters, he asked for food, and +they gave him what was yet on the board; and we lived well in Denmark. + +"There is no doubt that he hath a kingly hunger," quoth Grim as he +watched him. + +"Friend," said Havelok, hearing this, though it was not meant for his +ears, "it is likely, seeing that this is the third day since I have had +food given me. And I thank you, good people, though I would have you +know that it is the custom to serve the king's son kneeling." + +"How should we know that you are the king's son indeed?" asked Grim. + +"I am Havelok, son of Gunnar," the boy said gravely. "Yon traitor, +Hodulf, has slain my father, and my two sisters, and driven out my +mother, whither I cannot tell, and now he would drown me." + +Then the boy could hardly keep a brave front any longer, and he added, +"Yet I do not think that you will do to me as I heard him bid you." + +Then came over Grim a great pity and sorrow that it should seem needful +thus to sue to him, and there grew a lump in his throat, so that for a +while he might not answer, and the boy thought him in doubt, so that in +his eyes there was a great fear. But Leva wept outright, and threw +herself on her knees beside him, putting her arms round him as he sat, +speaking words of comfort. + +Then Grim knelt also, and said, "Thralls of yours are we, Havelok, son +of Gunnar, and for you shall our lives be given before Hodulf shall harm +you. Nor shall he know that you live until the day comes when you can go +to him sword in hand and helm on head, with half the men of this realm +at your back, and speak to him of what he did and what he planned, and +the vengeance that shall be therefor." + +So Grim took on himself to be Havelok's foster-father, and, as he ended, +the boy said with glowing eyes, "I would that I were grown up. How long +shall this be before it comes to pass?" + +And then of a sudden he said, as a tired child will, "Friends, I am +sorely weary. Let me sleep." + +So Leva took him in her arms and laid him in their own bed; and at once +he slept, so that she left him and came back to Grim by the fireside, +for there was much to be said. + +First of all it was clear that Havelok must be hidden, and it was not to +be supposed that Hodulf would be satisfied until he had seen the thrall +to whom he had trusted such a secret come back for his reward. If he +came not he would be sought; and then he would find out to whom he had +spoken, and there would be trouble enough. + +But it seemed easy to hide Havelok on board the ship, and sail with him +to England as soon as possible. A few days might well pass before a +thrall could get to Hodulf, so that he would suspect nothing just at +first. There were merchants in England who would care for the boy well, +and the two boats might be sunk, so that the king should not ask whose +they were. So when Grim came home again the fisher would be thought of +as drowned on his errand, and Hodulf would be content. + +But then, after a little talk of this, it was plain that all the town +could not be told to say that the fisher was drowned on such a night, +and Hodulf would leave naught undone to find the truth of the matter. So +the puzzle became greater, and the one thing that was clear was that +Grim was in sore danger, and Havelok also. + +Then suddenly outside the dogs barked, and a voice which they obeyed +quieted them. Grim sprang for his axe, which hung on the wall, and went +to the door, whereon someone was knocking gently. + +"Open, uncle; it is I, Arngeir." + +"What does the boy want at this time?" said Grim, taking down the great +bar that kept the door, axe in hand, for one must be cautious in such +times as these. + +Arngeir came in---a tall young man of twenty, handsome, and like Grim +in ways, for he was his brother's son. + +"Lucky am I in finding you astir," he said. "I thought I should have had +to wake you all. Are you just home from sea, or just going out?" + +"Not long home," answered Leva; "but what has brought you?" + +"I have a guest for you, if I may bring one here at this hour." + +"A friend of yours never comes at the wrong time," Grim said. "Why not +bring him in?" + +"If it were a friend of mine and a man he would do well enough at my +house for the night," said Arngeir, smiling; "but the one for whom I +have come is a lady, and, I think, one in sore trouble." + +"Who is she?" asked my mother, wondering much. + +"From the king's town, certainly," answered Arngeir, "but I do not know +her name. Truth to tell, I forgot to ask it, for she is sorely spent; +and so I made haste to come to you." + +Then Leva would know how a lady came at this time to Arngeir's house, +for he was alone, save for his four men, being an orphan without other +kin beside us, and his house was close to our shipyard and the sea. + +"She came not to me, but I found her," he replied. "My horse is sick, +and I must get up an hour ago and see to it for the second time tonight. +Then as I came from the stable I saw someone go towards the shipyard, +and, as I thought, into the open warehouse. It was dark, and I could not +tell then if this was man or woman; but I knew that no one had business +there, and there are a few things that a thief might pick up. So I took +an axe and one of the dogs, and went to see what was on hand, but at +first there was naught to be found of anyone. If it had not been for the +dog, I think that I should have gone away, but he went into the corner +where the bales of wool are set, and there he whined strangely, and when +I looked, there was this lady on the bales, and she was weeping and sore +afraid. So I asked her what was amiss, and it was not easy to get an +answer at first. But at last she told me that she had escaped from the +burning of the king's town, and would fain be taken across the sea into +some place of peace. So I cheered her by saying that you would surely +help her; and then I took her to my house and came to you. Worn and rent +are her garments, but one may see that they have been rich, and I deem +her some great lady." + +"Go and bring her here, husband," said my mother, on hearing that. + +But he was already going, and at once he and Arngeir went out and down +the street. There were many other ladies and their children who had +taken refuge here with the townsfolk after the burning, and the coming +of this one was but another count in the long tale of trouble that began +on the Welsh shore with the ways of Gunnar, the church's bane. + +My father was long gone, and the day was breaking when he came back. My +mother slept in the great chair before the fire, for waiting had wearied +her, but she woke as she heard Grim's footstep, and unbarred the door to +him, ready to welcome the guest that she looked for. But he was alone, +and on his face was the mark of some new trouble, and that a great one. + +He came in and barred the door after him, and then sat down wearily and +ate for the first time since we had had our meal at sea; and while he +did so Leva asked him nothing, wondering what was wrong, but knowing +that she would hear in good time. And when he had eaten well he spoke. + +"The lady is Eleyn the queen. She has been wandering for these many days +from place to place, sometimes in the woods, and sometimes in hiding in +the cottages of the poor folk, always with a fear of staying in one +place, lest Hodulf should find her, for it is known that he is seeking +her. Then at last one told her of my ship, and she is here to seek me." + +Now one may know what the wonder and pity of my mother was, and she +would fain have gone to her. But Grim had left her at Arngeir's house, +for folk were stirring in the town, and there were many who would know +the queen if they saw her. + +"It will soon be known that Arngeir has a guest," my mother said, +"whereas none would have wondered had she been here." + +"By this time tomorrow it will not matter if Hodulf knows," answered +Grim, "for she will be safe." + +"Where will you hide her then and what of Havelok?" + +"For those two there is no safety but across the sea, and they are the +most precious cargo that I shall ever have carried. Already Arngeir and +the men are at work on the ship, getting the rollers under her keel, +that she may take the water with the next tide. I shall sail with the +tide that comes with the darkness again, saying that I shall find cargo +elsewhere in other ports, as I have done once before." + +"I had not looked to say farewell to you quite so soon," my mother said; +"but this is right. Now I will have all things ready, that the queen +shall be in what comfort she may on the voyage. But it will be well that +none shall know, even of your seamen, who the passengers are, else will +word go to Hodulf in some way hereafter that Havelok has escaped." + +"I have thought of that," answered Grim. "It will be best that none, not +even Radbard, shall know who this is whom we have in the house. A chance +word goes far sometimes." + +"The boy will tell his name." + +"There are many who are named after him, and that is no matter. Do you +speak to him, for it is plain that he has sense enough, and bid him say +naught but that he and his mother have escaped from the town, and, if +you will, that he escaped in the sack. I will speak to Radbard, and +there will be no trouble. Only Arngeir must know the truth, and that not +until we are on the high seas perhaps." + +So there seemed to be no more fear, and in an hour the house was astir, +and there was work enough for all in preparing for the voyage. As for +me, I went down to the ship with my father, and worked there. + +Now, I will say that not for many a long year did I know who this +foster-brother of mine was. It was enough for me to be told that he was +the son of some great man or other with whom Hodulf had a private feud. +Nor did I ever speak of that night's work to any, for my father bade me +not to do so. Presently I knew, of course, that the lady was Havelok's +mother; but that told me nothing, for I never heard her name. + +We worked at the ship for three hours or so, stowing the bales of wool +and the other little cargo we had; and then my father sent me to the +fishing-boats for a pair of oars belonging to the ship's boat that were +there, and, as it fell out, it was a good thing that I and not one of +the men went. When I came to the place where they were drawn up on the +beach, as we had left them last night, there was a stranger talking to +some of the fisher folk, who were working at their nets not far off; and +though another might have paid no heed to this, I, with the remembrance +of last night fresh in my mind, wondered if he was by any chance there +on an errand from Hodulf. I thought that, were I he, I should surely +send someone to know, at least, if the fisher went out last night after +I had spoken with him. So I loitered about until the man went away, +which he did slowly, passing close to me, and looking at the boats +carefully, as if he would remember them. Then I went and asked the men +to whom he had been speaking what he wanted. They said that they +wondered that he had not spoken to me, for he had been asking about my +father and of his ship, and if he took any passenger with him this +voyage. It would seem that he wanted to sail with us, from all he said. + +Certainly he had begun by asking whose boats these were, and wondered +that a merchant should go fishing at all, when there was no need for him +to do so. Also he had asked if Grim had been out last night, and they +had of course told him that he had not, for neither boat had been +shifted from the berth she had been given when we came in at dusk. + +"Ah," he had said, "well did I wot that your merchant would do no night +work," and so made a jest of the matter, saying that in his country it +were below the state of a merchant to have aught to do with a thrall's +work. He was certainly a Norseman, and they thought that I should find +him with my father. Now I thought otherwise, and also I saw that all was +known. This man was a spy of Hodulf's, and would go straight back to his +master. My father must hear of this at once; and I hurried back to the +ship, and took him aside and told him. And as I did so his face grew +grey under the tan that sea and wind had given it, and I knew not +altogether why. + +"Tell Arngeir to come to me," he said; "I am going to the jarl. Tell no +one, but go home and say to mother that I shall be with her in an hour. +Then come back and work here." + +Then he and Arngeir went to Sigurd, and told him all from the beginning. +And when the jarl heard, he was glad for the safety of the queen and of +Havelok, but he said that there was no doubt that Denmark was no place +for Grim any longer. + +"That is my thought also," said my father; "but now am I Havelok's +foster-father, and for him I can make a home across the sea, where I +will train him up for the time that shall surely come, when he shall +return and take his father's kingdom." + +"That is well," the jarl said, "but you have little time. What Hodulf +will do one cannot say, but he may come here with his men behind him to +force me to give you up, and the town will be searched for Havelok, and +both he and the queen will be lost." + +"If that is so," my father answered, "we have time enough. Two hours for +the spy to reach his master; one hour for Hodulf to hear him, and to +bethink himself; an hour for gathering his men; and four hours, at the +least, in which to get here. Eight hours, at the least, have we, and the +tide serves in six. I had thought of waiting till dark, but that is of +no use now. We may as well go, for there are true men here, who will +wait to welcome him who flies when he comes again." + +"This is a sore wrench for you and yours, good friend and faithful," +Sigurd said, "but it must be. Nevertheless I can make your loss as +little as it may be. You shall sell all that is yours to me at your own +price, that you may have the means to make a new home well, wherever you +may choose." + +At first my father would not have that, saying that there would be much +trouble on his account presently. + +But Sigurd said that, first, the trouble was not of his making at all; +and next, that if Hodulf plundered the place, it was as well to send +away as much as possible beforehand; and lastly---and this was what +touched my father most---that he must think of his charge. + +"Why, old friend, you are giving up all for Havelok, as would I. And am +I to have no share in the training of him for the days to come?" + +Therewith he waited for no more words, but went to his great chest, and +took thereout chain after chain of linked gold rings, and put them in a +canvas bag, without weighing or counting them, and gave them to Grim. + +"Lord, here is enough to buy half the town!" my father said. + +"What of that? The town is Havelok's by right, and maybe you can buy him +a village across seas with it. But give me a full quittance for my +purchase of your goods and cattle and house, that I may have right to them." + +That Grim did at once, before witnesses who were called in, none +wondering that he chose thus to secure his property while he was away, +because Hodulf might make demands on it. They did not know that any +money changed hands, and thought it formal only, and a wise thing to be +done. + +After that Grim and Arngeir took leave of the jarl, thanking him, and +they went to our house. + +There waited my mother anxiously enough, for she knew from my message +that there was somewhat new to be told, or my father had not left the +ship. Nor do I think that what was to be done was altogether a surprise +to her, for she had thought much, and knew the dangers that might crop +up. So, being very brave, she strove to make light of the trouble that +leaving her home cost her, and set about gathering the few things that +she could take. + +Now on the hearth sat Withelm, tending the fire, and he heard presently +that we were all to go to sea; and that pleased him well, for he had +ever longed to sail with his father. As for Havelok, he had waked once, +and had well eaten, and now was sleeping again. + +Then said Withelm, "When will the sacrifice to Aegir and Ran [5] +for luck on the swan's path be?" + +"Scant time have we for that," my father said, "for tide will not wait." + +"Then," said the boy, "it were well to take the stone altar with us, and +make sacrifice on board. I have heard that Aegir is wrathful and strong." + +Then my father said to Leva, "The boy is right in one thing, and that +is, that if we are to make a new home beyond the sea, the blue stones +that have belonged to our family since time untold should go with us, +else will there be no luck in this flitting." + +"What matter?" + +"West they came with us in the days of Odin, and west they shall go with +us once more," my father said. + +And there was an end of question on the matter, for presently Arngeir +came up with the team of oxen and a sled, and my father hastily cried to +Thor as in time of sudden war, and then on the sled they loaded the +stones easily. I helped, and it is certain that they were no trouble to +uproot or lift, though they were bedded in the ground and heavy. +Wherefrom we all thought that the flitting was by the will of the Norns, +and likely to turn out well. + +But in no way could we lift Thor himself. It was as if he were rooted, +and maybe he was so. Therefore we left him, but sadly. + +One may suppose that, had any noticed that Grim was taking these sacred +things with him, there would have been a talk; but as we sailed light, +none thought them aught but needed ballast; and we brought other stones +to the ship with them and afterwards. + +Of course folk did wonder at this sudden sailing of ours, but my father +made no secret of his wish to get out of the way of Hodulf, who had +taken the ships of one or two other men elsewhere, so that all thought +he feared that his would be the next to be seized, and deemed him +prudent in going. As for our own crew, they were told that it was +certain that the ship would be taken unless we went on this tide, and so +they worked well. + +Very early in the morning, and unseen, Arngeir had brought Eleyn, the +queen, on board, and she was in the cabin under the raised after deck +all the while that the bustle of making ready was going on. Only my +father went in there at any time, unless he gave the key to one of us, +for there he kept his valuables and the arms. + +Presently, when all the men were forward and busy, I got Havelok on +board unnoticed. We had kept Withelm running to and fro from ship to +house with little burdens all the morning, mightily busy; and then, when +the chance came, Havelok in Withelm's clothes, and with a bundle on his +head, came running to me. I waited by the after cabin, and I opened the +door quickly and let him in. Then he saw his mother; and how those two +met, who had thought each other lost beyond finding, I will not try to say. + +I closed the door softly and left them, locking it again, and found +Withelm close to me, and Arngeir watching to see that all went well. + +Soon after that there came a Norseman, dressed as a merchant, who talked +with my father of goods, and lading, and whither he was bound, and the +like. When he went away, he thought that he had found out that we were +for the Texel, but I do not know that he was from Hodulf. There had been +time for him to send a spy in haste, however, if he wished to watch us; +but at any rate this man heard naught of our charges. + +Then, at the last moment, my mother and the children came on board, and +at once we hauled out of the harbour. I mind that an old woman ran along +the wharf when she found that all were going, and cried that Dame Leva +had not paid for certain fowls bought of her; and my father laughed in +lightness of heart, and threw her a silver penny, so that she let us go +with a blessing. And after that it did not matter what the people +thought of this going of ours, for in an hour we were far at sea with a +fair wind on the quarter, heading south at first, that the Norseman +might see us, but when the land was dim astern, and there was no more +fear, bearing away south and west for the Humber in far-off England. + +Now that was the last I saw of Denmark for many a long year, and I knew +it must be so. But, as I have told, none but my father and mother, and +now Arngeir, knew all that we were carrying with us. + + + CHAPTER IV. ACROSS THE SWAN'S PATH. + +All that night, and during the morning of the next day, we sailed +steadily with a fresh northwest breeze that bade fair to strengthen +by-and-by. If it held, we should see the cliffs of Northumbria on our +bow tomorrow morning, and then would run down the coast to the Humber, +where my father meant to put in first. He thought to leave the queen and +Havelok with merchants whom he knew in Lindsey, and with them would stay +my mother and the little ones while he made a trading voyage elsewhere. +There would be time enough to find out the best place in which to make a +home when the autumn came, and after he had been to an English port or +two that he did not know yet. + +When half the morning was past, the sun shone out warmly, and all came +on deck from the after cabin, where the ladies and children were. Our +men knew by this time that we had passengers, flying like ourselves from +Hodulf, and therefore they were not at all surprised to see Havelok and +his mother with their mistress. None of them had ever seen either of +them before, as it happened, though I do not think that any could have +recognized the queen as she was then, wan and worn with the terror of +her long hiding. Very silent was she as she sat on deck gazing ever at +the long white wake of the ship that seemed to stretch for a little way +towards Denmark, only to fade away as a track over which one may never +go back. And silent, too, was my mother; but the children, who had no +care, were pleased with all things, and Raven and I were full of the +ways of old seamen. + +So everything went quietly until after we had our midday meal. We were +all amidships on the wide deck, except my father and Arngeir, who sat +side by side on the steersman's bench on the high poop. There was no +spray coming on board, for we were running, and the ship was very +steady. Raven and I were forward with the men, busy with the many little +things yet to be done to the rigging and such like that had been left in +the haste at last, and there was no thought but that this quiet, save +for some shift of wind maybe, would last until we saw the English shore. + +Now I do not know if my father had seen aught from the after deck, but +presently he came forward, and passed up the steps to the forecastle, +and there sat down on the weather rail, looking out to leeward for some +time quietly. I thought that maybe he had sighted some of the high land +on the Scots coast, for it was clear enough to see very far, and so I +went to see also. But there was nothing, and we talked of this and that +for ten minutes, when he said, "Look and see if you can catch sight of +aught on the skyline just aft of the fore stay as you sit." + +I looked long, and presently caught sight of something white that showed +for a moment as we heaved up on a wave, and then was gone. + +"Somewhat I saw," I said, "but it has gone. It might have been the top +of a sail." + +Then I caught a glimpse of it again, and my father saw it also, and, as +we watched, it hove up slowly until it was plain to be seen. The vessel +it belonged to was sailing in such a way as to cross our course in the +end, though she was only a few points nearer the wind than we were. It +seemed that she was swifter than ourselves, too, from the way she kept +her place on our bow. Now a merchant must needs look on every sail with +more or less distrust, as there is always a chance of meeting with +ship-plundering Vikings, though the best of them will do naught but take +toll from a trader on the high seas. So before long all our men were +watching the stranger, and soon it was plain that she was a longship, +fresh from her winter quarters. We thought, therefore, that she was not +likely to trouble about us, having no need of stores as yet, and we +being plainly in ballast only. Nor did she alter her course in any way, +but mile after mile she sailed with us, always edging up nearer as she +went, until at last we could see the men on her bows and the helmsman at +his place. + +I thought that one could hardly see a more handsome ship than she was, +fresh with new paint, and with her dragon head shining golden in the +sun. But I had seen her before, and that in no pleasant way. She was the +ship of which I have already spoken--that which we beat off two years +ago, taking their cargo of plunder by way of amends for being attacked. + +There was this difference, however, at that time, that then we had all +our men on board, and the Viking was short-handed after a fighting raid, +whereas now we had but fifteen men instead of five-and-twenty, because +in the hurry we had not had time to summon any who lived beyond the +town, and it was plain that the Viking had a full crew, maybe of sixty men. + +"It is in my mind," my father said to Arngeir, "that our old foe will +think twice before he attacks us again; but seeing whom we have to deal +with, it is as well to be ready. We might keep him off with arrows, if +he does not find out how few we are, should he make an attempt on us; +but if he boards, we must submit, and make the best bargain we can." + +So he passed word that the men were to lie down on deck, leaving only a +few to be seen, that the Viking might think us as he had known us +before; and then the arms-chests were opened, and the bows and throwing +weapons were set to hand by us boys while the men armed themselves. + +Then my father spoke to them, saying, "I do not know if this Viking will +pass us by as too hard a nut to crack, seeing that he knows of us +already; but if he does not, it will be of no use our trying to fight +him, as you can see. I would not waste your lives for naught. But it may +be that a show of force will keep him off, so we will wait under arms +until we are sure what he will do." + +Then the men broke out, saying that they had beaten this man before with +him as leader, and they were in no mind to give up without a fight. + +"Well, then," my father answered, "it is plain that you will back me, +and so I will call on you if there is need or chance. But we have the +women folk to think of now, and we must not risk aught." + +Now the longship held on her course steadily, never shifting her helm +for so much as a point. In half an hour or so we must be alongside one +another, at this rate, and that Arngeir did not altogether like the look +of, for it would seem as if she meant to find out all about us at least. +There was some little sea running, and it might be thought easier to +board us on the lee side, therefore. We could not get away from her in +any way, for even now, while she was closer hauled than we, she kept +pace with us, and had she paid off to the same course as ourselves, she +would have left us astern in a very short time. + +Presently a man swarmed up her rigging in order to look down on our +decks, and as he went up, my father bade our men crawl over to windward, +so that he should see all one gunwale lined with men, and so think that +both were, and deem that we were setting a trap for them in order to +entice them alongside by pretending to be hardly manned. At the same +time, he sent the ladies and children into the cabin, so that they might +not be seen. + +That did not please Havelok at all, for he seemed to scent a fight in +the air, and wanted weapons, that he might stand beside the other men, +asking for an axe for choice. It was all that I could do to quiet him by +saying that if there was any need of him I would call him, but that just +now we thought the Vikings would go away if they saw many warriors on +deck. Which indeed was all that we hoped, but he thought that would +spoil sport, and so hastened into the shelter. + +After that there fell a silence on us, for at any moment now we might be +hailed by the other ship. And when we were but a bow shot apart the hail +came. The two vessels were then broadside on to each other, we a little +ahead, if anything. My father was steering now, fully armed, and Arngeir +was beside him with myself. I had the big shield wherewith one guards +the helmsman if arrows are flying. + +The Viking bade us strike sail, and let him come alongside, but my +father made no answer. Still we held on, and the Viking paid off a +little, as though he were not so sure if it were wise to fall on us, as +we showed no fear of him. + +Then my father spoke to Arngeir in a stern voice that I had heard only +when we met this same ship before. + +"This will not last long. If there is one chance for us, it is to run +him down and it may be done. Our ship will stand the blow, for these +longships are but eggshells beside her. Pass the word for the men to +shoot the steersman when I give the word. Then they must run forward, +lest the Vikings climb over the bows as we strike her." + +Arngeir's eyes flashed at that, and at once he went to the men, and +there was a click and rattle as the arrows went to string, and they +gathered themselves together in readiness to leap up when the word came. +There seemed every chance that we should be upon the longship before +they knew what we were about, for we had the weather gauge. + +Now the Viking hailed again, and again bore up for us a little, whereat +my father smiled grimly, for it helped his plan. And this time, as there +was no answer, his men sent an arrow or two on board, which did no harm. + +"It is plain that we are to be taken," my father said on that, "so we +will wait no longer. Stand by, men, and one lucky shot will do all. Shoot!" + +The helm went up as he spoke, and the men leaped to their feet, raining +arrows round the two men who were at the helm, and down on the Viking we +swept with a great cheer. + +But in a moment there were four men on her after deck, and whether the +first helmsman was shot I cannot say; but I think not, for quickly as we +had borne down on her she was ready, rushing away from us, instead of +luffing helplessly, as we had expected. It would almost have seemed that +our move had been looked for. + +Ten more minutes passed while we exchanged arrow flights, and then the +longship had so gained on us that she struck sail and waited for us with +her long oars run out and ready. + +"That is all we can do," said my father, with a sort of groan. "Put up +your weapons, men, for it is no good fighting now." + +They did so, growling; and as we neared the longship, her oars took the +water, and she flew alongside of us, and a grappling hook flung deftly +from her bows caught our after gunwale, and at once she dropped astern, +and swung to its chain as to a tow line. We were not so much as bidden +to strike sail now, and the Vikings began to crowd forward in order to +board us by the stern, as the grappling chain was hove short by their +windlass. + +"Hold on," my father cried to them "we give up. Where is your chief?" + +Now the men were making way for him when a strange thing happened. Out +of the after cabin ran Havelok when he heard that word, crying that it +was not the part of good warriors to give up while they could wield +sword--words that surely he had learned from Gunnar, his father. And +after him came his mother, silent, and terrified lest he should be harmed. + +Havelok ran up the steps to my father, and the queen followed. I have +said that there was a little sea running, and this made the ships jerk +and strain at the chain that held them together fiercely, now that it +was so short. And even as the queen came to the top step, where there +was no rail, for the steps were not amidships, but alongside the +gunwale, one of these jerks came; and in a moment she was in the sea, +and in a moment also Arngeir was after her, for he was a fine swimmer. + +The Vikings cried out as they saw this, but the poor queen said no word, +nor did she ever rise again after the first time. It is likely that she +was drawn under the longship at once. + +So for a little while there was no talk of terms or fighting, but all +held their breath as they watched to see if the queen floated alongside +anywhere; but there was only Arngeir, who swam under the lee of the +Viking, and called to her men for guidance. They threw him a rope's end +as he came to the stern, and he clung to it for a little while, hoping +to see the flash of a white hood that the queen wore, over the white +wave crests: but at last he gave up, and the Vikings hauled him on +board, praising him for his swimming, as he had on his mail. + +Then the chief turned to my father, and spoke to him across the few +fathoms of water that were between the ships. + +"We meet again, Grim, as time comes round; and now I have a mind to let +you go, though I have that old grudge against you, for I think that your +wife is loss enough." + +"Not my wife, Arnvid, but a passenger--one whom I would not have lost +for all that you can take from me." + +"Well, I am glad it is no worse. But it seems that you are in ballast. +How comes it that you have no cargo for me, for you owe me one?" + +Then my father told him shortly that he had fled from Hodulf; and all +those doings were news to the Viking, so that they talked in friendly +wise, while the men listened, and the ships crept on together down the wind. + +But when all was told, save of the matter of Havelok, and who the lost +lady was, the Viking laughed shortly, and said, "Pleasant gossip, Grim, +but not business. What will you give us to go away in peace? I do not +forget that you all but ran us down just now, and that one or two of us +have arrows sticking in us which came from your ship. But that first was +a good bit of seamanship, and there is not much harm from the last." + +"Well," said my father, "it seems to me that you owe me a ship, for it +is certain that I once had that one, and gave her back to you." + +The Viking laughed. + +"True enough, and therefore I give you back your ship now, and we are +quits. But I am coming on board to see what property I can lift." + +My father shrugged his shoulders, and turned away, and at once the +Vikings hauled on the chain until their dragon head was against our +quarter, when the chief and some twenty of his men came on board. The +way in which they took off the hatches without staying to question where +they should begin told a tale of many a like plundering. + +Then, I do not know how it was rightly, for I was aft with my father, +there began a quarrel between the Vikings and our men; and though both +Grim and the chief tried to stop it, five of our few were slain +outright, and three more badly hurt before it was ended. The rest of our +crew took refuge on the fore deck, and there bided after that. The whole +fray was over in a few minutes, and it seemed that the Vikings half +expected somewhat of the sort. + +Then they took all the linen and woollen goods, and our spare sails, and +all the arms and armour from the men and from the chests to their own +ship. Only they left my father and Arngeir their war gear, saying that +it were a shame to disarm two brave men. + +Then the chief said, "Little cargo have you, friend Grim, and therefore +I am the more sure that you have store of money with you. Even flight +from Hodulf would not prevent you from taking that wherewith to trade. +So I must have it; and it rests with you whether we tear your ship to +splinters in hunting for your hiding place or not." + +"I suppose there is no help for it, but I will say that the most of what +I have is not mine," said my father. + +"Why, what matter? When one gives gold into the hands of a seafarer, one +has to reckon with such chances as this. You must needs hand it over." + +So, as there was naught else to do, Grim brought out the jarl's heavy +bag, and gave it to the chief, who whistled to himself as he hefted it. + +"Grim," he said, "for half this I would have let you go without sending +a man on board. What is this foolishness? You must have known that." + +"The gold is not mine," my father answered; "it was my hope that you +would have been content with the cargo." + +"Well, I have met with an honest man for once," the Viking said; and he +called his men, and they cast off and left us. + +But we were in no happy plight when he had gone away to the eastward on +his old course. Half our men were gone, for the wounded were of no use, +and the loss of the queen weighed heavily on us. And before long it +began to blow hard from the north, and we had to shorten sail before +there was real need, lest it should be too much for us few presently, as +it certainly would have been by the time that darkness fell, for the +gale strengthened. + +Then, added to all this, there was trouble in the cabin under the after +deck, for since his mother was lost, Havelok had spoken no word. I had +brought him down to my mother from the deck, and had left him with her, +hoping that he did not know what had happened; but now he was in a high +fever, and sorely ill. Perhaps he would have been so in any case, after +the long days of Hodulf's cruelty, but he had borne them well. A child +is apt, however, to give up, as it were, suddenly. + +So, burdened with trouble, we drove before the gale, and the only +pleasant thing was to see how the good ship behaved in it, while at +least we were on our course all the time. Therefore, one could not say +that there was any danger; and but for these other things, none would +have thought much of wind or sea, which were no worse than we had +weathered many a time before. We had sea room, and no lee shore to fear, +and the ship was stanch, and no sailor can ask for more than that. + + + CHAPTER V. STORM AND SHIPWRECK. + +The gale held without much change through the night, and then with +morning shifted a few points to the westward, which was nothing to +complain of. The sea rose, and a few rain squalls came up and passed; +but they had no weight in them, and did not keep the waves down as a +steady fall will. And all day long it was the same, and the ship fled +ever before it. There was no thought now of reaching any port we might +wish, but least of all did we think of making the Lindsey shore, which +lies open to the north and east. When the gale broke, we must find +harbour where we could; and indeed; to my father at this time all ports +were alike, as refuge from Hodulf. When darkness came again one of the +wounded men died, and Havelok was yet ill in the after cabin, so that my +mother was most anxious for him. The plunging ship was no place for a +sick child. + +Now it was not possible for us to tell how far we had run since we had +parted from the Viking, and all we knew was that we had no shore to fear +with the wind as it was, and therefore nothing but patience was needed. +But in the night came a sudden lull in the gale that told of a change at +hand, and in half an hour it was blowing harder than ever from the +northeast, and setting us down to the English coast fast, for we could +do naught but run before such a wind. It thickened up also, and was very +dark even until full sunrise, so that one could hardly tell when the sun +was above the sea's rim. + +I crept from the fore cabin about this time, after trying in vain to +sleep, and found the men sheltering under the break of the deck and +looking always to leeward. Two of them were at the steering oar with my +father, for Arngeir was worn out, and I had left him in the cabin, +sleeping heavily in spite of the noise of waves and straining planking. +Maybe he would have waked in a moment had that turmoil ceased. + +It was of no use trying to speak to the men without shouting in their +ears, and getting to windward to do that, moreover, and so I looked +round to see if there was any change coming. But all was grey overhead, +and a grey wall of rain and flying drift from the wave tops was all +round us, blotting out all things that were half a mile from us, if +there were anything to be blotted out. It always seems as if there must +be somewhat beyond a thickness of any sort at sea. But there was one +thing that I did notice, and that was that the sea was no longer grey, +as it had been yesterday, but was browner against the cold sky, while +the foam of the following wave crests was surely not so white as it had +been, and at this I wondered. + +Then I crawled aft and went to my father and asked him what he thought +of the wind and the chance of its dropping. He had had the lead going +for long now. + +"We are right off the Humber mouth, to judge by the colour of the +water," he told me, "or else off the Wash, which is more to the south. I +cannot tell which rightly, for we have run far, and maybe faster than I +know. If only one could see--" + +There he stopped, and I knew enough to understand that we were in some +peril unless a shift of wind came very soon, since the shore was under +our lee now, if by good luck we were not carried straight into the great +river itself. So for an hour or more I watched, and all the time it +seemed that hope grew less, for the sea grew shorter, as if against +tide, and ever its colour was browner with the mud of the Trent and her +sisters. + +Presently, as I clung to the rail, there seemed to grow a new sound over +and amid all those to which I had become used--as it were a low +roaring that swelled up in the lulls, and sank and rose again. And I +knew what it was, and held up my hand to my father, listening, and he +heard also. It was the thunder of breakers on a sandy coast to leeward. + +He put his whistle to his lips and called shrilly, and the men saw him +if they could not hear, and sprang up, clawing aft through the water +that flooded the waist along the rail. + +"Breakers to leeward, men," he cried "we must wear ship, and then shall +clear them. We shall be standing right into Humber after that, as I think." + +Arngeir heard the men trampling, if not the whistle, and he was with us +directly, and heard what was to be done. + +"It is a chance if the yard stands it," he said, looking aloft. + +"Ay, but we cannot chance going about in this sea, and we are too short +of men to lower and hoist again. Listen!" + +Arngeir did so, and heard for the first time the growing anger of the +surf on the shore, and had no more doubt. We were then running with the +wind on the port quarter, and it was useless to haul closer to the wind +on that tack, whereas if we could wear safely we should be leaving the +shore at once by a little closer sailing. + +"Ran is spreading her nets," said Arngeir, "but if all holds, she will +have no luck with her fishing." [6] + +Then we manned the main sheet and the guys from the great yards, but we +were all too few for the task, which needed every man of the fifteen +that we had sailed with. There was the back stay to be set up afresh on +the weather quarter for the new tack also, and three men must see to that. + +We watched my father's hand for the word, and steadily sheeted home +until all seemed to be going well. But the next moment there was a crash +and a cry, and we were a mastless wreck, drifting helplessly. Maybe some +flaw of wind took us as the head of the great sail went over, but its +power was too much for the men at guys and back stay, and they had the +tackle torn through their hands. The mast snapped six feet above the +deck, smashing the gunwales as it fell forward and overboard, but +hurting none of us. + +Then a following sea or two broke over the stern, and I was washed from +the poop, for I had been at the sheet, down to the deck, and there saved +myself among the fallen rigging, half drowned. One of the men was washed +overboard at the same time, but a bight of the rigging that was over the +side caught him under the chin, and his mates hauled him on board again +by the head, as it were. He was wont to make a jest of it afterward, +saying that he was not likely to be hanged twice, but he had a wry neck +from that day forward. + +No more seas came over us, for the wreck over the bows brought us head +to wind, though we shipped a lot of water across the decks as she rolled +in the sea. Then we rode to the drag of the fallen sail for a time, and +it seemed quiet now that there was no noise of wind screaming in rigging +above us. But all the while the thunder of the breakers grew nearer and +plainer. + +I bided where I was, for the breath was knocked out of me for the +moment. I saw my father lash the helm, and then he and the rest got the +two axes that hung by the cabin door, and came forward with them. The +mast was pounding our side in a way that would start the planking before +long, and it must be cut adrift, and by that time I could join him. + +When that was done, and it did not take long, we cleared the anchor and +cable and let go, for it was time. The sound of the surf was drowning +all else. But the anchor held, and the danger was over for the while, +and as one might think altogether; but the tide was running against the +gale, and what might happen when it turned was another matter. + +Now we got the sail on deck again, and unlaced it from the yard, setting +that in place with some sort of rigging, ready to be stepped as a mast +if the wind shifted to any point that might help us off shore. + +It may be thought how we watched that one cable that held us from the +waves and the place where they broke, for therein lay our only chance, +and we longed for the clear light that comes after rain, that we might +see the worst, at least, if we were to feel it. But the anchor held, and +presently we lost the feeling of a coming terror that had been over us, +the utmost peril being past. My father went to the after cabin now, and +though the poor children were bruised with the heavy rolling of the ship +as she came into the wind, they were all well save Havelok, and he had +fallen asleep in my mother's arms at last. + +With the turn of the tide, which came about three hours after midday, +the clouds broke, and slowly the land grew out of the mists until we +could see it plainly, though it was hardly higher than the sea that +broke over it in whirling masses of spindrift. By-and-by we could see +far-off hills beyond wide-stretching marshlands that looked green and +rich across yellow sandhills that fringed the shore. And from them we +were not a mile, and at their feet were such breakers as no ship might +win through, though, if we might wait until they were at rest, the level +sand was good for beaching at the neap tides. For we were well into +Humber mouth, and to the northward of us, across the yellow water, was +the long point of Spurn, and the ancient port of Ravenspur, with its +Roman jetties falling into decay under the careless hand of the Saxon, +under its shelter. There was no port on this southern side of the +Humber, though farther south was Tetney Haven and again Saltfleet, to +which my father had been, but neither in nor out of them might a vessel +get in a northeast gale. + +I have said that this clearness came with the turn of the tide, and now +that began to flow strongly, setting in with the wind with more than its +wonted force, for the northwest shift of the gale had kept it from +falling, as it always will on this coast. That, of course, I learned +later, but it makes plain what happened next. Our anchor began to drag +with the weight of both tide and wind, and that was the uttermost of our +dread. + +Slowly it tore through its holding, and as it were step by step at +first, and once we thought it stopped when we had paid out all the +cable. But wind and sea were too strong, and presently again we saw the +shore marks shifting, and we knew that there was no hope. The ship must +touch the ground sooner or later, and then the end would come with one +last struggle in the surf, and on shore was no man whose hand might be +stretched to drag a spent man to the land, if he won through. It would +have seemed less lonely had one watched us, but I did not know then that +no pity for the wrecked need be looked for from the marshmen of the +Lindsey shore. There was not so much as a fisher's boat of wicker and +skins in sight on the sandhills, where one might have looked to see some +drawn up. + +Now my father went to the cabin and told my mother that things were at +their worst, and she was very brave. + +"If you are to die at this time, husband," she said, "it is good that I +shall die with you. Better it is, as I think, than a sickness that comes +to one and leaves the other. But after that you will go to the place of +Odin, to Valhalla; but I whither?" + +Then spoke little Withelm, ever thoughtful, and now not at all afraid. + +"If Freya wants not a sailor's wife who is willing to fight the waves +with Grim, my father, it will be strange." + +My mother was wont to say that this saying of the child's did much to +cheer her at that time, but there is little place for a woman in the old +faiths. So she smiled at him, and that made him bold to speak of what he +had surely been thinking since the storm began. + +"I suppose that Aegir is wroth because we made no sacrifice to him +before we set sail. I think that I would cast the altar stones to him, +that he may know that we meant to do so." + +This sounds a child's thought only, and so it was; but it set my father +thinking, and in the end helped us out of trouble. + +"I have heard," my father said, "that men in our case have thrown +overboard the high-seat pillars, and have followed them to shore safely. +We have none, but the stones are more sacred yet. Overboard they shall +go, and as the boat with them goes through the surf we may learn somewhat." + +With that he hastened on deck, and told the men what he would do; and +they thought it a good plan, as maybe they would have deemed anything +that seemed to call for help from the strong ones of the sea. So they +got the boat ready to launch over the quarter, and the four stones, +being uncovered since the Vikings took our cargo, were easily got on +deck, and they were placed in the bottom of the boat, and steadied there +with coils of fallen rigging, so that they could not shift. They were +just a fair load for the boat. Then my father cried for help to the +Asir, bidding Aegir take the altar as full sacrifice; and when we had +done so we waited for a chance as a long wave foamed past us, and +launched the boat fairly on its back, so that she seemed to fly from our +hands, and was far astern in a moment. + +Now we looked to see her make straight for the breakers, lift on the +first of them, and then capsize. That first line was not a quarter of a +mile from us now. + +But she never reached them. She plunged away at first, heading right for +the surf, and then went steadily westward, and up the shore line outside +it, until she was lost to sight among the wild waves, for she was very +low in the water. + +"Cheer up, men," my father said, as he saw that; "we are not ashore yet, +nor will be so long as the tide takes that current along shore. We shall +stop dragging directly." + +And so it was, for when the ship slowly came to the place where the boat +had changed her course, the anchor held once more for a while until the +gathering strength of the tide forced it to drag again. Now, however, it +was not toward the shore that we drifted, but up the Humber, as the boat +had gone; and as we went the sea became less heavy, for we were getting +into the lee of the Spurn headland. + +Soon the clouds began to break, flying wildly overhead with patches of +blue sky and passing sunshine in between them that gladdened us. The +wind worked round to the eastward at the same time, and we knew that the +end of the gale had come. But, blowing as it did right into the mouth of +the river, the sea became more angry, and it would be worse yet when the +tide set again outwards. Already we had shipped more water than was +good, and we might not stand much more. It seemed best, therefore, to my +father that we should try to run as far up the Humber as we might while +we had the chance, for the current that held us safe might change as +tide altered in force and depth. + +So we buoyed the cable, not being able to get the anchor in this sea, +and then stepped the yard in the mast's place, and hoisted the peak of +the sail corner-wise as best we might; and that was enough to heel us +almost gunwale under as the cable was slipped and the ship headed about +up the river mouth. We shipped one or two more heavy seas as she paid +off before the wind, but we were on the watch for them, and no harm was +done. + +After that the worst was past, for every mile we flew over brought us +into safer waters; and now we began to wonder where the boat with its +strange cargo had gone, and we looked out for her along the shore as we +sailed, and at last saw her, though it was a wonder that we did so. + +The tide had set her into a little creek that opened out suddenly, and +there Arngeir saw her first, aground on a sandbank, with the lift of +each wave that crept into the haven she had found sending her higher on +it. And my father cried to us that we had best follow her; and he put +the helm over, while we sheeted home and stood by for the shock of +grounding. + +Then in a few minutes we were in a smother of foam across a little sand +bar, and after that in quiet water, and the sorely-tried ship was safe. +She took the ground gently enough in the little creek, not ten score +paces from where the boat was lying, and we were but an arrow flight +from the shore. As the tide rose the ship drifted inward toward it, so +that we had to wait only for the ebb that we might go dry shod to the land. + +Before that time came there was rest for us all, and we needed it +sorely. It was a wonder that none of the children had been hurt in the +wild tossing of the ship, but children come safely through things that +would be hard on a man. Bruised they were and very hungry, but somehow +my mother had managed to steady them on the cabin floor, and they were +none the worse, only Havelok slept even yet with a sleep that was too +heavy to be broken by the worst of the tossing as he lay in my mother's +lap. She could not tell if this heavy sleep was good or not. + +Then we saw to the wounded men, and thereafter slept in the sun or in +the fore cabin as each chose, leaving Arngeir only on watch. It was +possible that the shore folk would be down to the strand soon, seeking +for what the waves might have sent them, and the tide must be watched also. + +Just before its turn he woke us, for it was needful that we should get a +line ashore to prevent the ship from going out with the ebb, and with +one I swam ashore. There was not so much as a stump to which to make +fast, and so one of the men followed me, and we went to the boat, set +the altar stones carefully ashore, then fetched the spare anchor, and +moored her with that in a place where the water seemed deep to the bank. + +It was a bad place. For when the tide fell, which it did very fast, we +found that we had put her on a ledge. Presently therefore, and while we +were trying to bail out the water that was in her, the ship took the +ground aft, and we could not move her before the worst happened. Swiftly +the tide left her, and her long keel bent and twisted, and her planks +gaped with the strain of her own weight, all the greater for the water +yet in her that flowed to the hanging bows. The good ship might sail no +more. Her back was broken. + +That was the only time that I have ever seen my father weep. But as the +stout timbers cracked and groaned under the strain it seemed to him as +if the ship that he loved was calling piteously to him for help that he +could not give, and it was too much for him. The gale that was yet +raging overhead and the sea that was still terrible in the wide waters +of the river had been things that had not moved him, for that the ship +should break up in a last struggle with them was, as it were, a fitting +end for her. But that by his fault here in the hardly-won haven she +should meet her end was not to be borne, and he turned away from us and +wept. + +Then came my mother and set her hand on his shoulder and spoke softly to +him with wise words. + +"Husband, but a little while ago it would have been wonderful if there +were one of us left alive, or one plank of the ship on another. And now +we are all safe and unhurt, and the loss of the ship is the least of +ills that might have been." + +"Nay, wife," he said; "you cannot understand." + +"Then it is woe for the--for the one who is with us. But how had it +been if you had seen Hodulf and his men round our house, and all the +children slain that one might not escape, while on the roof crowed the +red cock, and naught was left to us? We have lost less than if we had +stayed for that, and we have gained what we sought, even safety. See, to +the shore have come the ancient holy things of our house, and that not +by your guidance. Surely here shall be the place for us that is best." + +"Ay, wife; you are right in all these things, but it is not for them." + +Then she laughed a little, forcing herself to do so, as it seemed. + +"Why, then, it is for the ship that I was ever jealous of, for she took +you away from me. Now I think that I should be glad that she can do so +no more. But I am not, for well I know what the trouble must be, and I +would have you think no more of it. The good ship has saved us all, and +so her work is done, and well done. Never, if she sailed many a long sea +mile with you, would anything be worth telling of her besides this. And +the burden of common things would surely be all unmeet for her after +what she has borne hither." + +"It is well said, Leva, my wife," my father answered. + +From that time he was cheerful, and told us how it was certain that we +had been brought here for good, seeing that the Norns[7] must have led the +stones to the haven, so that this must be the place that we sought. + + + CHAPTER VI. THE BEGINNING OF GRIMSBY TOWN. + +Easily we went ashore when the tide fell, across the spits of sand that +ran between the mud banks, and we climbed the low sandhill range that +hid the land from us, and saw the place where we should bide. And it +might have been worse; for all the level country between us and the +hills was fat, green meadow and marsh, on which were many cattle and +sheep feeding. Here and there were groves of great trees, hemmed in with +the quickset fences that are as good as stockades for defence round the +farmsteads of the English folk, and on other patches of rising ground +were the huts of thralls or herdsmen, and across the wide meadows +glittered and flashed streams and meres, above which the wildfowl that +the storm had driven inland wheeled in clouds. All the lower hills +seemed to be wooded thickly, and the alder copses that would shelter +boar and deer and maybe wolves stretched in some places thence across +the marsh. Pleasant and homely seemed all this after long looking at the +restless sea. + +Then said my father, "Now am I no longer Grim the merchant, and that +pride of mine is at an end. But here is a place where Grim the fisher +may do well enough, if I am any judge of shore and sea. Here have we +haven for the boats, and yonder swim the fish, and inland are the towns +that need them. Nor have we seen a sign of a fisher so far as we have come." + +Now we had been seen as soon as we stood on the sandhills; and before +long the herdsman and thralls began to gather to us, keeping aloof +somewhat at first, as if fearing my father's arms. But when we spoke +with them we could learn nothing, for they were Welsh marshmen who knew +but little of the tongue of their English masters. Serfs they were now +in these old fastnesses of theirs to the English folk of the +Lindiswaras, who had won their land and called it after their own name, +Lindsey. + +But before long there rode from one of the farmsteads an Englishman of +some rank, who had been sent for, as it would seem, and he came with +half a dozen armed housecarls behind him to see what was going on. Him +we could understand well enough, for there is not so much difference +between our tongue and that of the English; and when he learned our +plight he was very kindly. His name was Witlaf Stalling, and he was the +great man of these parts, being lord over many a mile of the marsh and +upland, and dwelling at his own place, Stallingborough, some five miles +to the north and inland hence. + +Now it had been in this man's power to seize us and all we had as his +own, seeing that we were cast on his shore; but he treated us as guests +rather, bidding us shelter in one of his near farmsteads as long as we +would, and telling my father to come and speak with him when we had +saved what we could from the wreck. He bade the thralls help at that +also, so that we had fallen in with a friend, and our troubles were less +for his kindness. + +We saved what cargo we had left during the next few days, while we dwelt +at the farm. Then at the height of the spring tides the ship broke up, +for a second gale came before the sea that the last had raised was gone. +And then I went with my father to speak with Witlaf the thane at +Stallingborough, that we might ask his leave to make our home on the +little haven, and there become fishers once more. + +That he granted readily, asking many questions about our troubles, for +he wondered that one who had owned so good a ship seemed so content to +become a mere fisher in a strange land, without thought of making his +way home. But all that my father told him was that he had had to fly +from the new king of our land, and that he had been a fisher before, so +that there was no hardship in the change. + +"Friend Grim," said Witlaf when he had heard this, "you are a brave man, +as it seems to me, and well may you prosper here, as once before. I will +not stand in your way. Now, if you will hold it from me on condition of +service in any time of war, to be rendered by yourself and your sons and +any men you may hire, I will grant you what land you will along the +coast, so that none may question you in anything. Not that the land is +worth aught to any but a fisher who needs a place for boats and nets; +but if you prosper, others will come to the place, and you shall be master." + +One could hardly have sought so much as that, and heartily did we thank +the kindly thane, gladly taking the fore shore as he wished. But he said +that he thought the gain was on his side, seeing what men he had won. + +"Now we must call the place by a name, for it has none," he said, +laughing. "Grim's Stead, maybe?" + +"Call the place a town at once," answered my father, laughing also. +"Grimsby has a good sound to a homeless man." + +So Grimsby the place has been from that day forward, and, as I suppose, +will be now to the end of time. But for a while there was only the one +house that we built of the timbers and planks of our ship by the side of +the haven--a good house enough for a fisher and his family, but not +what one would look for from the name. + +By the time that was built Havelok was himself again, though he had been +near to his death. Soon he waxed strong and rosy in the sea winds, and +out-went Withelm both in stature and strength. But it seemed that of all +that had happened he remembered naught, either of the storm, or of his +mother's death, or of the time of Hodulf. My mother thought that the +sickness had taken away his memory, and that it might come back in time. +But from the day we came to the house on the shore he was content to +call Grim and Leva father and mother, and ourselves were his brothers, +even as he will hold us even now. Yet my father would never take him +with us to the fishing, as was right, seeing who he was and what might +lie before him. Nor did he ever ask to go, as we had asked since we were +able to climb into the boat as she lay on the shore; and we who knew not +who he was, and almost forgot how he came to us, ceased to wonder at +this after a while; and it seemed right that he should be the +home-stayer, as if there must needs be one in every household. + +Nevertheless he was always the foremost in all our sports, loving the +weapon play best of all, so that it was no softness that kept him from +the sea. I hold that the old saw that says, "What is bred in the bone +cometh out in the flesh," is true, and never truer than in the ways of +Havelok. + +For it is not to be thought that because my father went back perforce to +the fisher's calling he forgot that the son of Gunnar Kirkeban should be +brought up always in such wise that when the time came he should be +ready to go to the slayer of his father, sword in hand, and knowing how +to use it. Therefore both Havelok and we were trained always in the +craft of the warrior. + +Witlaf the thane was right when he said that men would draw to the place +if we prospered, and it was not so long before the name that had been a +jest at first was so no longer. Truly we had hard times at first, for +our one ship's boat was all unfitted for the fishing; but the Humber +teemed with fish, and there were stake nets to be set that need no boat. +None seemed to care for taking the fish but ourselves, for the English +folk had no knowledge of the riches to be won from the sea, and the eels +of the river were the best that they ever saw. So they were very ready +to buy, and soon the name of Grim the fisher was known far and wide in +Lindsey, for my father made great baskets of the willows of the marsh, +and carried his burden of fish through the land, alone at first, until +we were able to help him, while Arngeir and we minded the nets. + +Only two of our men stayed here with us, being fishers and old comrades +of my father. The rest he bade find their way home to Denmark to their +wives and children, from the Northumbrian coast, or else take service +with the king, Ethelwald, who ruled in East Anglia, beyond the Wash, +who, being a Dane by descent from the Jutes who took part with Angles +and Saxons in winning this new land, was glad to have Danish men for his +housecarls. Some went to him, and were well received there, as we knew +long afterwards. + +The man who had been washed overboard and hauled back at risk of his +neck was one of these. His name was Mord, and he would have stayed with +us; but my father thought it hard that he should not have some better +chance than we could give him here, for it was not easy to live at +first. Somewhat of the same kind he said to Arngeir, for he had heard of +this king when he had been in the king's new haven in the Wash some time +ago. But Arngeir would by no means leave the uncle who had been as a +father to him. + +Now when we marked out the land that Witlaf gave us, there was a good +omen. My father set the four blue altar stones at each corner of the +land as the boundaries, saying that thus they would hallow all the +place, rather than make an altar again of them here where there was no +grove to shelter them, or, indeed, any other spot that was not open, +where a holy place might be. And when we measured the distances between +them a second time they were greater than at first, which betokens the +best of luck to him whose house is to be there. I suppose that they will +bide in these places now while Grimsby is a town, for, as every one +knows, it is unlucky to move a boundary stone. + +Soon my father found a man who had some skill in the shipwright's craft, +and brought him to our place from Saltfleet. Then we built as good a +boat as one could wish, and, not long after that, another. But my father +was careful that none of the Lindsey folk whom he had known should think +that this fisher was the Grim whom they had once traded with, lest word +should go to Hodulf in any way. + +Now we soon hired men to help us, and the fishing throve apace. We +carried the fish even to the great city of Lincoln, where Alsi the +Lindsey king had his court, though it was thirty miles away. For we had +men in the villages on the road who took the great baskets on from one +to another, and always Grim and one of us were there on the market day, +and men said that never had the town and court seen such fish as Grim's +before. Soon, therefore, he was rich, for a fisher; and that was heard +of by other fishers from far off, and they drew to Grimsby, so that the +town spread, and Witlaf the good thane said that it was a lucky day +which drove us to his shore, for he waxed rich with dues that they were +willing to pay. We built boats and let them out to these men, so that +one might truly say that all the fishery was Grim's. + +Then a trading ship put in, hearing of the new haven, and that was a +great day for us. But her coming made my father anxious, since Hodulf +was likely to seek for news of Grim the merchant from any who had been +to England; and hearing at last of him, he would perhaps be down on us, +Vikingwise, with fire and sword. But after that traders came and went, +and we heard naught of him except we asked for news; for he left us in +peace, if he knew that his enemy lived yet. Men said that he was not +much loved in Denmark. + +So the town grew, and well did we prosper, so that there is naught to be +said of any more trouble, which is what my story seems to be made up of +so far. Yet we had come well through all at last; and that, I suppose, +is what makes the tale of any man worth hearing. + +Twelve years went all well thus, and in those years Havelok came to +manhood, though not yet to his full strength. What that would be in a +few more summers none could tell, for he was already almost a giant in +build and power, so that he could lift and carry at once the four great +fish baskets, which we bore one at a time when full of fish, easily, and +it was he who could get a stranded boat afloat when we could hardly move +her between us, though all three of us were strong as we grew up. + +Very handsome was Havelok also, and, like many very strong men, very +quiet. And all loved him, from the children who played along the water's +edge to the oldest dame in the town; for he had a good word for all, and +there was not one in the place whom he had not helped at one time or +another. More than one there was who owed him life--either his own, or +that of a child saved from the water. + +Most of all Havelok loved my father; and once, when he was about +eighteen, he took it into his head that he was burdensome to him by +reason of his great growth. So nothing would satisfy him but that he +must go with us to the fishing, though it was against Grim's will +somewhat. But he could make no hand at it, seeing that he could pull any +two of us round if he took an oar, and being as likely as not to break +that moreover. Nor could he bear the quiet of the long waiting at the +drift nets, when hour after hour of the night goes by in silence before +the herring shoal comes in a river of blue and silver and the buoys sink +with its weight; rather would he be at the weapon play with the sons of +Witlaf, our friend, who loved him. + +But though the fishing was not for him, after a while he would not be +idle, saying, when my father tried to persuade him to trouble not at all +about our work, that it was no shame for a man to work, but, rather, +that he should not do so. So one day he went to the old Welsh basket +maker who served us, and bade him make a great basket after his own +pattern, the like of which the old man had never so much as thought of. + +"Indeed, master," he said, when it was done, "you will never be able to +carry so great a load of fish as that will hold." + +"Let us see," quoth Havelok, laughing; and with that he put him gently +into it, and lifted him into the air, and on to his mighty shoulder, +carrying him easily, and setting him down in safety. + +The basket maker was cross at first, but none was able to be angry with +Havelok long, and he too began to smile. + +"It is 'curan' that you are, master," he said; "not even Arthur himself +could have done that." + +"Many times have I heard your folk call me that. I would learn what it +means," said Havelok. + +But the old man could hardly find the English word for the name, which +means "a wonder," and nothing more. Nevertheless the marsh folk were +wont to call their friend "Hablok Curan" in their talk, for a wonder he +was to all who knew him. + +So he came home with his great basket, and said, "Here sit I by the +fire, eating more than my share, and helping to win it not at all. Now +will I make amends, for I will go the fisher's rounds through the +marshlands with my basket, and I think that I shall do well." + +Now my father tried to prevent him doing this, because, as I know now, +it was not work for a king's son. But Havelok would not be denied. + +"Fat and idle am I, and my muscles need hardening," he said. "Let me go, +father, for I was restless at home." + +So from that time he went out into the marshland far and wide, and the +people grew to know and love him well. Always he came back with his fish +sold, and gave money and full account to my father, and mostly the +account would end thus: + +"Four fish also there were more, but the burden was heavy, and so I even +gave them to a certain old dame." + +And my mother would say, "It is likely that the burden was lighter for +her blessing." + +And, truly, if the love of poor folk did help, Havelok's burden weighed +naught, great though it was. + +Yet we thought little of the blessings of the Welsh folk of the marsh in +those days, for they blessed not in the names of the Asir, being sons of +the British Christians of long ago, and many, as I think, Christians +yet. Witlaf and all the English folk were Odin's men, as we were, having +a temple at the place called Thor's Way, among the hills. But we had +naught to do with the faith of the thralls, which was not our business. +Only Withelm was curious in the matter, and was wont to ask them thereof +at times, though at first they feared to tell him anything, seeing how +the Saxons and English had treated the Christian folk at their first +coming. But that was forgotten now, by the English at least, and times +were quiet for these poor folk. There was a wise man, too, of their +faith, who lived in the wild hills not far from the city, and they were +wont to go to him for advice if they needed it. They said also that the +king of Lindsey had once been a Christian, for he was Welsh by birth on +his mother's side, and had been so brought up. It is certain that his +sister Orwenna, who married Ethelwald of East Anglia, was one, but I +have seen Alsi the king at the feasts of the Asir at Thor's Way when +Yuletide was kept, so it is not so certain about him. He had many Welsh +nobles about him at the court, kinsmen of his mother mostly, so that it +did not seem strange, though there is not much love lost between the +English and the folk whom they conquered, as one might suppose. + +Now, as I have said, none but Withelm thought twice about these things; +but in the end the love of the marsh folk was a thing that was needed, +and that Withelm had learned somewhat of their faith was the greatest +help that could be, as will be seen. + + + CHAPTER VII. BROTHERHOOD. + +True are the words of the Havamal, the song of the wisdom of Odin, which +say, "One may know and no other, but all men know if three know." + +Therefore for all these years my father told none of us the secret of +Havelok's birth; and when Arngeir married my sister Solva he made him +take oath that he would not tell what he knew to her, while she, being +but a child at the time of the flight, had forgotten how this well-loved +brother of hers came to us. But it happened once that Grim was sick, and +it seemed likely that he would die, so that this secret weighed on him, +and he did not rightly know what to do for the best, Havelok at the time +being but seventeen, and the time that he should think of his own place +not being yet come. At that time he told Arngeir all that he foresaw, +and set things in order, that we three should not be backward when need was. + +He called us to him, Havelok not being present, and spoke to us. + +"Sons," he said, "well have you all obeyed me all these years, and I +think that you will listen to me now, for I must speak to you of +Havelok, who came to us as you know. Out of his saving from his foes +came our flight here; and I will not find fault with any of the things +that happened, for they have turned out well, save that it seems that I +may never see the land of my birth again, and at times I weary for it. +For me Denmark seems to lie within the four square of the ancient +stones; but if you will do my bidding, you and Havelok shall see her +again, though how I cannot tell." + +Then I could hardly speak for trouble, but Withelm said softly, "As we +have been wont to do, father, so it shall be." + +"Well shall my word be kept, therefore," Grim said, smiling on us. +"Listen, therefore. In the days to come, when time is ripe, Arngeir +shall tell you more of Havelok your foster-brother, and there will be +signs enough by which he shall know that it is time to speak. And then +Havelok will need all the help that you can give him; and as your lord +shall you serve him, with both hands, and with life itself if need be. +And I seem to see that each of you has his place beside him--Radbard +as his strong helper, and Raven as his watchful comrade, and Withelm as +his counsellor. For 'Bare is back without brother behind it,' son +Radbard and 'Ere one goes out, give heed to the doorways,' son Raven; +and 'Wisdom is wanted by him who fares widely' son Withelm. So say the +old proverbs, and they are true. No quarreller is Havelok; but if he +must fight, that will be no playground. Careful is he; but he has met +with no guile as yet, and he trusts all men. Slow to think, if sure, are +so mighty frames as his becomes, even when quick wit is needed." + +He was silent for a while, and I thought that he had no more to say, and +I knew that he had spoken rightly of what each was best fitted for, but +he went on once more. + +"This is my will, therefore, that to you shall Havelok be as the eldest +brother from this time forward, that these places shall not have to come +suddenly to you hereafter. Then will you know that I have spoken +rightly, though maybe it seems hard to Radbard and Raven now, they being +so much older." + +Then I said truly that already Havelok was first in our hearts. And that +was true, for he was as a king among us--a king who was served by all +with loving readiness, and yet one who served all. Maybe that is just +what makes a good king when all is said and done. + +Then my father bade us carry him out of the house and down to the shore +where there was a lonely place in the sandhills, covered with the sweet, +short grass that the sheep love; and, while Raven and I bore him, +Withelm went and brought Havelok. + +"This is well, father," he said gladly. "I had not thought you strong +enough to come thus far." + +"Maybe it is the last time that I come living out of the house," Grim +said; "but there is one thing yet to be done, and it must be done here. +See, son Havelok, these are your brothers in all but blood, and they +must be that also in the old Danish way." + +"Nothing more is needed, father," Havelok said, wondering. "I have no +brothers but these of mine, and they could be no more so." + +Thereat my father smiled, as well content, but he said that the ancient +way must he kept. + +"But I am sorely weak," he added. "Fetch hither Arngeir." + +It was because of this illness that none of us were at the fishing on +that day, and Arngeir was not long in coming. And while we waited for +that little while my father was silent, looking ever northward to the +land that he had given up for Havelok; and I think that foster-son of +his knew it, for he knelt beside him and set his strong arm round him, +saying nothing. So Arngeir came with Raven, who went for him, and my +father told him what he needed to be done; and Arngeir said that it was +well thought of, and went to work with his seax on the smooth turf. + +He cut a long strip where it seemed to be toughest, leaving the ends yet +fast, and carefully he raised it and stretched it until it would make an +arch some three spans high, and so propped it at either end with more +turf that it stayed in that position. + +Then my father said, "This is the old custom, that they who are of +different family should be brothers indeed. Out of one earth should they +be made afresh, as it were, that on the face of earth they shall be one. +Pass therefore under the arch, beginning with Havelok." + +Then, while my father spoke strange and ancient runes, Havelok did as he +was bidden, kneeling down and creeping under the uplifted turf; and as I +came after him he gave me his hand and raised me, and so with each of +the other two. And then, unbidden, Arngeir followed, for he too loved +Havelok, and would fain be his brother indeed. + +After that my father took a sharp flint knife that he had brought with +him, and with it cut Havelok's arm a little, and each of us set his lips +to that wound, and afterwards he to the like marks in our right arms, +and so the ancient rite was complete. + +Yet it had not been needed, as I know, for not even I ever thought of +him but as the dearest of brothers, though I minded how he came. + +Now after this my father grew stronger, maybe because this was off his +mind; but he might never go to sea again, nor even to Lincoln town, for +he was not strong enough. What his illness was I do not rightly know, +hut I do not think that any one here overlooked him, though it might be +that from across the sea Hodulf had power to work him harm. It was said +that he had Finnish wizards about his court; but if that was so, he +never harmed the one whom he had most to fear--even Havelok. But then +I suppose that even a Finn could not harm one for whom great things are +in store. + +So two years more passed over, and then came the time of which one +almost fears to think--the time of the great famine. Slowly it came on +the land; but we could see it coming, and the dread of it was fearsome, +but for the hope that never quite leaves a man until the end. For first +the wheat that was winter sown came not up but in scattered blades here +and there, and then ere the spring-sown grain had lain in the land for +three weeks it had rotted, and over the rich, ploughed lands seemed to +rise a sour smell in the springtime air, when one longs for the +sweetness of growing things. And then came drought in April, and all day +long the sun shone, or if it were not shining the clouds that hid it +were hard and grey and high and still over land and sea. + +Then before the marsh folk knew what they were doing, the merchants of +Lincoln had bought the stored corn, giving prices that should have told +men that it was precious to those who sold as to the buyers; and then +the grass failed in the drought, and the farmers were glad to sell the +cattle and sheep for what they could gain, rather than see them starve. + +Then my father bade us dry and store all the fish we might against the +time that he saw was coming, and hard we worked at that. And even as we +toiled, from day to day we caught less, for the fish were leaving the +shores, and we had to go farther and farther for them, until at last a +day came when the boats came home empty, and the women wept at the shore +as the men drew them up silently, looking away from those whom they +could feed no longer. + +That was the worst day, as I think, and it was in high summer. I mind +that I went to Stallingborough that day with the last of the fresh fish +of yesterday's catch for Witlaf's household, and it was hotter than +ever; and in all the orchards hung not one green apple, and even the +hardy blackberry briers had no leaves or sign of blossom, and in the +dikes the watercress was blackened and evil to see. + +But I will say that in Grimsby we felt not the worst, by reason of that +wisdom of my father, and always Witlaf and his house shared with us. +Hard it was here, but elsewhere harder. + +And then came the pestilence that goes with famine always. I have heard +that men have prayed to their gods for that, for it has seemed better to +them to die than live. + +With the first breath of the pestilence died Grim my father, and about +that I do not like to say much. He bade us remember the words he had +spoken of Havelok our brother, and he spoke long to Arngeir in private +of the same; and then he told us to lay him in mound in the ancient way, +but with his face toward Denmark, whence we came. And thereafter he said +no more, but lay still until there came up suddenly through the thick +air a thunderstorm from the north; and in that he passed, and with his +passing the rain came. + +Thereof Withelm said that surely Odin fetched him, and that at once he +had made prayer for us. But the Welsh folk said that not Odin but the +White Christ had taken the man who had been a father to them, and had +staved off the worst of the famine from them. + +Then pined and died my mother Leva, for she passed in her sleep on the +day before we made the mound over her husband, and so we laid them in it +together, and that was well for both, as I think, for so they would have +wished. + +So we made a great bale fire over my father's mound, where it stood over +the highest sandhill; and no warrior was ever more wept, for English and +Welsh and Danes were at one in this. We set his weapons with him, and +laid him in the boat that was the best--and a Saxon gave that--and +in it oars and mast and sail, and so covered him therein. And so he +waits for the end of all things that are now, and the beginning of those +better ones that shall be. + +That thunderstorm was nothing to the land, for it skirted the shores and +died away to the south, and after it came the heat again; but at least +it brought a little hope. There were fish along the shore that night, +too, if not many; and though they were gone again in the morning, there +was a better store in every house, for men were mindful of Grim's teaching. + +Now, of all men, Havelok seemed to feel the trouble of the famine the +most, because he could not bear to see the children hungry in the +cottages of the fishers. It seemed to him that he had more than his +share of the stores, because so mighty a frame of his needed feeding +mightily, as he said. And so for two days after my father died and was +left in his last resting, Havelok went silent about the place. Here by +the shore the pestilence hardly came, and so that trouble was not added +to us, though the weak and old went, as had Grim and Leva, here and there. + +Then, on the third day, Havelok called Arngeir and us, and spoke what +was in his mind. + +"Brothers, I may not bear this any longer, and I must go away. I can do +no more to help than can the weakest in the town; and even my strength +is an added trouble to those who have not enough without me. Day by day +grows the store in the house less; and it will waste more slowly if I am +elsewhere." + +Then Arngeir said quickly, "This is foolishness, Havelok, my brother. +Whither will you go? For worse is the famine inland; and I think that we +may last out here. The fish will come back presently." + +"I will go to Lincoln. All know that there is plenty there, for the +townsfolk were wise in time. There is the court, and at the court a +strong man is likely to be welcome, if only as one who shall keep the +starving poor from the doors, as porter." + +He spoke bitterly, for Alsi, the king, had no good name for kindness, +and at that Withelm laughed sadly. + +"Few poor would Havelok turn away," he said, under his breath; "rather +were he likely to take the king's food from the very board, and share it +among them." + +That made us laugh a little, for it was true enough; and one might seem +to see our mighty one sweeping the table, while none dared try to stay him. + +But many times of late Havelok had gone dinnerless, that he might feed +some weak one in the village. Maybe some of us did likewise; but, if so, +we learned from him. + +"Well, then," Havelok said, when we had had our wretched laugh, "Alsi, +the king, can better afford to feed me than can anyone else. Therefore, +I will go and see about it. And if not the king, then, doubtless, some +rich merchant will give me food for work, seeing that I can lift things +handily. But Radbard here is a great and hungry man also, and it will be +well that he come with me; or else, being young and helpless, I may fall +into bad hands." + +So he spoke, jesting and making little of the matter. But I saw that he +was right, and that we who were strong to take what might come should go +away. It was likely that a day of our meals would make a week's fare for +Arngeir's three little ones, and they were to be thought for. + +Now for a little while Arngeir tried to keep us back; but it was plain +that he knew also that our going was well thought of, and only his care +for Havelok stood in the way. Indeed, he said that I and Raven might go. + +"Raven knows as much about the fish as did our father," Havelok said. +"He will go out in the morning, and look at sky and sea, and sniff at +the wind; and if I say it will be fine, he says that the herrings will +be in such a place; and so they are, while maybe it rains all day to +spite my weather wisdom. You cannot do without Raven; for it is ill to +miss any chance of the sea just now. Nor can Withelm go, for he knows +all in the place, and who is most in want. It will not do to be without +house steward. So we two will go. Never have I been to Lincoln yet, and +Radbard knows the place well." + +I think that I have never said that Grim would never take Havelok to the +city, lest he should be known by some of the Danish folk who came now +and then to the court, some from over seas, and others from the court of +King Ethelwald, of whom I have spoken, the Norfolk king. But that danger +was surely over now, for Havelok would be forgotten in Denmark; and +Ethelwald was long dead, and his wife also, leaving his daughter +Goldberga to her uncle Alsi, as his ward. So Alsi held both kingdoms +until the princess was of age, when she would take her own. It was said +that she lived at Dover until that time, and so none of her Danes were +likely to be at court if we went there and found places. + +So Havelok's plan was to be carried out, and he and I were to set forth +next morning. Arngeir was yet uneasy about it, nevertheless, as one +could see; but I did not at that time know why it should be so doubtful +a matter that two strong men should go forth and seek their fortune but +thirty miles away. So we laughed at him. + +"Well," he said, "every one knows Radbard; but they will want to know +who his tall comrade may be. Old foes has Havelok, as Radbard knows, and +therefore it may be well to find a new name for him." + +"No need to go far for that," Withelm said. "The marsh folk call him Curan." + +"Curan, the wonder, is good," Arngeir said, after a little thought, for +we all knew Welsh enough by this time. "Or if you like a Danish name +better, brother, call it 'Kwaran,' but silent about yourself you must +surely be." + +We used to call him that at times--for it means "the quiet" in our old +tongue--seeing how gentle and courtly he was in all his ways. So the +name was well fitting in either way. + +"Silent and thoughtful should the son of a king be," says the Havamal, +and so it was with Havelok, son of Gunnar. + +Now when I came to think, it was plain that we three stood in the mind +of our brother in the place which my father had boded for us, and I was +glad. Well I knew that Raven, the watchful, and Withelm, the wise and +thoughtful, would do their parts; and I thought that whether I could do +mine was to be seen very shortly. If I failed in help at need it should +not be my fault. It had been long growing in my mind who Havelok must +be, though I said nothing of what I thought, because my father had +bidden me be silent long ago, and I thought that I knew why. + +We were to start early in the morning, so that we should get to the city +betimes in the evening; and there was one thing that troubled the good +sisters more than it did us. They would have had us go in all our +finery, such as we were wont to wear on holidays and at feastings; but +none of that was left. It had gone in buying corn, while there was any +left to buy, along with every silver penny that we had. So we must go in +the plain fisher gear, that is made for use and not for show, frayed and +stained, and a trifle tarry, but good enough. It would not do to go in +our war gear into a peaceful city; and so we took but the seax that +every Englishman wears, and the short travelling spear that all +wayfarers use. Hardly was it likely that even the most hungry outlaw of +the wild woldland would care to fall on us; for by this time such as we +seemed had spent their all in food for themselves and their families, +and all the money in Lindsey seemed to have gone away to places where +there was yet somewhat to buy. + +Busy were those kind sisters of ours that night in making ready the last +meal that we should need to take from them. And all the while they +foretold pleasant things for us at the king's court--how that we +should find high honour and the like. So they set us forth well and +cheerfully. + +With the dawn we started, and Havelok was thoughtful beyond his wont +after we had bidden farewell to the home folk, so that I thought that he +grieved for leaving them at the last. + +"Downhearted, are you, brother?" I said, when we had gone a couple of +miles in silence across the level. "I have been to Lincoln two or three +times in a month sometimes in the summer, and it is no great distance +after all. I think nothing of the journey, or of going so short a way +from home." + +"Nor do I," he answered. "First, I was thinking of the many times my +father, Grim, went this way, and now he can walk no more; and then I was +thinking of that empty cottage we passed just now, where there was a +pleasant little family enough three months ago, who are all gone. And +then--ay, I will tell you--I had a dream last night that stays in my +mind, so that I think that out of this journey of ours will come somewhat." + +"Food and shelter, to wit," said I, "which is all we want for a month or +two. Let us hear it." + +"If we get all that I had in that dream, we shall want no more all our +lives," he said, with a smile; "but it seems a foolish dream, now that I +come to tell it." + +"That is mostly the way with dreams. It is strange how wonderful they +seem until daylight comes. I have heard Witlaf's gleeman say that the +best lays he ever made were in his sleep; but if he remembered aught of +them, they were naught." + +"It is not like that altogether with my dream," Havelok said, "for it +went thus. I thought that I was in Denmark--though how I knew it was +Denmark I cannot say--and on a hill I sat, and at my feet was +stretched out all the land, so that I could see all over it at once. +Then I longed for it, and I stretched out my arms to gather it in, and +so long were they that they could well fathom it, and so I drew it to +myself. With towns and castles it was gathered in, and the keys of the +strongholds fell rattling at my feet, while the weight of the great land +seemed to lie on my knees. Then said one, and the voice was the voice of +Grim, 'This is not all the dream that I have made for you, but it is +enough for now.' That is the dream, therefore, and what make you of it?" + +"A most amazing hunger, brother, certainly, and promise of enough to +satisfy it withal. I think that the sisters have talked about our +advancement at court until you have dreamed thereof." + +"Why," he said, "that is surely at the bottom of the dream, and I am +foolish to think more of it." + +Then we went on, and grew light hearted as the miles passed. But though +I had seemed to think little of the dream, it went strangely with my +thoughts of what might lie before Havelok in days to come. + +As we went inland from the sea, the track of the pestilence was more +dread, for we passed house after house that had none living in them, and +some held the deserted dead. I might say many things of what we saw, but +I do not like to think of them much. Many a battlefield have I seen +since that day, but I do not think them so terrible as the field over +which has gone the foe that is unseen ere he smites. One knows the worst +of the battle when it is over and the roll is called, but who knows +where famine and pestilence stay? And those have given life for king or +land willingly, but these were helpless. + +It was good to climb the welds and look back, for in the high lands +there was none of this. Below us the levels, with their bright waters, +were wrapped in a strange blue haze, that had come with the famine at +its worst, and, as men said, had brought or made the sickness. I had +heard of it; but it was not so plain when one was in it, or else our +shore was free, which is likely, seeing how little we suffered. + +After that we kept to the high land, not so much fearing the blue robe +of the pestilence as what things of its working we might see; and so it +was late in the afternoon that we came in sight of Lincoln town, on its +hill, with the wide meres and river at its feet. I have seen no city +that stands more wonderfully than this of ours, with the grey walls of +the Roman town to crown the gathering of red and brown roofs that nestle +on the slope and within them. And ever as we drew nearer Havelok became +more silent, as I thought because he had never seen so great a town +before, until we passed the gates of the stockade that keeps the town +that lies without the old walls, and then he said, looking round him +strangely, "Brother, you will laugh at me, no doubt, for an arrant +dreamer, but this is the place whereto in dreams I have been many a +time. Now we shall come to yon turn of the road among the houses, and +beyond that we shall surely see a stone-arched gate in a great wall, and +spearmen on guard thereat." + +It was so, and the gate and guard were before us in a few more steps. It +was the gate of the old Roman town, inside which was the palace of the +king and one or two more great houses only. Our English kin hate a +walled town or a stone house, and they would not live within the strong +walls, whose wide span was, save for the king's palace, which was built +partly of the house of the Roman governor, and these other halls, which +went for naught in so wide a meadow, empty and green, and crossed by two +paved roads, with grass growing between the stones. There were brown +marks, as of the buried stones of other foundations, on the grass where +the old streets had been. + +All the straggling English town was outside the walls, and only in time +of war would the people use them as a stronghold, as they used the still +more ancient camps on the hills. + +"Many times have you heard us tell of this place, Havelok," I said. "It +is no wonder that you seem to know it." + +"Nay," he answered, "but this is the city of my dreams, and somewhat is +to happen here." + + + CHAPTER VIII. BERTHUN THE COOK. + +For that night we went to the house of the old dame with whom my father +and I were wont to lodge when we came to the market, and she took us in +willingly, though she could make little cheer for us. Truly, as had been +said, the scarcity was not so great in Lincoln, but everything was +terribly dear, and that to some is almost as bad. + +"No money have I now, dame," I said ruefully, "but I think that for old +sake's sake you will not turn us away." + +"Not I, faith," she answered. "I mind the first day your father came +here, and never a penny had he, and since then there has been no want in +this house. Luck comes with Grim and his folk, as I think. But this is a +son whom I have not seen before, if he is indeed your brother." + +"I am Grim's son Curan," said Havelok, "and I have not been to Lincoln +ere this. But I have heard of you many times." + +That pleased our old hostess, and then she asked after Grim. Hard it was +to have to tell her that he was gone, and hard it was for her to hear, +for the little house had been open to us for ten years. + +"What will you do now, masters?" she asked, when she had told us of many +a kindness done to her and her husband, who was long dead now, by my father. + +I told her that we were too many at home since the fishing had failed, +and had therefore come to find some work here, at the court if possible. + +"Doubtless two strong men will not have to go far to find somewhat," she +said; "but the court is full of idle folk, and maybe no place is empty. +Now I will have you bide with me while you are at a loose end, for there +are yet a few silver pennies in store, and I ween that they came out of +Grim's pouch to me. Lonely am I, and it is no good hoarding them when +his sons are hungry." + +We thanked her for that kind saying, but she made light of it, saying +that almost did she hope that we should find no work, that we might bide +and lighten her loneliness for a time. + +"But if an old woman's advice is good for aught, you shall not go to the +court first of all. Sour is King Alsi, and he is likely to turn you away +offhand rather than grant the smallest boon. But there is Berthun the +cook, as we call him--steward is his court name though--and he +orders the household, and is good-natured, so that all like him. Every +morning he comes into the market, and there you can ask him if there is +a place for you, and he loves to look on a man such as Curan. But if it +is weapons you want--and I suppose that is in the minds of tall men +always, though it brings sorrow in the end--there is the captain of +the guard who lives over the gate, and he might be glad to see you enough." + +We said that we would see the steward, for we wanted no long employment. +We would go back to Grimsby when the famine ended, if it were only by +the coming of the fish again. + +Then she gave us of the best she had--black bread and milk to wit; and +after that we slept soundly before the fire, as I had done many times +before in that humble house. Black bread and milk it was again in the +morning; but there was plenty, and goodwill to season it. Then the old +dame sent us forth cheerfully and early, that we might not miss Berthun +the steward, from whom she hoped great things for us. + +So we sat in the marketplace for an hour or more watching the gates of +the wall for his coming; and men stared at Havelok, so that we went to +the bridge and waited there. One could see all the market from thence. +There were a good many of the market folk coming in presently, and most +of them knew me, and more than one stopped and spoke. + +Now Havelok grew restless, and wandered here and there looking at +things, though not going far from me; and while I was thus alone on the +bridge, a man I knew by sight came and leaned on the rail by me, and +told me that he had just seen the most handsome man and the goodliest to +look on that was in the kingdom, as he thought. + +"Yonder he stands," he said, "like a king who has fallen on bad times. I +mind that I thought that Alsi, our king, would look like that, before I +saw him, and sorely disappointed was I in him therefore. Now I wonder +who yon man may be?" + +I did not say that I knew, but I looked at Havelok, and for the first +time, perhaps because I had never seen him among strangers before, I +knew that he was wondrous to look on. Full head and shoulders was he +above all the folk, and the Lindseymen are no babes in stature. And at +the same moment it came to me that it were not well that men should know +him as the son of Grim the fisher. If my father, who was the wisest of +men, had been so careful for all these years, I must not be less so; for +if there were ever any fear of the spies of Hodulf, it would be now when +his foe might be strong enough in years to think of giving trouble. Not +that I ever thought much of the said Hodulf, seeing how far off he was; +but my father had brought me up to dread him for this brother of mine. +Certainly by this time Hodulf knew that Grim had come to England in +safety, for the name of the new town must have come to his ears: and if +Grim, then the boy he had given to him. + +The man who spoke to me went away soon, and Havelok strolled back to me. + +"I would that the cook, or whoever he is, would come," he said. "I grow +weary of this crowd that seems to have naught to do but stare at a +stranger." + +"What shall we ask, when he does come? and supposing that there is a +place for but one of us?" I said. + +"Why, then, the one it fits best will take it, and the other must seek +some other chance. That is all." + +"As you will, brother," I answered, "but I would rather that we should +be together." + +"And I also. But after all, both will be in Lincoln, and we must take +what comes. It is but for a little while, and we shall not like to +burden that good old dame by being too hard to please. We want somewhat +to do until we can go home, not for a day longer, and I care not what it +is." + +"That is right," I said; "and the sooner I see one of our folk coming +over this bridge with a full basket of fish, the better I shall like it. +But it may be a long day before that. Now, I have been thinking that it +were not well that you should say that you are the son of Grim." + +I did not quite know how he would take this, for he was proud of my +father as I. But that very pride made it easy. + +"Maybe not," he said thoughtfully, "for it seems unworthy of his sons +that we have to ask for service from any man. But I do not think that he +could blame us, as things are. Nevertheless, folk shall not talk." + +"Men know me," said I, "but that cannot be helped." + +He laughed gaily at that. + +"Why, here we speak as if one man in a hundred knew you. And after all +it may be that we shall get a place that none need be ashamed of. Look, +here comes a mighty fine lord from the gateway." + +It was Berthun the steward, for whom we were waiting, and I knew him +well by sight. Often had he bought our fish, but I did not think that he +would remember me by name, if he had ever heard it. He was a portly and +well-favoured man, not old, and as he came down the street to the +marketplace at the hill foot he laughed and talked with one and another +of the townsfolk, whether high or low, in very pleasant wise. + +Presently he stopped at a stall, and priced some meat; and when he had +bought it he looked round and called for some men to carry it for him; +and at that the idlers made a rush for him, tripping over one another in +haste to be first, while he laughed at them. + +He chose two or three, and sent them up the hill to the palace with +their burdens, and then went to another booth and bought. + +"This is work at which I should make a good hand," said Havelok, +laughing at the scrambling men who ran forward when the steward again +called for porters. "Well paid also the job must be, to judge of their +eagerness." + +The three men who had been chosen took their burden and went away, and +the steward came near us, to a bakery that was close to the bridge end. + +"I have a mind to do porter for once," Havelok said. "Then I can at +least earn somewhat to take back to the dame tonight." + +"If you do so," I answered, "I will wait here for you. But you will have +to fight for the place." + +Now the steward bought all that he needed, and that was bread for the +whole palace for the day, and again he called for porters. Whereon +Havelok got up from the bridge rail and went towards him in no great +hurry, so that the idlers were in a crowd before him. + +"Ho! friends," cried Havelok, "let the good cook see all of us and make +his choice. He can only take one at a time." + +"One, forsooth," said a man from the crowd; "why, there is a load for +four men there." + +"Well, then, let him pick four little ones, and give these little ones a +chance of being seen." + +Now I do not think that he would have troubled with the matter any more; +but whether the men knew that this was the last load that the steward +had to send home, or whether they quarrelled, I cannot say, but in their +eagerness to raise the two great baskets they fell to struggling over +them, and the steward tried to quiet the turmoil by a free use of his +staff, and there was a danger that the bread should be scattered. + +"Here will be waste of what there is none too much of just now," said +Havelok; and with that he went to the aid of the steward, picking up and +setting aside the men before him, and then brushing the struggling +rivals into a ruefully wondering heap from about the baskets, so that he +and the steward faced each other, while there fell a silence on the +little crowd that had gathered. Even the men who had been put aside +stayed their abuse as they saw what manner of man had come to the rescue +of the baskets, and Havelok and the cook began to laugh. + +"Fe, fi, fo, fum!" said Berthun; "here is surely a Cornish giant among +us! Now I thank you, good Blunderbore, or whatever your name is, for +brushing off these flies." + +"The folk in this place are unmannerly," said Havelok; "hut if you want +the bread carried up the hill I will do it for you." + +Berthun looked him up and down in a puzzled sort of way once or twice +ere he answered, "Well, as that is your own proposal, pick your helpers +and do so; I would not have asked such a thing of you myself." + +"There is not much help needed," said Havelok. "I think this may be +managed if I get a fair hold." + +Now we were used to seeing him carry such loads as would try the +strength of even Raven and myself, who could lift a load for three men; +but when he took the two great baskets of bread and swung them into +place on either arm, a smothered shout went round the crowd, and more +than once I heard the old Welsh name that the marsh folk had given him +spoken. + +"Let us be going," said Havelok to the steward on that. "One would think +that none of these had ever hefted a fair load in his life, to listen to +them." + +So he nodded to me across the heads of the crowd, and followed Berthun, +and the idlers followed him for a little. The guard turned these back at +the gate, and Havelok went through, and I could see him no more. + +Presently the crowd drifted back to their places, and I heard them +talking. Havelok and his strength was likely to be a nine days' wonder +in Lincoln, and I was glad that I had asked him not to say whence he was. + +"He is some thane's son who is disguised," said one. + +"Maybe he is under a vow," said another; and then one chimed in with a +story of some prince of Arthur's time, by name Gareth, who hid his state +at his mother's command. + +"As for me," said the baker, "I think that he is a fisher, as he looks +--at least, that is, as his clothes make him." + +So even he had his doubts, and I will say that I understood well enough +now why my father never brought him here before. + +Havelok was long in coming back, as I thought, and I seemed to be +wasting time here, and so I bethought me of the other man to whom the +old dame had said we might go--namely, the captain of the gate. I +should see Havelok if I stood there. + +The captain was talking with some of his men as I came up, and of course +it was of Havelok that they spoke; and seeing that I wore the same dress +as he, they asked me if I knew who he was. + +"He is a fisher from the coast," I answered. "I have heard him called +Curan." + +"Welsh then," the captain answered, somewhat disappointed, as it seemed. +"If he had been a Mercian, or even a Saxon, I would have had him here, +but a fisher has had no training in arms after all." + +"Some of us have," said I. + +The captain looked me up and down, and then walked round me, saying +nothing until we were face to face again. + +"That, I take it, is a hint that you might like to be a housecarl of the +king's," he said. "Are you a Lindseyman?" + +"I am the son of Grim of Grimsby," I said. + +"Why, then, I suppose you would not think of it, seeing that my place is +not empty; but if you will dress in that way you must not wonder if I +took you for a likely man for a housecarl. We know Grim well by repute. +Come in and tell me about the famine, and this new town of yours that +one hears of." + +Now I could not see Havelok as yet, and so I went into the stone-arched +Roman guardroom, and Eglaf the captain fetched out a pot of wine and +some meat, and made me very welcome while we talked. And presently I +thought that I might do worse than be a housecarl for a time, if Eglaf +would have me. I should be armed at least, and with comrades to help if +Havelok needed me; though all the while I thought myself foolish for +thinking that any harm could come to him who was so strong. +Nevertheless, what my father had laid on us all was to be heeded, and I +was to be his helper in arms. So presently I told Eglaf that the +housecarl's life seemed an easy one, and that it would be pleasant to go +armed for a while, if he would have me for a short time, seeing that the +famine had left us naught to do. + +"Well, there is plenty to eat and drink," he said, "and good lodging in +the great hall or here, as one's post may be, and a silver penny every +day; but no fighting to be done, seeing that Alsi will sooner pay a foe +to go away than let us see to the matter. Doing naught is mighty hard +work at times." + +Then he asked if I had arms, and I said that I would send for them at +once, and that settled the matter. If I chose to come with my own arms I +should be welcome. + +"I am glad to get you," he said, "for there will be a crowd in the place +ere long, for the Witan is to meet, and the thanes will come with their +men, and there will be fine doings, so that we need another strong arm +or two that we may keep the peace," + +He took a long pull at the wine pot, and then went on, "Moreover, the +princess's Danes are sure to want to fight some of the English folk for +sport." + +"What! is she here?" + +"Not yet. They say that she is coming when the Witan meets, because the +Witan wants to see her, not because Alsi does. But he dare not go +against them, and so it must be." + +Now Goldberga, the princess, was, as I have said, Alsi's ward, and was +at this time just eighteen, so that it would be time for her to take the +kingdom that was hers by right. It was common talk, however, that Alsi +by no means liked the thought of giving the wide lands of East Anglia up +to her, and that he would not do so if he could anywise help it. Maybe +the Witan thought so also, and would see fair play. Ethelwald and his +wife Orwenna had been well loved both here and in Norfolk, and it was +said that Goldberga their daughter grew wondrous fair and queenly. + +I had learned one thing though, and that was that we should have +Ethelwald's Danes here shortly, and that I did not like; but after all, +what did these few men of an old household know of the past days in +Denmark? There had been no going backwards and forwards between the two +countries since the king died ten years ago. Nevertheless I was glad +that I had found a friend in Eglaf, and that I was to be here. + +Then I got up to go, and the captain bade me come as soon as I could, +for he could talk to me as he could not to the men, maybe. So I bade him +farewell, and went slowly back, down the street, sitting down in the old +place. + +It was not long after that before Havelok came, and I saw Berthun the +steward come as far as the gate with him, and stand looking after him as +he walked away; then Eglaf came out, and both looked and talked for a +while, and therefore, as soon as I knew that Havelok saw me, I went away +and across the bridge to a place that was quiet, and waited for him there. + +"Well, brother," I said, "you have had a long job with the cook. What is +the end of it all?" + +"I do not know," he answered slowly. "That is to be seen yet." + +I looked at him, for his voice was strange, and I saw that he seemed to +have the same puzzled look in his eyes as he had last night when we came +first into the city. I asked if anything was amiss. + +"Nothing," he said; "but this is a place of dreams. I think that I shall +wake presently in Grimsby." + +We walked on, and past the straggling houses outside the stockade, and +so into the fields; and little by little he told me what was troubling him. + +Berthun the steward had said nothing until the palace was reached, and +had led him to the great servants' hall, and there had bidden him set +down his load and rest. Then he had asked if he would like to see the +place, and of course Havelok had said that he would, wondering at the +same time if this was all the pay that the porters got. So he was shown +the king's hall, and the arms on the wall, and the high seat, and the +king's own chamber, and many more things, and all the while they seemed +nothing strange to Havelok. + +"This Berthun watched me as a cat watches a mouse all the while," he +said, "and at last he asked if I had ever seen a king's house before. I +told him that I had a dream palace which had all these things, but was +not the same. And at that he smiled and asked my name. 'Curan,' I said, +of course; and at that he smiled yet more, in a way that seemed to say +that he did not believe me. 'It is a good name for the purpose,' he +said, 'but I have to ask your pardon for calling you by the old giant's +name just now.' I said that as he did not know my name, and it was a +jest that fitted, it was no matter. Then he made a little bow, and asked +if I would take any food before I went from the place; so I told him +that it was just what I came for, and he laughed, and I had such a meal +as I have not seen for months. It is in my mind that I left a famine in +that house, so hungry was I. There is no pride about this Berthun, for +he served me himself, and I thanked him." + +Then Havelok stopped and passed his hand over his face, and he laughed a +little, uneasy laugh. + +"And all the while I could not get it out of my head that he ought to be +kneeling before me." + +"Well," he went on after a little, "when I had done, this Berthun asked +me a question, saying that he was a discreet man, and that if he could +help me in any way he would do so. Had I a vow on me? Nothing more than +to earn my keep until the famine was over, I said. I had left poor folk +who would have the more for my absence, and he seemed to think that this +was a wondrous good deed. So I told him that if he could help me in this +I should be glad. Whereon he lowered his voice and asked if I must +follow the way of Gareth the prince. I had not heard of this worthy, and +so I said that what was good enough for a prince was doubtless good +enough for me, and that pleased him wonderfully. + +"'Gladly will I take you into my service,' he said, 'if that will +content you.' Which it certainly would; and so I am to be porter again +tomorrow. Then I said that I had a comrade to whom I must speak first. +He said that no doubt word must be sent home of my welfare, and he saw +me as far as the gate." + +"Which of you went out of the hall first?" I asked. + +"Now I come to think of it, I did. I went to let him pass, as the elder, +though it was in my mind to walk out as if the place belonged to me; and +why, I do not know, for no such thought ever came to me in Witlaf's +house, or even in a cottage; but he stood aside and made me go first." + +Now I longed for Withelm and his counsel, for one thing was plain to me, +and that was that with the once familiar things of the kingship before +him the lost memory of his childhood was waking in Havelok, and I +thought that the time my father boded was at hand. The steward had seen +that a court and its ways were no new thing to him, and had seen too +that he had been wont to take the first place somewhere; so he had +deemed that this princely-looking youth was under a vow of service, in +the old way. It is likely that the Welsh name would make him think that +he was from beyond the marches to the west, and that was just as well. + +Then Havelok said, "Let us go back to the widow's house and sleep. My +head aches sorely, and it is full of things that are confused, so that I +do not know rightly who I am or where. Maybe it will pass with rest." + +We turned hack, and then I told him what I meant to do; and that pleased +him, for we should see one another often. + +"We are in luck, brother, so far," he said, "having lit on what we +needed so soon; but I would that these dreams would pass." + +"It is the poor food of many days gone by," I said. "Berthun will cure +that for you very shortly." + +"It is likely enough," he answered more gaily. + +"Little want is in that house, but honest Berthun does not know what a +trencherman he has hired. But I would that we had somewhat to take back +to our good old dame tonight." + +But she was more than satisfied with our news; and when she saw that +Havelok was silent, she made some curious draught of herbs for him, +which he swallowed, protesting, and after that he slept peacefully. + +I went out to the marketplace and found a man whom I knew--one of +those who carried our fish at times; and him I sent, with promise of two +silver pennies presently, to Arngeir for my arms, telling him that all +was well. + + + CHAPTER IX. CURAN THE PORTER. + +There is no need for me to say how my arms came to me from Grimsby, and +how I went to Eglaf as I had promised. I will only say that the life was +pleasant enough, if idle, as a housecarl, and that I saw Havelok every +day at one time or another, which was all that I could wish. + +But as I had to wait a day or two while the messenger went and the arms +came from home, I saw Havelok meet the steward on the next day: and a +quaint meeting enough it was, for Berthun hardly knew how he should +behave to this man, whom he had made up his mind was a wandering prince. + +There was the crowd who waited for the call for porters, as ever; hut +the steward would have none of them, until he saw his new man towering +over the rest, and then he half made a motion to unbonnet, which he +checked and turned into a beckoning wave of the hand, whereon the idlers +made their rush for him, and Havelok walked through and over them, more +or less, as they would not make way for him. But so good-naturedly was +this done, that even those whom he lifted from his path and dropped on +one side laughed when they saw who had cleared a way for himself, and +stood gaping to see what came next. + +"Ho--why, yes--Curan--that was the name certainly. I have been +looking for you, as we said," stammered the steward. + +"Here am I, therefore," answered Havelok, "and where is the load?" + +"Truth to tell, I have bought but this at present," said the steward, +pointing to a small basket of green stuff on the stall at which he stood. + +"Well, I suppose there is more to come," Havelok said, taking it up; "it +will be a beginning." + +"I will not ask you to carry more than that," Berthun began. + +"Why, man, this is foolishness. If you have a porter, make him carry all +he can, else he will not earn his keep." + +"As you will," answered the steward, shrugging his shoulders as one who +cannot account for some folk's whims, and going on to the next booth. + +Now, I suppose that the idlers looked to see Havelok walk away with this +light load gladly, as any one of them would have done, and that then +their turn would have come; but this was not what they expected. Maybe +they would have liked to see the strong man sweep up all the palace +marketing and carry it, as a show, but it might interfere with their own +gains. So there was a murmur or two among them, and this grew when +Havelok took the next burden in like manner. + +"Ho, master cook," cried a ragged man at last, "this is not the custom, +and it is not fair that one man should do all the work, and all for one +wage." + +Berthun took no notice of this; and so the cry was repeated, and that by +more than one. And at last he turned round and answered. + +"Go to, ye knaves," he said with a red face and angrily; "if I find a +man who will save me the trouble of your wrangles every day, shall I not +do as I please?" + +Then there was a tumult of voices, and some of them seemed sad, as if a +last hope was gone, and that Havelok heard. + +"There is somewhat in this," he said to the cook. "What pay have you +given to each man who carries for you?" + +"A yesterday's loaf each," answered Berthun, wondering plainly that +Havelok paid any heed to the noise. + +"Well, then, let us go on, and we will think of somewhat," Havelok said; +and then he turned to the people, who were silent at once. + +"I am a newcomer, and a hungry one," he said, smiling quietly, "and I +have a mind to earn my loaf well. Hinder me not for today, and hereafter +I will take my chance with the rest, if need is." + +Thereat the folk began to laugh also, for it was plain that none had any +chance at all if he chose to put forth his strength; but an old man said +loudly, "Let the good youth alone now, and he shall talk with us when he +has done his errand and fed that great bulk of his. He has an honest +face, and will be fair to all." + +That seemed to please the crowd; and after that they said no more, but +followed and watched the gathering up of Havelok's mighty burden. And +presently there was more than he could manage; and he spoke to Berthun, +who checked himself in a half bow as he answered. + +Then Havelok looked over the faces before him, and beckoned to two men +who seemed weakly and could not press forward, and to them he gave the +lighter wares, and so left the market with his master, as one must call +the steward. + +"What told I you?" said the old man, as they came back from the great +gate. "Never saw I one with a face like that who harmed any man, either +in word or deed." + +Now when Havelok had set down his load in the kitchen, he straightened +himself and said to Berthun, who was, as one may say, waiting his pleasure. + +"This is today's task; but it is in my mind that I would stay up here +and work." + +"What would you do?" + +"There are men yonder who will miss the carrying if I am market porter +always. But here are things I can earn my keep at, and help the other +servants with at the same time. Water drawing there is, and carrying of +logs for the fire, and cleaving them also, and many other things that +will be but hardening my muscles, while they are over heavy to be +pleasant for other folk." + +"Well," answered Berthun, "that is all I could wish, and welcome to some +here will you be. Let it be so." + +"Now, I do not think that you would make a gain by my work this morning?" + +"Truly not, if any one is wronged by my doing so," the puzzled steward said. + +Then Havelok asked how many men would have been needed to carry up the +goods that he had brought, and Berthun said that he was wont to send one +at least from each stall, and more if the burden was heavy. + +"Then today four poor knaves must go dinnerless by reason of my +strength, and that does not please me altogether," said Havelok gravely. +"Give these two their loaves; and then, I pray you, give me the other +four, and let me go back to the market." + +And then he added, with a smile, "I think that I can order matters there +so that things will be more fair, and that you will have less trouble +with that unmannerly scramble." + +"If you can do that, you are even as your name calls you. Take them and +welcome, Curan, and then come here and do what work you will," Berthun +said in haste. + +"Tasks you must set me, or I shall grow idle. That is the failing of +over-big men," Havelok said; and he took the loaves and left the palace +with the two market men at his heels. + +I saw him come back, and at once the crowd of idlers made for him, but +in a respectful way enough. I knew, however, how easily these folks took +to throwing mud and stones in their own quarrels, and I was a little +anxious, for to interfere with the ways of the market is a high offence +among them. + +But Havelok knew naught of that, and went his way with his loaves to the +bridge end, and there sat on the rail and looked at the men before him. +And /lo!/ back to my mind came old days in Denmark, and how I once saw +Gunnar the king sitting in open court to do justice, and then I knew for +certain that I was looking on his son. And when Havelok spoke it was in +the voice of Gunnar that I had long forgotten, but which came back to me +clear and plain, as if it were yesterday that I had heard it. Never does +a boy forget his first sight of the king. + +"Friends," said Havelok, "if I do two men's work I get two men's pay, or +else I might want to know the reason why. But I am only one man, all the +same, and it seems right to me that none should be the loser. Wherefore +I have a mind to share my pay fairly." + +There was a sort of shout at that and Havelok set his four loaves in a +row on the rail beside him. But then some of the rougher men went to +make a rush at them, and he took the foremost two and shook them, so +that others laughed and bade the rest beware. + +"So that is just where the trouble comes in," said Havelok coolly; "the +strong get the first chance, as I did this morning, by reason of there +being none to see fair play." + +"Bide in the market, master, and we will make you judge among us," cried +a small man from the edge of the crowd. + +"Fair and softly," Havelok answered. "I am not going to bide here longer +than I can help. Come hither, grandfer," and he beckoned to the old man +who had bidden them wait his return, "tell me the names of the men who +have been longest without any work." + +The old man pointed out three, and then Havelok stopped him. + +"One of these loaves is my own wage," he said; "but you three shall have +the others, and that will be the easiest day's work you ever did. But +think not that I am going to do the like every day, for Lincoln hill is +no easy climb, and the loaf is well earned at the top. Moreover, it is +not good to encourage the idle by working for them." + +So the three men had their loaves, and Havelok began to eat his own +slowly, swinging his legs on the bridge rail while the men watched him. + +"Master," said the small man from behind, pushing forward a little, now +that the crowd was looser, "make a law for the market, I pray you, that +all may have a chance." + +"Who am I to make laws?" said my brother slowly, and, as he said this, +his hand went up to his brows as it had gone last night when the palace +had wearied him. + +"The strong make laws for the weak," the old man said to him in a low +voice. "If the strong is honest, for the weak it is well. Things are +hard for the weak here; and therefore say somewhat, for it may be of use." + +"It can be none, unless the strong is at hand to see that the law is kept." + +"Sometimes the market will see that a rule is not broken, for itself. +There is no rule for this matter." + +Again Havelok passed his hand over his eyes, and he was long in +answering. The loaf lay at his side now. Presently he looked straight +before him, and, as if he saw far beyond Lincoln Hill and away to the +north, he said, "This is my will, therefore, that from this time forward +it shall be the law that men shall have one among them who may fairly +and without favour so order this matter that all shall come to Berthun +the steward in turns that shall be kept, and so also with the carrying +for any other man. There shall be a company of porters, therefore, which +a man must join before he shall do this work, save that every stranger +who comes shall be suffered to take a burden once, and then shall be +told of this company, and the custom that is to be. And I will that this +old man shall see to this matter." + +And then he stopped suddenly, and seemed to start as a great shout went +up from the men, a shout as of praise; and his eyes looked again on +them, and that wonderingly. + +"They will keep this law," said the old man. "Well have you spoken." + +"I have said a lot of foolishness, maybe," answered Havelok. "For the +life of me I could not say it again." + +"There is not one of us that could not do so," said his adviser. "But +bide you here, master, in the town?" + +"I am in service at the palace." + +Then the old man turned round to the others and said, "This is good that +we have heard, and it is nothing fresh, for all trades have their +companies, and why should not we? Is this stranger's word to be kept?" + +Maybe there were one or two of the rougher men who held their peace, for +they had had more than their share of work, but from the rest came a +shout of "Ay!" as it were at the Witan. + +"Well, then," said Havelok suddenly, getting down from his seat and +giving his loaf to the old man, "see you to it; and if any give trouble +hereafter, I shall hear from the cook, and, by Odin, I will even come +down and knock their heads together for them. So farewell." + +He smiled round pleasantly, yet in that way which has a meaning at the +back of it; and at that every cap went off and the men did him reverence +as to a thane at least, and he nodded to them and came across to me. + +"Come out into the fields, brother, for I shall weep if I bide here longer." + +So he said; and we went away quickly, while the men gathered round the +old leader who was to be, and talked earnestly. + +"This famine plays strange tricks with me," he said when we were away +from every one. "Did you hear all that I said?" + +"I heard all, and you have spoken the best thing that could have been +said. Eight years have I been to this market, and a porters' guild is +just what is needed. And it will come about now." + +"It was more dreaming, and so I must be a wise man in my dream. Even as +in the palace yesterday it came on me, and I seemed to be at the gate of +a great hall, and it was someone else that was speaking, and yet myself. +It is in my mind that I told these knaves what my lordly will was, +forsooth; and the words came to me in our old Danish tongue, so that it +was hard not to use it. But it seems to me that long ago I did these +things, or saw them, I know not which, somewhere. Tell me, did the king +live in our town across the sea?" + +"No, but in another some way off. My father took me there once or twice." + +"Can you mind that he took me also?" + +I shook my head, and longed for Withelm. Surely I would send for him, or +for Arngeir, if this went on. Arngeir for choice, for I could tell him +what I thought; and that would only puzzle Withelm, who knew less than I. + +"We will ask Arngeir some day," I said; "he can remember." + +"I suppose he did take me," mused Havelok; "and I suppose that I want +more sleep or more food or somewhat. Now we will go and tell the old +dame of my luck, for she has lost her lodger." + +Then he told me of his fortune with the steward. + +"Half afraid of me he seems, for he will have me do just what I will. +That will be no hard place therefore." + +But I thought that if I knew anything of Havelok my brother, he would be +likely to make it hard by doing every one's work for him, and that +Berthun saw this; or else that, as I had thought last night, the shrewd +courtier saw the prince behind the fisher's garb. + +So we parted presently at the gate of the palace wall, and I went back +to the widow to wait for my arms, while he went to his master. And I may +as well tell the end of Havelok's lawmaking. + +Berthun went down to the market next day, and came back with a wonder to +be told. And it was to Havelok that he went first to tell it, as he was +drawing bucket after bucket of water from the deep old Roman well in the +courtyard to fill the great tub which he considered a fair load to carry +at once. + +"There is something strange happening in the market," he said, "and I +think that you have a hand in it. The decency of the place is wonderful, +and you said that you thought I might have less trouble with the men +than I was wont if you went down with the loaves. What did you? For I +went to the baker's stalls and bought, and looked round for the tail +that is after me always; and I was alone, and all the market folk were +agape to see what was to be done. I thought that I had offended the +market by yesterday's business, as they had called out on me, and I +thought that I should have to come and fetch your--that is, if it +pleased you. But first I called, as is my wont, for porters. Now all +that rabble sat in a row along a wall, and, by Baldur, when I looked, +they had cleaned themselves! Whereupon an old gaffer, who has carried +things once or twice for me when there has been no crowd and he has been +able to come forward, lifted up his voice and asked how many men I +wanted, so please me. + +"'Two,'I said, wondering, and at that two got up and came to me, and I +sent them off. It was the same at the next booth, and the next, for he +told off men as I wanted them; and here am I back a full half-hour +earlier than ever before, and no mud splashes from the crowd either. It +is said that they have made a porters' guild; and who has put that sense +into their heads unless your--that is, unless you have done so, I +cannot say." + +Havelok laughed. + +"Well, I did tell them that they should take turns, or somewhat like +that; and I also told them that if you complained of them I would see to +it." + +"Did you say that you would pay them, may I ask--that is, of course, +if they were orderly? For if so, I thank--" + +"I told them that if you complained I would knock their heads together," +said Havelok. + +And that was the beginning of the Lincoln porters' guild; and in after +days Havelok was wont to say that he would that all lawmaking was as +easy as that first trial of his. Certainly from that day forward there +was no man in all the market who would not have done aught for my +brother, and many a dispute was he called on to settle. It is not always +that a law, however good it may be, finds not a single one to set +himself against it. But then Havelok was a strong man. + +Now there is naught to tell of either Havelok or myself for a little +while, for we went on in our new places comfortably enough. One heard +much of Havelok, though, for word of him and his strength and +goodliness, and of his kindness moreover, went through the town, with +tales of what he had done. But I never heard that any dared to ask him +to make a show of himself by doing feats of strength. Only when he came +down to the guardroom sometimes with me would he take part in the weapon +play that he loved, and the housecarls, who were all tried and good +warriors, said that he was their master in the use of every weapon, and +it puzzled them to know where he had learned so well, for he yet wore +his fisher's garb. They sent his arms with mine from Grimsby, thinking +that he also needed them; but he left them with the widow. + +Havelok used to laugh if they asked him this, and tell them that it came +by nature, and in that saying there was more than a little truth. So the +housecarls, when they heard how Berthun was wont to treat him, thought +also that he was some great man in hiding, and that the steward knew who +he was. They did not know but that my close friendship with him had +sprung up since he came, and that was well, and Eglaf and he and I were +soon much together. The captain wanted him to leave the cook and be one +of his men, but we thought that he had better bide where he was, rather +than let Alsi the king have him always about him. For now and then that +strange feeling, as of the old days, came over him when he was in the +great hall, and he had to go away and brood over it for a while until he +would set himself some mighty task and forget it. + +But one day he came to me and said that he was sure he knew the ways of +a king too well for it all to be a dream, adding that Berthun saw that +also, and was curious about him. + +"Tell me, brother, whence came I? /Was/ I truly brought up in a court?" + +"I have never heard," I answered. "All that I know for certain is that +you fled with us from Hodulf, the new king, and that for reasons which +my father never told me." + +Then said Havelok, "There was naught worth telling, therefore. I suppose +I was the child of some steward like Berthun; but yet--" + +So he went away, and I wondered long if it were not time that Arngeir +should tell all that he knew. It was of no good for me to say that in +voice and ways and deed he had brought back to me the Gunnar whom I had +not seen for so many long years, for that was as likely as not to be a +fancy of mine, or if not a fancy, he might be only a sister's son or the +like. But in all that he said there was no word of his mother, and by +that I knew that his remembrance must be but a shadow, if a growing one. + +But there was no head in all the wide street that was not turned to look +after him; and now he went his way from me with two children, whom he +had caught up from somewhere, perched on either shoulder, and another in +his arms, and they crowed with delight as he made believe to be some +giant who was to eat them forthwith, and ran up the hill with them. No +such playmate had the Lincoln children before Havelok came. + + + CHAPTER X. KING ALSI OF LINDSEY. + +Three weeks after we came the Witan[8] began to gather, +and that was a fine sight as the great nobles of Lindsey, and of the +North folk of East Anglia, came day by day into the town with their +followings, taking up their quarters either in the better houses of the +place or else pitching bright-coloured tents and pavilions on the +hillside meadows beyond the stockades. Many brought their ladies with +them, and all day long was feasting and mirth at one place or another, +as friend met with friend. Never had I seen such a gay sight as the +marketplace was at midday, when the young thanes and their men met there +and matched their followers at all sorts of sports. The English nobles +are far more fond of gay dress and jewels than our Danish folk, though I +must say that when the few Danes of Ethelwald's household came it would +seem that they had taken kindly to the fashion of their home. + +Our housecarls grumbled a bit for a while, for with all the newcomers +dressed span new for the gathering, we had had nothing fresh for it from +the king, as was the custom, and I for one was ashamed of myself, for +under my mail was naught but the fisher's coat, which is good enough for +hard wear, but not for show. But one day we were fitted out fresh by the +king's bounty in blue and scarlet jerkins and hose, and we swaggered +after that with the best, as one may suppose. + +Berthun had the ordering of that business, and he came and sat with +Eglaf in the gatehouse and talked of it. + +"Pity that you do not put your man Curan into decent gear," the captain +said. "That old sailcloth rig does not do either him or you or the court +credit." + +"That is what I would do," said the steward, "but he will not take aught +but the food that he calls his hire. He is a strange man altogether, and +I think that he is not what he seems." + +"So you have told me many times, and I think with you. He will be some +crack-brained Welsh princeling who has been crossed in love, and so has +taken some vow on him, as the King Arthur that they prate of taught them +to do. Well, if he is such, it is an easy matter to make him clothe +himself decently. It is only to tell him that the clothes are from the +king, and no man who has been well brought up may refuse such a gift." + +"But suppose that he thanks the king for the gift. Both he and the king +will be wroth with me." + +"Not Curan, when he has once got the things on; and as for Alsi, he will +take the thanks to himself, and chuckle to think that the mistake has +gained him credit for a good deed that he never did." + +"Hush, comrade, hush!" said Berthun quickly; "naught but good of the king!" + +"I said naught ill. But if Woden or Frey, or whoever looks after good +deeds, scores the mistake to Alsi as well, it will be the first on the +count of charity that--" + +But at this Berthun rose up in stately wise. + +"I may not listen to this. To think that here in the guardroom I should +hear such--" + +"Sit down, comrade," said Eglaf, laughing, and pulling the steward into +his seat again. "Well you know that I would be cut to pieces for the +king tomorrow if need were, and so I earn free speech of him I guard. If +I may not say what I think of him to a man who knows as much of him as +I, who may?" + +"I have no doubt that the king would clothe Curan if I asked him," said +Berthun stiffly, but noways loth to take his seat again. + +"But it is as much as your place is worth to do it. I know what you +would say." + +Berthun laughed. + +"I will do it myself, and if Alsi does get the credit, what matter?" + +Wherefore it came to pass that as I was on guard at the gate leading to +the town next day I saw a most noble-looking man coming towards me, and +I looked a second time, for I thought him one of the noblest of all the +thanes who had yet come, and the second look told me that it was Havelok +in this new array. I will say that honest Berthun had done his part +well; and if the king was supposed to be the giver, he had nothing to +complain of. Eglaf had told me of the way in which the dressing of +Havelok was to be done. + +"Ho!" said I, "I thought you some newcomer." + +"I hardly know myself," he answered, "and I am not going to grumble at +the change, seeing that this is holiday time. Berthun came to me last +evening, and called me aside, and said that it was the king's wont to +dress his folk anew at the time of the Witan, and then wanted to know if +my vow prevented me from wearing aught but fisher's clothes. And when I +said that if new clothes went as wage for service about the place I was +glad to hear it, he was pleased, as if it had been likely that I would +refuse a good offer. So the tailor went to work on me, and hence this +finery. But you are as fine, and this is more than we counted on when we +left Grimsby. I suppose it is all in honour of the lady of the North +folk, Goldberga." + +"Maybe, for I have heard that she is to come." + +"To be fetched rather, if one is to believe all that one hears. They say +that Alsi has kept her almost as a captive in Dover, having given her +into the charge of some friend of his there, that she may be far from +her own kingdom and people. Now the Norfolk Witan has made him bring her +here. Berthun seems to think there will be trouble." + +"Only because Alsi will not want to let the kingdom go from his hand to +her. But that will not matter. He is bound by the old promise to her +father." + +Now we were talking to one another in broad Danish, there being none +near to hear us. We had always used it among ourselves at Grimsby, for +my father loved his old tongue. But at that moment there rode up to the +gate a splendid horseman, young and handsome, and with great gold +bracelets on his arms, one or two of which caught my eye at once, for +they were of the old Danish patterns, and just such as Jarl Sigurd used +to wear. But if I was quick to notice these tokens of the old land, he +had been yet quicker, for he reined up before I stayed him, as was my +duty if he would pass through this gate to the palace, so that I might +know his authority. + +"If I am not mistaken," he said in our own tongue, "I heard you two +talking in the way I love best. Skoal, therefore, to the first Northman +I have met between here and London town, for it is good to hear a +friendly voice." + +"Skoal to the jarl!" I answered, and I gave the salute of Sigurd's +courtmen, which came into my mind on the moment with the familiar +greeting of long years ago. And "Skoal," said Havelok. + +"Jarl! How know you that I am that?" + +"By the jarl's bracelet that you wear, surely." + +"So you are a real Dane--not an English-bred one like myself. That is +good. You and I will have many a talk together. Odin, how good it is to +meet a housecarl who speaks as man to man and does not cringe to me! Who +are you?" + +"Radbard Grimsson of Grimsby, housecarl just now to this King of Lindsey." + +"And your comrade?" + +I was about to tell this friendly countryman Havelok's name without +thought, but stopped in time. Of all the things I had been brought up to +dread most for him, that an English Dane should find him out was the +worst, so I said, "He is called Curan, and he is a Lindsey marshman." + +"Who can talk Danish though his name is Welsh. That is strange. Well, +you are right about me. I am Ragnar of Norwich, the earl, as the English +for jarl goes. Now I want to see Alsi the king straightway." + +"That is a matter for the captain," I said, and I called for him. + +Eglaf came out and made a deep reverence when he saw the earl, knowing +at once who he was, and as this was just what the earl had said that he +did not like, he looked quaintly at me across Eglaf's broad bent back, +so that I had to grin perforce. + +All unknowing of which the captain heard the earl's business, and then +told me to see him to the palace gates, and take his horse to the +stables when he had dismounted and was in the hands of Berthun. + +So I went, and Havelok turned away and went on some errand down the +steep street. + +This Ragnar was one of whom I had often heard, for he was the governor +of all the North folk for Alsi until the Lady Goldberga should take her +place. He was her cousin, being the son of Ethelwald's sister, who was +of course a Dane. Danish, and from the old country, was his father also, +being one of the men who had come over to the court of East Anglia when +Ethelwald was made king. + +All the way to the door we talked of Denmark, but it was not far. There +Berthun came out and greeted the earl in court fashion, and I thought +that I was done with, because the grooms had run to take the great bay +horse as they heard the trampling. But, as it happened, I was wanted. + +Ragnar went in, saying to me that he would find me out again presently; +and I saw him walk across the great hall to the hearth, and stand there +while Berthun went to the king's presence to tell him of the new +arrival. Then I stood for a minute to look at the horse, for the grooms +had had no orders to take him away; and mindful of Eglaf's word to me, I +was going to tell them to do so, and to see it done, when Berthun came +hurriedly and called me. + +"Master Housecarl," he said rather breathlessly, "by the king's order +you are to come within the hall and guard the doorway." + +I shouldered my spear and followed him, and as we were out of hearing of +the grooms I said that the captain had ordered me to take the horse to +the stables. + +"I will see to that," he said. "Now you are to bide at the door while +the king speaks with Earl Ragnar, for there will be none else present. +Let no one pass in without the king's leave." + +We passed through the great door as he said that, and he closed it after +him. Ragnar was yet standing near the high seat, and turned as he heard +the sound, and smiled when he saw me. Berthun went quickly away through +a side entrance, and the hail was empty save for us two. The midday meal +was over an hour since, and the long tables had been cleared away, so +that the place seemed desolate to me, as I had only seen it before when +I sat with the other men at the cross tables for meals. It was not so +good a hall as was Jarl Sigurd's in Denmark, for it was not rich with +carving and colour as was his, and the arms on the wall were few, and +the hangings might have been brighter and better in a king's place. + +"Our king does not seem to keep much state," Ragnar said, looking round +as I was looking, and we both laughed. + +Then the door on the high place opened, and the king came in, soberly +dressed, and with a smile on his face which seemed to me to have been +made on purpose for this greeting, for he mostly looked sour enough. Nor +did it seem that his eyes had any pleasure in them. + +"Welcome, kinsman," he said, seeming hearty enough, however; "I had +looked for you before this. What news from our good town of Norwich?" + +He held out his hand to Ragnar, who took it frankly, and his strong grip +twisted the king's set smile into a grin of pain for a moment. + +"All was well there three weeks ago when I left there to go to London. +Now, I have ridden on to say that the Lady Goldberga is not far hence, +so that her coming may be prepared for." + +Now, as the earl said this, the king's smile went from his face, and +black enough he looked for a moment. The look passed quickly, and the +smile came back, but it seemed hard to keep it up. + +"Why, that is well," he said; "so you fell in with her on the way." + +"I have attended her from London," answered the earl, looking +steadfastly at Alsi, "and it was as well that I did so, as it happened." + +"What has been amiss?" asked the king sharply, and trying to look +troubled. He let the smile go now altogether. + +"Your henchman, Griffin the Welshman, had no guard with her that was +fitting for our princess," Ragnar said. "He had but twenty men, and +these not of the best. It is in my mind also that I should have been +told of this journey, for I am surely the right man to have guarded my +queen who is to be." + +At that Alsi's face went ashy pale, and I did not rightly know why at +the time, but it seemed more in anger than aught else. But he had to +make some answer. + +"We sent a messenger to you," he said hastily; "I cannot tell why he did +not reach you." + +"He must have come too late, and after I had heard of this from others; +so I had already gone to meet the princess. I am glad that I was sent +for, and it may pass. Well, it is lucky that I was in time, for we were +attacked on the road, and but for my men there would have been trouble." + +Then Alsi broke into wrath, which was real enough. + +"This passes all. Where and by whom were you attacked? and why should +any fall on the party?" + +"Five miles on the other side of Ancaster town, where the Ermin Street +runs among woods, we were fallen on, but who the men were I cannot say. +Why they should fall on us seems plain enough, seeing that the ransom of +a princess is likely to be a great sum." + +"Was it a sharp fight?" + +"It was not," answered Ragnar, "for it seemed to me that the men looked +only to find your Welsh thane Griffin and his men. When they saw my +Norfolk housecarls, they waited no longer, and we only rode down one or +two of them. But I have somewhat against this Griffin, for he helped me +not at all. Until this day he and his men had ridden fairly with us, but +by the time this attack came they were half a mile behind us." + +"Do you mean to say that you think Griffin in league with these-- +outlaws, as one may suppose them?" said Alsi, with wrath and more else +written in twitching mouth and crafty eyes. + +"I would not have said that," Ragnar answered, looking in some surprise +at the king, "it had never come into my head. But I will say that as the +Ermin Street is straight as an arrow, and he was in full sight of us, he +might have spurred his horses to our help, whereas he never quickened +his pace till he saw that the outlaws, or whoever they were, had gone. I +put this as a complaint to you." + +"These men seem to have scared you, at least," sneered the king. + +Ragnar flushed deeply. + +"For the princess--yes. It is not fitting that a man who is in charge +of so precious a lady should hold back in danger, even of the least +seeming, as did Griffin. And I told him so." + +Now I thought that Alsi would have been as angry with Griffin as was the +earl, and that he would add that he also would speak his mind to him, +hut instead of that he went off in another way. + +"It was a pity that a pleasant journey with a fair companion was thus +broken in upon. But it was doubtless pleasant that the lady should see +that her kinsman was not unwilling to draw sword for her. A pretty +little jest this, got up between Griffin and yourself, and such as a +young man may be forgiven for playing. I shall hear Goldberga complain +of honest Griffin presently, and now I shall know how to answer her. Ay, +I will promise him the like talking to that you gave him, and then we +three will laugh over it all together." + +And with that the king broke into a cackle of laughter, catching hold of +the earl's arm in his glee. And I never saw any man look so altogether +bewildered as did Ragnar. + +"Little jest was there in the matter, lord king, let me tell you," he +said, trying to draw his arm away. + +"Nay, I am not angry with you, kinsman; indeed, I am not. We have been +young and eager that bright eyes should see our valour ourselves ere +now," and he shook his finger at the earl gaily. "I only wonder that you +induced that fiery Welshman to take a rating in the hearing of the +princess quietly." + +"What I had to say to him I said apart. I will not say that he did take +it quietly." + +"Meaning--that you had a good laugh over it;" and Alsi shook the +earl's arm as in glee. "There now, you have made a clean breast, and I +am not one to spoil sport. Go and meet Goldberga at the gates, and bring +her to me in state, and you shall be lodged here, if you will. Quite +right of you to tell me this, or Griffin would have been in trouble. But +I must not have the lady scared again, mind you." + +He turned quickly away, then, with a sort of stifled laugh, as if he +wanted to get away to enjoy a good jest, and left Ragnar staring +speechless at him as he crossed the high place and went through the +private door. + +Then the earl turned to me, "By Loki, fellow countryman, there is +somewhat wrong here. What does he mean by feigning to think the whole +affair a jest? It won't be much of a jest if Griffin and I slay one +another tomorrow, as we mean to do, because of what was not done, and +what was said about it." + +"It has seemed to me, jarl," I said plainly, "that all this is more like +a jest between the king and Griffin." + +"Call it a jest, as that is loyal, at least. But I think that you are +right. If Goldberga had been carried off--Come, we shall be saying too +much in these walls." + +I had only been told to wait while the king and earl spoke together, and +so I opened the door and followed him out. The horse was yet there +waiting for him, and it was plain that the king had not meant him to stay. + +"Bid the grooms lead the horse after us, and we will go to your captain. +Then you shall take me to one of my friends, for you will know where +their houses are." + +But at that moment a man from the palace ran after us, bringing an order +from the king that I was to go back to him. So Ragnar bade me farewell. + +"Come to me tonight at the gatehouse," he said. "I will speak to the +captain to let you off duty." + +"Say nothing to him, jarl, for it is needless. I am only with him for a +time, and am my own master. I have no turn on watch tonight, and so am +free." + +So I went back, and found the king in the hall again, and he was still +smiling. If he had looked me straight in the face, I suppose that he +might have seen that I was not a man to whom he was used, but he did +not. He seemed not to wish to do so. + +"So, good fellow," he said, "you have heard a pleasant jest of our young +kinsman's contriving, but I will that you say nothing of it. It is a +pity to take a good guardroom story from you, however, without some +recompense, and therefore--" + +With that he put a little bag into my hand, and it was heavy. I said +nothing, but bowed in the English way, and he went on, "You understand; +no word is to be said of what you have heard unless I bid you repeat it. +That I may have to do, lest it is said that Griffin the thane is +'nidring' [9] by any of his enemies. You know all the +story--how the earl and he planned a sham attack on the princess's +party, that Ragnar might show his valour, which, of course, he could not +do if Griffin was there. Therefore the thane held back. But maybe you +heard all, and understood it." + +"I heard all, lord king, and I will say naught." + +The king waved his hand in sign that I was dismissed, and I bowed and +went. There were five rings of gold in the bag, worth about the whole +year's wage of a courtman, and I thought that for keeping a jest to +myself that was good pay indeed. There must be more behind that +business, as it had seemed to me already. + +Now, as I crossed the green within the old walls on my way to the gate, +it happened that Havelok came back from the town, and as he came I heard +him whistling softly to himself a strange wild call, as it were, of a +hunting horn, very sweet, and one that I had never heard before. + +"Ho, brother!" I said, for there was no one near us. "What is that call +you are whistling?" + +He started and looked up at me suddenly, and I saw that his trouble was +on him again. + +"In my dream," he said slowly, "there is a man on a great horse, and he +wears such bracelets as Ragnar of Norwich, and he winds his horn with +that call, and I run to him; and then I myself am on the horse, and I go +to the stables, and after that there is nothing but the call that I +hear. Now it has gone again." + +And his hand went up in the way that made me sad to see. + +"It will come back by-and-by. Trouble not about it." + +"I would that we were back in Grimsby," he said, with a great sigh. +"This is a place of shadows. Ghosts are these of days that I think can +never have been." + +"Well," said I, wanting to take him out of himself, "this is no ghost, +at all events. I would that one of our brothers would come from home +that I might send it to them in Grimsby. We do not need it." + +So I showed him the gold, and he wondered at it, and laughed, saying +that the housecarls had the best place after all. And so he went on, and +I back to the gate. + +Surely he minded at last the days when Gunnar his father had ridden home +to the gate, as the Danish earl had ridden even now, and had called his +son to him with that call. It was all coming back, as one thing or +another brought it to his mind; and I wondered what should be when he +knew that the dream was the truth. For what should Havelok, foster-son +of the fisher, do against a king who for twelve long years had held his +throne? And who in all the old land would believe that he was indeed the +son of the lost king? Better, it seemed to me, that this had not +happened, and that he had been yet the happy, careless, well-loved son +of Grim, with no thought of aught higher than the good of the folk he knew. + +When I got back to the gate, we were marched down the town, that we +might be ready to receive the princess; and as I went through the +market, I saw one of the porters whom I knew, and I beckoned to him, so +that he came alongside me in the ranks, and I asked him if he would go +to Grimsby for me for a silver penny. He would do it gladly; and so I +sent him with word to Arngeir that I needed one of them here to take a +gift that I had for them. I would meet whoever came at the widow's +house, and I set a time when I would look for them. I thought it was +well that the king's gold should not be wasted, even for a day's use, if +I could help it. And I wearied to see one of the brothers, and hear all +that was going on. + + + CHAPTER XI. THE COMING OF THE PRINCESS. + +There is no need for me to tell aught of the entry of the Lady Goldberga +into the town, for anyone may know how the people cheered her, and how +the party were met by the Norfolk thanes and many others, and so rode on +up the hill to the palace. What the princess was like I hardly noticed +at that time, for she was closely hooded, and her maidens were round +her. And I had something else to think of; for foremost, and richly +dressed, with a gold chain round his neck, rode a man whose strange way +of carrying his head caught my eye at once, so that I looked more than a +second time at him. + +And at last I knew him. It was that man of ours whose neck had been +twisted by the way in which he had been hauled on board at the time of +the wreck, and had afterwards gone to Ethelwald's court. One would say +that this Mord had prospered exceedingly, for he was plainly a man of +some consequence in the princess's household. He did not know me, though +it happened that he looked right at me for a moment; but I did not +expect him to do so after twelve years, seeing that I was but a boy when +we parted. I thought that I would seek him presently. + +Then I saw Griffin, the Welsh thane, and I did not like the looks of him +at all. He was a black-haired man, clean shaven, so that the cruel +thinness of his lips was not hidden, and his black eyes were restless, +and never stayed anywhere, unless he looked at Ragnar for a moment, and +then that was a look of deadly hatred. He wore his armour well, and had +a steady seat on his horse; but, if all that I had heard of him was +true, his looks did not belie him. Men had much to say of him here, for, +being some far-off kin to Alsi's Welsh mother, he was always about the +court, and was hated. He had gone to Dover to fetch the princess before +we came here, but it happened that I had once or twice seen him at other +times when I was in Lincoln, so that I knew him now. + +There was great feasting that night in the king's hall, as one may +suppose, and I sat with the housecarls at the cross tables beyond the +fire, and I could see the Lady Goldberga at Alsi's side. Tired she was +with her long journey, and she did not remain long at the table; but I +had never seen so wondrously beautiful a lady. Griffin sat next to her +on the king's right hand, for Ragnar was at the king's left, in the seat +of next honour; and I saw that the lady had no love for the Welsh thane. +But I also thought that I saw how he would give his all for a kindly +glance from her; and if, as Alsi had seemed to hint, Ragnar was a +favoured lover, I did not wonder that Griffin had been ready to do him a +bad turn. I had rather that the thane was my friend than my foe, for he +would be no open enemy. + +I left the feast when the first change of guard went out, for I saw that +the ale cup was passing faster than we Danes think fitting, being less +given to it than the English. And when the guard was set I waited alone +in the guardroom of the old gate, for Eglaf was yet at the hall, and +would be there all night maybe. And presently Earl Ragnar came in and +sat down with me. + +He was silent for a while, and I waited for him to speak, until he +looked up at me with a little laugh, and said, "I told you that I had to +fight Griffin tomorrow?" + +"You did, earl. Is that matter settled otherwise?" + +"Not at all," he answered. "I believe now that he was acting under +orders, but I have said things to him which he cannot pass over. I +called him 'nidring' to his face, and that I still mean; for though I +thought of cowardice at the time, he is none the less so if he has +plotted against the princess. So naught but the sword will end the feud." + +He pondered for some moments, and then went on, "It is a bad business; +for if I slay Griffin, he is the king's favourite; and if he slays me, +the Norfolk thanes will have somewhat to say. And all is bad for the +Lady Goldberga, who needs all the friends that she has, for in either +case there will be trouble between the two kingdoms that Alsi holds just +now." + +"If Griffin is slain," I said, "I think that the lady has one trouble +out of the way." + +"Ay; and the king will make out, as you heard him do even now, that I am +looking that way myself. It is not so, for I will say to you at once +that to me there is but one lady in all the world, and she is in Norfolk +at this time. Now I am going to ask you something that is a favour." + +I thought that he would give me some message for this lady, in case he +fell; but he had more to ask than that. Nothing more or less than that I +should be his second in the fight, because I was a fellow countryman, +while to ask an East Anglian thane would he to make things harder yet +for Goldberga. + +"I am no thane, earl," I said plainly. "This is an honour that is over +high for me." + +"It seems that you own a town, for I asked Eglaf just now," he answered; +"and that is enough surely to give you thane's rank in a matter like +this. But that is neither here nor there; it is as Dane to Dane that I +ask you. If I could find another of us I would ask him also, that you +might not have to stand alone. I am asking you to break the law that +bids the keeping of the peace at the time of the meeting of the Witan." + +"That is no matter," I said. "If I have to fly, it will be with you as +victor; and if it is but a matter of a fine, I have had that from the +king today which will surely pay it." + +And I told him of the gift for silence, whereat he laughed heartily, and +then said that the secret was more worth than he thought. This looked +very bad, and like proof that the king was at the bottom of the whole +business. + +Now I had been thinking, and it seemed better that there should be two +witnesses of the fight on our side, and I thought that Havelok was the +man who would make the second. So I told Ragnar that I could find +another Dane who was at least as worthy as I, and he was well pleased. +Then he told me where the meeting was to be, and where we should meet +him just before daylight; and so he went back to the hall, where the +lights were yet burning redly, and the songs were wilder than ever. + +And I found Havelok, and told him of the fight that was to be, and asked +him to come with us. His arms were at the widow's, and he could get them +without any noticing him. + +There is no need to say that he was ready as I to help Ragnar, and so we +spoke of time and place, and parted for the night. + +Very early came Havelok to the house, for I lodged at the widow's when I +was not on night duty; and we armed ourselves, and then came Ragnar. He +greeted me first, and then looked at Havelok in amaze, as it seemed, and +then bowed a little, and asked me to make my friend known to him. + +"If you are the friend of whom Radbard has told me, I think that I am +fortunate in having come to him." + +"I am his brother, lord earl," answered Havelok, "and I am at your service." + +Ragnar looked from one of us to the other, and then smiled. + +"A brother Dane and a brother in arms, truly," he said. "Well, that is +all that I need ask, except your name, as I am to be another brother of +the same sort." + +Then Havelok looked at me, and I nodded. I knew what he meant; but it +was not right that the earl should not know who he was. + +"Men call me Curan here, lord earl, and that I must be to you hereafter. +But I am Havelok of Grimsby, son of Grim." + +In a moment I saw that the earl knew more of that name than I had deemed +possible; and then I minded Mord, the wry-necked, who was the +chamberlain now. But Ragnar said nothing beyond that he would remember +the request, and that he was well seconded. And then we went out into +the grey morning, and without recrossing the bridge, away to the level +meadows on the south of the river, far from any roadway. + +"There is not an island in the stream," said Ragnar, "or I should have +wanted the old northern holmgang battle. I doubt if we could even get +these Welshmen to peg out the lists." + +"That we must see to," I said. "We will have all things fair in some way." + +Half a mile from the town we came to what they call a carr--a woody +rise in the level marsh--and on the skirts of this two men waited us. +They were the seconds of Griffin, Welsh or half Welsh both of them by +their looks, and both were well armed. Their greeting was courteous +enough, and they led us by a little track into the heart of the +thickets, and there was a wide and level clearing, most fit for a fight, +in which waited Griffin himself. + +Now I had never taken any part in a fight before, and I did not rightly +know what I had to do to begin with. However, one of the other side +seemed to be well up in the matter, and at once he came to me and +Havelok and took us aside. + +"Here is a little trouble," he said: "our men have said nothing of what +weapons they will use." + +"I take it," said Havelok at once, "that they meant to use those which +were most handy to them, therefore." + +The Welshman stared, and answered rather stiffly, "This is not a matter +of chance medley, young sir, but an ordered affair. But doubtless this +is the first time you have been in this case, and do not know the rules. +Let me tell you, therefore, that your earl, being the challenged man, +has choice of weapons. + +"Why, then," answered Havelok, "it seems to me that if we say as I have +already said, it is fair on our part. For it is certain that the earl +will want to use the axe, and your man is about half his weight, so that +would be uneven." + +"As the challenged man, the earl is entitled to any advantage in weapons." + +"He needs none. Let us fight fairly or not at all. The earl takes the +axe.--What say you, Radbard? Griffin takes what he likes." + +"You keep to the axe after all, and yet say that it gives an advantage." + +"Axe against axe it does, but if your man chooses to take a twenty-foot +spear and keep out of its way, we do not object. We give him his own +choice." + +Then the other second said frankly, "This is generous, Cadwal. No more +need be said. But this young thane has not yet asked his earl whether it +will suit him." + +"Faith, no," said Havelok, laughing; "I was thinking what I should like +myself, and nothing at all of the earl." + +So I went across to Ragnar, who was waiting patiently at one end of the +clearing, while Griffin was pacing with uneven steps backward and +forward at the other, and I told him what the question was. + +"I thought it would be a matter of swords," he said, "but I am Dane +enough to like the axe best. Settle it as you will. Of course he knows +naught of axe play, so that you are right in not pressing it on him. He +is a light man, and active, and maybe will be glad not even to try sword +to sword; for look at the sort of bodkin he is wearing." + +The earl and we had the northern long sword, of course; but when I +looked I saw that the Welsh had short, straight, and heavy weapons of +about half the length of ours, and so even sword to sword seemed hard on +the lighter man; wherein I was wrong, as I had yet to learn. + +I went back, therefore, and told the others. + +"The earl takes the axe, and the thane has his choice, as we have said." + +"We have to thank you," said the other second, while Cadwal only laughed +a short laugh, and bade us choose the ground with them. + +There was no difficulty about that, for the light was clear and bright, +and though the sun was up, the trees bid any bright rays that might be +in the eyes of the fighters. However, we set them across the light, so +that all there was might be even; and then we agreed that if one was +forced back to the edge of the clearing he was to be held beaten, as if +we had been on an island. It was nearly as good, for the shore of trees +and brushwood was very plain and sharp. + +Now Ragnar unslung his round shield from his shoulders, and took his axe +from me, for I had carried it for him, and his face was quiet and +steady, as the face of one should be who has a deed to do that must be +seen through to the end. But Griffin and his men talked quickly in their +own tongue, and I had to tell them that we understood it well enough. +Then they looked at each other, and were silent suddenly. I wondered +what they, were about to say, for it seemed that my warning came just in +time for them. + +Griffin took a shield from the thane they called Cadwal, and it was +square--a shape that I had not seen before in use, though Witlaf had +one like it on the wall at Stallingborough. He said that it had been won +from a chief by his forefathers when the English first came into the +land, and that it was the old Roman shape. It seemed unhandy to me, but +I had no time to think of it for a moment, for now Cadwal had a last +question. + +"Is this fight to be to the death?" + +"No," I answered; "else were the rule we made about the boundary of no use." + +Then Griffin cried in a sort of choked voice, "It shall be to the death." + +But I said nothing, and the other second, with Cadwal, shook his head. + +Ragnar made no sign, but Cadwal said to Havelok, "You were foremost in +the matter just now. What say you?" + +"Rules are rules, and what my comrade says is right. If the first blow +slays, we cannot help it, but there shall be no second wound. The man +who is first struck is defeated." + +"I will not have it so," said Griffin. + +"Well, then, thane, after you have wounded the earl you will have to +reckon with me, if you must slay someone." + +Griffin looked at the towering form of my brother and made no answer, +and the other second told him that it was right. There was naught but an +angry word or two to be atoned for. So there was an end, and Ragnar went +on guard. Griffin made ready also, and at once it was plain that here +was no uneven match after all. + +Both of them wore ring mail of the best. We had set the two six paces +apart, and they must step forward to get within striking distance. At +once Griffin seemed to grow smaller, for he crouched down as a cat that +is going to spring, and raised his shield before him, so that from where +I stood behind Ragnar I could only see his black glittering eyes and +round helm above its edge. And his right arm was drawn back, so that +only the point of his heavy leaf-bladed sword was to be seen glancing +from the right edge steadily. And now his eyes were steady as the sword +point, which was no brighter than they. If once he got inside the sweep +of the great axe it would be bad for Ragnar. + +One step forward went the earl, shield up and axe balanced, but Griffin +never moved. Then Ragnar leapt forward and struck out, but I could see +that it was a feint, and he recovered at once. Griffin's shield had gone +up in a moment above his head, and in a moment it was back in its place, +and over it his eyes glared as before, unwavering. And then, like a +wildcat, he sprang at Ragnar, making no sweeping blow with his sword, +but thrusting with straight arm, so that the whole weight of his flying +body was behind the point. Ragnar struck out, but the square shield was +overhead to stay the blow, and full on the round Danish buckler the +point of the short sword rang, for the earl was ready to meet it. + +In a moment the Welshman was back in his crouching guard, leaving a +great ragged hole in the shield whence he had wrenched his weapon point +in a way that told of a wrist turn that had been long practised. Ragnar +had needed no leech, had his quick eye not saved him from that thrust. + +Then for a breathing space the two watched each other, while we held our +breath, motionless. And then Griffin slowly began to circle round his +foe, still crouching. + +Then, like a thunderbolt, Ragnar's axe swept down on the thane, and +neither shield nor helm would have been of avail had that blow gone +home. Back leapt Griffin, and the axe shore the edge only of his shield; +and then, shield aloft and point foremost, he flew on the earl before +the axe had recovered from its swing, and I surely thought that the end +had come, for the earl's shield was lowered, and his face was unguarded. + +But that was what he looked for. Up and forward flew the round shield, +catching the thane's straightened arm along its whole length, and then, +as sword and arm were dashed upwards, smiting him fairly in the face; +and, like a stone, the Welshman was hurled from it, and fell backward in +a heap on the grass three paces away. It seemed to me that he was off +his feet in his spring as the shield smote him. + +There he lay, and Havelok strode forward and stood between the two, with +his face to Griffin, for Ragnar had dropped his axe to rest when his foe +fell. + +"No blood drawn," said my brother, "but no more fighting can there be. +The man's arm is out." + +And so it was, for the mighty heave that turned the thrust had ended +Griffin's fighting for a long day. But he did not think so. + +The sweat was standing on his face in great beads from the pain, but he +got up and shifted his sword to his left hand. + +"It is to the death," he cried; "I can fight as well with the left. +Stand aside." + +"An it had been so, you were a dead man now," said Havelok, "for the +earl held his hand where he might have slain. If he had chosen, you +might have felt his axe before you touched the ground." + +Thereat, without warning other than a snarl of "Your own saying," +Griffin leapt at my brother fiercely, only to meet a swing of his axe +that sent his sword flying from his hand. And that was deft of Havelok, +for there is nothing more hard to meet than a left-handed attack at any +time, and this seemed unlooked for. + +"Well, I did say somewhat of this sort," said Havelok; "but it was lucky +that I had not forgotten it." + +Then he took the thane by the waist and left arm and set him down +gently; and after that all the fury went from him, and he grew pale with +the pain of the arm that was hurt. But both I and the Welshmen had +shouted to Griffin to hold, all uselessly, so quick had been his onset +on his new foe. + +Cadwal held his peace, biting his lip, but the other Welshman began to +blame Griffin loudly for this. + +"Nay," said Havelok, smiling; "it was my own fault maybe. The thane was +overhasty certainly, but one does not think with pain gnawing at one. +Let that pass. + +"Now, earl, I think that you may say what you have to say that will set +things right once more." + +"Can none of us put the arm back first?" I said. "I will try, if none +else has done such a thing before, for it will not be the first time." + +"Put it back, if you can," said Cadwal. "If there is anything to be +said, it had better be in some sort of comfort." + +So I put the arm back, for when once the trick is learned there is not, +as a rule, much trouble. But Griffin never thanked me. He left that to +his seconds, who did so well enough. + +Then Ragnar came forward and said gravely, "I was wrong when I called +you 'nidring,' and I take back the word and ask you to forget it. No man +who is that will face the Danish axe as you have faced it, and I will +say that the British sword is a thing to be feared." + +But Griffin made no answer, and when Ragnar held out his hand he would +not see it. + +"Maybe I have not yet made amends," Ragnar went on. "I will add, +therefore, as I know that my words will go no farther, that I am sure +that the thing concerning which we quarrelled yesterday was done by you +at the orders of another. It was not your own doing, and no thought of +cowardice is in my mind now." + +But Griffin never answered; and now he turned his back on the earl, who +was plainly grieved, and said no more to him, but turned to us and the +two Welshmen. + +"I do not think that I can say more. If there is aught that is needed, +tell me. We have fought a fair fight, and I have taken back the words +that caused it." + +Then said Cadwal, "No more is needed. I did not think that we had met +with so generous a foe. If Griffin will say naught, we say this for him. +He has no cause for enmity left. And I say also that he has to thank +this thane for his life as well as the earl." + +"No thane am I," said Havelok, "but only Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby. +And even that name is set aside for a while, so that I must ask you to +forget it. I have seen a good fight, if a short one, and one could not +smite a wounded man who forgot himself for a moment." + +There was nothing more to be had from Griffin, for we waited a minute or +two in silence to see if he would speak, and then we saluted and left +the wood. + +The last thing that I saw seemed to be a matter of high words between +Griffin and his seconds; and, indeed, if they were telling him what they +thought, it is likely that he wished he had been more courteous. It is +easy enough for a man who wants a quarrel to have done with one and then +start another. + + + CHAPTER XII. IN LINCOLN MARKETPLACE. + +We went quietly back to the town, and there was only one thing that I +wished, and that was that Havelok had not had to tell his name twice. +Ragnar was full of thanks to us for our help, and said that he would +that we would come to Norfolk with him. + +"We have a man who knows you also," he said, "but he has been with our +princess for a long time now. He is called Mord, and is her chamberlain. +He has often told me how he came by his wry-neck at the time of your +shipwreck." + +So he said, and looked at Havelok. But this was a thing that he had not +seen, as he was so sick at the time. I said that I remembered Mord well, +and would seek him some time in the day. + +And as I said this I was thinking that I must find out from Mord whether +he knew and had told more than I could of who Havelok was and whence he +came to us. It seemed to me that the earl had heard some tale or other, +and unless it was from him I could not think from whence. + +Now the earl said, "This business has ended better than I could have +hoped, and I think that Alsi will not hear of it. Griffin can well +account for a slipped shoulder by any sort of fall that he likes to own +to, and Alsi would be hardly pleased to hear that he had run the risk of +setting all Norfolk against him for nothing after all." + +"There is no doubt that he meant you to know that he does not consider +the quarrel done with," I said. "You have an enemy there." + +"Nothing new, that," answered Ragnar, laughing. "He thinks that I stand +in his way with the princess. I suppose it is common talk that if he +wedded her Alsi would still hold the East Anglian kingdom, making him +ealdorman, if only I were out of the way. But were I to wed the lady, +then it is certain that she would take the crown at once. I do not mean +to do so, for then it is likely that three people would be unhappy for +the rest of their days. But that would be less wretched for her than to +wed Griffin." + +"This is no pleasant strait for the poor lady," said Havelok grimly. "Do +none ask what she herself can wish?" + +"That is the trouble," said the earl, "for she is in Alsi's hand, and +there is some old promise and oath sworn between him and Ethelwald her +father that holds him back. Else had she been wedded to Griffin before now." + +Then we came to the widow's house, and Havelok left his arms there, and +we went on to the marketplace. As we crossed the bridge we saw that +there was something going forward, for there was a gathering in the wide +space, and a shouting and cheering now and then, and even Berthun +himself was there looking on and seeming to be highly entertained. + +"Here is a crowd that I will not face just now, in my arms," said the +earl; "for this hole in my shield looks bad, not having been there when +I went out. Farewell for the time, therefore, and think of what I said +about your coming to Norwich with me." + +He turned away therefore, and Havelok looked after him for a moment. The +shield hung at his back, plain to be seen. + +"It is a hole, for certain," he said; "but there is no need to show it +in that wise." + +So he strode after him. + +"By your leave, earl, I will arrange your cloak across the shield, and +then you can get it to your armourer without notice." + +"That is well thought of," answered Ragnar, as Havelok did as he had +said. "I do not forget that I think that I owe you my life, though I +have said nothing as yet." + +"How is that?" + +"Griffin would have flown on me as he did on you, certainly; and it is +in my mind that you foresaw it, which I did not. I could not have stayed +him." + +"Well I did," answered my brother; "else had either I or you a hole in +us like the one that is well covered now. But I feared what came to pass." + +Ragnar held out his hand, and Havelok took it, and so they parted +without more words; but I knew that these two were friends from that +time forward, whatever happened. + +There were some sports of some sort on hand, when we came to see what +all the noise was; and Berthun, seeing us, called Havelok to him. + +"I have been looking for you," he said, with that curious tone of his +that always seemed to be asking pardon for his boldness in speaking to +my brother; "for here are games at which they need some one to show the +way." + +"This is a sport that I have not seen before," answered Havelok, looking +over the heads of the crowd. "I should make a poor hand at it." + +They had been tossing a great fir pole, which was now laid on one side, +with its top split from its falls, and they, thanes and freemen in turn, +were putting a great stone, so heavy that a matter of a few inches +beyond the longest cast yet made would be something to be proud of. Good +sport enough it was to see the brawny housecarls heave it from the +ground and swing it. But no one could lift it above his knee, so that +one may suppose that it flew no great distance at a cast. + +"Nay, but the thanes are trying," Berthun said. "It is open to all to do +what they can. One of your porters is best man so far." + +"Well, I will not try to outdo him." + +"I would that you would lift the stone, Curan. That is a thing that I +should most like to see." + +"Well then, master, as you bid me, I will try. But do not expect too much." + +The man who had the stone made his cast, which was nothing to speak of; +and then the stone lay unclaimed for a time, while all the onlookers +waited to see who came forward next. Then Havelok made his way through +the crowd, and a silence as of wonder fell on the people; for some knew +him, and had heard of his strength, and those who did not stared at him +as at a wonder. But the silence did not last long, for the porters who +were there set up a sort of shout of delight, and that one who had made +the longest cast so far began to tell him how best to heft the stone and +swing it. + +Then Havelok bent to raise the stone, and the noise hushed again. I saw +his mighty limbs harden and knot under the strain, and up to his knee he +heaved it, and to his middle, and yet higher, to his chest, while we all +held our breaths, and then with a mighty lift it was at his shoulder, +and he poised it, and swung as one who balances for a moment, and then +hurled it from him. Then was a shout that Alsi might have heard in his +hilltop palace, for full four paces beyond the strong porter's cast it +flew, lighting with a mighty crash, and bedding itself in the ground +where it lit. And I saw the young thanes with wide eyes looking at my +brother, and from beside me Berthun the cook fairly roared with delight. + +And then from across the space between the two lines of onlookers I saw +a man in a fisher's dress that caught my eye. It was Withelm, and we +nodded to each other, well pleased. + +Now there seemed to be a strife as to who should get nearest to Havelok, +for men crowded to pat him and to look up at him, and that pleased him +not at all. One came and bade him take the silver pennies that the +thanes had set out for the prize, but he shook his head and smiled. + +"I threw the thing because I was bidden, and not for any prize," he +said. "I would have it given to the porter who fairly won it." + +Then he elbowed his way to Berthun, and said, "let us go, master; we +have stayed here too long already." + +"As it pleases you," the steward said; and Havelok waved his hand to me, +and they went their way. + +He had not seen Withelm, and I was glad, for I wanted to speak to him +alone first. + +Now men began to ask who this was, and many voices answered, while the +porter went to claim the prize from the thane who held it. + +Two silver pennies the thane gave him, and said, "This seems to be a +friend of yours, and it was good to hear you try to help him without +acrimony. Not that he needed any hints from any one, however. Who is he?" + +"Men call him Curan, that being the name he gives himself; but he came +as a stranger to the place, and none know from whence, unless Berthun +the cook may do so. Surely he is a friend of mine, for he shook me once, +and that shaking made an honest man of me. He himself taught me what +fair play is, at that same time." + +So said the porter, and laughed, and the thane joined him. + +"Well, he has made a sort of name for himself as a wonder, certainly, +now. I think that this cast of his will be told of every time men lift a +stone here in Lincoln," said the thane. + +They left the stone where he had set it, and any one may see it there to +this day, and there I suppose it will be for a wonder while Havelok's +name is remembered. + +Then they began wrestling and the like, and I left the crowd and went to +Withelm, going afterwards to the widow's. I was not yet wanted by Eglaf +for any housecarl duty. + +"I sent a man to Grimsby yesterday," I said; "but you must have passed +him on the way somewhere, for he could not have started soon enough to +take you a message before you left." + +"I met him on the road last night, for I myself thought it time to come +and see how you two fared. I bided at Cabourn for the night, and your +messenger came on with me." + +Then he told me that all were well at Grimsby; for fish came now and +then and kept the famine from the town, though there were none to send +elsewhere; and it was well that we had left, though they all missed us +sorely. + +Then we began to talk of the doings here; and at last I spoke of +Havelok's trouble, as one may well call it, telling him also of the +strange dream with which it all began. + +"All this is strange," he said thoughtfully; "but if Havelok our brother +is indeed a king's son, it is only what he is like in all his ways. Wise +was our father Grim, and I mind how he seemed always to be careful of +him in every way, and good reason must he have had not to say what he +knew. We will not ask aught until the time of which Arngeir knows has +come. Nor can we say aught to Havelok, though he is troubled, for we +know nothing. As for the dream, that is part of it all, and it is a +portent, as I think." + +"Did I know the man who could read it, I would go to him and tell him it." + +"There is one man who can read dreams well," Withelm answered, flushing +a little, "but I do not know if you would care to seek him. I stayed +with him last night, and he is on his way even now to Lincoln, driven by +the famine. I mean the old British priest David, who has his little hut +and chapel in the Cabourn woods. His people have no more to give him." + +I knew that Withelm thought much of this old man of late, and I was not +surprised to hear him speak of him now. All knew his wisdom, and the +marsh folk were wont to seek him when they were in any trouble or +difficulty. But I did not care to go to him, for he seemed to belong to +the thralls, as one might say. + +"Well, if he comes here, no doubt you will know where to find him if we +need him," I said. "Bide with us for a few days at least, for here is +plenty, and there is much going on." + +So we went into the town, and then to the palace, and found Havelok, and +after that I had to go to the gate on guard. And what these two did I +cannot say, but, at all events, there is nothing worth telling of. + +Now, however, I have to tell things that I did not see or hear myself, +and therefore I would have it understood that I heard all from those who +took some part or other in the matter, and so know all well. + +I have not said much of the meetings of the Witan, for I had naught more +to do with them than to guard the doors of the hall where they met now +and then; but since the princess and Ragnar came they seem to have +somewhat to do with the story, as will be seen. + +On this day one of the Norfolk thanes asked in full meeting what plans +the king had for his ward Goldberga, and her coming into her kingdom, +saying that she, being eighteen years of age, was old enough to take her +place. + +Now Alsi had thought of this beforehand, and was ready at once. + +"It is a matter of concern to us always," he said, "and much have I +thought thereof. It is full time that she took her father's place with +the consent of the Witan, which is needed." + +He looked round us for reply to this, and at once the Norfolk thanes +said, "We will have Goldberga for our queen, as was the will of Ethelwald." + +"That," said Alsi, "is as I thought. I needed only to hear it said +openly. Now, therefore, it remains but to speak of one other thing and +that is a weighty one. It was her father's will and I swore to carry it +out, that she should be wedded to the most goodly and mightiest man in +the realm. It seems to me that on her marriage hangs all the wealth of +her kingdom; and ill it would be if, after she took the throne, she took +to herself one who made himself an evil adviser. I would say that it +were better to see her married first, for it does not follow that you +would choose to have the man whom I thought fitting to be over you, as +he certainly would be." + +Now all this was so straightforward in all seeming that none of the +thanes could be aught but pleased. Moreover, it took away a fear that +they had had lest Griffin was to be the man. None could say that he +fulfilled the conditions of the will of Ethelwald. The spokesman said, +therefore, that it was well set before them, and that it was best to +wait, saying at the end, "For, after all, we might have to change our +minds concerning the princess, if with her we must take a man who will +prove a burden or tyrant to us all." + +Then they asked the king to find a good husband for the princess as soon +as might be, so that he was not against her liking. + +"Well," said Alsi, "it is a hard task for a man who has no wife to help +him; but we will trust to the good sense of my niece. Now, I had thought +of Ragnar of Norwich; but it is in my mind that the old laws of near kin +are somewhat against this." + +I suppose that he had no intention of letting the earl marry the +princess; but this was policy, as it might please the thanes. However, +the matter of kinship did not please some, and that was all that he +needed, for there was excuse then for him if he forbade that match, +which was the last he wanted. + +Ragnar sat in his place and heard all this, and he wished himself back +at Norwich. + +So there the matter ended, and that was the last sitting of the Witan. +There was to be a great breaking-up feast that night before the thanes +scattered to their homes. + +Now while this was going on I ended my spell of duty, and bethought me +of Mord the chamberlain, and so went to Berthun and asked for him. He +said that if I had any special business with Mord I might see him; and I +said, truly enough, that my errand was special, having to do with +friends of his; so it was not long before they took me to him. He was in +a long room that was built on the side of the great hall, as it were, +and I could hear the murmur of the voices of those who spoke at the +Witan while I waited. + +Now Mord was not so much changed as I, and at first he did not know me +at all. + +"Well, master housecarl, what may your message be, and from whom is it?" +he said, without more than a glance at me. + +"Why, there are some old friends of yours who are anxious to know if you +have forgotten the feeling of a halter round your neck," I said in good +Danish. + +Then, after one look, he knew me at once, and ran to me, and took my +hand, and almost kissed me in his pleasure, for since I could handle an +oar he had known me, and had taught me how to do that, moreover. + +Then he called for wine and food; and we sat down together and had a +long talk of the old days, and of how we had fared after he left, and of +all else that came uppermost. And sorely he grieved at my father's +death, and at the trouble that was on us. The famine had not been so +sore in the south, and pestilence had not been at all. + +As for himself, he had been courtman, as we call the housecarls, at +first, and so had risen to be chamberlain to the king, and now to the +princess, and had been with her everywhere that Alsi had sent her since +her father died. + +"It was a good day for me, and wise was Grim when he bade me go to +Ethelwald to seek service," he said; "yet I would that I had seen him +once more. I have never been to this place before, else I should have +sought him." + +Now I was going to ask him about Havelok, but hardly knew how to begin. +He saved me the trouble however, by speaking first. + +"Who were the lady and the boy we had on board when we came to England?" +he said. "I never heard, and maybe it was as well that I did not." + +"My father never told me. But why do you think that it was well not to +know?" + +"Because I am sure that Grim had good reason for not telling. Before I +had been a year at Norwich there came a ship from Denmark into the +river, and soon men told me that her master was asking for news of one +Grim, a merchant, who was lost. So I saw him, not saying who I was or +that I had anything to do with Grim; and then I found that it was not so +much of the master that he wanted news as of the boy we had with us. He +did not ask of the lady at all, and I was sure that this was the man who +came and spoke to Grim just as we were sailing, if you remember. So then +it came to me that we knew nothing of the coming on board of these two, +only learning of their presence when we were far at sea. And now, if +Hodulf troubled himself so much about this boy, there must be something +that he was not meant to know about his flight, for he must be of some +note. Did I not know that the king's son was in his hands at that time, +I should have thought that our passenger was he. However, I told him of +the shipwreck as of a thing that I had seen, saying that Grim and his +family and a few men only had been saved; and I told him also that I had +heard that he had lost some folk in an attack by Vikings. With that he +seemed well satisfied, and I heard no more of him. I have wondered ever +since who the boy was, and if he was yet alive. I mind that he was like +to die when he came ashore." + +Then I laughed, and said that he would hear of him soon enough, for all +the town was talking of him; and he guessed whom I meant, for he had +heard of the cook's mighty man. + +Now I said no more but this: + +"My father kept this matter secret all these years, and with reason, as +we have seen; and so, while he is here, we call this foster-brother of +mine Curan, until the time comes when his name may he known. Maybe it +will be best for you not to say much of your knowledge of him. What does +Earl Ragnar know of our wreck? For he told me that you knew me." + +"I told him all about it at one time or another," Mord answered. "He +always wanted to hear of Denmark." + +So that was all that the chamberlain knew; but it was plain to me that +the earl had put two and two together when he heard Havelok's name, and +had remembered that this was also the name of Gunnar's son. Afterwards I +found that Mord had heard from Denmark that Hodulf was said to have made +away with Havelok, but he never remembered that at this time. Ragnar +knew this, and did remember it. + +Pleasant it was to talk of old days with an old friend thus, and the +time went quickly. Then Mord must go to his mistress and I to my place, +and so we parted for the time. But my last doubt of who Havelok my +brother might be was gone. I was sure that he was the son of Gunnar the +king. + + + CHAPTER XIII. THE WITAN'S FEASTING. + +Now I have to tell of a strange thing that happened in the night that +was just past, the first that the Lady Goldberga had spent here in +Lincoln for many a year, for on that happening hangs a great deal, and +it will make clear what I myself saw presently at the breaking-up feast +of the Witan. That puzzled me mightily at the time, as it did many at +the feast, but I see no reason why it should not be told at once. + +Now I have said that Goldberga left the hall early overnight, being +wearied with the journey, and having the remembrance of the attack on +her party so near to Lincoln to trouble her also. Not much cause to love +her uncle Alsi had she; though perhaps, also, not much to make her hate +him, except that he had kept her so far away from her own people of +late, in a sort of honourable captivity. Now it was plain to her that +had it not been for the presence of Ragnar and his men, her guard would +not have been able to drive off the attackers; and the strange way in +which Griffin had held back had been too plain for her not to notice. +Already she feared him, and it seemed that he might have plotted her +carrying off thus. That Alsi might have had a hand in the matter did not +come into her mind, as it did into the minds of others, for she knew +little of him, thinking him honest if not very pleasant in his ways, +else had not her father made him her guardian. + +I will say now that in the attack he did have a hand. Many a long year +afterward it all came out in some way. He dared not give his niece to +Griffin openly, but he wished to do so, as then he would have an +under-king in East Anglia of his own choosing. Sorely against the grain +with him was it that he should have to give up those fair lands to this +girl, who would hold the throne by her own right, and not at all under +him. So he and Griffin had plotted thus, and only Ragnar's presence had +spoilt the plan, though Griffin had tried to save it by holding back. +But I must say also that up to this time none had had aught to say +against Alsi as a ruler, though he was over close, and not at all hearty +in his ways at home. But now, for the sake of the kingdom, he had begun +to plot; and this plan having come to naught, he must make others, as +will be seen. I do not think that this planning to keep Ethelwald's +kingdom from his daughter was anything fresh to Alsi, but the time for +action had come now. + +He had made ready by keeping the fair princess far away, and there were +none who could speak of her goodness, or, indeed, had heard much of her +since she was a child. Therefore, as men were content enough with him, +none would trouble much if the princess came not to the throne, given +good reason why she should not do so. And the very best reason would be +that which Alsi had given at the Witan--if her husband was not fit to +be king. + +It is possible that Goldberga knew that her marriage would be talked of +at this Witan: but I do not think that she troubled herself much about +it, not by any means intending to be married against her will. I have +heard that so ran the will of Ethelwald, that she was to have choice to +some extent. However that may be, with so many thoughts to trouble her +she went to rest, and her sleep was not easy until the morning was near, +and then came quiet. + +But presently, in the grey of the dawn, she woke, and called her old +nurse, who was in the chamber with her; and when she came she told her +that she had had a strange vision or dream, so real that she did not +know which it was. And what it portended she could not say, for it was +wonderful altogether, and surely was good. + +"I thought that a voice wakened me, calling me to look on somewhat; and +so I rose as I was bidden, and saw before me the most mighty and +comeliest man that could be thought of. Kinglike he was, though he had +no crown and was meanly clad, without brooch or bracelet that a king +should wear. But the wonder was that from his mouth came a bright shaft +of flame, as it were of a sunbeam, that lighted all the place, and on +his shoulder shone a cross of burning light as of red-hot gold, and I +knew that it was the mark of a mighty king. + +"Then I heard the voice again, and I turned, and saw that it was an +angel who spoke to me, and his face was bright and kind. + +"'Fear not, Goldberga,' he said, 'for this is your husband that shall +be. King's son and heir is he, as that token of the fiery cross shows. +More, also, it will betoken--that he shall reign in England and in +Denmark, a great king and mighty. And this you shall see, and with him +shall you reign as queen and well-loved lady.' + +"So the voice ceased, and the angel was gone, and when I looked up there +was naught but the growing dawn across yon window, and the voice of the +thrush that sings outside." + +Now the old nurse pondered over the dream for a while without speaking, +for she could not see what it might mean at first. + +But at last she said, "It is a good dream surely, because of the angel +that spoke; but there seems only one way in which it can come to pass. A +prince must come for you from Denmark, for there he would reign by his +own right, and here he would do so by yours. Yet I have heard that the +Danish kings are most terrible heathen, worse than the Saxon kin, of +whom we know the worst now. Maybe that is why the angel told you to have +no fear. I mind Gunnar Kirkeban, and what he wrought on the churches and +Christian folk in Wales--in Gower on the Severn Sea, and on the holy +Dee--when I was young." + +For both Goldberga and this old nurse of hers were Christian, as had +been Orwenna, Ethelwald's wife, her mother. It had been a great day for +them when the King of Kent had brought over his fair wife, Bertha, from +France, for she, too, was Christian, and had restored the ancient church +in the very castle where Goldberga was kept. + +Now the princess went to sleep again, and woke refreshed; but all day +long the memory of the dream and of him whom she saw in it bided with +her, until it was time for her to go to the great hall for the feast of +the Witan. + +Now it happened that on this night I must be one of the two housecarls +who should stand, torch in hand, behind the king. It was a place that +none of the men cared for much, since they saw their comrades feasting +at the end of the room, while they must bide hungry till the end, and +mind that no sparks from the flaring pine fell on the guests, moreover. +Eglaf would have excused me this had I wished; but I would take my turn +with the rest, and maybe did not mind losing the best of the feast so +much as the others. There were some three hundred guests at that feast, +and it was a wondrous fair sight to me as I stood on the high place and +saw them gather. The long table behind which I was ran right across the +dais, rich with gold and silver and glass work: and below this, all down +the hall, ran long tables again, set lengthwise, that none might have +their backs to the king. And at the end of the hall, crosswise, were the +tables for the housecarls, and the men of the house, and of the thanes +who were guests. And as the housecarls came in they hung their shields +and weapons on the walls in order, so that they flashed bright from +above the hangings that Berthun and his men had set up afresh and more +gaily than I had seen yet in this place. + +There was a fire on the great hearth in the midst of the hall; but as it +was high summer, only a little one, and over it were no cauldrons, as +there would have been in the winter. Berthun was doing his cookery +elsewhere. But between the tables were spaces where his thralls and the +women could pass as they bore round the food and drink. And backwards +and forwards among them went Berthun until the very last, anxious and +important, seeing that all was right, and showing one guest after +another to their places. No light matter was that either, for to set a +thane in too low a place for his rank was likely to be a cause of strife +and complaint. Also he must know if there were old feuds still +remembered, lest he should set deadly enemies side by side. I did not +envy him, by any means. + +When it seemed that there were few more guests to come, and only half a +dozen seats were vacant on the high place, Berthun passed into the room +beyond the hall, and at once a hush fell on the noisy folk, who had been +talking to one another as though they had never met before. The gleemen +tuned their harps, and I and my comrade lit our torches from those +already burning on the wall, and stood ready, for the king was coming. + +Out of the door backed Berthun with many bows, and loud sang the +gleemen, while all in the hall stood up at once; and then came Alsi, +leading the princess, first; and then Ragnar, with the wife of some +great noble; and after him that noble and another lady; but Griffin was +not there. Bright looked Goldberga in her blue dress, with wondrous +jewels on arm and neck, and maybe the brighter for the absence of the +Welsh thane, as I thought. + +So they sat as last night, save that the noble who had come next to +Ragnar was in Griffin's place; and therefore I stood behind the king and +the princess, with the light of my torch falling between the two. + +Now they were set, and at once Berthun bore a great beaker of wine to +the king, and all down the hall ran his men with the pitchers of wine +and mead and ale, and with them the women of the household and the wives +of the courtmen, filling every drinking horn for the welcome cup. + +Then the gleemen hushed their song, and Alsi stood up with the +gold-rimmed horn of the king in his hand, and high he raised it, and +cried, "Waeshael!" + +And all the guests rose up, cup in hand, with a wonderful flashing of +the glorious English jewels, and cried with one voice, "Drinc hael, Cyning!" + +Then all sat them down, and at once came Berthun's men with the laden +spits and the cauldrons, and first they served the high table, kneeling +on the dais steps while each noble helped himself and the lady next him +with what he would. And then down the hall the feast began, and for a +time befell a silence--the silence of hungry folk who have before them +a good reason for not saying much for a little while. + +I looked for Havelok among Berthun's men, but he was not there. Nor was +he at the lower cross tables with the other people of the palace. But +Withelm was there, for Eglaf had seen him with me not an hour ago, and +had bidden him come, as a stranger from far off. There were a few other +strangers there also, as one might suppose, for the king's hall must be +open at these times. + +Now I looked on all this, and it pleased me; and then I began to hear +the talk of those at the high table, and that was pleasant also. First I +heard that Griffin had fallen off his horse, and had put his arm out. +Whereon one said that he only needed one hand to feed with, and +marvelled that so small a hurt kept him away from so pleasant a place as +was his. + +"It seems that he fell on his face," answered a thane who had seen him. +"He is not as handsome as he was last night. That is what keeps him +away. Some passerby put his arm in straightway." + +At that I almost laughed, but kept a face wooden as that of our old +statue of Thor, for Eglaf had warned me that I was but a torch, as it +were, unless by any chance I was spoken to. But Ragnar glanced my way +with a half smile. Presently they began to talk of the stone putting, +and of the mighty man who had come with Berthun, and I saw several +looking idly down the hall to see if they could spy him. One of the +thanes on the high seat, at the end, was he who had held the prizes at +these sports. + +Now it seemed that Alsi had not heard of this before; and when he had +been told all about it, he said that he did not know that he had any man +who was strong enough to make such a cast as they spoke of, though Eglaf +had picked up a big man somewhere lately, whom he had noticed at the +hall end once or twice. + +Then he ran his eyes over the tables, for now the women folk had sat +down among the men, and one could see everywhere. But he did not see the +man he meant, and so turned sharply on us two housecarls behind him. + +"Here he is," he said, laughing and looking at me. "Were you the mighty +stone putter they make such a talk of?" + +"I am not, lord," I said, somewhat out of countenance, because every one +looked at me together. It had never seemed to me that I was so big +before; perhaps because I was used to Havelok, and to Raven, who was +nigh as tall as myself, and maybe a bit broader. + +"Why, then, who was he?" said the king. "We must ask Berthun, unless +anyone can see him in the hall." + +Then the thane of the prizes said, "He is not here, lord; for little +trouble would there be in seeing him, if he were, seeing that he is a +full head and shoulders over even this housecarl of yours." + +Now the princess had turned to look at me, and she saw that I was +abashed, and so she smiled at me pleasantly, as much as to say that she +was a little sorry for me, and turned away. Then thought I that if ever +the princess needed one to fight for her, even to death, I would do so +for the sake of that smile and the thought for a rough housecarl that +was behind it. + +Now came Berthun with more wine, before the matter of the stone was +forgotten in other talk, and the king said, "It seems that you have +found a new man, steward, for all are talking of him. I mean the man who +is said to have thrown a big stone certain miles, or somewhat like it, +from all accounts. Where is he?" + +"He is my new porter," answered Berthun, with much pride; "but he is not +in the hail, for he does not like to hear much of himself, being quiet +in his ways, although so strong." + +"Here is a marvel," laughed Alsi, "and by-and-by we must see him. I +wonder that Eglaf let you have him." + +Now Eglaf sat at the head of the nearest of the lower tables, and all in +hearing of the king were of course listening by this time. So he said, +"The man had his choice, and chose the heavier place, if you will +believe me, lord. It is terrible to see how Berthun loads him at times; +so that I may get him yet." + +Then all laughed at the steward, whose face grew red; but he had to +laugh also, because the jest pleased the king. He went away quickly; and +one told Eglaf that he had better eat no more, else would he run risk of +somewhat deadly at the cook's hands. But those two were old friends, as +has been seen, and they were ever seeking jests at each other's expense. + +Now the talk drifted away to other things, and I hoped that Havelok had +been forgotten, for no more than I would he like being stared at. The +feast went on, and twice I had to take new torches, but Berthun saw that +I had wine, if I could not eat as yet. Then had men finished eating, and +the tables were cleared, and the singing began, very pleasant to +hearken. Not only the gleemen sang, but the harp went round, and all who +could did so. Well do the Lindsey folk sing, after their own manner, +three men at a time, in a gladsome way, with well-matched voices, and +that for just long enough to be pleasant. + +So the harp went its way down the hall, and the great folk fell to talk +again; and at last one said, so that Alsi heard him, "Why, we have not +seen the strong man yet. Strange that he is not feasting with the rest." + +Whereat the king beckoned Berthun. + +"Bring your new wonder here," he said. "Say that I have heard of his +deed, and would look on him." + +Berthun bowed and went his way; and I wondered how my brother would bear +this, for the hall and its ordering was wont, as I have said, to bring +back his troubled thoughts of things half remembered. + +Presently he came in at the door at the lower end of the hall, and at +first none noticed him, for there was singing going on, and through that +door came and went many with things for the feast from the kitchens. +Then some one turned to see who towered over them thus, and when he saw +Havelok he went on looking, so that others looked also. Then one of the +three singers looked, and his voice stayed, for he was a stranger, and +had heard nothing of this newcomer, and then Havelok followed Berthun up +the hall in a kind of hush that fell, and he was smiling a little, as if +it amused him. He had on the things that the steward had given him, and +they were good enough--as good as, if more sober than, my housecarl +finery. But I suppose that not one in all the gathering looked at what +he wore; for as he passed up the long tables, it seemed that there was +no man worth looking at but he, and even Ragnar seemed to be but a +common man when one turned to him with eyes that had seen Havelok. + +Now Alsi the king sat staring at him, still as a carven image, with his +hand halfway to his mouth, as he raised his horn from the table; and +Ragnar looked wide-eyed, for he knew him again, and I saw a little smile +curl the corners of his lips and pass; and then Havelok was at the step +of the high place, and there he gave the salute of the courtmen of a +Danish king, heeding Berthun, who tried to make him do reverence, not at +all. + +Now a spark from my torch drew my eyes from him, lest it should fall on +the princess's robe; and when it went out, I saw that the fair hand that +rested on the arm of the great chair was shaking like a leaf. When I +looked, her face was white and troubled, and she half rose from her seat +and then sank back in it gently, and the thane who sat next her spoke +anxiously to her in a low voice, and the lady by his side rose up and +came to her. + +Then Alsi turned, and he too spoke, asking if aught was amiss. + +"The princess faints with the heat of the hall," said the thane's wife. +"She yet feels the long journey. May she not go hence?" + +Then Goldberga said bravely, "It is naught, and it will pass." + +But they made her rise and leave the hall; and the guests stood up as +she went with her ladies round her, and many were the murmurs of pity +that I heard. + +"As though she had seen a ghost, so white is she," one whispered. + +But none knew how much the lady was to be pitied. She had seen the man +of her vision; and, lo! for all that she knew, he was a thrall who +toiled in the palace kitchens. + +And after her, as she withdrew, looked Havelok with eyes in which there +was more than pity. I could see him well, but I did not know how he had +seen the fair princess tremble and grow white as she gazed on him. I +know that, as he saw her for this first time, it was with the wish that +he were in Ragnar's place. But I thought that if Havelok were king, here +was the queen for him. + +Now Alsi bade the feast go on, and be spoke a few words only to Havelok, +letting him go at once, and I was glad. This sudden faintness of the +princess had put all out somewhat, and none cared to take up a jest +where it had stayed. Nevertheless, I saw the king's eyes follow my +brother down the hall, and in them was a new and strange look that was +not pleasant at all. + +Then it seemed that one was staring at me, and as will happen, I must +look in a certain place; and there was Cadwal, the Welsh thane, halfway +down one of the long tables, glaring first at me, and then at Havelok, +as he went. It came into my mind that he would be wroth with Ragnar for +bringing a kitchen knave as his second, as it were, in derision of +Griffin. I thought that I would find a chance presently to tell him why +my fellow second chose to be serving thus, and so make things right with +him, for this seemed to be due to Ragnar, if not to all concerned. + +Not long after Goldberga had gone, the king withdrew also, and then the +hall grew noisy enough, and I could leave my place. But by that time +Cadwal had left also; and next day, when I sought him, both he and +Griffin were no longer in Lincoln, none knowing whither they had gone. +So I troubled no more about them. + +But had I known that these two had been among the Welshmen that Hodulf +led to Denmark when he slew Gunnar Kirkeban, and therefore knew all the +story of the loss of Havelok, and how Hodulf had sought for news of him, +I should have been in fear enough that we had not yet done with them. +Rightly, too, should I have feared that, as will be seen. + +Now while I looked about the hall for Cadwal, Mord the chamberlain saw +me, and made me sit down by him while I ate. Hungry enough was I by that +time, as may be supposed, for one cannot make a meal off the sight of a +feast; and as I ate, the noise of the hall grew apace as the cups went +round. Then some of the older thanes left, and soon Mord and I had that +table to ourselves. It was plain that he was full of something that he +would say to me, and when I was ready to listen he bent near me and +said, "So that was the boy who fled with us." + +"Ay. He has grown since you saw him last." + +"That is not all," answered Mord. "Well I knew Gunnar, our king, and +tonight I thought he had come back to us from Valhalla, goodlier yet and +mightier than ever, as one who has feasted with the Asir might well be. +For if this boy of ours is not Gunnar's son, then he is Gunnar himself." + +Now that was no new thought to me, as I have shown, and I was ready for +it, seeing that even I had seen the likeness to the king as I remembered +him. + +"Keep that thought to yourself for a while, Mord," I said. "It is in my +mind that you are right, but the time has not yet come for me to know." + +"That is wisdom, too," he answered; "for if once he gathers a following, +there is a bad time in store for Hodulf. And it will be better that we +fall on him unawares, before he knows that Havelok, son of Gunnar, lives." + +"We fall on him?" + +"Ay, you and I, mail on chest and weapon in hand, with Havelok to lead +us. What? think you that I would hold back when Gunnar's son is calling?" + +"Steady, friend," I said, laughing; "men will be looking at us." + +So he was silent again; and now I thought that the time of which my +father spoke had surely come, for it was plain that Havelok was a man +whom men would gladly follow as he went to win back his kingdom. And I +went and fetched Withelm from where he sat, and so we three talked long +and pleasantly, until it was time for us to go forth from the hall. And +we thought that it was good for Arngeir to come here, for the secret was +coming to light of itself, as it were, and we would have him speak with +Mord. + + + CHAPTER XIV. THE CRAFT OF ALSI THE KING. + +Now Alsi the king went from the feast with a new and cruel thought in +his mind under the smiling face that he wore, and long he sat in his own +chamber, chin on hand and eyes far off, thinking; and at last he called +Berthun. + +"What is the name of this big knave of yours?" he asked, when the +steward stood before him. + +"He calls himself Curan, lord." + +"Calls himself. Well, it is likely that he knows his own name best. Is +he Welsh, therefore?" + +"So I think, lord." + +"You might have been certain by this time, surely. I like Welshmen about +the place, and I was giving you credit for finding me a good one. Whence +comes he?" + +Now it was on Berthun's tongue to say that he thought that Curan came +from the marshland, yet clinging to his own thoughts of what he was. He +did not at all believe that he came from that refuge of thralls. But he +must seem certain unless he was to be laughed at again. + +So he said, "He comes from the marsh-country." + +"Does he speak Welsh?" + +"I have heard him do so to the market people, if he happened to meet a +Briton there." + +"Why, then, of course he is Welsh: and here have I found out in two +minutes what you have taken I do not know how long to think about. Go +to, Berthun; you grow slow of mind with good living." + +The king chuckled, and Berthun bowed humbly; but now the steward was +determined to say no more than he was obliged in answer to more +questions. Also he began to hope that Alsi would ask nothing about the +clothes this man of his wore, else he would be well laughed at for +spending his money on a stranger. + +But Alsi seemed pleased with himself, or else with what he had heard, +and went on. + +"Has this Curan friends in the town?" + +"None, lord, so far as I know." + +"Let me tell you that you may know a man's friends by the company he +keeps. With whom does he talk?" + +"None come to seek him, lord, except one of the housecarls--the big +man to whom you spoke tonight. Seldom does he go into the town, and then +only the porters seem to know him, for he was among them, as a stranger, +when I met him first." + +"A big man will always make an acquaintance with another," Alsi said, +"and the porters are the lowest in the place. One may be sure that he +has left his friends in some starving village in the marsh, and has none +here. That will do, Berthun. Take care of him, for I may have use for +him. But next time you hire a man, use your wits to learn somewhat of +him, if it is too much trouble to ask." + +So Berthun was dismissed, and went out in a bad temper with himself. Yet +he knew that he would have been laughed at for a fool if he had said +that he thought Curan more than he seemed. + +Now Alsi was alone, and he fell to thought again. By-and-by it was plain +to be understood what his thoughts had been, and they were bad. And +after he had slept on them they were no better, seeing what came of +them. But I think that he was pleased to find that Havelok was, as he +thought, a Welsh marshman, and well-nigh friendless, for so he would be +the more ready to do what he was bidden; though, indeed, there seemed +little doubt that the plan Alsi made for himself would find no stumbling +block in Curan, if it might meet with a check elsewhere. That, however, +was to be seen. + +Well pleased was Alsi the king with somewhat, men said in the morning. + +But there was one who rose heavy and sorely troubled, and that was the +Lady Goldberga, for all the fancies that had been brought to her by the +vision had come to nothing, or worse than nothing, as she looked on +Havelok and saw in the cook's knave the very form of him of whom she had +dreamed, and whom she could not forget. Glad had she been to go to her +own chamber and away from the kindly ladies who could not know her real +trouble; but not even to her old nurse did she tell what that was. Her +one thought now was to seek someone who was skilful in the reading of +dreams, and so find some new hope from it all. But no one could tell her +of such a one here, unless it were to be a priest of Woden, and that she +would not hear of. + +Then, early in the morning, Alsi sent for her, saying that he would +speak with her alone for a while. So she went to him, where he sat in +the chamber beyond the high place; and he greeted her kindly, asking +after her rest, and saying that he hoped that the sudden faintness had +hurt her not. Then he led her to a seat, and bade her rest while he +talked of state affairs. + +"For it must be known to you, my niece, that the Witan thinks it time +that you should take your father's kingdom." + +Now Goldberga knew that, and had long made up her mind that when the +time came she would not shrink from the burden of the crown. + +It may well have been that Alsi thought that she would wish to wait for +a time yet, for he did not seem altogether pleased when she answered, +"If the Witan thinks right, I am ready." + +"But," he said, "there is one thing to come before that. The Witan must +know who your husband shall be. And that is reasonable, for he will have +a share in ruling the kingdom." + +Then said Goldberga, "They need have no fear in that matter, for I will +wed none but a king or the heir of a king." + +"Well," said Alsi, dryly enough, "they are not so plentiful as are +blackberries, and there may be two words to that." + +"I am not anxious to be wedded," answered the princess, "and I can wait. +It is, as you say, a matter that is much to the country." + +Then Alsi tried another plan, seeing that Goldberga was not at all put +out by this. So he forced a cunning smile that was meant to be pleasant, +and said, "I had thought that your mind ran somewhat on Ragnar." + +He looked to see the lady change colour, but she did not. + +"Ragnar is my cousin," she said, "or a good brother to me, if you will. +Moreover, until the other day when he met me in London by some good +fortune, I had hardly seen him since my father died." + +"What think you of Griffin?" + +"Nothing at all, for nidring he is," answered Goldberga with curling lip. + +Now that angered Alsi, for he had so much to do with that business; and +if Griffin was to be called thus by his fault, he was likely to lose a +friend. + +"I would have you remember," he said, "that in all this choosing it +remains for me to give consent or withhold it." + +"I shall only ask your consent to my wedding such a man as I have told +you of, uncle--a king or a king's son." + +"So," said Alsi, "you would choose first, and ask me afterwards, +forsooth! That is not the way that things are to be between us. It is +for me to choose, and that according to the oath which I took when your +father made me guardian of you and his realm." + +"Yet," said Goldberga very gently, "I think that my father would not +have meant that I should be the only one not to be asked." + +"I can only go by what I swore, and that I will carry out. I promised to +see you married to the most goodly and mightiest man in the land." + +"That can be none but a king, as I think." + +Now Alsi grew impatient, for he meant to settle one matter before he +went much farther. + +"I will say at once that I can have no king over the East Anglian +kingdom. It is not to be thought of that after all these years I should +have to take second place there. You will hold the kingdom from me, and +I shall be overlord there. I will send you some atheling who can keep +the land in order for you, but there shall be no king to bring that land +under the power of his own kingdom." + +That was plain speaking, and it roused Goldberga. + +"Never have you been overlord of my kingdom," she said. "Well have you +ruled it for me while I could not rule it myself, and for that I thank +you heartily. But it is not right that I should seem to hold it from you." + +"That is to be seen," sneered Alsi, "for it lies with me to say what +marriage you make, and on that depends whether the Witan, in its wisdom, +sees fit to hail you as queen. Not until you are married will you take +the kingdom at all." + +"Then," said the princess, growing pale, "I will speak to the Witan +myself, and learn their will." + +"The Witan has broken up," answered Alsi, "and the good thanes are miles +on their way homewards by this time. You are too late." + +"I will call them up again." + +"Certainly--that is, if I let my men run hither and thither to fetch +them. But after all, in this matter I am master. Whom you wed lies with me." + +Goldberga saw that she was in the hands of the king, and maybe as much a +prisoner as at Dover. So her spirits fled, and she asked what the king +willed. + +Alsi knew now that nothing but his utmost plan would be of any avail to +save that kingdom for himself, and so he broke out into wrath, working +up his fury that he might not go back. + +"My will is that you obey me in this carrying out of the oath I took on +the holy ring, [10] and on the Gospels also to please +your mother. You shall marry the man whom I choose, so that he be +according to the words of that oath." + +"So that he be king or son of a king, I will obey you," answered Goldberga. + +"Then you defy me. For that I have told you that I will not have. Now +shall we see who is master. You mind yon kitchen knave of last night? +There can be none in all England mightier or more goodly than he is to +look on, and him shall you wed. So will my oath be well kept. Then if +your precious Witan will have him, well and good, for his master shall I +be." + +Thereat the princess said that it were better that she should die; but +now Alsi had set out all his plan to her, and he did not mean to flinch +from carrying it out. There was no doubt that the Norfolk people would +hold that she had disgraced herself by the marriage, and so would refuse +to have her as queen. And that was all he needed. + +But Goldberga had no more to say, for she was past speaking, and the +king was fain to call her ladies. And when they came he went away +quickly, and gave orders for the safe keeping of the princess, lest she +should try to fly, or to get any message to Ragnar or other of the +Norfolk thanes. + +Now he must go through with this marriage, for he had shown himself too +plainly, and never would the princess trust him again. I have heard that +he sent for Griffin at this time; but, as I found, he was gone; and if +the king thought that perhaps the princess would wed him now to escape +from the kitchen knave, he had no chance to bring him forward. I suppose +he could have made out that Griffin, or for that matter any one else he +chose, was such a one as his oath to Ethelwald demanded. + +Sore wept Goldberga when she was back in her own place, and at first it +was hard for her to believe that Alsi could mean what he had threatened. +But then she could not forget her dream, and in that she had most +certainly seen the very form of him who stood before her at the high +place last night; and that perhaps troubled her more than aught, for it +seemed to say that him she must wed. But no king's son could he be, so +that there must be yet such another mighty man to be found. + +And then in her heart she knew that there could not be two such men, +both alike in all points to him of the vision. And she knew also, though +maybe she would not own it, that if this Curan had been but a thane of +little estate, she could have had naught to say against the matter. + +And so at last she found that in her trouble and doubt and wish for +peace she was thinking, "Would that he were not the kitchen knave!" + +Now, it chanced that the old nurse had gone out into the town, and was +away all this while, so that she knew nothing of this new trouble; and +presently she was coming back with her arms full of what she had bought, +and there met her Havelok and Withelm, who had been to the widow's, and +were on their way to find me at the gate. + +"Mother," said Havelok, "let me help you up with these things." + +That frightened the old lady, for she had been looking at him, and had +made up her mind that he was some mighty noble, as did most strangers. + +"Nay, lord," she said; "that is not fitting for you." + +"Less fitting is it that a strong man should see you thus burdened and +not help. No lord am I, but only the cook's man. So I am going to the +palace." + +But this she would not believe at first, and still refused. However, +Lincoln Hill is very steep, and she was not sorry when Havelok laughed +and took the things from her so soon as she had to halt for breath. + +"Curan will carry you up also, if you will, mother," said Withelm. + +The nurse tossed her head at him and made no answer, being on her +dignity at once. Moreover, she had heard of Curan by this time, though +she had not seen him before. So she said no more, and went on proudly +enough, with her mighty attendant after her; but all the while it was in +her mind that there was some jest, or maybe wager, between the two. + +Now Withelm stopped at the gate; but I was not there, for I had been +sent to the palace, where guards were to be at each door. The word was +that some plot had been found out against the princess, and that +therefore we had to be careful. One easily believed that with all the +talk about the attack made on her party that was flying about. So he +came on to the palace kitchens, for Berthun knew him well, having so +often bought fish from him in the market; and there he sat down to talk +with the steward, for there was nothing much going on at the time, and I +was on guard. + +Now, the old nurse went to her mistress; and Goldberga sat in the +shadow, and was weeping no longer, seeing that it would not help at all. + +"There is a wonder down yonder," said the old lady, not seeing that +there had been any trouble yet--"such a man as I never saw in all my +days; and he even carried my goods up all the hill for me, old and ugly +as I am. That is not what every young man would do nowadays. Maybe it +was different when I was young, or else my being young made the +difference. The youth with him called him Curan, which is the name of +the strong porter they prate of, but doubtless that was a jest. This is +the most kingly man that could be; and I ween that those two made a +wager that he dared not carry a bundle up to the palace, whereby I was +the gainer, for breath grows short up that pitch. And when I thanked him +he bowed in that wise that can only come of being rightly taught when +one is young. Now, I am going to ask Berthun who he is, for he spoke to +him when he saw him, and that humbly, as it seemed." + +So talked the nurse, and to all Goldberga answered never a word, for all +the trouble came back again, and with it the thought that she hated, +that if only-- + +Then, as the nurse was leaving her, she called her back. + +"Nurse," she said, "I am in sore trouble about the dream. It bides with +me, and will not cease to puzzle me until I weary for some one to read +it plainly. I would that Queen Bertha's good chaplain were here, for I +might have been helped by him." + +Then the nurse came back, quick to hear the sad tone in the voice of her +whom she had tended and loved since she was a child. + +"Why, my pretty, have you been weeping?" she said. "There was naught in +a dream like that to fray you thus." + +"Nay, but it has come to me that this place is altogether heathen; and +it may have come from the hand of Freya, the false fiend that they +worship as a goddess, so that I may be ready to wed a heathen. Is there +no Christian in all this place?" + +"There are Welsh folk yet left in the marsh," said the nurse, pondering; +"and where there is a Briton there is a Christian, and there, also, will +be a hidden priest. But it would be as much as his life is worth to come +here, even could we find one." + +Then Goldberga said, "Alsi is not altogether heathen. If I asked he +would surely grant this." + +For she thought that she knew how to gain consent. + +"If one can be found, and that is not likely. Well, then, I will ask +Berthun, who is good-natured enough, and most likely will not trouble +about a Christian coming here; and if so, we need not even ask Alsi." + +So she went, not thinking for a moment that there was a priest of the +faith to be heard of. Mostly she wanted to hear more of Havelok, but she +would honestly do her other errand. + +But on her way across the courtyard she met Mord, and he was a great +friend of hers. + +"Whither now, nurse? They will not let you go out of the palace. They +say that there is trouble on hand with those folk that fell on us, and +we have to bide in shelter for a day or two." + +"Well, I have been down the town this hour, and all is quiet enough. +This Alsi is an over-timid man. But I was seeking Berthun with a strange +message from the princess, and one that is not over safe here." + +"Let me give it then." + +"Well, it is nothing more or less than to ask if he can find a Christian +priest. Our mistress has had a strange dream, and it is true that it +sorely troubles her. So she wants one to whom she may tell it, that it +may be read aright. But though I must ask, I do not hope to find one." + +"Why," said Mord, "there is not one Christian in all Lindsey." + +"I would not say that. When I was first here with Orwenna the queen, +before she married Ethelwald, there were some in the marsh; for one day +I heard my own tongue spoken there, hunting with my mistress; and so she +stayed and talked with these poor folk, though the Welsh they spoke was +bad enough. But they were Christians, as they told her in fear and +trembling. They have not so much need to fear now." + +"Then I can help you," said Mord gladly. "Say nothing to the cook, for I +have found old friends who come from far in the marsh, and they will +tell me at once if they have heard of any priest. Why, when I think, +they know Welsh, and one has called himself by a Welsh name, and you +have seen him--Curan the porter." + +"Ay; then do you ask these friends, and tell them that the sooner they +can bring a priest the better shall they be rewarded. I would give much +to have Goldberga's mind set at rest." + +So Mord said that he would go at once; and glad he was to see Withelm +sitting with Berthun, + +"Well," said the steward, "I have known Withelm of Grimsby for the last +ten years or so, and I do not suppose that it matters if you speak with +him." + +"Why should it matter if I speak with any one I choose?" asked Mord, +somewhat angrily. + +"That you must ask the king; for his orders are that the people of the +princess have no dealings with outsiders for two days." + +"Mighty careful of us is Alsi all of a sudden," said Mord. "I suppose he +thinks that someone will stick a seax into some of us in all friendly +wise while we are talking." + +But Berthun only laughed, and went to where the nurse was beckoning to +him. He told her his own thoughts of Havelok, being glad to have a ready +hearer. + +At once Withelm was able to tell Mord that the old priest who was his +friend was in Lincoln at this time by good chance, and that he would +surely come to the princess at need. But when they came to talk of when +and how, it did not seem all so easy; and Mord went to the nurse to tell +her all. + +Then they had to speak to Berthun about it, and he was kindly and +willing to help; but he said that none might come to speak with the +princess without leave from the king. No doubt he would grant it easily, +if asked by Goldberga herself. + +"I will go and tell her," said the old lady. "Keep your man here till I +return." + +Now she brought this good news to the princess, and one need not say how +she rejoiced. And now a thought had come to her, and she was eager to +send a message to Alsi. + +"Surely," she thought, "he does but threaten me with the kitchen knave, +that he may make me change my will. And, therefore, if I say that I am +ready to obey him, he will be pleased; and then time is gained at the +least, and it is not possible that he will choose so badly for me after +all." + +So when the nurse asked her what she would do about getting the priest +to her presence, she said, "Go and tell my uncle first that I am willing +to obey him in the matter of which we spoke this morning." + +"So that was what has troubled you after all, and not the dream? I +thought it should not have made all these tear marks," said the nurse +quickly. "Now, why did you not tell me? I dare give Alsi a talking to if +he needs it." + +"Nay, nurse, but it was the dream. My uncle and I did but disagree on +somewhat, and maybe I was wrong. By-and-by I will tell you." + +"Tell me now, and then I shall know better how to ask for what you need." + +But Goldberga could not bring herself to say what Alsi had threatened, +and now felt sure that she would hear no more of that. So she told the +nurse that she had vowed only to marry a king, and that Alsi had been +angry, saying that kings were not so easily found. Also, that he was the +man who had to find her a husband. + +"That is the best sense that this king ever spoke," said the nurse. +"Many a long year might you wait if you had your way thus. You are wise +in sending that message. Well, after that I will ask him to let you see +the priest, saying, if he is cross-grained, that a talk with him will +make your mind even better fitted to obey. Many things like that I can +say. We shall have him here presently." + +Now, all that seemed very good to both of them, and the nurse went her +way. And when she came to Alsi, she gave the message plainly. + +"That will save a great deal of trouble," said the king. "Tell her that +I am glad to hear it. She says this of her own accord, and not at your +advice?" + +"She told me before I had heard a word of what the trouble was between +you. It was no word of mine." + +"I am glad of it. But I will say that I am somewhat surprised." + +And that was true, for this message seemed to Alsi to be nothing more or +less than that Goldberga would marry his man. When he thought for a +moment, however, he saw that it could not be thus; and also, it was +plain to him what the poor girl had in her mind. And now he chuckled to +think what a weapon he had against her. Nor would he be slow to use it. + +Then the nurse said that he need have no surprise, for Goldberga was +ever gentle and willing to be led, though sometimes the pride of her +race came uppermost for a time. And then she asked if a certain priest +of the faith might come and speak with her. + +Now, Alsi knew that only one could be meant--namely, the hermit who +bided at Cabourn. He had heard of him often, and would not suffer him to +be hurt, for his sister Orwenna had protected him. The heathen English +minded him not at all by this time, for he was the best leech in the +land, and so useful to them. So Alsi said pleasantly that he was quite +willing that the priest should come, deeming that he was at Cabourn, and +that it would be a day or two before he would be brought. + +So he called the housecarl from outside the door, and when he came he +said, "Pass the word that when one who calls himself David comes and +asks for the princess, he is to be admitted to her." + +So that was made easy, and the nurse thanked him and withdrew; and when +he was alone, Alsi grinned evilly and rubbed his hands. + +"Now is East Anglia mine in truth," he said; and with that he bade the +housecarl fetch Curan, the cook's porter, to him. And then he sent one +to Ragnar with such a message that he rode out that night and away to +Norwich. + + + CHAPTER XV. THE FORTUNE OF CURAN THE PORTER. + +While the nurse told Withelm to fetch the priest when Alsi was in the +hall that evening, the housecarl came for Havelok; and much wondering, +he followed the man to the king, and presently stood before him and saluted. + +"Where did you get that salute?" said Alsi sharply, seeing at once that +it was not English; and, indeed, it was that of Gunnar's courtmen. + +"I cannot tell," answered my brother. "It seems to be there when needed." + +"Well, it is not that used here. Get the housecarls to teach you better +manners." + +Then Havelok bowed a little, in token that he would do so; and when Alsi +spoke to him next it was in Welsh. + +"You are a marshman, as I hear?" + +Now Havelok had learned fairly well from the poor folk who loved him, +but carelessly, so that when he answered Alsi frowned at his way of +speaking. + +"I am from the marsh," he said simply. + +"We had better get back to English!" the king said; "you people forget +your own tongue. Now, are you married?" + +Thereat Havelok laughed lightly. + +"That I am not," he answered. + +"Well, then, if I find you a fair wife, you would be willing, doubtless?" + +"That I should not," answered Havelok bluntly, and wondering what this +crafty-looking king was driving at. "What could I do with a wife? For I +have neither house nor goods, nor where to take her, nor withal to keep +her; else had I not been the cook's knave." + +"It would seem that you carry all your fortune on your back, therefore," +said Alsi, looking at Havelok's gay attire with somewhat of a sneer. + +"That may well be, King Alsi, for even these clothes are not my own. +Berthun gave them me, and I think that they come from yourself." + +Alsi grinned, for Eglaf's saying of him was not so far wrong; but he had +more serious business on hand than to talk of these things with a churl. + +"Now, if I bid you, it is your part to obey. I have a wife for you, and +her you shall wed." + +"There are two words to that, King Alsi. Neither will I wed against my +will, nor will I wed one who is unwilling." + +"As to that first," said the king, for he began to be angered with +Havelok's boldness, "if a man will not do my bidding, I have dungeons +where he can have time to think things over, and men who can keep him +there, be he never so mighty; and if a man will not see with my eyes +when I bid him, blinded shall he be." + +This he said somewhat hurriedly, for a dark flush came on the face of +the man before him, and he thought that he must try some other plan than +force with him. + +"And as for that other point, I did not so much as hint that the bride +was likely to be unwilling. I will say that she is willing, rather." + +Now that troubled Havelok, for it seemed that all was arranged already, +and the thought of the dungeon was not pleasant. There was no doubt that +if the king chose he could cast him into one until he was forgotten; and +the light and the breath of the wind from the sea were very dear to +Havelok. So he thought that he would at least gain time by seeming to +listen to the proposal; for, after all, it might come to nothing, and +maybe it was but a jest, though a strange one. + +"Well, lord king," he said, "if the bride knows enough of me to be +willing, it is but fair that I should have the like chance of choice." + +Now Alsi thought that it was impossible that this churl, as he deemed +him, would not be overjoyed to hear of the match he had made for him, +and he must needs know it soon. Yet there was that about Havelok that +puzzled him, for his ways were not those of a churl, and he spoke as a +freeman should speak. + +So much the more likely that the people would believe him when he said +that Goldberga wedded him of her own wish, he thought. It was as well +that he was not altogether a common-seeming man. + +"You have seen the damsel already," he said therefore. "Now I will not +say that this match is altogether of my choosing; but I have an oath to +keep, and it seems that I can only keep it by making you her husband. +But, as I say, she is willing, and, I will add, well dowered." + +Now it grew plain to my brother that there was something strange in all +this, so he said, "An oath is a thing that must not be hindered in the +fulfilling, if a man can further it. But what has a king's oath to do +with me?" + +"I have sworn to find her the goodliest and mightiest man alive; and, +though I must needs say it to your face, there is none like yourself. No +flattery this to bend you to my will, but sober truth--at least, as I +see it." + +At that Havelok grew impatient. + +"Well, if that be so, who is the bride?" he asked, not caring to give +the king his title, or forgetting to do so, for on him was coming the +feeling that he was this man's equal here in the palace. And at last, +not seeming to notice this, Alsi answered plainly. + +"The Princess Goldberga." + +Then Havelok stared at him in blank wonder for some moments; and Alsi +grew red under his gaze, and his eyes were shifty, and would not meet +the honest look that was on him. + +Then at last said Havelok slowly, and watching the king intently all the +while, "What this means I cannot tell. If you speak truth, it is +wonderful; and if not, it is unkingly." + +"On my word as a king, truth it is," said Alsi hastily, for there was +that in Havelok's face that he did not like. + +One might think that the king was growing afraid of his own kitchen knave. + +"If that is so, there is no more to be said," answered Havelok. "Yet you +will forgive me if I say that I must have this from the lips of the +princess herself as well. It may be that her mind will change." + +"That is but fair," answered Alsi; "and you are a wise man. The mind of +a damsel is unsteady, whether she be princess or milkmaid; but have no +fear." + +"No man fear I; but I do fear to hurt any lady, and I would not do that." + +Then Alsi thought that all was well, and he spoke smooth words to my +brother, so that Havelok doubted him more than ever. Therefore it came +into his mind that all he could do for the best was to seem to agree, +and wait for what the princess herself said. And if Alsi was working +some subtlety, then he would wring his neck for him, if need be; and +after that--well, the housecarls would cut him in pieces, and he would +slay some of them, and so go to Valhalla, and dreams would be at an end. +And he would have died to some purpose here, for he knew that Goldberga +would come to her kingdom, ay, and maybe Alsi's as well, for she was his +sister's daughter, and his next of kin, and well loved by those who had +been allowed to know aught of her. + +But I would not have any think that the promise of so wondrous a bride +was not pleasing to him. It was more, for he had seen her grow white and +troubled as she looked on him, and he had seen her bear well whatever +pain had caused that; and he had known that in the one sight he had of +Goldberga somewhat had taught him what it was to have one face +unforgotten in his mind. + +So he said to Alsi, "All this fortune that you hold out to me is most +unlooked for, seeing what I am in your hall; and I have not thanked you +yet, King Alsi. That, however, is hard to do, as you may understand." + +"I understand well enough," answered the king, in high good humour +again, now that all seemed to be going well. "And after all, it is the +lady whom you must thank." + +"But when shall I see her to do so?" + +"Tomorrow, surely; ay, tomorrow early shall you speak with her," +answered the king quickly. "Now go, and hold your peace. Let me warn you +that there are those about the court who would go any lengths to remove +you from the face of the earth if they knew of this. Tell no man of the +honour that has come to you as yet. Be the porter for a short time +longer, and then you will be the man whom all envy. It is likely that I +must make you a thane, by right of the choice of the princess." + +"I know well when to speak and when to keep silence, lord king," said my +brother, and with that he bowed and left the hall. + +Then Alsi put his lips to a silver whistle that he carried, and blew a +call that brought Eglaf hurriedly to him from the outer door. + +"The guards may go," said the king; "but see that the porter Curan +leaves not the palace until I myself send him forth tomorrow." + +The captain saluted and went his way. He had had six men within call of +the king all the time that he spoke with Havelok, and one may make what +one likes of that. At least the threat of the dungeon was no idle one. + +Now went Havelok from the hall very heavy and troubled, for beyond the +fair talk of the king lurked surely some plan that was not fair at all. +It was not to be thought that he could not prevent, if he chose, a +foolish marriage of the princess, even did she desire it ever so much. +And my brother could not believe that she had set her heart on one whom +she had but seen once, and then in the midst of faintness. That, +however, might be known easily when he was face to face with her. It was +a thing that could not be made a matter of pretence. + +Now when he came back to the great kitchen, which was nigh as big as the +hall, Withelm was yet there, for the priest was at the widow's, and +there was no haste to bring him; and by that time I had come in also, +and was sitting with him at the far end, where none had need to come. It +was Berthun's own end, as one might say, and he was lord in his own +place. Only a few thralls were about, and the cook himself had gone into +the town. + +"Here is our brother," I said, "and there is somewhat wrong." + +He came moodily up to us, and sat him down, saying nothing, and he +leaned his head on his hands for a while. + +"What is amiss, brother?" said Withelm. + +"Wait," he answered. "I will think before I speak." + +I could see that this was not the old puzzlement, but something new and +heavy, so we held our peace. Long was he before he moved or spoke, and +when he did so it was wearily. + +"Well knew I that somewhat was to happen to me in this town, even as I +told you, brother, when we first passed its gates. And now it seems to +be coming to pass. For this is what is on me, as it seems to me-- +either that I must see the light of day no more, or must live to be a +scorn and sorrow to one for whom it were meet that a man should die." + +"Surely the black dream is on you, my brother! Neither of these things +can be for you!" I cried. + +"Would that it were the dream, for that is not all of sorrow, and that +also is of things so long past that they are forgotten. I can bear that, +for your voice always drives it away. But now the hand of Alsi the king +is on me for some ill of his own--" + +"Stay," said Withelm. "Let us go out and speak, if that name is to be +heard. It were safer." + +"Less safe, brother," answered Havelok. "At once we should be kept +apart. Listen, and I will tell you all, and then say your say." + +Then he told us, word for word, all that had just passed between him and +the king. And as we listened, it grew on us that here was no wrong to +the princess, but rather the beginning of honour. I could see the +downfall that was in store for Alsi, and I thought also that I saw hope +for the winning back of the Danish kingdom, with an East Anglian host to +back us. And this also saw Withelm, and his eyes sparkled. But Havelok +knew not yet all that had grown so plain to us. + +He ended, and we said nothing for a moment. + +"Well?" he said, not looking up, but with eyes that sought the floor, as +if ashamed. + +"By Odin," said I, speaking the thought that was uppermost, "here will +be a downfall for Alsi!" + +"Ay, you are right, brother. I will not wed her." + +But that was by no means what I meant, as may be known; and now Withelm +held up a warning hand to me, and I knew that his advice was always best. + +"If the maiden is unwilling, wed her not," he said. "If she is willing, +even as the king said, that is another matter. We have no reason to +doubt his word as yet." + +"You saw not his face as he spoke. And then, how should the princess +think of me?" + +"Who knows? Even Odin owned that the minds of maids were hard to fathom. +But one may find a reason or two. Maybe that oath has somewhat to do +with it. A good daughter will go far to carry out her father's will, +and, in the plain sense thereof, she will certainly do it thus. Then it +is likely that she knows that you are no churl, but the son of Grim, +though we have fallen on hard times for a while. I have heard say that +it is the custom here that a man who has crossed the seas in his own +ship so many times is a thane by right of that hardihood. Thane's son, +therefore, might we call you. Then there is the jealousy of every other +thane, if she chooses an East Anglian. Then she needs one who shall be +mighty to lead her forces. Even the greatest thane will be content to +follow a man who is a warrior of warriors. Ragnar can have told her what +you are in that way. Faith, brother, there are reasons enough." + +Havelok laughed a short laugh at all this, and he grew brighter. There +was sense in Withelm's words, if they would not bear looking deeply into. + +Then I said, adding to these words, "Moreover, Alsi could stop the whole +foolishness of his niece if he did not think it a fitting match in some +way." + +"So he could," answered Havelok. "But yet--I tell you that there was +naught but evil in his face. Why did he try to force me?" + +Then he went back to the thing that weighed mostly on his noble heart-- +the thought that he was unworthy altogether. + +"I fear that the princess does but think of me because she must. It is +in my mind that Alsi may have threatened her also until she has +consented. How shall I know this?" + +"Most easily, as she speaks with you," answered Withelm. "Tomorrow will +tell you that. And then, if you find things thus, what shall prevent +your flying?" + +"Brother Radbard and the other housecarls," said Havelok grimly. + +"Not if you ask the princess to help you out of her own way by +pretending to be most willing. If Alsi thinks you a gladsome couple, +there is no difficulty. You walk out of the palace as a master there. +Then you fly to Ragnar. That is all." + +Now that was such an easy way out of the whole coil that we planned it +out. And yet it seemed to me that it was a pity that Havelok knew not +more of what seemed to us so sure now. So, seeing that things were +fairly straightened by this last thought, I got up and said that I must +be going, making a sign to Withelm to come also; and, with a few more +words, we went out. I saw Havelok set himself to a mighty task of water +drawing as I looked back. + +"Now," said I, "here is a strange affair with a vengeance. Neither head +nor tail can I make of it. But if all we think is right, this is the +marriage for the son of Gunnar." + +"Son of Gunnar, or son of Grim," said Withelm, "princess or not, happy +is the maiden who gains Havelok for a husband. Maybe her woman's wit has +told her so. She will have many suitors whom she knows to be seeking her +throne only, and to him she gives it as a gift unsought." + +"That is all beyond me," I said; "but he would fill a throne well. But +his own modesty in the matter of his worthiness is likely to stand in +the way. Why should we not tell him all that we know? Then he will feel +that he is doing no wrong." + +"Because we are not sure, and because it is not for us to choose the +time. I have sent for Arngeir this morning, as we said would be well +last night. If the princess is unwilling, there are many things that may +be said; and if not, there must be many days before the wedding; and, +ere the day, Havelok may feel that he is her equal in birth at least, if +we are not wrong. But since I have waited here, Mord has told me the +dream that has troubled the princess, that I may tell the priest, so +that he can think it over. She has dreamed that she is to wed a man who +shall be king both in Denmark and England, and she saw the man, +moreover. Strangely like Havelok's dream is that. Now what else made her +turn faint but that this vision was like Havelok? And does not that make +it possible that she wishes to wed him? Therefore I am going to tell the +priest the story of Havelok, so far as I know it." + +"Well thought of. Tell him this also, for now I may surely tell you what +you have not yet heard thereof." + +So I told him how Grim and I had taken Havelok from Hodulf, and then he +was the more certain that we had saved the son of our king. + +Now we thought that we had got to the bottom of the whole matter of the +wedding. Of course the dream had all to do with the fainting, but +nothing to do with the supposed wish. But we did not know that. + +"Speak not of Gunnar by name, however," I said; "he was a terror to +Christian folk. The priest is likely to hinder the marriage with all his +might else." + +Withelm flushed as he had when he first spoke of the priest to me. + +"I think not, brother; for he knows Havelok well, and loves him." + +"So," said I shortly, "he hopes to make him a Christian, doubtless." + +"I think that he will do so, if he has a Christian wife to help." + +"That would not suit Havelok," I said, laughing. + +"Nay, but such a mind as his it seems to suit well already, though he +has not heard much." + +"Why, then," said I, wondering, "if it suits our best and bravest, it +must be a wondrous faith. It seems strange, however; but I know naught +of it. What is good for him and you, my brother, is sure to be best." + +"I feared that you would be angry." + +"Nay, but with you and Havelok? How should that be? Why, if you two said +that we must turn Christian, I should hold it right; so would Raven. I +suppose that I go to the Ve [11] because you do." + +Now I troubled no more about the matter, being nothing but a sea dog who +could use a weapon. And now I said that I was going to Eglaf to say that +I might have to leave him at any time for home, in case we had to fly +with Havelok. So Withelm went his way to the old priest with a light +heart, and I to the captain. + +"Well," said Eglaf, "this is about what I expected when your brother +came. Good it has been to have you here; and I think that I shall see +you as a housecarl for good yet. When do you go?" + +"The first time that I do not turn up on guard I am gone, not till then." + +"Come and drink a farewell cup first." + +"I shall be in a great hurry if I do not do that," I answered, laughing. + +But it was my thought that maybe when once my back was turned on the +town, I should not have time to think of going near King Alsi's guard. + +Then I went to find Ragnar the earl, for we thought it well that he +should know what was on hand. But when I came to the house of the thane +with whom he was quartered, they told me that he had gone hastily with +all his men, for word had come of some rising in his land that must be +seen to at once. That was bad; and as one must find a reason for +everything, I thought that the going of Griffin had much to do with the +outbreak. There I was wrong, as I found later. But then, too, I knew +that the craft of Alsi was at work in this message. He had his own +reasons for wishing the earl out of the way. + + + CHAPTER XVI. A STRANGEST WEDDING. + +Long spoke Withelm and the priest David together, until it was time for +them to seek the palace; and when they came there, they spoke to Mord +also. Then David thought it was well to say naught to Havelok until more +was learned from Goldberga herself, for he would soon see how things +stood with her. Then he would see Withelm again, and they would plan +together for the best. So Withelm waited for the return of the priest, +whom Mord took to his mistress. Alsi and his men were supping in the +hall, but Goldberga was waiting in her own chamber. + +Now the princess thought that, after her message to the king, she would +hear no more of the kitchen knave, and so was happier. But all the while +she pondered over her dream the thought of Havelok must needs come into +it, and that was troublesome. Nevertheless, it was not to be helped, +seeing that there was no doubt at all that he and the man of the vision +were like to each other as ever were twins. Wherefore if the thought of +one must be pleasant so at last must be that of the other. And then came +the nurse with tales of what Berthun thought of this man of his--how +that he was surely a wandering prince, with a vow of service on him, +like Gareth of the Round Table in the days of Arthur. + +So presently it seemed to the princess that the churl was gone, as it +were, and in his place was a wandering atheling, at least, who was not a +terror at all. Then at length the slow time wore away until Mord came +with David the priest. + +No priestly garb had the old man on, for that had made his danger +certain; but though he was clad in a thrall's rough dress, he was not to +be mistaken for aught but a most reverend man. + +"Peace be with you, my daughter," he said; "it is good to look on the +child of Orwenna, the queen whom we loved." + +Then the chamberlain left those two alone, and at once Goldberga told +the priest why she had asked him to run the risk of coming to her, for +there is no doubt that he was in peril, though not from Alsi himself. + +At first she asked him many things about her mother, and learned much of +her goodness to the poor folk, and of their love to her; and presently, +when she grew more sure of the kindness and seeming wisdom of the +priest, she told him all her dream, adding no thoughts of her own, as +she mistrusted them. + +Then said David, "There seems naught but good in this, and it is not +hard to unravel. I think that all shall come to pass even as it was told +you." + +"I feared the heathen ways of the place, and thought that it might be +some snare of the old gods," said Goldberga. + +But David told her that they could have no power on her, and asked her +if the king knew of the vision, that being one thing of which he was not +sure; and when he found that he did not, the whole affair seemed more +strange than before. + +But now the princess asked him, "Plain were the words that I heard, hut +what meant the light as of a sunbeam that came from the mouth of the man +of the vision?" + +"That surely means that in word and in heart and in all else the man +shall be kingly altogether, so that there shall be no mistaking the +same; and it may also mean that you shall know the man at once when you +see him." + +At that Goldberga grew pale and red by turns, so that David, quick to +read the thoughts of those who came to him for help, asked if she had +seen anyone who she thought must be meant, not at all knowing that she +must needs say that this was Curan. + +Not at all willingly did she tell him this; but she did so, adding at +last that Alsi had threatened to wed her to this man. + +Now it was plain to David that all was pulling the same way, for surely +Alsi wrought, unknowing, for the fulfilling of the dream; and all seemed +to prove that Havelok was the son of the Danish king, and that he would +win back his kingdom. Then he found out that the princess had no +knowledge that the king had spoken to Havelok, but it did not seem to be +needful that he should tell her that he had done so. That would be told +by Alsi himself if he meant, as seemed certain, to carry out his threat. +So he thought awhile, and at last he saw what he might do without saying +anything to bend the choice of the princess in any way. + +"It will soon be plain in what way the dream shall be fulfilled," he +said; "and this is certain, that you shall be wedded to none but the +right man, else had it not been sent. Have no fear, therefore, even as +it was bidden you." + +Then the princess said that the only thing which troubled her was the +fear lest Alsi should yet force her to wed this one who was so like him +she had seen in her dream. + +"That," said the priest, "is doubtless the most strange part of the +whole matter, yet I think that even thus there need be no fear. I will +tell you now that I know this one who is called Curan well, and I, and +all who know him, love him. Truly he is not a Christian, but he is no +hater of the faith, and that is much in these days. Nor is he a churl, +but rather one of the most noble of men. It is certain that, whatever +Alsi might wish, he would not wed you against your will. He has but to +know your thoughts in order to help you in any way. But I must also tell +you this, that he is a Dane, who fled from his land when he was a child; +and it is thought that he is the son of the Danish king, who was slain +at the time when Mord, your servant, fled also. He came to England in +the same ship as did Mord, who can tell you more of him. It is certain +that there is a secret about his birth, and the one who knows that +secret is not far off. If need is, we can learn it, for there was a set +time for its telling, and maybe this is it. Now, if it is true that he +is the son of the Danish king, it does seem as if your dream might be +bidding you to have no fear of what seems doubtful in the matter, though +I cannot tell, and do not like to say so for certain. His name is not +Curan, but Havelok." + +Then Goldberga said, "I have heard of that flight and of the wreck from +Mord often. He was wont to tell me of the child, and of the lady who was +drowned, and he said that he thought him the king's son." + +After that she was greatly cheered, for the worst of the trouble seemed +to be over and gone. It was in her mind now that Alsi knew who Havelok +was, and that he tried her, for she was not one to think ill of any. + +So she let the priest go, with many thanks, saying, "Now I know that +whatever happens is the will of Heaven, and must be for the best. I am +ready for whatever shall befall." + +Now I do not know what had seemed good to Alsi, for he had changed his +mind concerning David's visit to Goldberga, and had suddenly given +orders that if he came he was to be put in ward at once. So Mord met the +old man as he left the chamber, and told him that he must fly; and after +that Withelm took him away in the dusk, for none hindered his going, and +went to the widow's with him, hearing all that had been said; and that +which they thought was even as Goldberga had said, that all must needs +be for the best. In a day or two all would he plain, for Arngeir would +have come. So Withelm sent forth the old man to his own place with a +good store of food, going with him for some miles, and promising him +help for coming days until the dearth was ended. + +Now into the palace none might come after the feast was set; and all +this time I was on guard, for there were double posts round the place, +by reason of Alsi's fear of the attackers of the princess, as was said. +So it happened that neither of us saw Havelok until next morning; and +now I have to tell how we saw him, and what happened with the first +sunlight, when men were thinking of breaking their fast. + +We of the housecarls took that first meal of the day in the great hall +--so many of us, that is, who were not on duty; and when we had nigh +finished, Alsi would come in and seat himself on the high place, where +Eglaf and half a dozen other thanes sat also at times when there was no +special state to be kept. + +I was early this morning, having just taken my spell of watching at the +gate, and being, therefore, free for the rest of the day, and I was +hungry with the sweet air of the July weather and the freshness that +comes with sunrise. So I was not altogether pleased to see that there +was seemingly some new affair of state on hand, while the breakfast was +not yet set out by reason of preparations that were going on where the +king's chair was wont to stand. There was Berthun, looking puzzled and +by no means pleased, and his men were busy setting out benches on the +high place, of a sort that were not those that were wont to be there, in +three sides of a square, the open side facing the hall. One bench made +each side, and all three were carved from back rail to clawed feet +wondrously. Old they seemed also. Then, too, instead of the sweet sedges +that strewed the high place, men had spread a cloth of bright hues +underfoot there, and the sedges had been swept among the rushes of the +lower places. All this was so strange that I went forward, and when I +had a chance I asked the steward what was on hand. + +"If you know not, master housecarl, no more do I. 'Justice to be done,' +says the king, and so I suppose that you have some notable prisoner in +ward--maybe the leader of those villains who scared our fair princess." + +"But we had taken no man, and I will say that we had wondered that we +had not been sent out to hunt those people, instead of biding to see if +they came to trouble us here." + +"Why, then," said Berthun, "some thane must be bringing a captive +shortly. But why Alsi orders these benches, it passes me to make out. +They are those that have been used for the weddings of his kin since the +days of Hengist. Last time was when Orwenna, his sister, wedded +Ethelwald of Norfolk. Maybe he thinks that they need airing." + +He laughed and went on directing his men; but knowing what I knew, I +wondered what it all might mean, for there was one wedding that I could +not help thinking of. + +Presently the hall began to fill as men came in, and every one had +somewhat to say, and all marvelled at this that was going on. Then +Berthun came and beckoned to me, for I must fetch Eglaf the captain at +once, as the king had need of him, in haste. Then Eglaf hurried to the +hall; and after a word or two with Alsi, the horns were blown outside +the hall door to call every man of the guard to the place. And when they +came, we were all set round the wall as if guarding all that were in it. +But there were none but the folk of the palace to guard, and they were +wondering as were we; and when that was done, and the click and rattle +of arms as we moved to our places was ended, there was a silence on all +--the silence of men who wait for somewhat to happen. + +Now Berthun went to the door on the high place, as he was wont when all +was ready for the king's presence, and the hush deepened, none knowing +what they expected to see. + +Forth came Berthun backward, as was the custom, and he turned aside to +let the king pass him. His face was red and angry, as I thought, but +amazed also. I was standing next to Eglaf, and he was at the foot of the +dais, at the end of his line of men, so that I could see all plainly. + +Then came Alsi, leading the princess, and after Goldberga came her +nurse. No other ladies were with her; and now I noticed that there was +not one thane on the high place, which was strange, and the first time +that such a thing had been since I came here. I looked down the hall, +and none were present. Now I looked at Alsi; and on his pale face was a +smile that might have been as of one who will be glad, though he does +not feel so. But the eyes of the princess were bright with tears, and +hardly did she look from the floor. Hers was a face to make one sad to +see at that time, wondrously beautiful as it was. + +Alsi led her by the hand, and set her on the bench that was to his left, +and signed to the nurse to sit beside her, which the old lady did, +bridling and looking with scorn at the king as she took her place. There +she sought the hand of the princess, and held it tightly, as in +comforting wise. Very rich garments had the nurse, but Goldberga was +dressed in some plain robe of white that shone when the light caught it. +Mostly I do not see these things, but now I wished that she always wore +that same. + +As for Alsi, he had on his finest gear, even as at the great feast of +the Witan--crimson cloak, fur-lined, and dark-green hose, +gold-gartered across, and white and gold tunic. He had a little crown on +also, and that was the only thing kingly about him, to my mind. + +Now he cast one look at Goldberga, which made her shrink into herself, +as it were, and turned with a smile to us all. + +"Friends," he said, "this is short notice for a wedding, but all men +know that 'Happy is the wooing that is not long a-doing,' so no more +need be said of that. All men know also that when good Ethelwald died he +made me swear to him that I would wed his daughter to the mightiest and +goodliest and fairest man that was in the land. I have ever been mindful +of that oath, and now it seems that the time for keeping it has come. +Whether the man whom my niece will wed is all that the oath requires, +you shall judge; and if he is such a one, I must not stand in the way. I +do not myself know that I have ever seen one who is so fully set forth +in words as is this bridegroom in those of the oath." + +Now I heard one whisper near me, "Whom has Goldberga chosen?" + +And that was what Alsi would have liked to hear, for his speech seemed +to say that thus it was, and maybe that he did not altogether like the +choice. + +But now Alsi said to Berthun, "Bring in the bridegroom." + +"Whom shall I bring, lord?" the steward asked in blank wonder, and Alsi +whispered his answer. + +At that Berthun's hands flew up, and his mouth opened, and he did not stir. + +"Go, fool," said Alsi, and I thought that he would have stamped his foot. + +Now I knew who was meant in a moment, and even as the steward took his +first step from off the dais to go down the hail to his own entrance, I +said to Eglaf, "Here is an end to my service with you. My time is up." + +"Why, what is amiss?" + +"The bridegroom is my brother--that is all; and I must be free to +serve him as I may." + +"Well, if that is so, you are in luck. But I do not think that either of +Grim's sons can be the man. Big enough are you, certainly, but goodly? +Nay, but that red head of yours spoils you." + +I daresay that he would have said more about Raven and Withelm, for a +talk was going round; but a hush came suddenly, and then a strange +murmur of stifled wonder, for Havelok came into the hall after Berthun, +and all eyes were turned to him. + +Now I saw my brother smile as he came, seeing someone whom he liked +first of all; and then he looked up the hall, and at once his face +became ashy pale, for he saw what was to be done. Yet he went on firmly, +looking neither to right nor left, until he came to the high place. +There he caught my eye, and I made a little sign to him to show that I +knew his trouble. + +They came to the step, and Berthun stood aside to let Havelok pass, and +then Alsi held out his hand to raise my brother to the high place. But +Havelok seemed not to see that, stepping up by himself as the king bade +him come. Then the women who were in the hall spoke to one another in a +murmur that seemed of praise; but whiter and more white grew the +princess, so that I feared that she would faint. But she did not; and +presently there seemed to come into her eyes some brave resolve, and she +was herself again, looking from Alsi to Havelok, and again at Alsi. + +Now, too, the king looked at him up and down, as one who measures his +man before a fight. And when he met Havelok's eyes he grew red, and +turned away to the folk below him. + +"So, friends," he cried, "what say you? Am I true to the words of my +oath in allowing this marriage?" + +There was not one there who did not know Havelok, whom they called +Curan; and though all thought these doings strange, there was a hum of +assent, for the oath said naught of the station in life of the +bridegroom. Good King Ethelwald had been too trustful. + +"That is well," said Alsi, with a grave face. "All here will bear +witness that this was not done without counsel taken. Now, let the +bridegroom sit in his place here to my right." + +He waved his hand, and Havelok sat down on the bench that faced +Goldberga; and now he looked long at her with a look that seemed to be +questioning. Alsi was going to his seat in the cross bench, where the +parents of the couple are wont to sit at a wedding while the vows are +made, but he seemed to bethink himself. It is my belief that he said +what he did in order to shame both Havelok and Goldberga. + +"Why, it is not seemly that the bridegroom should sit alone without one +to be by him. Where are your friends, Curan?" + +At that Alsi met with more than he bargained for. At once Berthun came +forward, and forth came I, and without a word we sat one on each side of +him. There were others who would have come also, for I saw even Eglaf +take a step towards the high place, had we not done so. + +Alsi's face became black at that, for here was not the friendless churl +he was scoffing at. But he tried to smile, as if pleased. + +"Why, this is well," he said. "Good it is to see a master helping his +man, and a soldier ready to back a comrade of a sort. Now we have +witnesses. Let us go on with the wedding." + +Now the golden loving cup that was used at the feasts had been filled +and set at a little side table that stood there, and it was to be the +bride cup that should be drunk between the twain when all was settled. +So Alsi took this cup and held it, while he sat in the place of the +father of the bride. Now, I knew nothing of what should he done, but +Berthun did so, and well he took my brother's part, having undertaken +for him thus. + +"It is the custom," said Alsi, "that the bridegroom should state what he +sets forth of the dowry to the bride." + +Whereat Berthun, without hesitation, spoke hastily to Havelok, and told +him to let him answer, meaning, as I have not the least doubt, to +promise all that he had saved in long years of service. But Havelok +smiled a little, and set his hand to his neck, and I remembered one +thing that he had--a ring which had always hung on a cord under his +jerkin since he came to Grimsby, and which my father had bidden him keep +ever. + +"This give I," he said, setting it on the floor at his feet, "and with +it all that I am, and all that I shall hereafter be, and all that shall +be mine at any time." + +Alsi looked at the ring as it flashed before him, and his face changed. +No such jewel had he in all his treasures, for it was of dwarf work in +gold, set with a deep crimson stone that was like the setting sun for +brightness. I do not know whence these stones came, unless it were from +the East. Eleyn the queen, his mother, was thence, and I know now that +the ring was hers. But I think that when Alsi saw this he half repented +of the match, though he had gone too far now to draw back. So he bowed, +and said that it was well, as he would have said had there been nothing +forthcoming. + +Then Berthun, in his turn, asked for the bridegroom that the dowry of +the bride should be stated for all to hear. + +"The wealth left my niece by her father," said Alsi. "The matter of the +kingdom is for the Witan of the East Anglians to settle." + +Then came from out the king's chamber two men bearing bags of gold, and +that was set before the princess. It was a noble dowry, and honest was +the king in this matter at least. + +Now were the vows to be said and the bride cup to be drunk, and that was +the hardest part of all to Havelok. + +Slowly he rose as the king held it out to him, and he took it from his +hand and stood before Goldberga; and she, too, rose and faced him, and +for a moment they stood thus, surely the most handsome couple that had +ever been. + +Then Havelok said, looking in the clear eyes of the princess, "This have +I sworn, that I will wed no unwilling bride. It is but for you to say +one word, and the cup falls, and all is ended." + +Alsi started at that, and I thought he was going to speak, but he held +his peace. Still as a rock was Havelok while he waited for the answer, +and the folk in the hall were as still as he. They began to see that all +was not right as the king would have it thought. + +Once the princess looked at Alsi, and that with pride in her face, and +then she looked long and steadfastly at Havelok, and one by one his +fingers loosened themselves on the golden stem of the cup, that she +might know him ready for her word. + +Then she put forth her hand and closed it round his strong fingers, that +he must hold it fast by her doing, and that was all that was needed. It +was more than words could have told. And she smiled as she did it. + +And at that a light came on Havelok's face, and he smiled gravely back +at her, and he said in a low voice that shook a little, "May the gods so +treat me as I treat you, my princess. Can it be that you will trust me +thus?" + +She answered in no words, but I saw her hand tighten over his, and her +eyes never left his face. + +Then Havelok raised his other hand, and took that of Goldberga, which +was on the cup, and faced to the people. + +"Thus do I pledge her who shall be henceforward my wife through good and +ill; and may Odin, Freya, and Niord be witnesses of my oath of faith to +her in all that the word may mean." + +So he drank, and I stole a glance at the king. Never saw I a man so +amazed, for to him the Danish names of the Asir had come as some sort of +a shock, seeing that he had deemed this man, with the name of Curan, a +Briton. And he looked at Berthun with a look that seemed to say more +than was likely to be pleasant by-and-by. But the steward paid no heed +to him. + +Now Havelok had made his vow, and he gave the cup to the princess; and +she, too, turned a little toward the people, but still she looked on +Havelok. + +"Faith shall answer to faith," she said in a clear voice. "Here do I +take this man for my husband, in the sight of God, and with you all as +witnesses, and I pray that the blessing of Him may be on us both." + +So she drank also, and Havelok stopped and raised the wondrous ring from +where it had been unheeded on the floor, and took the band of Goldberga, +and set it on her finger, and kissed the hand ere he let it go. + +But Goldberga lifted her face toward him, and he bent and kissed her +forehead, and so they were wedded. + +I have heard men scoff at the thought of love at first sight, but never +can any one of us do so who saw this wedding. + + + CHAPTER XVII. HOW THE BRIDE WENT HOME. + +Now the folk cheered, and loudest of all honest Eglaf and his warriors. +I wondered what should come next, for neither feast nor bride ale was +prepared, and Berthun was looking puzzled. Then I saw that the only face +in all the wide hall which was not bright was that of Alsi, and his brow +was black as a thunder cloud, while his fingers were white with the +force with which he clutched and twisted the end of his jewelled belt. +Plainly he was in a royal rage that none had scoffed at this wedding, +but that all had taken it as a matter that was right altogether. + +But he had one more evil thing in his mind that must be seen through; +and he came forward, smoothing his face, as best he might, to the fixed +smile that I had seen when he spoke with Ragnar, and learned that his +first plot had miscarried. + +"Now, friends," he said, "all this has been so hasty that we have +prepared no feast. Even now, it seems that the horses stand at the door +to take bride and bridegroom hence, and doubtless there waits somewhere +the feast that has been bespoken without my knowledge. Well, strange are +the ways of lovers, and we will pardon them. I have therefore only to +bid them farewell." + +With that he turned to Havelok, and held out his hand, as in all good +fellowship, but Havelok would not see it. + +"Fare as it shall be meted to you by the Asir, King Alsi," he said, "for +at least Loki loves craft." + +Then he turned to me, and asked hurriedly where we should go if we must +leave thus. + +"To Grimsby," I said. "That is home." + +Alsi spoke to the princess now, and maybe it was as well that he did not +offer so much as his hand. Wise was he in his way. + +"Farewell, niece," he said; "all this shall come shortly before the +Witan of Ethelwald's folk." + +"Farewell, uncle," she answered calmly. "That is a matter which I will +see to myself. You have carried out your oath to the letter, so far, and +now it remains that you should leave the government of the realm to me." + +With that she put her hand on Havelok's arm. + +"Come, husband; we have heard that the horses wait. Let us be gone." + +And then in a quick whisper she added, as if nigh overdone, "Take me +hence quickly, for I may not bear more." + +They wasted no more words; and through a lane of folk, who blessed them, +those two went to the great door down the long hall, and I followed, and +Berthun and the nurse came after me. One flung the door open; and on the +steps, all unaware of what had happened, lounged Mord, waiting, and up +and down on the green the grooms led the horses of the princess--six +in all. On two were packed her goods, and the third had a pack saddle +that waited for the bags that held her dowry. The other three were for +herself and Mord and the nurse. There was not one for Havelok. + +"This is hasty, my princess," Mord said. "Whither are we bound?" + +"For Grimsby, Mord," I answered quickly. "Are there no more horses to be +had?" + +"Never a one, unless we steal from the king," he answered. + +The people were crowding out now that they might see the start, and I +saw Berthun speak to a man among them who was a stranger to me. And from +him he turned directly with a glad face. + +"Go down to such a hostelry," he said to me, "and there ask for what +horses you will. Maybe I shall have to follow you for my part in this +matter--that is, if I am not put in the dungeon." + +"Faith," I answered, "better had you come with us than run that risk. +Alsi is in a bad mood." + +He shook his head; and then the people behind him made way, for the king +was coming. + +"Almost had you forgotten this," he said; "and I think you will want it." + +The men with the money were there, and he waved his hand to them. +Havelok lifted the princess to her horse without heeding him, and the +men set the bags on the pack horses. + +"See the bridegroom down the street, you who were his witnesses," the +king went on, with a curling lip; "and if you are a wise man, master +Berthun, you will not come back again." + +Berthun bowed and went into the hail, past the king, and across to his +own door, without a word. After him the thronging people closed up, and +though I thought that a housecarl would have been sent to see what he +was about, this would have made an open talk, and Alsi forbore. + +"Let Havelok take your horse, Mord," I whispered to him; "I will tell +you why directly." + +He nodded, and I told Havelok to mount. Then I helped up the nurse, who +wept and muttered to herself; and so we started, Alsi standing on the +steps with words of feigned goodspeed as we did so. + +But the housecarls and the people shouted with wishes that were real, no +doubt thinking that we were bound for the far-off kingdom of the prince +who had won Goldberga by service as a kitchen knave in her uncle's hall +for very love of her. + +Directly we were outside the gate that leads down the hill, I saw +Withelm, who was there waiting for me, and he knew at once what had +happened. + +He came to my side, and asked only, "Already?" + +"Already," I answered; "but it is well. Go to the widow's straightway, +and bring Havelok's arms to him at the hostelry at the end of the +marketplace, where we have to find more horses." + +He went at once, and silently we came down the street and to the +courtyard of the inn. Some few folk stared at us; but the princess was +hardly known here, and she had cast her long, white mantle hoodwise over +her head and face, so that one could not tell who she was. So early in +the day there were few people in the marketplace either. + +Berthun was in the courtyard of the inn, and I was glad to see him, for +I did not know what would happen to him. It was likely that Alsi would +seek for someone on whom to visit his anger at the way things had gone. +But the steward had been warned, and was not one to run any risk. + +"I did but go back for a few things that I did not care to leave," he +said; and he showed me that he had brought his own horse from the +stables, and on it were large saddlebags. No poor man was Berthun after +years of service in the palace, where gifts from thane and lady are +always ready for the man who has had the care of them. Across the saddle +bow also were his mail shirt and arms, and his shield hung with his helm +from the peak. + +"You see that I must needs cast in my lot with yours, or rather +Curan's," he said, laughing; "but it is in my mind that in the end I +shall not be sorry to have done so. I think that I am tired of the +fireside, and want adventure for a while." + +"Well," I answered, "you are likely to have them, and that shortly, if I +am not mistaken; but we shall see. Now about these horses, for we had +better get out of Lincoln as soon as we may." + +The man he had spoken with was a merchant, who came yearly, and was a +friend of his. He had more horses than he meant to keep, as he had here +each year; for every one knows that a horse can always be sold in +Lincoln, and they were good ones. Then my gold came in well, and I +bought three, one for each of us brothers. I daresay that I paid dearly +for them, but there was no time for haggling in the way that a horse +dealer loves. Out of the way of Alsi we must get, before he bethought +him of more crafty devices. And I thought, moreover, that we should be +riding towards East Anglia shortly, and it was not everywhere that a +steed fit to carry Havelok on a long journey was to be had. + +I had bidden him leave all this to me as we came down the hill, and glad +he was to do so. Now he had dismounted, and stood by the side of the +princess, speaking earnestly to her. It was plain that what he said was +pleasant to her also. But we left them apart, as one might suppose. + +Now came a warrior into the courtyard, and he bore more arms. It was +Withelm, who had borrowed the gear of the widow's dead husband, that he +might be ready for whatever might happen: and it was good to see +Havelok's eyes grow bright as he spied the well-known weapons that his +brother had in his arms. He said one word to Goldberga, and then came to us. + +"Let me get into war gear at once," he said, laughing in a way that +lightened my heart. "I shall not feel that I have shaken off service to +Alsi until I have done so." + +And then he saw Berthun here for the first time. + +"Nay, but here is my master," he added. "And I will say that I owe him +much for his kindness." + +"Now the kindness shall be on your part, if any was on mine. Take me +into your service, I pray you, henceforward." + +"Good friend of mine," said Havelok, "naught have I to offer you. And +how should one serve me?" + +"With heart and hand and head, neither more nor less," answered Berthun. +"I have seen you serve, and now will see you command. Let me bide with +you, my master, at least, giving you such service as I may." + +"Such help as you may, rather. For now we all serve the princess," +Havelok said. + +And with that Berthun was well content for the time. + +"Well, then," said I, "see to Havelok's arms, while we get the horses +ready, for I want Withelm here." + +So Havelok and his new man went into the house with his arms, and then I +saw Goldberga beckoning to us. It was the first time that I had spoken +to her, and I think that I was frightened, if that is what they call the +feeling that makes one wish to be elsewhere. But there was nothing to +fear in the sweet face that she turned to us. + +"Brothers," she said, "Havelok tells me that it was one of you who +brought David the priest to me. I do not rightly know yet which is Withelm." + +With that she smiled and blushed a little, and I stood, helm in hand, +stupidly enough. But my brother was more ready. + +"I am Withelm, my princess--" he began. + +"Nay; but 'sister' it shall be between me and my husband's brothers. +Now, brother Withelm, there is one thing that is next my heart, and in +it I know you will help me." + +There she wavered for a moment, and then went on bravely. + +"Christian am I, and I do not think that we are rightly wedded until the +priest has done his part. And to that Havelok agrees most willingly, +saying that I must ask you thereof, for he does not know where the old +man is now." + +"Wedded in the little chapel that is in the thick of Cabourn woods shall +you be, for David has gone there already. We can ride and find him +before many hours are over, sweet lady of ours." + +She thanked him in few words, and with much content. + +Then came forth from the house Havelok, in the arms that suited him so +well--golden, shining mail shirt of hard bronze scales, and steel, +horned helm, plain and strong, and girt with sword and seax, and with +axe and shield slung over shoulder, as noble a warrior surely as was in +all England, ay, or in the Northlands that gave him birth either; and +what wonder that the eyes of the princess glowed with a new pride as she +looked at her mighty husband? + +But Mord almost shouted when he saw him come thus, and to me he said, + +"It is Gunnar--Gunnar, I tell you--come back from Asgard to help my +princess." + +"Wait till we get to Grimsby, and Arngeir will make all clear," I said. +"Get into your arms, and we will start. All is ready now." + +We did not wait for Mord, but mounted and rode out, and the princess +looked round at us as she rode first beside Havelok, and said, "Never +have I ridden so well attended, as I think." + +And from beside me, with broad face from under his helm, Berthun +answered for us all, "Never with men so ready to die for you, at least, +my mistress." + +And that was true. + +Half a mile out of the town we rode at a quick trot, and then thundered +Mord after us, and his hurry surely meant something. I reined up and +waited for him. + +"What is the hurry, Mord?" said I. + +"Maybe it is nothing, and maybe it is much," he answered; "but Griffin +of Chester has gone up to the palace, for I saw him. He has his arm in a +sling, and his face looks as if it had been trodden on. Now Alsi will +tell him all this, and if we are not followed I am mistaken. He would +think nothing of wiping out our party to take the princess, and Alsi +will not mind if he does. How shall we give him the slip?" + +Withelm rode with his chin over his shoulder, and I beckoned him and +told him this. Not long was his quick wit in seeing a way out of what +might be a danger. + +"Let us ride on quickly down the Ermin Street, and he will think us +making for the south and Norwich. Then we will turn off to Cabourn, and +he will lose us. After that he may hear that some of us belong to +Grimsby, and will go there; but he will be too late to hurt us. Hard men +are our fishers, and they would fight for Havelok and the sons of Grim." + +So we did that, riding down the old Roman way to a wide, waste forest +land where none should see us turn off, and then across the forest paths +to Cabourn; and there we found the hermit, and there Havelok and +Goldberga were wedded again with all the rites of Holy Church, and the +bride was well content. + +Now while that was our way, I will say what we escaped by this plan of +my brother's, though we did not hear all for a long time. Presently we +did hear what had happened at Grimsby towards this business, as will be +seen. + +To Lincoln comes Griffin, with Cadwal his thane, just as we had left the +town thus by another road, and straightway he betakes himself to the +palace. There he finds Alsi in an evil mood, and in the hall the people +are talking fast, and there is no Berthun to receive him. + +So, as he sits at the high table and breaks his fast beside the king, he +asks what all the wonderment may be. And Alsi tells him, speaking in Welsh. + +"East Anglia is mine," he says, "for I have rid myself of the girl." + +Griffin sets his hand on his dagger. + +"Hast killed her?" he says sharply. + +"No; married her." + +"To whom, then?" + +"To a man whom the Witan will not have as a king at any price." + +"There you broke faith with me," says Griffin, snarling. "I would have +taken her, and chanced that." + +"My oath was in the way of that. You missed the chance on the road the +other day, which would have made things easy for us both. There was no +other for you." + +Now Griffin curses Ragnar, and the Welsh tongue is good for that business. + +"Who is the man, then?" he says, when he has done. + +"The biggest and best-looking countryman of yours that I have ever set +eyes on," answers Alsi, looking askance at Griffin's angry face. "There +is a sort of consolation for you." + +"His name," fairly shouts Griffin. + +"Curan, the kitchen knave," says Alsi, chuckling. + +"O fool, and doubly fool!" cries Griffin; "now have you outdone +yourself. Was it not plain to you that the man could be no thrall? Even +Ragnar looks mean beside him, and I hate Ragnar, so that I know well how +goodly he is." + +Now Alsi grows uneasy, knowing that this had become plainer and plainer +to him as the wedding went on. + +"Why, what do you know of this knave of mine?" he asks. "He was goodly +enough for the sake of my oath, and the Witan will have none of him. +That is all I care for." + +"What do I know of him? Just this--that you have married the queen of +the East Angles to Havelok, son of Gunnar Kirkeban of Denmark, for whom +men wait over there even now. The Witan not have him? I tell you that +every man in the land will follow him and Goldberga if they so much as +lift their finger. Done are the days of your kingship, and that by your +own deed." + +Alsi grows white at this and trembles, for he minds the wondrous ring +and the names of the Asir, but he asks for more certainty. + +Then Griffin tells him that he was with Hodulf, and knew all the secret +of the making away with the boy, and how that came to naught. Then he +says that Hodulf had heard from certain Vikings that they had fallen on +Grim's ship, and that in the grappling of the vessel the boy and a lady +had been drowned. It is quite likely that they, or some of them, thought +so in truth, seeing how that happened. After that Hodulf had made +inquiry, and was told that there were none but the children of Grim with +him, and so was content. So my father's wisdom was justified. + +"Now I learned his name the other day; and I have a ship waiting to take +me at once to Hodulf, that I may warn him. I have ridden back from +Grimsby even now to say that, given a chance, say on some lonely ride, +that might well have been contrived, I would take Goldberga with me +beyond the sea. I thought more of that than of Hodulf, to say the truth." + +Now Alsi breaks down altogether, and prays Griffin to help him out of this. + +"Follow the party and take her. They are few and unarmed, and it will be +easy, for men think that there is a plot to carry her off, and this will +not surprise any. Go to the sheriff and tell him that it has happened, +and he will hang the men on sight when you have taken them. Then get to +sea with the girl, and to Hodulf, and both he and I will reward you." + +"Thanks," says Griffin, with a sneer; "I have my own men. Yours might +have orders that I am the one to be hanged. It would be worth your while +now to make a friend of your kitchen knave. You are not to be trusted." + +So these two wrangle for a while bitterly, for Alsi is not overlord of +Griffin in any way. And the end is that the thane rides towards Grimsby +first of all, with twenty men at his heels, knowing more than we +thought. But he hears naught of us, and presently meets Arngeir on his +way thence to see us. Him he knows, for already he has had dealings with +him in the hiring of the ship. So he learns from him that certainly no +such party as he seeks is on the road, and therefore rides off to the +Ermin Street to stay us from going south. + +But now we had time for a long start; and so he follows the Roman road +when he reaches it all that day and part of next, and we hear no more of +him at that time. There are many parties travelling on that way, and he +follows one after another. + +Now Arngeir knew at once that somewhat had happened when he heard from +Griffin that the most notable man of those whom he sought was named +Curan, and therefore he turned back at once and waited for us. And when +we came in sight of the long roof of the house that Grim, our father, +had built, standing among the clustering cottages of our fishers, with +the masts of a trading ship or two showing above it in the haven, he was +there on the road to greet us, having watched anxiously for our coming +from the beacon tower that we had made. + +Maybe we were two miles out of Grimsby at this time, for one can see far +along the level marsh tracks from our tower; and Withelm and Mord and I +rode on to him as soon as we saw him, that we might tell him all that +had happened, and we rode slowly and talked for half a mile or so. + +Then Withelm waited and brought Havelok to us, staying himself with the +princess, that he might tell her the wondrous story of her husband; for +we thought that it would be easier for him than for our brother maybe. +Havelok was not one to speak freely of himself. + +And when Goldberga had heard all, she was silent for a long way, and +then wept a little, but at last told Withelm that all this had been +foretold to her in her dream. + +"Yet I am glad," she said, "that I did not know this for certain, else +had my Havelok thought that I did but wed him for his birth. Tell him, +brother, that it was not so; say that I knew him as the husband Heaven +sent for me when first I saw him." + +Now Havelok listened to Arngeir as he told him the well-kept secret, and +now and again asked a question. + +And when all was told he said, "Now have the dreams passed, and the +light is come. I mind all plainly from the first." + +And he told all that had happened after Hodulf caught him, from the +murder of his sisters to the time when I helped my father to take him +from the sack. Only he never remembered the death of his mother or the +storm, or how we came to Grimsby. Maybe it is rather a wonder that after +all those hard things gone through he should recall anything, for he was +nearly dying when we came ashore, as I have told. + +"But I am Grim's son," he said, "for all this, and never shall I forget +it. By right of life saved, and by right of upbringing, am I his, and by +right of brotherhood to his sons. Gunnar, who was my father, would have +me say this, if I am like him, as Mord tells me I am." + +Then he looked at us in brotherly wise, as if we would maybe not allow +that claim now; but there needed naught to be said between us when he +met our eyes. He was Grim's son indeed to us, and we his younger +brothers for all the days that were to come. + +"One thing there is that makes me glad," he said, "and that is because I +may now be held worthy of this sweet bride of mine so strangely given, +as indeed I fear that I am not. Men will say that she has done no wrong +in wedding me; and for all that Alsi may say, it will be believed that +she knew well whom she was wedding. There will be no blame to her." + +That seemed to be all his thought of the matter now, and it was like +him. Then he went back to his princess, and we spurred on to Grimsby, +and set all to work, that the greeting might be all that we could make it. + +And so, when those two rode into our garth, and the gates were closed +after them, we reined our horses round them, and drew our swords, and +cried the ancient greeting with one mighty shout: + +"Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson--Skoal to Goldberga, Havelok's wife! +Skoal! Yours we are, and for you we will die! Skoal!" + + + CHAPTER XVIII. JARL SIGURD OF DENMARK. + +Now one would like to tell of quiet days at Grimsby; but they were not +to be. Three days after Havelok's homecoming we were on the "swan's +path," and heading for Denmark, with the soft south wind of high summer +speeding us on the way. And I will tell how that came about, for else it +may seem strange that Havelok did not see to the rights of his wife +first of all. + +That was his first thought, in truth, and we brothers planned many ways +of getting to work for her, for it was certain that Alsi would be on his +guard. And on the next day came a man from Lincoln to seek Berthun, with +news. That good friend had done what none of us had been able to manage, +for he had told the merchant, his friend, to bide in the hall and hear +what went on, and then to let him know all else that seemed needful that +we should hear. Now he had learned all from the words of Griffin and +Alsi, who took no care in their speech, thinking that none in the hall +knew the Welsh tongue that they used. + +It being the business of a merchant to know that of every place where he +trades, and he travelling widely, there was no difficulty to him, and +mightily he enjoyed the sport. Then he sent off straightway to us; and +now it was plain that we were in danger--not at once, maybe, but ere +long. Griffin would hear sooner or later that his quarry was in Grimsby +after all. So we went to our good old friend, Witlaf of Stallingborough, +and told him all. + +"Why," he said, "I will have no Welsh outsiders harrying my friends. +Light up your beacon if he comes, and shut your gates in his face, and I +and the housecarls will take him in the rear, and he will not wait here +long. I have not had a fight for these twenty years or so, and it does +me good to think of one." + +So we thought that there was little fear of the Welshman. + +When I came back from this errand, however, I chose to pass the mound +where my father slept, and on it, hand in hand, sat Havelok and +Goldberga--for it was a quiet place, and none came near it often. It +was good to see them thus in that place, and happy they seemed together. + +Goldberga called me when I came near, and I sat down beside them as she +bade me. + +"Here we have been talking of what we shall do now, for it seems that to +both of us are many things to hand," she said. "Good it would be if we +could set them aside; but we were born to them, and we cannot let them +be. And, most of all, here in this place we may not forget the duty that +Grim would remind us of. Havelok must go to Denmark and win back his +kingdom from Hodulf first of all." + +"We have thought that East Anglia was to be won first from Alsi," I said. + +"So says Havelok; but I do not think so. For, indeed, I am but the wife, +and the things of the husband come first of all. Now, this is what I +would say. Sail to Denmark before Hodulf knows what is coming, and there +will be less trouble." + +"I am slow at seeing things," said Havelok; "but the same might be said +of your kingdom." + +"Alsi is ready, and Hodulf is not," she answered, laughing; "any one can +see that. + +"Is it not so, brother?" + +So it was; and I thought that she was right. + +"Let us ask the brothers," I said, "for here are many things to be +thought of; and, first of all, where to get men." + +That was the greatest trouble to our minds, but none at all to hers. + +"Get them in Denmark," she said, when we were all together in the great +room of the house that evening. "Let us go as merchant folk, and find +Sigurd, or his son if he is dead. If I am not much mistaken, all the +land will rise for the son of Gunnar so soon as it is known that he has +come again." + +"Sigurd is yet alive," Arngeir said; "and more than that, he is waiting. +For he promised Grim that he would be ready, and I heard the promise. I +think that this plan is good, and can well be managed. Here is the ship +that Griffin was to have taken today, and he is not here. Gold enough I +have, for Grim hoarded against this time." + +Then he showed us the store that, through long years, my father had +brought together to take the place of that of Sigurd's which had been +lost; and it was no small one. And so we planned at once; and in the end +we three brothers were to go with Havelok and Goldberga, leaving Mord to +get to Ragnar and tell him that Goldberga was following the fortunes of +her husband, and would return to see to her own if all went well. +Berthun would go with him, and Arngeir would bide at home, for we needed +one to whom messages might come; and while none would know us now in +Denmark, either Arngeir or Mord might be seen, and men would tell Hodulf +that the men of Grim had come home, and so perhaps spoil all. Word might +go to Denmark from Griffin even yet. + +We had little thought of any sorry ending to our plans, for the dreams +that had come so true so far cheered us. And so, with the evening tide +of the next day, we sailed in the same ship that had been hired for Griffin. + +But first Havelok spent a long hour on my father's mound alone, thinking +of all that he owed to him who rested there. And to him came Goldberga +softly, presently, lest he should be lonely in that place. And there she +spoke to him of her own faith, saying that already he owed much to it. +For he was making his vows to the Asir for success. + +"Shall you pray yet again to the Asir, my husband?" she asked. + +"Why should I? I have vowed my vows, and there is an end. If they heed +them, all is well; and if not, the Norns hinder." + +"There is One whom the Norns hinder not at all," she said gently, and so +told him how that her prayers would go up every day. + +Fain was she that he also prayed in that wise to her God, that naught +might be apart in their minds. + +Then he said, "I have heard this from David and Withelm also, and it is +good. Teach me to vow to your God, sweet wife, and I will do so; and you +shall teach me to pray as you pray." + +So it came to pass that Havelok in the after days was more than ready to +help the Christian teachers when they came to him; for that was how the +vow that he made ran, that he would do so if he was king, and had the power. + +Now there is nothing to tell of our voyage, for one could not wish for a +better passage, if the ship was slow. Indeed, she was so slow that a +smaller vessel that left Tetney haven on the next day reached the same +port that we were bound for on the night that we came to our old home. +And that we learned soon after she had come. + +Into Sigurd's haven we sailed on the morning tide, and strange it seemed +to me to see the well-known place unchanged as we neared it. My father's +house was there, and Arngeir's, and the great hall of the jarl towered +over all, as I remembered it. Men were building a ship in the long shed +where ours had been built, and where the queen had hidden; and the +fishing boats lay on the hard as on the day when Havelok had come to us. +The little grove was yet behind our house, and it seemed strange when I +remembered that the old stones of its altar were far beyond the seas. I +wondered if Thor yet stood under his great ash tree; and then I saw one +change, for that tree was gone, and in its place stood a watchtower, +stone built, and broad and high, for haven beacon. + +On the high fore deck stood Havelok, and his arm was round Goldberga as +we ran in, but they were silent. The land held overmuch of coming wonder +for them to put into words, as I think. + +Presently the boats came off to us in the old way, and here and there I +seemed to know the faces of the men, but I was not sure. It was but the +remembrance of the old Danish cast of face, maybe. I could put no names +to any of them. And as we were warped alongside the wharf, there rode +down to see who we were Sigurd the jarl himself, seeming unchanged, +although twelve years had gone over him. He was younger than my father, +I think, and was at that age when a man changes too slowly for a boy to +notice aught but that the one he left as a man he thought old is so yet. +He was just the noble-looking warrior that I had always wondered at and +admired. + +We had arranged in this way: Havelok was to be the merchant, and we his +partners in the venture, trading with the goods in the ship as our own. +That the owner, who was also ship master, had agreed to willingly +enough, as we promised to make good any loss that might be from our want +of skill in bargaining. One may say that we bought the cargo, which was +not a great one, on our own risk, therefore, hiring the vessel to wait +our needs, in case we found it better to fly or to land elsewhere +presently. Then Havelok was to ask the jarl's leave to trade in the +land, and so find a chance to speak with him in private. After that the +goods might be an excuse for going far and wide through the villages to +let men know who had come, without rousing Hodulf's fears. + +And as we thought of all this on the voyage, Goldberga remembered that +it was likely that Sigurd would know again the ring that had been the +queen's, and she said that it had better be shown him at once, that he +might begin to suspect who his guest was. For we knew that he was true +to the son of Gunnar, if none else might still be so. + +This seemed good to us all; and, indeed, everything seemed to be well +planned, though we knew that there are always some happenings that have +been overlooked. We thought we had provided against these by keeping the +ship as our own to wait for us, however, and it will be seen how it all +worked out in the end. + +Now Havelok went ashore as soon as the ship was moored; and the moment +that he touched land he made a sign on his breast, and I think that it +was not that of the hammer of Thor, for Goldberga watched him with +bright eyes, and she seemed content as she did so. He went at once to +where the jarl sat on his horse waiting him, and greetings passed. I was +so used to seeing men stare at my brother that I thought little of the +long look that Sigurd gave him; but presently it seemed that he was +mightily taken with this newcomer, for he came on board the ship, that +he might speak more with him and us. + +"Presently," he said, "you must come and dine with me at my hall; for +the lady whom I saw as you came in will be weary, and a meal on shore +after a long voyage is ever pleasant. Now what is your errand here?" + +"Trading, jarl," answered Havelok. + +"I thought you somewhat over warlike-looking for a merchant," said +Sigurd; "what is your merchandise?" + +"Lincoln cloth, and bar iron, and such like; and with it all one thing +that is worth showing to you, jarl, for I will sell it to none but +yourself." + +Now we went aft slowly, and presently Havelok and the jarl were alone by +the steering oar, by design on our part. + +"This seems to be somewhat special," said Sigurd. "What is it?" + +Havelok took the ring from his pouch, and set it in the jarl's hand +without a word; and long Sigurd looked at it. I saw the red on his cheek +deepen as he did so, but he said never a word for a long time. And next +he looked at Havelok, and the eyes of these two met. + +"This is beyond price," said the jarl slowly. "Not my whole town would +buy this. It is such as a queen might wear and be proud of." + +"Should I show it to Hodulf the king, therefore?" asked Havelok, with +his eyes on those of the jarl. + +"Let no man see it until I know if I can buy it," answered Sigurd. +"Trust it to my keeping, if you will, for I would have it valued maybe." + +"It is my wife's, and you must ask her that." + +Then Havelok called Goldberga from her cabin under the after deck, and +the jarl greeted her in most courtly wise. + +"I will trust it with you, Jarl Sigurd," she said, when he asked her if +he might keep the ring for a time. "Yet it is a great trust, as you +know, and it will be well to show the ring to none but men who are true." + +"It is to true men that I would show it," he answered, with that look +that had passed between him and Havelok already; and I was sure that he +knew now pretty certainly who we were. Yet he could not say more at this +time, for the many men who waited for Havelok must be told somewhat of +his coming first. + +Now men were gathering on the wharf to see the newcomers, and so the +jarl spoke openly for all to hear. + +"Come up to my hall, all of you, and take a meal ashore with me; for +good is the first food on dry land after days at sea and the fare of the +ship." + +So he went across the gangway, and to his horse, and rode away quickly, +calling back to us, "Hasten, for we wait for you. And I will find you +lodgings in the town for the time that you bide with us." + +Now at first that seemed somewhat hazardous, for we had meant to stay in +the ship, lest we should have to fly for any reason suddenly. But it +seemed that we had no choice but to do as he bade us, and we could not +doubt him in any way. We should go armed, of course, as in a strange +place; and, after all, unless Hodulf heard of us, and wanted to see us, +he was not to be feared as yet. So I fell to wondering where our +lodgings would he, and if the old families still dwelt in the houses +that I had known, and then who had ours. Many such thoughts will crowd +into the mind of one who sees his old land again after many years, and +finds naught changed, to the eye at least. + +Men have told me that, as we came into the hall presently, they thought +us the most goodly company that had ever crossed its threshold; and that +is likely, for at our head were Havelok and Goldberga. Raven was a +mighty warrior to look on as he came next, grave and silent, with +far-seeing grey eyes that were full of watching, as it were, from his +long seafaring, and yet had the seaman's ready smile in them. And +Withelm was the pattern of a well-made youth who has his strength yet to +gather, and already knows how to make the best use of that he has. There +were none but thought that he was the most handsome of the three sons of +Grim. And last came I, and I am big enough, at least, to stand at +Havelok's back; and for the rest, one remembers what Eglaf said of me. +But I do not think that any noticed us with those twain to look at, +unless they scanned our arms, which were more after the English sort +than the Danish, so far as mail and helms are concerned, and therefore +might seem strange. + +The old hall was not changed at all; and handsome it seemed after +Alsi's, though it was not so large. There were more and better weapons +on the walls, and carved work was everywhere, so that in the swirl and +heat-flicker of the torches the beams, and door posts, and bench ends, +and the pillars of the high seat seemed alive with knotted dragons that +began, and ended, and writhed everywhere, wondrous to look on. Our +English have not the long winter nights, and cruel frosts, and deep snow +that make time for such work as this for the men of the household. + +There fell a silence as we came in, and then Sigurd greeted us; and we +were set on the high seat, and feasted royally. On right and left of our +host sat Havelok and Goldberga, and the jarl's wife next to Havelok, and +Biorn the Brown, the sheriff, next to our princess. This was a newcomer +here since my days, but well we liked him. + +There is nothing to tell of what happened at this feast, for Sigurd +asked no questions of us but the most common ones of sea, and wind, and +voyage, and never a word that would have been hard for Havelok to answer +in this company, where men of Hodulf's might well be present. Withelm +noticed this, and said that no doubt it was done purposely, and he +thought much of it. + +When we had ended with song and tale, and it was near time for rest, +Sigurd bade Biorn, the sheriff, take us to his house for the night, +telling him that he must answer for our safety, and specially that of +the fair lady who had come from so far. And then he gave us a good guard +of his housecarls to take us down the street, as if he feared some danger. + +"Why, jarl," said Biorn, "our guests will have a bad night if they think +that in our quiet place they need twenty men to see them to bed thus!" + +"Nay, but the town is strange to the lady," answered Sigurd; "and who +knows what she may fear in a foreign land!" + +So Biorn laughed, and was content; and we bade farewell to the jarl, and +went out. And then I found that it was to my father's house we were to +go, for it had been given to Biorn. + +Now, I was next to Goldberga as we came to the door, and there was a +step into the house which we always had to warn strangers of when it was +dark; and so, in the old way, without thinking for a moment, I said to +her, "One step into the house, sister." + +"Ho, Master Radbard, if that is you, you have sharp eyes in the dark," +said Biorn at once; "I was just about to say that myself." + +"I have some feeling in my toes," I answered; and that turned the +matter, for they laughed. + +And then, when we were inside, and the courtmen had gone clattering down +the street homewards, Biorn took the great door bar from its old place +and ran it into the sockets in the doorposts, as I had done so many +times; and the runes that my father had cut on it when he made the house +were still plain to be seen on it, with the notches I had made with the +first knife that I ever had. More I will not say, but everywhere that my +eyes fell were things that I knew, even to fishing gear, for it seemed +that Biorn was somewhat of a fisher, like Grim himself. + +Then they put me and my brothers into our old loft, and Havelok and +Goldberga had the room that had been my father's. As for Biorn, he would +be in the great room, before the fire. There was only this one door to +the house, and therefore he would guard that. His thralls were in the +sheds, as ours used to be, so that we and he were alone in the house. + +Now, as soon as we three had gone into our old place of rest, Raven went +at once, as in the old days, to the little square window that was in the +high-pitched gable, and looked out over the town and sea. We used to +laugh at him for this, for he was never happy until he had seen, as we +said, if all was yet there. + +"There are yet lights in the jarl's hall," he said, "and there are one +or two moving about down in the haven. I think that there is a vessel +coming in." + +"Come and lie down, brother," I said. "We are not in Grimsby, and you +cannot go and take toll from her if there is." + +He laughed, and came to his bed; but we talked of old days and of many +things more for a long while before we slept. And most of all, we +thought that Sigurd the jarl knew Havelok by the token of the ring and +by that likeness to Gunnar which Mord had seen, and that our errand was +almost told. + +So we slept without thought of any danger; but the first hour of the +night in that house was not so quiet to Goldberga, for presently she +woke Havelok, and she was trembling. + +"Husband," she said, "it is in my mind that we are in danger in this +place; for I cannot sleep by reason of a dream that will come to me so +soon as my eyes are closed." + +"You are overtired with the voyage," Havelok told her gently; and then +he asked her what the dream was. + +"It seems that I see you attacked by a boar and many foxes, and hard +pressed, and then that a bear and good hounds help you. Yet we have to +flee to a great tree, and there is safety. Then come two lions, and they +obey you." + +"I think that is a dream that comes of waves, and the foam that has +followed us, and the shrill wind in the rigging, and the humming of the +sail, sweet wife; and the tree is the tall mast maybe, and the lions are +the surges that you saw along this shore, where is no danger." + +So she was content; and then all in the house slept. + + + CHAPTER XIX. THE LAST OF GRIFFIN OF WALES. + +Maybe it was about an hour before midnight when the first waking came to +any of us, and then it was Biorn himself who was roused by footsteps +that stayed at the doorway itself, after coming across the garth, and +then a voice that was strange to him which bade him open. At once he +caught up his axe and went to the door, and asked quietly who was there. + +"Open at once," said the man who was without; "we must speak with you." + +"Go hence, I pray you, and wait for morning," said the sheriff. "Here +are guests of the jarl's, and they must not be disturbed." + +"Open, or we will open for ourselves," was the answer. "We have no time +to stay here talking." + +"That is no honest speech," quoth Biorn. "Go hence, or give me your +errand from without." + +"Open, fool, or we will have the door down." + +"There is an axe waiting for you if you do that. I rede you go hence in +peace, or it may be worse for you in the end." + +I suppose it was in the mind of the sheriff that here were some friends +of his who had been overlong at the ale bench in the hall that evening; +but on this there was a little talk outside, and then the crash of a +great stone that was hurled against the door; and at that he started +back and got his mail shirt on him, for the door was strong enough to +stand many such blows yet. It seemed that there was more than a drunken +frolic on hand. Then came another stone against the door, and it shook; +and at the same moment Havelok came from his chamber to see what was +amiss, for the noise had waked him. He had thrown on the feasting gear +that he had been wearing; but he had neither mail nor helm, though he +had his axe in his hand. + +"What is the noise?" he said anxiously, seeing that Biorn was arming. + +The sheriff told him quickly, and again the door was battered. + +"It is a pity that a good door should be spoilt," said Havelok, "for +down it is bound to come thus. Stand you there with the axe, and I will +even save them the trouble of breaking in." + +"Nay," said Biorn; "we know not how many are there, and it were better +that you should arm first. There is time." + +"Why, they think that you are alone in the house, no doubt, and will run +when they find out their mistake. They are common thieves from the +forest, or outlaws. Stand you by to cut down the first man that dares to +enter, if there happen to be one bold enough." + +He set his axe down, and went to the bar, and began to slide it back +into the deep socket that would let it free, and the men outside stayed +their blows as they heard it scraping. It was a very heavy bar of oak, +some seven feet long, and over a palm square. + +"Now!" cried Havelok, and caught the bar from its place. + +He did not take the trouble to set it down and get his axe; but as the +door opened a little he stood back balancing the great beam in his +hands, as a boy would handle a quarterstaff, ready for the rush of the +thieves that he expected, and so he was in the way of Biorn more or less. + +Now there was silence outside, and one saw that the door was free, and +set his foot to it, and flung it open, for it went inwards. And then +Havelok knew that there was a stern fight before him, for the moonlight +showed the grim form of Griffin, the Welsh thane, fully armed and ready. + +"Stand back, friend," cried Biorn hastily, fearing for the unarmed man, +and caring nothing that beyond the foremost was a group of some half +dozen more warriors. + +But he spoke too late, for as Griffin stepped back a pace on seeing his +enemy himself in the doorway, Havelok had gone a pace forward, and now +was outside, where he had a clear swing of his unhandy weapon. + +Now Griffin gathered himself together, and spoke some few words to his +men in his own tongue; but my brother paid no heed to them, for he knew +what the way of the Briton was likely to be. And he was not wrong, for +without warning Griffin flew on him, sword point foremost, and left +handed, for he might not use the right for many a long day yet. + +Biorn shouted; but Havelok was ready, and the heavy bar caught and +shivered the light sword, and then swung and hurled the thane back among +his men with a rib broken. Havelok followed that up, falling on the men +even as their leader was among their feet. Two he felled with downright +strokes, and another shrank away in time to save himself from the like +fate. Then a fourth got in under his guard, and wounded Havelok slightly +in the left arm; and unless Biorn had been out and beside him by that +time it would have gone hard with him, for both those who were left were +on him, and another was hanging back for a chance to come. + +There was shouting enough now, for the Briton does not fight in silence +as do the northern men, and we had waked. First of all Raven ran down to +the great room, half dazed with sleep, and blaming himself for all this +trouble, for he had seen that a ship was coming in, and he might have +thought it possible that it had brought Griffin and his men, whose +tongue had told him at once what had happened. + +Now he called to us to arm quickly, and sought for a weapon for himself; +and in that familiar place he went to the old corner where the oars were +wont to be set. There was one, for I have said that this Biorn was a +fisher, and the place that was handy for us had been so for him. That +was a homely weapon to Raven, and out into the moonlight he came with +it, and swept a Welshman away from Havelok's side as he came. But now +more men were coming--townsfolk who had been roused by the noise-- +and they knew nothing of the attackers, and so thought them friends of +ours, who joined us in falling on their sheriff; and there was a wild +confusion when Withelm and I came down armed. + +But what we saw first was a dim, white figure in the doorway of the +other room; and there stood Goldberga, wide eyed and trembling. + +"My dream, my dream!" she said. + +But of that we knew nothing; and we could but tell her to be of good +courage, for we would win through yet, and so went out to the fight. + +By this time Griffin was up again, and as I came from the door he was +once more ready to fall on Havelok from behind. So I thought it best to +stay him, and I shouted his name, and he turned and made for me. But +there was no skill in his coming, or he did not think me worth it, for +the axe had the better, and there was an end of Griffin. + +Withelm saw at once that Havelok had no weapon but the bar, and he ran +to him and held out his own axe. + +"Thanks, brother. Mine is inside the door. Get it for me," said he; but +now he was laughing, and doing not much harm to anyone, and as I got +behind his back I saw why this was. + +There was only one of Griffin's men left, and all the rest of the crowd +of half-armed men were townsfolk. Havelok and Raven were keeping these +back with sweeps of their long weapons, and behind them against the wall +was the sheriff, swearing and shouting vainly to bid his people hold off +and listen to him. And the noise was so great that they did but think +that he was calling them to rescue him from these who had taken him +prisoner. It seemed that the Welshman was keeping this up also; but +neither he nor any of the men cared to risk any nearness to the sweep of +bar and long oar in such hands. There were many broken heads in that +crowd; but it was growing greater every minute, and those who were +coming were well armed, having taken their time over it. They say that +there were sixty men there at one time. + +Now ran Withelm with the axe, and at that Havelok parted with the door +bar, and ended the last Welshman at the same time, for he hurled it at +him endwise, like a spear, and it took him full in the chest, and he +went down to rise no more. And at that the townsmen ran in, and we were +busy for a space, until once more they were in a howling circle round +us. But they had wounded Havelok again; and Biorn was at his wit's end, +for he had had to take part in the fight this time. The men were mad +with battle, and forgot who he was, as it seemed. And now some raised a +cry for bows. + +That was the worst thing that we had to fear, and Raven called to us, +"Into the house, brothers, and keep them out of it till the jarl comes. +He will hear, or be sent for." + +So we went back and got into the doorway, and we could not bar it at +first. But Withelm hewed off the blade of Raven's oar, and I went out +and cleared the folk away for a space, and leapt back; and Havelok and I +got the door shut quickly against them as they came back on it, and we +barred it with the oar loom. That was but pine, however, and it would +not last long. + +Outside, the people were quiet for a little, wondering, no doubt, how to +rescue Biorn. He wanted to go out to them, but it did not seem safe just +yet. If they grew more reasonable it might be so. + +Then, as we rested thus, Goldberga came quickly, for she saw that her +husband was wounded, and she began to bind his hurts with a scarf she +had. She was very pale, but she was not weeping, and her hands did not +shake as she went to work. + +"This is my dream," she said. "Was that the voice of Griffin that I +heard? It does not seem possible; but there is none other who speaks in +the old tongue of Britain here, surely." + +"There is no more fear of him," said Havelok, looking tenderly at her. +"Your dream has come true so far, if he was in it. How did it end?" + +"We fled to a tree," she said, smiling faintly. + +Havelok smiled also, for this seemed dream stuff only to all of us-- +all of us but Withelm, that is, for at once he said, "This door will be +down with a few blows. What of that tower of yours, Biorn? Might we not +get there and wait till the jarl comes?" + +At that Biorn almost shouted. + +"That is a good thought, and we can get there easily. Well it will be, +also, for the men are wild now, and there have been too many slain and +hurt for them to listen to reason." + +"Bide you here," said Withelm, "for it is we whom they seek. Then you +can talk to them." + +But he would not do that, seeing that we had been put in his charge by +the jarl. + +"I go with you," he said. "Now, if we climb out of the window that is in +the back of the house we can get to the tower before they know we are gone." + +We went into that chamber where Havelok had once been when he was taken +from the sack, and even as I unbarred the heavy shutter and took it +down, the door began to shake with a fresh attack on it. The trees of +the grove were two hundred yards from the house, maybe, and among them +loomed high and black the watchtower I had seen from the sea. A wide +path had been cut to it, and the moonlight shone straight down this to +the door of the building. + +Now Biorn went out first, and then he helped out Goldberga, and after +her we made Havelok go; and we called to these three to get to the tower +as Withelm came next, for every moment I looked to see our enemies--if +they are to be called so when I hardly suppose they knew what they were +fighting about--come round to fall on the back of the house. + +Because of Goldberga they went; and Biorn opened the tower door, and she +passed into the blackness of its entry, but the two men stayed outside +for us. And we three were all out of the house when the first of the +crowd bethought themselves, and made for the back, and saw us. + +At once they raised a shout and a rush, and we did not think it worth +while to wait for them, as they would get between us and the tower, +which was open for us. So we ran, and they were, some twenty of them, +hard at our heels as we reached the door, and half fell inside, for the +winding stairway was close to the entry. I think that Biorn and Havelok +had made their plans as they saw what was coming, for Havelok followed +us and stood in the doorway, while Biorn was just outside with his axe +ready. + +"Hold hard, friends!" he called, as the men came up and halted before +him; "what is all this?" + +"Stand aside and let us get at them," said the foremost, panting. + +"Nay," said Biorn; "what harm have they done?" + +"Slain a dozen men and lamed twice as many more," answered several +voices; "have them forth straightway." + +"They were attacked, and defended themselves," said the sheriff, "and it +is no fault of theirs that they had to do their best. Get you home, and +I will answer to the jarl for them. They are the jarl's guests." + +Then was a howl that was strange, and with it voices which seemed to let +some light on the matter. + +"They have slain the jarl's guests." + +And then came forward a big black-bearded man whom I had seen in the +crowd already, and he squared up to Biorn. + +"Lies are no good, master sheriff, for we know that the outlanders who +spoke the strange tongue must be the guests who came." + +"I am no liar," answered Biorn. "Is there not one man here who saw the +ship and her folk this afternoon?" + +Now this man seemed not to want that question answered, for he shouted +to the crowd not to waste time in wrangling, but to have out the +murderers; and he took a step towards Biorn, bidding him side no more +with the men, but let the folk deal with them. + +"You overdo your business as sheriff!" he said. + +It was Biorn who wasted no more time, for he saw that here was deeper +trouble than a common riot. He lifted his axe. + +"Come nearer at your peril," he said. + +Then the black-bearded man sprang at him, and axe met sword for a parry +or two, flashing white in the moonlight. Then one weapon flashed red +suddenly, and it was Biorn's, and back into the tower he sprang as his +foe fell, and Havelok flung the door to, and I barred it. + +"Up," said Biorn; and in the dark we stumbled from stair to stair, while +the crowd howled and beat on the door below us. It was good to get out +into the moonlight on the roof, where we could rest. I was glad that the +tower was there instead of Thor, and also that it was strong. It was no +great height, but wide, and the men below looked comfortably far off at +all events. + +"Here is a fine affair," quoth Biorn, sitting himself down with his back +against the high stone wall round the tower top. "It will take me all my +time to set this right." + +"You have stood by us well, friend," Havelok said, "and it is a pity +that you have had to share our trouble so far as this. Who was the man +who fell on you?" + +"That is the trouble," answered Biorn, "for there will be more noise +over him than all the rest. He was Hodulf's steward, the man who gathers +the scatt, and therefore is not liked. And all men know that there was +no love lost between him and me." + +"Hodulf's man," said I; "how long has he been here, and is he a Norseman?" + +For I knew him. He was the man who had spoken to me at the boat side +when we had to fly--one, therefore, who knew all of the secret of Havelok. + +"Ay, one of the Norsemen who came here with the king at the first, and +is almost the last left of that crew. I suppose that you have heard the +story." + +We had, in a way that the honest sheriff did not guess, and I only +nodded. But I thought that we had got rid of an enemy in him, and that +Griffin had fallen in with him on landing, and known him, and taken him +into his counsel about us. He would have gone down to see the vessel and +collect the king's dues from her and from us at the same time. He had +not come into the town till late, as we heard afterwards. + +There was no time for asking more now, however, for the shouts of the +men round the door ceased, and someone gave orders, as if there was a +plan to be carried out. So I went and looked over on the side where the +door was to see what was on hand. + +It was about what one would have expected. They had got the trunk of a +tree, and were going to batter the door in. But now we were all armed, +for Raven had brought Havelok's gear with him when he fetched his own. +He had thought also for Goldberga, and she was sitting in the corner of +the tower walls wrapped in a great cloak that she had used at sea, with +her eyes on her husband, unfearing, and as it seemed waiting for the end +that her dream foretold. + +I called the rest, and we looked down on the men. They saw us, and an +arrow or two flew at us, badly aimed in the moonlight. + +"Waste of good arrows," said Havelok; "but we must keep them from the +door somehow." + +"Would that the jarl would come," growled Biorn, "for I do not see how +we are to do that." + +"If they do break in," said I, "any one can hold a stairway like this +against a crowd." + +"I do not want to hurt more of these," answered Havelok, looking round +him. And then his eyes lit up, and he laughed. "Why, we can keep them +back easily enough, after all." + +He went to the tower corner, and shouted to the men below. Four or five +had the heavy log that they were to use as a ram, and they were just +about to charge the door with it, and no timber planking can stand that +sort of thing. + +"Ho, men," he cried; "set that down, or some of you may get hurt." + +They set up a roar of laughter at him as they heard, and then Havelok +laid hold of the great square block of stone that was on the very corner +of the wall, and tore it from its setting. + +"Odin!" said Biorn, as he saw that, "where do they breed such men as this?" + +"Here," answered Withelm, looking at the sheriff. + +Now Havelok hove up the stone over his head, and a sort of gasp went up +from the crowd below. One saw what was coming, and ran to drag back the +men with the beam, and stopped short before he reached them in terror, +crying to them to beware. But their heads were down, and they were +starting into a run. + +"Halt!" cried Havelok, but they did not stay. "Stand clear!" he shouted +in the sailor's way. + +And then he swung the stone and let it go, while those who watched fled +back as if it was cast at them. Down is crashed on the attackers, +felling the man whom it struck, and dashing the timber from the grasp of +the others, so that one fell with it across his leg and lay howling, +while the rest gathered themselves up and got away from under the tower +as soon as they might. + +Now no man dared to come forward, and that angered Havelok. + +"Are you going to let these two bide there?" he said. "Pick the poor +knaves from under the stone and timber, and see to them." + +But they hung back yet, and he called them "nidring." + +Thereat two or three made a step forward, and one said, "Lord, let us do +as you bid us, and harm us not." + +"You are safe," he answered, and Biorn laughed and said that this was +the most wholesome word that he had heard tonight. + +"Lord, forsooth! Mighty little of that was there five minutes ago." + +But it was not the terrible stone throwing only that wrung this from +them, as I think. They had seen Havelok in his arms, with the light of +battle on his face in the broad moonlight, and knew him for a king among +men. + +They took the hurt men from under the tower, and then crowded together, +watching us. And some man must needs loose an arrow at us, and it rang +on my mail, and that let loose the crowd again. Soon we had to shelter +under the battlement, but they were not able to lodge any arrows among +us, for that is a bit of skill that needs daylight. Then they dared to +get to the timber once more, and we saw them coming. + +Havelok took his helm, and set it on his sword point, and raised it +slowly above the wall, and that drew all the arrows in a moment. Then he +leapt up, and tore the stone from the other corner; and again, but this +time without warning, it fell on the men below, and that wrought more +harm than before. But it stayed them for a time, though not so long, for +now their blood was up, and the berserk spirit was waking in them. +Already the third stone was poised in the mighty hands, and would have +fallen, when there was a cry of, "The jarl! the jarl!" and along the +path into the clearing galloped Sigurd himself, with his courtmen +running behind him, and he called on the men to stay. + +They dropped the beam at the command, and were silent. And Sigurd looked +up at the tower, and saw who was there, and stayed with his face raised, +motionless for a space. I minded how Mord had stared and cried out when +first he saw Havelok, the son of Gunnar, in his war gear. + +"Biorn! where is Biorn?" cried Sigurd, looking back on the crowd as if +he thought he would be there. + +"Here am I, jarl," came the answer, and the sheriff looked out from +beside Havelok. + +"What is all this?" + +"On my word, jarl, I cannot tell. Here have I been beset in my own +house, and but for your guests some of us would have come off badly. +There were outlanders who fell on us, and, as I think, stirred up the +folk to carry on the business, telling them that we had slain ourselves, +as one might say, for it was the cry that we had slain the jarl's guests." + +"O fools, to take up the word of a chance stranger against that of your +own sheriff!" Sigurd cried, facing the people. + +"Nay, but the steward said so likewise," cried some. + +"Hodulf's steward?" said the jarl suddenly; "where is he?" + +"Yonder. Biorn slew him." + +"He was leading this crowd," said Biorn from above, "tried to force his +way into the tower past me, and would not be warned." + +"What of the outlanders?" + +"All slain. Seven Welshmen they were." + +Then I said plainly, remembering that the jarl would have known him, +"Their leader was Griffin, who came with Hodulf at the first. What +brought him here, think you, Sigurd the jarl?" + +But Sigurd looked round on the people, and scanned them for a long time, +and at last he said, in a hush that fell when he began to speak, "Men +who mind the old days, look at the man whom you have sought to kill, and +say if there is that about him which will tell you why Hodulf's men have +set you on him thus." + +Then the white faces turned with one accord to Havelok, as he stood +resting the great cornerstone on the battlement before him, and there +grew a whisper that became a word and that was almost a shout from the +many voices that answered. + +"Gunnar! Gunnar Kirkeban come again!" + +Then was silence, and the jarl spoke to Havelok. + +"Tell us your name, and whence you come." + +"Havelok Grimsson of Grimsby men call me," he said. + +And then men knew who he was indeed, for little by little the secret had +been pieced together, if not told from the king's place, in the years +that had passed. And at that there rose and grew a murmur and a cry. + +"Havelok, son of Gunnar! Havelok the king!" + +Then said Sigurd in a great voice, "Who is for Hodulf of us all? Let no +man go hence who is for him." + +And I saw two or three men cut down then and there, and after that there +was a roar of voices that called for Havelok to lead them. + +"Come down, lord," said Sigurd, unhelming and looking up. + +So we went from the tower, and round Havelok the men crowded, kissing +his hand and asking pardon for what they had wrought in error; and +Sigurd dismounted and knelt before him, holding forth his sword hilt in +token of homage, that his king might touch it. + +"Only Havelok son of Gunnar dares call himself son of Grim also, and in +that word all the tale is told. But I have known you from the first by +the token of the ring and by this likeness. Yet I waited for you to +speak, and for the time that should be best; and now that has come of +itself, and I am glad." + +So said Sigurd, as we went from the tower to the hall, with the townsmen +at our heels in a wondering crowd. There were many among them who would +show the wounds that Havelok had given them with pride hereafter, as +tokens that they had known him well. + +Then we stayed on the steps of the hall door, and the jarl called out +man by man, and the war arrow was put in their hands with the names of +those men who waited for the coming of Havelok, that all through the +night the message that should bring him a mighty host on the morrow +should go far and wide. + +And the gathering word was, "Come, for the horn of the king is sounding." + +Then Sigurd said, "Speak to the people, my king, and all is done." + +So Havelok smiled, and lifted his voice, and spoke. + +"Stand by me, friends, as steadfastly as you have fought against me, and +I shall be well content. And see, here is the queen for whom you will +fight also. There is not one of you but will play the man under her eyes." + +Not many words or crafty, but men saw his face, and heard that which was +in the voice, and they needed no word of reward to come, but shouted as +we had shouted when the bride came home to Grimsby, and I thought that +with the shout the throne of Hodulf was rocking. + + + CHAPTER XX. THE OWNING OF THE HEIR. + +Worn out we were with that long fight, and we all had some small wounds +--not much worth speaking of; and when these were seen to, we slept. +Only my brother Raven waked, and he sat through all the rest of the +short night on the high place, with his sword across his knees, +watching, for he blamed himself, overmuch as we all thought, for the +happenings of the attack. + +"Trouble not, brother, for we were in the keeping of Biorn, and he could +not have dreamt that foes could follow us over seas. It was not for you +to be on guard." + +These were Withelm's words, but for once Raven did not heed them. + +"Would Grim, our father, have slept with a lee shore under him, leaving +a stranger to keep watch? That is not how he taught me my duty; and I +have been careless, and I know it. I should have thought of Griffin when +I saw the ship come in." + +So he had his way, and the last that I saw ere my eyes closed was his +stern form guarding us; and when I woke he was yet there, motionless, +with far-off eyes that noted the little movement that I made, and +glanced at me to see that all was well. + +In the grey of the morning the first of the chiefs to whom the arrow had +sped began to come in; but the jarl would not have Havelok waked, for he +was greatly troubled at the little wounds that had befallen this +long-waited guest. So the chiefs gathered very silently in the great +hall, and sat waiting while the light broadened and shone, gleam by +gleam, on their bright arms and anxious faces. It was not possible for +those who had not yet seen Havelok to be all so sure that it was indeed +he. They longed to see him, and to know him for the very son of Gunnar +for themselves. + +Presently there were maybe twenty chiefs in the hall--men who had +fought beside Kirkeban, and men who had been boys with Havelok, and some +who had known his grandfather--and the jarl thought that it was time +that they had the surety that they needed, for time went on, and there +was certainty that Hodulf must hear of all this morning. One could not +expect that no man would earn reward by warning him. + +So Sigurd went softly to the place where Havelok lay in the little guest +chamber that opened out of the inner room that was the jarl's own, and +he slid the boards that closed it apart gently and looked in to wake +him. But instead of doing that, he came back to the hall and beckoned +the chiefs, and they rose and followed him silently. And when they went +Raven went also, without a word, that he might be near his charge while +these many strangers spoke with him. + +Now Sigurd stood at the spot where the little shifting of the sliding +board made it possible to see within the chamber, and one by one the +chiefs came and peered through the chink for a moment, and stood aside +for the next. And it was wondrous to see how each man went and looked +with doubt or wonder or just carelessly, and then turned away with a +great light of joy on his face and a new life in the whole turn and sway +of the body. + +It was dark in the chamber, save for the dim spaces under the eaves that +let in the sweet air from the sea to the sleepers. But from somewhere +aloft, where the timbering of the upper walls toward the east had +shrunk, so that there was a little hole that faced the newly-risen sun, +came the long shaft of a sunbeam that pierced the darkness like a +glorious spear, and lit on the mighty shoulder of Havelok that lay bare +of covering, and on the white hand of Goldberga that was across it. And +on the one they saw the crimson bent-armed cross that was the mark of +the line whence he and his father had sprung, and on the other glowed +and flashed the blood-red stone of the ring of Eleyn the queen. And +round that circle of sunshine was light enough for the chiefs to see +those two noble faces, and they were content. + +"Gunnar's son," said one old chief: "but were he only the son of Grim, +for those twain would I die." + +So the warriors crept back to the hall silently as they had come; and +now they went out to their men and told them that all doubt had gone, +and along the road that led to Hodulf's town the jarl sent mounted men +to watch for his coming. And always fresh men were pouring in, and among +them went the chiefs who had seen Havelok, and told them the news. + +Now it was not long before there was a gathering of all the chiefs in +the hall of Sigurd, that they might break their fast, and then they saw +Havelok as he led in the princess to meet them. He stood on the high +place in his arms, and a shout of greeting went up; and when it was +over, Sigurd asked him to tell all that had happened to him; and he did +that in as few words as might be, for he was no great speaker, though +what he did say was always to the point, and left little to be asked. + +And when he had ended, there rose up a grey-headed old chief, and said, +"Give this warrior the horn of Gunnar, that we may hear him wind it. I +would not say that unless I were sure that he was the right man to have it." + +Now I stood beside Havelok, and while Sigurd went from the hall to some +treasure chamber to get this that had been asked for, I said to him, +"Mind you the day when we met Ragnar. and a call came into your dream? +Wind that call now; for, if I am not wrong, it will be welcome to those +who knew your father." + +"I mind the day but not the call. I have never remembered it since," he +said, and I was sorry. + +Sigurd brought the horn, and it was a wondrous one, golden and heavy. It +seemed to be a hunting horn, not very long, and little curved, but from +end to end it was wrought with strange figures of men and beasts in +rings that ran round it. + +"Have you seen this before?" asked Sigurd wistfully, and looking into +Havelok's face as he gave it into his hand. + +One could feel that men waited his answer, and it came slowly. + +"Ay, friend, I am sure that I have, but I cannot yet say when or where. +I am sure that it is not the first time that I have had it in my hand." + +And as he said this, Havelok's face flushed a little, and his brow +wrinkled as if he tried to bring back the things of that which he had +thought his dream for so long. + +It would seem that in the years there had grown up a tale that this was +a magic horn, which none but the very son of Gunnar could wind, and to +the chiefs who saw Havelok now for the first time this was a test to +prove him. But all knew that the words he spoke of it were proof enough, +for a pretender would have said plainly that it had been Gunnar's, and +that he knew it. I think that Sigurd was wise in what he did next, for +he set another horn in my brother's hand, and asked him the same +question; and at this Havelok looked for a moment and shook his head. + +"I have not seen that one before, nor one like it. I am sure that I have +seen this, or its fellow." + +At that the faces that watched brightened, for there was no doubt in the +way that Havelok spoke; and then the old chief who had asked for the +horn said, "That--'The horn of the king is sounding'--was the +gathering word of the night that has brought us here, and long have we +waited for it. Let Havelok wind his father's horn, that we may hear it +once again." + +Then Havelok set it to his lips, and at once the call that he had +remembered came back to him, and clear and sweet and full of longing its +strange notes rang under the arched roof, unfaltering until the last; +and then over him came the full remembrance of all that it had been to +him, and he turned away from the many eyes and sank on the high seat, +and set his head in his arms on the table, that men might not see that +he needs must weep; and Goldberga stepped a little before him, and set +her hand on his, for I think that she knew the loneliness that came on him. + +Yet he was not alone in his sorrow, for down in the hall were men to +whom the lost call brought back the memory of a bright young king riding +to his home, and calling the son whom he loved with the call that he had +made for him alone; and they saw the fair child running from the hall, +and the mother following more slowly with smiles of welcome; and they +saw the grim courtmen, who looked on and were glad; and they minded how +they had lifted the boy to the war saddle; and their eyes grew hot with +tears also, and they had no need to be ashamed. + +And as men stood motionless, with the last notes of the wild horn yet +ringing in their ears, there drifted a shadow across the days, and, lo! +beside Havelok, with his hand on his shoulder, stood the form of Gunnar +the king for a long moment, bright as any one of us who lived, in the +morning sunlight, and his face was full of joy and of hope and promise +for the time to come. And then he passed, but as he faded from us his +hand was on the hand of Goldberga that clasped her husband's, as though +he would wed them afresh there on the high place of his friend's hall. + +Now there went a sigh of wonder among the chiefs, and Havelok looked up +as if he followed the going of one whom he would not lose, and I know +that he saw Gunnar after he was unseen to us. + +"Surely," he said, "surely that was my father who was here?" + +And Sigurd answered, "With your own call you called him, and he was here." + +But now the last lurking doubt was gone, and there was no more delay, +for the chiefs crowded with shouts of joy to the high place, and they +knelt to Havelok and hailed him as king then and there; and so they led +him to the great door of the hall, and the mightiest of them raised him +high on a wide shield before all the freemen who waited on the green +that is round the jarl's house, and they cried, "Skoal to Havelok the king!" + +And there was in answer the most stirring shout that a man may hear-- +the shout of a host that hail the one for whom they are content to die. + +That was the first day of the reign of Havelok the king; and now there +were two kings in the land, and one was loved as few have been loved, +and the other was hated. And one was weak in men, as yet, while the +other was strong. + +Now Sigurd bade all those who were present gather in solemn Thing, that +they might make Havelok king indeed; and that was a gathering of all the +best in our quarter of the land, so that all would uphold what they had +done. And when they were gathered in the great hall in due order, the +doors were set wide open, and outside the freemen who followed the +chiefs sat in silence to see what they might and hear. + +Then swore Havelok to keep the ancient laws and customs, and to do +even-handed justice to all men, and to be bound by all else that a good +king should hold by. Sometimes these oaths are not kept as well as they +might be, but I was certain that here was one who would keep them. + +Thereafter Sigurd brought forth a crown that he had had made hastily by +his craftsmen from two gold arm rings, and they set it on Havelok's +head, and hailed him as king indeed; and one by one the chiefs came and +swore all fealty to him, beginning with Sigurd, and ending with a boy of +some seventeen winters, who looked at the king he bent before as though +he was Thor himself. + +Then they would have had Havelok forth to the people at once; but he +bade them hearken for a moment, and said, taking Goldberga by the hand, +"Were it not for this my wife, I do not think that I had been here +today, and without her I am nothing. Now I am king by your word, and I +think that I might bid you take her as queen. But I had rather that she +was made queen by your word also, that whither I live or fall in the +strife that is to come, you may fight for her." + +At that there was a murmur of praise, and all agreed that she should be +crowned at once. So Havelok set the crown on her head while the chiefs +in one voice swore to uphold her through good and ill, as though she +were Havelok himself. + +Then said Havelok, "Now have you taken her for queen for her own sake, +and I will tell you a thing that has not been heard here as yet. On this +throne sits the queen of two lands, and there shall come a day when you +and I shall set your lady on that other throne which is hers by right. +King's daughter she is, for Ethelwald of the East Angles was her father, +and out of her right has she been kept by Alsi of Lindsey, her evil +kinsman." + +At that men were glad, for great is the magic of kingly descent. And +thereupon that old warrior who had bidden Havelok sound the horn said, +"We have heard of Ethelwald the good king, and of this Alsi moreover, +and we know men who have seen both, and also Orwenna, the mother of our +own queen here. I followed your father across the seas in the old days, +and I seem to hear his voice again as you speak to us. And I saw him-- +ay, I saw him yonder even now, and I am content. When the time comes +that for the sake of Goldberga you will gather a host and cross the +'swan's path,' I will not hold back, if you will have me." + +There was spoken the mind of all that company, and they were not +backward to say so. For in the heart of the Dane is ever the love of the +sea, and of the clash of arms on a far-off strand that comes after +battle with wind and wave. + +Very bravely did Goldberga thank the chiefs for their love to her +husband and herself in a few words that were all that were needed to +bind the hearers to her, so well and truly were they chosen. And she +said that if the Anglian land was to be won it was for Havelok and not +for herself altogether, and she added, "Here we have spoken as if +already Hodulf was overthrown, and it is good that we are in such brave +heart. Yet this has been foretold to me, and I am sure that there will +be no mishap." + +Then Sigurd said, "What gift do we give our queen, now that she has come +among us?" + +But Goldberga replied, "If it is the custom that one shall be given, I +will mind you of the promise hereafter, when Anglia is won, and you and +I are Havelok's upholders on that throne. There is one thing that I will +ask then, that a wrong may be righted." + +"Nay, but we will give you some gift now, and then you shall ask what +you will also." + +"You have given me more than I dared hope," she said, "even the brave +hearts and hands that have hailed us here. I can ask no more. Only +promise to give me one boon when I need it, and I am happy." + +Then they said, "What you will, and when you will, Goldberga, the queen. +There is naught that you will ask amiss." + +Now they showed Havelok to the warriors as crowned king, and I need not +tell how he was greeted. And after that we all went back into the hall +to speak of the way in which we were to meet Hodulf. + +Havelok would have a message sent to him, bidding him give up the land +in peace. + +"It may be that thus we shall save the sadness of fighting our own +people, though, indeed, they love the playground of Hodulf. He is an +outlander, and perhaps he may think well to make terms with us." + +Some said that it was of no use, but then Havelok answered that even so +it was good to send a challenge to him. + +"For the sake of peace we will do this, though I would rather meet him +in open fight, for I have my father to avenge." + +Now I rose up and said, "Let me go and speak with him, taking Withelm as +my counsellor. For I know all the story, and that will make him sure +that he has the right man to fight against. I will speak with him in +open hall, and more than he shall learn how he thought to slay Havelok." + +All thought that this was good, and I was to go at once. It was but a +few hours' ride, as has been said, to his town, and the matter was as +well done with. + +So they gave me a guard of twenty of the jarl's courtmen, and in half an +hour I was riding northward on my errand. And to say the truth I did not +know if it was certain that I should come back, for Hodulf was hardly to +be trusted. + +I did wait to break my fast, and that was all, for I had no mind to +spend the night on the road back from the talk that I should have had; +but though I wasted so little time, the people were already beginning to +prepare for rejoicing in their own way with games of all sorts and with +feasting in the open. I saw, as we rode down the street, the piles of +firewood that were to roast oxen whole, and near them were the butts +that held ale for all comers. There were men who set up the marks for +the archers, and others who staked out the rings for the wrestling and +sword play. And as we left the town we met two men who led a great brown +bear by a ring in his nose, for the baiting. I was sorry for the poor +beast, but the men called him "Hodulf," already, and I thought that a +good sign in its way. + +Another good sign, and that one which could not be mistaken, was to see +the warriors coming in by twos and threes as the news reached them. They +were dotted along the roads from all quarters, and across the heaths we +saw the flash of the arms of more. + +And ever as they met us they hailed us with, "What cheer, comrades? Is +the news true? Is Havelok come to his own?" and the like, and they would +hurry on, rejoicing in the answer that they had. + +But I will say that presently, when we passed a stretch of wild moor +where we saw no man, the same was going on towards the town of Hodulf; +for if the news came to a village, some would be for the king that was, +and other and older men for the king that might be. Yet all asked that +question; and more than once, when they heard the reply, there would be +a halt and a talk, and then the men would turn and cast in their lot +with the son of Gunnar, hastening to him with more eager steps than had +taken them to Hodulf. + + + CHAPTER XXI. THE TOKEN OF SACK AND ANCHOR. + +It seemed only the other day that I had passed over the well-known ways, +and I showed Withelm the hollow where Grim had met with the king and +taken his precious burden from him. Then we passed along the wild shore, +and the linnets were singing and the whinchats were calling as ever, and +the old mounds of the heroes of the bygone were awesome to me now as +long ago, when I looked at them standing lonesome along the shore with +only the wash of the waves to disturb them. And so we came to the town +at high noon, and already there was the bustle of a gathering host in +the place, for the news had fled before us. + +They had built a new and greater hall in place of that which had been +burned; and there sat Hodulf with his chiefs, wondering and planning, +and maybe waiting for more certain news of what had happened. Not long +would they wait for that now. + +We rode to the door, and one came to meet us with words of welcome, +thinking that we were men who came to the levy that was gathering; but +his words stayed when I asked to be taken to the presence of Hodulf, as +I came with a message from Havelok Gunnarsson the king. + +The man, chamberlain or steward, or whatever he was, stared at me, and +said in a low voice, "It is true then?" + +"True as I am Radbard Grimsson, who helped Havelok to fly from hence." + +"Unwelcome will you be, for Hodulf is in no good mood," the man said. "I +hardly think it safe for you to trust yourself with him." + +"Then," said I, "open the door of the hall, and I will go in with my +men, and see what he says." + +"Well, that will be bad for me, but I have a mind to see Havelok." + +So I told Withelm to come at my side, and bade half the courtmen follow +us closely, and when they were inside to see that the door was not +barred after us on any pretence. The rest would bide with the horses +outside. + +Then we loosed the peace strings of our weapons, and in we went, quietly +and in order; and the chiefs turned to look at us, thinking us more of +themselves. Hodulf sat on his place on the dais, and there were +thirty-one others with him, sitting on the benches that were set along +the walls. Withelm counted them. + +Then the door was closed, and the man with whom I had spoken set his +back against it, but it was not barred; and I went forward to the steps +of the high place, and stood before Hodulf. + +"Well, what now?" he said, seeing that I was a stranger. + +"First of all, I ask for safe conduct from this hall as a messenger from +king to king." + +"That you have, of course," he answered. "What is your message?" + +It did not seem that he thought of Havelok at all, but rather that I +came from some king to whom he had sent. There were two living not so +far off. I thought that there was no good in beating about the bush, for +such an errand as mine had better he told boldly. So I spoke out for all +to hear. + +"This is the word of Havelok, son of Gunnar the king, to Hodulf of +Norway, who sits in his place. Home he has come to take his own, and now +he would tell you that the time has come that he is able to rule the +kingdom for himself." + +"And what if he has?" said Hodulf, without the least change of face, as +if he had been expecting this, and nothing more or less. + +But if he was quiet, the chiefs had heard my words in a very different +way. Some had leaped up, and others bent forward, to hear the answer to +my words the better. I heard one or two laugh; but there were some on +whose faces seemed to be written doubt and anxiety. I think that some +would have spoken, for Hodulf held up his hand for silence, and looked +to me for answer. + +"It will be well for you to give up the throne to him, making such terms +as you may," I said. + +"That is a fair offer," said Hodulf, quite unmoved, to all seeming, but +looking at me in a way that told me how his anger was held back by main +force, as it were; "but how am I to know that this one who sends so bold +a message is the real Havelok? I am not a fool that I should give up my +throne to the first who asks it. Doubtless you bring some token that you +come from the very son of Gunnar." + +"It is right that you should ask one, and also that you should have one +that there can be no mistaking," I said. "This is it. By the token of +the sack and the anchor I bid you know that Havelok sends me to you." + +At that the face of Hodulf became ashy grey beneath the tan of wind and +sea, and I saw that his hand clutched the hilt of his sword so that the +knuckles of his fingers grew white. He had never thought to hear of that +deed again, and he knew that he had to deal with the one whom he had +thought dead. Some of the young chiefs in the hall laughed at that +token, but he flashed a glance at them which stayed the laugh on their lips. + +"I know not what you mean," he said, altogether staggered. + +"It is right," I said, "that if the token is not plain I should make it +so. It is but fair also to the chiefs who are here." + +Then he stayed me. True it is that old sin makes new shame. + +"I will take it as enough," he said hastily. "I mind some old saying of +the kind. Ay, that is it--a hidden king and a voyage across the sea. +It is enough." + +"Not enough," said a chief in the hall close to the high seat. "Let this +warrior say what he means plainly." + +There were many who agreed to this, and I did not wait for Hodulf any +longer. I told them who I was, and then showed them why that token was +to be held enough for any man; and as I spoke, there were black looks +toward the high seat among the older men. As for Hodulf, he sat with a +forced smile, and seemed to listen indulgently, as to a well-made tale. + +And after that the matter was out of my hands, for the same chief who +had asked for the tale came and stood by my side, and he faced Hodulf +and spoke. + +"For twelve years have I served you as king, and now I know that I have +wasted the faith I gave you. What became of the sisters of Havelok? +Answer me that, Hodulf, or I will go and ask their brother concerning +whom you have lied to me." + +"Go and ask him," answered Hodulf, biting his lips; "go and hear more +lies. Who can know the son of Gunnar when he sees him?" + +"That is answered out of your own mouth," said the chief. "Is Sigurd a +fool that he should hail the first man who asks him to do so?" + +And from beside me Withelm answered also, "Maybe it is a pity that +Griffin of Wales was slain last night in trying to kill Havelok. He knew +him, and I have heard that he came here to warn Hodulf that his time was +come." + +Hodulf's face grew whiter when he heard that; but it was what he needed, +as some sort of excuse to let loose his passion. + +White and shaking with wrath and fear, he rose up and he cried, +"Murdered is Griffin! Ho, warriors, let not these go forth!" + +Whereon the old chief lifted his voice also, "Ho, Gunnar's men! Ho, men +who love the old line! To Grim's son, ahoy!" + +And he drew his sword, snapping the thongs that had bound it to the +sheath, so manfully tugged he at them in his wrath, and there was a rush +of men to us, and another to Hodulf. + +Now I think that we might have slain him there, and after that have been +slain ourselves, for the odds were against us, even though I had the +courtmen; but that was Havelok's deed to do, for the sake of father and +sisters to be avenged, and so we only cut our way out of the hall to the +door, which my men threw open at once. There were two of Hodulf's men +hurt only, for the most of them had run to the high place, and few were +between us and our going. So we took five chiefs and their followers +back with us, and that was worth the errand. + +We thought that it would not be long now before Hodulf was on us; but +the days passed, and there was no news of him, and all the while we grew +stronger. I do not know if the same could be said of him, and it is +doubtful if time made much difference to his forces. Those who followed +him were the men who owed all to him, either as men raised to some sort +of power when he first came, or else strangers whom he had brought in +with him. Some of the younger chiefs of the old families held by him +also, for they had known no other, and then there were old feuds with +Gunnar that held back some from us; but these few took part with neither +side. + +So before a week was out we had a matter of six thousand men in and +about the town; and it seemed that, with so good a force, it was as well +to march on Hodulf as to wait for him. And that was good hearing for us +all, for there was not a man who did not long to be up and doing, though +to smite a blow for Havelok should be the last deed that he might do. + +They made me captain of the courtmen who were Havelok's own, maybe +because I had served with Alsi, and Withelm was captain of Goldberga's +own guard. High honour was that for the sons of Grim, for there was not +one in either of these companies but was of high birth; but then we were +Havelok's brothers, and all seemed well content to serve under us. I +wanted Raven to be in my place, but he said that he was no warrior on shore. + +"Just now I am Havelok's watchdog, to be at his heels always. Presently, +if he likes to give me a ship when we sail to England, that will suit me." + +So Havelok made him his standard bearer; and as that would keep him at +the king's side in the thickest fight, he was well pleased. Goldberga +wrought the standard that he bore, with the help of Sigurd's wife, and +on it was the figure of Grim, sword and shield in hand, but with his +helm at his feet, as showing that he had laid it by; and on either side +of him stood Havelok and his wife, each with a crown above their heads, +as though they waited for the coming time when they should be set there +firmly by the bearing forward of this banner. Havelok bore his axe, +holding out the ring to Goldberga with the other hand, while she had her +sceptre in the left, and stretched the right hand to her husband. There +were runes that told the names of these three, for that is needful in +such work, as it passes the skill of woman to make a good likeness, nor +do I think it would be lucky to do so if it could be compassed. Wondrous +was the banner with gold and bright colours, and it was hung from a +gilded spear, ashen hafted, and long, that it might be seen afar in battle. + +Now on the day when Havelok set his men in order for the march on Hodulf +word came that he was coming at last. It is likely that he knew we were +on the point of marching, and would choose his own ground on which to +wait for us. So we went to certain battle, as it seemed, and none were +sorry for that. So in the bright sunshine of a cloudless morning Havelok +and Goldberga rode down the line of the men, who would fight to the +death for them, and those two were good to look on. Day and night +Sigurd's weapon smiths had wrought to make a mail shirt that should be +worthy of a king, and I thought that they had wrought well. They had set +a crown round the helm that they made for him, and Sigurd had given him +a sword that had been his father's at one time, golden hilted, and with +runes on its blue blade. But Havelok would not part with the axe that +Grim had given him, plain as it was, and that was his chosen weapon. + +But for once I think that men looked more at her who rode at Havelok's +side than at him, goodly and kingly as he was in the war gear. For +Goldberga had on a silver coat of chain mail, and a little gold circlet +was round the silver helm that she wore, while at her saddle bow was an +axe, on which were runes written in gold, and a sword light enough for +her hand was in a gem-studded baldric from her shoulder. There was a +chief who had given her these, and it was said that they had first of +all belonged to one who had fought as a shield maiden at the great +battle of Dunheidi, by the side of Hervoer, the sister of the mighty +hero Angantyr. His forefather had won them at that time, and now they +were worn by one who was surely like the Valkyries, for no fairer or +more wondrous to look on in war gear could they be than our English queen. + +She would have gone even into the battle with Havelok, but that neither +he nor we would suffer. She was to bide here in the town until we came +back in triumph or defeat; and as men looked on her, they grew strong, +that no tears might be for those bright eyes. + +Now I left them before the march began, for I and the courtmen were to +go forward and see where the foe was posted, and so bring word again. +And we went some five miles before we saw the first sign of them. Then +on a rise in the wild heath waited a few horsemen, who watched us for a +little while, and then rode away from us and beyond it. We followed +them, and when we came to where they had been, we saw that they had +fallen back on a company of about the same strength as ours, save that +there were more horsemen. I was the only mounted man of my little force, +and that rather to save my strength than because I liked riding. I +should certainly fight on foot, as would Havelok himself, in the old +way. It is not good to trust to the four feet of a horse when one means +business. + +We bided where we were, waiting to see what these men did, and soon +beyond them grew the long cloud of dust starred with shifting sparks +that told us that the host of Hodulf was on foot and advancing. It +seemed to me that here we had a good place to meet it, for the land went +down in a long slope that was in our favour, and therefore I set a man +on my horse, and sent him back with all speed to Havelok to bid him +hasten. Our host was not so far behind me, and I could see both from +this hill. We had full time to take position here before Hodulf's army +was in reach. + +Now it seemed that the foemen would see what they could also, and they +began to move toward us. It was plain that we should have a small fight +on our own account directly, for I did not mean to let them take our +place. We moved, therefore, toward them, and at that the half-dozen +horsemen made for us at a trot. Then I saw that their leader was Hodulf +himself. + +We were in a track that led across the hill, and here on the slope it +was worn deep with ages of traffic between the two towns, and on either +side the heather grew thick and high, so that the horsemen could not get +round us. So Hodulf rode forward to where we barred the way, and told me +to stand aside. + +"What next?" I asked. "I may as well bid you go back, for I came here to +stop you." + +"Come over to me, and leave this half-crowned kinglet of yours. It shall +be worth your while." + +"Hard up for men must you be, Hodulf," said one of my courtmen, laughing. + +At that he made a sign to his followers, for they came on us at the +gallop, with levelled spears. We closed up, and hewed the spear points +off, and then dealt with the horses and men who foundered among us, and +they struggled back, leaving three men and four horses in the roadway. +It was bravely done, too, for there were only eight of them, and they +did us no harm beyond a bruise or two. I wished that we had taken or +slain Hodulf, however, for that might have made things easier in the end. + +Hodulf got back to his courtmen, and now they came on. At that moment +over the hill behind us rode Havelok and Raven, and saw at once what was +on hand. They had ridden on, but the host was hard after them. + +"Send a man to bid the host halt," Havelok said to me, "for we can end +the matter here. Now shall I be hand to hand with Hodulf, even as I +would wish." + +I sent a man back as he bade me, and he stayed the host half a mile +beyond the hill, where they were not seen. Hodulf's army was yet two +miles away across the heath, and none had gone back to hasten it. + +Now Havelok went forward, holding up his hand in token of parley, and +his enemy rode from his men to meet him. + +"There is much between us, Hodulf," Havelok said, "and we have been +together along this road before. Yet for the sake of the men who follow +us it may be that we can make peace." + +"That is for me to say," answered Hodulf, "for you have invaded my land, +and are the peace breaker." + +"I might mind you of a blood feud between us two," said Havelok, "but +that is not the business of the host. For the sake of the land I will +say this. Give up the throne that you have held for me, and you shall go +hence with what treasure you have gathered, taking your Norsemen with +you. There will be no shame in doing that, for I am able now to hold the +land for myself." + +Hodulf laughed a short laugh. + +"Fine talk that for the son of Grim the thrall, who drowned Havelok for +me! 'Nidring' should I be if I gave up to you." + +"If things must go in that way, we will settle the matter here and now. +Will you that we fight hand to hand while our men look on, or shall we +go back to them and charge? I like the first plan best myself, as I +would avenge my father and sisters, and also that insult of the way in +which we passed this road together twelve years ago." + +So said Havelok, and his words fell like ice from his lips, and he was +very still as he spoke, though the red flush crept into his cheek and +his brows lowered. + +And Hodulf did not answer at once. He looked at the towering young +warrior before him, and maybe into his mind there crept the thought of +the children whom he had slain, whom this one would avenge. Well he knew +that the true Havelok was speaking with him, though he would not own it, +and branded my father with the name of thrall for the sake of insult to +his foster son. + +At last he said, "We will go back to the men, for you have advantage in +that bulk of yours." + +"As you will," answered Havelok. "Twelve years ago that was on your side." + +He reined round at once, and touched his horse with the spur without +another glance at his enemy. And then we shouted, and Raven spurred +forward with a great oath, for Hodulf plucked his sword from the +scabbard, and with a new treachery in his heart, rode after our brother +and was almost on him. The shout was just in time, for Havelok turned in +his saddle as the blow was falling. + +Quick as light, he took it on the shaft of the spear he carried, and +turned it, wheeling his horse short round at the same time. Lindsey +training was there in that horsemanship of his. Hodulf's horse shot past +as the blow failed, and then Raven seemed to be the next man to be dealt +with. + +But Havelok called to him to stand aside, for this was his own fight; +and at that Hodulf had his horse in hand again, and was ready to meet +his foe fairly. + +And now Havelok had cast aside the spear, and taken the axe from the +saddle bow; and these two met, unshielded, for neither had time to +unsling the round buckler from his shoulder. + +It was no long fight, for now Hodulf's men were coming up, and there +need be no more thought of aught but ending one who was ready to smite a +foul blow before us all shamelessly. Havelok spurred his horse, and the +two met and closed for one moment. Then down went the Norseman with +cleft helm, and the old wrongs were avenged, and there was but one king +in the land. + +Then Hodulf's men were on Havelok, but not before Raven was at his back, +and over Hodulf there was a struggle in which Havelok was in peril for a +short time before we closed round him. Well fought the courtmen of the +fallen king, and well fought my men, and we bore them back, fighting +every foot of ground, until there were only five of them left, and these +five yielded in all honour, being outnumbered. Yet ours was a smaller +band by half ere there was an end. + +It had not lasted long, and still the host of Hodulf was so far off that +they knew not so much as that there was any fighting. Then we went to +the hilltop, and set the banner there, and our line came on and halted +along the crest. + +One hardly need say what wonder and rejoicing there was when it was +known how Hodulf had met his end, and Sigurd and other chiefs went to +where we had fought, and looked on him. And one took the helm, which had +round it the stolen crown, and gave it to Havelok. + +"Set it on the standard," he said, "for we may need that it shall be +shown presently. As for Hodulf, bear him aside out of the path of the +host, that we may lay him in mound when all is ended." + +One cried that he did not deserve honour of any kind, and there were +some who agreed to that openly. I will not say that I was not one of +them, for I had seen the foul play, and heard the insult to Grim, my father. + +But Havelok answered gravely, "He has been a king, and I have not heard +that he was altogether a bad one. All else was between him and me, and +that is paid for by his death. Think only of the twelve years in which +you have owned him as lord, and then you will know that it is right that +he should be given the last honours. You had no feud as had I." + +Then they did as he bade them, and that gladly, for the words were +king-like, and of good omen for the days to come. I saw Sigurd and the +older chiefs glance at each other, and it was plain that they were well +pleased. + +Now the host came on, and it was greater than ours; but when there was +no sign of its leader the march wavered, and at last halted altogether. +Whereon some chiefs rode to speak to us, and Havelok met them with his +leaders. He had to speak first, for they could not well ask where Hodulf +was. The helm was a token that told them much. + +"I met your king even now," he said, "and I offered him peace and +honourable return to Norway with his property if he would give up the +throne that is mine by right. Maybe I was wrong in thinking that he +might do so, but he refused. There were certain matters between us two, +besides that of the crown, which needed settling; and therefore, after +that, I challenged him to fight on these points, that being needful +before they were done with. So we fought, and our feud was ended. Hodulf +is dead, and his courtmen would not live after him while there was a +chance of avenging his fall. That was before the host came up. Now I +offer peace and friendship to all, and I can blame none who have held to +the king who has fallen. It was not to be expected that all would own me +at once. Only those Norsemen who came with Hodulf or have come hither +since must leave the land, and they shall go in honour, taking their +goods with them. Their time is up; that is all." + +It was a long speech for Havelok, but in it was all that could be said. +Long and closely did the chiefs look at him as he spoke, for none of +them had seen him before. His words were not idly to be set aside +either, and they spoke together in a low voice when he had ended. + +"This is a matter for the whole host to settle," one said at last. "We +will speak to them, and give you an answer shortly." + +"Take one of Hodulf's courtmen with you, that he may tell all of the +fight," Havelok said: "he need not come back." + +I gave the man his arms again, for he might as well have them if he stayed. + +"Thanks, lord," he said. "Here is one who will tell the truth for Havelok." + +Then our host sat down, and we watched the foemen as the news came to +them. We could not hear, of course, for they were a quarter of a mile +away, but if any tumult rose we should be warned in time. They were very +still, however. There was a long talk, and then one chief came back to us. + +"I am going to ask a strange thing," he said, "but the men wish to see +Havelok face to face." + +Now Sigurd said that this was too great a risk, and even Withelm agreed +with him. + +But Havelok answered, "The men are my own men, but they are not sure +that I am the right king. It is plain that I am like my father, and +therefore it is safe for me to go." + +"That," said the chief, "is what we told them, and what they wish to see." + +"Then," said Havelok, "I will come. Bid your men sit down, and bid the +horsemen dismount, and I will ride to them with five others. Then can be +no fear on either side." + +"That will do well," said Sigurd; and the chief went back, and at once +the host sat down. + +Then Havelok rode to them, and with him went we three and Sigurd and Biorn. + +There was a murmur of wonder as he came, and it grew louder as he +unhelmed and stayed before them. + +And then one shouted, "Skoal to Havelok Gunnarsson!" and at once the +shout was taken up along the line. And that shout grew until the chiefs +joined in it, for it was the voice of the host, which cannot be +gainsaid; and without more delay, one by one the leaders pressed forward +and knelt on one knee to their king, and did homage to him. Only the +Norsemen held back; and presently, when we were talking to the Danish +chiefs in all friendly wise, they drew apart with their men, and formed +up into a close-ranked body that looked dangerous. + +"Surely they do not mean to fight!" said Withelm. + +Then one of them shouted that he must speak to the king, and that seemed +as if they owned him at least, so Havelok went to them. + +"You have heard my terms," he said, "and I think that they are all that +you could ask. What is amiss?" + +"Your terms are good enough," the speaker said, "and we know that our +time is come. But we must have surety that the people will not fall on +us, for we are flying, as it were. And we want the body of our king. We +would not have him buried any wise, as if he was a thrall." + +"He shall be given to you, and as for the rest none shall harm you. +Moreover, for that saying about your king I will add this: that if there +are any of you who hold lands to which there is no Danish heir, he shall +take service with me if he will, and so keep them." + +So there was no man in all the host who was not content; and that was +the second king-making of Havelok, as it were, for now there was no man +against him. The hosts were disbanded then and there, and we went that +day to Hodulf's town, and took possession of all that had been in his +hands. Then was rejoicing over all the land, for a king of the old line +was on the throne once more, and his way was full of promise. + + + CHAPTER XXII. KING ALSI'S WELCOME. + +Now there was one thing that was in the minds of all of us, and that was +the winning of Goldberga's kingdom for her; but that was a matter which +was not to be thought of yet for a long while. Two years were we in +Denmark, and well loved was Havelok by all, whether one speaks of the +other kings who owned him as Gunnar's heir at once, or the people over +whom he and Goldberga reigned. But we sent messages to Arngeir and to +Ragnar to say that all was well, and we heard from them in time how Alsi +feared what was to come, and had rather make friends with the Anglians +than offend them. So he had not given out anything that was against the +princess, but had told all how she had wedded the heir of Denmark, and +that she had given up her land to himself, and followed her husband +across the sea. It was not hard for him to feign gladness in her +well-doing; and Berthun counselled Ragnar to let things be thus, and yet +prepare for her return. + +In my own heart was the wish to go back to England always, for there was +my home; and I found that it was the same with my brothers, for there is +that in the English land which makes all who touch it love it. And there +was the mound that held my father, and there were the folk among whom we +had been brought up in the town that we had made; and I longed to see +once more the green marshes and the grey wolds of Lindsey, and the brown +waves of the wide Humber rolling shorewards, line after line. I tired of +the heaths and forests and peat mosses of this land of my birth. And if +that was so to me, it was a yet deeper longing in the hearts of the +brothers who hardly remembered this place; and after a while we spoke of +it more often. + +I do not know if we said much to others, but at last the younger chiefs +began to wonder when the promised time when they should cross the +"swan's path" for Goldberga should come. Maybe they tired of the long +peace, as a Dane will. But when that talk began, Withelm knew that +things were ripe, and he told Havelok. That was in the third spring of +Havelok's kingship, when it grew near to the time when men fit out their +ships. + +"This is what I have looked for," he said; "and now we will delay no +longer, for here am I king indeed, and there is none who will rise +against me. Wonderful it is that men have hailed me thus. And now I will +tell you, brother, that I long for England. If I might take my friends +with me, I do not think that I should care if I never came here again. +It is not my home; and here my Goldberga is not altogether happy, well +as the folk love her." + +Thereafter he called a great Thing[12] of all the +freemen in the land, and set the matter plainly before them, asking if +they minded the words he spoke when they crowned the queen, and if they +were still ready to follow him to the winning of her crown beyond the sea. + +There was no doubt what the answer would be; and it was said at once +that the sooner the ships were got ready the better. + +"Then," said Havelok, "who shall mind this land while I am away? It may +be long ere I come back." + +Now there was a cry that I should be king while Havelok was away, +forsooth! and a poor hand I should have made at the business. But I said +that it was foolishness, and that, moreover, I would go with Havelok. +And when they said that this was modesty on my part, I answered that I +had seen several kings, and that there was but one who was worth +thinking of, and that was my brother; therefore, I would go on serving +him where I could see him. + +"This is what Grim, my father, said to me long ago," I said--"I was to +mind the old saying, 'Bare is back without brother behind it;' and, +therefore, I must see Havelok safe through this." + +"Why, brother," says Havelok, laughing, "if that saying must be +remembered--and I at least know it is true--it would make for +leaving you behind me here to see all fair when my back was turned." + +Then he saw that I was grieved, for I thought for the moment that he +would bid me to stay, and so I should have to do so; but he took my part. + +"I cannot be without my brothers," he said. "If I had any word in the +matter--which mainly concerns the folk to be ruled, as it seems to me +(for I do not know of any man who would not uphold me)--I should say +that Sigurd the jarl was the right man, for all know that he is a good +ruler, nor will it be any new thing to submit to him." + +That pleased all, and the end of it was that Sigurd was chosen to hold +the land for Havelok. + +Then Sigurd sat on the steps of the high place at Havelok's feet, and +the king said, "I have no need to tell any man here who this is, and why +I think him worthy of the highest honour, for all know him and his worth +as well as I. Mainly by him was the thought of my return kept in the +minds of men, so that when the time came all were ready to hail me, as +you have done. Therefore, as by him I am king, so I make him king also +for me. He shall rule all the land while I am away, and to him shall all +men account as to me. And because it is right that his kingship should +be certain, I give him all his jarldom as a kingdom from henceforth, +only subject to me and my heirs as overlord. King therefore he is, and +none can say that you are ruled by naught but a jarl." + +Then Havelok girt on the new king's sword, and set his own crowned helm +on his head for a moment; and all the Thing hailed him gladly, for he +was the right man without doubt. + +Then Sigurd did homage for his new honour; and after that he rose up, +and grew red and uneasy, as if there was somewhat that he wished to say, +and was half afraid to do so. + +Thereat some friend in the hall said, "You take your kingship worse than +did Radbard himself, as it seems. What is amiss?" + +"Why, I wanted to go on the Viking path with Havelok, and now it seems +that I cannot." + +Then one shouted, "I never heard of a land going wrong while its king +was away risking his life to get property for his men. There is no man +here who is going to rise against either you or Havelok. And it is only +to send a message to our great overlord to say what we are about, and he +will see that the land is in peace. Nor do I think that any king would +harry Havelok's land, for he is well loved by all his peers." + +Wherefore it seemed that Sigurd must go also, and we had to set Biorn as +head man while Sigurd was away; but that would only be for a month or +two. So all things were ordered well, and in a month we set sail with +twenty ships, and in them a matter of fifteen hundred men. + +At first we thought that we would make for Grimsby; but then it seemed +best to land elsewhere, and more to the south, for we would have +messages sent at once to Ragnar to call East Anglia to Havelok's banner, +and Alsi would have less chance of cutting us off from him. So we sailed +to Saltfleet haven, which lies some twenty-five miles southward from +Grimsby. Raven piloted us in safely, and there were none to hinder our +landing. The town was empty, indeed, when the ships came into the haven, +for all had fled in haste, except a few thralls, for fear of the Vikings. + +Yet when we sent these thralls to say that Goldberga had come for her +own, the people came back and made us welcome, for her story was in +every mouth; and after that we fared well in Saltfleet, and men began to +gather to us. + +We sent to Arngeir and to Ragnar at once, and next day the Grimsby folk +were with us, but long before any word could come to Norwich, Alsi had +set about gathering a host against us. + +But we had not come to fight him for Lindsey, and our errand was to bid +him give up her own rights to Goldberga. One must be ready with the +strong hand if one expects to find justice from such a man; and Havelok +had thought it possible that if we came here first we should bring him +to reason at once, whereas if we went to Norfolk there would be fighting +with all the host of the Lindsey kingdom before long; while if he did +fight here we might save Goldberga's land from that trouble, and maybe +have fewer to deal with. + +So a message was to be sent to Alsi at once, bidding him know that +Goldberga had come to ask for her rights, and that he might give them to +her in all honour. Arngeir was to take this, for it did not seem right +that a Dane should do so, and he was one who would be listened to. I was +to go with him, with my courtmen as guard; and we rode to Lincoln on the +fourth day after our coming to Saltfleet. Good it was to ride over the +old land again, and I thought that it had never looked more fair with +the ripening harvest, for when last I had seen it there was none. The +track of the famine was yet on all the villages, for fewer folk were in +them than in the days before the pestilence and the dearth, but these +had enough and to spare. + +And when these poor folk heard from us that Curan and his princess had +come again for what was hers, they took rusty weapons and flint-tipped +arrows and stone hammers from the hiding places in the thatch of their +hovels, and went across the marshlands to where the little hill of +Saltfleet stands above its haven, that they might help the one whom they +had loved as a fisher lad to become a mighty king. + +So we came to Lincoln, and already there was a gathering of thanes and +their men in the town, and they knew on what errand we had come well +enough. But they were courteous, and we were given quarters in the town +at once, that we might see Alsi with the first light in the morning. + +I will not say that we had a quiet night there, for we did not trust +Alsi; but we had no need to fear. In the morning Eglaf came to bid us to +the palace to speak with the king. + +"This is about what I expected, when I heard of the mistake that our +king had made," he said, "and so far you are in luck. It is not everyone +who is a fisher one day and captain of the courtmen next, as one might +say. I like the look of your men, and I am going to take some of the +credit of that to myself, for a man has to learn before he can command." + +"I will not deny your share in the matter," I answered, laughing, "for +had it not been for my time with you I had been at sea altogether. Now, +shall we have to fight you?" + +He shrugged his broad shoulders. + +"Who knows what is in the mind of our king? I do not, and you know +enough of him by this time to be certain that one cannot guess. He may +be all smiles and rejoicing that his dear niece has come back safely, or +just the other way. He has been very careful how he has dealt with the +Norfolk thanes of late, and what that means I do not know." + +Then he asked what had become of Griffin, and I told him. I do not think +that he was surprised, for some word of the matter had reached here by +the news that chapmen bring from all parts. + +Now there was no more time for talk, for we came to the hall; and we +went in, Arngeir leading, and the rest of us following two by two. The +hall was pretty full of thanes and their men, and it was just as I had +last seen it. Alsi sat alone on his high seat, and there was no man with +him on the dais. I thought that he looked thinner and anxious. + +Arngeir went up the hall at once, and stood before the king, and greeted +him in the English way, which seemed strange to me after the two years +of Danish customs; and then Alsi bade him tell his errand. + +"I have come from Goldberga of East Anglia, and from Havelok the Dane, +her husband, to say that she has returned to her land, and would ask +that you would give her the throne that you have held for her since the +day that her father made you her guardian. It has been said that she +might ask you to give account of your management of the realm to her; +but that she does not wish to do, being sure that all will be rightly +done in the matter, and she only asks to be set in the place that was +her father's." + +So said Arngeir, plainly, and I could see that the thanes thought the +words good. + +And Alsi answered, "Has this matter been put before the Witan of the +East Angles?" + +I suppose that he thought to hear Arngeir say that there had been no +time for so doing at present, but my brother was readier than I should +have been. + +"Doubtless it has," he said, "for that was your own promise to Goldberga +on her marriage." + +At that Alsi flushed, and his brows wrinkled. He had said nothing to the +Witan at all, but had waited in hopes that he should hear no more of his +niece, telling the tale that we had heard. + +"I have had no answer from them," he said at last, for Arngeir was +looking at him in a way that he could not meet. "It was her saying that +she would do this for herself." + +"Then they do not refuse," said Arngeir quietly, "nor did I think that +they would do so. It only remains therefore, that you, King Alsi, should +do your part. Then can the queen speak to the Witan, even as she said, +concerning her husband." + +Now it must have been clear to the king that nothing short of a plain +answer would be taken, and he sat and thought for a while. One could see +that he was planning what to say, as if things had not gone as he +expected. Maybe he hoped to put off the matter by talk of asking the +Witan, and so to gain time, for we had certainly taken him unawares. + +At last he said, "How am I to know that you are here with full power to +speak for Goldberga? For this is a weighty matter." + +Arngeir held out his hand, and on it was the ring of Orwenna the queen, +which Alsi had last seen here on the high place. + +"There is the token, King Alsi, and it is one which you know well," he +answered. + +"Ay, I know it," answered the king with a grin that was not pleasant. + +And then he said, "I will speak with my thanes, and give you word to +carry back in an hour's time, now that I know you to be a true messenger." + +"There should be no reason for waiting so long as that, nor do I think +that the matter of the throne of East Anglia is a question for Lindsey +thanes," answered Arngeir at once. "All this is between you and the +princess." + +Thereat one of the thanes rose up and said, "If a kingdom has been +handed over to our king, it is not to be taken again without our having +a good deal to say about it. I do not know, moreover, if we can have a +foreigner over any part of our land." + +"Goldberga never gave up her right to the kingdom," Arngeir answered, +"as anyone who was here at the wedding would tell you. And as for +Havelok, her husband, being a foreigner, it seems to me that a Jute who +has been brought up here in Lindsey since he was seven winters old is +less a foreigner than a Briton is to us." + +None made any answer to that, and I could see that the king was growing +angry at being met thus at every turn. But he began to smile in that way +of his that I had learned to mistrust. + +"That is not altogether courteous to either Goldberga or myself," he +said, as if he would think the words a jest, seeing that he was half +Welsh. "Give me time, I pray you, to think of this, as I have asked, and +you shall go back with your answer." + +There was no help for it, and we had to leave the hall in order that +Alsi might say what he had to say to his thanes. And I said to Arngeir +that it seemed that we should have to fight the matter out. + +"Alsi risks losing both kingdoms if he does that," he answered, "for we +shall take what we choose if we are the victors. The visions that have +been thus right so far say that we shall be so." + +"I shall be glad if we do come out on the right side," I said; "but I +have not so much faith in these dream tellings as some. Nor do I think +that it seems altogether fair to fight on a certainty." + +"When it is a matter of punishing one who does not keep faith, I do not +think that it matters much," he answered, laughing. "I should like +certainty that he would not get the best of the honest side in that case." + +We were outside on the wide green within the square of the Roman walls +at this time, and now from within the hall came the sound of shouts and +cheering which we heard plainly enough. But whether it meant that the +thanes cheered Alsi because he would fight, rather than that they +applauded his justice to his niece, was not to be known as yet. As for +me, I thought that it was hardly likely to be the latter. + +Then came three thanes from the hail with the message, and it was this, +"Alsi bids Havelok go back to his own land and bide content therewith." + +"What word is there for Goldberga, then?" asked Arngeir. + +"None. She has thrown in her lot with the Dane, and it is he with whom +we will not deal." + +Then said I, "How was it that she had to throw in her lot with Havelok? +He was Alsi's own choice for her." + +"That is not what we have heard," the spokesman answered. "Now it is +best that you go hence, for you have the answer." + +"This means fighting for Goldberga's rights," said Arngeir, "and I will +tell you that Havelok will not be backward in the matter." + +"In that case we shall meet again on the battlefield ere long," answered +the thane. "I will not say that Havelok is in the wrong, and things +might have been better settled. Farewell till then. The Norns will show +who is right." + +So we went, and I thought, as did Arngeir, that there was some little +feeling among his men that Alsi was wrong. + +Now Alsi set to work to gather forces in earnest, and he went to work in +a way that was all his own: for, saying nothing about Goldberga, he sent +to all his thanes with word that the Vikings had come in force and +invaded the land, led by the son of Gunnar Kirkeban, whose ways were +worse than those of his father, for he spared none, whereas Kirkeban +harried but the Welsh Christian folk. He prayed them therefore to +hasten, that this scourge might be driven back to the sea whence he +came. And that brought men to him fast, for no Englishman can bear that +an invader shall set foot on his shore, be he who he may. Few knew who +the wife of Havelok was at that time, but I do not know that it would +have made so much difference if they had. None thought that into England +had come the fair princess who was so well loved. + +Sorely troubled was Goldberga when she heard this answer, but it was all +that the rest of us looked for. And the next question was how best to +meet the false king. + +In the end we did a thing that may seem to some to have been rash +altogether, but it was our wish to compel Alsi to fight before his force +was great enough to crush us. It might be long before Ragnar could raise +a host and join us, for there was always a chance that he might have +trouble in getting the Norfolk thanes to come to his standard for a +march on Lindsey. If we had gone to Norfolk at once there would have +been no fear of that kind, but the fighting might have been more bitter +and longer drawn out. + +We sent the fleet southward into the Wash, that it might wait for us at +the port of the Fossdyke, on what men call the Frieston shore; and then +we left Saltfleet and marched across country to the wolds, and southward +and westward along them, that we might draw Alsi from Lincoln. And all +the way men joined us for the sake of Curan, whom they knew, and of +Goldberga, of whom they had heard, so that in numbers at least our host +was a great one. Ragged it might be, as one may say, with the wild +marshmen, who had no sort of training and no chiefs to keep them in +hand; but I knew that no host Alsi could get together had any such +trained force in it as we had in the fifteen hundred Vikings, for they +had seen many fights, and the ways of the sea teach men to hold together +and to obey orders at once and without hesitating. + +So we went until we came to Tetford, above Horncastle town; and there is +a great camp on a hilltop, made by the British, no doubt, in the days +when they fought with Rome. There we stayed, for Alsi was upon us. We +saw the fires of his camp in the village and on the hillsides across the +valley, but a mile or two from us that night; and it seemed that his +host was greater than ours, as we thought it would be, but not so much +so as to cause dread of the battle that was to come. + +Now there were two men who came to us that night, and we thought that +they had brought some message from Alsi at first. But all that they +wanted was to join Havelok, and we were glad of them. They were those +two seconds of Griffin's, Cadwal and the other, whose name was Idrys, +and with them was David the priest, who had fled to us. + +"We know that Havelok is one who is worth fighting for," they said, "for +we have proved it already. We are not Alsi's men, and our fathers fought +for his mother's Welsh kin against the English long ago. Let us fight +for the rights of Goldberga, at least." + +Havelok welcomed them in all friendliness, though he asked them if they +had no grudge against him for the slaying of Griffin. + +"As to that," they said, "after the duel we think that he deserved all +that has befallen him. We were ashamed to be his seconds." + +Now these two took in hand to lead the marshmen, and set to work with +them at once, for they were ready to follow them as known thanes of the +British. And that was something gained. + +We slept on our arms that night, and all night long David woke and +prayed for our success, and I think that his prayers were not lost. + + + CHAPTER XXIII. BY TETFORD STREAM. + +In the early morning Alsi set his men in order in the valley, and seemed +to wait for us to come down to him, for it was of no use to try to take +the strong camp which sheltered us. And so, after council held, we did +not keep him waiting, but left the hill and marched on him. We had the +camp to fall back on if things went the wrong way, and beyond that the +road to the sea and the ships was open, with a chance of meeting Ragnar +on the way, moreover. + +Very long and deep seemed the line as we neared it, and it was formed on +the banks of a stream that runs down the valley, so that we must cross +the water to attack. But the stream was shallow now with the August +heat, and it was not much sunk between its banks. + +When he saw that, Sigurd, who was a man of many fights, said that we had +better send the marshmen round to fall on the wings of the foe, while we +went straight for the centre of the line in the wedge formation that the +Viking loves. For so we should have no trouble in crossing the stream, +and should cut the force against us in two. + +So the two Welsh thanes led their wild levies out on either side of us +Danes, who were in the centre, and then we formed the wedge. Havelok +himself would have gone first of all at its point: but that we would not +suffer, for if he fell the battle was lost at its beginning. + +"Nay," he said, "for we fight for Goldberga." + +"And what would she say were we to set you foremost of us all?" asked +Withelm. "Little love were there to either of you in that. You are the +heart of the host, and one shields that although it gives strength to +all the hands which obey it." + +So Withelm and Arngeir and I went foremost, and behind us came the +courtmen, and in the midst of their shield wall was Havelok, with Raven +and the banner at his side. After them, rank on rank and with +close-locked shields, was such a force as had not been seen in Lindsey +for many a long day. Alsi's men grew very silent as they saw us come on, +until we reached, through a storm of arrows that could not stay us, the +bank of the stream, and then they raised a war song that roared and +thundered among the hills as though the tide was coming up the valley in +one great wave. But we saved our breath until the first of us were on +the banks of the stream, and then I shouted, and with a great shout of +"Ahoy!" in answer, we charged through the stream and up the far bank, +where Alsi's spearmen waited for us. + +They crowded together as they saw how narrow our front was, and there +was a hedge of steel before us three brothers; but the spear is not the +weapon to use if one would check the onrush of the Northman's wedge, and +shield and axe between them dashed and hewed a way to the men who got to +their swords too late, and then we were in the midst of Alsi's line, +with the gap that we had made widening behind us with each step that we +took forward. + +Now it was sheer hewing at the mass who crowded on us; and I mind how we +seemed to fight in silence, although the battle cries were unceasing, +and waxed ever louder; for it was as when one walks by the shore and +thinks not at all of the noise of breakers that never ends. Now and then +there was one shout that was new, and it seemed to be the only voice. +Most of all, the noise grew on the wings where the savage Welsh fell on +their masters and ancient foes in wild tumult. + +We tried to cut our way to Alsi, for we could see him as he sat on his +horse--the only mounted man in all the hosts; but we could not reach +him. And presently the time came when we who were foremost must let +fresh men take our places. Sigurd stepped to my side, and Withelm fell +back, and another took the place of Arngeir, and then my turn came, and +we went slowly from the front to where the hollow centre of the wedge +gave us rest. Only a few arrows fell there now and then; but the time +for using bows was past, seeing that we were hand to hand with all the +Lindsey host. And then I saw that Sigurd had done what we had failed in, +for he had reached the shield wall that was round the king himself. And +for a moment I was savage that the chance came to him so soon after I +had left the fighting line; but then I minded that Eglaf, my friend, +would be there, and I was glad that I need not cross swords with him +after all. I had thought of that happening before the fight began, but +in the turmoil of hottest struggle I had forgotten it. + +Now Sigurd was before the thick mass of the housecarls, and hand to hand +with them; and then he was among them, and he leapt at the bridle of +Alsi's horse and grasped it. I saw the king's sword flash down on his +helm, and he reeled under the stroke, but without letting go of the +rein. Then the housecarls made a rush, and bore back our men, and the +horse reared suddenly. There was a wild shout, and the war saddle was +empty; and again our men surged forward, so that I could not see what +had happened. + +But now our Welshmen had been beaten back from the wings--not easily, +but for want of training--and they were forced back across the brook, +and there held our bank well, giving way no step further. The water kept +them in an even front, against their will, as it were; and Alsi's men +charged them in vain, knee deep in the stream that ran red. But that let +loose the men who had been held back from us; and now we were overborne +by numbers, and we began to go back. That was the worst part of the +whole fight, and the hardest hour of all the battle, as may be supposed, +for the wedge grew closer, as it was forced together by sheer weight. +None ever broke into it. + +Presently our rear was on the water's edge, and it seemed likely that in +crossing there might be a breaking of the line; and when he saw that, +Havelok called to me, and he went to the front with the courtmen round +him. It was good to hear the cheers of our men as they saw the dancing +banner above the fight, and beneath it, in the bright sun, the +gold-circled helm of their king. The Lindseymen drew back a foot's pace +as they saw the giant who came on them, and I heard some call that this +was Curan of Grimsby, as if in wonder. Then we had to fight hard, and +Sigurd fell back past me, with a wound on his shoulder where Alsi's +sword had glanced from the helm. No life had been left to Sigurd had a +better hand wielded the weapon; but he was not badly hurt. I could not +see Alsi anywhere, nor Eglaf. + +Steadily the numbers drove us back, though before Havelok was always a +space into which men hardly dared to come. The wedge was pushed away +from us, and we had to fall back with it, until we crossed the stream; +and there Sigurd swung the massed men into line, and then came the first +pause in the fight. The two hosts stood, with the narrow water between +them, and glared on each other, silent now. And then the bowmen began to +get to work from either side, until the arrows were all gone. + +Now Havelok called to the foe, and they were silent while he spoke to them. + +"Is Alsi yet alive?" he said; "for if not, I have no war with his men. +If he is, let me speak with him." + +None answered for a while, and the men looked at each other as if they +knew not if the man they were fighting for lived or not. + +Then one came forward and said, "Alsi lives, and we have not done with +you yet. Get you back to your home beyond the sea!" + +And then they charged us again; but the water was a better front for us +than it had been for them, and across it they could not win. We drove +them back once and twice; and again came a time when both sides were +wearied and must needs rest. + +So it went on until night fell. We never stirred from that water's edge, +and the stream was choked with valiant English and hardy Danes; and yet +the attacks came with the shout of "Out! out!" and the answer from us of +"Havelok, ahoy!" + +At last one who seemed a great chief came and cried a truce, for night +was falling; and he said that if Havelok would claim no advantage +therefrom, the men of Lindsey would get back from the field, and leave +it free for us to take our fallen. + +"But I must have your word that with the end of that task you go back to +the place you now hold, that we may begin afresh, if it seems good to +us, in the morning." + +Then said Havelok, "That is well spoken, and I cannot but agree. Who are +you, however, for I must know that this is said with authority?" + +"I am the Earl of Chester," he answered. "Alsi has set the leading of +the host in my hands, for he is hurt somewhat." + +"I did not think that Mercians would have troubled to fight to uphold +Alsi of Lindsey in his ways with his niece," Havelok said. + +"What is that?" said the earl. "Hither came I for love of fighting, +maybe, in the first place; and next to drive out certain Vikings. I know +naught of the business of which you speak." + +"Then," said I, "go and ask Eglaf, the captain of the housecarls, for he +knows all about it. We are no raiding Danes, but those who fight for +Goldberga of East Anglia." + +At that a hum of voices went down the English line, and this earl bit +his lip in doubt. + +"Well," he said, "that is Alsi's affair, and I will speak to him. We +have had a good fight, and I will not say that either of us has the best +of it. Shall it be as I have said?" + +"Ay," answered Havelok; and the earl drew off his men for half a mile, +and in the gathering dusk we crossed the brook, and went on our errand +across the field. It was not hard to find our men, for they lay in a +great wedge as we had fought. There had been no straggling from that +array, and no break had been made in its lines. Alsi had lost more than +we, for his men had beaten against that steel wall in vain, and the arms +of the Northman are better than those of any other nation. + +We took the wounded back to the camp, and there Goldberga and the wives +of our English thanes tended them; and as we gathered up the slain the +Lindsey men were among us at the same work, and we spoke to them as if +naught was amiss between us, nor any fight to begin again in the +morning. And then we learned how few knew what we had come for. It was +with them as with the Earl of Chester. They had no knowledge of +Goldberga's homecoming, and least of all thought that at the back of the +trouble were the wiles of Alsi. It was two years ago that Goldberga had +gone, and her wedding had seemed to end her story. Now the men heard and +wondered; and it is said that very many left Alsi that night and went +home, angry with him for his falsehood. + +Now when all was done we sought rest, and weary we were. I will say for +myself that I did not feel like fighting next morning at all, for I was +tired out, and the one or two wounds that I had were getting sorely +stiff. Raven was much in the same case, and grumbled, sailor-wise, at +the weight of the banner and aught else that came uppermost in his mind. +Yet I knew that he would be the first to go forward again when the time +came. + +The host slept on their arms along the bank of the stream through the +hot night, and the banner was pitched in their midst. Soon the moon +rose, and only the footsteps of the sentries along our front went up and +down, while across the water was the same silence; for both hosts were +wearied out, and each had learned that the other were true men, and +there was no mistrust on either side. When the light came once more we +should fight to prove who were the best men at arms, and with no hatred +between us. + +Presently the mists crept up from the stream and wreathed the sleepers +on either bank with white, swaying clouds, and I mind that the last +thought I had before I closed my eyes was that my armour would be rusted +by the clinging damp--as if it were not war-stained from helm to +deerskin shoe already with stains that needed more cleansing than any rust. + +Then I waked suddenly, for someone went past me, and I sat up to see who +it might be. The moon was very bright and high now, but the figure that +I saw wading in the white mist was shadowy, and I could not tell who it +was. And then another and yet another figure came from the rear of our +line, and passed among the sleeping ranks, and joined the first +noiselessly; and after a little while many came, hurrying, and they +formed up on the bank of the stream into the mighty wedge. And I feared +greatly, for not one of the sleepers stirred as the warriors went among +us, and I had looked on the faces of those who passed me, and I knew +that they were the dead whom I had seen the men gather even now and lay +in their last rank beyond our line. + +Then I saw that on the far bank was gathered another host, and that was +of Alsi's men, and among them I knew the forms of some who had fallen in +the first onset when I led the charge. + +I tried to put forth my hand to wake Withelm, but I could not stir, and +when I would have spoken, I could frame no word, so that alone in all +the host I saw the slain men fight their battle over again, step by +step. The wedge of the Northmen won to the far shore as we had won--as +they had won in life but a few hours ago--and into the line of foemen +they cut their way, and on the far side of the stream they stayed and +fought, as it had been in the battle. Yet though one could see that the +men shouted and cried, there was no sound at all, and among the wildest +turmoil walked the sentries of Alsi's host unconcerned and unknowing. +And to me they seemed to be the ghosts, and the phantom strife that +which was real. + +Then I was ware of a stranger thing yet than all I had seen so far, for +on the field were more than those whom I knew. There stood watching on +either side of the battle two other ghostly hosts, taking no part in the +struggle, but watching it as we had watched from our place when we fell +back into the rear to rest, pointing and seeming to cheer strokes that +were good and deeds that were valiant. And I knew that these were men +who had fought and died on this same field in older days, for on one +side were the white-clad Britons, and on the other the stern, dark-faced +Romans, steel and bronze from head to foot. + +So the battle went onward to where we had won and had been pressed back; +and then, little by little, the hosts faded away, and with them went the +watchers, and surely across the field went the quick gallop of no +earthly steeds, the passing to Odin of the choosers of the slain, the +Valkyries. + +Then came across the brook to me one through the mist, and the sentries +paid no heed to him, and he came to my side and spoke to me. It was +Cadwal, the Welsh thane, and his breast was gashed so that I thought +that he could not have lived. + +"Ay, I am dead," he said, "as men count death, and yet I would have part +in victory over Alsi, for the sake of Havelok and of Goldberga. Stay up +my body on the morrow, that I may seem to fight at least, that I may +bide in the ranks once more in the day of victory. Little victory have +the British seen since Hengist came. Say that you will do this." + +Then he looked wistfully at me, and I gave him some token of assent; and +at that came back all the shadows of our men, and seemed to pray the +same. And then was a stir of feet near me, and a shadow across the +trampled grass, and instead of the dead the voice of Havelok spoke +softly to me, and with him was Goldberga, clad in her mail. And I +thought that they and I were slain also, and I cried to this one who +seemed to be one of Odin's maidens that I too would fain be stayed up +with Cadwal and the rest, that I might have part in victory. + +Then Goldberga stooped to me, and laid her soft hand on my forehead, and +took off my helm, so that the air came to me, and thereat I woke altogether. + +"Brother," she said, "you are restless and sorely wounded, as it seems. +It is not good that you should lie in this mist." + +At her voice the others woke, and for a while she talked with us in a +low tone, cheering us. And presently she asked of that strange request +that I had made to her. + +I told her, for it was a message that should not be kept back, thus +given; and when he heard it, Withelm sighed a little, and said, "Would +that we had all those who have fallen. Yet if it is as they have asked +our brother, our host will seem as strong as before we joined battle in +the morning. Leave this to me, brother, for it may be done." + +Then he rose up and went softly to where Idrys, the friend of Cadwal, +lay, and spoke long with him. It was true that Cadwal was slain, though +I had not yet heard of it until he told me himself thus. + +Then I slept heavily, while the others talked for a while. It is a hard +place at a wedge tip when Englishmen are against one; and I am not much +use in a council. Presently they would wake me if my word was wanted. + +But it was not needed, for the sunlight woke me. There was a growing +stir in our lines and across the water also, and I looked round. The +mists were yet dense, for there was not enough breeze to stir the heavy +folds of the banner, and Raven slept still with his arm round its staff. +Havelok was not here now, and I thought that he had gone to the camp +with Goldberga, and would be back shortly. + +Then I saw that our rear rank was already formed up, as I thought, and +that is not quite the order of things, as a rule, and it seemed far off +from the stream. I thought that they should have asked me about this, +for there were some of my courtmen in that line. + +And then I saw that in the line was no movement, and no flash of arms, +as when one man speaks to another, turning a little. And before that +line stood the form of a chief who leant on his broad spear, motionless +and seeming watchful. I knew him at once, and it was Cadwal, and those +he commanded were the dead. That was even to me an awesome sight, for in +the mists they seemed ready and waiting for the word that would never +come to their ears, resting on the spears that they could use no more. +It had been done by the marshmen in the dark hours of the morning, and +from across the stream I saw Alsi's men staring at the new force that +they thought had come to help us. There were men enough moving along our +bank with food to us to prevent them seeing that this line stirred not +at all. + +There was a scald who came with us from Denmark, and now with the full +rising of the sun he took his harp and went along the stream bank +singing the song of Dunheidi fight and so sweet was his voice, and so +strong, that even Alsi's men gathered to hearken to him. His name was +Heidrek, and he has set all that he saw with Havelok into a saga; but +we, here, mostly remember the brave waking that he gave us that morning. +It was wonderful how the bright song cheered us. One saw that the +stiffened limbs shook themselves into litheness once more, and the +listless faces brightened, and into the hearts that were heavy came new +hope, and that was the song's work. + +Now men began to jest with their foes across the stream, and those who +had Danish loaves threw them across in exchange for English, that they +might have somewhat to talk of. Ours were rye, and theirs of barley; but +it was not a fair change after ours had been so long a voyage. + +It was not long before our war horns sounded for the mustering, and men +ran to their arms. The Lindsey host drew back from the talk with our men +at the same time, and, without waiting for word from their leaders, +began to get in line along the stream, where they had been when we +halted last night. But we had no thought of falling on them until we had +had some parley with the king or the Earl of Chester. And now it was +plain that with the grim rearguard behind us we outnumbered the men of +Alsi who were left. + +Now came from the village in rear of the foe a little company, in the +midst of which was one horseman, and that was the king himself. His arm +was slung to his breast, and he sat his horse weakly, so that it was +true enough that he had been hurt. With him were the earl and Eglaf, and +the housecarls, and I sent one to fetch Havelok quickly, that there +might be no delay in the words that were to be said. + +Alsi rode to the water's edge and looked out over our host, and his +white face became whiter, and his thin lips twitched as he saw that our +line was no weaker than it had seemed when first he saw it. He spoke to +the earl, and he too counted the odds before him, and he smiled a little +to himself. He had not much to say to Alsi. + +Then broke out a thunderous cheer from all our men, for with Havelok and +Sigurd at her horse's rein, and with Withelm's courtmen of her own guard +behind her, came Goldberga the queen to speak with the man who had +broken his trust. She had on her mail, as on the day when we ended +Hodulf; and she rode to the centre of our line, and there stayed, with a +flush on her cheek that the wild shouts of our men had called there. + +Then I heard the name of "Goldberga, Goldberga!" run down the English +line, and I saw Alsi shrink back into himself, as it were; and then some +Lincoln men close to him began to grow restless, and all at once they +lifted their helms and cheered also, and that cheer was taken up by all +the host, as it seemed, until the ring of hills seemed alive with +voices. And with that Alsi half turned his horse to fly. + +Yet his men did not mean to leave him. It was but the hailing of the +lady whom they knew, and her coming thus was more than the simple +warriors had wit or mind to fathom. But now Goldberga held up her hand, +and the cries ceased, and silence came. Then she lifted her voice, clear +as a silver bell, and said, "It seems strange to me that English folk +should be fighting against me and my husband's men who have brought me +home. I would know the meaning of this, King Alsi, for it would seem +that your oath to my father is badly kept. Maybe I have thought that the +people would not have me in his place; but their voice does not ring in +those shouts, for which I thank them with all my heart, as if they hated +me. Now, therefore, I myself ask that my guardian will give up to me +that which is my own." + +We held our peace, but a hum of talk went all through the English ranks. +The Earl of Chester sat down on the bank, and set his sword across his +knees, and began to tie the peace strings round the hilt, in token that +he was going to fight no more. Now and then he looked at Goldberga, and +smiled at her earnest face. But Alsi made no sign of answer. + +Then the queen spoke again to him. + +"There must be some reason why you have thus set a host in arms against +me," she said, "and what that may be I would know." + +Then, as Alsi answered not at all, the earl spoke frankly. + +"We were told that we had to drive out the Vikings, and I must say that +they do not go easily. But it was not told us that they came here to +right a wrong, else had I not fought." + +Many called out in the same words, and then sat down as the earl had done. + +And at last Alsi spoke for himself. + +"We do not fight against you, my niece, but against the Danes. We cannot +have them in the country." + +"They do not mean to bide here, but they will not go before my throne is +given to me. Never came a foreign host into a land in more friendly wise +than this of mine." + +At that Alsi's face seemed to clear, and his forced smile came to him. +He looked round on the thanes who were nearest him, and coughed, and +then answered, "Here has been some mistake, my niece, and it has cost +many good lives. If it is even as you say, get you to your land of +Anglia, and there shall be peace. I myself will send word to Ragnar that +he shall hail you as queen." + +Then up spoke a new voice, and it was one that I knew well. + +"No need to do that, lord king," said Berthun the cook. "Here have I +come posthaste, and riding day and night, to say that Ragnar is but a +day's march from here, that he and all Norfolk may see that their queen +comes to her own." + +Then Alsi's face grew ashy pale, and without another word he swung his +horse round and went his way. I saw him reel in the saddle before he had +gone far, and Eglaf set his arm round him and stayed him up. After him +Goldberga looked wistfully, for she was forgiving, and had fain that he +had spoken one word of sorrow. But none else heeded him, for now the +thanes, led by the earl himself, came thronging across the water, that +they might ask forgiveness for even seeming to withstand Goldberga. And +on both sides the men set down their arms, and began to pile mighty +fires, that the peace made should not want its handfasting feast. + +For the fair princess had won her own, and there was naught but gladness. + + + CHAPTER XXIV. PEACE, AND FAREWELL. + +Now there was feasting enough, and somewhere they found at a thane's +house a great tent, and they set that up, so that Havelok and Goldberga +might have their own court round them, as it were. Gladly did Berthun +rid himself of war gear and take to his old trade again. I suppose that +the little Tetford valley had never heard the like sounds of rejoicing +before. + +Near midnight a man came to me and said that a message had come to me +from the other side, and I rose from the board and went out, to find +Eglaf waiting for me in the moonlight. He was armed, and his face was +wan and tired. + +"Come apart, friend," he said; "I have a message from the king." + +"To me?" + +"No, to Havelok. But you must hear it first, and then tell him as you will." + +We walked away from the tent and across the hillside for some way, and +then he said without more words, "This is the message that Alsi sends to +Havelok, whose name was Curan. 'Forgive the things that are past, for +many there are that need forgiving. I have no heir, and it is for myself +that I have schemed amiss. In Lincoln town lies a great treasure, of +which Eglaf and I alone know. Give it, I pray you, to your Danes, that +they may harm the land not at all, and so shall I ward off some of the +evil that might come through me even yet. I think that, after me, you +shall be king.'" + +"That is wise of Alsi; but is there no word for Goldberga?" + +"Ay, but not by my mouth. I fetched David the priest two hours ago, and +he bears those messages." + +"Is there yet more to say?" I asked, for it seemed to me that there was. + +"There is," he answered. "Alsi is dead." + +So there was an end of all his schemings, and I will say no more of +them. It was Eglaf's thought that it was not so much his hurts that had +killed the king, but a broken heart because of this failure. For the +second time now I knew that it is true that "old sin makes new shame." + +Now how we told Havelok this, and how Goldberga was somewhat comforted +by the words that David the priest brought her from her uncle, there is +no need to say. But when the news was known in all the host of Lindsey, +there was a great gathering of all in the wide meadow, and we sat in the +camp and wondered what end should be to the talk. Ragnar had come; but +his host was now no great one, for we had sent word to him of the peace, +and there was a great welcome for him and his men. + +The Lindsey thanes did not talk long, and presently some half dozen of +the best of them came to us, and said that with one accord the gathering +would ask that Havelok and Goldberga should reign over them. + +"We will answer for all in the land," they said. "If there are other +thanes who should have had a word in the matter, they are not here +because, knowing more than we, they would not fight for Alsi in this +quarrel. If there is any other man to be thought of, he cannot go +against the word of the host." + +"I have my kingdom in Denmark," said Havelok, "and my wife has hers in +Anglia. How should we take this? See, here is Ragnar of Norwich; he is +worthy to be king, if any. Here, too, is the Earl of Chester, who led +you. It will be well to set these two names before the host." + +"The host will have none but Havelok and Goldberga," they said. + +So the long-ago visions came to pass, and in a few days more we were +feasting in the old hall at Lincoln. But before we left the valley of +the battle we laid in mound in all honour those who had fallen. Seven +great mounds we made, at which men wonder and will wonder while they +stand at Tetford. For well fought the Danes of Goldberga, and well +fought the Lindseymen on that day. Yet I think that those who would fain +have lived to see the victory had their share in it, as they stood in +their grim and silent ranks behind us. + +Then was a new crowning of those two, and messages to the overlord of +Lindsey, sent by the thanes, to say that all was settled on the old +lines of peaceful tribute to be paid; and then, when word and presents +came back from him, Goldberga rose up on the high place where she had +been so strangely wedded, and looked down at the joyous faces of her +nobles at the long tables. + +"When I was crowned in Denmark," she said, "there was a promise made me, +that when this day came to me in Norfolk I might ask one boon of all who +upheld me. I do not know if I may ask it here and now, for the promise +was made by my husband's people. Yet it is a matter that is dear to my +heart that I shall seek from you all, if I may." + +Then all the hall rang with voices that bade her ask what she would; and +she bowed and flushed red, and hesitated a little. Then she took heart +and spoke. + +"It is but this," she said. "Let the poor Christian folk bide in peace; +and if teachers come from the south or from the north presently who will +speak of that faith, bear with them, I pray you, for they work no harm +indeed." + +Almost was she weeping as she said this, and her white hands were +clasped tightly before her. But she looked bravely at the thanes, and +waited for the answer, though I think that she feared what it would be. + +But an old thane rose up in his place, smiling, and he answered, "If you +had commanded us this, my queen, it would have been done. The Christian +folk, if there are any, shall have no hurt. I think that we had +forgotten the old days of trouble with them. Yet I hear that in Kent the +new faith, as it seems to us, is being taught, and that the king looks +on it with favour. It may be that here it will come also. For your sake +I will listen if a teacher comes to me." + +The thanes thought little of this boon, and they all answered that it +was freely granted. But they said that it was no boon to give, and bade +her ask somewhat that was better. + +"Why then," she said, "if I must ask more, think no more of me as queen +save as that I am the wife of the king. Havelok is your ruler in good +sooth." + +That pleased them all well, and they laughed and wished that all had +wives who had no mind to rule. + +"Here is word that is going home to my wife," said one to his neighbour. +"If the queen sets the fashion of obedience, it behoves all good wives +to follow her leading." + +"Maybe I would let some other than yourself tell the lady that," +answered the other thane with a great laugh, for he knew that household +and its ruler. + +So Goldberga had her will, and then began the long years of peace and +happiness to the kingdoms of which all men know. Wherefore I think that +my story is done. What I have told is halting maybe, and rough, but it +is true. And Goldberga, my sister, says that it is good. Which is all +the praise that I need. + +------------------------------------------------------------------------ + +So far went Radbard, my friend, and then he would tell no more. So it is +left to me, Wislac the priest, who have written for him, to finish. He +says that everyone knows the rest, and so they do just now. But in the +years to come, when this story is read, men will want to know more. So +it is fit that I should end the story, telling things that I myself know +to be true also. + +Sigurd's host went back in the autumn, rich with the treasure of Alsi +the king; and from that time forward no Danish host ever sought our +shores. Wars enough have been in England here, but they have not harmed +us. No host has been suffered to cross the borders of Lindsey or East +Anglia, save in peace, and in the wars of Penda of Mercia Havelok has +taken no part. Yet he has had to fight to hold his own more than once, +but always with victory, for always the prayers of the few Christians +have been with him. + +They set Earl Ragnar to hold the southern kingdom for Havelok and his +wife; and presently, when he was left a widower, he wedded the youngest +daughter of Grim, Havelok's foster father. Eglaf was captain of the +Lincoln courtmen or housecarls, whichever the right name may be among +those who speak of them. One name is Danish and the other English, but +they mean the same. As for my good friend Radbard, he was high sheriff +before long, and that he is yet. He wedded Ragnar's sister the year that +Havelok was crowned in Norwich, which was the next year after the +crowning at Lincoln. + +Raven went back to the sea, and he will now be in Denmark or else on the +Viking path with Sigurd, for that is what he best loves. Arngeir bides +at Grimsby, high in honour with all, and the port and town grow greater +and more prosperous year by year. Wise was Grim when he chose to stay in +the place where he had chanced to come, if it were not more than chance +that brought him. I suppose that for all time the ships that are from +Grimsby will be free from all dues in the ports that are Havelok's in +the Danish land. Witlaf, the good old thane, bides in his place yet, and +he rejoices ever that he had a hand in bringing Havelok up. Nor does our +king forget that. + +Indeed, I think that he forgets naught but ill done toward him. Never is +a man who has done one little thing for him overlooked, if he is met by +our king after many years, and that is a royal gift indeed. + +I would that all married folk were as are this royal couple of ours. +Never are they happy apart, and never has a word gone awry between them. +If one speaks of Havelok, one must needs think of Goldberga; and if one +says a word of the queen, one means the king also. Happy in their people +and in their wondrous fair children are they, and that is all that can +be wished for them. + +There was one thing wanting for long years, that I and Withelm ever +longed for for Havelok--a thing for which Goldberga prayed ever. I +came to them from Queen Bertha in Kent, when good old David died; and at +that time Havelok was not a Christian, but surely the most Christian +heathen that ever was. I knew that he must come into the faith at some +time; and I, at least, could not find it in my heart to blame him +altogether for holding to the Asir whom his fathers worshipped. It was +in sheer honesty and singleness of heart that he did so, and I had never +skill enough to show him the right. But Withelm, who has long been a +priest of the faith, and shall surely be our bishop ere long, had more +to do with his conversion than any other. + +Yet it did not come until the days when Paulinus came from York and +preached with the fire of the missionary to us all. And then we saw the +mighty warrior go down to the water in the white robe of the catechumen, +and come therefrom with his face shining with a new and wondrous light. + +Then he founded a monastery at Grimsby, that there the men of the marsh, +who had been kind to him in the old days, might find teachers in all +that was good; and there it will surely be after many a long year, until +there is need for its work no more, if such a time ever comes. + +So the land grows Christian fast, and good will be its folk if they +follow the way of king and queen and their brothers. + +Now have I finished also, and this is farewell. Look you, husbands and +wives, that you may be said to be like Havelok and Goldberga; and see, +brothers, that you mind the words that Grim spoke to his sons, and which +they heeded so well-- + +"Bare is back without brother behind it." And that is a true word, +though it was a heathen who spoke it. + +THE END. + +1 I have to thank the Mayor of Grimsby for most kindly +furnishing me with an impression of this ancient seal. + +2 Now Nishni-Novgorod, from time immemorial the great +meetingplace of north and south, east and west. + +3 The garth was the fenced and stockaded enclosure +round a northern homestead. + +4 The seax was the heavy, curved dagger carried by men +of all ranks. + +5 The northern sea god and goddess. + +6 Men drowned at sea were thought to go to the halls of +Pan and Aegir. Ran is represented as fishing for heroes in time of storm. + +7 The Norns were the Fates of the northern mythology. + +8 The "Witanagemot," the representative assembly for +the kingdom, whence our Parliament sprang. + +9 The greatest term of reproach for a coward. + +10 The gold ring kept in the Temple of the Asir, on +which all oaths must be sworn. + +11 The sanctuary of the Asir. Thorsway and Withern in +Lincolnshire both preserve the name in the last and first syllable +respectively, both meaning "Thor's sanctuary." + +12 The northern equivalent of the Saxon "Folkmote," or +general assembly of the people. + + + + + + +End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Havelok The Dane, by Charles Whistler + +*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK HAVELOK THE DANE *** + +***** This file should be named 12847.txt or 12847.zip ***** +This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: + https://www.gutenberg.org/1/2/8/4/12847/ + +Produced by Martin Robb. + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions +will be renamed. + +Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no +one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation +(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without +permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, +set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to +copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to +protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project +Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you +charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you +do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the +rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose +such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and +research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do +practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is +subject to the trademark license, especially commercial +redistribution. + + + +*** START: FULL LICENSE *** + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project +Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project +Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at +https://gutenberg.org/license). + + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy +all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. +If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the +terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or +entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. + +1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement +and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" +or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the +collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an +individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are +located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from +copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative +works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg +are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project +Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by +freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of +this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with +the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by +keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project +Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in +a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check +the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement +before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or +creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project +Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning +the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United +States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate +access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently +whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the +phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project +Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, +copied or distributed: + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived +from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is +posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied +and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees +or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work +with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the +work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 +through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the +Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or +1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional +terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked +to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the +permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg-tm License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any +word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or +distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than +"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version +posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), +you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a +copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon +request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other +form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided +that + +- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is + owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he + has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the + Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments + must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you + prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax + returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and + sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the + address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to + the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm + License. You must require such a user to return or + destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium + and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of + Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any + money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days + of receipt of the work. + +- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set +forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from +both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael +Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the +Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm +collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain +"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual +property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a +computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by +your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right +of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with +your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with +the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a +refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity +providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to +receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy +is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further +opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO +WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. +If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the +law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be +interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by +the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any +provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance +with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, +promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, +harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, +that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do +or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm +work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any +Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. + + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm + +Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers +including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists +because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from +people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. +To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 +and the Foundation web page at https://www.pglaf.org. + + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive +Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at +https://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent +permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. +Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered +throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at +809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email +business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact +information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official +page at https://pglaf.org + +For additional contact information: + Dr. Gregory B. Newby + Chief Executive and Director + gbnewby@pglaf.org + + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide +spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To +SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any +particular state visit https://pglaf.org + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including including checks, online payments and credit card +donations. To donate, please visit: https://pglaf.org/donate + + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. + +Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm +concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared +with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project +Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. + + +Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + + +Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: + + https://www.gutenberg.org + +This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. diff --git a/old/old/12847.zip b/old/old/12847.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..7ef642c --- /dev/null +++ b/old/old/12847.zip |
